summaryrefslogtreecommitdiffstats
path: root/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
authorPete Travis <immanetize@fedoraproject.org>2014-10-01 11:33:51 -0600
committerPete Travis <immanetize@fedoraproject.org>2014-10-01 11:33:51 -0600
commit3f6c1435a4cbdf73a65639b05898a01c0dfc21ac (patch)
treec29f3db44b106fc8b145656cd0238341551b22c0 /scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib
parent46c50fce0354d81d347a8055314a688fc8aa9f52 (diff)
downloadrpmbuild-sles10-bash.tar.gz
rpmbuild-sles10-bash.tar.xz
rpmbuild-sles10-bash.zip
we might need this sles10 stuff latersles10-bash
Diffstat (limited to 'scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib')
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/Makefile.in158
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/collsyms.h140
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/doc/Makefile5
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/doc/glob.texi1
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/glob.c885
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/glob.h35
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/glob_loop.c67
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/ndir.h50
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/sm_loop.c760
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/smatch.c393
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/strmatch.c79
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/strmatch.h62
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/xmbsrtowcs.c250
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/ChangeLog4
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/Makefile.in465
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/VERSION1
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/bindtextdom.c374
-rwxr-xr-xscratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/config.charset467
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/dcgettext.c59
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/dcigettext.c1246
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/dcngettext.c60
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/dgettext.c59
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/dngettext.c61
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/eval-plural.h114
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/explodename.c192
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/finddomain.c195
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/gettext.c64
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/gettextP.h224
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/gmo.h148
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/hash-string.h59
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/intl-compat.c151
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/l10nflist.c453
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/libgnuintl.h.in309
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/loadinfo.h156
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/loadmsgcat.c1322
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/localcharset.c398
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/localcharset.h42
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/locale.alias78
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/localealias.c419
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/localename.c772
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/log.c104
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/ngettext.c68
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/os2compat.c98
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/os2compat.h46
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/osdep.c24
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/plural-exp.c156
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/plural-exp.h126
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/plural.c1518
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/plural.y409
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/ref-add.sin31
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/ref-del.sin26
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/relocatable.c439
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/relocatable.h67
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/textdomain.c142
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/Makefile.in139
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/alloca.c482
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/getpagesize.h58
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/i386-alloca.s16
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/imalloc.h168
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/malloc.c1305
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/mstats.h108
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/shmalloc.h68
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/stats.c202
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/stub.c22
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/table.c290
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/table.h103
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/trace.c125
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/watch.c150
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/watch.h39
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/x386-alloca.s63
-rwxr-xr-xscratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/xleaktrace43
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/xmalloc.c94
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/COPYING339
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/ChangeLog403
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/Makefile.in366
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/README6
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/STANDALONE2
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/ansi_stdlib.h54
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/bind.c2279
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/callback.c260
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/chardefs.h165
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/compat.c113
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/complete.c2211
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/display.c2379
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/Makefile144
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/fdl.texi452
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/history.texi104
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/hstech.texi573
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/hsuser.texi457
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/rlman.texi101
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/rltech.texi2285
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/rluser.texi1846
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/rluserman.texi88
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/version.texi10
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/emacs_keymap.c873
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/Inputrc81
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/Makefile44
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/excallback.c188
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/fileman.c485
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/histexamp.c124
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/manexamp.c112
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/rl.c158
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/rlcat.c180
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/rltest.c93
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/funmap.c255
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/histexpand.c1593
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/histfile.c542
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/histlib.h82
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/history.c441
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/history.h266
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/histsearch.c195
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/input.c570
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/isearch.c666
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/keymaps.c149
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/keymaps.h103
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/kill.c693
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/macro.c271
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/mbutil.c373
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/misc.c601
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/nls.c252
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/parens.c183
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/posixdir.h61
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/posixjmp.h40
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/posixstat.h142
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/readline.c1194
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/readline.h849
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rlconf.h60
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rldefs.h160
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rlmbutil.h146
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rlprivate.h420
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rlshell.h34
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rlstdc.h45
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rltty.c1035
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rltty.h82
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rltypedefs.h94
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rlwinsize.h57
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/savestring.c37
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/search.c572
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/shell.c208
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/signals.c426
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/tcap.h60
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/terminal.c698
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/text.c1639
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/tilde.c502
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/tilde.h81
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/undo.c268
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/util.c355
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/vi_keymap.c877
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/vi_mode.c1717
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/xmalloc.c88
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/xmalloc.h46
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/Makefile.in455
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/clktck.c59
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/clock.c81
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/fmtullong.c29
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/fmtulong.c190
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/fmtumax.c25
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/getcwd.c313
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/getenv.c233
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/inet_aton.c210
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/itos.c72
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/mailstat.c159
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/makepath.c118
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/memset.c26
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/mktime.c425
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/netconn.c83
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/netopen.c340
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/oslib.c296
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/pathcanon.c234
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/pathphys.c296
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/rename.c76
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/setlinebuf.c63
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/shmatch.c121
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/shquote.c276
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/shtty.c284
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/snprintf.c2107
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/spell.c188
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strcasecmp.c84
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strerror.c74
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strftime.c874
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strindex.c47
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/stringlist.c297
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/stringvec.c232
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strnlen.c45
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strpbrk.c44
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strstr.c122
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtod.c197
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtoimax.c106
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtol.c258
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtoll.c26
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtoul.c26
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtoull.c27
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtoumax.c106
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtrans.c274
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/times.c77
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/timeval.c145
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/tmpfile.c216
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/vprint.c85
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/winsize.c82
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/xstrchr.c78
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/zcatfd.c68
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/zread.c136
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/zwrite.c62
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/Makefile.in91
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/COPYING347
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/ChangeLog137
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/INSTALL176
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/Makefile.in138
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/NEWS20
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/README34
-rwxr-xr-xscratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/configure998
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/configure.in23
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/termcap.info80
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/termcap.info-11114
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/termcap.info-2974
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/termcap.info-31480
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/termcap.info-4220
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/termcap.texi3617
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/texinfo.tex4422
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/ltcap.h29
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/termcap.c800
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/termcap.h62
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/tparam.c334
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/version.c18
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/tilde/Makefile.in127
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/tilde/README5
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/tilde/shell.c70
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/tilde/tilde.c502
-rw-r--r--scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/tilde/tilde.h81
229 files changed, 80155 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/Makefile.in b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/Makefile.in
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9bb4dd3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/Makefile.in
@@ -0,0 +1,158 @@
+## -*- text -*- ####################################################
+# #
+# Makefile for the GNU Glob Library. #
+# #
+####################################################################
+#
+# Copyright (C) 1996-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+# any later version.
+
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+# GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA.
+
+srcdir = @srcdir@
+VPATH = .:@srcdir@
+topdir = @top_srcdir@
+BUILD_DIR = @BUILD_DIR@
+
+INSTALL = @INSTALL@
+INSTALL_PROGRAM = @INSTALL_PROGRAM@
+INSTALL_DATA = @INSTALL_DATA@
+
+CC = @CC@
+RANLIB = @RANLIB@
+AR = @AR@
+ARFLAGS = @ARFLAGS@
+RM = rm
+CP = cp
+MV = mv
+
+SHELL = @MAKE_SHELL@
+
+PROFILE_FLAGS = @PROFILE_FLAGS@
+
+CFLAGS = @CFLAGS@
+LOCAL_CFLAGS = @LOCAL_CFLAGS@
+CPPFLAGS = @CPPFLAGS@
+LDFLAGS = @LDFLAGS@ @LOCAL_LDFLAGS@
+
+DEFS = @DEFS@
+LOCAL_DEFS = @LOCAL_DEFS@
+
+BASHINCDIR = ${topdir}/include
+
+INCLUDES = -I. -I../.. -I$(topdir) -I$(BASHINCDIR) -I$(topdir)/lib
+
+CCFLAGS = $(PROFILE_FLAGS) $(DEFS) $(LOCAL_DEFS) $(CPPFLAGS) ${INCLUDES} \
+ $(LOCAL_CFLAGS) $(CFLAGS)
+
+# Here is a rule for making .o files from .c files that doesn't force
+# the type of the machine (like -sun3) into the flags.
+.c.o:
+ $(CC) -c $(CCFLAGS) $<
+
+# The name of the library target.
+LIBRARY_NAME = libglob.a
+
+# The C code source files for this library.
+CSOURCES = $(srcdir)/glob.c $(srcdir)/strmatch.c $(srcdir)/smatch.c \
+ $(srcdir)/xmbsrtowcs.c
+
+# The header files for this library.
+HSOURCES = $(srcdir)/strmatch.h
+
+OBJECTS = glob.o strmatch.o smatch.o xmbsrtowcs.o
+
+# The texinfo files which document this library.
+DOCSOURCE = doc/glob.texi
+DOCOBJECT = doc/glob.dvi
+DOCSUPPORT = doc/Makefile
+DOCUMENTATION = $(DOCSOURCE) $(DOCOBJECT) $(DOCSUPPORT)
+
+SUPPORT = Makefile ChangeLog $(DOCSUPPORT)
+
+SOURCES = $(CSOURCES) $(HSOURCES) $(DOCSOURCE)
+
+THINGS_TO_TAR = $(SOURCES) $(SUPPORT)
+
+######################################################################
+
+all: $(LIBRARY_NAME)
+
+$(LIBRARY_NAME): $(OBJECTS)
+ $(RM) -f $@
+ $(AR) $(ARFLAGS) $@ $(OBJECTS)
+ -test -n "$(RANLIB)" && $(RANLIB) $@
+
+what-tar:
+ @for file in $(THINGS_TO_TAR); do \
+ echo $(selfdir)$$file; \
+ done
+
+documentation: force
+ -(cd doc; $(MAKE) $(MFLAGS))
+force:
+
+# The rule for 'includes' is written funny so that the if statement
+# always returns TRUE unless there really was an error installing the
+# include files.
+install:
+
+clean:
+ rm -f $(OBJECTS) $(LIBRARY_NAME)
+ -(cd doc && $(MAKE) $(MFLAGS) $@ )
+
+realclean distclean maintainer-clean: clean
+ -( cd doc && $(MAKE) $(MFLAGS) $@ )
+ $(RM) -f Makefile
+
+mostlyclean: clean
+ -( cd doc && $(MAKE) $(MFLAGS) $@ )
+
+######################################################################
+# #
+# Dependencies for the object files which make up this library. #
+# #
+######################################################################
+
+smatch.o: strmatch.h
+smatch.o: $(BUILD_DIR)/config.h
+smatch.o: $(BASHINCDIR)/chartypes.h
+smatch.o: $(BASHINCDIR)/ansi_stdlib.h $(topdir)/bashansi.h
+smatch.o: $(BASHINCDIR)/shmbutil.h
+smatch.o: $(topdir)/xmalloc.h
+
+strmatch.o: strmatch.h
+strmatch.o: $(BUILD_DIR)/config.h
+strmatch.o: $(BASHINCDIR)/stdc.h
+
+glob.o: $(BUILD_DIR)/config.h
+glob.o: $(topdir)/bashtypes.h $(BASHINCDIR)/ansi_stdlib.h $(topdir)/bashansi.h
+glob.o: $(BASHINCDIR)/posixstat.h $(BASHINCDIR)/memalloc.h
+glob.o: strmatch.h glob.h
+glob.o: $(BASHINCDIR)/shmbutil.h
+glob.o: $(topdir)/xmalloc.h
+
+xmbsrtowcs.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+xmbsrtowcs.o: ${topdir}/bashansi.h ${BASHINCDIR}/ansi_stdlib.h
+xmbsrtowcs.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/shmbutil.h
+
+# Rules for deficient makes, like SunOS and Solaris
+glob.o: glob.c
+strmatch.o: strmatch.c
+smatch.o: smatch.c
+xmbsrtowcs.o: xmbsrtowcs.c
+
+# dependencies for C files that include other C files
+glob.o: glob_loop.c
+smatch.o: sm_loop.c
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/collsyms.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/collsyms.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ccd9f43
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/collsyms.h
@@ -0,0 +1,140 @@
+/* collsyms.h -- collating symbol names and their corresponding characters
+ (in ascii) as given by POSIX.2 in table 2.8. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1997-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+/* The upper-case letters, lower-case letters, and digits are omitted from
+ this table. The digits are not included in the table in the POSIX.2
+ spec. The upper and lower case letters are translated by the code
+ in smatch.c:collsym(). */
+
+typedef struct _COLLSYM {
+ XCHAR *name;
+ CHAR code;
+} __COLLSYM;
+
+static __COLLSYM POSIXCOLL [] =
+{
+ { L("NUL"), L('\0') },
+ { L("SOH"), L('\001') },
+ { L("STX"), L('\002') },
+ { L("ETX"), L('\003') },
+ { L("EOT"), L('\004') },
+ { L("ENQ"), L('\005') },
+ { L("ACK"), L('\006') },
+#ifdef __STDC__
+ { L("alert"), L('\a') },
+#else
+ { L("alert"), L('\007') },
+#endif
+ { L("BS"), L('\010') },
+ { L("backspace"), L('\b') },
+ { L("HT"), L('\011') },
+ { L("tab"), L('\t') },
+ { L("LF"), L('\012') },
+ { L("newline"), L('\n') },
+ { L("VT"), L('\013') },
+ { L("vertical-tab"), L('\v') },
+ { L("FF"), L('\014') },
+ { L("form-feed"), L('\f') },
+ { L("CR"), L('\015') },
+ { L("carriage-return"), L('\r') },
+ { L("SO"), L('\016') },
+ { L("SI"), L('\017') },
+ { L("DLE"), L('\020') },
+ { L("DC1"), L('\021') },
+ { L("DC2"), L('\022') },
+ { L("DC3"), L('\023') },
+ { L("DC4"), L('\024') },
+ { L("NAK"), L('\025') },
+ { L("SYN"), L('\026') },
+ { L("ETB"), L('\027') },
+ { L("CAN"), L('\030') },
+ { L("EM"), L('\031') },
+ { L("SUB"), L('\032') },
+ { L("ESC"), L('\033') },
+ { L("IS4"), L('\034') },
+ { L("FS"), L('\034') },
+ { L("IS3"), L('\035') },
+ { L("GS"), L('\035') },
+ { L("IS2"), L('\036') },
+ { L("RS"), L('\036') },
+ { L("IS1"), L('\037') },
+ { L("US"), L('\037') },
+ { L("space"), L(' ') },
+ { L("exclamation-mark"), L('!') },
+ { L("quotation-mark"), L('"') },
+ { L("number-sign"), L('#') },
+ { L("dollar-sign"), L('$') },
+ { L("percent-sign"), L('%') },
+ { L("ampersand"), L('&') },
+ { L("apostrophe"), L('\'') },
+ { L("left-parenthesis"), L('(') },
+ { L("right-parenthesis"), L(')') },
+ { L("asterisk"), L('*') },
+ { L("plus-sign"), L('+') },
+ { L("comma"), L(',') },
+ { L("hyphen"), L('-') },
+ { L("hyphen-minus"), L('-') },
+ { L("minus"), L('-') }, /* extension from POSIX.2 */
+ { L("dash"), L('-') }, /* extension from POSIX.2 */
+ { L("period"), L('.') },
+ { L("full-stop"), L('.') },
+ { L("slash"), L('/') },
+ { L("solidus"), L('/') }, /* extension from POSIX.2 */
+ { L("zero"), L('0') },
+ { L("one"), L('1') },
+ { L("two"), L('2') },
+ { L("three"), L('3') },
+ { L("four"), L('4') },
+ { L("five"), L('5') },
+ { L("six"), L('6') },
+ { L("seven"), L('7') },
+ { L("eight"), L('8') },
+ { L("nine"), L('9') },
+ { L("colon"), L(':') },
+ { L("semicolon"), L(';') },
+ { L("less-than-sign"), L('<') },
+ { L("equals-sign"), L('=') },
+ { L("greater-than-sign"), L('>') },
+ { L("question-mark"), L('?') },
+ { L("commercial-at"), L('@') },
+ /* upper-case letters omitted */
+ { L("left-square-bracket"), L('[') },
+ { L("backslash"), L('\\') },
+ { L("reverse-solidus"), L('\\') },
+ { L("right-square-bracket"), L(']') },
+ { L("circumflex"), L('^') },
+ { L("circumflex-accent"), L('^') }, /* extension from POSIX.2 */
+ { L("underscore"), L('_') },
+ { L("grave-accent"), L('`') },
+ /* lower-case letters omitted */
+ { L("left-brace"), L('{') }, /* extension from POSIX.2 */
+ { L("left-curly-bracket"), L('{') },
+ { L("vertical-line"), L('|') },
+ { L("right-brace"), L('}') }, /* extension from POSIX.2 */
+ { L("right-curly-bracket"), L('}') },
+ { L("tilde"), L('~') },
+ { L("DEL"), L('\177') },
+ { 0, 0 },
+};
+
+#undef _COLLSYM
+#undef __COLLSYM
+#undef POSIXCOLL
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/doc/Makefile b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/doc/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..8dca606
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/doc/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,5 @@
+all:
+ cp glob.texi glob.info
+
+clean distclean mostlyclean maintainer-clean:
+ rm -f glob.?? glob.info
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/doc/glob.texi b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/doc/glob.texi
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..0262ef1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/doc/glob.texi
@@ -0,0 +1 @@
+Nothing happens here.
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/glob.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/glob.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9a2d833
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/glob.c
@@ -0,0 +1,885 @@
+/* glob.c -- file-name wildcard pattern matching for Bash.
+
+ Copyright (C) 1985-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+/* To whomever it may concern: I have never seen the code which most
+ Unix programs use to perform this function. I wrote this from scratch
+ based on specifications for the pattern matching. --RMS. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#if !defined (__GNUC__) && !defined (HAVE_ALLOCA_H) && defined (_AIX)
+ #pragma alloca
+#endif /* _AIX && RISC6000 && !__GNUC__ */
+
+#include "bashtypes.h"
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "bashansi.h"
+#include "posixdir.h"
+#include "posixstat.h"
+#include "shmbutil.h"
+#include "xmalloc.h"
+
+#include "filecntl.h"
+#if !defined (F_OK)
+# define F_OK 0
+#endif
+
+#include "stdc.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "quit.h"
+
+#include "glob.h"
+#include "strmatch.h"
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_BCOPY) && !defined (bcopy)
+# define bcopy(s, d, n) ((void) memcpy ((d), (s), (n)))
+#endif /* !HAVE_BCOPY && !bcopy */
+
+#if !defined (NULL)
+# if defined (__STDC__)
+# define NULL ((void *) 0)
+# else
+# define NULL 0x0
+# endif /* __STDC__ */
+#endif /* !NULL */
+
+#if !defined (FREE)
+# define FREE(x) if (x) free (x)
+#endif
+
+/* Don't try to alloca() more than this much memory for `struct globval'
+ in glob_vector() */
+#ifndef ALLOCA_MAX
+# define ALLOCA_MAX 100000
+#endif
+
+extern void throw_to_top_level __P((void));
+extern int test_eaccess __P((char *, int));
+
+extern int extended_glob;
+
+/* Global variable which controls whether or not * matches .*.
+ Non-zero means don't match .*. */
+int noglob_dot_filenames = 1;
+
+/* Global variable which controls whether or not filename globbing
+ is done without regard to case. */
+int glob_ignore_case = 0;
+
+/* Global variable to return to signify an error in globbing. */
+char *glob_error_return;
+
+/* Some forward declarations. */
+static int skipname __P((char *, char *));
+#if HANDLE_MULTIBYTE
+static int mbskipname __P((char *, char *));
+#endif
+#if HANDLE_MULTIBYTE
+static void udequote_pathname __P((char *));
+static void wdequote_pathname __P((char *));
+#else
+# define dequote_pathname udequote_pathname
+#endif
+static void dequote_pathname __P((char *));
+static int glob_testdir __P((char *));
+static char **glob_dir_to_array __P((char *, char **, int));
+
+/* Compile `glob_loop.c' for single-byte characters. */
+#define CHAR unsigned char
+#define INT int
+#define L(CS) CS
+#define INTERNAL_GLOB_PATTERN_P internal_glob_pattern_p
+#include "glob_loop.c"
+
+/* Compile `glob_loop.c' again for multibyte characters. */
+#if HANDLE_MULTIBYTE
+
+#define CHAR wchar_t
+#define INT wint_t
+#define L(CS) L##CS
+#define INTERNAL_GLOB_PATTERN_P internal_glob_wpattern_p
+#include "glob_loop.c"
+
+#endif /* HANDLE_MULTIBYTE */
+
+/* And now a function that calls either the single-byte or multibyte version
+ of internal_glob_pattern_p. */
+int
+glob_pattern_p (pattern)
+ const char *pattern;
+{
+#if HANDLE_MULTIBYTE
+ size_t n;
+ wchar_t *wpattern;
+ int r;
+
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX == 1)
+ return (internal_glob_pattern_p ((unsigned char *)pattern));
+
+ /* Convert strings to wide chars, and call the multibyte version. */
+ n = xdupmbstowcs (&wpattern, NULL, pattern);
+ if (n == (size_t)-1)
+ /* Oops. Invalid multibyte sequence. Try it as single-byte sequence. */
+ return (internal_glob_pattern_p ((unsigned char *)pattern));
+
+ r = internal_glob_wpattern_p (wpattern);
+ free (wpattern);
+
+ return r;
+#else
+ return (internal_glob_pattern_p (pattern));
+#endif
+}
+
+/* Return 1 if DNAME should be skipped according to PAT. Mostly concerned
+ with matching leading `.'. */
+
+static int
+skipname (pat, dname)
+ char *pat;
+ char *dname;
+{
+ /* If a leading dot need not be explicitly matched, and the pattern
+ doesn't start with a `.', don't match `.' or `..' */
+ if (noglob_dot_filenames == 0 && pat[0] != '.' &&
+ (pat[0] != '\\' || pat[1] != '.') &&
+ (dname[0] == '.' &&
+ (dname[1] == '\0' || (dname[1] == '.' && dname[2] == '\0'))))
+ return 1;
+
+ /* If a dot must be explicity matched, check to see if they do. */
+ else if (noglob_dot_filenames && dname[0] == '.' && pat[0] != '.' &&
+ (pat[0] != '\\' || pat[1] != '.'))
+ return 1;
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+#if HANDLE_MULTIBYTE
+/* Return 1 if DNAME should be skipped according to PAT. Handles multibyte
+ characters in PAT and DNAME. Mostly concerned with matching leading `.'. */
+
+static int
+mbskipname (pat, dname)
+ char *pat, *dname;
+{
+ int ret;
+ wchar_t *pat_wc, *dn_wc;
+ size_t pat_n, dn_n, n;
+
+ pat_n = xdupmbstowcs (&pat_wc, NULL, pat);
+ dn_n = xdupmbstowcs (&dn_wc, NULL, dname);
+
+ ret = 0;
+ if (pat_n != (size_t)-1 && dn_n !=(size_t)-1)
+ {
+ /* If a leading dot need not be explicitly matched, and the
+ pattern doesn't start with a `.', don't match `.' or `..' */
+ if (noglob_dot_filenames == 0 && pat_wc[0] != L'.' &&
+ (pat_wc[0] != L'\\' || pat_wc[1] != L'.') &&
+ (dn_wc[0] == L'.' &&
+ (dn_wc[1] == L'\0' || (dn_wc[1] == L'.' && dn_wc[2] == L'\0'))))
+ ret = 1;
+
+ /* If a leading dot must be explicity matched, check to see if the
+ pattern and dirname both have one. */
+ else if (noglob_dot_filenames && dn_wc[0] == L'.' &&
+ pat_wc[0] != L'.' &&
+ (pat_wc[0] != L'\\' || pat_wc[1] != L'.'))
+ ret = 1;
+ }
+
+ FREE (pat_wc);
+ FREE (dn_wc);
+
+ return ret;
+}
+#endif /* HANDLE_MULTIBYTE */
+
+/* Remove backslashes quoting characters in PATHNAME by modifying PATHNAME. */
+static void
+udequote_pathname (pathname)
+ char *pathname;
+{
+ register int i, j;
+
+ for (i = j = 0; pathname && pathname[i]; )
+ {
+ if (pathname[i] == '\\')
+ i++;
+
+ pathname[j++] = pathname[i++];
+
+ if (pathname[i - 1] == 0)
+ break;
+ }
+ pathname[j] = '\0';
+}
+
+#if HANDLE_MULTIBYTE
+/* Remove backslashes quoting characters in PATHNAME by modifying PATHNAME. */
+static void
+wdequote_pathname (pathname)
+ char *pathname;
+{
+ mbstate_t ps;
+ size_t len, n;
+ wchar_t *wpathname;
+ int i, j;
+ wchar_t *orig_wpathname;
+
+ len = strlen (pathname);
+ /* Convert the strings into wide characters. */
+ n = xdupmbstowcs (&wpathname, NULL, pathname);
+ if (n == (size_t) -1)
+ /* Something wrong. */
+ return;
+ orig_wpathname = wpathname;
+
+ for (i = j = 0; wpathname && wpathname[i]; )
+ {
+ if (wpathname[i] == L'\\')
+ i++;
+
+ wpathname[j++] = wpathname[i++];
+
+ if (wpathname[i - 1] == L'\0')
+ break;
+ }
+ wpathname[j] = L'\0';
+
+ /* Convert the wide character string into unibyte character set. */
+ memset (&ps, '\0', sizeof(mbstate_t));
+ n = wcsrtombs(pathname, (const wchar_t **)&wpathname, len, &ps);
+ pathname[len] = '\0';
+
+ /* Can't just free wpathname here; wcsrtombs changes it in many cases. */
+ free (orig_wpathname);
+}
+
+static void
+dequote_pathname (pathname)
+ char *pathname;
+{
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1)
+ wdequote_pathname (pathname);
+ else
+ udequote_pathname (pathname);
+}
+#endif /* HANDLE_MULTIBYTE */
+
+/* Test whether NAME exists. */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_LSTAT)
+# define GLOB_TESTNAME(name) (lstat (name, &finfo))
+#else /* !HAVE_LSTAT */
+# if !defined (AFS)
+# define GLOB_TESTNAME(name) (test_eaccess (nextname, F_OK))
+# else /* AFS */
+# define GLOB_TESTNAME(name) (access (nextname, F_OK))
+# endif /* AFS */
+#endif /* !HAVE_LSTAT */
+
+/* Return 0 if DIR is a directory, -1 otherwise. */
+static int
+glob_testdir (dir)
+ char *dir;
+{
+ struct stat finfo;
+
+ if (stat (dir, &finfo) < 0)
+ return (-1);
+
+ if (S_ISDIR (finfo.st_mode) == 0)
+ return (-1);
+
+ return (0);
+}
+
+/* Return a vector of names of files in directory DIR
+ whose names match glob pattern PAT.
+ The names are not in any particular order.
+ Wildcards at the beginning of PAT do not match an initial period.
+
+ The vector is terminated by an element that is a null pointer.
+
+ To free the space allocated, first free the vector's elements,
+ then free the vector.
+
+ Return 0 if cannot get enough memory to hold the pointer
+ and the names.
+
+ Return -1 if cannot access directory DIR.
+ Look in errno for more information. */
+
+char **
+glob_vector (pat, dir, flags)
+ char *pat;
+ char *dir;
+ int flags;
+{
+ struct globval
+ {
+ struct globval *next;
+ char *name;
+ };
+
+ DIR *d;
+ register struct dirent *dp;
+ struct globval *lastlink;
+ register struct globval *nextlink;
+ register char *nextname, *npat;
+ unsigned int count;
+ int lose, skip;
+ register char **name_vector;
+ register unsigned int i;
+ int mflags; /* Flags passed to strmatch (). */
+ int nalloca;
+ struct globval *firstmalloc, *tmplink;
+
+ lastlink = 0;
+ count = lose = skip = 0;
+
+ firstmalloc = 0;
+
+ /* If PAT is empty, skip the loop, but return one (empty) filename. */
+ if (pat == 0 || *pat == '\0')
+ {
+ if (glob_testdir (dir) < 0)
+ return ((char **) &glob_error_return);
+
+ nextlink = (struct globval *)alloca (sizeof (struct globval));
+ if (nextlink == NULL)
+ return ((char **) NULL);
+
+ nextlink->next = (struct globval *)0;
+ nextname = (char *) malloc (1);
+ if (nextname == 0)
+ lose = 1;
+ else
+ {
+ lastlink = nextlink;
+ nextlink->name = nextname;
+ nextname[0] = '\0';
+ count = 1;
+ }
+
+ skip = 1;
+ }
+
+ /* If the filename pattern (PAT) does not contain any globbing characters,
+ we can dispense with reading the directory, and just see if there is
+ a filename `DIR/PAT'. If there is, and we can access it, just make the
+ vector to return and bail immediately. */
+ if (skip == 0 && glob_pattern_p (pat) == 0)
+ {
+ int dirlen;
+ struct stat finfo;
+
+ if (glob_testdir (dir) < 0)
+ return ((char **) &glob_error_return);
+
+ dirlen = strlen (dir);
+ nextname = (char *)malloc (dirlen + strlen (pat) + 2);
+ npat = (char *)malloc (strlen (pat) + 1);
+ if (nextname == 0 || npat == 0)
+ lose = 1;
+ else
+ {
+ strcpy (npat, pat);
+ dequote_pathname (npat);
+
+ strcpy (nextname, dir);
+ nextname[dirlen++] = '/';
+ strcpy (nextname + dirlen, npat);
+
+ if (GLOB_TESTNAME (nextname) >= 0)
+ {
+ free (nextname);
+ nextlink = (struct globval *)alloca (sizeof (struct globval));
+ if (nextlink)
+ {
+ nextlink->next = (struct globval *)0;
+ lastlink = nextlink;
+ nextlink->name = npat;
+ count = 1;
+ }
+ else
+ lose = 1;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ free (nextname);
+ free (npat);
+ }
+ }
+
+ skip = 1;
+ }
+
+ if (skip == 0)
+ {
+ /* Open the directory, punting immediately if we cannot. If opendir
+ is not robust (i.e., it opens non-directories successfully), test
+ that DIR is a directory and punt if it's not. */
+#if defined (OPENDIR_NOT_ROBUST)
+ if (glob_testdir (dir) < 0)
+ return ((char **) &glob_error_return);
+#endif
+
+ d = opendir (dir);
+ if (d == NULL)
+ return ((char **) &glob_error_return);
+
+ /* Compute the flags that will be passed to strmatch(). We don't
+ need to do this every time through the loop. */
+ mflags = (noglob_dot_filenames ? FNM_PERIOD : 0) | FNM_PATHNAME;
+
+#ifdef FNM_CASEFOLD
+ if (glob_ignore_case)
+ mflags |= FNM_CASEFOLD;
+#endif
+
+ if (extended_glob)
+ mflags |= FNM_EXTMATCH;
+
+ /* Scan the directory, finding all names that match.
+ For each name that matches, allocate a struct globval
+ on the stack and store the name in it.
+ Chain those structs together; lastlink is the front of the chain. */
+ while (1)
+ {
+ /* Make globbing interruptible in the shell. */
+ if (interrupt_state)
+ {
+ lose = 1;
+ break;
+ }
+
+ dp = readdir (d);
+ if (dp == NULL)
+ break;
+
+ /* If this directory entry is not to be used, try again. */
+ if (REAL_DIR_ENTRY (dp) == 0)
+ continue;
+
+#if 0
+ if (dp->d_name == 0 || *dp->d_name == 0)
+ continue;
+#endif
+
+#if HANDLE_MULTIBYTE
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && mbskipname (pat, dp->d_name))
+ continue;
+ else
+#endif
+ if (skipname (pat, dp->d_name))
+ continue;
+
+ if (strmatch (pat, dp->d_name, mflags) != FNM_NOMATCH)
+ {
+ if (nalloca < ALLOCA_MAX)
+ {
+ nextlink = (struct globval *) alloca (sizeof (struct globval));
+ nalloca += sizeof (struct globval);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ nextlink = (struct globval *) malloc (sizeof (struct globval));
+ if (firstmalloc == 0)
+ firstmalloc = nextlink;
+ }
+ nextname = (char *) malloc (D_NAMLEN (dp) + 1);
+ if (nextlink == 0 || nextname == 0)
+ {
+ lose = 1;
+ break;
+ }
+ nextlink->next = lastlink;
+ lastlink = nextlink;
+ nextlink->name = nextname;
+ bcopy (dp->d_name, nextname, D_NAMLEN (dp) + 1);
+ ++count;
+ }
+ }
+
+ (void) closedir (d);
+ }
+
+ if (lose == 0)
+ {
+ name_vector = (char **) malloc ((count + 1) * sizeof (char *));
+ lose |= name_vector == NULL;
+ }
+
+ /* Have we run out of memory? */
+ if (lose)
+ {
+ tmplink = 0;
+
+ /* Here free the strings we have got. */
+ while (lastlink)
+ {
+ if (firstmalloc)
+ {
+ if (lastlink == firstmalloc)
+ firstmalloc = 0;
+ tmplink = lastlink;
+ }
+ free (lastlink->name);
+ lastlink = lastlink->next;
+ FREE (tmplink);
+ }
+
+ QUIT;
+
+ return ((char **)NULL);
+ }
+
+ /* Copy the name pointers from the linked list into the vector. */
+ for (tmplink = lastlink, i = 0; i < count; ++i)
+ {
+ name_vector[i] = tmplink->name;
+ tmplink = tmplink->next;
+ }
+
+ name_vector[count] = NULL;
+
+ /* If we allocated some of the struct globvals, free them now. */
+ if (firstmalloc)
+ {
+ tmplink = 0;
+ while (lastlink)
+ {
+ tmplink = lastlink;
+ if (lastlink == firstmalloc)
+ lastlink = firstmalloc = 0;
+ else
+ lastlink = lastlink->next;
+ free (tmplink);
+ }
+ }
+
+ return (name_vector);
+}
+
+/* Return a new array which is the concatenation of each string in ARRAY
+ to DIR. This function expects you to pass in an allocated ARRAY, and
+ it takes care of free()ing that array. Thus, you might think of this
+ function as side-effecting ARRAY. This should handle GX_MARKDIRS. */
+static char **
+glob_dir_to_array (dir, array, flags)
+ char *dir, **array;
+ int flags;
+{
+ register unsigned int i, l;
+ int add_slash;
+ char **result, *new;
+ struct stat sb;
+
+ l = strlen (dir);
+ if (l == 0)
+ {
+ if (flags & GX_MARKDIRS)
+ for (i = 0; array[i]; i++)
+ {
+ if ((stat (array[i], &sb) == 0) && S_ISDIR (sb.st_mode))
+ {
+ l = strlen (array[i]);
+ new = (char *)realloc (array[i], l + 2);
+ if (new == 0)
+ return NULL;
+ new[l] = '/';
+ new[l+1] = '\0';
+ array[i] = new;
+ }
+ }
+ return (array);
+ }
+
+ add_slash = dir[l - 1] != '/';
+
+ i = 0;
+ while (array[i] != NULL)
+ ++i;
+
+ result = (char **) malloc ((i + 1) * sizeof (char *));
+ if (result == NULL)
+ return (NULL);
+
+ for (i = 0; array[i] != NULL; i++)
+ {
+ /* 3 == 1 for NUL, 1 for slash at end of DIR, 1 for GX_MARKDIRS */
+ result[i] = (char *) malloc (l + strlen (array[i]) + 3);
+
+ if (result[i] == NULL)
+ return (NULL);
+
+ strcpy (result[i], dir);
+ if (add_slash)
+ result[i][l] = '/';
+ strcpy (result[i] + l + add_slash, array[i]);
+ if (flags & GX_MARKDIRS)
+ {
+ if ((stat (result[i], &sb) == 0) && S_ISDIR (sb.st_mode))
+ {
+ size_t rlen;
+ rlen = strlen (result[i]);
+ result[i][rlen] = '/';
+ result[i][rlen+1] = '\0';
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ result[i] = NULL;
+
+ /* Free the input array. */
+ for (i = 0; array[i] != NULL; i++)
+ free (array[i]);
+ free ((char *) array);
+
+ return (result);
+}
+
+/* Do globbing on PATHNAME. Return an array of pathnames that match,
+ marking the end of the array with a null-pointer as an element.
+ If no pathnames match, then the array is empty (first element is null).
+ If there isn't enough memory, then return NULL.
+ If a file system error occurs, return -1; `errno' has the error code. */
+char **
+glob_filename (pathname, flags)
+ char *pathname;
+ int flags;
+{
+ char **result;
+ unsigned int result_size;
+ char *directory_name, *filename;
+ unsigned int directory_len;
+ int free_dirname; /* flag */
+
+ result = (char **) malloc (sizeof (char *));
+ result_size = 1;
+ if (result == NULL)
+ return (NULL);
+
+ result[0] = NULL;
+
+ directory_name = NULL;
+
+ /* Find the filename. */
+ filename = strrchr (pathname, '/');
+ if (filename == NULL)
+ {
+ filename = pathname;
+ directory_name = "";
+ directory_len = 0;
+ free_dirname = 0;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ directory_len = (filename - pathname) + 1;
+ directory_name = (char *) malloc (directory_len + 1);
+
+ if (directory_name == 0) /* allocation failed? */
+ return (NULL);
+
+ bcopy (pathname, directory_name, directory_len);
+ directory_name[directory_len] = '\0';
+ ++filename;
+ free_dirname = 1;
+ }
+
+ /* If directory_name contains globbing characters, then we
+ have to expand the previous levels. Just recurse. */
+ if (glob_pattern_p (directory_name))
+ {
+ char **directories;
+ register unsigned int i;
+
+ if (directory_name[directory_len - 1] == '/')
+ directory_name[directory_len - 1] = '\0';
+
+ directories = glob_filename (directory_name, flags & ~GX_MARKDIRS);
+
+ if (free_dirname)
+ {
+ free (directory_name);
+ directory_name = NULL;
+ }
+
+ if (directories == NULL)
+ goto memory_error;
+ else if (directories == (char **)&glob_error_return)
+ {
+ free ((char *) result);
+ return ((char **) &glob_error_return);
+ }
+ else if (*directories == NULL)
+ {
+ free ((char *) directories);
+ free ((char *) result);
+ return ((char **) &glob_error_return);
+ }
+
+ /* We have successfully globbed the preceding directory name.
+ For each name in DIRECTORIES, call glob_vector on it and
+ FILENAME. Concatenate the results together. */
+ for (i = 0; directories[i] != NULL; ++i)
+ {
+ char **temp_results;
+
+ /* Scan directory even on a NULL pathname. That way, `*h/'
+ returns only directories ending in `h', instead of all
+ files ending in `h' with a `/' appended. */
+ temp_results = glob_vector (filename, directories[i], flags & ~GX_MARKDIRS);
+
+ /* Handle error cases. */
+ if (temp_results == NULL)
+ goto memory_error;
+ else if (temp_results == (char **)&glob_error_return)
+ /* This filename is probably not a directory. Ignore it. */
+ ;
+ else
+ {
+ char **array;
+ register unsigned int l;
+
+ array = glob_dir_to_array (directories[i], temp_results, flags);
+ l = 0;
+ while (array[l] != NULL)
+ ++l;
+
+ result =
+ (char **)realloc (result, (result_size + l) * sizeof (char *));
+
+ if (result == NULL)
+ goto memory_error;
+
+ for (l = 0; array[l] != NULL; ++l)
+ result[result_size++ - 1] = array[l];
+
+ result[result_size - 1] = NULL;
+
+ /* Note that the elements of ARRAY are not freed. */
+ free ((char *) array);
+ }
+ }
+ /* Free the directories. */
+ for (i = 0; directories[i]; i++)
+ free (directories[i]);
+
+ free ((char *) directories);
+
+ return (result);
+ }
+
+ /* If there is only a directory name, return it. */
+ if (*filename == '\0')
+ {
+ result = (char **) realloc ((char *) result, 2 * sizeof (char *));
+ if (result == NULL)
+ return (NULL);
+ /* Handle GX_MARKDIRS here. */
+ result[0] = (char *) malloc (directory_len + 1);
+ if (result[0] == NULL)
+ goto memory_error;
+ bcopy (directory_name, result[0], directory_len + 1);
+ if (free_dirname)
+ free (directory_name);
+ result[1] = NULL;
+ return (result);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ char **temp_results;
+
+ /* There are no unquoted globbing characters in DIRECTORY_NAME.
+ Dequote it before we try to open the directory since there may
+ be quoted globbing characters which should be treated verbatim. */
+ if (directory_len > 0)
+ dequote_pathname (directory_name);
+
+ /* We allocated a small array called RESULT, which we won't be using.
+ Free that memory now. */
+ free (result);
+
+ /* Just return what glob_vector () returns appended to the
+ directory name. */
+ temp_results = glob_vector (filename,
+ (directory_len == 0 ? "." : directory_name),
+ flags & ~GX_MARKDIRS);
+
+ if (temp_results == NULL || temp_results == (char **)&glob_error_return)
+ {
+ if (free_dirname)
+ free (directory_name);
+ return (temp_results);
+ }
+
+ result = glob_dir_to_array (directory_name, temp_results, flags);
+ if (free_dirname)
+ free (directory_name);
+ return (result);
+ }
+
+ /* We get to memory_error if the program has run out of memory, or
+ if this is the shell, and we have been interrupted. */
+ memory_error:
+ if (result != NULL)
+ {
+ register unsigned int i;
+ for (i = 0; result[i] != NULL; ++i)
+ free (result[i]);
+ free ((char *) result);
+ }
+
+ if (free_dirname && directory_name)
+ free (directory_name);
+
+ QUIT;
+
+ return (NULL);
+}
+
+#if defined (TEST)
+
+main (argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char **argv;
+{
+ unsigned int i;
+
+ for (i = 1; i < argc; ++i)
+ {
+ char **value = glob_filename (argv[i], 0);
+ if (value == NULL)
+ puts ("Out of memory.");
+ else if (value == &glob_error_return)
+ perror (argv[i]);
+ else
+ for (i = 0; value[i] != NULL; i++)
+ puts (value[i]);
+ }
+
+ exit (0);
+}
+#endif /* TEST. */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/glob.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/glob.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..95108a4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/glob.h
@@ -0,0 +1,35 @@
+/* File-name wildcard pattern matching for GNU.
+ Copyright (C) 1985, 1988, 1989 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#ifndef _GLOB_H_
+#define _GLOB_H_
+
+#include "stdc.h"
+
+#define GX_MARKDIRS 0x01 /* mark directory names with trailing `/' */
+#define GX_NOCASE 0x02 /* ignore case */
+#define GX_MATCHDOT 0x04 /* match `.' literally */
+
+extern int glob_pattern_p __P((const char *));
+extern char **glob_vector __P((char *, char *, int));
+extern char **glob_filename __P((char *, int));
+
+extern char *glob_error_return;
+extern int noglob_dot_filenames;
+extern int glob_ignore_case;
+
+#endif /* _GLOB_H_ */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/glob_loop.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/glob_loop.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..253cac9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/glob_loop.c
@@ -0,0 +1,67 @@
+/* Copyright (C) 1991-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+static int INTERNAL_GLOB_PATTERN_P __P((const CHAR *));
+
+/* Return nonzero if PATTERN has any special globbing chars in it.
+ Compiled twice, once each for single-byte and multibyte characters. */
+static int
+INTERNAL_GLOB_PATTERN_P (pattern)
+ const CHAR *pattern;
+{
+ register const CHAR *p;
+ register CHAR c;
+ int bopen;
+
+ p = pattern;
+ bopen = 0;
+
+ while ((c = *p++) != L('\0'))
+ switch (c)
+ {
+ case L('?'):
+ case L('*'):
+ return 1;
+
+ case L('['): /* Only accept an open brace if there is a close */
+ bopen++; /* brace to match it. Bracket expressions must be */
+ continue; /* complete, according to Posix.2 */
+ case L(']'):
+ if (bopen)
+ return 1;
+ continue;
+
+ case L('+'): /* extended matching operators */
+ case L('@'):
+ case L('!'):
+ if (*p == L('(')) /*) */
+ return 1;
+ continue;
+
+ case L('\\'):
+ if (*p++ == L('\0'))
+ return 0;
+ }
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+#undef INTERNAL_GLOB_PATTERN_P
+#undef L
+#undef INT
+#undef CHAR
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/ndir.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/ndir.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..31261eb
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/ndir.h
@@ -0,0 +1,50 @@
+/* <dir.h> -- definitions for 4.2BSD-compatible directory access.
+ last edit: 09-Jul-1983 D A Gwyn. */
+
+#if defined (VMS)
+# if !defined (FAB$C_BID)
+# include <fab.h>
+# endif
+# if !defined (NAM$C_BID)
+# include <nam.h>
+# endif
+# if !defined (RMS$_SUC)
+# include <rmsdef.h>
+# endif
+# include "dir.h"
+#endif /* VMS */
+
+/* Size of directory block. */
+#define DIRBLKSIZ 512
+
+/* NOTE: MAXNAMLEN must be one less than a multiple of 4 */
+
+#if defined (VMS)
+# define MAXNAMLEN (DIR$S_NAME + 7) /* 80 plus room for version #. */
+# define MAXFULLSPEC NAM$C_MAXRSS /* Maximum full spec */
+#else
+# define MAXNAMLEN 15 /* Maximum filename length. */
+#endif /* VMS */
+
+/* Data from readdir (). */
+struct direct {
+ long d_ino; /* Inode number of entry. */
+ unsigned short d_reclen; /* Length of this record. */
+ unsigned short d_namlen; /* Length of string in d_name. */
+ char d_name[MAXNAMLEN + 1]; /* Name of file. */
+};
+
+/* Stream data from opendir (). */
+typedef struct {
+ int dd_fd; /* File descriptor. */
+ int dd_loc; /* Offset in block. */
+ int dd_size; /* Amount of valid data. */
+ char dd_buf[DIRBLKSIZ]; /* Directory block. */
+} DIR;
+
+extern DIR *opendir ();
+extern struct direct *readdir ();
+extern long telldir ();
+extern void seekdir (), closedir ();
+
+#define rewinddir(dirp) seekdir (dirp, 0L)
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/sm_loop.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/sm_loop.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6e8cf3a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/sm_loop.c
@@ -0,0 +1,760 @@
+/* Copyright (C) 1991-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+int FCT __P((CHAR *, CHAR *, int));
+
+static int GMATCH __P((CHAR *, CHAR *, CHAR *, CHAR *, int));
+static CHAR *PARSE_COLLSYM __P((CHAR *, INT *));
+static CHAR *BRACKMATCH __P((CHAR *, U_CHAR, int));
+static int EXTMATCH __P((INT, CHAR *, CHAR *, CHAR *, CHAR *, int));
+static CHAR *PATSCAN __P((CHAR *, CHAR *, INT));
+
+int
+FCT (pattern, string, flags)
+ CHAR *pattern;
+ CHAR *string;
+ int flags;
+{
+ CHAR *se, *pe;
+
+ if (string == 0 || pattern == 0)
+ return FNM_NOMATCH;
+
+ se = string + STRLEN ((XCHAR *)string);
+ pe = pattern + STRLEN ((XCHAR *)pattern);
+
+ return (GMATCH (string, se, pattern, pe, flags));
+}
+
+/* Match STRING against the filename pattern PATTERN, returning zero if
+ it matches, FNM_NOMATCH if not. */
+static int
+GMATCH (string, se, pattern, pe, flags)
+ CHAR *string, *se;
+ CHAR *pattern, *pe;
+ int flags;
+{
+ CHAR *p, *n; /* pattern, string */
+ INT c; /* current pattern character - XXX U_CHAR? */
+ INT sc; /* current string character - XXX U_CHAR? */
+
+ p = pattern;
+ n = string;
+
+ if (string == 0 || pattern == 0)
+ return FNM_NOMATCH;
+
+#if DEBUG_MATCHING
+fprintf(stderr, "gmatch: string = %s; se = %s\n", string, se);
+fprintf(stderr, "gmatch: pattern = %s; pe = %s\n", pattern, pe);
+#endif
+
+ while (p < pe)
+ {
+ c = *p++;
+ c = FOLD (c);
+
+ sc = n < se ? *n : '\0';
+
+#ifdef EXTENDED_GLOB
+ /* EXTMATCH () will handle recursively calling GMATCH, so we can
+ just return what EXTMATCH() returns. */
+ if ((flags & FNM_EXTMATCH) && *p == L('(') &&
+ (c == L('+') || c == L('*') || c == L('?') || c == L('@') || c == L('!'))) /* ) */
+ {
+ int lflags;
+ /* If we're not matching the start of the string, we're not
+ concerned about the special cases for matching `.' */
+ lflags = (n == string) ? flags : (flags & ~FNM_PERIOD);
+ return (EXTMATCH (c, n, se, p, pe, lflags));
+ }
+#endif /* EXTENDED_GLOB */
+
+ switch (c)
+ {
+ case L('?'): /* Match single character */
+ if (sc == '\0')
+ return FNM_NOMATCH;
+ else if ((flags & FNM_PATHNAME) && sc == L('/'))
+ /* If we are matching a pathname, `?' can never match a `/'. */
+ return FNM_NOMATCH;
+ else if ((flags & FNM_PERIOD) && sc == L('.') &&
+ (n == string || ((flags & FNM_PATHNAME) && n[-1] == L('/'))))
+ /* `?' cannot match a `.' if it is the first character of the
+ string or if it is the first character following a slash and
+ we are matching a pathname. */
+ return FNM_NOMATCH;
+ break;
+
+ case L('\\'): /* backslash escape removes special meaning */
+ if (p == pe)
+ return FNM_NOMATCH;
+
+ if ((flags & FNM_NOESCAPE) == 0)
+ {
+ c = *p++;
+ /* A trailing `\' cannot match. */
+ if (p > pe)
+ return FNM_NOMATCH;
+ c = FOLD (c);
+ }
+ if (FOLD (sc) != (U_CHAR)c)
+ return FNM_NOMATCH;
+ break;
+
+ case '*': /* Match zero or more characters */
+ if (p == pe)
+ return 0;
+
+ if ((flags & FNM_PERIOD) && sc == L('.') &&
+ (n == string || ((flags & FNM_PATHNAME) && n[-1] == L('/'))))
+ /* `*' cannot match a `.' if it is the first character of the
+ string or if it is the first character following a slash and
+ we are matching a pathname. */
+ return FNM_NOMATCH;
+
+ /* Collapse multiple consecutive `*' and `?', but make sure that
+ one character of the string is consumed for each `?'. */
+ for (c = *p++; (c == L('?') || c == L('*')); c = *p++)
+ {
+ if ((flags & FNM_PATHNAME) && sc == L('/'))
+ /* A slash does not match a wildcard under FNM_PATHNAME. */
+ return FNM_NOMATCH;
+#ifdef EXTENDED_GLOB
+ else if ((flags & FNM_EXTMATCH) && c == L('?') && *p == L('(')) /* ) */
+ {
+ CHAR *newn;
+ for (newn = n; newn < se; ++newn)
+ {
+ if (EXTMATCH (c, newn, se, p, pe, flags) == 0)
+ return (0);
+ }
+ /* We didn't match. If we have a `?(...)', that's failure. */
+ return FNM_NOMATCH;
+ }
+#endif
+ else if (c == L('?'))
+ {
+ if (sc == L('\0'))
+ return FNM_NOMATCH;
+ /* One character of the string is consumed in matching
+ this ? wildcard, so *??? won't match if there are
+ fewer than three characters. */
+ n++;
+ sc = n < se ? *n : '\0';
+ }
+
+#ifdef EXTENDED_GLOB
+ /* Handle ******(patlist) */
+ if ((flags & FNM_EXTMATCH) && c == L('*') && *p == L('(')) /*)*/
+ {
+ CHAR *newn;
+ /* We need to check whether or not the extended glob
+ pattern matches the remainder of the string.
+ If it does, we match the entire pattern. */
+ for (newn = n; newn < se; ++newn)
+ {
+ if (EXTMATCH (c, newn, se, p, pe, flags) == 0)
+ return (0);
+ }
+ /* We didn't match the extended glob pattern, but
+ that's OK, since we can match 0 or more occurrences.
+ We need to skip the glob pattern and see if we
+ match the rest of the string. */
+ newn = PATSCAN (p + 1, pe, 0);
+ /* If NEWN is 0, we have an ill-formed pattern. */
+ p = newn ? newn : pe;
+ }
+#endif
+ if (p == pe)
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /* If we've hit the end of the pattern and the last character of
+ the pattern was handled by the loop above, we've succeeded.
+ Otherwise, we need to match that last character. */
+ if (p == pe && (c == L('?') || c == L('*')))
+ return (0);
+
+ /* General case, use recursion. */
+ {
+ U_CHAR c1;
+
+ c1 = ((flags & FNM_NOESCAPE) == 0 && c == L('\\')) ? *p : c;
+ c1 = FOLD (c1);
+ for (--p; n < se; ++n)
+ {
+ /* Only call strmatch if the first character indicates a
+ possible match. We can check the first character if
+ we're not doing an extended glob match. */
+ if ((flags & FNM_EXTMATCH) == 0 && c != L('[') && FOLD (*n) != c1) /*]*/
+ continue;
+
+ /* If we're doing an extended glob match and the pattern is not
+ one of the extended glob patterns, we can check the first
+ character. */
+ if ((flags & FNM_EXTMATCH) && p[1] != L('(') && /*)*/
+ STRCHR (L("?*+@!"), *p) == 0 && c != L('[') && FOLD (*n) != c1) /*]*/
+ continue;
+
+ /* Otherwise, we just recurse. */
+ if (GMATCH (n, se, p, pe, flags & ~FNM_PERIOD) == 0)
+ return (0);
+ }
+ return FNM_NOMATCH;
+ }
+
+ case L('['):
+ {
+ if (sc == L('\0') || n == se)
+ return FNM_NOMATCH;
+
+ /* A character class cannot match a `.' if it is the first
+ character of the string or if it is the first character
+ following a slash and we are matching a pathname. */
+ if ((flags & FNM_PERIOD) && sc == L('.') &&
+ (n == string || ((flags & FNM_PATHNAME) && n[-1] == L('/'))))
+ return (FNM_NOMATCH);
+
+ p = BRACKMATCH (p, sc, flags);
+ if (p == 0)
+ return FNM_NOMATCH;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ default:
+ if ((U_CHAR)c != FOLD (sc))
+ return (FNM_NOMATCH);
+ }
+
+ ++n;
+ }
+
+ if (n == se)
+ return (0);
+
+ if ((flags & FNM_LEADING_DIR) && *n == L('/'))
+ /* The FNM_LEADING_DIR flag says that "foo*" matches "foobar/frobozz". */
+ return 0;
+
+ return (FNM_NOMATCH);
+}
+
+/* Parse a bracket expression collating symbol ([.sym.]) starting at P, find
+ the value of the symbol, and move P past the collating symbol expression.
+ The value is returned in *VP, if VP is not null. */
+static CHAR *
+PARSE_COLLSYM (p, vp)
+ CHAR *p;
+ INT *vp;
+{
+ register int pc;
+ INT val;
+
+ p++; /* move past the `.' */
+
+ for (pc = 0; p[pc]; pc++)
+ if (p[pc] == L('.') && p[pc+1] == L(']'))
+ break;
+ val = COLLSYM (p, pc);
+ if (vp)
+ *vp = val;
+ return (p + pc + 2);
+}
+
+/* Use prototype definition here because of type promotion. */
+static CHAR *
+#if defined (PROTOTYPES)
+BRACKMATCH (CHAR *p, U_CHAR test, int flags)
+#else
+BRACKMATCH (p, test, flags)
+ CHAR *p;
+ U_CHAR test;
+ int flags;
+#endif
+{
+ register CHAR cstart, cend, c;
+ register int not; /* Nonzero if the sense of the character class is inverted. */
+ int brcnt;
+ INT pc;
+ CHAR *savep;
+
+ test = FOLD (test);
+
+ savep = p;
+
+ /* POSIX.2 3.13.1 says that an exclamation mark (`!') shall replace the
+ circumflex (`^') in its role in a `nonmatching list'. A bracket
+ expression starting with an unquoted circumflex character produces
+ unspecified results. This implementation treats the two identically. */
+ if (not = (*p == L('!') || *p == L('^')))
+ ++p;
+
+ c = *p++;
+ for (;;)
+ {
+ /* Initialize cstart and cend in case `-' is the last
+ character of the pattern. */
+ cstart = cend = c;
+
+ /* POSIX.2 equivalence class: [=c=]. See POSIX.2 2.8.3.2. Find
+ the end of the equivalence class, move the pattern pointer past
+ it, and check for equivalence. XXX - this handles only
+ single-character equivalence classes, which is wrong, or at
+ least incomplete. */
+ if (c == L('[') && *p == L('=') && p[2] == L('=') && p[3] == L(']'))
+ {
+ pc = FOLD (p[1]);
+ p += 4;
+ if (COLLEQUIV (test, pc))
+ {
+/*[*/ /* Move past the closing `]', since the first thing we do at
+ the `matched:' label is back p up one. */
+ p++;
+ goto matched;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ c = *p++;
+ if (c == L('\0'))
+ return ((test == L('[')) ? savep : (CHAR *)0); /*]*/
+ c = FOLD (c);
+ continue;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* POSIX.2 character class expression. See POSIX.2 2.8.3.2. */
+ if (c == L('[') && *p == L(':'))
+ {
+ CHAR *close, *ccname;
+
+ pc = 0; /* make sure invalid char classes don't match. */
+ /* Find end of character class name */
+ for (close = p + 1; *close != '\0'; close++)
+ if (*close == L(':') && *(close+1) == L(']'))
+ break;
+
+ if (*close != L('\0'))
+ {
+ ccname = (CHAR *)malloc ((close - p) * sizeof (CHAR));
+ if (ccname == 0)
+ pc = 0;
+ else
+ {
+ bcopy (p + 1, ccname, (close - p - 1) * sizeof (CHAR));
+ *(ccname + (close - p - 1)) = L('\0');
+ pc = IS_CCLASS (test, (XCHAR *)ccname);
+ }
+ if (pc == -1)
+ pc = 0;
+ else
+ p = close + 2;
+
+ free (ccname);
+ }
+
+ if (pc)
+ {
+/*[*/ /* Move past the closing `]', since the first thing we do at
+ the `matched:' label is back p up one. */
+ p++;
+ goto matched;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* continue the loop here, since this expression can't be
+ the first part of a range expression. */
+ c = *p++;
+ if (c == L('\0'))
+ return ((test == L('[')) ? savep : (CHAR *)0);
+ else if (c == L(']'))
+ break;
+ c = FOLD (c);
+ continue;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* POSIX.2 collating symbols. See POSIX.2 2.8.3.2. Find the end of
+ the symbol name, make sure it is terminated by `.]', translate
+ the name to a character using the external table, and do the
+ comparison. */
+ if (c == L('[') && *p == L('.'))
+ {
+ p = PARSE_COLLSYM (p, &pc);
+ /* An invalid collating symbol cannot be the first point of a
+ range. If it is, we set cstart to one greater than `test',
+ so any comparisons later will fail. */
+ cstart = (pc == INVALID) ? test + 1 : pc;
+ }
+
+ if (!(flags & FNM_NOESCAPE) && c == L('\\'))
+ {
+ if (*p == '\0')
+ return (CHAR *)0;
+ cstart = cend = *p++;
+ }
+
+ cstart = cend = FOLD (cstart);
+
+ /* POSIX.2 2.8.3.1.2 says: `An expression containing a `[' that
+ is not preceded by a backslash and is not part of a bracket
+ expression produces undefined results.' This implementation
+ treats the `[' as just a character to be matched if there is
+ not a closing `]'. */
+ if (c == L('\0'))
+ return ((test == L('[')) ? savep : (CHAR *)0);
+
+ c = *p++;
+ c = FOLD (c);
+
+ if ((flags & FNM_PATHNAME) && c == L('/'))
+ /* [/] can never match when matching a pathname. */
+ return (CHAR *)0;
+
+ /* This introduces a range, unless the `-' is the last
+ character of the class. Find the end of the range
+ and move past it. */
+ if (c == L('-') && *p != L(']'))
+ {
+ cend = *p++;
+ if (!(flags & FNM_NOESCAPE) && cend == L('\\'))
+ cend = *p++;
+ if (cend == L('\0'))
+ return (CHAR *)0;
+ if (cend == L('[') && *p == L('.'))
+ {
+ p = PARSE_COLLSYM (p, &pc);
+ /* An invalid collating symbol cannot be the second part of a
+ range expression. If we get one, we set cend to one fewer
+ than the test character to make sure the range test fails. */
+ cend = (pc == INVALID) ? test - 1 : pc;
+ }
+ cend = FOLD (cend);
+
+ c = *p++;
+
+ /* POSIX.2 2.8.3.2: ``The ending range point shall collate
+ equal to or higher than the starting range point; otherwise
+ the expression shall be treated as invalid.'' Note that this
+ applies to only the range expression; the rest of the bracket
+ expression is still checked for matches. */
+ if (RANGECMP (cstart, cend) > 0)
+ {
+ if (c == L(']'))
+ break;
+ c = FOLD (c);
+ continue;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (RANGECMP (test, cstart) >= 0 && RANGECMP (test, cend) <= 0)
+ goto matched;
+
+ if (c == L(']'))
+ break;
+ }
+ /* No match. */
+ return (!not ? (CHAR *)0 : p);
+
+matched:
+ /* Skip the rest of the [...] that already matched. */
+ c = *--p;
+ brcnt = 1;
+ while (brcnt > 0)
+ {
+ /* A `[' without a matching `]' is just another character to match. */
+ if (c == L('\0'))
+ return ((test == L('[')) ? savep : (CHAR *)0);
+
+ c = *p++;
+ if (c == L('[') && (*p == L('=') || *p == L(':') || *p == L('.')))
+ brcnt++;
+ else if (c == L(']'))
+ brcnt--;
+ else if (!(flags & FNM_NOESCAPE) && c == L('\\'))
+ {
+ if (*p == '\0')
+ return (CHAR *)0;
+ /* XXX 1003.2d11 is unclear if this is right. */
+ ++p;
+ }
+ }
+ return (not ? (CHAR *)0 : p);
+}
+
+#if defined (EXTENDED_GLOB)
+/* ksh-like extended pattern matching:
+
+ [?*+@!](pat-list)
+
+ where pat-list is a list of one or patterns separated by `|'. Operation
+ is as follows:
+
+ ?(patlist) match zero or one of the given patterns
+ *(patlist) match zero or more of the given patterns
+ +(patlist) match one or more of the given patterns
+ @(patlist) match exactly one of the given patterns
+ !(patlist) match anything except one of the given patterns
+*/
+
+/* Scan a pattern starting at STRING and ending at END, keeping track of
+ embedded () and []. If DELIM is 0, we scan until a matching `)'
+ because we're scanning a `patlist'. Otherwise, we scan until we see
+ DELIM. In all cases, we never scan past END. The return value is the
+ first character after the matching DELIM. */
+static CHAR *
+PATSCAN (string, end, delim)
+ CHAR *string, *end;
+ INT delim;
+{
+ int pnest, bnest, skip;
+ INT cchar;
+ CHAR *s, c, *bfirst;
+
+ pnest = bnest = skip = 0;
+ cchar = 0;
+ bfirst = NULL;
+
+ for (s = string; c = *s; s++)
+ {
+ if (s >= end)
+ return (s);
+ if (skip)
+ {
+ skip = 0;
+ continue;
+ }
+ switch (c)
+ {
+ case L('\\'):
+ skip = 1;
+ break;
+
+ case L('\0'):
+ return ((CHAR *)NULL);
+
+ /* `[' is not special inside a bracket expression, but it may
+ introduce one of the special POSIX bracket expressions
+ ([.SYM.], [=c=], [: ... :]) that needs special handling. */
+ case L('['):
+ if (bnest == 0)
+ {
+ bfirst = s + 1;
+ if (*bfirst == L('!') || *bfirst == L('^'))
+ bfirst++;
+ bnest++;
+ }
+ else if (s[1] == L(':') || s[1] == L('.') || s[1] == L('='))
+ cchar = s[1];
+ break;
+
+ /* `]' is not special if it's the first char (after a leading `!'
+ or `^') in a bracket expression or if it's part of one of the
+ special POSIX bracket expressions ([.SYM.], [=c=], [: ... :]) */
+ case L(']'):
+ if (bnest)
+ {
+ if (cchar && s[-1] == cchar)
+ cchar = 0;
+ else if (s != bfirst)
+ {
+ bnest--;
+ bfirst = 0;
+ }
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case L('('):
+ if (bnest == 0)
+ pnest++;
+ break;
+
+ case L(')'):
+ if (bnest == 0 && pnest-- <= 0)
+ return ++s;
+ break;
+
+ case L('|'):
+ if (bnest == 0 && pnest == 0 && delim == L('|'))
+ return ++s;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ return (NULL);
+}
+
+/* Return 0 if dequoted pattern matches S in the current locale. */
+static int
+STRCOMPARE (p, pe, s, se)
+ CHAR *p, *pe, *s, *se;
+{
+ int ret;
+ CHAR c1, c2;
+
+ c1 = *pe;
+ c2 = *se;
+
+ *pe = *se = '\0';
+#if HAVE_MULTIBYTE || defined (HAVE_STRCOLL)
+ ret = STRCOLL ((XCHAR *)p, (XCHAR *)s);
+#else
+ ret = STRCMP ((XCHAR *)p, (XCHAR *)s);
+#endif
+
+ *pe = c1;
+ *se = c2;
+
+ return (ret == 0 ? ret : FNM_NOMATCH);
+}
+
+/* Match a ksh extended pattern specifier. Return FNM_NOMATCH on failure or
+ 0 on success. This is handed the entire rest of the pattern and string
+ the first time an extended pattern specifier is encountered, so it calls
+ gmatch recursively. */
+static int
+EXTMATCH (xc, s, se, p, pe, flags)
+ INT xc; /* select which operation */
+ CHAR *s, *se;
+ CHAR *p, *pe;
+ int flags;
+{
+ CHAR *prest; /* pointer to rest of pattern */
+ CHAR *psub; /* pointer to sub-pattern */
+ CHAR *pnext; /* pointer to next sub-pattern */
+ CHAR *srest; /* pointer to rest of string */
+ int m1, m2;
+
+#if DEBUG_MATCHING
+fprintf(stderr, "extmatch: xc = %c\n", xc);
+fprintf(stderr, "extmatch: s = %s; se = %s\n", s, se);
+fprintf(stderr, "extmatch: p = %s; pe = %s\n", p, pe);
+#endif
+
+ prest = PATSCAN (p + (*p == L('(')), pe, 0); /* ) */
+ if (prest == 0)
+ /* If PREST is 0, we failed to scan a valid pattern. In this
+ case, we just want to compare the two as strings. */
+ return (STRCOMPARE (p - 1, pe, s, se));
+
+ switch (xc)
+ {
+ case L('+'): /* match one or more occurrences */
+ case L('*'): /* match zero or more occurrences */
+ /* If we can get away with no matches, don't even bother. Just
+ call GMATCH on the rest of the pattern and return success if
+ it succeeds. */
+ if (xc == L('*') && (GMATCH (s, se, prest, pe, flags) == 0))
+ return 0;
+
+ /* OK, we have to do this the hard way. First, we make sure one of
+ the subpatterns matches, then we try to match the rest of the
+ string. */
+ for (psub = p + 1; ; psub = pnext)
+ {
+ pnext = PATSCAN (psub, pe, L('|'));
+ for (srest = s; srest <= se; srest++)
+ {
+ /* Match this substring (S -> SREST) against this
+ subpattern (psub -> pnext - 1) */
+ m1 = GMATCH (s, srest, psub, pnext - 1, flags) == 0;
+ /* OK, we matched a subpattern, so make sure the rest of the
+ string matches the rest of the pattern. Also handle
+ multiple matches of the pattern. */
+ if (m1)
+ m2 = (GMATCH (srest, se, prest, pe, flags) == 0) ||
+ (s != srest && GMATCH (srest, se, p - 1, pe, flags) == 0);
+ if (m1 && m2)
+ return (0);
+ }
+ if (pnext == prest)
+ break;
+ }
+ return (FNM_NOMATCH);
+
+ case L('?'): /* match zero or one of the patterns */
+ case L('@'): /* match exactly one of the patterns */
+ /* If we can get away with no matches, don't even bother. Just
+ call gmatch on the rest of the pattern and return success if
+ it succeeds. */
+ if (xc == L('?') && (GMATCH (s, se, prest, pe, flags) == 0))
+ return 0;
+
+ /* OK, we have to do this the hard way. First, we see if one of
+ the subpatterns matches, then, if it does, we try to match the
+ rest of the string. */
+ for (psub = p + 1; ; psub = pnext)
+ {
+ pnext = PATSCAN (psub, pe, L('|'));
+ srest = (prest == pe) ? se : s;
+ for ( ; srest <= se; srest++)
+ {
+ if (GMATCH (s, srest, psub, pnext - 1, flags) == 0 &&
+ GMATCH (srest, se, prest, pe, flags) == 0)
+ return (0);
+ }
+ if (pnext == prest)
+ break;
+ }
+ return (FNM_NOMATCH);
+
+ case '!': /* match anything *except* one of the patterns */
+ for (srest = s; srest <= se; srest++)
+ {
+ m1 = 0;
+ for (psub = p + 1; ; psub = pnext)
+ {
+ pnext = PATSCAN (psub, pe, L('|'));
+ /* If one of the patterns matches, just bail immediately. */
+ if (m1 = (GMATCH (s, srest, psub, pnext - 1, flags) == 0))
+ break;
+ if (pnext == prest)
+ break;
+ }
+ if (m1 == 0 && GMATCH (srest, se, prest, pe, flags) == 0)
+ return (0);
+ }
+ return (FNM_NOMATCH);
+ }
+
+ return (FNM_NOMATCH);
+}
+#endif /* EXTENDED_GLOB */
+
+#undef IS_CCLASS
+#undef FOLD
+#undef CHAR
+#undef U_CHAR
+#undef XCHAR
+#undef INT
+#undef INVALID
+#undef FCT
+#undef GMATCH
+#undef COLLSYM
+#undef PARSE_COLLSYM
+#undef PATSCAN
+#undef STRCOMPARE
+#undef EXTMATCH
+#undef BRACKMATCH
+#undef STRCHR
+#undef STRCOLL
+#undef STRLEN
+#undef STRCMP
+#undef COLLEQUIV
+#undef RANGECMP
+#undef L
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/smatch.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/smatch.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..12fde3d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/smatch.c
@@ -0,0 +1,393 @@
+/* strmatch.c -- ksh-like extended pattern matching for the shell and filename
+ globbing. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1991-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#include <stdio.h> /* for debugging */
+
+#include "strmatch.h"
+#include <chartypes.h>
+
+#include "bashansi.h"
+#include "shmbutil.h"
+#include "xmalloc.h"
+
+/* First, compile `sm_loop.c' for single-byte characters. */
+#define CHAR unsigned char
+#define U_CHAR unsigned char
+#define XCHAR char
+#define INT int
+#define L(CS) CS
+#define INVALID -1
+
+#undef STREQ
+#undef STREQN
+#define STREQ(a, b) ((a)[0] == (b)[0] && strcmp(a, b) == 0)
+#define STREQN(a, b, n) ((a)[0] == (b)[0] && strncmp(a, b, n) == 0)
+
+/* We use strcoll(3) for range comparisons in bracket expressions,
+ even though it can have unwanted side effects in locales
+ other than POSIX or US. For instance, in the de locale, [A-Z] matches
+ all characters. */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STRCOLL)
+/* Helper function for collating symbol equivalence. */
+static int rangecmp (c1, c2)
+ int c1, c2;
+{
+ static char s1[2] = { ' ', '\0' };
+ static char s2[2] = { ' ', '\0' };
+ int ret;
+
+ /* Eight bits only. Period. */
+ c1 &= 0xFF;
+ c2 &= 0xFF;
+
+ if (c1 == c2)
+ return (0);
+
+ s1[0] = c1;
+ s2[0] = c2;
+
+ if ((ret = strcoll (s1, s2)) != 0)
+ return ret;
+ return (c1 - c2);
+}
+#else /* !HAVE_STRCOLL */
+# define rangecmp(c1, c2) ((int)(c1) - (int)(c2))
+#endif /* !HAVE_STRCOLL */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STRCOLL)
+static int
+collequiv (c1, c2)
+ int c1, c2;
+{
+ return (rangecmp (c1, c2) == 0);
+}
+#else
+# define collequiv(c1, c2) ((c1) == (c2))
+#endif
+
+#define _COLLSYM _collsym
+#define __COLLSYM __collsym
+#define POSIXCOLL posix_collsyms
+#include "collsyms.h"
+
+static int
+collsym (s, len)
+ CHAR *s;
+ int len;
+{
+ register struct _collsym *csp;
+ char *x;
+
+ x = (char *)s;
+ for (csp = posix_collsyms; csp->name; csp++)
+ {
+ if (STREQN(csp->name, x, len) && csp->name[len] == '\0')
+ return (csp->code);
+ }
+ if (len == 1)
+ return s[0];
+ return INVALID;
+}
+
+/* unibyte character classification */
+#if !defined (isascii) && !defined (HAVE_ISASCII)
+# define isascii(c) ((unsigned int)(c) <= 0177)
+#endif
+
+enum char_class
+ {
+ CC_NO_CLASS = 0,
+ CC_ASCII, CC_ALNUM, CC_ALPHA, CC_BLANK, CC_CNTRL, CC_DIGIT, CC_GRAPH,
+ CC_LOWER, CC_PRINT, CC_PUNCT, CC_SPACE, CC_UPPER, CC_WORD, CC_XDIGIT
+ };
+
+static char const *const cclass_name[] =
+ {
+ "",
+ "ascii", "alnum", "alpha", "blank", "cntrl", "digit", "graph",
+ "lower", "print", "punct", "space", "upper", "word", "xdigit"
+ };
+
+#define N_CHAR_CLASS (sizeof(cclass_name) / sizeof (cclass_name[0]))
+
+static int
+is_cclass (c, name)
+ int c;
+ const char *name;
+{
+ enum char_class char_class = CC_NO_CLASS;
+ int i, result;
+
+ for (i = 1; i < N_CHAR_CLASS; i++)
+ {
+ if (STREQ (name, cclass_name[i]))
+ {
+ char_class = (enum char_class)i;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (char_class == 0)
+ return -1;
+
+ switch (char_class)
+ {
+ case CC_ASCII:
+ result = isascii (c);
+ break;
+ case CC_ALNUM:
+ result = ISALNUM (c);
+ break;
+ case CC_ALPHA:
+ result = ISALPHA (c);
+ break;
+ case CC_BLANK:
+ result = ISBLANK (c);
+ break;
+ case CC_CNTRL:
+ result = ISCNTRL (c);
+ break;
+ case CC_DIGIT:
+ result = ISDIGIT (c);
+ break;
+ case CC_GRAPH:
+ result = ISGRAPH (c);
+ break;
+ case CC_LOWER:
+ result = ISLOWER (c);
+ break;
+ case CC_PRINT:
+ result = ISPRINT (c);
+ break;
+ case CC_PUNCT:
+ result = ISPUNCT (c);
+ break;
+ case CC_SPACE:
+ result = ISSPACE (c);
+ break;
+ case CC_UPPER:
+ result = ISUPPER (c);
+ break;
+ case CC_WORD:
+ result = (ISALNUM (c) || c == '_');
+ break;
+ case CC_XDIGIT:
+ result = ISXDIGIT (c);
+ break;
+ default:
+ result = -1;
+ break;
+ }
+
+ return result;
+}
+
+/* Now include `sm_loop.c' for single-byte characters. */
+/* The result of FOLD is an `unsigned char' */
+# define FOLD(c) ((flags & FNM_CASEFOLD) \
+ ? TOLOWER ((unsigned char)c) \
+ : ((unsigned char)c))
+
+#define FCT internal_strmatch
+#define GMATCH gmatch
+#define COLLSYM collsym
+#define PARSE_COLLSYM parse_collsym
+#define BRACKMATCH brackmatch
+#define PATSCAN patscan
+#define STRCOMPARE strcompare
+#define EXTMATCH extmatch
+#define STRCHR(S, C) strchr((S), (C))
+#define STRCOLL(S1, S2) strcoll((S1), (S2))
+#define STRLEN(S) strlen(S)
+#define STRCMP(S1, S2) strcmp((S1), (S2))
+#define RANGECMP(C1, C2) rangecmp((C1), (C2))
+#define COLLEQUIV(C1, C2) collequiv((C1), (C2))
+#define CTYPE_T enum char_class
+#define IS_CCLASS(C, S) is_cclass((C), (S))
+#include "sm_loop.c"
+
+#if HANDLE_MULTIBYTE
+
+# define CHAR wchar_t
+# define U_CHAR wint_t
+# define XCHAR wchar_t
+# define INT wint_t
+# define L(CS) L##CS
+# define INVALID WEOF
+
+# undef STREQ
+# undef STREQN
+# define STREQ(s1, s2) ((wcscmp (s1, s2) == 0))
+# define STREQN(a, b, n) ((a)[0] == (b)[0] && wcsncmp(a, b, n) == 0)
+
+static int
+rangecmp_wc (c1, c2)
+ wint_t c1, c2;
+{
+ static wchar_t s1[2] = { L' ', L'\0' };
+ static wchar_t s2[2] = { L' ', L'\0' };
+ int ret;
+
+ if (c1 == c2)
+ return 0;
+
+ s1[0] = c1;
+ s2[0] = c2;
+
+ return (wcscoll (s1, s2));
+}
+
+static int
+collequiv_wc (c, equiv)
+ wint_t c, equiv;
+{
+ return (!(c - equiv));
+}
+
+/* Helper function for collating symbol. */
+# define _COLLSYM _collwcsym
+# define __COLLSYM __collwcsym
+# define POSIXCOLL posix_collwcsyms
+# include "collsyms.h"
+
+static wint_t
+collwcsym (s, len)
+ wchar_t *s;
+ int len;
+{
+ register struct _collwcsym *csp;
+
+ for (csp = posix_collwcsyms; csp->name; csp++)
+ {
+ if (STREQN(csp->name, s, len) && csp->name[len] == L'\0')
+ return (csp->code);
+ }
+ if (len == 1)
+ return s[0];
+ return INVALID;
+}
+
+static int
+is_wcclass (wc, name)
+ wint_t wc;
+ wchar_t *name;
+{
+ char *mbs;
+ mbstate_t state;
+ size_t mbslength;
+ wctype_t desc;
+ int want_word;
+
+ if ((wctype ("ascii") == (wctype_t)0) && (wcscmp (name, L"ascii") == 0))
+ {
+ int c;
+
+ if ((c = wctob (wc)) == EOF)
+ return 0;
+ else
+ return (c <= 0x7F);
+ }
+
+ want_word = (wcscmp (name, L"word") == 0);
+ if (want_word)
+ name = L"alnum";
+
+ memset (&state, '\0', sizeof (mbstate_t));
+ mbs = (char *) malloc (wcslen(name) * MB_CUR_MAX + 1);
+ mbslength = wcsrtombs(mbs, (const wchar_t **)&name, (wcslen(name) * MB_CUR_MAX + 1), &state);
+
+ if (mbslength == (size_t)-1 || mbslength == (size_t)-2)
+ {
+ free (mbs);
+ return -1;
+ }
+ desc = wctype (mbs);
+ free (mbs);
+
+ if (desc == (wctype_t)0)
+ return -1;
+
+ if (want_word)
+ return (iswctype (wc, desc) || wc == L'_');
+ else
+ return (iswctype (wc, desc));
+}
+
+/* Now include `sm_loop.c' for multibyte characters. */
+#define FOLD(c) ((flags & FNM_CASEFOLD) && iswupper (c) ? towlower (c) : (c))
+#define FCT internal_wstrmatch
+#define GMATCH gmatch_wc
+#define COLLSYM collwcsym
+#define PARSE_COLLSYM parse_collwcsym
+#define BRACKMATCH brackmatch_wc
+#define PATSCAN patscan_wc
+#define STRCOMPARE wscompare
+#define EXTMATCH extmatch_wc
+#define STRCHR(S, C) wcschr((S), (C))
+#define STRCOLL(S1, S2) wcscoll((S1), (S2))
+#define STRLEN(S) wcslen(S)
+#define STRCMP(S1, S2) wcscmp((S1), (S2))
+#define RANGECMP(C1, C2) rangecmp_wc((C1), (C2))
+#define COLLEQUIV(C1, C2) collequiv_wc((C1), (C2))
+#define CTYPE_T enum char_class
+#define IS_CCLASS(C, S) is_wcclass((C), (S))
+#include "sm_loop.c"
+
+#endif /* HAVE_MULTIBYTE */
+
+int
+xstrmatch (pattern, string, flags)
+ char *pattern;
+ char *string;
+ int flags;
+{
+#if HANDLE_MULTIBYTE
+ int ret;
+ size_t n;
+ wchar_t *wpattern, *wstring;
+
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX == 1)
+ return (internal_strmatch ((unsigned char *)pattern, (unsigned char *)string, flags));
+
+ n = xdupmbstowcs (&wpattern, NULL, pattern);
+ if (n == (size_t)-1 || n == (size_t)-2)
+ return (internal_strmatch ((unsigned char *)pattern, (unsigned char *)string, flags));
+
+ n = xdupmbstowcs (&wstring, NULL, string);
+ if (n == (size_t)-1 || n == (size_t)-2)
+ {
+ free (wpattern);
+ return (internal_strmatch ((unsigned char *)pattern, (unsigned char *)string, flags));
+ }
+
+ ret = internal_wstrmatch (wpattern, wstring, flags);
+
+ free (wpattern);
+ free (wstring);
+
+ return ret;
+#else
+ return (internal_strmatch ((unsigned char *)pattern, (unsigned char *)string, flags));
+#endif /* !HANDLE_MULTIBYTE */
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/strmatch.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/strmatch.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..4d9c68d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/strmatch.c
@@ -0,0 +1,79 @@
+/* strmatch.c -- ksh-like extended pattern matching for the shell and filename
+ globbing. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1991-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#include "stdc.h"
+#include "strmatch.h"
+
+extern int xstrmatch __P((char *, char *, int));
+#if defined (HAVE_MULTIBYTE)
+extern int internal_wstrmatch __P((wchar_t *, wchar_t *, int));
+#endif
+
+int
+strmatch (pattern, string, flags)
+ char *pattern;
+ char *string;
+ int flags;
+{
+ if (string == 0 || pattern == 0)
+ return FNM_NOMATCH;
+
+ return (xstrmatch (pattern, string, flags));
+}
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+int
+wcsmatch (wpattern, wstring, flags)
+ wchar_t *wpattern;
+ wchar_t *wstring;
+ int flags;
+{
+ if (wstring == 0 || wpattern == 0)
+ return (FNM_NOMATCH);
+
+ return (internal_wstrmatch (wpattern, wstring, flags));
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifdef TEST
+main (c, v)
+ int c;
+ char **v;
+{
+ char *string, *pat;
+
+ string = v[1];
+ pat = v[2];
+
+ if (strmatch (pat, string, 0) == 0)
+ {
+ printf ("%s matches %s\n", string, pat);
+ exit (0);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ printf ("%s does not match %s\n", string, pat);
+ exit (1);
+ }
+}
+#endif
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/strmatch.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/strmatch.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..7471444
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/strmatch.h
@@ -0,0 +1,62 @@
+/* Copyright (C) 1991-2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+This file is part of the GNU C Library.
+
+The GNU C Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+modify it under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as
+published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the
+License, or (at your option) any later version.
+
+The GNU C Library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+Library General Public License for more details.
+
+You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+License along with the GNU C Library; see the file COPYING.LIB. If
+not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
+59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#ifndef _STRMATCH_H
+#define _STRMATCH_H 1
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#include "stdc.h"
+
+/* We #undef these before defining them because some losing systems
+ (HP-UX A.08.07 for example) define these in <unistd.h>. */
+#undef FNM_PATHNAME
+#undef FNM_NOESCAPE
+#undef FNM_PERIOD
+
+/* Bits set in the FLAGS argument to `strmatch'. */
+
+/* standard flags are like fnmatch(3). */
+#define FNM_PATHNAME (1 << 0) /* No wildcard can ever match `/'. */
+#define FNM_NOESCAPE (1 << 1) /* Backslashes don't quote special chars. */
+#define FNM_PERIOD (1 << 2) /* Leading `.' is matched only explicitly. */
+
+/* extended flags not available in most libc fnmatch versions, but we undef
+ them to avoid any possible warnings. */
+#undef FNM_LEADING_DIR
+#undef FNM_CASEFOLD
+#undef FNM_EXTMATCH
+
+#define FNM_LEADING_DIR (1 << 3) /* Ignore `/...' after a match. */
+#define FNM_CASEFOLD (1 << 4) /* Compare without regard to case. */
+#define FNM_EXTMATCH (1 << 5) /* Use ksh-like extended matching. */
+
+/* Value returned by `strmatch' if STRING does not match PATTERN. */
+#undef FNM_NOMATCH
+
+#define FNM_NOMATCH 1
+
+/* Match STRING against the filename pattern PATTERN,
+ returning zero if it matches, FNM_NOMATCH if not. */
+extern int strmatch __P((char *, char *, int));
+
+#if HANDLE_MULTIBYTE
+extern int wcsmatch __P((wchar_t *, wchar_t *, int));
+#endif
+
+#endif /* _STRMATCH_H */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/xmbsrtowcs.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/xmbsrtowcs.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f8c29b9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/glob/xmbsrtowcs.c
@@ -0,0 +1,250 @@
+/* xmbsrtowcs.c -- replacement function for mbsrtowcs */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 2002-2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#include <config.h>
+
+#include <bashansi.h>
+
+/* <wchar.h>, <wctype.h> and <stdlib.h> are included in "shmbutil.h".
+ If <wchar.h>, <wctype.h>, mbsrtowcs(), exist, HANDLE_MULTIBYTE
+ is defined as 1. */
+#include <shmbutil.h>
+
+#if HANDLE_MULTIBYTE
+/* On some locales (ex. ja_JP.sjis), mbsrtowc doesn't convert 0x5c to U<0x5c>.
+ So, this function is made for converting 0x5c to U<0x5c>. */
+
+static mbstate_t local_state;
+static int local_state_use = 0;
+
+size_t
+xmbsrtowcs (dest, src, len, pstate)
+ wchar_t *dest;
+ const char **src;
+ size_t len;
+ mbstate_t *pstate;
+{
+ mbstate_t *ps;
+ size_t mblength, wclength, n;
+
+ ps = pstate;
+ if (pstate == NULL)
+ {
+ if (!local_state_use)
+ {
+ memset (&local_state, '\0', sizeof(mbstate_t));
+ local_state_use = 1;
+ }
+ ps = &local_state;
+ }
+
+ n = strlen (*src);
+
+ if (dest == NULL)
+ {
+ wchar_t *wsbuf;
+ const char *mbs;
+ mbstate_t psbuf;
+
+ /* It doesn't matter if malloc fails here, since mbsrtowcs should do
+ the right thing with a NULL first argument. */
+ wsbuf = (wchar_t *) malloc ((n + 1) * sizeof(wchar_t));
+ mbs = *src;
+ psbuf = *ps;
+
+ wclength = mbsrtowcs (wsbuf, &mbs, n, &psbuf);
+
+ if (wsbuf)
+ free (wsbuf);
+ return wclength;
+ }
+
+ for (wclength = 0; wclength < len; wclength++, dest++)
+ {
+ if (mbsinit(ps))
+ {
+ if (**src == '\0')
+ {
+ *dest = L'\0';
+ *src = NULL;
+ return (wclength);
+ }
+ else if (**src == '\\')
+ {
+ *dest = L'\\';
+ mblength = 1;
+ }
+ else
+ mblength = mbrtowc(dest, *src, n, ps);
+ }
+ else
+ mblength = mbrtowc(dest, *src, n, ps);
+
+ /* Cannot convert multibyte character to wide character. */
+ if (mblength == (size_t)-1 || mblength == (size_t)-2)
+ return (size_t)-1;
+
+ *src += mblength;
+ n -= mblength;
+
+ /* The multibyte string has been completely converted,
+ including the terminating '\0'. */
+ if (*dest == L'\0')
+ {
+ *src = NULL;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ return (wclength);
+}
+
+/* Convert a multibyte string to a wide character string. Memory for the
+ new wide character string is obtained with malloc.
+
+ The return value is the length of the wide character string. Returns a
+ pointer to the wide character string in DESTP. If INDICESP is not NULL,
+ INDICESP stores the pointer to the pointer array. Each pointer is to
+ the first byte of each multibyte character. Memory for the pointer array
+ is obtained with malloc, too.
+ If conversion is failed, the return value is (size_t)-1 and the values
+ of DESTP and INDICESP are NULL. */
+
+#define WSBUF_INC 32
+
+size_t
+xdupmbstowcs (destp, indicesp, src)
+ wchar_t **destp; /* Store the pointer to the wide character string */
+ char ***indicesp; /* Store the pointer to the pointer array. */
+ const char *src; /* Multibyte character string */
+{
+ const char *p; /* Conversion start position of src */
+ wchar_t wc; /* Created wide character by conversion */
+ wchar_t *wsbuf; /* Buffer for wide characters. */
+ char **indices; /* Buffer for indices. */
+ size_t wsbuf_size; /* Size of WSBUF */
+ size_t wcnum; /* Number of wide characters in WSBUF */
+ mbstate_t state; /* Conversion State */
+
+ /* In case SRC or DESP is NULL, conversion doesn't take place. */
+ if (src == NULL || destp == NULL)
+ {
+ *destp = NULL;
+ return (size_t)-1;
+ }
+
+ memset (&state, '\0', sizeof(mbstate_t));
+ wsbuf_size = WSBUF_INC;
+
+ wsbuf = (wchar_t *) malloc (wsbuf_size * sizeof(wchar_t));
+ if (wsbuf == NULL)
+ {
+ *destp = NULL;
+ return (size_t)-1;
+ }
+
+ indices = (char **) malloc (wsbuf_size * sizeof(char *));
+ if (indices == NULL)
+ {
+ free (wsbuf);
+ *destp = NULL;
+ return (size_t)-1;
+ }
+
+ p = src;
+ wcnum = 0;
+ do
+ {
+ size_t mblength; /* Byte length of one multibyte character. */
+
+ if (mbsinit (&state))
+ {
+ if (*p == '\0')
+ {
+ wc = L'\0';
+ mblength = 1;
+ }
+ else if (*p == '\\')
+ {
+ wc = L'\\';
+ mblength = 1;
+ }
+ else
+ mblength = mbrtowc(&wc, p, MB_LEN_MAX, &state);
+ }
+ else
+ mblength = mbrtowc(&wc, p, MB_LEN_MAX, &state);
+
+ /* Conversion failed. */
+ if (MB_INVALIDCH (mblength))
+ {
+ free (wsbuf);
+ free (indices);
+ *destp = NULL;
+ return (size_t)-1;
+ }
+
+ ++wcnum;
+
+ /* Resize buffers when they are not large enough. */
+ if (wsbuf_size < wcnum)
+ {
+ wchar_t *wstmp;
+ char **idxtmp;
+
+ wsbuf_size += WSBUF_INC;
+
+ wstmp = (wchar_t *) realloc (wsbuf, wsbuf_size * sizeof (wchar_t));
+ if (wstmp == NULL)
+ {
+ free (wsbuf);
+ free (indices);
+ *destp = NULL;
+ return (size_t)-1;
+ }
+ wsbuf = wstmp;
+
+ idxtmp = (char **) realloc (indices, wsbuf_size * sizeof (char **));
+ if (idxtmp == NULL)
+ {
+ free (wsbuf);
+ free (indices);
+ *destp = NULL;
+ return (size_t)-1;
+ }
+ indices = idxtmp;
+ }
+
+ wsbuf[wcnum - 1] = wc;
+ indices[wcnum - 1] = (char *)p;
+ p += mblength;
+ }
+ while (MB_NULLWCH (wc) == 0);
+
+ /* Return the length of the wide character string, not including `\0'. */
+ *destp = wsbuf;
+ if (indicesp != NULL)
+ *indicesp = indices;
+ else
+ free (indices);
+
+ return (wcnum - 1);
+}
+
+#endif /* HANDLE_MULTIBYTE */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/ChangeLog b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/ChangeLog
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..eed2d21
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/ChangeLog
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+2003-05-22 GNU <bug-gnu-gettext@gnu.org>
+
+ * Version 0.12.1 released.
+
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/Makefile.in b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/Makefile.in
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..8520ed2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/Makefile.in
@@ -0,0 +1,465 @@
+# Makefile for directory with message catalog handling library of GNU gettext
+# Copyright (C) 1995-1998, 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+#
+# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+# under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+# by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+# any later version.
+#
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+# Library General Public License for more details.
+#
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+# License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+# USA.
+
+PACKAGE = @PACKAGE_NAME@
+VERSION = @PACKAGE_VERSION@
+
+SHELL = /bin/sh
+
+srcdir = @srcdir@
+top_srcdir = @top_srcdir@
+top_builddir = @BUILD_DIR@
+VPATH = $(srcdir)
+
+prefix = @prefix@
+exec_prefix = @exec_prefix@
+transform = @program_transform_name@
+libdir = @libdir@
+includedir = @includedir@
+datadir = @datadir@
+localedir = $(datadir)/locale
+gettextsrcdir = $(datadir)/gettext/intl
+aliaspath = $(localedir)
+subdir = intl
+
+INSTALL = @INSTALL@
+INSTALL_DATA = @INSTALL_DATA@
+MKINSTALLDIRS = @MKINSTALLDIRS@
+mkinstalldirs = $(SHELL) $(MKINSTALLDIRS)
+
+l = @INTL_LIBTOOL_SUFFIX_PREFIX@
+
+AR = ar
+CC = @CC@
+LIBTOOL = @LIBTOOL@
+RANLIB = @RANLIB@
+YACC = @INTLBISON@ -y -d
+YFLAGS = --name-prefix=__gettext
+
+LOCAL_DEFS = @LOCAL_DEFS@
+
+DEFS = -DLOCALEDIR=\"$(localedir)\" -DLOCALE_ALIAS_PATH=\"$(aliaspath)\" \
+-DLIBDIR=\"$(prefix)/libdata\" -DIN_LIBINTL \
+-DENABLE_RELOCATABLE=1 -DIN_LIBRARY -DINSTALLDIR=\"$(libdir)\" -DNO_XMALLOC \
+-Dset_relocation_prefix=libintl_set_relocation_prefix \
+-Drelocate=libintl_relocate \
+-DDEPENDS_ON_LIBICONV=1 @DEFS@ @LOCAL_DEFS@
+CPPFLAGS = @CPPFLAGS@
+CFLAGS = @CFLAGS@
+LDFLAGS = @LDFLAGS@
+LIBS = @LIBS@
+
+COMPILE = $(CC) -c $(DEFS) $(INCLUDES) $(CPPFLAGS) $(CFLAGS) $(XCFLAGS)
+
+HEADERS = \
+ gmo.h \
+ gettextP.h \
+ hash-string.h \
+ loadinfo.h \
+ plural-exp.h \
+ eval-plural.h \
+ localcharset.h \
+ relocatable.h \
+ os2compat.h \
+ libgnuintl.h.in
+SOURCES = \
+ bindtextdom.c \
+ dcgettext.c \
+ dgettext.c \
+ gettext.c \
+ finddomain.c \
+ loadmsgcat.c \
+ localealias.c \
+ textdomain.c \
+ l10nflist.c \
+ explodename.c \
+ dcigettext.c \
+ dcngettext.c \
+ dngettext.c \
+ ngettext.c \
+ plural.y \
+ plural-exp.c \
+ localcharset.c \
+ relocatable.c \
+ localename.c \
+ log.c \
+ osdep.c \
+ os2compat.c \
+ intl-compat.c
+OBJECTS = \
+ bindtextdom.$lo \
+ dcgettext.$lo \
+ dgettext.$lo \
+ gettext.$lo \
+ finddomain.$lo \
+ loadmsgcat.$lo \
+ localealias.$lo \
+ textdomain.$lo \
+ l10nflist.$lo \
+ explodename.$lo \
+ dcigettext.$lo \
+ dcngettext.$lo \
+ dngettext.$lo \
+ ngettext.$lo \
+ plural.$lo \
+ plural-exp.$lo \
+ localcharset.$lo \
+ relocatable.$lo \
+ localename.$lo \
+ log.$lo \
+ osdep.$lo \
+ intl-compat.$lo
+DISTFILES.common = Makefile.in \
+config.charset locale.alias ref-add.sin ref-del.sin $(HEADERS) $(SOURCES)
+DISTFILES.generated = plural.c
+DISTFILES.normal = VERSION
+DISTFILES.gettext = COPYING.LIB-2.0 COPYING.LIB-2.1 libintl.glibc \
+Makefile.vms libgnuintl.h.msvc-shared README.woe32 Makefile.msvc
+DISTFILES.obsolete = xopen-msg.sed linux-msg.sed po2tbl.sed.in cat-compat.c \
+COPYING.LIB-2 gettext.h libgettext.h plural-eval.c libgnuintl.h
+
+all: all-@USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL@
+all-yes: libintl.$la libintl.h charset.alias ref-add.sed ref-del.sed
+all-no: all-no-@BUILD_INCLUDED_LIBINTL@
+all-no-yes: libgnuintl.$la
+all-no-no:
+
+libintl.a libgnuintl.a: $(OBJECTS)
+ rm -f $@
+ $(AR) cru $@ $(OBJECTS)
+ $(RANLIB) $@
+
+libintl.la libgnuintl.la: $(OBJECTS)
+ $(LIBTOOL) --mode=link \
+ $(CC) $(CPPFLAGS) $(CFLAGS) $(XCFLAGS) $(LDFLAGS) -o $@ \
+ $(OBJECTS) @LTLIBICONV@ $(LIBS) \
+ -version-info $(LTV_CURRENT):$(LTV_REVISION):$(LTV_AGE) \
+ -rpath $(libdir) \
+ -no-undefined
+
+# Libtool's library version information for libintl.
+# Before making a gettext release, the gettext maintainer must change this
+# according to the libtool documentation, section "Library interface versions".
+# Maintainers of other packages that include the intl directory must *not*
+# change these values.
+LTV_CURRENT=5
+LTV_REVISION=0
+LTV_AGE=3
+
+.SUFFIXES:
+.SUFFIXES: .c .y .o .lo .sin .sed
+
+.c.o:
+ $(COMPILE) $<
+
+.y.c:
+ $(YACC) $(YFLAGS) --output $@ $<
+ rm -f $*.h
+
+bindtextdom.lo: $(srcdir)/bindtextdom.c
+ $(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/bindtextdom.c
+dcgettext.lo: $(srcdir)/dcgettext.c
+ $(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/dcgettext.c
+dgettext.lo: $(srcdir)/dgettext.c
+ $(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/dgettext.c
+gettext.lo: $(srcdir)/gettext.c
+ $(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/gettext.c
+finddomain.lo: $(srcdir)/finddomain.c
+ $(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/finddomain.c
+loadmsgcat.lo: $(srcdir)/loadmsgcat.c
+ $(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/loadmsgcat.c
+localealias.lo: $(srcdir)/localealias.c
+ $(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/localealias.c
+textdomain.lo: $(srcdir)/textdomain.c
+ $(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/textdomain.c
+l10nflist.lo: $(srcdir)/l10nflist.c
+ $(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/l10nflist.c
+explodename.lo: $(srcdir)/explodename.c
+ $(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/explodename.c
+dcigettext.lo: $(srcdir)/dcigettext.c
+ $(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/dcigettext.c
+dcngettext.lo: $(srcdir)/dcngettext.c
+ $(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/dcngettext.c
+dngettext.lo: $(srcdir)/dngettext.c
+ $(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/dngettext.c
+ngettext.lo: $(srcdir)/ngettext.c
+ $(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/ngettext.c
+plural.lo: $(srcdir)/plural.c
+ $(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/plural.c
+plural-exp.lo: $(srcdir)/plural-exp.c
+ $(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/plural-exp.c
+localcharset.lo: $(srcdir)/localcharset.c
+ $(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/localcharset.c
+relocatable.lo: $(srcdir)/relocatable.c
+ $(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/relocatable.c
+localename.lo: $(srcdir)/localename.c
+ $(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/localename.c
+log.lo: $(srcdir)/log.c
+ $(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/log.c
+osdep.lo: $(srcdir)/osdep.c
+ $(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/osdep.c
+intl-compat.lo: $(srcdir)/intl-compat.c
+ $(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/intl-compat.c
+
+ref-add.sed: $(srcdir)/ref-add.sin
+ sed -e '/^#/d' -e 's/@''PACKAGE''@/@PACKAGE@/g' $(srcdir)/ref-add.sin > t-ref-add.sed
+ mv t-ref-add.sed ref-add.sed
+ref-del.sed: $(srcdir)/ref-del.sin
+ sed -e '/^#/d' -e 's/@''PACKAGE''@/@PACKAGE@/g' $(srcdir)/ref-del.sin > t-ref-del.sed
+ mv t-ref-del.sed ref-del.sed
+
+INCLUDES = -I. -I$(srcdir) -I${top_builddir} -I${top_srcdir}
+
+libgnuintl.h: $(srcdir)/libgnuintl.h.in
+ cp $(srcdir)/libgnuintl.h.in libgnuintl.h
+
+libintl.h: libgnuintl.h
+ cp libgnuintl.h libintl.h
+
+charset.alias: $(srcdir)/config.charset
+ $(SHELL) $(srcdir)/config.charset '@host@' > t-$@
+ mv t-$@ $@
+
+check: all
+
+# We must not install the libintl.h/libintl.a files if we are on a
+# system which has the GNU gettext() function in its C library or in a
+# separate library.
+# If you want to use the one which comes with this version of the
+# package, you have to use `configure --with-included-gettext'.
+install: install-exec install-data
+install-exec: all
+ if { test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-runtime" || test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-tools"; } \
+ && test '@USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL@' = yes; then \
+ $(mkinstalldirs) $(DESTDIR)$(libdir) $(DESTDIR)$(includedir); \
+ $(INSTALL_DATA) libintl.h $(DESTDIR)$(includedir)/libintl.h; \
+ $(LIBTOOL) --mode=install \
+ $(INSTALL_DATA) libintl.$la $(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/libintl.$la; \
+ if test "@RELOCATABLE@" = yes; then \
+ dependencies=`sed -n -e 's,^dependency_libs=\(.*\),\1,p' < $(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/libintl.la | sed -e "s,^',," -e "s,'\$$,,"`; \
+ if test -n "$dependencies"; then \
+ rm -f $(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/libintl.la; \
+ fi; \
+ fi; \
+ else \
+ : ; \
+ fi
+ if test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-tools" \
+ && test '@USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL@' = no; then \
+ $(mkinstalldirs) $(DESTDIR)$(libdir); \
+ $(LIBTOOL) --mode=install \
+ $(INSTALL_DATA) libgnuintl.$la $(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/libgnuintl.$la; \
+ rm -f $(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/preloadable_libintl.so; \
+ $(INSTALL_DATA) $(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/libgnuintl.so $(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/preloadable_libintl.so; \
+ $(LIBTOOL) --mode=uninstall \
+ rm -f $(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/libgnuintl.$la; \
+ else \
+ : ; \
+ fi
+ if test '@USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL@' = yes; then \
+ $(mkinstalldirs) $(DESTDIR)$(localedir); \
+ test -f $(DESTDIR)$(localedir)/locale.alias \
+ && orig=$(DESTDIR)$(localedir)/locale.alias \
+ || orig=$(srcdir)/locale.alias; \
+ temp=$(DESTDIR)$(localedir)/t-locale.alias; \
+ dest=$(DESTDIR)$(localedir)/locale.alias; \
+ sed -f ref-add.sed $$orig > $$temp; \
+ $(INSTALL_DATA) $$temp $$dest; \
+ rm -f $$temp; \
+ else \
+ : ; \
+ fi
+install-data: all
+ if test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-tools"; then \
+ $(mkinstalldirs) $(DESTDIR)$(gettextsrcdir); \
+ $(INSTALL_DATA) VERSION $(DESTDIR)$(gettextsrcdir)/VERSION; \
+ $(INSTALL_DATA) ChangeLog.inst $(DESTDIR)$(gettextsrcdir)/ChangeLog; \
+ dists="COPYING.LIB-2.0 COPYING.LIB-2.1 $(DISTFILES.common)"; \
+ for file in $$dists; do \
+ $(INSTALL_DATA) $(srcdir)/$$file \
+ $(DESTDIR)$(gettextsrcdir)/$$file; \
+ done; \
+ chmod a+x $(DESTDIR)$(gettextsrcdir)/config.charset; \
+ dists="$(DISTFILES.generated)"; \
+ for file in $$dists; do \
+ if test -f $$file; then dir=.; else dir=$(srcdir); fi; \
+ $(INSTALL_DATA) $$dir/$$file \
+ $(DESTDIR)$(gettextsrcdir)/$$file; \
+ done; \
+ dists="$(DISTFILES.obsolete)"; \
+ for file in $$dists; do \
+ rm -f $(DESTDIR)$(gettextsrcdir)/$$file; \
+ done; \
+ else \
+ : ; \
+ fi
+
+install-strip: install
+
+installdirs:
+ if { test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-runtime" || test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-tools"; } \
+ && test '@USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL@' = yes; then \
+ $(mkinstalldirs) $(DESTDIR)$(libdir) $(DESTDIR)$(includedir); \
+ else \
+ : ; \
+ fi
+ if test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-tools" \
+ && test '@USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL@' = no; then \
+ $(mkinstalldirs) $(DESTDIR)$(libdir); \
+ else \
+ : ; \
+ fi
+ if test '@USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL@' = yes; then \
+ test @GLIBC21@ != no || $(mkinstalldirs) $(DESTDIR)$(libdir); \
+ $(mkinstalldirs) $(DESTDIR)$(localedir); \
+ else \
+ : ; \
+ fi
+ if test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-tools"; then \
+ $(mkinstalldirs) $(DESTDIR)$(gettextsrcdir); \
+ else \
+ : ; \
+ fi
+
+# Define this as empty until I found a useful application.
+installcheck:
+
+uninstall:
+ if { test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-runtime" || test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-tools"; } \
+ && test '@USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL@' = yes; then \
+ rm -f $(DESTDIR)$(includedir)/libintl.h; \
+ $(LIBTOOL) --mode=uninstall \
+ rm -f $(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/libintl.$la; \
+ else \
+ : ; \
+ fi
+ if test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-tools" \
+ && test '@USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL@' = no; then \
+ rm -f $(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/preloadable_libintl.so; \
+ else \
+ : ; \
+ fi
+ if test '@USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL@' = yes; then \
+ if test -f $(DESTDIR)$(prefix)/libdata/charset.alias; then \
+ temp=$(DESTDIR)$(prefix)/libdata/t-charset.alias; \
+ dest=$(DESTDIR)$(prefix)/libdata/charset.alias; \
+ sed -f ref-del.sed $$dest > $$temp; \
+ if grep '^# Packages using this file: $$' $$temp > /dev/null; then \
+ rm -f $$dest; \
+ else \
+ $(INSTALL_DATA) $$temp $$dest; \
+ fi; \
+ rm -f $$temp; \
+ fi; \
+ if test -f $(DESTDIR)$(localedir)/locale.alias; then \
+ temp=$(DESTDIR)$(localedir)/t-locale.alias; \
+ dest=$(DESTDIR)$(localedir)/locale.alias; \
+ sed -f ref-del.sed $$dest > $$temp; \
+ if grep '^# Packages using this file: $$' $$temp > /dev/null; then \
+ rm -f $$dest; \
+ else \
+ $(INSTALL_DATA) $$temp $$dest; \
+ fi; \
+ rm -f $$temp; \
+ fi; \
+ else \
+ : ; \
+ fi
+ if test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-tools"; then \
+ for file in VERSION ChangeLog COPYING.LIB-2.0 COPYING.LIB-2.1 $(DISTFILES.common) $(DISTFILES.generated); do \
+ rm -f $(DESTDIR)$(gettextsrcdir)/$$file; \
+ done; \
+ else \
+ : ; \
+ fi
+
+info dvi ps pdf html:
+
+$(OBJECTS): ${top_builddir}/config.h libgnuintl.h
+bindtextdom.$lo dcgettext.$lo dcigettext.$lo dcngettext.$lo dgettext.$lo dngettext.$lo finddomain.$lo gettext.$lo intl-compat.$lo loadmsgcat.$lo localealias.$lo ngettext.$lo textdomain.$lo: $(srcdir)/gettextP.h $(srcdir)/gmo.h $(srcdir)/loadinfo.h
+dcigettext.$lo loadmsgcat.$lo: $(srcdir)/hash-string.h
+explodename.$lo l10nflist.$lo: $(srcdir)/loadinfo.h
+dcigettext.$lo loadmsgcat.$lo plural.$lo plural-exp.$lo: $(srcdir)/plural-exp.h
+dcigettext.$lo: $(srcdir)/eval-plural.h
+localcharset.$lo: $(srcdir)/localcharset.h
+localealias.$lo localcharset.$lo relocatable.$lo: $(srcdir)/relocatable.h
+
+tags: TAGS
+
+TAGS: $(HEADERS) $(SOURCES)
+ here=`pwd`; cd $(srcdir) && etags -o $$here/TAGS $(HEADERS) $(SOURCES)
+
+ctags: CTAGS
+
+CTAGS: $(HEADERS) $(SOURCES)
+ here=`pwd`; cd $(srcdir) && ctags -o $$here/CTAGS $(HEADERS) $(SOURCES)
+
+id: ID
+
+ID: $(HEADERS) $(SOURCES)
+ here=`pwd`; cd $(srcdir) && mkid -f$$here/ID $(HEADERS) $(SOURCES)
+
+
+mostlyclean:
+ rm -f *.a *.la *.o *.obj *.lo core core.*
+ rm -f libgnuintl.h libintl.h charset.alias ref-add.sed ref-del.sed
+ rm -f -r .libs _libs
+
+clean: mostlyclean
+
+distclean: clean
+ rm -f Makefile ID TAGS
+ if test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-runtime" || test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-tools"; then \
+ rm -f ChangeLog.inst $(DISTFILES.normal); \
+ else \
+ : ; \
+ fi
+
+maintainer-clean: distclean
+ @echo "This command is intended for maintainers to use;"
+ @echo "it deletes files that may require special tools to rebuild."
+
+
+# GNU gettext needs not contain the file `VERSION' but contains some
+# other files which should not be distributed in other packages.
+distdir = ../$(PACKAGE)-$(VERSION)/$(subdir)
+dist distdir: Makefile
+ if test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-tools"; then \
+ : ; \
+ else \
+ if test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-runtime"; then \
+ additional="$(DISTFILES.gettext)"; \
+ else \
+ additional="$(DISTFILES.normal)"; \
+ fi; \
+ $(MAKE) $(DISTFILES.common) $(DISTFILES.generated) $$additional; \
+ for file in ChangeLog $(DISTFILES.common) $(DISTFILES.generated) $$additional; do \
+ if test -f $$file; then dir=.; else dir=$(srcdir); fi; \
+ cp -p $$dir/$$file $(distdir); \
+ done; \
+ fi
+
+Makefile: $(srcdir)/Makefile.in $(top_builddir)/config.status
+ cd $(top_builddir) && $(SHELL) ./config.status
+# This would be more efficient, but doesn't work any more with autoconf-2.57,
+# when AC_CONFIG_FILES([intl/Makefile:somedir/Makefile.in]) is used.
+# cd $(top_builddir) && CONFIG_FILES=$(subdir)/$@ CONFIG_HEADERS= $(SHELL) ./config.status
+
+# Tell versions [3.59,3.63) of GNU make not to export all variables.
+# Otherwise a system limit (for SysV at least) may be exceeded.
+.NOEXPORT:
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/VERSION b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/VERSION
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1303183
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/VERSION
@@ -0,0 +1 @@
+GNU gettext library from gettext-0.12.1
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/bindtextdom.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/bindtextdom.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..250f5e8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/bindtextdom.c
@@ -0,0 +1,374 @@
+/* Implementation of the bindtextdomain(3) function
+ Copyright (C) 1995-1998, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stddef.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# include <libintl.h>
+#else
+# include "libgnuintl.h"
+#endif
+#include "gettextP.h"
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+/* We have to handle multi-threaded applications. */
+# include <bits/libc-lock.h>
+#else
+/* Provide dummy implementation if this is outside glibc. */
+# define __libc_rwlock_define(CLASS, NAME)
+# define __libc_rwlock_wrlock(NAME)
+# define __libc_rwlock_unlock(NAME)
+#endif
+
+/* The internal variables in the standalone libintl.a must have different
+ names than the internal variables in GNU libc, otherwise programs
+ using libintl.a cannot be linked statically. */
+#if !defined _LIBC
+# define _nl_default_dirname libintl_nl_default_dirname
+# define _nl_domain_bindings libintl_nl_domain_bindings
+#endif
+
+/* Some compilers, like SunOS4 cc, don't have offsetof in <stddef.h>. */
+#ifndef offsetof
+# define offsetof(type,ident) ((size_t)&(((type*)0)->ident))
+#endif
+
+/* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+
+/* Contains the default location of the message catalogs. */
+extern const char _nl_default_dirname[];
+#ifdef _LIBC
+extern const char _nl_default_dirname_internal[] attribute_hidden;
+#else
+# define INTUSE(name) name
+#endif
+
+/* List with bindings of specific domains. */
+extern struct binding *_nl_domain_bindings;
+
+/* Lock variable to protect the global data in the gettext implementation. */
+__libc_rwlock_define (extern, _nl_state_lock attribute_hidden)
+
+
+/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. They must not clash
+ with existing names and they should follow ANSI C. But this source
+ code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __
+ prefix. So we have to make a difference here. */
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# define BINDTEXTDOMAIN __bindtextdomain
+# define BIND_TEXTDOMAIN_CODESET __bind_textdomain_codeset
+# ifndef strdup
+# define strdup(str) __strdup (str)
+# endif
+#else
+# define BINDTEXTDOMAIN libintl_bindtextdomain
+# define BIND_TEXTDOMAIN_CODESET libintl_bind_textdomain_codeset
+#endif
+
+/* Prototypes for local functions. */
+static void set_binding_values PARAMS ((const char *domainname,
+ const char **dirnamep,
+ const char **codesetp));
+
+/* Specifies the directory name *DIRNAMEP and the output codeset *CODESETP
+ to be used for the DOMAINNAME message catalog.
+ If *DIRNAMEP or *CODESETP is NULL, the corresponding attribute is not
+ modified, only the current value is returned.
+ If DIRNAMEP or CODESETP is NULL, the corresponding attribute is neither
+ modified nor returned. */
+static void
+set_binding_values (domainname, dirnamep, codesetp)
+ const char *domainname;
+ const char **dirnamep;
+ const char **codesetp;
+{
+ struct binding *binding;
+ int modified;
+
+ /* Some sanity checks. */
+ if (domainname == NULL || domainname[0] == '\0')
+ {
+ if (dirnamep)
+ *dirnamep = NULL;
+ if (codesetp)
+ *codesetp = NULL;
+ return;
+ }
+
+ __libc_rwlock_wrlock (_nl_state_lock);
+
+ modified = 0;
+
+ for (binding = _nl_domain_bindings; binding != NULL; binding = binding->next)
+ {
+ int compare = strcmp (domainname, binding->domainname);
+ if (compare == 0)
+ /* We found it! */
+ break;
+ if (compare < 0)
+ {
+ /* It is not in the list. */
+ binding = NULL;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (binding != NULL)
+ {
+ if (dirnamep)
+ {
+ const char *dirname = *dirnamep;
+
+ if (dirname == NULL)
+ /* The current binding has be to returned. */
+ *dirnamep = binding->dirname;
+ else
+ {
+ /* The domain is already bound. If the new value and the old
+ one are equal we simply do nothing. Otherwise replace the
+ old binding. */
+ char *result = binding->dirname;
+ if (strcmp (dirname, result) != 0)
+ {
+ if (strcmp (dirname, INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname)) == 0)
+ result = (char *) INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname);
+ else
+ {
+#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_STRDUP
+ result = strdup (dirname);
+#else
+ size_t len = strlen (dirname) + 1;
+ result = (char *) malloc (len);
+ if (__builtin_expect (result != NULL, 1))
+ memcpy (result, dirname, len);
+#endif
+ }
+
+ if (__builtin_expect (result != NULL, 1))
+ {
+ if (binding->dirname != INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname))
+ free (binding->dirname);
+
+ binding->dirname = result;
+ modified = 1;
+ }
+ }
+ *dirnamep = result;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (codesetp)
+ {
+ const char *codeset = *codesetp;
+
+ if (codeset == NULL)
+ /* The current binding has be to returned. */
+ *codesetp = binding->codeset;
+ else
+ {
+ /* The domain is already bound. If the new value and the old
+ one are equal we simply do nothing. Otherwise replace the
+ old binding. */
+ char *result = binding->codeset;
+ if (result == NULL || strcmp (codeset, result) != 0)
+ {
+#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_STRDUP
+ result = strdup (codeset);
+#else
+ size_t len = strlen (codeset) + 1;
+ result = (char *) malloc (len);
+ if (__builtin_expect (result != NULL, 1))
+ memcpy (result, codeset, len);
+#endif
+
+ if (__builtin_expect (result != NULL, 1))
+ {
+ if (binding->codeset != NULL)
+ free (binding->codeset);
+
+ binding->codeset = result;
+ binding->codeset_cntr++;
+ modified = 1;
+ }
+ }
+ *codesetp = result;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ else if ((dirnamep == NULL || *dirnamep == NULL)
+ && (codesetp == NULL || *codesetp == NULL))
+ {
+ /* Simply return the default values. */
+ if (dirnamep)
+ *dirnamep = INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname);
+ if (codesetp)
+ *codesetp = NULL;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* We have to create a new binding. */
+ size_t len = strlen (domainname) + 1;
+ struct binding *new_binding =
+ (struct binding *) malloc (offsetof (struct binding, domainname) + len);
+
+ if (__builtin_expect (new_binding == NULL, 0))
+ goto failed;
+
+ memcpy (new_binding->domainname, domainname, len);
+
+ if (dirnamep)
+ {
+ const char *dirname = *dirnamep;
+
+ if (dirname == NULL)
+ /* The default value. */
+ dirname = INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname);
+ else
+ {
+ if (strcmp (dirname, INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname)) == 0)
+ dirname = INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname);
+ else
+ {
+ char *result;
+#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_STRDUP
+ result = strdup (dirname);
+ if (__builtin_expect (result == NULL, 0))
+ goto failed_dirname;
+#else
+ size_t len = strlen (dirname) + 1;
+ result = (char *) malloc (len);
+ if (__builtin_expect (result == NULL, 0))
+ goto failed_dirname;
+ memcpy (result, dirname, len);
+#endif
+ dirname = result;
+ }
+ }
+ *dirnamep = dirname;
+ new_binding->dirname = (char *) dirname;
+ }
+ else
+ /* The default value. */
+ new_binding->dirname = (char *) INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname);
+
+ new_binding->codeset_cntr = 0;
+
+ if (codesetp)
+ {
+ const char *codeset = *codesetp;
+
+ if (codeset != NULL)
+ {
+ char *result;
+
+#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_STRDUP
+ result = strdup (codeset);
+ if (__builtin_expect (result == NULL, 0))
+ goto failed_codeset;
+#else
+ size_t len = strlen (codeset) + 1;
+ result = (char *) malloc (len);
+ if (__builtin_expect (result == NULL, 0))
+ goto failed_codeset;
+ memcpy (result, codeset, len);
+#endif
+ codeset = result;
+ new_binding->codeset_cntr++;
+ }
+ *codesetp = codeset;
+ new_binding->codeset = (char *) codeset;
+ }
+ else
+ new_binding->codeset = NULL;
+
+ /* Now enqueue it. */
+ if (_nl_domain_bindings == NULL
+ || strcmp (domainname, _nl_domain_bindings->domainname) < 0)
+ {
+ new_binding->next = _nl_domain_bindings;
+ _nl_domain_bindings = new_binding;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ binding = _nl_domain_bindings;
+ while (binding->next != NULL
+ && strcmp (domainname, binding->next->domainname) > 0)
+ binding = binding->next;
+
+ new_binding->next = binding->next;
+ binding->next = new_binding;
+ }
+
+ modified = 1;
+
+ /* Here we deal with memory allocation failures. */
+ if (0)
+ {
+ failed_codeset:
+ if (new_binding->dirname != INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname))
+ free (new_binding->dirname);
+ failed_dirname:
+ free (new_binding);
+ failed:
+ if (dirnamep)
+ *dirnamep = NULL;
+ if (codesetp)
+ *codesetp = NULL;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* If we modified any binding, we flush the caches. */
+ if (modified)
+ ++_nl_msg_cat_cntr;
+
+ __libc_rwlock_unlock (_nl_state_lock);
+}
+
+/* Specify that the DOMAINNAME message catalog will be found
+ in DIRNAME rather than in the system locale data base. */
+char *
+BINDTEXTDOMAIN (domainname, dirname)
+ const char *domainname;
+ const char *dirname;
+{
+ set_binding_values (domainname, &dirname, NULL);
+ return (char *) dirname;
+}
+
+/* Specify the character encoding in which the messages from the
+ DOMAINNAME message catalog will be returned. */
+char *
+BIND_TEXTDOMAIN_CODESET (domainname, codeset)
+ const char *domainname;
+ const char *codeset;
+{
+ set_binding_values (domainname, NULL, &codeset);
+ return (char *) codeset;
+}
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+/* Aliases for function names in GNU C Library. */
+weak_alias (__bindtextdomain, bindtextdomain);
+weak_alias (__bind_textdomain_codeset, bind_textdomain_codeset);
+#endif
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/config.charset b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/config.charset
new file mode 100755
index 0000000..32becec
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/config.charset
@@ -0,0 +1,467 @@
+#! /bin/sh
+# Output a system dependent table of character encoding aliases.
+#
+# Copyright (C) 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+#
+# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+# under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+# by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+# any later version.
+#
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+# Library General Public License for more details.
+#
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+# License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+# USA.
+#
+# The table consists of lines of the form
+# ALIAS CANONICAL
+#
+# ALIAS is the (system dependent) result of "nl_langinfo (CODESET)".
+# ALIAS is compared in a case sensitive way.
+#
+# CANONICAL is the GNU canonical name for this character encoding.
+# It must be an encoding supported by libiconv. Support by GNU libc is
+# also desirable. CANONICAL is case insensitive. Usually an upper case
+# MIME charset name is preferred.
+# The current list of GNU canonical charset names is as follows.
+#
+# name used by which systems a MIME name?
+# ASCII, ANSI_X3.4-1968 glibc solaris freebsd
+# ISO-8859-1 glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris freebsd yes
+# ISO-8859-2 glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris freebsd yes
+# ISO-8859-3 glibc solaris yes
+# ISO-8859-4 osf solaris freebsd yes
+# ISO-8859-5 glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris freebsd yes
+# ISO-8859-6 glibc aix hpux solaris yes
+# ISO-8859-7 glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris yes
+# ISO-8859-8 glibc aix hpux osf solaris yes
+# ISO-8859-9 glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris yes
+# ISO-8859-13 glibc
+# ISO-8859-14 glibc
+# ISO-8859-15 glibc aix osf solaris freebsd
+# KOI8-R glibc solaris freebsd yes
+# KOI8-U glibc freebsd yes
+# KOI8-T glibc
+# CP437 dos
+# CP775 dos
+# CP850 aix osf dos
+# CP852 dos
+# CP855 dos
+# CP856 aix
+# CP857 dos
+# CP861 dos
+# CP862 dos
+# CP864 dos
+# CP865 dos
+# CP866 freebsd dos
+# CP869 dos
+# CP874 woe32 dos
+# CP922 aix
+# CP932 aix woe32 dos
+# CP943 aix
+# CP949 osf woe32 dos
+# CP950 woe32 dos
+# CP1046 aix
+# CP1124 aix
+# CP1125 dos
+# CP1129 aix
+# CP1250 woe32
+# CP1251 glibc solaris woe32
+# CP1252 aix woe32
+# CP1253 woe32
+# CP1254 woe32
+# CP1255 glibc woe32
+# CP1256 woe32
+# CP1257 woe32
+# GB2312 glibc aix hpux irix solaris freebsd yes
+# EUC-JP glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris freebsd yes
+# EUC-KR glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris freebsd yes
+# EUC-TW glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris
+# BIG5 glibc aix hpux osf solaris freebsd yes
+# BIG5-HKSCS glibc solaris
+# GBK glibc aix osf solaris woe32 dos
+# GB18030 glibc solaris
+# SHIFT_JIS hpux osf solaris freebsd yes
+# JOHAB glibc solaris woe32
+# TIS-620 glibc aix hpux osf solaris
+# VISCII glibc yes
+# TCVN5712-1 glibc
+# GEORGIAN-PS glibc
+# HP-ROMAN8 hpux
+# HP-ARABIC8 hpux
+# HP-GREEK8 hpux
+# HP-HEBREW8 hpux
+# HP-TURKISH8 hpux
+# HP-KANA8 hpux
+# DEC-KANJI osf
+# DEC-HANYU osf
+# UTF-8 glibc aix hpux osf solaris yes
+#
+# Note: Names which are not marked as being a MIME name should not be used in
+# Internet protocols for information interchange (mail, news, etc.).
+#
+# Note: ASCII and ANSI_X3.4-1968 are synonymous canonical names. Applications
+# must understand both names and treat them as equivalent.
+#
+# The first argument passed to this file is the canonical host specification,
+# CPU_TYPE-MANUFACTURER-OPERATING_SYSTEM
+# or
+# CPU_TYPE-MANUFACTURER-KERNEL-OPERATING_SYSTEM
+
+host="$1"
+os=`echo "$host" | sed -e 's/^[^-]*-[^-]*-\(.*\)$/\1/'`
+echo "# This file contains a table of character encoding aliases,"
+echo "# suitable for operating system '${os}'."
+echo "# It was automatically generated from config.charset."
+# List of references, updated during installation:
+echo "# Packages using this file: "
+case "$os" in
+ linux* | *-gnu*)
+ # With glibc-2.1 or newer, we don't need any canonicalization,
+ # because glibc has iconv and both glibc and libiconv support all
+ # GNU canonical names directly. Therefore, the Makefile does not
+ # need to install the alias file at all.
+ # The following applies only to glibc-2.0.x and older libcs.
+ echo "ISO_646.IRV:1983 ASCII"
+ ;;
+ aix*)
+ echo "ISO8859-1 ISO-8859-1"
+ echo "ISO8859-2 ISO-8859-2"
+ echo "ISO8859-5 ISO-8859-5"
+ echo "ISO8859-6 ISO-8859-6"
+ echo "ISO8859-7 ISO-8859-7"
+ echo "ISO8859-8 ISO-8859-8"
+ echo "ISO8859-9 ISO-8859-9"
+ echo "ISO8859-15 ISO-8859-15"
+ echo "IBM-850 CP850"
+ echo "IBM-856 CP856"
+ echo "IBM-921 ISO-8859-13"
+ echo "IBM-922 CP922"
+ echo "IBM-932 CP932"
+ echo "IBM-943 CP943"
+ echo "IBM-1046 CP1046"
+ echo "IBM-1124 CP1124"
+ echo "IBM-1129 CP1129"
+ echo "IBM-1252 CP1252"
+ echo "IBM-eucCN GB2312"
+ echo "IBM-eucJP EUC-JP"
+ echo "IBM-eucKR EUC-KR"
+ echo "IBM-eucTW EUC-TW"
+ echo "big5 BIG5"
+ echo "GBK GBK"
+ echo "TIS-620 TIS-620"
+ echo "UTF-8 UTF-8"
+ ;;
+ hpux*)
+ echo "iso88591 ISO-8859-1"
+ echo "iso88592 ISO-8859-2"
+ echo "iso88595 ISO-8859-5"
+ echo "iso88596 ISO-8859-6"
+ echo "iso88597 ISO-8859-7"
+ echo "iso88598 ISO-8859-8"
+ echo "iso88599 ISO-8859-9"
+ echo "iso885915 ISO-8859-15"
+ echo "roman8 HP-ROMAN8"
+ echo "arabic8 HP-ARABIC8"
+ echo "greek8 HP-GREEK8"
+ echo "hebrew8 HP-HEBREW8"
+ echo "turkish8 HP-TURKISH8"
+ echo "kana8 HP-KANA8"
+ echo "tis620 TIS-620"
+ echo "big5 BIG5"
+ echo "eucJP EUC-JP"
+ echo "eucKR EUC-KR"
+ echo "eucTW EUC-TW"
+ echo "hp15CN GB2312"
+ #echo "ccdc ?" # what is this?
+ echo "SJIS SHIFT_JIS"
+ echo "utf8 UTF-8"
+ ;;
+ irix*)
+ echo "ISO8859-1 ISO-8859-1"
+ echo "ISO8859-2 ISO-8859-2"
+ echo "ISO8859-5 ISO-8859-5"
+ echo "ISO8859-7 ISO-8859-7"
+ echo "ISO8859-9 ISO-8859-9"
+ echo "eucCN GB2312"
+ echo "eucJP EUC-JP"
+ echo "eucKR EUC-KR"
+ echo "eucTW EUC-TW"
+ ;;
+ osf*)
+ echo "ISO8859-1 ISO-8859-1"
+ echo "ISO8859-2 ISO-8859-2"
+ echo "ISO8859-4 ISO-8859-4"
+ echo "ISO8859-5 ISO-8859-5"
+ echo "ISO8859-7 ISO-8859-7"
+ echo "ISO8859-8 ISO-8859-8"
+ echo "ISO8859-9 ISO-8859-9"
+ echo "ISO8859-15 ISO-8859-15"
+ echo "cp850 CP850"
+ echo "big5 BIG5"
+ echo "dechanyu DEC-HANYU"
+ echo "dechanzi GB2312"
+ echo "deckanji DEC-KANJI"
+ echo "deckorean EUC-KR"
+ echo "eucJP EUC-JP"
+ echo "eucKR EUC-KR"
+ echo "eucTW EUC-TW"
+ echo "GBK GBK"
+ echo "KSC5601 CP949"
+ echo "sdeckanji EUC-JP"
+ echo "SJIS SHIFT_JIS"
+ echo "TACTIS TIS-620"
+ echo "UTF-8 UTF-8"
+ ;;
+ solaris*)
+ echo "646 ASCII"
+ echo "ISO8859-1 ISO-8859-1"
+ echo "ISO8859-2 ISO-8859-2"
+ echo "ISO8859-3 ISO-8859-3"
+ echo "ISO8859-4 ISO-8859-4"
+ echo "ISO8859-5 ISO-8859-5"
+ echo "ISO8859-6 ISO-8859-6"
+ echo "ISO8859-7 ISO-8859-7"
+ echo "ISO8859-8 ISO-8859-8"
+ echo "ISO8859-9 ISO-8859-9"
+ echo "ISO8859-15 ISO-8859-15"
+ echo "koi8-r KOI8-R"
+ echo "ansi-1251 CP1251"
+ echo "BIG5 BIG5"
+ echo "Big5-HKSCS BIG5-HKSCS"
+ echo "gb2312 GB2312"
+ echo "GBK GBK"
+ echo "GB18030 GB18030"
+ echo "cns11643 EUC-TW"
+ echo "5601 EUC-KR"
+ echo "ko_KR.johap92 JOHAB"
+ echo "eucJP EUC-JP"
+ echo "PCK SHIFT_JIS"
+ echo "TIS620.2533 TIS-620"
+ #echo "sun_eu_greek ?" # what is this?
+ echo "UTF-8 UTF-8"
+ ;;
+ freebsd* | os2*)
+ # FreeBSD 4.2 doesn't have nl_langinfo(CODESET); therefore
+ # localcharset.c falls back to using the full locale name
+ # from the environment variables.
+ # Likewise for OS/2. OS/2 has XFree86 just like FreeBSD. Just
+ # reuse FreeBSD's locale data for OS/2.
+ echo "C ASCII"
+ echo "US-ASCII ASCII"
+ for l in la_LN lt_LN; do
+ echo "$l.ASCII ASCII"
+ done
+ for l in da_DK de_AT de_CH de_DE en_AU en_CA en_GB en_US es_ES \
+ fi_FI fr_BE fr_CA fr_CH fr_FR is_IS it_CH it_IT la_LN \
+ lt_LN nl_BE nl_NL no_NO pt_PT sv_SE; do
+ echo "$l.ISO_8859-1 ISO-8859-1"
+ echo "$l.DIS_8859-15 ISO-8859-15"
+ done
+ for l in cs_CZ hr_HR hu_HU la_LN lt_LN pl_PL sl_SI; do
+ echo "$l.ISO_8859-2 ISO-8859-2"
+ done
+ for l in la_LN lt_LT; do
+ echo "$l.ISO_8859-4 ISO-8859-4"
+ done
+ for l in ru_RU ru_SU; do
+ echo "$l.KOI8-R KOI8-R"
+ echo "$l.ISO_8859-5 ISO-8859-5"
+ echo "$l.CP866 CP866"
+ done
+ echo "uk_UA.KOI8-U KOI8-U"
+ echo "zh_TW.BIG5 BIG5"
+ echo "zh_TW.Big5 BIG5"
+ echo "zh_CN.EUC GB2312"
+ echo "ja_JP.EUC EUC-JP"
+ echo "ja_JP.SJIS SHIFT_JIS"
+ echo "ja_JP.Shift_JIS SHIFT_JIS"
+ echo "ko_KR.EUC EUC-KR"
+ ;;
+ netbsd*)
+ echo "646 ASCII"
+ echo "ISO8859-1 ISO-8859-1"
+ echo "ISO8859-2 ISO-8859-2"
+ echo "ISO8859-4 ISO-8859-4"
+ echo "ISO8859-5 ISO-8859-5"
+ echo "ISO8859-15 ISO-8859-15"
+ echo "eucCN GB2312"
+ echo "eucJP EUC-JP"
+ echo "eucKR EUC-KR"
+ echo "eucTW EUC-TW"
+ echo "BIG5 BIG5"
+ echo "SJIS SHIFT_JIS"
+ ;;
+ beos*)
+ # BeOS has a single locale, and it has UTF-8 encoding.
+ echo "* UTF-8"
+ ;;
+ msdosdjgpp*)
+ # DJGPP 2.03 doesn't have nl_langinfo(CODESET); therefore
+ # localcharset.c falls back to using the full locale name
+ # from the environment variables.
+ echo "#"
+ echo "# The encodings given here may not all be correct."
+ echo "# If you find that the encoding given for your language and"
+ echo "# country is not the one your DOS machine actually uses, just"
+ echo "# correct it in this file, and send a mail to"
+ echo "# Juan Manuel Guerrero <st001906@hrz1.hrz.tu-darmstadt.de>"
+ echo "# and Bruno Haible <bruno@clisp.org>."
+ echo "#"
+ echo "C ASCII"
+ # ISO-8859-1 languages
+ echo "ca CP850"
+ echo "ca_ES CP850"
+ echo "da CP865" # not CP850 ??
+ echo "da_DK CP865" # not CP850 ??
+ echo "de CP850"
+ echo "de_AT CP850"
+ echo "de_CH CP850"
+ echo "de_DE CP850"
+ echo "en CP850"
+ echo "en_AU CP850" # not CP437 ??
+ echo "en_CA CP850"
+ echo "en_GB CP850"
+ echo "en_NZ CP437"
+ echo "en_US CP437"
+ echo "en_ZA CP850" # not CP437 ??
+ echo "es CP850"
+ echo "es_AR CP850"
+ echo "es_BO CP850"
+ echo "es_CL CP850"
+ echo "es_CO CP850"
+ echo "es_CR CP850"
+ echo "es_CU CP850"
+ echo "es_DO CP850"
+ echo "es_EC CP850"
+ echo "es_ES CP850"
+ echo "es_GT CP850"
+ echo "es_HN CP850"
+ echo "es_MX CP850"
+ echo "es_NI CP850"
+ echo "es_PA CP850"
+ echo "es_PY CP850"
+ echo "es_PE CP850"
+ echo "es_SV CP850"
+ echo "es_UY CP850"
+ echo "es_VE CP850"
+ echo "et CP850"
+ echo "et_EE CP850"
+ echo "eu CP850"
+ echo "eu_ES CP850"
+ echo "fi CP850"
+ echo "fi_FI CP850"
+ echo "fr CP850"
+ echo "fr_BE CP850"
+ echo "fr_CA CP850"
+ echo "fr_CH CP850"
+ echo "fr_FR CP850"
+ echo "ga CP850"
+ echo "ga_IE CP850"
+ echo "gd CP850"
+ echo "gd_GB CP850"
+ echo "gl CP850"
+ echo "gl_ES CP850"
+ echo "id CP850" # not CP437 ??
+ echo "id_ID CP850" # not CP437 ??
+ echo "is CP861" # not CP850 ??
+ echo "is_IS CP861" # not CP850 ??
+ echo "it CP850"
+ echo "it_CH CP850"
+ echo "it_IT CP850"
+ echo "lt CP775"
+ echo "lt_LT CP775"
+ echo "lv CP775"
+ echo "lv_LV CP775"
+ echo "nb CP865" # not CP850 ??
+ echo "nb_NO CP865" # not CP850 ??
+ echo "nl CP850"
+ echo "nl_BE CP850"
+ echo "nl_NL CP850"
+ echo "nn CP865" # not CP850 ??
+ echo "nn_NO CP865" # not CP850 ??
+ echo "no CP865" # not CP850 ??
+ echo "no_NO CP865" # not CP850 ??
+ echo "pt CP850"
+ echo "pt_BR CP850"
+ echo "pt_PT CP850"
+ echo "sv CP850"
+ echo "sv_SE CP850"
+ # ISO-8859-2 languages
+ echo "cs CP852"
+ echo "cs_CZ CP852"
+ echo "hr CP852"
+ echo "hr_HR CP852"
+ echo "hu CP852"
+ echo "hu_HU CP852"
+ echo "pl CP852"
+ echo "pl_PL CP852"
+ echo "ro CP852"
+ echo "ro_RO CP852"
+ echo "sk CP852"
+ echo "sk_SK CP852"
+ echo "sl CP852"
+ echo "sl_SI CP852"
+ echo "sq CP852"
+ echo "sq_AL CP852"
+ echo "sr CP852" # CP852 or CP866 or CP855 ??
+ echo "sr_YU CP852" # CP852 or CP866 or CP855 ??
+ # ISO-8859-3 languages
+ echo "mt CP850"
+ echo "mt_MT CP850"
+ # ISO-8859-5 languages
+ echo "be CP866"
+ echo "be_BE CP866"
+ echo "bg CP866" # not CP855 ??
+ echo "bg_BG CP866" # not CP855 ??
+ echo "mk CP866" # not CP855 ??
+ echo "mk_MK CP866" # not CP855 ??
+ echo "ru CP866"
+ echo "ru_RU CP866"
+ echo "uk CP1125"
+ echo "uk_UA CP1125"
+ # ISO-8859-6 languages
+ echo "ar CP864"
+ echo "ar_AE CP864"
+ echo "ar_DZ CP864"
+ echo "ar_EG CP864"
+ echo "ar_IQ CP864"
+ echo "ar_IR CP864"
+ echo "ar_JO CP864"
+ echo "ar_KW CP864"
+ echo "ar_MA CP864"
+ echo "ar_OM CP864"
+ echo "ar_QA CP864"
+ echo "ar_SA CP864"
+ echo "ar_SY CP864"
+ # ISO-8859-7 languages
+ echo "el CP869"
+ echo "el_GR CP869"
+ # ISO-8859-8 languages
+ echo "he CP862"
+ echo "he_IL CP862"
+ # ISO-8859-9 languages
+ echo "tr CP857"
+ echo "tr_TR CP857"
+ # Japanese
+ echo "ja CP932"
+ echo "ja_JP CP932"
+ # Chinese
+ echo "zh_CN GBK"
+ echo "zh_TW CP950" # not CP938 ??
+ # Korean
+ echo "kr CP949" # not CP934 ??
+ echo "kr_KR CP949" # not CP934 ??
+ # Thai
+ echo "th CP874"
+ echo "th_TH CP874"
+ # Other
+ echo "eo CP850"
+ echo "eo_EO CP850"
+ ;;
+esac
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/dcgettext.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/dcgettext.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ca6a1c8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/dcgettext.c
@@ -0,0 +1,59 @@
+/* Implementation of the dcgettext(3) function.
+ Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "gettextP.h"
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# include <libintl.h>
+#else
+# include "libgnuintl.h"
+#endif
+
+/* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+
+/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. They must not clash
+ with existing names and they should follow ANSI C. But this source
+ code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __
+ prefix. So we have to make a difference here. */
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# define DCGETTEXT __dcgettext
+# define DCIGETTEXT __dcigettext
+#else
+# define DCGETTEXT libintl_dcgettext
+# define DCIGETTEXT libintl_dcigettext
+#endif
+
+/* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog for the current CATEGORY
+ locale. */
+char *
+DCGETTEXT (domainname, msgid, category)
+ const char *domainname;
+ const char *msgid;
+ int category;
+{
+ return DCIGETTEXT (domainname, msgid, NULL, 0, 0, category);
+}
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+/* Alias for function name in GNU C Library. */
+INTDEF(__dcgettext)
+weak_alias (__dcgettext, dcgettext);
+#endif
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/dcigettext.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/dcigettext.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c7e696a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/dcigettext.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1246 @@
+/* Implementation of the internal dcigettext function.
+ Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+/* Tell glibc's <string.h> to provide a prototype for mempcpy().
+ This must come before <config.h> because <config.h> may include
+ <features.h>, and once <features.h> has been included, it's too late. */
+#ifndef _GNU_SOURCE
+# define _GNU_SOURCE 1
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#ifdef __GNUC__
+# define alloca __builtin_alloca
+# define HAVE_ALLOCA 1
+#else
+# ifdef _MSC_VER
+# include <malloc.h>
+# define alloca _alloca
+# else
+# if defined HAVE_ALLOCA_H || defined _LIBC
+# include <alloca.h>
+# else
+# ifdef _AIX
+ #pragma alloca
+# else
+# ifndef alloca
+char *alloca ();
+# endif
+# endif
+# endif
+# endif
+#endif
+
+#include <errno.h>
+#ifndef errno
+extern int errno;
+#endif
+#ifndef __set_errno
+# define __set_errno(val) errno = (val)
+#endif
+
+#include <stddef.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+#if defined HAVE_UNISTD_H || defined _LIBC
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <locale.h>
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+ /* Guess whether integer division by zero raises signal SIGFPE.
+ Set to 1 only if you know for sure. In case of doubt, set to 0. */
+# if defined __alpha__ || defined __arm__ || defined __i386__ \
+ || defined __m68k__ || defined __s390__
+# define INTDIV0_RAISES_SIGFPE 1
+# else
+# define INTDIV0_RAISES_SIGFPE 0
+# endif
+#endif
+#if !INTDIV0_RAISES_SIGFPE
+# include <signal.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined HAVE_SYS_PARAM_H || defined _LIBC
+# include <sys/param.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "gettextP.h"
+#include "plural-exp.h"
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# include <libintl.h>
+#else
+# include "libgnuintl.h"
+#endif
+#include "hash-string.h"
+
+/* Thread safetyness. */
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# include <bits/libc-lock.h>
+#else
+/* Provide dummy implementation if this is outside glibc. */
+# define __libc_lock_define_initialized(CLASS, NAME)
+# define __libc_lock_lock(NAME)
+# define __libc_lock_unlock(NAME)
+# define __libc_rwlock_define_initialized(CLASS, NAME)
+# define __libc_rwlock_rdlock(NAME)
+# define __libc_rwlock_unlock(NAME)
+#endif
+
+/* Alignment of types. */
+#if defined __GNUC__ && __GNUC__ >= 2
+# define alignof(TYPE) __alignof__ (TYPE)
+#else
+# define alignof(TYPE) \
+ ((int) &((struct { char dummy1; TYPE dummy2; } *) 0)->dummy2)
+#endif
+
+/* The internal variables in the standalone libintl.a must have different
+ names than the internal variables in GNU libc, otherwise programs
+ using libintl.a cannot be linked statically. */
+#if !defined _LIBC
+# define _nl_default_default_domain libintl_nl_default_default_domain
+# define _nl_current_default_domain libintl_nl_current_default_domain
+# define _nl_default_dirname libintl_nl_default_dirname
+# define _nl_domain_bindings libintl_nl_domain_bindings
+#endif
+
+/* Some compilers, like SunOS4 cc, don't have offsetof in <stddef.h>. */
+#ifndef offsetof
+# define offsetof(type,ident) ((size_t)&(((type*)0)->ident))
+#endif
+
+/* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+
+#if defined (SHELL) && !defined (HAVE_GETCWD)
+# define HAVE_GETCWD
+#endif
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+/* Rename the non ANSI C functions. This is required by the standard
+ because some ANSI C functions will require linking with this object
+ file and the name space must not be polluted. */
+# define getcwd __getcwd
+# ifndef stpcpy
+# define stpcpy __stpcpy
+# endif
+# define tfind __tfind
+#else
+# if !defined HAVE_GETCWD
+char *getwd ();
+# define getcwd(buf, max) getwd (buf)
+# else
+char *getcwd ();
+# endif
+# ifndef HAVE_STPCPY
+static char *stpcpy PARAMS ((char *dest, const char *src));
+# endif
+# ifndef HAVE_MEMPCPY
+static void *mempcpy PARAMS ((void *dest, const void *src, size_t n));
+# endif
+#endif
+
+/* Amount to increase buffer size by in each try. */
+#define PATH_INCR 32
+
+/* The following is from pathmax.h. */
+/* Non-POSIX BSD systems might have gcc's limits.h, which doesn't define
+ PATH_MAX but might cause redefinition warnings when sys/param.h is
+ later included (as on MORE/BSD 4.3). */
+#if defined _POSIX_VERSION || (defined HAVE_LIMITS_H && !defined __GNUC__)
+# include <limits.h>
+#endif
+
+#ifndef _POSIX_PATH_MAX
+# define _POSIX_PATH_MAX 255
+#endif
+
+#if !defined PATH_MAX && defined _PC_PATH_MAX
+# define PATH_MAX (pathconf ("/", _PC_PATH_MAX) < 1 ? 1024 : pathconf ("/", _PC_PATH_MAX))
+#endif
+
+/* Don't include sys/param.h if it already has been. */
+#if defined HAVE_SYS_PARAM_H && !defined PATH_MAX && !defined MAXPATHLEN
+# include <sys/param.h>
+#endif
+
+#if !defined PATH_MAX && defined MAXPATHLEN
+# define PATH_MAX MAXPATHLEN
+#endif
+
+#ifndef PATH_MAX
+# define PATH_MAX _POSIX_PATH_MAX
+#endif
+
+/* Pathname support.
+ ISSLASH(C) tests whether C is a directory separator character.
+ IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH(P) tests whether P is an absolute path. If it is not,
+ it may be concatenated to a directory pathname.
+ IS_PATH_WITH_DIR(P) tests whether P contains a directory specification.
+ */
+#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ || defined __EMX__ || defined __DJGPP__
+ /* Win32, OS/2, DOS */
+# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == '/' || (C) == '\\')
+# define HAS_DEVICE(P) \
+ ((((P)[0] >= 'A' && (P)[0] <= 'Z') || ((P)[0] >= 'a' && (P)[0] <= 'z')) \
+ && (P)[1] == ':')
+# define IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH(P) (ISSLASH ((P)[0]) || HAS_DEVICE (P))
+# define IS_PATH_WITH_DIR(P) \
+ (strchr (P, '/') != NULL || strchr (P, '\\') != NULL || HAS_DEVICE (P))
+#else
+ /* Unix */
+# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == '/')
+# define IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH(P) ISSLASH ((P)[0])
+# define IS_PATH_WITH_DIR(P) (strchr (P, '/') != NULL)
+#endif
+
+/* This is the type used for the search tree where known translations
+ are stored. */
+struct known_translation_t
+{
+ /* Domain in which to search. */
+ char *domainname;
+
+ /* The category. */
+ int category;
+
+ /* State of the catalog counter at the point the string was found. */
+ int counter;
+
+ /* Catalog where the string was found. */
+ struct loaded_l10nfile *domain;
+
+ /* And finally the translation. */
+ const char *translation;
+ size_t translation_length;
+
+ /* Pointer to the string in question. */
+ char msgid[ZERO];
+};
+
+/* Root of the search tree with known translations. We can use this
+ only if the system provides the `tsearch' function family. */
+#if defined HAVE_TSEARCH || defined _LIBC
+# include <search.h>
+
+static void *root;
+
+# ifdef _LIBC
+# define tsearch __tsearch
+# endif
+
+/* Function to compare two entries in the table of known translations. */
+static int transcmp PARAMS ((const void *p1, const void *p2));
+static int
+transcmp (p1, p2)
+ const void *p1;
+ const void *p2;
+{
+ const struct known_translation_t *s1;
+ const struct known_translation_t *s2;
+ int result;
+
+ s1 = (const struct known_translation_t *) p1;
+ s2 = (const struct known_translation_t *) p2;
+
+ result = strcmp (s1->msgid, s2->msgid);
+ if (result == 0)
+ {
+ result = strcmp (s1->domainname, s2->domainname);
+ if (result == 0)
+ /* We compare the category last (though this is the cheapest
+ operation) since it is hopefully always the same (namely
+ LC_MESSAGES). */
+ result = s1->category - s2->category;
+ }
+
+ return result;
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef INTVARDEF
+# define INTVARDEF(name)
+#endif
+#ifndef INTUSE
+# define INTUSE(name) name
+#endif
+
+/* Name of the default domain used for gettext(3) prior any call to
+ textdomain(3). The default value for this is "messages". */
+const char _nl_default_default_domain[] attribute_hidden = "messages";
+
+/* Value used as the default domain for gettext(3). */
+const char *_nl_current_default_domain attribute_hidden
+ = _nl_default_default_domain;
+
+/* Contains the default location of the message catalogs. */
+#if defined __EMX__
+extern const char _nl_default_dirname[];
+#else
+const char _nl_default_dirname[] = LOCALEDIR;
+INTVARDEF (_nl_default_dirname)
+#endif
+
+/* List with bindings of specific domains created by bindtextdomain()
+ calls. */
+struct binding *_nl_domain_bindings;
+
+/* Prototypes for local functions. */
+static char *plural_lookup PARAMS ((struct loaded_l10nfile *domain,
+ unsigned long int n,
+ const char *translation,
+ size_t translation_len))
+ internal_function;
+static const char *guess_category_value PARAMS ((int category,
+ const char *categoryname))
+ internal_function;
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# include "../locale/localeinfo.h"
+# define category_to_name(category) _nl_category_names[category]
+#else
+static const char *category_to_name PARAMS ((int category)) internal_function;
+#endif
+
+
+/* For those loosing systems which don't have `alloca' we have to add
+ some additional code emulating it. */
+#ifdef HAVE_ALLOCA
+/* Nothing has to be done. */
+# define freea(p) /* nothing */
+# define ADD_BLOCK(list, address) /* nothing */
+# define FREE_BLOCKS(list) /* nothing */
+#else
+struct block_list
+{
+ void *address;
+ struct block_list *next;
+};
+# define ADD_BLOCK(list, addr) \
+ do { \
+ struct block_list *newp = (struct block_list *) malloc (sizeof (*newp)); \
+ /* If we cannot get a free block we cannot add the new element to \
+ the list. */ \
+ if (newp != NULL) { \
+ newp->address = (addr); \
+ newp->next = (list); \
+ (list) = newp; \
+ } \
+ } while (0)
+# define FREE_BLOCKS(list) \
+ do { \
+ while (list != NULL) { \
+ struct block_list *old = list; \
+ list = list->next; \
+ free (old->address); \
+ free (old); \
+ } \
+ } while (0)
+# undef alloca
+# define alloca(size) (malloc (size))
+# define freea(p) free (p)
+#endif /* have alloca */
+
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+/* List of blocks allocated for translations. */
+typedef struct transmem_list
+{
+ struct transmem_list *next;
+ char data[ZERO];
+} transmem_block_t;
+static struct transmem_list *transmem_list;
+#else
+typedef unsigned char transmem_block_t;
+#endif
+
+
+/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. They must not clash
+ with existing names and they should follow ANSI C. But this source
+ code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __
+ prefix. So we have to make a difference here. */
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# define DCIGETTEXT __dcigettext
+#else
+# define DCIGETTEXT libintl_dcigettext
+#endif
+
+/* Lock variable to protect the global data in the gettext implementation. */
+#ifdef _LIBC
+__libc_rwlock_define_initialized (, _nl_state_lock attribute_hidden)
+#endif
+
+/* Checking whether the binaries runs SUID must be done and glibc provides
+ easier methods therefore we make a difference here. */
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# define ENABLE_SECURE __libc_enable_secure
+# define DETERMINE_SECURE
+#else
+# ifndef HAVE_GETUID
+# define getuid() 0
+# endif
+# ifndef HAVE_GETGID
+# define getgid() 0
+# endif
+# ifndef HAVE_GETEUID
+# define geteuid() getuid()
+# endif
+# ifndef HAVE_GETEGID
+# define getegid() getgid()
+# endif
+static int enable_secure;
+# define ENABLE_SECURE (enable_secure == 1)
+# define DETERMINE_SECURE \
+ if (enable_secure == 0) \
+ { \
+ if (getuid () != geteuid () || getgid () != getegid ()) \
+ enable_secure = 1; \
+ else \
+ enable_secure = -1; \
+ }
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_RAISE
+# define raise(x) kill (getpid (), (x))
+#endif
+
+/* Get the function to evaluate the plural expression. */
+#include "eval-plural.h"
+
+/* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog for the current
+ CATEGORY locale and, if PLURAL is nonzero, search over string
+ depending on the plural form determined by N. */
+char *
+DCIGETTEXT (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, plural, n, category)
+ const char *domainname;
+ const char *msgid1;
+ const char *msgid2;
+ int plural;
+ unsigned long int n;
+ int category;
+{
+#ifndef HAVE_ALLOCA
+ struct block_list *block_list = NULL;
+#endif
+ struct loaded_l10nfile *domain;
+ struct binding *binding;
+ const char *categoryname;
+ const char *categoryvalue;
+ char *dirname, *xdomainname;
+ char *single_locale;
+ char *retval;
+ size_t retlen;
+ int saved_errno;
+#if defined HAVE_TSEARCH || defined _LIBC
+ struct known_translation_t *search;
+ struct known_translation_t **foundp = NULL;
+ size_t msgid_len;
+#endif
+ size_t domainname_len;
+
+ /* If no real MSGID is given return NULL. */
+ if (msgid1 == NULL)
+ return NULL;
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+ if (category < 0 || category >= __LC_LAST || category == LC_ALL)
+ /* Bogus. */
+ return (plural == 0
+ ? (char *) msgid1
+ /* Use the Germanic plural rule. */
+ : n == 1 ? (char *) msgid1 : (char *) msgid2);
+#endif
+
+ __libc_rwlock_rdlock (_nl_state_lock);
+
+ /* If DOMAINNAME is NULL, we are interested in the default domain. If
+ CATEGORY is not LC_MESSAGES this might not make much sense but the
+ definition left this undefined. */
+ if (domainname == NULL)
+ domainname = _nl_current_default_domain;
+
+ /* OS/2 specific: backward compatibility with older libintl versions */
+#ifdef LC_MESSAGES_COMPAT
+ if (category == LC_MESSAGES_COMPAT)
+ category = LC_MESSAGES;
+#endif
+
+#if defined HAVE_TSEARCH || defined _LIBC
+ msgid_len = strlen (msgid1) + 1;
+
+ /* Try to find the translation among those which we found at
+ some time. */
+ search = (struct known_translation_t *)
+ alloca (offsetof (struct known_translation_t, msgid) + msgid_len);
+ memcpy (search->msgid, msgid1, msgid_len);
+ search->domainname = (char *) domainname;
+ search->category = category;
+
+ foundp = (struct known_translation_t **) tfind (search, &root, transcmp);
+ freea (search);
+ if (foundp != NULL && (*foundp)->counter == _nl_msg_cat_cntr)
+ {
+ /* Now deal with plural. */
+ if (plural)
+ retval = plural_lookup ((*foundp)->domain, n, (*foundp)->translation,
+ (*foundp)->translation_length);
+ else
+ retval = (char *) (*foundp)->translation;
+
+ __libc_rwlock_unlock (_nl_state_lock);
+ return retval;
+ }
+#endif
+
+ /* Preserve the `errno' value. */
+ saved_errno = errno;
+
+ /* See whether this is a SUID binary or not. */
+ DETERMINE_SECURE;
+
+ /* First find matching binding. */
+ for (binding = _nl_domain_bindings; binding != NULL; binding = binding->next)
+ {
+ int compare = strcmp (domainname, binding->domainname);
+ if (compare == 0)
+ /* We found it! */
+ break;
+ if (compare < 0)
+ {
+ /* It is not in the list. */
+ binding = NULL;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (binding == NULL)
+ dirname = (char *) INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname);
+ else if (IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (binding->dirname))
+ dirname = binding->dirname;
+ else
+ {
+ /* We have a relative path. Make it absolute now. */
+ size_t dirname_len = strlen (binding->dirname) + 1;
+ size_t path_max;
+ char *ret;
+
+ path_max = (unsigned int) PATH_MAX;
+ path_max += 2; /* The getcwd docs say to do this. */
+
+ for (;;)
+ {
+ dirname = (char *) alloca (path_max + dirname_len);
+ ADD_BLOCK (block_list, dirname);
+
+ __set_errno (0);
+ ret = getcwd (dirname, path_max);
+ if (ret != NULL || errno != ERANGE)
+ break;
+
+ path_max += path_max / 2;
+ path_max += PATH_INCR;
+ }
+
+ if (ret == NULL)
+ /* We cannot get the current working directory. Don't signal an
+ error but simply return the default string. */
+ goto return_untranslated;
+
+ stpcpy (stpcpy (strchr (dirname, '\0'), "/"), binding->dirname);
+ }
+
+ /* Now determine the symbolic name of CATEGORY and its value. */
+ categoryname = category_to_name (category);
+ categoryvalue = guess_category_value (category, categoryname);
+
+ domainname_len = strlen (domainname);
+ xdomainname = (char *) alloca (strlen (categoryname)
+ + domainname_len + 5);
+ ADD_BLOCK (block_list, xdomainname);
+
+ stpcpy (mempcpy (stpcpy (stpcpy (xdomainname, categoryname), "/"),
+ domainname, domainname_len),
+ ".mo");
+
+ /* Creating working area. */
+ single_locale = (char *) alloca (strlen (categoryvalue) + 1);
+ ADD_BLOCK (block_list, single_locale);
+
+
+ /* Search for the given string. This is a loop because we perhaps
+ got an ordered list of languages to consider for the translation. */
+ while (1)
+ {
+ /* Make CATEGORYVALUE point to the next element of the list. */
+ while (categoryvalue[0] != '\0' && categoryvalue[0] == ':')
+ ++categoryvalue;
+ if (categoryvalue[0] == '\0')
+ {
+ /* The whole contents of CATEGORYVALUE has been searched but
+ no valid entry has been found. We solve this situation
+ by implicitly appending a "C" entry, i.e. no translation
+ will take place. */
+ single_locale[0] = 'C';
+ single_locale[1] = '\0';
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ char *cp = single_locale;
+ while (categoryvalue[0] != '\0' && categoryvalue[0] != ':')
+ *cp++ = *categoryvalue++;
+ *cp = '\0';
+
+ /* When this is a SUID binary we must not allow accessing files
+ outside the dedicated directories. */
+ if (ENABLE_SECURE && IS_PATH_WITH_DIR (single_locale))
+ /* Ingore this entry. */
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /* If the current locale value is C (or POSIX) we don't load a
+ domain. Return the MSGID. */
+ if (strcmp (single_locale, "C") == 0
+ || strcmp (single_locale, "POSIX") == 0)
+ break;
+
+ /* Find structure describing the message catalog matching the
+ DOMAINNAME and CATEGORY. */
+ domain = _nl_find_domain (dirname, single_locale, xdomainname, binding);
+
+ if (domain != NULL)
+ {
+ retval = _nl_find_msg (domain, binding, msgid1, &retlen);
+
+ if (retval == NULL)
+ {
+ int cnt;
+
+ for (cnt = 0; domain->successor[cnt] != NULL; ++cnt)
+ {
+ retval = _nl_find_msg (domain->successor[cnt], binding,
+ msgid1, &retlen);
+
+ if (retval != NULL)
+ {
+ domain = domain->successor[cnt];
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (retval != NULL)
+ {
+ /* Found the translation of MSGID1 in domain DOMAIN:
+ starting at RETVAL, RETLEN bytes. */
+ FREE_BLOCKS (block_list);
+#if defined HAVE_TSEARCH || defined _LIBC
+ if (foundp == NULL)
+ {
+ /* Create a new entry and add it to the search tree. */
+ struct known_translation_t *newp;
+
+ newp = (struct known_translation_t *)
+ malloc (offsetof (struct known_translation_t, msgid)
+ + msgid_len + domainname_len + 1);
+ if (newp != NULL)
+ {
+ newp->domainname =
+ mempcpy (newp->msgid, msgid1, msgid_len);
+ memcpy (newp->domainname, domainname, domainname_len + 1);
+ newp->category = category;
+ newp->counter = _nl_msg_cat_cntr;
+ newp->domain = domain;
+ newp->translation = retval;
+ newp->translation_length = retlen;
+
+ /* Insert the entry in the search tree. */
+ foundp = (struct known_translation_t **)
+ tsearch (newp, &root, transcmp);
+ if (foundp == NULL
+ || __builtin_expect (*foundp != newp, 0))
+ /* The insert failed. */
+ free (newp);
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* We can update the existing entry. */
+ (*foundp)->counter = _nl_msg_cat_cntr;
+ (*foundp)->domain = domain;
+ (*foundp)->translation = retval;
+ (*foundp)->translation_length = retlen;
+ }
+#endif
+ __set_errno (saved_errno);
+
+ /* Now deal with plural. */
+ if (plural)
+ retval = plural_lookup (domain, n, retval, retlen);
+
+ __libc_rwlock_unlock (_nl_state_lock);
+ return retval;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ return_untranslated:
+ /* Return the untranslated MSGID. */
+ FREE_BLOCKS (block_list);
+ __libc_rwlock_unlock (_nl_state_lock);
+#ifndef _LIBC
+ if (!ENABLE_SECURE)
+ {
+ extern void _nl_log_untranslated PARAMS ((const char *logfilename,
+ const char *domainname,
+ const char *msgid1,
+ const char *msgid2,
+ int plural));
+ const char *logfilename = getenv ("GETTEXT_LOG_UNTRANSLATED");
+
+ if (logfilename != NULL && logfilename[0] != '\0')
+ _nl_log_untranslated (logfilename, domainname, msgid1, msgid2, plural);
+ }
+#endif
+ __set_errno (saved_errno);
+ return (plural == 0
+ ? (char *) msgid1
+ /* Use the Germanic plural rule. */
+ : n == 1 ? (char *) msgid1 : (char *) msgid2);
+}
+
+
+char *
+internal_function
+_nl_find_msg (domain_file, domainbinding, msgid, lengthp)
+ struct loaded_l10nfile *domain_file;
+ struct binding *domainbinding;
+ const char *msgid;
+ size_t *lengthp;
+{
+ struct loaded_domain *domain;
+ nls_uint32 nstrings;
+ size_t act;
+ char *result;
+ size_t resultlen;
+
+ if (domain_file->decided == 0)
+ _nl_load_domain (domain_file, domainbinding);
+
+ if (domain_file->data == NULL)
+ return NULL;
+
+ domain = (struct loaded_domain *) domain_file->data;
+
+ nstrings = domain->nstrings;
+
+ /* Locate the MSGID and its translation. */
+ if (domain->hash_tab != NULL)
+ {
+ /* Use the hashing table. */
+ nls_uint32 len = strlen (msgid);
+ nls_uint32 hash_val = hash_string (msgid);
+ nls_uint32 idx = hash_val % domain->hash_size;
+ nls_uint32 incr = 1 + (hash_val % (domain->hash_size - 2));
+
+ while (1)
+ {
+ nls_uint32 nstr =
+ W (domain->must_swap_hash_tab, domain->hash_tab[idx]);
+
+ if (nstr == 0)
+ /* Hash table entry is empty. */
+ return NULL;
+
+ nstr--;
+
+ /* Compare msgid with the original string at index nstr.
+ We compare the lengths with >=, not ==, because plural entries
+ are represented by strings with an embedded NUL. */
+ if (nstr < nstrings
+ ? W (domain->must_swap, domain->orig_tab[nstr].length) >= len
+ && (strcmp (msgid,
+ domain->data + W (domain->must_swap,
+ domain->orig_tab[nstr].offset))
+ == 0)
+ : domain->orig_sysdep_tab[nstr - nstrings].length > len
+ && (strcmp (msgid,
+ domain->orig_sysdep_tab[nstr - nstrings].pointer)
+ == 0))
+ {
+ act = nstr;
+ goto found;
+ }
+
+ if (idx >= domain->hash_size - incr)
+ idx -= domain->hash_size - incr;
+ else
+ idx += incr;
+ }
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Try the default method: binary search in the sorted array of
+ messages. */
+ size_t top, bottom;
+
+ bottom = 0;
+ top = nstrings;
+ while (bottom < top)
+ {
+ int cmp_val;
+
+ act = (bottom + top) / 2;
+ cmp_val = strcmp (msgid, (domain->data
+ + W (domain->must_swap,
+ domain->orig_tab[act].offset)));
+ if (cmp_val < 0)
+ top = act;
+ else if (cmp_val > 0)
+ bottom = act + 1;
+ else
+ goto found;
+ }
+ /* No translation was found. */
+ return NULL;
+ }
+
+ found:
+ /* The translation was found at index ACT. If we have to convert the
+ string to use a different character set, this is the time. */
+ if (act < nstrings)
+ {
+ result = (char *)
+ (domain->data + W (domain->must_swap, domain->trans_tab[act].offset));
+ resultlen = W (domain->must_swap, domain->trans_tab[act].length) + 1;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ result = (char *) domain->trans_sysdep_tab[act - nstrings].pointer;
+ resultlen = domain->trans_sysdep_tab[act - nstrings].length;
+ }
+
+#if defined _LIBC || HAVE_ICONV
+ if (domain->codeset_cntr
+ != (domainbinding != NULL ? domainbinding->codeset_cntr : 0))
+ {
+ /* The domain's codeset has changed through bind_textdomain_codeset()
+ since the message catalog was initialized or last accessed. We
+ have to reinitialize the converter. */
+ _nl_free_domain_conv (domain);
+ _nl_init_domain_conv (domain_file, domain, domainbinding);
+ }
+
+ if (
+# ifdef _LIBC
+ domain->conv != (__gconv_t) -1
+# else
+# if HAVE_ICONV
+ domain->conv != (iconv_t) -1
+# endif
+# endif
+ )
+ {
+ /* We are supposed to do a conversion. First allocate an
+ appropriate table with the same structure as the table
+ of translations in the file, where we can put the pointers
+ to the converted strings in.
+ There is a slight complication with plural entries. They
+ are represented by consecutive NUL terminated strings. We
+ handle this case by converting RESULTLEN bytes, including
+ NULs. */
+
+ if (domain->conv_tab == NULL
+ && ((domain->conv_tab =
+ (char **) calloc (nstrings + domain->n_sysdep_strings,
+ sizeof (char *)))
+ == NULL))
+ /* Mark that we didn't succeed allocating a table. */
+ domain->conv_tab = (char **) -1;
+
+ if (__builtin_expect (domain->conv_tab == (char **) -1, 0))
+ /* Nothing we can do, no more memory. */
+ goto converted;
+
+ if (domain->conv_tab[act] == NULL)
+ {
+ /* We haven't used this string so far, so it is not
+ translated yet. Do this now. */
+ /* We use a bit more efficient memory handling.
+ We allocate always larger blocks which get used over
+ time. This is faster than many small allocations. */
+ __libc_lock_define_initialized (static, lock)
+# define INITIAL_BLOCK_SIZE 4080
+ static unsigned char *freemem;
+ static size_t freemem_size;
+
+ const unsigned char *inbuf;
+ unsigned char *outbuf;
+ int malloc_count;
+# ifndef _LIBC
+ transmem_block_t *transmem_list = NULL;
+# endif
+
+ __libc_lock_lock (lock);
+
+ inbuf = (const unsigned char *) result;
+ outbuf = freemem + sizeof (size_t);
+
+ malloc_count = 0;
+ while (1)
+ {
+ transmem_block_t *newmem;
+# ifdef _LIBC
+ size_t non_reversible;
+ int res;
+
+ if (freemem_size < sizeof (size_t))
+ goto resize_freemem;
+
+ res = __gconv (domain->conv,
+ &inbuf, inbuf + resultlen,
+ &outbuf,
+ outbuf + freemem_size - sizeof (size_t),
+ &non_reversible);
+
+ if (res == __GCONV_OK || res == __GCONV_EMPTY_INPUT)
+ break;
+
+ if (res != __GCONV_FULL_OUTPUT)
+ {
+ __libc_lock_unlock (lock);
+ goto converted;
+ }
+
+ inbuf = result;
+# else
+# if HAVE_ICONV
+ const char *inptr = (const char *) inbuf;
+ size_t inleft = resultlen;
+ char *outptr = (char *) outbuf;
+ size_t outleft;
+
+ if (freemem_size < sizeof (size_t))
+ goto resize_freemem;
+
+ outleft = freemem_size - sizeof (size_t);
+ if (iconv (domain->conv,
+ (ICONV_CONST char **) &inptr, &inleft,
+ &outptr, &outleft)
+ != (size_t) (-1))
+ {
+ outbuf = (unsigned char *) outptr;
+ break;
+ }
+ if (errno != E2BIG)
+ {
+ __libc_lock_unlock (lock);
+ goto converted;
+ }
+# endif
+# endif
+
+ resize_freemem:
+ /* We must allocate a new buffer or resize the old one. */
+ if (malloc_count > 0)
+ {
+ ++malloc_count;
+ freemem_size = malloc_count * INITIAL_BLOCK_SIZE;
+ newmem = (transmem_block_t *) realloc (transmem_list,
+ freemem_size);
+# ifdef _LIBC
+ if (newmem != NULL)
+ transmem_list = transmem_list->next;
+ else
+ {
+ struct transmem_list *old = transmem_list;
+
+ transmem_list = transmem_list->next;
+ free (old);
+ }
+# endif
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ malloc_count = 1;
+ freemem_size = INITIAL_BLOCK_SIZE;
+ newmem = (transmem_block_t *) malloc (freemem_size);
+ }
+ if (__builtin_expect (newmem == NULL, 0))
+ {
+ freemem = NULL;
+ freemem_size = 0;
+ __libc_lock_unlock (lock);
+ goto converted;
+ }
+
+# ifdef _LIBC
+ /* Add the block to the list of blocks we have to free
+ at some point. */
+ newmem->next = transmem_list;
+ transmem_list = newmem;
+
+ freemem = newmem->data;
+ freemem_size -= offsetof (struct transmem_list, data);
+# else
+ transmem_list = newmem;
+ freemem = newmem;
+# endif
+
+ outbuf = freemem + sizeof (size_t);
+ }
+
+ /* We have now in our buffer a converted string. Put this
+ into the table of conversions. */
+ *(size_t *) freemem = outbuf - freemem - sizeof (size_t);
+ domain->conv_tab[act] = (char *) freemem;
+ /* Shrink freemem, but keep it aligned. */
+ freemem_size -= outbuf - freemem;
+ freemem = outbuf;
+ freemem += freemem_size & (alignof (size_t) - 1);
+ freemem_size = freemem_size & ~ (alignof (size_t) - 1);
+
+ __libc_lock_unlock (lock);
+ }
+
+ /* Now domain->conv_tab[act] contains the translation of all
+ the plural variants. */
+ result = domain->conv_tab[act] + sizeof (size_t);
+ resultlen = *(size_t *) domain->conv_tab[act];
+ }
+
+ converted:
+ /* The result string is converted. */
+
+#endif /* _LIBC || HAVE_ICONV */
+
+ *lengthp = resultlen;
+ return result;
+}
+
+
+/* Look up a plural variant. */
+static char *
+internal_function
+plural_lookup (domain, n, translation, translation_len)
+ struct loaded_l10nfile *domain;
+ unsigned long int n;
+ const char *translation;
+ size_t translation_len;
+{
+ struct loaded_domain *domaindata = (struct loaded_domain *) domain->data;
+ unsigned long int index;
+ const char *p;
+
+ index = plural_eval (domaindata->plural, n);
+ if (index >= domaindata->nplurals)
+ /* This should never happen. It means the plural expression and the
+ given maximum value do not match. */
+ index = 0;
+
+ /* Skip INDEX strings at TRANSLATION. */
+ p = translation;
+ while (index-- > 0)
+ {
+#ifdef _LIBC
+ p = __rawmemchr (p, '\0');
+#else
+ p = strchr (p, '\0');
+#endif
+ /* And skip over the NUL byte. */
+ p++;
+
+ if (p >= translation + translation_len)
+ /* This should never happen. It means the plural expression
+ evaluated to a value larger than the number of variants
+ available for MSGID1. */
+ return (char *) translation;
+ }
+ return (char *) p;
+}
+
+#ifndef _LIBC
+/* Return string representation of locale CATEGORY. */
+static const char *
+internal_function
+category_to_name (category)
+ int category;
+{
+ const char *retval;
+
+ switch (category)
+ {
+#ifdef LC_COLLATE
+ case LC_COLLATE:
+ retval = "LC_COLLATE";
+ break;
+#endif
+#ifdef LC_CTYPE
+ case LC_CTYPE:
+ retval = "LC_CTYPE";
+ break;
+#endif
+#ifdef LC_MONETARY
+ case LC_MONETARY:
+ retval = "LC_MONETARY";
+ break;
+#endif
+#ifdef LC_NUMERIC
+ case LC_NUMERIC:
+ retval = "LC_NUMERIC";
+ break;
+#endif
+#ifdef LC_TIME
+ case LC_TIME:
+ retval = "LC_TIME";
+ break;
+#endif
+#ifdef LC_MESSAGES
+ case LC_MESSAGES:
+ retval = "LC_MESSAGES";
+ break;
+#endif
+#ifdef LC_RESPONSE
+ case LC_RESPONSE:
+ retval = "LC_RESPONSE";
+ break;
+#endif
+#ifdef LC_ALL
+ case LC_ALL:
+ /* This might not make sense but is perhaps better than any other
+ value. */
+ retval = "LC_ALL";
+ break;
+#endif
+ default:
+ /* If you have a better idea for a default value let me know. */
+ retval = "LC_XXX";
+ }
+
+ return retval;
+}
+#endif
+
+/* Guess value of current locale from value of the environment variables. */
+static const char *
+internal_function
+guess_category_value (category, categoryname)
+ int category;
+ const char *categoryname;
+{
+ const char *language;
+ const char *retval;
+
+ /* The highest priority value is the `LANGUAGE' environment
+ variable. But we don't use the value if the currently selected
+ locale is the C locale. This is a GNU extension. */
+ language = getenv ("LANGUAGE");
+ if (language != NULL && language[0] == '\0')
+ language = NULL;
+
+ /* We have to proceed with the POSIX methods of looking to `LC_ALL',
+ `LC_xxx', and `LANG'. On some systems this can be done by the
+ `setlocale' function itself. */
+#ifdef _LIBC
+ retval = __current_locale_name (category);
+#else
+ retval = _nl_locale_name (category, categoryname);
+#endif
+
+ /* Ignore LANGUAGE if the locale is set to "C" because
+ 1. "C" locale usually uses the ASCII encoding, and most international
+ messages use non-ASCII characters. These characters get displayed
+ as question marks (if using glibc's iconv()) or as invalid 8-bit
+ characters (because other iconv()s refuse to convert most non-ASCII
+ characters to ASCII). In any case, the output is ugly.
+ 2. The precise output of some programs in the "C" locale is specified
+ by POSIX and should not depend on environment variables like
+ "LANGUAGE". We allow such programs to use gettext(). */
+ return language != NULL && strcmp (retval, "C") != 0 ? language : retval;
+}
+
+/* @@ begin of epilog @@ */
+
+/* We don't want libintl.a to depend on any other library. So we
+ avoid the non-standard function stpcpy. In GNU C Library this
+ function is available, though. Also allow the symbol HAVE_STPCPY
+ to be defined. */
+#if !_LIBC && !HAVE_STPCPY
+static char *
+stpcpy (dest, src)
+ char *dest;
+ const char *src;
+{
+ while ((*dest++ = *src++) != '\0')
+ /* Do nothing. */ ;
+ return dest - 1;
+}
+#endif
+
+#if !_LIBC && !HAVE_MEMPCPY
+static void *
+mempcpy (dest, src, n)
+ void *dest;
+ const void *src;
+ size_t n;
+{
+ return (void *) ((char *) memcpy (dest, src, n) + n);
+}
+#endif
+
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+/* If we want to free all resources we have to do some work at
+ program's end. */
+libc_freeres_fn (free_mem)
+{
+ void *old;
+
+ while (_nl_domain_bindings != NULL)
+ {
+ struct binding *oldp = _nl_domain_bindings;
+ _nl_domain_bindings = _nl_domain_bindings->next;
+ if (oldp->dirname != INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname))
+ /* Yes, this is a pointer comparison. */
+ free (oldp->dirname);
+ free (oldp->codeset);
+ free (oldp);
+ }
+
+ if (_nl_current_default_domain != _nl_default_default_domain)
+ /* Yes, again a pointer comparison. */
+ free ((char *) _nl_current_default_domain);
+
+ /* Remove the search tree with the known translations. */
+ __tdestroy (root, free);
+ root = NULL;
+
+ while (transmem_list != NULL)
+ {
+ old = transmem_list;
+ transmem_list = transmem_list->next;
+ free (old);
+ }
+}
+#endif
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/dcngettext.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/dcngettext.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3a3404e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/dcngettext.c
@@ -0,0 +1,60 @@
+/* Implementation of the dcngettext(3) function.
+ Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "gettextP.h"
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# include <libintl.h>
+#else
+# include "libgnuintl.h"
+#endif
+
+/* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+
+/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. They must not clash
+ with existing names and they should follow ANSI C. But this source
+ code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __
+ prefix. So we have to make a difference here. */
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# define DCNGETTEXT __dcngettext
+# define DCIGETTEXT __dcigettext
+#else
+# define DCNGETTEXT libintl_dcngettext
+# define DCIGETTEXT libintl_dcigettext
+#endif
+
+/* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog for the current CATEGORY
+ locale. */
+char *
+DCNGETTEXT (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, n, category)
+ const char *domainname;
+ const char *msgid1;
+ const char *msgid2;
+ unsigned long int n;
+ int category;
+{
+ return DCIGETTEXT (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, 1, n, category);
+}
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+/* Alias for function name in GNU C Library. */
+weak_alias (__dcngettext, dcngettext);
+#endif
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/dgettext.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/dgettext.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..cf5b403
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/dgettext.c
@@ -0,0 +1,59 @@
+/* Implementation of the dgettext(3) function.
+ Copyright (C) 1995-1997, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <locale.h>
+
+#include "gettextP.h"
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# include <libintl.h>
+#else
+# include "libgnuintl.h"
+#endif
+
+/* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+
+/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. They must not clash
+ with existing names and they should follow ANSI C. But this source
+ code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __
+ prefix. So we have to make a difference here. */
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# define DGETTEXT __dgettext
+# define DCGETTEXT INTUSE(__dcgettext)
+#else
+# define DGETTEXT libintl_dgettext
+# define DCGETTEXT libintl_dcgettext
+#endif
+
+/* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog of the current
+ LC_MESSAGES locale. */
+char *
+DGETTEXT (domainname, msgid)
+ const char *domainname;
+ const char *msgid;
+{
+ return DCGETTEXT (domainname, msgid, LC_MESSAGES);
+}
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+/* Alias for function name in GNU C Library. */
+weak_alias (__dgettext, dgettext);
+#endif
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/dngettext.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/dngettext.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..67fd030
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/dngettext.c
@@ -0,0 +1,61 @@
+/* Implementation of the dngettext(3) function.
+ Copyright (C) 1995-1997, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <locale.h>
+
+#include "gettextP.h"
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# include <libintl.h>
+#else
+# include "libgnuintl.h"
+#endif
+
+/* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+
+/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. They must not clash
+ with existing names and they should follow ANSI C. But this source
+ code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __
+ prefix. So we have to make a difference here. */
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# define DNGETTEXT __dngettext
+# define DCNGETTEXT __dcngettext
+#else
+# define DNGETTEXT libintl_dngettext
+# define DCNGETTEXT libintl_dcngettext
+#endif
+
+/* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog of the current
+ LC_MESSAGES locale and skip message according to the plural form. */
+char *
+DNGETTEXT (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, n)
+ const char *domainname;
+ const char *msgid1;
+ const char *msgid2;
+ unsigned long int n;
+{
+ return DCNGETTEXT (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, n, LC_MESSAGES);
+}
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+/* Alias for function name in GNU C Library. */
+weak_alias (__dngettext, dngettext);
+#endif
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/eval-plural.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/eval-plural.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..19c7ca6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/eval-plural.h
@@ -0,0 +1,114 @@
+/* Plural expression evaluation.
+ Copyright (C) 2000-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+#ifndef STATIC
+#define STATIC static
+#endif
+
+/* Evaluate the plural expression and return an index value. */
+STATIC unsigned long int plural_eval PARAMS ((struct expression *pexp,
+ unsigned long int n))
+ internal_function;
+
+STATIC
+unsigned long int
+internal_function
+plural_eval (pexp, n)
+ struct expression *pexp;
+ unsigned long int n;
+{
+ switch (pexp->nargs)
+ {
+ case 0:
+ switch (pexp->operation)
+ {
+ case var:
+ return n;
+ case num:
+ return pexp->val.num;
+ default:
+ break;
+ }
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+ break;
+ case 1:
+ {
+ /* pexp->operation must be lnot. */
+ unsigned long int arg = plural_eval (pexp->val.args[0], n);
+ return ! arg;
+ }
+ case 2:
+ {
+ unsigned long int leftarg = plural_eval (pexp->val.args[0], n);
+ if (pexp->operation == lor)
+ return leftarg || plural_eval (pexp->val.args[1], n);
+ else if (pexp->operation == land)
+ return leftarg && plural_eval (pexp->val.args[1], n);
+ else
+ {
+ unsigned long int rightarg = plural_eval (pexp->val.args[1], n);
+
+ switch (pexp->operation)
+ {
+ case mult:
+ return leftarg * rightarg;
+ case divide:
+#if !INTDIV0_RAISES_SIGFPE
+ if (rightarg == 0)
+ raise (SIGFPE);
+#endif
+ return leftarg / rightarg;
+ case module:
+#if !INTDIV0_RAISES_SIGFPE
+ if (rightarg == 0)
+ raise (SIGFPE);
+#endif
+ return leftarg % rightarg;
+ case plus:
+ return leftarg + rightarg;
+ case minus:
+ return leftarg - rightarg;
+ case less_than:
+ return leftarg < rightarg;
+ case greater_than:
+ return leftarg > rightarg;
+ case less_or_equal:
+ return leftarg <= rightarg;
+ case greater_or_equal:
+ return leftarg >= rightarg;
+ case equal:
+ return leftarg == rightarg;
+ case not_equal:
+ return leftarg != rightarg;
+ default:
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+ break;
+ }
+ case 3:
+ {
+ /* pexp->operation must be qmop. */
+ unsigned long int boolarg = plural_eval (pexp->val.args[0], n);
+ return plural_eval (pexp->val.args[boolarg ? 1 : 2], n);
+ }
+ }
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+ return 0;
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/explodename.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/explodename.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..2985064
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/explodename.c
@@ -0,0 +1,192 @@
+/* Copyright (C) 1995-1998, 2000, 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.ai.mit.edu>, 1995.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#include "loadinfo.h"
+
+/* On some strange systems still no definition of NULL is found. Sigh! */
+#ifndef NULL
+# if defined __STDC__ && __STDC__
+# define NULL ((void *) 0)
+# else
+# define NULL 0
+# endif
+#endif
+
+/* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+
+char *
+_nl_find_language (name)
+ const char *name;
+{
+ while (name[0] != '\0' && name[0] != '_' && name[0] != '@'
+ && name[0] != '+' && name[0] != ',')
+ ++name;
+
+ return (char *) name;
+}
+
+
+int
+_nl_explode_name (name, language, modifier, territory, codeset,
+ normalized_codeset, special, sponsor, revision)
+ char *name;
+ const char **language;
+ const char **modifier;
+ const char **territory;
+ const char **codeset;
+ const char **normalized_codeset;
+ const char **special;
+ const char **sponsor;
+ const char **revision;
+{
+ enum { undecided, xpg, cen } syntax;
+ char *cp;
+ int mask;
+
+ *modifier = NULL;
+ *territory = NULL;
+ *codeset = NULL;
+ *normalized_codeset = NULL;
+ *special = NULL;
+ *sponsor = NULL;
+ *revision = NULL;
+
+ /* Now we determine the single parts of the locale name. First
+ look for the language. Termination symbols are `_' and `@' if
+ we use XPG4 style, and `_', `+', and `,' if we use CEN syntax. */
+ mask = 0;
+ syntax = undecided;
+ *language = cp = name;
+ cp = _nl_find_language (*language);
+
+ if (*language == cp)
+ /* This does not make sense: language has to be specified. Use
+ this entry as it is without exploding. Perhaps it is an alias. */
+ cp = strchr (*language, '\0');
+ else if (cp[0] == '_')
+ {
+ /* Next is the territory. */
+ cp[0] = '\0';
+ *territory = ++cp;
+
+ while (cp[0] != '\0' && cp[0] != '.' && cp[0] != '@'
+ && cp[0] != '+' && cp[0] != ',' && cp[0] != '_')
+ ++cp;
+
+ mask |= TERRITORY;
+
+ if (cp[0] == '.')
+ {
+ /* Next is the codeset. */
+ syntax = xpg;
+ cp[0] = '\0';
+ *codeset = ++cp;
+
+ while (cp[0] != '\0' && cp[0] != '@')
+ ++cp;
+
+ mask |= XPG_CODESET;
+
+ if (*codeset != cp && (*codeset)[0] != '\0')
+ {
+ *normalized_codeset = _nl_normalize_codeset (*codeset,
+ cp - *codeset);
+ if (strcmp (*codeset, *normalized_codeset) == 0)
+ free ((char *) *normalized_codeset);
+ else
+ mask |= XPG_NORM_CODESET;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (cp[0] == '@' || (syntax != xpg && cp[0] == '+'))
+ {
+ /* Next is the modifier. */
+ syntax = cp[0] == '@' ? xpg : cen;
+ cp[0] = '\0';
+ *modifier = ++cp;
+
+ while (syntax == cen && cp[0] != '\0' && cp[0] != '+'
+ && cp[0] != ',' && cp[0] != '_')
+ ++cp;
+
+ mask |= XPG_MODIFIER | CEN_AUDIENCE;
+ }
+
+ if (syntax != xpg && (cp[0] == '+' || cp[0] == ',' || cp[0] == '_'))
+ {
+ syntax = cen;
+
+ if (cp[0] == '+')
+ {
+ /* Next is special application (CEN syntax). */
+ cp[0] = '\0';
+ *special = ++cp;
+
+ while (cp[0] != '\0' && cp[0] != ',' && cp[0] != '_')
+ ++cp;
+
+ mask |= CEN_SPECIAL;
+ }
+
+ if (cp[0] == ',')
+ {
+ /* Next is sponsor (CEN syntax). */
+ cp[0] = '\0';
+ *sponsor = ++cp;
+
+ while (cp[0] != '\0' && cp[0] != '_')
+ ++cp;
+
+ mask |= CEN_SPONSOR;
+ }
+
+ if (cp[0] == '_')
+ {
+ /* Next is revision (CEN syntax). */
+ cp[0] = '\0';
+ *revision = ++cp;
+
+ mask |= CEN_REVISION;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* For CEN syntax values it might be important to have the
+ separator character in the file name, not for XPG syntax. */
+ if (syntax == xpg)
+ {
+ if (*territory != NULL && (*territory)[0] == '\0')
+ mask &= ~TERRITORY;
+
+ if (*codeset != NULL && (*codeset)[0] == '\0')
+ mask &= ~XPG_CODESET;
+
+ if (*modifier != NULL && (*modifier)[0] == '\0')
+ mask &= ~XPG_MODIFIER;
+ }
+
+ return mask;
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/finddomain.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/finddomain.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d242764
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/finddomain.c
@@ -0,0 +1,195 @@
+/* Handle list of needed message catalogs
+ Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000, 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.org>, 1995.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+#if defined HAVE_UNISTD_H || defined _LIBC
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "gettextP.h"
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# include <libintl.h>
+#else
+# include "libgnuintl.h"
+#endif
+
+/* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+/* List of already loaded domains. */
+static struct loaded_l10nfile *_nl_loaded_domains;
+
+
+/* Return a data structure describing the message catalog described by
+ the DOMAINNAME and CATEGORY parameters with respect to the currently
+ established bindings. */
+struct loaded_l10nfile *
+internal_function
+_nl_find_domain (dirname, locale, domainname, domainbinding)
+ const char *dirname;
+ char *locale;
+ const char *domainname;
+ struct binding *domainbinding;
+{
+ struct loaded_l10nfile *retval;
+ const char *language;
+ const char *modifier;
+ const char *territory;
+ const char *codeset;
+ const char *normalized_codeset;
+ const char *special;
+ const char *sponsor;
+ const char *revision;
+ const char *alias_value;
+ int mask;
+
+ /* LOCALE can consist of up to four recognized parts for the XPG syntax:
+
+ language[_territory[.codeset]][@modifier]
+
+ and six parts for the CEN syntax:
+
+ language[_territory][+audience][+special][,[sponsor][_revision]]
+
+ Beside the first part all of them are allowed to be missing. If
+ the full specified locale is not found, the less specific one are
+ looked for. The various parts will be stripped off according to
+ the following order:
+ (1) revision
+ (2) sponsor
+ (3) special
+ (4) codeset
+ (5) normalized codeset
+ (6) territory
+ (7) audience/modifier
+ */
+
+ /* If we have already tested for this locale entry there has to
+ be one data set in the list of loaded domains. */
+ retval = _nl_make_l10nflist (&_nl_loaded_domains, dirname,
+ strlen (dirname) + 1, 0, locale, NULL, NULL,
+ NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, domainname, 0);
+ if (retval != NULL)
+ {
+ /* We know something about this locale. */
+ int cnt;
+
+ if (retval->decided == 0)
+ _nl_load_domain (retval, domainbinding);
+
+ if (retval->data != NULL)
+ return retval;
+
+ for (cnt = 0; retval->successor[cnt] != NULL; ++cnt)
+ {
+ if (retval->successor[cnt]->decided == 0)
+ _nl_load_domain (retval->successor[cnt], domainbinding);
+
+ if (retval->successor[cnt]->data != NULL)
+ break;
+ }
+ return cnt >= 0 ? retval : NULL;
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+ }
+
+ /* See whether the locale value is an alias. If yes its value
+ *overwrites* the alias name. No test for the original value is
+ done. */
+ alias_value = _nl_expand_alias (locale);
+ if (alias_value != NULL)
+ {
+#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_STRDUP
+ locale = strdup (alias_value);
+ if (locale == NULL)
+ return NULL;
+#else
+ size_t len = strlen (alias_value) + 1;
+ locale = (char *) malloc (len);
+ if (locale == NULL)
+ return NULL;
+
+ memcpy (locale, alias_value, len);
+#endif
+ }
+
+ /* Now we determine the single parts of the locale name. First
+ look for the language. Termination symbols are `_' and `@' if
+ we use XPG4 style, and `_', `+', and `,' if we use CEN syntax. */
+ mask = _nl_explode_name (locale, &language, &modifier, &territory,
+ &codeset, &normalized_codeset, &special,
+ &sponsor, &revision);
+
+ /* Create all possible locale entries which might be interested in
+ generalization. */
+ retval = _nl_make_l10nflist (&_nl_loaded_domains, dirname,
+ strlen (dirname) + 1, mask, language, territory,
+ codeset, normalized_codeset, modifier, special,
+ sponsor, revision, domainname, 1);
+ if (retval == NULL)
+ /* This means we are out of core. */
+ return NULL;
+
+ if (retval->decided == 0)
+ _nl_load_domain (retval, domainbinding);
+ if (retval->data == NULL)
+ {
+ int cnt;
+ for (cnt = 0; retval->successor[cnt] != NULL; ++cnt)
+ {
+ if (retval->successor[cnt]->decided == 0)
+ _nl_load_domain (retval->successor[cnt], domainbinding);
+ if (retval->successor[cnt]->data != NULL)
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* The room for an alias was dynamically allocated. Free it now. */
+ if (alias_value != NULL)
+ free (locale);
+
+ /* The space for normalized_codeset is dynamically allocated. Free it. */
+ if (mask & XPG_NORM_CODESET)
+ free ((void *) normalized_codeset);
+
+ return retval;
+}
+
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+libc_freeres_fn (free_mem)
+{
+ struct loaded_l10nfile *runp = _nl_loaded_domains;
+
+ while (runp != NULL)
+ {
+ struct loaded_l10nfile *here = runp;
+ if (runp->data != NULL)
+ _nl_unload_domain ((struct loaded_domain *) runp->data);
+ runp = runp->next;
+ free ((char *) here->filename);
+ free (here);
+ }
+}
+#endif
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/gettext.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/gettext.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..43d689f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/gettext.c
@@ -0,0 +1,64 @@
+/* Implementation of gettext(3) function.
+ Copyright (C) 1995, 1997, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# define __need_NULL
+# include <stddef.h>
+#else
+# include <stdlib.h> /* Just for NULL. */
+#endif
+
+#include "gettextP.h"
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# include <libintl.h>
+#else
+# include "libgnuintl.h"
+#endif
+
+/* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+
+/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. They must not clash
+ with existing names and they should follow ANSI C. But this source
+ code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __
+ prefix. So we have to make a difference here. */
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# define GETTEXT __gettext
+# define DCGETTEXT INTUSE(__dcgettext)
+#else
+# define GETTEXT libintl_gettext
+# define DCGETTEXT libintl_dcgettext
+#endif
+
+/* Look up MSGID in the current default message catalog for the current
+ LC_MESSAGES locale. If not found, returns MSGID itself (the default
+ text). */
+char *
+GETTEXT (msgid)
+ const char *msgid;
+{
+ return DCGETTEXT (NULL, msgid, LC_MESSAGES);
+}
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+/* Alias for function name in GNU C Library. */
+weak_alias (__gettext, gettext);
+#endif
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/gettextP.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/gettextP.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f1748a3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/gettextP.h
@@ -0,0 +1,224 @@
+/* Header describing internals of libintl library.
+ Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1995.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+#ifndef _GETTEXTP_H
+#define _GETTEXTP_H
+
+#include <stddef.h> /* Get size_t. */
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# include "../iconv/gconv_int.h"
+#else
+# if HAVE_ICONV
+# include <iconv.h>
+# endif
+#endif
+
+#include "loadinfo.h"
+
+#include "gmo.h" /* Get nls_uint32. */
+
+/* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+
+#ifndef PARAMS
+# if __STDC__ || defined __GNUC__ || defined __SUNPRO_C || defined __cplusplus || __PROTOTYPES
+# define PARAMS(args) args
+# else
+# define PARAMS(args) ()
+# endif
+#endif
+
+#ifndef internal_function
+# define internal_function
+#endif
+
+#ifndef attribute_hidden
+# define attribute_hidden
+#endif
+
+/* Tell the compiler when a conditional or integer expression is
+ almost always true or almost always false. */
+#ifndef HAVE_BUILTIN_EXPECT
+# define __builtin_expect(expr, val) (expr)
+#endif
+
+#ifndef W
+# define W(flag, data) ((flag) ? SWAP (data) : (data))
+#endif
+
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# include <byteswap.h>
+# define SWAP(i) bswap_32 (i)
+#else
+static inline nls_uint32
+SWAP (i)
+ nls_uint32 i;
+{
+ return (i << 24) | ((i & 0xff00) << 8) | ((i >> 8) & 0xff00) | (i >> 24);
+}
+#endif
+
+
+/* In-memory representation of system dependent string. */
+struct sysdep_string_desc
+{
+ /* Length of addressed string, including the trailing NUL. */
+ size_t length;
+ /* Pointer to addressed string. */
+ const char *pointer;
+};
+
+/* The representation of an opened message catalog. */
+struct loaded_domain
+{
+ /* Pointer to memory containing the .mo file. */
+ const char *data;
+ /* 1 if the memory is mmap()ed, 0 if the memory is malloc()ed. */
+ int use_mmap;
+ /* Size of mmap()ed memory. */
+ size_t mmap_size;
+ /* 1 if the .mo file uses a different endianness than this machine. */
+ int must_swap;
+ /* Pointer to additional malloc()ed memory. */
+ void *malloced;
+
+ /* Number of static strings pairs. */
+ nls_uint32 nstrings;
+ /* Pointer to descriptors of original strings in the file. */
+ const struct string_desc *orig_tab;
+ /* Pointer to descriptors of translated strings in the file. */
+ const struct string_desc *trans_tab;
+
+ /* Number of system dependent strings pairs. */
+ nls_uint32 n_sysdep_strings;
+ /* Pointer to descriptors of original sysdep strings. */
+ const struct sysdep_string_desc *orig_sysdep_tab;
+ /* Pointer to descriptors of translated sysdep strings. */
+ const struct sysdep_string_desc *trans_sysdep_tab;
+
+ /* Size of hash table. */
+ nls_uint32 hash_size;
+ /* Pointer to hash table. */
+ const nls_uint32 *hash_tab;
+ /* 1 if the hash table uses a different endianness than this machine. */
+ int must_swap_hash_tab;
+
+ int codeset_cntr;
+#ifdef _LIBC
+ __gconv_t conv;
+#else
+# if HAVE_ICONV
+ iconv_t conv;
+# endif
+#endif
+ char **conv_tab;
+
+ struct expression *plural;
+ unsigned long int nplurals;
+};
+
+/* We want to allocate a string at the end of the struct. But ISO C
+ doesn't allow zero sized arrays. */
+#ifdef __GNUC__
+# define ZERO 0
+#else
+# define ZERO 1
+#endif
+
+/* A set of settings bound to a message domain. Used to store settings
+ from bindtextdomain() and bind_textdomain_codeset(). */
+struct binding
+{
+ struct binding *next;
+ char *dirname;
+ int codeset_cntr; /* Incremented each time codeset changes. */
+ char *codeset;
+ char domainname[ZERO];
+};
+
+/* A counter which is incremented each time some previous translations
+ become invalid.
+ This variable is part of the external ABI of the GNU libintl. */
+extern int _nl_msg_cat_cntr;
+
+#ifndef _LIBC
+const char *_nl_locale_name PARAMS ((int category, const char *categoryname));
+#endif
+
+struct loaded_l10nfile *_nl_find_domain PARAMS ((const char *__dirname,
+ char *__locale,
+ const char *__domainname,
+ struct binding *__domainbinding))
+ internal_function;
+void _nl_load_domain PARAMS ((struct loaded_l10nfile *__domain,
+ struct binding *__domainbinding))
+ internal_function;
+void _nl_unload_domain PARAMS ((struct loaded_domain *__domain))
+ internal_function;
+const char *_nl_init_domain_conv PARAMS ((struct loaded_l10nfile *__domain_file,
+ struct loaded_domain *__domain,
+ struct binding *__domainbinding))
+ internal_function;
+void _nl_free_domain_conv PARAMS ((struct loaded_domain *__domain))
+ internal_function;
+
+char *_nl_find_msg PARAMS ((struct loaded_l10nfile *domain_file,
+ struct binding *domainbinding,
+ const char *msgid, size_t *lengthp))
+ internal_function;
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+extern char *__gettext PARAMS ((const char *__msgid));
+extern char *__dgettext PARAMS ((const char *__domainname,
+ const char *__msgid));
+extern char *__dcgettext PARAMS ((const char *__domainname,
+ const char *__msgid, int __category));
+extern char *__ngettext PARAMS ((const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2,
+ unsigned long int __n));
+extern char *__dngettext PARAMS ((const char *__domainname,
+ const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2,
+ unsigned long int n));
+extern char *__dcngettext PARAMS ((const char *__domainname,
+ const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2,
+ unsigned long int __n, int __category));
+extern char *__dcigettext PARAMS ((const char *__domainname,
+ const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2,
+ int __plural, unsigned long int __n,
+ int __category));
+extern char *__textdomain PARAMS ((const char *__domainname));
+extern char *__bindtextdomain PARAMS ((const char *__domainname,
+ const char *__dirname));
+extern char *__bind_textdomain_codeset PARAMS ((const char *__domainname,
+ const char *__codeset));
+#else
+/* Declare the exported libintl_* functions, in a way that allows us to
+ call them under their real name. */
+# define _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS
+# include "libgnuintl.h"
+extern char *libintl_dcigettext PARAMS ((const char *__domainname,
+ const char *__msgid1,
+ const char *__msgid2,
+ int __plural, unsigned long int __n,
+ int __category));
+#endif
+
+/* @@ begin of epilog @@ */
+
+#endif /* gettextP.h */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/gmo.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/gmo.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d1fe4d6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/gmo.h
@@ -0,0 +1,148 @@
+/* Description of GNU message catalog format: general file layout.
+ Copyright (C) 1995, 1997, 2000-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+#ifndef _GETTEXT_H
+#define _GETTEXT_H 1
+
+#include <limits.h>
+
+/* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+
+/* The magic number of the GNU message catalog format. */
+#define _MAGIC 0x950412de
+#define _MAGIC_SWAPPED 0xde120495
+
+/* Revision number of the currently used .mo (binary) file format. */
+#define MO_REVISION_NUMBER 0
+
+/* The following contortions are an attempt to use the C preprocessor
+ to determine an unsigned integral type that is 32 bits wide. An
+ alternative approach is to use autoconf's AC_CHECK_SIZEOF macro, but
+ as of version autoconf-2.13, the AC_CHECK_SIZEOF macro doesn't work
+ when cross-compiling. */
+
+#if __STDC__
+# define UINT_MAX_32_BITS 4294967295U
+#else
+# define UINT_MAX_32_BITS 0xFFFFFFFF
+#endif
+
+/* If UINT_MAX isn't defined, assume it's a 32-bit type.
+ This should be valid for all systems GNU cares about because
+ that doesn't include 16-bit systems, and only modern systems
+ (that certainly have <limits.h>) have 64+-bit integral types. */
+
+#ifndef UINT_MAX
+# define UINT_MAX UINT_MAX_32_BITS
+#endif
+
+#if UINT_MAX == UINT_MAX_32_BITS
+typedef unsigned nls_uint32;
+#else
+# if USHRT_MAX == UINT_MAX_32_BITS
+typedef unsigned short nls_uint32;
+# else
+# if ULONG_MAX == UINT_MAX_32_BITS
+typedef unsigned long nls_uint32;
+# else
+ /* The following line is intended to throw an error. Using #error is
+ not portable enough. */
+ "Cannot determine unsigned 32-bit data type."
+# endif
+# endif
+#endif
+
+
+/* Header for binary .mo file format. */
+struct mo_file_header
+{
+ /* The magic number. */
+ nls_uint32 magic;
+ /* The revision number of the file format. */
+ nls_uint32 revision;
+
+ /* The following are only used in .mo files with major revision 0. */
+
+ /* The number of strings pairs. */
+ nls_uint32 nstrings;
+ /* Offset of table with start offsets of original strings. */
+ nls_uint32 orig_tab_offset;
+ /* Offset of table with start offsets of translated strings. */
+ nls_uint32 trans_tab_offset;
+ /* Size of hash table. */
+ nls_uint32 hash_tab_size;
+ /* Offset of first hash table entry. */
+ nls_uint32 hash_tab_offset;
+
+ /* The following are only used in .mo files with minor revision >= 1. */
+
+ /* The number of system dependent segments. */
+ nls_uint32 n_sysdep_segments;
+ /* Offset of table describing system dependent segments. */
+ nls_uint32 sysdep_segments_offset;
+ /* The number of system dependent strings pairs. */
+ nls_uint32 n_sysdep_strings;
+ /* Offset of table with start offsets of original sysdep strings. */
+ nls_uint32 orig_sysdep_tab_offset;
+ /* Offset of table with start offsets of translated sysdep strings. */
+ nls_uint32 trans_sysdep_tab_offset;
+};
+
+/* Descriptor for static string contained in the binary .mo file. */
+struct string_desc
+{
+ /* Length of addressed string, not including the trailing NUL. */
+ nls_uint32 length;
+ /* Offset of string in file. */
+ nls_uint32 offset;
+};
+
+/* The following are only used in .mo files with minor revision >= 1. */
+
+/* Descriptor for system dependent string segment. */
+struct sysdep_segment
+{
+ /* Length of addressed string, including the trailing NUL. */
+ nls_uint32 length;
+ /* Offset of string in file. */
+ nls_uint32 offset;
+};
+
+/* Descriptor for system dependent string. */
+struct sysdep_string
+{
+ /* Offset of static string segments in file. */
+ nls_uint32 offset;
+ /* Alternating sequence of static and system dependent segments.
+ The last segment is a static segment, including the trailing NUL. */
+ struct segment_pair
+ {
+ /* Size of static segment. */
+ nls_uint32 segsize;
+ /* Reference to system dependent string segment, or ~0 at the end. */
+ nls_uint32 sysdepref;
+ } segments[1];
+};
+
+/* Marker for the end of the segments[] array. This has the value 0xFFFFFFFF,
+ regardless whether 'int' is 16 bit, 32 bit, or 64 bit. */
+#define SEGMENTS_END ((nls_uint32) ~0)
+
+/* @@ begin of epilog @@ */
+
+#endif /* gettext.h */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/hash-string.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/hash-string.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b267a87
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/hash-string.h
@@ -0,0 +1,59 @@
+/* Description of GNU message catalog format: string hashing function.
+ Copyright (C) 1995, 1997, 1998, 2000, 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+/* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+
+#ifndef PARAMS
+# if __STDC__ || defined __GNUC__ || defined __SUNPRO_C || defined __cplusplus || __PROTOTYPES
+# define PARAMS(Args) Args
+# else
+# define PARAMS(Args) ()
+# endif
+#endif
+
+/* We assume to have `unsigned long int' value with at least 32 bits. */
+#define HASHWORDBITS 32
+
+
+/* Defines the so called `hashpjw' function by P.J. Weinberger
+ [see Aho/Sethi/Ullman, COMPILERS: Principles, Techniques and Tools,
+ 1986, 1987 Bell Telephone Laboratories, Inc.] */
+static unsigned long int hash_string PARAMS ((const char *__str_param));
+
+static inline unsigned long int
+hash_string (str_param)
+ const char *str_param;
+{
+ unsigned long int hval, g;
+ const char *str = str_param;
+
+ /* Compute the hash value for the given string. */
+ hval = 0;
+ while (*str != '\0')
+ {
+ hval <<= 4;
+ hval += (unsigned long int) *str++;
+ g = hval & ((unsigned long int) 0xf << (HASHWORDBITS - 4));
+ if (g != 0)
+ {
+ hval ^= g >> (HASHWORDBITS - 8);
+ hval ^= g;
+ }
+ }
+ return hval;
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/intl-compat.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/intl-compat.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..36b7af0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/intl-compat.c
@@ -0,0 +1,151 @@
+/* intl-compat.c - Stub functions to call gettext functions from GNU gettext
+ Library.
+ Copyright (C) 1995, 2000-2003 Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "gettextP.h"
+
+/* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+
+/* This file redirects the gettext functions (without prefix) to those
+ defined in the included GNU libintl library (with "libintl_" prefix).
+ It is compiled into libintl in order to make the AM_GNU_GETTEXT test
+ of gettext <= 0.11.2 work with the libintl library >= 0.11.3 which
+ has the redirections primarily in the <libintl.h> include file.
+ It is also compiled into libgnuintl so that libgnuintl.so can be used
+ as LD_PRELOADable library on glibc systems, to provide the extra
+ features that the functions in the libc don't have (namely, logging). */
+
+
+#undef gettext
+#undef dgettext
+#undef dcgettext
+#undef ngettext
+#undef dngettext
+#undef dcngettext
+#undef textdomain
+#undef bindtextdomain
+#undef bind_textdomain_codeset
+
+
+/* When building a DLL, we must export some functions. Note that because
+ the functions are only defined for binary backward compatibility, we
+ don't need to use __declspec(dllimport) in any case. */
+#if defined _MSC_VER && BUILDING_DLL
+# define DLL_EXPORTED __declspec(dllexport)
+#else
+# define DLL_EXPORTED
+#endif
+
+
+DLL_EXPORTED
+char *
+gettext (msgid)
+ const char *msgid;
+{
+ return libintl_gettext (msgid);
+}
+
+
+DLL_EXPORTED
+char *
+dgettext (domainname, msgid)
+ const char *domainname;
+ const char *msgid;
+{
+ return libintl_dgettext (domainname, msgid);
+}
+
+
+DLL_EXPORTED
+char *
+dcgettext (domainname, msgid, category)
+ const char *domainname;
+ const char *msgid;
+ int category;
+{
+ return libintl_dcgettext (domainname, msgid, category);
+}
+
+
+DLL_EXPORTED
+char *
+ngettext (msgid1, msgid2, n)
+ const char *msgid1;
+ const char *msgid2;
+ unsigned long int n;
+{
+ return libintl_ngettext (msgid1, msgid2, n);
+}
+
+
+DLL_EXPORTED
+char *
+dngettext (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, n)
+ const char *domainname;
+ const char *msgid1;
+ const char *msgid2;
+ unsigned long int n;
+{
+ return libintl_dngettext (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, n);
+}
+
+
+DLL_EXPORTED
+char *
+dcngettext (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, n, category)
+ const char *domainname;
+ const char *msgid1;
+ const char *msgid2;
+ unsigned long int n;
+ int category;
+{
+ return libintl_dcngettext (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, n, category);
+}
+
+
+DLL_EXPORTED
+char *
+textdomain (domainname)
+ const char *domainname;
+{
+ return libintl_textdomain (domainname);
+}
+
+
+DLL_EXPORTED
+char *
+bindtextdomain (domainname, dirname)
+ const char *domainname;
+ const char *dirname;
+{
+ return libintl_bindtextdomain (domainname, dirname);
+}
+
+
+DLL_EXPORTED
+char *
+bind_textdomain_codeset (domainname, codeset)
+ const char *domainname;
+ const char *codeset;
+{
+ return libintl_bind_textdomain_codeset (domainname, codeset);
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/l10nflist.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/l10nflist.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ec8713f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/l10nflist.c
@@ -0,0 +1,453 @@
+/* Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.ai.mit.edu>, 1995.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+/* Tell glibc's <string.h> to provide a prototype for stpcpy().
+ This must come before <config.h> because <config.h> may include
+ <features.h>, and once <features.h> has been included, it's too late. */
+#ifndef _GNU_SOURCE
+# define _GNU_SOURCE 1
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <string.h>
+
+#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_ARGZ_H
+# include <argz.h>
+#endif
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+
+#include "loadinfo.h"
+
+/* On some strange systems still no definition of NULL is found. Sigh! */
+#ifndef NULL
+# if defined __STDC__ && __STDC__
+# define NULL ((void *) 0)
+# else
+# define NULL 0
+# endif
+#endif
+
+/* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+/* Rename the non ANSI C functions. This is required by the standard
+ because some ANSI C functions will require linking with this object
+ file and the name space must not be polluted. */
+# ifndef stpcpy
+# define stpcpy(dest, src) __stpcpy(dest, src)
+# endif
+#else
+# ifndef HAVE_STPCPY
+static char *stpcpy PARAMS ((char *dest, const char *src));
+# endif
+#endif
+
+/* Pathname support.
+ ISSLASH(C) tests whether C is a directory separator character.
+ IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH(P) tests whether P is an absolute path. If it is not,
+ it may be concatenated to a directory pathname.
+ */
+#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ || defined __EMX__ || defined __DJGPP__
+ /* Win32, OS/2, DOS */
+# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == '/' || (C) == '\\')
+# define HAS_DEVICE(P) \
+ ((((P)[0] >= 'A' && (P)[0] <= 'Z') || ((P)[0] >= 'a' && (P)[0] <= 'z')) \
+ && (P)[1] == ':')
+# define IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH(P) (ISSLASH ((P)[0]) || HAS_DEVICE (P))
+#else
+ /* Unix */
+# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == '/')
+# define IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH(P) ISSLASH ((P)[0])
+#endif
+
+/* Define function which are usually not available. */
+
+#if !defined _LIBC && !defined HAVE___ARGZ_COUNT
+/* Returns the number of strings in ARGZ. */
+static size_t argz_count__ PARAMS ((const char *argz, size_t len));
+
+static size_t
+argz_count__ (argz, len)
+ const char *argz;
+ size_t len;
+{
+ size_t count = 0;
+ while (len > 0)
+ {
+ size_t part_len = strlen (argz);
+ argz += part_len + 1;
+ len -= part_len + 1;
+ count++;
+ }
+ return count;
+}
+# undef __argz_count
+# define __argz_count(argz, len) argz_count__ (argz, len)
+#else
+# ifdef _LIBC
+# define __argz_count(argz, len) INTUSE(__argz_count) (argz, len)
+# endif
+#endif /* !_LIBC && !HAVE___ARGZ_COUNT */
+
+#if !defined _LIBC && !defined HAVE___ARGZ_STRINGIFY
+/* Make '\0' separated arg vector ARGZ printable by converting all the '\0's
+ except the last into the character SEP. */
+static void argz_stringify__ PARAMS ((char *argz, size_t len, int sep));
+
+static void
+argz_stringify__ (argz, len, sep)
+ char *argz;
+ size_t len;
+ int sep;
+{
+ while (len > 0)
+ {
+ size_t part_len = strlen (argz);
+ argz += part_len;
+ len -= part_len + 1;
+ if (len > 0)
+ *argz++ = sep;
+ }
+}
+# undef __argz_stringify
+# define __argz_stringify(argz, len, sep) argz_stringify__ (argz, len, sep)
+#else
+# ifdef _LIBC
+# define __argz_stringify(argz, len, sep) \
+ INTUSE(__argz_stringify) (argz, len, sep)
+# endif
+#endif /* !_LIBC && !HAVE___ARGZ_STRINGIFY */
+
+#if !defined _LIBC && !defined HAVE___ARGZ_NEXT
+static char *argz_next__ PARAMS ((char *argz, size_t argz_len,
+ const char *entry));
+
+static char *
+argz_next__ (argz, argz_len, entry)
+ char *argz;
+ size_t argz_len;
+ const char *entry;
+{
+ if (entry)
+ {
+ if (entry < argz + argz_len)
+ entry = strchr (entry, '\0') + 1;
+
+ return entry >= argz + argz_len ? NULL : (char *) entry;
+ }
+ else
+ if (argz_len > 0)
+ return argz;
+ else
+ return 0;
+}
+# undef __argz_next
+# define __argz_next(argz, len, entry) argz_next__ (argz, len, entry)
+#endif /* !_LIBC && !HAVE___ARGZ_NEXT */
+
+
+/* Return number of bits set in X. */
+static int pop PARAMS ((int x));
+
+static inline int
+pop (x)
+ int x;
+{
+ /* We assume that no more than 16 bits are used. */
+ x = ((x & ~0x5555) >> 1) + (x & 0x5555);
+ x = ((x & ~0x3333) >> 2) + (x & 0x3333);
+ x = ((x >> 4) + x) & 0x0f0f;
+ x = ((x >> 8) + x) & 0xff;
+
+ return x;
+}
+
+
+struct loaded_l10nfile *
+_nl_make_l10nflist (l10nfile_list, dirlist, dirlist_len, mask, language,
+ territory, codeset, normalized_codeset, modifier, special,
+ sponsor, revision, filename, do_allocate)
+ struct loaded_l10nfile **l10nfile_list;
+ const char *dirlist;
+ size_t dirlist_len;
+ int mask;
+ const char *language;
+ const char *territory;
+ const char *codeset;
+ const char *normalized_codeset;
+ const char *modifier;
+ const char *special;
+ const char *sponsor;
+ const char *revision;
+ const char *filename;
+ int do_allocate;
+{
+ char *abs_filename;
+ struct loaded_l10nfile **lastp;
+ struct loaded_l10nfile *retval;
+ char *cp;
+ size_t dirlist_count;
+ size_t entries;
+ int cnt;
+
+ /* If LANGUAGE contains an absolute directory specification, we ignore
+ DIRLIST. */
+ if (IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (language))
+ dirlist_len = 0;
+
+ /* Allocate room for the full file name. */
+ abs_filename = (char *) malloc (dirlist_len
+ + strlen (language)
+ + ((mask & TERRITORY) != 0
+ ? strlen (territory) + 1 : 0)
+ + ((mask & XPG_CODESET) != 0
+ ? strlen (codeset) + 1 : 0)
+ + ((mask & XPG_NORM_CODESET) != 0
+ ? strlen (normalized_codeset) + 1 : 0)
+ + (((mask & XPG_MODIFIER) != 0
+ || (mask & CEN_AUDIENCE) != 0)
+ ? strlen (modifier) + 1 : 0)
+ + ((mask & CEN_SPECIAL) != 0
+ ? strlen (special) + 1 : 0)
+ + (((mask & CEN_SPONSOR) != 0
+ || (mask & CEN_REVISION) != 0)
+ ? (1 + ((mask & CEN_SPONSOR) != 0
+ ? strlen (sponsor) : 0)
+ + ((mask & CEN_REVISION) != 0
+ ? strlen (revision) + 1 : 0)) : 0)
+ + 1 + strlen (filename) + 1);
+
+ if (abs_filename == NULL)
+ return NULL;
+
+ /* Construct file name. */
+ cp = abs_filename;
+ if (dirlist_len > 0)
+ {
+ memcpy (cp, dirlist, dirlist_len);
+ __argz_stringify (cp, dirlist_len, PATH_SEPARATOR);
+ cp += dirlist_len;
+ cp[-1] = '/';
+ }
+
+ cp = stpcpy (cp, language);
+
+ if ((mask & TERRITORY) != 0)
+ {
+ *cp++ = '_';
+ cp = stpcpy (cp, territory);
+ }
+ if ((mask & XPG_CODESET) != 0)
+ {
+ *cp++ = '.';
+ cp = stpcpy (cp, codeset);
+ }
+ if ((mask & XPG_NORM_CODESET) != 0)
+ {
+ *cp++ = '.';
+ cp = stpcpy (cp, normalized_codeset);
+ }
+ if ((mask & (XPG_MODIFIER | CEN_AUDIENCE)) != 0)
+ {
+ /* This component can be part of both syntaces but has different
+ leading characters. For CEN we use `+', else `@'. */
+ *cp++ = (mask & CEN_AUDIENCE) != 0 ? '+' : '@';
+ cp = stpcpy (cp, modifier);
+ }
+ if ((mask & CEN_SPECIAL) != 0)
+ {
+ *cp++ = '+';
+ cp = stpcpy (cp, special);
+ }
+ if ((mask & (CEN_SPONSOR | CEN_REVISION)) != 0)
+ {
+ *cp++ = ',';
+ if ((mask & CEN_SPONSOR) != 0)
+ cp = stpcpy (cp, sponsor);
+ if ((mask & CEN_REVISION) != 0)
+ {
+ *cp++ = '_';
+ cp = stpcpy (cp, revision);
+ }
+ }
+
+ *cp++ = '/';
+ stpcpy (cp, filename);
+
+ /* Look in list of already loaded domains whether it is already
+ available. */
+ lastp = l10nfile_list;
+ for (retval = *l10nfile_list; retval != NULL; retval = retval->next)
+ if (retval->filename != NULL)
+ {
+ int compare = strcmp (retval->filename, abs_filename);
+ if (compare == 0)
+ /* We found it! */
+ break;
+ if (compare < 0)
+ {
+ /* It's not in the list. */
+ retval = NULL;
+ break;
+ }
+
+ lastp = &retval->next;
+ }
+
+ if (retval != NULL || do_allocate == 0)
+ {
+ free (abs_filename);
+ return retval;
+ }
+
+ dirlist_count = (dirlist_len > 0 ? __argz_count (dirlist, dirlist_len) : 1);
+
+ /* Allocate a new loaded_l10nfile. */
+ retval =
+ (struct loaded_l10nfile *)
+ malloc (sizeof (*retval)
+ + (((dirlist_count << pop (mask)) + (dirlist_count > 1 ? 1 : 0))
+ * sizeof (struct loaded_l10nfile *)));
+ if (retval == NULL)
+ return NULL;
+
+ retval->filename = abs_filename;
+
+ /* We set retval->data to NULL here; it is filled in later.
+ Setting retval->decided to 1 here means that retval does not
+ correspond to a real file (dirlist_count > 1) or is not worth
+ looking up (if an unnormalized codeset was specified). */
+ retval->decided = (dirlist_count > 1
+ || ((mask & XPG_CODESET) != 0
+ && (mask & XPG_NORM_CODESET) != 0));
+ retval->data = NULL;
+
+ retval->next = *lastp;
+ *lastp = retval;
+
+ entries = 0;
+ /* Recurse to fill the inheritance list of RETVAL.
+ If the DIRLIST is a real list (i.e. DIRLIST_COUNT > 1), the RETVAL
+ entry does not correspond to a real file; retval->filename contains
+ colons. In this case we loop across all elements of DIRLIST and
+ across all bit patterns dominated by MASK.
+ If the DIRLIST is a single directory or entirely redundant (i.e.
+ DIRLIST_COUNT == 1), we loop across all bit patterns dominated by
+ MASK, excluding MASK itself.
+ In either case, we loop down from MASK to 0. This has the effect
+ that the extra bits in the locale name are dropped in this order:
+ first the modifier, then the territory, then the codeset, then the
+ normalized_codeset. */
+ for (cnt = dirlist_count > 1 ? mask : mask - 1; cnt >= 0; --cnt)
+ if ((cnt & ~mask) == 0
+ && ((cnt & CEN_SPECIFIC) == 0 || (cnt & XPG_SPECIFIC) == 0)
+ && ((cnt & XPG_CODESET) == 0 || (cnt & XPG_NORM_CODESET) == 0))
+ {
+ if (dirlist_count > 1)
+ {
+ /* Iterate over all elements of the DIRLIST. */
+ char *dir = NULL;
+
+ while ((dir = __argz_next ((char *) dirlist, dirlist_len, dir))
+ != NULL)
+ retval->successor[entries++]
+ = _nl_make_l10nflist (l10nfile_list, dir, strlen (dir) + 1,
+ cnt, language, territory, codeset,
+ normalized_codeset, modifier, special,
+ sponsor, revision, filename, 1);
+ }
+ else
+ retval->successor[entries++]
+ = _nl_make_l10nflist (l10nfile_list, dirlist, dirlist_len,
+ cnt, language, territory, codeset,
+ normalized_codeset, modifier, special,
+ sponsor, revision, filename, 1);
+ }
+ retval->successor[entries] = NULL;
+
+ return retval;
+}
+
+/* Normalize codeset name. There is no standard for the codeset
+ names. Normalization allows the user to use any of the common
+ names. The return value is dynamically allocated and has to be
+ freed by the caller. */
+const char *
+_nl_normalize_codeset (codeset, name_len)
+ const char *codeset;
+ size_t name_len;
+{
+ int len = 0;
+ int only_digit = 1;
+ char *retval;
+ char *wp;
+ size_t cnt;
+
+ for (cnt = 0; cnt < name_len; ++cnt)
+ if (isalnum ((unsigned char) codeset[cnt]))
+ {
+ ++len;
+
+ if (isalpha ((unsigned char) codeset[cnt]))
+ only_digit = 0;
+ }
+
+ retval = (char *) malloc ((only_digit ? 3 : 0) + len + 1);
+
+ if (retval != NULL)
+ {
+ if (only_digit)
+ wp = stpcpy (retval, "iso");
+ else
+ wp = retval;
+
+ for (cnt = 0; cnt < name_len; ++cnt)
+ if (isalpha ((unsigned char) codeset[cnt]))
+ *wp++ = tolower ((unsigned char) codeset[cnt]);
+ else if (isdigit ((unsigned char) codeset[cnt]))
+ *wp++ = codeset[cnt];
+
+ *wp = '\0';
+ }
+
+ return (const char *) retval;
+}
+
+
+/* @@ begin of epilog @@ */
+
+/* We don't want libintl.a to depend on any other library. So we
+ avoid the non-standard function stpcpy. In GNU C Library this
+ function is available, though. Also allow the symbol HAVE_STPCPY
+ to be defined. */
+#if !_LIBC && !HAVE_STPCPY
+static char *
+stpcpy (dest, src)
+ char *dest;
+ const char *src;
+{
+ while ((*dest++ = *src++) != '\0')
+ /* Do nothing. */ ;
+ return dest - 1;
+}
+#endif
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/libgnuintl.h.in b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/libgnuintl.h.in
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f596cfc
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/libgnuintl.h.in
@@ -0,0 +1,309 @@
+/* Message catalogs for internationalization.
+ Copyright (C) 1995-1997, 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+#ifndef _LIBINTL_H
+#define _LIBINTL_H 1
+
+#include <locale.h>
+
+/* The LC_MESSAGES locale category is the category used by the functions
+ gettext() and dgettext(). It is specified in POSIX, but not in ANSI C.
+ On systems that don't define it, use an arbitrary value instead.
+ On Solaris, <locale.h> defines __LOCALE_H (or _LOCALE_H in Solaris 2.5)
+ then includes <libintl.h> (i.e. this file!) and then only defines
+ LC_MESSAGES. To avoid a redefinition warning, don't define LC_MESSAGES
+ in this case. */
+#if !defined LC_MESSAGES && !(defined __LOCALE_H || (defined _LOCALE_H && defined __sun))
+# define LC_MESSAGES 1729
+#endif
+
+/* We define an additional symbol to signal that we use the GNU
+ implementation of gettext. */
+#define __USE_GNU_GETTEXT 1
+
+/* Provide information about the supported file formats. Returns the
+ maximum minor revision number supported for a given major revision. */
+#define __GNU_GETTEXT_SUPPORTED_REVISION(major) \
+ ((major) == 0 ? 1 : -1)
+
+/* Resolve a platform specific conflict on DJGPP. GNU gettext takes
+ precedence over _conio_gettext. */
+#ifdef __DJGPP__
+# undef gettext
+#endif
+
+/* Use _INTL_PARAMS, not PARAMS, in order to avoid clashes with identifiers
+ used by programs. Similarly, test __PROTOTYPES, not PROTOTYPES. */
+#ifndef _INTL_PARAMS
+# if __STDC__ || defined __GNUC__ || defined __SUNPRO_C || defined __cplusplus || __PROTOTYPES
+# define _INTL_PARAMS(args) args
+# else
+# define _INTL_PARAMS(args) ()
+# endif
+#endif
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+extern "C" {
+#endif
+
+
+/* We redirect the functions to those prefixed with "libintl_". This is
+ necessary, because some systems define gettext/textdomain/... in the C
+ library (namely, Solaris 2.4 and newer, and GNU libc 2.0 and newer).
+ If we used the unprefixed names, there would be cases where the
+ definition in the C library would override the one in the libintl.so
+ shared library. Recall that on ELF systems, the symbols are looked
+ up in the following order:
+ 1. in the executable,
+ 2. in the shared libraries specified on the link command line, in order,
+ 3. in the dependencies of the shared libraries specified on the link
+ command line,
+ 4. in the dlopen()ed shared libraries, in the order in which they were
+ dlopen()ed.
+ The definition in the C library would override the one in libintl.so if
+ either
+ * -lc is given on the link command line and -lintl isn't, or
+ * -lc is given on the link command line before -lintl, or
+ * libintl.so is a dependency of a dlopen()ed shared library but not
+ linked to the executable at link time.
+ Since Solaris gettext() behaves differently than GNU gettext(), this
+ would be unacceptable.
+
+ The redirection happens by default through macros in C, so that &gettext
+ is independent of the compilation unit, but through inline functions in
+ C++, in order not to interfere with the name mangling of class fields or
+ class methods called 'gettext'. */
+
+/* The user can define _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE or _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS.
+ If he doesn't, we choose the method. A third possible method is
+ _INTL_REDIRECT_ASM, supported only by GCC. */
+#if !(defined _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE || defined _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS)
+# if __GNUC__ >= 2 && !defined __APPLE_CC__ && (defined __STDC__ || defined __cplusplus)
+# define _INTL_REDIRECT_ASM
+# else
+# ifdef __cplusplus
+# define _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE
+# else
+# define _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS
+# endif
+# endif
+#endif
+/* Auxiliary macros. */
+#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_ASM
+# define _INTL_ASM(cname) __asm__ (_INTL_ASMNAME (__USER_LABEL_PREFIX__, #cname))
+# define _INTL_ASMNAME(prefix,cnamestring) _INTL_STRINGIFY (prefix) cnamestring
+# define _INTL_STRINGIFY(prefix) #prefix
+#else
+# define _INTL_ASM(cname)
+#endif
+
+/* Look up MSGID in the current default message catalog for the current
+ LC_MESSAGES locale. If not found, returns MSGID itself (the default
+ text). */
+#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE
+extern char *libintl_gettext (const char *__msgid);
+static inline char *gettext (const char *__msgid)
+{
+ return libintl_gettext (__msgid);
+}
+#else
+#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS
+# define gettext libintl_gettext
+#endif
+extern char *gettext _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *__msgid))
+ _INTL_ASM (libintl_gettext);
+#endif
+
+/* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog for the current
+ LC_MESSAGES locale. */
+#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE
+extern char *libintl_dgettext (const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid);
+static inline char *dgettext (const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid)
+{
+ return libintl_dgettext (__domainname, __msgid);
+}
+#else
+#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS
+# define dgettext libintl_dgettext
+#endif
+extern char *dgettext _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *__domainname,
+ const char *__msgid))
+ _INTL_ASM (libintl_dgettext);
+#endif
+
+/* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog for the current CATEGORY
+ locale. */
+#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE
+extern char *libintl_dcgettext (const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid,
+ int __category);
+static inline char *dcgettext (const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid,
+ int __category)
+{
+ return libintl_dcgettext (__domainname, __msgid, __category);
+}
+#else
+#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS
+# define dcgettext libintl_dcgettext
+#endif
+extern char *dcgettext _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *__domainname,
+ const char *__msgid,
+ int __category))
+ _INTL_ASM (libintl_dcgettext);
+#endif
+
+
+/* Similar to `gettext' but select the plural form corresponding to the
+ number N. */
+#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE
+extern char *libintl_ngettext (const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2,
+ unsigned long int __n);
+static inline char *ngettext (const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2,
+ unsigned long int __n)
+{
+ return libintl_ngettext (__msgid1, __msgid2, __n);
+}
+#else
+#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS
+# define ngettext libintl_ngettext
+#endif
+extern char *ngettext _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *__msgid1,
+ const char *__msgid2,
+ unsigned long int __n))
+ _INTL_ASM (libintl_ngettext);
+#endif
+
+/* Similar to `dgettext' but select the plural form corresponding to the
+ number N. */
+#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE
+extern char *libintl_dngettext (const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid1,
+ const char *__msgid2, unsigned long int __n);
+static inline char *dngettext (const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid1,
+ const char *__msgid2, unsigned long int __n)
+{
+ return libintl_dngettext (__domainname, __msgid1, __msgid2, __n);
+}
+#else
+#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS
+# define dngettext libintl_dngettext
+#endif
+extern char *dngettext _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *__domainname,
+ const char *__msgid1,
+ const char *__msgid2,
+ unsigned long int __n))
+ _INTL_ASM (libintl_dngettext);
+#endif
+
+/* Similar to `dcgettext' but select the plural form corresponding to the
+ number N. */
+#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE
+extern char *libintl_dcngettext (const char *__domainname,
+ const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2,
+ unsigned long int __n, int __category);
+static inline char *dcngettext (const char *__domainname,
+ const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2,
+ unsigned long int __n, int __category)
+{
+ return libintl_dcngettext (__domainname, __msgid1, __msgid2, __n, __category);
+}
+#else
+#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS
+# define dcngettext libintl_dcngettext
+#endif
+extern char *dcngettext _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *__domainname,
+ const char *__msgid1,
+ const char *__msgid2,
+ unsigned long int __n,
+ int __category))
+ _INTL_ASM (libintl_dcngettext);
+#endif
+
+
+/* Set the current default message catalog to DOMAINNAME.
+ If DOMAINNAME is null, return the current default.
+ If DOMAINNAME is "", reset to the default of "messages". */
+#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE
+extern char *libintl_textdomain (const char *__domainname);
+static inline char *textdomain (const char *__domainname)
+{
+ return libintl_textdomain (__domainname);
+}
+#else
+#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS
+# define textdomain libintl_textdomain
+#endif
+extern char *textdomain _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *__domainname))
+ _INTL_ASM (libintl_textdomain);
+#endif
+
+/* Specify that the DOMAINNAME message catalog will be found
+ in DIRNAME rather than in the system locale data base. */
+#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE
+extern char *libintl_bindtextdomain (const char *__domainname,
+ const char *__dirname);
+static inline char *bindtextdomain (const char *__domainname,
+ const char *__dirname)
+{
+ return libintl_bindtextdomain (__domainname, __dirname);
+}
+#else
+#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS
+# define bindtextdomain libintl_bindtextdomain
+#endif
+extern char *bindtextdomain _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *__domainname,
+ const char *__dirname))
+ _INTL_ASM (libintl_bindtextdomain);
+#endif
+
+/* Specify the character encoding in which the messages from the
+ DOMAINNAME message catalog will be returned. */
+#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE
+extern char *libintl_bind_textdomain_codeset (const char *__domainname,
+ const char *__codeset);
+static inline char *bind_textdomain_codeset (const char *__domainname,
+ const char *__codeset)
+{
+ return libintl_bind_textdomain_codeset (__domainname, __codeset);
+}
+#else
+#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS
+# define bind_textdomain_codeset libintl_bind_textdomain_codeset
+#endif
+extern char *bind_textdomain_codeset _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *__domainname,
+ const char *__codeset))
+ _INTL_ASM (libintl_bind_textdomain_codeset);
+#endif
+
+
+/* Support for relocatable packages. */
+
+/* Sets the original and the current installation prefix of the package.
+ Relocation simply replaces a pathname starting with the original prefix
+ by the corresponding pathname with the current prefix instead. Both
+ prefixes should be directory names without trailing slash (i.e. use ""
+ instead of "/"). */
+#define libintl_set_relocation_prefix libintl_set_relocation_prefix
+extern void
+ libintl_set_relocation_prefix _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *orig_prefix,
+ const char *curr_prefix));
+
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+}
+#endif
+
+#endif /* libintl.h */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/loadinfo.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/loadinfo.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1d3ba61
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/loadinfo.h
@@ -0,0 +1,156 @@
+/* Copyright (C) 1996-1999, 2000-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ This file is part of the GNU C Library.
+ Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1996.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+#ifndef _LOADINFO_H
+#define _LOADINFO_H 1
+
+/* Declarations of locale dependent catalog lookup functions.
+ Implemented in
+
+ localealias.c Possibly replace a locale name by another.
+ explodename.c Split a locale name into its various fields.
+ l10nflist.c Generate a list of filenames of possible message catalogs.
+ finddomain.c Find and open the relevant message catalogs.
+
+ The main function _nl_find_domain() in finddomain.c is declared
+ in gettextP.h.
+ */
+
+#ifndef PARAMS
+# if __STDC__ || defined __GNUC__ || defined __SUNPRO_C || defined __cplusplus || __PROTOTYPES
+# define PARAMS(args) args
+# else
+# define PARAMS(args) ()
+# endif
+#endif
+
+#ifndef internal_function
+# define internal_function
+#endif
+
+/* Tell the compiler when a conditional or integer expression is
+ almost always true or almost always false. */
+#ifndef HAVE_BUILTIN_EXPECT
+# define __builtin_expect(expr, val) (expr)
+#endif
+
+/* Separator in PATH like lists of pathnames. */
+#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ || defined __EMX__ || defined __DJGPP__
+ /* Win32, OS/2, DOS */
+# define PATH_SEPARATOR ';'
+#else
+ /* Unix */
+# define PATH_SEPARATOR ':'
+#endif
+
+/* Encoding of locale name parts. */
+#define CEN_REVISION 1
+#define CEN_SPONSOR 2
+#define CEN_SPECIAL 4
+#define XPG_NORM_CODESET 8
+#define XPG_CODESET 16
+#define TERRITORY 32
+#define CEN_AUDIENCE 64
+#define XPG_MODIFIER 128
+
+#define CEN_SPECIFIC (CEN_REVISION|CEN_SPONSOR|CEN_SPECIAL|CEN_AUDIENCE)
+#define XPG_SPECIFIC (XPG_CODESET|XPG_NORM_CODESET|XPG_MODIFIER)
+
+
+struct loaded_l10nfile
+{
+ const char *filename;
+ int decided;
+
+ const void *data;
+
+ struct loaded_l10nfile *next;
+ struct loaded_l10nfile *successor[1];
+};
+
+
+/* Normalize codeset name. There is no standard for the codeset
+ names. Normalization allows the user to use any of the common
+ names. The return value is dynamically allocated and has to be
+ freed by the caller. */
+extern const char *_nl_normalize_codeset PARAMS ((const char *codeset,
+ size_t name_len));
+
+/* Lookup a locale dependent file.
+ *L10NFILE_LIST denotes a pool of lookup results of locale dependent
+ files of the same kind, sorted in decreasing order of ->filename.
+ DIRLIST and DIRLIST_LEN are an argz list of directories in which to
+ look, containing at least one directory (i.e. DIRLIST_LEN > 0).
+ MASK, LANGUAGE, TERRITORY, CODESET, NORMALIZED_CODESET, MODIFIER,
+ SPECIAL, SPONSOR, REVISION are the pieces of the locale name, as
+ produced by _nl_explode_name(). FILENAME is the filename suffix.
+ The return value is the lookup result, either found in *L10NFILE_LIST,
+ or - if DO_ALLOCATE is nonzero - freshly allocated, or possibly NULL.
+ If the return value is non-NULL, it is added to *L10NFILE_LIST, and
+ its ->next field denotes the chaining inside *L10NFILE_LIST, and
+ furthermore its ->successor[] field contains a list of other lookup
+ results from which this lookup result inherits. */
+extern struct loaded_l10nfile *
+_nl_make_l10nflist PARAMS ((struct loaded_l10nfile **l10nfile_list,
+ const char *dirlist, size_t dirlist_len, int mask,
+ const char *language, const char *territory,
+ const char *codeset,
+ const char *normalized_codeset,
+ const char *modifier, const char *special,
+ const char *sponsor, const char *revision,
+ const char *filename, int do_allocate));
+
+/* Lookup the real locale name for a locale alias NAME, or NULL if
+ NAME is not a locale alias (but possibly a real locale name).
+ The return value is statically allocated and must not be freed. */
+extern const char *_nl_expand_alias PARAMS ((const char *name));
+
+/* Split a locale name NAME into its pieces: language, modifier,
+ territory, codeset, special, sponsor, revision.
+ NAME gets destructively modified: NUL bytes are inserted here and
+ there. *LANGUAGE gets assigned NAME. Each of *MODIFIER, *TERRITORY,
+ *CODESET, *SPECIAL, *SPONSOR, *REVISION gets assigned either a
+ pointer into the old NAME string, or NULL. *NORMALIZED_CODESET
+ gets assigned the expanded *CODESET, if it is different from *CODESET;
+ this one is dynamically allocated and has to be freed by the caller.
+ The return value is a bitmask, where each bit corresponds to one
+ filled-in value:
+ XPG_MODIFIER, CEN_AUDIENCE for *MODIFIER,
+ TERRITORY for *TERRITORY,
+ XPG_CODESET for *CODESET,
+ XPG_NORM_CODESET for *NORMALIZED_CODESET,
+ CEN_SPECIAL for *SPECIAL,
+ CEN_SPONSOR for *SPONSOR,
+ CEN_REVISION for *REVISION.
+ */
+extern int _nl_explode_name PARAMS ((char *name, const char **language,
+ const char **modifier,
+ const char **territory,
+ const char **codeset,
+ const char **normalized_codeset,
+ const char **special,
+ const char **sponsor,
+ const char **revision));
+
+/* Split a locale name NAME into a leading language part and all the
+ rest. Return a pointer to the first character after the language,
+ i.e. to the first byte of the rest. */
+extern char *_nl_find_language PARAMS ((const char *name));
+
+#endif /* loadinfo.h */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/loadmsgcat.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/loadmsgcat.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..8509bd3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/loadmsgcat.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1322 @@
+/* Load needed message catalogs.
+ Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+/* Tell glibc's <string.h> to provide a prototype for mempcpy().
+ This must come before <config.h> because <config.h> may include
+ <features.h>, and once <features.h> has been included, it's too late. */
+#ifndef _GNU_SOURCE
+# define _GNU_SOURCE 1
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+
+#ifdef __GNUC__
+# undef alloca
+# define alloca __builtin_alloca
+# define HAVE_ALLOCA 1
+#else
+# ifdef _MSC_VER
+# include <malloc.h>
+# define alloca _alloca
+# else
+# if defined HAVE_ALLOCA_H || defined _LIBC
+# include <alloca.h>
+# else
+# ifdef _AIX
+ #pragma alloca
+# else
+# ifndef alloca
+char *alloca ();
+# endif
+# endif
+# endif
+# endif
+#endif
+
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+#if defined HAVE_UNISTD_H || defined _LIBC
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# include <langinfo.h>
+# include <locale.h>
+#endif
+
+#if (defined HAVE_MMAP && defined HAVE_MUNMAP && !defined DISALLOW_MMAP) \
+ || (defined _LIBC && defined _POSIX_MAPPED_FILES)
+# include <sys/mman.h>
+# undef HAVE_MMAP
+# define HAVE_MMAP 1
+#else
+# undef HAVE_MMAP
+#endif
+
+#if defined HAVE_STDINT_H_WITH_UINTMAX || defined _LIBC
+# include <stdint.h>
+#endif
+#if defined HAVE_INTTYPES_H || defined _LIBC
+# include <inttypes.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "gmo.h"
+#include "gettextP.h"
+#include "hash-string.h"
+#include "plural-exp.h"
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# include "../locale/localeinfo.h"
+#endif
+
+/* Provide fallback values for macros that ought to be defined in <inttypes.h>.
+ Note that our fallback values need not be literal strings, because we don't
+ use them with preprocessor string concatenation. */
+#if !defined PRId8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRId8
+# define PRId8 "d"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIi8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIi8
+# define PRIi8 "i"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIo8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIo8
+# define PRIo8 "o"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIu8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIu8
+# define PRIu8 "u"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIx8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIx8
+# define PRIx8 "x"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIX8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIX8
+# define PRIX8 "X"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRId16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRId16
+# define PRId16 "d"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIi16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIi16
+# define PRIi16 "i"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIo16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIo16
+# define PRIo16 "o"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIu16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIu16
+# define PRIu16 "u"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIx16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIx16
+# define PRIx16 "x"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIX16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIX16
+# define PRIX16 "X"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRId32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRId32
+# define PRId32 "d"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIi32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIi32
+# define PRIi32 "i"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIo32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIo32
+# define PRIo32 "o"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIu32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIu32
+# define PRIu32 "u"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIx32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIx32
+# define PRIx32 "x"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIX32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIX32
+# define PRIX32 "X"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRId64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRId64
+# define PRId64 (sizeof (long) == 8 ? "ld" : "lld")
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIi64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIi64
+# define PRIi64 (sizeof (long) == 8 ? "li" : "lli")
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIo64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIo64
+# define PRIo64 (sizeof (long) == 8 ? "lo" : "llo")
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIu64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIu64
+# define PRIu64 (sizeof (long) == 8 ? "lu" : "llu")
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIx64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIx64
+# define PRIx64 (sizeof (long) == 8 ? "lx" : "llx")
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIX64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIX64
+# define PRIX64 (sizeof (long) == 8 ? "lX" : "llX")
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIdLEAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIdLEAST8
+# define PRIdLEAST8 "d"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIiLEAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIiLEAST8
+# define PRIiLEAST8 "i"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIoLEAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIoLEAST8
+# define PRIoLEAST8 "o"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIuLEAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIuLEAST8
+# define PRIuLEAST8 "u"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIxLEAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIxLEAST8
+# define PRIxLEAST8 "x"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIXLEAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIXLEAST8
+# define PRIXLEAST8 "X"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIdLEAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIdLEAST16
+# define PRIdLEAST16 "d"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIiLEAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIiLEAST16
+# define PRIiLEAST16 "i"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIoLEAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIoLEAST16
+# define PRIoLEAST16 "o"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIuLEAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIuLEAST16
+# define PRIuLEAST16 "u"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIxLEAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIxLEAST16
+# define PRIxLEAST16 "x"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIXLEAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIXLEAST16
+# define PRIXLEAST16 "X"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIdLEAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIdLEAST32
+# define PRIdLEAST32 "d"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIiLEAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIiLEAST32
+# define PRIiLEAST32 "i"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIoLEAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIoLEAST32
+# define PRIoLEAST32 "o"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIuLEAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIuLEAST32
+# define PRIuLEAST32 "u"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIxLEAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIxLEAST32
+# define PRIxLEAST32 "x"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIXLEAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIXLEAST32
+# define PRIXLEAST32 "X"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIdLEAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIdLEAST64
+# define PRIdLEAST64 PRId64
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIiLEAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIiLEAST64
+# define PRIiLEAST64 PRIi64
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIoLEAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIoLEAST64
+# define PRIoLEAST64 PRIo64
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIuLEAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIuLEAST64
+# define PRIuLEAST64 PRIu64
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIxLEAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIxLEAST64
+# define PRIxLEAST64 PRIx64
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIXLEAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIXLEAST64
+# define PRIXLEAST64 PRIX64
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIdFAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIdFAST8
+# define PRIdFAST8 "d"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIiFAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIiFAST8
+# define PRIiFAST8 "i"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIoFAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIoFAST8
+# define PRIoFAST8 "o"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIuFAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIuFAST8
+# define PRIuFAST8 "u"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIxFAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIxFAST8
+# define PRIxFAST8 "x"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIXFAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIXFAST8
+# define PRIXFAST8 "X"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIdFAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIdFAST16
+# define PRIdFAST16 "d"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIiFAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIiFAST16
+# define PRIiFAST16 "i"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIoFAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIoFAST16
+# define PRIoFAST16 "o"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIuFAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIuFAST16
+# define PRIuFAST16 "u"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIxFAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIxFAST16
+# define PRIxFAST16 "x"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIXFAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIXFAST16
+# define PRIXFAST16 "X"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIdFAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIdFAST32
+# define PRIdFAST32 "d"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIiFAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIiFAST32
+# define PRIiFAST32 "i"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIoFAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIoFAST32
+# define PRIoFAST32 "o"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIuFAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIuFAST32
+# define PRIuFAST32 "u"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIxFAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIxFAST32
+# define PRIxFAST32 "x"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIXFAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIXFAST32
+# define PRIXFAST32 "X"
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIdFAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIdFAST64
+# define PRIdFAST64 PRId64
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIiFAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIiFAST64
+# define PRIiFAST64 PRIi64
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIoFAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIoFAST64
+# define PRIoFAST64 PRIo64
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIuFAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIuFAST64
+# define PRIuFAST64 PRIu64
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIxFAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIxFAST64
+# define PRIxFAST64 PRIx64
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIXFAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIXFAST64
+# define PRIXFAST64 PRIX64
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIdMAX || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIdMAX
+# define PRIdMAX (sizeof (uintmax_t) == sizeof (long) ? "ld" : "lld")
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIiMAX || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIiMAX
+# define PRIiMAX (sizeof (uintmax_t) == sizeof (long) ? "li" : "lli")
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIoMAX || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIoMAX
+# define PRIoMAX (sizeof (uintmax_t) == sizeof (long) ? "lo" : "llo")
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIuMAX || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIuMAX
+# define PRIuMAX (sizeof (uintmax_t) == sizeof (long) ? "lu" : "llu")
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIxMAX || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIxMAX
+# define PRIxMAX (sizeof (uintmax_t) == sizeof (long) ? "lx" : "llx")
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIXMAX || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIXMAX
+# define PRIXMAX (sizeof (uintmax_t) == sizeof (long) ? "lX" : "llX")
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIdPTR || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIdPTR
+# define PRIdPTR \
+ (sizeof (void *) == sizeof (long) ? "ld" : \
+ sizeof (void *) == sizeof (int) ? "d" : \
+ "lld")
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIiPTR || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIiPTR
+# define PRIiPTR \
+ (sizeof (void *) == sizeof (long) ? "li" : \
+ sizeof (void *) == sizeof (int) ? "i" : \
+ "lli")
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIoPTR || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIoPTR
+# define PRIoPTR \
+ (sizeof (void *) == sizeof (long) ? "lo" : \
+ sizeof (void *) == sizeof (int) ? "o" : \
+ "llo")
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIuPTR || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIuPTR
+# define PRIuPTR \
+ (sizeof (void *) == sizeof (long) ? "lu" : \
+ sizeof (void *) == sizeof (int) ? "u" : \
+ "llu")
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIxPTR || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIxPTR
+# define PRIxPTR \
+ (sizeof (void *) == sizeof (long) ? "lx" : \
+ sizeof (void *) == sizeof (int) ? "x" : \
+ "llx")
+#endif
+#if !defined PRIXPTR || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
+# undef PRIXPTR
+# define PRIXPTR \
+ (sizeof (void *) == sizeof (long) ? "lX" : \
+ sizeof (void *) == sizeof (int) ? "X" : \
+ "llX")
+#endif
+
+/* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+/* Rename the non ISO C functions. This is required by the standard
+ because some ISO C functions will require linking with this object
+ file and the name space must not be polluted. */
+# define open __open
+# define close __close
+# define read __read
+# define mmap __mmap
+# define munmap __munmap
+#endif
+
+/* For those losing systems which don't have `alloca' we have to add
+ some additional code emulating it. */
+#ifdef HAVE_ALLOCA
+# define freea(p) /* nothing */
+#else
+# define alloca(n) malloc (n)
+# define freea(p) free (p)
+#endif
+
+/* For systems that distinguish between text and binary I/O.
+ O_BINARY is usually declared in <fcntl.h>. */
+#if !defined O_BINARY && defined _O_BINARY
+ /* For MSC-compatible compilers. */
+# define O_BINARY _O_BINARY
+# define O_TEXT _O_TEXT
+#endif
+#ifdef __BEOS__
+ /* BeOS 5 has O_BINARY and O_TEXT, but they have no effect. */
+# undef O_BINARY
+# undef O_TEXT
+#endif
+/* On reasonable systems, binary I/O is the default. */
+#ifndef O_BINARY
+# define O_BINARY 0
+#endif
+
+
+/* Prototypes for local functions. Needed to ensure compiler checking of
+ function argument counts despite of K&R C function definition syntax. */
+static const char *get_sysdep_segment_value PARAMS ((const char *name));
+
+
+/* We need a sign, whether a new catalog was loaded, which can be associated
+ with all translations. This is important if the translations are
+ cached by one of GCC's features. */
+int _nl_msg_cat_cntr;
+
+
+/* Expand a system dependent string segment. Return NULL if unsupported. */
+static const char *
+get_sysdep_segment_value (name)
+ const char *name;
+{
+ /* Test for an ISO C 99 section 7.8.1 format string directive.
+ Syntax:
+ P R I { d | i | o | u | x | X }
+ { { | LEAST | FAST } { 8 | 16 | 32 | 64 } | MAX | PTR } */
+ /* We don't use a table of 14 times 6 'const char *' strings here, because
+ data relocations cost startup time. */
+ if (name[0] == 'P' && name[1] == 'R' && name[2] == 'I')
+ {
+ if (name[3] == 'd' || name[3] == 'i' || name[3] == 'o' || name[3] == 'u'
+ || name[3] == 'x' || name[3] == 'X')
+ {
+ if (name[4] == '8' && name[5] == '\0')
+ {
+ if (name[3] == 'd')
+ return PRId8;
+ if (name[3] == 'i')
+ return PRIi8;
+ if (name[3] == 'o')
+ return PRIo8;
+ if (name[3] == 'u')
+ return PRIu8;
+ if (name[3] == 'x')
+ return PRIx8;
+ if (name[3] == 'X')
+ return PRIX8;
+ abort ();
+ }
+ if (name[4] == '1' && name[5] == '6' && name[6] == '\0')
+ {
+ if (name[3] == 'd')
+ return PRId16;
+ if (name[3] == 'i')
+ return PRIi16;
+ if (name[3] == 'o')
+ return PRIo16;
+ if (name[3] == 'u')
+ return PRIu16;
+ if (name[3] == 'x')
+ return PRIx16;
+ if (name[3] == 'X')
+ return PRIX16;
+ abort ();
+ }
+ if (name[4] == '3' && name[5] == '2' && name[6] == '\0')
+ {
+ if (name[3] == 'd')
+ return PRId32;
+ if (name[3] == 'i')
+ return PRIi32;
+ if (name[3] == 'o')
+ return PRIo32;
+ if (name[3] == 'u')
+ return PRIu32;
+ if (name[3] == 'x')
+ return PRIx32;
+ if (name[3] == 'X')
+ return PRIX32;
+ abort ();
+ }
+ if (name[4] == '6' && name[5] == '4' && name[6] == '\0')
+ {
+ if (name[3] == 'd')
+ return PRId64;
+ if (name[3] == 'i')
+ return PRIi64;
+ if (name[3] == 'o')
+ return PRIo64;
+ if (name[3] == 'u')
+ return PRIu64;
+ if (name[3] == 'x')
+ return PRIx64;
+ if (name[3] == 'X')
+ return PRIX64;
+ abort ();
+ }
+ if (name[4] == 'L' && name[5] == 'E' && name[6] == 'A'
+ && name[7] == 'S' && name[8] == 'T')
+ {
+ if (name[9] == '8' && name[10] == '\0')
+ {
+ if (name[3] == 'd')
+ return PRIdLEAST8;
+ if (name[3] == 'i')
+ return PRIiLEAST8;
+ if (name[3] == 'o')
+ return PRIoLEAST8;
+ if (name[3] == 'u')
+ return PRIuLEAST8;
+ if (name[3] == 'x')
+ return PRIxLEAST8;
+ if (name[3] == 'X')
+ return PRIXLEAST8;
+ abort ();
+ }
+ if (name[9] == '1' && name[10] == '6' && name[11] == '\0')
+ {
+ if (name[3] == 'd')
+ return PRIdLEAST16;
+ if (name[3] == 'i')
+ return PRIiLEAST16;
+ if (name[3] == 'o')
+ return PRIoLEAST16;
+ if (name[3] == 'u')
+ return PRIuLEAST16;
+ if (name[3] == 'x')
+ return PRIxLEAST16;
+ if (name[3] == 'X')
+ return PRIXLEAST16;
+ abort ();
+ }
+ if (name[9] == '3' && name[10] == '2' && name[11] == '\0')
+ {
+ if (name[3] == 'd')
+ return PRIdLEAST32;
+ if (name[3] == 'i')
+ return PRIiLEAST32;
+ if (name[3] == 'o')
+ return PRIoLEAST32;
+ if (name[3] == 'u')
+ return PRIuLEAST32;
+ if (name[3] == 'x')
+ return PRIxLEAST32;
+ if (name[3] == 'X')
+ return PRIXLEAST32;
+ abort ();
+ }
+ if (name[9] == '6' && name[10] == '4' && name[11] == '\0')
+ {
+ if (name[3] == 'd')
+ return PRIdLEAST64;
+ if (name[3] == 'i')
+ return PRIiLEAST64;
+ if (name[3] == 'o')
+ return PRIoLEAST64;
+ if (name[3] == 'u')
+ return PRIuLEAST64;
+ if (name[3] == 'x')
+ return PRIxLEAST64;
+ if (name[3] == 'X')
+ return PRIXLEAST64;
+ abort ();
+ }
+ }
+ if (name[4] == 'F' && name[5] == 'A' && name[6] == 'S'
+ && name[7] == 'T')
+ {
+ if (name[8] == '8' && name[9] == '\0')
+ {
+ if (name[3] == 'd')
+ return PRIdFAST8;
+ if (name[3] == 'i')
+ return PRIiFAST8;
+ if (name[3] == 'o')
+ return PRIoFAST8;
+ if (name[3] == 'u')
+ return PRIuFAST8;
+ if (name[3] == 'x')
+ return PRIxFAST8;
+ if (name[3] == 'X')
+ return PRIXFAST8;
+ abort ();
+ }
+ if (name[8] == '1' && name[9] == '6' && name[10] == '\0')
+ {
+ if (name[3] == 'd')
+ return PRIdFAST16;
+ if (name[3] == 'i')
+ return PRIiFAST16;
+ if (name[3] == 'o')
+ return PRIoFAST16;
+ if (name[3] == 'u')
+ return PRIuFAST16;
+ if (name[3] == 'x')
+ return PRIxFAST16;
+ if (name[3] == 'X')
+ return PRIXFAST16;
+ abort ();
+ }
+ if (name[8] == '3' && name[9] == '2' && name[10] == '\0')
+ {
+ if (name[3] == 'd')
+ return PRIdFAST32;
+ if (name[3] == 'i')
+ return PRIiFAST32;
+ if (name[3] == 'o')
+ return PRIoFAST32;
+ if (name[3] == 'u')
+ return PRIuFAST32;
+ if (name[3] == 'x')
+ return PRIxFAST32;
+ if (name[3] == 'X')
+ return PRIXFAST32;
+ abort ();
+ }
+ if (name[8] == '6' && name[9] == '4' && name[10] == '\0')
+ {
+ if (name[3] == 'd')
+ return PRIdFAST64;
+ if (name[3] == 'i')
+ return PRIiFAST64;
+ if (name[3] == 'o')
+ return PRIoFAST64;
+ if (name[3] == 'u')
+ return PRIuFAST64;
+ if (name[3] == 'x')
+ return PRIxFAST64;
+ if (name[3] == 'X')
+ return PRIXFAST64;
+ abort ();
+ }
+ }
+ if (name[4] == 'M' && name[5] == 'A' && name[6] == 'X'
+ && name[7] == '\0')
+ {
+ if (name[3] == 'd')
+ return PRIdMAX;
+ if (name[3] == 'i')
+ return PRIiMAX;
+ if (name[3] == 'o')
+ return PRIoMAX;
+ if (name[3] == 'u')
+ return PRIuMAX;
+ if (name[3] == 'x')
+ return PRIxMAX;
+ if (name[3] == 'X')
+ return PRIXMAX;
+ abort ();
+ }
+ if (name[4] == 'P' && name[5] == 'T' && name[6] == 'R'
+ && name[7] == '\0')
+ {
+ if (name[3] == 'd')
+ return PRIdPTR;
+ if (name[3] == 'i')
+ return PRIiPTR;
+ if (name[3] == 'o')
+ return PRIoPTR;
+ if (name[3] == 'u')
+ return PRIuPTR;
+ if (name[3] == 'x')
+ return PRIxPTR;
+ if (name[3] == 'X')
+ return PRIXPTR;
+ abort ();
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ /* Other system dependent strings are not valid. */
+ return NULL;
+}
+
+/* Initialize the codeset dependent parts of an opened message catalog.
+ Return the header entry. */
+const char *
+internal_function
+_nl_init_domain_conv (domain_file, domain, domainbinding)
+ struct loaded_l10nfile *domain_file;
+ struct loaded_domain *domain;
+ struct binding *domainbinding;
+{
+ /* Find out about the character set the file is encoded with.
+ This can be found (in textual form) in the entry "". If this
+ entry does not exist or if this does not contain the `charset='
+ information, we will assume the charset matches the one the
+ current locale and we don't have to perform any conversion. */
+ char *nullentry;
+ size_t nullentrylen;
+
+ /* Preinitialize fields, to avoid recursion during _nl_find_msg. */
+ domain->codeset_cntr =
+ (domainbinding != NULL ? domainbinding->codeset_cntr : 0);
+#ifdef _LIBC
+ domain->conv = (__gconv_t) -1;
+#else
+# if HAVE_ICONV
+ domain->conv = (iconv_t) -1;
+# endif
+#endif
+ domain->conv_tab = NULL;
+
+ /* Get the header entry. */
+ nullentry = _nl_find_msg (domain_file, domainbinding, "", &nullentrylen);
+
+ if (nullentry != NULL)
+ {
+#if defined _LIBC || HAVE_ICONV
+ const char *charsetstr;
+
+ charsetstr = strstr (nullentry, "charset=");
+ if (charsetstr != NULL)
+ {
+ size_t len;
+ char *charset;
+ const char *outcharset;
+
+ charsetstr += strlen ("charset=");
+ len = strcspn (charsetstr, " \t\n");
+
+ charset = (char *) alloca (len + 1);
+# if defined _LIBC || HAVE_MEMPCPY
+ *((char *) mempcpy (charset, charsetstr, len)) = '\0';
+# else
+ memcpy (charset, charsetstr, len);
+ charset[len] = '\0';
+# endif
+
+ /* The output charset should normally be determined by the
+ locale. But sometimes the locale is not used or not correctly
+ set up, so we provide a possibility for the user to override
+ this. Moreover, the value specified through
+ bind_textdomain_codeset overrides both. */
+ if (domainbinding != NULL && domainbinding->codeset != NULL)
+ outcharset = domainbinding->codeset;
+ else
+ {
+ outcharset = getenv ("OUTPUT_CHARSET");
+ if (outcharset == NULL || outcharset[0] == '\0')
+ {
+# ifdef _LIBC
+ outcharset = _NL_CURRENT (LC_CTYPE, CODESET);
+# else
+# if HAVE_ICONV
+ extern const char *locale_charset PARAMS ((void));
+ outcharset = locale_charset ();
+# endif
+# endif
+ }
+ }
+
+# ifdef _LIBC
+ /* We always want to use transliteration. */
+ outcharset = norm_add_slashes (outcharset, "TRANSLIT");
+ charset = norm_add_slashes (charset, NULL);
+ if (__gconv_open (outcharset, charset, &domain->conv,
+ GCONV_AVOID_NOCONV)
+ != __GCONV_OK)
+ domain->conv = (__gconv_t) -1;
+# else
+# if HAVE_ICONV
+ /* When using GNU libc >= 2.2 or GNU libiconv >= 1.5,
+ we want to use transliteration. */
+# if (__GLIBC__ == 2 && __GLIBC_MINOR__ >= 2) || __GLIBC__ > 2 \
+ || _LIBICONV_VERSION >= 0x0105
+ if (strchr (outcharset, '/') == NULL)
+ {
+ char *tmp;
+
+ len = strlen (outcharset);
+ tmp = (char *) alloca (len + 10 + 1);
+ memcpy (tmp, outcharset, len);
+ memcpy (tmp + len, "//TRANSLIT", 10 + 1);
+ outcharset = tmp;
+
+ domain->conv = iconv_open (outcharset, charset);
+
+ freea (outcharset);
+ }
+ else
+# endif
+ domain->conv = iconv_open (outcharset, charset);
+# endif
+# endif
+
+ freea (charset);
+ }
+#endif /* _LIBC || HAVE_ICONV */
+ }
+
+ return nullentry;
+}
+
+/* Frees the codeset dependent parts of an opened message catalog. */
+void
+internal_function
+_nl_free_domain_conv (domain)
+ struct loaded_domain *domain;
+{
+ if (domain->conv_tab != NULL && domain->conv_tab != (char **) -1)
+ free (domain->conv_tab);
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+ if (domain->conv != (__gconv_t) -1)
+ __gconv_close (domain->conv);
+#else
+# if HAVE_ICONV
+ if (domain->conv != (iconv_t) -1)
+ iconv_close (domain->conv);
+# endif
+#endif
+}
+
+/* Load the message catalogs specified by FILENAME. If it is no valid
+ message catalog do nothing. */
+void
+internal_function
+_nl_load_domain (domain_file, domainbinding)
+ struct loaded_l10nfile *domain_file;
+ struct binding *domainbinding;
+{
+ int fd;
+ size_t size;
+#ifdef _LIBC
+ struct stat64 st;
+#else
+ struct stat st;
+#endif
+ struct mo_file_header *data = (struct mo_file_header *) -1;
+ int use_mmap = 0;
+ struct loaded_domain *domain;
+ int revision;
+ const char *nullentry;
+
+ domain_file->decided = 1;
+ domain_file->data = NULL;
+
+ /* Note that it would be useless to store domainbinding in domain_file
+ because domainbinding might be == NULL now but != NULL later (after
+ a call to bind_textdomain_codeset). */
+
+ /* If the record does not represent a valid locale the FILENAME
+ might be NULL. This can happen when according to the given
+ specification the locale file name is different for XPG and CEN
+ syntax. */
+ if (domain_file->filename == NULL)
+ return;
+
+ /* Try to open the addressed file. */
+ fd = open (domain_file->filename, O_RDONLY | O_BINARY);
+ if (fd == -1)
+ return;
+
+ /* We must know about the size of the file. */
+ if (
+#ifdef _LIBC
+ __builtin_expect (fstat64 (fd, &st) != 0, 0)
+#else
+ __builtin_expect (fstat (fd, &st) != 0, 0)
+#endif
+ || __builtin_expect ((size = (size_t) st.st_size) != st.st_size, 0)
+ || __builtin_expect (size < sizeof (struct mo_file_header), 0))
+ {
+ /* Something went wrong. */
+ close (fd);
+ return;
+ }
+
+#ifdef HAVE_MMAP
+ /* Now we are ready to load the file. If mmap() is available we try
+ this first. If not available or it failed we try to load it. */
+ data = (struct mo_file_header *) mmap (NULL, size, PROT_READ,
+ MAP_PRIVATE, fd, 0);
+
+ if (__builtin_expect (data != (struct mo_file_header *) -1, 1))
+ {
+ /* mmap() call was successful. */
+ close (fd);
+ use_mmap = 1;
+ }
+#endif
+
+ /* If the data is not yet available (i.e. mmap'ed) we try to load
+ it manually. */
+ if (data == (struct mo_file_header *) -1)
+ {
+ size_t to_read;
+ char *read_ptr;
+
+ data = (struct mo_file_header *) malloc (size);
+ if (data == NULL)
+ return;
+
+ to_read = size;
+ read_ptr = (char *) data;
+ do
+ {
+ long int nb = (long int) read (fd, read_ptr, to_read);
+ if (nb <= 0)
+ {
+#ifdef EINTR
+ if (nb == -1 && errno == EINTR)
+ continue;
+#endif
+ close (fd);
+ return;
+ }
+ read_ptr += nb;
+ to_read -= nb;
+ }
+ while (to_read > 0);
+
+ close (fd);
+ }
+
+ /* Using the magic number we can test whether it really is a message
+ catalog file. */
+ if (__builtin_expect (data->magic != _MAGIC && data->magic != _MAGIC_SWAPPED,
+ 0))
+ {
+ /* The magic number is wrong: not a message catalog file. */
+#ifdef HAVE_MMAP
+ if (use_mmap)
+ munmap ((caddr_t) data, size);
+ else
+#endif
+ free (data);
+ return;
+ }
+
+ domain = (struct loaded_domain *) malloc (sizeof (struct loaded_domain));
+ if (domain == NULL)
+ return;
+ domain_file->data = domain;
+
+ domain->data = (char *) data;
+ domain->use_mmap = use_mmap;
+ domain->mmap_size = size;
+ domain->must_swap = data->magic != _MAGIC;
+ domain->malloced = NULL;
+
+ /* Fill in the information about the available tables. */
+ revision = W (domain->must_swap, data->revision);
+ /* We support only the major revision 0. */
+ switch (revision >> 16)
+ {
+ case 0:
+ domain->nstrings = W (domain->must_swap, data->nstrings);
+ domain->orig_tab = (const struct string_desc *)
+ ((char *) data + W (domain->must_swap, data->orig_tab_offset));
+ domain->trans_tab = (const struct string_desc *)
+ ((char *) data + W (domain->must_swap, data->trans_tab_offset));
+ domain->hash_size = W (domain->must_swap, data->hash_tab_size);
+ domain->hash_tab =
+ (domain->hash_size > 2
+ ? (const nls_uint32 *)
+ ((char *) data + W (domain->must_swap, data->hash_tab_offset))
+ : NULL);
+ domain->must_swap_hash_tab = domain->must_swap;
+
+ /* Now dispatch on the minor revision. */
+ switch (revision & 0xffff)
+ {
+ case 0:
+ domain->n_sysdep_strings = 0;
+ domain->orig_sysdep_tab = NULL;
+ domain->trans_sysdep_tab = NULL;
+ break;
+ case 1:
+ default:
+ {
+ nls_uint32 n_sysdep_strings;
+
+ if (domain->hash_tab == NULL)
+ /* This is invalid. These minor revisions need a hash table. */
+ goto invalid;
+
+ n_sysdep_strings =
+ W (domain->must_swap, data->n_sysdep_strings);
+ if (n_sysdep_strings > 0)
+ {
+ nls_uint32 n_sysdep_segments;
+ const struct sysdep_segment *sysdep_segments;
+ const char **sysdep_segment_values;
+ const nls_uint32 *orig_sysdep_tab;
+ const nls_uint32 *trans_sysdep_tab;
+ size_t memneed;
+ char *mem;
+ struct sysdep_string_desc *inmem_orig_sysdep_tab;
+ struct sysdep_string_desc *inmem_trans_sysdep_tab;
+ nls_uint32 *inmem_hash_tab;
+ unsigned int i;
+
+ /* Get the values of the system dependent segments. */
+ n_sysdep_segments =
+ W (domain->must_swap, data->n_sysdep_segments);
+ sysdep_segments = (const struct sysdep_segment *)
+ ((char *) data
+ + W (domain->must_swap, data->sysdep_segments_offset));
+ sysdep_segment_values =
+ alloca (n_sysdep_segments * sizeof (const char *));
+ for (i = 0; i < n_sysdep_segments; i++)
+ {
+ const char *name =
+ (char *) data
+ + W (domain->must_swap, sysdep_segments[i].offset);
+ nls_uint32 namelen =
+ W (domain->must_swap, sysdep_segments[i].length);
+
+ if (!(namelen > 0 && name[namelen - 1] == '\0'))
+ {
+ freea (sysdep_segment_values);
+ goto invalid;
+ }
+
+ sysdep_segment_values[i] = get_sysdep_segment_value (name);
+ }
+
+ orig_sysdep_tab = (const nls_uint32 *)
+ ((char *) data
+ + W (domain->must_swap, data->orig_sysdep_tab_offset));
+ trans_sysdep_tab = (const nls_uint32 *)
+ ((char *) data
+ + W (domain->must_swap, data->trans_sysdep_tab_offset));
+
+ /* Compute the amount of additional memory needed for the
+ system dependent strings and the augmented hash table. */
+ memneed = 2 * n_sysdep_strings
+ * sizeof (struct sysdep_string_desc)
+ + domain->hash_size * sizeof (nls_uint32);
+ for (i = 0; i < 2 * n_sysdep_strings; i++)
+ {
+ const struct sysdep_string *sysdep_string =
+ (const struct sysdep_string *)
+ ((char *) data
+ + W (domain->must_swap,
+ i < n_sysdep_strings
+ ? orig_sysdep_tab[i]
+ : trans_sysdep_tab[i - n_sysdep_strings]));
+ size_t need = 0;
+ const struct segment_pair *p = sysdep_string->segments;
+
+ if (W (domain->must_swap, p->sysdepref) != SEGMENTS_END)
+ for (p = sysdep_string->segments;; p++)
+ {
+ nls_uint32 sysdepref;
+
+ need += W (domain->must_swap, p->segsize);
+
+ sysdepref = W (domain->must_swap, p->sysdepref);
+ if (sysdepref == SEGMENTS_END)
+ break;
+
+ if (sysdepref >= n_sysdep_segments)
+ {
+ /* Invalid. */
+ freea (sysdep_segment_values);
+ goto invalid;
+ }
+
+ need += strlen (sysdep_segment_values[sysdepref]);
+ }
+
+ memneed += need;
+ }
+
+ /* Allocate additional memory. */
+ mem = (char *) malloc (memneed);
+ if (mem == NULL)
+ goto invalid;
+
+ domain->malloced = mem;
+ inmem_orig_sysdep_tab = (struct sysdep_string_desc *) mem;
+ mem += n_sysdep_strings * sizeof (struct sysdep_string_desc);
+ inmem_trans_sysdep_tab = (struct sysdep_string_desc *) mem;
+ mem += n_sysdep_strings * sizeof (struct sysdep_string_desc);
+ inmem_hash_tab = (nls_uint32 *) mem;
+ mem += domain->hash_size * sizeof (nls_uint32);
+
+ /* Compute the system dependent strings. */
+ for (i = 0; i < 2 * n_sysdep_strings; i++)
+ {
+ const struct sysdep_string *sysdep_string =
+ (const struct sysdep_string *)
+ ((char *) data
+ + W (domain->must_swap,
+ i < n_sysdep_strings
+ ? orig_sysdep_tab[i]
+ : trans_sysdep_tab[i - n_sysdep_strings]));
+ const char *static_segments =
+ (char *) data
+ + W (domain->must_swap, sysdep_string->offset);
+ const struct segment_pair *p = sysdep_string->segments;
+
+ /* Concatenate the segments, and fill
+ inmem_orig_sysdep_tab[i] (for i < n_sysdep_strings) and
+ inmem_trans_sysdep_tab[i-n_sysdep_strings] (for
+ i >= n_sysdep_strings). */
+
+ if (W (domain->must_swap, p->sysdepref) == SEGMENTS_END)
+ {
+ /* Only one static segment. */
+ inmem_orig_sysdep_tab[i].length =
+ W (domain->must_swap, p->segsize);
+ inmem_orig_sysdep_tab[i].pointer = static_segments;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ inmem_orig_sysdep_tab[i].pointer = mem;
+
+ for (p = sysdep_string->segments;; p++)
+ {
+ nls_uint32 segsize =
+ W (domain->must_swap, p->segsize);
+ nls_uint32 sysdepref =
+ W (domain->must_swap, p->sysdepref);
+ size_t n;
+
+ if (segsize > 0)
+ {
+ memcpy (mem, static_segments, segsize);
+ mem += segsize;
+ static_segments += segsize;
+ }
+
+ if (sysdepref == SEGMENTS_END)
+ break;
+
+ n = strlen (sysdep_segment_values[sysdepref]);
+ memcpy (mem, sysdep_segment_values[sysdepref], n);
+ mem += n;
+ }
+
+ inmem_orig_sysdep_tab[i].length =
+ mem - inmem_orig_sysdep_tab[i].pointer;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Compute the augmented hash table. */
+ for (i = 0; i < domain->hash_size; i++)
+ inmem_hash_tab[i] =
+ W (domain->must_swap_hash_tab, domain->hash_tab[i]);
+ for (i = 0; i < n_sysdep_strings; i++)
+ {
+ const char *msgid = inmem_orig_sysdep_tab[i].pointer;
+ nls_uint32 hash_val = hash_string (msgid);
+ nls_uint32 idx = hash_val % domain->hash_size;
+ nls_uint32 incr = 1 + (hash_val % (domain->hash_size - 2));
+
+ for (;;)
+ {
+ if (inmem_hash_tab[idx] == 0)
+ {
+ /* Hash table entry is empty. Use it. */
+ inmem_hash_tab[idx] = 1 + domain->nstrings + i;
+ break;
+ }
+
+ if (idx >= domain->hash_size - incr)
+ idx -= domain->hash_size - incr;
+ else
+ idx += incr;
+ }
+ }
+
+ freea (sysdep_segment_values);
+
+ domain->n_sysdep_strings = n_sysdep_strings;
+ domain->orig_sysdep_tab = inmem_orig_sysdep_tab;
+ domain->trans_sysdep_tab = inmem_trans_sysdep_tab;
+
+ domain->hash_tab = inmem_hash_tab;
+ domain->must_swap_hash_tab = 0;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ domain->n_sysdep_strings = 0;
+ domain->orig_sysdep_tab = NULL;
+ domain->trans_sysdep_tab = NULL;
+ }
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ break;
+ default:
+ /* This is an invalid revision. */
+ invalid:
+ /* This is an invalid .mo file. */
+ if (domain->malloced)
+ free (domain->malloced);
+#ifdef HAVE_MMAP
+ if (use_mmap)
+ munmap ((caddr_t) data, size);
+ else
+#endif
+ free (data);
+ free (domain);
+ domain_file->data = NULL;
+ return;
+ }
+
+ /* Now initialize the character set converter from the character set
+ the file is encoded with (found in the header entry) to the domain's
+ specified character set or the locale's character set. */
+ nullentry = _nl_init_domain_conv (domain_file, domain, domainbinding);
+
+ /* Also look for a plural specification. */
+ EXTRACT_PLURAL_EXPRESSION (nullentry, &domain->plural, &domain->nplurals);
+}
+
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+void
+internal_function
+_nl_unload_domain (domain)
+ struct loaded_domain *domain;
+{
+ if (domain->plural != &__gettext_germanic_plural)
+ __gettext_free_exp (domain->plural);
+
+ _nl_free_domain_conv (domain);
+
+ if (domain->malloced)
+ free (domain->malloced);
+
+# ifdef _POSIX_MAPPED_FILES
+ if (domain->use_mmap)
+ munmap ((caddr_t) domain->data, domain->mmap_size);
+ else
+# endif /* _POSIX_MAPPED_FILES */
+ free ((void *) domain->data);
+
+ free (domain);
+}
+#endif
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/localcharset.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/localcharset.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d04d053
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/localcharset.c
@@ -0,0 +1,398 @@
+/* Determine a canonical name for the current locale's character encoding.
+
+ Copyright (C) 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+/* Written by Bruno Haible <bruno@clisp.org>. */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+/* Specification. */
+#include "localcharset.h"
+
+#if HAVE_STDDEF_H
+# include <stddef.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#if HAVE_STRING_H
+# include <string.h>
+#else
+# include <strings.h>
+#endif
+#if HAVE_STDLIB_H
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__
+# undef WIN32 /* avoid warning on mingw32 */
+# define WIN32
+#endif
+
+#if defined __EMX__
+/* Assume EMX program runs on OS/2, even if compiled under DOS. */
+# define OS2
+#endif
+
+#if !defined WIN32
+# if HAVE_LANGINFO_CODESET
+# include <langinfo.h>
+# else
+# if HAVE_SETLOCALE
+# include <locale.h>
+# endif
+# endif
+#elif defined WIN32
+# define WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN
+# include <windows.h>
+#endif
+#if defined OS2
+# define INCL_DOS
+# include <os2.h>
+#endif
+
+#if ENABLE_RELOCATABLE
+# include "relocatable.h"
+#else
+# define relocate(pathname) (pathname)
+#endif
+
+#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ || defined __EMX__ || defined __DJGPP__
+ /* Win32, OS/2, DOS */
+# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == '/' || (C) == '\\')
+#endif
+
+#ifndef DIRECTORY_SEPARATOR
+# define DIRECTORY_SEPARATOR '/'
+#endif
+
+#ifndef ISSLASH
+# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == DIRECTORY_SEPARATOR)
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_GETC_UNLOCKED
+# undef getc
+# define getc getc_unlocked
+#endif
+
+/* The following static variable is declared 'volatile' to avoid a
+ possible multithread problem in the function get_charset_aliases. If we
+ are running in a threaded environment, and if two threads initialize
+ 'charset_aliases' simultaneously, both will produce the same value,
+ and everything will be ok if the two assignments to 'charset_aliases'
+ are atomic. But I don't know what will happen if the two assignments mix. */
+#if __STDC__ != 1
+# define volatile /* empty */
+#endif
+/* Pointer to the contents of the charset.alias file, if it has already been
+ read, else NULL. Its format is:
+ ALIAS_1 '\0' CANONICAL_1 '\0' ... ALIAS_n '\0' CANONICAL_n '\0' '\0' */
+static const char * volatile charset_aliases;
+
+/* Return a pointer to the contents of the charset.alias file. */
+static const char *
+get_charset_aliases ()
+{
+ const char *cp;
+
+ cp = charset_aliases;
+ if (cp == NULL)
+ {
+#if !(defined VMS || defined WIN32)
+ FILE *fp;
+ const char *dir = relocate (LIBDIR);
+ const char *base = "charset.alias";
+ char *file_name;
+
+ /* Concatenate dir and base into freshly allocated file_name. */
+ {
+ size_t dir_len = strlen (dir);
+ size_t base_len = strlen (base);
+ int add_slash = (dir_len > 0 && !ISSLASH (dir[dir_len - 1]));
+ file_name = (char *) malloc (dir_len + add_slash + base_len + 1);
+ if (file_name != NULL)
+ {
+ memcpy (file_name, dir, dir_len);
+ if (add_slash)
+ file_name[dir_len] = DIRECTORY_SEPARATOR;
+ memcpy (file_name + dir_len + add_slash, base, base_len + 1);
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (file_name == NULL || (fp = fopen (file_name, "r")) == NULL)
+ /* Out of memory or file not found, treat it as empty. */
+ cp = "";
+ else
+ {
+ /* Parse the file's contents. */
+ int c;
+ char buf1[50+1];
+ char buf2[50+1];
+ char *res_ptr = NULL;
+ size_t res_size = 0;
+ size_t l1, l2;
+
+ for (;;)
+ {
+ c = getc (fp);
+ if (c == EOF)
+ break;
+ if (c == '\n' || c == ' ' || c == '\t')
+ continue;
+ if (c == '#')
+ {
+ /* Skip comment, to end of line. */
+ do
+ c = getc (fp);
+ while (!(c == EOF || c == '\n'));
+ if (c == EOF)
+ break;
+ continue;
+ }
+ ungetc (c, fp);
+ if (fscanf (fp, "%50s %50s", buf1, buf2) < 2)
+ break;
+ l1 = strlen (buf1);
+ l2 = strlen (buf2);
+ if (res_size == 0)
+ {
+ res_size = l1 + 1 + l2 + 1;
+ res_ptr = (char *) malloc (res_size + 1);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ res_size += l1 + 1 + l2 + 1;
+ res_ptr = (char *) realloc (res_ptr, res_size + 1);
+ }
+ if (res_ptr == NULL)
+ {
+ /* Out of memory. */
+ res_size = 0;
+ break;
+ }
+ strcpy (res_ptr + res_size - (l2 + 1) - (l1 + 1), buf1);
+ strcpy (res_ptr + res_size - (l2 + 1), buf2);
+ }
+ fclose (fp);
+ if (res_size == 0)
+ cp = "";
+ else
+ {
+ *(res_ptr + res_size) = '\0';
+ cp = res_ptr;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (file_name != NULL)
+ free (file_name);
+
+#else
+
+# if defined VMS
+ /* To avoid the troubles of an extra file charset.alias_vms in the
+ sources of many GNU packages, simply inline the aliases here. */
+ /* The list of encodings is taken from the OpenVMS 7.3-1 documentation
+ "Compaq C Run-Time Library Reference Manual for OpenVMS systems"
+ section 10.7 "Handling Different Character Sets". */
+ cp = "ISO8859-1" "\0" "ISO-8859-1" "\0"
+ "ISO8859-2" "\0" "ISO-8859-2" "\0"
+ "ISO8859-5" "\0" "ISO-8859-5" "\0"
+ "ISO8859-7" "\0" "ISO-8859-7" "\0"
+ "ISO8859-8" "\0" "ISO-8859-8" "\0"
+ "ISO8859-9" "\0" "ISO-8859-9" "\0"
+ /* Japanese */
+ "eucJP" "\0" "EUC-JP" "\0"
+ "SJIS" "\0" "SHIFT_JIS" "\0"
+ "DECKANJI" "\0" "DEC-KANJI" "\0"
+ "SDECKANJI" "\0" "EUC-JP" "\0"
+ /* Chinese */
+ "eucTW" "\0" "EUC-TW" "\0"
+ "DECHANYU" "\0" "DEC-HANYU" "\0"
+ "DECHANZI" "\0" "GB2312" "\0"
+ /* Korean */
+ "DECKOREAN" "\0" "EUC-KR" "\0";
+# endif
+
+# if defined WIN32
+ /* To avoid the troubles of installing a separate file in the same
+ directory as the DLL and of retrieving the DLL's directory at
+ runtime, simply inline the aliases here. */
+
+ cp = "CP936" "\0" "GBK" "\0"
+ "CP1361" "\0" "JOHAB" "\0"
+ "CP20127" "\0" "ASCII" "\0"
+ "CP20866" "\0" "KOI8-R" "\0"
+ "CP21866" "\0" "KOI8-RU" "\0"
+ "CP28591" "\0" "ISO-8859-1" "\0"
+ "CP28592" "\0" "ISO-8859-2" "\0"
+ "CP28593" "\0" "ISO-8859-3" "\0"
+ "CP28594" "\0" "ISO-8859-4" "\0"
+ "CP28595" "\0" "ISO-8859-5" "\0"
+ "CP28596" "\0" "ISO-8859-6" "\0"
+ "CP28597" "\0" "ISO-8859-7" "\0"
+ "CP28598" "\0" "ISO-8859-8" "\0"
+ "CP28599" "\0" "ISO-8859-9" "\0"
+ "CP28605" "\0" "ISO-8859-15" "\0";
+# endif
+#endif
+
+ charset_aliases = cp;
+ }
+
+ return cp;
+}
+
+/* Determine the current locale's character encoding, and canonicalize it
+ into one of the canonical names listed in config.charset.
+ The result must not be freed; it is statically allocated.
+ If the canonical name cannot be determined, the result is a non-canonical
+ name. */
+
+#ifdef STATIC
+STATIC
+#endif
+const char *
+locale_charset ()
+{
+ const char *codeset;
+ const char *aliases;
+
+#if !(defined WIN32 || defined OS2)
+
+# if HAVE_LANGINFO_CODESET
+
+ /* Most systems support nl_langinfo (CODESET) nowadays. */
+ codeset = nl_langinfo (CODESET);
+
+# else
+
+ /* On old systems which lack it, use setlocale or getenv. */
+ const char *locale = NULL;
+
+ /* But most old systems don't have a complete set of locales. Some
+ (like SunOS 4 or DJGPP) have only the C locale. Therefore we don't
+ use setlocale here; it would return "C" when it doesn't support the
+ locale name the user has set. */
+# if HAVE_SETLOCALE && 0
+ locale = setlocale (LC_CTYPE, NULL);
+# endif
+ if (locale == NULL || locale[0] == '\0')
+ {
+ locale = getenv ("LC_ALL");
+ if (locale == NULL || locale[0] == '\0')
+ {
+ locale = getenv ("LC_CTYPE");
+ if (locale == NULL || locale[0] == '\0')
+ locale = getenv ("LANG");
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* On some old systems, one used to set locale = "iso8859_1". On others,
+ you set it to "language_COUNTRY.charset". In any case, we resolve it
+ through the charset.alias file. */
+ codeset = locale;
+
+# endif
+
+#elif defined WIN32
+
+ static char buf[2 + 10 + 1];
+
+ /* Woe32 has a function returning the locale's codepage as a number. */
+ sprintf (buf, "CP%u", GetACP ());
+ codeset = buf;
+
+#elif defined OS2
+
+ const char *locale;
+ static char buf[2 + 10 + 1];
+ ULONG cp[3];
+ ULONG cplen;
+
+ /* Allow user to override the codeset, as set in the operating system,
+ with standard language environment variables. */
+ locale = getenv ("LC_ALL");
+ if (locale == NULL || locale[0] == '\0')
+ {
+ locale = getenv ("LC_CTYPE");
+ if (locale == NULL || locale[0] == '\0')
+ locale = getenv ("LANG");
+ }
+ if (locale != NULL && locale[0] != '\0')
+ {
+ /* If the locale name contains an encoding after the dot, return it. */
+ const char *dot = strchr (locale, '.');
+
+ if (dot != NULL)
+ {
+ const char *modifier;
+
+ dot++;
+ /* Look for the possible @... trailer and remove it, if any. */
+ modifier = strchr (dot, '@');
+ if (modifier == NULL)
+ return dot;
+ if (modifier - dot < sizeof (buf))
+ {
+ memcpy (buf, dot, modifier - dot);
+ buf [modifier - dot] = '\0';
+ return buf;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Resolve through the charset.alias file. */
+ codeset = locale;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* OS/2 has a function returning the locale's codepage as a number. */
+ if (DosQueryCp (sizeof (cp), cp, &cplen))
+ codeset = "";
+ else
+ {
+ sprintf (buf, "CP%u", cp[0]);
+ codeset = buf;
+ }
+ }
+
+#endif
+
+ if (codeset == NULL)
+ /* The canonical name cannot be determined. */
+ codeset = "";
+
+ /* Resolve alias. */
+ for (aliases = get_charset_aliases ();
+ *aliases != '\0';
+ aliases += strlen (aliases) + 1, aliases += strlen (aliases) + 1)
+ if (strcmp (codeset, aliases) == 0
+ || (aliases[0] == '*' && aliases[1] == '\0'))
+ {
+ codeset = aliases + strlen (aliases) + 1;
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /* Don't return an empty string. GNU libc and GNU libiconv interpret
+ the empty string as denoting "the locale's character encoding",
+ thus GNU libiconv would call this function a second time. */
+ if (codeset[0] == '\0')
+ codeset = "ASCII";
+
+ return codeset;
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/localcharset.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/localcharset.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3b137e7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/localcharset.h
@@ -0,0 +1,42 @@
+/* Determine a canonical name for the current locale's character encoding.
+ Copyright (C) 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ This file is part of the GNU CHARSET Library.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+#ifndef _LOCALCHARSET_H
+#define _LOCALCHARSET_H
+
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+extern "C" {
+#endif
+
+
+/* Determine the current locale's character encoding, and canonicalize it
+ into one of the canonical names listed in config.charset.
+ The result must not be freed; it is statically allocated.
+ If the canonical name cannot be determined, the result is a non-canonical
+ name. */
+extern const char * locale_charset (void);
+
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+}
+#endif
+
+
+#endif /* _LOCALCHARSET_H */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/locale.alias b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/locale.alias
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..bd7b9b3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/locale.alias
@@ -0,0 +1,78 @@
+# Locale name alias data base.
+# Copyright (C) 1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+#
+# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+# under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+# by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+# any later version.
+#
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+# Library General Public License for more details.
+#
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+# License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+# USA.
+
+# The format of this file is the same as for the corresponding file of
+# the X Window System, which normally can be found in
+# /usr/lib/X11/locale/locale.alias
+# A single line contains two fields: an alias and a substitution value.
+# All entries are case independent.
+
+# Note: This file is far from being complete. If you have a value for
+# your own site which you think might be useful for others too, share
+# it with the rest of us. Send it using the `glibcbug' script to
+# bugs@gnu.org.
+
+# Packages using this file:
+
+bokmal no_NO.ISO-8859-1
+bokmål no_NO.ISO-8859-1
+catalan ca_ES.ISO-8859-1
+croatian hr_HR.ISO-8859-2
+czech cs_CZ.ISO-8859-2
+danish da_DK.ISO-8859-1
+dansk da_DK.ISO-8859-1
+deutsch de_DE.ISO-8859-1
+dutch nl_NL.ISO-8859-1
+eesti et_EE.ISO-8859-1
+estonian et_EE.ISO-8859-1
+finnish fi_FI.ISO-8859-1
+français fr_FR.ISO-8859-1
+french fr_FR.ISO-8859-1
+galego gl_ES.ISO-8859-1
+galician gl_ES.ISO-8859-1
+german de_DE.ISO-8859-1
+greek el_GR.ISO-8859-7
+hebrew he_IL.ISO-8859-8
+hrvatski hr_HR.ISO-8859-2
+hungarian hu_HU.ISO-8859-2
+icelandic is_IS.ISO-8859-1
+italian it_IT.ISO-8859-1
+japanese ja_JP.eucJP
+japanese.euc ja_JP.eucJP
+ja_JP ja_JP.eucJP
+ja_JP.ujis ja_JP.eucJP
+japanese.sjis ja_JP.SJIS
+korean ko_KR.eucKR
+korean.euc ko_KR.eucKR
+ko_KR ko_KR.eucKR
+lithuanian lt_LT.ISO-8859-13
+nb_NO no_NO.ISO-8859-1
+nb_NO.ISO-8859-1 no_NO.ISO-8859-1
+norwegian no_NO.ISO-8859-1
+nynorsk nn_NO.ISO-8859-1
+polish pl_PL.ISO-8859-2
+portuguese pt_PT.ISO-8859-1
+romanian ro_RO.ISO-8859-2
+russian ru_RU.ISO-8859-5
+slovak sk_SK.ISO-8859-2
+slovene sl_SI.ISO-8859-2
+slovenian sl_SI.ISO-8859-2
+spanish es_ES.ISO-8859-1
+swedish sv_SE.ISO-8859-1
+thai th_TH.TIS-620
+turkish tr_TR.ISO-8859-9
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/localealias.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/localealias.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..7c4ce58
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/localealias.c
@@ -0,0 +1,419 @@
+/* Handle aliases for locale names.
+ Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000-2001, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+/* Tell glibc's <string.h> to provide a prototype for mempcpy().
+ This must come before <config.h> because <config.h> may include
+ <features.h>, and once <features.h> has been included, it's too late. */
+#ifndef _GNU_SOURCE
+# define _GNU_SOURCE 1
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE___FSETLOCKING
+# include <stdio_ext.h>
+#endif
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#ifdef __GNUC__
+# undef alloca
+# define alloca __builtin_alloca
+# define HAVE_ALLOCA 1
+#else
+# ifdef _MSC_VER
+# include <malloc.h>
+# define alloca _alloca
+# else
+# if defined HAVE_ALLOCA_H || defined _LIBC
+# include <alloca.h>
+# else
+# ifdef _AIX
+ #pragma alloca
+# else
+# ifndef alloca
+char *alloca ();
+# endif
+# endif
+# endif
+# endif
+#endif
+
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+#include "gettextP.h"
+
+#if ENABLE_RELOCATABLE
+# include "relocatable.h"
+#else
+# define relocate(pathname) (pathname)
+#endif
+
+/* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+/* Rename the non ANSI C functions. This is required by the standard
+ because some ANSI C functions will require linking with this object
+ file and the name space must not be polluted. */
+# define strcasecmp __strcasecmp
+
+# ifndef mempcpy
+# define mempcpy __mempcpy
+# endif
+# define HAVE_MEMPCPY 1
+# define HAVE___FSETLOCKING 1
+
+/* We need locking here since we can be called from different places. */
+# include <bits/libc-lock.h>
+
+__libc_lock_define_initialized (static, lock);
+#endif
+
+#ifndef internal_function
+# define internal_function
+#endif
+
+/* Some optimizations for glibc. */
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# define FEOF(fp) feof_unlocked (fp)
+# define FGETS(buf, n, fp) fgets_unlocked (buf, n, fp)
+#else
+# define FEOF(fp) feof (fp)
+# define FGETS(buf, n, fp) fgets (buf, n, fp)
+#endif
+
+/* For those losing systems which don't have `alloca' we have to add
+ some additional code emulating it. */
+#ifdef HAVE_ALLOCA
+# define freea(p) /* nothing */
+#else
+# define alloca(n) malloc (n)
+# define freea(p) free (p)
+#endif
+
+#if defined _LIBC_REENTRANT || defined HAVE_FGETS_UNLOCKED
+# undef fgets
+# define fgets(buf, len, s) fgets_unlocked (buf, len, s)
+#endif
+#if defined _LIBC_REENTRANT || defined HAVE_FEOF_UNLOCKED
+# undef feof
+# define feof(s) feof_unlocked (s)
+#endif
+
+
+struct alias_map
+{
+ const char *alias;
+ const char *value;
+};
+
+
+#ifndef _LIBC
+# define libc_freeres_ptr(decl) decl
+#endif
+
+libc_freeres_ptr (static char *string_space);
+static size_t string_space_act;
+static size_t string_space_max;
+libc_freeres_ptr (static struct alias_map *map);
+static size_t nmap;
+static size_t maxmap;
+
+
+/* Prototypes for local functions. */
+static size_t read_alias_file PARAMS ((const char *fname, int fname_len))
+ internal_function;
+static int extend_alias_table PARAMS ((void));
+static int alias_compare PARAMS ((const struct alias_map *map1,
+ const struct alias_map *map2));
+
+
+const char *
+_nl_expand_alias (name)
+ const char *name;
+{
+ static const char *locale_alias_path;
+ struct alias_map *retval;
+ const char *result = NULL;
+ size_t added;
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+ __libc_lock_lock (lock);
+#endif
+
+ if (locale_alias_path == NULL)
+ locale_alias_path = LOCALE_ALIAS_PATH;
+
+ do
+ {
+ struct alias_map item;
+
+ item.alias = name;
+
+ if (nmap > 0)
+ retval = (struct alias_map *) bsearch (&item, map, nmap,
+ sizeof (struct alias_map),
+ (int (*) PARAMS ((const void *,
+ const void *))
+ ) alias_compare);
+ else
+ retval = NULL;
+
+ /* We really found an alias. Return the value. */
+ if (retval != NULL)
+ {
+ result = retval->value;
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /* Perhaps we can find another alias file. */
+ added = 0;
+ while (added == 0 && locale_alias_path[0] != '\0')
+ {
+ const char *start;
+
+ while (locale_alias_path[0] == PATH_SEPARATOR)
+ ++locale_alias_path;
+ start = locale_alias_path;
+
+ while (locale_alias_path[0] != '\0'
+ && locale_alias_path[0] != PATH_SEPARATOR)
+ ++locale_alias_path;
+
+ if (start < locale_alias_path)
+ added = read_alias_file (start, locale_alias_path - start);
+ }
+ }
+ while (added != 0);
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+ __libc_lock_unlock (lock);
+#endif
+
+ return result;
+}
+
+
+static size_t
+internal_function
+read_alias_file (fname, fname_len)
+ const char *fname;
+ int fname_len;
+{
+ FILE *fp;
+ char *full_fname;
+ size_t added;
+ static const char aliasfile[] = "/locale.alias";
+
+ full_fname = (char *) alloca (fname_len + sizeof aliasfile);
+#ifdef HAVE_MEMPCPY
+ mempcpy (mempcpy (full_fname, fname, fname_len),
+ aliasfile, sizeof aliasfile);
+#else
+ memcpy (full_fname, fname, fname_len);
+ memcpy (&full_fname[fname_len], aliasfile, sizeof aliasfile);
+#endif
+
+ fp = fopen (relocate (full_fname), "r");
+ freea (full_fname);
+ if (fp == NULL)
+ return 0;
+
+#ifdef HAVE___FSETLOCKING
+ /* No threads present. */
+ __fsetlocking (fp, FSETLOCKING_BYCALLER);
+#endif
+
+ added = 0;
+ while (!FEOF (fp))
+ {
+ /* It is a reasonable approach to use a fix buffer here because
+ a) we are only interested in the first two fields
+ b) these fields must be usable as file names and so must not
+ be that long
+ We avoid a multi-kilobyte buffer here since this would use up
+ stack space which we might not have if the program ran out of
+ memory. */
+ char buf[400];
+ char *alias;
+ char *value;
+ char *cp;
+
+ if (FGETS (buf, sizeof buf, fp) == NULL)
+ /* EOF reached. */
+ break;
+
+ cp = buf;
+ /* Ignore leading white space. */
+ while (isspace ((unsigned char) cp[0]))
+ ++cp;
+
+ /* A leading '#' signals a comment line. */
+ if (cp[0] != '\0' && cp[0] != '#')
+ {
+ alias = cp++;
+ while (cp[0] != '\0' && !isspace ((unsigned char) cp[0]))
+ ++cp;
+ /* Terminate alias name. */
+ if (cp[0] != '\0')
+ *cp++ = '\0';
+
+ /* Now look for the beginning of the value. */
+ while (isspace ((unsigned char) cp[0]))
+ ++cp;
+
+ if (cp[0] != '\0')
+ {
+ size_t alias_len;
+ size_t value_len;
+
+ value = cp++;
+ while (cp[0] != '\0' && !isspace ((unsigned char) cp[0]))
+ ++cp;
+ /* Terminate value. */
+ if (cp[0] == '\n')
+ {
+ /* This has to be done to make the following test
+ for the end of line possible. We are looking for
+ the terminating '\n' which do not overwrite here. */
+ *cp++ = '\0';
+ *cp = '\n';
+ }
+ else if (cp[0] != '\0')
+ *cp++ = '\0';
+
+ if (nmap >= maxmap)
+ if (__builtin_expect (extend_alias_table (), 0))
+ return added;
+
+ alias_len = strlen (alias) + 1;
+ value_len = strlen (value) + 1;
+
+ if (string_space_act + alias_len + value_len > string_space_max)
+ {
+ /* Increase size of memory pool. */
+ size_t new_size = (string_space_max
+ + (alias_len + value_len > 1024
+ ? alias_len + value_len : 1024));
+ char *new_pool = (char *) realloc (string_space, new_size);
+ if (new_pool == NULL)
+ return added;
+
+ if (__builtin_expect (string_space != new_pool, 0))
+ {
+ size_t i;
+
+ for (i = 0; i < nmap; i++)
+ {
+ map[i].alias += new_pool - string_space;
+ map[i].value += new_pool - string_space;
+ }
+ }
+
+ string_space = new_pool;
+ string_space_max = new_size;
+ }
+
+ map[nmap].alias = memcpy (&string_space[string_space_act],
+ alias, alias_len);
+ string_space_act += alias_len;
+
+ map[nmap].value = memcpy (&string_space[string_space_act],
+ value, value_len);
+ string_space_act += value_len;
+
+ ++nmap;
+ ++added;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Possibly not the whole line fits into the buffer. Ignore
+ the rest of the line. */
+ while (strchr (buf, '\n') == NULL)
+ if (FGETS (buf, sizeof buf, fp) == NULL)
+ /* Make sure the inner loop will be left. The outer loop
+ will exit at the `feof' test. */
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /* Should we test for ferror()? I think we have to silently ignore
+ errors. --drepper */
+ fclose (fp);
+
+ if (added > 0)
+ qsort (map, nmap, sizeof (struct alias_map),
+ (int (*) PARAMS ((const void *, const void *))) alias_compare);
+
+ return added;
+}
+
+
+static int
+extend_alias_table ()
+{
+ size_t new_size;
+ struct alias_map *new_map;
+
+ new_size = maxmap == 0 ? 100 : 2 * maxmap;
+ new_map = (struct alias_map *) realloc (map, (new_size
+ * sizeof (struct alias_map)));
+ if (new_map == NULL)
+ /* Simply don't extend: we don't have any more core. */
+ return -1;
+
+ map = new_map;
+ maxmap = new_size;
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+static int
+alias_compare (map1, map2)
+ const struct alias_map *map1;
+ const struct alias_map *map2;
+{
+#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_STRCASECMP
+ return strcasecmp (map1->alias, map2->alias);
+#else
+ const unsigned char *p1 = (const unsigned char *) map1->alias;
+ const unsigned char *p2 = (const unsigned char *) map2->alias;
+ unsigned char c1, c2;
+
+ if (p1 == p2)
+ return 0;
+
+ do
+ {
+ /* I know this seems to be odd but the tolower() function in
+ some systems libc cannot handle nonalpha characters. */
+ c1 = isupper (*p1) ? tolower (*p1) : *p1;
+ c2 = isupper (*p2) ? tolower (*p2) : *p2;
+ if (c1 == '\0')
+ break;
+ ++p1;
+ ++p2;
+ }
+ while (c1 == c2);
+
+ return c1 - c2;
+#endif
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/localename.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/localename.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..faacecd
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/localename.c
@@ -0,0 +1,772 @@
+/* Determine the current selected locale.
+ Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+/* Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.org>, 1995. */
+/* Win32 code written by Tor Lillqvist <tml@iki.fi>. */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <locale.h>
+
+#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__
+# undef WIN32 /* avoid warning on mingw32 */
+# define WIN32
+#endif
+
+#ifdef WIN32
+# define WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN
+# include <windows.h>
+/* Mingw headers don't have latest language and sublanguage codes. */
+# ifndef LANG_AFRIKAANS
+# define LANG_AFRIKAANS 0x36
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_ALBANIAN
+# define LANG_ALBANIAN 0x1c
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_ARABIC
+# define LANG_ARABIC 0x01
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_ARMENIAN
+# define LANG_ARMENIAN 0x2b
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_ASSAMESE
+# define LANG_ASSAMESE 0x4d
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_AZERI
+# define LANG_AZERI 0x2c
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_BASQUE
+# define LANG_BASQUE 0x2d
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_BELARUSIAN
+# define LANG_BELARUSIAN 0x23
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_BENGALI
+# define LANG_BENGALI 0x45
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_CATALAN
+# define LANG_CATALAN 0x03
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_DIVEHI
+# define LANG_DIVEHI 0x65
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_ESTONIAN
+# define LANG_ESTONIAN 0x25
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_FAEROESE
+# define LANG_FAEROESE 0x38
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_FARSI
+# define LANG_FARSI 0x29
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_GALICIAN
+# define LANG_GALICIAN 0x56
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_GEORGIAN
+# define LANG_GEORGIAN 0x37
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_GUJARATI
+# define LANG_GUJARATI 0x47
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_HEBREW
+# define LANG_HEBREW 0x0d
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_HINDI
+# define LANG_HINDI 0x39
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_INDONESIAN
+# define LANG_INDONESIAN 0x21
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_KANNADA
+# define LANG_KANNADA 0x4b
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_KASHMIRI
+# define LANG_KASHMIRI 0x60
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_KAZAK
+# define LANG_KAZAK 0x3f
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_KONKANI
+# define LANG_KONKANI 0x57
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_KYRGYZ
+# define LANG_KYRGYZ 0x40
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_LATVIAN
+# define LANG_LATVIAN 0x26
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_LITHUANIAN
+# define LANG_LITHUANIAN 0x27
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_MACEDONIAN
+# define LANG_MACEDONIAN 0x2f
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_MALAY
+# define LANG_MALAY 0x3e
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_MALAYALAM
+# define LANG_MALAYALAM 0x4c
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_MANIPURI
+# define LANG_MANIPURI 0x58
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_MARATHI
+# define LANG_MARATHI 0x4e
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_MONGOLIAN
+# define LANG_MONGOLIAN 0x50
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_NEPALI
+# define LANG_NEPALI 0x61
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_ORIYA
+# define LANG_ORIYA 0x48
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_PUNJABI
+# define LANG_PUNJABI 0x46
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_SANSKRIT
+# define LANG_SANSKRIT 0x4f
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_SERBIAN
+# define LANG_SERBIAN 0x1a
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_SINDHI
+# define LANG_SINDHI 0x59
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_SLOVAK
+# define LANG_SLOVAK 0x1b
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_SORBIAN
+# define LANG_SORBIAN 0x2e
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_SWAHILI
+# define LANG_SWAHILI 0x41
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_SYRIAC
+# define LANG_SYRIAC 0x5a
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_TAMIL
+# define LANG_TAMIL 0x49
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_TATAR
+# define LANG_TATAR 0x44
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_TELUGU
+# define LANG_TELUGU 0x4a
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_THAI
+# define LANG_THAI 0x1e
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_UKRAINIAN
+# define LANG_UKRAINIAN 0x22
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_URDU
+# define LANG_URDU 0x20
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_UZBEK
+# define LANG_UZBEK 0x43
+# endif
+# ifndef LANG_VIETNAMESE
+# define LANG_VIETNAMESE 0x2a
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_SAUDI_ARABIA
+# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_SAUDI_ARABIA 0x01
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_IRAQ
+# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_IRAQ 0x02
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_EGYPT
+# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_EGYPT 0x03
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_LIBYA
+# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_LIBYA 0x04
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_ALGERIA
+# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_ALGERIA 0x05
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_MOROCCO
+# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_MOROCCO 0x06
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_TUNISIA
+# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_TUNISIA 0x07
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_OMAN
+# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_OMAN 0x08
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_YEMEN
+# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_YEMEN 0x09
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_SYRIA
+# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_SYRIA 0x0a
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_JORDAN
+# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_JORDAN 0x0b
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_LEBANON
+# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_LEBANON 0x0c
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_KUWAIT
+# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_KUWAIT 0x0d
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_UAE
+# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_UAE 0x0e
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_BAHRAIN
+# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_BAHRAIN 0x0f
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_QATAR
+# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_QATAR 0x10
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_AZERI_LATIN
+# define SUBLANG_AZERI_LATIN 0x01
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_AZERI_CYRILLIC
+# define SUBLANG_AZERI_CYRILLIC 0x02
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_CHINESE_MACAU
+# define SUBLANG_CHINESE_MACAU 0x05
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_SOUTH_AFRICA
+# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_SOUTH_AFRICA 0x07
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_JAMAICA
+# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_JAMAICA 0x08
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_CARIBBEAN
+# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_CARIBBEAN 0x09
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_BELIZE
+# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_BELIZE 0x0a
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_TRINIDAD
+# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_TRINIDAD 0x0b
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_ZIMBABWE
+# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_ZIMBABWE 0x0c
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_PHILIPPINES
+# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_PHILIPPINES 0x0d
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_FRENCH_LUXEMBOURG
+# define SUBLANG_FRENCH_LUXEMBOURG 0x05
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_FRENCH_MONACO
+# define SUBLANG_FRENCH_MONACO 0x06
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_GERMAN_LUXEMBOURG
+# define SUBLANG_GERMAN_LUXEMBOURG 0x04
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_GERMAN_LIECHTENSTEIN
+# define SUBLANG_GERMAN_LIECHTENSTEIN 0x05
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_KASHMIRI_INDIA
+# define SUBLANG_KASHMIRI_INDIA 0x02
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_MALAY_MALAYSIA
+# define SUBLANG_MALAY_MALAYSIA 0x01
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_MALAY_BRUNEI_DARUSSALAM
+# define SUBLANG_MALAY_BRUNEI_DARUSSALAM 0x02
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_NEPALI_INDIA
+# define SUBLANG_NEPALI_INDIA 0x02
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_SERBIAN_LATIN
+# define SUBLANG_SERBIAN_LATIN 0x02
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_SERBIAN_CYRILLIC
+# define SUBLANG_SERBIAN_CYRILLIC 0x03
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_GUATEMALA
+# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_GUATEMALA 0x04
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_COSTA_RICA
+# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_COSTA_RICA 0x05
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_PANAMA
+# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_PANAMA 0x06
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_DOMINICAN_REPUBLIC
+# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_DOMINICAN_REPUBLIC 0x07
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_VENEZUELA
+# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_VENEZUELA 0x08
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_COLOMBIA
+# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_COLOMBIA 0x09
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_PERU
+# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_PERU 0x0a
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_ARGENTINA
+# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_ARGENTINA 0x0b
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_ECUADOR
+# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_ECUADOR 0x0c
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_CHILE
+# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_CHILE 0x0d
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_URUGUAY
+# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_URUGUAY 0x0e
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_PARAGUAY
+# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_PARAGUAY 0x0f
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_BOLIVIA
+# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_BOLIVIA 0x10
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_EL_SALVADOR
+# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_EL_SALVADOR 0x11
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_HONDURAS
+# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_HONDURAS 0x12
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_NICARAGUA
+# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_NICARAGUA 0x13
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_PUERTO_RICO
+# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_PUERTO_RICO 0x14
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_SWEDISH_FINLAND
+# define SUBLANG_SWEDISH_FINLAND 0x02
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_URDU_PAKISTAN
+# define SUBLANG_URDU_PAKISTAN 0x01
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_URDU_INDIA
+# define SUBLANG_URDU_INDIA 0x02
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_UZBEK_LATIN
+# define SUBLANG_UZBEK_LATIN 0x01
+# endif
+# ifndef SUBLANG_UZBEK_CYRILLIC
+# define SUBLANG_UZBEK_CYRILLIC 0x02
+# endif
+#endif
+
+/* XPG3 defines the result of 'setlocale (category, NULL)' as:
+ "Directs 'setlocale()' to query 'category' and return the current
+ setting of 'local'."
+ However it does not specify the exact format. Neither do SUSV2 and
+ ISO C 99. So we can use this feature only on selected systems (e.g.
+ those using GNU C Library). */
+#if defined _LIBC || (defined __GNU_LIBRARY__ && __GNU_LIBRARY__ >= 2)
+# define HAVE_LOCALE_NULL
+#endif
+
+/* Determine the current locale's name, and canonicalize it into XPG syntax
+ language[_territory[.codeset]][@modifier]
+ The codeset part in the result is not reliable; the locale_charset()
+ should be used for codeset information instead.
+ The result must not be freed; it is statically allocated. */
+
+const char *
+_nl_locale_name (category, categoryname)
+ int category;
+ const char *categoryname;
+{
+ const char *retval;
+
+#ifndef WIN32
+
+ /* Use the POSIX methods of looking to 'LC_ALL', 'LC_xxx', and 'LANG'.
+ On some systems this can be done by the 'setlocale' function itself. */
+# if defined HAVE_SETLOCALE && defined HAVE_LC_MESSAGES && defined HAVE_LOCALE_NULL
+ retval = setlocale (category, NULL);
+# else
+ /* Setting of LC_ALL overwrites all other. */
+ retval = getenv ("LC_ALL");
+ if (retval == NULL || retval[0] == '\0')
+ {
+ /* Next comes the name of the desired category. */
+ retval = getenv (categoryname);
+ if (retval == NULL || retval[0] == '\0')
+ {
+ /* Last possibility is the LANG environment variable. */
+ retval = getenv ("LANG");
+ if (retval == NULL || retval[0] == '\0')
+ /* We use C as the default domain. POSIX says this is
+ implementation defined. */
+ retval = "C";
+ }
+ }
+# endif
+
+ return retval;
+
+#else /* WIN32 */
+
+ /* Return an XPG style locale name language[_territory][@modifier].
+ Don't even bother determining the codeset; it's not useful in this
+ context, because message catalogs are not specific to a single
+ codeset. */
+
+ LCID lcid;
+ LANGID langid;
+ int primary, sub;
+
+ /* Let the user override the system settings through environment
+ variables, as on POSIX systems. */
+ retval = getenv ("LC_ALL");
+ if (retval != NULL && retval[0] != '\0')
+ return retval;
+ retval = getenv (categoryname);
+ if (retval != NULL && retval[0] != '\0')
+ return retval;
+ retval = getenv ("LANG");
+ if (retval != NULL && retval[0] != '\0')
+ return retval;
+
+ /* Use native Win32 API locale ID. */
+ lcid = GetThreadLocale ();
+
+ /* Strip off the sorting rules, keep only the language part. */
+ langid = LANGIDFROMLCID (lcid);
+
+ /* Split into language and territory part. */
+ primary = PRIMARYLANGID (langid);
+ sub = SUBLANGID (langid);
+
+ /* Dispatch on language.
+ See also http://www.unicode.org/unicode/onlinedat/languages.html .
+ For details about languages, see http://www.ethnologue.com/ . */
+ switch (primary)
+ {
+ case LANG_AFRIKAANS: return "af_ZA";
+ case LANG_ALBANIAN: return "sq_AL";
+ case 0x5e: /* AMHARIC */ return "am_ET";
+ case LANG_ARABIC:
+ switch (sub)
+ {
+ case SUBLANG_ARABIC_SAUDI_ARABIA: return "ar_SA";
+ case SUBLANG_ARABIC_IRAQ: return "ar_IQ";
+ case SUBLANG_ARABIC_EGYPT: return "ar_EG";
+ case SUBLANG_ARABIC_LIBYA: return "ar_LY";
+ case SUBLANG_ARABIC_ALGERIA: return "ar_DZ";
+ case SUBLANG_ARABIC_MOROCCO: return "ar_MA";
+ case SUBLANG_ARABIC_TUNISIA: return "ar_TN";
+ case SUBLANG_ARABIC_OMAN: return "ar_OM";
+ case SUBLANG_ARABIC_YEMEN: return "ar_YE";
+ case SUBLANG_ARABIC_SYRIA: return "ar_SY";
+ case SUBLANG_ARABIC_JORDAN: return "ar_JO";
+ case SUBLANG_ARABIC_LEBANON: return "ar_LB";
+ case SUBLANG_ARABIC_KUWAIT: return "ar_KW";
+ case SUBLANG_ARABIC_UAE: return "ar_AE";
+ case SUBLANG_ARABIC_BAHRAIN: return "ar_BH";
+ case SUBLANG_ARABIC_QATAR: return "ar_QA";
+ }
+ return "ar";
+ case LANG_ARMENIAN: return "hy_AM";
+ case LANG_ASSAMESE: return "as_IN";
+ case LANG_AZERI:
+ switch (sub)
+ {
+ /* FIXME: Adjust this when Azerbaijani locales appear on Unix. */
+ case SUBLANG_AZERI_LATIN: return "az_AZ@latin";
+ case SUBLANG_AZERI_CYRILLIC: return "az_AZ@cyrillic";
+ }
+ return "az";
+ case LANG_BASQUE:
+ return "eu"; /* Ambiguous: could be "eu_ES" or "eu_FR". */
+ case LANG_BELARUSIAN: return "be_BY";
+ case LANG_BENGALI: return "bn_IN";
+ case LANG_BULGARIAN: return "bg_BG";
+ case 0x55: /* BURMESE */ return "my_MM";
+ case 0x53: /* CAMBODIAN */ return "km_KH";
+ case LANG_CATALAN: return "ca_ES";
+ case 0x5c: /* CHEROKEE */ return "chr_US";
+ case LANG_CHINESE:
+ switch (sub)
+ {
+ case SUBLANG_CHINESE_TRADITIONAL: return "zh_TW";
+ case SUBLANG_CHINESE_SIMPLIFIED: return "zh_CN";
+ case SUBLANG_CHINESE_HONGKONG: return "zh_HK";
+ case SUBLANG_CHINESE_SINGAPORE: return "zh_SG";
+ case SUBLANG_CHINESE_MACAU: return "zh_MO";
+ }
+ return "zh";
+ case LANG_CROATIAN: /* LANG_CROATIAN == LANG_SERBIAN
+ * What used to be called Serbo-Croatian
+ * should really now be two separate
+ * languages because of political reasons.
+ * (Says tml, who knows nothing about Serbian
+ * or Croatian.)
+ * (I can feel those flames coming already.)
+ */
+ switch (sub)
+ {
+ case SUBLANG_DEFAULT: return "hr_HR";
+ case SUBLANG_SERBIAN_LATIN: return "sr_YU";
+ case SUBLANG_SERBIAN_CYRILLIC: return "sr_YU@cyrillic";
+ }
+ return "hr";
+ case LANG_CZECH: return "cs_CZ";
+ case LANG_DANISH: return "da_DK";
+ case LANG_DIVEHI: return "div_MV";
+ case LANG_DUTCH:
+ switch (sub)
+ {
+ case SUBLANG_DUTCH: return "nl_NL";
+ case SUBLANG_DUTCH_BELGIAN: /* FLEMISH, VLAAMS */ return "nl_BE";
+ }
+ return "nl";
+ case 0x66: /* EDO */ return "bin_NG";
+ case LANG_ENGLISH:
+ switch (sub)
+ {
+ /* SUBLANG_ENGLISH_US == SUBLANG_DEFAULT. Heh. I thought
+ * English was the language spoken in England.
+ * Oh well.
+ */
+ case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_US: return "en_US";
+ case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_UK: return "en_GB";
+ case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_AUS: return "en_AU";
+ case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_CAN: return "en_CA";
+ case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_NZ: return "en_NZ";
+ case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_EIRE: return "en_IE";
+ case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_SOUTH_AFRICA: return "en_ZA";
+ case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_JAMAICA: return "en_JM";
+ case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_CARIBBEAN: return "en_GD"; /* Grenada? */
+ case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_BELIZE: return "en_BZ";
+ case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_TRINIDAD: return "en_TT";
+ case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_ZIMBABWE: return "en_ZW";
+ case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_PHILIPPINES: return "en_PH";
+ }
+ return "en";
+ case LANG_ESTONIAN: return "et_EE";
+ case LANG_FAEROESE: return "fo_FO";
+ case LANG_FARSI: return "fa_IR";
+ case LANG_FINNISH: return "fi_FI";
+ case LANG_FRENCH:
+ switch (sub)
+ {
+ case SUBLANG_FRENCH: return "fr_FR";
+ case SUBLANG_FRENCH_BELGIAN: /* WALLOON */ return "fr_BE";
+ case SUBLANG_FRENCH_CANADIAN: return "fr_CA";
+ case SUBLANG_FRENCH_SWISS: return "fr_CH";
+ case SUBLANG_FRENCH_LUXEMBOURG: return "fr_LU";
+ case SUBLANG_FRENCH_MONACO: return "fr_MC";
+ }
+ return "fr";
+ case 0x62: /* FRISIAN */ return "fy_NL";
+ case 0x67: /* FULFULDE */ return "ful_NG";
+ case 0x3c: /* GAELIC */
+ switch (sub)
+ {
+ case 0x01: /* SCOTTISH */ return "gd_GB";
+ case 0x02: /* IRISH */ return "ga_IE";
+ }
+ return "C";
+ case LANG_GALICIAN: return "gl_ES";
+ case LANG_GEORGIAN: return "ka_GE";
+ case LANG_GERMAN:
+ switch (sub)
+ {
+ case SUBLANG_GERMAN: return "de_DE";
+ case SUBLANG_GERMAN_SWISS: return "de_CH";
+ case SUBLANG_GERMAN_AUSTRIAN: return "de_AT";
+ case SUBLANG_GERMAN_LUXEMBOURG: return "de_LU";
+ case SUBLANG_GERMAN_LIECHTENSTEIN: return "de_LI";
+ }
+ return "de";
+ case LANG_GREEK: return "el_GR";
+ case 0x74: /* GUARANI */ return "gn_PY";
+ case LANG_GUJARATI: return "gu_IN";
+ case 0x68: /* HAUSA */ return "ha_NG";
+ case 0x75: /* HAWAIIAN */
+ /* FIXME: Do they mean Hawaiian ("haw_US", 1000 speakers)
+ or Hawaii Creole English ("cpe_US", 600000 speakers)? */
+ return "cpe_US";
+ case LANG_HEBREW: return "he_IL";
+ case LANG_HINDI: return "hi_IN";
+ case LANG_HUNGARIAN: return "hu_HU";
+ case 0x69: /* IBIBIO */ return "nic_NG";
+ case LANG_ICELANDIC: return "is_IS";
+ case 0x70: /* IGBO */ return "ibo_NG";
+ case LANG_INDONESIAN: return "id_ID";
+ case 0x5d: /* INUKTITUT */ return "iu_CA";
+ case LANG_ITALIAN:
+ switch (sub)
+ {
+ case SUBLANG_ITALIAN: return "it_IT";
+ case SUBLANG_ITALIAN_SWISS: return "it_CH";
+ }
+ return "it";
+ case LANG_JAPANESE: return "ja_JP";
+ case LANG_KANNADA: return "kn_IN";
+ case 0x71: /* KANURI */ return "kau_NG";
+ case LANG_KASHMIRI:
+ switch (sub)
+ {
+ case SUBLANG_DEFAULT: return "ks_PK";
+ case SUBLANG_KASHMIRI_INDIA: return "ks_IN";
+ }
+ return "ks";
+ case LANG_KAZAK: return "kk_KZ";
+ case LANG_KONKANI:
+ /* FIXME: Adjust this when such locales appear on Unix. */
+ return "kok_IN";
+ case LANG_KOREAN: return "ko_KR";
+ case LANG_KYRGYZ: return "ky_KG";
+ case 0x54: /* LAO */ return "lo_LA";
+ case 0x76: /* LATIN */ return "la_VA";
+ case LANG_LATVIAN: return "lv_LV";
+ case LANG_LITHUANIAN: return "lt_LT";
+ case LANG_MACEDONIAN: return "mk_MK";
+ case LANG_MALAY:
+ switch (sub)
+ {
+ case SUBLANG_MALAY_MALAYSIA: return "ms_MY";
+ case SUBLANG_MALAY_BRUNEI_DARUSSALAM: return "ms_BN";
+ }
+ return "ms";
+ case LANG_MALAYALAM: return "ml_IN";
+ case 0x3a: /* MALTESE */ return "mt_MT";
+ case LANG_MANIPURI:
+ /* FIXME: Adjust this when such locales appear on Unix. */
+ return "mni_IN";
+ case LANG_MARATHI: return "mr_IN";
+ case LANG_MONGOLIAN:
+ return "mn"; /* Ambiguous: could be "mn_CN" or "mn_MN". */
+ case LANG_NEPALI:
+ switch (sub)
+ {
+ case SUBLANG_DEFAULT: return "ne_NP";
+ case SUBLANG_NEPALI_INDIA: return "ne_IN";
+ }
+ return "ne";
+ case LANG_NORWEGIAN:
+ switch (sub)
+ {
+ case SUBLANG_NORWEGIAN_BOKMAL: return "no_NO";
+ case SUBLANG_NORWEGIAN_NYNORSK: return "nn_NO";
+ }
+ return "no";
+ case LANG_ORIYA: return "or_IN";
+ case 0x72: /* OROMO */ return "om_ET";
+ case 0x79: /* PAPIAMENTU */ return "pap_AN";
+ case 0x63: /* PASHTO */
+ return "ps"; /* Ambiguous: could be "ps_PK" or "ps_AF". */
+ case LANG_POLISH: return "pl_PL";
+ case LANG_PORTUGUESE:
+ switch (sub)
+ {
+ case SUBLANG_PORTUGUESE: return "pt_PT";
+ /* Hmm. SUBLANG_PORTUGUESE_BRAZILIAN == SUBLANG_DEFAULT.
+ Same phenomenon as SUBLANG_ENGLISH_US == SUBLANG_DEFAULT. */
+ case SUBLANG_PORTUGUESE_BRAZILIAN: return "pt_BR";
+ }
+ return "pt";
+ case LANG_PUNJABI: return "pa_IN";
+ case 0x17: /* RHAETO-ROMANCE */ return "rm_CH";
+ case LANG_ROMANIAN: return "ro_RO";
+ case LANG_RUSSIAN:
+ return "ru"; /* Ambiguous: could be "ru_RU" or "ru_UA". */
+ case 0x3b: /* SAMI */ return "se_NO";
+ case LANG_SANSKRIT: return "sa_IN";
+ case LANG_SINDHI: return "sd";
+ case 0x5b: /* SINHALESE */ return "si_LK";
+ case LANG_SLOVAK: return "sk_SK";
+ case LANG_SLOVENIAN: return "sl_SI";
+ case 0x77: /* SOMALI */ return "so_SO";
+ case LANG_SORBIAN:
+ /* FIXME: Adjust this when such locales appear on Unix. */
+ return "wen_DE";
+ case LANG_SPANISH:
+ switch (sub)
+ {
+ case SUBLANG_SPANISH: return "es_ES";
+ case SUBLANG_SPANISH_MEXICAN: return "es_MX";
+ case SUBLANG_SPANISH_MODERN:
+ return "es_ES@modern"; /* not seen on Unix */
+ case SUBLANG_SPANISH_GUATEMALA: return "es_GT";
+ case SUBLANG_SPANISH_COSTA_RICA: return "es_CR";
+ case SUBLANG_SPANISH_PANAMA: return "es_PA";
+ case SUBLANG_SPANISH_DOMINICAN_REPUBLIC: return "es_DO";
+ case SUBLANG_SPANISH_VENEZUELA: return "es_VE";
+ case SUBLANG_SPANISH_COLOMBIA: return "es_CO";
+ case SUBLANG_SPANISH_PERU: return "es_PE";
+ case SUBLANG_SPANISH_ARGENTINA: return "es_AR";
+ case SUBLANG_SPANISH_ECUADOR: return "es_EC";
+ case SUBLANG_SPANISH_CHILE: return "es_CL";
+ case SUBLANG_SPANISH_URUGUAY: return "es_UY";
+ case SUBLANG_SPANISH_PARAGUAY: return "es_PY";
+ case SUBLANG_SPANISH_BOLIVIA: return "es_BO";
+ case SUBLANG_SPANISH_EL_SALVADOR: return "es_SV";
+ case SUBLANG_SPANISH_HONDURAS: return "es_HN";
+ case SUBLANG_SPANISH_NICARAGUA: return "es_NI";
+ case SUBLANG_SPANISH_PUERTO_RICO: return "es_PR";
+ }
+ return "es";
+ case 0x30: /* SUTU */ return "bnt_TZ";
+ case LANG_SWAHILI: return "sw_KE";
+ case LANG_SWEDISH:
+ switch (sub)
+ {
+ case SUBLANG_DEFAULT: return "sv_SE";
+ case SUBLANG_SWEDISH_FINLAND: return "sv_FI";
+ }
+ return "sv";
+ case LANG_SYRIAC: return "syr_TR"; /* An extinct language. */
+ case 0x64: /* TAGALOG */ return "tl_PH";
+ case 0x28: /* TAJIK */ return "tg_TJ";
+ case 0x5f: /* TAMAZIGHT */ return "ber_MA";
+ case LANG_TAMIL:
+ return "ta"; /* Ambiguous: could be "ta_IN" or "ta_LK" or "ta_SG". */
+ case LANG_TATAR: return "tt_RU";
+ case LANG_TELUGU: return "te_IN";
+ case LANG_THAI: return "th_TH";
+ case 0x51: /* TIBETAN */ return "bo_CN";
+ case 0x73: /* TIGRINYA */ return "ti_ET";
+ case 0x31: /* TSONGA */ return "ts_ZA";
+ case LANG_TURKISH: return "tr_TR";
+ case 0x42: /* TURKMEN */ return "tk_TM";
+ case LANG_UKRAINIAN: return "uk_UA";
+ case LANG_URDU:
+ switch (sub)
+ {
+ case SUBLANG_URDU_PAKISTAN: return "ur_PK";
+ case SUBLANG_URDU_INDIA: return "ur_IN";
+ }
+ return "ur";
+ case LANG_UZBEK:
+ switch (sub)
+ {
+ /* FIXME: Adjust this when Uzbek locales appear on Unix. */
+ case SUBLANG_UZBEK_LATIN: return "uz_UZ@latin";
+ case SUBLANG_UZBEK_CYRILLIC: return "uz_UZ@cyrillic";
+ }
+ return "uz";
+ case 0x33: /* VENDA */ return "ven_ZA";
+ case LANG_VIETNAMESE: return "vi_VN";
+ case 0x52: /* WELSH */ return "cy_GB";
+ case 0x34: /* XHOSA */ return "xh_ZA";
+ case 0x78: /* YI */ return "sit_CN";
+ case 0x3d: /* YIDDISH */ return "yi_IL";
+ case 0x6a: /* YORUBA */ return "yo_NG";
+ case 0x35: /* ZULU */ return "zu_ZA";
+ default: return "C";
+ }
+
+#endif
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/log.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/log.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9c84791
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/log.c
@@ -0,0 +1,104 @@
+/* Log file output.
+ Copyright (C) 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+/* Written by Bruno Haible <bruno@clisp.org>. */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+/* Print an ASCII string with quotes and escape sequences where needed. */
+static void
+print_escaped (stream, str)
+ FILE *stream;
+ const char *str;
+{
+ putc ('"', stream);
+ for (; *str != '\0'; str++)
+ if (*str == '\n')
+ {
+ fputs ("\\n\"", stream);
+ if (str[1] == '\0')
+ return;
+ fputs ("\n\"", stream);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if (*str == '"' || *str == '\\')
+ putc ('\\', stream);
+ putc (*str, stream);
+ }
+ putc ('"', stream);
+}
+
+/* Add to the log file an entry denoting a failed translation. */
+void
+_nl_log_untranslated (logfilename, domainname, msgid1, msgid2, plural)
+ const char *logfilename;
+ const char *domainname;
+ const char *msgid1;
+ const char *msgid2;
+ int plural;
+{
+ static char *last_logfilename = NULL;
+ static FILE *last_logfile = NULL;
+ FILE *logfile;
+
+ /* Can we reuse the last opened logfile? */
+ if (last_logfilename == NULL || strcmp (logfilename, last_logfilename) != 0)
+ {
+ /* Close the last used logfile. */
+ if (last_logfilename != NULL)
+ {
+ if (last_logfile != NULL)
+ {
+ fclose (last_logfile);
+ last_logfile = NULL;
+ }
+ free (last_logfilename);
+ last_logfilename = NULL;
+ }
+ /* Open the logfile. */
+ last_logfilename = (char *) malloc (strlen (logfilename) + 1);
+ if (last_logfilename == NULL)
+ return;
+ strcpy (last_logfilename, logfilename);
+ last_logfile = fopen (logfilename, "a");
+ if (last_logfile == NULL)
+ return;
+ }
+ logfile = last_logfile;
+
+ fprintf (logfile, "domain ");
+ print_escaped (logfile, domainname);
+ fprintf (logfile, "\nmsgid ");
+ print_escaped (logfile, msgid1);
+ if (plural)
+ {
+ fprintf (logfile, "\nmsgid_plural ");
+ print_escaped (logfile, msgid2);
+ fprintf (logfile, "\nmsgstr[0] \"\"\n");
+ }
+ else
+ fprintf (logfile, "\nmsgstr \"\"\n");
+ putc ('\n', logfile);
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/ngettext.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/ngettext.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..17a27f4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/ngettext.c
@@ -0,0 +1,68 @@
+/* Implementation of ngettext(3) function.
+ Copyright (C) 1995, 1997, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# define __need_NULL
+# include <stddef.h>
+#else
+# include <stdlib.h> /* Just for NULL. */
+#endif
+
+#include "gettextP.h"
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# include <libintl.h>
+#else
+# include "libgnuintl.h"
+#endif
+
+#include <locale.h>
+
+/* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+
+/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. They must not clash
+ with existing names and they should follow ANSI C. But this source
+ code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __
+ prefix. So we have to make a difference here. */
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# define NGETTEXT __ngettext
+# define DCNGETTEXT __dcngettext
+#else
+# define NGETTEXT libintl_ngettext
+# define DCNGETTEXT libintl_dcngettext
+#endif
+
+/* Look up MSGID in the current default message catalog for the current
+ LC_MESSAGES locale. If not found, returns MSGID itself (the default
+ text). */
+char *
+NGETTEXT (msgid1, msgid2, n)
+ const char *msgid1;
+ const char *msgid2;
+ unsigned long int n;
+{
+ return DCNGETTEXT (NULL, msgid1, msgid2, n, LC_MESSAGES);
+}
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+/* Alias for function name in GNU C Library. */
+weak_alias (__ngettext, ngettext);
+#endif
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/os2compat.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/os2compat.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c8dc33e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/os2compat.c
@@ -0,0 +1,98 @@
+/* OS/2 compatibility functions.
+ Copyright (C) 2001-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+#define OS2_AWARE
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+#include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <sys/param.h>
+
+/* A version of getenv() that works from DLLs */
+extern unsigned long DosScanEnv (const unsigned char *pszName, unsigned char **ppszValue);
+
+char *
+_nl_getenv (const char *name)
+{
+ unsigned char *value;
+ if (DosScanEnv (name, &value))
+ return NULL;
+ else
+ return value;
+}
+
+/* A fixed size buffer. */
+char libintl_nl_default_dirname[MAXPATHLEN+1];
+
+char *_nlos2_libdir = NULL;
+char *_nlos2_localealiaspath = NULL;
+char *_nlos2_localedir = NULL;
+
+static __attribute__((constructor)) void
+nlos2_initialize ()
+{
+ char *root = getenv ("UNIXROOT");
+ char *gnulocaledir = getenv ("GNULOCALEDIR");
+
+ _nlos2_libdir = gnulocaledir;
+ if (!_nlos2_libdir)
+ {
+ if (root)
+ {
+ size_t sl = strlen (root);
+ _nlos2_libdir = (char *) malloc (sl + strlen (LIBDIR) + 1);
+ memcpy (_nlos2_libdir, root, sl);
+ memcpy (_nlos2_libdir + sl, LIBDIR, strlen (LIBDIR) + 1);
+ }
+ else
+ _nlos2_libdir = LIBDIR;
+ }
+
+ _nlos2_localealiaspath = gnulocaledir;
+ if (!_nlos2_localealiaspath)
+ {
+ if (root)
+ {
+ size_t sl = strlen (root);
+ _nlos2_localealiaspath = (char *) malloc (sl + strlen (LOCALE_ALIAS_PATH) + 1);
+ memcpy (_nlos2_localealiaspath, root, sl);
+ memcpy (_nlos2_localealiaspath + sl, LOCALE_ALIAS_PATH, strlen (LOCALE_ALIAS_PATH) + 1);
+ }
+ else
+ _nlos2_localealiaspath = LOCALE_ALIAS_PATH;
+ }
+
+ _nlos2_localedir = gnulocaledir;
+ if (!_nlos2_localedir)
+ {
+ if (root)
+ {
+ size_t sl = strlen (root);
+ _nlos2_localedir = (char *) malloc (sl + strlen (LOCALEDIR) + 1);
+ memcpy (_nlos2_localedir, root, sl);
+ memcpy (_nlos2_localedir + sl, LOCALEDIR, strlen (LOCALEDIR) + 1);
+ }
+ else
+ _nlos2_localedir = LOCALEDIR;
+ }
+
+ if (strlen (_nlos2_localedir) <= MAXPATHLEN)
+ strcpy (libintl_nl_default_dirname, _nlos2_localedir);
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/os2compat.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/os2compat.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..4f74e8c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/os2compat.h
@@ -0,0 +1,46 @@
+/* OS/2 compatibility defines.
+ This file is intended to be included from config.h
+ Copyright (C) 2001-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+/* When included from os2compat.h we need all the original definitions */
+#ifndef OS2_AWARE
+
+#undef LIBDIR
+#define LIBDIR _nlos2_libdir
+extern char *_nlos2_libdir;
+
+#undef LOCALEDIR
+#define LOCALEDIR _nlos2_localedir
+extern char *_nlos2_localedir;
+
+#undef LOCALE_ALIAS_PATH
+#define LOCALE_ALIAS_PATH _nlos2_localealiaspath
+extern char *_nlos2_localealiaspath;
+
+#endif
+
+#undef HAVE_STRCASECMP
+#define HAVE_STRCASECMP 1
+#define strcasecmp stricmp
+#define strncasecmp strnicmp
+
+/* We have our own getenv() which works even if library is compiled as DLL */
+#define getenv _nl_getenv
+
+/* Older versions of gettext used -1 as the value of LC_MESSAGES */
+#define LC_MESSAGES_COMPAT (-1)
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/osdep.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/osdep.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b372598
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/osdep.c
@@ -0,0 +1,24 @@
+/* OS dependent parts of libintl.
+ Copyright (C) 2001-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+#if defined __EMX__
+# include "os2compat.c"
+#else
+/* Avoid AIX compiler warning. */
+typedef int dummy;
+#endif
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/plural-exp.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/plural-exp.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c937c01
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/plural-exp.c
@@ -0,0 +1,156 @@
+/* Expression parsing for plural form selection.
+ Copyright (C) 2000, 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 2000.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+#include "plural-exp.h"
+
+#if (defined __GNUC__ && !defined __APPLE_CC__) \
+ || (defined __STDC_VERSION__ && __STDC_VERSION__ >= 199901L)
+
+/* These structs are the constant expression for the germanic plural
+ form determination. It represents the expression "n != 1". */
+static const struct expression plvar =
+{
+ .nargs = 0,
+ .operation = var,
+};
+static const struct expression plone =
+{
+ .nargs = 0,
+ .operation = num,
+ .val =
+ {
+ .num = 1
+ }
+};
+struct expression GERMANIC_PLURAL =
+{
+ .nargs = 2,
+ .operation = not_equal,
+ .val =
+ {
+ .args =
+ {
+ [0] = (struct expression *) &plvar,
+ [1] = (struct expression *) &plone
+ }
+ }
+};
+
+# define INIT_GERMANIC_PLURAL()
+
+#else
+
+/* For compilers without support for ISO C 99 struct/union initializers:
+ Initialization at run-time. */
+
+static struct expression plvar;
+static struct expression plone;
+struct expression GERMANIC_PLURAL;
+
+static void
+init_germanic_plural ()
+{
+ if (plone.val.num == 0)
+ {
+ plvar.nargs = 0;
+ plvar.operation = var;
+
+ plone.nargs = 0;
+ plone.operation = num;
+ plone.val.num = 1;
+
+ GERMANIC_PLURAL.nargs = 2;
+ GERMANIC_PLURAL.operation = not_equal;
+ GERMANIC_PLURAL.val.args[0] = &plvar;
+ GERMANIC_PLURAL.val.args[1] = &plone;
+ }
+}
+
+# define INIT_GERMANIC_PLURAL() init_germanic_plural ()
+
+#endif
+
+void
+internal_function
+EXTRACT_PLURAL_EXPRESSION (nullentry, pluralp, npluralsp)
+ const char *nullentry;
+ struct expression **pluralp;
+ unsigned long int *npluralsp;
+{
+ if (nullentry != NULL)
+ {
+ const char *plural;
+ const char *nplurals;
+
+ plural = strstr (nullentry, "plural=");
+ nplurals = strstr (nullentry, "nplurals=");
+ if (plural == NULL || nplurals == NULL)
+ goto no_plural;
+ else
+ {
+ char *endp;
+ unsigned long int n;
+ struct parse_args args;
+
+ /* First get the number. */
+ nplurals += 9;
+ while (*nplurals != '\0' && isspace ((unsigned char) *nplurals))
+ ++nplurals;
+ if (!(*nplurals >= '0' && *nplurals <= '9'))
+ goto no_plural;
+#if defined HAVE_STRTOUL || defined _LIBC
+ n = strtoul (nplurals, &endp, 10);
+#else
+ for (endp = nplurals, n = 0; *endp >= '0' && *endp <= '9'; endp++)
+ n = n * 10 + (*endp - '0');
+#endif
+ if (nplurals == endp)
+ goto no_plural;
+ *npluralsp = n;
+
+ /* Due to the restrictions bison imposes onto the interface of the
+ scanner function we have to put the input string and the result
+ passed up from the parser into the same structure which address
+ is passed down to the parser. */
+ plural += 7;
+ args.cp = plural;
+ if (PLURAL_PARSE (&args) != 0)
+ goto no_plural;
+ *pluralp = args.res;
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* By default we are using the Germanic form: singular form only
+ for `one', the plural form otherwise. Yes, this is also what
+ English is using since English is a Germanic language. */
+ no_plural:
+ INIT_GERMANIC_PLURAL ();
+ *pluralp = &GERMANIC_PLURAL;
+ *npluralsp = 2;
+ }
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/plural-exp.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/plural-exp.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9e5d165
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/plural-exp.h
@@ -0,0 +1,126 @@
+/* Expression parsing and evaluation for plural form selection.
+ Copyright (C) 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 2000.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+#ifndef _PLURAL_EXP_H
+#define _PLURAL_EXP_H
+
+#ifndef PARAMS
+# if __STDC__ || defined __GNUC__ || defined __SUNPRO_C || defined __cplusplus || __PROTOTYPES
+# define PARAMS(args) args
+# else
+# define PARAMS(args) ()
+# endif
+#endif
+
+#ifndef internal_function
+# define internal_function
+#endif
+
+#ifndef attribute_hidden
+# define attribute_hidden
+#endif
+
+
+/* This is the representation of the expressions to determine the
+ plural form. */
+struct expression
+{
+ int nargs; /* Number of arguments. */
+ enum operator
+ {
+ /* Without arguments: */
+ var, /* The variable "n". */
+ num, /* Decimal number. */
+ /* Unary operators: */
+ lnot, /* Logical NOT. */
+ /* Binary operators: */
+ mult, /* Multiplication. */
+ divide, /* Division. */
+ module, /* Modulo operation. */
+ plus, /* Addition. */
+ minus, /* Subtraction. */
+ less_than, /* Comparison. */
+ greater_than, /* Comparison. */
+ less_or_equal, /* Comparison. */
+ greater_or_equal, /* Comparison. */
+ equal, /* Comparison for equality. */
+ not_equal, /* Comparison for inequality. */
+ land, /* Logical AND. */
+ lor, /* Logical OR. */
+ /* Ternary operators: */
+ qmop /* Question mark operator. */
+ } operation;
+ union
+ {
+ unsigned long int num; /* Number value for `num'. */
+ struct expression *args[3]; /* Up to three arguments. */
+ } val;
+};
+
+/* This is the data structure to pass information to the parser and get
+ the result in a thread-safe way. */
+struct parse_args
+{
+ const char *cp;
+ struct expression *res;
+};
+
+
+/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. This source code is used
+ 1. in the GNU C Library library,
+ 2. in the GNU libintl library,
+ 3. in the GNU gettext tools.
+ The function names in each situation must be different, to allow for
+ binary incompatible changes in 'struct expression'. Furthermore,
+ 1. in the GNU C Library library, the names have a __ prefix,
+ 2.+3. in the GNU libintl library and in the GNU gettext tools, the names
+ must follow ANSI C and not start with __.
+ So we have to distinguish the three cases. */
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# define FREE_EXPRESSION __gettext_free_exp
+# define PLURAL_PARSE __gettextparse
+# define GERMANIC_PLURAL __gettext_germanic_plural
+# define EXTRACT_PLURAL_EXPRESSION __gettext_extract_plural
+#elif defined (IN_LIBINTL)
+# define FREE_EXPRESSION libintl_gettext_free_exp
+# define PLURAL_PARSE libintl_gettextparse
+# define GERMANIC_PLURAL libintl_gettext_germanic_plural
+# define EXTRACT_PLURAL_EXPRESSION libintl_gettext_extract_plural
+#else
+# define FREE_EXPRESSION free_plural_expression
+# define PLURAL_PARSE parse_plural_expression
+# define GERMANIC_PLURAL germanic_plural
+# define EXTRACT_PLURAL_EXPRESSION extract_plural_expression
+#endif
+
+extern void FREE_EXPRESSION PARAMS ((struct expression *exp))
+ internal_function;
+extern int PLURAL_PARSE PARAMS ((void *arg));
+extern struct expression GERMANIC_PLURAL attribute_hidden;
+extern void EXTRACT_PLURAL_EXPRESSION PARAMS ((const char *nullentry,
+ struct expression **pluralp,
+ unsigned long int *npluralsp))
+ internal_function;
+
+#if !defined (_LIBC) && !defined (IN_LIBINTL)
+extern unsigned long int plural_eval PARAMS ((struct expression *pexp,
+ unsigned long int n));
+#endif
+
+#endif /* _PLURAL_EXP_H */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/plural.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/plural.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3a4fa20
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/plural.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1518 @@
+/* A Bison parser, made from plural.y
+ by GNU bison 1.35. */
+
+#define YYBISON 1 /* Identify Bison output. */
+
+#define yyparse __gettextparse
+#define yylex __gettextlex
+#define yyerror __gettexterror
+#define yylval __gettextlval
+#define yychar __gettextchar
+#define yydebug __gettextdebug
+#define yynerrs __gettextnerrs
+# define EQUOP2 257
+# define CMPOP2 258
+# define ADDOP2 259
+# define MULOP2 260
+# define NUMBER 261
+
+#line 1 "plural.y"
+
+/* Expression parsing for plural form selection.
+ Copyright (C) 2000, 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 2000.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+/* The bison generated parser uses alloca. AIX 3 forces us to put this
+ declaration at the beginning of the file. The declaration in bison's
+ skeleton file comes too late. This must come before <config.h>
+ because <config.h> may include arbitrary system headers. */
+#if defined _AIX && !defined __GNUC__
+ #pragma alloca
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stddef.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include "plural-exp.h"
+
+/* The main function generated by the parser is called __gettextparse,
+ but we want it to be called PLURAL_PARSE. */
+#ifndef _LIBC
+# define __gettextparse PLURAL_PARSE
+#endif
+
+#define YYLEX_PARAM &((struct parse_args *) arg)->cp
+#define YYPARSE_PARAM arg
+
+#line 49 "plural.y"
+#ifndef YYSTYPE
+typedef union {
+ unsigned long int num;
+ enum operator op;
+ struct expression *exp;
+} yystype;
+# define YYSTYPE yystype
+# define YYSTYPE_IS_TRIVIAL 1
+#endif
+#line 55 "plural.y"
+
+/* Prototypes for local functions. */
+static struct expression *new_exp PARAMS ((int nargs, enum operator op,
+ struct expression * const *args));
+static inline struct expression *new_exp_0 PARAMS ((enum operator op));
+static inline struct expression *new_exp_1 PARAMS ((enum operator op,
+ struct expression *right));
+static struct expression *new_exp_2 PARAMS ((enum operator op,
+ struct expression *left,
+ struct expression *right));
+static inline struct expression *new_exp_3 PARAMS ((enum operator op,
+ struct expression *bexp,
+ struct expression *tbranch,
+ struct expression *fbranch));
+static int yylex PARAMS ((YYSTYPE *lval, const char **pexp));
+static void yyerror PARAMS ((const char *str));
+
+/* Allocation of expressions. */
+
+static struct expression *
+new_exp (nargs, op, args)
+ int nargs;
+ enum operator op;
+ struct expression * const *args;
+{
+ int i;
+ struct expression *newp;
+
+ /* If any of the argument could not be malloc'ed, just return NULL. */
+ for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; i--)
+ if (args[i] == NULL)
+ goto fail;
+
+ /* Allocate a new expression. */
+ newp = (struct expression *) malloc (sizeof (*newp));
+ if (newp != NULL)
+ {
+ newp->nargs = nargs;
+ newp->operation = op;
+ for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; i--)
+ newp->val.args[i] = args[i];
+ return newp;
+ }
+
+ fail:
+ for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; i--)
+ FREE_EXPRESSION (args[i]);
+
+ return NULL;
+}
+
+static inline struct expression *
+new_exp_0 (op)
+ enum operator op;
+{
+ return new_exp (0, op, NULL);
+}
+
+static inline struct expression *
+new_exp_1 (op, right)
+ enum operator op;
+ struct expression *right;
+{
+ struct expression *args[1];
+
+ args[0] = right;
+ return new_exp (1, op, args);
+}
+
+static struct expression *
+new_exp_2 (op, left, right)
+ enum operator op;
+ struct expression *left;
+ struct expression *right;
+{
+ struct expression *args[2];
+
+ args[0] = left;
+ args[1] = right;
+ return new_exp (2, op, args);
+}
+
+static inline struct expression *
+new_exp_3 (op, bexp, tbranch, fbranch)
+ enum operator op;
+ struct expression *bexp;
+ struct expression *tbranch;
+ struct expression *fbranch;
+{
+ struct expression *args[3];
+
+ args[0] = bexp;
+ args[1] = tbranch;
+ args[2] = fbranch;
+ return new_exp (3, op, args);
+}
+
+#ifndef YYDEBUG
+# define YYDEBUG 0
+#endif
+
+
+
+#define YYFINAL 27
+#define YYFLAG -32768
+#define YYNTBASE 16
+
+/* YYTRANSLATE(YYLEX) -- Bison token number corresponding to YYLEX. */
+#define YYTRANSLATE(x) ((unsigned)(x) <= 261 ? yytranslate[x] : 18)
+
+/* YYTRANSLATE[YYLEX] -- Bison token number corresponding to YYLEX. */
+static const char yytranslate[] =
+{
+ 0, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2,
+ 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2,
+ 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2,
+ 2, 2, 2, 10, 2, 2, 2, 2, 5, 2,
+ 14, 15, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2,
+ 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 12, 2,
+ 2, 2, 2, 3, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2,
+ 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2,
+ 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2,
+ 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2,
+ 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2,
+ 13, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2,
+ 2, 2, 2, 2, 4, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2,
+ 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2,
+ 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2,
+ 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2,
+ 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2,
+ 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2,
+ 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2,
+ 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2,
+ 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2,
+ 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2,
+ 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2,
+ 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2,
+ 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2,
+ 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 1, 6, 7, 8,
+ 9, 11
+};
+
+#if YYDEBUG
+static const short yyprhs[] =
+{
+ 0, 0, 2, 8, 12, 16, 20, 24, 28, 32,
+ 35, 37, 39
+};
+static const short yyrhs[] =
+{
+ 17, 0, 17, 3, 17, 12, 17, 0, 17, 4,
+ 17, 0, 17, 5, 17, 0, 17, 6, 17, 0,
+ 17, 7, 17, 0, 17, 8, 17, 0, 17, 9,
+ 17, 0, 10, 17, 0, 13, 0, 11, 0, 14,
+ 17, 15, 0
+};
+
+#endif
+
+#if YYDEBUG
+/* YYRLINE[YYN] -- source line where rule number YYN was defined. */
+static const short yyrline[] =
+{
+ 0, 174, 182, 186, 190, 194, 198, 202, 206, 210,
+ 214, 218, 223
+};
+#endif
+
+
+#if (YYDEBUG) || defined YYERROR_VERBOSE
+
+/* YYTNAME[TOKEN_NUM] -- String name of the token TOKEN_NUM. */
+static const char *const yytname[] =
+{
+ "$", "error", "$undefined.", "'?'", "'|'", "'&'", "EQUOP2", "CMPOP2",
+ "ADDOP2", "MULOP2", "'!'", "NUMBER", "':'", "'n'", "'('", "')'",
+ "start", "exp", 0
+};
+#endif
+
+/* YYR1[YYN] -- Symbol number of symbol that rule YYN derives. */
+static const short yyr1[] =
+{
+ 0, 16, 17, 17, 17, 17, 17, 17, 17, 17,
+ 17, 17, 17
+};
+
+/* YYR2[YYN] -- Number of symbols composing right hand side of rule YYN. */
+static const short yyr2[] =
+{
+ 0, 1, 5, 3, 3, 3, 3, 3, 3, 2,
+ 1, 1, 3
+};
+
+/* YYDEFACT[S] -- default rule to reduce with in state S when YYTABLE
+ doesn't specify something else to do. Zero means the default is an
+ error. */
+static const short yydefact[] =
+{
+ 0, 0, 11, 10, 0, 1, 9, 0, 0, 0,
+ 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 12, 0, 3, 4, 5,
+ 6, 7, 8, 0, 2, 0, 0, 0
+};
+
+static const short yydefgoto[] =
+{
+ 25, 5
+};
+
+static const short yypact[] =
+{
+ -9, -9,-32768,-32768, -9, 34,-32768, 11, -9, -9,
+ -9, -9, -9, -9, -9,-32768, 24, 39, 43, 16,
+ 26, -3,-32768, -9, 34, 21, 53,-32768
+};
+
+static const short yypgoto[] =
+{
+ -32768, -1
+};
+
+
+#define YYLAST 53
+
+
+static const short yytable[] =
+{
+ 6, 1, 2, 7, 3, 4, 14, 16, 17, 18,
+ 19, 20, 21, 22, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13,
+ 14, 26, 24, 12, 13, 14, 15, 8, 9, 10,
+ 11, 12, 13, 14, 13, 14, 23, 8, 9, 10,
+ 11, 12, 13, 14, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 11,
+ 12, 13, 14, 27
+};
+
+static const short yycheck[] =
+{
+ 1, 10, 11, 4, 13, 14, 9, 8, 9, 10,
+ 11, 12, 13, 14, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8,
+ 9, 0, 23, 7, 8, 9, 15, 3, 4, 5,
+ 6, 7, 8, 9, 8, 9, 12, 3, 4, 5,
+ 6, 7, 8, 9, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 6,
+ 7, 8, 9, 0
+};
+#define YYPURE 1
+
+/* -*-C-*- Note some compilers choke on comments on `#line' lines. */
+#line 3 "/usr/local/share/bison/bison.simple"
+
+/* Skeleton output parser for bison,
+
+ Copyright (C) 1984, 1989, 1990, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
+ Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
+
+/* As a special exception, when this file is copied by Bison into a
+ Bison output file, you may use that output file without restriction.
+ This special exception was added by the Free Software Foundation
+ in version 1.24 of Bison. */
+
+/* This is the parser code that is written into each bison parser when
+ the %semantic_parser declaration is not specified in the grammar.
+ It was written by Richard Stallman by simplifying the hairy parser
+ used when %semantic_parser is specified. */
+
+/* All symbols defined below should begin with yy or YY, to avoid
+ infringing on user name space. This should be done even for local
+ variables, as they might otherwise be expanded by user macros.
+ There are some unavoidable exceptions within include files to
+ define necessary library symbols; they are noted "INFRINGES ON
+ USER NAME SPACE" below. */
+
+#if ! defined (yyoverflow) || defined (YYERROR_VERBOSE)
+
+/* The parser invokes alloca or malloc; define the necessary symbols. */
+
+# if YYSTACK_USE_ALLOCA
+# define YYSTACK_ALLOC alloca
+# else
+# ifndef YYSTACK_USE_ALLOCA
+# if defined (alloca) || defined (_ALLOCA_H)
+# define YYSTACK_ALLOC alloca
+# else
+# ifdef __GNUC__
+# define YYSTACK_ALLOC __builtin_alloca
+# endif
+# endif
+# endif
+# endif
+
+# ifdef YYSTACK_ALLOC
+ /* Pacify GCC's `empty if-body' warning. */
+# define YYSTACK_FREE(Ptr) do { /* empty */; } while (0)
+# else
+# if defined (__STDC__) || defined (__cplusplus)
+# include <stdlib.h> /* INFRINGES ON USER NAME SPACE */
+# define YYSIZE_T size_t
+# endif
+# define YYSTACK_ALLOC malloc
+# define YYSTACK_FREE free
+# endif
+#endif /* ! defined (yyoverflow) || defined (YYERROR_VERBOSE) */
+
+
+#if (! defined (yyoverflow) \
+ && (! defined (__cplusplus) \
+ || (YYLTYPE_IS_TRIVIAL && YYSTYPE_IS_TRIVIAL)))
+
+/* A type that is properly aligned for any stack member. */
+union yyalloc
+{
+ short yyss;
+ YYSTYPE yyvs;
+# if YYLSP_NEEDED
+ YYLTYPE yyls;
+# endif
+};
+
+/* The size of the maximum gap between one aligned stack and the next. */
+# define YYSTACK_GAP_MAX (sizeof (union yyalloc) - 1)
+
+/* The size of an array large to enough to hold all stacks, each with
+ N elements. */
+# if YYLSP_NEEDED
+# define YYSTACK_BYTES(N) \
+ ((N) * (sizeof (short) + sizeof (YYSTYPE) + sizeof (YYLTYPE)) \
+ + 2 * YYSTACK_GAP_MAX)
+# else
+# define YYSTACK_BYTES(N) \
+ ((N) * (sizeof (short) + sizeof (YYSTYPE)) \
+ + YYSTACK_GAP_MAX)
+# endif
+
+/* Copy COUNT objects from FROM to TO. The source and destination do
+ not overlap. */
+# ifndef YYCOPY
+# if 1 < __GNUC__
+# define YYCOPY(To, From, Count) \
+ __builtin_memcpy (To, From, (Count) * sizeof (*(From)))
+# else
+# define YYCOPY(To, From, Count) \
+ do \
+ { \
+ register YYSIZE_T yyi; \
+ for (yyi = 0; yyi < (Count); yyi++) \
+ (To)[yyi] = (From)[yyi]; \
+ } \
+ while (0)
+# endif
+# endif
+
+/* Relocate STACK from its old location to the new one. The
+ local variables YYSIZE and YYSTACKSIZE give the old and new number of
+ elements in the stack, and YYPTR gives the new location of the
+ stack. Advance YYPTR to a properly aligned location for the next
+ stack. */
+# define YYSTACK_RELOCATE(Stack) \
+ do \
+ { \
+ YYSIZE_T yynewbytes; \
+ YYCOPY (&yyptr->Stack, Stack, yysize); \
+ Stack = &yyptr->Stack; \
+ yynewbytes = yystacksize * sizeof (*Stack) + YYSTACK_GAP_MAX; \
+ yyptr += yynewbytes / sizeof (*yyptr); \
+ } \
+ while (0)
+
+#endif
+
+
+#if ! defined (YYSIZE_T) && defined (__SIZE_TYPE__)
+# define YYSIZE_T __SIZE_TYPE__
+#endif
+#if ! defined (YYSIZE_T) && defined (size_t)
+# define YYSIZE_T size_t
+#endif
+#if ! defined (YYSIZE_T)
+# if defined (__STDC__) || defined (__cplusplus)
+# include <stddef.h> /* INFRINGES ON USER NAME SPACE */
+# define YYSIZE_T size_t
+# endif
+#endif
+#if ! defined (YYSIZE_T)
+# define YYSIZE_T unsigned int
+#endif
+
+#define yyerrok (yyerrstatus = 0)
+#define yyclearin (yychar = YYEMPTY)
+#define YYEMPTY -2
+#define YYEOF 0
+#define YYACCEPT goto yyacceptlab
+#define YYABORT goto yyabortlab
+#define YYERROR goto yyerrlab1
+/* Like YYERROR except do call yyerror. This remains here temporarily
+ to ease the transition to the new meaning of YYERROR, for GCC.
+ Once GCC version 2 has supplanted version 1, this can go. */
+#define YYFAIL goto yyerrlab
+#define YYRECOVERING() (!!yyerrstatus)
+#define YYBACKUP(Token, Value) \
+do \
+ if (yychar == YYEMPTY && yylen == 1) \
+ { \
+ yychar = (Token); \
+ yylval = (Value); \
+ yychar1 = YYTRANSLATE (yychar); \
+ YYPOPSTACK; \
+ goto yybackup; \
+ } \
+ else \
+ { \
+ yyerror ("syntax error: cannot back up"); \
+ YYERROR; \
+ } \
+while (0)
+
+#define YYTERROR 1
+#define YYERRCODE 256
+
+
+/* YYLLOC_DEFAULT -- Compute the default location (before the actions
+ are run).
+
+ When YYLLOC_DEFAULT is run, CURRENT is set the location of the
+ first token. By default, to implement support for ranges, extend
+ its range to the last symbol. */
+
+#ifndef YYLLOC_DEFAULT
+# define YYLLOC_DEFAULT(Current, Rhs, N) \
+ Current.last_line = Rhs[N].last_line; \
+ Current.last_column = Rhs[N].last_column;
+#endif
+
+
+/* YYLEX -- calling `yylex' with the right arguments. */
+
+#if YYPURE
+# if YYLSP_NEEDED
+# ifdef YYLEX_PARAM
+# define YYLEX yylex (&yylval, &yylloc, YYLEX_PARAM)
+# else
+# define YYLEX yylex (&yylval, &yylloc)
+# endif
+# else /* !YYLSP_NEEDED */
+# ifdef YYLEX_PARAM
+# define YYLEX yylex (&yylval, YYLEX_PARAM)
+# else
+# define YYLEX yylex (&yylval)
+# endif
+# endif /* !YYLSP_NEEDED */
+#else /* !YYPURE */
+# define YYLEX yylex ()
+#endif /* !YYPURE */
+
+
+/* Enable debugging if requested. */
+#if YYDEBUG
+
+# ifndef YYFPRINTF
+# include <stdio.h> /* INFRINGES ON USER NAME SPACE */
+# define YYFPRINTF fprintf
+# endif
+
+# define YYDPRINTF(Args) \
+do { \
+ if (yydebug) \
+ YYFPRINTF Args; \
+} while (0)
+/* Nonzero means print parse trace. It is left uninitialized so that
+ multiple parsers can coexist. */
+int yydebug;
+#else /* !YYDEBUG */
+# define YYDPRINTF(Args)
+#endif /* !YYDEBUG */
+
+/* YYINITDEPTH -- initial size of the parser's stacks. */
+#ifndef YYINITDEPTH
+# define YYINITDEPTH 200
+#endif
+
+/* YYMAXDEPTH -- maximum size the stacks can grow to (effective only
+ if the built-in stack extension method is used).
+
+ Do not make this value too large; the results are undefined if
+ SIZE_MAX < YYSTACK_BYTES (YYMAXDEPTH)
+ evaluated with infinite-precision integer arithmetic. */
+
+#if YYMAXDEPTH == 0
+# undef YYMAXDEPTH
+#endif
+
+#ifndef YYMAXDEPTH
+# define YYMAXDEPTH 10000
+#endif
+
+#ifdef YYERROR_VERBOSE
+
+# ifndef yystrlen
+# if defined (__GLIBC__) && defined (_STRING_H)
+# define yystrlen strlen
+# else
+/* Return the length of YYSTR. */
+static YYSIZE_T
+# if defined (__STDC__) || defined (__cplusplus)
+yystrlen (const char *yystr)
+# else
+yystrlen (yystr)
+ const char *yystr;
+# endif
+{
+ register const char *yys = yystr;
+
+ while (*yys++ != '\0')
+ continue;
+
+ return yys - yystr - 1;
+}
+# endif
+# endif
+
+# ifndef yystpcpy
+# if defined (__GLIBC__) && defined (_STRING_H) && defined (_GNU_SOURCE)
+# define yystpcpy stpcpy
+# else
+/* Copy YYSRC to YYDEST, returning the address of the terminating '\0' in
+ YYDEST. */
+static char *
+# if defined (__STDC__) || defined (__cplusplus)
+yystpcpy (char *yydest, const char *yysrc)
+# else
+yystpcpy (yydest, yysrc)
+ char *yydest;
+ const char *yysrc;
+# endif
+{
+ register char *yyd = yydest;
+ register const char *yys = yysrc;
+
+ while ((*yyd++ = *yys++) != '\0')
+ continue;
+
+ return yyd - 1;
+}
+# endif
+# endif
+#endif
+
+#line 315 "/usr/local/share/bison/bison.simple"
+
+
+/* The user can define YYPARSE_PARAM as the name of an argument to be passed
+ into yyparse. The argument should have type void *.
+ It should actually point to an object.
+ Grammar actions can access the variable by casting it
+ to the proper pointer type. */
+
+#ifdef YYPARSE_PARAM
+# if defined (__STDC__) || defined (__cplusplus)
+# define YYPARSE_PARAM_ARG void *YYPARSE_PARAM
+# define YYPARSE_PARAM_DECL
+# else
+# define YYPARSE_PARAM_ARG YYPARSE_PARAM
+# define YYPARSE_PARAM_DECL void *YYPARSE_PARAM;
+# endif
+#else /* !YYPARSE_PARAM */
+# define YYPARSE_PARAM_ARG
+# define YYPARSE_PARAM_DECL
+#endif /* !YYPARSE_PARAM */
+
+/* Prevent warning if -Wstrict-prototypes. */
+#ifdef __GNUC__
+# ifdef YYPARSE_PARAM
+int yyparse (void *);
+# else
+int yyparse (void);
+# endif
+#endif
+
+/* YY_DECL_VARIABLES -- depending whether we use a pure parser,
+ variables are global, or local to YYPARSE. */
+
+#define YY_DECL_NON_LSP_VARIABLES \
+/* The lookahead symbol. */ \
+int yychar; \
+ \
+/* The semantic value of the lookahead symbol. */ \
+YYSTYPE yylval; \
+ \
+/* Number of parse errors so far. */ \
+int yynerrs;
+
+#if YYLSP_NEEDED
+# define YY_DECL_VARIABLES \
+YY_DECL_NON_LSP_VARIABLES \
+ \
+/* Location data for the lookahead symbol. */ \
+YYLTYPE yylloc;
+#else
+# define YY_DECL_VARIABLES \
+YY_DECL_NON_LSP_VARIABLES
+#endif
+
+
+/* If nonreentrant, generate the variables here. */
+
+#if !YYPURE
+YY_DECL_VARIABLES
+#endif /* !YYPURE */
+
+int
+yyparse (YYPARSE_PARAM_ARG)
+ YYPARSE_PARAM_DECL
+{
+ /* If reentrant, generate the variables here. */
+#if YYPURE
+ YY_DECL_VARIABLES
+#endif /* !YYPURE */
+
+ register int yystate;
+ register int yyn;
+ int yyresult;
+ /* Number of tokens to shift before error messages enabled. */
+ int yyerrstatus;
+ /* Lookahead token as an internal (translated) token number. */
+ int yychar1 = 0;
+
+ /* Three stacks and their tools:
+ `yyss': related to states,
+ `yyvs': related to semantic values,
+ `yyls': related to locations.
+
+ Refer to the stacks thru separate pointers, to allow yyoverflow
+ to reallocate them elsewhere. */
+
+ /* The state stack. */
+ short yyssa[YYINITDEPTH];
+ short *yyss = yyssa;
+ register short *yyssp;
+
+ /* The semantic value stack. */
+ YYSTYPE yyvsa[YYINITDEPTH];
+ YYSTYPE *yyvs = yyvsa;
+ register YYSTYPE *yyvsp;
+
+#if YYLSP_NEEDED
+ /* The location stack. */
+ YYLTYPE yylsa[YYINITDEPTH];
+ YYLTYPE *yyls = yylsa;
+ YYLTYPE *yylsp;
+#endif
+
+#if YYLSP_NEEDED
+# define YYPOPSTACK (yyvsp--, yyssp--, yylsp--)
+#else
+# define YYPOPSTACK (yyvsp--, yyssp--)
+#endif
+
+ YYSIZE_T yystacksize = YYINITDEPTH;
+
+
+ /* The variables used to return semantic value and location from the
+ action routines. */
+ YYSTYPE yyval;
+#if YYLSP_NEEDED
+ YYLTYPE yyloc;
+#endif
+
+ /* When reducing, the number of symbols on the RHS of the reduced
+ rule. */
+ int yylen;
+
+ YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Starting parse\n"));
+
+ yystate = 0;
+ yyerrstatus = 0;
+ yynerrs = 0;
+ yychar = YYEMPTY; /* Cause a token to be read. */
+
+ /* Initialize stack pointers.
+ Waste one element of value and location stack
+ so that they stay on the same level as the state stack.
+ The wasted elements are never initialized. */
+
+ yyssp = yyss;
+ yyvsp = yyvs;
+#if YYLSP_NEEDED
+ yylsp = yyls;
+#endif
+ goto yysetstate;
+
+/*------------------------------------------------------------.
+| yynewstate -- Push a new state, which is found in yystate. |
+`------------------------------------------------------------*/
+ yynewstate:
+ /* In all cases, when you get here, the value and location stacks
+ have just been pushed. so pushing a state here evens the stacks.
+ */
+ yyssp++;
+
+ yysetstate:
+ *yyssp = yystate;
+
+ if (yyssp >= yyss + yystacksize - 1)
+ {
+ /* Get the current used size of the three stacks, in elements. */
+ YYSIZE_T yysize = yyssp - yyss + 1;
+
+#ifdef yyoverflow
+ {
+ /* Give user a chance to reallocate the stack. Use copies of
+ these so that the &'s don't force the real ones into
+ memory. */
+ YYSTYPE *yyvs1 = yyvs;
+ short *yyss1 = yyss;
+
+ /* Each stack pointer address is followed by the size of the
+ data in use in that stack, in bytes. */
+# if YYLSP_NEEDED
+ YYLTYPE *yyls1 = yyls;
+ /* This used to be a conditional around just the two extra args,
+ but that might be undefined if yyoverflow is a macro. */
+ yyoverflow ("parser stack overflow",
+ &yyss1, yysize * sizeof (*yyssp),
+ &yyvs1, yysize * sizeof (*yyvsp),
+ &yyls1, yysize * sizeof (*yylsp),
+ &yystacksize);
+ yyls = yyls1;
+# else
+ yyoverflow ("parser stack overflow",
+ &yyss1, yysize * sizeof (*yyssp),
+ &yyvs1, yysize * sizeof (*yyvsp),
+ &yystacksize);
+# endif
+ yyss = yyss1;
+ yyvs = yyvs1;
+ }
+#else /* no yyoverflow */
+# ifndef YYSTACK_RELOCATE
+ goto yyoverflowlab;
+# else
+ /* Extend the stack our own way. */
+ if (yystacksize >= YYMAXDEPTH)
+ goto yyoverflowlab;
+ yystacksize *= 2;
+ if (yystacksize > YYMAXDEPTH)
+ yystacksize = YYMAXDEPTH;
+
+ {
+ short *yyss1 = yyss;
+ union yyalloc *yyptr =
+ (union yyalloc *) YYSTACK_ALLOC (YYSTACK_BYTES (yystacksize));
+ if (! yyptr)
+ goto yyoverflowlab;
+ YYSTACK_RELOCATE (yyss);
+ YYSTACK_RELOCATE (yyvs);
+# if YYLSP_NEEDED
+ YYSTACK_RELOCATE (yyls);
+# endif
+# undef YYSTACK_RELOCATE
+ if (yyss1 != yyssa)
+ YYSTACK_FREE (yyss1);
+ }
+# endif
+#endif /* no yyoverflow */
+
+ yyssp = yyss + yysize - 1;
+ yyvsp = yyvs + yysize - 1;
+#if YYLSP_NEEDED
+ yylsp = yyls + yysize - 1;
+#endif
+
+ YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Stack size increased to %lu\n",
+ (unsigned long int) yystacksize));
+
+ if (yyssp >= yyss + yystacksize - 1)
+ YYABORT;
+ }
+
+ YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Entering state %d\n", yystate));
+
+ goto yybackup;
+
+
+/*-----------.
+| yybackup. |
+`-----------*/
+yybackup:
+
+/* Do appropriate processing given the current state. */
+/* Read a lookahead token if we need one and don't already have one. */
+/* yyresume: */
+
+ /* First try to decide what to do without reference to lookahead token. */
+
+ yyn = yypact[yystate];
+ if (yyn == YYFLAG)
+ goto yydefault;
+
+ /* Not known => get a lookahead token if don't already have one. */
+
+ /* yychar is either YYEMPTY or YYEOF
+ or a valid token in external form. */
+
+ if (yychar == YYEMPTY)
+ {
+ YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Reading a token: "));
+ yychar = YYLEX;
+ }
+
+ /* Convert token to internal form (in yychar1) for indexing tables with */
+
+ if (yychar <= 0) /* This means end of input. */
+ {
+ yychar1 = 0;
+ yychar = YYEOF; /* Don't call YYLEX any more */
+
+ YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Now at end of input.\n"));
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ yychar1 = YYTRANSLATE (yychar);
+
+#if YYDEBUG
+ /* We have to keep this `#if YYDEBUG', since we use variables
+ which are defined only if `YYDEBUG' is set. */
+ if (yydebug)
+ {
+ YYFPRINTF (stderr, "Next token is %d (%s",
+ yychar, yytname[yychar1]);
+ /* Give the individual parser a way to print the precise
+ meaning of a token, for further debugging info. */
+# ifdef YYPRINT
+ YYPRINT (stderr, yychar, yylval);
+# endif
+ YYFPRINTF (stderr, ")\n");
+ }
+#endif
+ }
+
+ yyn += yychar1;
+ if (yyn < 0 || yyn > YYLAST || yycheck[yyn] != yychar1)
+ goto yydefault;
+
+ yyn = yytable[yyn];
+
+ /* yyn is what to do for this token type in this state.
+ Negative => reduce, -yyn is rule number.
+ Positive => shift, yyn is new state.
+ New state is final state => don't bother to shift,
+ just return success.
+ 0, or most negative number => error. */
+
+ if (yyn < 0)
+ {
+ if (yyn == YYFLAG)
+ goto yyerrlab;
+ yyn = -yyn;
+ goto yyreduce;
+ }
+ else if (yyn == 0)
+ goto yyerrlab;
+
+ if (yyn == YYFINAL)
+ YYACCEPT;
+
+ /* Shift the lookahead token. */
+ YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Shifting token %d (%s), ",
+ yychar, yytname[yychar1]));
+
+ /* Discard the token being shifted unless it is eof. */
+ if (yychar != YYEOF)
+ yychar = YYEMPTY;
+
+ *++yyvsp = yylval;
+#if YYLSP_NEEDED
+ *++yylsp = yylloc;
+#endif
+
+ /* Count tokens shifted since error; after three, turn off error
+ status. */
+ if (yyerrstatus)
+ yyerrstatus--;
+
+ yystate = yyn;
+ goto yynewstate;
+
+
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------.
+| yydefault -- do the default action for the current state. |
+`-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+yydefault:
+ yyn = yydefact[yystate];
+ if (yyn == 0)
+ goto yyerrlab;
+ goto yyreduce;
+
+
+/*-----------------------------.
+| yyreduce -- Do a reduction. |
+`-----------------------------*/
+yyreduce:
+ /* yyn is the number of a rule to reduce with. */
+ yylen = yyr2[yyn];
+
+ /* If YYLEN is nonzero, implement the default value of the action:
+ `$$ = $1'.
+
+ Otherwise, the following line sets YYVAL to the semantic value of
+ the lookahead token. This behavior is undocumented and Bison
+ users should not rely upon it. Assigning to YYVAL
+ unconditionally makes the parser a bit smaller, and it avoids a
+ GCC warning that YYVAL may be used uninitialized. */
+ yyval = yyvsp[1-yylen];
+
+#if YYLSP_NEEDED
+ /* Similarly for the default location. Let the user run additional
+ commands if for instance locations are ranges. */
+ yyloc = yylsp[1-yylen];
+ YYLLOC_DEFAULT (yyloc, (yylsp - yylen), yylen);
+#endif
+
+#if YYDEBUG
+ /* We have to keep this `#if YYDEBUG', since we use variables which
+ are defined only if `YYDEBUG' is set. */
+ if (yydebug)
+ {
+ int yyi;
+
+ YYFPRINTF (stderr, "Reducing via rule %d (line %d), ",
+ yyn, yyrline[yyn]);
+
+ /* Print the symbols being reduced, and their result. */
+ for (yyi = yyprhs[yyn]; yyrhs[yyi] > 0; yyi++)
+ YYFPRINTF (stderr, "%s ", yytname[yyrhs[yyi]]);
+ YYFPRINTF (stderr, " -> %s\n", yytname[yyr1[yyn]]);
+ }
+#endif
+
+ switch (yyn) {
+
+case 1:
+#line 175 "plural.y"
+{
+ if (yyvsp[0].exp == NULL)
+ YYABORT;
+ ((struct parse_args *) arg)->res = yyvsp[0].exp;
+ }
+ break;
+case 2:
+#line 183 "plural.y"
+{
+ yyval.exp = new_exp_3 (qmop, yyvsp[-4].exp, yyvsp[-2].exp, yyvsp[0].exp);
+ }
+ break;
+case 3:
+#line 187 "plural.y"
+{
+ yyval.exp = new_exp_2 (lor, yyvsp[-2].exp, yyvsp[0].exp);
+ }
+ break;
+case 4:
+#line 191 "plural.y"
+{
+ yyval.exp = new_exp_2 (land, yyvsp[-2].exp, yyvsp[0].exp);
+ }
+ break;
+case 5:
+#line 195 "plural.y"
+{
+ yyval.exp = new_exp_2 (yyvsp[-1].op, yyvsp[-2].exp, yyvsp[0].exp);
+ }
+ break;
+case 6:
+#line 199 "plural.y"
+{
+ yyval.exp = new_exp_2 (yyvsp[-1].op, yyvsp[-2].exp, yyvsp[0].exp);
+ }
+ break;
+case 7:
+#line 203 "plural.y"
+{
+ yyval.exp = new_exp_2 (yyvsp[-1].op, yyvsp[-2].exp, yyvsp[0].exp);
+ }
+ break;
+case 8:
+#line 207 "plural.y"
+{
+ yyval.exp = new_exp_2 (yyvsp[-1].op, yyvsp[-2].exp, yyvsp[0].exp);
+ }
+ break;
+case 9:
+#line 211 "plural.y"
+{
+ yyval.exp = new_exp_1 (lnot, yyvsp[0].exp);
+ }
+ break;
+case 10:
+#line 215 "plural.y"
+{
+ yyval.exp = new_exp_0 (var);
+ }
+ break;
+case 11:
+#line 219 "plural.y"
+{
+ if ((yyval.exp = new_exp_0 (num)) != NULL)
+ yyval.exp->val.num = yyvsp[0].num;
+ }
+ break;
+case 12:
+#line 224 "plural.y"
+{
+ yyval.exp = yyvsp[-1].exp;
+ }
+ break;
+}
+
+#line 705 "/usr/local/share/bison/bison.simple"
+
+
+ yyvsp -= yylen;
+ yyssp -= yylen;
+#if YYLSP_NEEDED
+ yylsp -= yylen;
+#endif
+
+#if YYDEBUG
+ if (yydebug)
+ {
+ short *yyssp1 = yyss - 1;
+ YYFPRINTF (stderr, "state stack now");
+ while (yyssp1 != yyssp)
+ YYFPRINTF (stderr, " %d", *++yyssp1);
+ YYFPRINTF (stderr, "\n");
+ }
+#endif
+
+ *++yyvsp = yyval;
+#if YYLSP_NEEDED
+ *++yylsp = yyloc;
+#endif
+
+ /* Now `shift' the result of the reduction. Determine what state
+ that goes to, based on the state we popped back to and the rule
+ number reduced by. */
+
+ yyn = yyr1[yyn];
+
+ yystate = yypgoto[yyn - YYNTBASE] + *yyssp;
+ if (yystate >= 0 && yystate <= YYLAST && yycheck[yystate] == *yyssp)
+ yystate = yytable[yystate];
+ else
+ yystate = yydefgoto[yyn - YYNTBASE];
+
+ goto yynewstate;
+
+
+/*------------------------------------.
+| yyerrlab -- here on detecting error |
+`------------------------------------*/
+yyerrlab:
+ /* If not already recovering from an error, report this error. */
+ if (!yyerrstatus)
+ {
+ ++yynerrs;
+
+#ifdef YYERROR_VERBOSE
+ yyn = yypact[yystate];
+
+ if (yyn > YYFLAG && yyn < YYLAST)
+ {
+ YYSIZE_T yysize = 0;
+ char *yymsg;
+ int yyx, yycount;
+
+ yycount = 0;
+ /* Start YYX at -YYN if negative to avoid negative indexes in
+ YYCHECK. */
+ for (yyx = yyn < 0 ? -yyn : 0;
+ yyx < (int) (sizeof (yytname) / sizeof (char *)); yyx++)
+ if (yycheck[yyx + yyn] == yyx)
+ yysize += yystrlen (yytname[yyx]) + 15, yycount++;
+ yysize += yystrlen ("parse error, unexpected ") + 1;
+ yysize += yystrlen (yytname[YYTRANSLATE (yychar)]);
+ yymsg = (char *) YYSTACK_ALLOC (yysize);
+ if (yymsg != 0)
+ {
+ char *yyp = yystpcpy (yymsg, "parse error, unexpected ");
+ yyp = yystpcpy (yyp, yytname[YYTRANSLATE (yychar)]);
+
+ if (yycount < 5)
+ {
+ yycount = 0;
+ for (yyx = yyn < 0 ? -yyn : 0;
+ yyx < (int) (sizeof (yytname) / sizeof (char *));
+ yyx++)
+ if (yycheck[yyx + yyn] == yyx)
+ {
+ const char *yyq = ! yycount ? ", expecting " : " or ";
+ yyp = yystpcpy (yyp, yyq);
+ yyp = yystpcpy (yyp, yytname[yyx]);
+ yycount++;
+ }
+ }
+ yyerror (yymsg);
+ YYSTACK_FREE (yymsg);
+ }
+ else
+ yyerror ("parse error; also virtual memory exhausted");
+ }
+ else
+#endif /* defined (YYERROR_VERBOSE) */
+ yyerror ("parse error");
+ }
+ goto yyerrlab1;
+
+
+/*--------------------------------------------------.
+| yyerrlab1 -- error raised explicitly by an action |
+`--------------------------------------------------*/
+yyerrlab1:
+ if (yyerrstatus == 3)
+ {
+ /* If just tried and failed to reuse lookahead token after an
+ error, discard it. */
+
+ /* return failure if at end of input */
+ if (yychar == YYEOF)
+ YYABORT;
+ YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Discarding token %d (%s).\n",
+ yychar, yytname[yychar1]));
+ yychar = YYEMPTY;
+ }
+
+ /* Else will try to reuse lookahead token after shifting the error
+ token. */
+
+ yyerrstatus = 3; /* Each real token shifted decrements this */
+
+ goto yyerrhandle;
+
+
+/*-------------------------------------------------------------------.
+| yyerrdefault -- current state does not do anything special for the |
+| error token. |
+`-------------------------------------------------------------------*/
+yyerrdefault:
+#if 0
+ /* This is wrong; only states that explicitly want error tokens
+ should shift them. */
+
+ /* If its default is to accept any token, ok. Otherwise pop it. */
+ yyn = yydefact[yystate];
+ if (yyn)
+ goto yydefault;
+#endif
+
+
+/*---------------------------------------------------------------.
+| yyerrpop -- pop the current state because it cannot handle the |
+| error token |
+`---------------------------------------------------------------*/
+yyerrpop:
+ if (yyssp == yyss)
+ YYABORT;
+ yyvsp--;
+ yystate = *--yyssp;
+#if YYLSP_NEEDED
+ yylsp--;
+#endif
+
+#if YYDEBUG
+ if (yydebug)
+ {
+ short *yyssp1 = yyss - 1;
+ YYFPRINTF (stderr, "Error: state stack now");
+ while (yyssp1 != yyssp)
+ YYFPRINTF (stderr, " %d", *++yyssp1);
+ YYFPRINTF (stderr, "\n");
+ }
+#endif
+
+/*--------------.
+| yyerrhandle. |
+`--------------*/
+yyerrhandle:
+ yyn = yypact[yystate];
+ if (yyn == YYFLAG)
+ goto yyerrdefault;
+
+ yyn += YYTERROR;
+ if (yyn < 0 || yyn > YYLAST || yycheck[yyn] != YYTERROR)
+ goto yyerrdefault;
+
+ yyn = yytable[yyn];
+ if (yyn < 0)
+ {
+ if (yyn == YYFLAG)
+ goto yyerrpop;
+ yyn = -yyn;
+ goto yyreduce;
+ }
+ else if (yyn == 0)
+ goto yyerrpop;
+
+ if (yyn == YYFINAL)
+ YYACCEPT;
+
+ YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Shifting error token, "));
+
+ *++yyvsp = yylval;
+#if YYLSP_NEEDED
+ *++yylsp = yylloc;
+#endif
+
+ yystate = yyn;
+ goto yynewstate;
+
+
+/*-------------------------------------.
+| yyacceptlab -- YYACCEPT comes here. |
+`-------------------------------------*/
+yyacceptlab:
+ yyresult = 0;
+ goto yyreturn;
+
+/*-----------------------------------.
+| yyabortlab -- YYABORT comes here. |
+`-----------------------------------*/
+yyabortlab:
+ yyresult = 1;
+ goto yyreturn;
+
+/*---------------------------------------------.
+| yyoverflowab -- parser overflow comes here. |
+`---------------------------------------------*/
+yyoverflowlab:
+ yyerror ("parser stack overflow");
+ yyresult = 2;
+ /* Fall through. */
+
+yyreturn:
+#ifndef yyoverflow
+ if (yyss != yyssa)
+ YYSTACK_FREE (yyss);
+#endif
+ return yyresult;
+}
+#line 229 "plural.y"
+
+
+void
+internal_function
+FREE_EXPRESSION (exp)
+ struct expression *exp;
+{
+ if (exp == NULL)
+ return;
+
+ /* Handle the recursive case. */
+ switch (exp->nargs)
+ {
+ case 3:
+ FREE_EXPRESSION (exp->val.args[2]);
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ case 2:
+ FREE_EXPRESSION (exp->val.args[1]);
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ case 1:
+ FREE_EXPRESSION (exp->val.args[0]);
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ default:
+ break;
+ }
+
+ free (exp);
+}
+
+
+static int
+yylex (lval, pexp)
+ YYSTYPE *lval;
+ const char **pexp;
+{
+ const char *exp = *pexp;
+ int result;
+
+ while (1)
+ {
+ if (exp[0] == '\0')
+ {
+ *pexp = exp;
+ return YYEOF;
+ }
+
+ if (exp[0] != ' ' && exp[0] != '\t')
+ break;
+
+ ++exp;
+ }
+
+ result = *exp++;
+ switch (result)
+ {
+ case '0': case '1': case '2': case '3': case '4':
+ case '5': case '6': case '7': case '8': case '9':
+ {
+ unsigned long int n = result - '0';
+ while (exp[0] >= '0' && exp[0] <= '9')
+ {
+ n *= 10;
+ n += exp[0] - '0';
+ ++exp;
+ }
+ lval->num = n;
+ result = NUMBER;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case '=':
+ if (exp[0] == '=')
+ {
+ ++exp;
+ lval->op = equal;
+ result = EQUOP2;
+ }
+ else
+ result = YYERRCODE;
+ break;
+
+ case '!':
+ if (exp[0] == '=')
+ {
+ ++exp;
+ lval->op = not_equal;
+ result = EQUOP2;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case '&':
+ case '|':
+ if (exp[0] == result)
+ ++exp;
+ else
+ result = YYERRCODE;
+ break;
+
+ case '<':
+ if (exp[0] == '=')
+ {
+ ++exp;
+ lval->op = less_or_equal;
+ }
+ else
+ lval->op = less_than;
+ result = CMPOP2;
+ break;
+
+ case '>':
+ if (exp[0] == '=')
+ {
+ ++exp;
+ lval->op = greater_or_equal;
+ }
+ else
+ lval->op = greater_than;
+ result = CMPOP2;
+ break;
+
+ case '*':
+ lval->op = mult;
+ result = MULOP2;
+ break;
+
+ case '/':
+ lval->op = divide;
+ result = MULOP2;
+ break;
+
+ case '%':
+ lval->op = module;
+ result = MULOP2;
+ break;
+
+ case '+':
+ lval->op = plus;
+ result = ADDOP2;
+ break;
+
+ case '-':
+ lval->op = minus;
+ result = ADDOP2;
+ break;
+
+ case 'n':
+ case '?':
+ case ':':
+ case '(':
+ case ')':
+ /* Nothing, just return the character. */
+ break;
+
+ case ';':
+ case '\n':
+ case '\0':
+ /* Be safe and let the user call this function again. */
+ --exp;
+ result = YYEOF;
+ break;
+
+ default:
+ result = YYERRCODE;
+#if YYDEBUG != 0
+ --exp;
+#endif
+ break;
+ }
+
+ *pexp = exp;
+
+ return result;
+}
+
+
+static void
+yyerror (str)
+ const char *str;
+{
+ /* Do nothing. We don't print error messages here. */
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/plural.y b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/plural.y
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..616b7c1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/plural.y
@@ -0,0 +1,409 @@
+%{
+/* Expression parsing for plural form selection.
+ Copyright (C) 2000, 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 2000.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+/* The bison generated parser uses alloca. AIX 3 forces us to put this
+ declaration at the beginning of the file. The declaration in bison's
+ skeleton file comes too late. This must come before <config.h>
+ because <config.h> may include arbitrary system headers. */
+#if defined _AIX && !defined __GNUC__
+ #pragma alloca
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stddef.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include "plural-exp.h"
+
+/* The main function generated by the parser is called __gettextparse,
+ but we want it to be called PLURAL_PARSE. */
+#ifndef _LIBC
+# define __gettextparse PLURAL_PARSE
+#endif
+
+#define YYLEX_PARAM &((struct parse_args *) arg)->cp
+#define YYPARSE_PARAM arg
+%}
+%pure_parser
+%expect 7
+
+%union {
+ unsigned long int num;
+ enum operator op;
+ struct expression *exp;
+}
+
+%{
+/* Prototypes for local functions. */
+static struct expression *new_exp PARAMS ((int nargs, enum operator op,
+ struct expression * const *args));
+static inline struct expression *new_exp_0 PARAMS ((enum operator op));
+static inline struct expression *new_exp_1 PARAMS ((enum operator op,
+ struct expression *right));
+static struct expression *new_exp_2 PARAMS ((enum operator op,
+ struct expression *left,
+ struct expression *right));
+static inline struct expression *new_exp_3 PARAMS ((enum operator op,
+ struct expression *bexp,
+ struct expression *tbranch,
+ struct expression *fbranch));
+static int yylex PARAMS ((YYSTYPE *lval, const char **pexp));
+static void yyerror PARAMS ((const char *str));
+
+/* Allocation of expressions. */
+
+static struct expression *
+new_exp (nargs, op, args)
+ int nargs;
+ enum operator op;
+ struct expression * const *args;
+{
+ int i;
+ struct expression *newp;
+
+ /* If any of the argument could not be malloc'ed, just return NULL. */
+ for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; i--)
+ if (args[i] == NULL)
+ goto fail;
+
+ /* Allocate a new expression. */
+ newp = (struct expression *) malloc (sizeof (*newp));
+ if (newp != NULL)
+ {
+ newp->nargs = nargs;
+ newp->operation = op;
+ for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; i--)
+ newp->val.args[i] = args[i];
+ return newp;
+ }
+
+ fail:
+ for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; i--)
+ FREE_EXPRESSION (args[i]);
+
+ return NULL;
+}
+
+static inline struct expression *
+new_exp_0 (op)
+ enum operator op;
+{
+ return new_exp (0, op, NULL);
+}
+
+static inline struct expression *
+new_exp_1 (op, right)
+ enum operator op;
+ struct expression *right;
+{
+ struct expression *args[1];
+
+ args[0] = right;
+ return new_exp (1, op, args);
+}
+
+static struct expression *
+new_exp_2 (op, left, right)
+ enum operator op;
+ struct expression *left;
+ struct expression *right;
+{
+ struct expression *args[2];
+
+ args[0] = left;
+ args[1] = right;
+ return new_exp (2, op, args);
+}
+
+static inline struct expression *
+new_exp_3 (op, bexp, tbranch, fbranch)
+ enum operator op;
+ struct expression *bexp;
+ struct expression *tbranch;
+ struct expression *fbranch;
+{
+ struct expression *args[3];
+
+ args[0] = bexp;
+ args[1] = tbranch;
+ args[2] = fbranch;
+ return new_exp (3, op, args);
+}
+
+%}
+
+/* This declares that all operators have the same associativity and the
+ precedence order as in C. See [Harbison, Steele: C, A Reference Manual].
+ There is no unary minus and no bitwise operators.
+ Operators with the same syntactic behaviour have been merged into a single
+ token, to save space in the array generated by bison. */
+%right '?' /* ? */
+%left '|' /* || */
+%left '&' /* && */
+%left EQUOP2 /* == != */
+%left CMPOP2 /* < > <= >= */
+%left ADDOP2 /* + - */
+%left MULOP2 /* * / % */
+%right '!' /* ! */
+
+%token <op> EQUOP2 CMPOP2 ADDOP2 MULOP2
+%token <num> NUMBER
+%type <exp> exp
+
+%%
+
+start: exp
+ {
+ if ($1 == NULL)
+ YYABORT;
+ ((struct parse_args *) arg)->res = $1;
+ }
+ ;
+
+exp: exp '?' exp ':' exp
+ {
+ $$ = new_exp_3 (qmop, $1, $3, $5);
+ }
+ | exp '|' exp
+ {
+ $$ = new_exp_2 (lor, $1, $3);
+ }
+ | exp '&' exp
+ {
+ $$ = new_exp_2 (land, $1, $3);
+ }
+ | exp EQUOP2 exp
+ {
+ $$ = new_exp_2 ($2, $1, $3);
+ }
+ | exp CMPOP2 exp
+ {
+ $$ = new_exp_2 ($2, $1, $3);
+ }
+ | exp ADDOP2 exp
+ {
+ $$ = new_exp_2 ($2, $1, $3);
+ }
+ | exp MULOP2 exp
+ {
+ $$ = new_exp_2 ($2, $1, $3);
+ }
+ | '!' exp
+ {
+ $$ = new_exp_1 (lnot, $2);
+ }
+ | 'n'
+ {
+ $$ = new_exp_0 (var);
+ }
+ | NUMBER
+ {
+ if (($$ = new_exp_0 (num)) != NULL)
+ $$->val.num = $1;
+ }
+ | '(' exp ')'
+ {
+ $$ = $2;
+ }
+ ;
+
+%%
+
+void
+internal_function
+FREE_EXPRESSION (exp)
+ struct expression *exp;
+{
+ if (exp == NULL)
+ return;
+
+ /* Handle the recursive case. */
+ switch (exp->nargs)
+ {
+ case 3:
+ FREE_EXPRESSION (exp->val.args[2]);
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ case 2:
+ FREE_EXPRESSION (exp->val.args[1]);
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ case 1:
+ FREE_EXPRESSION (exp->val.args[0]);
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ default:
+ break;
+ }
+
+ free (exp);
+}
+
+
+static int
+yylex (lval, pexp)
+ YYSTYPE *lval;
+ const char **pexp;
+{
+ const char *exp = *pexp;
+ int result;
+
+ while (1)
+ {
+ if (exp[0] == '\0')
+ {
+ *pexp = exp;
+ return YYEOF;
+ }
+
+ if (exp[0] != ' ' && exp[0] != '\t')
+ break;
+
+ ++exp;
+ }
+
+ result = *exp++;
+ switch (result)
+ {
+ case '0': case '1': case '2': case '3': case '4':
+ case '5': case '6': case '7': case '8': case '9':
+ {
+ unsigned long int n = result - '0';
+ while (exp[0] >= '0' && exp[0] <= '9')
+ {
+ n *= 10;
+ n += exp[0] - '0';
+ ++exp;
+ }
+ lval->num = n;
+ result = NUMBER;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case '=':
+ if (exp[0] == '=')
+ {
+ ++exp;
+ lval->op = equal;
+ result = EQUOP2;
+ }
+ else
+ result = YYERRCODE;
+ break;
+
+ case '!':
+ if (exp[0] == '=')
+ {
+ ++exp;
+ lval->op = not_equal;
+ result = EQUOP2;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case '&':
+ case '|':
+ if (exp[0] == result)
+ ++exp;
+ else
+ result = YYERRCODE;
+ break;
+
+ case '<':
+ if (exp[0] == '=')
+ {
+ ++exp;
+ lval->op = less_or_equal;
+ }
+ else
+ lval->op = less_than;
+ result = CMPOP2;
+ break;
+
+ case '>':
+ if (exp[0] == '=')
+ {
+ ++exp;
+ lval->op = greater_or_equal;
+ }
+ else
+ lval->op = greater_than;
+ result = CMPOP2;
+ break;
+
+ case '*':
+ lval->op = mult;
+ result = MULOP2;
+ break;
+
+ case '/':
+ lval->op = divide;
+ result = MULOP2;
+ break;
+
+ case '%':
+ lval->op = module;
+ result = MULOP2;
+ break;
+
+ case '+':
+ lval->op = plus;
+ result = ADDOP2;
+ break;
+
+ case '-':
+ lval->op = minus;
+ result = ADDOP2;
+ break;
+
+ case 'n':
+ case '?':
+ case ':':
+ case '(':
+ case ')':
+ /* Nothing, just return the character. */
+ break;
+
+ case ';':
+ case '\n':
+ case '\0':
+ /* Be safe and let the user call this function again. */
+ --exp;
+ result = YYEOF;
+ break;
+
+ default:
+ result = YYERRCODE;
+#if YYDEBUG != 0
+ --exp;
+#endif
+ break;
+ }
+
+ *pexp = exp;
+
+ return result;
+}
+
+
+static void
+yyerror (str)
+ const char *str;
+{
+ /* Do nothing. We don't print error messages here. */
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/ref-add.sin b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/ref-add.sin
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..167374e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/ref-add.sin
@@ -0,0 +1,31 @@
+# Add this package to a list of references stored in a text file.
+#
+# Copyright (C) 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+#
+# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+# under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+# by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+# any later version.
+#
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+# Library General Public License for more details.
+#
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+# License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+# USA.
+#
+# Written by Bruno Haible <haible@clisp.cons.org>.
+#
+/^# Packages using this file: / {
+ s/# Packages using this file://
+ ta
+ :a
+ s/ @PACKAGE@ / @PACKAGE@ /
+ tb
+ s/ $/ @PACKAGE@ /
+ :b
+ s/^/# Packages using this file:/
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/ref-del.sin b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/ref-del.sin
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..613cf37
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/ref-del.sin
@@ -0,0 +1,26 @@
+# Remove this package from a list of references stored in a text file.
+#
+# Copyright (C) 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+#
+# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+# under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+# by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+# any later version.
+#
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+# Library General Public License for more details.
+#
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+# License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+# USA.
+#
+# Written by Bruno Haible <haible@clisp.cons.org>.
+#
+/^# Packages using this file: / {
+ s/# Packages using this file://
+ s/ @PACKAGE@ / /
+ s/^/# Packages using this file:/
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/relocatable.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/relocatable.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..16f79a5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/relocatable.c
@@ -0,0 +1,439 @@
+/* Provide relocatable packages.
+ Copyright (C) 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ Written by Bruno Haible <bruno@clisp.org>, 2003.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+
+/* Tell glibc's <stdio.h> to provide a prototype for getline().
+ This must come before <config.h> because <config.h> may include
+ <features.h>, and once <features.h> has been included, it's too late. */
+#ifndef _GNU_SOURCE
+# define _GNU_SOURCE 1
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include "config.h"
+#endif
+
+/* Specification. */
+#include "relocatable.h"
+
+#if ENABLE_RELOCATABLE
+
+#include <stddef.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+#ifdef NO_XMALLOC
+# define xmalloc malloc
+#else
+# include "xmalloc.h"
+#endif
+
+#if DEPENDS_ON_LIBCHARSET
+# include <libcharset.h>
+#endif
+#if DEPENDS_ON_LIBICONV && HAVE_ICONV
+# include <iconv.h>
+#endif
+#if DEPENDS_ON_LIBINTL && ENABLE_NLS
+# include <libintl.h>
+#endif
+
+/* Faked cheap 'bool'. */
+#undef bool
+#undef false
+#undef true
+#define bool int
+#define false 0
+#define true 1
+
+/* Pathname support.
+ ISSLASH(C) tests whether C is a directory separator character.
+ IS_PATH_WITH_DIR(P) tests whether P contains a directory specification.
+ */
+#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ || defined __EMX__ || defined __DJGPP__
+ /* Win32, OS/2, DOS */
+# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == '/' || (C) == '\\')
+# define HAS_DEVICE(P) \
+ ((((P)[0] >= 'A' && (P)[0] <= 'Z') || ((P)[0] >= 'a' && (P)[0] <= 'z')) \
+ && (P)[1] == ':')
+# define IS_PATH_WITH_DIR(P) \
+ (strchr (P, '/') != NULL || strchr (P, '\\') != NULL || HAS_DEVICE (P))
+# define FILESYSTEM_PREFIX_LEN(P) (HAS_DEVICE (P) ? 2 : 0)
+#else
+ /* Unix */
+# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == '/')
+# define IS_PATH_WITH_DIR(P) (strchr (P, '/') != NULL)
+# define FILESYSTEM_PREFIX_LEN(P) 0
+#endif
+
+/* Original installation prefix. */
+static char *orig_prefix;
+static size_t orig_prefix_len;
+/* Current installation prefix. */
+static char *curr_prefix;
+static size_t curr_prefix_len;
+/* These prefixes do not end in a slash. Anything that will be concatenated
+ to them must start with a slash. */
+
+/* Sets the original and the current installation prefix of this module.
+ Relocation simply replaces a pathname starting with the original prefix
+ by the corresponding pathname with the current prefix instead. Both
+ prefixes should be directory names without trailing slash (i.e. use ""
+ instead of "/"). */
+static void
+set_this_relocation_prefix (const char *orig_prefix_arg,
+ const char *curr_prefix_arg)
+{
+ if (orig_prefix_arg != NULL && curr_prefix_arg != NULL
+ /* Optimization: if orig_prefix and curr_prefix are equal, the
+ relocation is a nop. */
+ && strcmp (orig_prefix_arg, curr_prefix_arg) != 0)
+ {
+ /* Duplicate the argument strings. */
+ char *memory;
+
+ orig_prefix_len = strlen (orig_prefix_arg);
+ curr_prefix_len = strlen (curr_prefix_arg);
+ memory = (char *) xmalloc (orig_prefix_len + 1 + curr_prefix_len + 1);
+#ifdef NO_XMALLOC
+ if (memory != NULL)
+#endif
+ {
+ memcpy (memory, orig_prefix_arg, orig_prefix_len + 1);
+ orig_prefix = memory;
+ memory += orig_prefix_len + 1;
+ memcpy (memory, curr_prefix_arg, curr_prefix_len + 1);
+ curr_prefix = memory;
+ return;
+ }
+ }
+ orig_prefix = NULL;
+ curr_prefix = NULL;
+ /* Don't worry about wasted memory here - this function is usually only
+ called once. */
+}
+
+/* Sets the original and the current installation prefix of the package.
+ Relocation simply replaces a pathname starting with the original prefix
+ by the corresponding pathname with the current prefix instead. Both
+ prefixes should be directory names without trailing slash (i.e. use ""
+ instead of "/"). */
+void
+set_relocation_prefix (const char *orig_prefix_arg, const char *curr_prefix_arg)
+{
+ set_this_relocation_prefix (orig_prefix_arg, curr_prefix_arg);
+
+ /* Now notify all dependent libraries. */
+#if DEPENDS_ON_LIBCHARSET
+ libcharset_set_relocation_prefix (orig_prefix_arg, curr_prefix_arg);
+#endif
+#if DEPENDS_ON_LIBICONV && HAVE_ICONV && _LIBICONV_VERSION >= 0x0109
+ libiconv_set_relocation_prefix (orig_prefix_arg, curr_prefix_arg);
+#endif
+#if DEPENDS_ON_LIBINTL && ENABLE_NLS && defined libintl_set_relocation_prefix
+ libintl_set_relocation_prefix (orig_prefix_arg, curr_prefix_arg);
+#endif
+}
+
+/* Convenience function:
+ Computes the current installation prefix, based on the original
+ installation prefix, the original installation directory of a particular
+ file, and the current pathname of this file. Returns NULL upon failure. */
+#ifdef IN_LIBRARY
+#define compute_curr_prefix local_compute_curr_prefix
+static
+#endif
+const char *
+compute_curr_prefix (const char *orig_installprefix,
+ const char *orig_installdir,
+ const char *curr_pathname)
+{
+ const char *curr_installdir;
+ const char *rel_installdir;
+
+ if (curr_pathname == NULL)
+ return NULL;
+
+ /* Determine the relative installation directory, relative to the prefix.
+ This is simply the difference between orig_installprefix and
+ orig_installdir. */
+ if (strncmp (orig_installprefix, orig_installdir, strlen (orig_installprefix))
+ != 0)
+ /* Shouldn't happen - nothing should be installed outside $(prefix). */
+ return NULL;
+ rel_installdir = orig_installdir + strlen (orig_installprefix);
+
+ /* Determine the current installation directory. */
+ {
+ const char *p_base = curr_pathname + FILESYSTEM_PREFIX_LEN (curr_pathname);
+ const char *p = curr_pathname + strlen (curr_pathname);
+ char *q;
+
+ while (p > p_base)
+ {
+ p--;
+ if (ISSLASH (*p))
+ break;
+ }
+
+ q = (char *) xmalloc (p - curr_pathname + 1);
+#ifdef NO_XMALLOC
+ if (q == NULL)
+ return NULL;
+#endif
+ memcpy (q, curr_pathname, p - curr_pathname);
+ q[p - curr_pathname] = '\0';
+ curr_installdir = q;
+ }
+
+ /* Compute the current installation prefix by removing the trailing
+ rel_installdir from it. */
+ {
+ const char *rp = rel_installdir + strlen (rel_installdir);
+ const char *cp = curr_installdir + strlen (curr_installdir);
+ const char *cp_base =
+ curr_installdir + FILESYSTEM_PREFIX_LEN (curr_installdir);
+
+ while (rp > rel_installdir && cp > cp_base)
+ {
+ bool same = false;
+ const char *rpi = rp;
+ const char *cpi = cp;
+
+ while (rpi > rel_installdir && cpi > cp_base)
+ {
+ rpi--;
+ cpi--;
+ if (ISSLASH (*rpi) || ISSLASH (*cpi))
+ {
+ if (ISSLASH (*rpi) && ISSLASH (*cpi))
+ same = true;
+ break;
+ }
+#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ || defined __EMX__ || defined __DJGPP__
+ /* Win32, OS/2, DOS - case insignificant filesystem */
+ if ((*rpi >= 'a' && *rpi <= 'z' ? *rpi - 'a' + 'A' : *rpi)
+ != (*cpi >= 'a' && *cpi <= 'z' ? *cpi - 'a' + 'A' : *cpi))
+ break;
+#else
+ if (*rpi != *cpi)
+ break;
+#endif
+ }
+ if (!same)
+ break;
+ /* The last pathname component was the same. opi and cpi now point
+ to the slash before it. */
+ rp = rpi;
+ cp = cpi;
+ }
+
+ if (rp > rel_installdir)
+ /* Unexpected: The curr_installdir does not end with rel_installdir. */
+ return NULL;
+
+ {
+ size_t curr_prefix_len = cp - curr_installdir;
+ char *curr_prefix;
+
+ curr_prefix = (char *) xmalloc (curr_prefix_len + 1);
+#ifdef NO_XMALLOC
+ if (curr_prefix == NULL)
+ return NULL;
+#endif
+ memcpy (curr_prefix, curr_installdir, curr_prefix_len);
+ curr_prefix[curr_prefix_len] = '\0';
+
+ return curr_prefix;
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+#if defined PIC && defined INSTALLDIR
+
+/* Full pathname of shared library, or NULL. */
+static char *shared_library_fullname;
+
+#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__
+
+/* Determine the full pathname of the shared library when it is loaded. */
+
+BOOL WINAPI
+DllMain (HINSTANCE module_handle, DWORD event, LPVOID reserved)
+{
+ (void) reserved;
+
+ if (event == DLL_PROCESS_ATTACH)
+ {
+ /* The DLL is being loaded into an application's address range. */
+ static char location[MAX_PATH];
+
+ if (!GetModuleFileName (module_handle, location, sizeof (location)))
+ /* Shouldn't happen. */
+ return FALSE;
+
+ if (!IS_PATH_WITH_DIR (location))
+ /* Shouldn't happen. */
+ return FALSE;
+
+ shared_library_fullname = strdup (location);
+ }
+
+ return TRUE;
+}
+
+#else /* Unix */
+
+static void
+find_shared_library_fullname ()
+{
+#ifdef __linux__
+ FILE *fp;
+
+ /* Open the current process' maps file. It describes one VMA per line. */
+ fp = fopen ("/proc/self/maps", "r");
+ if (fp)
+ {
+ unsigned long address = (unsigned long) &find_shared_library_fullname;
+ for (;;)
+ {
+ unsigned long start, end;
+ int c;
+
+ if (fscanf (fp, "%lx-%lx", &start, &end) != 2)
+ break;
+ if (address >= start && address <= end - 1)
+ {
+ /* Found it. Now see if this line contains a filename. */
+ while (c = getc (fp), c != EOF && c != '\n' && c != '/')
+ continue;
+ if (c == '/')
+ {
+ size_t size;
+ int len;
+
+ ungetc (c, fp);
+ shared_library_fullname = NULL; size = 0;
+ len = getline (&shared_library_fullname, &size, fp);
+ if (len >= 0)
+ {
+ /* Success: filled shared_library_fullname. */
+ if (len > 0 && shared_library_fullname[len - 1] == '\n')
+ shared_library_fullname[len - 1] = '\0';
+ }
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ while (c = getc (fp), c != EOF && c != '\n')
+ continue;
+ }
+ fclose (fp);
+ }
+#endif
+}
+
+#endif /* WIN32 / Unix */
+
+/* Return the full pathname of the current shared library.
+ Return NULL if unknown.
+ Guaranteed to work only on Linux and Woe32. */
+static char *
+get_shared_library_fullname ()
+{
+#if !(defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__)
+ static bool tried_find_shared_library_fullname;
+ if (!tried_find_shared_library_fullname)
+ {
+ find_shared_library_fullname ();
+ tried_find_shared_library_fullname = true;
+ }
+#endif
+ return shared_library_fullname;
+}
+
+#endif /* PIC */
+
+/* Returns the pathname, relocated according to the current installation
+ directory. */
+const char *
+relocate (const char *pathname)
+{
+#if defined PIC && defined INSTALLDIR
+ static int initialized;
+
+ /* Initialization code for a shared library. */
+ if (!initialized)
+ {
+ /* At this point, orig_prefix and curr_prefix likely have already been
+ set through the main program's set_program_name_and_installdir
+ function. This is sufficient in the case that the library has
+ initially been installed in the same orig_prefix. But we can do
+ better, to also cover the cases that 1. it has been installed
+ in a different prefix before being moved to orig_prefix and (later)
+ to curr_prefix, 2. unlike the program, it has not moved away from
+ orig_prefix. */
+ const char *orig_installprefix = INSTALLPREFIX;
+ const char *orig_installdir = INSTALLDIR;
+ const char *curr_prefix_better;
+
+ curr_prefix_better =
+ compute_curr_prefix (orig_installprefix, orig_installdir,
+ get_shared_library_fullname ());
+ if (curr_prefix_better == NULL)
+ curr_prefix_better = curr_prefix;
+
+ set_relocation_prefix (orig_installprefix, curr_prefix_better);
+
+ initialized = 1;
+ }
+#endif
+
+ /* Note: It is not necessary to perform case insensitive comparison here,
+ even for DOS-like filesystems, because the pathname argument was
+ typically created from the same Makefile variable as orig_prefix came
+ from. */
+ if (orig_prefix != NULL && curr_prefix != NULL
+ && strncmp (pathname, orig_prefix, orig_prefix_len) == 0)
+ {
+ if (pathname[orig_prefix_len] == '\0')
+ /* pathname equals orig_prefix. */
+ return curr_prefix;
+ if (ISSLASH (pathname[orig_prefix_len]))
+ {
+ /* pathname starts with orig_prefix. */
+ const char *pathname_tail = &pathname[orig_prefix_len];
+ char *result =
+ (char *) xmalloc (curr_prefix_len + strlen (pathname_tail) + 1);
+
+#ifdef NO_XMALLOC
+ if (result != NULL)
+#endif
+ {
+ memcpy (result, curr_prefix, curr_prefix_len);
+ strcpy (result + curr_prefix_len, pathname_tail);
+ return result;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ /* Nothing to relocate. */
+ return pathname;
+}
+
+#endif
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/relocatable.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/relocatable.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d141200
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/relocatable.h
@@ -0,0 +1,67 @@
+/* Provide relocatable packages.
+ Copyright (C) 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ Written by Bruno Haible <bruno@clisp.org>, 2003.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+#ifndef _RELOCATABLE_H
+#define _RELOCATABLE_H
+
+/* This can be enabled through the configure --enable-relocatable option. */
+#if ENABLE_RELOCATABLE
+
+/* When building a DLL, we must export some functions. Note that because
+ this is a private .h file, we don't need to use __declspec(dllimport)
+ in any case. */
+#if defined _MSC_VER && BUILDING_DLL
+# define RELOCATABLE_DLL_EXPORTED __declspec(dllexport)
+#else
+# define RELOCATABLE_DLL_EXPORTED
+#endif
+
+/* Sets the original and the current installation prefix of the package.
+ Relocation simply replaces a pathname starting with the original prefix
+ by the corresponding pathname with the current prefix instead. Both
+ prefixes should be directory names without trailing slash (i.e. use ""
+ instead of "/"). */
+extern RELOCATABLE_DLL_EXPORTED void
+ set_relocation_prefix (const char *orig_prefix,
+ const char *curr_prefix);
+
+/* Returns the pathname, relocated according to the current installation
+ directory. */
+extern const char * relocate (const char *pathname);
+
+/* Memory management: relocate() leaks memory, because it has to construct
+ a fresh pathname. If this is a problem because your program calls
+ relocate() frequently, think about caching the result. */
+
+/* Convenience function:
+ Computes the current installation prefix, based on the original
+ installation prefix, the original installation directory of a particular
+ file, and the current pathname of this file. Returns NULL upon failure. */
+extern const char * compute_curr_prefix (const char *orig_installprefix,
+ const char *orig_installdir,
+ const char *curr_pathname);
+
+#else
+
+/* By default, we use the hardwired pathnames. */
+#define relocate(pathname) (pathname)
+
+#endif
+
+#endif /* _RELOCATABLE_H */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/textdomain.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/textdomain.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f259c69
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/intl/textdomain.c
@@ -0,0 +1,142 @@
+/* Implementation of the textdomain(3) function.
+ Copyright (C) 1995-1998, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
+ by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
+ USA. */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# include <libintl.h>
+#else
+# include "libgnuintl.h"
+#endif
+#include "gettextP.h"
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+/* We have to handle multi-threaded applications. */
+# include <bits/libc-lock.h>
+#else
+/* Provide dummy implementation if this is outside glibc. */
+# define __libc_rwlock_define(CLASS, NAME)
+# define __libc_rwlock_wrlock(NAME)
+# define __libc_rwlock_unlock(NAME)
+#endif
+
+/* The internal variables in the standalone libintl.a must have different
+ names than the internal variables in GNU libc, otherwise programs
+ using libintl.a cannot be linked statically. */
+#if !defined _LIBC
+# define _nl_default_default_domain libintl_nl_default_default_domain
+# define _nl_current_default_domain libintl_nl_current_default_domain
+#endif
+
+/* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+
+/* Name of the default text domain. */
+extern const char _nl_default_default_domain[] attribute_hidden;
+
+/* Default text domain in which entries for gettext(3) are to be found. */
+extern const char *_nl_current_default_domain attribute_hidden;
+
+
+/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. They must not clash
+ with existing names and they should follow ANSI C. But this source
+ code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __
+ prefix. So we have to make a difference here. */
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# define TEXTDOMAIN __textdomain
+# ifndef strdup
+# define strdup(str) __strdup (str)
+# endif
+#else
+# define TEXTDOMAIN libintl_textdomain
+#endif
+
+/* Lock variable to protect the global data in the gettext implementation. */
+__libc_rwlock_define (extern, _nl_state_lock attribute_hidden)
+
+/* Set the current default message catalog to DOMAINNAME.
+ If DOMAINNAME is null, return the current default.
+ If DOMAINNAME is "", reset to the default of "messages". */
+char *
+TEXTDOMAIN (domainname)
+ const char *domainname;
+{
+ char *new_domain;
+ char *old_domain;
+
+ /* A NULL pointer requests the current setting. */
+ if (domainname == NULL)
+ return (char *) _nl_current_default_domain;
+
+ __libc_rwlock_wrlock (_nl_state_lock);
+
+ old_domain = (char *) _nl_current_default_domain;
+
+ /* If domain name is the null string set to default domain "messages". */
+ if (domainname[0] == '\0'
+ || strcmp (domainname, _nl_default_default_domain) == 0)
+ {
+ _nl_current_default_domain = _nl_default_default_domain;
+ new_domain = (char *) _nl_current_default_domain;
+ }
+ else if (strcmp (domainname, old_domain) == 0)
+ /* This can happen and people will use it to signal that some
+ environment variable changed. */
+ new_domain = old_domain;
+ else
+ {
+ /* If the following malloc fails `_nl_current_default_domain'
+ will be NULL. This value will be returned and so signals we
+ are out of core. */
+#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_STRDUP
+ new_domain = strdup (domainname);
+#else
+ size_t len = strlen (domainname) + 1;
+ new_domain = (char *) malloc (len);
+ if (new_domain != NULL)
+ memcpy (new_domain, domainname, len);
+#endif
+
+ if (new_domain != NULL)
+ _nl_current_default_domain = new_domain;
+ }
+
+ /* We use this possibility to signal a change of the loaded catalogs
+ since this is most likely the case and there is no other easy we
+ to do it. Do it only when the call was successful. */
+ if (new_domain != NULL)
+ {
+ ++_nl_msg_cat_cntr;
+
+ if (old_domain != new_domain && old_domain != _nl_default_default_domain)
+ free (old_domain);
+ }
+
+ __libc_rwlock_unlock (_nl_state_lock);
+
+ return new_domain;
+}
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+/* Alias for function name in GNU C Library. */
+weak_alias (__textdomain, textdomain);
+#endif
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/Makefile.in b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/Makefile.in
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b2c785b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/Makefile.in
@@ -0,0 +1,139 @@
+# Skeleton Makefile for the GNU malloc code
+#
+#
+# Copyright (C) 1996-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+# any later version.
+
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+# GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA.
+
+srcdir = @srcdir@
+VPATH = .:@srcdir@
+topdir = @top_srcdir@
+BUILD_DIR = @BUILD_DIR@
+
+INSTALL = @INSTALL@
+INSTALL_PROGRAM = @INSTALL_PROGRAM@
+INSTALL_DATA = @INSTALL_DATA@
+
+CC = @CC@
+RANLIB = @RANLIB@
+AR = @AR@
+ARFLAGS = @ARFLAGS@
+RM = rm -f
+CP = cp
+MV = mv
+
+SHELL = @MAKE_SHELL@
+
+PROFILE_FLAGS = @PROFILE_FLAGS@
+
+CFLAGS = @CFLAGS@
+LOCAL_CFLAGS = @LOCAL_CFLAGS@
+CPPFLAGS = @CPPFLAGS@
+LDFLAGS = @LDFLAGS@
+
+DEFS = @DEFS@
+LOCAL_DEFS = @LOCAL_DEFS@
+
+LIBBUILD = ${BUILD_DIR}/lib
+
+BASHINCDIR = ${topdir}/include
+
+INTL_LIBSRC = ${topdir}/lib/intl
+INTL_BUILDDIR = ${LIBBUILD}/intl
+INTL_INC = @INTL_INC@
+LIBINTL_H = @LIBINTL_H@
+
+INCLUDES = -I. -I../.. -I$(topdir) -I$(BASHINCDIR) -I$(topdir)/lib $(INTL_INC)
+
+CCFLAGS = ${PROFILE_FLAGS} ${INCLUDES} $(DEFS) $(LOCAL_DEFS) $(LOCAL_CFLAGS) \
+ $(CFLAGS) $(MALLOC_CFLAGS) $(CPPFLAGS)
+
+.c.o:
+ $(CC) $(CCFLAGS) -c $<
+
+.s.o:
+ $(CC) $(CCFLAGS) -c $<
+
+MALLOC_SOURCE = malloc.c
+STUB_SOURCE = stub.c
+
+ALLOCA_SOURCE = alloca.c
+ALLOCA_OBJECT = alloca.o
+
+MALLOC_SRC = @MALLOC_SRC@
+MALLOC = @MALLOC@
+ALLOCA = @ALLOCA@
+
+MALLOC_OBJS = malloc.o $(ALLOCA) trace.o stats.o table.o watch.o
+STUB_OBJS = $(ALLOCA) stub.o
+
+.PHONY: malloc stubmalloc
+
+all: malloc
+
+malloc: ${MALLOC_OBJS}
+ ${RM} libmalloc.a
+ ${AR} ${ARFLAGS} libmalloc.a ${MALLOC_OBJS}
+ -test -n "$(RANLIB)" && $(RANLIB) libmalloc.a
+
+stubmalloc: ${STUB_OBJS}
+ ${RM} libmalloc.a
+ ${AR} ${ARFLAGS} libmalloc.a ${STUB_OBJS}
+ -test -n "$(RANLIB)" && $(RANLIB) libmalloc.a
+
+alloca: ${ALLOCA}
+ ${RM} libmalloc.a
+ ${AR} ${ARFLAGS} libmalloc.a ${ALLOCA}
+ -test -n "$(RANLIB)" && $(RANLIB) libmalloc.a
+
+alloca.o: $(srcdir)/$(ALLOCA_SOURCE)
+ $(CC) $(CCFLAGS) -c $(srcdir)/$(ALLOCA_SOURCE)
+ @- if test "$(ALLOCA_OBJECT)" != alloca.o ; then \
+ mv $(ALLOCA_OBJECT) alloca.o >/dev/null 2>&1 ; \
+ fi
+
+mostlyclean clean:
+ $(RM) *.o libmalloc.a
+
+distclean realclean maintainer-clean: clean
+ $(RM) Makefile
+
+alloca.o: $(BUILD_DIR)/config.h
+malloc.o: $(BUILD_DIR)/config.h $(topdir)/bashtypes.h getpagesize.h
+xmalloc.o: $(BUILD_DIR)/config.h $(BASHINCDIR)/ansi_stdlib.h
+trace.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+table.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+watch.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+
+malloc.o: ${srcdir}/imalloc.h ${srcdir}/mstats.h
+malloc.o: ${srcdir}/table.h ${srcdir}/watch.h
+stats.o: ${srcdir}/imalloc.h ${srcdir}/mstats.h
+trace.o: ${srcdir}/imalloc.h
+table.o: ${srcdir}/imalloc.h ${srcdir}/table.h
+watch.o: ${srcdir}/imalloc.h ${srcdir}/watch.h
+
+malloc.o: ${topdir}/bashintl.h ${LIBINTL_H} ${BASHINCDIR}/gettext.h
+stats.o: ${topdir}/bashintl.h ${LIBINTL_H} ${BASHINCDIR}/gettext.h
+trace.o: ${topdir}/bashintl.h ${LIBINTL_H} ${BASHINCDIR}/gettext.h
+table.o: ${topdir}/bashintl.h ${LIBINTL_H} ${BASHINCDIR}/gettext.h
+watch.o: ${topdir}/bashintl.h ${LIBINTL_H} ${BASHINCDIR}/gettext.h
+
+# Rules for deficient makes, like SunOS and Solaris
+stub.o: stub.c
+malloc.o: malloc.c
+table.o: table.c
+trace.o: trace.c
+stats.o: stats.c
+watch.o: watch.c
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/alloca.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/alloca.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..26319c2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/alloca.c
@@ -0,0 +1,482 @@
+/* alloca.c -- allocate automatically reclaimed memory
+ (Mostly) portable public-domain implementation -- D A Gwyn
+
+ This implementation of the PWB library alloca function,
+ which is used to allocate space off the run-time stack so
+ that it is automatically reclaimed upon procedure exit,
+ was inspired by discussions with J. Q. Johnson of Cornell.
+ J.Otto Tennant <jot@cray.com> contributed the Cray support.
+
+ There are some preprocessor constants that can
+ be defined when compiling for your specific system, for
+ improved efficiency; however, the defaults should be okay.
+
+ The general concept of this implementation is to keep
+ track of all alloca-allocated blocks, and reclaim any
+ that are found to be deeper in the stack than the current
+ invocation. This heuristic does not reclaim storage as
+ soon as it becomes invalid, but it will do so eventually.
+
+ As a special case, alloca(0) reclaims storage without
+ allocating any. It is a good idea to use alloca(0) in
+ your main control loop, etc. to force garbage collection. */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+#include "config.h"
+#endif
+
+/* If compiling with GCC 2, this file's not needed. */
+#if !defined (__GNUC__) || __GNUC__ < 2
+
+#include <bashtypes.h> /* for size_t */
+
+/* If alloca is defined somewhere, this file is not needed. */
+#ifndef alloca
+
+#ifdef emacs
+#ifdef static
+/* actually, only want this if static is defined as ""
+ -- this is for usg, in which emacs must undefine static
+ in order to make unexec workable
+ */
+#ifndef STACK_DIRECTION
+you
+lose
+-- must know STACK_DIRECTION at compile-time
+#endif /* STACK_DIRECTION undefined */
+#endif /* static */
+#endif /* emacs */
+
+/* If your stack is a linked list of frames, you have to
+ provide an "address metric" ADDRESS_FUNCTION macro. */
+
+#if defined (CRAY) && defined (CRAY_STACKSEG_END)
+long i00afunc ();
+#define ADDRESS_FUNCTION(arg) (char *) i00afunc (&(arg))
+#else
+#define ADDRESS_FUNCTION(arg) &(arg)
+#endif /* CRAY && CRAY_STACKSEG_END */
+
+#if __STDC__
+typedef void *pointer;
+#else
+typedef char *pointer;
+#endif
+
+#define NULL 0
+
+/* Different portions of Emacs need to call different versions of
+ malloc. The Emacs executable needs alloca to call xmalloc, because
+ ordinary malloc isn't protected from input signals. On the other
+ hand, the utilities in lib-src need alloca to call malloc; some of
+ them are very simple, and don't have an xmalloc routine.
+
+ Non-Emacs programs expect this to call use xmalloc.
+
+ Callers below should use malloc. */
+
+#ifndef emacs
+#define malloc xmalloc
+extern pointer xmalloc ();
+#endif
+
+/* Define STACK_DIRECTION if you know the direction of stack
+ growth for your system; otherwise it will be automatically
+ deduced at run-time.
+
+ STACK_DIRECTION > 0 => grows toward higher addresses
+ STACK_DIRECTION < 0 => grows toward lower addresses
+ STACK_DIRECTION = 0 => direction of growth unknown */
+
+#ifndef STACK_DIRECTION
+#define STACK_DIRECTION 0 /* Direction unknown. */
+#endif
+
+#if STACK_DIRECTION != 0
+
+#define STACK_DIR STACK_DIRECTION /* Known at compile-time. */
+
+#else /* STACK_DIRECTION == 0; need run-time code. */
+
+static int stack_dir; /* 1 or -1 once known. */
+#define STACK_DIR stack_dir
+
+static void
+find_stack_direction ()
+{
+ static char *addr = NULL; /* Address of first `dummy', once known. */
+ auto char dummy; /* To get stack address. */
+
+ if (addr == NULL)
+ { /* Initial entry. */
+ addr = ADDRESS_FUNCTION (dummy);
+
+ find_stack_direction (); /* Recurse once. */
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Second entry. */
+ if (ADDRESS_FUNCTION (dummy) > addr)
+ stack_dir = 1; /* Stack grew upward. */
+ else
+ stack_dir = -1; /* Stack grew downward. */
+ }
+}
+
+#endif /* STACK_DIRECTION == 0 */
+
+/* An "alloca header" is used to:
+ (a) chain together all alloca'ed blocks;
+ (b) keep track of stack depth.
+
+ It is very important that sizeof(header) agree with malloc
+ alignment chunk size. The following default should work okay. */
+
+#ifndef ALIGN_SIZE
+#define ALIGN_SIZE sizeof(double)
+#endif
+
+typedef union hdr
+{
+ char align[ALIGN_SIZE]; /* To force sizeof(header). */
+ struct
+ {
+ union hdr *next; /* For chaining headers. */
+ char *deep; /* For stack depth measure. */
+ } h;
+} header;
+
+static header *last_alloca_header = NULL; /* -> last alloca header. */
+
+/* Return a pointer to at least SIZE bytes of storage,
+ which will be automatically reclaimed upon exit from
+ the procedure that called alloca. Originally, this space
+ was supposed to be taken from the current stack frame of the
+ caller, but that method cannot be made to work for some
+ implementations of C, for example under Gould's UTX/32. */
+
+pointer
+alloca (size)
+ size_t size;
+{
+ auto char probe; /* Probes stack depth: */
+ register char *depth = ADDRESS_FUNCTION (probe);
+
+#if STACK_DIRECTION == 0
+ if (STACK_DIR == 0) /* Unknown growth direction. */
+ find_stack_direction ();
+#endif
+
+ /* Reclaim garbage, defined as all alloca'd storage that
+ was allocated from deeper in the stack than currently. */
+
+ {
+ register header *hp; /* Traverses linked list. */
+
+ for (hp = last_alloca_header; hp != NULL;)
+ if ((STACK_DIR > 0 && hp->h.deep > depth)
+ || (STACK_DIR < 0 && hp->h.deep < depth))
+ {
+ register header *np = hp->h.next;
+
+ free ((pointer) hp); /* Collect garbage. */
+
+ hp = np; /* -> next header. */
+ }
+ else
+ break; /* Rest are not deeper. */
+
+ last_alloca_header = hp; /* -> last valid storage. */
+ }
+
+ if (size == 0)
+ return NULL; /* No allocation required. */
+
+ /* Allocate combined header + user data storage. */
+
+ {
+ register pointer new = malloc (sizeof (header) + size);
+ /* Address of header. */
+
+ ((header *) new)->h.next = last_alloca_header;
+ ((header *) new)->h.deep = depth;
+
+ last_alloca_header = (header *) new;
+
+ /* User storage begins just after header. */
+
+ return (pointer) ((char *) new + sizeof (header));
+ }
+}
+
+#if defined (CRAY) && defined (CRAY_STACKSEG_END)
+
+#ifdef DEBUG_I00AFUNC
+#include <stdio.h>
+#endif
+
+#ifndef CRAY_STACK
+#define CRAY_STACK
+#ifndef CRAY2
+/* Stack structures for CRAY-1, CRAY X-MP, and CRAY Y-MP */
+struct stack_control_header
+ {
+ long shgrow:32; /* Number of times stack has grown. */
+ long shaseg:32; /* Size of increments to stack. */
+ long shhwm:32; /* High water mark of stack. */
+ long shsize:32; /* Current size of stack (all segments). */
+ };
+
+/* The stack segment linkage control information occurs at
+ the high-address end of a stack segment. (The stack
+ grows from low addresses to high addresses.) The initial
+ part of the stack segment linkage control information is
+ 0200 (octal) words. This provides for register storage
+ for the routine which overflows the stack. */
+
+struct stack_segment_linkage
+ {
+ long ss[0200]; /* 0200 overflow words. */
+ long sssize:32; /* Number of words in this segment. */
+ long ssbase:32; /* Offset to stack base. */
+ long:32;
+ long sspseg:32; /* Offset to linkage control of previous
+ segment of stack. */
+ long:32;
+ long sstcpt:32; /* Pointer to task common address block. */
+ long sscsnm; /* Private control structure number for
+ microtasking. */
+ long ssusr1; /* Reserved for user. */
+ long ssusr2; /* Reserved for user. */
+ long sstpid; /* Process ID for pid based multi-tasking. */
+ long ssgvup; /* Pointer to multitasking thread giveup. */
+ long sscray[7]; /* Reserved for Cray Research. */
+ long ssa0;
+ long ssa1;
+ long ssa2;
+ long ssa3;
+ long ssa4;
+ long ssa5;
+ long ssa6;
+ long ssa7;
+ long sss0;
+ long sss1;
+ long sss2;
+ long sss3;
+ long sss4;
+ long sss5;
+ long sss6;
+ long sss7;
+ };
+
+#else /* CRAY2 */
+/* The following structure defines the vector of words
+ returned by the STKSTAT library routine. */
+struct stk_stat
+ {
+ long now; /* Current total stack size. */
+ long maxc; /* Amount of contiguous space which would
+ be required to satisfy the maximum
+ stack demand to date. */
+ long high_water; /* Stack high-water mark. */
+ long overflows; /* Number of stack overflow ($STKOFEN) calls. */
+ long hits; /* Number of internal buffer hits. */
+ long extends; /* Number of block extensions. */
+ long stko_mallocs; /* Block allocations by $STKOFEN. */
+ long underflows; /* Number of stack underflow calls ($STKRETN). */
+ long stko_free; /* Number of deallocations by $STKRETN. */
+ long stkm_free; /* Number of deallocations by $STKMRET. */
+ long segments; /* Current number of stack segments. */
+ long maxs; /* Maximum number of stack segments so far. */
+ long pad_size; /* Stack pad size. */
+ long current_address; /* Current stack segment address. */
+ long current_size; /* Current stack segment size. This
+ number is actually corrupted by STKSTAT to
+ include the fifteen word trailer area. */
+ long initial_address; /* Address of initial segment. */
+ long initial_size; /* Size of initial segment. */
+ };
+
+/* The following structure describes the data structure which trails
+ any stack segment. I think that the description in 'asdef' is
+ out of date. I only describe the parts that I am sure about. */
+
+struct stk_trailer
+ {
+ long this_address; /* Address of this block. */
+ long this_size; /* Size of this block (does not include
+ this trailer). */
+ long unknown2;
+ long unknown3;
+ long link; /* Address of trailer block of previous
+ segment. */
+ long unknown5;
+ long unknown6;
+ long unknown7;
+ long unknown8;
+ long unknown9;
+ long unknown10;
+ long unknown11;
+ long unknown12;
+ long unknown13;
+ long unknown14;
+ };
+
+#endif /* CRAY2 */
+#endif /* not CRAY_STACK */
+
+#ifdef CRAY2
+/* Determine a "stack measure" for an arbitrary ADDRESS.
+ I doubt that "lint" will like this much. */
+
+static long
+i00afunc (long *address)
+{
+ struct stk_stat status;
+ struct stk_trailer *trailer;
+ long *block, size;
+ long result = 0;
+
+ /* We want to iterate through all of the segments. The first
+ step is to get the stack status structure. We could do this
+ more quickly and more directly, perhaps, by referencing the
+ $LM00 common block, but I know that this works. */
+
+ STKSTAT (&status);
+
+ /* Set up the iteration. */
+
+ trailer = (struct stk_trailer *) (status.current_address
+ + status.current_size
+ - 15);
+
+ /* There must be at least one stack segment. Therefore it is
+ a fatal error if "trailer" is null. */
+
+ if (trailer == 0)
+ abort ();
+
+ /* Discard segments that do not contain our argument address. */
+
+ while (trailer != 0)
+ {
+ block = (long *) trailer->this_address;
+ size = trailer->this_size;
+ if (block == 0 || size == 0)
+ abort ();
+ trailer = (struct stk_trailer *) trailer->link;
+ if ((block <= address) && (address < (block + size)))
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /* Set the result to the offset in this segment and add the sizes
+ of all predecessor segments. */
+
+ result = address - block;
+
+ if (trailer == 0)
+ {
+ return result;
+ }
+
+ do
+ {
+ if (trailer->this_size <= 0)
+ abort ();
+ result += trailer->this_size;
+ trailer = (struct stk_trailer *) trailer->link;
+ }
+ while (trailer != 0);
+
+ /* We are done. Note that if you present a bogus address (one
+ not in any segment), you will get a different number back, formed
+ from subtracting the address of the first block. This is probably
+ not what you want. */
+
+ return (result);
+}
+
+#else /* not CRAY2 */
+/* Stack address function for a CRAY-1, CRAY X-MP, or CRAY Y-MP.
+ Determine the number of the cell within the stack,
+ given the address of the cell. The purpose of this
+ routine is to linearize, in some sense, stack addresses
+ for alloca. */
+
+static long
+i00afunc (long address)
+{
+ long stkl = 0;
+
+ long size, pseg, this_segment, stack;
+ long result = 0;
+
+ struct stack_segment_linkage *ssptr;
+
+ /* Register B67 contains the address of the end of the
+ current stack segment. If you (as a subprogram) store
+ your registers on the stack and find that you are past
+ the contents of B67, you have overflowed the segment.
+
+ B67 also points to the stack segment linkage control
+ area, which is what we are really interested in. */
+
+ /* This might be _getb67() or GETB67 () or getb67 () */
+ stkl = CRAY_STACKSEG_END ();
+ ssptr = (struct stack_segment_linkage *) stkl;
+
+ /* If one subtracts 'size' from the end of the segment,
+ one has the address of the first word of the segment.
+
+ If this is not the first segment, 'pseg' will be
+ nonzero. */
+
+ pseg = ssptr->sspseg;
+ size = ssptr->sssize;
+
+ this_segment = stkl - size;
+
+ /* It is possible that calling this routine itself caused
+ a stack overflow. Discard stack segments which do not
+ contain the target address. */
+
+ while (!(this_segment <= address && address <= stkl))
+ {
+#ifdef DEBUG_I00AFUNC
+ fprintf (stderr, "%011o %011o %011o\n", this_segment, address, stkl);
+#endif
+ if (pseg == 0)
+ break;
+ stkl = stkl - pseg;
+ ssptr = (struct stack_segment_linkage *) stkl;
+ size = ssptr->sssize;
+ pseg = ssptr->sspseg;
+ this_segment = stkl - size;
+ }
+
+ result = address - this_segment;
+
+ /* If you subtract pseg from the current end of the stack,
+ you get the address of the previous stack segment's end.
+ This seems a little convoluted to me, but I'll bet you save
+ a cycle somewhere. */
+
+ while (pseg != 0)
+ {
+#ifdef DEBUG_I00AFUNC
+ fprintf (stderr, "%011o %011o\n", pseg, size);
+#endif
+ stkl = stkl - pseg;
+ ssptr = (struct stack_segment_linkage *) stkl;
+ size = ssptr->sssize;
+ pseg = ssptr->sspseg;
+ result += size;
+ }
+ return (result);
+}
+
+#endif /* not CRAY2 */
+#endif /* CRAY && CRAY_STACKSEG_END */
+
+#endif /* no alloca */
+#endif /* !__GNUC__ || __GNUC__ < 2 */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/getpagesize.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/getpagesize.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..835f5da
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/getpagesize.h
@@ -0,0 +1,58 @@
+/* Emulation of getpagesize() for systems that need it.
+ Copyright (C) 1991-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
+(at your option) any later version.
+
+This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# ifdef _MINIX
+# include <sys/types.h>
+# endif
+# include <unistd.h>
+# if defined (_SC_PAGESIZE)
+# define getpagesize() sysconf(_SC_PAGESIZE)
+# else
+# if defined (_SC_PAGE_SIZE)
+# define getpagesize() sysconf(_SC_PAGE_SIZE)
+# endif /* _SC_PAGE_SIZE */
+# endif /* _SC_PAGESIZE */
+#endif
+
+#if !defined (getpagesize)
+# ifndef _MINIX
+# include <sys/param.h>
+# endif
+# if defined (PAGESIZE)
+# define getpagesize() PAGESIZE
+# else /* !PAGESIZE */
+# if defined (EXEC_PAGESIZE)
+# define getpagesize() EXEC_PAGESIZE
+# else /* !EXEC_PAGESIZE */
+# if defined (NBPG)
+# if !defined (CLSIZE)
+# define CLSIZE 1
+# endif /* !CLSIZE */
+# define getpagesize() (NBPG * CLSIZE)
+# else /* !NBPG */
+# if defined (NBPC)
+# define getpagesize() NBPC
+# endif /* NBPC */
+# endif /* !NBPG */
+# endif /* !EXEC_PAGESIZE */
+# endif /* !PAGESIZE */
+#endif /* !getpagesize */
+
+#if !defined (getpagesize)
+# define getpagesize() 4096 /* Just punt and use reasonable value */
+#endif
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/i386-alloca.s b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/i386-alloca.s
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..01b2cfe
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/i386-alloca.s
@@ -0,0 +1,16 @@
+ .file "alloca.s"
+ .text
+ .align 4
+ .def alloca; .val alloca; .scl 2; .type 044; .endef
+ .globl alloca
+alloca:
+ popl %edx
+ popl %eax
+ addl $3,%eax
+ andl $0xfffffffc,%eax
+ subl %eax,%esp
+ movl %esp,%eax
+ pushl %eax
+ pushl %edx
+ ret
+ .def alloca; .val .; .scl -1; .endef
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/imalloc.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/imalloc.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..72ba65a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/imalloc.h
@@ -0,0 +1,168 @@
+/* imalloc.h -- internal malloc definitions shared by source files. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 2001-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+/* Must be included *after* config.h */
+
+#ifndef _IMALLOC_H
+#define _IMALLOC_H
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_DEBUG
+#define MALLOC_STATS
+#define MALLOC_TRACE
+#define MALLOC_REGISTER
+#define MALLOC_WATCH
+#endif
+
+#define MALLOC_WRAPFUNCS
+
+/* Generic pointer type. */
+#ifndef PTR_T
+# if defined (__STDC__)
+# define PTR_T void *
+# else
+# define PTR_T char *
+# endif
+#endif
+
+#if !defined (NULL)
+# define NULL 0
+#endif
+
+#if !defined (__STRING)
+# if defined (HAVE_STRINGIZE)
+# define __STRING(x) #x
+# else
+# define __STRING(x) "x"
+# endif /* !HAVE_STRINGIZE */
+#endif /* !__STRING */
+
+#if __GNUC__ > 1
+# define FASTCOPY(s, d, n) __builtin_memcpy (d, s, n)
+#else /* !__GNUC__ */
+# if !defined (HAVE_BCOPY)
+# if !defined (HAVE_MEMMOVE)
+# define FASTCOPY(s, d, n) memcpy (d, s, n)
+# else
+# define FASTCOPY(s, d, n) memmove (d, s, n)
+# endif /* !HAVE_MEMMOVE */
+# else /* HAVE_BCOPY */
+# define FASTCOPY(s, d, n) bcopy (s, d, n)
+# endif /* HAVE_BCOPY */
+#endif /* !__GNUC__ */
+
+#if !defined (__P)
+# if defined (__STDC__) || defined (__GNUC__) || defined (__cplusplus) || defined (PROTOTYPES)
+# define __P(protos) protos
+# else
+# define __P(protos) ()
+# endif
+#endif
+
+/* Use Duff's device for good zeroing/copying performance. DO NOT call the
+ Duff's device macros with NBYTES == 0. */
+
+#define MALLOC_BZERO(charp, nbytes) \
+do { \
+ if ((nbytes) <= 32) { \
+ size_t * mzp = (size_t *)(charp); \
+ unsigned long mctmp = (nbytes)/sizeof(size_t); \
+ long mcn; \
+ if (mctmp < 8) mcn = 0; else { mcn = (mctmp-1)/8; mctmp &= 7; } \
+ switch (mctmp) { \
+ case 0: for(;;) { *mzp++ = 0; \
+ case 7: *mzp++ = 0; \
+ case 6: *mzp++ = 0; \
+ case 5: *mzp++ = 0; \
+ case 4: *mzp++ = 0; \
+ case 3: *mzp++ = 0; \
+ case 2: *mzp++ = 0; \
+ case 1: *mzp++ = 0; if(mcn <= 0) break; mcn--; } \
+ } \
+ else \
+ memset ((charp), 0, (nbytes)); \
+} while(0)
+
+#define MALLOC_ZERO(charp, nbytes) \
+do { \
+ size_t mzsz = (nbytes); \
+ if (mzsz <= 9 * sizeof(mzsz) { \
+ size_t *mz = (size_t *)(charp); \
+ if(mzsz >= 5*sizeof(mzsz)) { *mz++ = 0; \
+ *mz++ = 0; \
+ if(mzsz >= 7*sizeof(mzsz)) { *mz++ = 0; \
+ *mz++ = 0; \
+ if(mzsz >= 9*sizeof(mzsz)) { *mz++ = 0; \
+ *mz++ = 0; }}} \
+ *mz++ = 0; \
+ *mz++ = 0; \
+ *mz = 0; \
+ } else \
+ memset ((charp), 0, mzsz); \
+} while (0)
+
+#define MALLOC_MEMSET(charp, xch, nbytes) \
+do { \
+ if ((nbytes) <= 32) { \
+ register char * mzp = (charp); \
+ unsigned long mctmp = (nbytes); \
+ register long mcn; \
+ if (mctmp < 8) mcn = 0; else { mcn = (mctmp-1)/8; mctmp &= 7; } \
+ switch (mctmp) { \
+ case 0: for(;;) { *mzp++ = xch; \
+ case 7: *mzp++ = xch; \
+ case 6: *mzp++ = xch; \
+ case 5: *mzp++ = xch; \
+ case 4: *mzp++ = xch; \
+ case 3: *mzp++ = xch; \
+ case 2: *mzp++ = xch; \
+ case 1: *mzp++ = xch; if(mcn <= 0) break; mcn--; } \
+ } \
+ } else \
+ memset ((charp), (xch), (nbytes)); \
+} while(0)
+
+#define MALLOC_MEMCPY(dest,src,nbytes) \
+do { \
+ if ((nbytes) <= 32) { \
+ size_t* mcsrc = (size_t*) src; \
+ size_t* mcdst = (size_t*) dest; \
+ unsigned long mctmp = (nbytes)/sizeof(size_t); \
+ long mcn; \
+ if (mctmp < 8) mcn = 0; else { mcn = (mctmp-1)/8; mctmp &= 7; } \
+ switch (mctmp) { \
+ case 0: for(;;) { *mcdst++ = *mcsrc++; \
+ case 7: *mcdst++ = *mcsrc++; \
+ case 6: *mcdst++ = *mcsrc++; \
+ case 5: *mcdst++ = *mcsrc++; \
+ case 4: *mcdst++ = *mcsrc++; \
+ case 3: *mcdst++ = *mcsrc++; \
+ case 2: *mcdst++ = *mcsrc++; \
+ case 1: *mcdst++ = *mcsrc++; if(mcn <= 0) break; mcn--; } \
+ } else \
+ memcpy ((dest), (src), (nbytes)) \
+} while(0)
+
+#if defined (SHELL)
+# include "bashintl.h"
+#else
+# define _(x) x
+#endif
+
+#endif /* _IMALLOC_H */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/malloc.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/malloc.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f9a08da
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/malloc.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1305 @@
+/* malloc.c - dynamic memory allocation for bash. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1985-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA.
+
+In other words, you are welcome to use, share and improve this program.
+You are forbidden to forbid anyone else to use, share and improve
+what you give them. Help stamp out software-hoarding! */
+
+/*
+ * @(#)nmalloc.c 1 (Caltech) 2/21/82
+ *
+ * U of M Modified: 20 Jun 1983 ACT: strange hacks for Emacs
+ *
+ * Nov 1983, Mike@BRL, Added support for 4.1C/4.2 BSD.
+ *
+ * This is a very fast storage allocator. It allocates blocks of a small
+ * number of different sizes, and keeps free lists of each size. Blocks
+ * that don't exactly fit are passed up to the next larger size. In this
+ * implementation, the available sizes are (2^n)-4 (or -16) bytes long.
+ * This is designed for use in a program that uses vast quantities of
+ * memory, but bombs when it runs out. To make it a little better, it
+ * warns the user when he starts to get near the end.
+ *
+ * June 84, ACT: modified rcheck code to check the range given to malloc,
+ * rather than the range determined by the 2-power used.
+ *
+ * Jan 85, RMS: calls malloc_warning to issue warning on nearly full.
+ * No longer Emacs-specific; can serve as all-purpose malloc for GNU.
+ * You should call malloc_init to reinitialize after loading dumped Emacs.
+ * Call malloc_stats to get info on memory stats if MALLOC_STATS turned on.
+ * realloc knows how to return same block given, just changing its size,
+ * if the power of 2 is correct.
+ */
+
+/*
+ * nextf[i] is the pointer to the next free block of size 2^(i+3). The
+ * smallest allocatable block is 8 bytes. The overhead information will
+ * go in the first int of the block, and the returned pointer will point
+ * to the second.
+ */
+
+/* Define MEMSCRAMBLE to have free() write 0xcf into memory as it's freed, to
+ uncover callers that refer to freed memory, and to have malloc() write 0xdf
+ into memory as it's allocated to avoid referring to previous contents. */
+
+/* SCO 3.2v4 getcwd and possibly other libc routines fail with MEMSCRAMBLE;
+ handled by configure. */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif /* HAVE_CONFIG_H */
+
+#if defined (SHELL)
+# include "bashtypes.h"
+# include "stdc.h"
+#else
+# include <sys/types.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+/* Determine which kind of system this is. */
+#include <signal.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STRING_H)
+# include <string.h>
+#else
+# include <strings.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+/* Define getpagesize () if the system does not. */
+#ifndef HAVE_GETPAGESIZE
+# include "getpagesize.h"
+#endif
+
+#include "imalloc.h"
+#ifdef MALLOC_STATS
+# include "mstats.h"
+#endif
+#ifdef MALLOC_REGISTER
+# include "table.h"
+#endif
+#ifdef MALLOC_WATCH
+# include "watch.h"
+#endif
+
+/* System-specific omissions. */
+#ifdef HPUX
+# define NO_VALLOC
+#endif
+
+#define NBUCKETS 30
+
+#define ISALLOC ((char) 0xf7) /* magic byte that implies allocation */
+#define ISFREE ((char) 0x54) /* magic byte that implies free block */
+ /* this is for error checking only */
+#define ISMEMALIGN ((char) 0xd6) /* Stored before the value returned by
+ memalign, with the rest of the word
+ being the distance to the true
+ beginning of the block. */
+
+
+/* We have a flag indicating whether memory is allocated, an index in
+ nextf[], a size field, and a sentinel value to determine whether or
+ not a caller wrote before the start of allocated memory; to realloc()
+ memory we either copy mh_nbytes or just change mh_nbytes if there is
+ enough room in the block for the new size. Range checking is always
+ done. */
+union mhead {
+ bits64_t mh_align; /* 8 */
+ struct {
+ char mi_alloc; /* ISALLOC or ISFREE */ /* 1 */
+ char mi_index; /* index in nextf[] */ /* 1 */
+ /* Remainder are valid only when block is allocated */
+ u_bits16_t mi_magic2; /* should be == MAGIC2 */ /* 2 */
+ u_bits32_t mi_nbytes; /* # of bytes allocated */ /* 4 */
+ } minfo;
+};
+#define mh_alloc minfo.mi_alloc
+#define mh_index minfo.mi_index
+#define mh_nbytes minfo.mi_nbytes
+#define mh_magic2 minfo.mi_magic2
+
+#define MOVERHEAD sizeof(union mhead)
+#define MALIGN_MASK 7 /* one less than desired alignment */
+
+typedef union _malloc_guard {
+ char s[4];
+ u_bits32_t i;
+} mguard_t;
+
+/* Access free-list pointer of a block.
+ It is stored at block + sizeof (char *).
+ This is not a field in the minfo structure member of union mhead
+ because we want sizeof (union mhead)
+ to describe the overhead for when the block is in use,
+ and we do not want the free-list pointer to count in that. */
+
+#define CHAIN(a) \
+ (*(union mhead **) (sizeof (char *) + (char *) (a)))
+
+/* To implement range checking, we write magic values in at the beginning
+ and end of each allocated block, and make sure they are undisturbed
+ whenever a free or a realloc occurs. */
+
+/* Written in the 2 bytes before the block's real space (-4 bytes) */
+#define MAGIC2 0x5555
+#define MSLOP 4 /* 4 bytes extra for u_bits32_t size */
+
+/* How many bytes are actually allocated for a request of size N --
+ rounded up to nearest multiple of 8 after accounting for malloc
+ overhead. */
+#define ALLOCATED_BYTES(n) \
+ (((n) + MOVERHEAD + MSLOP + MALIGN_MASK) & ~MALIGN_MASK)
+
+#define ASSERT(p) \
+ do \
+ { \
+ if (!(p)) xbotch((PTR_T)0, ERR_ASSERT_FAILED, __STRING(p), file, line); \
+ } \
+ while (0)
+
+/* Minimum and maximum bucket indices for block splitting (and to bound
+ the search for a block to split). */
+#define SPLIT_MIN 2 /* XXX - was 3 */
+#define SPLIT_MID 11
+#define SPLIT_MAX 14
+
+/* Minimum and maximum bucket indices for block coalescing. */
+#define COMBINE_MIN 2
+#define COMBINE_MAX (pagebucket - 1) /* XXX */
+
+#define LESSCORE_MIN 10
+#define LESSCORE_FRC 13
+
+#define STARTBUCK 1
+
+/* Flags for the internal functions. */
+#define MALLOC_WRAPPER 0x01 /* wrapper function */
+#define MALLOC_INTERNAL 0x02 /* internal function calling another */
+#define MALLOC_NOTRACE 0x04 /* don't trace this allocation or free */
+#define MALLOC_NOREG 0x08 /* don't register this allocation or free */
+
+/* Future use. */
+#define ERR_DUPFREE 0x01
+#define ERR_UNALLOC 0x02
+#define ERR_UNDERFLOW 0x04
+#define ERR_ASSERT_FAILED 0x08
+
+/* Evaluates to true if NB is appropriate for bucket NU. NB is adjusted
+ appropriately by the caller to account for malloc overhead. This only
+ checks that the recorded size is not too big for the bucket. We
+ can't check whether or not it's in between NU and NU-1 because we
+ might have encountered a busy bucket when allocating and moved up to
+ the next size. */
+#define IN_BUCKET(nb, nu) ((nb) <= binsizes[(nu)])
+
+/* Use this when we want to be sure that NB is in bucket NU. */
+#define RIGHT_BUCKET(nb, nu) \
+ (((nb) > binsizes[(nu)-1]) && ((nb) <= binsizes[(nu)]))
+
+/* nextf[i] is free list of blocks of size 2**(i + 3) */
+
+static union mhead *nextf[NBUCKETS];
+
+/* busy[i] is nonzero while allocation or free of block size i is in progress. */
+
+static char busy[NBUCKETS];
+
+static int pagesz; /* system page size. */
+static int pagebucket; /* bucket for requests a page in size */
+static int maxbuck; /* highest bucket receiving allocation request. */
+
+static char *memtop; /* top of heap */
+
+static unsigned long binsizes[NBUCKETS] = {
+ 8UL, 16UL, 32UL, 64UL, 128UL, 256UL, 512UL, 1024UL, 2048UL, 4096UL,
+ 8192UL, 16384UL, 32768UL, 65536UL, 131072UL, 262144UL, 524288UL,
+ 1048576UL, 2097152UL, 4194304UL, 8388608UL, 16777216UL, 33554432UL,
+ 67108864UL, 134217728UL, 268435456UL, 536870912UL, 1073741824UL,
+ 2147483648UL, 4294967295UL
+};
+
+/* binsizes[x] == (1 << ((x) + 3)) */
+#define binsize(x) binsizes[(x)]
+
+/* Declarations for internal functions */
+static PTR_T internal_malloc __P((size_t, const char *, int, int));
+static PTR_T internal_realloc __P((PTR_T, size_t, const char *, int, int));
+static void internal_free __P((PTR_T, const char *, int, int));
+static PTR_T internal_memalign __P((size_t, size_t, const char *, int, int));
+#ifndef NO_CALLOC
+static PTR_T internal_calloc __P((size_t, size_t, const char *, int, int));
+static void internal_cfree __P((PTR_T, const char *, int, int));
+#endif
+#ifndef NO_VALLOC
+static PTR_T internal_valloc __P((size_t, const char *, int, int));
+#endif
+
+#if defined (botch)
+extern void botch ();
+#else
+static void botch __P((const char *, const char *, int));
+#endif
+static void xbotch __P((PTR_T, int, const char *, const char *, int));
+
+#if !HAVE_DECL_SBRK
+extern char *sbrk ();
+#endif /* !HAVE_DECL_SBRK */
+
+#ifdef SHELL
+extern int interrupt_immediately;
+extern int signal_is_trapped __P((int));
+#endif
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_STATS
+struct _malstats _mstats;
+#endif /* MALLOC_STATS */
+
+/* Debugging variables available to applications. */
+int malloc_flags = 0; /* future use */
+int malloc_trace = 0; /* trace allocations and frees to stderr */
+int malloc_register = 0; /* future use */
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_TRACE
+char _malloc_trace_buckets[NBUCKETS];
+
+/* These should really go into a header file. */
+extern void mtrace_alloc __P((const char *, PTR_T, size_t, const char *, int));
+extern void mtrace_free __P((PTR_T, int, const char *, int));
+#endif
+
+#if !defined (botch)
+static void
+botch (s, file, line)
+ const char *s;
+ const char *file;
+ int line;
+{
+ fprintf (stderr, _("malloc: failed assertion: %s\n"), s);
+ (void)fflush (stderr);
+ abort ();
+}
+#endif
+
+/* print the file and line number that caused the assertion failure and
+ call botch() to do whatever the application wants with the information */
+static void
+xbotch (mem, e, s, file, line)
+ PTR_T mem;
+ int e;
+ const char *s;
+ const char *file;
+ int line;
+{
+ fprintf (stderr, _("\r\nmalloc: %s:%d: assertion botched\r\n"),
+ file ? file : "unknown", line);
+#ifdef MALLOC_REGISTER
+ if (mem != NULL && malloc_register)
+ mregister_describe_mem (mem, stderr);
+#endif
+ (void)fflush (stderr);
+ botch(s, file, line);
+}
+
+/* Coalesce two adjacent free blocks off the free list for size NU - 1,
+ as long as we can find two adjacent free blocks. nextf[NU -1] is
+ assumed to not be busy; the caller (morecore()) checks for this.
+ BUSY[NU] must be set to 1. */
+static void
+bcoalesce (nu)
+ register int nu;
+{
+ register union mhead *mp, *mp1, *mp2;
+ register int nbuck;
+ unsigned long siz;
+
+ nbuck = nu - 1;
+ if (nextf[nbuck] == 0 || busy[nbuck])
+ return;
+
+ busy[nbuck] = 1;
+ siz = binsize (nbuck);
+
+ mp2 = mp1 = nextf[nbuck];
+ mp = CHAIN (mp1);
+ while (mp && mp != (union mhead *)((char *)mp1 + siz))
+ {
+ mp2 = mp1;
+ mp1 = mp;
+ mp = CHAIN (mp);
+ }
+
+ if (mp == 0)
+ {
+ busy[nbuck] = 0;
+ return;
+ }
+
+ /* OK, now we have mp1 pointing to the block we want to add to nextf[NU].
+ CHAIN(mp2) must equal mp1. Check that mp1 and mp are adjacent. */
+ if (mp2 != mp1 && CHAIN(mp2) != mp1)
+ {
+ busy[nbuck] = 0;
+ xbotch ((PTR_T)0, 0, "bcoalesce: CHAIN(mp2) != mp1", (char *)NULL, 0);
+ }
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_DEBUG
+ if (CHAIN (mp1) != (union mhead *)((char *)mp1 + siz))
+ {
+ busy[nbuck] = 0;
+ return; /* not adjacent */
+ }
+#endif
+
+ /* Since they are adjacent, remove them from the free list */
+ if (mp1 == nextf[nbuck])
+ nextf[nbuck] = CHAIN (mp);
+ else
+ CHAIN (mp2) = CHAIN (mp);
+ busy[nbuck] = 0;
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_STATS
+ _mstats.tbcoalesce++;
+ _mstats.ncoalesce[nbuck]++;
+#endif
+
+ /* And add the combined two blocks to nextf[NU]. */
+ mp1->mh_alloc = ISFREE;
+ mp1->mh_index = nu;
+ CHAIN (mp1) = nextf[nu];
+ nextf[nu] = mp1;
+}
+
+/* Split a block at index > NU (but less than SPLIT_MAX) into a set of
+ blocks of the correct size, and attach them to nextf[NU]. nextf[NU]
+ is assumed to be empty. Must be called with signals blocked (e.g.,
+ by morecore()). BUSY[NU] must be set to 1. */
+static void
+bsplit (nu)
+ register int nu;
+{
+ register union mhead *mp;
+ int nbuck, nblks, split_max;
+ unsigned long siz;
+
+ split_max = (maxbuck > SPLIT_MAX) ? maxbuck : SPLIT_MAX;
+
+ if (nu >= SPLIT_MID)
+ {
+ for (nbuck = split_max; nbuck > nu; nbuck--)
+ {
+ if (busy[nbuck] || nextf[nbuck] == 0)
+ continue;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ for (nbuck = nu + 1; nbuck <= split_max; nbuck++)
+ {
+ if (busy[nbuck] || nextf[nbuck] == 0)
+ continue;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (nbuck > split_max || nbuck <= nu)
+ return;
+
+ /* XXX might want to split only if nextf[nbuck] has >= 2 blocks free
+ and nbuck is below some threshold. */
+
+ /* Remove the block from the chain of larger blocks. */
+ busy[nbuck] = 1;
+ mp = nextf[nbuck];
+ nextf[nbuck] = CHAIN (mp);
+ busy[nbuck] = 0;
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_STATS
+ _mstats.tbsplit++;
+ _mstats.nsplit[nbuck]++;
+#endif
+
+ /* Figure out how many blocks we'll get. */
+ siz = binsize (nu);
+ nblks = binsize (nbuck) / siz;
+
+ /* Split the block and put it on the requested chain. */
+ nextf[nu] = mp;
+ while (1)
+ {
+ mp->mh_alloc = ISFREE;
+ mp->mh_index = nu;
+ if (--nblks <= 0) break;
+ CHAIN (mp) = (union mhead *)((char *)mp + siz);
+ mp = (union mhead *)((char *)mp + siz);
+ }
+ CHAIN (mp) = 0;
+}
+
+/* Take the memory block MP and add it to a chain < NU. NU is the right bucket,
+ but is busy. This avoids memory orphaning. */
+static void
+xsplit (mp, nu)
+ union mhead *mp;
+ int nu;
+{
+ union mhead *nh;
+ int nbuck, nblks, split_max;
+ unsigned long siz;
+
+ nbuck = nu - 1;
+ while (nbuck >= SPLIT_MIN && busy[nbuck])
+ nbuck--;
+ if (nbuck < SPLIT_MIN)
+ return;
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_STATS
+ _mstats.tbsplit++;
+ _mstats.nsplit[nu]++;
+#endif
+
+ /* Figure out how many blocks we'll get. */
+ siz = binsize (nu); /* original block size */
+ nblks = siz / binsize (nbuck); /* should be 2 most of the time */
+
+ /* And add it to nextf[nbuck] */
+ siz = binsize (nbuck); /* XXX - resetting here */
+ nh = mp;
+ while (1)
+ {
+ mp->mh_alloc = ISFREE;
+ mp->mh_index = nbuck;
+ if (--nblks <= 0) break;
+ CHAIN (mp) = (union mhead *)((char *)mp + siz);
+ mp = (union mhead *)((char *)mp + siz);
+ }
+ busy[nbuck] = 1;
+ CHAIN (mp) = nextf[nbuck];
+ nextf[nbuck] = nh;
+ busy[nbuck] = 0;
+}
+
+static void
+block_signals (setp, osetp)
+ sigset_t *setp, *osetp;
+{
+#ifdef HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS
+ sigfillset (setp);
+ sigemptyset (osetp);
+ sigprocmask (SIG_BLOCK, setp, osetp);
+#else
+# if defined (HAVE_BSD_SIGNALS)
+ *osetp = sigsetmask (-1);
+# endif
+#endif
+}
+
+static void
+unblock_signals (setp, osetp)
+ sigset_t *setp, *osetp;
+{
+#ifdef HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS
+ sigprocmask (SIG_SETMASK, osetp, (sigset_t *)NULL);
+#else
+# if defined (HAVE_BSD_SIGNALS)
+ sigsetmask (*osetp);
+# endif
+#endif
+}
+
+/* Return some memory to the system by reducing the break. This is only
+ called with NU > pagebucket, so we're always assured of giving back
+ more than one page of memory. */
+static void
+lesscore (nu) /* give system back some memory */
+ register int nu; /* size index we're discarding */
+{
+ long siz;
+
+ siz = binsize (nu);
+ /* Should check for errors here, I guess. */
+ sbrk (-siz);
+ memtop -= siz;
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_STATS
+ _mstats.nsbrk++;
+ _mstats.tsbrk -= siz;
+ _mstats.nlesscore[nu]++;
+#endif
+}
+
+/* Ask system for more memory; add to NEXTF[NU]. BUSY[NU] must be set to 1. */
+static void
+morecore (nu)
+ register int nu; /* size index to get more of */
+{
+ register union mhead *mp;
+ register int nblks;
+ register long siz;
+ long sbrk_amt; /* amount to get via sbrk() */
+ sigset_t set, oset;
+ int blocked_sigs;
+
+ /* Block all signals in case we are executed from a signal handler. */
+ blocked_sigs = 0;
+#ifdef SHELL
+ if (interrupt_immediately || signal_is_trapped (SIGINT) || signal_is_trapped (SIGCHLD))
+#endif
+ {
+ block_signals (&set, &oset);
+ blocked_sigs = 1;
+ }
+
+ siz = binsize (nu); /* size of desired block for nextf[nu] */
+
+ if (siz < 0)
+ goto morecore_done; /* oops */
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_STATS
+ _mstats.nmorecore[nu]++;
+#endif
+
+ /* Try to split a larger block here, if we're within the range of sizes
+ to split. */
+ if (nu >= SPLIT_MIN)
+ {
+ bsplit (nu);
+ if (nextf[nu] != 0)
+ goto morecore_done;
+ }
+
+ /* Try to coalesce two adjacent blocks from the free list on nextf[nu - 1],
+ if we can, and we're within the range of the block coalescing limits. */
+ if (nu >= COMBINE_MIN && nu < COMBINE_MAX && busy[nu - 1] == 0 && nextf[nu - 1])
+ {
+ bcoalesce (nu);
+ if (nextf[nu] != 0)
+ goto morecore_done;
+ }
+
+ /* Take at least a page, and figure out how many blocks of the requested
+ size we're getting. */
+ if (siz <= pagesz)
+ {
+ sbrk_amt = pagesz;
+ nblks = sbrk_amt / siz;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* We always want to request an integral multiple of the page size
+ from the kernel, so let's compute whether or not `siz' is such
+ an amount. If it is, we can just request it. If not, we want
+ the smallest integral multiple of pagesize that is larger than
+ `siz' and will satisfy the request. */
+ sbrk_amt = siz & (pagesz - 1);
+ if (sbrk_amt == 0)
+ sbrk_amt = siz;
+ else
+ sbrk_amt = siz + pagesz - sbrk_amt;
+ nblks = 1;
+ }
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_STATS
+ _mstats.nsbrk++;
+ _mstats.tsbrk += sbrk_amt;
+#endif
+
+ mp = (union mhead *) sbrk (sbrk_amt);
+
+ /* Totally out of memory. */
+ if ((long)mp == -1)
+ goto morecore_done;
+
+ memtop += sbrk_amt;
+
+ /* shouldn't happen, but just in case -- require 8-byte alignment */
+ if ((long)mp & MALIGN_MASK)
+ {
+ mp = (union mhead *) (((long)mp + MALIGN_MASK) & ~MALIGN_MASK);
+ nblks--;
+ }
+
+ /* save new header and link the nblks blocks together */
+ nextf[nu] = mp;
+ while (1)
+ {
+ mp->mh_alloc = ISFREE;
+ mp->mh_index = nu;
+ if (--nblks <= 0) break;
+ CHAIN (mp) = (union mhead *)((char *)mp + siz);
+ mp = (union mhead *)((char *)mp + siz);
+ }
+ CHAIN (mp) = 0;
+
+morecore_done:
+ if (blocked_sigs)
+ unblock_signals (&set, &oset);
+}
+
+static void
+malloc_debug_dummy ()
+{
+ write (1, "malloc_debug_dummy\n", 19);
+}
+
+#define PREPOP_BIN 2
+#define PREPOP_SIZE 32
+
+static int
+pagealign ()
+{
+ register int nunits;
+ register union mhead *mp;
+ long sbrk_needed;
+ char *curbrk;
+
+ pagesz = getpagesize ();
+ if (pagesz < 1024)
+ pagesz = 1024;
+
+ /* OK, how much do we need to allocate to make things page-aligned?
+ Some of this partial page will be wasted space, but we'll use as
+ much as we can. Once we figure out how much to advance the break
+ pointer, go ahead and do it. */
+ memtop = curbrk = sbrk (0);
+ sbrk_needed = pagesz - ((long)curbrk & (pagesz - 1)); /* sbrk(0) % pagesz */
+ if (sbrk_needed < 0)
+ sbrk_needed += pagesz;
+
+ /* Now allocate the wasted space. */
+ if (sbrk_needed)
+ {
+#ifdef MALLOC_STATS
+ _mstats.nsbrk++;
+ _mstats.tsbrk += sbrk_needed;
+#endif
+ curbrk = sbrk (sbrk_needed);
+ if ((long)curbrk == -1)
+ return -1;
+ memtop += sbrk_needed;
+
+ /* Take the memory which would otherwise be wasted and populate the most
+ popular bin (2 == 32 bytes) with it. Add whatever we need to curbrk
+ to make things 32-byte aligned, compute how many 32-byte chunks we're
+ going to get, and set up the bin. */
+ curbrk += sbrk_needed & (PREPOP_SIZE - 1);
+ sbrk_needed -= sbrk_needed & (PREPOP_SIZE - 1);
+ nunits = sbrk_needed / PREPOP_SIZE;
+
+ if (nunits > 0)
+ {
+ mp = (union mhead *)curbrk;
+
+ nextf[PREPOP_BIN] = mp;
+ while (1)
+ {
+ mp->mh_alloc = ISFREE;
+ mp->mh_index = PREPOP_BIN;
+ if (--nunits <= 0) break;
+ CHAIN(mp) = (union mhead *)((char *)mp + PREPOP_SIZE);
+ mp = (union mhead *)((char *)mp + PREPOP_SIZE);
+ }
+ CHAIN(mp) = 0;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* compute which bin corresponds to the page size. */
+ for (nunits = 7; nunits < NBUCKETS; nunits++)
+ if (pagesz <= binsize(nunits))
+ break;
+ pagebucket = nunits;
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+static PTR_T
+internal_malloc (n, file, line, flags) /* get a block */
+ size_t n;
+ const char *file;
+ int line, flags;
+{
+ register union mhead *p;
+ register int nunits;
+ register char *m, *z;
+ long nbytes;
+ mguard_t mg;
+
+ /* Get the system page size and align break pointer so future sbrks will
+ be page-aligned. The page size must be at least 1K -- anything
+ smaller is increased. */
+ if (pagesz == 0)
+ if (pagealign () < 0)
+ return ((PTR_T)NULL);
+
+ /* Figure out how many bytes are required, rounding up to the nearest
+ multiple of 8, then figure out which nextf[] area to use. Try to
+ be smart about where to start searching -- if the number of bytes
+ needed is greater than the page size, we can start at pagebucket. */
+ nbytes = ALLOCATED_BYTES(n);
+ nunits = (nbytes <= (pagesz >> 1)) ? STARTBUCK : pagebucket;
+ for ( ; nunits < NBUCKETS; nunits++)
+ if (nbytes <= binsize(nunits))
+ break;
+
+ /* Silently reject too-large requests. */
+ if (nunits >= NBUCKETS)
+ return ((PTR_T) NULL);
+
+ /* In case this is reentrant use of malloc from signal handler,
+ pick a block size that no other malloc level is currently
+ trying to allocate. That's the easiest harmless way not to
+ interfere with the other level of execution. */
+#ifdef MALLOC_STATS
+ if (busy[nunits]) _mstats.nrecurse++;
+#endif
+ while (busy[nunits]) nunits++;
+ busy[nunits] = 1;
+
+ if (nunits > maxbuck)
+ maxbuck = nunits;
+
+ /* If there are no blocks of the appropriate size, go get some */
+ if (nextf[nunits] == 0)
+ morecore (nunits);
+
+ /* Get one block off the list, and set the new list head */
+ if ((p = nextf[nunits]) == NULL)
+ {
+ busy[nunits] = 0;
+ return NULL;
+ }
+ nextf[nunits] = CHAIN (p);
+ busy[nunits] = 0;
+
+ /* Check for free block clobbered */
+ /* If not for this check, we would gobble a clobbered free chain ptr
+ and bomb out on the NEXT allocate of this size block */
+ if (p->mh_alloc != ISFREE || p->mh_index != nunits)
+ xbotch ((PTR_T)(p+1), 0, _("malloc: block on free list clobbered"), file, line);
+
+ /* Fill in the info, and set up the magic numbers for range checking. */
+ p->mh_alloc = ISALLOC;
+ p->mh_magic2 = MAGIC2;
+ p->mh_nbytes = n;
+
+ /* End guard */
+ mg.i = n;
+ z = mg.s;
+ m = (char *) (p + 1) + n;
+ *m++ = *z++, *m++ = *z++, *m++ = *z++, *m++ = *z++;
+
+#ifdef MEMSCRAMBLE
+ if (n)
+ MALLOC_MEMSET ((char *)(p + 1), 0xdf, n); /* scramble previous contents */
+#endif
+#ifdef MALLOC_STATS
+ _mstats.nmalloc[nunits]++;
+ _mstats.tmalloc[nunits]++;
+ _mstats.nmal++;
+ _mstats.bytesreq += n;
+#endif /* MALLOC_STATS */
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_TRACE
+ if (malloc_trace && (flags & MALLOC_NOTRACE) == 0)
+ mtrace_alloc ("malloc", p + 1, n, file, line);
+ else if (_malloc_trace_buckets[nunits])
+ mtrace_alloc ("malloc", p + 1, n, file, line);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_REGISTER
+ if (malloc_register && (flags & MALLOC_NOREG) == 0)
+ mregister_alloc ("malloc", p + 1, n, file, line);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_WATCH
+ if (_malloc_nwatch > 0)
+ _malloc_ckwatch (p + 1, file, line, W_ALLOC, n);
+#endif
+
+ return (PTR_T) (p + 1);
+}
+
+static void
+internal_free (mem, file, line, flags)
+ PTR_T mem;
+ const char *file;
+ int line, flags;
+{
+ register union mhead *p;
+ register char *ap, *z;
+ register int nunits;
+ register unsigned int nbytes;
+ int ubytes; /* caller-requested size */
+ mguard_t mg;
+
+ if ((ap = (char *)mem) == 0)
+ return;
+
+ p = (union mhead *) ap - 1;
+
+ if (p->mh_alloc == ISMEMALIGN)
+ {
+ ap -= p->mh_nbytes;
+ p = (union mhead *) ap - 1;
+ }
+
+#if defined (MALLOC_TRACE) || defined (MALLOC_REGISTER)
+ if (malloc_trace || malloc_register)
+ ubytes = p->mh_nbytes;
+#endif
+
+ if (p->mh_alloc != ISALLOC)
+ {
+ if (p->mh_alloc == ISFREE)
+ xbotch (mem, ERR_DUPFREE,
+ _("free: called with already freed block argument"), file, line);
+ else
+ xbotch (mem, ERR_UNALLOC,
+ _("free: called with unallocated block argument"), file, line);
+ }
+
+ ASSERT (p->mh_magic2 == MAGIC2);
+
+ nunits = p->mh_index;
+ nbytes = ALLOCATED_BYTES(p->mh_nbytes);
+ /* Since the sizeof(u_bits32_t) bytes before the memory handed to the user
+ are now used for the number of bytes allocated, a simple check of
+ mh_magic2 is no longer sufficient to catch things like p[-1] = 'x'.
+ We sanity-check the value of mh_nbytes against the size of the blocks
+ in the appropriate bucket before we use it. This can still cause problems
+ and obscure errors if mh_nbytes is wrong but still within range; the
+ checks against the size recorded at the end of the chunk will probably
+ fail then. Using MALLOC_REGISTER will help here, since it saves the
+ original number of bytes requested. */
+
+ if (IN_BUCKET(nbytes, nunits) == 0)
+ xbotch (mem, ERR_UNDERFLOW,
+ _("free: underflow detected; mh_nbytes out of range"), file, line);
+
+ ap += p->mh_nbytes;
+ z = mg.s;
+ *z++ = *ap++, *z++ = *ap++, *z++ = *ap++, *z++ = *ap++;
+ if (mg.i != p->mh_nbytes)
+ xbotch (mem, ERR_ASSERT_FAILED, _("free: start and end chunk sizes differ"), file, line);
+
+#if 1
+ if (nunits >= LESSCORE_MIN && ((char *)p + binsize(nunits) == memtop))
+#else
+ if (((char *)p + binsize(nunits) == memtop) && nunits >= LESSCORE_MIN)
+#endif
+ {
+ /* If above LESSCORE_FRC, give back unconditionally. This should be set
+ high enough to be infrequently encountered. If between LESSCORE_MIN
+ and LESSCORE_FRC, call lesscore if the bucket is marked as busy or if
+ there's already a block on the free list. */
+ if ((nunits >= LESSCORE_FRC) || busy[nunits] || nextf[nunits] != 0)
+ {
+ lesscore (nunits);
+ /* keeps the tracing and registering code in one place */
+ goto free_return;
+ }
+ }
+
+#ifdef MEMSCRAMBLE
+ if (p->mh_nbytes)
+ MALLOC_MEMSET (mem, 0xcf, p->mh_nbytes);
+#endif
+
+ ASSERT (nunits < NBUCKETS);
+
+ if (busy[nunits] == 1)
+ {
+ xsplit (p, nunits); /* split block and add to different chain */
+ goto free_return;
+ }
+
+ p->mh_alloc = ISFREE;
+ /* Protect against signal handlers calling malloc. */
+ busy[nunits] = 1;
+ /* Put this block on the free list. */
+ CHAIN (p) = nextf[nunits];
+ nextf[nunits] = p;
+ busy[nunits] = 0;
+
+free_return:
+ ; /* Empty statement in case this is the end of the function */
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_STATS
+ _mstats.nmalloc[nunits]--;
+ _mstats.nfre++;
+#endif /* MALLOC_STATS */
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_TRACE
+ if (malloc_trace && (flags & MALLOC_NOTRACE) == 0)
+ mtrace_free (mem, ubytes, file, line);
+ else if (_malloc_trace_buckets[nunits])
+ mtrace_free (mem, ubytes, file, line);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_REGISTER
+ if (malloc_register && (flags & MALLOC_NOREG) == 0)
+ mregister_free (mem, ubytes, file, line);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_WATCH
+ if (_malloc_nwatch > 0)
+ _malloc_ckwatch (mem, file, line, W_FREE, ubytes);
+#endif
+}
+
+static PTR_T
+internal_realloc (mem, n, file, line, flags)
+ PTR_T mem;
+ register size_t n;
+ const char *file;
+ int line, flags;
+{
+ register union mhead *p;
+ register u_bits32_t tocopy;
+ register unsigned int nbytes;
+ register int nunits;
+ register char *m, *z;
+ mguard_t mg;
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_STATS
+ _mstats.nrealloc++;
+#endif
+
+ if (n == 0)
+ {
+ internal_free (mem, file, line, MALLOC_INTERNAL);
+ return (NULL);
+ }
+ if ((p = (union mhead *) mem) == 0)
+ return internal_malloc (n, file, line, MALLOC_INTERNAL);
+
+ p--;
+ nunits = p->mh_index;
+ ASSERT (nunits < NBUCKETS);
+
+ if (p->mh_alloc != ISALLOC)
+ xbotch (mem, ERR_UNALLOC,
+ _("realloc: called with unallocated block argument"), file, line);
+
+ ASSERT (p->mh_magic2 == MAGIC2);
+ nbytes = ALLOCATED_BYTES(p->mh_nbytes);
+ /* Since the sizeof(u_bits32_t) bytes before the memory handed to the user
+ are now used for the number of bytes allocated, a simple check of
+ mh_magic2 is no longer sufficient to catch things like p[-1] = 'x'.
+ We sanity-check the value of mh_nbytes against the size of the blocks
+ in the appropriate bucket before we use it. This can still cause problems
+ and obscure errors if mh_nbytes is wrong but still within range; the
+ checks against the size recorded at the end of the chunk will probably
+ fail then. Using MALLOC_REGISTER will help here, since it saves the
+ original number of bytes requested. */
+ if (IN_BUCKET(nbytes, nunits) == 0)
+ xbotch (mem, ERR_UNDERFLOW,
+ _("realloc: underflow detected; mh_nbytes out of range"), file, line);
+
+ m = (char *)mem + (tocopy = p->mh_nbytes);
+ z = mg.s;
+ *z++ = *m++, *z++ = *m++, *z++ = *m++, *z++ = *m++;
+ if (mg.i != p->mh_nbytes)
+ xbotch (mem, ERR_ASSERT_FAILED, _("realloc: start and end chunk sizes differ"), file, line);
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_WATCH
+ if (_malloc_nwatch > 0)
+ _malloc_ckwatch (p + 1, file, line, W_REALLOC, n);
+#endif
+#ifdef MALLOC_STATS
+ _mstats.bytesreq += (n < tocopy) ? 0 : n - tocopy;
+#endif
+
+ /* See if desired size rounds to same power of 2 as actual size. */
+ nbytes = ALLOCATED_BYTES(n);
+
+ /* If ok, use the same block, just marking its size as changed. */
+ if (RIGHT_BUCKET(nbytes, nunits))
+ {
+#if 0
+ m = (char *)mem + p->mh_nbytes;
+#else
+ /* Compensate for increment above. */
+ m -= 4;
+#endif
+ *m++ = 0; *m++ = 0; *m++ = 0; *m++ = 0;
+ m = (char *)mem + (p->mh_nbytes = n);
+
+ mg.i = n;
+ z = mg.s;
+ *m++ = *z++, *m++ = *z++, *m++ = *z++, *m++ = *z++;
+
+ return mem;
+ }
+
+ if (n < tocopy)
+ tocopy = n;
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_STATS
+ _mstats.nrcopy++;
+#endif
+
+ if ((m = internal_malloc (n, file, line, MALLOC_INTERNAL|MALLOC_NOTRACE|MALLOC_NOREG)) == 0)
+ return 0;
+ FASTCOPY (mem, m, tocopy);
+ internal_free (mem, file, line, MALLOC_INTERNAL);
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_TRACE
+ if (malloc_trace && (flags & MALLOC_NOTRACE) == 0)
+ mtrace_alloc ("realloc", m, n, file, line);
+ else if (_malloc_trace_buckets[nunits])
+ mtrace_alloc ("realloc", m, n, file, line);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_REGISTER
+ if (malloc_register && (flags & MALLOC_NOREG) == 0)
+ mregister_alloc ("realloc", m, n, file, line);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_WATCH
+ if (_malloc_nwatch > 0)
+ _malloc_ckwatch (m, file, line, W_RESIZED, n);
+#endif
+
+ return m;
+}
+
+static PTR_T
+internal_memalign (alignment, size, file, line, flags)
+ size_t alignment;
+ size_t size;
+ const char *file;
+ int line, flags;
+{
+ register char *ptr;
+ register char *aligned;
+ register union mhead *p;
+
+ ptr = internal_malloc (size + alignment, file, line, MALLOC_INTERNAL);
+
+ if (ptr == 0)
+ return 0;
+ /* If entire block has the desired alignment, just accept it. */
+ if (((long) ptr & (alignment - 1)) == 0)
+ return ptr;
+ /* Otherwise, get address of byte in the block that has that alignment. */
+#if 0
+ aligned = (char *) (((long) ptr + alignment - 1) & -alignment);
+#else
+ aligned = (char *) (((long) ptr + alignment - 1) & (~alignment + 1));
+#endif
+
+ /* Store a suitable indication of how to free the block,
+ so that free can find the true beginning of it. */
+ p = (union mhead *) aligned - 1;
+ p->mh_nbytes = aligned - ptr;
+ p->mh_alloc = ISMEMALIGN;
+
+ return aligned;
+}
+
+#if !defined (NO_VALLOC)
+/* This runs into trouble with getpagesize on HPUX, and Multimax machines.
+ Patching out seems cleaner than the ugly fix needed. */
+static PTR_T
+internal_valloc (size, file, line, flags)
+ size_t size;
+ const char *file;
+ int line, flags;
+{
+ return internal_memalign (getpagesize (), size, file, line, flags|MALLOC_INTERNAL);
+}
+#endif /* !NO_VALLOC */
+
+#ifndef NO_CALLOC
+static PTR_T
+internal_calloc (n, s, file, line, flags)
+ size_t n, s;
+ const char *file;
+ int line, flags;
+{
+ size_t total;
+ PTR_T result;
+
+ total = n * s;
+ result = internal_malloc (total, file, line, flags|MALLOC_INTERNAL);
+ if (result)
+ memset (result, 0, total);
+ return result;
+}
+
+static void
+internal_cfree (p, file, line, flags)
+ PTR_T p;
+ const char *file;
+ int line, flags;
+{
+ internal_free (p, file, line, flags|MALLOC_INTERNAL);
+}
+#endif /* !NO_CALLOC */
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_STATS
+int
+malloc_free_blocks (size)
+ int size;
+{
+ int nfree;
+ register union mhead *p;
+
+ nfree = 0;
+ for (p = nextf[size]; p; p = CHAIN (p))
+ nfree++;
+
+ return nfree;
+}
+#endif
+
+#if defined (MALLOC_WRAPFUNCS)
+PTR_T
+sh_malloc (bytes, file, line)
+ size_t bytes;
+ const char *file;
+ int line;
+{
+ return internal_malloc (bytes, file, line, MALLOC_WRAPPER);
+}
+
+PTR_T
+sh_realloc (ptr, size, file, line)
+ PTR_T ptr;
+ size_t size;
+ const char *file;
+ int line;
+{
+ return internal_realloc (ptr, size, file, line, MALLOC_WRAPPER);
+}
+
+void
+sh_free (mem, file, line)
+ PTR_T mem;
+ const char *file;
+ int line;
+{
+ internal_free (mem, file, line, MALLOC_WRAPPER);
+}
+
+PTR_T
+sh_memalign (alignment, size, file, line)
+ size_t alignment;
+ size_t size;
+ const char *file;
+ int line;
+{
+ return internal_memalign (alignment, size, file, line, MALLOC_WRAPPER);
+}
+
+#ifndef NO_CALLOC
+PTR_T
+sh_calloc (n, s, file, line)
+ size_t n, s;
+ const char *file;
+ int line;
+{
+ return internal_calloc (n, s, file, line, MALLOC_WRAPPER);
+}
+
+void
+sh_cfree (mem, file, line)
+ PTR_T mem;
+ const char *file;
+ int line;
+{
+ internal_cfree (mem, file, line, MALLOC_WRAPPER);
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef NO_VALLOC
+PTR_T
+sh_valloc (size, file, line)
+ size_t size;
+ const char *file;
+ int line;
+{
+ return internal_valloc (size, file, line, MALLOC_WRAPPER);
+}
+#endif /* !NO_VALLOC */
+
+#endif /* MALLOC_WRAPFUNCS */
+
+/* Externally-available functions that call their internal counterparts. */
+
+PTR_T
+malloc (size)
+ size_t size;
+{
+ return internal_malloc (size, (char *)NULL, 0, 0);
+}
+
+PTR_T
+realloc (mem, nbytes)
+ PTR_T mem;
+ size_t nbytes;
+{
+ return internal_realloc (mem, nbytes, (char *)NULL, 0, 0);
+}
+
+void
+free (mem)
+ PTR_T mem;
+{
+ internal_free (mem, (char *)NULL, 0, 0);
+}
+
+PTR_T
+memalign (alignment, size)
+ size_t alignment;
+ size_t size;
+{
+ return internal_memalign (alignment, size, (char *)NULL, 0, 0);
+}
+
+#ifndef NO_VALLOC
+PTR_T
+valloc (size)
+ size_t size;
+{
+ return internal_valloc (size, (char *)NULL, 0, 0);
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef NO_CALLOC
+PTR_T
+calloc (n, s)
+ size_t n, s;
+{
+ return internal_calloc (n, s, (char *)NULL, 0, 0);
+}
+
+void
+cfree (mem)
+ PTR_T mem;
+{
+ internal_cfree (mem, (char *)NULL, 0, 0);
+}
+#endif
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/mstats.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/mstats.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3153744
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/mstats.h
@@ -0,0 +1,108 @@
+/* mstats.h - definitions for malloc statistics */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 2001-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#ifndef _MSTATS_H
+#define _MSTATS_H
+
+#include "imalloc.h"
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_STATS
+
+#ifndef NBUCKETS
+# define NBUCKETS 30
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * NMALLOC[i] is the difference between the number of mallocs and frees
+ * for a given block size. TMALLOC[i] is the total number of mallocs for
+ * a given block size. NMORECORE[i] is the total number of calls to
+ * morecore(i). NLESSCORE[i] is the total number of calls to lesscore(i).
+ *
+ * NMAL and NFRE are counts of the number of calls to malloc() and free(),
+ * respectively. NREALLOC is the total number of calls to realloc();
+ * NRCOPY is the number of times realloc() had to allocate new memory and
+ * copy to it. NRECURSE is a count of the number of recursive calls to
+ * malloc() for the same bucket size, which can be caused by calls to
+ * malloc() from a signal handler.
+ *
+ * NSBRK is the number of calls to sbrk() (whether by morecore() or for
+ * alignment); TSBRK is the total number of bytes requested from the kernel
+ * with sbrk().
+ *
+ * BYTESUSED is the total number of bytes consumed by blocks currently in
+ * use; BYTESFREE is the total number of bytes currently on all of the free
+ * lists. BYTESREQ is the total number of bytes requested by the caller
+ * via calls to malloc() and realloc().
+ *
+ * TBSPLIT is the number of times a larger block was split to satisfy a
+ * smaller request. NSPLIT[i] is the number of times a block of size I was
+ * split.
+ *
+ * TBCOALESCE is the number of times two adjacent smaller blocks off the free
+ * list were combined to satisfy a larger request.
+ */
+struct _malstats {
+ int nmalloc[NBUCKETS];
+ int tmalloc[NBUCKETS];
+ int nmorecore[NBUCKETS];
+ int nlesscore[NBUCKETS];
+ int nmal;
+ int nfre;
+ int nrealloc;
+ int nrcopy;
+ int nrecurse;
+ int nsbrk;
+ bits32_t tsbrk;
+ bits32_t bytesused;
+ bits32_t bytesfree;
+ u_bits32_t bytesreq;
+ int tbsplit;
+ int nsplit[NBUCKETS];
+ int tbcoalesce;
+ int ncoalesce[NBUCKETS];
+};
+
+/* Return statistics describing allocation of blocks of size BLOCKSIZE.
+ NFREE is the number of free blocks for this allocation size. NUSED
+ is the number of blocks in use. NMAL is the number of requests for
+ blocks of size BLOCKSIZE. NMORECORE is the number of times we had
+ to call MORECORE to repopulate the free list for this bucket.
+ NLESSCORE is the number of times we gave memory back to the system
+ from this bucket. NSPLIT is the number of times a block of this size
+ was split to satisfy a smaller request. NCOALESCE is the number of
+ times two blocks of this size were combined to satisfy a larger
+ request. */
+struct bucket_stats {
+ u_bits32_t blocksize;
+ int nfree;
+ int nused;
+ int nmal;
+ int nmorecore;
+ int nlesscore;
+ int nsplit;
+ int ncoalesce;
+};
+
+extern struct bucket_stats malloc_bucket_stats __P((int));
+extern struct _malstats malloc_stats __P((void));
+extern void print_malloc_stats __P((char *));
+extern void trace_malloc_stats __P((char *, char *));
+
+#endif /* MALLOC_STATS */
+
+#endif /* _MSTATS_H */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/shmalloc.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/shmalloc.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e51e92b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/shmalloc.h
@@ -0,0 +1,68 @@
+/* Functions (currently) for use by the shell to do malloc debugging and
+ tracking. */
+/* Copyright (C) 2001-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
+(at your option) any later version.
+
+This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#ifndef _SH_MALLOC_H
+#define _SH_MALLOC_H
+
+#ifndef __P
+# if defined (__STDC__) || defined (__GNUC__) || defined (__cplusplus)
+# define __P(protos) protos
+# else
+# define __P(protos) ()
+# endif
+#endif
+
+/* Generic pointer type. */
+#ifndef PTR_T
+
+#if defined (__STDC__)
+# define PTR_T void *
+#else
+# define PTR_T char *
+#endif
+
+#endif /* PTR_T */
+
+
+extern PTR_T sh_malloc __P((size_t, const char *, int));
+extern PTR_T sh_realloc __P((PTR_T, size_t, const char *, int));
+extern void sh_free __P((PTR_T, const char *, int));
+
+extern PTR_T sh_memalign __P((size_t, size_t, const char *, int));
+
+extern PTR_T sh_calloc __P((size_t, size_t, const char *, int));
+extern void sh_cfree __P((PTR_T, const char *, int));
+
+extern PTR_T sh_valloc __P((size_t, const char *, int));
+
+/* trace.c */
+extern int malloc_set_trace __P((int));
+extern void malloc_set_tracefp (); /* full prototype requires stdio.h */
+extern void malloc_set_tracefn __P((char *, char *));
+
+/* table.c */
+extern void mregister_dump_table __P((void));
+extern void mregister_table_init __P((void));
+extern int malloc_set_register __P((int));
+
+/* stats.c */
+extern void print_malloc_stats __P((char *));
+extern void fprint_malloc_stats (); /* full prototype requires stdio.h */
+extern void trace_malloc_stats __P((char *, char *));
+
+#endif
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/stats.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/stats.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..18c3cef
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/stats.c
@@ -0,0 +1,202 @@
+/* stats.c - malloc statistics */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 2001-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "imalloc.h"
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_STATS
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "mstats.h"
+
+extern int malloc_free_blocks __P((int));
+
+extern struct _malstats _mstats;
+
+extern FILE *_imalloc_fopen __P((char *, char *, char *, char *, size_t));
+
+struct bucket_stats
+malloc_bucket_stats (size)
+ int size;
+{
+ struct bucket_stats v;
+
+ v.nfree = 0;
+
+ if (size < 0 || size >= NBUCKETS)
+ {
+ v.blocksize = 0;
+ v.nused = v.nmal = v.nmorecore = v.nlesscore = v.nsplit = 0;
+ return v;
+ }
+
+ v.blocksize = 1 << (size + 3);
+ v.nused = _mstats.nmalloc[size];
+ v.nmal = _mstats.tmalloc[size];
+ v.nmorecore = _mstats.nmorecore[size];
+ v.nlesscore = _mstats.nlesscore[size];
+ v.nsplit = _mstats.nsplit[size];
+ v.ncoalesce = _mstats.ncoalesce[size];
+
+ v.nfree = malloc_free_blocks (size); /* call back to malloc.c */
+
+ return v;
+}
+
+/* Return a copy of _MSTATS, with two additional fields filled in:
+ BYTESFREE is the total number of bytes on free lists. BYTESUSED
+ is the total number of bytes in use. These two fields are fairly
+ expensive to compute, so we do it only when asked to. */
+struct _malstats
+malloc_stats ()
+{
+ struct _malstats result;
+ struct bucket_stats v;
+ register int i;
+
+ result = _mstats;
+ result.bytesused = result.bytesfree = 0;
+ for (i = 0; i < NBUCKETS; i++)
+ {
+ v = malloc_bucket_stats (i);
+ result.bytesfree += v.nfree * v.blocksize;
+ result.bytesused += v.nused * v.blocksize;
+ }
+ return (result);
+}
+
+static void
+_print_malloc_stats (s, fp)
+ char *s;
+ FILE *fp;
+{
+ register int i;
+ unsigned long totused, totfree;
+ struct bucket_stats v;
+
+ fprintf (fp, "Memory allocation statistics: %s\n size\tfree\tin use\ttotal\tmorecore lesscore split\tcoalesce\n", s ? s : "");
+ for (i = totused = totfree = 0; i < NBUCKETS; i++)
+ {
+ v = malloc_bucket_stats (i);
+ if (v.nmal > 0)
+ fprintf (fp, "%8lu\t%4d\t%6d\t%5d\t%8d\t%d %5d %8d\n", (unsigned long)v.blocksize, v.nfree, v.nused, v.nmal, v.nmorecore, v.nlesscore, v.nsplit, v.ncoalesce);
+ totfree += v.nfree * v.blocksize;
+ totused += v.nused * v.blocksize;
+ }
+ fprintf (fp, "\nTotal bytes in use: %lu, total bytes free: %lu\n",
+ totused, totfree);
+ fprintf (fp, "\nTotal bytes requested by application: %lu\n", _mstats.bytesreq);
+ fprintf (fp, "Total mallocs: %d, total frees: %d, total reallocs: %d (%d copies)\n",
+ _mstats.nmal, _mstats.nfre, _mstats.nrealloc, _mstats.nrcopy);
+ fprintf (fp, "Total sbrks: %d, total bytes via sbrk: %d\n",
+ _mstats.nsbrk, _mstats.tsbrk);
+ fprintf (fp, "Total blocks split: %d, total block coalesces: %d\n",
+ _mstats.tbsplit, _mstats.tbcoalesce);
+}
+
+void
+print_malloc_stats (s)
+ char *s;
+{
+ _print_malloc_stats (s, stderr);
+}
+
+void
+fprint_malloc_stats (s, fp)
+ char *s;
+ FILE *fp;
+{
+ _print_malloc_stats (s, fp);
+}
+
+#define TRACEROOT "/var/tmp/maltrace/stats."
+
+void
+trace_malloc_stats (s, fn)
+ char *s, *fn;
+{
+ FILE *fp;
+ char defname[sizeof (TRACEROOT) + 64];
+ static char mallbuf[1024];
+
+ fp = _imalloc_fopen (s, fn, TRACEROOT, defname, sizeof (defname));
+ if (fp)
+ {
+ setvbuf (fp, mallbuf, _IOFBF, sizeof (mallbuf));
+ _print_malloc_stats (s, fp);
+ fflush(fp);
+ fclose(fp);
+ }
+}
+
+#endif /* MALLOC_STATS */
+
+#if defined (MALLOC_STATS) || defined (MALLOC_TRACE)
+FILE *
+_imalloc_fopen (s, fn, def, defbuf, defsiz)
+ char *s;
+ char *fn;
+ char *def;
+ char *defbuf;
+ size_t defsiz;
+{
+ char fname[1024];
+ long l;
+ FILE *fp;
+
+ l = (long)getpid ();
+ if (fn == 0)
+ {
+ sprintf (defbuf, "%s%ld", def, l);
+ fp = fopen(defbuf, "w");
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ char *p, *q, *r;
+ char pidbuf[32];
+ int sp;
+
+ sprintf (pidbuf, "%ld", l);
+ if ((strlen (pidbuf) + strlen (fn) + 2) >= sizeof (fname))
+ return;
+ for (sp = 0, p = fname, q = fn; *q; )
+ {
+ if (sp == 0 && *q == '%' && q[1] == 'p')
+ {
+ sp = 1;
+ for (r = pidbuf; *r; )
+ *p++ = *r++;
+ q += 2;
+ }
+ else
+ *p++ = *q++;
+ }
+ *p = '\0';
+ fp = fopen (fname, "w");
+ }
+
+ return fp;
+}
+#endif /* MALLOC_STATS || MALLOC_TRACE */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/stub.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/stub.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..770e3f9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/stub.c
@@ -0,0 +1,22 @@
+/* Copyright (C) 1993-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+void
+bash_malloc_stub()
+{
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/table.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/table.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ee37b3a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/table.c
@@ -0,0 +1,290 @@
+/* table.c - bookkeeping functions for allocated memory */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 2001-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+#include "imalloc.h"
+#include "table.h"
+
+extern int malloc_register;
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_REGISTER
+
+#define FIND_ALLOC 0x01 /* allocate new entry or find existing */
+#define FIND_EXIST 0x02 /* find existing entry */
+
+static int table_count = 0;
+static int table_allocated = 0;
+static mr_table_t mem_table[REG_TABLE_SIZE];
+static mr_table_t mem_overflow;
+
+/*
+ * NOTE: taken from dmalloc (http://dmalloc.com) and modified.
+ */
+static unsigned int
+mt_hash (key)
+ const PTR_T key;
+{
+ unsigned int a, b, c;
+ unsigned long x;
+
+ /* set up the internal state */
+ a = 0x9e3779b9; /* the golden ratio; an arbitrary value */
+ x = (unsigned long)key; /* truncation is OK */
+ b = x >> 8;
+ c = x >> 3; /* XXX - was >> 4 */
+
+ HASH_MIX(a, b, c);
+ return c;
+}
+
+#if 0
+static unsigned int
+which_bucket (mem)
+ PTR_T mem;
+{
+ return (mt_hash ((unsigned char *)mem) & (REG_TABLE_SIZE-1));
+}
+#else
+#define which_bucket(mem) (mt_hash ((unsigned char *)(mem)) & (REG_TABLE_SIZE-1));
+#endif
+
+static mr_table_t *
+find_entry (mem, flags)
+ PTR_T mem;
+ int flags;
+{
+ unsigned int bucket;
+ register mr_table_t *tp;
+ mr_table_t *endp, *lastp;
+
+ if (mem_overflow.mem == mem)
+ return (&mem_overflow);
+
+ bucket = which_bucket (mem); /* get initial hash */
+ tp = endp = mem_table + bucket;
+ lastp = mem_table + REG_TABLE_SIZE;
+
+ while (1)
+ {
+ if (tp->mem == mem)
+ return (tp);
+ if (tp->mem == 0 && (flags & FIND_ALLOC))
+ {
+ table_count++;
+ return (tp);
+ }
+
+ tp++;
+
+ if (tp == lastp) /* wrap around */
+ tp = mem_table;
+
+ if (tp == endp && (flags & FIND_EXIST))
+ return ((mr_table_t *)NULL);
+
+ if (tp == endp && (flags & FIND_ALLOC))
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /* oops. table is full. replace an existing free entry. */
+ do
+ {
+ /* If there are no free entries, punt right away without searching. */
+ if (table_allocated == REG_TABLE_SIZE)
+ break;
+
+ if (tp->flags & MT_FREE)
+ {
+ memset(tp, 0, sizeof (mr_table_t));
+ return (tp);
+ }
+ tp++;
+
+ if (tp == lastp)
+ tp = mem_table;
+ }
+ while (tp != endp);
+
+ /* wow. entirely full. return mem_overflow dummy entry. */
+ tp = &mem_overflow;
+ memset (tp, 0, sizeof (mr_table_t));
+ return tp;
+}
+
+mr_table_t *
+mr_table_entry (mem)
+ PTR_T mem;
+{
+ return (find_entry (mem, FIND_EXIST));
+}
+
+void
+mregister_describe_mem (mem, fp)
+ PTR_T mem;
+ FILE *fp;
+{
+ mr_table_t *entry;
+
+ entry = find_entry (mem, FIND_EXIST);
+ if (entry == 0)
+ return;
+ fprintf (fp, "malloc: %p: %s: last %s from %s:%d\n",
+ mem,
+ (entry->flags & MT_ALLOC) ? "allocated" : "free",
+ (entry->flags & MT_ALLOC) ? "allocated" : "freed",
+ entry->file ? entry->file : "unknown",
+ entry->line);
+}
+
+void
+mregister_alloc (tag, mem, size, file, line)
+ const char *tag;
+ PTR_T mem;
+ size_t size;
+ const char *file;
+ int line;
+{
+ mr_table_t *tentry;
+
+ tentry = find_entry (mem, FIND_ALLOC);
+
+ if (tentry == 0)
+ {
+ /* oops. table is full. punt. */
+ fprintf (stderr, _("register_alloc: alloc table is full with FIND_ALLOC?\n"));
+ return;
+ }
+
+ if (tentry->flags & MT_ALLOC)
+ {
+ /* oops. bad bookkeeping. ignore for now */
+ fprintf (stderr, _("register_alloc: %p already in table as allocated?\n"), mem);
+ }
+
+ tentry->mem = mem;
+ tentry->size = size;
+ tentry->func = tag;
+ tentry->flags = MT_ALLOC;
+ tentry->file = file;
+ tentry->line = line;
+ tentry->nalloc++;
+
+ if (tentry != &mem_overflow)
+ table_allocated++;
+}
+
+void
+mregister_free (mem, size, file, line)
+ PTR_T mem;
+ int size;
+ const char *file;
+ int line;
+{
+ mr_table_t *tentry;
+
+ tentry = find_entry (mem, FIND_EXIST);
+ if (tentry == 0)
+ {
+ /* oops. not found. */
+#if 0
+ fprintf (stderr, "register_free: %p not in allocation table?\n", mem);
+#endif
+ return;
+ }
+ if (tentry->flags & MT_FREE)
+ {
+ /* oops. bad bookkeeping. ignore for now */
+ fprintf (stderr, _("register_free: %p already in table as free?\n"), mem);
+ }
+
+ tentry->flags = MT_FREE;
+ tentry->func = "free";
+ tentry->file = file;
+ tentry->line = line;
+ tentry->nfree++;
+
+ if (tentry != &mem_overflow)
+ table_allocated--;
+}
+
+/* If we ever add more flags, this will require changes. */
+static char *
+_entry_flags(x)
+ int x;
+{
+ if (x & MT_FREE)
+ return "free";
+ else if (x & MT_ALLOC)
+ return "allocated";
+ else
+ return "undetermined?";
+}
+
+static void
+_register_dump_table(fp)
+ FILE *fp;
+{
+ register int i;
+ mr_table_t entry;
+
+ for (i = 0; i < REG_TABLE_SIZE; i++)
+ {
+ entry = mem_table[i];
+ if (entry.mem)
+ fprintf (fp, "[%d] %p:%d:%s:%s:%s:%d:%d:%d\n", i,
+ entry.mem, entry.size,
+ _entry_flags(entry.flags),
+ entry.func ? entry.func : "unknown",
+ entry.file ? entry.file : "unknown",
+ entry.line,
+ entry.nalloc, entry.nfree);
+ }
+}
+
+void
+mregister_dump_table()
+{
+ _register_dump_table (stderr);
+}
+
+void
+mregister_table_init ()
+{
+ memset (mem_table, 0, sizeof(mr_table_t) * REG_TABLE_SIZE);
+ memset (&mem_overflow, 0, sizeof (mr_table_t));
+ table_count = 0;
+}
+
+#endif /* MALLOC_REGISTER */
+
+int
+malloc_set_register(n)
+ int n;
+{
+ int old;
+
+ old = malloc_register;
+ malloc_register = n;
+ return old;
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/table.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/table.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..0d22376
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/table.h
@@ -0,0 +1,103 @@
+/* table.h - definitions for tables for keeping track of allocated memory */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 2001-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#ifndef _MTABLE_H
+#define _MTABLE_H
+
+#include "imalloc.h"
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_REGISTER
+
+/* values for flags byte. */
+#define MT_ALLOC 0x01
+#define MT_FREE 0x02
+
+/*
+ * Memory table entry.
+ *
+ * MEM is the address of the allocated pointer.
+ * SIZE is the requested allocation size.
+ * FLAGS includes either MT_ALLOC (MEM is allocated) or MT_FREE (MEM is
+ * not allocated). Other flags later.
+ * FUNC is set to the name of the function doing the allocation (from the
+ * `tag' argument to register_alloc().
+ * FILE and LINE are the filename and line number of the last allocation
+ * and free (depending on STATUS) of MEM.
+ * NALLOC and NFREE are incremented on each allocation that returns MEM or
+ * each free of MEM, respectively (way to keep track of memory reuse
+ * and how well the free lists are working).
+ *
+ */
+typedef struct mr_table {
+ PTR_T mem;
+ size_t size;
+ char flags;
+ const char *func;
+ const char *file;
+ int line;
+ int nalloc, nfree;
+} mr_table_t;
+
+#define REG_TABLE_SIZE 8192
+
+extern mr_table_t *mr_table_entry __P((PTR_T));
+extern void mregister_alloc __P((const char *, PTR_T, size_t, const char *, int));
+extern void mregister_free __P((PTR_T, int, const char *, int));
+extern void mregister_describe_mem ();
+extern void mregister_dump_table __P((void));
+extern void mregister_table_init __P((void));
+
+/* NOTE: HASH_MIX taken from dmalloc (http://dmalloc.com) */
+
+/*
+ * void HASH_MIX
+ *
+ * DESCRIPTION:
+ *
+ * Mix 3 32-bit values reversibly. For every delta with one or two
+ * bits set, and the deltas of all three high bits or all three low
+ * bits, whether the original value of a,b,c is almost all zero or is
+ * uniformly distributed.
+ *
+ * If HASH_MIX() is run forward or backward, at least 32 bits in a,b,c
+ * have at least 1/4 probability of changing. If mix() is run
+ * forward, every bit of c will change between 1/3 and 2/3 of the
+ * time. (Well, 22/100 and 78/100 for some 2-bit deltas.)
+ *
+ * HASH_MIX() takes 36 machine instructions, but only 18 cycles on a
+ * superscalar machine (like a Pentium or a Sparc). No faster mixer
+ * seems to work, that's the result of my brute-force search. There
+ * were about 2^68 hashes to choose from. I only tested about a
+ * billion of those.
+ */
+#define HASH_MIX(a, b, c) \
+ do { \
+ a -= b; a -= c; a ^= (c >> 13); \
+ b -= c; b -= a; b ^= (a << 8); \
+ c -= a; c -= b; c ^= (b >> 13); \
+ a -= b; a -= c; a ^= (c >> 12); \
+ b -= c; b -= a; b ^= (a << 16); \
+ c -= a; c -= b; c ^= (b >> 5); \
+ a -= b; a -= c; a ^= (c >> 3); \
+ b -= c; b -= a; b ^= (a << 10); \
+ c -= a; c -= b; c ^= (b >> 15); \
+ } while(0)
+
+#endif /* MALLOC_REGISTER */
+
+#endif /* _MTABLE_H */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/trace.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/trace.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..79f4668
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/trace.c
@@ -0,0 +1,125 @@
+/* trace.c - tracing functions for malloc */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 2001-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "imalloc.h"
+
+extern int malloc_trace;
+
+static int _mtrace_verbose = 0;
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_TRACE
+
+extern FILE *_imalloc_fopen __P((char *, char *, char *, char *, size_t));
+
+FILE *_mtrace_fp = NULL;
+extern char _malloc_trace_buckets[];
+
+void
+mtrace_alloc (tag, mem, size, file, line)
+ const char *tag;
+ PTR_T mem;
+ size_t size;
+ const char *file;
+ int line;
+{
+ if (_mtrace_fp == NULL)
+ _mtrace_fp = stderr;
+
+ if (_mtrace_verbose)
+ fprintf (_mtrace_fp, "alloc: %s: %p (%d bytes) from '%s:%d'\n",
+ tag, mem, size, file ? file : "unknown", line);
+ else
+ fprintf (_mtrace_fp, "alloc:%p:%d:%s:%d\n",
+ mem, size, file ? file : "unknown", line);
+}
+
+void
+mtrace_free (mem, size, file, line)
+ PTR_T mem;
+ int size;
+ const char *file;
+ int line;
+{
+ if (_mtrace_fp == NULL)
+ _mtrace_fp = stderr;
+
+ if (_mtrace_verbose)
+ fprintf (_mtrace_fp, "free: %p (%d bytes) from '%s:%d'\n",
+ mem, size, file ? file : "unknown", line);
+ else
+ fprintf (_mtrace_fp, "free:%p:%d:%s:%d\n",
+ mem, size, file ? file : "unknown", line);
+}
+#endif /* MALLOC_TRACE */
+
+int
+malloc_set_trace (n)
+ int n;
+{
+ int old;
+
+ old = malloc_trace;
+ malloc_trace = n;
+ _mtrace_verbose = (n > 1);
+ return old;
+}
+
+void
+malloc_set_tracefp (fp)
+ FILE *fp;
+{
+#ifdef MALLOC_TRACE
+ _mtrace_fp = fp ? fp : stderr;
+#endif
+}
+
+void
+malloc_trace_bin (n)
+ int n;
+{
+#ifdef MALLOC_TRACE
+ _malloc_trace_buckets[n] = 1;
+#endif
+}
+
+#define TRACEROOT "/var/tmp/maltrace/trace."
+
+void
+malloc_set_tracefn (s, fn)
+ char *s;
+ char *fn;
+{
+#ifdef MALLOC_TRACE
+ FILE *fp;
+ char defname[sizeof (TRACEROOT) + 64];
+
+ fp = _imalloc_fopen (s, fn, TRACEROOT, defname, sizeof (defname));
+ if (fp)
+ malloc_set_tracefp (fp);
+#endif
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/watch.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/watch.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..11ab744
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/watch.c
@@ -0,0 +1,150 @@
+/* watch.c - watchpoint functions for malloc */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 2001-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+#include "imalloc.h"
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_WATCH
+#include "watch.h"
+
+#define WATCH_MAX 32
+
+int _malloc_nwatch;
+static PTR_T _malloc_watch_list[WATCH_MAX];
+
+static void
+watch_warn (addr, file, line, type, data)
+ PTR_T addr;
+ const char *file;
+ int line, type;
+ unsigned long data;
+{
+ char *tag;
+
+ if (type == W_ALLOC)
+ tag = _("allocated");
+ else if (type == W_FREE)
+ tag = _("freed");
+ else if (type == W_REALLOC)
+ tag = _("requesting resize");
+ else if (type == W_RESIZED)
+ tag = _("just resized");
+ else
+ tag = _("bug: unknown operation");
+
+ fprintf (stderr, _("malloc: watch alert: %p %s "), addr, tag);
+ if (data != (unsigned long)-1)
+ fprintf (stderr, "(size %lu) ", data);
+ fprintf (stderr, "from '%s:%d'\n", file ? file : "unknown", line);
+}
+
+void
+_malloc_ckwatch (addr, file, line, type, data)
+ PTR_T addr;
+ const char *file;
+ int line, type;
+ unsigned long data;
+{
+ register int i;
+
+ for (i = _malloc_nwatch - 1; i >= 0; i--)
+ {
+ if (_malloc_watch_list[i] == addr)
+ {
+ watch_warn (addr, file, line, type, data);
+ return;
+ }
+ }
+}
+#endif /* MALLOC_WATCH */
+
+PTR_T
+malloc_watch (addr)
+ PTR_T addr;
+{
+ register int i;
+ PTR_T ret;
+
+ if (addr == 0)
+ return addr;
+ ret = (PTR_T)0;
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_WATCH
+ for (i = _malloc_nwatch - 1; i >= 0; i--)
+ {
+ if (_malloc_watch_list[i] == addr)
+ break;
+ }
+ if (i < 0)
+ {
+ if (_malloc_nwatch == WATCH_MAX) /* full, take out first */
+ {
+ ret = _malloc_watch_list[0];
+ _malloc_nwatch--;
+ for (i = 0; i < _malloc_nwatch; i++)
+ _malloc_watch_list[i] = _malloc_watch_list[i+1];
+ }
+ _malloc_watch_list[_malloc_nwatch++] = addr;
+ }
+#endif
+
+ return ret;
+}
+
+/* Remove a watchpoint set on ADDR. If ADDR is NULL, remove all
+ watchpoints. Returns ADDR if everything went OK, NULL if ADDR was
+ not being watched. */
+PTR_T
+malloc_unwatch (addr)
+ PTR_T addr;
+{
+#ifdef MALLOC_WATCH
+ register int i;
+
+ if (addr == 0)
+ {
+ for (i = 0; i < _malloc_nwatch; i++)
+ _malloc_watch_list[i] = (PTR_T)0;
+ _malloc_nwatch = 0;
+ return ((PTR_T)0);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ for (i = 0; i < _malloc_nwatch; i++)
+ {
+ if (_malloc_watch_list[i] == addr)
+ break;
+ }
+ if (i == _malloc_nwatch)
+ return ((PTR_T)0); /* not found */
+ /* shuffle everything from i+1 to end down 1 */
+ _malloc_nwatch--;
+ for ( ; i < _malloc_nwatch; i++)
+ _malloc_watch_list[i] = _malloc_watch_list[i+1];
+ return addr;
+ }
+#else
+ return ((PTR_T)0);
+#endif
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/watch.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/watch.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..757bbd2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/watch.h
@@ -0,0 +1,39 @@
+/* watch.h - definitions for tables for keeping track of allocated memory */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 2001-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#ifndef _MWATCH_H
+#define _MWATCH_H
+
+#include "imalloc.h"
+
+#ifdef MALLOC_WATCH
+
+/* `Events' for watchpoints */
+
+#define W_ALLOC 0x01
+#define W_FREE 0x02
+#define W_REALLOC 0x04
+#define W_RESIZED 0x08
+
+extern int _malloc_nwatch;
+
+extern void _malloc_ckwatch __P((PTR_T, const char *, int, int, unsigned long));
+
+#endif /* MALLOC_WATCH */
+
+#endif /* _MWATCH_H */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/x386-alloca.s b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/x386-alloca.s
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..112d33c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/x386-alloca.s
@@ -0,0 +1,63 @@
+;; alloca386.s 1.2
+;; GNU-compatible stack allocation function for Xenix/386.
+;; Written by Chip Salzenberg at ComDev.
+;; Last modified 90/01/11
+;;> Is your alloca clearly better than the one in i386-alloca.s? I haven't
+;;> looked at either.
+;;
+;;They're different because Xenix/386 has a different assembler. SCO
+;;Xenix has the Microsoft C compiler and the Microsoft macro assembler,
+;;called "masm". MASM's assembler syntax is quite different from AT&T's
+;;in all sorts of ways. Xenix people can't use the AT&T version.
+;;--
+;;Chip Salzenberg at ComDev/TCT <chip@tct.uucp>, <uunet!ateng!tct!chip>
+
+ TITLE $alloca386
+
+ .386
+DGROUP GROUP CONST, _BSS, _DATA
+_DATA SEGMENT DWORD USE32 PUBLIC 'DATA'
+_DATA ENDS
+_BSS SEGMENT DWORD USE32 PUBLIC 'BSS'
+_BSS ENDS
+CONST SEGMENT DWORD USE32 PUBLIC 'CONST'
+CONST ENDS
+_TEXT SEGMENT DWORD USE32 PUBLIC 'CODE'
+ ASSUME CS: _TEXT, DS: DGROUP, SS: DGROUP, ES: DGROUP
+
+ PUBLIC _alloca
+_alloca PROC NEAR
+
+; Get argument.
+ pop edx ; edx -> return address
+ pop eax ; eax = amount to allocate
+
+; Validate allocation amount.
+ add eax,3
+ and eax,not 3
+ cmp eax,0
+ jg aa_size_ok
+ mov eax,4
+aa_size_ok:
+
+; Allocate stack space.
+ mov ecx,esp ; ecx -> old stack pointer
+ sub esp,eax ; perform allocation
+ mov eax,esp ; eax -> new stack pointer
+
+; Copy the three saved register variables from old stack top to new stack top.
+; They may not be there. So we waste twelve bytes. Big fat hairy deal.
+ push DWORD PTR 8[ecx]
+ push DWORD PTR 4[ecx]
+ push DWORD PTR 0[ecx]
+
+; Push something so the caller can pop it off.
+ push eax
+
+; Return to caller.
+ jmp edx
+
+_alloca ENDP
+
+_TEXT ENDS
+ END
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/xleaktrace b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/xleaktrace
new file mode 100755
index 0000000..573437c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/xleaktrace
@@ -0,0 +1,43 @@
+#! /usr/bin/awk -f
+#
+# xleaktrace - print unfreed memory using input generated by compact malloc
+# tracing (malloc_set_trace(1))
+#
+# NOTE: we ignore `realloc' tags because they're just extra information
+#
+# Chet Ramey
+# chet@po.cwru.edu
+#
+BEGIN {
+ FS=":";
+}
+
+$1 == "alloc" {
+ alloc[$2] = 1;
+
+ size[$2] = $3;
+ file[$2] = $4;
+ line[$2] = $5;
+
+# printf "allocated: %s %d %d %s %d\n", $2, alloc[$2], size[$2], file[$2], line[$2];
+ }
+
+$1 == "free" {
+ if ($2 in alloc) {
+ alloc[$2] = 0;
+# printf "freed: %s %d\n", $2, alloc[$2];
+ } else
+ printf "freeing unallocated pointer: %s\n", $2;
+
+ }
+
+END {
+ printf "unfreed memory\n";
+ for (ptr in alloc) {
+ if (alloc[ptr] == 1) {
+ printf "%s (%d) from %s:%d\n", ptr, size[ptr], file[ptr], line[ptr];
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/xmalloc.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/xmalloc.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ab7c91a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/malloc/xmalloc.c
@@ -0,0 +1,94 @@
+/* xmalloc.c -- safe versions of malloc and realloc */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1991-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Readline, a library for reading lines
+ of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ Readline is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the
+ Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any
+ later version.
+
+ Readline is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
+ WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with Readline; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
+ Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+#include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STDLIB_H)
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif /* HAVE_STDLIB_H */
+
+/* Generic pointer type. */
+#ifndef PTR_T
+
+#if defined (__STDC__)
+# define PTR_T void *
+#else
+# define PTR_T char *
+#endif
+
+#endif /* PTR_T */
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Memory Allocation and Deallocation. */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+static void
+memory_error_and_abort (fname)
+ char *fname;
+{
+ fprintf (stderr, "%s: out of virtual memory\n", fname);
+ exit (2);
+}
+
+/* Return a pointer to free()able block of memory large enough
+ to hold BYTES number of bytes. If the memory cannot be allocated,
+ print an error message and abort. */
+PTR_T
+xmalloc (bytes)
+ size_t bytes;
+{
+ PTR_T temp;
+
+ temp = malloc (bytes);
+ if (temp == 0)
+ memory_error_and_abort ("xmalloc");
+ return (temp);
+}
+
+PTR_T
+xrealloc (pointer, bytes)
+ PTR_T pointer;
+ size_t bytes;
+{
+ PTR_T temp;
+
+ temp = pointer ? realloc (pointer, bytes) : malloc (bytes);
+
+ if (temp == 0)
+ memory_error_and_abort ("xrealloc");
+ return (temp);
+}
+
+void
+xfree (string)
+ PTR_T string;
+{
+ if (string)
+ free (string);
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/COPYING b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/COPYING
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1bf1526
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/COPYING
@@ -0,0 +1,339 @@
+ GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
+ Version 2, June 1991
+
+ Copyright (C) 1989, 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA
+ Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
+ of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
+
+ Preamble
+
+ The licenses for most software are designed to take away your
+freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the GNU General Public
+License is intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change free
+software--to make sure the software is free for all its users. This
+General Public License applies to most of the Free Software
+Foundation's software and to any other program whose authors commit to
+using it. (Some other Free Software Foundation software is covered by
+the GNU Library General Public License instead.) You can apply it to
+your programs, too.
+
+ When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not
+price. Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you
+have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for
+this service if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it
+if you want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it
+in new free programs; and that you know you can do these things.
+
+ To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid
+anyone to deny you these rights or to ask you to surrender the rights.
+These restrictions translate to certain responsibilities for you if you
+distribute copies of the software, or if you modify it.
+
+ For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether
+gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all the rights that
+you have. You must make sure that they, too, receive or can get the
+source code. And you must show them these terms so they know their
+rights.
+
+ We protect your rights with two steps: (1) copyright the software, and
+(2) offer you this license which gives you legal permission to copy,
+distribute and/or modify the software.
+
+ Also, for each author's protection and ours, we want to make certain
+that everyone understands that there is no warranty for this free
+software. If the software is modified by someone else and passed on, we
+want its recipients to know that what they have is not the original, so
+that any problems introduced by others will not reflect on the original
+authors' reputations.
+
+ Finally, any free program is threatened constantly by software
+patents. We wish to avoid the danger that redistributors of a free
+program will individually obtain patent licenses, in effect making the
+program proprietary. To prevent this, we have made it clear that any
+patent must be licensed for everyone's free use or not licensed at all.
+
+ The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and
+modification follow.
+
+ GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
+ TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION
+
+ 0. This License applies to any program or other work which contains
+a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it may be distributed
+under the terms of this General Public License. The "Program", below,
+refers to any such program or work, and a "work based on the Program"
+means either the Program or any derivative work under copyright law:
+that is to say, a work containing the Program or a portion of it,
+either verbatim or with modifications and/or translated into another
+language. (Hereinafter, translation is included without limitation in
+the term "modification".) Each licensee is addressed as "you".
+
+Activities other than copying, distribution and modification are not
+covered by this License; they are outside its scope. The act of
+running the Program is not restricted, and the output from the Program
+is covered only if its contents constitute a work based on the
+Program (independent of having been made by running the Program).
+Whether that is true depends on what the Program does.
+
+ 1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the Program's
+source code as you receive it, in any medium, provided that you
+conspicuously and appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate
+copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact all the
+notices that refer to this License and to the absence of any warranty;
+and give any other recipients of the Program a copy of this License
+along with the Program.
+
+You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy, and
+you may at your option offer warranty protection in exchange for a fee.
+
+ 2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Program or any portion
+of it, thus forming a work based on the Program, and copy and
+distribute such modifications or work under the terms of Section 1
+above, provided that you also meet all of these conditions:
+
+ a) You must cause the modified files to carry prominent notices
+ stating that you changed the files and the date of any change.
+
+ b) You must cause any work that you distribute or publish, that in
+ whole or in part contains or is derived from the Program or any
+ part thereof, to be licensed as a whole at no charge to all third
+ parties under the terms of this License.
+
+ c) If the modified program normally reads commands interactively
+ when run, you must cause it, when started running for such
+ interactive use in the most ordinary way, to print or display an
+ announcement including an appropriate copyright notice and a
+ notice that there is no warranty (or else, saying that you provide
+ a warranty) and that users may redistribute the program under
+ these conditions, and telling the user how to view a copy of this
+ License. (Exception: if the Program itself is interactive but
+ does not normally print such an announcement, your work based on
+ the Program is not required to print an announcement.)
+
+These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. If
+identifiable sections of that work are not derived from the Program,
+and can be reasonably considered independent and separate works in
+themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not apply to those
+sections when you distribute them as separate works. But when you
+distribute the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based
+on the Program, the distribution of the whole must be on the terms of
+this License, whose permissions for other licensees extend to the
+entire whole, and thus to each and every part regardless of who wrote it.
+
+Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest
+your rights to work written entirely by you; rather, the intent is to
+exercise the right to control the distribution of derivative or
+collective works based on the Program.
+
+In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on the Program
+with the Program (or with a work based on the Program) on a volume of
+a storage or distribution medium does not bring the other work under
+the scope of this License.
+
+ 3. You may copy and distribute the Program (or a work based on it,
+under Section 2) in object code or executable form under the terms of
+Sections 1 and 2 above provided that you also do one of the following:
+
+ a) Accompany it with the complete corresponding machine-readable
+ source code, which must be distributed under the terms of Sections
+ 1 and 2 above on a medium customarily used for software interchange; or,
+
+ b) Accompany it with a written offer, valid for at least three
+ years, to give any third party, for a charge no more than your
+ cost of physically performing source distribution, a complete
+ machine-readable copy of the corresponding source code, to be
+ distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a medium
+ customarily used for software interchange; or,
+
+ c) Accompany it with the information you received as to the offer
+ to distribute corresponding source code. (This alternative is
+ allowed only for noncommercial distribution and only if you
+ received the program in object code or executable form with such
+ an offer, in accord with Subsection b above.)
+
+The source code for a work means the preferred form of the work for
+making modifications to it. For an executable work, complete source
+code means all the source code for all modules it contains, plus any
+associated interface definition files, plus the scripts used to
+control compilation and installation of the executable. However, as a
+special exception, the source code distributed need not include
+anything that is normally distributed (in either source or binary
+form) with the major components (compiler, kernel, and so on) of the
+operating system on which the executable runs, unless that component
+itself accompanies the executable.
+
+If distribution of executable or object code is made by offering
+access to copy from a designated place, then offering equivalent
+access to copy the source code from the same place counts as
+distribution of the source code, even though third parties are not
+compelled to copy the source along with the object code.
+
+ 4. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Program
+except as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt
+otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense or distribute the Program is
+void, and will automatically terminate your rights under this License.
+However, parties who have received copies, or rights, from you under
+this License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such
+parties remain in full compliance.
+
+ 5. You are not required to accept this License, since you have not
+signed it. However, nothing else grants you permission to modify or
+distribute the Program or its derivative works. These actions are
+prohibited by law if you do not accept this License. Therefore, by
+modifying or distributing the Program (or any work based on the
+Program), you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so, and
+all its terms and conditions for copying, distributing or modifying
+the Program or works based on it.
+
+ 6. Each time you redistribute the Program (or any work based on the
+Program), the recipient automatically receives a license from the
+original licensor to copy, distribute or modify the Program subject to
+these terms and conditions. You may not impose any further
+restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the rights granted herein.
+You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties to
+this License.
+
+ 7. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent
+infringement or for any other reason (not limited to patent issues),
+conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or
+otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not
+excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot
+distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this
+License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you
+may not distribute the Program at all. For example, if a patent
+license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of the Program by
+all those who receive copies directly or indirectly through you, then
+the only way you could satisfy both it and this License would be to
+refrain entirely from distribution of the Program.
+
+If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under
+any particular circumstance, the balance of the section is intended to
+apply and the section as a whole is intended to apply in other
+circumstances.
+
+It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any
+patents or other property right claims or to contest validity of any
+such claims; this section has the sole purpose of protecting the
+integrity of the free software distribution system, which is
+implemented by public license practices. Many people have made
+generous contributions to the wide range of software distributed
+through that system in reliance on consistent application of that
+system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he or she is willing
+to distribute software through any other system and a licensee cannot
+impose that choice.
+
+This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to
+be a consequence of the rest of this License.
+
+ 8. If the distribution and/or use of the Program is restricted in
+certain countries either by patents or by copyrighted interfaces, the
+original copyright holder who places the Program under this License
+may add an explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding
+those countries, so that distribution is permitted only in or among
+countries not thus excluded. In such case, this License incorporates
+the limitation as if written in the body of this License.
+
+ 9. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions
+of the General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will
+be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to
+address new problems or concerns.
+
+Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Program
+specifies a version number of this License which applies to it and "any
+later version", you have the option of following the terms and conditions
+either of that version or of any later version published by the Free
+Software Foundation. If the Program does not specify a version number of
+this License, you may choose any version ever published by the Free Software
+Foundation.
+
+ 10. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Program into other free
+programs whose distribution conditions are different, write to the author
+to ask for permission. For software which is copyrighted by the Free
+Software Foundation, write to the Free Software Foundation; we sometimes
+make exceptions for this. Our decision will be guided by the two goals
+of preserving the free status of all derivatives of our free software and
+of promoting the sharing and reuse of software generally.
+
+ NO WARRANTY
+
+ 11. BECAUSE THE PROGRAM IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY
+FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN
+OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES
+PROVIDE THE PROGRAM "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED
+OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
+MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS
+TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE
+PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING,
+REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
+
+ 12. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING
+WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY AND/OR
+REDISTRIBUTE THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES,
+INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING
+OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED
+TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY
+YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER
+PROGRAMS), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE
+POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
+
+ END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
+
+ Appendix: How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs
+
+ If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the greatest
+possible use to the public, the best way to achieve this is to make it
+free software which everyone can redistribute and change under these terms.
+
+ To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is safest
+to attach them to the start of each source file to most effectively
+convey the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least
+the "copyright" line and a pointer to where the full notice is found.
+
+ <one line to give the program's name and a brief idea of what it does.>
+ Copyright (C) 19yy <name of author>
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA
+
+Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail.
+
+If the program is interactive, make it output a short notice like this
+when it starts in an interactive mode:
+
+ Gnomovision version 69, Copyright (C) 19yy name of author
+ Gnomovision comes with ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY; for details type `show w'.
+ This is free software, and you are welcome to redistribute it
+ under certain conditions; type `show c' for details.
+
+The hypothetical commands `show w' and `show c' should show the appropriate
+parts of the General Public License. Of course, the commands you use may
+be called something other than `show w' and `show c'; they could even be
+mouse-clicks or menu items--whatever suits your program.
+
+You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or your
+school, if any, to sign a "copyright disclaimer" for the program, if
+necessary. Here is a sample; alter the names:
+
+ Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest in the program
+ `Gnomovision' (which makes passes at compilers) written by James Hacker.
+
+ <signature of Ty Coon>, 1 April 1989
+ Ty Coon, President of Vice
+
+This General Public License does not permit incorporating your program into
+proprietary programs. If your program is a subroutine library, you may
+consider it more useful to permit linking proprietary applications with the
+library. If this is what you want to do, use the GNU Library General
+Public License instead of this License.
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/ChangeLog b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/ChangeLog
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1cf0c00
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/ChangeLog
@@ -0,0 +1,403 @@
+Tue Mar 23 14:36:51 1993 Brian Fox (bfox@eos.crseo.ucsb.edu)
+
+ * readline.c (rl_copy): Changed name to rl_copy_text.
+
+Mon Mar 22 19:16:05 1993 Brian Fox (bfox@eos.crseo.ucsb.edu)
+
+ * dispose_cmd.c, several other files. Declare dispose_xxx () as
+ "void".
+
+ * builtins/hashcom.h: Make declarations of hashed_filenames be
+ "extern" to keep the SGI compiler happy.
+
+ * readline.c (rl_initialize_everything): Assign values to
+ out_stream and in_stream immediately, since
+ output_character_function () can be called before
+ readline_internal () is called.
+
+Tue Dec 8 09:30:56 1992 Brian Fox (bfox@cubit)
+
+ * readline.c (rl_init_terminal) Set PC from BC, not from *buffer.
+
+Mon Nov 30 09:35:47 1992 Brian Fox (bfox@cubit)
+
+ * readline.c (invoking_keyseqs_in_map, rl_parse_and_bind) Allow
+ backslash to quote characters, such as backslash, double quote,
+ and space. Backslash quotes all character indiscriminately.
+
+ * funmap.c (vi_keymap) Fix type in "vi-replace" declaration.
+
+Fri Nov 20 10:55:05 1992 Brian Fox (bfox@cubit)
+
+ * readline.c (init_terminal_io, rl_prep_terminal): FINALLY!
+ Declare and use termcap variable `ospeed' when setting up terminal
+ parameters.
+
+Thu Oct 8 08:53:07 1992 Brian J. Fox (bfox@helios)
+
+ * Makefile, this directory: Include (as links to the canonical
+ sources), tilde.c, tilde.h, posixstat.h and xmalloc.c.
+
+Tue Sep 29 13:07:21 1992 Brian J. Fox (bfox@helios)
+
+ * readline.c (init_terminal_io) Don't set arrow keys if the key
+ sequences that represent them are already set.
+
+ * readline.c (rl_function_of_keyseq) New function returns the first
+ function (or macro) found while searching a key sequence.
+
+Mon Sep 28 00:34:04 1992 Brian J. Fox (bfox@helios)
+
+ * readline.c (LibraryVersion) New static char * contains current
+ version number. Version is at 2.0.
+
+ * readline.c (rl_complete_internal): Incorporated clean changes
+ from gilmore (gnu@cygnus.com) to support quoted substrings within
+ completion functions.
+
+ * readline.c (many locations) Added support for the _GO32_,
+ whatever that is. Patches supplied by Cygnus, typed in by hand,
+ with cleanups.
+
+Sun Aug 16 12:46:24 1992 Brian Fox (bfox@cubit)
+
+ * readline.c (init_terminal_io): Find out the values of the keypad
+ arrows and bind them to appropriate RL functions if present.
+
+Mon Aug 10 18:13:24 1992 Brian Fox (bfox@cubit)
+
+ * history.c (stifle_history): A negative argument to stifle
+ becomes zero.
+
+Tue Jul 28 09:28:41 1992 Brian Fox (bfox@cubit)
+
+ * readline.c (rl_variable_bind): New local structure describes
+ booleans by name and address; code in rl_variable_bind () looks at
+ structure to set simple variables.
+
+ * parens.c (rl_insert_close): New variable rl_blink_matching_paren
+ is non-zero if we want to blink the matching open when a close is
+ inserted. If FD_SET is defined, rl_blink_matching_paren defaults
+ to 1, else 0. If FD_SET is not defined, and
+ rl_blink_matching_paren is non-zero, the close character(s) are/is
+ simply inserted.
+
+Wed Jul 22 20:03:59 1992 Brian Fox (bfox@cubit)
+
+ * history.c, readline.c, vi_mode.c: Cause the functions strchr ()
+ and strrchr () to be used instead of index () and rindex ()
+ throughout the source.
+
+Mon Jul 13 11:34:07 1992 Brian Fox (bfox@cubit)
+
+ * readline.c: (rl_variable_bind) New variable "meta-flag" if "on"
+ means force the use of the 8th bit as Meta bit. Internal variable
+ is called meta_flag.
+
+Thu Jul 9 10:37:56 1992 Brian Fox (bfox@cubit)
+
+ * history.c (get_history_event) Change INDEX to LOCAL_INDEX. If
+ compiling for the shell, allow shell metacharacters to separate
+ history tokens as they would for shell tokens.
+
+Sat Jul 4 19:29:12 1992 Brian Fox (bfox@cubit)
+
+ * vi_keymap.c: According to Posix, TAB self-inserts instead of
+ doing completion.
+
+ * vi_mode.c: (rl_vi_yank_arg) Enter VI insert mode after yanking
+ an arg from the previous line.
+
+ * search.c: New file takes over vi style searching and implements
+ non-incremental searching the history.
+
+ Makefile: Add search.c and search.o.
+
+ funmap.c: Add names for non-incremental-forward-search-history and
+ non-incremental-reverse-search-history.
+
+ readline.h: Add extern definitions for non-incremental searching.
+
+ vi_mode.c: Remove old search code; add calls to code in search.c.
+
+Fri Jul 3 10:36:33 1992 Brian Fox (bfox@cubit)
+
+ * readline.c (rl_delete_horizontal_space); New function deletes
+ all whitespace surrounding point.
+
+ funmap.c: Add "delete-horizontal-space".
+ emacs_keymap.c: Put rl_delete_horizontal_space () on M-\.
+
+ * readline.c (rl_set_signals, rl_clear_signals); New function
+ rl_set_sighandler () is either defined in a Posix way (if
+ HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS is defined) or in a BSD way. Function is
+ called from rl_set_signals () and rl_clear_signals ().
+
+Fri May 8 12:50:15 1992 Brian Fox (bfox@cubit)
+
+ * readline.c: (readline_default_bindings) Do comparisons with
+ _POSIX_VDISABLE casted to `unsigned char'. Change tty characters
+ to be unsigned char.
+
+Thu Apr 30 12:36:35 1992 Brian Fox (bfox@cubit)
+
+ * readline.c: (rl_getc) Handle "read would block" error on
+ non-blocking IO streams.
+
+ * readline.c: (rl_signal_handler): Unblock only the signal that we
+ have caught, not all signals.
+
+Sun Feb 23 03:33:09 1992 Brian Fox (bfox at gnuwest.fsf.org)
+
+ * readline.c: Many functions. Use only the macros META_CHAR and
+ UNMETA to deal with meta characters. Prior to this, we used
+ numeric values and tests.
+
+ * readline.c (rl_complete_internal) Report exactly the number of
+ possible completions, not the number + 1.
+
+ * vi_mode.c (rl_do_move) Do not change the cursor position when
+ using `cw' or `cW'.
+
+ * vi_mode.c (rl_vi_complete) Enter insert mode after completing
+ with `*' or `\'.
+
+Fri Feb 21 05:58:18 1992 Brian Fox (bfox at gnuwest.fsf.org)
+
+ * readline.c (rl_dispatch) Increment rl_key_sequence_length for
+ meta characters that map onto ESC map.
+
+Mon Feb 10 01:41:35 1992 Brian Fox (bfox at gnuwest.fsf.org)
+
+ * history.c (history_do_write) Build a buffer of all of the lines
+ to write and write them in one fell swoop (lower overhead than
+ calling write () for each line). Suggested by Peter Ho.
+
+ * readline.c: Include hbullx20 as well as hpux for determining
+ USGr3ness.
+
+ * readline.c (rl_unix_word_rubout) As per the "Now REMEMBER"
+ comment, pass arguments to rl_kill_text () in the correct order to
+ preserve prepending and appending of killed text.
+
+ * readline.c (rl_search_history) malloc (), realloc (), and free
+ () SEARCH_STRING so that there are no static limits on searching.
+
+ * vi_mode.c (rl_vi_subst) Don't forget to end the undo group.
+
+Fri Jan 31 14:51:02 1992 Brian Fox (bfox at gnuwest.fsf.org)
+
+ * readline.c (rl_signal_handler): Zero the current history entry's
+ pointer after freeing the undo_list when SIGINT received.
+ Reformat a couple of functions.
+
+Sat Jan 25 13:47:35 1992 Brian Fox (bfox at bears)
+
+ * readline.c (parser_if): free () TNAME after use.
+
+Tue Jan 21 01:01:35 1992 Brian Fox (bfox at gnuwest.fsf.org)
+
+ * readline.c (rl_redisplay) and (rl_character_len): Display
+ Control characters as "^c" and Meta characters as "\234", instead
+ of "C-C" and "M-C".
+
+Sun Dec 29 10:59:00 1991 Brian Fox (bfox at gnuwest.fsf.org)
+
+ * readline.c (init_terminal_io) Default to environment variables
+ LINES and COLUMNS before termcap entry values. If all else fails,
+ then assume 80x24 terminal.
+
+Sat Dec 28 16:33:11 1991 Brian Fox (bfox at gnuwest.fsf.org)
+
+ * readline.c: If this machine is USG and it is hpux, then define
+ USGr3.
+
+ * history.c: Cosmetic fixes.
+
+Thu Nov 21 00:10:12 1991 Brian Fox (bfox at gnuwest.fsf.org)
+
+ * vi_mode.c: (rl_do_move) Place cursor at end of line, never at
+ next to last character.
+
+Thu Nov 14 05:08:01 1991 Brian Fox (bfox at gnuwest.fsf.org)
+
+ * history.c (get_history_event) Non-anchored searches can have a
+ return index of greater than zero from get_history_event ().
+
+Fri Nov 1 07:02:13 1991 Brian Fox (bfox at gnuwest.fsf.org)
+
+ * readline.c (rl_translate_keyseq) Make C-? translate to RUBOUT
+ unconditionally.
+
+Mon Oct 28 11:34:52 1991 Brian Fox (bfox at gnuwest.fsf.org)
+
+ * readline.c; Use Posix directory routines and macros.
+
+ * funmap.c; Add entry for call-last-kbd-macro.
+
+ * readline.c (rl_prep_term); Use system EOF character on POSIX
+ systems also.
+
+Thu Oct 3 16:19:53 1991 Brian Fox (bfox at gnuwest.fsf.org)
+
+ * readline.c; Make a distinction between having a TERMIOS tty
+ driver, and having POSIX signal handling. You might one without
+ the other. New defines used HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS, and
+ TERMIOS_TTY_DRIVER.
+
+Tue Jul 30 22:37:26 1991 Brian Fox (bfox at gnuwest.fsf.org)
+
+ * readline.c: rl_getc () If a call to read () returns without an
+ error, but with zero characters, the file is empty, so return EOF.
+
+Thu Jul 11 20:58:38 1991 Brian Fox (bfox at gnuwest.fsf.org)
+
+ * readline.c: (rl_get_next_history, rl_get_previous_history)
+ Reallocate the buffer space if the line being moved to is longer
+ the the current space allocated. Amazing that no one has found
+ this bug until now.
+
+Sun Jul 7 02:37:05 1991 Brian Fox (bfox at gnuwest.fsf.org)
+
+ * readline.c:(rl_parse_and_bind) Allow leading whitespace.
+ Make sure TERMIO and TERMIOS systems treat CR and NL
+ disctinctly.
+
+Tue Jun 25 04:09:27 1991 Brian Fox (bfox at gnuwest.fsf.org)
+
+ * readline.c: Rework parsing conditionals to pay attention to the
+ prior states of the conditional stack. This makes $if statements
+ work correctly.
+
+Mon Jun 24 20:45:59 1991 Brian Fox (bfox at gnuwest.fsf.org)
+
+ * readline.c: support for displaying key binding information
+ includes the functions rl_list_funmap_names (),
+ invoking_keyseqs_in_map (), rl_invoking_keyseqs (),
+ rl_dump_functions (), and rl_function_dumper ().
+
+ funmap.c: support for same includes rl_funmap_names ().
+
+ readline.c, funmap.c: no longer define STATIC_MALLOC. However,
+ update both version of xrealloc () to handle a null pointer.
+
+Thu Apr 25 12:03:49 1991 Brian Fox (bfox at gnuwest.fsf.org)
+
+ * vi_mode.c (rl_vi_fword, fWord, etc. All functions use
+ the macro `isident()'. Fixed movement bug which prevents
+ continious movement through the text.
+
+Fri Jul 27 16:47:01 1990 Brian Fox (bfox at gnuwest.fsf.org)
+
+ * readline.c (parser_if) Allow "$if term=foo" construct.
+
+Wed May 23 16:10:33 1990 Brian Fox (bfox at gnuwest.fsf.org)
+
+ * readline.c (rl_dispatch) Correctly remember the last command
+ executed. Fixed typo in username_completion_function ().
+
+Mon Apr 9 19:55:48 1990 Brian Fox (bfox at gnuwest.fsf.org)
+
+ * readline.c: username_completion_function (); For text passed in
+ with a leading `~', remember that this could be a filename (after
+ it is completed).
+
+Thu Apr 5 13:44:24 1990 Brian Fox (bfox at gnuwest.fsf.org)
+
+ * readline.c: rl_search_history (): Correctly handle case of an
+ unfound search string, but a graceful exit (as with ESC).
+
+ * readline.c: rl_restart_output (); The Apollo passes the address
+ of the file descriptor to TIOCSTART, not the descriptor itself.
+
+Tue Mar 20 05:38:55 1990 Brian Fox (bfox at gnuwest.fsf.org)
+
+ * readline.c: rl_complete (); second call in a row causes possible
+ completions to be listed.
+
+ * readline.c: rl_redisplay (), added prompt_this_line variable
+ which is the first character character following \n in prompt.
+
+Sun Mar 11 04:32:03 1990 Brian Fox (bfox at gnuwest.fsf.org)
+
+ * Signals are now supposedly handled inside of SYSV compilation.
+
+Wed Jan 17 19:24:09 1990 Brian Fox (bfox at sbphy.ucsb.edu)
+
+ * history.c: history_expand (); fixed overwriting memory error,
+ added needed argument to call to get_history_event ().
+
+Thu Jan 11 10:54:04 1990 Brian Fox (bfox at sbphy.ucsb.edu)
+
+ * readline.c: added mark_modified_lines to control the
+ display of an asterisk on modified history lines. Also
+ added a user variable called mark-modified-lines to the
+ `set' command.
+
+Thu Jan 4 10:38:05 1990 Brian Fox (bfox at sbphy.ucsb.edu)
+
+ * readline.c: start_insert (). Only use IC if we don't have an im
+ capability.
+
+Fri Sep 8 09:00:45 1989 Brian Fox (bfox at aurel)
+
+ * readline.c: rl_prep_terminal (). Only turn on 8th bit
+ as meta-bit iff the terminal is not using parity.
+
+Sun Sep 3 08:57:40 1989 Brian Fox (bfox at aurel)
+
+ * readline.c: start_insert (). Uses multiple
+ insertion call in cases where that makes sense.
+
+ rl_insert (). Read type-ahead buffer for additional
+ keys that are bound to rl_insert, and insert them
+ all at once. Make insertion of single keys given
+ with an argument much more efficient.
+
+Tue Aug 8 18:13:57 1989 Brian Fox (bfox at aurel)
+
+ * readline.c: Changed handling of EOF. readline () returns
+ (char *)EOF or consed string. The EOF character is read from the
+ tty, or if the tty doesn't have one, defaults to C-d.
+
+ * readline.c: Added support for event driven programs.
+ rl_event_hook is the address of a function you want called
+ while Readline is waiting for input.
+
+ * readline.c: Cleanup time. Functions without type declarations
+ do not use return with a value.
+
+ * history.c: history_expand () has new variable which is the
+ characters to ignore immediately following history_expansion_char.
+
+Sun Jul 16 08:14:00 1989 Brian Fox (bfox at aurel)
+
+ * rl_prep_terminal ()
+ BSD version turns off C-s, C-q, C-y, C-v.
+
+ * readline.c -- rl_prep_terminal ()
+ SYSV version hacks readline_echoing_p.
+ BSD version turns on passing of the 8th bit for the duration
+ of reading the line.
+
+Tue Jul 11 06:25:01 1989 Brian Fox (bfox at aurel)
+
+ * readline.c: new variable rl_tilde_expander.
+ If non-null, this contains the address of a function to call if
+ the standard meaning for expanding a tilde fails. The function is
+ called with the text sans tilde (as in "foo"), and returns a
+ malloc()'ed string which is the expansion, or a NULL pointer if
+ there is no expansion.
+
+ * readline.h - new file chardefs.h
+ Separates things that only readline.c needs from the standard
+ header file publishing interesting things about readline.
+
+ * readline.c:
+ readline_default_bindings () now looks at terminal chararacters
+ and binds those as well.
+
+Wed Jun 28 20:20:51 1989 Brian Fox (bfox at aurel)
+
+ * Made readline and history into independent libraries.
+
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/Makefile.in b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/Makefile.in
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..98169e4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/Makefile.in
@@ -0,0 +1,366 @@
+## -*- text -*- #############################################################
+# #
+# Makefile for the Bash versions of the GNU Readline and History Libraries. #
+# #
+#############################################################################
+
+# Copyright (C) 1994-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+# any later version.
+
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+# GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA.
+
+PACKAGE = @PACKAGE_NAME@
+VERSION = @PACKAGE_VERSION@
+
+PACKAGE_BUGREPORT = @PACKAGE_BUGREPORT@
+PACKAGE_NAME = @PACKAGE_NAME@
+PACKAGE_STRING = @PACKAGE_STRING@
+PACKAGE_VERSION = @PACKAGE_VERSION@
+
+srcdir = @srcdir@
+VPATH = .:@srcdir@
+topdir = @top_srcdir@
+BUILD_DIR = @BUILD_DIR@
+
+INSTALL = @INSTALL@
+INSTALL_PROGRAM = @INSTALL_PROGRAM@
+INSTALL_DATA = @INSTALL_DATA@
+
+CC = @CC@
+RANLIB = @RANLIB@
+AR = @AR@
+ARFLAGS = @ARFLAGS@
+RM = rm -f
+CP = cp
+MV = mv
+
+SHELL = @MAKE_SHELL@
+
+# Programs to make tags files.
+ETAGS = etags -tw
+CTAGS = ctags -tw
+
+CFLAGS = @CFLAGS@
+LOCAL_CFLAGS = @LOCAL_CFLAGS@
+CPPFLAGS = @CPPFLAGS@
+LDFLAGS = @LDFLAGS@
+
+DEFS = @DEFS@
+LOCAL_DEFS = @LOCAL_DEFS@
+
+INCLUDES = -I. -I$(BUILD_DIR) -I$(topdir) -I$(topdir)/lib
+
+CCFLAGS = $(DEFS) $(LOCAL_DEFS) $(APP_CFLAGS) $(CPPFLAGS) ${INCLUDES} $(LOCAL_CFLAGS) $(CFLAGS)
+
+.c.o:
+ ${RM} $@
+ $(CC) -c $(CCFLAGS) $<
+
+# The name of the main library target.
+LIBRARY_NAME = libreadline.a
+
+# The C code source files for this library.
+CSOURCES = $(srcdir)/readline.c $(srcdir)/funmap.c $(srcdir)/keymaps.c \
+ $(srcdir)/vi_mode.c $(srcdir)/parens.c $(srcdir)/rltty.c \
+ $(srcdir)/complete.c $(srcdir)/bind.c $(srcdir)/isearch.c \
+ $(srcdir)/display.c $(srcdir)/signals.c $(srcdir)/emacs_keymap.c \
+ $(srcdir)/vi_keymap.c $(srcdir)/util.c $(srcdir)/kill.c \
+ $(srcdir)/undo.c $(srcdir)/macro.c $(srcdir)/input.c \
+ $(srcdir)/callback.c $(srcdir)/terminal.c $(srcdir)/xmalloc.c \
+ $(srcdir)/history.c $(srcdir)/histsearch.c $(srcdir)/histexpand.c \
+ $(srcdir)/histfile.c $(srcdir)/nls.c $(srcdir)/search.c \
+ $(srcdir)/shell.c $(srcdir)/tilde.c $(srcdir)/savestring.c \
+ $(srcdir)/text.c $(srcdir)/misc.c $(srcdir)/compat.c \
+ $(srcdir)/mbutil.c
+
+# The header files for this library.
+HSOURCES = readline.h rldefs.h chardefs.h keymaps.h history.h histlib.h \
+ posixstat.h posixdir.h posixjmp.h tilde.h rlconf.h rltty.h \
+ ansi_stdlib.h rlstdc.h tcap.h xmalloc.h rlprivate.h rlshell.h \
+ rltypedefs.h rlmbutil.h
+
+HISTOBJ = history.o histexpand.o histfile.o histsearch.o shell.o savestring.o \
+ mbutil.o
+TILDEOBJ = tilde.o
+OBJECTS = readline.o vi_mode.o funmap.o keymaps.o parens.o search.o \
+ rltty.o complete.o bind.o isearch.o display.o signals.o \
+ util.o kill.o undo.o macro.o input.o callback.o terminal.o \
+ text.o nls.o misc.o $(HISTOBJ) $(TILDEOBJ) xmalloc.o compat.o
+
+# The texinfo files which document this library.
+DOCSOURCE = doc/rlman.texinfo doc/rltech.texinfo doc/rluser.texinfo
+DOCOBJECT = doc/readline.dvi
+DOCSUPPORT = doc/Makefile
+DOCUMENTATION = $(DOCSOURCE) $(DOCOBJECT) $(DOCSUPPORT)
+
+SUPPORT = Makefile ChangeLog $(DOCSUPPORT) examples/[-a-z.]*
+
+SOURCES = $(CSOURCES) $(HSOURCES) $(DOCSOURCE)
+
+THINGS_TO_TAR = $(SOURCES) $(SUPPORT)
+
+INSTALLED_HEADERS = readline.h chardefs.h keymaps.h history.h tilde.h \
+ rlstdc.h rlconf.h rltypedefs.h
+
+##########################################################################
+
+all: libreadline.a libhistory.a
+
+libreadline.a: $(OBJECTS)
+ $(RM) $@
+ $(AR) $(ARFLAGS) $@ $(OBJECTS)
+ -test -n "$(RANLIB)" && $(RANLIB) $@
+
+libhistory.a: $(HISTOBJ) xmalloc.o
+ $(RM) $@
+ $(AR) $(ARFLAGS) $@ $(HISTOBJ) xmalloc.o
+ -test -n "$(RANLIB)" && $(RANLIB) $@
+
+documentation: force
+ test -d doc || mkdir doc
+ -( cd doc && $(MAKE) $(MFLAGS) )
+
+# Since tilde.c is shared between readline and bash, make sure we compile
+# it with the right flags when it's built as part of readline
+tilde.o: tilde.c
+ rm -f $@
+ $(CC) $(CCFLAGS) -DREADLINE_LIBRARY -c $(srcdir)/tilde.c
+
+force:
+
+install:
+ @echo "This version of the readline library should not be installed."
+
+uninstall:
+ @echo "This version of the readline library should not be installed."
+
+TAGS: force
+ $(ETAGS) $(CSOURCES) $(HSOURCES)
+
+tags: force
+ $(CTAGS) $(CSOURCES) $(HSOURCES)
+
+clean: force
+ $(RM) $(OBJECTS) *.a
+ -( cd doc && $(MAKE) $(MFLAGS) $@ )
+
+mostlyclean: clean
+ -( cd doc && $(MAKE) $(MFLAGS) $@ )
+
+distclean maintainer-clean: clean
+ -( cd doc && $(MAKE) $(MFLAGS) $@ )
+ $(RM) Makefile
+ $(RM) TAGS tags
+
+# Dependencies
+bind.o: ansi_stdlib.h posixstat.h
+bind.o: rldefs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h rlconf.h
+bind.o: readline.h keymaps.h rltypedefs.h chardefs.h tilde.h
+bind.o: history.h rlstdc.h
+callback.o: rlconf.h ansi_stdlib.h
+callback.o: rldefs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h rlconf.h
+callback.o: readline.h keymaps.h rltypedefs.h chardefs.h tilde.h rlstdc.h
+compat.o: rlstdc.h
+complete.o: ansi_stdlib.h posixdir.h posixstat.h
+complete.o: rldefs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h rlconf.h
+complete.o: readline.h keymaps.h rltypedefs.h chardefs.h tilde.h rlstdc.h
+display.o: ansi_stdlib.h posixstat.h
+display.o: rldefs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h rlconf.h
+display.o: tcap.h
+display.o: readline.h keymaps.h rltypedefs.h chardefs.h tilde.h
+display.o: history.h rlstdc.h
+funmap.o: readline.h keymaps.h rltypedefs.h chardefs.h tilde.h
+funmap.o: rlconf.h ansi_stdlib.h rlstdc.h
+funmap.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+histexpand.o: ansi_stdlib.h
+histexpand.o: history.h histlib.h rlstdc.h
+histexpand.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+histfile.o: ansi_stdlib.h
+histfile.o: history.h histlib.h rlstdc.h
+histfile.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+history.o: ansi_stdlib.h
+history.o: history.h histlib.h rlstdc.h
+history.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+histsearch.o: ansi_stdlib.h
+histsearch.o: history.h histlib.h rlstdc.h
+histsearch.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+input.o: ansi_stdlib.h
+input.o: rldefs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h rlconf.h
+input.o: readline.h keymaps.h rltypedefs.h chardefs.h tilde.h rlstdc.h
+isearch.o: rldefs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h rlconf.h
+isearch.o: readline.h keymaps.h rltypedefs.h chardefs.h tilde.h
+isearch.o: ansi_stdlib.h history.h rlstdc.h
+keymaps.o: emacs_keymap.c vi_keymap.c
+keymaps.o: keymaps.h rltypedefs.h chardefs.h rlconf.h ansi_stdlib.h
+keymaps.o: readline.h keymaps.h rltypedefs.h chardefs.h tilde.h
+keymaps.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h rlstdc.h
+kill.o: ansi_stdlib.h
+kill.o: rldefs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h rlconf.h
+kill.o: readline.h keymaps.h rltypedefs.h chardefs.h tilde.h
+kill.o: history.h rlstdc.h
+macro.o: ansi_stdlib.h
+macro.o: rldefs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h rlconf.h
+macro.o: readline.h keymaps.h rltypedefs.h chardefs.h tilde.h
+macro.o: history.h rlstdc.h
+mbutil.o: rldefs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h rlconf.h rlmbutil.h
+mbutil.o: readline.h keymaps.h rltypedefs.h chardefs.h rlstdc.h
+misc.o: readline.h keymaps.h rltypedefs.h chardefs.h tilde.h
+misc.o: rldefs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h rlconf.h
+misc.o: history.h rlstdc.h ansi_stdlib.h
+nls.o: ansi_stdlib.h
+nls.o: rldefs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h rlconf.h
+nls.o: readline.h keymaps.h rltypedefs.h chardefs.h tilde.h
+nls.o: history.h rlstdc.h
+parens.o: rlconf.h
+parens.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+parens.o: readline.h keymaps.h rltypedefs.h chardefs.h tilde.h rlstdc.h
+readline.o: readline.h keymaps.h rltypedefs.h chardefs.h tilde.h
+readline.o: rldefs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h rlconf.h
+readline.o: history.h rlstdc.h
+readline.o: posixstat.h ansi_stdlib.h posixjmp.h
+rltty.o: rldefs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h rlconf.h
+rltty.o: rltty.h
+rltty.o: readline.h keymaps.h rltypedefs.h chardefs.h tilde.h rlstdc.h
+search.o: rldefs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h rlconf.h
+search.o: readline.h keymaps.h rltypedefs.h chardefs.h tilde.h
+search.o: ansi_stdlib.h history.h rlstdc.h
+shell.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h ansi_stdlib.h
+signals.o: rldefs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h rlconf.h
+signals.o: readline.h keymaps.h rltypedefs.h chardefs.h tilde.h
+signals.o: history.h rlstdc.h
+terminal.o: rldefs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h rlconf.h
+terminal.o: tcap.h
+terminal.o: readline.h keymaps.h rltypedefs.h chardefs.h tilde.h
+terminal.o: history.h rlstdc.h
+text.o: readline.h keymaps.h rltypedefs.h chardefs.h tilde.h
+text.o: rldefs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h rlconf.h
+text.o: history.h rlstdc.h ansi_stdlib.h
+rltty.o: rldefs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h rlconf.h
+tilde.o: ansi_stdlib.h
+tilde.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+tilde.o: tilde.h
+undo.o: ansi_stdlib.h
+undo.o: rldefs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h rlconf.h
+undo.o: readline.h keymaps.h rltypedefs.h chardefs.h tilde.h
+undo.o: history.h rlstdc.h xmalloc.h
+util.o: posixjmp.h ansi_stdlib.h
+util.o: rldefs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h rlconf.h
+util.o: readline.h keymaps.h rltypedefs.h chardefs.h tilde.h rlstdc.h
+vi_mode.o: rldefs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h rlconf.h
+vi_mode.o: readline.h keymaps.h rltypedefs.h chardefs.h tilde.h
+vi_mode.o: history.h ansi_stdlib.h rlstdc.h
+xmalloc.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h ansi_stdlib.h
+
+bind.o: rlshell.h
+histfile.o: rlshell.h
+nls.o: rlshell.h
+readline.o: rlshell.h
+shell.o: rlshell.h
+terminal.o: rlshell.h
+histexpand.o: rlshell.h
+
+bind.o: rlprivate.h
+callback.o: rlprivate.h
+complete.o: rlprivate.h
+display.o: rlprivate.h
+input.o: rlprivate.h
+isearch.o: rlprivate.h
+kill.o: rlprivate.h
+macro.o: rlprivate.h
+mbutil.o: rlprivate.h
+misc.o: rlprivate.h
+nls.o: rlprivate.h
+parens.o: rlprivate.h
+readline.o: rlprivate.h
+rltty.o: rlprivate.h
+search.o: rlprivate.h
+signals.o: rlprivate.h
+terminal.o: rlprivate.h
+text.o: rlprivate.h
+undo.o: rlprivate.h
+util.o: rlprivate.h
+vi_mode.o: rlprivate.h
+
+bind.o: xmalloc.h
+complete.o: xmalloc.h
+display.o: xmalloc.h
+funmap.o: xmalloc.h
+histexpand.o: xmalloc.h
+histfile.o: xmalloc.h
+history.o: xmalloc.h
+input.o: xmalloc.h
+isearch.o: xmalloc.h
+keymaps.o: xmalloc.h
+kill.o: xmalloc.h
+macro.o: xmalloc.h
+mbutil.o: xmalloc.h
+misc.o: xmalloc.h
+readline.o: xmalloc.h
+savestring.o: xmalloc.h
+search.o: xmalloc.h
+shell.o: xmalloc.h
+terminal.o: xmalloc.h
+text.o: xmalloc.h
+tilde.o: xmalloc.h
+undo.o: xmalloc.h
+util.o: xmalloc.h
+vi_mode.o: xmalloc.h
+xmalloc.o: xmalloc.h
+
+complete.o: rlmbutil.h
+display.o: rlmbutil.h
+histexpand.o: rlmbutil.h
+input.o: rlmbutil.h
+isearch.o: rlmbutil.h
+mbutil.o: rlmbutil.h
+misc.o: rlmbutil.h
+readline.o: rlmbutil.h
+search.o: rlmbutil.h
+text.o: rlmbutil.h
+vi_mode.o: rlmbutil.h
+
+# Rules for deficient makes, like SunOS and Solaris
+bind.o: bind.c
+callback.o: callback.c
+compat.o: compat.c
+complete.o: complete.c
+display.o: display.c
+funmap.o: funmap.c
+input.o: input.c
+isearch.o: isearch.c
+keymaps.o: keymaps.c emacs_keymap.c vi_keymap.c
+kill.o: kill.c
+macro.o: macro.c
+mbutil.o: mbutil.c
+misc.o: misc.c
+nls.o: nls.c
+parens.o: parens.c
+readline.o: readline.c
+rltty.o: rltty.c
+savestring.o: savestring.c
+search.o: search.c
+shell.o: shell.c
+signals.o: signals.c
+terminal.o: terminal.c
+text.o: text.c
+tilde.o: tilde.c
+undo.o: undo.c
+util.o: util.c
+vi_mode.o: vi_mode.c
+xmalloc.o: xmalloc.c
+
+histexpand.o: histexpand.c
+histfile.o: histfile.c
+history.o: history.c
+histsearch.o: histsearch.c
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/README b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/README
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..131471c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/README
@@ -0,0 +1,6 @@
+This is the distribution of the Gnu Readline library. See the file
+STANDALONE for a description of the #defines that can be passed via
+the makefile to build readline on different systems.
+
+The file rlconf.h contains defines that enable and disable certain
+readline features.
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/STANDALONE b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/STANDALONE
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c6b5cbd
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/STANDALONE
@@ -0,0 +1,2 @@
+This is not to be built as a standalone library to be installed in some
+public place; get the full readline distribution instead.
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/ansi_stdlib.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/ansi_stdlib.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..db13cd2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/ansi_stdlib.h
@@ -0,0 +1,54 @@
+/* ansi_stdlib.h -- An ANSI Standard stdlib.h. */
+/* A minimal stdlib.h containing extern declarations for those functions
+ that bash uses. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1993 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#if !defined (_STDLIB_H_)
+#define _STDLIB_H_ 1
+
+/* String conversion functions. */
+extern int atoi ();
+
+extern double atof ();
+extern double strtod ();
+
+/* Memory allocation functions. */
+/* Generic pointer type. */
+#ifndef PTR_T
+
+#if defined (__STDC__)
+# define PTR_T void *
+#else
+# define PTR_T char *
+#endif
+
+#endif /* PTR_T */
+
+extern PTR_T malloc ();
+extern PTR_T realloc ();
+extern void free ();
+
+/* Other miscellaneous functions. */
+extern void abort ();
+extern void exit ();
+extern char *getenv ();
+extern void qsort ();
+
+#endif /* _STDLIB_H */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/bind.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/bind.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..7559d32
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/bind.c
@@ -0,0 +1,2279 @@
+/* bind.c -- key binding and startup file support for the readline library. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1987-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#if defined (__TANDEM)
+# include <floss.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#if defined (HAVE_SYS_FILE_H)
+# include <sys/file.h>
+#endif /* HAVE_SYS_FILE_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif /* HAVE_UNISTD_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STDLIB_H)
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif /* HAVE_STDLIB_H */
+
+#include <errno.h>
+
+#if !defined (errno)
+extern int errno;
+#endif /* !errno */
+
+#include "posixstat.h"
+
+/* System-specific feature definitions and include files. */
+#include "rldefs.h"
+
+/* Some standard library routines. */
+#include "readline.h"
+#include "history.h"
+
+#include "rlprivate.h"
+#include "rlshell.h"
+#include "xmalloc.h"
+
+#if !defined (strchr) && !defined (__STDC__)
+extern char *strchr (), *strrchr ();
+#endif /* !strchr && !__STDC__ */
+
+/* Variables exported by this file. */
+Keymap rl_binding_keymap;
+
+static char *_rl_read_file PARAMS((char *, size_t *));
+static void _rl_init_file_error PARAMS((const char *));
+static int _rl_read_init_file PARAMS((const char *, int));
+static int glean_key_from_name PARAMS((char *));
+static int find_boolean_var PARAMS((const char *));
+
+static char *_rl_get_string_variable_value PARAMS((const char *));
+static int substring_member_of_array PARAMS((char *, const char **));
+
+static int currently_reading_init_file;
+
+/* used only in this file */
+static int _rl_prefer_visible_bell = 1;
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Binding keys */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* rl_add_defun (char *name, rl_command_func_t *function, int key)
+ Add NAME to the list of named functions. Make FUNCTION be the function
+ that gets called. If KEY is not -1, then bind it. */
+int
+rl_add_defun (name, function, key)
+ const char *name;
+ rl_command_func_t *function;
+ int key;
+{
+ if (key != -1)
+ rl_bind_key (key, function);
+ rl_add_funmap_entry (name, function);
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Bind KEY to FUNCTION. Returns non-zero if KEY is out of range. */
+int
+rl_bind_key (key, function)
+ int key;
+ rl_command_func_t *function;
+{
+ if (key < 0)
+ return (key);
+
+ if (META_CHAR (key) && _rl_convert_meta_chars_to_ascii)
+ {
+ if (_rl_keymap[ESC].type == ISKMAP)
+ {
+ Keymap escmap;
+
+ escmap = FUNCTION_TO_KEYMAP (_rl_keymap, ESC);
+ key = UNMETA (key);
+ escmap[key].type = ISFUNC;
+ escmap[key].function = function;
+ return (0);
+ }
+ return (key);
+ }
+
+ _rl_keymap[key].type = ISFUNC;
+ _rl_keymap[key].function = function;
+ rl_binding_keymap = _rl_keymap;
+ return (0);
+}
+
+/* Bind KEY to FUNCTION in MAP. Returns non-zero in case of invalid
+ KEY. */
+int
+rl_bind_key_in_map (key, function, map)
+ int key;
+ rl_command_func_t *function;
+ Keymap map;
+{
+ int result;
+ Keymap oldmap;
+
+ oldmap = _rl_keymap;
+ _rl_keymap = map;
+ result = rl_bind_key (key, function);
+ _rl_keymap = oldmap;
+ return (result);
+}
+
+/* Bind key sequence KEYSEQ to DEFAULT_FUNC if KEYSEQ is unbound. Right
+ now, this is always used to attempt to bind the arrow keys, hence the
+ check for rl_vi_movement_mode. */
+int
+rl_bind_key_if_unbound_in_map (key, default_func, kmap)
+ int key;
+ rl_command_func_t *default_func;
+ Keymap kmap;
+{
+ char keyseq[2];
+
+ keyseq[0] = (unsigned char)key;
+ keyseq[1] = '\0';
+ return (rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound_in_map (keyseq, default_func, kmap));
+}
+
+int
+rl_bind_key_if_unbound (key, default_func)
+ int key;
+ rl_command_func_t *default_func;
+{
+ char keyseq[2];
+
+ keyseq[0] = (unsigned char)key;
+ keyseq[1] = '\0';
+ return (rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound_in_map (keyseq, default_func, _rl_keymap));
+}
+
+/* Make KEY do nothing in the currently selected keymap.
+ Returns non-zero in case of error. */
+int
+rl_unbind_key (key)
+ int key;
+{
+ return (rl_bind_key (key, (rl_command_func_t *)NULL));
+}
+
+/* Make KEY do nothing in MAP.
+ Returns non-zero in case of error. */
+int
+rl_unbind_key_in_map (key, map)
+ int key;
+ Keymap map;
+{
+ return (rl_bind_key_in_map (key, (rl_command_func_t *)NULL, map));
+}
+
+/* Unbind all keys bound to FUNCTION in MAP. */
+int
+rl_unbind_function_in_map (func, map)
+ rl_command_func_t *func;
+ Keymap map;
+{
+ register int i, rval;
+
+ for (i = rval = 0; i < KEYMAP_SIZE; i++)
+ {
+ if (map[i].type == ISFUNC && map[i].function == func)
+ {
+ map[i].function = (rl_command_func_t *)NULL;
+ rval = 1;
+ }
+ }
+ return rval;
+}
+
+int
+rl_unbind_command_in_map (command, map)
+ const char *command;
+ Keymap map;
+{
+ rl_command_func_t *func;
+
+ func = rl_named_function (command);
+ if (func == 0)
+ return 0;
+ return (rl_unbind_function_in_map (func, map));
+}
+
+/* Bind the key sequence represented by the string KEYSEQ to
+ FUNCTION, starting in the current keymap. This makes new
+ keymaps as necessary. */
+int
+rl_bind_keyseq (keyseq, function)
+ const char *keyseq;
+ rl_command_func_t *function;
+{
+ return (rl_generic_bind (ISFUNC, keyseq, (char *)function, _rl_keymap));
+}
+
+/* Bind the key sequence represented by the string KEYSEQ to
+ FUNCTION. This makes new keymaps as necessary. The initial
+ place to do bindings is in MAP. */
+int
+rl_bind_keyseq_in_map (keyseq, function, map)
+ const char *keyseq;
+ rl_command_func_t *function;
+ Keymap map;
+{
+ return (rl_generic_bind (ISFUNC, keyseq, (char *)function, map));
+}
+
+/* Backwards compatibility; equivalent to rl_bind_keyseq_in_map() */
+int
+rl_set_key (keyseq, function, map)
+ const char *keyseq;
+ rl_command_func_t *function;
+ Keymap map;
+{
+ return (rl_generic_bind (ISFUNC, keyseq, (char *)function, map));
+}
+
+/* Bind key sequence KEYSEQ to DEFAULT_FUNC if KEYSEQ is unbound. Right
+ now, this is always used to attempt to bind the arrow keys, hence the
+ check for rl_vi_movement_mode. */
+int
+rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound_in_map (keyseq, default_func, kmap)
+ const char *keyseq;
+ rl_command_func_t *default_func;
+ Keymap kmap;
+{
+ rl_command_func_t *func;
+
+ if (keyseq)
+ {
+ func = rl_function_of_keyseq (keyseq, kmap, (int *)NULL);
+#if defined (VI_MODE)
+ if (!func || func == rl_do_lowercase_version || func == rl_vi_movement_mode)
+#else
+ if (!func || func == rl_do_lowercase_version)
+#endif
+ return (rl_bind_keyseq_in_map (keyseq, default_func, kmap));
+ else
+ return 1;
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+int
+rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound (keyseq, default_func)
+ const char *keyseq;
+ rl_command_func_t *default_func;
+{
+ return (rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound_in_map (keyseq, default_func, _rl_keymap));
+}
+
+/* Bind the key sequence represented by the string KEYSEQ to
+ the string of characters MACRO. This makes new keymaps as
+ necessary. The initial place to do bindings is in MAP. */
+int
+rl_macro_bind (keyseq, macro, map)
+ const char *keyseq, *macro;
+ Keymap map;
+{
+ char *macro_keys;
+ int macro_keys_len;
+
+ macro_keys = (char *)xmalloc ((2 * strlen (macro)) + 1);
+
+ if (rl_translate_keyseq (macro, macro_keys, &macro_keys_len))
+ {
+ free (macro_keys);
+ return -1;
+ }
+ rl_generic_bind (ISMACR, keyseq, macro_keys, map);
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Bind the key sequence represented by the string KEYSEQ to
+ the arbitrary pointer DATA. TYPE says what kind of data is
+ pointed to by DATA, right now this can be a function (ISFUNC),
+ a macro (ISMACR), or a keymap (ISKMAP). This makes new keymaps
+ as necessary. The initial place to do bindings is in MAP. */
+int
+rl_generic_bind (type, keyseq, data, map)
+ int type;
+ const char *keyseq;
+ char *data;
+ Keymap map;
+{
+ char *keys;
+ int keys_len;
+ register int i;
+ KEYMAP_ENTRY k;
+
+ k.function = 0;
+
+ /* If no keys to bind to, exit right away. */
+ if (keyseq == 0 || *keyseq == 0)
+ {
+ if (type == ISMACR)
+ free (data);
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ keys = (char *)xmalloc (1 + (2 * strlen (keyseq)));
+
+ /* Translate the ASCII representation of KEYSEQ into an array of
+ characters. Stuff the characters into KEYS, and the length of
+ KEYS into KEYS_LEN. */
+ if (rl_translate_keyseq (keyseq, keys, &keys_len))
+ {
+ free (keys);
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ /* Bind keys, making new keymaps as necessary. */
+ for (i = 0; i < keys_len; i++)
+ {
+ unsigned char uc = keys[i];
+ int ic;
+
+ ic = uc;
+ if (ic < 0 || ic >= KEYMAP_SIZE)
+ return -1;
+
+ if (META_CHAR (ic) && _rl_convert_meta_chars_to_ascii)
+ {
+ ic = UNMETA (ic);
+ if (map[ESC].type == ISKMAP)
+ map = FUNCTION_TO_KEYMAP (map, ESC);
+ }
+
+ if ((i + 1) < keys_len)
+ {
+ if (map[ic].type != ISKMAP)
+ {
+ /* We allow subsequences of keys. If a keymap is being
+ created that will `shadow' an existing function or macro
+ key binding, we save that keybinding into the ANYOTHERKEY
+ index in the new map. The dispatch code will look there
+ to find the function to execute if the subsequence is not
+ matched. ANYOTHERKEY was chosen to be greater than
+ UCHAR_MAX. */
+ k = map[ic];
+
+ map[ic].type = ISKMAP;
+ map[ic].function = KEYMAP_TO_FUNCTION (rl_make_bare_keymap());
+ }
+ map = FUNCTION_TO_KEYMAP (map, ic);
+ /* The dispatch code will return this function if no matching
+ key sequence is found in the keymap. This (with a little
+ help from the dispatch code in readline.c) allows `a' to be
+ mapped to something, `abc' to be mapped to something else,
+ and the function bound to `a' to be executed when the user
+ types `abx', leaving `bx' in the input queue. */
+ if (k.function && ((k.type == ISFUNC && k.function != rl_do_lowercase_version) || k.type == ISMACR))
+ {
+ map[ANYOTHERKEY] = k;
+ k.function = 0;
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if (map[ic].type == ISMACR)
+ free ((char *)map[ic].function);
+ else if (map[ic].type == ISKMAP)
+ {
+ map = FUNCTION_TO_KEYMAP (map, ic);
+ ic = ANYOTHERKEY;
+ }
+
+ map[ic].function = KEYMAP_TO_FUNCTION (data);
+ map[ic].type = type;
+ }
+
+ rl_binding_keymap = map;
+ }
+ free (keys);
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Translate the ASCII representation of SEQ, stuffing the values into ARRAY,
+ an array of characters. LEN gets the final length of ARRAY. Return
+ non-zero if there was an error parsing SEQ. */
+int
+rl_translate_keyseq (seq, array, len)
+ const char *seq;
+ char *array;
+ int *len;
+{
+ register int i, c, l, temp;
+
+ for (i = l = 0; c = seq[i]; i++)
+ {
+ if (c == '\\')
+ {
+ c = seq[++i];
+
+ if (c == 0)
+ break;
+
+ /* Handle \C- and \M- prefixes. */
+ if ((c == 'C' || c == 'M') && seq[i + 1] == '-')
+ {
+ /* Handle special case of backwards define. */
+ if (strncmp (&seq[i], "C-\\M-", 5) == 0)
+ {
+ array[l++] = ESC; /* ESC is meta-prefix */
+ i += 5;
+ array[l++] = CTRL (_rl_to_upper (seq[i]));
+ if (seq[i] == '\0')
+ i--;
+ }
+ else if (c == 'M')
+ {
+ i++;
+ /* XXX - should obey convert-meta setting? */
+ if (_rl_convert_meta_chars_to_ascii && _rl_keymap[ESC].type == ISKMAP)
+ array[l++] = ESC; /* ESC is meta-prefix */
+ else
+ {
+ i++;
+ array[l++] = META (seq[i]);
+ }
+ }
+ else if (c == 'C')
+ {
+ i += 2;
+ /* Special hack for C-?... */
+ array[l++] = (seq[i] == '?') ? RUBOUT : CTRL (_rl_to_upper (seq[i]));
+ }
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /* Translate other backslash-escaped characters. These are the
+ same escape sequences that bash's `echo' and `printf' builtins
+ handle, with the addition of \d -> RUBOUT. A backslash
+ preceding a character that is not special is stripped. */
+ switch (c)
+ {
+ case 'a':
+ array[l++] = '\007';
+ break;
+ case 'b':
+ array[l++] = '\b';
+ break;
+ case 'd':
+ array[l++] = RUBOUT; /* readline-specific */
+ break;
+ case 'e':
+ array[l++] = ESC;
+ break;
+ case 'f':
+ array[l++] = '\f';
+ break;
+ case 'n':
+ array[l++] = NEWLINE;
+ break;
+ case 'r':
+ array[l++] = RETURN;
+ break;
+ case 't':
+ array[l++] = TAB;
+ break;
+ case 'v':
+ array[l++] = 0x0B;
+ break;
+ case '\\':
+ array[l++] = '\\';
+ break;
+ case '0': case '1': case '2': case '3':
+ case '4': case '5': case '6': case '7':
+ i++;
+ for (temp = 2, c -= '0'; ISOCTAL (seq[i]) && temp--; i++)
+ c = (c * 8) + OCTVALUE (seq[i]);
+ i--; /* auto-increment in for loop */
+ array[l++] = c & largest_char;
+ break;
+ case 'x':
+ i++;
+ for (temp = 2, c = 0; ISXDIGIT ((unsigned char)seq[i]) && temp--; i++)
+ c = (c * 16) + HEXVALUE (seq[i]);
+ if (temp == 2)
+ c = 'x';
+ i--; /* auto-increment in for loop */
+ array[l++] = c & largest_char;
+ break;
+ default: /* backslashes before non-special chars just add the char */
+ array[l++] = c;
+ break; /* the backslash is stripped */
+ }
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ array[l++] = c;
+ }
+
+ *len = l;
+ array[l] = '\0';
+ return (0);
+}
+
+char *
+rl_untranslate_keyseq (seq)
+ int seq;
+{
+ static char kseq[16];
+ int i, c;
+
+ i = 0;
+ c = seq;
+ if (META_CHAR (c))
+ {
+ kseq[i++] = '\\';
+ kseq[i++] = 'M';
+ kseq[i++] = '-';
+ c = UNMETA (c);
+ }
+ else if (CTRL_CHAR (c))
+ {
+ kseq[i++] = '\\';
+ kseq[i++] = 'C';
+ kseq[i++] = '-';
+ c = _rl_to_lower (UNCTRL (c));
+ }
+ else if (c == RUBOUT)
+ {
+ kseq[i++] = '\\';
+ kseq[i++] = 'C';
+ kseq[i++] = '-';
+ c = '?';
+ }
+
+ if (c == ESC)
+ {
+ kseq[i++] = '\\';
+ c = 'e';
+ }
+ else if (c == '\\' || c == '"')
+ {
+ kseq[i++] = '\\';
+ }
+
+ kseq[i++] = (unsigned char) c;
+ kseq[i] = '\0';
+ return kseq;
+}
+
+static char *
+_rl_untranslate_macro_value (seq)
+ char *seq;
+{
+ char *ret, *r, *s;
+ int c;
+
+ r = ret = (char *)xmalloc (7 * strlen (seq) + 1);
+ for (s = seq; *s; s++)
+ {
+ c = *s;
+ if (META_CHAR (c))
+ {
+ *r++ = '\\';
+ *r++ = 'M';
+ *r++ = '-';
+ c = UNMETA (c);
+ }
+ else if (CTRL_CHAR (c) && c != ESC)
+ {
+ *r++ = '\\';
+ *r++ = 'C';
+ *r++ = '-';
+ c = _rl_to_lower (UNCTRL (c));
+ }
+ else if (c == RUBOUT)
+ {
+ *r++ = '\\';
+ *r++ = 'C';
+ *r++ = '-';
+ c = '?';
+ }
+
+ if (c == ESC)
+ {
+ *r++ = '\\';
+ c = 'e';
+ }
+ else if (c == '\\' || c == '"')
+ *r++ = '\\';
+
+ *r++ = (unsigned char)c;
+ }
+ *r = '\0';
+ return ret;
+}
+
+/* Return a pointer to the function that STRING represents.
+ If STRING doesn't have a matching function, then a NULL pointer
+ is returned. */
+rl_command_func_t *
+rl_named_function (string)
+ const char *string;
+{
+ register int i;
+
+ rl_initialize_funmap ();
+
+ for (i = 0; funmap[i]; i++)
+ if (_rl_stricmp (funmap[i]->name, string) == 0)
+ return (funmap[i]->function);
+ return ((rl_command_func_t *)NULL);
+}
+
+/* Return the function (or macro) definition which would be invoked via
+ KEYSEQ if executed in MAP. If MAP is NULL, then the current keymap is
+ used. TYPE, if non-NULL, is a pointer to an int which will receive the
+ type of the object pointed to. One of ISFUNC (function), ISKMAP (keymap),
+ or ISMACR (macro). */
+rl_command_func_t *
+rl_function_of_keyseq (keyseq, map, type)
+ const char *keyseq;
+ Keymap map;
+ int *type;
+{
+ register int i;
+
+ if (!map)
+ map = _rl_keymap;
+
+ for (i = 0; keyseq && keyseq[i]; i++)
+ {
+ unsigned char ic = keyseq[i];
+
+ if (META_CHAR (ic) && _rl_convert_meta_chars_to_ascii)
+ {
+ if (map[ESC].type != ISKMAP)
+ {
+ if (type)
+ *type = map[ESC].type;
+
+ return (map[ESC].function);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ map = FUNCTION_TO_KEYMAP (map, ESC);
+ ic = UNMETA (ic);
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (map[ic].type == ISKMAP)
+ {
+ /* If this is the last key in the key sequence, return the
+ map. */
+ if (!keyseq[i + 1])
+ {
+ if (type)
+ *type = ISKMAP;
+
+ return (map[ic].function);
+ }
+ else
+ map = FUNCTION_TO_KEYMAP (map, ic);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if (type)
+ *type = map[ic].type;
+
+ return (map[ic].function);
+ }
+ }
+ return ((rl_command_func_t *) NULL);
+}
+
+/* The last key bindings file read. */
+static char *last_readline_init_file = (char *)NULL;
+
+/* The file we're currently reading key bindings from. */
+static const char *current_readline_init_file;
+static int current_readline_init_include_level;
+static int current_readline_init_lineno;
+
+/* Read FILENAME into a locally-allocated buffer and return the buffer.
+ The size of the buffer is returned in *SIZEP. Returns NULL if any
+ errors were encountered. */
+static char *
+_rl_read_file (filename, sizep)
+ char *filename;
+ size_t *sizep;
+{
+ struct stat finfo;
+ size_t file_size;
+ char *buffer;
+ int i, file;
+
+ if ((stat (filename, &finfo) < 0) || (file = open (filename, O_RDONLY, 0666)) < 0)
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+
+ file_size = (size_t)finfo.st_size;
+
+ /* check for overflow on very large files */
+ if (file_size != finfo.st_size || file_size + 1 < file_size)
+ {
+ if (file >= 0)
+ close (file);
+#if defined (EFBIG)
+ errno = EFBIG;
+#endif
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+ }
+
+ /* Read the file into BUFFER. */
+ buffer = (char *)xmalloc (file_size + 1);
+ i = read (file, buffer, file_size);
+ close (file);
+
+ if (i < 0)
+ {
+ free (buffer);
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+ }
+
+ buffer[i] = '\0';
+ if (sizep)
+ *sizep = i;
+
+ return (buffer);
+}
+
+/* Re-read the current keybindings file. */
+int
+rl_re_read_init_file (count, ignore)
+ int count, ignore;
+{
+ int r;
+ r = rl_read_init_file ((const char *)NULL);
+ rl_set_keymap_from_edit_mode ();
+ return r;
+}
+
+/* Do key bindings from a file. If FILENAME is NULL it defaults
+ to the first non-null filename from this list:
+ 1. the filename used for the previous call
+ 2. the value of the shell variable `INPUTRC'
+ 3. ~/.inputrc
+ If the file existed and could be opened and read, 0 is returned,
+ otherwise errno is returned. */
+int
+rl_read_init_file (filename)
+ const char *filename;
+{
+ /* Default the filename. */
+ if (filename == 0)
+ {
+ filename = last_readline_init_file;
+ if (filename == 0)
+ filename = sh_get_env_value ("INPUTRC");
+ if (filename == 0)
+ filename = DEFAULT_INPUTRC;
+ }
+
+ if (*filename == 0)
+ filename = DEFAULT_INPUTRC;
+
+#if defined (__MSDOS__)
+ if (_rl_read_init_file (filename, 0) == 0)
+ return 0;
+ filename = "~/_inputrc";
+#endif
+ return (_rl_read_init_file (filename, 0));
+}
+
+static int
+_rl_read_init_file (filename, include_level)
+ const char *filename;
+ int include_level;
+{
+ register int i;
+ char *buffer, *openname, *line, *end;
+ size_t file_size;
+
+ current_readline_init_file = filename;
+ current_readline_init_include_level = include_level;
+
+ openname = tilde_expand (filename);
+ buffer = _rl_read_file (openname, &file_size);
+ free (openname);
+
+ if (buffer == 0)
+ return (errno);
+
+ if (include_level == 0 && filename != last_readline_init_file)
+ {
+ FREE (last_readline_init_file);
+ last_readline_init_file = savestring (filename);
+ }
+
+ currently_reading_init_file = 1;
+
+ /* Loop over the lines in the file. Lines that start with `#' are
+ comments; all other lines are commands for readline initialization. */
+ current_readline_init_lineno = 1;
+ line = buffer;
+ end = buffer + file_size;
+ while (line < end)
+ {
+ /* Find the end of this line. */
+ for (i = 0; line + i != end && line[i] != '\n'; i++);
+
+#if defined (__CYGWIN__)
+ /* ``Be liberal in what you accept.'' */
+ if (line[i] == '\n' && line[i-1] == '\r')
+ line[i - 1] = '\0';
+#endif
+
+ /* Mark end of line. */
+ line[i] = '\0';
+
+ /* Skip leading whitespace. */
+ while (*line && whitespace (*line))
+ {
+ line++;
+ i--;
+ }
+
+ /* If the line is not a comment, then parse it. */
+ if (*line && *line != '#')
+ rl_parse_and_bind (line);
+
+ /* Move to the next line. */
+ line += i + 1;
+ current_readline_init_lineno++;
+ }
+
+ free (buffer);
+ currently_reading_init_file = 0;
+ return (0);
+}
+
+static void
+_rl_init_file_error (msg)
+ const char *msg;
+{
+ if (currently_reading_init_file)
+ fprintf (stderr, "readline: %s: line %d: %s\n", current_readline_init_file,
+ current_readline_init_lineno, msg);
+ else
+ fprintf (stderr, "readline: %s\n", msg);
+}
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Parser Directives */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+typedef int _rl_parser_func_t PARAMS((char *));
+
+/* Things that mean `Control'. */
+const char *_rl_possible_control_prefixes[] = {
+ "Control-", "C-", "CTRL-", (const char *)NULL
+};
+
+const char *_rl_possible_meta_prefixes[] = {
+ "Meta", "M-", (const char *)NULL
+};
+
+/* Conditionals. */
+
+/* Calling programs set this to have their argv[0]. */
+const char *rl_readline_name = "other";
+
+/* Stack of previous values of parsing_conditionalized_out. */
+static unsigned char *if_stack = (unsigned char *)NULL;
+static int if_stack_depth;
+static int if_stack_size;
+
+/* Push _rl_parsing_conditionalized_out, and set parser state based
+ on ARGS. */
+static int
+parser_if (args)
+ char *args;
+{
+ register int i;
+
+ /* Push parser state. */
+ if (if_stack_depth + 1 >= if_stack_size)
+ {
+ if (!if_stack)
+ if_stack = (unsigned char *)xmalloc (if_stack_size = 20);
+ else
+ if_stack = (unsigned char *)xrealloc (if_stack, if_stack_size += 20);
+ }
+ if_stack[if_stack_depth++] = _rl_parsing_conditionalized_out;
+
+ /* If parsing is turned off, then nothing can turn it back on except
+ for finding the matching endif. In that case, return right now. */
+ if (_rl_parsing_conditionalized_out)
+ return 0;
+
+ /* Isolate first argument. */
+ for (i = 0; args[i] && !whitespace (args[i]); i++);
+
+ if (args[i])
+ args[i++] = '\0';
+
+ /* Handle "$if term=foo" and "$if mode=emacs" constructs. If this
+ isn't term=foo, or mode=emacs, then check to see if the first
+ word in ARGS is the same as the value stored in rl_readline_name. */
+ if (rl_terminal_name && _rl_strnicmp (args, "term=", 5) == 0)
+ {
+ char *tem, *tname;
+
+ /* Terminals like "aaa-60" are equivalent to "aaa". */
+ tname = savestring (rl_terminal_name);
+ tem = strchr (tname, '-');
+ if (tem)
+ *tem = '\0';
+
+ /* Test the `long' and `short' forms of the terminal name so that
+ if someone has a `sun-cmd' and does not want to have bindings
+ that will be executed if the terminal is a `sun', they can put
+ `$if term=sun-cmd' into their .inputrc. */
+ _rl_parsing_conditionalized_out = _rl_stricmp (args + 5, tname) &&
+ _rl_stricmp (args + 5, rl_terminal_name);
+ free (tname);
+ }
+#if defined (VI_MODE)
+ else if (_rl_strnicmp (args, "mode=", 5) == 0)
+ {
+ int mode;
+
+ if (_rl_stricmp (args + 5, "emacs") == 0)
+ mode = emacs_mode;
+ else if (_rl_stricmp (args + 5, "vi") == 0)
+ mode = vi_mode;
+ else
+ mode = no_mode;
+
+ _rl_parsing_conditionalized_out = mode != rl_editing_mode;
+ }
+#endif /* VI_MODE */
+ /* Check to see if the first word in ARGS is the same as the
+ value stored in rl_readline_name. */
+ else if (_rl_stricmp (args, rl_readline_name) == 0)
+ _rl_parsing_conditionalized_out = 0;
+ else
+ _rl_parsing_conditionalized_out = 1;
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Invert the current parser state if there is anything on the stack. */
+static int
+parser_else (args)
+ char *args;
+{
+ register int i;
+
+ if (if_stack_depth == 0)
+ {
+ _rl_init_file_error ("$else found without matching $if");
+ return 0;
+ }
+
+#if 0
+ /* Check the previous (n - 1) levels of the stack to make sure that
+ we haven't previously turned off parsing. */
+ for (i = 0; i < if_stack_depth - 1; i++)
+#else
+ /* Check the previous (n) levels of the stack to make sure that
+ we haven't previously turned off parsing. */
+ for (i = 0; i < if_stack_depth; i++)
+#endif
+ if (if_stack[i] == 1)
+ return 0;
+
+ /* Invert the state of parsing if at top level. */
+ _rl_parsing_conditionalized_out = !_rl_parsing_conditionalized_out;
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Terminate a conditional, popping the value of
+ _rl_parsing_conditionalized_out from the stack. */
+static int
+parser_endif (args)
+ char *args;
+{
+ if (if_stack_depth)
+ _rl_parsing_conditionalized_out = if_stack[--if_stack_depth];
+ else
+ _rl_init_file_error ("$endif without matching $if");
+ return 0;
+}
+
+static int
+parser_include (args)
+ char *args;
+{
+ const char *old_init_file;
+ char *e;
+ int old_line_number, old_include_level, r;
+
+ if (_rl_parsing_conditionalized_out)
+ return (0);
+
+ old_init_file = current_readline_init_file;
+ old_line_number = current_readline_init_lineno;
+ old_include_level = current_readline_init_include_level;
+
+ e = strchr (args, '\n');
+ if (e)
+ *e = '\0';
+ r = _rl_read_init_file ((const char *)args, old_include_level + 1);
+
+ current_readline_init_file = old_init_file;
+ current_readline_init_lineno = old_line_number;
+ current_readline_init_include_level = old_include_level;
+
+ return r;
+}
+
+/* Associate textual names with actual functions. */
+static struct {
+ const char *name;
+ _rl_parser_func_t *function;
+} parser_directives [] = {
+ { "if", parser_if },
+ { "endif", parser_endif },
+ { "else", parser_else },
+ { "include", parser_include },
+ { (char *)0x0, (_rl_parser_func_t *)0x0 }
+};
+
+/* Handle a parser directive. STATEMENT is the line of the directive
+ without any leading `$'. */
+static int
+handle_parser_directive (statement)
+ char *statement;
+{
+ register int i;
+ char *directive, *args;
+
+ /* Isolate the actual directive. */
+
+ /* Skip whitespace. */
+ for (i = 0; whitespace (statement[i]); i++);
+
+ directive = &statement[i];
+
+ for (; statement[i] && !whitespace (statement[i]); i++);
+
+ if (statement[i])
+ statement[i++] = '\0';
+
+ for (; statement[i] && whitespace (statement[i]); i++);
+
+ args = &statement[i];
+
+ /* Lookup the command, and act on it. */
+ for (i = 0; parser_directives[i].name; i++)
+ if (_rl_stricmp (directive, parser_directives[i].name) == 0)
+ {
+ (*parser_directives[i].function) (args);
+ return (0);
+ }
+
+ /* display an error message about the unknown parser directive */
+ _rl_init_file_error ("unknown parser directive");
+ return (1);
+}
+
+/* Read the binding command from STRING and perform it.
+ A key binding command looks like: Keyname: function-name\0,
+ a variable binding command looks like: set variable value.
+ A new-style keybinding looks like "\C-x\C-x": exchange-point-and-mark. */
+int
+rl_parse_and_bind (string)
+ char *string;
+{
+ char *funname, *kname;
+ register int c, i;
+ int key, equivalency;
+
+ while (string && whitespace (*string))
+ string++;
+
+ if (!string || !*string || *string == '#')
+ return 0;
+
+ /* If this is a parser directive, act on it. */
+ if (*string == '$')
+ {
+ handle_parser_directive (&string[1]);
+ return 0;
+ }
+
+ /* If we aren't supposed to be parsing right now, then we're done. */
+ if (_rl_parsing_conditionalized_out)
+ return 0;
+
+ i = 0;
+ /* If this keyname is a complex key expression surrounded by quotes,
+ advance to after the matching close quote. This code allows the
+ backslash to quote characters in the key expression. */
+ if (*string == '"')
+ {
+ int passc = 0;
+
+ for (i = 1; c = string[i]; i++)
+ {
+ if (passc)
+ {
+ passc = 0;
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ if (c == '\\')
+ {
+ passc++;
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ if (c == '"')
+ break;
+ }
+ /* If we didn't find a closing quote, abort the line. */
+ if (string[i] == '\0')
+ {
+ _rl_init_file_error ("no closing `\"' in key binding");
+ return 1;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Advance to the colon (:) or whitespace which separates the two objects. */
+ for (; (c = string[i]) && c != ':' && c != ' ' && c != '\t'; i++ );
+
+ equivalency = (c == ':' && string[i + 1] == '=');
+
+ /* Mark the end of the command (or keyname). */
+ if (string[i])
+ string[i++] = '\0';
+
+ /* If doing assignment, skip the '=' sign as well. */
+ if (equivalency)
+ string[i++] = '\0';
+
+ /* If this is a command to set a variable, then do that. */
+ if (_rl_stricmp (string, "set") == 0)
+ {
+ char *var, *value, *e;
+
+ var = string + i;
+ /* Make VAR point to start of variable name. */
+ while (*var && whitespace (*var)) var++;
+
+ /* Make VALUE point to start of value string. */
+ value = var;
+ while (*value && !whitespace (*value)) value++;
+ if (*value)
+ *value++ = '\0';
+ while (*value && whitespace (*value)) value++;
+
+ /* Strip trailing whitespace from values to boolean variables. Temp
+ fix until I get a real quoted-string parser here. */
+ i = find_boolean_var (var);
+ if (i >= 0)
+ {
+ /* remove trailing whitespace */
+ e = value + strlen (value) - 1;
+ while (e >= value && whitespace (*e))
+ e--;
+ e++; /* skip back to whitespace or EOS */
+ if (*e && e >= value)
+ *e = '\0';
+ }
+
+ rl_variable_bind (var, value);
+ return 0;
+ }
+
+ /* Skip any whitespace between keyname and funname. */
+ for (; string[i] && whitespace (string[i]); i++);
+ funname = &string[i];
+
+ /* Now isolate funname.
+ For straight function names just look for whitespace, since
+ that will signify the end of the string. But this could be a
+ macro definition. In that case, the string is quoted, so skip
+ to the matching delimiter. We allow the backslash to quote the
+ delimiter characters in the macro body. */
+ /* This code exists to allow whitespace in macro expansions, which
+ would otherwise be gobbled up by the next `for' loop.*/
+ /* XXX - it may be desirable to allow backslash quoting only if " is
+ the quoted string delimiter, like the shell. */
+ if (*funname == '\'' || *funname == '"')
+ {
+ int delimiter, passc;
+
+ delimiter = string[i++];
+ for (passc = 0; c = string[i]; i++)
+ {
+ if (passc)
+ {
+ passc = 0;
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ if (c == '\\')
+ {
+ passc = 1;
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ if (c == delimiter)
+ break;
+ }
+ if (c)
+ i++;
+ }
+
+ /* Advance to the end of the string. */
+ for (; string[i] && !whitespace (string[i]); i++);
+
+ /* No extra whitespace at the end of the string. */
+ string[i] = '\0';
+
+ /* Handle equivalency bindings here. Make the left-hand side be exactly
+ whatever the right-hand evaluates to, including keymaps. */
+ if (equivalency)
+ {
+ return 0;
+ }
+
+ /* If this is a new-style key-binding, then do the binding with
+ rl_bind_keyseq (). Otherwise, let the older code deal with it. */
+ if (*string == '"')
+ {
+ char *seq;
+ register int j, k, passc;
+
+ seq = (char *)xmalloc (1 + strlen (string));
+ for (j = 1, k = passc = 0; string[j]; j++)
+ {
+ /* Allow backslash to quote characters, but leave them in place.
+ This allows a string to end with a backslash quoting another
+ backslash, or with a backslash quoting a double quote. The
+ backslashes are left in place for rl_translate_keyseq (). */
+ if (passc || (string[j] == '\\'))
+ {
+ seq[k++] = string[j];
+ passc = !passc;
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ if (string[j] == '"')
+ break;
+
+ seq[k++] = string[j];
+ }
+ seq[k] = '\0';
+
+ /* Binding macro? */
+ if (*funname == '\'' || *funname == '"')
+ {
+ j = strlen (funname);
+
+ /* Remove the delimiting quotes from each end of FUNNAME. */
+ if (j && funname[j - 1] == *funname)
+ funname[j - 1] = '\0';
+
+ rl_macro_bind (seq, &funname[1], _rl_keymap);
+ }
+ else
+ rl_bind_keyseq (seq, rl_named_function (funname));
+
+ free (seq);
+ return 0;
+ }
+
+ /* Get the actual character we want to deal with. */
+ kname = strrchr (string, '-');
+ if (!kname)
+ kname = string;
+ else
+ kname++;
+
+ key = glean_key_from_name (kname);
+
+ /* Add in control and meta bits. */
+ if (substring_member_of_array (string, _rl_possible_control_prefixes))
+ key = CTRL (_rl_to_upper (key));
+
+ if (substring_member_of_array (string, _rl_possible_meta_prefixes))
+ key = META (key);
+
+ /* Temporary. Handle old-style keyname with macro-binding. */
+ if (*funname == '\'' || *funname == '"')
+ {
+ char useq[2];
+ int fl = strlen (funname);
+
+ useq[0] = key; useq[1] = '\0';
+ if (fl && funname[fl - 1] == *funname)
+ funname[fl - 1] = '\0';
+
+ rl_macro_bind (useq, &funname[1], _rl_keymap);
+ }
+#if defined (PREFIX_META_HACK)
+ /* Ugly, but working hack to keep prefix-meta around. */
+ else if (_rl_stricmp (funname, "prefix-meta") == 0)
+ {
+ char seq[2];
+
+ seq[0] = key;
+ seq[1] = '\0';
+ rl_generic_bind (ISKMAP, seq, (char *)emacs_meta_keymap, _rl_keymap);
+ }
+#endif /* PREFIX_META_HACK */
+ else
+ rl_bind_key (key, rl_named_function (funname));
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Simple structure for boolean readline variables (i.e., those that can
+ have one of two values; either "On" or 1 for truth, or "Off" or 0 for
+ false. */
+
+#define V_SPECIAL 0x1
+
+static struct {
+ const char *name;
+ int *value;
+ int flags;
+} boolean_varlist [] = {
+ { "bind-tty-special-chars", &_rl_bind_stty_chars, 0 },
+ { "blink-matching-paren", &rl_blink_matching_paren, V_SPECIAL },
+ { "byte-oriented", &rl_byte_oriented, 0 },
+ { "completion-ignore-case", &_rl_completion_case_fold, 0 },
+ { "convert-meta", &_rl_convert_meta_chars_to_ascii, 0 },
+ { "disable-completion", &rl_inhibit_completion, 0 },
+ { "enable-keypad", &_rl_enable_keypad, 0 },
+ { "expand-tilde", &rl_complete_with_tilde_expansion, 0 },
+ { "history-preserve-point", &_rl_history_preserve_point, 0 },
+ { "horizontal-scroll-mode", &_rl_horizontal_scroll_mode, 0 },
+ { "input-meta", &_rl_meta_flag, 0 },
+ { "mark-directories", &_rl_complete_mark_directories, 0 },
+ { "mark-modified-lines", &_rl_mark_modified_lines, 0 },
+ { "mark-symlinked-directories", &_rl_complete_mark_symlink_dirs, 0 },
+ { "match-hidden-files", &_rl_match_hidden_files, 0 },
+ { "meta-flag", &_rl_meta_flag, 0 },
+ { "output-meta", &_rl_output_meta_chars, 0 },
+ { "page-completions", &_rl_page_completions, 0 },
+ { "prefer-visible-bell", &_rl_prefer_visible_bell, V_SPECIAL },
+ { "print-completions-horizontally", &_rl_print_completions_horizontally, 0 },
+ { "show-all-if-ambiguous", &_rl_complete_show_all, 0 },
+ { "show-all-if-unmodified", &_rl_complete_show_unmodified, 0 },
+#if defined (VISIBLE_STATS)
+ { "visible-stats", &rl_visible_stats, 0 },
+#endif /* VISIBLE_STATS */
+ { (char *)NULL, (int *)NULL }
+};
+
+static int
+find_boolean_var (name)
+ const char *name;
+{
+ register int i;
+
+ for (i = 0; boolean_varlist[i].name; i++)
+ if (_rl_stricmp (name, boolean_varlist[i].name) == 0)
+ return i;
+ return -1;
+}
+
+/* Hooks for handling special boolean variables, where a
+ function needs to be called or another variable needs
+ to be changed when they're changed. */
+static void
+hack_special_boolean_var (i)
+ int i;
+{
+ const char *name;
+
+ name = boolean_varlist[i].name;
+
+ if (_rl_stricmp (name, "blink-matching-paren") == 0)
+ _rl_enable_paren_matching (rl_blink_matching_paren);
+ else if (_rl_stricmp (name, "prefer-visible-bell") == 0)
+ {
+ if (_rl_prefer_visible_bell)
+ _rl_bell_preference = VISIBLE_BELL;
+ else
+ _rl_bell_preference = AUDIBLE_BELL;
+ }
+}
+
+typedef int _rl_sv_func_t PARAMS((const char *));
+
+/* These *must* correspond to the array indices for the appropriate
+ string variable. (Though they're not used right now.) */
+#define V_BELLSTYLE 0
+#define V_COMBEGIN 1
+#define V_EDITMODE 2
+#define V_ISRCHTERM 3
+#define V_KEYMAP 4
+
+#define V_STRING 1
+#define V_INT 2
+
+/* Forward declarations */
+static int sv_bell_style PARAMS((const char *));
+static int sv_combegin PARAMS((const char *));
+static int sv_compquery PARAMS((const char *));
+static int sv_editmode PARAMS((const char *));
+static int sv_isrchterm PARAMS((const char *));
+static int sv_keymap PARAMS((const char *));
+
+static struct {
+ const char *name;
+ int flags;
+ _rl_sv_func_t *set_func;
+} string_varlist[] = {
+ { "bell-style", V_STRING, sv_bell_style },
+ { "comment-begin", V_STRING, sv_combegin },
+ { "completion-query-items", V_INT, sv_compquery },
+ { "editing-mode", V_STRING, sv_editmode },
+ { "isearch-terminators", V_STRING, sv_isrchterm },
+ { "keymap", V_STRING, sv_keymap },
+ { (char *)NULL, 0 }
+};
+
+static int
+find_string_var (name)
+ const char *name;
+{
+ register int i;
+
+ for (i = 0; string_varlist[i].name; i++)
+ if (_rl_stricmp (name, string_varlist[i].name) == 0)
+ return i;
+ return -1;
+}
+
+/* A boolean value that can appear in a `set variable' command is true if
+ the value is null or empty, `on' (case-insenstive), or "1". Any other
+ values result in 0 (false). */
+static int
+bool_to_int (value)
+ const char *value;
+{
+ return (value == 0 || *value == '\0' ||
+ (_rl_stricmp (value, "on") == 0) ||
+ (value[0] == '1' && value[1] == '\0'));
+}
+
+char *
+rl_variable_value (name)
+ const char *name;
+{
+ register int i;
+ int v;
+ char *ret;
+
+ /* Check for simple variables first. */
+ i = find_boolean_var (name);
+ if (i >= 0)
+ return (*boolean_varlist[i].value ? "on" : "off");
+
+ i = find_string_var (name);
+ if (i >= 0)
+ return (_rl_get_string_variable_value (string_varlist[i].name));
+
+ /* Unknown variable names return NULL. */
+ return 0;
+}
+
+int
+rl_variable_bind (name, value)
+ const char *name, *value;
+{
+ register int i;
+ int v;
+
+ /* Check for simple variables first. */
+ i = find_boolean_var (name);
+ if (i >= 0)
+ {
+ *boolean_varlist[i].value = bool_to_int (value);
+ if (boolean_varlist[i].flags & V_SPECIAL)
+ hack_special_boolean_var (i);
+ return 0;
+ }
+
+ i = find_string_var (name);
+
+ /* For the time being, unknown variable names or string names without a
+ handler function are simply ignored. */
+ if (i < 0 || string_varlist[i].set_func == 0)
+ return 0;
+
+ v = (*string_varlist[i].set_func) (value);
+ return v;
+}
+
+static int
+sv_editmode (value)
+ const char *value;
+{
+ if (_rl_strnicmp (value, "vi", 2) == 0)
+ {
+#if defined (VI_MODE)
+ _rl_keymap = vi_insertion_keymap;
+ rl_editing_mode = vi_mode;
+#endif /* VI_MODE */
+ return 0;
+ }
+ else if (_rl_strnicmp (value, "emacs", 5) == 0)
+ {
+ _rl_keymap = emacs_standard_keymap;
+ rl_editing_mode = emacs_mode;
+ return 0;
+ }
+ return 1;
+}
+
+static int
+sv_combegin (value)
+ const char *value;
+{
+ if (value && *value)
+ {
+ FREE (_rl_comment_begin);
+ _rl_comment_begin = savestring (value);
+ return 0;
+ }
+ return 1;
+}
+
+static int
+sv_compquery (value)
+ const char *value;
+{
+ int nval = 100;
+
+ if (value && *value)
+ {
+ nval = atoi (value);
+ if (nval < 0)
+ nval = 0;
+ }
+ rl_completion_query_items = nval;
+ return 0;
+}
+
+static int
+sv_keymap (value)
+ const char *value;
+{
+ Keymap kmap;
+
+ kmap = rl_get_keymap_by_name (value);
+ if (kmap)
+ {
+ rl_set_keymap (kmap);
+ return 0;
+ }
+ return 1;
+}
+
+static int
+sv_bell_style (value)
+ const char *value;
+{
+ if (value == 0 || *value == '\0')
+ _rl_bell_preference = AUDIBLE_BELL;
+ else if (_rl_stricmp (value, "none") == 0 || _rl_stricmp (value, "off") == 0)
+ _rl_bell_preference = NO_BELL;
+ else if (_rl_stricmp (value, "audible") == 0 || _rl_stricmp (value, "on") == 0)
+ _rl_bell_preference = AUDIBLE_BELL;
+ else if (_rl_stricmp (value, "visible") == 0)
+ _rl_bell_preference = VISIBLE_BELL;
+ else
+ return 1;
+ return 0;
+}
+
+static int
+sv_isrchterm (value)
+ const char *value;
+{
+ int beg, end, delim;
+ char *v;
+
+ if (value == 0)
+ return 1;
+
+ /* Isolate the value and translate it into a character string. */
+ v = savestring (value);
+ FREE (_rl_isearch_terminators);
+ if (v[0] == '"' || v[0] == '\'')
+ {
+ delim = v[0];
+ for (beg = end = 1; v[end] && v[end] != delim; end++)
+ ;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ for (beg = end = 0; whitespace (v[end]) == 0; end++)
+ ;
+ }
+
+ v[end] = '\0';
+
+ /* The value starts at v + beg. Translate it into a character string. */
+ _rl_isearch_terminators = (char *)xmalloc (2 * strlen (v) + 1);
+ rl_translate_keyseq (v + beg, _rl_isearch_terminators, &end);
+ _rl_isearch_terminators[end] = '\0';
+
+ free (v);
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Return the character which matches NAME.
+ For example, `Space' returns ' '. */
+
+typedef struct {
+ const char *name;
+ int value;
+} assoc_list;
+
+static assoc_list name_key_alist[] = {
+ { "DEL", 0x7f },
+ { "ESC", '\033' },
+ { "Escape", '\033' },
+ { "LFD", '\n' },
+ { "Newline", '\n' },
+ { "RET", '\r' },
+ { "Return", '\r' },
+ { "Rubout", 0x7f },
+ { "SPC", ' ' },
+ { "Space", ' ' },
+ { "Tab", 0x09 },
+ { (char *)0x0, 0 }
+};
+
+static int
+glean_key_from_name (name)
+ char *name;
+{
+ register int i;
+
+ for (i = 0; name_key_alist[i].name; i++)
+ if (_rl_stricmp (name, name_key_alist[i].name) == 0)
+ return (name_key_alist[i].value);
+
+ return (*(unsigned char *)name); /* XXX was return (*name) */
+}
+
+/* Auxiliary functions to manage keymaps. */
+static struct {
+ const char *name;
+ Keymap map;
+} keymap_names[] = {
+ { "emacs", emacs_standard_keymap },
+ { "emacs-standard", emacs_standard_keymap },
+ { "emacs-meta", emacs_meta_keymap },
+ { "emacs-ctlx", emacs_ctlx_keymap },
+#if defined (VI_MODE)
+ { "vi", vi_movement_keymap },
+ { "vi-move", vi_movement_keymap },
+ { "vi-command", vi_movement_keymap },
+ { "vi-insert", vi_insertion_keymap },
+#endif /* VI_MODE */
+ { (char *)0x0, (Keymap)0x0 }
+};
+
+Keymap
+rl_get_keymap_by_name (name)
+ const char *name;
+{
+ register int i;
+
+ for (i = 0; keymap_names[i].name; i++)
+ if (_rl_stricmp (name, keymap_names[i].name) == 0)
+ return (keymap_names[i].map);
+ return ((Keymap) NULL);
+}
+
+char *
+rl_get_keymap_name (map)
+ Keymap map;
+{
+ register int i;
+ for (i = 0; keymap_names[i].name; i++)
+ if (map == keymap_names[i].map)
+ return ((char *)keymap_names[i].name);
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+}
+
+void
+rl_set_keymap (map)
+ Keymap map;
+{
+ if (map)
+ _rl_keymap = map;
+}
+
+Keymap
+rl_get_keymap ()
+{
+ return (_rl_keymap);
+}
+
+void
+rl_set_keymap_from_edit_mode ()
+{
+ if (rl_editing_mode == emacs_mode)
+ _rl_keymap = emacs_standard_keymap;
+#if defined (VI_MODE)
+ else if (rl_editing_mode == vi_mode)
+ _rl_keymap = vi_insertion_keymap;
+#endif /* VI_MODE */
+}
+
+char *
+rl_get_keymap_name_from_edit_mode ()
+{
+ if (rl_editing_mode == emacs_mode)
+ return "emacs";
+#if defined (VI_MODE)
+ else if (rl_editing_mode == vi_mode)
+ return "vi";
+#endif /* VI_MODE */
+ else
+ return "none";
+}
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Key Binding and Function Information */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* Each of the following functions produces information about the
+ state of keybindings and functions known to Readline. The info
+ is always printed to rl_outstream, and in such a way that it can
+ be read back in (i.e., passed to rl_parse_and_bind ()). */
+
+/* Print the names of functions known to Readline. */
+void
+rl_list_funmap_names ()
+{
+ register int i;
+ const char **funmap_names;
+
+ funmap_names = rl_funmap_names ();
+
+ if (!funmap_names)
+ return;
+
+ for (i = 0; funmap_names[i]; i++)
+ fprintf (rl_outstream, "%s\n", funmap_names[i]);
+
+ free (funmap_names);
+}
+
+static char *
+_rl_get_keyname (key)
+ int key;
+{
+ char *keyname;
+ int i, c;
+
+ keyname = (char *)xmalloc (8);
+
+ c = key;
+ /* Since this is going to be used to write out keysequence-function
+ pairs for possible inclusion in an inputrc file, we don't want to
+ do any special meta processing on KEY. */
+
+#if 1
+ /* XXX - Experimental */
+ /* We might want to do this, but the old version of the code did not. */
+
+ /* If this is an escape character, we don't want to do any more processing.
+ Just add the special ESC key sequence and return. */
+ if (c == ESC)
+ {
+ keyname[0] = '\\';
+ keyname[1] = 'e';
+ keyname[2] = '\0';
+ return keyname;
+ }
+#endif
+
+ /* RUBOUT is translated directly into \C-? */
+ if (key == RUBOUT)
+ {
+ keyname[0] = '\\';
+ keyname[1] = 'C';
+ keyname[2] = '-';
+ keyname[3] = '?';
+ keyname[4] = '\0';
+ return keyname;
+ }
+
+ i = 0;
+ /* Now add special prefixes needed for control characters. This can
+ potentially change C. */
+ if (CTRL_CHAR (c))
+ {
+ keyname[i++] = '\\';
+ keyname[i++] = 'C';
+ keyname[i++] = '-';
+ c = _rl_to_lower (UNCTRL (c));
+ }
+
+ /* XXX experimental code. Turn the characters that are not ASCII or
+ ISO Latin 1 (128 - 159) into octal escape sequences (\200 - \237).
+ This changes C. */
+ if (c >= 128 && c <= 159)
+ {
+ keyname[i++] = '\\';
+ keyname[i++] = '2';
+ c -= 128;
+ keyname[i++] = (c / 8) + '0';
+ c = (c % 8) + '0';
+ }
+
+ /* Now, if the character needs to be quoted with a backslash, do that. */
+ if (c == '\\' || c == '"')
+ keyname[i++] = '\\';
+
+ /* Now add the key, terminate the string, and return it. */
+ keyname[i++] = (char) c;
+ keyname[i] = '\0';
+
+ return keyname;
+}
+
+/* Return a NULL terminated array of strings which represent the key
+ sequences that are used to invoke FUNCTION in MAP. */
+char **
+rl_invoking_keyseqs_in_map (function, map)
+ rl_command_func_t *function;
+ Keymap map;
+{
+ register int key;
+ char **result;
+ int result_index, result_size;
+
+ result = (char **)NULL;
+ result_index = result_size = 0;
+
+ for (key = 0; key < KEYMAP_SIZE; key++)
+ {
+ switch (map[key].type)
+ {
+ case ISMACR:
+ /* Macros match, if, and only if, the pointers are identical.
+ Thus, they are treated exactly like functions in here. */
+ case ISFUNC:
+ /* If the function in the keymap is the one we are looking for,
+ then add the current KEY to the list of invoking keys. */
+ if (map[key].function == function)
+ {
+ char *keyname;
+
+ keyname = _rl_get_keyname (key);
+
+ if (result_index + 2 > result_size)
+ {
+ result_size += 10;
+ result = (char **)xrealloc (result, result_size * sizeof (char *));
+ }
+
+ result[result_index++] = keyname;
+ result[result_index] = (char *)NULL;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case ISKMAP:
+ {
+ char **seqs;
+ register int i;
+
+ /* Find the list of keyseqs in this map which have FUNCTION as
+ their target. Add the key sequences found to RESULT. */
+ if (map[key].function)
+ seqs =
+ rl_invoking_keyseqs_in_map (function, FUNCTION_TO_KEYMAP (map, key));
+ else
+ break;
+
+ if (seqs == 0)
+ break;
+
+ for (i = 0; seqs[i]; i++)
+ {
+ char *keyname = (char *)xmalloc (6 + strlen (seqs[i]));
+
+ if (key == ESC)
+#if 0
+ sprintf (keyname, "\\e");
+#else
+ /* XXX - experimental */
+ sprintf (keyname, "\\M-");
+#endif
+ else if (CTRL_CHAR (key))
+ sprintf (keyname, "\\C-%c", _rl_to_lower (UNCTRL (key)));
+ else if (key == RUBOUT)
+ sprintf (keyname, "\\C-?");
+ else if (key == '\\' || key == '"')
+ {
+ keyname[0] = '\\';
+ keyname[1] = (char) key;
+ keyname[2] = '\0';
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ keyname[0] = (char) key;
+ keyname[1] = '\0';
+ }
+
+ strcat (keyname, seqs[i]);
+ free (seqs[i]);
+
+ if (result_index + 2 > result_size)
+ {
+ result_size += 10;
+ result = (char **)xrealloc (result, result_size * sizeof (char *));
+ }
+
+ result[result_index++] = keyname;
+ result[result_index] = (char *)NULL;
+ }
+
+ free (seqs);
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ return (result);
+}
+
+/* Return a NULL terminated array of strings which represent the key
+ sequences that can be used to invoke FUNCTION using the current keymap. */
+char **
+rl_invoking_keyseqs (function)
+ rl_command_func_t *function;
+{
+ return (rl_invoking_keyseqs_in_map (function, _rl_keymap));
+}
+
+/* Print all of the functions and their bindings to rl_outstream. If
+ PRINT_READABLY is non-zero, then print the output in such a way
+ that it can be read back in. */
+void
+rl_function_dumper (print_readably)
+ int print_readably;
+{
+ register int i;
+ const char **names;
+ const char *name;
+
+ names = rl_funmap_names ();
+
+ fprintf (rl_outstream, "\n");
+
+ for (i = 0; name = names[i]; i++)
+ {
+ rl_command_func_t *function;
+ char **invokers;
+
+ function = rl_named_function (name);
+ invokers = rl_invoking_keyseqs_in_map (function, _rl_keymap);
+
+ if (print_readably)
+ {
+ if (!invokers)
+ fprintf (rl_outstream, "# %s (not bound)\n", name);
+ else
+ {
+ register int j;
+
+ for (j = 0; invokers[j]; j++)
+ {
+ fprintf (rl_outstream, "\"%s\": %s\n",
+ invokers[j], name);
+ free (invokers[j]);
+ }
+
+ free (invokers);
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if (!invokers)
+ fprintf (rl_outstream, "%s is not bound to any keys\n",
+ name);
+ else
+ {
+ register int j;
+
+ fprintf (rl_outstream, "%s can be found on ", name);
+
+ for (j = 0; invokers[j] && j < 5; j++)
+ {
+ fprintf (rl_outstream, "\"%s\"%s", invokers[j],
+ invokers[j + 1] ? ", " : ".\n");
+ }
+
+ if (j == 5 && invokers[j])
+ fprintf (rl_outstream, "...\n");
+
+ for (j = 0; invokers[j]; j++)
+ free (invokers[j]);
+
+ free (invokers);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+/* Print all of the current functions and their bindings to
+ rl_outstream. If an explicit argument is given, then print
+ the output in such a way that it can be read back in. */
+int
+rl_dump_functions (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ if (rl_dispatching)
+ fprintf (rl_outstream, "\r\n");
+ rl_function_dumper (rl_explicit_arg);
+ rl_on_new_line ();
+ return (0);
+}
+
+static void
+_rl_macro_dumper_internal (print_readably, map, prefix)
+ int print_readably;
+ Keymap map;
+ char *prefix;
+{
+ register int key;
+ char *keyname, *out;
+ int prefix_len;
+
+ for (key = 0; key < KEYMAP_SIZE; key++)
+ {
+ switch (map[key].type)
+ {
+ case ISMACR:
+ keyname = _rl_get_keyname (key);
+ out = _rl_untranslate_macro_value ((char *)map[key].function);
+
+ if (print_readably)
+ fprintf (rl_outstream, "\"%s%s\": \"%s\"\n", prefix ? prefix : "",
+ keyname,
+ out ? out : "");
+ else
+ fprintf (rl_outstream, "%s%s outputs %s\n", prefix ? prefix : "",
+ keyname,
+ out ? out : "");
+ free (keyname);
+ free (out);
+ break;
+ case ISFUNC:
+ break;
+ case ISKMAP:
+ prefix_len = prefix ? strlen (prefix) : 0;
+ if (key == ESC)
+ {
+ keyname = (char *)xmalloc (3 + prefix_len);
+ if (prefix)
+ strcpy (keyname, prefix);
+ keyname[prefix_len] = '\\';
+ keyname[prefix_len + 1] = 'e';
+ keyname[prefix_len + 2] = '\0';
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ keyname = _rl_get_keyname (key);
+ if (prefix)
+ {
+ out = (char *)xmalloc (strlen (keyname) + prefix_len + 1);
+ strcpy (out, prefix);
+ strcpy (out + prefix_len, keyname);
+ free (keyname);
+ keyname = out;
+ }
+ }
+
+ _rl_macro_dumper_internal (print_readably, FUNCTION_TO_KEYMAP (map, key), keyname);
+ free (keyname);
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+void
+rl_macro_dumper (print_readably)
+ int print_readably;
+{
+ _rl_macro_dumper_internal (print_readably, _rl_keymap, (char *)NULL);
+}
+
+int
+rl_dump_macros (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ if (rl_dispatching)
+ fprintf (rl_outstream, "\r\n");
+ rl_macro_dumper (rl_explicit_arg);
+ rl_on_new_line ();
+ return (0);
+}
+
+static char *
+_rl_get_string_variable_value (name)
+ const char *name;
+{
+ static char numbuf[32];
+ char *ret;
+ int n;
+
+ if (_rl_stricmp (name, "bell-style") == 0)
+ {
+ switch (_rl_bell_preference)
+ {
+ case NO_BELL:
+ return "none";
+ case VISIBLE_BELL:
+ return "visible";
+ case AUDIBLE_BELL:
+ default:
+ return "audible";
+ }
+ }
+ else if (_rl_stricmp (name, "comment-begin") == 0)
+ return (_rl_comment_begin ? _rl_comment_begin : RL_COMMENT_BEGIN_DEFAULT);
+ else if (_rl_stricmp (name, "completion-query-items") == 0)
+ {
+ sprintf (numbuf, "%d", rl_completion_query_items);
+ return (numbuf);
+ }
+ else if (_rl_stricmp (name, "editing-mode") == 0)
+ return (rl_get_keymap_name_from_edit_mode ());
+ else if (_rl_stricmp (name, "isearch-terminators") == 0)
+ {
+ if (_rl_isearch_terminators == 0)
+ return 0;
+ ret = _rl_untranslate_macro_value (_rl_isearch_terminators);
+ if (ret)
+ {
+ strncpy (numbuf, ret, sizeof (numbuf) - 1);
+ free (ret);
+ numbuf[sizeof(numbuf) - 1] = '\0';
+ }
+ else
+ numbuf[0] = '\0';
+ return numbuf;
+ }
+ else if (_rl_stricmp (name, "keymap") == 0)
+ {
+ ret = rl_get_keymap_name (_rl_keymap);
+ if (ret == 0)
+ ret = rl_get_keymap_name_from_edit_mode ();
+ return (ret ? ret : "none");
+ }
+ else
+ return (0);
+}
+
+void
+rl_variable_dumper (print_readably)
+ int print_readably;
+{
+ int i;
+ char *v;
+
+ for (i = 0; boolean_varlist[i].name; i++)
+ {
+ if (print_readably)
+ fprintf (rl_outstream, "set %s %s\n", boolean_varlist[i].name,
+ *boolean_varlist[i].value ? "on" : "off");
+ else
+ fprintf (rl_outstream, "%s is set to `%s'\n", boolean_varlist[i].name,
+ *boolean_varlist[i].value ? "on" : "off");
+ }
+
+ for (i = 0; string_varlist[i].name; i++)
+ {
+ v = _rl_get_string_variable_value (string_varlist[i].name);
+ if (v == 0) /* _rl_isearch_terminators can be NULL */
+ continue;
+ if (print_readably)
+ fprintf (rl_outstream, "set %s %s\n", string_varlist[i].name, v);
+ else
+ fprintf (rl_outstream, "%s is set to `%s'\n", string_varlist[i].name, v);
+ }
+}
+
+/* Print all of the current variables and their values to
+ rl_outstream. If an explicit argument is given, then print
+ the output in such a way that it can be read back in. */
+int
+rl_dump_variables (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ if (rl_dispatching)
+ fprintf (rl_outstream, "\r\n");
+ rl_variable_dumper (rl_explicit_arg);
+ rl_on_new_line ();
+ return (0);
+}
+
+/* Return non-zero if any members of ARRAY are a substring in STRING. */
+static int
+substring_member_of_array (string, array)
+ char *string;
+ const char **array;
+{
+ while (*array)
+ {
+ if (_rl_strindex (string, *array))
+ return (1);
+ array++;
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/callback.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/callback.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9120969
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/callback.c
@@ -0,0 +1,260 @@
+/* callback.c -- functions to use readline as an X `callback' mechanism. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1987-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "rlconf.h"
+
+#if defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#ifdef HAVE_STDLIB_H
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+/* System-specific feature definitions and include files. */
+#include "rldefs.h"
+#include "readline.h"
+#include "rlprivate.h"
+
+/* Private data for callback registration functions. See comments in
+ rl_callback_read_char for more details. */
+_rl_callback_func_t *_rl_callback_func = 0;
+_rl_callback_generic_arg *_rl_callback_data = 0;
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Callback Readline Functions */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* Allow using readline in situations where a program may have multiple
+ things to handle at once, and dispatches them via select(). Call
+ rl_callback_handler_install() with the prompt and a function to call
+ whenever a complete line of input is ready. The user must then
+ call rl_callback_read_char() every time some input is available, and
+ rl_callback_read_char() will call the user's function with the complete
+ text read in at each end of line. The terminal is kept prepped and
+ signals handled all the time, except during calls to the user's function. */
+
+rl_vcpfunc_t *rl_linefunc; /* user callback function */
+static int in_handler; /* terminal_prepped and signals set? */
+
+/* Make sure the terminal is set up, initialize readline, and prompt. */
+static void
+_rl_callback_newline ()
+{
+ rl_initialize ();
+
+ if (in_handler == 0)
+ {
+ in_handler = 1;
+
+ if (rl_prep_term_function)
+ (*rl_prep_term_function) (_rl_meta_flag);
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_SIGNALS)
+ rl_set_signals ();
+#endif
+ }
+
+ readline_internal_setup ();
+}
+
+/* Install a readline handler, set up the terminal, and issue the prompt. */
+void
+rl_callback_handler_install (prompt, linefunc)
+ const char *prompt;
+ rl_vcpfunc_t *linefunc;
+{
+ rl_set_prompt (prompt);
+ RL_SETSTATE (RL_STATE_CALLBACK);
+ rl_linefunc = linefunc;
+ _rl_callback_newline ();
+}
+
+/* Read one character, and dispatch to the handler if it ends the line. */
+void
+rl_callback_read_char ()
+{
+ char *line;
+ int eof, jcode;
+ static procenv_t olevel;
+
+ if (rl_linefunc == NULL)
+ {
+ fprintf (stderr, "readline: readline_callback_read_char() called with no handler!\r\n");
+ abort ();
+ }
+
+ memcpy ((void *)olevel, (void *)readline_top_level, sizeof (procenv_t));
+ jcode = setjmp (readline_top_level);
+ if (jcode)
+ {
+ (*rl_redisplay_function) ();
+ _rl_want_redisplay = 0;
+ memcpy ((void *)readline_top_level, (void *)olevel, sizeof (procenv_t));
+ return;
+ }
+
+ if (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_ISEARCH))
+ {
+ eof = _rl_isearch_callback (_rl_iscxt);
+ if (eof == 0 && (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_ISEARCH) == 0) && RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_INPUTPENDING))
+ rl_callback_read_char ();
+
+ return;
+ }
+ else if (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_NSEARCH))
+ {
+ eof = _rl_nsearch_callback (_rl_nscxt);
+ return;
+ }
+ else if (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_NUMERICARG))
+ {
+ eof = _rl_arg_callback (_rl_argcxt);
+ if (eof == 0 && (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_NUMERICARG) == 0) && RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_INPUTPENDING))
+ rl_callback_read_char ();
+ /* XXX - this should handle _rl_last_command_was_kill better */
+ else if (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_NUMERICARG) == 0)
+ _rl_internal_char_cleanup ();
+
+ return;
+ }
+ else if (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_MULTIKEY))
+ {
+ eof = _rl_dispatch_callback (_rl_kscxt); /* For now */
+ while ((eof == -1 || eof == -2) && RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_MULTIKEY) && _rl_kscxt && (_rl_kscxt->flags & KSEQ_DISPATCHED))
+ eof = _rl_dispatch_callback (_rl_kscxt);
+ if (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_MULTIKEY) == 0)
+ {
+ _rl_internal_char_cleanup ();
+ _rl_want_redisplay = 1;
+ }
+ }
+ else if (_rl_callback_func)
+ {
+ /* This allows functions that simply need to read an additional character
+ (like quoted-insert) to register a function to be called when input is
+ available. _rl_callback_data is simply a pointer to a struct that has
+ the argument count originally passed to the registering function and
+ space for any additional parameters. */
+ eof = (*_rl_callback_func) (_rl_callback_data);
+ /* If the function `deregisters' itself, make sure the data is cleaned
+ up. */
+ if (_rl_callback_func == 0)
+ {
+ if (_rl_callback_data)
+ {
+ _rl_callback_data_dispose (_rl_callback_data);
+ _rl_callback_data = 0;
+ }
+ _rl_internal_char_cleanup ();
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ eof = readline_internal_char ();
+
+ if (rl_done == 0 && _rl_want_redisplay)
+ {
+ (*rl_redisplay_function) ();
+ _rl_want_redisplay = 0;
+ }
+
+ /* We loop in case some function has pushed input back with rl_execute_next. */
+ for (;;)
+ {
+ if (rl_done)
+ {
+ line = readline_internal_teardown (eof);
+
+ if (rl_deprep_term_function)
+ (*rl_deprep_term_function) ();
+#if defined (HANDLE_SIGNALS)
+ rl_clear_signals ();
+#endif
+ in_handler = 0;
+ (*rl_linefunc) (line);
+
+ /* If the user did not clear out the line, do it for him. */
+ if (rl_line_buffer[0])
+ _rl_init_line_state ();
+
+ /* Redisplay the prompt if readline_handler_{install,remove}
+ not called. */
+ if (in_handler == 0 && rl_linefunc)
+ _rl_callback_newline ();
+ }
+ if (rl_pending_input || _rl_pushed_input_available () || RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_MACROINPUT))
+ eof = readline_internal_char ();
+ else
+ break;
+ }
+}
+
+/* Remove the handler, and make sure the terminal is in its normal state. */
+void
+rl_callback_handler_remove ()
+{
+ rl_linefunc = NULL;
+ RL_UNSETSTATE (RL_STATE_CALLBACK);
+ if (in_handler)
+ {
+ in_handler = 0;
+ if (rl_deprep_term_function)
+ (*rl_deprep_term_function) ();
+#if defined (HANDLE_SIGNALS)
+ rl_clear_signals ();
+#endif
+ }
+}
+
+_rl_callback_generic_arg *
+_rl_callback_data_alloc (count)
+ int count;
+{
+ _rl_callback_generic_arg *arg;
+
+ arg = (_rl_callback_generic_arg *)xmalloc (sizeof (_rl_callback_generic_arg));
+ arg->count = count;
+
+ arg->i1 = arg->i2 = 0;
+
+ return arg;
+}
+
+void _rl_callback_data_dispose (arg)
+ _rl_callback_generic_arg *arg;
+{
+ if (arg)
+ free (arg);
+}
+
+#endif
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/chardefs.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/chardefs.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..def3a11
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/chardefs.h
@@ -0,0 +1,165 @@
+/* chardefs.h -- Character definitions for readline. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1994 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#ifndef _CHARDEFS_H_
+#define _CHARDEFS_H_
+
+#include <ctype.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# if defined (HAVE_STRING_H)
+# if ! defined (STDC_HEADERS) && defined (HAVE_MEMORY_H)
+# include <memory.h>
+# endif
+# include <string.h>
+# endif /* HAVE_STRING_H */
+# if defined (HAVE_STRINGS_H)
+# include <strings.h>
+# endif /* HAVE_STRINGS_H */
+#else
+# include <string.h>
+#endif /* !HAVE_CONFIG_H */
+
+#ifndef whitespace
+#define whitespace(c) (((c) == ' ') || ((c) == '\t'))
+#endif
+
+#ifdef CTRL
+# undef CTRL
+#endif
+#ifdef UNCTRL
+# undef UNCTRL
+#endif
+
+/* Some character stuff. */
+#define control_character_threshold 0x020 /* Smaller than this is control. */
+#define control_character_mask 0x1f /* 0x20 - 1 */
+#define meta_character_threshold 0x07f /* Larger than this is Meta. */
+#define control_character_bit 0x40 /* 0x000000, must be off. */
+#define meta_character_bit 0x080 /* x0000000, must be on. */
+#define largest_char 255 /* Largest character value. */
+
+#define CTRL_CHAR(c) ((c) < control_character_threshold && (((c) & 0x80) == 0))
+#define META_CHAR(c) ((c) > meta_character_threshold && (c) <= largest_char)
+
+#define CTRL(c) ((c) & control_character_mask)
+#define META(c) ((c) | meta_character_bit)
+
+#define UNMETA(c) ((c) & (~meta_character_bit))
+#define UNCTRL(c) _rl_to_upper(((c)|control_character_bit))
+
+#if defined STDC_HEADERS || (!defined (isascii) && !defined (HAVE_ISASCII))
+# define IN_CTYPE_DOMAIN(c) 1
+#else
+# define IN_CTYPE_DOMAIN(c) isascii(c)
+#endif
+
+#if !defined (isxdigit) && !defined (HAVE_ISXDIGIT)
+# define isxdigit(c) (isdigit((c)) || ((c) >= 'a' && (c) <= 'f') || ((c) >= 'A' && (c) <= 'F'))
+#endif
+
+#if defined (CTYPE_NON_ASCII)
+# define NON_NEGATIVE(c) 1
+#else
+# define NON_NEGATIVE(c) ((unsigned char)(c) == (c))
+#endif
+
+/* Some systems define these; we want our definitions. */
+#undef ISPRINT
+
+/* Beware: these only work with single-byte ASCII characters. */
+
+#define ISALNUM(c) (IN_CTYPE_DOMAIN (c) && isalnum (c))
+#define ISALPHA(c) (IN_CTYPE_DOMAIN (c) && isalpha (c))
+#define ISDIGIT(c) (IN_CTYPE_DOMAIN (c) && isdigit (c))
+#define ISLOWER(c) (IN_CTYPE_DOMAIN (c) && islower (c))
+#define ISPRINT(c) (IN_CTYPE_DOMAIN (c) && isprint (c))
+#define ISUPPER(c) (IN_CTYPE_DOMAIN (c) && isupper (c))
+#define ISXDIGIT(c) (IN_CTYPE_DOMAIN (c) && isxdigit (c))
+
+#define _rl_lowercase_p(c) (NON_NEGATIVE(c) && ISLOWER(c))
+#define _rl_uppercase_p(c) (NON_NEGATIVE(c) && ISUPPER(c))
+#define _rl_digit_p(c) ((c) >= '0' && (c) <= '9')
+
+#define _rl_pure_alphabetic(c) (NON_NEGATIVE(c) && ISALPHA(c))
+#define ALPHABETIC(c) (NON_NEGATIVE(c) && ISALNUM(c))
+
+#ifndef _rl_to_upper
+# define _rl_to_upper(c) (_rl_lowercase_p(c) ? toupper((unsigned char)c) : (c))
+# define _rl_to_lower(c) (_rl_uppercase_p(c) ? tolower((unsigned char)c) : (c))
+#endif
+
+#ifndef _rl_digit_value
+# define _rl_digit_value(x) ((x) - '0')
+#endif
+
+#ifndef _rl_isident
+# define _rl_isident(c) (ISALNUM(c) || (c) == '_')
+#endif
+
+#ifndef ISOCTAL
+# define ISOCTAL(c) ((c) >= '0' && (c) <= '7')
+#endif
+#define OCTVALUE(c) ((c) - '0')
+
+#define HEXVALUE(c) \
+ (((c) >= 'a' && (c) <= 'f') \
+ ? (c)-'a'+10 \
+ : (c) >= 'A' && (c) <= 'F' ? (c)-'A'+10 : (c)-'0')
+
+#ifndef NEWLINE
+#define NEWLINE '\n'
+#endif
+
+#ifndef RETURN
+#define RETURN CTRL('M')
+#endif
+
+#ifndef RUBOUT
+#define RUBOUT 0x7f
+#endif
+
+#ifndef TAB
+#define TAB '\t'
+#endif
+
+#ifdef ABORT_CHAR
+#undef ABORT_CHAR
+#endif
+#define ABORT_CHAR CTRL('G')
+
+#ifdef PAGE
+#undef PAGE
+#endif
+#define PAGE CTRL('L')
+
+#ifdef SPACE
+#undef SPACE
+#endif
+#define SPACE ' ' /* XXX - was 0x20 */
+
+#ifdef ESC
+#undef ESC
+#endif
+#define ESC CTRL('[')
+
+#endif /* _CHARDEFS_H_ */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/compat.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/compat.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..a66d210
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/compat.c
@@ -0,0 +1,113 @@
+/* compat.c -- backwards compatibility functions. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+#include "rlstdc.h"
+#include "rltypedefs.h"
+
+extern void rl_free_undo_list PARAMS((void));
+extern int rl_maybe_save_line PARAMS((void));
+extern int rl_maybe_unsave_line PARAMS((void));
+extern int rl_maybe_replace_line PARAMS((void));
+
+extern int rl_crlf PARAMS((void));
+extern int rl_ding PARAMS((void));
+extern int rl_alphabetic PARAMS((int));
+
+extern char **rl_completion_matches PARAMS((const char *, rl_compentry_func_t *));
+extern char *rl_username_completion_function PARAMS((const char *, int));
+extern char *rl_filename_completion_function PARAMS((const char *, int));
+
+/* Provide backwards-compatible entry points for old function names. */
+
+void
+free_undo_list ()
+{
+ rl_free_undo_list ();
+}
+
+int
+maybe_replace_line ()
+{
+ return rl_maybe_replace_line ();
+}
+
+int
+maybe_save_line ()
+{
+ return rl_maybe_save_line ();
+}
+
+int
+maybe_unsave_line ()
+{
+ return rl_maybe_unsave_line ();
+}
+
+int
+ding ()
+{
+ return rl_ding ();
+}
+
+int
+crlf ()
+{
+ return rl_crlf ();
+}
+
+int
+alphabetic (c)
+ int c;
+{
+ return rl_alphabetic (c);
+}
+
+char **
+completion_matches (s, f)
+ const char *s;
+ rl_compentry_func_t *f;
+{
+ return rl_completion_matches (s, f);
+}
+
+char *
+username_completion_function (s, i)
+ const char *s;
+ int i;
+{
+ return rl_username_completion_function (s, i);
+}
+
+char *
+filename_completion_function (s, i)
+ const char *s;
+ int i;
+{
+ return rl_filename_completion_function (s, i);
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/complete.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/complete.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d93c15a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/complete.c
@@ -0,0 +1,2211 @@
+/* complete.c -- filename completion for readline. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1987-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#if defined (HAVE_SYS_FILE_H)
+# include <sys/file.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif /* HAVE_UNISTD_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STDLIB_H)
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif /* HAVE_STDLIB_H */
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+#include <errno.h>
+#if !defined (errno)
+extern int errno;
+#endif /* !errno */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_PWD_H)
+#include <pwd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "posixdir.h"
+#include "posixstat.h"
+
+/* System-specific feature definitions and include files. */
+#include "rldefs.h"
+#include "rlmbutil.h"
+
+/* Some standard library routines. */
+#include "readline.h"
+#include "xmalloc.h"
+#include "rlprivate.h"
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+typedef int QSFUNC (const void *, const void *);
+#else
+typedef int QSFUNC ();
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_LSTAT
+# define LSTAT lstat
+#else
+# define LSTAT stat
+#endif
+
+/* Unix version of a hidden file. Could be different on other systems. */
+#define HIDDEN_FILE(fname) ((fname)[0] == '.')
+
+/* Most systems don't declare getpwent in <pwd.h> if _POSIX_SOURCE is
+ defined. */
+#if defined (HAVE_GETPWENT) && (!defined (HAVE_GETPW_DECLS) || defined (_POSIX_SOURCE))
+extern struct passwd *getpwent PARAMS((void));
+#endif /* HAVE_GETPWENT && (!HAVE_GETPW_DECLS || _POSIX_SOURCE) */
+
+/* If non-zero, then this is the address of a function to call when
+ completing a word would normally display the list of possible matches.
+ This function is called instead of actually doing the display.
+ It takes three arguments: (char **matches, int num_matches, int max_length)
+ where MATCHES is the array of strings that matched, NUM_MATCHES is the
+ number of strings in that array, and MAX_LENGTH is the length of the
+ longest string in that array. */
+rl_compdisp_func_t *rl_completion_display_matches_hook = (rl_compdisp_func_t *)NULL;
+
+#if defined (VISIBLE_STATS)
+# if !defined (X_OK)
+# define X_OK 1
+# endif
+static int stat_char PARAMS((char *));
+#endif
+
+static int path_isdir PARAMS((const char *));
+
+static char *rl_quote_filename PARAMS((char *, int, char *));
+
+static void set_completion_defaults PARAMS((int));
+static int get_y_or_n PARAMS((int));
+static int _rl_internal_pager PARAMS((int));
+static char *printable_part PARAMS((char *));
+static int fnwidth PARAMS((const char *));
+static int fnprint PARAMS((const char *));
+static int print_filename PARAMS((char *, char *));
+
+static char **gen_completion_matches PARAMS((char *, int, int, rl_compentry_func_t *, int, int));
+
+static char **remove_duplicate_matches PARAMS((char **));
+static void insert_match PARAMS((char *, int, int, char *));
+static int append_to_match PARAMS((char *, int, int, int));
+static void insert_all_matches PARAMS((char **, int, char *));
+static void display_matches PARAMS((char **));
+static int compute_lcd_of_matches PARAMS((char **, int, const char *));
+static int postprocess_matches PARAMS((char ***, int));
+
+static char *make_quoted_replacement PARAMS((char *, int, char *));
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Completion matching, from readline's point of view. */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* Variables known only to the readline library. */
+
+/* If non-zero, non-unique completions always show the list of matches. */
+int _rl_complete_show_all = 0;
+
+/* If non-zero, non-unique completions show the list of matches, unless it
+ is not possible to do partial completion and modify the line. */
+int _rl_complete_show_unmodified = 0;
+
+/* If non-zero, completed directory names have a slash appended. */
+int _rl_complete_mark_directories = 1;
+
+/* If non-zero, the symlinked directory completion behavior introduced in
+ readline-4.2a is disabled, and symlinks that point to directories have
+ a slash appended (subject to the value of _rl_complete_mark_directories).
+ This is user-settable via the mark-symlinked-directories variable. */
+int _rl_complete_mark_symlink_dirs = 0;
+
+/* If non-zero, completions are printed horizontally in alphabetical order,
+ like `ls -x'. */
+int _rl_print_completions_horizontally;
+
+/* Non-zero means that case is not significant in filename completion. */
+#if defined (__MSDOS__) && !defined (__DJGPP__)
+int _rl_completion_case_fold = 1;
+#else
+int _rl_completion_case_fold;
+#endif
+
+/* If non-zero, don't match hidden files (filenames beginning with a `.' on
+ Unix) when doing filename completion. */
+int _rl_match_hidden_files = 1;
+
+/* Global variables available to applications using readline. */
+
+#if defined (VISIBLE_STATS)
+/* Non-zero means add an additional character to each filename displayed
+ during listing completion iff rl_filename_completion_desired which helps
+ to indicate the type of file being listed. */
+int rl_visible_stats = 0;
+#endif /* VISIBLE_STATS */
+
+/* If non-zero, then this is the address of a function to call when
+ completing on a directory name. The function is called with
+ the address of a string (the current directory name) as an arg. */
+rl_icppfunc_t *rl_directory_completion_hook = (rl_icppfunc_t *)NULL;
+
+rl_icppfunc_t *rl_directory_rewrite_hook = (rl_icppfunc_t *)NULL;
+
+/* Non-zero means readline completion functions perform tilde expansion. */
+int rl_complete_with_tilde_expansion = 0;
+
+/* Pointer to the generator function for completion_matches ().
+ NULL means to use rl_filename_completion_function (), the default filename
+ completer. */
+rl_compentry_func_t *rl_completion_entry_function = (rl_compentry_func_t *)NULL;
+
+/* Pointer to alternative function to create matches.
+ Function is called with TEXT, START, and END.
+ START and END are indices in RL_LINE_BUFFER saying what the boundaries
+ of TEXT are.
+ If this function exists and returns NULL then call the value of
+ rl_completion_entry_function to try to match, otherwise use the
+ array of strings returned. */
+rl_completion_func_t *rl_attempted_completion_function = (rl_completion_func_t *)NULL;
+
+/* Non-zero means to suppress normal filename completion after the
+ user-specified completion function has been called. */
+int rl_attempted_completion_over = 0;
+
+/* Set to a character indicating the type of completion being performed
+ by rl_complete_internal, available for use by application completion
+ functions. */
+int rl_completion_type = 0;
+
+/* Up to this many items will be displayed in response to a
+ possible-completions call. After that, we ask the user if
+ she is sure she wants to see them all. A negative value means
+ don't ask. */
+int rl_completion_query_items = 100;
+
+int _rl_page_completions = 1;
+
+/* The basic list of characters that signal a break between words for the
+ completer routine. The contents of this variable is what breaks words
+ in the shell, i.e. " \t\n\"\\'`@$><=" */
+const char *rl_basic_word_break_characters = " \t\n\"\\'`@$><=;|&{("; /* }) */
+
+/* List of basic quoting characters. */
+const char *rl_basic_quote_characters = "\"'";
+
+/* The list of characters that signal a break between words for
+ rl_complete_internal. The default list is the contents of
+ rl_basic_word_break_characters. */
+/*const*/ char *rl_completer_word_break_characters = (/*const*/ char *)NULL;
+
+/* Hook function to allow an application to set the completion word
+ break characters before readline breaks up the line. Allows
+ position-dependent word break characters. */
+rl_cpvfunc_t *rl_completion_word_break_hook = (rl_cpvfunc_t *)NULL;
+
+/* List of characters which can be used to quote a substring of the line.
+ Completion occurs on the entire substring, and within the substring
+ rl_completer_word_break_characters are treated as any other character,
+ unless they also appear within this list. */
+const char *rl_completer_quote_characters = (const char *)NULL;
+
+/* List of characters that should be quoted in filenames by the completer. */
+const char *rl_filename_quote_characters = (const char *)NULL;
+
+/* List of characters that are word break characters, but should be left
+ in TEXT when it is passed to the completion function. The shell uses
+ this to help determine what kind of completing to do. */
+const char *rl_special_prefixes = (const char *)NULL;
+
+/* If non-zero, then disallow duplicates in the matches. */
+int rl_ignore_completion_duplicates = 1;
+
+/* Non-zero means that the results of the matches are to be treated
+ as filenames. This is ALWAYS zero on entry, and can only be changed
+ within a completion entry finder function. */
+int rl_filename_completion_desired = 0;
+
+/* Non-zero means that the results of the matches are to be quoted using
+ double quotes (or an application-specific quoting mechanism) if the
+ filename contains any characters in rl_filename_quote_chars. This is
+ ALWAYS non-zero on entry, and can only be changed within a completion
+ entry finder function. */
+int rl_filename_quoting_desired = 1;
+
+/* This function, if defined, is called by the completer when real
+ filename completion is done, after all the matching names have been
+ generated. It is passed a (char**) known as matches in the code below.
+ It consists of a NULL-terminated array of pointers to potential
+ matching strings. The 1st element (matches[0]) is the maximal
+ substring that is common to all matches. This function can re-arrange
+ the list of matches as required, but all elements of the array must be
+ free()'d if they are deleted. The main intent of this function is
+ to implement FIGNORE a la SunOS csh. */
+rl_compignore_func_t *rl_ignore_some_completions_function = (rl_compignore_func_t *)NULL;
+
+/* Set to a function to quote a filename in an application-specific fashion.
+ Called with the text to quote, the type of match found (single or multiple)
+ and a pointer to the quoting character to be used, which the function can
+ reset if desired. */
+rl_quote_func_t *rl_filename_quoting_function = rl_quote_filename;
+
+/* Function to call to remove quoting characters from a filename. Called
+ before completion is attempted, so the embedded quotes do not interfere
+ with matching names in the file system. Readline doesn't do anything
+ with this; it's set only by applications. */
+rl_dequote_func_t *rl_filename_dequoting_function = (rl_dequote_func_t *)NULL;
+
+/* Function to call to decide whether or not a word break character is
+ quoted. If a character is quoted, it does not break words for the
+ completer. */
+rl_linebuf_func_t *rl_char_is_quoted_p = (rl_linebuf_func_t *)NULL;
+
+/* If non-zero, the completion functions don't append anything except a
+ possible closing quote. This is set to 0 by rl_complete_internal and
+ may be changed by an application-specific completion function. */
+int rl_completion_suppress_append = 0;
+
+/* Character appended to completed words when at the end of the line. The
+ default is a space. */
+int rl_completion_append_character = ' ';
+
+/* If non-zero, the completion functions don't append any closing quote.
+ This is set to 0 by rl_complete_internal and may be changed by an
+ application-specific completion function. */
+int rl_completion_suppress_quote = 0;
+
+/* Set to any quote character readline thinks it finds before any application
+ completion function is called. */
+int rl_completion_quote_character;
+
+/* Set to a non-zero value if readline found quoting anywhere in the word to
+ be completed; set before any application completion function is called. */
+int rl_completion_found_quote;
+
+/* If non-zero, a slash will be appended to completed filenames that are
+ symbolic links to directory names, subject to the value of the
+ mark-directories variable (which is user-settable). This exists so
+ that application completion functions can override the user's preference
+ (set via the mark-symlinked-directories variable) if appropriate.
+ It's set to the value of _rl_complete_mark_symlink_dirs in
+ rl_complete_internal before any application-specific completion
+ function is called, so without that function doing anything, the user's
+ preferences are honored. */
+int rl_completion_mark_symlink_dirs;
+
+/* If non-zero, inhibit completion (temporarily). */
+int rl_inhibit_completion;
+
+/* Variables local to this file. */
+
+/* Local variable states what happened during the last completion attempt. */
+static int completion_changed_buffer;
+
+/*************************************/
+/* */
+/* Bindable completion functions */
+/* */
+/*************************************/
+
+/* Complete the word at or before point. You have supplied the function
+ that does the initial simple matching selection algorithm (see
+ rl_completion_matches ()). The default is to do filename completion. */
+int
+rl_complete (ignore, invoking_key)
+ int ignore, invoking_key;
+{
+ if (rl_inhibit_completion)
+ return (_rl_insert_char (ignore, invoking_key));
+ else if (rl_last_func == rl_complete && !completion_changed_buffer)
+ return (rl_complete_internal ('?'));
+ else if (_rl_complete_show_all)
+ return (rl_complete_internal ('!'));
+ else if (_rl_complete_show_unmodified)
+ return (rl_complete_internal ('@'));
+ else
+ return (rl_complete_internal (TAB));
+}
+
+/* List the possible completions. See description of rl_complete (). */
+int
+rl_possible_completions (ignore, invoking_key)
+ int ignore, invoking_key;
+{
+ return (rl_complete_internal ('?'));
+}
+
+int
+rl_insert_completions (ignore, invoking_key)
+ int ignore, invoking_key;
+{
+ return (rl_complete_internal ('*'));
+}
+
+/* Return the correct value to pass to rl_complete_internal performing
+ the same tests as rl_complete. This allows consecutive calls to an
+ application's completion function to list possible completions and for
+ an application-specific completion function to honor the
+ show-all-if-ambiguous readline variable. */
+int
+rl_completion_mode (cfunc)
+ rl_command_func_t *cfunc;
+{
+ if (rl_last_func == cfunc && !completion_changed_buffer)
+ return '?';
+ else if (_rl_complete_show_all)
+ return '!';
+ else if (_rl_complete_show_unmodified)
+ return '@';
+ else
+ return TAB;
+}
+
+/************************************/
+/* */
+/* Completion utility functions */
+/* */
+/************************************/
+
+/* Set default values for readline word completion. These are the variables
+ that application completion functions can change or inspect. */
+static void
+set_completion_defaults (what_to_do)
+ int what_to_do;
+{
+ /* Only the completion entry function can change these. */
+ rl_filename_completion_desired = 0;
+ rl_filename_quoting_desired = 1;
+ rl_completion_type = what_to_do;
+ rl_completion_suppress_append = rl_completion_suppress_quote = 0;
+
+ /* The completion entry function may optionally change this. */
+ rl_completion_mark_symlink_dirs = _rl_complete_mark_symlink_dirs;
+}
+
+/* The user must press "y" or "n". Non-zero return means "y" pressed. */
+static int
+get_y_or_n (for_pager)
+ int for_pager;
+{
+ int c;
+
+ for (;;)
+ {
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+ c = rl_read_key ();
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+
+ if (c == 'y' || c == 'Y' || c == ' ')
+ return (1);
+ if (c == 'n' || c == 'N' || c == RUBOUT)
+ return (0);
+ if (c == ABORT_CHAR)
+ _rl_abort_internal ();
+ if (for_pager && (c == NEWLINE || c == RETURN))
+ return (2);
+ if (for_pager && (c == 'q' || c == 'Q'))
+ return (0);
+ rl_ding ();
+ }
+}
+
+static int
+_rl_internal_pager (lines)
+ int lines;
+{
+ int i;
+
+ fprintf (rl_outstream, "--More--");
+ fflush (rl_outstream);
+ i = get_y_or_n (1);
+ _rl_erase_entire_line ();
+ if (i == 0)
+ return -1;
+ else if (i == 2)
+ return (lines - 1);
+ else
+ return 0;
+}
+
+static int
+path_isdir (filename)
+ const char *filename;
+{
+ struct stat finfo;
+
+ return (stat (filename, &finfo) == 0 && S_ISDIR (finfo.st_mode));
+}
+
+#if defined (VISIBLE_STATS)
+/* Return the character which best describes FILENAME.
+ `@' for symbolic links
+ `/' for directories
+ `*' for executables
+ `=' for sockets
+ `|' for FIFOs
+ `%' for character special devices
+ `#' for block special devices */
+static int
+stat_char (filename)
+ char *filename;
+{
+ struct stat finfo;
+ int character, r;
+
+#if defined (HAVE_LSTAT) && defined (S_ISLNK)
+ r = lstat (filename, &finfo);
+#else
+ r = stat (filename, &finfo);
+#endif
+
+ if (r == -1)
+ return (0);
+
+ character = 0;
+ if (S_ISDIR (finfo.st_mode))
+ character = '/';
+#if defined (S_ISCHR)
+ else if (S_ISCHR (finfo.st_mode))
+ character = '%';
+#endif /* S_ISCHR */
+#if defined (S_ISBLK)
+ else if (S_ISBLK (finfo.st_mode))
+ character = '#';
+#endif /* S_ISBLK */
+#if defined (S_ISLNK)
+ else if (S_ISLNK (finfo.st_mode))
+ character = '@';
+#endif /* S_ISLNK */
+#if defined (S_ISSOCK)
+ else if (S_ISSOCK (finfo.st_mode))
+ character = '=';
+#endif /* S_ISSOCK */
+#if defined (S_ISFIFO)
+ else if (S_ISFIFO (finfo.st_mode))
+ character = '|';
+#endif
+ else if (S_ISREG (finfo.st_mode))
+ {
+ if (access (filename, X_OK) == 0)
+ character = '*';
+ }
+ return (character);
+}
+#endif /* VISIBLE_STATS */
+
+/* Return the portion of PATHNAME that should be output when listing
+ possible completions. If we are hacking filename completion, we
+ are only interested in the basename, the portion following the
+ final slash. Otherwise, we return what we were passed. Since
+ printing empty strings is not very informative, if we're doing
+ filename completion, and the basename is the empty string, we look
+ for the previous slash and return the portion following that. If
+ there's no previous slash, we just return what we were passed. */
+static char *
+printable_part (pathname)
+ char *pathname;
+{
+ char *temp, *x;
+
+ if (rl_filename_completion_desired == 0) /* don't need to do anything */
+ return (pathname);
+
+ temp = strrchr (pathname, '/');
+#if defined (__MSDOS__)
+ if (temp == 0 && ISALPHA ((unsigned char)pathname[0]) && pathname[1] == ':')
+ temp = pathname + 1;
+#endif
+
+ if (temp == 0 || *temp == '\0')
+ return (pathname);
+ /* If the basename is NULL, we might have a pathname like '/usr/src/'.
+ Look for a previous slash and, if one is found, return the portion
+ following that slash. If there's no previous slash, just return the
+ pathname we were passed. */
+ else if (temp[1] == '\0')
+ {
+ for (x = temp - 1; x > pathname; x--)
+ if (*x == '/')
+ break;
+ return ((*x == '/') ? x + 1 : pathname);
+ }
+ else
+ return ++temp;
+}
+
+/* Compute width of STRING when displayed on screen by print_filename */
+static int
+fnwidth (string)
+ const char *string;
+{
+ int width, pos;
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ mbstate_t ps;
+ int left, w;
+ size_t clen;
+ wchar_t wc;
+
+ left = strlen (string) + 1;
+ memset (&ps, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+#endif
+
+ width = pos = 0;
+ while (string[pos])
+ {
+ if (CTRL_CHAR (*string) || *string == RUBOUT)
+ {
+ width += 2;
+ pos++;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ clen = mbrtowc (&wc, string + pos, left - pos, &ps);
+ if (MB_INVALIDCH (clen))
+ {
+ width++;
+ pos++;
+ memset (&ps, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+ }
+ else if (MB_NULLWCH (clen))
+ break;
+ else
+ {
+ pos += clen;
+ w = wcwidth (wc);
+ width += (w >= 0) ? w : 1;
+ }
+#else
+ width++;
+ pos++;
+#endif
+ }
+ }
+
+ return width;
+}
+
+static int
+fnprint (to_print)
+ const char *to_print;
+{
+ int printed_len;
+ const char *s;
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ mbstate_t ps;
+ const char *end;
+ size_t tlen;
+ int width, w;
+ wchar_t wc;
+
+ end = to_print + strlen (to_print) + 1;
+ memset (&ps, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+#endif
+
+ printed_len = 0;
+ s = to_print;
+ while (*s)
+ {
+ if (CTRL_CHAR (*s))
+ {
+ putc ('^', rl_outstream);
+ putc (UNCTRL (*s), rl_outstream);
+ printed_len += 2;
+ s++;
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ memset (&ps, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+#endif
+ }
+ else if (*s == RUBOUT)
+ {
+ putc ('^', rl_outstream);
+ putc ('?', rl_outstream);
+ printed_len += 2;
+ s++;
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ memset (&ps, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+#endif
+ }
+ else
+ {
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ tlen = mbrtowc (&wc, s, end - s, &ps);
+ if (MB_INVALIDCH (tlen))
+ {
+ tlen = 1;
+ width = 1;
+ memset (&ps, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+ }
+ else if (MB_NULLWCH (tlen))
+ break;
+ else
+ {
+ w = wcwidth (wc);
+ width = (w >= 0) ? w : 1;
+ }
+ fwrite (s, 1, tlen, rl_outstream);
+ s += tlen;
+ printed_len += width;
+#else
+ putc (*s, rl_outstream);
+ s++;
+ printed_len++;
+#endif
+ }
+ }
+
+ return printed_len;
+}
+
+/* Output TO_PRINT to rl_outstream. If VISIBLE_STATS is defined and we
+ are using it, check for and output a single character for `special'
+ filenames. Return the number of characters we output. */
+
+static int
+print_filename (to_print, full_pathname)
+ char *to_print, *full_pathname;
+{
+ int printed_len, extension_char, slen, tlen;
+ char *s, c, *new_full_pathname, *dn;
+
+ extension_char = 0;
+ printed_len = fnprint (to_print);
+
+#if defined (VISIBLE_STATS)
+ if (rl_filename_completion_desired && (rl_visible_stats || _rl_complete_mark_directories))
+#else
+ if (rl_filename_completion_desired && _rl_complete_mark_directories)
+#endif
+ {
+ /* If to_print != full_pathname, to_print is the basename of the
+ path passed. In this case, we try to expand the directory
+ name before checking for the stat character. */
+ if (to_print != full_pathname)
+ {
+ /* Terminate the directory name. */
+ c = to_print[-1];
+ to_print[-1] = '\0';
+
+ /* If setting the last slash in full_pathname to a NUL results in
+ full_pathname being the empty string, we are trying to complete
+ files in the root directory. If we pass a null string to the
+ bash directory completion hook, for example, it will expand it
+ to the current directory. We just want the `/'. */
+ if (full_pathname == 0 || *full_pathname == 0)
+ dn = "/";
+ else if (full_pathname[0] != '/')
+ dn = full_pathname;
+ else if (full_pathname[1] == 0)
+ dn = "//"; /* restore trailing slash to `//' */
+ else if (full_pathname[1] == '/' && full_pathname[2] == 0)
+ dn = "/"; /* don't turn /// into // */
+ else
+ dn = full_pathname;
+ s = tilde_expand (dn);
+ if (rl_directory_completion_hook)
+ (*rl_directory_completion_hook) (&s);
+
+ slen = strlen (s);
+ tlen = strlen (to_print);
+ new_full_pathname = (char *)xmalloc (slen + tlen + 2);
+ strcpy (new_full_pathname, s);
+ if (s[slen - 1] == '/')
+ slen--;
+ else
+ new_full_pathname[slen] = '/';
+ new_full_pathname[slen] = '/';
+ strcpy (new_full_pathname + slen + 1, to_print);
+
+#if defined (VISIBLE_STATS)
+ if (rl_visible_stats)
+ extension_char = stat_char (new_full_pathname);
+ else
+#endif
+ if (path_isdir (new_full_pathname))
+ extension_char = '/';
+
+ free (new_full_pathname);
+ to_print[-1] = c;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ s = tilde_expand (full_pathname);
+#if defined (VISIBLE_STATS)
+ if (rl_visible_stats)
+ extension_char = stat_char (s);
+ else
+#endif
+ if (path_isdir (s))
+ extension_char = '/';
+ }
+
+ free (s);
+ if (extension_char)
+ {
+ putc (extension_char, rl_outstream);
+ printed_len++;
+ }
+ }
+
+ return printed_len;
+}
+
+static char *
+rl_quote_filename (s, rtype, qcp)
+ char *s;
+ int rtype;
+ char *qcp;
+{
+ char *r;
+
+ r = (char *)xmalloc (strlen (s) + 2);
+ *r = *rl_completer_quote_characters;
+ strcpy (r + 1, s);
+ if (qcp)
+ *qcp = *rl_completer_quote_characters;
+ return r;
+}
+
+/* Find the bounds of the current word for completion purposes, and leave
+ rl_point set to the end of the word. This function skips quoted
+ substrings (characters between matched pairs of characters in
+ rl_completer_quote_characters). First we try to find an unclosed
+ quoted substring on which to do matching. If one is not found, we use
+ the word break characters to find the boundaries of the current word.
+ We call an application-specific function to decide whether or not a
+ particular word break character is quoted; if that function returns a
+ non-zero result, the character does not break a word. This function
+ returns the opening quote character if we found an unclosed quoted
+ substring, '\0' otherwise. FP, if non-null, is set to a value saying
+ which (shell-like) quote characters we found (single quote, double
+ quote, or backslash) anywhere in the string. DP, if non-null, is set to
+ the value of the delimiter character that caused a word break. */
+
+char
+_rl_find_completion_word (fp, dp)
+ int *fp, *dp;
+{
+ int scan, end, found_quote, delimiter, pass_next, isbrk;
+ char quote_char, *brkchars;
+
+ end = rl_point;
+ found_quote = delimiter = 0;
+ quote_char = '\0';
+
+ brkchars = 0;
+ if (rl_completion_word_break_hook)
+ brkchars = (*rl_completion_word_break_hook) ();
+ if (brkchars == 0)
+ brkchars = rl_completer_word_break_characters;
+
+ if (rl_completer_quote_characters)
+ {
+ /* We have a list of characters which can be used in pairs to
+ quote substrings for the completer. Try to find the start
+ of an unclosed quoted substring. */
+ /* FOUND_QUOTE is set so we know what kind of quotes we found. */
+ for (scan = pass_next = 0; scan < end; scan = MB_NEXTCHAR (rl_line_buffer, scan, 1, MB_FIND_ANY))
+ {
+ if (pass_next)
+ {
+ pass_next = 0;
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /* Shell-like semantics for single quotes -- don't allow backslash
+ to quote anything in single quotes, especially not the closing
+ quote. If you don't like this, take out the check on the value
+ of quote_char. */
+ if (quote_char != '\'' && rl_line_buffer[scan] == '\\')
+ {
+ pass_next = 1;
+ found_quote |= RL_QF_BACKSLASH;
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ if (quote_char != '\0')
+ {
+ /* Ignore everything until the matching close quote char. */
+ if (rl_line_buffer[scan] == quote_char)
+ {
+ /* Found matching close. Abandon this substring. */
+ quote_char = '\0';
+ rl_point = end;
+ }
+ }
+ else if (strchr (rl_completer_quote_characters, rl_line_buffer[scan]))
+ {
+ /* Found start of a quoted substring. */
+ quote_char = rl_line_buffer[scan];
+ rl_point = scan + 1;
+ /* Shell-like quoting conventions. */
+ if (quote_char == '\'')
+ found_quote |= RL_QF_SINGLE_QUOTE;
+ else if (quote_char == '"')
+ found_quote |= RL_QF_DOUBLE_QUOTE;
+ else
+ found_quote |= RL_QF_OTHER_QUOTE;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (rl_point == end && quote_char == '\0')
+ {
+ /* We didn't find an unclosed quoted substring upon which to do
+ completion, so use the word break characters to find the
+ substring on which to complete. */
+ while (rl_point = MB_PREVCHAR (rl_line_buffer, rl_point, MB_FIND_ANY))
+ {
+ scan = rl_line_buffer[rl_point];
+
+ if (strchr (brkchars, scan) == 0)
+ continue;
+
+ /* Call the application-specific function to tell us whether
+ this word break character is quoted and should be skipped. */
+ if (rl_char_is_quoted_p && found_quote &&
+ (*rl_char_is_quoted_p) (rl_line_buffer, rl_point))
+ continue;
+
+ /* Convoluted code, but it avoids an n^2 algorithm with calls
+ to char_is_quoted. */
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* If we are at an unquoted word break, then advance past it. */
+ scan = rl_line_buffer[rl_point];
+
+ /* If there is an application-specific function to say whether or not
+ a character is quoted and we found a quote character, let that
+ function decide whether or not a character is a word break, even
+ if it is found in rl_completer_word_break_characters. Don't bother
+ if we're at the end of the line, though. */
+ if (scan)
+ {
+ if (rl_char_is_quoted_p)
+ isbrk = (found_quote == 0 ||
+ (*rl_char_is_quoted_p) (rl_line_buffer, rl_point) == 0) &&
+ strchr (brkchars, scan) != 0;
+ else
+ isbrk = strchr (brkchars, scan) != 0;
+
+ if (isbrk)
+ {
+ /* If the character that caused the word break was a quoting
+ character, then remember it as the delimiter. */
+ if (rl_basic_quote_characters &&
+ strchr (rl_basic_quote_characters, scan) &&
+ (end - rl_point) > 1)
+ delimiter = scan;
+
+ /* If the character isn't needed to determine something special
+ about what kind of completion to perform, then advance past it. */
+ if (rl_special_prefixes == 0 || strchr (rl_special_prefixes, scan) == 0)
+ rl_point++;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (fp)
+ *fp = found_quote;
+ if (dp)
+ *dp = delimiter;
+
+ return (quote_char);
+}
+
+static char **
+gen_completion_matches (text, start, end, our_func, found_quote, quote_char)
+ char *text;
+ int start, end;
+ rl_compentry_func_t *our_func;
+ int found_quote, quote_char;
+{
+ char **matches, *temp;
+
+ rl_completion_found_quote = found_quote;
+ rl_completion_quote_character = quote_char;
+
+ /* If the user wants to TRY to complete, but then wants to give
+ up and use the default completion function, they set the
+ variable rl_attempted_completion_function. */
+ if (rl_attempted_completion_function)
+ {
+ matches = (*rl_attempted_completion_function) (text, start, end);
+
+ if (matches || rl_attempted_completion_over)
+ {
+ rl_attempted_completion_over = 0;
+ return (matches);
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Beware -- we're stripping the quotes here. Do this only if we know
+ we are doing filename completion and the application has defined a
+ filename dequoting function. */
+ temp = (char *)NULL;
+
+ if (found_quote && our_func == rl_filename_completion_function &&
+ rl_filename_dequoting_function)
+ {
+ /* delete single and double quotes */
+ temp = (*rl_filename_dequoting_function) (text, quote_char);
+ text = temp; /* not freeing text is not a memory leak */
+ }
+
+ matches = rl_completion_matches (text, our_func);
+ FREE (temp);
+ return matches;
+}
+
+/* Filter out duplicates in MATCHES. This frees up the strings in
+ MATCHES. */
+static char **
+remove_duplicate_matches (matches)
+ char **matches;
+{
+ char *lowest_common;
+ int i, j, newlen;
+ char dead_slot;
+ char **temp_array;
+
+ /* Sort the items. */
+ for (i = 0; matches[i]; i++)
+ ;
+
+ /* Sort the array without matches[0], since we need it to
+ stay in place no matter what. */
+ if (i)
+ qsort (matches+1, i-1, sizeof (char *), (QSFUNC *)_rl_qsort_string_compare);
+
+ /* Remember the lowest common denominator for it may be unique. */
+ lowest_common = savestring (matches[0]);
+
+ for (i = newlen = 0; matches[i + 1]; i++)
+ {
+ if (strcmp (matches[i], matches[i + 1]) == 0)
+ {
+ free (matches[i]);
+ matches[i] = (char *)&dead_slot;
+ }
+ else
+ newlen++;
+ }
+
+ /* We have marked all the dead slots with (char *)&dead_slot.
+ Copy all the non-dead entries into a new array. */
+ temp_array = (char **)xmalloc ((3 + newlen) * sizeof (char *));
+ for (i = j = 1; matches[i]; i++)
+ {
+ if (matches[i] != (char *)&dead_slot)
+ temp_array[j++] = matches[i];
+ }
+ temp_array[j] = (char *)NULL;
+
+ if (matches[0] != (char *)&dead_slot)
+ free (matches[0]);
+
+ /* Place the lowest common denominator back in [0]. */
+ temp_array[0] = lowest_common;
+
+ /* If there is one string left, and it is identical to the
+ lowest common denominator, then the LCD is the string to
+ insert. */
+ if (j == 2 && strcmp (temp_array[0], temp_array[1]) == 0)
+ {
+ free (temp_array[1]);
+ temp_array[1] = (char *)NULL;
+ }
+ return (temp_array);
+}
+
+/* Find the common prefix of the list of matches, and put it into
+ matches[0]. */
+static int
+compute_lcd_of_matches (match_list, matches, text)
+ char **match_list;
+ int matches;
+ const char *text;
+{
+ register int i, c1, c2, si;
+ int low; /* Count of max-matched characters. */
+ char *dtext; /* dequoted TEXT, if needed */
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ int v;
+ mbstate_t ps1, ps2;
+ wchar_t wc1, wc2;
+#endif
+
+ /* If only one match, just use that. Otherwise, compare each
+ member of the list with the next, finding out where they
+ stop matching. */
+ if (matches == 1)
+ {
+ match_list[0] = match_list[1];
+ match_list[1] = (char *)NULL;
+ return 1;
+ }
+
+ for (i = 1, low = 100000; i < matches; i++)
+ {
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ {
+ memset (&ps1, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+ memset (&ps2, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+ }
+#endif
+ if (_rl_completion_case_fold)
+ {
+ for (si = 0;
+ (c1 = _rl_to_lower(match_list[i][si])) &&
+ (c2 = _rl_to_lower(match_list[i + 1][si]));
+ si++)
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ {
+ v = mbrtowc (&wc1, match_list[i]+si, strlen (match_list[i]+si), &ps1);
+ mbrtowc (&wc2, match_list[i+1]+si, strlen (match_list[i+1]+si), &ps2);
+ wc1 = towlower (wc1);
+ wc2 = towlower (wc2);
+ if (wc1 != wc2)
+ break;
+ else if (v > 1)
+ si += v - 1;
+ }
+ else
+#endif
+ if (c1 != c2)
+ break;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ for (si = 0;
+ (c1 = match_list[i][si]) &&
+ (c2 = match_list[i + 1][si]);
+ si++)
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ {
+ mbstate_t ps_back = ps1;
+ if (!_rl_compare_chars (match_list[i], si, &ps1, match_list[i+1], si, &ps2))
+ break;
+ else if ((v = _rl_get_char_len (&match_list[i][si], &ps_back)) > 1)
+ si += v - 1;
+ }
+ else
+#endif
+ if (c1 != c2)
+ break;
+ }
+
+ if (low > si)
+ low = si;
+ }
+
+ /* If there were multiple matches, but none matched up to even the
+ first character, and the user typed something, use that as the
+ value of matches[0]. */
+ if (low == 0 && text && *text)
+ {
+ match_list[0] = (char *)xmalloc (strlen (text) + 1);
+ strcpy (match_list[0], text);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ match_list[0] = (char *)xmalloc (low + 1);
+
+ /* XXX - this might need changes in the presence of multibyte chars */
+
+ /* If we are ignoring case, try to preserve the case of the string
+ the user typed in the face of multiple matches differing in case. */
+ if (_rl_completion_case_fold)
+ {
+ /* We're making an assumption here:
+ IF we're completing filenames AND
+ the application has defined a filename dequoting function AND
+ we found a quote character AND
+ the application has requested filename quoting
+ THEN
+ we assume that TEXT was dequoted before checking against
+ the file system and needs to be dequoted here before we
+ check against the list of matches
+ FI */
+ dtext = (char *)NULL;
+ if (rl_filename_completion_desired &&
+ rl_filename_dequoting_function &&
+ rl_completion_found_quote &&
+ rl_filename_quoting_desired)
+ {
+ dtext = (*rl_filename_dequoting_function) ((char *)text, rl_completion_quote_character);
+ text = dtext;
+ }
+
+ /* sort the list to get consistent answers. */
+ qsort (match_list+1, matches, sizeof(char *), (QSFUNC *)_rl_qsort_string_compare);
+
+ si = strlen (text);
+ if (si <= low)
+ {
+ for (i = 1; i <= matches; i++)
+ if (strncmp (match_list[i], text, si) == 0)
+ {
+ strncpy (match_list[0], match_list[i], low);
+ break;
+ }
+ /* no casematch, use first entry */
+ if (i > matches)
+ strncpy (match_list[0], match_list[1], low);
+ }
+ else
+ /* otherwise, just use the text the user typed. */
+ strncpy (match_list[0], text, low);
+
+ FREE (dtext);
+ }
+ else
+ strncpy (match_list[0], match_list[1], low);
+
+ match_list[0][low] = '\0';
+ }
+
+ return matches;
+}
+
+static int
+postprocess_matches (matchesp, matching_filenames)
+ char ***matchesp;
+ int matching_filenames;
+{
+ char *t, **matches, **temp_matches;
+ int nmatch, i;
+
+ matches = *matchesp;
+
+ if (matches == 0)
+ return 0;
+
+ /* It seems to me that in all the cases we handle we would like
+ to ignore duplicate possiblilities. Scan for the text to
+ insert being identical to the other completions. */
+ if (rl_ignore_completion_duplicates)
+ {
+ temp_matches = remove_duplicate_matches (matches);
+ free (matches);
+ matches = temp_matches;
+ }
+
+ /* If we are matching filenames, then here is our chance to
+ do clever processing by re-examining the list. Call the
+ ignore function with the array as a parameter. It can
+ munge the array, deleting matches as it desires. */
+ if (rl_ignore_some_completions_function && matching_filenames)
+ {
+ for (nmatch = 1; matches[nmatch]; nmatch++)
+ ;
+ (void)(*rl_ignore_some_completions_function) (matches);
+ if (matches == 0 || matches[0] == 0)
+ {
+ FREE (matches);
+ *matchesp = (char **)0;
+ return 0;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* If we removed some matches, recompute the common prefix. */
+ for (i = 1; matches[i]; i++)
+ ;
+ if (i > 1 && i < nmatch)
+ {
+ t = matches[0];
+ compute_lcd_of_matches (matches, i - 1, t);
+ FREE (t);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ *matchesp = matches;
+ return (1);
+}
+
+/* A convenience function for displaying a list of strings in
+ columnar format on readline's output stream. MATCHES is the list
+ of strings, in argv format, LEN is the number of strings in MATCHES,
+ and MAX is the length of the longest string in MATCHES. */
+void
+rl_display_match_list (matches, len, max)
+ char **matches;
+ int len, max;
+{
+ int count, limit, printed_len, lines;
+ int i, j, k, l;
+ char *temp;
+
+ /* How many items of MAX length can we fit in the screen window? */
+ max += 2;
+ limit = _rl_screenwidth / max;
+ if (limit != 1 && (limit * max == _rl_screenwidth))
+ limit--;
+
+ /* Avoid a possible floating exception. If max > _rl_screenwidth,
+ limit will be 0 and a divide-by-zero fault will result. */
+ if (limit == 0)
+ limit = 1;
+
+ /* How many iterations of the printing loop? */
+ count = (len + (limit - 1)) / limit;
+
+ /* Watch out for special case. If LEN is less than LIMIT, then
+ just do the inner printing loop.
+ 0 < len <= limit implies count = 1. */
+
+ /* Sort the items if they are not already sorted. */
+ if (rl_ignore_completion_duplicates == 0)
+ qsort (matches + 1, len, sizeof (char *), (QSFUNC *)_rl_qsort_string_compare);
+
+ rl_crlf ();
+
+ lines = 0;
+ if (_rl_print_completions_horizontally == 0)
+ {
+ /* Print the sorted items, up-and-down alphabetically, like ls. */
+ for (i = 1; i <= count; i++)
+ {
+ for (j = 0, l = i; j < limit; j++)
+ {
+ if (l > len || matches[l] == 0)
+ break;
+ else
+ {
+ temp = printable_part (matches[l]);
+ printed_len = print_filename (temp, matches[l]);
+
+ if (j + 1 < limit)
+ for (k = 0; k < max - printed_len; k++)
+ putc (' ', rl_outstream);
+ }
+ l += count;
+ }
+ rl_crlf ();
+ lines++;
+ if (_rl_page_completions && lines >= (_rl_screenheight - 1) && i < count)
+ {
+ lines = _rl_internal_pager (lines);
+ if (lines < 0)
+ return;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Print the sorted items, across alphabetically, like ls -x. */
+ for (i = 1; matches[i]; i++)
+ {
+ temp = printable_part (matches[i]);
+ printed_len = print_filename (temp, matches[i]);
+ /* Have we reached the end of this line? */
+ if (matches[i+1])
+ {
+ if (i && (limit > 1) && (i % limit) == 0)
+ {
+ rl_crlf ();
+ lines++;
+ if (_rl_page_completions && lines >= _rl_screenheight - 1)
+ {
+ lines = _rl_internal_pager (lines);
+ if (lines < 0)
+ return;
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ for (k = 0; k < max - printed_len; k++)
+ putc (' ', rl_outstream);
+ }
+ }
+ rl_crlf ();
+ }
+}
+
+/* Display MATCHES, a list of matching filenames in argv format. This
+ handles the simple case -- a single match -- first. If there is more
+ than one match, we compute the number of strings in the list and the
+ length of the longest string, which will be needed by the display
+ function. If the application wants to handle displaying the list of
+ matches itself, it sets RL_COMPLETION_DISPLAY_MATCHES_HOOK to the
+ address of a function, and we just call it. If we're handling the
+ display ourselves, we just call rl_display_match_list. We also check
+ that the list of matches doesn't exceed the user-settable threshold,
+ and ask the user if he wants to see the list if there are more matches
+ than RL_COMPLETION_QUERY_ITEMS. */
+static void
+display_matches (matches)
+ char **matches;
+{
+ int len, max, i;
+ char *temp;
+
+ /* Move to the last visible line of a possibly-multiple-line command. */
+ _rl_move_vert (_rl_vis_botlin);
+
+ /* Handle simple case first. What if there is only one answer? */
+ if (matches[1] == 0)
+ {
+ temp = printable_part (matches[0]);
+ rl_crlf ();
+ print_filename (temp, matches[0]);
+ rl_crlf ();
+
+ rl_forced_update_display ();
+ rl_display_fixed = 1;
+
+ return;
+ }
+
+ /* There is more than one answer. Find out how many there are,
+ and find the maximum printed length of a single entry. */
+ for (max = 0, i = 1; matches[i]; i++)
+ {
+ temp = printable_part (matches[i]);
+ len = fnwidth (temp);
+
+ if (len > max)
+ max = len;
+ }
+
+ len = i - 1;
+
+ /* If the caller has defined a display hook, then call that now. */
+ if (rl_completion_display_matches_hook)
+ {
+ (*rl_completion_display_matches_hook) (matches, len, max);
+ return;
+ }
+
+ /* If there are many items, then ask the user if she really wants to
+ see them all. */
+ if (rl_completion_query_items > 0 && len >= rl_completion_query_items)
+ {
+ rl_crlf ();
+ fprintf (rl_outstream, "Display all %d possibilities? (y or n)", len);
+ fflush (rl_outstream);
+ if (get_y_or_n (0) == 0)
+ {
+ rl_crlf ();
+
+ rl_forced_update_display ();
+ rl_display_fixed = 1;
+
+ return;
+ }
+ }
+
+ rl_display_match_list (matches, len, max);
+
+ rl_forced_update_display ();
+ rl_display_fixed = 1;
+}
+
+static char *
+make_quoted_replacement (match, mtype, qc)
+ char *match;
+ int mtype;
+ char *qc; /* Pointer to quoting character, if any */
+{
+ int should_quote, do_replace;
+ char *replacement;
+
+ /* If we are doing completion on quoted substrings, and any matches
+ contain any of the completer_word_break_characters, then auto-
+ matically prepend the substring with a quote character (just pick
+ the first one from the list of such) if it does not already begin
+ with a quote string. FIXME: Need to remove any such automatically
+ inserted quote character when it no longer is necessary, such as
+ if we change the string we are completing on and the new set of
+ matches don't require a quoted substring. */
+ replacement = match;
+
+ should_quote = match && rl_completer_quote_characters &&
+ rl_filename_completion_desired &&
+ rl_filename_quoting_desired;
+
+ if (should_quote)
+ should_quote = should_quote && (!qc || !*qc ||
+ (rl_completer_quote_characters && strchr (rl_completer_quote_characters, *qc)));
+
+ if (should_quote)
+ {
+ /* If there is a single match, see if we need to quote it.
+ This also checks whether the common prefix of several
+ matches needs to be quoted. */
+ should_quote = rl_filename_quote_characters
+ ? (_rl_strpbrk (match, rl_filename_quote_characters) != 0)
+ : 0;
+
+ do_replace = should_quote ? mtype : NO_MATCH;
+ /* Quote the replacement, since we found an embedded
+ word break character in a potential match. */
+ if (do_replace != NO_MATCH && rl_filename_quoting_function)
+ replacement = (*rl_filename_quoting_function) (match, do_replace, qc);
+ }
+ return (replacement);
+}
+
+static void
+insert_match (match, start, mtype, qc)
+ char *match;
+ int start, mtype;
+ char *qc;
+{
+ char *replacement;
+ char oqc;
+
+ oqc = qc ? *qc : '\0';
+ replacement = make_quoted_replacement (match, mtype, qc);
+
+ /* Now insert the match. */
+ if (replacement)
+ {
+ /* Don't double an opening quote character. */
+ if (qc && *qc && start && rl_line_buffer[start - 1] == *qc &&
+ replacement[0] == *qc)
+ start--;
+ /* If make_quoted_replacement changed the quoting character, remove
+ the opening quote and insert the (fully-quoted) replacement. */
+ else if (qc && (*qc != oqc) && start && rl_line_buffer[start - 1] == oqc &&
+ replacement[0] != oqc)
+ start--;
+ _rl_replace_text (replacement, start, rl_point - 1);
+ if (replacement != match)
+ free (replacement);
+ }
+}
+
+/* Append any necessary closing quote and a separator character to the
+ just-inserted match. If the user has specified that directories
+ should be marked by a trailing `/', append one of those instead. The
+ default trailing character is a space. Returns the number of characters
+ appended. If NONTRIVIAL_MATCH is set, we test for a symlink (if the OS
+ has them) and don't add a suffix for a symlink to a directory. A
+ nontrivial match is one that actually adds to the word being completed.
+ The variable rl_completion_mark_symlink_dirs controls this behavior
+ (it's initially set to the what the user has chosen, indicated by the
+ value of _rl_complete_mark_symlink_dirs, but may be modified by an
+ application's completion function). */
+static int
+append_to_match (text, delimiter, quote_char, nontrivial_match)
+ char *text;
+ int delimiter, quote_char, nontrivial_match;
+{
+ char temp_string[4], *filename;
+ int temp_string_index, s;
+ struct stat finfo;
+
+ temp_string_index = 0;
+ if (quote_char && rl_point && rl_completion_suppress_quote == 0 &&
+ rl_line_buffer[rl_point - 1] != quote_char)
+ temp_string[temp_string_index++] = quote_char;
+
+ if (delimiter)
+ temp_string[temp_string_index++] = delimiter;
+ else if (rl_completion_suppress_append == 0 && rl_completion_append_character)
+ temp_string[temp_string_index++] = rl_completion_append_character;
+
+ temp_string[temp_string_index++] = '\0';
+
+ if (rl_filename_completion_desired)
+ {
+ filename = tilde_expand (text);
+ s = (nontrivial_match && rl_completion_mark_symlink_dirs == 0)
+ ? LSTAT (filename, &finfo)
+ : stat (filename, &finfo);
+ if (s == 0 && S_ISDIR (finfo.st_mode))
+ {
+ if (_rl_complete_mark_directories /* && rl_completion_suppress_append == 0 */)
+ {
+ /* This is clumsy. Avoid putting in a double slash if point
+ is at the end of the line and the previous character is a
+ slash. */
+ if (rl_point && rl_line_buffer[rl_point] == '\0' && rl_line_buffer[rl_point - 1] == '/')
+ ;
+ else if (rl_line_buffer[rl_point] != '/')
+ rl_insert_text ("/");
+ }
+ }
+#ifdef S_ISLNK
+ /* Don't add anything if the filename is a symlink and resolves to a
+ directory. */
+ else if (s == 0 && S_ISLNK (finfo.st_mode) &&
+ stat (filename, &finfo) == 0 && S_ISDIR (finfo.st_mode))
+ ;
+#endif
+ else
+ {
+ if (rl_point == rl_end && temp_string_index)
+ rl_insert_text (temp_string);
+ }
+ free (filename);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if (rl_point == rl_end && temp_string_index)
+ rl_insert_text (temp_string);
+ }
+
+ return (temp_string_index);
+}
+
+static void
+insert_all_matches (matches, point, qc)
+ char **matches;
+ int point;
+ char *qc;
+{
+ int i;
+ char *rp;
+
+ rl_begin_undo_group ();
+ /* remove any opening quote character; make_quoted_replacement will add
+ it back. */
+ if (qc && *qc && point && rl_line_buffer[point - 1] == *qc)
+ point--;
+ rl_delete_text (point, rl_point);
+ rl_point = point;
+
+ if (matches[1])
+ {
+ for (i = 1; matches[i]; i++)
+ {
+ rp = make_quoted_replacement (matches[i], SINGLE_MATCH, qc);
+ rl_insert_text (rp);
+ rl_insert_text (" ");
+ if (rp != matches[i])
+ free (rp);
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ rp = make_quoted_replacement (matches[0], SINGLE_MATCH, qc);
+ rl_insert_text (rp);
+ rl_insert_text (" ");
+ if (rp != matches[0])
+ free (rp);
+ }
+ rl_end_undo_group ();
+}
+
+void
+_rl_free_match_list (matches)
+ char **matches;
+{
+ register int i;
+
+ if (matches == 0)
+ return;
+
+ for (i = 0; matches[i]; i++)
+ free (matches[i]);
+ free (matches);
+}
+
+/* Complete the word at or before point.
+ WHAT_TO_DO says what to do with the completion.
+ `?' means list the possible completions.
+ TAB means do standard completion.
+ `*' means insert all of the possible completions.
+ `!' means to do standard completion, and list all possible completions if
+ there is more than one.
+ `@' means to do standard completion, and list all possible completions if
+ there is more than one and partial completion is not possible. */
+int
+rl_complete_internal (what_to_do)
+ int what_to_do;
+{
+ char **matches;
+ rl_compentry_func_t *our_func;
+ int start, end, delimiter, found_quote, i, nontrivial_lcd;
+ char *text, *saved_line_buffer;
+ char quote_char;
+
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_COMPLETING);
+
+ set_completion_defaults (what_to_do);
+
+ saved_line_buffer = rl_line_buffer ? savestring (rl_line_buffer) : (char *)NULL;
+ our_func = rl_completion_entry_function
+ ? rl_completion_entry_function
+ : rl_filename_completion_function;
+ /* We now look backwards for the start of a filename/variable word. */
+ end = rl_point;
+ found_quote = delimiter = 0;
+ quote_char = '\0';
+
+ if (rl_point)
+ /* This (possibly) changes rl_point. If it returns a non-zero char,
+ we know we have an open quote. */
+ quote_char = _rl_find_completion_word (&found_quote, &delimiter);
+
+ start = rl_point;
+ rl_point = end;
+
+ text = rl_copy_text (start, end);
+ matches = gen_completion_matches (text, start, end, our_func, found_quote, quote_char);
+ /* nontrivial_lcd is set if the common prefix adds something to the word
+ being completed. */
+ nontrivial_lcd = matches && strcmp (text, matches[0]) != 0;
+ free (text);
+
+ if (matches == 0)
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ FREE (saved_line_buffer);
+ completion_changed_buffer = 0;
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_COMPLETING);
+ return (0);
+ }
+
+ /* If we are matching filenames, the attempted completion function will
+ have set rl_filename_completion_desired to a non-zero value. The basic
+ rl_filename_completion_function does this. */
+ i = rl_filename_completion_desired;
+
+ if (postprocess_matches (&matches, i) == 0)
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ FREE (saved_line_buffer);
+ completion_changed_buffer = 0;
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_COMPLETING);
+ return (0);
+ }
+
+ switch (what_to_do)
+ {
+ case TAB:
+ case '!':
+ case '@':
+ /* Insert the first match with proper quoting. */
+ if (*matches[0])
+ insert_match (matches[0], start, matches[1] ? MULT_MATCH : SINGLE_MATCH, &quote_char);
+
+ /* If there are more matches, ring the bell to indicate.
+ If we are in vi mode, Posix.2 says to not ring the bell.
+ If the `show-all-if-ambiguous' variable is set, display
+ all the matches immediately. Otherwise, if this was the
+ only match, and we are hacking files, check the file to
+ see if it was a directory. If so, and the `mark-directories'
+ variable is set, add a '/' to the name. If not, and we
+ are at the end of the line, then add a space. */
+ if (matches[1])
+ {
+ if (what_to_do == '!')
+ {
+ display_matches (matches);
+ break;
+ }
+ else if (what_to_do == '@')
+ {
+ if (nontrivial_lcd == 0)
+ display_matches (matches);
+ break;
+ }
+ else if (rl_editing_mode != vi_mode)
+ rl_ding (); /* There are other matches remaining. */
+ }
+ else
+ append_to_match (matches[0], delimiter, quote_char, nontrivial_lcd);
+
+ break;
+
+ case '*':
+ insert_all_matches (matches, start, &quote_char);
+ break;
+
+ case '?':
+ display_matches (matches);
+ break;
+
+ default:
+ fprintf (stderr, "\r\nreadline: bad value %d for what_to_do in rl_complete\n", what_to_do);
+ rl_ding ();
+ FREE (saved_line_buffer);
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_COMPLETING);
+ return 1;
+ }
+
+ _rl_free_match_list (matches);
+
+ /* Check to see if the line has changed through all of this manipulation. */
+ if (saved_line_buffer)
+ {
+ completion_changed_buffer = strcmp (rl_line_buffer, saved_line_buffer) != 0;
+ free (saved_line_buffer);
+ }
+
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_COMPLETING);
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/***************************************************************/
+/* */
+/* Application-callable completion match generator functions */
+/* */
+/***************************************************************/
+
+/* Return an array of (char *) which is a list of completions for TEXT.
+ If there are no completions, return a NULL pointer.
+ The first entry in the returned array is the substitution for TEXT.
+ The remaining entries are the possible completions.
+ The array is terminated with a NULL pointer.
+
+ ENTRY_FUNCTION is a function of two args, and returns a (char *).
+ The first argument is TEXT.
+ The second is a state argument; it should be zero on the first call, and
+ non-zero on subsequent calls. It returns a NULL pointer to the caller
+ when there are no more matches.
+ */
+char **
+rl_completion_matches (text, entry_function)
+ const char *text;
+ rl_compentry_func_t *entry_function;
+{
+ /* Number of slots in match_list. */
+ int match_list_size;
+
+ /* The list of matches. */
+ char **match_list;
+
+ /* Number of matches actually found. */
+ int matches;
+
+ /* Temporary string binder. */
+ char *string;
+
+ matches = 0;
+ match_list_size = 10;
+ match_list = (char **)xmalloc ((match_list_size + 1) * sizeof (char *));
+ match_list[1] = (char *)NULL;
+
+ while (string = (*entry_function) (text, matches))
+ {
+ if (matches + 1 == match_list_size)
+ match_list = (char **)xrealloc
+ (match_list, ((match_list_size += 10) + 1) * sizeof (char *));
+
+ match_list[++matches] = string;
+ match_list[matches + 1] = (char *)NULL;
+ }
+
+ /* If there were any matches, then look through them finding out the
+ lowest common denominator. That then becomes match_list[0]. */
+ if (matches)
+ compute_lcd_of_matches (match_list, matches, text);
+ else /* There were no matches. */
+ {
+ free (match_list);
+ match_list = (char **)NULL;
+ }
+ return (match_list);
+}
+
+/* A completion function for usernames.
+ TEXT contains a partial username preceded by a random
+ character (usually `~'). */
+char *
+rl_username_completion_function (text, state)
+ const char *text;
+ int state;
+{
+#if defined (__WIN32__) || defined (__OPENNT)
+ return (char *)NULL;
+#else /* !__WIN32__ && !__OPENNT) */
+ static char *username = (char *)NULL;
+ static struct passwd *entry;
+ static int namelen, first_char, first_char_loc;
+ char *value;
+
+ if (state == 0)
+ {
+ FREE (username);
+
+ first_char = *text;
+ first_char_loc = first_char == '~';
+
+ username = savestring (&text[first_char_loc]);
+ namelen = strlen (username);
+ setpwent ();
+ }
+
+#if defined (HAVE_GETPWENT)
+ while (entry = getpwent ())
+ {
+ /* Null usernames should result in all users as possible completions. */
+ if (namelen == 0 || (STREQN (username, entry->pw_name, namelen)))
+ break;
+ }
+#endif
+
+ if (entry == 0)
+ {
+#if defined (HAVE_GETPWENT)
+ endpwent ();
+#endif
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ value = (char *)xmalloc (2 + strlen (entry->pw_name));
+
+ *value = *text;
+
+ strcpy (value + first_char_loc, entry->pw_name);
+
+ if (first_char == '~')
+ rl_filename_completion_desired = 1;
+
+ return (value);
+ }
+#endif /* !__WIN32__ && !__OPENNT */
+}
+
+/* Okay, now we write the entry_function for filename completion. In the
+ general case. Note that completion in the shell is a little different
+ because of all the pathnames that must be followed when looking up the
+ completion for a command. */
+char *
+rl_filename_completion_function (text, state)
+ const char *text;
+ int state;
+{
+ static DIR *directory = (DIR *)NULL;
+ static char *filename = (char *)NULL;
+ static char *dirname = (char *)NULL;
+ static char *users_dirname = (char *)NULL;
+ static int filename_len;
+ char *temp;
+ int dirlen;
+ struct dirent *entry;
+
+ /* If we don't have any state, then do some initialization. */
+ if (state == 0)
+ {
+ /* If we were interrupted before closing the directory or reading
+ all of its contents, close it. */
+ if (directory)
+ {
+ closedir (directory);
+ directory = (DIR *)NULL;
+ }
+ FREE (dirname);
+ FREE (filename);
+ FREE (users_dirname);
+
+ filename = savestring (text);
+ if (*text == 0)
+ text = ".";
+ dirname = savestring (text);
+
+ temp = strrchr (dirname, '/');
+
+#if defined (__MSDOS__)
+ /* special hack for //X/... */
+ if (dirname[0] == '/' && dirname[1] == '/' && ISALPHA ((unsigned char)dirname[2]) && dirname[3] == '/')
+ temp = strrchr (dirname + 3, '/');
+#endif
+
+ if (temp)
+ {
+ strcpy (filename, ++temp);
+ *temp = '\0';
+ }
+#if defined (__MSDOS__)
+ /* searches from current directory on the drive */
+ else if (ISALPHA ((unsigned char)dirname[0]) && dirname[1] == ':')
+ {
+ strcpy (filename, dirname + 2);
+ dirname[2] = '\0';
+ }
+#endif
+ else
+ {
+ dirname[0] = '.';
+ dirname[1] = '\0';
+ }
+
+ /* We aren't done yet. We also support the "~user" syntax. */
+
+ /* Save the version of the directory that the user typed. */
+ users_dirname = savestring (dirname);
+
+ if (*dirname == '~')
+ {
+ temp = tilde_expand (dirname);
+ free (dirname);
+ dirname = temp;
+ }
+
+ if (rl_directory_rewrite_hook)
+ (*rl_directory_rewrite_hook) (&dirname);
+
+ if (rl_directory_completion_hook && (*rl_directory_completion_hook) (&dirname))
+ {
+ free (users_dirname);
+ users_dirname = savestring (dirname);
+ }
+
+ directory = opendir (dirname);
+ filename_len = strlen (filename);
+
+ rl_filename_completion_desired = 1;
+ }
+
+ /* At this point we should entertain the possibility of hacking wildcarded
+ filenames, like /usr/man/man<WILD>/te<TAB>. If the directory name
+ contains globbing characters, then build an array of directories, and
+ then map over that list while completing. */
+ /* *** UNIMPLEMENTED *** */
+
+ /* Now that we have some state, we can read the directory. */
+
+ entry = (struct dirent *)NULL;
+ while (directory && (entry = readdir (directory)))
+ {
+ /* Special case for no filename. If the user has disabled the
+ `match-hidden-files' variable, skip filenames beginning with `.'.
+ All other entries except "." and ".." match. */
+ if (filename_len == 0)
+ {
+ if (_rl_match_hidden_files == 0 && HIDDEN_FILE (entry->d_name))
+ continue;
+
+ if (entry->d_name[0] != '.' ||
+ (entry->d_name[1] &&
+ (entry->d_name[1] != '.' || entry->d_name[2])))
+ break;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Otherwise, if these match up to the length of filename, then
+ it is a match. */
+ if (_rl_completion_case_fold)
+ {
+ if ((_rl_to_lower (entry->d_name[0]) == _rl_to_lower (filename[0])) &&
+ (((int)D_NAMLEN (entry)) >= filename_len) &&
+ (_rl_strnicmp (filename, entry->d_name, filename_len) == 0))
+ break;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if ((entry->d_name[0] == filename[0]) &&
+ (((int)D_NAMLEN (entry)) >= filename_len) &&
+ (strncmp (filename, entry->d_name, filename_len) == 0))
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (entry == 0)
+ {
+ if (directory)
+ {
+ closedir (directory);
+ directory = (DIR *)NULL;
+ }
+ if (dirname)
+ {
+ free (dirname);
+ dirname = (char *)NULL;
+ }
+ if (filename)
+ {
+ free (filename);
+ filename = (char *)NULL;
+ }
+ if (users_dirname)
+ {
+ free (users_dirname);
+ users_dirname = (char *)NULL;
+ }
+
+ return (char *)NULL;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* dirname && (strcmp (dirname, ".") != 0) */
+ if (dirname && (dirname[0] != '.' || dirname[1]))
+ {
+ if (rl_complete_with_tilde_expansion && *users_dirname == '~')
+ {
+ dirlen = strlen (dirname);
+ temp = (char *)xmalloc (2 + dirlen + D_NAMLEN (entry));
+ strcpy (temp, dirname);
+ /* Canonicalization cuts off any final slash present. We
+ may need to add it back. */
+ if (dirname[dirlen - 1] != '/')
+ {
+ temp[dirlen++] = '/';
+ temp[dirlen] = '\0';
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ dirlen = strlen (users_dirname);
+ temp = (char *)xmalloc (2 + dirlen + D_NAMLEN (entry));
+ strcpy (temp, users_dirname);
+ /* Make sure that temp has a trailing slash here. */
+ if (users_dirname[dirlen - 1] != '/')
+ temp[dirlen++] = '/';
+ }
+
+ strcpy (temp + dirlen, entry->d_name);
+ }
+ else
+ temp = savestring (entry->d_name);
+
+ return (temp);
+ }
+}
+
+/* An initial implementation of a menu completion function a la tcsh. The
+ first time (if the last readline command was not rl_menu_complete), we
+ generate the list of matches. This code is very similar to the code in
+ rl_complete_internal -- there should be a way to combine the two. Then,
+ for each item in the list of matches, we insert the match in an undoable
+ fashion, with the appropriate character appended (this happens on the
+ second and subsequent consecutive calls to rl_menu_complete). When we
+ hit the end of the match list, we restore the original unmatched text,
+ ring the bell, and reset the counter to zero. */
+int
+rl_menu_complete (count, ignore)
+ int count, ignore;
+{
+ rl_compentry_func_t *our_func;
+ int matching_filenames, found_quote;
+
+ static char *orig_text;
+ static char **matches = (char **)0;
+ static int match_list_index = 0;
+ static int match_list_size = 0;
+ static int orig_start, orig_end;
+ static char quote_char;
+ static int delimiter;
+
+ /* The first time through, we generate the list of matches and set things
+ up to insert them. */
+ if (rl_last_func != rl_menu_complete)
+ {
+ /* Clean up from previous call, if any. */
+ FREE (orig_text);
+ if (matches)
+ _rl_free_match_list (matches);
+
+ match_list_index = match_list_size = 0;
+ matches = (char **)NULL;
+
+ /* Only the completion entry function can change these. */
+ set_completion_defaults ('%');
+
+ our_func = rl_completion_entry_function
+ ? rl_completion_entry_function
+ : rl_filename_completion_function;
+
+ /* We now look backwards for the start of a filename/variable word. */
+ orig_end = rl_point;
+ found_quote = delimiter = 0;
+ quote_char = '\0';
+
+ if (rl_point)
+ /* This (possibly) changes rl_point. If it returns a non-zero char,
+ we know we have an open quote. */
+ quote_char = _rl_find_completion_word (&found_quote, &delimiter);
+
+ orig_start = rl_point;
+ rl_point = orig_end;
+
+ orig_text = rl_copy_text (orig_start, orig_end);
+ matches = gen_completion_matches (orig_text, orig_start, orig_end,
+ our_func, found_quote, quote_char);
+
+ /* If we are matching filenames, the attempted completion function will
+ have set rl_filename_completion_desired to a non-zero value. The basic
+ rl_filename_completion_function does this. */
+ matching_filenames = rl_filename_completion_desired;
+
+ if (matches == 0 || postprocess_matches (&matches, matching_filenames) == 0)
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ FREE (matches);
+ matches = (char **)0;
+ FREE (orig_text);
+ orig_text = (char *)0;
+ completion_changed_buffer = 0;
+ return (0);
+ }
+
+ for (match_list_size = 0; matches[match_list_size]; match_list_size++)
+ ;
+ /* matches[0] is lcd if match_list_size > 1, but the circular buffer
+ code below should take care of it. */
+ }
+
+ /* Now we have the list of matches. Replace the text between
+ rl_line_buffer[orig_start] and rl_line_buffer[rl_point] with
+ matches[match_list_index], and add any necessary closing char. */
+
+ if (matches == 0 || match_list_size == 0)
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ FREE (matches);
+ matches = (char **)0;
+ completion_changed_buffer = 0;
+ return (0);
+ }
+
+ match_list_index += count;
+ if (match_list_index < 0)
+ match_list_index += match_list_size;
+ else
+ match_list_index %= match_list_size;
+
+ if (match_list_index == 0 && match_list_size > 1)
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ insert_match (orig_text, orig_start, MULT_MATCH, &quote_char);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ insert_match (matches[match_list_index], orig_start, SINGLE_MATCH, &quote_char);
+ append_to_match (matches[match_list_index], delimiter, quote_char,
+ strcmp (orig_text, matches[match_list_index]));
+ }
+
+ completion_changed_buffer = 1;
+ return (0);
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/display.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/display.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b22521b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/display.c
@@ -0,0 +1,2379 @@
+/* display.c -- readline redisplay facility. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1987-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif /* HAVE_UNISTD_H */
+
+#include "posixstat.h"
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STDLIB_H)
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif /* HAVE_STDLIB_H */
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+/* System-specific feature definitions and include files. */
+#include "rldefs.h"
+#include "rlmbutil.h"
+
+/* Termcap library stuff. */
+#include "tcap.h"
+
+/* Some standard library routines. */
+#include "readline.h"
+#include "history.h"
+
+#include "rlprivate.h"
+#include "xmalloc.h"
+
+#if !defined (strchr) && !defined (__STDC__)
+extern char *strchr (), *strrchr ();
+#endif /* !strchr && !__STDC__ */
+
+#if defined (HACK_TERMCAP_MOTION)
+extern char *_rl_term_forward_char;
+#endif
+
+static void update_line PARAMS((char *, char *, int, int, int, int));
+static void space_to_eol PARAMS((int));
+static void delete_chars PARAMS((int));
+static void insert_some_chars PARAMS((char *, int, int));
+static void cr PARAMS((void));
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+static int _rl_col_width PARAMS((const char *, int, int));
+static int *_rl_wrapped_line;
+#else
+# define _rl_col_width(l, s, e) (((e) <= (s)) ? 0 : (e) - (s))
+#endif
+
+static int *inv_lbreaks, *vis_lbreaks;
+static int inv_lbsize, vis_lbsize;
+
+/* Heuristic used to decide whether it is faster to move from CUR to NEW
+ by backing up or outputting a carriage return and moving forward. */
+#define CR_FASTER(new, cur) (((new) + 1) < ((cur) - (new)))
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Display stuff */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* This is the stuff that is hard for me. I never seem to write good
+ display routines in C. Let's see how I do this time. */
+
+/* (PWP) Well... Good for a simple line updater, but totally ignores
+ the problems of input lines longer than the screen width.
+
+ update_line and the code that calls it makes a multiple line,
+ automatically wrapping line update. Careful attention needs
+ to be paid to the vertical position variables. */
+
+/* Keep two buffers; one which reflects the current contents of the
+ screen, and the other to draw what we think the new contents should
+ be. Then compare the buffers, and make whatever changes to the
+ screen itself that we should. Finally, make the buffer that we
+ just drew into be the one which reflects the current contents of the
+ screen, and place the cursor where it belongs.
+
+ Commands that want to can fix the display themselves, and then let
+ this function know that the display has been fixed by setting the
+ RL_DISPLAY_FIXED variable. This is good for efficiency. */
+
+/* Application-specific redisplay function. */
+rl_voidfunc_t *rl_redisplay_function = rl_redisplay;
+
+/* Global variables declared here. */
+/* What YOU turn on when you have handled all redisplay yourself. */
+int rl_display_fixed = 0;
+
+int _rl_suppress_redisplay = 0;
+int _rl_want_redisplay = 0;
+
+/* The stuff that gets printed out before the actual text of the line.
+ This is usually pointing to rl_prompt. */
+char *rl_display_prompt = (char *)NULL;
+
+/* Pseudo-global variables declared here. */
+
+/* The visible cursor position. If you print some text, adjust this. */
+/* NOTE: _rl_last_c_pos is used as a buffer index when not in a locale
+ supporting multibyte characters, and an absolute cursor position when
+ in such a locale. This is an artifact of the donated multibyte support.
+ Care must be taken when modifying its value. */
+int _rl_last_c_pos = 0;
+int _rl_last_v_pos = 0;
+
+static int cpos_adjusted;
+
+/* Number of lines currently on screen minus 1. */
+int _rl_vis_botlin = 0;
+
+/* Variables used only in this file. */
+/* The last left edge of text that was displayed. This is used when
+ doing horizontal scrolling. It shifts in thirds of a screenwidth. */
+static int last_lmargin;
+
+/* The line display buffers. One is the line currently displayed on
+ the screen. The other is the line about to be displayed. */
+static char *visible_line = (char *)NULL;
+static char *invisible_line = (char *)NULL;
+
+/* A buffer for `modeline' messages. */
+static char msg_buf[128];
+
+/* Non-zero forces the redisplay even if we thought it was unnecessary. */
+static int forced_display;
+
+/* Default and initial buffer size. Can grow. */
+static int line_size = 1024;
+
+/* Variables to keep track of the expanded prompt string, which may
+ include invisible characters. */
+
+static char *local_prompt, *local_prompt_prefix;
+static int prompt_visible_length, prompt_prefix_length;
+
+/* The number of invisible characters in the line currently being
+ displayed on the screen. */
+static int visible_wrap_offset;
+
+/* The number of invisible characters in the prompt string. Static so it
+ can be shared between rl_redisplay and update_line */
+static int wrap_offset;
+
+/* The index of the last invisible character in the prompt string. */
+static int prompt_last_invisible;
+
+/* The length (buffer offset) of the first line of the last (possibly
+ multi-line) buffer displayed on the screen. */
+static int visible_first_line_len;
+
+/* Number of invisible characters on the first physical line of the prompt.
+ Only valid when the number of physical characters in the prompt exceeds
+ (or is equal to) _rl_screenwidth. */
+static int prompt_invis_chars_first_line;
+
+static int prompt_last_screen_line;
+
+static int prompt_physical_chars;
+
+/* Variables to save and restore prompt and display information. */
+
+/* These are getting numerous enough that it's time to create a struct. */
+
+static char *saved_local_prompt;
+static char *saved_local_prefix;
+static int saved_last_invisible;
+static int saved_visible_length;
+static int saved_prefix_length;
+static int saved_invis_chars_first_line;
+static int saved_physical_chars;
+
+/* Expand the prompt string S and return the number of visible
+ characters in *LP, if LP is not null. This is currently more-or-less
+ a placeholder for expansion. LIP, if non-null is a place to store the
+ index of the last invisible character in the returned string. NIFLP,
+ if non-zero, is a place to store the number of invisible characters in
+ the first prompt line. The previous are used as byte counts -- indexes
+ into a character buffer. */
+
+/* Current implementation:
+ \001 (^A) start non-visible characters
+ \002 (^B) end non-visible characters
+ all characters except \001 and \002 (following a \001) are copied to
+ the returned string; all characters except those between \001 and
+ \002 are assumed to be `visible'. */
+
+static char *
+expand_prompt (pmt, lp, lip, niflp, vlp)
+ char *pmt;
+ int *lp, *lip, *niflp, *vlp;
+{
+ char *r, *ret, *p;
+ int l, rl, last, ignoring, ninvis, invfl, invflset, ind, pind, physchars;
+
+ /* Short-circuit if we can. */
+ if ((MB_CUR_MAX <= 1 || rl_byte_oriented) && strchr (pmt, RL_PROMPT_START_IGNORE) == 0)
+ {
+ r = savestring (pmt);
+ if (lp)
+ *lp = strlen (r);
+ if (lip)
+ *lip = 0;
+ if (niflp)
+ *niflp = 0;
+ if (vlp)
+ *vlp = lp ? *lp : strlen (r);
+ return r;
+ }
+
+ l = strlen (pmt);
+ r = ret = (char *)xmalloc (l + 1);
+
+ invfl = 0; /* invisible chars in first line of prompt */
+ invflset = 0; /* we only want to set invfl once */
+
+ for (rl = ignoring = last = ninvis = physchars = 0, p = pmt; p && *p; p++)
+ {
+ /* This code strips the invisible character string markers
+ RL_PROMPT_START_IGNORE and RL_PROMPT_END_IGNORE */
+ if (*p == RL_PROMPT_START_IGNORE)
+ {
+ ignoring++;
+ continue;
+ }
+ else if (ignoring && *p == RL_PROMPT_END_IGNORE)
+ {
+ ignoring = 0;
+ if (p[-1] != RL_PROMPT_START_IGNORE)
+ last = r - ret - 1;
+ continue;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ {
+ pind = p - pmt;
+ ind = _rl_find_next_mbchar (pmt, pind, 1, MB_FIND_NONZERO);
+ l = ind - pind;
+ while (l--)
+ *r++ = *p++;
+ if (!ignoring)
+ {
+ rl += ind - pind;
+ physchars += _rl_col_width (pmt, pind, ind);
+ }
+ else
+ ninvis += ind - pind;
+ p--; /* compensate for later increment */
+ }
+ else
+#endif
+ {
+ *r++ = *p;
+ if (!ignoring)
+ {
+ rl++; /* visible length byte counter */
+ physchars++;
+ }
+ else
+ ninvis++; /* invisible chars byte counter */
+ }
+
+ if (invflset == 0 && rl >= _rl_screenwidth)
+ {
+ invfl = ninvis;
+ invflset = 1;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (rl < _rl_screenwidth)
+ invfl = ninvis;
+
+ *r = '\0';
+ if (lp)
+ *lp = rl;
+ if (lip)
+ *lip = last;
+ if (niflp)
+ *niflp = invfl;
+ if (vlp)
+ *vlp = physchars;
+ return ret;
+}
+
+/* Just strip out RL_PROMPT_START_IGNORE and RL_PROMPT_END_IGNORE from
+ PMT and return the rest of PMT. */
+char *
+_rl_strip_prompt (pmt)
+ char *pmt;
+{
+ char *ret;
+
+ ret = expand_prompt (pmt, (int *)NULL, (int *)NULL, (int *)NULL, (int *)NULL);
+ return ret;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Expand the prompt string into the various display components, if
+ * necessary.
+ *
+ * local_prompt = expanded last line of string in rl_display_prompt
+ * (portion after the final newline)
+ * local_prompt_prefix = portion before last newline of rl_display_prompt,
+ * expanded via expand_prompt
+ * prompt_visible_length = number of visible characters in local_prompt
+ * prompt_prefix_length = number of visible characters in local_prompt_prefix
+ *
+ * This function is called once per call to readline(). It may also be
+ * called arbitrarily to expand the primary prompt.
+ *
+ * The return value is the number of visible characters on the last line
+ * of the (possibly multi-line) prompt.
+ */
+int
+rl_expand_prompt (prompt)
+ char *prompt;
+{
+ char *p, *t;
+ int c;
+
+ /* Clear out any saved values. */
+ FREE (local_prompt);
+ FREE (local_prompt_prefix);
+
+ local_prompt = local_prompt_prefix = (char *)0;
+ prompt_last_invisible = prompt_invis_chars_first_line = 0;
+ prompt_visible_length = prompt_physical_chars = 0;
+
+ if (prompt == 0 || *prompt == 0)
+ return (0);
+
+ p = strrchr (prompt, '\n');
+ if (!p)
+ {
+ /* The prompt is only one logical line, though it might wrap. */
+ local_prompt = expand_prompt (prompt, &prompt_visible_length,
+ &prompt_last_invisible,
+ &prompt_invis_chars_first_line,
+ &prompt_physical_chars);
+ local_prompt_prefix = (char *)0;
+ return (prompt_visible_length);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* The prompt spans multiple lines. */
+ t = ++p;
+ local_prompt = expand_prompt (p, &prompt_visible_length,
+ &prompt_last_invisible,
+ (int *)NULL,
+ &prompt_physical_chars);
+ c = *t; *t = '\0';
+ /* The portion of the prompt string up to and including the
+ final newline is now null-terminated. */
+ local_prompt_prefix = expand_prompt (prompt, &prompt_prefix_length,
+ (int *)NULL,
+ &prompt_invis_chars_first_line,
+ (int *)NULL);
+ *t = c;
+ return (prompt_prefix_length);
+ }
+}
+
+/* Initialize the VISIBLE_LINE and INVISIBLE_LINE arrays, and their associated
+ arrays of line break markers. MINSIZE is the minimum size of VISIBLE_LINE
+ and INVISIBLE_LINE; if it is greater than LINE_SIZE, LINE_SIZE is
+ increased. If the lines have already been allocated, this ensures that
+ they can hold at least MINSIZE characters. */
+static void
+init_line_structures (minsize)
+ int minsize;
+{
+ register int n;
+
+ if (invisible_line == 0) /* initialize it */
+ {
+ if (line_size < minsize)
+ line_size = minsize;
+ visible_line = (char *)xmalloc (line_size);
+ invisible_line = (char *)xmalloc (line_size);
+ }
+ else if (line_size < minsize) /* ensure it can hold MINSIZE chars */
+ {
+ line_size *= 2;
+ if (line_size < minsize)
+ line_size = minsize;
+ visible_line = (char *)xrealloc (visible_line, line_size);
+ invisible_line = (char *)xrealloc (invisible_line, line_size);
+ }
+
+ for (n = minsize; n < line_size; n++)
+ {
+ visible_line[n] = 0;
+ invisible_line[n] = 1;
+ }
+
+ if (vis_lbreaks == 0)
+ {
+ /* should be enough. */
+ inv_lbsize = vis_lbsize = 256;
+ inv_lbreaks = (int *)xmalloc (inv_lbsize * sizeof (int));
+ vis_lbreaks = (int *)xmalloc (vis_lbsize * sizeof (int));
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ _rl_wrapped_line = (int *)xmalloc (vis_lbsize * sizeof (int));
+#endif
+ inv_lbreaks[0] = vis_lbreaks[0] = 0;
+ }
+}
+
+/* Basic redisplay algorithm. */
+void
+rl_redisplay ()
+{
+ register int in, out, c, linenum, cursor_linenum;
+ register char *line;
+ int c_pos, inv_botlin, lb_botlin, lb_linenum, o_cpos;
+ int newlines, lpos, temp, modmark, n0, num;
+ char *prompt_this_line;
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ wchar_t wc;
+ size_t wc_bytes;
+ int wc_width;
+ mbstate_t ps;
+ int _rl_wrapped_multicolumn = 0;
+#endif
+
+ if (!readline_echoing_p)
+ return;
+
+ if (!rl_display_prompt)
+ rl_display_prompt = "";
+
+ if (invisible_line == 0 || vis_lbreaks == 0)
+ {
+ init_line_structures (0);
+ rl_on_new_line ();
+ }
+
+ /* Draw the line into the buffer. */
+ c_pos = -1;
+
+ line = invisible_line;
+ out = inv_botlin = 0;
+
+ /* Mark the line as modified or not. We only do this for history
+ lines. */
+ modmark = 0;
+ if (_rl_mark_modified_lines && current_history () && rl_undo_list)
+ {
+ line[out++] = '*';
+ line[out] = '\0';
+ modmark = 1;
+ }
+
+ /* If someone thought that the redisplay was handled, but the currently
+ visible line has a different modification state than the one about
+ to become visible, then correct the caller's misconception. */
+ if (visible_line[0] != invisible_line[0])
+ rl_display_fixed = 0;
+
+ /* If the prompt to be displayed is the `primary' readline prompt (the
+ one passed to readline()), use the values we have already expanded.
+ If not, use what's already in rl_display_prompt. WRAP_OFFSET is the
+ number of non-visible characters in the prompt string. */
+ if (rl_display_prompt == rl_prompt || local_prompt)
+ {
+ int local_len = local_prompt ? strlen (local_prompt) : 0;
+ if (local_prompt_prefix && forced_display)
+ _rl_output_some_chars (local_prompt_prefix, strlen (local_prompt_prefix));
+
+ if (local_len > 0)
+ {
+ temp = local_len + out + 2;
+ if (temp >= line_size)
+ {
+ line_size = (temp + 1024) - (temp % 1024);
+ visible_line = (char *)xrealloc (visible_line, line_size);
+ line = invisible_line = (char *)xrealloc (invisible_line, line_size);
+ }
+ strncpy (line + out, local_prompt, local_len);
+ out += local_len;
+ }
+ line[out] = '\0';
+ wrap_offset = local_len - prompt_visible_length;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ int pmtlen;
+ prompt_this_line = strrchr (rl_display_prompt, '\n');
+ if (!prompt_this_line)
+ prompt_this_line = rl_display_prompt;
+ else
+ {
+ prompt_this_line++;
+ pmtlen = prompt_this_line - rl_display_prompt; /* temp var */
+ if (forced_display)
+ {
+ _rl_output_some_chars (rl_display_prompt, pmtlen);
+ /* Make sure we are at column zero even after a newline,
+ regardless of the state of terminal output processing. */
+ if (pmtlen < 2 || prompt_this_line[-2] != '\r')
+ cr ();
+ }
+ }
+
+ prompt_physical_chars = pmtlen = strlen (prompt_this_line);
+ temp = pmtlen + out + 2;
+ if (temp >= line_size)
+ {
+ line_size = (temp + 1024) - (temp % 1024);
+ visible_line = (char *)xrealloc (visible_line, line_size);
+ line = invisible_line = (char *)xrealloc (invisible_line, line_size);
+ }
+ strncpy (line + out, prompt_this_line, pmtlen);
+ out += pmtlen;
+ line[out] = '\0';
+ wrap_offset = prompt_invis_chars_first_line = 0;
+ }
+
+#define CHECK_INV_LBREAKS() \
+ do { \
+ if (newlines >= (inv_lbsize - 2)) \
+ { \
+ inv_lbsize *= 2; \
+ inv_lbreaks = (int *)xrealloc (inv_lbreaks, inv_lbsize * sizeof (int)); \
+ } \
+ } while (0)
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+#define CHECK_LPOS() \
+ do { \
+ lpos++; \
+ if (lpos >= _rl_screenwidth) \
+ { \
+ if (newlines >= (inv_lbsize - 2)) \
+ { \
+ inv_lbsize *= 2; \
+ inv_lbreaks = (int *)xrealloc (inv_lbreaks, inv_lbsize * sizeof (int)); \
+ _rl_wrapped_line = (int *)xrealloc (_rl_wrapped_line, inv_lbsize * sizeof (int)); \
+ } \
+ inv_lbreaks[++newlines] = out; \
+ _rl_wrapped_line[newlines] = _rl_wrapped_multicolumn; \
+ lpos = 0; \
+ } \
+ } while (0)
+#else
+#define CHECK_LPOS() \
+ do { \
+ lpos++; \
+ if (lpos >= _rl_screenwidth) \
+ { \
+ if (newlines >= (inv_lbsize - 2)) \
+ { \
+ inv_lbsize *= 2; \
+ inv_lbreaks = (int *)xrealloc (inv_lbreaks, inv_lbsize * sizeof (int)); \
+ } \
+ inv_lbreaks[++newlines] = out; \
+ lpos = 0; \
+ } \
+ } while (0)
+#endif
+
+ /* inv_lbreaks[i] is where line i starts in the buffer. */
+ inv_lbreaks[newlines = 0] = 0;
+#if 0
+ lpos = out - wrap_offset;
+#else
+ lpos = prompt_physical_chars + modmark;
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ memset (_rl_wrapped_line, 0, vis_lbsize);
+ num = 0;
+#endif
+
+ /* prompt_invis_chars_first_line is the number of invisible characters in
+ the first physical line of the prompt.
+ wrap_offset - prompt_invis_chars_first_line is the number of invis
+ chars on the second line. */
+
+ /* what if lpos is already >= _rl_screenwidth before we start drawing the
+ contents of the command line? */
+ while (lpos >= _rl_screenwidth)
+ {
+ /* fix from Darin Johnson <darin@acuson.com> for prompt string with
+ invisible characters that is longer than the screen width. The
+ prompt_invis_chars_first_line variable could be made into an array
+ saying how many invisible characters there are per line, but that's
+ probably too much work for the benefit gained. How many people have
+ prompts that exceed two physical lines?
+ Additional logic fix from Edward Catmur <ed@catmur.co.uk> */
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ n0 = num;
+ temp = local_prompt ? strlen (local_prompt) : 0;
+ while (num < temp)
+ {
+ if (_rl_col_width (local_prompt, n0, num) > _rl_screenwidth)
+ {
+ num = _rl_find_prev_mbchar (local_prompt, num, MB_FIND_ANY);
+ break;
+ }
+ num++;
+ }
+ temp = num +
+#else
+ temp = ((newlines + 1) * _rl_screenwidth) +
+#endif /* !HANDLE_MULTIBYTE */
+ ((local_prompt_prefix == 0) ? ((newlines == 0) ? prompt_invis_chars_first_line
+ : ((newlines == 1) ? wrap_offset : 0))
+ : ((newlines == 0) ? wrap_offset :0));
+
+ inv_lbreaks[++newlines] = temp;
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ lpos -= _rl_col_width (local_prompt, n0, num);
+#else
+ lpos -= _rl_screenwidth;
+#endif
+ }
+
+ prompt_last_screen_line = newlines;
+
+ /* Draw the rest of the line (after the prompt) into invisible_line, keeping
+ track of where the cursor is (c_pos), the number of the line containing
+ the cursor (lb_linenum), the last line number (lb_botlin and inv_botlin).
+ It maintains an array of line breaks for display (inv_lbreaks).
+ This handles expanding tabs for display and displaying meta characters. */
+ lb_linenum = 0;
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ in = 0;
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ {
+ memset (&ps, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+ wc_bytes = mbrtowc (&wc, rl_line_buffer, rl_end, &ps);
+ }
+ else
+ wc_bytes = 1;
+ while (in < rl_end)
+#else
+ for (in = 0; in < rl_end; in++)
+#endif
+ {
+ c = (unsigned char)rl_line_buffer[in];
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ {
+ if (MB_INVALIDCH (wc_bytes))
+ {
+ /* Byte sequence is invalid or shortened. Assume that the
+ first byte represents a character. */
+ wc_bytes = 1;
+ /* Assume that a character occupies a single column. */
+ wc_width = 1;
+ memset (&ps, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+ }
+ else if (MB_NULLWCH (wc_bytes))
+ break; /* Found '\0' */
+ else
+ {
+ temp = wcwidth (wc);
+ wc_width = (temp >= 0) ? temp : 1;
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+
+ if (out + 8 >= line_size) /* XXX - 8 for \t */
+ {
+ line_size *= 2;
+ visible_line = (char *)xrealloc (visible_line, line_size);
+ invisible_line = (char *)xrealloc (invisible_line, line_size);
+ line = invisible_line;
+ }
+
+ if (in == rl_point)
+ {
+ c_pos = out;
+ lb_linenum = newlines;
+ }
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ if (META_CHAR (c) && _rl_output_meta_chars == 0) /* XXX - clean up */
+#else
+ if (META_CHAR (c))
+#endif
+ {
+ if (_rl_output_meta_chars == 0)
+ {
+ sprintf (line + out, "\\%o", c);
+
+ if (lpos + 4 >= _rl_screenwidth)
+ {
+ temp = _rl_screenwidth - lpos;
+ CHECK_INV_LBREAKS ();
+ inv_lbreaks[++newlines] = out + temp;
+ lpos = 4 - temp;
+ }
+ else
+ lpos += 4;
+
+ out += 4;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ line[out++] = c;
+ CHECK_LPOS();
+ }
+ }
+#if defined (DISPLAY_TABS)
+ else if (c == '\t')
+ {
+ register int newout;
+
+#if 0
+ newout = (out | (int)7) + 1;
+#else
+ newout = out + 8 - lpos % 8;
+#endif
+ temp = newout - out;
+ if (lpos + temp >= _rl_screenwidth)
+ {
+ register int temp2;
+ temp2 = _rl_screenwidth - lpos;
+ CHECK_INV_LBREAKS ();
+ inv_lbreaks[++newlines] = out + temp2;
+ lpos = temp - temp2;
+ while (out < newout)
+ line[out++] = ' ';
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ while (out < newout)
+ line[out++] = ' ';
+ lpos += temp;
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+ else if (c == '\n' && _rl_horizontal_scroll_mode == 0 && _rl_term_up && *_rl_term_up)
+ {
+ line[out++] = '\0'; /* XXX - sentinel */
+ CHECK_INV_LBREAKS ();
+ inv_lbreaks[++newlines] = out;
+ lpos = 0;
+ }
+ else if (CTRL_CHAR (c) || c == RUBOUT)
+ {
+ line[out++] = '^';
+ CHECK_LPOS();
+ line[out++] = CTRL_CHAR (c) ? UNCTRL (c) : '?';
+ CHECK_LPOS();
+ }
+ else
+ {
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ {
+ register int i;
+
+ _rl_wrapped_multicolumn = 0;
+
+ if (_rl_screenwidth < lpos + wc_width)
+ for (i = lpos; i < _rl_screenwidth; i++)
+ {
+ /* The space will be removed in update_line() */
+ line[out++] = ' ';
+ _rl_wrapped_multicolumn++;
+ CHECK_LPOS();
+ }
+ if (in == rl_point)
+ {
+ c_pos = out;
+ lb_linenum = newlines;
+ }
+ for (i = in; i < in+wc_bytes; i++)
+ line[out++] = rl_line_buffer[i];
+ for (i = 0; i < wc_width; i++)
+ CHECK_LPOS();
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ line[out++] = c;
+ CHECK_LPOS();
+ }
+#else
+ line[out++] = c;
+ CHECK_LPOS();
+#endif
+ }
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ {
+ in += wc_bytes;
+ wc_bytes = mbrtowc (&wc, rl_line_buffer + in, rl_end - in, &ps);
+ }
+ else
+ in++;
+#endif
+
+ }
+ line[out] = '\0';
+ if (c_pos < 0)
+ {
+ c_pos = out;
+ lb_linenum = newlines;
+ }
+
+ inv_botlin = lb_botlin = newlines;
+ CHECK_INV_LBREAKS ();
+ inv_lbreaks[newlines+1] = out;
+ cursor_linenum = lb_linenum;
+
+ /* C_POS == position in buffer where cursor should be placed.
+ CURSOR_LINENUM == line number where the cursor should be placed. */
+
+ /* PWP: now is when things get a bit hairy. The visible and invisible
+ line buffers are really multiple lines, which would wrap every
+ (screenwidth - 1) characters. Go through each in turn, finding
+ the changed region and updating it. The line order is top to bottom. */
+
+ /* If we can move the cursor up and down, then use multiple lines,
+ otherwise, let long lines display in a single terminal line, and
+ horizontally scroll it. */
+
+ if (_rl_horizontal_scroll_mode == 0 && _rl_term_up && *_rl_term_up)
+ {
+ int nleft, pos, changed_screen_line, tx;
+
+ if (!rl_display_fixed || forced_display)
+ {
+ forced_display = 0;
+
+ /* If we have more than a screenful of material to display, then
+ only display a screenful. We should display the last screen,
+ not the first. */
+ if (out >= _rl_screenchars)
+ {
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ out = _rl_find_prev_mbchar (line, _rl_screenchars, MB_FIND_ANY);
+ else
+ out = _rl_screenchars - 1;
+ }
+
+ /* The first line is at character position 0 in the buffer. The
+ second and subsequent lines start at inv_lbreaks[N], offset by
+ OFFSET (which has already been calculated above). */
+
+#define W_OFFSET(line, offset) ((line) == 0 ? offset : 0)
+#define VIS_LLEN(l) ((l) > _rl_vis_botlin ? 0 : (vis_lbreaks[l+1] - vis_lbreaks[l]))
+#define INV_LLEN(l) (inv_lbreaks[l+1] - inv_lbreaks[l])
+#define VIS_CHARS(line) (visible_line + vis_lbreaks[line])
+#define VIS_LINE(line) ((line) > _rl_vis_botlin) ? "" : VIS_CHARS(line)
+#define INV_LINE(line) (invisible_line + inv_lbreaks[line])
+
+ /* For each line in the buffer, do the updating display. */
+ for (linenum = 0; linenum <= inv_botlin; linenum++)
+ {
+ o_cpos = _rl_last_c_pos;
+ cpos_adjusted = 0;
+ update_line (VIS_LINE(linenum), INV_LINE(linenum), linenum,
+ VIS_LLEN(linenum), INV_LLEN(linenum), inv_botlin);
+
+ /* update_line potentially changes _rl_last_c_pos, but doesn't
+ take invisible characters into account, since _rl_last_c_pos
+ is an absolute cursor position in a multibyte locale. See
+ if compensating here is the right thing, or if we have to
+ change update_line itself. There is one case in which
+ update_line adjusts _rl_last_c_pos itself (so it can pass
+ _rl_move_cursor_relative accurate values); it communicates
+ this back by setting cpos_adjusted */
+ if (linenum == 0 && (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0) &&
+ cpos_adjusted == 0 &&
+ _rl_last_c_pos != o_cpos &&
+ _rl_last_c_pos > wrap_offset &&
+ o_cpos < prompt_last_invisible)
+ _rl_last_c_pos -= wrap_offset;
+
+ /* If this is the line with the prompt, we might need to
+ compensate for invisible characters in the new line. Do
+ this only if there is not more than one new line (which
+ implies that we completely overwrite the old visible line)
+ and the new line is shorter than the old. Make sure we are
+ at the end of the new line before clearing. */
+ if (linenum == 0 &&
+ inv_botlin == 0 && _rl_last_c_pos == out &&
+ (wrap_offset > visible_wrap_offset) &&
+ (_rl_last_c_pos < visible_first_line_len))
+ {
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ nleft = _rl_screenwidth - _rl_last_c_pos;
+ else
+ nleft = _rl_screenwidth + wrap_offset - _rl_last_c_pos;
+ if (nleft)
+ _rl_clear_to_eol (nleft);
+ }
+
+ /* Since the new first line is now visible, save its length. */
+ if (linenum == 0)
+ visible_first_line_len = (inv_botlin > 0) ? inv_lbreaks[1] : out - wrap_offset;
+ }
+
+ /* We may have deleted some lines. If so, clear the left over
+ blank ones at the bottom out. */
+ if (_rl_vis_botlin > inv_botlin)
+ {
+ char *tt;
+ for (; linenum <= _rl_vis_botlin; linenum++)
+ {
+ tt = VIS_CHARS (linenum);
+ _rl_move_vert (linenum);
+ _rl_move_cursor_relative (0, tt);
+ _rl_clear_to_eol
+ ((linenum == _rl_vis_botlin) ? strlen (tt) : _rl_screenwidth);
+ }
+ }
+ _rl_vis_botlin = inv_botlin;
+
+ /* CHANGED_SCREEN_LINE is set to 1 if we have moved to a
+ different screen line during this redisplay. */
+ changed_screen_line = _rl_last_v_pos != cursor_linenum;
+ if (changed_screen_line)
+ {
+ _rl_move_vert (cursor_linenum);
+ /* If we moved up to the line with the prompt using _rl_term_up,
+ the physical cursor position on the screen stays the same,
+ but the buffer position needs to be adjusted to account
+ for invisible characters. */
+ if ((MB_CUR_MAX == 1 || rl_byte_oriented) && cursor_linenum == 0 && wrap_offset)
+ _rl_last_c_pos += wrap_offset;
+ }
+
+ /* We have to reprint the prompt if it contains invisible
+ characters, since it's not generally OK to just reprint
+ the characters from the current cursor position. But we
+ only need to reprint it if the cursor is before the last
+ invisible character in the prompt string. */
+ nleft = prompt_visible_length + wrap_offset;
+ if (cursor_linenum == 0 && wrap_offset > 0 && _rl_last_c_pos > 0 &&
+ _rl_last_c_pos <= prompt_last_invisible && local_prompt)
+ {
+#if defined (__MSDOS__)
+ putc ('\r', rl_outstream);
+#else
+ if (_rl_term_cr)
+ tputs (_rl_term_cr, 1, _rl_output_character_function);
+#endif
+ _rl_output_some_chars (local_prompt, nleft);
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ _rl_last_c_pos = _rl_col_width (local_prompt, 0, nleft) - wrap_offset;
+ else
+ _rl_last_c_pos = nleft;
+ }
+
+ /* Where on that line? And where does that line start
+ in the buffer? */
+ pos = inv_lbreaks[cursor_linenum];
+ /* nleft == number of characters in the line buffer between the
+ start of the line and the cursor position. */
+ nleft = c_pos - pos;
+
+ /* NLEFT is now a number of characters in a buffer. When in a
+ multibyte locale, however, _rl_last_c_pos is an absolute cursor
+ position that doesn't take invisible characters in the prompt
+ into account. We use a fudge factor to compensate. */
+
+ /* Since _rl_backspace() doesn't know about invisible characters in the
+ prompt, and there's no good way to tell it, we compensate for
+ those characters here and call _rl_backspace() directly. */
+ if (wrap_offset && cursor_linenum == 0 && nleft < _rl_last_c_pos)
+ {
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ tx = _rl_col_width (&visible_line[pos], 0, nleft) - visible_wrap_offset;
+ else
+ tx = nleft;
+ if (_rl_last_c_pos > tx)
+ {
+ _rl_backspace (_rl_last_c_pos - tx); /* XXX */
+ _rl_last_c_pos = tx;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* We need to note that in a multibyte locale we are dealing with
+ _rl_last_c_pos as an absolute cursor position, but moving to a
+ point specified by a buffer position (NLEFT) that doesn't take
+ invisible characters into account. */
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ _rl_move_cursor_relative (nleft, &invisible_line[pos]);
+ else if (nleft != _rl_last_c_pos)
+ _rl_move_cursor_relative (nleft, &invisible_line[pos]);
+ }
+ }
+ else /* Do horizontal scrolling. */
+ {
+#define M_OFFSET(margin, offset) ((margin) == 0 ? offset : 0)
+ int lmargin, ndisp, nleft, phys_c_pos, t;
+
+ /* Always at top line. */
+ _rl_last_v_pos = 0;
+
+ /* Compute where in the buffer the displayed line should start. This
+ will be LMARGIN. */
+
+ /* The number of characters that will be displayed before the cursor. */
+ ndisp = c_pos - wrap_offset;
+ nleft = prompt_visible_length + wrap_offset;
+ /* Where the new cursor position will be on the screen. This can be
+ longer than SCREENWIDTH; if it is, lmargin will be adjusted. */
+ phys_c_pos = c_pos - (last_lmargin ? last_lmargin : wrap_offset);
+ t = _rl_screenwidth / 3;
+
+ /* If the number of characters had already exceeded the screenwidth,
+ last_lmargin will be > 0. */
+
+ /* If the number of characters to be displayed is more than the screen
+ width, compute the starting offset so that the cursor is about
+ two-thirds of the way across the screen. */
+ if (phys_c_pos > _rl_screenwidth - 2)
+ {
+ lmargin = c_pos - (2 * t);
+ if (lmargin < 0)
+ lmargin = 0;
+ /* If the left margin would be in the middle of a prompt with
+ invisible characters, don't display the prompt at all. */
+ if (wrap_offset && lmargin > 0 && lmargin < nleft)
+ lmargin = nleft;
+ }
+ else if (ndisp < _rl_screenwidth - 2) /* XXX - was -1 */
+ lmargin = 0;
+ else if (phys_c_pos < 1)
+ {
+ /* If we are moving back towards the beginning of the line and
+ the last margin is no longer correct, compute a new one. */
+ lmargin = ((c_pos - 1) / t) * t; /* XXX */
+ if (wrap_offset && lmargin > 0 && lmargin < nleft)
+ lmargin = nleft;
+ }
+ else
+ lmargin = last_lmargin;
+
+ /* If the first character on the screen isn't the first character
+ in the display line, indicate this with a special character. */
+ if (lmargin > 0)
+ line[lmargin] = '<';
+
+ /* If SCREENWIDTH characters starting at LMARGIN do not encompass
+ the whole line, indicate that with a special character at the
+ right edge of the screen. If LMARGIN is 0, we need to take the
+ wrap offset into account. */
+ t = lmargin + M_OFFSET (lmargin, wrap_offset) + _rl_screenwidth;
+ if (t < out)
+ line[t - 1] = '>';
+
+ if (!rl_display_fixed || forced_display || lmargin != last_lmargin)
+ {
+ forced_display = 0;
+ update_line (&visible_line[last_lmargin],
+ &invisible_line[lmargin],
+ 0,
+ _rl_screenwidth + visible_wrap_offset,
+ _rl_screenwidth + (lmargin ? 0 : wrap_offset),
+ 0);
+
+ /* If the visible new line is shorter than the old, but the number
+ of invisible characters is greater, and we are at the end of
+ the new line, we need to clear to eol. */
+ t = _rl_last_c_pos - M_OFFSET (lmargin, wrap_offset);
+ if ((M_OFFSET (lmargin, wrap_offset) > visible_wrap_offset) &&
+ (_rl_last_c_pos == out) &&
+ t < visible_first_line_len)
+ {
+ nleft = _rl_screenwidth - t;
+ _rl_clear_to_eol (nleft);
+ }
+ visible_first_line_len = out - lmargin - M_OFFSET (lmargin, wrap_offset);
+ if (visible_first_line_len > _rl_screenwidth)
+ visible_first_line_len = _rl_screenwidth;
+
+ _rl_move_cursor_relative (c_pos - lmargin, &invisible_line[lmargin]);
+ last_lmargin = lmargin;
+ }
+ }
+ fflush (rl_outstream);
+
+ /* Swap visible and non-visible lines. */
+ {
+ char *vtemp = visible_line;
+ int *itemp = vis_lbreaks, ntemp = vis_lbsize;
+
+ visible_line = invisible_line;
+ invisible_line = vtemp;
+
+ vis_lbreaks = inv_lbreaks;
+ inv_lbreaks = itemp;
+
+ vis_lbsize = inv_lbsize;
+ inv_lbsize = ntemp;
+
+ rl_display_fixed = 0;
+ /* If we are displaying on a single line, and last_lmargin is > 0, we
+ are not displaying any invisible characters, so set visible_wrap_offset
+ to 0. */
+ if (_rl_horizontal_scroll_mode && last_lmargin)
+ visible_wrap_offset = 0;
+ else
+ visible_wrap_offset = wrap_offset;
+ }
+}
+
+/* PWP: update_line() is based on finding the middle difference of each
+ line on the screen; vis:
+
+ /old first difference
+ /beginning of line | /old last same /old EOL
+ v v v v
+old: eddie> Oh, my little gruntle-buggy is to me, as lurgid as
+new: eddie> Oh, my little buggy says to me, as lurgid as
+ ^ ^ ^ ^
+ \beginning of line | \new last same \new end of line
+ \new first difference
+
+ All are character pointers for the sake of speed. Special cases for
+ no differences, as well as for end of line additions must be handled.
+
+ Could be made even smarter, but this works well enough */
+static void
+update_line (old, new, current_line, omax, nmax, inv_botlin)
+ register char *old, *new;
+ int current_line, omax, nmax, inv_botlin;
+{
+ register char *ofd, *ols, *oe, *nfd, *nls, *ne;
+ int temp, lendiff, wsatend, od, nd;
+ int current_invis_chars;
+ int col_lendiff, col_temp;
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ mbstate_t ps_new, ps_old;
+ int new_offset, old_offset, tmp;
+#endif
+
+ /* If we're at the right edge of a terminal that supports xn, we're
+ ready to wrap around, so do so. This fixes problems with knowing
+ the exact cursor position and cut-and-paste with certain terminal
+ emulators. In this calculation, TEMP is the physical screen
+ position of the cursor. */
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ temp = _rl_last_c_pos;
+ else
+ temp = _rl_last_c_pos - W_OFFSET(_rl_last_v_pos, visible_wrap_offset);
+ if (temp == _rl_screenwidth && _rl_term_autowrap && !_rl_horizontal_scroll_mode
+ && _rl_last_v_pos == current_line - 1)
+ {
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ {
+ wchar_t wc;
+ mbstate_t ps;
+ int tempwidth, bytes;
+ size_t ret;
+
+ /* This fixes only double-column characters, but if the wrapped
+ character comsumes more than three columns, spaces will be
+ inserted in the string buffer. */
+ if (_rl_wrapped_line[current_line] > 0)
+ _rl_clear_to_eol (_rl_wrapped_line[current_line]);
+
+ memset (&ps, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+ ret = mbrtowc (&wc, new, MB_CUR_MAX, &ps);
+ if (MB_INVALIDCH (ret))
+ {
+ tempwidth = 1;
+ ret = 1;
+ }
+ else if (MB_NULLWCH (ret))
+ tempwidth = 0;
+ else
+ tempwidth = wcwidth (wc);
+
+ if (tempwidth > 0)
+ {
+ int count;
+ bytes = ret;
+ for (count = 0; count < bytes; count++)
+ putc (new[count], rl_outstream);
+ _rl_last_c_pos = tempwidth;
+ _rl_last_v_pos++;
+ memset (&ps, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+ ret = mbrtowc (&wc, old, MB_CUR_MAX, &ps);
+ if (ret != 0 && bytes != 0)
+ {
+ if (MB_INVALIDCH (ret))
+ memmove (old+bytes, old+1, strlen (old+1));
+ else
+ memmove (old+bytes, old+ret, strlen (old+ret));
+ memcpy (old, new, bytes);
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ putc (' ', rl_outstream);
+ _rl_last_c_pos = 1;
+ _rl_last_v_pos++;
+ if (old[0] && new[0])
+ old[0] = new[0];
+ }
+ }
+ else
+#endif
+ {
+ if (new[0])
+ putc (new[0], rl_outstream);
+ else
+ putc (' ', rl_outstream);
+ _rl_last_c_pos = 1;
+ _rl_last_v_pos++;
+ if (old[0] && new[0])
+ old[0] = new[0];
+ }
+ }
+
+
+ /* Find first difference. */
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ {
+ /* See if the old line is a subset of the new line, so that the
+ only change is adding characters. */
+ temp = (omax < nmax) ? omax : nmax;
+ if (memcmp (old, new, temp) == 0)
+ {
+ ofd = old + temp;
+ nfd = new + temp;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ memset (&ps_new, 0, sizeof(mbstate_t));
+ memset (&ps_old, 0, sizeof(mbstate_t));
+
+ if (omax == nmax && STREQN (new, old, omax))
+ {
+ ofd = old + omax;
+ nfd = new + nmax;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ new_offset = old_offset = 0;
+ for (ofd = old, nfd = new;
+ (ofd - old < omax) && *ofd &&
+ _rl_compare_chars(old, old_offset, &ps_old, new, new_offset, &ps_new); )
+ {
+ old_offset = _rl_find_next_mbchar (old, old_offset, 1, MB_FIND_ANY);
+ new_offset = _rl_find_next_mbchar (new, new_offset, 1, MB_FIND_ANY);
+ ofd = old + old_offset;
+ nfd = new + new_offset;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ else
+#endif
+ for (ofd = old, nfd = new;
+ (ofd - old < omax) && *ofd && (*ofd == *nfd);
+ ofd++, nfd++)
+ ;
+
+ /* Move to the end of the screen line. ND and OD are used to keep track
+ of the distance between ne and new and oe and old, respectively, to
+ move a subtraction out of each loop. */
+ for (od = ofd - old, oe = ofd; od < omax && *oe; oe++, od++);
+ for (nd = nfd - new, ne = nfd; nd < nmax && *ne; ne++, nd++);
+
+ /* If no difference, continue to next line. */
+ if (ofd == oe && nfd == ne)
+ return;
+
+ wsatend = 1; /* flag for trailing whitespace */
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ {
+ ols = old + _rl_find_prev_mbchar (old, oe - old, MB_FIND_ANY);
+ nls = new + _rl_find_prev_mbchar (new, ne - new, MB_FIND_ANY);
+ while ((ols > ofd) && (nls > nfd))
+ {
+ memset (&ps_old, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+ memset (&ps_new, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+
+#if 0
+ /* On advice from jir@yamato.ibm.com */
+ _rl_adjust_point (old, ols - old, &ps_old);
+ _rl_adjust_point (new, nls - new, &ps_new);
+#endif
+
+ if (_rl_compare_chars (old, ols - old, &ps_old, new, nls - new, &ps_new) == 0)
+ break;
+
+ if (*ols == ' ')
+ wsatend = 0;
+
+ ols = old + _rl_find_prev_mbchar (old, ols - old, MB_FIND_ANY);
+ nls = new + _rl_find_prev_mbchar (new, nls - new, MB_FIND_ANY);
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+#endif /* HANDLE_MULTIBYTE */
+ ols = oe - 1; /* find last same */
+ nls = ne - 1;
+ while ((ols > ofd) && (nls > nfd) && (*ols == *nls))
+ {
+ if (*ols != ' ')
+ wsatend = 0;
+ ols--;
+ nls--;
+ }
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ }
+#endif
+
+ if (wsatend)
+ {
+ ols = oe;
+ nls = ne;
+ }
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ /* This may not work for stateful encoding, but who cares? To handle
+ stateful encoding properly, we have to scan each string from the
+ beginning and compare. */
+ else if (_rl_compare_chars (ols, 0, NULL, nls, 0, NULL) == 0)
+#else
+ else if (*ols != *nls)
+#endif
+ {
+ if (*ols) /* don't step past the NUL */
+ {
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ ols = old + _rl_find_next_mbchar (old, ols - old, 1, MB_FIND_ANY);
+ else
+ ols++;
+ }
+ if (*nls)
+ {
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ nls = new + _rl_find_next_mbchar (new, nls - new, 1, MB_FIND_ANY);
+ else
+ nls++;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* count of invisible characters in the current invisible line. */
+ current_invis_chars = W_OFFSET (current_line, wrap_offset);
+ if (_rl_last_v_pos != current_line)
+ {
+ _rl_move_vert (current_line);
+ if ((MB_CUR_MAX == 1 || rl_byte_oriented) && current_line == 0 && visible_wrap_offset)
+ _rl_last_c_pos += visible_wrap_offset;
+ }
+
+ /* If this is the first line and there are invisible characters in the
+ prompt string, and the prompt string has not changed, and the current
+ cursor position is before the last invisible character in the prompt,
+ and the index of the character to move to is past the end of the prompt
+ string, then redraw the entire prompt string. We can only do this
+ reliably if the terminal supports a `cr' capability.
+
+ This is not an efficiency hack -- there is a problem with redrawing
+ portions of the prompt string if they contain terminal escape
+ sequences (like drawing the `unbold' sequence without a corresponding
+ `bold') that manifests itself on certain terminals. */
+
+ lendiff = local_prompt ? strlen (local_prompt) : 0;
+ od = ofd - old; /* index of first difference in visible line */
+ if (current_line == 0 && !_rl_horizontal_scroll_mode &&
+ _rl_term_cr && lendiff > prompt_visible_length && _rl_last_c_pos > 0 &&
+ od >= lendiff && _rl_last_c_pos <= prompt_last_invisible)
+ {
+#if defined (__MSDOS__)
+ putc ('\r', rl_outstream);
+#else
+ tputs (_rl_term_cr, 1, _rl_output_character_function);
+#endif
+ _rl_output_some_chars (local_prompt, lendiff);
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ {
+ /* We take wrap_offset into account here so we can pass correct
+ information to _rl_move_cursor_relative. */
+ _rl_last_c_pos = _rl_col_width (local_prompt, 0, lendiff) - wrap_offset;
+ cpos_adjusted = 1;
+ }
+ else
+ _rl_last_c_pos = lendiff;
+ }
+
+ _rl_move_cursor_relative (od, old);
+
+ /* if (len (new) > len (old))
+ lendiff == difference in buffer
+ col_lendiff == difference on screen
+ When not using multibyte characters, these are equal */
+ lendiff = (nls - nfd) - (ols - ofd);
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ col_lendiff = _rl_col_width (new, nfd - new, nls - new) - _rl_col_width (old, ofd - old, ols - old);
+ else
+ col_lendiff = lendiff;
+
+ /* If we are changing the number of invisible characters in a line, and
+ the spot of first difference is before the end of the invisible chars,
+ lendiff needs to be adjusted. */
+ if (current_line == 0 && !_rl_horizontal_scroll_mode &&
+ current_invis_chars != visible_wrap_offset)
+ {
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ {
+ lendiff += visible_wrap_offset - current_invis_chars;
+ col_lendiff += visible_wrap_offset - current_invis_chars;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ lendiff += visible_wrap_offset - current_invis_chars;
+ col_lendiff = lendiff;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Insert (diff (len (old), len (new)) ch. */
+ temp = ne - nfd;
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ col_temp = _rl_col_width (new, nfd - new, ne - new);
+ else
+ col_temp = temp;
+
+ if (col_lendiff > 0) /* XXX - was lendiff */
+ {
+ /* Non-zero if we're increasing the number of lines. */
+ int gl = current_line >= _rl_vis_botlin && inv_botlin > _rl_vis_botlin;
+ /* Sometimes it is cheaper to print the characters rather than
+ use the terminal's capabilities. If we're growing the number
+ of lines, make sure we actually cause the new line to wrap
+ around on auto-wrapping terminals. */
+ if (_rl_terminal_can_insert && ((2 * col_temp) >= col_lendiff || _rl_term_IC) && (!_rl_term_autowrap || !gl))
+ {
+ /* If lendiff > prompt_visible_length and _rl_last_c_pos == 0 and
+ _rl_horizontal_scroll_mode == 1, inserting the characters with
+ _rl_term_IC or _rl_term_ic will screw up the screen because of the
+ invisible characters. We need to just draw them. */
+ if (*ols && (!_rl_horizontal_scroll_mode || _rl_last_c_pos > 0 ||
+ lendiff <= prompt_visible_length || !current_invis_chars))
+ {
+ insert_some_chars (nfd, lendiff, col_lendiff);
+ _rl_last_c_pos += col_lendiff;
+ }
+ else if ((MB_CUR_MAX == 1 || rl_byte_oriented != 0) && *ols == 0 && lendiff > 0)
+ {
+ /* At the end of a line the characters do not have to
+ be "inserted". They can just be placed on the screen. */
+ /* However, this screws up the rest of this block, which
+ assumes you've done the insert because you can. */
+ _rl_output_some_chars (nfd, lendiff);
+ _rl_last_c_pos += col_lendiff;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* We have horizontal scrolling and we are not inserting at
+ the end. We have invisible characters in this line. This
+ is a dumb update. */
+ _rl_output_some_chars (nfd, temp);
+ _rl_last_c_pos += col_temp;
+ return;
+ }
+ /* Copy (new) chars to screen from first diff to last match. */
+ temp = nls - nfd;
+ if ((temp - lendiff) > 0)
+ {
+ _rl_output_some_chars (nfd + lendiff, temp - lendiff);
+#if 1
+ /* XXX -- this bears closer inspection. Fixes a redisplay bug
+ reported against bash-3.0-alpha by Andreas Schwab involving
+ multibyte characters and prompt strings with invisible
+ characters, but was previously disabled. */
+ _rl_last_c_pos += _rl_col_width (nfd+lendiff, 0, temp-col_lendiff);
+#else
+ _rl_last_c_pos += _rl_col_width (nfd+lendiff, 0, temp-lendiff);
+#endif
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* cannot insert chars, write to EOL */
+ _rl_output_some_chars (nfd, temp);
+ _rl_last_c_pos += col_temp;
+ /* If we're in a multibyte locale and were before the last invisible
+ char in the current line (which implies we just output some invisible
+ characters) we need to adjust _rl_last_c_pos, since it represents
+ a physical character position. */
+ }
+ }
+ else /* Delete characters from line. */
+ {
+ /* If possible and inexpensive to use terminal deletion, then do so. */
+ if (_rl_term_dc && (2 * col_temp) >= -col_lendiff)
+ {
+ /* If all we're doing is erasing the invisible characters in the
+ prompt string, don't bother. It screws up the assumptions
+ about what's on the screen. */
+ if (_rl_horizontal_scroll_mode && _rl_last_c_pos == 0 &&
+ -lendiff == visible_wrap_offset)
+ col_lendiff = 0;
+
+ if (col_lendiff)
+ delete_chars (-col_lendiff); /* delete (diff) characters */
+
+ /* Copy (new) chars to screen from first diff to last match */
+ temp = nls - nfd;
+ if (temp > 0)
+ {
+ _rl_output_some_chars (nfd, temp);
+ _rl_last_c_pos += _rl_col_width (nfd, 0, temp);;
+ }
+ }
+ /* Otherwise, print over the existing material. */
+ else
+ {
+ if (temp > 0)
+ {
+ _rl_output_some_chars (nfd, temp);
+ _rl_last_c_pos += col_temp; /* XXX */
+ }
+ lendiff = (oe - old) - (ne - new);
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ col_lendiff = _rl_col_width (old, 0, oe - old) - _rl_col_width (new, 0, ne - new);
+ else
+ col_lendiff = lendiff;
+
+ if (col_lendiff)
+ {
+ if (_rl_term_autowrap && current_line < inv_botlin)
+ space_to_eol (col_lendiff);
+ else
+ _rl_clear_to_eol (col_lendiff);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+/* Tell the update routines that we have moved onto a new (empty) line. */
+int
+rl_on_new_line ()
+{
+ if (visible_line)
+ visible_line[0] = '\0';
+
+ _rl_last_c_pos = _rl_last_v_pos = 0;
+ _rl_vis_botlin = last_lmargin = 0;
+ if (vis_lbreaks)
+ vis_lbreaks[0] = vis_lbreaks[1] = 0;
+ visible_wrap_offset = 0;
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Tell the update routines that we have moved onto a new line with the
+ prompt already displayed. Code originally from the version of readline
+ distributed with CLISP. rl_expand_prompt must have already been called
+ (explicitly or implicitly). This still doesn't work exactly right. */
+int
+rl_on_new_line_with_prompt ()
+{
+ int prompt_size, i, l, real_screenwidth, newlines;
+ char *prompt_last_line, *lprompt;
+
+ /* Initialize visible_line and invisible_line to ensure that they can hold
+ the already-displayed prompt. */
+ prompt_size = strlen (rl_prompt) + 1;
+ init_line_structures (prompt_size);
+
+ /* Make sure the line structures hold the already-displayed prompt for
+ redisplay. */
+ lprompt = local_prompt ? local_prompt : rl_prompt;
+ strcpy (visible_line, lprompt);
+ strcpy (invisible_line, lprompt);
+
+ /* If the prompt contains newlines, take the last tail. */
+ prompt_last_line = strrchr (rl_prompt, '\n');
+ if (!prompt_last_line)
+ prompt_last_line = rl_prompt;
+
+ l = strlen (prompt_last_line);
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ _rl_last_c_pos = _rl_col_width (prompt_last_line, 0, l); /* XXX */
+ else
+ _rl_last_c_pos = l;
+
+ /* Dissect prompt_last_line into screen lines. Note that here we have
+ to use the real screenwidth. Readline's notion of screenwidth might be
+ one less, see terminal.c. */
+ real_screenwidth = _rl_screenwidth + (_rl_term_autowrap ? 0 : 1);
+ _rl_last_v_pos = l / real_screenwidth;
+ /* If the prompt length is a multiple of real_screenwidth, we don't know
+ whether the cursor is at the end of the last line, or already at the
+ beginning of the next line. Output a newline just to be safe. */
+ if (l > 0 && (l % real_screenwidth) == 0)
+ _rl_output_some_chars ("\n", 1);
+ last_lmargin = 0;
+
+ newlines = 0; i = 0;
+ while (i <= l)
+ {
+ _rl_vis_botlin = newlines;
+ vis_lbreaks[newlines++] = i;
+ i += real_screenwidth;
+ }
+ vis_lbreaks[newlines] = l;
+ visible_wrap_offset = 0;
+
+ rl_display_prompt = rl_prompt; /* XXX - make sure it's set */
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Actually update the display, period. */
+int
+rl_forced_update_display ()
+{
+ if (visible_line)
+ {
+ register char *temp = visible_line;
+
+ while (*temp)
+ *temp++ = '\0';
+ }
+ rl_on_new_line ();
+ forced_display++;
+ (*rl_redisplay_function) ();
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Move the cursor from _rl_last_c_pos to NEW, which are buffer indices.
+ (Well, when we don't have multibyte characters, _rl_last_c_pos is a
+ buffer index.)
+ DATA is the contents of the screen line of interest; i.e., where
+ the movement is being done. */
+void
+_rl_move_cursor_relative (new, data)
+ int new;
+ const char *data;
+{
+ register int i;
+ int woff; /* number of invisible chars on current line */
+ int cpos, dpos; /* current and desired cursor positions */
+
+ woff = W_OFFSET (_rl_last_v_pos, wrap_offset);
+ cpos = _rl_last_c_pos;
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ /* If we have multibyte characters, NEW is indexed by the buffer point in
+ a multibyte string, but _rl_last_c_pos is the display position. In
+ this case, NEW's display position is not obvious and must be
+ calculated. We need to account for invisible characters in this line,
+ as long as we are past them and they are counted by _rl_col_width. */
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ {
+ dpos = _rl_col_width (data, 0, new);
+ if (dpos > woff)
+ dpos -= woff;
+ }
+ else
+#endif
+ dpos = new;
+
+ /* If we don't have to do anything, then return. */
+ if (cpos == dpos)
+ return;
+
+ /* It may be faster to output a CR, and then move forwards instead
+ of moving backwards. */
+ /* i == current physical cursor position. */
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ i = _rl_last_c_pos;
+ else
+#endif
+ i = _rl_last_c_pos - woff;
+ if (new == 0 || CR_FASTER (new, _rl_last_c_pos) ||
+ (_rl_term_autowrap && i == _rl_screenwidth))
+ {
+#if defined (__MSDOS__)
+ putc ('\r', rl_outstream);
+#else
+ tputs (_rl_term_cr, 1, _rl_output_character_function);
+#endif /* !__MSDOS__ */
+ cpos = _rl_last_c_pos = 0;
+ }
+
+ if (cpos < dpos)
+ {
+ /* Move the cursor forward. We do it by printing the command
+ to move the cursor forward if there is one, else print that
+ portion of the output buffer again. Which is cheaper? */
+
+ /* The above comment is left here for posterity. It is faster
+ to print one character (non-control) than to print a control
+ sequence telling the terminal to move forward one character.
+ That kind of control is for people who don't know what the
+ data is underneath the cursor. */
+#if defined (HACK_TERMCAP_MOTION)
+ if (_rl_term_forward_char)
+ {
+ for (i = cpos; i < dpos; i++)
+ tputs (_rl_term_forward_char, 1, _rl_output_character_function);
+ }
+ else
+#endif /* HACK_TERMCAP_MOTION */
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ {
+ tputs (_rl_term_cr, 1, _rl_output_character_function);
+ for (i = 0; i < new; i++)
+ putc (data[i], rl_outstream);
+ }
+ else
+ for (i = cpos; i < new; i++)
+ putc (data[i], rl_outstream);
+ }
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ /* NEW points to the buffer point, but _rl_last_c_pos is the display point.
+ The byte length of the string is probably bigger than the column width
+ of the string, which means that if NEW == _rl_last_c_pos, then NEW's
+ display point is less than _rl_last_c_pos. */
+#endif
+ else if (cpos > dpos)
+ _rl_backspace (cpos - dpos);
+
+ _rl_last_c_pos = dpos;
+}
+
+/* PWP: move the cursor up or down. */
+void
+_rl_move_vert (to)
+ int to;
+{
+ register int delta, i;
+
+ if (_rl_last_v_pos == to || to > _rl_screenheight)
+ return;
+
+ if ((delta = to - _rl_last_v_pos) > 0)
+ {
+ for (i = 0; i < delta; i++)
+ putc ('\n', rl_outstream);
+#if defined (__MSDOS__)
+ putc ('\r', rl_outstream);
+#else
+ tputs (_rl_term_cr, 1, _rl_output_character_function);
+#endif
+ _rl_last_c_pos = 0;
+ }
+ else
+ { /* delta < 0 */
+ if (_rl_term_up && *_rl_term_up)
+ for (i = 0; i < -delta; i++)
+ tputs (_rl_term_up, 1, _rl_output_character_function);
+ }
+
+ _rl_last_v_pos = to; /* Now TO is here */
+}
+
+/* Physically print C on rl_outstream. This is for functions which know
+ how to optimize the display. Return the number of characters output. */
+int
+rl_show_char (c)
+ int c;
+{
+ int n = 1;
+ if (META_CHAR (c) && (_rl_output_meta_chars == 0))
+ {
+ fprintf (rl_outstream, "M-");
+ n += 2;
+ c = UNMETA (c);
+ }
+
+#if defined (DISPLAY_TABS)
+ if ((CTRL_CHAR (c) && c != '\t') || c == RUBOUT)
+#else
+ if (CTRL_CHAR (c) || c == RUBOUT)
+#endif /* !DISPLAY_TABS */
+ {
+ fprintf (rl_outstream, "C-");
+ n += 2;
+ c = CTRL_CHAR (c) ? UNCTRL (c) : '?';
+ }
+
+ putc (c, rl_outstream);
+ fflush (rl_outstream);
+ return n;
+}
+
+int
+rl_character_len (c, pos)
+ register int c, pos;
+{
+ unsigned char uc;
+
+ uc = (unsigned char)c;
+
+ if (META_CHAR (uc))
+ return ((_rl_output_meta_chars == 0) ? 4 : 1);
+
+ if (uc == '\t')
+ {
+#if defined (DISPLAY_TABS)
+ return (((pos | 7) + 1) - pos);
+#else
+ return (2);
+#endif /* !DISPLAY_TABS */
+ }
+
+ if (CTRL_CHAR (c) || c == RUBOUT)
+ return (2);
+
+ return ((ISPRINT (uc)) ? 1 : 2);
+}
+/* How to print things in the "echo-area". The prompt is treated as a
+ mini-modeline. */
+static int msg_saved_prompt = 0;
+
+#if defined (USE_VARARGS)
+int
+#if defined (PREFER_STDARG)
+rl_message (const char *format, ...)
+#else
+rl_message (va_alist)
+ va_dcl
+#endif
+{
+ va_list args;
+#if defined (PREFER_VARARGS)
+ char *format;
+#endif
+
+#if defined (PREFER_STDARG)
+ va_start (args, format);
+#else
+ va_start (args);
+ format = va_arg (args, char *);
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_VSNPRINTF)
+ vsnprintf (msg_buf, sizeof (msg_buf) - 1, format, args);
+#else
+ vsprintf (msg_buf, format, args);
+ msg_buf[sizeof(msg_buf) - 1] = '\0'; /* overflow? */
+#endif
+ va_end (args);
+
+ if (saved_local_prompt == 0)
+ {
+ rl_save_prompt ();
+ msg_saved_prompt = 1;
+ }
+ rl_display_prompt = msg_buf;
+ local_prompt = expand_prompt (msg_buf, &prompt_visible_length,
+ &prompt_last_invisible,
+ &prompt_invis_chars_first_line,
+ &prompt_physical_chars);
+ local_prompt_prefix = (char *)NULL;
+ (*rl_redisplay_function) ();
+
+ return 0;
+}
+#else /* !USE_VARARGS */
+int
+rl_message (format, arg1, arg2)
+ char *format;
+{
+ sprintf (msg_buf, format, arg1, arg2);
+ msg_buf[sizeof(msg_buf) - 1] = '\0'; /* overflow? */
+
+ rl_display_prompt = msg_buf;
+ if (saved_local_prompt == 0)
+ {
+ rl_save_prompt ();
+ msg_saved_prompt = 1;
+ }
+ local_prompt = expand_prompt (msg_buf, &prompt_visible_length,
+ &prompt_last_invisible,
+ &prompt_invis_chars_first_line,
+ &prompt_physical_chars);
+ local_prompt_prefix = (char *)NULL;
+ (*rl_redisplay_function) ();
+
+ return 0;
+}
+#endif /* !USE_VARARGS */
+
+/* How to clear things from the "echo-area". */
+int
+rl_clear_message ()
+{
+ rl_display_prompt = rl_prompt;
+ if (msg_saved_prompt)
+ {
+ rl_restore_prompt ();
+ msg_saved_prompt = 0;
+ }
+ (*rl_redisplay_function) ();
+ return 0;
+}
+
+int
+rl_reset_line_state ()
+{
+ rl_on_new_line ();
+
+ rl_display_prompt = rl_prompt ? rl_prompt : "";
+ forced_display = 1;
+ return 0;
+}
+
+void
+rl_save_prompt ()
+{
+ saved_local_prompt = local_prompt;
+ saved_local_prefix = local_prompt_prefix;
+ saved_prefix_length = prompt_prefix_length;
+ saved_last_invisible = prompt_last_invisible;
+ saved_visible_length = prompt_visible_length;
+ saved_invis_chars_first_line = prompt_invis_chars_first_line;
+ saved_physical_chars = prompt_physical_chars;
+
+ local_prompt = local_prompt_prefix = (char *)0;
+ prompt_last_invisible = prompt_visible_length = prompt_prefix_length = 0;
+ prompt_invis_chars_first_line = prompt_physical_chars = 0;
+}
+
+void
+rl_restore_prompt ()
+{
+ FREE (local_prompt);
+ FREE (local_prompt_prefix);
+
+ local_prompt = saved_local_prompt;
+ local_prompt_prefix = saved_local_prefix;
+ prompt_prefix_length = saved_prefix_length;
+ prompt_last_invisible = saved_last_invisible;
+ prompt_visible_length = saved_visible_length;
+ prompt_invis_chars_first_line = saved_invis_chars_first_line;
+ prompt_physical_chars = saved_physical_chars;
+
+ /* can test saved_local_prompt to see if prompt info has been saved. */
+ saved_local_prompt = saved_local_prefix = (char *)0;
+ saved_last_invisible = saved_visible_length = saved_prefix_length = 0;
+ saved_invis_chars_first_line = saved_physical_chars = 0;
+}
+
+char *
+_rl_make_prompt_for_search (pchar)
+ int pchar;
+{
+ int len;
+ char *pmt;
+
+ rl_save_prompt ();
+
+ if (saved_local_prompt == 0)
+ {
+ len = (rl_prompt && *rl_prompt) ? strlen (rl_prompt) : 0;
+ pmt = (char *)xmalloc (len + 2);
+ if (len)
+ strcpy (pmt, rl_prompt);
+ pmt[len] = pchar;
+ pmt[len+1] = '\0';
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ len = *saved_local_prompt ? strlen (saved_local_prompt) : 0;
+ pmt = (char *)xmalloc (len + 2);
+ if (len)
+ strcpy (pmt, saved_local_prompt);
+ pmt[len] = pchar;
+ pmt[len+1] = '\0';
+ local_prompt = savestring (pmt);
+ prompt_last_invisible = saved_last_invisible;
+ prompt_visible_length = saved_visible_length + 1;
+ }
+
+ prompt_physical_chars = saved_physical_chars + 1;
+
+ return pmt;
+}
+
+/* Quick redisplay hack when erasing characters at the end of the line. */
+void
+_rl_erase_at_end_of_line (l)
+ int l;
+{
+ register int i;
+
+ _rl_backspace (l);
+ for (i = 0; i < l; i++)
+ putc (' ', rl_outstream);
+ _rl_backspace (l);
+ for (i = 0; i < l; i++)
+ visible_line[--_rl_last_c_pos] = '\0';
+ rl_display_fixed++;
+}
+
+/* Clear to the end of the line. COUNT is the minimum
+ number of character spaces to clear, */
+void
+_rl_clear_to_eol (count)
+ int count;
+{
+ if (_rl_term_clreol)
+ tputs (_rl_term_clreol, 1, _rl_output_character_function);
+ else if (count)
+ space_to_eol (count);
+}
+
+/* Clear to the end of the line using spaces. COUNT is the minimum
+ number of character spaces to clear, */
+static void
+space_to_eol (count)
+ int count;
+{
+ register int i;
+
+ for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
+ putc (' ', rl_outstream);
+
+ _rl_last_c_pos += count;
+}
+
+void
+_rl_clear_screen ()
+{
+ if (_rl_term_clrpag)
+ tputs (_rl_term_clrpag, 1, _rl_output_character_function);
+ else
+ rl_crlf ();
+}
+
+/* Insert COUNT characters from STRING to the output stream at column COL. */
+static void
+insert_some_chars (string, count, col)
+ char *string;
+ int count, col;
+{
+#if defined (__MSDOS__) || defined (__MINGW32__)
+ _rl_output_some_chars (string, count);
+#else
+ /* DEBUGGING */
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX == 1 || rl_byte_oriented)
+ if (count != col)
+ fprintf(stderr, "readline: debug: insert_some_chars: count (%d) != col (%d)\n", count, col);
+
+ /* If IC is defined, then we do not have to "enter" insert mode. */
+ if (_rl_term_IC)
+ {
+ char *buffer;
+
+ buffer = tgoto (_rl_term_IC, 0, col);
+ tputs (buffer, 1, _rl_output_character_function);
+ _rl_output_some_chars (string, count);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ register int i;
+
+ /* If we have to turn on insert-mode, then do so. */
+ if (_rl_term_im && *_rl_term_im)
+ tputs (_rl_term_im, 1, _rl_output_character_function);
+
+ /* If there is a special command for inserting characters, then
+ use that first to open up the space. */
+ if (_rl_term_ic && *_rl_term_ic)
+ {
+ for (i = col; i--; )
+ tputs (_rl_term_ic, 1, _rl_output_character_function);
+ }
+
+ /* Print the text. */
+ _rl_output_some_chars (string, count);
+
+ /* If there is a string to turn off insert mode, we had best use
+ it now. */
+ if (_rl_term_ei && *_rl_term_ei)
+ tputs (_rl_term_ei, 1, _rl_output_character_function);
+ }
+#endif /* __MSDOS__ || __MINGW32__ */
+}
+
+/* Delete COUNT characters from the display line. */
+static void
+delete_chars (count)
+ int count;
+{
+ if (count > _rl_screenwidth) /* XXX */
+ return;
+
+#if !defined (__MSDOS__) && !defined (__MINGW32__)
+ if (_rl_term_DC && *_rl_term_DC)
+ {
+ char *buffer;
+ buffer = tgoto (_rl_term_DC, count, count);
+ tputs (buffer, count, _rl_output_character_function);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if (_rl_term_dc && *_rl_term_dc)
+ while (count--)
+ tputs (_rl_term_dc, 1, _rl_output_character_function);
+ }
+#endif /* !__MSDOS__ && !__MINGW32__ */
+}
+
+void
+_rl_update_final ()
+{
+ int full_lines;
+
+ full_lines = 0;
+ /* If the cursor is the only thing on an otherwise-blank last line,
+ compensate so we don't print an extra CRLF. */
+ if (_rl_vis_botlin && _rl_last_c_pos == 0 &&
+ visible_line[vis_lbreaks[_rl_vis_botlin]] == 0)
+ {
+ _rl_vis_botlin--;
+ full_lines = 1;
+ }
+ _rl_move_vert (_rl_vis_botlin);
+ /* If we've wrapped lines, remove the final xterm line-wrap flag. */
+ if (full_lines && _rl_term_autowrap && (VIS_LLEN(_rl_vis_botlin) == _rl_screenwidth))
+ {
+ char *last_line;
+
+ last_line = &visible_line[vis_lbreaks[_rl_vis_botlin]];
+ _rl_move_cursor_relative (_rl_screenwidth - 1, last_line);
+ _rl_clear_to_eol (0);
+ putc (last_line[_rl_screenwidth - 1], rl_outstream);
+ }
+ _rl_vis_botlin = 0;
+ rl_crlf ();
+ fflush (rl_outstream);
+ rl_display_fixed++;
+}
+
+/* Move to the start of the current line. */
+static void
+cr ()
+{
+ if (_rl_term_cr)
+ {
+#if defined (__MSDOS__)
+ putc ('\r', rl_outstream);
+#else
+ tputs (_rl_term_cr, 1, _rl_output_character_function);
+#endif
+ _rl_last_c_pos = 0;
+ }
+}
+
+/* Redraw the last line of a multi-line prompt that may possibly contain
+ terminal escape sequences. Called with the cursor at column 0 of the
+ line to draw the prompt on. */
+static void
+redraw_prompt (t)
+ char *t;
+{
+ char *oldp;
+
+ oldp = rl_display_prompt;
+ rl_save_prompt ();
+
+ rl_display_prompt = t;
+ local_prompt = expand_prompt (t, &prompt_visible_length,
+ &prompt_last_invisible,
+ &prompt_invis_chars_first_line,
+ &prompt_physical_chars);
+ local_prompt_prefix = (char *)NULL;
+
+ rl_forced_update_display ();
+
+ rl_display_prompt = oldp;
+ rl_restore_prompt();
+}
+
+/* Redisplay the current line after a SIGWINCH is received. */
+void
+_rl_redisplay_after_sigwinch ()
+{
+ char *t;
+
+ /* Clear the current line and put the cursor at column 0. Make sure
+ the right thing happens if we have wrapped to a new screen line. */
+ if (_rl_term_cr)
+ {
+#if defined (__MSDOS__)
+ putc ('\r', rl_outstream);
+#else
+ tputs (_rl_term_cr, 1, _rl_output_character_function);
+#endif
+ _rl_last_c_pos = 0;
+#if defined (__MSDOS__)
+ space_to_eol (_rl_screenwidth);
+ putc ('\r', rl_outstream);
+#else
+ if (_rl_term_clreol)
+ tputs (_rl_term_clreol, 1, _rl_output_character_function);
+ else
+ {
+ space_to_eol (_rl_screenwidth);
+ tputs (_rl_term_cr, 1, _rl_output_character_function);
+ }
+#endif
+ if (_rl_last_v_pos > 0)
+ _rl_move_vert (0);
+ }
+ else
+ rl_crlf ();
+
+ /* Redraw only the last line of a multi-line prompt. */
+ t = strrchr (rl_display_prompt, '\n');
+ if (t)
+ redraw_prompt (++t);
+ else
+ rl_forced_update_display ();
+}
+
+void
+_rl_clean_up_for_exit ()
+{
+ if (readline_echoing_p)
+ {
+ _rl_move_vert (_rl_vis_botlin);
+ _rl_vis_botlin = 0;
+ fflush (rl_outstream);
+ rl_restart_output (1, 0);
+ }
+}
+
+void
+_rl_erase_entire_line ()
+{
+ cr ();
+ _rl_clear_to_eol (0);
+ cr ();
+ fflush (rl_outstream);
+}
+
+/* return the `current display line' of the cursor -- the number of lines to
+ move up to get to the first screen line of the current readline line. */
+int
+_rl_current_display_line ()
+{
+ int ret, nleft;
+
+ /* Find out whether or not there might be invisible characters in the
+ editing buffer. */
+ if (rl_display_prompt == rl_prompt)
+ nleft = _rl_last_c_pos - _rl_screenwidth - rl_visible_prompt_length;
+ else
+ nleft = _rl_last_c_pos - _rl_screenwidth;
+
+ if (nleft > 0)
+ ret = 1 + nleft / _rl_screenwidth;
+ else
+ ret = 0;
+
+ return ret;
+}
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+/* Calculate the number of screen columns occupied by STR from START to END.
+ In the case of multibyte characters with stateful encoding, we have to
+ scan from the beginning of the string to take the state into account. */
+static int
+_rl_col_width (str, start, end)
+ const char *str;
+ int start, end;
+{
+ wchar_t wc;
+ mbstate_t ps = {0};
+ int tmp, point, width, max;
+
+ if (end <= start)
+ return 0;
+
+ point = 0;
+ max = end;
+
+ while (point < start)
+ {
+ tmp = mbrlen (str + point, max, &ps);
+ if (MB_INVALIDCH ((size_t)tmp))
+ {
+ /* In this case, the bytes are invalid or too short to compose a
+ multibyte character, so we assume that the first byte represents
+ a single character. */
+ point++;
+ max--;
+
+ /* Clear the state of the byte sequence, because in this case the
+ effect of mbstate is undefined. */
+ memset (&ps, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+ }
+ else if (MB_NULLWCH (tmp))
+ break; /* Found '\0' */
+ else
+ {
+ point += tmp;
+ max -= tmp;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* If START is not a byte that starts a character, then POINT will be
+ greater than START. In this case, assume that (POINT - START) gives
+ a byte count that is the number of columns of difference. */
+ width = point - start;
+
+ while (point < end)
+ {
+ tmp = mbrtowc (&wc, str + point, max, &ps);
+ if (MB_INVALIDCH ((size_t)tmp))
+ {
+ /* In this case, the bytes are invalid or too short to compose a
+ multibyte character, so we assume that the first byte represents
+ a single character. */
+ point++;
+ max--;
+
+ /* and assume that the byte occupies a single column. */
+ width++;
+
+ /* Clear the state of the byte sequence, because in this case the
+ effect of mbstate is undefined. */
+ memset (&ps, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+ }
+ else if (MB_NULLWCH (tmp))
+ break; /* Found '\0' */
+ else
+ {
+ point += tmp;
+ max -= tmp;
+ tmp = wcwidth(wc);
+ width += (tmp >= 0) ? tmp : 1;
+ }
+ }
+
+ width += point - end;
+
+ return width;
+}
+#endif /* HANDLE_MULTIBYTE */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/Makefile b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..817c2af
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,144 @@
+# Derived by hand from the generated readline-src/doc/Makefile
+# This makefile for Readline library documentation is in -*- text -*- mode.
+# Emacs likes it that way.
+
+# Copyright (C) 1996-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+#
+# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+# any later version.
+#
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+# GNU General Public License for more details.
+#
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA.
+
+topdir = .
+srcdir = .
+VPATH = .
+
+prefix = /usr/local
+infodir = ${prefix}/info
+
+mandir = ${prefix}/man
+manpfx = man
+
+man1ext = 1
+man1dir = $(mandir)/$(manpfx)$(man1ext)
+man3ext = 3
+man3dir = $(mandir)/$(manpfx)$(man3ext)
+
+SHELL = /bin/sh
+RM = rm -f
+
+INSTALL = /usr/bin/install -c
+INSTALL_DATA = ${INSTALL} -m 644
+
+BUILD_DIR = .
+TEXINPUTDIR = $(srcdir)
+
+MAKEINFO = LANGUAGE= makeinfo
+TEXI2DVI = $(srcdir)/texi2dvi
+TEXI2HTML = $(srcdir)/texi2html
+QUIETPS = #set this to -q to shut up dvips
+PSDPI = 300 # I don't have any 600-dpi printers
+DVIPS = dvips -D ${PSDPI} $(QUIETPS) -o $@ # tricky
+
+RLSRC = $(srcdir)/rlman.texi $(srcdir)/rluser.texi \
+ $(srcdir)/rltech.texi $(srcdir)/version.texi \
+ $(srcdir)/rluserman.texi
+HISTSRC = $(srcdir)/history.texi $(srcdir)/hsuser.texi \
+ $(srcdir)/hstech.texi $(srcdir)/version.texi
+
+# This should be a program that converts troff to an ascii-readable format
+NROFF = groff -Tascii
+
+# This should be a program that converts troff to postscript
+GROFF = groff
+
+DVIOBJ = readline.dvi history.dvi rluserman.dvi
+INFOOBJ = readline.info history.info rluserman.info
+PSOBJ = readline.ps history.ps rluserman.ps
+HTMLOBJ = readline.html history.html rluserman.html
+
+INTERMEDIATE_OBJ = rlman.dvi
+
+CREATED_DOCS = $(DVIOBJ) $(INFOOBJ) $(PSOBJ) $(HTMLOBJ)
+
+.SUFFIXES: .ps .txt .dvi
+
+all: info dvi html ps
+nodvi: info html
+
+readline.dvi: $(RLSRC)
+ TEXINPUTS=.:$(TEXINPUTDIR):$$TEXINPUTS $(TEXI2DVI) $(srcdir)/rlman.texi
+ mv rlman.dvi readline.dvi
+
+readline.info: $(RLSRC)
+ $(MAKEINFO) --no-split -I $(TEXINPUTDIR) -o $@ $(srcdir)/rlman.texi
+
+rluserman.dvi: $(RLSRC)
+ TEXINPUTS=.:$(TEXINPUTDIR):$$TEXINPUTS $(TEXI2DVI) $(srcdir)/rluserman.texi
+
+rluserman.info: $(RLSRC)
+ $(MAKEINFO) --no-split -I $(TEXINPUTDIR) -o $@ $(srcdir)/rluserman.texi
+
+history.dvi: ${HISTSRC}
+ TEXINPUTS=.:$(TEXINPUTDIR):$$TEXINPUTS $(TEXI2DVI) $(srcdir)/history.texi
+
+history.info: ${HISTSRC}
+ $(MAKEINFO) --no-split -I $(TEXINPUTDIR) -o $@ $(srcdir)/history.texi
+
+readline.ps: readline.dvi
+ $(RM) $@
+ $(DVIPS) readline.dvi
+
+rluserman.ps: rluserman.dvi
+ $(RM) $@
+ $(DVIPS) rluserman.dvi
+
+history.ps: history.dvi
+ $(RM) $@
+ $(DVIPS) history.dvi
+
+readline.html: ${RLSRC}
+ $(TEXI2HTML) -menu -monolithic -I $(TEXINPUTDIR) $(srcdir)/rlman.texi
+ sed -e 's:rlman.html:readline.html:' rlman.html > readline.html
+ $(RM) rlman.html
+
+rluserman.html: ${RLSRC}
+ $(TEXI2HTML) -menu -monolithic -I $(TEXINPUTDIR) $(srcdir)/rluserman.texi
+
+history.html: ${HISTSRC}
+ $(TEXI2HTML) -menu -monolithic -I $(TEXINPUTDIR) $(srcdir)/history.texi
+
+info: $(INFOOBJ)
+dvi: $(DVIOBJ)
+ps: $(PSOBJ)
+html: $(HTMLOBJ)
+
+clean:
+ $(RM) *.aux *.cp *.fn *.ky *.log *.pg *.toc *.tp *.vr *.cps *.pgs \
+ *.fns *.kys *.tps *.vrs *.o core
+
+distclean: clean
+ $(RM) $(CREATED_DOCS)
+ $(RM) $(INTERMEDIATE_OBJ)
+ $(RM) Makefile
+
+mostlyclean: clean
+
+maintainer-clean: clean
+ $(RM) $(CREATED_DOCS)
+ $(RM) $(INTERMEDIATE_OBJ)
+ $(RM) Makefile
+
+install:
+ @echo "This documentation should not be installed."
+
+uninstall:
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/fdl.texi b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/fdl.texi
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..47ead9f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/fdl.texi
@@ -0,0 +1,452 @@
+
+@node GNU Free Documentation License
+@appendixsec GNU Free Documentation License
+
+@cindex FDL, GNU Free Documentation License
+@center Version 1.2, November 2002
+
+@display
+Copyright @copyright{} 2000,2001,2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA
+
+Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
+of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
+@end display
+
+@enumerate 0
+@item
+PREAMBLE
+
+The purpose of this License is to make a manual, textbook, or other
+functional and useful document @dfn{free} in the sense of freedom: to
+assure everyone the effective freedom to copy and redistribute it,
+with or without modifying it, either commercially or noncommercially.
+Secondarily, this License preserves for the author and publisher a way
+to get credit for their work, while not being considered responsible
+for modifications made by others.
+
+This License is a kind of ``copyleft'', which means that derivative
+works of the document must themselves be free in the same sense. It
+complements the GNU General Public License, which is a copyleft
+license designed for free software.
+
+We have designed this License in order to use it for manuals for free
+software, because free software needs free documentation: a free
+program should come with manuals providing the same freedoms that the
+software does. But this License is not limited to software manuals;
+it can be used for any textual work, regardless of subject matter or
+whether it is published as a printed book. We recommend this License
+principally for works whose purpose is instruction or reference.
+
+@item
+APPLICABILITY AND DEFINITIONS
+
+This License applies to any manual or other work, in any medium, that
+contains a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it can be
+distributed under the terms of this License. Such a notice grants a
+world-wide, royalty-free license, unlimited in duration, to use that
+work under the conditions stated herein. The ``Document'', below,
+refers to any such manual or work. Any member of the public is a
+licensee, and is addressed as ``you''. You accept the license if you
+copy, modify or distribute the work in a way requiring permission
+under copyright law.
+
+A ``Modified Version'' of the Document means any work containing the
+Document or a portion of it, either copied verbatim, or with
+modifications and/or translated into another language.
+
+A ``Secondary Section'' is a named appendix or a front-matter section
+of the Document that deals exclusively with the relationship of the
+publishers or authors of the Document to the Document's overall
+subject (or to related matters) and contains nothing that could fall
+directly within that overall subject. (Thus, if the Document is in
+part a textbook of mathematics, a Secondary Section may not explain
+any mathematics.) The relationship could be a matter of historical
+connection with the subject or with related matters, or of legal,
+commercial, philosophical, ethical or political position regarding
+them.
+
+The ``Invariant Sections'' are certain Secondary Sections whose titles
+are designated, as being those of Invariant Sections, in the notice
+that says that the Document is released under this License. If a
+section does not fit the above definition of Secondary then it is not
+allowed to be designated as Invariant. The Document may contain zero
+Invariant Sections. If the Document does not identify any Invariant
+Sections then there are none.
+
+The ``Cover Texts'' are certain short passages of text that are listed,
+as Front-Cover Texts or Back-Cover Texts, in the notice that says that
+the Document is released under this License. A Front-Cover Text may
+be at most 5 words, and a Back-Cover Text may be at most 25 words.
+
+A ``Transparent'' copy of the Document means a machine-readable copy,
+represented in a format whose specification is available to the
+general public, that is suitable for revising the document
+straightforwardly with generic text editors or (for images composed of
+pixels) generic paint programs or (for drawings) some widely available
+drawing editor, and that is suitable for input to text formatters or
+for automatic translation to a variety of formats suitable for input
+to text formatters. A copy made in an otherwise Transparent file
+format whose markup, or absence of markup, has been arranged to thwart
+or discourage subsequent modification by readers is not Transparent.
+An image format is not Transparent if used for any substantial amount
+of text. A copy that is not ``Transparent'' is called ``Opaque''.
+
+Examples of suitable formats for Transparent copies include plain
+@sc{ascii} without markup, Texinfo input format, La@TeX{} input
+format, @acronym{SGML} or @acronym{XML} using a publicly available
+@acronym{DTD}, and standard-conforming simple @acronym{HTML},
+PostScript or @acronym{PDF} designed for human modification. Examples
+of transparent image formats include @acronym{PNG}, @acronym{XCF} and
+@acronym{JPG}. Opaque formats include proprietary formats that can be
+read and edited only by proprietary word processors, @acronym{SGML} or
+@acronym{XML} for which the @acronym{DTD} and/or processing tools are
+not generally available, and the machine-generated @acronym{HTML},
+PostScript or @acronym{PDF} produced by some word processors for
+output purposes only.
+
+The ``Title Page'' means, for a printed book, the title page itself,
+plus such following pages as are needed to hold, legibly, the material
+this License requires to appear in the title page. For works in
+formats which do not have any title page as such, ``Title Page'' means
+the text near the most prominent appearance of the work's title,
+preceding the beginning of the body of the text.
+
+A section ``Entitled XYZ'' means a named subunit of the Document whose
+title either is precisely XYZ or contains XYZ in parentheses following
+text that translates XYZ in another language. (Here XYZ stands for a
+specific section name mentioned below, such as ``Acknowledgements'',
+``Dedications'', ``Endorsements'', or ``History''.) To ``Preserve the Title''
+of such a section when you modify the Document means that it remains a
+section ``Entitled XYZ'' according to this definition.
+
+The Document may include Warranty Disclaimers next to the notice which
+states that this License applies to the Document. These Warranty
+Disclaimers are considered to be included by reference in this
+License, but only as regards disclaiming warranties: any other
+implication that these Warranty Disclaimers may have is void and has
+no effect on the meaning of this License.
+
+@item
+VERBATIM COPYING
+
+You may copy and distribute the Document in any medium, either
+commercially or noncommercially, provided that this License, the
+copyright notices, and the license notice saying this License applies
+to the Document are reproduced in all copies, and that you add no other
+conditions whatsoever to those of this License. You may not use
+technical measures to obstruct or control the reading or further
+copying of the copies you make or distribute. However, you may accept
+compensation in exchange for copies. If you distribute a large enough
+number of copies you must also follow the conditions in section 3.
+
+You may also lend copies, under the same conditions stated above, and
+you may publicly display copies.
+
+@item
+COPYING IN QUANTITY
+
+If you publish printed copies (or copies in media that commonly have
+printed covers) of the Document, numbering more than 100, and the
+Document's license notice requires Cover Texts, you must enclose the
+copies in covers that carry, clearly and legibly, all these Cover
+Texts: Front-Cover Texts on the front cover, and Back-Cover Texts on
+the back cover. Both covers must also clearly and legibly identify
+you as the publisher of these copies. The front cover must present
+the full title with all words of the title equally prominent and
+visible. You may add other material on the covers in addition.
+Copying with changes limited to the covers, as long as they preserve
+the title of the Document and satisfy these conditions, can be treated
+as verbatim copying in other respects.
+
+If the required texts for either cover are too voluminous to fit
+legibly, you should put the first ones listed (as many as fit
+reasonably) on the actual cover, and continue the rest onto adjacent
+pages.
+
+If you publish or distribute Opaque copies of the Document numbering
+more than 100, you must either include a machine-readable Transparent
+copy along with each Opaque copy, or state in or with each Opaque copy
+a computer-network location from which the general network-using
+public has access to download using public-standard network protocols
+a complete Transparent copy of the Document, free of added material.
+If you use the latter option, you must take reasonably prudent steps,
+when you begin distribution of Opaque copies in quantity, to ensure
+that this Transparent copy will remain thus accessible at the stated
+location until at least one year after the last time you distribute an
+Opaque copy (directly or through your agents or retailers) of that
+edition to the public.
+
+It is requested, but not required, that you contact the authors of the
+Document well before redistributing any large number of copies, to give
+them a chance to provide you with an updated version of the Document.
+
+@item
+MODIFICATIONS
+
+You may copy and distribute a Modified Version of the Document under
+the conditions of sections 2 and 3 above, provided that you release
+the Modified Version under precisely this License, with the Modified
+Version filling the role of the Document, thus licensing distribution
+and modification of the Modified Version to whoever possesses a copy
+of it. In addition, you must do these things in the Modified Version:
+
+@enumerate A
+@item
+Use in the Title Page (and on the covers, if any) a title distinct
+from that of the Document, and from those of previous versions
+(which should, if there were any, be listed in the History section
+of the Document). You may use the same title as a previous version
+if the original publisher of that version gives permission.
+
+@item
+List on the Title Page, as authors, one or more persons or entities
+responsible for authorship of the modifications in the Modified
+Version, together with at least five of the principal authors of the
+Document (all of its principal authors, if it has fewer than five),
+unless they release you from this requirement.
+
+@item
+State on the Title page the name of the publisher of the
+Modified Version, as the publisher.
+
+@item
+Preserve all the copyright notices of the Document.
+
+@item
+Add an appropriate copyright notice for your modifications
+adjacent to the other copyright notices.
+
+@item
+Include, immediately after the copyright notices, a license notice
+giving the public permission to use the Modified Version under the
+terms of this License, in the form shown in the Addendum below.
+
+@item
+Preserve in that license notice the full lists of Invariant Sections
+and required Cover Texts given in the Document's license notice.
+
+@item
+Include an unaltered copy of this License.
+
+@item
+Preserve the section Entitled ``History'', Preserve its Title, and add
+to it an item stating at least the title, year, new authors, and
+publisher of the Modified Version as given on the Title Page. If
+there is no section Entitled ``History'' in the Document, create one
+stating the title, year, authors, and publisher of the Document as
+given on its Title Page, then add an item describing the Modified
+Version as stated in the previous sentence.
+
+@item
+Preserve the network location, if any, given in the Document for
+public access to a Transparent copy of the Document, and likewise
+the network locations given in the Document for previous versions
+it was based on. These may be placed in the ``History'' section.
+You may omit a network location for a work that was published at
+least four years before the Document itself, or if the original
+publisher of the version it refers to gives permission.
+
+@item
+For any section Entitled ``Acknowledgements'' or ``Dedications'', Preserve
+the Title of the section, and preserve in the section all the
+substance and tone of each of the contributor acknowledgements and/or
+dedications given therein.
+
+@item
+Preserve all the Invariant Sections of the Document,
+unaltered in their text and in their titles. Section numbers
+or the equivalent are not considered part of the section titles.
+
+@item
+Delete any section Entitled ``Endorsements''. Such a section
+may not be included in the Modified Version.
+
+@item
+Do not retitle any existing section to be Entitled ``Endorsements'' or
+to conflict in title with any Invariant Section.
+
+@item
+Preserve any Warranty Disclaimers.
+@end enumerate
+
+If the Modified Version includes new front-matter sections or
+appendices that qualify as Secondary Sections and contain no material
+copied from the Document, you may at your option designate some or all
+of these sections as invariant. To do this, add their titles to the
+list of Invariant Sections in the Modified Version's license notice.
+These titles must be distinct from any other section titles.
+
+You may add a section Entitled ``Endorsements'', provided it contains
+nothing but endorsements of your Modified Version by various
+parties---for example, statements of peer review or that the text has
+been approved by an organization as the authoritative definition of a
+standard.
+
+You may add a passage of up to five words as a Front-Cover Text, and a
+passage of up to 25 words as a Back-Cover Text, to the end of the list
+of Cover Texts in the Modified Version. Only one passage of
+Front-Cover Text and one of Back-Cover Text may be added by (or
+through arrangements made by) any one entity. If the Document already
+includes a cover text for the same cover, previously added by you or
+by arrangement made by the same entity you are acting on behalf of,
+you may not add another; but you may replace the old one, on explicit
+permission from the previous publisher that added the old one.
+
+The author(s) and publisher(s) of the Document do not by this License
+give permission to use their names for publicity for or to assert or
+imply endorsement of any Modified Version.
+
+@item
+COMBINING DOCUMENTS
+
+You may combine the Document with other documents released under this
+License, under the terms defined in section 4 above for modified
+versions, provided that you include in the combination all of the
+Invariant Sections of all of the original documents, unmodified, and
+list them all as Invariant Sections of your combined work in its
+license notice, and that you preserve all their Warranty Disclaimers.
+
+The combined work need only contain one copy of this License, and
+multiple identical Invariant Sections may be replaced with a single
+copy. If there are multiple Invariant Sections with the same name but
+different contents, make the title of each such section unique by
+adding at the end of it, in parentheses, the name of the original
+author or publisher of that section if known, or else a unique number.
+Make the same adjustment to the section titles in the list of
+Invariant Sections in the license notice of the combined work.
+
+In the combination, you must combine any sections Entitled ``History''
+in the various original documents, forming one section Entitled
+``History''; likewise combine any sections Entitled ``Acknowledgements'',
+and any sections Entitled ``Dedications''. You must delete all
+sections Entitled ``Endorsements.''
+
+@item
+COLLECTIONS OF DOCUMENTS
+
+You may make a collection consisting of the Document and other documents
+released under this License, and replace the individual copies of this
+License in the various documents with a single copy that is included in
+the collection, provided that you follow the rules of this License for
+verbatim copying of each of the documents in all other respects.
+
+You may extract a single document from such a collection, and distribute
+it individually under this License, provided you insert a copy of this
+License into the extracted document, and follow this License in all
+other respects regarding verbatim copying of that document.
+
+@item
+AGGREGATION WITH INDEPENDENT WORKS
+
+A compilation of the Document or its derivatives with other separate
+and independent documents or works, in or on a volume of a storage or
+distribution medium, is called an ``aggregate'' if the copyright
+resulting from the compilation is not used to limit the legal rights
+of the compilation's users beyond what the individual works permit.
+When the Document is included an aggregate, this License does not
+apply to the other works in the aggregate which are not themselves
+derivative works of the Document.
+
+If the Cover Text requirement of section 3 is applicable to these
+copies of the Document, then if the Document is less than one half of
+the entire aggregate, the Document's Cover Texts may be placed on
+covers that bracket the Document within the aggregate, or the
+electronic equivalent of covers if the Document is in electronic form.
+Otherwise they must appear on printed covers that bracket the whole
+aggregate.
+
+@item
+TRANSLATION
+
+Translation is considered a kind of modification, so you may
+distribute translations of the Document under the terms of section 4.
+Replacing Invariant Sections with translations requires special
+permission from their copyright holders, but you may include
+translations of some or all Invariant Sections in addition to the
+original versions of these Invariant Sections. You may include a
+translation of this License, and all the license notices in the
+Document, and any Warranty Disclaimers, provided that you also include
+the original English version of this License and the original versions
+of those notices and disclaimers. In case of a disagreement between
+the translation and the original version of this License or a notice
+or disclaimer, the original version will prevail.
+
+If a section in the Document is Entitled ``Acknowledgements'',
+``Dedications'', or ``History'', the requirement (section 4) to Preserve
+its Title (section 1) will typically require changing the actual
+title.
+
+@item
+TERMINATION
+
+You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Document except
+as expressly provided for under this License. Any other attempt to
+copy, modify, sublicense or distribute the Document is void, and will
+automatically terminate your rights under this License. However,
+parties who have received copies, or rights, from you under this
+License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such
+parties remain in full compliance.
+
+@item
+FUTURE REVISIONS OF THIS LICENSE
+
+The Free Software Foundation may publish new, revised versions
+of the GNU Free Documentation License from time to time. Such new
+versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may
+differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. See
+@uref{http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/}.
+
+Each version of the License is given a distinguishing version number.
+If the Document specifies that a particular numbered version of this
+License ``or any later version'' applies to it, you have the option of
+following the terms and conditions either of that specified version or
+of any later version that has been published (not as a draft) by the
+Free Software Foundation. If the Document does not specify a version
+number of this License, you may choose any version ever published (not
+as a draft) by the Free Software Foundation.
+@end enumerate
+
+@page
+@appendixsubsec ADDENDUM: How to use this License for your documents
+
+To use this License in a document you have written, include a copy of
+the License in the document and put the following copyright and
+license notices just after the title page:
+
+@smallexample
+@group
+ Copyright (C) @var{year} @var{your name}.
+ Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
+ under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2
+ or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
+ with no Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts.
+ A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
+ Free Documentation License''.
+@end group
+@end smallexample
+
+If you have Invariant Sections, Front-Cover Texts and Back-Cover Texts,
+replace the ``with...Texts.'' line with this:
+
+@smallexample
+@group
+ with the Invariant Sections being @var{list their titles}, with
+ the Front-Cover Texts being @var{list}, and with the Back-Cover Texts
+ being @var{list}.
+@end group
+@end smallexample
+
+If you have Invariant Sections without Cover Texts, or some other
+combination of the three, merge those two alternatives to suit the
+situation.
+
+If your document contains nontrivial examples of program code, we
+recommend releasing these examples in parallel under your choice of
+free software license, such as the GNU General Public License,
+to permit their use in free software.
+
+@c Local Variables:
+@c ispell-local-pdict: "ispell-dict"
+@c End:
+
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/history.texi b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/history.texi
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f6a3d20
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/history.texi
@@ -0,0 +1,104 @@
+\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
+@c %**start of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
+@setfilename history.info
+@settitle GNU History Library
+@c %**end of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
+
+@setchapternewpage odd
+
+@include version.texi
+
+@copying
+This document describes the GNU History library
+(version @value{VERSION}, @value{UPDATED}),
+a programming tool that provides a consistent user interface for
+recalling lines of previously typed input.
+
+Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
+this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
+are preserved on all copies.
+
+@quotation
+Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
+under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
+any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
+Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
+and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license is
+included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
+
+(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
+this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
+Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
+@end quotation
+@end copying
+
+@dircategory Libraries
+@direntry
+* History: (history). The GNU history library API.
+@end direntry
+
+@titlepage
+@title GNU History Library
+@subtitle Edition @value{EDITION}, for @code{History Library} Version @value{VERSION}.
+@subtitle @value{UPDATED-MONTH}
+@author Chet Ramey, Case Western Reserve University
+@author Brian Fox, Free Software Foundation
+
+@page
+
+@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
+@insertcopying
+
+@sp 1
+Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
+59 Temple Place, Suite 330, @*
+Boston, MA 02111-1307 @*
+USA @*
+
+@end titlepage
+
+@contents
+
+@ifnottex
+@node Top
+@top GNU History Library
+
+This document describes the GNU History library, a programming tool that
+provides a consistent user interface for recalling lines of previously
+typed input.
+
+@menu
+* Using History Interactively:: GNU History User's Manual.
+* Programming with GNU History:: GNU History Programmer's Manual.
+* Copying This Manual:: Copying This Manual.
+* Concept Index:: Index of concepts described in this manual.
+* Function and Variable Index:: Index of externally visible functions
+ and variables.
+@end menu
+@end ifnottex
+
+@syncodeindex fn vr
+
+@include hsuser.texi
+@include hstech.texi
+
+@node Copying This Manual
+@appendix Copying This Manual
+
+@menu
+* GNU Free Documentation License:: License for copying this manual.
+@end menu
+
+@include fdl.texi
+
+@node Concept Index
+@appendix Concept Index
+@printindex cp
+
+@node Function and Variable Index
+@appendix Function and Variable Index
+@printindex vr
+
+@bye
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/hstech.texi b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/hstech.texi
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..4fdda5f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/hstech.texi
@@ -0,0 +1,573 @@
+@ignore
+This file documents the user interface to the GNU History library.
+
+Copyright (C) 1988-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+Authored by Brian Fox and Chet Ramey.
+
+Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of this manual
+provided the copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved on
+all copies.
+
+Permission is granted to process this file through Tex and print the
+results, provided the printed document carries copying permission notice
+identical to this one except for the removal of this paragraph (this
+paragraph not being relevant to the printed manual).
+
+Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
+manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
+GNU Copyright statement is available to the distributee, and provided that
+the entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
+permission notice identical to this one.
+
+Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
+into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
+@end ignore
+
+@node Programming with GNU History
+@chapter Programming with GNU History
+
+This chapter describes how to interface programs that you write
+with the @sc{gnu} History Library.
+It should be considered a technical guide.
+For information on the interactive use of @sc{gnu} History, @pxref{Using
+History Interactively}.
+
+@menu
+* Introduction to History:: What is the GNU History library for?
+* History Storage:: How information is stored.
+* History Functions:: Functions that you can use.
+* History Variables:: Variables that control behaviour.
+* History Programming Example:: Example of using the GNU History Library.
+@end menu
+
+@node Introduction to History
+@section Introduction to History
+
+Many programs read input from the user a line at a time. The @sc{gnu}
+History library is able to keep track of those lines, associate arbitrary
+data with each line, and utilize information from previous lines in
+composing new ones.
+
+The programmer using the History library has available functions
+for remembering lines on a history list, associating arbitrary data
+with a line, removing lines from the list, searching through the list
+for a line containing an arbitrary text string, and referencing any line
+in the list directly. In addition, a history @dfn{expansion} function
+is available which provides for a consistent user interface across
+different programs.
+
+The user using programs written with the History library has the
+benefit of a consistent user interface with a set of well-known
+commands for manipulating the text of previous lines and using that text
+in new commands. The basic history manipulation commands are similar to
+the history substitution provided by @code{csh}.
+
+If the programmer desires, he can use the Readline library, which
+includes some history manipulation by default, and has the added
+advantage of command line editing.
+
+Before declaring any functions using any functionality the History
+library provides in other code, an application writer should include
+the file @code{<readline/history.h>} in any file that uses the
+History library's features. It supplies extern declarations for all
+of the library's public functions and variables, and declares all of
+the public data structures.
+
+@node History Storage
+@section History Storage
+
+The history list is an array of history entries. A history entry is
+declared as follows:
+
+@example
+typedef void *histdata_t;
+
+typedef struct _hist_entry @{
+ char *line;
+ char *timestamp;
+ histdata_t data;
+@} HIST_ENTRY;
+@end example
+
+The history list itself might therefore be declared as
+
+@example
+HIST_ENTRY **the_history_list;
+@end example
+
+The state of the History library is encapsulated into a single structure:
+
+@example
+/*
+ * A structure used to pass around the current state of the history.
+ */
+typedef struct _hist_state @{
+ HIST_ENTRY **entries; /* Pointer to the entries themselves. */
+ int offset; /* The location pointer within this array. */
+ int length; /* Number of elements within this array. */
+ int size; /* Number of slots allocated to this array. */
+ int flags;
+@} HISTORY_STATE;
+@end example
+
+If the flags member includes @code{HS_STIFLED}, the history has been
+stifled.
+
+@node History Functions
+@section History Functions
+
+This section describes the calling sequence for the various functions
+exported by the @sc{gnu} History library.
+
+@menu
+* Initializing History and State Management:: Functions to call when you
+ want to use history in a
+ program.
+* History List Management:: Functions used to manage the list
+ of history entries.
+* Information About the History List:: Functions returning information about
+ the history list.
+* Moving Around the History List:: Functions used to change the position
+ in the history list.
+* Searching the History List:: Functions to search the history list
+ for entries containing a string.
+* Managing the History File:: Functions that read and write a file
+ containing the history list.
+* History Expansion:: Functions to perform csh-like history
+ expansion.
+@end menu
+
+@node Initializing History and State Management
+@subsection Initializing History and State Management
+
+This section describes functions used to initialize and manage
+the state of the History library when you want to use the history
+functions in your program.
+
+@deftypefun void using_history (void)
+Begin a session in which the history functions might be used. This
+initializes the interactive variables.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun {HISTORY_STATE *} history_get_history_state (void)
+Return a structure describing the current state of the input history.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun void history_set_history_state (HISTORY_STATE *state)
+Set the state of the history list according to @var{state}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@node History List Management
+@subsection History List Management
+
+These functions manage individual entries on the history list, or set
+parameters managing the list itself.
+
+@deftypefun void add_history (const char *string)
+Place @var{string} at the end of the history list. The associated data
+field (if any) is set to @code{NULL}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun void add_history_time (const char *string)
+Change the time stamp associated with the most recent history entry to
+@var{string}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun {HIST_ENTRY *} remove_history (int which)
+Remove history entry at offset @var{which} from the history. The
+removed element is returned so you can free the line, data,
+and containing structure.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun {histdata_t} free_history_entry (HIST_ENTRY *histent)
+Free the history entry @var{histent} and any history library private
+data associated with it. Returns the application-specific data
+so the caller can dispose of it.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun {HIST_ENTRY *} replace_history_entry (int which, const char *line, histdata_t data)
+Make the history entry at offset @var{which} have @var{line} and @var{data}.
+This returns the old entry so the caller can dispose of any
+application-specific data. In the case
+of an invalid @var{which}, a @code{NULL} pointer is returned.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun void clear_history (void)
+Clear the history list by deleting all the entries.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun void stifle_history (int max)
+Stifle the history list, remembering only the last @var{max} entries.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int unstifle_history (void)
+Stop stifling the history. This returns the previously-set
+maximum number of history entries (as set by @code{stifle_history()}).
+The value is positive if the history was
+stifled, negative if it wasn't.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int history_is_stifled (void)
+Returns non-zero if the history is stifled, zero if it is not.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@node Information About the History List
+@subsection Information About the History List
+
+These functions return information about the entire history list or
+individual list entries.
+
+@deftypefun {HIST_ENTRY **} history_list (void)
+Return a @code{NULL} terminated array of @code{HIST_ENTRY *} which is the
+current input history. Element 0 of this list is the beginning of time.
+If there is no history, return @code{NULL}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int where_history (void)
+Returns the offset of the current history element.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun {HIST_ENTRY *} current_history (void)
+Return the history entry at the current position, as determined by
+@code{where_history()}. If there is no entry there, return a @code{NULL}
+pointer.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun {HIST_ENTRY *} history_get (int offset)
+Return the history entry at position @var{offset}, starting from
+@code{history_base} (@pxref{History Variables}).
+If there is no entry there, or if @var{offset}
+is greater than the history length, return a @code{NULL} pointer.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun time_t history_get_time (HIST_ENTRY *entry)
+Return the time stamp associated with the history entry @var{entry}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int history_total_bytes (void)
+Return the number of bytes that the primary history entries are using.
+This function returns the sum of the lengths of all the lines in the
+history.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@node Moving Around the History List
+@subsection Moving Around the History List
+
+These functions allow the current index into the history list to be
+set or changed.
+
+@deftypefun int history_set_pos (int pos)
+Set the current history offset to @var{pos}, an absolute index
+into the list.
+Returns 1 on success, 0 if @var{pos} is less than zero or greater
+than the number of history entries.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun {HIST_ENTRY *} previous_history (void)
+Back up the current history offset to the previous history entry, and
+return a pointer to that entry. If there is no previous entry, return
+a @code{NULL} pointer.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun {HIST_ENTRY *} next_history (void)
+Move the current history offset forward to the next history entry, and
+return the a pointer to that entry. If there is no next entry, return
+a @code{NULL} pointer.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@node Searching the History List
+@subsection Searching the History List
+@cindex History Searching
+
+These functions allow searching of the history list for entries containing
+a specific string. Searching may be performed both forward and backward
+from the current history position. The search may be @dfn{anchored},
+meaning that the string must match at the beginning of the history entry.
+@cindex anchored search
+
+@deftypefun int history_search (const char *string, int direction)
+Search the history for @var{string}, starting at the current history offset.
+If @var{direction} is less than 0, then the search is through
+previous entries, otherwise through subsequent entries.
+If @var{string} is found, then
+the current history index is set to that history entry, and the value
+returned is the offset in the line of the entry where
+@var{string} was found. Otherwise, nothing is changed, and a -1 is
+returned.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int history_search_prefix (const char *string, int direction)
+Search the history for @var{string}, starting at the current history
+offset. The search is anchored: matching lines must begin with
+@var{string}. If @var{direction} is less than 0, then the search is
+through previous entries, otherwise through subsequent entries.
+If @var{string} is found, then the
+current history index is set to that entry, and the return value is 0.
+Otherwise, nothing is changed, and a -1 is returned.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int history_search_pos (const char *string, int direction, int pos)
+Search for @var{string} in the history list, starting at @var{pos}, an
+absolute index into the list. If @var{direction} is negative, the search
+proceeds backward from @var{pos}, otherwise forward. Returns the absolute
+index of the history element where @var{string} was found, or -1 otherwise.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@node Managing the History File
+@subsection Managing the History File
+
+The History library can read the history from and write it to a file.
+This section documents the functions for managing a history file.
+
+@deftypefun int read_history (const char *filename)
+Add the contents of @var{filename} to the history list, a line at a time.
+If @var{filename} is @code{NULL}, then read from @file{~/.history}.
+Returns 0 if successful, or @code{errno} if not.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int read_history_range (const char *filename, int from, int to)
+Read a range of lines from @var{filename}, adding them to the history list.
+Start reading at line @var{from} and end at @var{to}.
+If @var{from} is zero, start at the beginning. If @var{to} is less than
+@var{from}, then read until the end of the file. If @var{filename} is
+@code{NULL}, then read from @file{~/.history}. Returns 0 if successful,
+or @code{errno} if not.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int write_history (const char *filename)
+Write the current history to @var{filename}, overwriting @var{filename}
+if necessary.
+If @var{filename} is @code{NULL}, then write the history list to
+@file{~/.history}.
+Returns 0 on success, or @code{errno} on a read or write error.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int append_history (int nelements, const char *filename)
+Append the last @var{nelements} of the history list to @var{filename}.
+If @var{filename} is @code{NULL}, then append to @file{~/.history}.
+Returns 0 on success, or @code{errno} on a read or write error.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int history_truncate_file (const char *filename, int nlines)
+Truncate the history file @var{filename}, leaving only the last
+@var{nlines} lines.
+If @var{filename} is @code{NULL}, then @file{~/.history} is truncated.
+Returns 0 on success, or @code{errno} on failure.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@node History Expansion
+@subsection History Expansion
+
+These functions implement history expansion.
+
+@deftypefun int history_expand (char *string, char **output)
+Expand @var{string}, placing the result into @var{output}, a pointer
+to a string (@pxref{History Interaction}). Returns:
+@table @code
+@item 0
+If no expansions took place (or, if the only change in
+the text was the removal of escape characters preceding the history expansion
+character);
+@item 1
+if expansions did take place;
+@item -1
+if there was an error in expansion;
+@item 2
+if the returned line should be displayed, but not executed,
+as with the @code{:p} modifier (@pxref{Modifiers}).
+@end table
+
+If an error ocurred in expansion, then @var{output} contains a descriptive
+error message.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun {char *} get_history_event (const char *string, int *cindex, int qchar)
+Returns the text of the history event beginning at @var{string} +
+@var{*cindex}. @var{*cindex} is modified to point to after the event
+specifier. At function entry, @var{cindex} points to the index into
+@var{string} where the history event specification begins. @var{qchar}
+is a character that is allowed to end the event specification in addition
+to the ``normal'' terminating characters.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun {char **} history_tokenize (const char *string)
+Return an array of tokens parsed out of @var{string}, much as the
+shell might. The tokens are split on the characters in the
+@var{history_word_delimiters} variable,
+and shell quoting conventions are obeyed.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun {char *} history_arg_extract (int first, int last, const char *string)
+Extract a string segment consisting of the @var{first} through @var{last}
+arguments present in @var{string}. Arguments are split using
+@code{history_tokenize}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@node History Variables
+@section History Variables
+
+This section describes the externally-visible variables exported by
+the @sc{gnu} History Library.
+
+@deftypevar int history_base
+The logical offset of the first entry in the history list.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar int history_length
+The number of entries currently stored in the history list.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar int history_max_entries
+The maximum number of history entries. This must be changed using
+@code{stifle_history()}.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar int history_write_timestamps
+If non-zero, timestamps are written to the history file, so they can be
+preserved between sessions. The default value is 0, meaning that
+timestamps are not saved.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar char history_expansion_char
+The character that introduces a history event. The default is @samp{!}.
+Setting this to 0 inhibits history expansion.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar char history_subst_char
+The character that invokes word substitution if found at the start of
+a line. The default is @samp{^}.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar char history_comment_char
+During tokenization, if this character is seen as the first character
+of a word, then it and all subsequent characters up to a newline are
+ignored, suppressing history expansion for the remainder of the line.
+This is disabled by default.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {char *} history_word_delimiters
+The characters that separate tokens for @code{history_tokenize()}.
+The default value is @code{" \t\n()<>;&|"}.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {char *} history_search_delimiter_chars
+The list of additional characters which can delimit a history search
+string, in addition to space, TAB, @samp{:} and @samp{?} in the case of
+a substring search. The default is empty.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {char *} history_no_expand_chars
+The list of characters which inhibit history expansion if found immediately
+following @var{history_expansion_char}. The default is space, tab, newline,
+carriage return, and @samp{=}.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar int history_quotes_inhibit_expansion
+If non-zero, single-quoted words are not scanned for the history expansion
+character. The default value is 0.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {rl_linebuf_func_t *} history_inhibit_expansion_function
+This should be set to the address of a function that takes two arguments:
+a @code{char *} (@var{string})
+and an @code{int} index into that string (@var{i}).
+It should return a non-zero value if the history expansion starting at
+@var{string[i]} should not be performed; zero if the expansion should
+be done.
+It is intended for use by applications like Bash that use the history
+expansion character for additional purposes.
+By default, this variable is set to @code{NULL}.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@node History Programming Example
+@section History Programming Example
+
+The following program demonstrates simple use of the @sc{gnu} History Library.
+
+@smallexample
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <readline/history.h>
+
+main (argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char **argv;
+@{
+ char line[1024], *t;
+ int len, done = 0;
+
+ line[0] = 0;
+
+ using_history ();
+ while (!done)
+ @{
+ printf ("history$ ");
+ fflush (stdout);
+ t = fgets (line, sizeof (line) - 1, stdin);
+ if (t && *t)
+ @{
+ len = strlen (t);
+ if (t[len - 1] == '\n')
+ t[len - 1] = '\0';
+ @}
+
+ if (!t)
+ strcpy (line, "quit");
+
+ if (line[0])
+ @{
+ char *expansion;
+ int result;
+
+ result = history_expand (line, &expansion);
+ if (result)
+ fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", expansion);
+
+ if (result < 0 || result == 2)
+ @{
+ free (expansion);
+ continue;
+ @}
+
+ add_history (expansion);
+ strncpy (line, expansion, sizeof (line) - 1);
+ free (expansion);
+ @}
+
+ if (strcmp (line, "quit") == 0)
+ done = 1;
+ else if (strcmp (line, "save") == 0)
+ write_history ("history_file");
+ else if (strcmp (line, "read") == 0)
+ read_history ("history_file");
+ else if (strcmp (line, "list") == 0)
+ @{
+ register HIST_ENTRY **the_list;
+ register int i;
+
+ the_list = history_list ();
+ if (the_list)
+ for (i = 0; the_list[i]; i++)
+ printf ("%d: %s\n", i + history_base, the_list[i]->line);
+ @}
+ else if (strncmp (line, "delete", 6) == 0)
+ @{
+ int which;
+ if ((sscanf (line + 6, "%d", &which)) == 1)
+ @{
+ HIST_ENTRY *entry = remove_history (which);
+ if (!entry)
+ fprintf (stderr, "No such entry %d\n", which);
+ else
+ @{
+ free (entry->line);
+ free (entry);
+ @}
+ @}
+ else
+ @{
+ fprintf (stderr, "non-numeric arg given to `delete'\n");
+ @}
+ @}
+ @}
+@}
+@end smallexample
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/hsuser.texi b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/hsuser.texi
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6c89183
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/hsuser.texi
@@ -0,0 +1,457 @@
+@ignore
+This file documents the user interface to the GNU History library.
+
+Copyright (C) 1988-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+Authored by Brian Fox and Chet Ramey.
+
+Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of this manual
+provided the copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved on
+all copies.
+
+Permission is granted to process this file through Tex and print the
+results, provided the printed document carries copying permission notice
+identical to this one except for the removal of this paragraph (this
+paragraph not being relevant to the printed manual).
+
+Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
+manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
+GNU Copyright statement is available to the distributee, and provided that
+the entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
+permission notice identical to this one.
+
+Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
+into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
+@end ignore
+
+@node Using History Interactively
+@chapter Using History Interactively
+
+@ifclear BashFeatures
+@defcodeindex bt
+@end ifclear
+
+@ifset BashFeatures
+This chapter describes how to use the @sc{gnu} History Library
+interactively, from a user's standpoint.
+It should be considered a user's guide.
+For information on using the @sc{gnu} History Library in other programs,
+see the @sc{gnu} Readline Library Manual.
+@end ifset
+@ifclear BashFeatures
+This chapter describes how to use the @sc{gnu} History Library interactively,
+from a user's standpoint. It should be considered a user's guide. For
+information on using the @sc{gnu} History Library in your own programs,
+@pxref{Programming with GNU History}.
+@end ifclear
+
+@ifset BashFeatures
+@menu
+* Bash History Facilities:: How Bash lets you manipulate your command
+ history.
+* Bash History Builtins:: The Bash builtin commands that manipulate
+ the command history.
+* History Interaction:: What it feels like using History as a user.
+@end menu
+@end ifset
+@ifclear BashFeatures
+@menu
+* History Interaction:: What it feels like using History as a user.
+@end menu
+@end ifclear
+
+@ifset BashFeatures
+@node Bash History Facilities
+@section Bash History Facilities
+@cindex command history
+@cindex history list
+
+When the @option{-o history} option to the @code{set} builtin
+is enabled (@pxref{The Set Builtin}),
+the shell provides access to the @dfn{command history},
+the list of commands previously typed.
+The value of the @env{HISTSIZE} shell variable is used as the
+number of commands to save in a history list.
+The text of the last @env{$HISTSIZE}
+commands (default 500) is saved.
+The shell stores each command in the history list prior to
+parameter and variable expansion
+but after history expansion is performed, subject to the
+values of the shell variables
+@env{HISTIGNORE} and @env{HISTCONTROL}.
+
+When the shell starts up, the history is initialized from the
+file named by the @env{HISTFILE} variable (default @file{~/.bash_history}).
+The file named by the value of @env{HISTFILE} is truncated, if
+necessary, to contain no more than the number of lines specified by
+the value of the @env{HISTFILESIZE} variable.
+When an interactive shell exits, the last
+@env{$HISTSIZE} lines are copied from the history list to the file
+named by @env{$HISTFILE}.
+If the @code{histappend} shell option is set (@pxref{Bash Builtins}),
+the lines are appended to the history file,
+otherwise the history file is overwritten.
+If @env{HISTFILE}
+is unset, or if the history file is unwritable, the history is
+not saved. After saving the history, the history file is truncated
+to contain no more than @env{$HISTFILESIZE}
+lines. If @env{HISTFILESIZE} is not set, no truncation is performed.
+
+If the @env{HISTTIMEFORMAT} is set, the time stamp information
+associated with each history entry is written to the history file.
+
+The builtin command @code{fc} may be used to list or edit and re-execute
+a portion of the history list.
+The @code{history} builtin may be used to display or modify the history
+list and manipulate the history file.
+When using command-line editing, search commands
+are available in each editing mode that provide access to the
+history list (@pxref{Commands For History}).
+
+The shell allows control over which commands are saved on the history
+list. The @env{HISTCONTROL} and @env{HISTIGNORE}
+variables may be set to cause the shell to save only a subset of the
+commands entered.
+The @code{cmdhist}
+shell option, if enabled, causes the shell to attempt to save each
+line of a multi-line command in the same history entry, adding
+semicolons where necessary to preserve syntactic correctness.
+The @code{lithist}
+shell option causes the shell to save the command with embedded newlines
+instead of semicolons.
+The @code{shopt} builtin is used to set these options.
+@xref{Bash Builtins}, for a description of @code{shopt}.
+
+@node Bash History Builtins
+@section Bash History Builtins
+@cindex history builtins
+
+Bash provides two builtin commands which manipulate the
+history list and history file.
+
+@table @code
+
+@item fc
+@btindex fc
+@example
+@code{fc [-e @var{ename}] [-nlr] [@var{first}] [@var{last}]}
+@code{fc -s [@var{pat}=@var{rep}] [@var{command}]}
+@end example
+
+Fix Command. In the first form, a range of commands from @var{first} to
+@var{last} is selected from the history list. Both @var{first} and
+@var{last} may be specified as a string (to locate the most recent
+command beginning with that string) or as a number (an index into the
+history list, where a negative number is used as an offset from the
+current command number). If @var{last} is not specified it is set to
+@var{first}. If @var{first} is not specified it is set to the previous
+command for editing and @minus{}16 for listing. If the @option{-l} flag is
+given, the commands are listed on standard output. The @option{-n} flag
+suppresses the command numbers when listing. The @option{-r} flag
+reverses the order of the listing. Otherwise, the editor given by
+@var{ename} is invoked on a file containing those commands. If
+@var{ename} is not given, the value of the following variable expansion
+is used: @code{$@{FCEDIT:-$@{EDITOR:-vi@}@}}. This says to use the
+value of the @env{FCEDIT} variable if set, or the value of the
+@env{EDITOR} variable if that is set, or @code{vi} if neither is set.
+When editing is complete, the edited commands are echoed and executed.
+
+In the second form, @var{command} is re-executed after each instance
+of @var{pat} in the selected command is replaced by @var{rep}.
+
+A useful alias to use with the @code{fc} command is @code{r='fc -s'}, so
+that typing @samp{r cc} runs the last command beginning with @code{cc}
+and typing @samp{r} re-executes the last command (@pxref{Aliases}).
+
+@item history
+@btindex history
+@example
+history [@var{n}]
+history -c
+history -d @var{offset}
+history [-anrw] [@var{filename}]
+history -ps @var{arg}
+@end example
+
+With no options, display the history list with line numbers.
+Lines prefixed with a @samp{*} have been modified.
+An argument of @var{n} lists only the last @var{n} lines.
+If the shell variable @env{HISTTIMEFORMAT} is set and not null,
+it is used as a format string for @var{strftime} to display
+the time stamp associated with each displayed history entry.
+No intervening blank is printed between the formatted time stamp
+and the history line.
+
+Options, if supplied, have the following meanings:
+
+@table @code
+@item -c
+Clear the history list. This may be combined
+with the other options to replace the history list completely.
+
+@item -d @var{offset}
+Delete the history entry at position @var{offset}.
+@var{offset} should be specified as it appears when the history is
+displayed.
+
+@item -a
+Append the new
+history lines (history lines entered since the beginning of the
+current Bash session) to the history file.
+
+@item -n
+Append the history lines not already read from the history file
+to the current history list. These are lines appended to the history
+file since the beginning of the current Bash session.
+
+@item -r
+Read the current history file and append its contents to
+the history list.
+
+@item -w
+Write out the current history to the history file.
+
+@item -p
+Perform history substitution on the @var{arg}s and display the result
+on the standard output, without storing the results in the history list.
+
+@item -s
+The @var{arg}s are added to the end of
+the history list as a single entry.
+
+@end table
+
+When any of the @option{-w}, @option{-r}, @option{-a}, or @option{-n} options is
+used, if @var{filename}
+is given, then it is used as the history file. If not, then
+the value of the @env{HISTFILE} variable is used.
+
+@end table
+@end ifset
+
+@node History Interaction
+@section History Expansion
+@cindex history expansion
+
+The History library provides a history expansion feature that is similar
+to the history expansion provided by @code{csh}. This section
+describes the syntax used to manipulate the history information.
+
+History expansions introduce words from the history list into
+the input stream, making it easy to repeat commands, insert the
+arguments to a previous command into the current input line, or
+fix errors in previous commands quickly.
+
+History expansion takes place in two parts. The first is to determine
+which line from the history list should be used during substitution.
+The second is to select portions of that line for inclusion into the
+current one. The line selected from the history is called the
+@dfn{event}, and the portions of that line that are acted upon are
+called @dfn{words}. Various @dfn{modifiers} are available to manipulate
+the selected words. The line is broken into words in the same fashion
+that Bash does, so that several words
+surrounded by quotes are considered one word.
+History expansions are introduced by the appearance of the
+history expansion character, which is @samp{!} by default.
+@ifset BashFeatures
+Only @samp{\} and @samp{'} may be used to escape the history expansion
+character.
+@end ifset
+
+@ifset BashFeatures
+Several shell options settable with the @code{shopt}
+builtin (@pxref{Bash Builtins}) may be used to tailor
+the behavior of history expansion. If the
+@code{histverify} shell option is enabled, and Readline
+is being used, history substitutions are not immediately passed to
+the shell parser.
+Instead, the expanded line is reloaded into the Readline
+editing buffer for further modification.
+If Readline is being used, and the @code{histreedit}
+shell option is enabled, a failed history expansion will be
+reloaded into the Readline editing buffer for correction.
+The @option{-p} option to the @code{history} builtin command
+may be used to see what a history expansion will do before using it.
+The @option{-s} option to the @code{history} builtin may be used to
+add commands to the end of the history list without actually executing
+them, so that they are available for subsequent recall.
+This is most useful in conjunction with Readline.
+
+The shell allows control of the various characters used by the
+history expansion mechanism with the @code{histchars} variable.
+@end ifset
+
+@menu
+* Event Designators:: How to specify which history line to use.
+* Word Designators:: Specifying which words are of interest.
+* Modifiers:: Modifying the results of substitution.
+@end menu
+
+@node Event Designators
+@subsection Event Designators
+@cindex event designators
+
+An event designator is a reference to a command line entry in the
+history list.
+@cindex history events
+
+@table @asis
+
+@item @code{!}
+@ifset BashFeatures
+Start a history substitution, except when followed by a space, tab,
+the end of the line, @samp{=} or @samp{(} (when the
+@code{extglob} shell option is enabled using the @code{shopt} builtin).
+@end ifset
+@ifclear BashFeatures
+Start a history substitution, except when followed by a space, tab,
+the end of the line, or @samp{=}.
+@end ifclear
+
+@item @code{!@var{n}}
+Refer to command line @var{n}.
+
+@item @code{!-@var{n}}
+Refer to the command @var{n} lines back.
+
+@item @code{!!}
+Refer to the previous command. This is a synonym for @samp{!-1}.
+
+@item @code{!@var{string}}
+Refer to the most recent command starting with @var{string}.
+
+@item @code{!?@var{string}[?]}
+Refer to the most recent command containing @var{string}. The trailing
+@samp{?} may be omitted if the @var{string} is followed immediately by
+a newline.
+
+@item @code{^@var{string1}^@var{string2}^}
+Quick Substitution. Repeat the last command, replacing @var{string1}
+with @var{string2}. Equivalent to
+@code{!!:s/@var{string1}/@var{string2}/}.
+
+@item @code{!#}
+The entire command line typed so far.
+
+@end table
+
+@node Word Designators
+@subsection Word Designators
+
+Word designators are used to select desired words from the event.
+A @samp{:} separates the event specification from the word designator. It
+may be omitted if the word designator begins with a @samp{^}, @samp{$},
+@samp{*}, @samp{-}, or @samp{%}. Words are numbered from the beginning
+of the line, with the first word being denoted by 0 (zero). Words are
+inserted into the current line separated by single spaces.
+
+@need 0.75
+For example,
+
+@table @code
+@item !!
+designates the preceding command. When you type this, the preceding
+command is repeated in toto.
+
+@item !!:$
+designates the last argument of the preceding command. This may be
+shortened to @code{!$}.
+
+@item !fi:2
+designates the second argument of the most recent command starting with
+the letters @code{fi}.
+@end table
+
+@need 0.75
+Here are the word designators:
+
+@table @code
+
+@item 0 (zero)
+The @code{0}th word. For many applications, this is the command word.
+
+@item @var{n}
+The @var{n}th word.
+
+@item ^
+The first argument; that is, word 1.
+
+@item $
+The last argument.
+
+@item %
+The word matched by the most recent @samp{?@var{string}?} search.
+
+@item @var{x}-@var{y}
+A range of words; @samp{-@var{y}} abbreviates @samp{0-@var{y}}.
+
+@item *
+All of the words, except the @code{0}th. This is a synonym for @samp{1-$}.
+It is not an error to use @samp{*} if there is just one word in the event;
+the empty string is returned in that case.
+
+@item @var{x}*
+Abbreviates @samp{@var{x}-$}
+
+@item @var{x}-
+Abbreviates @samp{@var{x}-$} like @samp{@var{x}*}, but omits the last word.
+
+@end table
+
+If a word designator is supplied without an event specification, the
+previous command is used as the event.
+
+@node Modifiers
+@subsection Modifiers
+
+After the optional word designator, you can add a sequence of one or more
+of the following modifiers, each preceded by a @samp{:}.
+
+@table @code
+
+@item h
+Remove a trailing pathname component, leaving only the head.
+
+@item t
+Remove all leading pathname components, leaving the tail.
+
+@item r
+Remove a trailing suffix of the form @samp{.@var{suffix}}, leaving
+the basename.
+
+@item e
+Remove all but the trailing suffix.
+
+@item p
+Print the new command but do not execute it.
+
+@ifset BashFeatures
+@item q
+Quote the substituted words, escaping further substitutions.
+
+@item x
+Quote the substituted words as with @samp{q},
+but break into words at spaces, tabs, and newlines.
+@end ifset
+
+@item s/@var{old}/@var{new}/
+Substitute @var{new} for the first occurrence of @var{old} in the
+event line. Any delimiter may be used in place of @samp{/}.
+The delimiter may be quoted in @var{old} and @var{new}
+with a single backslash. If @samp{&} appears in @var{new},
+it is replaced by @var{old}. A single backslash will quote
+the @samp{&}. The final delimiter is optional if it is the last
+character on the input line.
+
+@item &
+Repeat the previous substitution.
+
+@item g
+@itemx a
+Cause changes to be applied over the entire event line. Used in
+conjunction with @samp{s}, as in @code{gs/@var{old}/@var{new}/},
+or with @samp{&}.
+
+@item G
+Apply the following @samp{s} modifier once to each word in the event.
+
+@end table
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/rlman.texi b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/rlman.texi
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f834b58
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/rlman.texi
@@ -0,0 +1,101 @@
+\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
+@comment %**start of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
+@setfilename readline.info
+@settitle GNU Readline Library
+@comment %**end of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
+@synindex vr fn
+@setchapternewpage odd
+
+@include version.texi
+
+@copying
+This manual describes the GNU Readline Library
+(version @value{VERSION}, @value{UPDATED}), a library which aids in the
+consistency of user interface across discrete programs which provide
+a command line interface.
+
+Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
+this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
+are preserved on all copies.
+
+@quotation
+Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
+under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
+any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
+Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
+and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license is
+included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
+
+(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
+this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
+Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
+@end quotation
+@end copying
+
+@dircategory Libraries
+@direntry
+* Readline: (readline). The GNU readline library API.
+@end direntry
+
+@titlepage
+@title GNU Readline Library
+@subtitle Edition @value{EDITION}, for @code{Readline Library} Version @value{VERSION}.
+@subtitle @value{UPDATED-MONTH}
+@author Chet Ramey, Case Western Reserve University
+@author Brian Fox, Free Software Foundation
+
+@page
+@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
+@insertcopying
+
+@sp 1
+Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
+59 Temple Place, Suite 330, @*
+Boston, MA 02111-1307 @*
+USA @*
+
+@end titlepage
+
+@contents
+
+@ifnottex
+@node Top
+@top GNU Readline Library
+
+This document describes the GNU Readline Library, a utility which aids
+in the consistency of user interface across discrete programs which
+provide a command line interface.
+
+@menu
+* Command Line Editing:: GNU Readline User's Manual.
+* Programming with GNU Readline:: GNU Readline Programmer's Manual.
+* Copying This Manual:: Copying this manual.
+* Concept Index:: Index of concepts described in this manual.
+* Function and Variable Index:: Index of externally visible functions
+ and variables.
+@end menu
+@end ifnottex
+
+@include rluser.texi
+@include rltech.texi
+
+@node Copying This Manual
+@appendix Copying This Manual
+
+@menu
+* GNU Free Documentation License:: License for copying this manual.
+@end menu
+
+@include fdl.texi
+
+@node Concept Index
+@unnumbered Concept Index
+@printindex cp
+
+@node Function and Variable Index
+@unnumbered Function and Variable Index
+@printindex fn
+
+@bye
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/rltech.texi b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/rltech.texi
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6f2e2ee
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/rltech.texi
@@ -0,0 +1,2285 @@
+@comment %**start of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
+@setfilename rltech.info
+@comment %**end of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
+@setchapternewpage odd
+
+@ifinfo
+This document describes the GNU Readline Library, a utility for aiding
+in the consistency of user interface across discrete programs that need
+to provide a command line interface.
+
+Copyright (C) 1988-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
+this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
+pare preserved on all copies.
+
+@ignore
+Permission is granted to process this file through TeX and print the
+results, provided the printed document carries copying permission
+notice identical to this one except for the removal of this paragraph
+(this paragraph not being relevant to the printed manual).
+@end ignore
+
+Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
+manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided that the entire
+resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a permission
+notice identical to this one.
+
+Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
+into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions,
+except that this permission notice may be stated in a translation approved
+by the Foundation.
+@end ifinfo
+
+@node Programming with GNU Readline
+@chapter Programming with GNU Readline
+
+This chapter describes the interface between the @sc{gnu} Readline Library and
+other programs. If you are a programmer, and you wish to include the
+features found in @sc{gnu} Readline
+such as completion, line editing, and interactive history manipulation
+in your own programs, this section is for you.
+
+@menu
+* Basic Behavior:: Using the default behavior of Readline.
+* Custom Functions:: Adding your own functions to Readline.
+* Readline Variables:: Variables accessible to custom
+ functions.
+* Readline Convenience Functions:: Functions which Readline supplies to
+ aid in writing your own custom
+ functions.
+* Readline Signal Handling:: How Readline behaves when it receives signals.
+* Custom Completers:: Supplanting or supplementing Readline's
+ completion functions.
+@end menu
+
+@node Basic Behavior
+@section Basic Behavior
+
+Many programs provide a command line interface, such as @code{mail},
+@code{ftp}, and @code{sh}. For such programs, the default behaviour of
+Readline is sufficient. This section describes how to use Readline in
+the simplest way possible, perhaps to replace calls in your code to
+@code{gets()} or @code{fgets()}.
+
+@findex readline
+@cindex readline, function
+
+The function @code{readline()} prints a prompt @var{prompt}
+and then reads and returns a single line of text from the user.
+If @var{prompt} is @code{NULL} or the empty string, no prompt is displayed.
+The line @code{readline} returns is allocated with @code{malloc()};
+the caller should @code{free()} the line when it has finished with it.
+The declaration for @code{readline} in ANSI C is
+
+@example
+@code{char *readline (const char *@var{prompt});}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+So, one might say
+@example
+@code{char *line = readline ("Enter a line: ");}
+@end example
+@noindent
+in order to read a line of text from the user.
+The line returned has the final newline removed, so only the
+text remains.
+
+If @code{readline} encounters an @code{EOF} while reading the line, and the
+line is empty at that point, then @code{(char *)NULL} is returned.
+Otherwise, the line is ended just as if a newline had been typed.
+
+If you want the user to be able to get at the line later, (with
+@key{C-p} for example), you must call @code{add_history()} to save the
+line away in a @dfn{history} list of such lines.
+
+@example
+@code{add_history (line)};
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+For full details on the GNU History Library, see the associated manual.
+
+It is preferable to avoid saving empty lines on the history list, since
+users rarely have a burning need to reuse a blank line. Here is
+a function which usefully replaces the standard @code{gets()} library
+function, and has the advantage of no static buffer to overflow:
+
+@example
+/* A static variable for holding the line. */
+static char *line_read = (char *)NULL;
+
+/* Read a string, and return a pointer to it.
+ Returns NULL on EOF. */
+char *
+rl_gets ()
+@{
+ /* If the buffer has already been allocated,
+ return the memory to the free pool. */
+ if (line_read)
+ @{
+ free (line_read);
+ line_read = (char *)NULL;
+ @}
+
+ /* Get a line from the user. */
+ line_read = readline ("");
+
+ /* If the line has any text in it,
+ save it on the history. */
+ if (line_read && *line_read)
+ add_history (line_read);
+
+ return (line_read);
+@}
+@end example
+
+This function gives the user the default behaviour of @key{TAB}
+completion: completion on file names. If you do not want Readline to
+complete on filenames, you can change the binding of the @key{TAB} key
+with @code{rl_bind_key()}.
+
+@example
+@code{int rl_bind_key (int @var{key}, rl_command_func_t *@var{function});}
+@end example
+
+@code{rl_bind_key()} takes two arguments: @var{key} is the character that
+you want to bind, and @var{function} is the address of the function to
+call when @var{key} is pressed. Binding @key{TAB} to @code{rl_insert()}
+makes @key{TAB} insert itself.
+@code{rl_bind_key()} returns non-zero if @var{key} is not a valid
+ASCII character code (between 0 and 255).
+
+Thus, to disable the default @key{TAB} behavior, the following suffices:
+@example
+@code{rl_bind_key ('\t', rl_insert);}
+@end example
+
+This code should be executed once at the start of your program; you
+might write a function called @code{initialize_readline()} which
+performs this and other desired initializations, such as installing
+custom completers (@pxref{Custom Completers}).
+
+@node Custom Functions
+@section Custom Functions
+
+Readline provides many functions for manipulating the text of
+the line, but it isn't possible to anticipate the needs of all
+programs. This section describes the various functions and variables
+defined within the Readline library which allow a user program to add
+customized functionality to Readline.
+
+Before declaring any functions that customize Readline's behavior, or
+using any functionality Readline provides in other code, an
+application writer should include the file @code{<readline/readline.h>}
+in any file that uses Readline's features. Since some of the definitions
+in @code{readline.h} use the @code{stdio} library, the file
+@code{<stdio.h>} should be included before @code{readline.h}.
+
+@code{readline.h} defines a C preprocessor variable that should
+be treated as an integer, @code{RL_READLINE_VERSION}, which may
+be used to conditionally compile application code depending on
+the installed Readline version. The value is a hexadecimal
+encoding of the major and minor version numbers of the library,
+of the form 0x@var{MMmm}. @var{MM} is the two-digit major
+version number; @var{mm} is the two-digit minor version number.
+For Readline 4.2, for example, the value of
+@code{RL_READLINE_VERSION} would be @code{0x0402}.
+
+@menu
+* Readline Typedefs:: C declarations to make code readable.
+* Function Writing:: Variables and calling conventions.
+@end menu
+
+@node Readline Typedefs
+@subsection Readline Typedefs
+
+For readabilty, we declare a number of new object types, all pointers
+to functions.
+
+The reason for declaring these new types is to make it easier to write
+code describing pointers to C functions with appropriately prototyped
+arguments and return values.
+
+For instance, say we want to declare a variable @var{func} as a pointer
+to a function which takes two @code{int} arguments and returns an
+@code{int} (this is the type of all of the Readline bindable functions).
+Instead of the classic C declaration
+
+@code{int (*func)();}
+
+@noindent
+or the ANSI-C style declaration
+
+@code{int (*func)(int, int);}
+
+@noindent
+we may write
+
+@code{rl_command_func_t *func;}
+
+The full list of function pointer types available is
+
+@table @code
+@item typedef int rl_command_func_t (int, int);
+
+@item typedef char *rl_compentry_func_t (const char *, int);
+
+@item typedef char **rl_completion_func_t (const char *, int, int);
+
+@item typedef char *rl_quote_func_t (char *, int, char *);
+
+@item typedef char *rl_dequote_func_t (char *, int);
+
+@item typedef int rl_compignore_func_t (char **);
+
+@item typedef void rl_compdisp_func_t (char **, int, int);
+
+@item typedef int rl_hook_func_t (void);
+
+@item typedef int rl_getc_func_t (FILE *);
+
+@item typedef int rl_linebuf_func_t (char *, int);
+
+@item typedef int rl_intfunc_t (int);
+@item #define rl_ivoidfunc_t rl_hook_func_t
+@item typedef int rl_icpfunc_t (char *);
+@item typedef int rl_icppfunc_t (char **);
+
+@item typedef void rl_voidfunc_t (void);
+@item typedef void rl_vintfunc_t (int);
+@item typedef void rl_vcpfunc_t (char *);
+@item typedef void rl_vcppfunc_t (char **);
+
+@end table
+
+@node Function Writing
+@subsection Writing a New Function
+
+In order to write new functions for Readline, you need to know the
+calling conventions for keyboard-invoked functions, and the names of the
+variables that describe the current state of the line read so far.
+
+The calling sequence for a command @code{foo} looks like
+
+@example
+@code{int foo (int count, int key)}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+where @var{count} is the numeric argument (or 1 if defaulted) and
+@var{key} is the key that invoked this function.
+
+It is completely up to the function as to what should be done with the
+numeric argument. Some functions use it as a repeat count, some
+as a flag, and others to choose alternate behavior (refreshing the current
+line as opposed to refreshing the screen, for example). Some choose to
+ignore it. In general, if a
+function uses the numeric argument as a repeat count, it should be able
+to do something useful with both negative and positive arguments.
+At the very least, it should be aware that it can be passed a
+negative argument.
+
+A command function should return 0 if its action completes successfully,
+and a non-zero value if some error occurs.
+This is the convention obeyed by all of the builtin Readline bindable
+command functions.
+
+@node Readline Variables
+@section Readline Variables
+
+These variables are available to function writers.
+
+@deftypevar {char *} rl_line_buffer
+This is the line gathered so far. You are welcome to modify the
+contents of the line, but see @ref{Allowing Undoing}. The
+function @code{rl_extend_line_buffer} is available to increase
+the memory allocated to @code{rl_line_buffer}.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar int rl_point
+The offset of the current cursor position in @code{rl_line_buffer}
+(the @emph{point}).
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar int rl_end
+The number of characters present in @code{rl_line_buffer}. When
+@code{rl_point} is at the end of the line, @code{rl_point} and
+@code{rl_end} are equal.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar int rl_mark
+The @var{mark} (saved position) in the current line. If set, the mark
+and point define a @emph{region}.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar int rl_done
+Setting this to a non-zero value causes Readline to return the current
+line immediately.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar int rl_num_chars_to_read
+Setting this to a positive value before calling @code{readline()} causes
+Readline to return after accepting that many characters, rather
+than reading up to a character bound to @code{accept-line}.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar int rl_pending_input
+Setting this to a value makes it the next keystroke read. This is a
+way to stuff a single character into the input stream.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar int rl_dispatching
+Set to a non-zero value if a function is being called from a key binding;
+zero otherwise. Application functions can test this to discover whether
+they were called directly or by Readline's dispatching mechanism.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar int rl_erase_empty_line
+Setting this to a non-zero value causes Readline to completely erase
+the current line, including any prompt, any time a newline is typed as
+the only character on an otherwise-empty line. The cursor is moved to
+the beginning of the newly-blank line.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {char *} rl_prompt
+The prompt Readline uses. This is set from the argument to
+@code{readline()}, and should not be assigned to directly.
+The @code{rl_set_prompt()} function (@pxref{Redisplay}) may
+be used to modify the prompt string after calling @code{readline()}.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar int rl_already_prompted
+If an application wishes to display the prompt itself, rather than have
+Readline do it the first time @code{readline()} is called, it should set
+this variable to a non-zero value after displaying the prompt.
+The prompt must also be passed as the argument to @code{readline()} so
+the redisplay functions can update the display properly.
+The calling application is responsible for managing the value; Readline
+never sets it.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {const char *} rl_library_version
+The version number of this revision of the library.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar int rl_readline_version
+An integer encoding the current version of the library. The encoding is
+of the form 0x@var{MMmm}, where @var{MM} is the two-digit major version
+number, and @var{mm} is the two-digit minor version number.
+For example, for Readline-4.2, @code{rl_readline_version} would have the
+value 0x0402.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {int} rl_gnu_readline_p
+Always set to 1, denoting that this is @sc{gnu} readline rather than some
+emulation.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {const char *} rl_terminal_name
+The terminal type, used for initialization. If not set by the application,
+Readline sets this to the value of the @env{TERM} environment variable
+the first time it is called.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {const char *} rl_readline_name
+This variable is set to a unique name by each application using Readline.
+The value allows conditional parsing of the inputrc file
+(@pxref{Conditional Init Constructs}).
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {FILE *} rl_instream
+The stdio stream from which Readline reads input.
+If @code{NULL}, Readline defaults to @var{stdin}.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {FILE *} rl_outstream
+The stdio stream to which Readline performs output.
+If @code{NULL}, Readline defaults to @var{stdout}.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar int rl_prefer_env_winsize
+If non-zero, Readline gives values found in the @env{LINES} and
+@env{COLUMNS} environment variables greater precedence than values fetched
+from the kernel when computing the screen dimensions.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {rl_command_func_t *} rl_last_func
+The address of the last command function Readline executed. May be used to
+test whether or not a function is being executed twice in succession, for
+example.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {rl_hook_func_t *} rl_startup_hook
+If non-zero, this is the address of a function to call just
+before @code{readline} prints the first prompt.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {rl_hook_func_t *} rl_pre_input_hook
+If non-zero, this is the address of a function to call after
+the first prompt has been printed and just before @code{readline}
+starts reading input characters.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {rl_hook_func_t *} rl_event_hook
+If non-zero, this is the address of a function to call periodically
+when Readline is waiting for terminal input.
+By default, this will be called at most ten times a second if there
+is no keyboard input.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {rl_getc_func_t *} rl_getc_function
+If non-zero, Readline will call indirectly through this pointer
+to get a character from the input stream. By default, it is set to
+@code{rl_getc}, the default Readline character input function
+(@pxref{Character Input}).
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {rl_voidfunc_t *} rl_redisplay_function
+If non-zero, Readline will call indirectly through this pointer
+to update the display with the current contents of the editing buffer.
+By default, it is set to @code{rl_redisplay}, the default Readline
+redisplay function (@pxref{Redisplay}).
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {rl_vintfunc_t *} rl_prep_term_function
+If non-zero, Readline will call indirectly through this pointer
+to initialize the terminal. The function takes a single argument, an
+@code{int} flag that says whether or not to use eight-bit characters.
+By default, this is set to @code{rl_prep_terminal}
+(@pxref{Terminal Management}).
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {rl_voidfunc_t *} rl_deprep_term_function
+If non-zero, Readline will call indirectly through this pointer
+to reset the terminal. This function should undo the effects of
+@code{rl_prep_term_function}.
+By default, this is set to @code{rl_deprep_terminal}
+(@pxref{Terminal Management}).
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {Keymap} rl_executing_keymap
+This variable is set to the keymap (@pxref{Keymaps}) in which the
+currently executing readline function was found.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {Keymap} rl_binding_keymap
+This variable is set to the keymap (@pxref{Keymaps}) in which the
+last key binding occurred.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {char *} rl_executing_macro
+This variable is set to the text of any currently-executing macro.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {int} rl_readline_state
+A variable with bit values that encapsulate the current Readline state.
+A bit is set with the @code{RL_SETSTATE} macro, and unset with the
+@code{RL_UNSETSTATE} macro. Use the @code{RL_ISSTATE} macro to test
+whether a particular state bit is set. Current state bits include:
+
+@table @code
+@item RL_STATE_NONE
+Readline has not yet been called, nor has it begun to intialize.
+@item RL_STATE_INITIALIZING
+Readline is initializing its internal data structures.
+@item RL_STATE_INITIALIZED
+Readline has completed its initialization.
+@item RL_STATE_TERMPREPPED
+Readline has modified the terminal modes to do its own input and redisplay.
+@item RL_STATE_READCMD
+Readline is reading a command from the keyboard.
+@item RL_STATE_METANEXT
+Readline is reading more input after reading the meta-prefix character.
+@item RL_STATE_DISPATCHING
+Readline is dispatching to a command.
+@item RL_STATE_MOREINPUT
+Readline is reading more input while executing an editing command.
+@item RL_STATE_ISEARCH
+Readline is performing an incremental history search.
+@item RL_STATE_NSEARCH
+Readline is performing a non-incremental history search.
+@item RL_STATE_SEARCH
+Readline is searching backward or forward through the history for a string.
+@item RL_STATE_NUMERICARG
+Readline is reading a numeric argument.
+@item RL_STATE_MACROINPUT
+Readline is currently getting its input from a previously-defined keyboard
+macro.
+@item RL_STATE_MACRODEF
+Readline is currently reading characters defining a keyboard macro.
+@item RL_STATE_OVERWRITE
+Readline is in overwrite mode.
+@item RL_STATE_COMPLETING
+Readline is performing word completion.
+@item RL_STATE_SIGHANDLER
+Readline is currently executing the readline signal handler.
+@item RL_STATE_UNDOING
+Readline is performing an undo.
+@item RL_STATE_DONE
+Readline has read a key sequence bound to @code{accept-line}
+and is about to return the line to the caller.
+@end table
+
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {int} rl_explicit_arg
+Set to a non-zero value if an explicit numeric argument was specified by
+the user. Only valid in a bindable command function.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {int} rl_numeric_arg
+Set to the value of any numeric argument explicitly specified by the user
+before executing the current Readline function. Only valid in a bindable
+command function.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {int} rl_editing_mode
+Set to a value denoting Readline's current editing mode. A value of
+@var{1} means Readline is currently in emacs mode; @var{0}
+means that vi mode is active.
+@end deftypevar
+
+
+@node Readline Convenience Functions
+@section Readline Convenience Functions
+
+@menu
+* Function Naming:: How to give a function you write a name.
+* Keymaps:: Making keymaps.
+* Binding Keys:: Changing Keymaps.
+* Associating Function Names and Bindings:: Translate function names to
+ key sequences.
+* Allowing Undoing:: How to make your functions undoable.
+* Redisplay:: Functions to control line display.
+* Modifying Text:: Functions to modify @code{rl_line_buffer}.
+* Character Input:: Functions to read keyboard input.
+* Terminal Management:: Functions to manage terminal settings.
+* Utility Functions:: Generally useful functions and hooks.
+* Miscellaneous Functions:: Functions that don't fall into any category.
+* Alternate Interface:: Using Readline in a `callback' fashion.
+* A Readline Example:: An example Readline function.
+@end menu
+
+@node Function Naming
+@subsection Naming a Function
+
+The user can dynamically change the bindings of keys while using
+Readline. This is done by representing the function with a descriptive
+name. The user is able to type the descriptive name when referring to
+the function. Thus, in an init file, one might find
+
+@example
+Meta-Rubout: backward-kill-word
+@end example
+
+This binds the keystroke @key{Meta-Rubout} to the function
+@emph{descriptively} named @code{backward-kill-word}. You, as the
+programmer, should bind the functions you write to descriptive names as
+well. Readline provides a function for doing that:
+
+@deftypefun int rl_add_defun (const char *name, rl_command_func_t *function, int key)
+Add @var{name} to the list of named functions. Make @var{function} be
+the function that gets called. If @var{key} is not -1, then bind it to
+@var{function} using @code{rl_bind_key()}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+Using this function alone is sufficient for most applications.
+It is the recommended way to add a few functions to the default
+functions that Readline has built in.
+If you need to do something other than adding a function to Readline,
+you may need to use the underlying functions described below.
+
+@node Keymaps
+@subsection Selecting a Keymap
+
+Key bindings take place on a @dfn{keymap}. The keymap is the
+association between the keys that the user types and the functions that
+get run. You can make your own keymaps, copy existing keymaps, and tell
+Readline which keymap to use.
+
+@deftypefun Keymap rl_make_bare_keymap (void)
+Returns a new, empty keymap. The space for the keymap is allocated with
+@code{malloc()}; the caller should free it by calling
+@code{rl_discard_keymap()} when done.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun Keymap rl_copy_keymap (Keymap map)
+Return a new keymap which is a copy of @var{map}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun Keymap rl_make_keymap (void)
+Return a new keymap with the printing characters bound to rl_insert,
+the lowercase Meta characters bound to run their equivalents, and
+the Meta digits bound to produce numeric arguments.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun void rl_discard_keymap (Keymap keymap)
+Free the storage associated with @var{keymap}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+Readline has several internal keymaps. These functions allow you to
+change which keymap is active.
+
+@deftypefun Keymap rl_get_keymap (void)
+Returns the currently active keymap.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun void rl_set_keymap (Keymap keymap)
+Makes @var{keymap} the currently active keymap.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun Keymap rl_get_keymap_by_name (const char *name)
+Return the keymap matching @var{name}. @var{name} is one which would
+be supplied in a @code{set keymap} inputrc line (@pxref{Readline Init File}).
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun {char *} rl_get_keymap_name (Keymap keymap)
+Return the name matching @var{keymap}. @var{name} is one which would
+be supplied in a @code{set keymap} inputrc line (@pxref{Readline Init File}).
+@end deftypefun
+
+@node Binding Keys
+@subsection Binding Keys
+
+Key sequences are associate with functions through the keymap.
+Readline has several internal keymaps: @code{emacs_standard_keymap},
+@code{emacs_meta_keymap}, @code{emacs_ctlx_keymap},
+@code{vi_movement_keymap}, and @code{vi_insertion_keymap}.
+@code{emacs_standard_keymap} is the default, and the examples in
+this manual assume that.
+
+Since @code{readline()} installs a set of default key bindings the first
+time it is called, there is always the danger that a custom binding
+installed before the first call to @code{readline()} will be overridden.
+An alternate mechanism is to install custom key bindings in an
+initialization function assigned to the @code{rl_startup_hook} variable
+(@pxref{Readline Variables}).
+
+These functions manage key bindings.
+
+@deftypefun int rl_bind_key (int key, rl_command_func_t *function)
+Binds @var{key} to @var{function} in the currently active keymap.
+Returns non-zero in the case of an invalid @var{key}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_bind_key_in_map (int key, rl_command_func_t *function, Keymap map)
+Bind @var{key} to @var{function} in @var{map}.
+Returns non-zero in the case of an invalid @var{key}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_bind_key_if_unbound (int key, rl_command_func_t *function)
+Binds @var{key} to @var{function} if it is not already bound in the
+currently active keymap.
+Returns non-zero in the case of an invalid @var{key} or if @var{key} is
+already bound.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_bind_key_if_unbound_in_map (int key, rl_command_func_t *function, Keymap map)
+Binds @var{key} to @var{function} if it is not already bound in @var{map}.
+Returns non-zero in the case of an invalid @var{key} or if @var{key} is
+already bound.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_unbind_key (int key)
+Bind @var{key} to the null function in the currently active keymap.
+Returns non-zero in case of error.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_unbind_key_in_map (int key, Keymap map)
+Bind @var{key} to the null function in @var{map}.
+Returns non-zero in case of error.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_unbind_function_in_map (rl_command_func_t *function, Keymap map)
+Unbind all keys that execute @var{function} in @var{map}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_unbind_command_in_map (const char *command, Keymap map)
+Unbind all keys that are bound to @var{command} in @var{map}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_bind_keyseq (const char *keyseq, rl_command_func_t *function)
+Bind the key sequence represented by the string @var{keyseq} to the function
+@var{function}, beginning in the current keymap.
+This makes new keymaps as necessary.
+The return value is non-zero if @var{keyseq} is invalid.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_bind_keyseq_in_map (const char *keyseq, rl_command_func_t *function, Keymap map)
+Bind the key sequence represented by the string @var{keyseq} to the function
+@var{function}. This makes new keymaps as necessary.
+Initial bindings are performed in @var{map}.
+The return value is non-zero if @var{keyseq} is invalid.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_set_key (const char *keyseq, rl_command_func_t *function, Keymap map)
+Equivalent to @code{rl_bind_keyseq_in_map}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound (const char *keyseq, rl_command_func_t *function)
+Binds @var{keyseq} to @var{function} if it is not already bound in the
+currently active keymap.
+Returns non-zero in the case of an invalid @var{keyseq} or if @var{keyseq} is
+already bound.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound_in_map (const char *keyseq, rl_command_func_t *function, Keymap map)
+Binds @var{keyseq} to @var{function} if it is not already bound in @var{map}.
+Returns non-zero in the case of an invalid @var{keyseq} or if @var{keyseq} is
+already bound.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_generic_bind (int type, const char *keyseq, char *data, Keymap map)
+Bind the key sequence represented by the string @var{keyseq} to the arbitrary
+pointer @var{data}. @var{type} says what kind of data is pointed to by
+@var{data}; this can be a function (@code{ISFUNC}), a macro
+(@code{ISMACR}), or a keymap (@code{ISKMAP}). This makes new keymaps as
+necessary. The initial keymap in which to do bindings is @var{map}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_parse_and_bind (char *line)
+Parse @var{line} as if it had been read from the @code{inputrc} file and
+perform any key bindings and variable assignments found
+(@pxref{Readline Init File}).
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_read_init_file (const char *filename)
+Read keybindings and variable assignments from @var{filename}
+(@pxref{Readline Init File}).
+@end deftypefun
+
+@node Associating Function Names and Bindings
+@subsection Associating Function Names and Bindings
+
+These functions allow you to find out what keys invoke named functions
+and the functions invoked by a particular key sequence. You may also
+associate a new function name with an arbitrary function.
+
+@deftypefun {rl_command_func_t *} rl_named_function (const char *name)
+Return the function with name @var{name}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun {rl_command_func_t *} rl_function_of_keyseq (const char *keyseq, Keymap map, int *type)
+Return the function invoked by @var{keyseq} in keymap @var{map}.
+If @var{map} is @code{NULL}, the current keymap is used. If @var{type} is
+not @code{NULL}, the type of the object is returned in the @code{int} variable
+it points to (one of @code{ISFUNC}, @code{ISKMAP}, or @code{ISMACR}).
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun {char **} rl_invoking_keyseqs (rl_command_func_t *function)
+Return an array of strings representing the key sequences used to
+invoke @var{function} in the current keymap.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun {char **} rl_invoking_keyseqs_in_map (rl_command_func_t *function, Keymap map)
+Return an array of strings representing the key sequences used to
+invoke @var{function} in the keymap @var{map}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun void rl_function_dumper (int readable)
+Print the readline function names and the key sequences currently
+bound to them to @code{rl_outstream}. If @var{readable} is non-zero,
+the list is formatted in such a way that it can be made part of an
+@code{inputrc} file and re-read.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun void rl_list_funmap_names (void)
+Print the names of all bindable Readline functions to @code{rl_outstream}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun {const char **} rl_funmap_names (void)
+Return a NULL terminated array of known function names. The array is
+sorted. The array itself is allocated, but not the strings inside. You
+should @code{free()} the array when you are done, but not the pointers.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_add_funmap_entry (const char *name, rl_command_func_t *function)
+Add @var{name} to the list of bindable Readline command names, and make
+@var{function} the function to be called when @var{name} is invoked.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@node Allowing Undoing
+@subsection Allowing Undoing
+
+Supporting the undo command is a painless thing, and makes your
+functions much more useful. It is certainly easy to try
+something if you know you can undo it.
+
+If your function simply inserts text once, or deletes text once, and
+uses @code{rl_insert_text()} or @code{rl_delete_text()} to do it, then
+undoing is already done for you automatically.
+
+If you do multiple insertions or multiple deletions, or any combination
+of these operations, you should group them together into one operation.
+This is done with @code{rl_begin_undo_group()} and
+@code{rl_end_undo_group()}.
+
+The types of events that can be undone are:
+
+@smallexample
+enum undo_code @{ UNDO_DELETE, UNDO_INSERT, UNDO_BEGIN, UNDO_END @};
+@end smallexample
+
+Notice that @code{UNDO_DELETE} means to insert some text, and
+@code{UNDO_INSERT} means to delete some text. That is, the undo code
+tells what to undo, not how to undo it. @code{UNDO_BEGIN} and
+@code{UNDO_END} are tags added by @code{rl_begin_undo_group()} and
+@code{rl_end_undo_group()}.
+
+@deftypefun int rl_begin_undo_group (void)
+Begins saving undo information in a group construct. The undo
+information usually comes from calls to @code{rl_insert_text()} and
+@code{rl_delete_text()}, but could be the result of calls to
+@code{rl_add_undo()}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_end_undo_group (void)
+Closes the current undo group started with @code{rl_begin_undo_group
+()}. There should be one call to @code{rl_end_undo_group()}
+for each call to @code{rl_begin_undo_group()}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun void rl_add_undo (enum undo_code what, int start, int end, char *text)
+Remember how to undo an event (according to @var{what}). The affected
+text runs from @var{start} to @var{end}, and encompasses @var{text}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun void rl_free_undo_list (void)
+Free the existing undo list.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_do_undo (void)
+Undo the first thing on the undo list. Returns @code{0} if there was
+nothing to undo, non-zero if something was undone.
+@end deftypefun
+
+Finally, if you neither insert nor delete text, but directly modify the
+existing text (e.g., change its case), call @code{rl_modifying()}
+once, just before you modify the text. You must supply the indices of
+the text range that you are going to modify.
+
+@deftypefun int rl_modifying (int start, int end)
+Tell Readline to save the text between @var{start} and @var{end} as a
+single undo unit. It is assumed that you will subsequently modify
+that text.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@node Redisplay
+@subsection Redisplay
+
+@deftypefun void rl_redisplay (void)
+Change what's displayed on the screen to reflect the current contents
+of @code{rl_line_buffer}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_forced_update_display (void)
+Force the line to be updated and redisplayed, whether or not
+Readline thinks the screen display is correct.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_on_new_line (void)
+Tell the update functions that we have moved onto a new (empty) line,
+usually after ouputting a newline.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_on_new_line_with_prompt (void)
+Tell the update functions that we have moved onto a new line, with
+@var{rl_prompt} already displayed.
+This could be used by applications that want to output the prompt string
+themselves, but still need Readline to know the prompt string length for
+redisplay.
+It should be used after setting @var{rl_already_prompted}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_reset_line_state (void)
+Reset the display state to a clean state and redisplay the current line
+starting on a new line.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_crlf (void)
+Move the cursor to the start of the next screen line.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_show_char (int c)
+Display character @var{c} on @code{rl_outstream}.
+If Readline has not been set to display meta characters directly, this
+will convert meta characters to a meta-prefixed key sequence.
+This is intended for use by applications which wish to do their own
+redisplay.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_message (const char *, @dots{})
+The arguments are a format string as would be supplied to @code{printf},
+possibly containing conversion specifications such as @samp{%d}, and
+any additional arguments necessary to satisfy the conversion specifications.
+The resulting string is displayed in the @dfn{echo area}. The echo area
+is also used to display numeric arguments and search strings.
+You should call @code{rl_save_prompt} to save the prompt information
+before calling this function.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_clear_message (void)
+Clear the message in the echo area. If the prompt was saved with a call to
+@code{rl_save_prompt} before the last call to @code{rl_message},
+call @code{rl_restore_prompt} before calling this function.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun void rl_save_prompt (void)
+Save the local Readline prompt display state in preparation for
+displaying a new message in the message area with @code{rl_message()}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun void rl_restore_prompt (void)
+Restore the local Readline prompt display state saved by the most
+recent call to @code{rl_save_prompt}.
+if @code{rl_save_prompt} was called to save the prompt before a call
+to @code{rl_message}, this function should be called before the
+corresponding call to @code{rl_clear_message}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_expand_prompt (char *prompt)
+Expand any special character sequences in @var{prompt} and set up the
+local Readline prompt redisplay variables.
+This function is called by @code{readline()}. It may also be called to
+expand the primary prompt if the @code{rl_on_new_line_with_prompt()}
+function or @code{rl_already_prompted} variable is used.
+It returns the number of visible characters on the last line of the
+(possibly multi-line) prompt.
+Applications may indicate that the prompt contains characters that take
+up no physical screen space when displayed by bracketing a sequence of
+such characters with the special markers @code{RL_PROMPT_START_IGNORE}
+and @code{RL_PROMPT_END_IGNORE} (declared in @file{readline.h}. This may
+be used to embed terminal-specific escape sequences in prompts.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_set_prompt (const char *prompt)
+Make Readline use @var{prompt} for subsequent redisplay. This calls
+@code{rl_expand_prompt()} to expand the prompt and sets @code{rl_prompt}
+to the result.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@node Modifying Text
+@subsection Modifying Text
+
+@deftypefun int rl_insert_text (const char *text)
+Insert @var{text} into the line at the current cursor position.
+Returns the number of characters inserted.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_delete_text (int start, int end)
+Delete the text between @var{start} and @var{end} in the current line.
+Returns the number of characters deleted.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun {char *} rl_copy_text (int start, int end)
+Return a copy of the text between @var{start} and @var{end} in
+the current line.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_kill_text (int start, int end)
+Copy the text between @var{start} and @var{end} in the current line
+to the kill ring, appending or prepending to the last kill if the
+last command was a kill command. The text is deleted.
+If @var{start} is less than @var{end},
+the text is appended, otherwise prepended. If the last command was
+not a kill, a new kill ring slot is used.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_push_macro_input (char *macro)
+Cause @var{macro} to be inserted into the line, as if it had been invoked
+by a key bound to a macro. Not especially useful; use
+@code{rl_insert_text()} instead.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@node Character Input
+@subsection Character Input
+
+@deftypefun int rl_read_key (void)
+Return the next character available from Readline's current input stream.
+This handles input inserted into
+the input stream via @var{rl_pending_input} (@pxref{Readline Variables})
+and @code{rl_stuff_char()}, macros, and characters read from the keyboard.
+While waiting for input, this function will call any function assigned to
+the @code{rl_event_hook} variable.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_getc (FILE *stream)
+Return the next character available from @var{stream}, which is assumed to
+be the keyboard.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_stuff_char (int c)
+Insert @var{c} into the Readline input stream. It will be "read"
+before Readline attempts to read characters from the terminal with
+@code{rl_read_key()}. Up to 512 characters may be pushed back.
+@code{rl_stuff_char} returns 1 if the character was successfully inserted;
+0 otherwise.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_execute_next (int c)
+Make @var{c} be the next command to be executed when @code{rl_read_key()}
+is called. This sets @var{rl_pending_input}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_clear_pending_input (void)
+Unset @var{rl_pending_input}, effectively negating the effect of any
+previous call to @code{rl_execute_next()}. This works only if the
+pending input has not already been read with @code{rl_read_key()}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_set_keyboard_input_timeout (int u)
+While waiting for keyboard input in @code{rl_read_key()}, Readline will
+wait for @var{u} microseconds for input before calling any function
+assigned to @code{rl_event_hook}. The default waiting period is
+one-tenth of a second. Returns the old timeout value.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@node Terminal Management
+@subsection Terminal Management
+
+@deftypefun void rl_prep_terminal (int meta_flag)
+Modify the terminal settings for Readline's use, so @code{readline()}
+can read a single character at a time from the keyboard.
+The @var{meta_flag} argument should be non-zero if Readline should
+read eight-bit input.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun void rl_deprep_terminal (void)
+Undo the effects of @code{rl_prep_terminal()}, leaving the terminal in
+the state in which it was before the most recent call to
+@code{rl_prep_terminal()}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun void rl_tty_set_default_bindings (Keymap kmap)
+Read the operating system's terminal editing characters (as would be
+displayed by @code{stty}) to their Readline equivalents.
+The bindings are performed in @var{kmap}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun void rl_tty_unset_default_bindings (Keymap kmap)
+Reset the bindings manipulated by @code{rl_tty_set_default_bindings} so
+that the terminal editing characters are bound to @code{rl_insert}.
+The bindings are performed in @var{kmap}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_reset_terminal (const char *terminal_name)
+Reinitialize Readline's idea of the terminal settings using
+@var{terminal_name} as the terminal type (e.g., @code{vt100}).
+If @var{terminal_name} is @code{NULL}, the value of the @code{TERM}
+environment variable is used.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@node Utility Functions
+@subsection Utility Functions
+
+@deftypefun void rl_replace_line (const char *text, int clear_undo)
+Replace the contents of @code{rl_line_buffer} with @var{text}.
+The point and mark are preserved, if possible.
+If @var{clear_undo} is non-zero, the undo list associated with the
+current line is cleared.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_extend_line_buffer (int len)
+Ensure that @code{rl_line_buffer} has enough space to hold @var{len}
+characters, possibly reallocating it if necessary.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_initialize (void)
+Initialize or re-initialize Readline's internal state.
+It's not strictly necessary to call this; @code{readline()} calls it before
+reading any input.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_ding (void)
+Ring the terminal bell, obeying the setting of @code{bell-style}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_alphabetic (int c)
+Return 1 if @var{c} is an alphabetic character.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun void rl_display_match_list (char **matches, int len, int max)
+A convenience function for displaying a list of strings in
+columnar format on Readline's output stream. @code{matches} is the list
+of strings, in argv format, such as a list of completion matches.
+@code{len} is the number of strings in @code{matches}, and @code{max}
+is the length of the longest string in @code{matches}. This function uses
+the setting of @code{print-completions-horizontally} to select how the
+matches are displayed (@pxref{Readline Init File Syntax}).
+@end deftypefun
+
+The following are implemented as macros, defined in @code{chardefs.h}.
+Applications should refrain from using them.
+
+@deftypefun int _rl_uppercase_p (int c)
+Return 1 if @var{c} is an uppercase alphabetic character.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int _rl_lowercase_p (int c)
+Return 1 if @var{c} is a lowercase alphabetic character.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int _rl_digit_p (int c)
+Return 1 if @var{c} is a numeric character.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int _rl_to_upper (int c)
+If @var{c} is a lowercase alphabetic character, return the corresponding
+uppercase character.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int _rl_to_lower (int c)
+If @var{c} is an uppercase alphabetic character, return the corresponding
+lowercase character.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int _rl_digit_value (int c)
+If @var{c} is a number, return the value it represents.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@node Miscellaneous Functions
+@subsection Miscellaneous Functions
+
+@deftypefun int rl_macro_bind (const char *keyseq, const char *macro, Keymap map)
+Bind the key sequence @var{keyseq} to invoke the macro @var{macro}.
+The binding is performed in @var{map}. When @var{keyseq} is invoked, the
+@var{macro} will be inserted into the line. This function is deprecated;
+use @code{rl_generic_bind()} instead.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun void rl_macro_dumper (int readable)
+Print the key sequences bound to macros and their values, using
+the current keymap, to @code{rl_outstream}.
+If @var{readable} is non-zero, the list is formatted in such a way
+that it can be made part of an @code{inputrc} file and re-read.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_variable_bind (const char *variable, const char *value)
+Make the Readline variable @var{variable} have @var{value}.
+This behaves as if the readline command
+@samp{set @var{variable} @var{value}} had been executed in an @code{inputrc}
+file (@pxref{Readline Init File Syntax}).
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun {char *} rl_variable_value (const char *variable)
+Return a string representing the value of the Readline variable @var{variable}.
+For boolean variables, this string is either @samp{on} or @samp{off}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun void rl_variable_dumper (int readable)
+Print the readline variable names and their current values
+to @code{rl_outstream}.
+If @var{readable} is non-zero, the list is formatted in such a way
+that it can be made part of an @code{inputrc} file and re-read.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_set_paren_blink_timeout (int u)
+Set the time interval (in microseconds) that Readline waits when showing
+a balancing character when @code{blink-matching-paren} has been enabled.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun {char *} rl_get_termcap (const char *cap)
+Retrieve the string value of the termcap capability @var{cap}.
+Readline fetches the termcap entry for the current terminal name and
+uses those capabilities to move around the screen line and perform other
+terminal-specific operations, like erasing a line. Readline does not
+use all of a terminal's capabilities, and this function will return
+values for only those capabilities Readline uses.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@node Alternate Interface
+@subsection Alternate Interface
+
+An alternate interface is available to plain @code{readline()}. Some
+applications need to interleave keyboard I/O with file, device, or
+window system I/O, typically by using a main loop to @code{select()}
+on various file descriptors. To accomodate this need, readline can
+also be invoked as a `callback' function from an event loop. There
+are functions available to make this easy.
+
+@deftypefun void rl_callback_handler_install (const char *prompt, rl_vcpfunc_t *lhandler)
+Set up the terminal for readline I/O and display the initial
+expanded value of @var{prompt}. Save the value of @var{lhandler} to
+use as a function to call when a complete line of input has been entered.
+The function takes the text of the line as an argument.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun void rl_callback_read_char (void)
+Whenever an application determines that keyboard input is available, it
+should call @code{rl_callback_read_char()}, which will read the next
+character from the current input source.
+If that character completes the line, @code{rl_callback_read_char} will
+invoke the @var{lhandler} function saved by @code{rl_callback_handler_install}
+to process the line.
+Before calling the @var{lhandler} function, the terminal settings are
+reset to the values they had before calling
+@code{rl_callback_handler_install}.
+If the @var{lhandler} function returns,
+the terminal settings are modified for Readline's use again.
+@code{EOF} is indicated by calling @var{lhandler} with a
+@code{NULL} line.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun void rl_callback_handler_remove (void)
+Restore the terminal to its initial state and remove the line handler.
+This may be called from within a callback as well as independently.
+If the @var{lhandler} installed by @code{rl_callback_handler_install}
+does not exit the program, either this function or the function referred
+to by the value of @code{rl_deprep_term_function} should be called before
+the program exits to reset the terminal settings.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@node A Readline Example
+@subsection A Readline Example
+
+Here is a function which changes lowercase characters to their uppercase
+equivalents, and uppercase characters to lowercase. If
+this function was bound to @samp{M-c}, then typing @samp{M-c} would
+change the case of the character under point. Typing @samp{M-1 0 M-c}
+would change the case of the following 10 characters, leaving the cursor on
+the last character changed.
+
+@example
+/* Invert the case of the COUNT following characters. */
+int
+invert_case_line (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+@{
+ register int start, end, i;
+
+ start = rl_point;
+
+ if (rl_point >= rl_end)
+ return (0);
+
+ if (count < 0)
+ @{
+ direction = -1;
+ count = -count;
+ @}
+ else
+ direction = 1;
+
+ /* Find the end of the range to modify. */
+ end = start + (count * direction);
+
+ /* Force it to be within range. */
+ if (end > rl_end)
+ end = rl_end;
+ else if (end < 0)
+ end = 0;
+
+ if (start == end)
+ return (0);
+
+ if (start > end)
+ @{
+ int temp = start;
+ start = end;
+ end = temp;
+ @}
+
+ /* Tell readline that we are modifying the line,
+ so it will save the undo information. */
+ rl_modifying (start, end);
+
+ for (i = start; i != end; i++)
+ @{
+ if (_rl_uppercase_p (rl_line_buffer[i]))
+ rl_line_buffer[i] = _rl_to_lower (rl_line_buffer[i]);
+ else if (_rl_lowercase_p (rl_line_buffer[i]))
+ rl_line_buffer[i] = _rl_to_upper (rl_line_buffer[i]);
+ @}
+ /* Move point to on top of the last character changed. */
+ rl_point = (direction == 1) ? end - 1 : start;
+ return (0);
+@}
+@end example
+
+@node Readline Signal Handling
+@section Readline Signal Handling
+
+Signals are asynchronous events sent to a process by the Unix kernel,
+sometimes on behalf of another process. They are intended to indicate
+exceptional events, like a user pressing the interrupt key on his terminal,
+or a network connection being broken. There is a class of signals that can
+be sent to the process currently reading input from the keyboard. Since
+Readline changes the terminal attributes when it is called, it needs to
+perform special processing when such a signal is received in order to
+restore the terminal to a sane state, or provide application writers with
+functions to do so manually.
+
+Readline contains an internal signal handler that is installed for a
+number of signals (@code{SIGINT}, @code{SIGQUIT}, @code{SIGTERM},
+@code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGTSTP}, @code{SIGTTIN}, and @code{SIGTTOU}).
+When one of these signals is received, the signal handler
+will reset the terminal attributes to those that were in effect before
+@code{readline()} was called, reset the signal handling to what it was
+before @code{readline()} was called, and resend the signal to the calling
+application.
+If and when the calling application's signal handler returns, Readline
+will reinitialize the terminal and continue to accept input.
+When a @code{SIGINT} is received, the Readline signal handler performs
+some additional work, which will cause any partially-entered line to be
+aborted (see the description of @code{rl_free_line_state()} below).
+
+There is an additional Readline signal handler, for @code{SIGWINCH}, which
+the kernel sends to a process whenever the terminal's size changes (for
+example, if a user resizes an @code{xterm}). The Readline @code{SIGWINCH}
+handler updates Readline's internal screen size information, and then calls
+any @code{SIGWINCH} signal handler the calling application has installed.
+Readline calls the application's @code{SIGWINCH} signal handler without
+resetting the terminal to its original state. If the application's signal
+handler does more than update its idea of the terminal size and return (for
+example, a @code{longjmp} back to a main processing loop), it @emph{must}
+call @code{rl_cleanup_after_signal()} (described below), to restore the
+terminal state.
+
+Readline provides two variables that allow application writers to
+control whether or not it will catch certain signals and act on them
+when they are received. It is important that applications change the
+values of these variables only when calling @code{readline()}, not in
+a signal handler, so Readline's internal signal state is not corrupted.
+
+@deftypevar int rl_catch_signals
+If this variable is non-zero, Readline will install signal handlers for
+@code{SIGINT}, @code{SIGQUIT}, @code{SIGTERM}, @code{SIGALRM},
+@code{SIGTSTP}, @code{SIGTTIN}, and @code{SIGTTOU}.
+
+The default value of @code{rl_catch_signals} is 1.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar int rl_catch_sigwinch
+If this variable is non-zero, Readline will install a signal handler for
+@code{SIGWINCH}.
+
+The default value of @code{rl_catch_sigwinch} is 1.
+@end deftypevar
+
+If an application does not wish to have Readline catch any signals, or
+to handle signals other than those Readline catches (@code{SIGHUP},
+for example),
+Readline provides convenience functions to do the necessary terminal
+and internal state cleanup upon receipt of a signal.
+
+@deftypefun void rl_cleanup_after_signal (void)
+This function will reset the state of the terminal to what it was before
+@code{readline()} was called, and remove the Readline signal handlers for
+all signals, depending on the values of @code{rl_catch_signals} and
+@code{rl_catch_sigwinch}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun void rl_free_line_state (void)
+This will free any partial state associated with the current input line
+(undo information, any partial history entry, any partially-entered
+keyboard macro, and any partially-entered numeric argument). This
+should be called before @code{rl_cleanup_after_signal()}. The
+Readline signal handler for @code{SIGINT} calls this to abort the
+current input line.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun void rl_reset_after_signal (void)
+This will reinitialize the terminal and reinstall any Readline signal
+handlers, depending on the values of @code{rl_catch_signals} and
+@code{rl_catch_sigwinch}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+If an application does not wish Readline to catch @code{SIGWINCH}, it may
+call @code{rl_resize_terminal()} or @code{rl_set_screen_size()} to force
+Readline to update its idea of the terminal size when a @code{SIGWINCH}
+is received.
+
+@deftypefun void rl_resize_terminal (void)
+Update Readline's internal screen size by reading values from the kernel.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun void rl_set_screen_size (int rows, int cols)
+Set Readline's idea of the terminal size to @var{rows} rows and
+@var{cols} columns. If either @var{rows} or @var{columns} is less than
+or equal to 0, Readline's idea of that terminal dimension is unchanged.
+@end deftypefun
+
+If an application does not want to install a @code{SIGWINCH} handler, but
+is still interested in the screen dimensions, Readline's idea of the screen
+size may be queried.
+
+@deftypefun void rl_get_screen_size (int *rows, int *cols)
+Return Readline's idea of the terminal's size in the
+variables pointed to by the arguments.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun void rl_reset_screen_size (void)
+Cause Readline to reobtain the screen size and recalculate its dimensions.
+@end deftypefun
+
+The following functions install and remove Readline's signal handlers.
+
+@deftypefun int rl_set_signals (void)
+Install Readline's signal handler for @code{SIGINT}, @code{SIGQUIT},
+@code{SIGTERM}, @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGTSTP}, @code{SIGTTIN},
+@code{SIGTTOU}, and @code{SIGWINCH}, depending on the values of
+@code{rl_catch_signals} and @code{rl_catch_sigwinch}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_clear_signals (void)
+Remove all of the Readline signal handlers installed by
+@code{rl_set_signals()}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@node Custom Completers
+@section Custom Completers
+@cindex application-specific completion functions
+
+Typically, a program that reads commands from the user has a way of
+disambiguating commands and data. If your program is one of these, then
+it can provide completion for commands, data, or both.
+The following sections describe how your program and Readline
+cooperate to provide this service.
+
+@menu
+* How Completing Works:: The logic used to do completion.
+* Completion Functions:: Functions provided by Readline.
+* Completion Variables:: Variables which control completion.
+* A Short Completion Example:: An example of writing completer subroutines.
+@end menu
+
+@node How Completing Works
+@subsection How Completing Works
+
+In order to complete some text, the full list of possible completions
+must be available. That is, it is not possible to accurately
+expand a partial word without knowing all of the possible words
+which make sense in that context. The Readline library provides
+the user interface to completion, and two of the most common
+completion functions: filename and username. For completing other types
+of text, you must write your own completion function. This section
+describes exactly what such functions must do, and provides an example.
+
+There are three major functions used to perform completion:
+
+@enumerate
+@item
+The user-interface function @code{rl_complete()}. This function is
+called with the same arguments as other bindable Readline functions:
+@var{count} and @var{invoking_key}.
+It isolates the word to be completed and calls
+@code{rl_completion_matches()} to generate a list of possible completions.
+It then either lists the possible completions, inserts the possible
+completions, or actually performs the
+completion, depending on which behavior is desired.
+
+@item
+The internal function @code{rl_completion_matches()} uses an
+application-supplied @dfn{generator} function to generate the list of
+possible matches, and then returns the array of these matches.
+The caller should place the address of its generator function in
+@code{rl_completion_entry_function}.
+
+@item
+The generator function is called repeatedly from
+@code{rl_completion_matches()}, returning a string each time. The
+arguments to the generator function are @var{text} and @var{state}.
+@var{text} is the partial word to be completed. @var{state} is zero the
+first time the function is called, allowing the generator to perform
+any necessary initialization, and a positive non-zero integer for
+each subsequent call. The generator function returns
+@code{(char *)NULL} to inform @code{rl_completion_matches()} that there are
+no more possibilities left. Usually the generator function computes the
+list of possible completions when @var{state} is zero, and returns them
+one at a time on subsequent calls. Each string the generator function
+returns as a match must be allocated with @code{malloc()}; Readline
+frees the strings when it has finished with them.
+Such a generator function is referred to as an
+@dfn{application-specific completion function}.
+
+@end enumerate
+
+@deftypefun int rl_complete (int ignore, int invoking_key)
+Complete the word at or before point. You have supplied the function
+that does the initial simple matching selection algorithm (see
+@code{rl_completion_matches()}). The default is to do filename completion.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypevar {rl_compentry_func_t *} rl_completion_entry_function
+This is a pointer to the generator function for
+@code{rl_completion_matches()}.
+If the value of @code{rl_completion_entry_function} is
+@code{NULL} then the default filename generator
+function, @code{rl_filename_completion_function()}, is used.
+An @dfn{application-specific completion function} is a function whose
+address is assigned to @code{rl_completion_entry_function} and whose
+return values are used to generate possible completions.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@node Completion Functions
+@subsection Completion Functions
+
+Here is the complete list of callable completion functions present in
+Readline.
+
+@deftypefun int rl_complete_internal (int what_to_do)
+Complete the word at or before point. @var{what_to_do} says what to do
+with the completion. A value of @samp{?} means list the possible
+completions. @samp{TAB} means do standard completion. @samp{*} means
+insert all of the possible completions. @samp{!} means to display
+all of the possible completions, if there is more than one, as well as
+performing partial completion. @samp{@@} is similar to @samp{!}, but
+possible completions are not listed if the possible completions share
+a common prefix.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_complete (int ignore, int invoking_key)
+Complete the word at or before point. You have supplied the function
+that does the initial simple matching selection algorithm (see
+@code{rl_completion_matches()} and @code{rl_completion_entry_function}).
+The default is to do filename
+completion. This calls @code{rl_complete_internal()} with an
+argument depending on @var{invoking_key}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_possible_completions (int count, int invoking_key)
+List the possible completions. See description of @code{rl_complete
+()}. This calls @code{rl_complete_internal()} with an argument of
+@samp{?}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_insert_completions (int count, int invoking_key)
+Insert the list of possible completions into the line, deleting the
+partially-completed word. See description of @code{rl_complete()}.
+This calls @code{rl_complete_internal()} with an argument of @samp{*}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun int rl_completion_mode (rl_command_func_t *cfunc)
+Returns the apppriate value to pass to @code{rl_complete_internal()}
+depending on whether @var{cfunc} was called twice in succession and
+the values of the @code{show-all-if-ambiguous} and
+@code{show-all-if-unmodified} variables.
+Application-specific completion functions may use this function to present
+the same interface as @code{rl_complete()}.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun {char **} rl_completion_matches (const char *text, rl_compentry_func_t *entry_func)
+Returns an array of strings which is a list of completions for
+@var{text}. If there are no completions, returns @code{NULL}.
+The first entry in the returned array is the substitution for @var{text}.
+The remaining entries are the possible completions. The array is
+terminated with a @code{NULL} pointer.
+
+@var{entry_func} is a function of two args, and returns a
+@code{char *}. The first argument is @var{text}. The second is a
+state argument; it is zero on the first call, and non-zero on subsequent
+calls. @var{entry_func} returns a @code{NULL} pointer to the caller
+when there are no more matches.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun {char *} rl_filename_completion_function (const char *text, int state)
+A generator function for filename completion in the general case.
+@var{text} is a partial filename.
+The Bash source is a useful reference for writing application-specific
+completion functions (the Bash completion functions call this and other
+Readline functions).
+@end deftypefun
+
+@deftypefun {char *} rl_username_completion_function (const char *text, int state)
+A completion generator for usernames. @var{text} contains a partial
+username preceded by a random character (usually @samp{~}). As with all
+completion generators, @var{state} is zero on the first call and non-zero
+for subsequent calls.
+@end deftypefun
+
+@node Completion Variables
+@subsection Completion Variables
+
+@deftypevar {rl_compentry_func_t *} rl_completion_entry_function
+A pointer to the generator function for @code{rl_completion_matches()}.
+@code{NULL} means to use @code{rl_filename_completion_function()},
+the default filename completer.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {rl_completion_func_t *} rl_attempted_completion_function
+A pointer to an alternative function to create matches.
+The function is called with @var{text}, @var{start}, and @var{end}.
+@var{start} and @var{end} are indices in @code{rl_line_buffer} defining
+the boundaries of @var{text}, which is a character string.
+If this function exists and returns @code{NULL}, or if this variable is
+set to @code{NULL}, then @code{rl_complete()} will call the value of
+@code{rl_completion_entry_function} to generate matches, otherwise the
+array of strings returned will be used.
+If this function sets the @code{rl_attempted_completion_over}
+variable to a non-zero value, Readline will not perform its default
+completion even if this function returns no matches.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {rl_quote_func_t *} rl_filename_quoting_function
+A pointer to a function that will quote a filename in an
+application-specific fashion. This is called if filename completion is being
+attempted and one of the characters in @code{rl_filename_quote_characters}
+appears in a completed filename. The function is called with
+@var{text}, @var{match_type}, and @var{quote_pointer}. The @var{text}
+is the filename to be quoted. The @var{match_type} is either
+@code{SINGLE_MATCH}, if there is only one completion match, or
+@code{MULT_MATCH}. Some functions use this to decide whether or not to
+insert a closing quote character. The @var{quote_pointer} is a pointer
+to any opening quote character the user typed. Some functions choose
+to reset this character.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {rl_dequote_func_t *} rl_filename_dequoting_function
+A pointer to a function that will remove application-specific quoting
+characters from a filename before completion is attempted, so those
+characters do not interfere with matching the text against names in
+the filesystem. It is called with @var{text}, the text of the word
+to be dequoted, and @var{quote_char}, which is the quoting character
+that delimits the filename (usually @samp{'} or @samp{"}). If
+@var{quote_char} is zero, the filename was not in an embedded string.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {rl_linebuf_func_t *} rl_char_is_quoted_p
+A pointer to a function to call that determines whether or not a specific
+character in the line buffer is quoted, according to whatever quoting
+mechanism the program calling Readline uses. The function is called with
+two arguments: @var{text}, the text of the line, and @var{index}, the
+index of the character in the line. It is used to decide whether a
+character found in @code{rl_completer_word_break_characters} should be
+used to break words for the completer.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {rl_compignore_func_t *} rl_ignore_some_completions_function
+This function, if defined, is called by the completer when real filename
+completion is done, after all the matching names have been generated.
+It is passed a @code{NULL} terminated array of matches.
+The first element (@code{matches[0]}) is the
+maximal substring common to all matches. This function can
+re-arrange the list of matches as required, but each element deleted
+from the array must be freed.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {rl_icppfunc_t *} rl_directory_completion_hook
+This function, if defined, is allowed to modify the directory portion
+of filenames Readline completes. It is called with the address of a
+string (the current directory name) as an argument, and may modify that string.
+If the string is replaced with a new string, the old value should be freed.
+Any modified directory name should have a trailing slash.
+The modified value will be displayed as part of the completion, replacing
+the directory portion of the pathname the user typed.
+It returns an integer that should be non-zero if the function modifies
+its directory argument.
+It could be used to expand symbolic links or shell variables in pathnames.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {rl_compdisp_func_t *} rl_completion_display_matches_hook
+If non-zero, then this is the address of a function to call when
+completing a word would normally display the list of possible matches.
+This function is called in lieu of Readline displaying the list.
+It takes three arguments:
+(@code{char **}@var{matches}, @code{int} @var{num_matches}, @code{int} @var{max_length})
+where @var{matches} is the array of matching strings,
+@var{num_matches} is the number of strings in that array, and
+@var{max_length} is the length of the longest string in that array.
+Readline provides a convenience function, @code{rl_display_match_list},
+that takes care of doing the display to Readline's output stream. That
+function may be called from this hook.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {const char *} rl_basic_word_break_characters
+The basic list of characters that signal a break between words for the
+completer routine. The default value of this variable is the characters
+which break words for completion in Bash:
+@code{" \t\n\"\\'`@@$><=;|&@{("}.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {const char *} rl_basic_quote_characters
+A list of quote characters which can cause a word break.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {const char *} rl_completer_word_break_characters
+The list of characters that signal a break between words for
+@code{rl_complete_internal()}. The default list is the value of
+@code{rl_basic_word_break_characters}.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {rl_cpvfunc_t *} rl_completion_word_break_hook
+If non-zero, this is the address of a function to call when Readline is
+deciding where to separate words for word completion. It should return
+a character string like @code{rl_completer_word_break_characters} to be
+used to perform the current completion. The function may choose to set
+@code{rl_completer_word_break_characters} itself. If the function
+returns @code{NULL}, @code{rl_completer_word_break_characters} is used.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {const char *} rl_completer_quote_characters
+A list of characters which can be used to quote a substring of the line.
+Completion occurs on the entire substring, and within the substring
+@code{rl_completer_word_break_characters} are treated as any other character,
+unless they also appear within this list.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {const char *} rl_filename_quote_characters
+A list of characters that cause a filename to be quoted by the completer
+when they appear in a completed filename. The default is the null string.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {const char *} rl_special_prefixes
+The list of characters that are word break characters, but should be
+left in @var{text} when it is passed to the completion function.
+Programs can use this to help determine what kind of completing to do.
+For instance, Bash sets this variable to "$@@" so that it can complete
+shell variables and hostnames.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar int rl_completion_query_items
+Up to this many items will be displayed in response to a
+possible-completions call. After that, readline asks the user if she is sure
+she wants to see them all. The default value is 100. A negative value
+indicates that Readline should never ask the user.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar {int} rl_completion_append_character
+When a single completion alternative matches at the end of the command
+line, this character is appended to the inserted completion text. The
+default is a space character (@samp{ }). Setting this to the null
+character (@samp{\0}) prevents anything being appended automatically.
+This can be changed in application-specific completion functions to
+provide the ``most sensible word separator character'' according to
+an application-specific command line syntax specification.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar int rl_completion_suppress_append
+If non-zero, @var{rl_completion_append_character} is not appended to
+matches at the end of the command line, as described above.
+It is set to 0 before any application-specific completion function
+is called, and may only be changed within such a function.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar int rl_completion_quote_character
+When Readline is completing quoted text, as delimited by one of the
+characters in @var{rl_completer_quote_characters}, it sets this variable
+to the quoting character found.
+This is set before any application-specific completion function is called.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar int rl_completion_suppress_quote
+If non-zero, Readline does not append a matching quote character when
+performing completion on a quoted string.
+It is set to 0 before any application-specific completion function
+is called, and may only be changed within such a function.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar int rl_completion_found_quote
+When Readline is completing quoted text, it sets this variable
+to a non-zero value if the word being completed contains or is delimited
+by any quoting characters, including backslashes.
+This is set before any application-specific completion function is called.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar int rl_completion_mark_symlink_dirs
+If non-zero, a slash will be appended to completed filenames that are
+symbolic links to directory names, subject to the value of the
+user-settable @var{mark-directories} variable.
+This variable exists so that application-specific completion functions
+can override the user's global preference (set via the
+@var{mark-symlinked-directories} Readline variable) if appropriate.
+This variable is set to the user's preference before any
+application-specific completion function is called, so unless that
+function modifies the value, the user's preferences are honored.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar int rl_ignore_completion_duplicates
+If non-zero, then duplicates in the matches are removed.
+The default is 1.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar int rl_filename_completion_desired
+Non-zero means that the results of the matches are to be treated as
+filenames. This is @emph{always} zero when completion is attempted,
+and can only be changed
+within an application-specific completion function. If it is set to a
+non-zero value by such a function, directory names have a slash appended
+and Readline attempts to quote completed filenames if they contain any
+characters in @code{rl_filename_quote_characters} and
+@code{rl_filename_quoting_desired} is set to a non-zero value.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar int rl_filename_quoting_desired
+Non-zero means that the results of the matches are to be quoted using
+double quotes (or an application-specific quoting mechanism) if the
+completed filename contains any characters in
+@code{rl_filename_quote_chars}. This is @emph{always} non-zero
+when completion is attempted, and can only be changed within an
+application-specific completion function.
+The quoting is effected via a call to the function pointed to
+by @code{rl_filename_quoting_function}.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar int rl_attempted_completion_over
+If an application-specific completion function assigned to
+@code{rl_attempted_completion_function} sets this variable to a non-zero
+value, Readline will not perform its default filename completion even
+if the application's completion function returns no matches.
+It should be set only by an application's completion function.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar int rl_completion_type
+Set to a character describing the type of completion Readline is currently
+attempting; see the description of @code{rl_complete_internal()}
+(@pxref{Completion Functions}) for the list of characters.
+This is set to the appropriate value before any application-specific
+completion function is called, allowing such functions to present
+the same interface as @code{rl_complete()}.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@deftypevar int rl_inhibit_completion
+If this variable is non-zero, completion is inhibited. The completion
+character will be inserted as any other bound to @code{self-insert}.
+@end deftypevar
+
+@node A Short Completion Example
+@subsection A Short Completion Example
+
+Here is a small application demonstrating the use of the GNU Readline
+library. It is called @code{fileman}, and the source code resides in
+@file{examples/fileman.c}. This sample application provides
+completion of command names, line editing features, and access to the
+history list.
+
+@page
+@smallexample
+/* fileman.c -- A tiny application which demonstrates how to use the
+ GNU Readline library. This application interactively allows users
+ to manipulate files and their modes. */
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/file.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <sys/errno.h>
+
+#include <readline/readline.h>
+#include <readline/history.h>
+
+extern char *xmalloc ();
+
+/* The names of functions that actually do the manipulation. */
+int com_list __P((char *));
+int com_view __P((char *));
+int com_rename __P((char *));
+int com_stat __P((char *));
+int com_pwd __P((char *));
+int com_delete __P((char *));
+int com_help __P((char *));
+int com_cd __P((char *));
+int com_quit __P((char *));
+
+/* A structure which contains information on the commands this program
+ can understand. */
+
+typedef struct @{
+ char *name; /* User printable name of the function. */
+ rl_icpfunc_t *func; /* Function to call to do the job. */
+ char *doc; /* Documentation for this function. */
+@} COMMAND;
+
+COMMAND commands[] = @{
+ @{ "cd", com_cd, "Change to directory DIR" @},
+ @{ "delete", com_delete, "Delete FILE" @},
+ @{ "help", com_help, "Display this text" @},
+ @{ "?", com_help, "Synonym for `help'" @},
+ @{ "list", com_list, "List files in DIR" @},
+ @{ "ls", com_list, "Synonym for `list'" @},
+ @{ "pwd", com_pwd, "Print the current working directory" @},
+ @{ "quit", com_quit, "Quit using Fileman" @},
+ @{ "rename", com_rename, "Rename FILE to NEWNAME" @},
+ @{ "stat", com_stat, "Print out statistics on FILE" @},
+ @{ "view", com_view, "View the contents of FILE" @},
+ @{ (char *)NULL, (rl_icpfunc_t *)NULL, (char *)NULL @}
+@};
+
+/* Forward declarations. */
+char *stripwhite ();
+COMMAND *find_command ();
+
+/* The name of this program, as taken from argv[0]. */
+char *progname;
+
+/* When non-zero, this means the user is done using this program. */
+int done;
+
+char *
+dupstr (s)
+ int s;
+@{
+ char *r;
+
+ r = xmalloc (strlen (s) + 1);
+ strcpy (r, s);
+ return (r);
+@}
+
+main (argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char **argv;
+@{
+ char *line, *s;
+
+ progname = argv[0];
+
+ initialize_readline (); /* Bind our completer. */
+
+ /* Loop reading and executing lines until the user quits. */
+ for ( ; done == 0; )
+ @{
+ line = readline ("FileMan: ");
+
+ if (!line)
+ break;
+
+ /* Remove leading and trailing whitespace from the line.
+ Then, if there is anything left, add it to the history list
+ and execute it. */
+ s = stripwhite (line);
+
+ if (*s)
+ @{
+ add_history (s);
+ execute_line (s);
+ @}
+
+ free (line);
+ @}
+ exit (0);
+@}
+
+/* Execute a command line. */
+int
+execute_line (line)
+ char *line;
+@{
+ register int i;
+ COMMAND *command;
+ char *word;
+
+ /* Isolate the command word. */
+ i = 0;
+ while (line[i] && whitespace (line[i]))
+ i++;
+ word = line + i;
+
+ while (line[i] && !whitespace (line[i]))
+ i++;
+
+ if (line[i])
+ line[i++] = '\0';
+
+ command = find_command (word);
+
+ if (!command)
+ @{
+ fprintf (stderr, "%s: No such command for FileMan.\n", word);
+ return (-1);
+ @}
+
+ /* Get argument to command, if any. */
+ while (whitespace (line[i]))
+ i++;
+
+ word = line + i;
+
+ /* Call the function. */
+ return ((*(command->func)) (word));
+@}
+
+/* Look up NAME as the name of a command, and return a pointer to that
+ command. Return a NULL pointer if NAME isn't a command name. */
+COMMAND *
+find_command (name)
+ char *name;
+@{
+ register int i;
+
+ for (i = 0; commands[i].name; i++)
+ if (strcmp (name, commands[i].name) == 0)
+ return (&commands[i]);
+
+ return ((COMMAND *)NULL);
+@}
+
+/* Strip whitespace from the start and end of STRING. Return a pointer
+ into STRING. */
+char *
+stripwhite (string)
+ char *string;
+@{
+ register char *s, *t;
+
+ for (s = string; whitespace (*s); s++)
+ ;
+
+ if (*s == 0)
+ return (s);
+
+ t = s + strlen (s) - 1;
+ while (t > s && whitespace (*t))
+ t--;
+ *++t = '\0';
+
+ return s;
+@}
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Interface to Readline Completion */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+char *command_generator __P((const char *, int));
+char **fileman_completion __P((const char *, int, int));
+
+/* Tell the GNU Readline library how to complete. We want to try to
+ complete on command names if this is the first word in the line, or
+ on filenames if not. */
+initialize_readline ()
+@{
+ /* Allow conditional parsing of the ~/.inputrc file. */
+ rl_readline_name = "FileMan";
+
+ /* Tell the completer that we want a crack first. */
+ rl_attempted_completion_function = fileman_completion;
+@}
+
+/* Attempt to complete on the contents of TEXT. START and END
+ bound the region of rl_line_buffer that contains the word to
+ complete. TEXT is the word to complete. We can use the entire
+ contents of rl_line_buffer in case we want to do some simple
+ parsing. Returnthe array of matches, or NULL if there aren't any. */
+char **
+fileman_completion (text, start, end)
+ const char *text;
+ int start, end;
+@{
+ char **matches;
+
+ matches = (char **)NULL;
+
+ /* If this word is at the start of the line, then it is a command
+ to complete. Otherwise it is the name of a file in the current
+ directory. */
+ if (start == 0)
+ matches = rl_completion_matches (text, command_generator);
+
+ return (matches);
+@}
+
+/* Generator function for command completion. STATE lets us
+ know whether to start from scratch; without any state
+ (i.e. STATE == 0), then we start at the top of the list. */
+char *
+command_generator (text, state)
+ const char *text;
+ int state;
+@{
+ static int list_index, len;
+ char *name;
+
+ /* If this is a new word to complete, initialize now. This
+ includes saving the length of TEXT for efficiency, and
+ initializing the index variable to 0. */
+ if (!state)
+ @{
+ list_index = 0;
+ len = strlen (text);
+ @}
+
+ /* Return the next name which partially matches from the
+ command list. */
+ while (name = commands[list_index].name)
+ @{
+ list_index++;
+
+ if (strncmp (name, text, len) == 0)
+ return (dupstr(name));
+ @}
+
+ /* If no names matched, then return NULL. */
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+@}
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* FileMan Commands */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* String to pass to system (). This is for the LIST, VIEW and RENAME
+ commands. */
+static char syscom[1024];
+
+/* List the file(s) named in arg. */
+com_list (arg)
+ char *arg;
+@{
+ if (!arg)
+ arg = "";
+
+ sprintf (syscom, "ls -FClg %s", arg);
+ return (system (syscom));
+@}
+
+com_view (arg)
+ char *arg;
+@{
+ if (!valid_argument ("view", arg))
+ return 1;
+
+ sprintf (syscom, "more %s", arg);
+ return (system (syscom));
+@}
+
+com_rename (arg)
+ char *arg;
+@{
+ too_dangerous ("rename");
+ return (1);
+@}
+
+com_stat (arg)
+ char *arg;
+@{
+ struct stat finfo;
+
+ if (!valid_argument ("stat", arg))
+ return (1);
+
+ if (stat (arg, &finfo) == -1)
+ @{
+ perror (arg);
+ return (1);
+ @}
+
+ printf ("Statistics for `%s':\n", arg);
+
+ printf ("%s has %d link%s, and is %d byte%s in length.\n", arg,
+ finfo.st_nlink,
+ (finfo.st_nlink == 1) ? "" : "s",
+ finfo.st_size,
+ (finfo.st_size == 1) ? "" : "s");
+ printf ("Inode Last Change at: %s", ctime (&finfo.st_ctime));
+ printf (" Last access at: %s", ctime (&finfo.st_atime));
+ printf (" Last modified at: %s", ctime (&finfo.st_mtime));
+ return (0);
+@}
+
+com_delete (arg)
+ char *arg;
+@{
+ too_dangerous ("delete");
+ return (1);
+@}
+
+/* Print out help for ARG, or for all of the commands if ARG is
+ not present. */
+com_help (arg)
+ char *arg;
+@{
+ register int i;
+ int printed = 0;
+
+ for (i = 0; commands[i].name; i++)
+ @{
+ if (!*arg || (strcmp (arg, commands[i].name) == 0))
+ @{
+ printf ("%s\t\t%s.\n", commands[i].name, commands[i].doc);
+ printed++;
+ @}
+ @}
+
+ if (!printed)
+ @{
+ printf ("No commands match `%s'. Possibilties are:\n", arg);
+
+ for (i = 0; commands[i].name; i++)
+ @{
+ /* Print in six columns. */
+ if (printed == 6)
+ @{
+ printed = 0;
+ printf ("\n");
+ @}
+
+ printf ("%s\t", commands[i].name);
+ printed++;
+ @}
+
+ if (printed)
+ printf ("\n");
+ @}
+ return (0);
+@}
+
+/* Change to the directory ARG. */
+com_cd (arg)
+ char *arg;
+@{
+ if (chdir (arg) == -1)
+ @{
+ perror (arg);
+ return 1;
+ @}
+
+ com_pwd ("");
+ return (0);
+@}
+
+/* Print out the current working directory. */
+com_pwd (ignore)
+ char *ignore;
+@{
+ char dir[1024], *s;
+
+ s = getcwd (dir, sizeof(dir) - 1);
+ if (s == 0)
+ @{
+ printf ("Error getting pwd: %s\n", dir);
+ return 1;
+ @}
+
+ printf ("Current directory is %s\n", dir);
+ return 0;
+@}
+
+/* The user wishes to quit using this program. Just set DONE
+ non-zero. */
+com_quit (arg)
+ char *arg;
+@{
+ done = 1;
+ return (0);
+@}
+
+/* Function which tells you that you can't do this. */
+too_dangerous (caller)
+ char *caller;
+@{
+ fprintf (stderr,
+ "%s: Too dangerous for me to distribute.\n",
+ caller);
+ fprintf (stderr, "Write it yourself.\n");
+@}
+
+/* Return non-zero if ARG is a valid argument for CALLER,
+ else print an error message and return zero. */
+int
+valid_argument (caller, arg)
+ char *caller, *arg;
+@{
+ if (!arg || !*arg)
+ @{
+ fprintf (stderr, "%s: Argument required.\n", caller);
+ return (0);
+ @}
+
+ return (1);
+@}
+@end smallexample
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/rluser.texi b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/rluser.texi
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..478b41f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/rluser.texi
@@ -0,0 +1,1846 @@
+@comment %**start of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
+@setfilename rluser.info
+@comment %**end of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
+@setchapternewpage odd
+
+@ignore
+This file documents the end user interface to the GNU command line
+editing features. It is to be an appendix to manuals for programs which
+use these features. There is a document entitled "readline.texinfo"
+which contains both end-user and programmer documentation for the
+GNU Readline Library.
+
+Copyright (C) 1988-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+Authored by Brian Fox and Chet Ramey.
+
+Permission is granted to process this file through Tex and print the
+results, provided the printed document carries copying permission notice
+identical to this one except for the removal of this paragraph (this
+paragraph not being relevant to the printed manual).
+
+Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of this manual
+provided the copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved on
+all copies.
+
+Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
+manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
+GNU Copyright statement is available to the distributee, and provided that
+the entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
+permission notice identical to this one.
+
+Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
+into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
+@end ignore
+
+@comment If you are including this manual as an appendix, then set the
+@comment variable readline-appendix.
+
+@ifclear BashFeatures
+@defcodeindex bt
+@end ifclear
+
+@node Command Line Editing
+@chapter Command Line Editing
+
+This chapter describes the basic features of the @sc{gnu}
+command line editing interface.
+@ifset BashFeatures
+Command line editing is provided by the Readline library, which is
+used by several different programs, including Bash.
+@end ifset
+
+@menu
+* Introduction and Notation:: Notation used in this text.
+* Readline Interaction:: The minimum set of commands for editing a line.
+* Readline Init File:: Customizing Readline from a user's view.
+* Bindable Readline Commands:: A description of most of the Readline commands
+ available for binding
+* Readline vi Mode:: A short description of how to make Readline
+ behave like the vi editor.
+@ifset BashFeatures
+* Programmable Completion:: How to specify the possible completions for
+ a specific command.
+* Programmable Completion Builtins:: Builtin commands to specify how to
+ complete arguments for a particular command.
+@end ifset
+@end menu
+
+@node Introduction and Notation
+@section Introduction to Line Editing
+
+The following paragraphs describe the notation used to represent
+keystrokes.
+
+The text @kbd{C-k} is read as `Control-K' and describes the character
+produced when the @key{k} key is pressed while the Control key
+is depressed.
+
+The text @kbd{M-k} is read as `Meta-K' and describes the character
+produced when the Meta key (if you have one) is depressed, and the @key{k}
+key is pressed.
+The Meta key is labeled @key{ALT} on many keyboards.
+On keyboards with two keys labeled @key{ALT} (usually to either side of
+the space bar), the @key{ALT} on the left side is generally set to
+work as a Meta key.
+The @key{ALT} key on the right may also be configured to work as a
+Meta key or may be configured as some other modifier, such as a
+Compose key for typing accented characters.
+
+If you do not have a Meta or @key{ALT} key, or another key working as
+a Meta key, the identical keystroke can be generated by typing @key{ESC}
+@emph{first}, and then typing @key{k}.
+Either process is known as @dfn{metafying} the @key{k} key.
+
+The text @kbd{M-C-k} is read as `Meta-Control-k' and describes the
+character produced by @dfn{metafying} @kbd{C-k}.
+
+In addition, several keys have their own names. Specifically,
+@key{DEL}, @key{ESC}, @key{LFD}, @key{SPC}, @key{RET}, and @key{TAB} all
+stand for themselves when seen in this text, or in an init file
+(@pxref{Readline Init File}).
+If your keyboard lacks a @key{LFD} key, typing @key{C-j} will
+produce the desired character.
+The @key{RET} key may be labeled @key{Return} or @key{Enter} on
+some keyboards.
+
+@node Readline Interaction
+@section Readline Interaction
+@cindex interaction, readline
+
+Often during an interactive session you type in a long line of text,
+only to notice that the first word on the line is misspelled. The
+Readline library gives you a set of commands for manipulating the text
+as you type it in, allowing you to just fix your typo, and not forcing
+you to retype the majority of the line. Using these editing commands,
+you move the cursor to the place that needs correction, and delete or
+insert the text of the corrections. Then, when you are satisfied with
+the line, you simply press @key{RET}. You do not have to be at the
+end of the line to press @key{RET}; the entire line is accepted
+regardless of the location of the cursor within the line.
+
+@menu
+* Readline Bare Essentials:: The least you need to know about Readline.
+* Readline Movement Commands:: Moving about the input line.
+* Readline Killing Commands:: How to delete text, and how to get it back!
+* Readline Arguments:: Giving numeric arguments to commands.
+* Searching:: Searching through previous lines.
+@end menu
+
+@node Readline Bare Essentials
+@subsection Readline Bare Essentials
+@cindex notation, readline
+@cindex command editing
+@cindex editing command lines
+
+In order to enter characters into the line, simply type them. The typed
+character appears where the cursor was, and then the cursor moves one
+space to the right. If you mistype a character, you can use your
+erase character to back up and delete the mistyped character.
+
+Sometimes you may mistype a character, and
+not notice the error until you have typed several other characters. In
+that case, you can type @kbd{C-b} to move the cursor to the left, and then
+correct your mistake. Afterwards, you can move the cursor to the right
+with @kbd{C-f}.
+
+When you add text in the middle of a line, you will notice that characters
+to the right of the cursor are `pushed over' to make room for the text
+that you have inserted. Likewise, when you delete text behind the cursor,
+characters to the right of the cursor are `pulled back' to fill in the
+blank space created by the removal of the text. A list of the bare
+essentials for editing the text of an input line follows.
+
+@table @asis
+@item @kbd{C-b}
+Move back one character.
+@item @kbd{C-f}
+Move forward one character.
+@item @key{DEL} or @key{Backspace}
+Delete the character to the left of the cursor.
+@item @kbd{C-d}
+Delete the character underneath the cursor.
+@item @w{Printing characters}
+Insert the character into the line at the cursor.
+@item @kbd{C-_} or @kbd{C-x C-u}
+Undo the last editing command. You can undo all the way back to an
+empty line.
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+(Depending on your configuration, the @key{Backspace} key be set to
+delete the character to the left of the cursor and the @key{DEL} key set
+to delete the character underneath the cursor, like @kbd{C-d}, rather
+than the character to the left of the cursor.)
+
+@node Readline Movement Commands
+@subsection Readline Movement Commands
+
+
+The above table describes the most basic keystrokes that you need
+in order to do editing of the input line. For your convenience, many
+other commands have been added in addition to @kbd{C-b}, @kbd{C-f},
+@kbd{C-d}, and @key{DEL}. Here are some commands for moving more rapidly
+about the line.
+
+@table @kbd
+@item C-a
+Move to the start of the line.
+@item C-e
+Move to the end of the line.
+@item M-f
+Move forward a word, where a word is composed of letters and digits.
+@item M-b
+Move backward a word.
+@item C-l
+Clear the screen, reprinting the current line at the top.
+@end table
+
+Notice how @kbd{C-f} moves forward a character, while @kbd{M-f} moves
+forward a word. It is a loose convention that control keystrokes
+operate on characters while meta keystrokes operate on words.
+
+@node Readline Killing Commands
+@subsection Readline Killing Commands
+
+@cindex killing text
+@cindex yanking text
+
+@dfn{Killing} text means to delete the text from the line, but to save
+it away for later use, usually by @dfn{yanking} (re-inserting)
+it back into the line.
+(`Cut' and `paste' are more recent jargon for `kill' and `yank'.)
+
+If the description for a command says that it `kills' text, then you can
+be sure that you can get the text back in a different (or the same)
+place later.
+
+When you use a kill command, the text is saved in a @dfn{kill-ring}.
+Any number of consecutive kills save all of the killed text together, so
+that when you yank it back, you get it all. The kill
+ring is not line specific; the text that you killed on a previously
+typed line is available to be yanked back later, when you are typing
+another line.
+@cindex kill ring
+
+Here is the list of commands for killing text.
+
+@table @kbd
+@item C-k
+Kill the text from the current cursor position to the end of the line.
+
+@item M-d
+Kill from the cursor to the end of the current word, or, if between
+words, to the end of the next word.
+Word boundaries are the same as those used by @kbd{M-f}.
+
+@item M-@key{DEL}
+Kill from the cursor the start of the current word, or, if between
+words, to the start of the previous word.
+Word boundaries are the same as those used by @kbd{M-b}.
+
+@item C-w
+Kill from the cursor to the previous whitespace. This is different than
+@kbd{M-@key{DEL}} because the word boundaries differ.
+
+@end table
+
+Here is how to @dfn{yank} the text back into the line. Yanking
+means to copy the most-recently-killed text from the kill buffer.
+
+@table @kbd
+@item C-y
+Yank the most recently killed text back into the buffer at the cursor.
+
+@item M-y
+Rotate the kill-ring, and yank the new top. You can only do this if
+the prior command is @kbd{C-y} or @kbd{M-y}.
+@end table
+
+@node Readline Arguments
+@subsection Readline Arguments
+
+You can pass numeric arguments to Readline commands. Sometimes the
+argument acts as a repeat count, other times it is the @i{sign} of the
+argument that is significant. If you pass a negative argument to a
+command which normally acts in a forward direction, that command will
+act in a backward direction. For example, to kill text back to the
+start of the line, you might type @samp{M-- C-k}.
+
+The general way to pass numeric arguments to a command is to type meta
+digits before the command. If the first `digit' typed is a minus
+sign (@samp{-}), then the sign of the argument will be negative. Once
+you have typed one meta digit to get the argument started, you can type
+the remainder of the digits, and then the command. For example, to give
+the @kbd{C-d} command an argument of 10, you could type @samp{M-1 0 C-d},
+which will delete the next ten characters on the input line.
+
+@node Searching
+@subsection Searching for Commands in the History
+
+Readline provides commands for searching through the command history
+@ifset BashFeatures
+(@pxref{Bash History Facilities})
+@end ifset
+for lines containing a specified string.
+There are two search modes: @dfn{incremental} and @dfn{non-incremental}.
+
+Incremental searches begin before the user has finished typing the
+search string.
+As each character of the search string is typed, Readline displays
+the next entry from the history matching the string typed so far.
+An incremental search requires only as many characters as needed to
+find the desired history entry.
+To search backward in the history for a particular string, type
+@kbd{C-r}. Typing @kbd{C-s} searches forward through the history.
+The characters present in the value of the @code{isearch-terminators} variable
+are used to terminate an incremental search.
+If that variable has not been assigned a value, the @key{ESC} and
+@kbd{C-J} characters will terminate an incremental search.
+@kbd{C-g} will abort an incremental search and restore the original line.
+When the search is terminated, the history entry containing the
+search string becomes the current line.
+
+To find other matching entries in the history list, type @kbd{C-r} or
+@kbd{C-s} as appropriate.
+This will search backward or forward in the history for the next
+entry matching the search string typed so far.
+Any other key sequence bound to a Readline command will terminate
+the search and execute that command.
+For instance, a @key{RET} will terminate the search and accept
+the line, thereby executing the command from the history list.
+A movement command will terminate the search, make the last line found
+the current line, and begin editing.
+
+Readline remembers the last incremental search string. If two
+@kbd{C-r}s are typed without any intervening characters defining a new
+search string, any remembered search string is used.
+
+Non-incremental searches read the entire search string before starting
+to search for matching history lines. The search string may be
+typed by the user or be part of the contents of the current line.
+
+@node Readline Init File
+@section Readline Init File
+@cindex initialization file, readline
+
+Although the Readline library comes with a set of Emacs-like
+keybindings installed by default, it is possible to use a different set
+of keybindings.
+Any user can customize programs that use Readline by putting
+commands in an @dfn{inputrc} file, conventionally in his home directory.
+The name of this
+@ifset BashFeatures
+file is taken from the value of the shell variable @env{INPUTRC}. If
+@end ifset
+@ifclear BashFeatures
+file is taken from the value of the environment variable @env{INPUTRC}. If
+@end ifclear
+that variable is unset, the default is @file{~/.inputrc}.
+
+When a program which uses the Readline library starts up, the
+init file is read, and the key bindings are set.
+
+In addition, the @code{C-x C-r} command re-reads this init file, thus
+incorporating any changes that you might have made to it.
+
+@menu
+* Readline Init File Syntax:: Syntax for the commands in the inputrc file.
+
+* Conditional Init Constructs:: Conditional key bindings in the inputrc file.
+
+* Sample Init File:: An example inputrc file.
+@end menu
+
+@node Readline Init File Syntax
+@subsection Readline Init File Syntax
+
+There are only a few basic constructs allowed in the
+Readline init file. Blank lines are ignored.
+Lines beginning with a @samp{#} are comments.
+Lines beginning with a @samp{$} indicate conditional
+constructs (@pxref{Conditional Init Constructs}). Other lines
+denote variable settings and key bindings.
+
+@table @asis
+@item Variable Settings
+You can modify the run-time behavior of Readline by
+altering the values of variables in Readline
+using the @code{set} command within the init file.
+The syntax is simple:
+
+@example
+set @var{variable} @var{value}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Here, for example, is how to
+change from the default Emacs-like key binding to use
+@code{vi} line editing commands:
+
+@example
+set editing-mode vi
+@end example
+
+Variable names and values, where appropriate, are recognized without regard
+to case. Unrecognized variable names are ignored.
+
+Boolean variables (those that can be set to on or off) are set to on if
+the value is null or empty, @var{on} (case-insensitive), or 1. Any other
+value results in the variable being set to off.
+
+@ifset BashFeatures
+The @w{@code{bind -V}} command lists the current Readline variable names
+and values. @xref{Bash Builtins}.
+@end ifset
+
+A great deal of run-time behavior is changeable with the following
+variables.
+
+@cindex variables, readline
+@table @code
+
+@item bell-style
+@vindex bell-style
+Controls what happens when Readline wants to ring the terminal bell.
+If set to @samp{none}, Readline never rings the bell. If set to
+@samp{visible}, Readline uses a visible bell if one is available.
+If set to @samp{audible} (the default), Readline attempts to ring
+the terminal's bell.
+
+@item bind-tty-special-chars
+@vindex bind-tty-special-chars
+If set to @samp{on}, Readline attempts to bind the control characters
+treated specially by the kernel's terminal driver to their Readline
+equivalents.
+
+@item comment-begin
+@vindex comment-begin
+The string to insert at the beginning of the line when the
+@code{insert-comment} command is executed. The default value
+is @code{"#"}.
+
+@item completion-ignore-case
+If set to @samp{on}, Readline performs filename matching and completion
+in a case-insensitive fashion.
+The default value is @samp{off}.
+
+@item completion-query-items
+@vindex completion-query-items
+The number of possible completions that determines when the user is
+asked whether the list of possibilities should be displayed.
+If the number of possible completions is greater than this value,
+Readline will ask the user whether or not he wishes to view
+them; otherwise, they are simply listed.
+This variable must be set to an integer value greater than or equal to 0.
+A negative value means Readline should never ask.
+The default limit is @code{100}.
+
+@item convert-meta
+@vindex convert-meta
+If set to @samp{on}, Readline will convert characters with the
+eighth bit set to an @sc{ascii} key sequence by stripping the eighth
+bit and prefixing an @key{ESC} character, converting them to a
+meta-prefixed key sequence. The default value is @samp{on}.
+
+@item disable-completion
+@vindex disable-completion
+If set to @samp{On}, Readline will inhibit word completion.
+Completion characters will be inserted into the line as if they had
+been mapped to @code{self-insert}. The default is @samp{off}.
+
+@item editing-mode
+@vindex editing-mode
+The @code{editing-mode} variable controls which default set of
+key bindings is used. By default, Readline starts up in Emacs editing
+mode, where the keystrokes are most similar to Emacs. This variable can be
+set to either @samp{emacs} or @samp{vi}.
+
+@item enable-keypad
+@vindex enable-keypad
+When set to @samp{on}, Readline will try to enable the application
+keypad when it is called. Some systems need this to enable the
+arrow keys. The default is @samp{off}.
+
+@item expand-tilde
+@vindex expand-tilde
+If set to @samp{on}, tilde expansion is performed when Readline
+attempts word completion. The default is @samp{off}.
+
+@item history-preserve-point
+@vindex history-preserve-point
+If set to @samp{on}, the history code attempts to place point at the
+same location on each history line retrieved with @code{previous-history}
+or @code{next-history}. The default is @samp{off}.
+
+@item horizontal-scroll-mode
+@vindex horizontal-scroll-mode
+This variable can be set to either @samp{on} or @samp{off}. Setting it
+to @samp{on} means that the text of the lines being edited will scroll
+horizontally on a single screen line when they are longer than the width
+of the screen, instead of wrapping onto a new screen line. By default,
+this variable is set to @samp{off}.
+
+@item input-meta
+@vindex input-meta
+@vindex meta-flag
+If set to @samp{on}, Readline will enable eight-bit input (it
+will not clear the eighth bit in the characters it reads),
+regardless of what the terminal claims it can support. The
+default value is @samp{off}. The name @code{meta-flag} is a
+synonym for this variable.
+
+@item isearch-terminators
+@vindex isearch-terminators
+The string of characters that should terminate an incremental search without
+subsequently executing the character as a command (@pxref{Searching}).
+If this variable has not been given a value, the characters @key{ESC} and
+@kbd{C-J} will terminate an incremental search.
+
+@item keymap
+@vindex keymap
+Sets Readline's idea of the current keymap for key binding commands.
+Acceptable @code{keymap} names are
+@code{emacs},
+@code{emacs-standard},
+@code{emacs-meta},
+@code{emacs-ctlx},
+@code{vi},
+@code{vi-move},
+@code{vi-command}, and
+@code{vi-insert}.
+@code{vi} is equivalent to @code{vi-command}; @code{emacs} is
+equivalent to @code{emacs-standard}. The default value is @code{emacs}.
+The value of the @code{editing-mode} variable also affects the
+default keymap.
+
+@item mark-directories
+If set to @samp{on}, completed directory names have a slash
+appended. The default is @samp{on}.
+
+@item mark-modified-lines
+@vindex mark-modified-lines
+This variable, when set to @samp{on}, causes Readline to display an
+asterisk (@samp{*}) at the start of history lines which have been modified.
+This variable is @samp{off} by default.
+
+@item mark-symlinked-directories
+@vindex mark-symlinked-directories
+If set to @samp{on}, completed names which are symbolic links
+to directories have a slash appended (subject to the value of
+@code{mark-directories}).
+The default is @samp{off}.
+
+@item match-hidden-files
+@vindex match-hidden-files
+This variable, when set to @samp{on}, causes Readline to match files whose
+names begin with a @samp{.} (hidden files) when performing filename
+completion, unless the leading @samp{.} is
+supplied by the user in the filename to be completed.
+This variable is @samp{on} by default.
+
+@item output-meta
+@vindex output-meta
+If set to @samp{on}, Readline will display characters with the
+eighth bit set directly rather than as a meta-prefixed escape
+sequence. The default is @samp{off}.
+
+@item page-completions
+@vindex page-completions
+If set to @samp{on}, Readline uses an internal @code{more}-like pager
+to display a screenful of possible completions at a time.
+This variable is @samp{on} by default.
+
+@item print-completions-horizontally
+If set to @samp{on}, Readline will display completions with matches
+sorted horizontally in alphabetical order, rather than down the screen.
+The default is @samp{off}.
+
+@item show-all-if-ambiguous
+@vindex show-all-if-ambiguous
+This alters the default behavior of the completion functions. If
+set to @samp{on},
+words which have more than one possible completion cause the
+matches to be listed immediately instead of ringing the bell.
+The default value is @samp{off}.
+
+@item show-all-if-unmodified
+@vindex show-all-if-unmodified
+This alters the default behavior of the completion functions in
+a fashion similar to @var{show-all-if-ambiguous}.
+If set to @samp{on},
+words which have more than one possible completion without any
+possible partial completion (the possible completions don't share
+a common prefix) cause the matches to be listed immediately instead
+of ringing the bell.
+The default value is @samp{off}.
+
+@item visible-stats
+@vindex visible-stats
+If set to @samp{on}, a character denoting a file's type
+is appended to the filename when listing possible
+completions. The default is @samp{off}.
+
+@end table
+
+@item Key Bindings
+The syntax for controlling key bindings in the init file is
+simple. First you need to find the name of the command that you
+want to change. The following sections contain tables of the command
+name, the default keybinding, if any, and a short description of what
+the command does.
+
+Once you know the name of the command, simply place on a line
+in the init file the name of the key
+you wish to bind the command to, a colon, and then the name of the
+command. The name of the key
+can be expressed in different ways, depending on what you find most
+comfortable.
+
+In addition to command names, readline allows keys to be bound
+to a string that is inserted when the key is pressed (a @var{macro}).
+
+@ifset BashFeatures
+The @w{@code{bind -p}} command displays Readline function names and
+bindings in a format that can put directly into an initialization file.
+@xref{Bash Builtins}.
+@end ifset
+
+@table @asis
+@item @w{@var{keyname}: @var{function-name} or @var{macro}}
+@var{keyname} is the name of a key spelled out in English. For example:
+@example
+Control-u: universal-argument
+Meta-Rubout: backward-kill-word
+Control-o: "> output"
+@end example
+
+In the above example, @kbd{C-u} is bound to the function
+@code{universal-argument},
+@kbd{M-DEL} is bound to the function @code{backward-kill-word}, and
+@kbd{C-o} is bound to run the macro
+expressed on the right hand side (that is, to insert the text
+@samp{> output} into the line).
+
+A number of symbolic character names are recognized while
+processing this key binding syntax:
+@var{DEL},
+@var{ESC},
+@var{ESCAPE},
+@var{LFD},
+@var{NEWLINE},
+@var{RET},
+@var{RETURN},
+@var{RUBOUT},
+@var{SPACE},
+@var{SPC},
+and
+@var{TAB}.
+
+@item @w{"@var{keyseq}": @var{function-name} or @var{macro}}
+@var{keyseq} differs from @var{keyname} above in that strings
+denoting an entire key sequence can be specified, by placing
+the key sequence in double quotes. Some @sc{gnu} Emacs style key
+escapes can be used, as in the following example, but the
+special character names are not recognized.
+
+@example
+"\C-u": universal-argument
+"\C-x\C-r": re-read-init-file
+"\e[11~": "Function Key 1"
+@end example
+
+In the above example, @kbd{C-u} is again bound to the function
+@code{universal-argument} (just as it was in the first example),
+@samp{@kbd{C-x} @kbd{C-r}} is bound to the function @code{re-read-init-file},
+and @samp{@key{ESC} @key{[} @key{1} @key{1} @key{~}} is bound to insert
+the text @samp{Function Key 1}.
+
+@end table
+
+The following @sc{gnu} Emacs style escape sequences are available when
+specifying key sequences:
+
+@table @code
+@item @kbd{\C-}
+control prefix
+@item @kbd{\M-}
+meta prefix
+@item @kbd{\e}
+an escape character
+@item @kbd{\\}
+backslash
+@item @kbd{\"}
+@key{"}, a double quotation mark
+@item @kbd{\'}
+@key{'}, a single quote or apostrophe
+@end table
+
+In addition to the @sc{gnu} Emacs style escape sequences, a second
+set of backslash escapes is available:
+
+@table @code
+@item \a
+alert (bell)
+@item \b
+backspace
+@item \d
+delete
+@item \f
+form feed
+@item \n
+newline
+@item \r
+carriage return
+@item \t
+horizontal tab
+@item \v
+vertical tab
+@item \@var{nnn}
+the eight-bit character whose value is the octal value @var{nnn}
+(one to three digits)
+@item \x@var{HH}
+the eight-bit character whose value is the hexadecimal value @var{HH}
+(one or two hex digits)
+@end table
+
+When entering the text of a macro, single or double quotes must
+be used to indicate a macro definition.
+Unquoted text is assumed to be a function name.
+In the macro body, the backslash escapes described above are expanded.
+Backslash will quote any other character in the macro text,
+including @samp{"} and @samp{'}.
+For example, the following binding will make @samp{@kbd{C-x} \}
+insert a single @samp{\} into the line:
+@example
+"\C-x\\": "\\"
+@end example
+
+@end table
+
+@node Conditional Init Constructs
+@subsection Conditional Init Constructs
+
+Readline implements a facility similar in spirit to the conditional
+compilation features of the C preprocessor which allows key
+bindings and variable settings to be performed as the result
+of tests. There are four parser directives used.
+
+@table @code
+@item $if
+The @code{$if} construct allows bindings to be made based on the
+editing mode, the terminal being used, or the application using
+Readline. The text of the test extends to the end of the line;
+no characters are required to isolate it.
+
+@table @code
+@item mode
+The @code{mode=} form of the @code{$if} directive is used to test
+whether Readline is in @code{emacs} or @code{vi} mode.
+This may be used in conjunction
+with the @samp{set keymap} command, for instance, to set bindings in
+the @code{emacs-standard} and @code{emacs-ctlx} keymaps only if
+Readline is starting out in @code{emacs} mode.
+
+@item term
+The @code{term=} form may be used to include terminal-specific
+key bindings, perhaps to bind the key sequences output by the
+terminal's function keys. The word on the right side of the
+@samp{=} is tested against both the full name of the terminal and
+the portion of the terminal name before the first @samp{-}. This
+allows @code{sun} to match both @code{sun} and @code{sun-cmd},
+for instance.
+
+@item application
+The @var{application} construct is used to include
+application-specific settings. Each program using the Readline
+library sets the @var{application name}, and you can test for
+a particular value.
+This could be used to bind key sequences to functions useful for
+a specific program. For instance, the following command adds a
+key sequence that quotes the current or previous word in Bash:
+@example
+$if Bash
+# Quote the current or previous word
+"\C-xq": "\eb\"\ef\""
+$endif
+@end example
+@end table
+
+@item $endif
+This command, as seen in the previous example, terminates an
+@code{$if} command.
+
+@item $else
+Commands in this branch of the @code{$if} directive are executed if
+the test fails.
+
+@item $include
+This directive takes a single filename as an argument and reads commands
+and bindings from that file.
+For example, the following directive reads from @file{/etc/inputrc}:
+@example
+$include /etc/inputrc
+@end example
+@end table
+
+@node Sample Init File
+@subsection Sample Init File
+
+Here is an example of an @var{inputrc} file. This illustrates key
+binding, variable assignment, and conditional syntax.
+
+@example
+@page
+# This file controls the behaviour of line input editing for
+# programs that use the GNU Readline library. Existing
+# programs include FTP, Bash, and GDB.
+#
+# You can re-read the inputrc file with C-x C-r.
+# Lines beginning with '#' are comments.
+#
+# First, include any systemwide bindings and variable
+# assignments from /etc/Inputrc
+$include /etc/Inputrc
+
+#
+# Set various bindings for emacs mode.
+
+set editing-mode emacs
+
+$if mode=emacs
+
+Meta-Control-h: backward-kill-word Text after the function name is ignored
+
+#
+# Arrow keys in keypad mode
+#
+#"\M-OD": backward-char
+#"\M-OC": forward-char
+#"\M-OA": previous-history
+#"\M-OB": next-history
+#
+# Arrow keys in ANSI mode
+#
+"\M-[D": backward-char
+"\M-[C": forward-char
+"\M-[A": previous-history
+"\M-[B": next-history
+#
+# Arrow keys in 8 bit keypad mode
+#
+#"\M-\C-OD": backward-char
+#"\M-\C-OC": forward-char
+#"\M-\C-OA": previous-history
+#"\M-\C-OB": next-history
+#
+# Arrow keys in 8 bit ANSI mode
+#
+#"\M-\C-[D": backward-char
+#"\M-\C-[C": forward-char
+#"\M-\C-[A": previous-history
+#"\M-\C-[B": next-history
+
+C-q: quoted-insert
+
+$endif
+
+# An old-style binding. This happens to be the default.
+TAB: complete
+
+# Macros that are convenient for shell interaction
+$if Bash
+# edit the path
+"\C-xp": "PATH=$@{PATH@}\e\C-e\C-a\ef\C-f"
+# prepare to type a quoted word --
+# insert open and close double quotes
+# and move to just after the open quote
+"\C-x\"": "\"\"\C-b"
+# insert a backslash (testing backslash escapes
+# in sequences and macros)
+"\C-x\\": "\\"
+# Quote the current or previous word
+"\C-xq": "\eb\"\ef\""
+# Add a binding to refresh the line, which is unbound
+"\C-xr": redraw-current-line
+# Edit variable on current line.
+"\M-\C-v": "\C-a\C-k$\C-y\M-\C-e\C-a\C-y="
+$endif
+
+# use a visible bell if one is available
+set bell-style visible
+
+# don't strip characters to 7 bits when reading
+set input-meta on
+
+# allow iso-latin1 characters to be inserted rather
+# than converted to prefix-meta sequences
+set convert-meta off
+
+# display characters with the eighth bit set directly
+# rather than as meta-prefixed characters
+set output-meta on
+
+# if there are more than 150 possible completions for
+# a word, ask the user if he wants to see all of them
+set completion-query-items 150
+
+# For FTP
+$if Ftp
+"\C-xg": "get \M-?"
+"\C-xt": "put \M-?"
+"\M-.": yank-last-arg
+$endif
+@end example
+
+@node Bindable Readline Commands
+@section Bindable Readline Commands
+
+@menu
+* Commands For Moving:: Moving about the line.
+* Commands For History:: Getting at previous lines.
+* Commands For Text:: Commands for changing text.
+* Commands For Killing:: Commands for killing and yanking.
+* Numeric Arguments:: Specifying numeric arguments, repeat counts.
+* Commands For Completion:: Getting Readline to do the typing for you.
+* Keyboard Macros:: Saving and re-executing typed characters
+* Miscellaneous Commands:: Other miscellaneous commands.
+@end menu
+
+This section describes Readline commands that may be bound to key
+sequences.
+@ifset BashFeatures
+You can list your key bindings by executing
+@w{@code{bind -P}} or, for a more terse format, suitable for an
+@var{inputrc} file, @w{@code{bind -p}}. (@xref{Bash Builtins}.)
+@end ifset
+Command names without an accompanying key sequence are unbound by default.
+
+In the following descriptions, @dfn{point} refers to the current cursor
+position, and @dfn{mark} refers to a cursor position saved by the
+@code{set-mark} command.
+The text between the point and mark is referred to as the @dfn{region}.
+
+@node Commands For Moving
+@subsection Commands For Moving
+@ftable @code
+@item beginning-of-line (C-a)
+Move to the start of the current line.
+
+@item end-of-line (C-e)
+Move to the end of the line.
+
+@item forward-char (C-f)
+Move forward a character.
+
+@item backward-char (C-b)
+Move back a character.
+
+@item forward-word (M-f)
+Move forward to the end of the next word. Words are composed of
+letters and digits.
+
+@item backward-word (M-b)
+Move back to the start of the current or previous word. Words are
+composed of letters and digits.
+
+@item clear-screen (C-l)
+Clear the screen and redraw the current line,
+leaving the current line at the top of the screen.
+
+@item redraw-current-line ()
+Refresh the current line. By default, this is unbound.
+
+@end ftable
+
+@node Commands For History
+@subsection Commands For Manipulating The History
+
+@ftable @code
+@item accept-line (Newline or Return)
+@ifset BashFeatures
+Accept the line regardless of where the cursor is.
+If this line is
+non-empty, add it to the history list according to the setting of
+the @env{HISTCONTROL} and @env{HISTIGNORE} variables.
+If this line is a modified history line, then restore the history line
+to its original state.
+@end ifset
+@ifclear BashFeatures
+Accept the line regardless of where the cursor is.
+If this line is
+non-empty, it may be added to the history list for future recall with
+@code{add_history()}.
+If this line is a modified history line, the history line is restored
+to its original state.
+@end ifclear
+
+@item previous-history (C-p)
+Move `back' through the history list, fetching the previous command.
+
+@item next-history (C-n)
+Move `forward' through the history list, fetching the next command.
+
+@item beginning-of-history (M-<)
+Move to the first line in the history.
+
+@item end-of-history (M->)
+Move to the end of the input history, i.e., the line currently
+being entered.
+
+@item reverse-search-history (C-r)
+Search backward starting at the current line and moving `up' through
+the history as necessary. This is an incremental search.
+
+@item forward-search-history (C-s)
+Search forward starting at the current line and moving `down' through
+the the history as necessary. This is an incremental search.
+
+@item non-incremental-reverse-search-history (M-p)
+Search backward starting at the current line and moving `up'
+through the history as necessary using a non-incremental search
+for a string supplied by the user.
+
+@item non-incremental-forward-search-history (M-n)
+Search forward starting at the current line and moving `down'
+through the the history as necessary using a non-incremental search
+for a string supplied by the user.
+
+@item history-search-forward ()
+Search forward through the history for the string of characters
+between the start of the current line and the point.
+This is a non-incremental search.
+By default, this command is unbound.
+
+@item history-search-backward ()
+Search backward through the history for the string of characters
+between the start of the current line and the point. This
+is a non-incremental search. By default, this command is unbound.
+
+@item yank-nth-arg (M-C-y)
+Insert the first argument to the previous command (usually
+the second word on the previous line) at point.
+With an argument @var{n},
+insert the @var{n}th word from the previous command (the words
+in the previous command begin with word 0). A negative argument
+inserts the @var{n}th word from the end of the previous command.
+Once the argument @var{n} is computed, the argument is extracted
+as if the @samp{!@var{n}} history expansion had been specified.
+
+@item yank-last-arg (M-. or M-_)
+Insert last argument to the previous command (the last word of the
+previous history entry). With an
+argument, behave exactly like @code{yank-nth-arg}.
+Successive calls to @code{yank-last-arg} move back through the history
+list, inserting the last argument of each line in turn.
+The history expansion facilities are used to extract the last argument,
+as if the @samp{!$} history expansion had been specified.
+
+@end ftable
+
+@node Commands For Text
+@subsection Commands For Changing Text
+
+@ftable @code
+@item delete-char (C-d)
+Delete the character at point. If point is at the
+beginning of the line, there are no characters in the line, and
+the last character typed was not bound to @code{delete-char}, then
+return @sc{eof}.
+
+@item backward-delete-char (Rubout)
+Delete the character behind the cursor. A numeric argument means
+to kill the characters instead of deleting them.
+
+@item forward-backward-delete-char ()
+Delete the character under the cursor, unless the cursor is at the
+end of the line, in which case the character behind the cursor is
+deleted. By default, this is not bound to a key.
+
+@item quoted-insert (C-q or C-v)
+Add the next character typed to the line verbatim. This is
+how to insert key sequences like @kbd{C-q}, for example.
+
+@ifclear BashFeatures
+@item tab-insert (M-@key{TAB})
+Insert a tab character.
+@end ifclear
+
+@item self-insert (a, b, A, 1, !, @dots{})
+Insert yourself.
+
+@item transpose-chars (C-t)
+Drag the character before the cursor forward over
+the character at the cursor, moving the
+cursor forward as well. If the insertion point
+is at the end of the line, then this
+transposes the last two characters of the line.
+Negative arguments have no effect.
+
+@item transpose-words (M-t)
+Drag the word before point past the word after point,
+moving point past that word as well.
+If the insertion point is at the end of the line, this transposes
+the last two words on the line.
+
+@item upcase-word (M-u)
+Uppercase the current (or following) word. With a negative argument,
+uppercase the previous word, but do not move the cursor.
+
+@item downcase-word (M-l)
+Lowercase the current (or following) word. With a negative argument,
+lowercase the previous word, but do not move the cursor.
+
+@item capitalize-word (M-c)
+Capitalize the current (or following) word. With a negative argument,
+capitalize the previous word, but do not move the cursor.
+
+@item overwrite-mode ()
+Toggle overwrite mode. With an explicit positive numeric argument,
+switches to overwrite mode. With an explicit non-positive numeric
+argument, switches to insert mode. This command affects only
+@code{emacs} mode; @code{vi} mode does overwrite differently.
+Each call to @code{readline()} starts in insert mode.
+
+In overwrite mode, characters bound to @code{self-insert} replace
+the text at point rather than pushing the text to the right.
+Characters bound to @code{backward-delete-char} replace the character
+before point with a space.
+
+By default, this command is unbound.
+
+@end ftable
+
+@node Commands For Killing
+@subsection Killing And Yanking
+
+@ftable @code
+
+@item kill-line (C-k)
+Kill the text from point to the end of the line.
+
+@item backward-kill-line (C-x Rubout)
+Kill backward to the beginning of the line.
+
+@item unix-line-discard (C-u)
+Kill backward from the cursor to the beginning of the current line.
+
+@item kill-whole-line ()
+Kill all characters on the current line, no matter where point is.
+By default, this is unbound.
+
+@item kill-word (M-d)
+Kill from point to the end of the current word, or if between
+words, to the end of the next word.
+Word boundaries are the same as @code{forward-word}.
+
+@item backward-kill-word (M-@key{DEL})
+Kill the word behind point.
+Word boundaries are the same as @code{backward-word}.
+
+@item unix-word-rubout (C-w)
+Kill the word behind point, using white space as a word boundary.
+The killed text is saved on the kill-ring.
+
+@item unix-filename-rubout ()
+Kill the word behind point, using white space and the slash character
+as the word boundaries.
+The killed text is saved on the kill-ring.
+
+@item delete-horizontal-space ()
+Delete all spaces and tabs around point. By default, this is unbound.
+
+@item kill-region ()
+Kill the text in the current region.
+By default, this command is unbound.
+
+@item copy-region-as-kill ()
+Copy the text in the region to the kill buffer, so it can be yanked
+right away. By default, this command is unbound.
+
+@item copy-backward-word ()
+Copy the word before point to the kill buffer.
+The word boundaries are the same as @code{backward-word}.
+By default, this command is unbound.
+
+@item copy-forward-word ()
+Copy the word following point to the kill buffer.
+The word boundaries are the same as @code{forward-word}.
+By default, this command is unbound.
+
+@item yank (C-y)
+Yank the top of the kill ring into the buffer at point.
+
+@item yank-pop (M-y)
+Rotate the kill-ring, and yank the new top. You can only do this if
+the prior command is @code{yank} or @code{yank-pop}.
+@end ftable
+
+@node Numeric Arguments
+@subsection Specifying Numeric Arguments
+@ftable @code
+
+@item digit-argument (@kbd{M-0}, @kbd{M-1}, @dots{} @kbd{M--})
+Add this digit to the argument already accumulating, or start a new
+argument. @kbd{M--} starts a negative argument.
+
+@item universal-argument ()
+This is another way to specify an argument.
+If this command is followed by one or more digits, optionally with a
+leading minus sign, those digits define the argument.
+If the command is followed by digits, executing @code{universal-argument}
+again ends the numeric argument, but is otherwise ignored.
+As a special case, if this command is immediately followed by a
+character that is neither a digit or minus sign, the argument count
+for the next command is multiplied by four.
+The argument count is initially one, so executing this function the
+first time makes the argument count four, a second time makes the
+argument count sixteen, and so on.
+By default, this is not bound to a key.
+@end ftable
+
+@node Commands For Completion
+@subsection Letting Readline Type For You
+
+@ftable @code
+@item complete (@key{TAB})
+Attempt to perform completion on the text before point.
+The actual completion performed is application-specific.
+@ifset BashFeatures
+Bash attempts completion treating the text as a variable (if the
+text begins with @samp{$}), username (if the text begins with
+@samp{~}), hostname (if the text begins with @samp{@@}), or
+command (including aliases and functions) in turn. If none
+of these produces a match, filename completion is attempted.
+@end ifset
+@ifclear BashFeatures
+The default is filename completion.
+@end ifclear
+
+@item possible-completions (M-?)
+List the possible completions of the text before point.
+
+@item insert-completions (M-*)
+Insert all completions of the text before point that would have
+been generated by @code{possible-completions}.
+
+@item menu-complete ()
+Similar to @code{complete}, but replaces the word to be completed
+with a single match from the list of possible completions.
+Repeated execution of @code{menu-complete} steps through the list
+of possible completions, inserting each match in turn.
+At the end of the list of completions, the bell is rung
+(subject to the setting of @code{bell-style})
+and the original text is restored.
+An argument of @var{n} moves @var{n} positions forward in the list
+of matches; a negative argument may be used to move backward
+through the list.
+This command is intended to be bound to @key{TAB}, but is unbound
+by default.
+
+@item delete-char-or-list ()
+Deletes the character under the cursor if not at the beginning or
+end of the line (like @code{delete-char}).
+If at the end of the line, behaves identically to
+@code{possible-completions}.
+This command is unbound by default.
+
+@ifset BashFeatures
+@item complete-filename (M-/)
+Attempt filename completion on the text before point.
+
+@item possible-filename-completions (C-x /)
+List the possible completions of the text before point,
+treating it as a filename.
+
+@item complete-username (M-~)
+Attempt completion on the text before point, treating
+it as a username.
+
+@item possible-username-completions (C-x ~)
+List the possible completions of the text before point,
+treating it as a username.
+
+@item complete-variable (M-$)
+Attempt completion on the text before point, treating
+it as a shell variable.
+
+@item possible-variable-completions (C-x $)
+List the possible completions of the text before point,
+treating it as a shell variable.
+
+@item complete-hostname (M-@@)
+Attempt completion on the text before point, treating
+it as a hostname.
+
+@item possible-hostname-completions (C-x @@)
+List the possible completions of the text before point,
+treating it as a hostname.
+
+@item complete-command (M-!)
+Attempt completion on the text before point, treating
+it as a command name. Command completion attempts to
+match the text against aliases, reserved words, shell
+functions, shell builtins, and finally executable filenames,
+in that order.
+
+@item possible-command-completions (C-x !)
+List the possible completions of the text before point,
+treating it as a command name.
+
+@item dynamic-complete-history (M-@key{TAB})
+Attempt completion on the text before point, comparing
+the text against lines from the history list for possible
+completion matches.
+
+@item complete-into-braces (M-@{)
+Perform filename completion and insert the list of possible completions
+enclosed within braces so the list is available to the shell
+(@pxref{Brace Expansion}).
+
+@end ifset
+@end ftable
+
+@node Keyboard Macros
+@subsection Keyboard Macros
+@ftable @code
+
+@item start-kbd-macro (C-x ()
+Begin saving the characters typed into the current keyboard macro.
+
+@item end-kbd-macro (C-x ))
+Stop saving the characters typed into the current keyboard macro
+and save the definition.
+
+@item call-last-kbd-macro (C-x e)
+Re-execute the last keyboard macro defined, by making the characters
+in the macro appear as if typed at the keyboard.
+
+@end ftable
+
+@node Miscellaneous Commands
+@subsection Some Miscellaneous Commands
+@ftable @code
+
+@item re-read-init-file (C-x C-r)
+Read in the contents of the @var{inputrc} file, and incorporate
+any bindings or variable assignments found there.
+
+@item abort (C-g)
+Abort the current editing command and
+ring the terminal's bell (subject to the setting of
+@code{bell-style}).
+
+@item do-uppercase-version (M-a, M-b, M-@var{x}, @dots{})
+If the metafied character @var{x} is lowercase, run the command
+that is bound to the corresponding uppercase character.
+
+@item prefix-meta (@key{ESC})
+Metafy the next character typed. This is for keyboards
+without a meta key. Typing @samp{@key{ESC} f} is equivalent to typing
+@kbd{M-f}.
+
+@item undo (C-_ or C-x C-u)
+Incremental undo, separately remembered for each line.
+
+@item revert-line (M-r)
+Undo all changes made to this line. This is like executing the @code{undo}
+command enough times to get back to the beginning.
+
+@ifset BashFeatures
+@item tilde-expand (M-&)
+@end ifset
+@ifclear BashFeatures
+@item tilde-expand (M-~)
+@end ifclear
+Perform tilde expansion on the current word.
+
+@item set-mark (C-@@)
+Set the mark to the point. If a
+numeric argument is supplied, the mark is set to that position.
+
+@item exchange-point-and-mark (C-x C-x)
+Swap the point with the mark. The current cursor position is set to
+the saved position, and the old cursor position is saved as the mark.
+
+@item character-search (C-])
+A character is read and point is moved to the next occurrence of that
+character. A negative count searches for previous occurrences.
+
+@item character-search-backward (M-C-])
+A character is read and point is moved to the previous occurrence
+of that character. A negative count searches for subsequent
+occurrences.
+
+@item insert-comment (M-#)
+Without a numeric argument, the value of the @code{comment-begin}
+variable is inserted at the beginning of the current line.
+If a numeric argument is supplied, this command acts as a toggle: if
+the characters at the beginning of the line do not match the value
+of @code{comment-begin}, the value is inserted, otherwise
+the characters in @code{comment-begin} are deleted from the beginning of
+the line.
+In either case, the line is accepted as if a newline had been typed.
+@ifset BashFeatures
+The default value of @code{comment-begin} causes this command
+to make the current line a shell comment.
+If a numeric argument causes the comment character to be removed, the line
+will be executed by the shell.
+@end ifset
+
+@item dump-functions ()
+Print all of the functions and their key bindings to the
+Readline output stream. If a numeric argument is supplied,
+the output is formatted in such a way that it can be made part
+of an @var{inputrc} file. This command is unbound by default.
+
+@item dump-variables ()
+Print all of the settable variables and their values to the
+Readline output stream. If a numeric argument is supplied,
+the output is formatted in such a way that it can be made part
+of an @var{inputrc} file. This command is unbound by default.
+
+@item dump-macros ()
+Print all of the Readline key sequences bound to macros and the
+strings they output. If a numeric argument is supplied,
+the output is formatted in such a way that it can be made part
+of an @var{inputrc} file. This command is unbound by default.
+
+@ifset BashFeatures
+@item glob-complete-word (M-g)
+The word before point is treated as a pattern for pathname expansion,
+with an asterisk implicitly appended. This pattern is used to
+generate a list of matching file names for possible completions.
+
+@item glob-expand-word (C-x *)
+The word before point is treated as a pattern for pathname expansion,
+and the list of matching file names is inserted, replacing the word.
+If a numeric argument is supplied, a @samp{*} is appended before
+pathname expansion.
+
+@item glob-list-expansions (C-x g)
+The list of expansions that would have been generated by
+@code{glob-expand-word} is displayed, and the line is redrawn.
+If a numeric argument is supplied, a @samp{*} is appended before
+pathname expansion.
+
+@item display-shell-version (C-x C-v)
+Display version information about the current instance of Bash.
+
+@item shell-expand-line (M-C-e)
+Expand the line as the shell does.
+This performs alias and history expansion as well as all of the shell
+word expansions (@pxref{Shell Expansions}).
+
+@item history-expand-line (M-^)
+Perform history expansion on the current line.
+
+@item magic-space ()
+Perform history expansion on the current line and insert a space
+(@pxref{History Interaction}).
+
+@item alias-expand-line ()
+Perform alias expansion on the current line (@pxref{Aliases}).
+
+@item history-and-alias-expand-line ()
+Perform history and alias expansion on the current line.
+
+@item insert-last-argument (M-. or M-_)
+A synonym for @code{yank-last-arg}.
+
+@item operate-and-get-next (C-o)
+Accept the current line for execution and fetch the next line
+relative to the current line from the history for editing. Any
+argument is ignored.
+
+@item edit-and-execute-command (C-xC-e)
+Invoke an editor on the current command line, and execute the result as shell
+commands.
+Bash attempts to invoke
+@code{$VISUAL}, @code{$EDITOR}, and @code{emacs}
+as the editor, in that order.
+
+@end ifset
+
+@ifclear BashFeatures
+@item emacs-editing-mode (C-e)
+When in @code{vi} command mode, this causes a switch to @code{emacs}
+editing mode.
+
+@item vi-editing-mode (M-C-j)
+When in @code{emacs} editing mode, this causes a switch to @code{vi}
+editing mode.
+
+@end ifclear
+
+@end ftable
+
+@node Readline vi Mode
+@section Readline vi Mode
+
+While the Readline library does not have a full set of @code{vi}
+editing functions, it does contain enough to allow simple editing
+of the line. The Readline @code{vi} mode behaves as specified in
+the @sc{posix} 1003.2 standard.
+
+@ifset BashFeatures
+In order to switch interactively between @code{emacs} and @code{vi}
+editing modes, use the @samp{set -o emacs} and @samp{set -o vi}
+commands (@pxref{The Set Builtin}).
+@end ifset
+@ifclear BashFeatures
+In order to switch interactively between @code{emacs} and @code{vi}
+editing modes, use the command @kbd{M-C-j} (bound to emacs-editing-mode
+when in @code{vi} mode and to vi-editing-mode in @code{emacs} mode).
+@end ifclear
+The Readline default is @code{emacs} mode.
+
+When you enter a line in @code{vi} mode, you are already placed in
+`insertion' mode, as if you had typed an @samp{i}. Pressing @key{ESC}
+switches you into `command' mode, where you can edit the text of the
+line with the standard @code{vi} movement keys, move to previous
+history lines with @samp{k} and subsequent lines with @samp{j}, and
+so forth.
+
+@ifset BashFeatures
+@node Programmable Completion
+@section Programmable Completion
+@cindex programmable completion
+
+When word completion is attempted for an argument to a command for
+which a completion specification (a @var{compspec}) has been defined
+using the @code{complete} builtin (@pxref{Programmable Completion Builtins}),
+the programmable completion facilities are invoked.
+
+First, the command name is identified.
+If a compspec has been defined for that command, the
+compspec is used to generate the list of possible completions for the word.
+If the command word is a full pathname, a compspec for the full
+pathname is searched for first.
+If no compspec is found for the full pathname, an attempt is made to
+find a compspec for the portion following the final slash.
+
+Once a compspec has been found, it is used to generate the list of
+matching words.
+If a compspec is not found, the default Bash completion
+described above (@pxref{Commands For Completion}) is performed.
+
+First, the actions specified by the compspec are used.
+Only matches which are prefixed by the word being completed are
+returned.
+When the @option{-f} or @option{-d} option is used for filename or
+directory name completion, the shell variable @env{FIGNORE} is
+used to filter the matches.
+@xref{Bash Variables}, for a description of @env{FIGNORE}.
+
+Any completions specified by a filename expansion pattern to the
+@option{-G} option are generated next.
+The words generated by the pattern need not match the word being completed.
+The @env{GLOBIGNORE} shell variable is not used to filter the matches,
+but the @env{FIGNORE} shell variable is used.
+
+Next, the string specified as the argument to the @option{-W} option
+is considered.
+The string is first split using the characters in the @env{IFS}
+special variable as delimiters.
+Shell quoting is honored.
+Each word is then expanded using
+brace expansion, tilde expansion, parameter and variable expansion,
+command substitution, and arithmetic expansion,
+as described above (@pxref{Shell Expansions}).
+The results are split using the rules described above
+(@pxref{Word Splitting}).
+The results of the expansion are prefix-matched against the word being
+completed, and the matching words become the possible completions.
+
+After these matches have been generated, any shell function or command
+specified with the @option{-F} and @option{-C} options is invoked.
+When the command or function is invoked, the @env{COMP_LINE} and
+@env{COMP_POINT} variables are assigned values as described above
+(@pxref{Bash Variables}).
+If a shell function is being invoked, the @env{COMP_WORDS} and
+@env{COMP_CWORD} variables are also set.
+When the function or command is invoked, the first argument is the
+name of the command whose arguments are being completed, the
+second argument is the word being completed, and the third argument
+is the word preceding the word being completed on the current command line.
+No filtering of the generated completions against the word being completed
+is performed; the function or command has complete freedom in generating
+the matches.
+
+Any function specified with @option{-F} is invoked first.
+The function may use any of the shell facilities, including the
+@code{compgen} builtin described below
+(@pxref{Programmable Completion Builtins}), to generate the matches.
+It must put the possible completions in the @env{COMPREPLY} array
+variable.
+
+Next, any command specified with the @option{-C} option is invoked
+in an environment equivalent to command substitution.
+It should print a list of completions, one per line, to
+the standard output.
+Backslash may be used to escape a newline, if necessary.
+
+After all of the possible completions are generated, any filter
+specified with the @option{-X} option is applied to the list.
+The filter is a pattern as used for pathname expansion; a @samp{&}
+in the pattern is replaced with the text of the word being completed.
+A literal @samp{&} may be escaped with a backslash; the backslash
+is removed before attempting a match.
+Any completion that matches the pattern will be removed from the list.
+A leading @samp{!} negates the pattern; in this case any completion
+not matching the pattern will be removed.
+
+Finally, any prefix and suffix specified with the @option{-P} and @option{-S}
+options are added to each member of the completion list, and the result is
+returned to the Readline completion code as the list of possible
+completions.
+
+If the previously-applied actions do not generate any matches, and the
+@option{-o dirnames} option was supplied to @code{complete} when the
+compspec was defined, directory name completion is attempted.
+
+If the @option{-o plusdirs} option was supplied to @code{complete} when
+the compspec was defined, directory name completion is attempted and any
+matches are added to the results of the other actions.
+
+By default, if a compspec is found, whatever it generates is returned to
+the completion code as the full set of possible completions.
+The default Bash completions are not attempted, and the Readline default
+of filename completion is disabled.
+If the @option{-o bashdefault} option was supplied to @code{complete} when
+the compspec was defined, the default Bash completions are attempted
+if the compspec generates no matches.
+If the @option{-o default} option was supplied to @code{complete} when the
+compspec was defined, Readline's default completion will be performed
+if the compspec (and, if attempted, the default Bash completions)
+generate no matches.
+
+When a compspec indicates that directory name completion is desired,
+the programmable completion functions force Readline to append a slash
+to completed names which are symbolic links to directories, subject to
+the value of the @var{mark-directories} Readline variable, regardless
+of the setting of the @var{mark-symlinked-directories} Readline variable.
+
+@node Programmable Completion Builtins
+@section Programmable Completion Builtins
+@cindex completion builtins
+
+Two builtin commands are available to manipulate the programmable completion
+facilities.
+
+@table @code
+@item compgen
+@btindex compgen
+@example
+@code{compgen [@var{option}] [@var{word}]}
+@end example
+
+Generate possible completion matches for @var{word} according to
+the @var{option}s, which may be any option accepted by the
+@code{complete}
+builtin with the exception of @option{-p} and @option{-r}, and write
+the matches to the standard output.
+When using the @option{-F} or @option{-C} options, the various shell variables
+set by the programmable completion facilities, while available, will not
+have useful values.
+
+The matches will be generated in the same way as if the programmable
+completion code had generated them directly from a completion specification
+with the same flags.
+If @var{word} is specified, only those completions matching @var{word}
+will be displayed.
+
+The return value is true unless an invalid option is supplied, or no
+matches were generated.
+
+@item complete
+@btindex complete
+@example
+@code{complete [-abcdefgjksuv] [-o @var{comp-option}] [-A @var{action}] [-G @var{globpat}] [-W @var{wordlist}]
+[-P @var{prefix}] [-S @var{suffix}] [-X @var{filterpat}] [-F @var{function}]
+[-C @var{command}] @var{name} [@var{name} @dots{}]}
+@code{complete -pr [@var{name} @dots{}]}
+@end example
+
+Specify how arguments to each @var{name} should be completed.
+If the @option{-p} option is supplied, or if no options are supplied, existing
+completion specifications are printed in a way that allows them to be
+reused as input.
+The @option{-r} option removes a completion specification for
+each @var{name}, or, if no @var{name}s are supplied, all
+completion specifications.
+
+The process of applying these completion specifications when word completion
+is attempted is described above (@pxref{Programmable Completion}).
+
+Other options, if specified, have the following meanings.
+The arguments to the @option{-G}, @option{-W}, and @option{-X} options
+(and, if necessary, the @option{-P} and @option{-S} options)
+should be quoted to protect them from expansion before the
+@code{complete} builtin is invoked.
+
+
+@table @code
+@item -o @var{comp-option}
+The @var{comp-option} controls several aspects of the compspec's behavior
+beyond the simple generation of completions.
+@var{comp-option} may be one of:
+
+@table @code
+
+@item bashdefault
+Perform the rest of the default Bash completions if the compspec
+generates no matches.
+
+@item default
+Use Readline's default filename completion if the compspec generates
+no matches.
+
+@item dirnames
+Perform directory name completion if the compspec generates no matches.
+
+@item filenames
+Tell Readline that the compspec generates filenames, so it can perform any
+filename-specific processing (like adding a slash to directory names or
+suppressing trailing spaces). This option is intended to be used with
+shell functions specified with @option{-F}.
+
+@item nospace
+Tell Readline not to append a space (the default) to words completed at
+the end of the line.
+
+@item plusdirs
+After any matches defined by the compspec are generated,
+directory name completion is attempted and any
+matches are added to the results of the other actions.
+
+@end table
+
+@item -A @var{action}
+The @var{action} may be one of the following to generate a list of possible
+completions:
+
+@table @code
+@item alias
+Alias names. May also be specified as @option{-a}.
+
+@item arrayvar
+Array variable names.
+
+@item binding
+Readline key binding names (@pxref{Bindable Readline Commands}).
+
+@item builtin
+Names of shell builtin commands. May also be specified as @option{-b}.
+
+@item command
+Command names. May also be specified as @option{-c}.
+
+@item directory
+Directory names. May also be specified as @option{-d}.
+
+@item disabled
+Names of disabled shell builtins.
+
+@item enabled
+Names of enabled shell builtins.
+
+@item export
+Names of exported shell variables. May also be specified as @option{-e}.
+
+@item file
+File names. May also be specified as @option{-f}.
+
+@item function
+Names of shell functions.
+
+@item group
+Group names. May also be specified as @option{-g}.
+
+@item helptopic
+Help topics as accepted by the @code{help} builtin (@pxref{Bash Builtins}).
+
+@item hostname
+Hostnames, as taken from the file specified by the
+@env{HOSTFILE} shell variable (@pxref{Bash Variables}).
+
+@item job
+Job names, if job control is active. May also be specified as @option{-j}.
+
+@item keyword
+Shell reserved words. May also be specified as @option{-k}.
+
+@item running
+Names of running jobs, if job control is active.
+
+@item service
+Service names. May also be specified as @option{-s}.
+
+@item setopt
+Valid arguments for the @option{-o} option to the @code{set} builtin
+(@pxref{The Set Builtin}).
+
+@item shopt
+Shell option names as accepted by the @code{shopt} builtin
+(@pxref{Bash Builtins}).
+
+@item signal
+Signal names.
+
+@item stopped
+Names of stopped jobs, if job control is active.
+
+@item user
+User names. May also be specified as @option{-u}.
+
+@item variable
+Names of all shell variables. May also be specified as @option{-v}.
+@end table
+
+@item -G @var{globpat}
+The filename expansion pattern @var{globpat} is expanded to generate
+the possible completions.
+
+@item -W @var{wordlist}
+The @var{wordlist} is split using the characters in the
+@env{IFS} special variable as delimiters, and each resultant word
+is expanded.
+The possible completions are the members of the resultant list which
+match the word being completed.
+
+@item -C @var{command}
+@var{command} is executed in a subshell environment, and its output is
+used as the possible completions.
+
+@item -F @var{function}
+The shell function @var{function} is executed in the current shell
+environment.
+When it finishes, the possible completions are retrieved from the value
+of the @env{COMPREPLY} array variable.
+
+@item -X @var{filterpat}
+@var{filterpat} is a pattern as used for filename expansion.
+It is applied to the list of possible completions generated by the
+preceding options and arguments, and each completion matching
+@var{filterpat} is removed from the list.
+A leading @samp{!} in @var{filterpat} negates the pattern; in this
+case, any completion not matching @var{filterpat} is removed.
+
+@item -P @var{prefix}
+@var{prefix} is added at the beginning of each possible completion
+after all other options have been applied.
+
+@item -S @var{suffix}
+@var{suffix} is appended to each possible completion
+after all other options have been applied.
+@end table
+
+The return value is true unless an invalid option is supplied, an option
+other than @option{-p} or @option{-r} is supplied without a @var{name}
+argument, an attempt is made to remove a completion specification for
+a @var{name} for which no specification exists, or
+an error occurs adding a completion specification.
+
+@end table
+@end ifset
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/rluserman.texi b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/rluserman.texi
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..db80b31
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/rluserman.texi
@@ -0,0 +1,88 @@
+\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
+@comment %**start of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
+@setfilename rluserman.info
+@settitle GNU Readline Library
+@comment %**end of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
+
+@setchapternewpage odd
+
+@include version.texi
+
+@copying
+This manual describes the end user interface of the GNU Readline Library
+(version @value{VERSION}, @value{UPDATED}), a library which aids in the
+consistency of user interface across discrete programs which provide
+a command line interface.
+
+Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
+this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
+are preserved on all copies.
+
+@quotation
+Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
+under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
+any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
+Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
+and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license is
+included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
+
+(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
+this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
+Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
+@end quotation
+@end copying
+
+@dircategory Libraries
+@direntry
+* RLuserman: (rluserman). The GNU readline library User's Manual.
+@end direntry
+
+@titlepage
+@title GNU Readline Library User Interface
+@subtitle Edition @value{EDITION}, for @code{Readline Library} Version @value{VERSION}.
+@subtitle @value{UPDATED-MONTH}
+@author Chet Ramey, Case Western Reserve University
+@author Brian Fox, Free Software Foundation
+
+@page
+@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
+@insertcopying
+
+@sp 1
+Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
+59 Temple Place, Suite 330, @*
+Boston, MA 02111-1307 @*
+USA @*
+
+@end titlepage
+
+@contents
+
+@ifnottex
+@node Top
+@top GNU Readline Library
+
+This document describes the end user interface of the GNU Readline Library,
+a utility which aids in the consistency of user interface across discrete
+programs which provide a command line interface.
+
+@menu
+* Command Line Editing:: GNU Readline User's Manual.
+* Copying This Manual:: Copying This Manual.
+@end menu
+@end ifnottex
+
+@include rluser.texi
+
+@node Copying This Manual
+@appendix Copying This Manual
+
+@menu
+* GNU Free Documentation License:: License for copying this manual.
+@end menu
+
+@include fdl.texi
+
+@bye
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/version.texi b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/version.texi
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..99816bf
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/doc/version.texi
@@ -0,0 +1,10 @@
+@ignore
+Copyright (C) 1988-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+@end ignore
+
+@set EDITION 5.1-beta1
+@set VERSION 5.1-beta1
+@set UPDATED 11 November 2005
+@set UPDATED-MONTH November 2005
+
+@set LASTCHANGE Fri Nov 11 19:50:51 EST 2005
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/emacs_keymap.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/emacs_keymap.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ca9d134
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/emacs_keymap.c
@@ -0,0 +1,873 @@
+/* emacs_keymap.c -- the keymap for emacs_mode in readline (). */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1987, 1989, 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#if !defined (BUFSIZ)
+#include <stdio.h>
+#endif /* !BUFSIZ */
+
+#include "readline.h"
+
+/* An array of function pointers, one for each possible key.
+ If the type byte is ISKMAP, then the pointer is the address of
+ a keymap. */
+
+KEYMAP_ENTRY_ARRAY emacs_standard_keymap = {
+
+ /* Control keys. */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_set_mark }, /* Control-@ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_beg_of_line }, /* Control-a */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_backward_char }, /* Control-b */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-c */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_delete }, /* Control-d */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_end_of_line }, /* Control-e */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_forward_char }, /* Control-f */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_abort }, /* Control-g */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_rubout }, /* Control-h */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_complete }, /* Control-i */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_newline }, /* Control-j */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_kill_line }, /* Control-k */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_clear_screen }, /* Control-l */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_newline }, /* Control-m */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_get_next_history }, /* Control-n */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-o */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_get_previous_history }, /* Control-p */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_quoted_insert }, /* Control-q */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_reverse_search_history }, /* Control-r */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_forward_search_history }, /* Control-s */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_transpose_chars }, /* Control-t */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_unix_line_discard }, /* Control-u */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_quoted_insert }, /* Control-v */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_unix_word_rubout }, /* Control-w */
+ { ISKMAP, (rl_command_func_t *)emacs_ctlx_keymap }, /* Control-x */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_yank }, /* Control-y */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-z */
+ { ISKMAP, (rl_command_func_t *)emacs_meta_keymap }, /* Control-[ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-\ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_char_search }, /* Control-] */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-^ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_undo_command }, /* Control-_ */
+
+ /* The start of printing characters. */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* SPACE */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ! */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* " */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* # */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* $ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* % */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* & */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ' */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ( */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ) */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* * */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* + */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* , */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* - */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* . */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* / */
+
+ /* Regular digits. */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* 0 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* 1 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* 2 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* 3 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* 4 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* 5 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* 6 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* 7 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* 8 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* 9 */
+
+ /* A little more punctuation. */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* : */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ; */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* < */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* = */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* > */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* @ */
+
+ /* Uppercase alphabet. */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* A */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* B */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* C */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* D */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* E */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* F */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* G */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* H */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* I */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* J */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* K */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* L */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* M */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* N */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* O */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* P */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Q */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* R */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* S */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* T */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* U */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* V */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* W */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* X */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Y */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Z */
+
+ /* Some more punctuation. */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* [ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* \ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ] */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ^ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* _ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ` */
+
+ /* Lowercase alphabet. */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* a */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* b */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* c */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* d */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* e */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* f */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* g */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* h */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* i */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* j */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* k */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* l */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* m */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* n */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* o */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* p */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* q */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* r */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* s */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* t */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* u */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* v */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* w */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* x */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* y */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* z */
+
+ /* Final punctuation. */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* { */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* | */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* } */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ~ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_rubout }, /* RUBOUT */
+
+#if KEYMAP_SIZE > 128
+ /* Pure 8-bit characters (128 - 159).
+ These might be used in some
+ character sets. */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+
+ /* ISO Latin-1 characters (160 - 255) */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* No-break space */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Inverted exclamation mark */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Cent sign */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Pound sign */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Currency sign */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Yen sign */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Broken bar */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Section sign */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Diaeresis */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Copyright sign */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Feminine ordinal indicator */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Left pointing double angle quotation mark */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Not sign */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Soft hyphen */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Registered sign */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Macron */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Degree sign */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Plus-minus sign */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Superscript two */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Superscript three */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Acute accent */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Micro sign */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Pilcrow sign */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Middle dot */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Cedilla */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Superscript one */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Masculine ordinal indicator */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Right pointing double angle quotation mark */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Vulgar fraction one quarter */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Vulgar fraction one half */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Vulgar fraction three quarters */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Inverted questionk mark */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter a with grave */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter a with acute */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter a with circumflex */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter a with tilde */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter a with diaeresis */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter a with ring above */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter ae */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter c with cedilla */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter e with grave */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter e with acute */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter e with circumflex */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter e with diaeresis */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter i with grave */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter i with acute */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter i with circumflex */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter i with diaeresis */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter eth (Icelandic) */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter n with tilde */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter o with grave */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter o with acute */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter o with circumflex */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter o with tilde */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter o with diaeresis */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Multiplication sign */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter o with stroke */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter u with grave */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter u with acute */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter u with circumflex */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter u with diaeresis */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter Y with acute */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter thorn (Icelandic) */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter sharp s (German) */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter a with grave */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter a with acute */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter a with circumflex */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter a with tilde */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter a with diaeresis */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter a with ring above */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter ae */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter c with cedilla */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter e with grave */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter e with acute */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter e with circumflex */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter e with diaeresis */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter i with grave */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter i with acute */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter i with circumflex */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter i with diaeresis */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter eth (Icelandic) */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter n with tilde */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter o with grave */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter o with acute */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter o with circumflex */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter o with tilde */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter o with diaeresis */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Division sign */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter o with stroke */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter u with grave */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter u with acute */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter u with circumflex */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter u with diaeresis */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter y with acute */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter thorn (Icelandic) */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert } /* Latin small letter y with diaeresis */
+#endif /* KEYMAP_SIZE > 128 */
+};
+
+KEYMAP_ENTRY_ARRAY emacs_meta_keymap = {
+
+ /* Meta keys. Just like above, but the high bit is set. */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-Control-@ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-Control-a */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-Control-b */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-Control-c */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-Control-d */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-Control-e */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-Control-f */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_abort }, /* Meta-Control-g */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_backward_kill_word }, /* Meta-Control-h */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_tab_insert }, /* Meta-Control-i */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_editing_mode }, /* Meta-Control-j */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-Control-k */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-Control-l */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_editing_mode }, /* Meta-Control-m */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-Control-n */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-Control-o */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-Control-p */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-Control-q */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_revert_line }, /* Meta-Control-r */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-Control-s */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-Control-t */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-Control-u */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-Control-v */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-Control-w */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-Control-x */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_yank_nth_arg }, /* Meta-Control-y */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-Control-z */
+
+ { ISFUNC, rl_complete }, /* Meta-Control-[ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-Control-\ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_backward_char_search }, /* Meta-Control-] */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-Control-^ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-Control-_ */
+
+ /* The start of printing characters. */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_set_mark }, /* Meta-SPACE */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-! */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-" */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert_comment }, /* Meta-# */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-$ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-% */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_tilde_expand }, /* Meta-& */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-' */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-( */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-) */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert_completions }, /* Meta-* */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-+ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-, */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_digit_argument }, /* Meta-- */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_yank_last_arg}, /* Meta-. */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-/ */
+
+ /* Regular digits. */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_digit_argument }, /* Meta-0 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_digit_argument }, /* Meta-1 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_digit_argument }, /* Meta-2 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_digit_argument }, /* Meta-3 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_digit_argument }, /* Meta-4 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_digit_argument }, /* Meta-5 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_digit_argument }, /* Meta-6 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_digit_argument }, /* Meta-7 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_digit_argument }, /* Meta-8 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_digit_argument }, /* Meta-9 */
+
+ /* A little more punctuation. */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-: */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-; */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_beginning_of_history }, /* Meta-< */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_possible_completions }, /* Meta-= */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_end_of_history }, /* Meta-> */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_possible_completions }, /* Meta-? */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-@ */
+
+ /* Uppercase alphabet. */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Meta-A */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Meta-B */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Meta-C */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Meta-D */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Meta-E */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Meta-F */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Meta-G */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Meta-H */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Meta-I */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Meta-J */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Meta-K */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Meta-L */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Meta-M */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Meta-N */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Meta-O */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Meta-P */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Meta-Q */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Meta-R */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Meta-S */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Meta-T */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Meta-U */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Meta-V */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Meta-W */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Meta-X */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Meta-Y */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Meta-Z */
+
+ /* Some more punctuation. */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-[ */ /* was rl_arrow_keys */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_delete_horizontal_space }, /* Meta-\ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-] */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-^ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_yank_last_arg }, /* Meta-_ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-` */
+
+ /* Lowercase alphabet. */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-a */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_backward_word }, /* Meta-b */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_capitalize_word }, /* Meta-c */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_kill_word }, /* Meta-d */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-e */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_forward_word }, /* Meta-f */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-g */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-h */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-i */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-j */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-k */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_downcase_word }, /* Meta-l */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-m */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_noninc_forward_search }, /* Meta-n */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-o */ /* was rl_arrow_keys */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_noninc_reverse_search }, /* Meta-p */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-q */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_revert_line }, /* Meta-r */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-s */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_transpose_words }, /* Meta-t */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_upcase_word }, /* Meta-u */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-v */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-w */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-x */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_yank_pop }, /* Meta-y */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-z */
+
+ /* Final punctuation. */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-{ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-| */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Meta-} */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_tilde_expand }, /* Meta-~ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_backward_kill_word }, /* Meta-rubout */
+
+#if KEYMAP_SIZE > 128
+ /* Undefined keys. */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }
+#endif /* KEYMAP_SIZE > 128 */
+};
+
+KEYMAP_ENTRY_ARRAY emacs_ctlx_keymap = {
+
+ /* Control keys. */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-@ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-a */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-b */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-c */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-d */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-e */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-f */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_abort }, /* Control-g */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-h */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-i */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-j */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-k */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-l */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-m */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-n */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-o */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-p */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-q */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_re_read_init_file }, /* Control-r */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-s */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-t */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_undo_command }, /* Control-u */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-v */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-w */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_exchange_point_and_mark }, /* Control-x */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-y */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-z */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-[ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-\ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-] */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-^ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-_ */
+
+ /* The start of printing characters. */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* SPACE */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* ! */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* " */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* # */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* $ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* % */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* & */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* ' */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_start_kbd_macro }, /* ( */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_end_kbd_macro }, /* ) */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* * */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* + */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* , */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* - */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* . */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* / */
+
+ /* Regular digits. */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* 0 */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* 1 */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* 2 */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* 3 */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* 4 */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* 5 */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* 6 */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* 7 */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* 8 */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* 9 */
+
+ /* A little more punctuation. */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* : */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* ; */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* < */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* = */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* > */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* @ */
+
+ /* Uppercase alphabet. */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* A */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* B */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* C */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* D */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* E */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* F */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* G */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* H */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* I */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* J */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* K */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* L */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* M */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* N */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* O */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* P */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Q */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* R */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* S */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* T */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* U */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* V */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* W */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* X */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Y */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Z */
+
+ /* Some more punctuation. */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* [ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* \ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* ] */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* ^ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* _ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* ` */
+
+ /* Lowercase alphabet. */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* a */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* b */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* c */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* d */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_call_last_kbd_macro }, /* e */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* f */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* g */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* h */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* i */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* j */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* k */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* l */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* m */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* n */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* o */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* p */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* q */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* r */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* s */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* t */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* u */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* v */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* w */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* x */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* y */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* z */
+
+ /* Final punctuation. */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* { */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* | */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* } */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* ~ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_backward_kill_line }, /* RUBOUT */
+
+#if KEYMAP_SIZE > 128
+ /* Undefined keys. */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }
+#endif /* KEYMAP_SIZE > 128 */
+};
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/Inputrc b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/Inputrc
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d7fdb42
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/Inputrc
@@ -0,0 +1,81 @@
+# My ~/.inputrc file is in -*- text -*- for easy editing with Emacs.
+#
+# Notice the various bindings which are conditionalized depending
+# on which program is running, or what terminal is active.
+#
+
+# Copyright (C) 1989-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+#
+# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+# any later version.
+#
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+# GNU General Public License for more details.
+#
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA.
+
+# In all programs, all terminals, make sure this is bound.
+"\C-x\C-r": re-read-init-file
+
+# Hp terminals (and some others) have ugly default behaviour for C-h.
+"\C-h": backward-delete-char
+"\e\C-h": backward-kill-word
+"\C-xd": dump-functions
+
+# In xterm windows, make the arrow keys do the right thing.
+$if TERM=xterm
+"\e[A": previous-history
+"\e[B": next-history
+"\e[C": forward-char
+"\e[D": backward-char
+
+# alternate arrow key prefix
+"\eOA": previous-history
+"\eOB": next-history
+"\eOC": forward-char
+"\eOD": backward-char
+
+# Under Xterm in Bash, we bind local Function keys to do something useful.
+$if Bash
+"\e[11~": "Function Key 1"
+"\e[12~": "Function Key 2"
+"\e[13~": "Function Key 3"
+"\e[14~": "Function Key 4"
+"\e[15~": "Function Key 5"
+
+# I know the following escape sequence numbers are 1 greater than
+# the function key. Don't ask me why, I didn't design the xterm terminal.
+"\e[17~": "Function Key 6"
+"\e[18~": "Function Key 7"
+"\e[19~": "Function Key 8"
+"\e[20~": "Function Key 9"
+"\e[21~": "Function Key 10"
+$endif
+$endif
+
+# For Bash, all terminals, add some Bash specific hacks.
+$if Bash
+"\C-xv": show-bash-version
+"\C-x\C-e": shell-expand-line
+
+# Here is one for editing my path.
+"\C-xp": "$PATH\C-x\C-e\C-e\"\C-aPATH=\":\C-b"
+
+# Make C-x r read my mail in emacs.
+# "\C-xr": "emacs -f rmail\C-j"
+$endif
+
+# For FTP, different hacks:
+$if Ftp
+"\C-xg": "get \M-?"
+"\C-xt": "put \M-?"
+"\M-.": yank-last-arg
+$endif
+
+" ": self-insert
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/Makefile b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..636a1dc
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,44 @@
+# This is the Makefile for the examples subdirectory of readline. -*- text -*-
+#
+# Copyright (C) 1994 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+# any later version.
+
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+# GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA.
+
+EXECUTABLES = fileman rltest rl
+CFLAGS = -g -I../.. -I.. -DREADLINE_LIBRARY
+LDFLAGS = -g -L..
+
+.c.o:
+ $(CC) $(CFLAGS) -c $<
+
+all: $(EXECUTABLES)
+
+
+rl: rl.o
+ $(CC) $(LDFLAGS) -o $@ rl.o -lreadline -ltermcap
+
+fileman: fileman.o
+ $(CC) $(LDFLAGS) -o $@ fileman.o -lreadline -ltermcap
+
+rltest: rltest.o
+ $(CC) $(LDFLAGS) -o $@ rltest.o -lreadline -ltermcap
+
+rlcat: rlcat.o
+ $(CC) $(LDFLAGS) -o $@ rlcat.o -lreadline -ltermcap
+
+fileman.o: fileman.c
+rltest.o: rltest.c
+rl.o: rl.c
+rlcat.o: rlcat.c
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/excallback.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/excallback.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3d4bb18
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/excallback.c
@@ -0,0 +1,188 @@
+/*
+From: Jeff Solomon <jsolomon@stanford.edu>
+Date: Fri, 9 Apr 1999 10:13:27 -0700 (PDT)
+To: chet@po.cwru.edu
+Subject: new readline example
+Message-ID: <14094.12094.527305.199695@mrclean.Stanford.EDU>
+
+Chet,
+
+I've been using readline 4.0. Specifically, I've been using the perl
+version Term::ReadLine::Gnu. It works great.
+
+Anyway, I've been playing around the alternate interface and I wanted
+to contribute a little C program, callback.c, to you that you could
+use as an example of the alternate interface in the /examples
+directory of the readline distribution.
+
+My example shows how, using the alternate interface, you can
+interactively change the prompt (which is very nice imo). Also, I
+point out that you must roll your own terminal setting when using the
+alternate interface because readline depreps (using your parlance) the
+terminal while in the user callback. I try to demostrate what I mean
+with an example. I've included the program below.
+
+To compile, I just put the program in the examples directory and made
+the appropriate changes to the EXECUTABLES and OBJECTS line and added
+an additional target 'callback'.
+
+I compiled on my Sun Solaris2.6 box using Sun's cc.
+
+Let me know what you think.
+
+Jeff
+*/
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+#include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
+#include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <termios.h> /* xxx - should make this more general */
+
+#ifdef READLINE_LIBRARY
+# include "readline.h"
+#else
+# include <readline/readline.h>
+#endif
+
+/* This little examples demonstrates the alternate interface to using readline.
+ * In the alternate interface, the user maintains control over program flow and
+ * only calls readline when STDIN is readable. Using the alternate interface,
+ * you can do anything else while still using readline (like talking to a
+ * network or another program) without blocking.
+ *
+ * Specifically, this program highlights two importants features of the
+ * alternate interface. The first is the ability to interactively change the
+ * prompt, which can't be done using the regular interface since rl_prompt is
+ * read-only.
+ *
+ * The second feature really highlights a subtle point when using the alternate
+ * interface. That is, readline will not alter the terminal when inside your
+ * callback handler. So let's so, your callback executes a user command that
+ * takes a non-trivial amount of time to complete (seconds). While your
+ * executing the command, the user continues to type keystrokes and expects them
+ * to be re-echoed on the new prompt when it returns. Unfortunately, the default
+ * terminal configuration doesn't do this. After the prompt returns, the user
+ * must hit one additional keystroke and then will see all of his previous
+ * keystrokes. To illustrate this, compile and run this program. Type "sleep" at
+ * the prompt and then type "bar" before the prompt returns (you have 3
+ * seconds). Notice how "bar" is re-echoed on the prompt after the prompt
+ * returns? This is what you expect to happen. Now comment out the 4 lines below
+ * the line that says COMMENT LINE BELOW. Recompile and rerun the program and do
+ * the same thing. When the prompt returns, you should not see "bar". Now type
+ * "f", see how "barf" magically appears? This behavior is un-expected and not
+ * desired.
+ */
+
+void process_line(char *line);
+int change_prompt(void);
+char *get_prompt(void);
+
+int prompt = 1;
+char prompt_buf[40], line_buf[256];
+tcflag_t old_lflag;
+cc_t old_vtime;
+struct termios term;
+
+int
+main()
+{
+ fd_set fds;
+
+ /* Adjust the terminal slightly before the handler is installed. Disable
+ * canonical mode processing and set the input character time flag to be
+ * non-blocking.
+ */
+ if( tcgetattr(STDIN_FILENO, &term) < 0 ) {
+ perror("tcgetattr");
+ exit(1);
+ }
+ old_lflag = term.c_lflag;
+ old_vtime = term.c_cc[VTIME];
+ term.c_lflag &= ~ICANON;
+ term.c_cc[VTIME] = 1;
+ /* COMMENT LINE BELOW - see above */
+ if( tcsetattr(STDIN_FILENO, TCSANOW, &term) < 0 ) {
+ perror("tcsetattr");
+ exit(1);
+ }
+
+ rl_add_defun("change-prompt", change_prompt, CTRL('t'));
+ rl_callback_handler_install(get_prompt(), process_line);
+
+ while(1) {
+ FD_ZERO(&fds);
+ FD_SET(fileno(stdin), &fds);
+
+ if( select(FD_SETSIZE, &fds, NULL, NULL, NULL) < 0) {
+ perror("select");
+ exit(1);
+ }
+
+ if( FD_ISSET(fileno(stdin), &fds) ) {
+ rl_callback_read_char();
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+void
+process_line(char *line)
+{
+ if( line == NULL ) {
+ fprintf(stderr, "\n", line);
+
+ /* reset the old terminal setting before exiting */
+ term.c_lflag = old_lflag;
+ term.c_cc[VTIME] = old_vtime;
+ if( tcsetattr(STDIN_FILENO, TCSANOW, &term) < 0 ) {
+ perror("tcsetattr");
+ exit(1);
+ }
+ exit(0);
+ }
+
+ if( strcmp(line, "sleep") == 0 ) {
+ sleep(3);
+ } else {
+ fprintf(stderr, "|%s|\n", line);
+ }
+
+ free (line);
+}
+
+int
+change_prompt(void)
+{
+ /* toggle the prompt variable */
+ prompt = !prompt;
+
+ /* save away the current contents of the line */
+ strcpy(line_buf, rl_line_buffer);
+
+ /* install a new handler which will change the prompt and erase the current line */
+ rl_callback_handler_install(get_prompt(), process_line);
+
+ /* insert the old text on the new line */
+ rl_insert_text(line_buf);
+
+ /* redraw the current line - this is an undocumented function. It invokes the
+ * redraw-current-line command.
+ */
+ rl_refresh_line(0, 0);
+}
+
+char *
+get_prompt(void)
+{
+ /* The prompts can even be different lengths! */
+ sprintf(prompt_buf, "%s",
+ prompt ? "Hit ctrl-t to toggle prompt> " : "Pretty cool huh?> ");
+ return prompt_buf;
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/fileman.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/fileman.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..340eee7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/fileman.c
@@ -0,0 +1,485 @@
+/* Copyright (C) 1987-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+/* fileman.c -- A tiny application which demonstrates how to use the
+ GNU Readline library. This application interactively allows users
+ to manipulate files and their modes. */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#ifdef HAVE_SYS_FILE_H
+# include <sys/file.h>
+#endif
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+
+#ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STRING_H)
+# include <string.h>
+#else /* !HAVE_STRING_H */
+# include <strings.h>
+#endif /* !HAVE_STRING_H */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_STDLIB_H
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#endif
+
+#ifdef READLINE_LIBRARY
+# include "readline.h"
+# include "history.h"
+#else
+# include <readline/readline.h>
+# include <readline/history.h>
+#endif
+
+extern char *xmalloc ();
+
+/* The names of functions that actually do the manipulation. */
+int com_list PARAMS((char *));
+int com_view PARAMS((char *));
+int com_rename PARAMS((char *));
+int com_stat PARAMS((char *));
+int com_pwd PARAMS((char *));
+int com_delete PARAMS((char *));
+int com_help PARAMS((char *));
+int com_cd PARAMS((char *));
+int com_quit PARAMS((char *));
+
+/* A structure which contains information on the commands this program
+ can understand. */
+
+typedef struct {
+ char *name; /* User printable name of the function. */
+ rl_icpfunc_t *func; /* Function to call to do the job. */
+ char *doc; /* Documentation for this function. */
+} COMMAND;
+
+COMMAND commands[] = {
+ { "cd", com_cd, "Change to directory DIR" },
+ { "delete", com_delete, "Delete FILE" },
+ { "help", com_help, "Display this text" },
+ { "?", com_help, "Synonym for `help'" },
+ { "list", com_list, "List files in DIR" },
+ { "ls", com_list, "Synonym for `list'" },
+ { "pwd", com_pwd, "Print the current working directory" },
+ { "quit", com_quit, "Quit using Fileman" },
+ { "rename", com_rename, "Rename FILE to NEWNAME" },
+ { "stat", com_stat, "Print out statistics on FILE" },
+ { "view", com_view, "View the contents of FILE" },
+ { (char *)NULL, (rl_icpfunc_t *)NULL, (char *)NULL }
+};
+
+/* Forward declarations. */
+char *stripwhite ();
+COMMAND *find_command ();
+
+/* The name of this program, as taken from argv[0]. */
+char *progname;
+
+/* When non-zero, this global means the user is done using this program. */
+int done;
+
+char *
+dupstr (s)
+ char *s;
+{
+ char *r;
+
+ r = xmalloc (strlen (s) + 1);
+ strcpy (r, s);
+ return (r);
+}
+
+main (argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char **argv;
+{
+ char *line, *s;
+
+ progname = argv[0];
+
+ initialize_readline (); /* Bind our completer. */
+
+ /* Loop reading and executing lines until the user quits. */
+ for ( ; done == 0; )
+ {
+ line = readline ("FileMan: ");
+
+ if (!line)
+ break;
+
+ /* Remove leading and trailing whitespace from the line.
+ Then, if there is anything left, add it to the history list
+ and execute it. */
+ s = stripwhite (line);
+
+ if (*s)
+ {
+ add_history (s);
+ execute_line (s);
+ }
+
+ free (line);
+ }
+ exit (0);
+}
+
+/* Execute a command line. */
+int
+execute_line (line)
+ char *line;
+{
+ register int i;
+ COMMAND *command;
+ char *word;
+
+ /* Isolate the command word. */
+ i = 0;
+ while (line[i] && whitespace (line[i]))
+ i++;
+ word = line + i;
+
+ while (line[i] && !whitespace (line[i]))
+ i++;
+
+ if (line[i])
+ line[i++] = '\0';
+
+ command = find_command (word);
+
+ if (!command)
+ {
+ fprintf (stderr, "%s: No such command for FileMan.\n", word);
+ return (-1);
+ }
+
+ /* Get argument to command, if any. */
+ while (whitespace (line[i]))
+ i++;
+
+ word = line + i;
+
+ /* Call the function. */
+ return ((*(command->func)) (word));
+}
+
+/* Look up NAME as the name of a command, and return a pointer to that
+ command. Return a NULL pointer if NAME isn't a command name. */
+COMMAND *
+find_command (name)
+ char *name;
+{
+ register int i;
+
+ for (i = 0; commands[i].name; i++)
+ if (strcmp (name, commands[i].name) == 0)
+ return (&commands[i]);
+
+ return ((COMMAND *)NULL);
+}
+
+/* Strip whitespace from the start and end of STRING. Return a pointer
+ into STRING. */
+char *
+stripwhite (string)
+ char *string;
+{
+ register char *s, *t;
+
+ for (s = string; whitespace (*s); s++)
+ ;
+
+ if (*s == 0)
+ return (s);
+
+ t = s + strlen (s) - 1;
+ while (t > s && whitespace (*t))
+ t--;
+ *++t = '\0';
+
+ return s;
+}
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Interface to Readline Completion */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+char *command_generator PARAMS((const char *, int));
+char **fileman_completion PARAMS((const char *, int, int));
+
+/* Tell the GNU Readline library how to complete. We want to try to complete
+ on command names if this is the first word in the line, or on filenames
+ if not. */
+initialize_readline ()
+{
+ /* Allow conditional parsing of the ~/.inputrc file. */
+ rl_readline_name = "FileMan";
+
+ /* Tell the completer that we want a crack first. */
+ rl_attempted_completion_function = fileman_completion;
+}
+
+/* Attempt to complete on the contents of TEXT. START and END bound the
+ region of rl_line_buffer that contains the word to complete. TEXT is
+ the word to complete. We can use the entire contents of rl_line_buffer
+ in case we want to do some simple parsing. Return the array of matches,
+ or NULL if there aren't any. */
+char **
+fileman_completion (text, start, end)
+ const char *text;
+ int start, end;
+{
+ char **matches;
+
+ matches = (char **)NULL;
+
+ /* If this word is at the start of the line, then it is a command
+ to complete. Otherwise it is the name of a file in the current
+ directory. */
+ if (start == 0)
+ matches = rl_completion_matches (text, command_generator);
+
+ return (matches);
+}
+
+/* Generator function for command completion. STATE lets us know whether
+ to start from scratch; without any state (i.e. STATE == 0), then we
+ start at the top of the list. */
+char *
+command_generator (text, state)
+ const char *text;
+ int state;
+{
+ static int list_index, len;
+ char *name;
+
+ /* If this is a new word to complete, initialize now. This includes
+ saving the length of TEXT for efficiency, and initializing the index
+ variable to 0. */
+ if (!state)
+ {
+ list_index = 0;
+ len = strlen (text);
+ }
+
+ /* Return the next name which partially matches from the command list. */
+ while (name = commands[list_index].name)
+ {
+ list_index++;
+
+ if (strncmp (name, text, len) == 0)
+ return (dupstr(name));
+ }
+
+ /* If no names matched, then return NULL. */
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+}
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* FileMan Commands */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* String to pass to system (). This is for the LIST, VIEW and RENAME
+ commands. */
+static char syscom[1024];
+
+/* List the file(s) named in arg. */
+com_list (arg)
+ char *arg;
+{
+ if (!arg)
+ arg = "";
+
+ sprintf (syscom, "ls -FClg %s", arg);
+ return (system (syscom));
+}
+
+com_view (arg)
+ char *arg;
+{
+ if (!valid_argument ("view", arg))
+ return 1;
+
+#if defined (__MSDOS__)
+ /* more.com doesn't grok slashes in pathnames */
+ sprintf (syscom, "less %s", arg);
+#else
+ sprintf (syscom, "more %s", arg);
+#endif
+ return (system (syscom));
+}
+
+com_rename (arg)
+ char *arg;
+{
+ too_dangerous ("rename");
+ return (1);
+}
+
+com_stat (arg)
+ char *arg;
+{
+ struct stat finfo;
+
+ if (!valid_argument ("stat", arg))
+ return (1);
+
+ if (stat (arg, &finfo) == -1)
+ {
+ perror (arg);
+ return (1);
+ }
+
+ printf ("Statistics for `%s':\n", arg);
+
+ printf ("%s has %d link%s, and is %d byte%s in length.\n",
+ arg,
+ finfo.st_nlink,
+ (finfo.st_nlink == 1) ? "" : "s",
+ finfo.st_size,
+ (finfo.st_size == 1) ? "" : "s");
+ printf ("Inode Last Change at: %s", ctime (&finfo.st_ctime));
+ printf (" Last access at: %s", ctime (&finfo.st_atime));
+ printf (" Last modified at: %s", ctime (&finfo.st_mtime));
+ return (0);
+}
+
+com_delete (arg)
+ char *arg;
+{
+ too_dangerous ("delete");
+ return (1);
+}
+
+/* Print out help for ARG, or for all of the commands if ARG is
+ not present. */
+com_help (arg)
+ char *arg;
+{
+ register int i;
+ int printed = 0;
+
+ for (i = 0; commands[i].name; i++)
+ {
+ if (!*arg || (strcmp (arg, commands[i].name) == 0))
+ {
+ printf ("%s\t\t%s.\n", commands[i].name, commands[i].doc);
+ printed++;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (!printed)
+ {
+ printf ("No commands match `%s'. Possibilties are:\n", arg);
+
+ for (i = 0; commands[i].name; i++)
+ {
+ /* Print in six columns. */
+ if (printed == 6)
+ {
+ printed = 0;
+ printf ("\n");
+ }
+
+ printf ("%s\t", commands[i].name);
+ printed++;
+ }
+
+ if (printed)
+ printf ("\n");
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+
+/* Change to the directory ARG. */
+com_cd (arg)
+ char *arg;
+{
+ if (chdir (arg) == -1)
+ {
+ perror (arg);
+ return 1;
+ }
+
+ com_pwd ("");
+ return (0);
+}
+
+/* Print out the current working directory. */
+com_pwd (ignore)
+ char *ignore;
+{
+ char dir[1024], *s;
+
+ s = getcwd (dir, sizeof(dir) - 1);
+ if (s == 0)
+ {
+ printf ("Error getting pwd: %s\n", dir);
+ return 1;
+ }
+
+ printf ("Current directory is %s\n", dir);
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* The user wishes to quit using this program. Just set DONE non-zero. */
+com_quit (arg)
+ char *arg;
+{
+ done = 1;
+ return (0);
+}
+
+/* Function which tells you that you can't do this. */
+too_dangerous (caller)
+ char *caller;
+{
+ fprintf (stderr,
+ "%s: Too dangerous for me to distribute. Write it yourself.\n",
+ caller);
+}
+
+/* Return non-zero if ARG is a valid argument for CALLER, else print
+ an error message and return zero. */
+int
+valid_argument (caller, arg)
+ char *caller, *arg;
+{
+ if (!arg || !*arg)
+ {
+ fprintf (stderr, "%s: Argument required.\n", caller);
+ return (0);
+ }
+
+ return (1);
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/histexamp.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/histexamp.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..4f059c1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/histexamp.c
@@ -0,0 +1,124 @@
+/* Copyright (C) 1987-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+#ifdef READLINE_LIBRARY
+# include "history.h"
+#else
+# include <readline/history.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <string.h>
+
+main (argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char **argv;
+{
+ char line[1024], *t;
+ int len, done;
+
+ line[0] = 0;
+ done = 0;
+
+ using_history ();
+ while (!done)
+ {
+ printf ("history$ ");
+ fflush (stdout);
+ t = fgets (line, sizeof (line) - 1, stdin);
+ if (t && *t)
+ {
+ len = strlen (t);
+ if (t[len - 1] == '\n')
+ t[len - 1] = '\0';
+ }
+
+ if (!t)
+ strcpy (line, "quit");
+
+ if (line[0])
+ {
+ char *expansion;
+ int result;
+
+ using_history ();
+
+ result = history_expand (line, &expansion);
+ if (result)
+ fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", expansion);
+
+ if (result < 0 || result == 2)
+ {
+ free (expansion);
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ add_history (expansion);
+ strncpy (line, expansion, sizeof (line) - 1);
+ free (expansion);
+ }
+
+ if (strcmp (line, "quit") == 0)
+ done = 1;
+ else if (strcmp (line, "save") == 0)
+ write_history ("history_file");
+ else if (strcmp (line, "read") == 0)
+ read_history ("history_file");
+ else if (strcmp (line, "list") == 0)
+ {
+ register HIST_ENTRY **the_list;
+ register int i;
+ time_t tt;
+ char timestr[128];
+
+ the_list = history_list ();
+ if (the_list)
+ for (i = 0; the_list[i]; i++)
+ {
+ tt = history_get_time (the_list[i]);
+ if (tt)
+ strftime (timestr, sizeof (timestr), "%a %R", localtime(&tt));
+ else
+ strcpy (timestr, "??");
+ printf ("%d: %s: %s\n", i + history_base, timestr, the_list[i]->line);
+ }
+ }
+ else if (strncmp (line, "delete", 6) == 0)
+ {
+ int which;
+ if ((sscanf (line + 6, "%d", &which)) == 1)
+ {
+ HIST_ENTRY *entry = remove_history (which);
+ if (!entry)
+ fprintf (stderr, "No such entry %d\n", which);
+ else
+ {
+ free (entry->line);
+ free (entry);
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ fprintf (stderr, "non-numeric arg given to `delete'\n");
+ }
+ }
+ }
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/manexamp.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/manexamp.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9c6cf2c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/manexamp.c
@@ -0,0 +1,112 @@
+/* manexamp.c -- The examples which appear in the documentation are here. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1987-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <readline/readline.h>
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* How to Emulate gets () */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* A static variable for holding the line. */
+static char *line_read = (char *)NULL;
+
+/* Read a string, and return a pointer to it. Returns NULL on EOF. */
+char *
+rl_gets ()
+{
+ /* If the buffer has already been allocated, return the memory
+ to the free pool. */
+ if (line_read)
+ {
+ free (line_read);
+ line_read = (char *)NULL;
+ }
+
+ /* Get a line from the user. */
+ line_read = readline ("");
+
+ /* If the line has any text in it, save it on the history. */
+ if (line_read && *line_read)
+ add_history (line_read);
+
+ return (line_read);
+}
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Writing a Function to be Called by Readline. */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* Invert the case of the COUNT following characters. */
+invert_case_line (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ register int start, end;
+
+ start = rl_point;
+
+ if (count < 0)
+ {
+ direction = -1;
+ count = -count;
+ }
+ else
+ direction = 1;
+
+ /* Find the end of the range to modify. */
+ end = start + (count * direction);
+
+ /* Force it to be within range. */
+ if (end > rl_end)
+ end = rl_end;
+ else if (end < 0)
+ end = -1;
+
+ if (start > end)
+ {
+ int temp = start;
+ start = end;
+ end = temp;
+ }
+
+ if (start == end)
+ return;
+
+ /* Tell readline that we are modifying the line, so save the undo
+ information. */
+ rl_modifying (start, end);
+
+ for (; start != end; start += direction)
+ {
+ if (_rl_uppercase_p (rl_line_buffer[start]))
+ rl_line_buffer[start] = _rl_to_lower (rl_line_buffer[start]);
+ else if (_rl_lowercase_p (rl_line_buffer[start]))
+ rl_line_buffer[start] = _rl_to_upper (rl_line_buffer[start]);
+ }
+
+ /* Move point to on top of the last character changed. */
+ rl_point = end - direction;
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/rl.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/rl.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c608c15
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/rl.c
@@ -0,0 +1,158 @@
+/*
+ * rl - command-line interface to read a line from the standard input
+ * (or another fd) using readline.
+ *
+ * usage: rl [-p prompt] [-u unit] [-d default] [-n nchars]
+ */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1987-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#ifdef HAVE_STDLIB_H
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+extern void exit();
+#endif
+
+#if defined (READLINE_LIBRARY)
+# include "posixstat.h"
+# include "readline.h"
+# include "history.h"
+#else
+# include <sys/stat.h>
+# include <readline/readline.h>
+# include <readline/history.h>
+#endif
+
+extern int optind;
+extern char *optarg;
+
+#if !defined (strchr) && !defined (__STDC__)
+extern char *strrchr();
+#endif
+
+static char *progname;
+static char *deftext;
+
+static int
+set_deftext ()
+{
+ if (deftext)
+ {
+ rl_insert_text (deftext);
+ deftext = (char *)NULL;
+ rl_startup_hook = (rl_hook_func_t *)NULL;
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+static void
+usage()
+{
+ fprintf (stderr, "%s: usage: %s [-p prompt] [-u unit] [-d default] [-n nchars]\n",
+ progname, progname);
+}
+
+int
+main (argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char **argv;
+{
+ char *temp, *prompt;
+ struct stat sb;
+ int opt, fd, nch;
+ FILE *ifp;
+
+ progname = strrchr(argv[0], '/');
+ if (progname == 0)
+ progname = argv[0];
+ else
+ progname++;
+
+ /* defaults */
+ prompt = "readline$ ";
+ fd = nch = 0;
+ deftext = (char *)0;
+
+ while ((opt = getopt(argc, argv, "p:u:d:n:")) != EOF)
+ {
+ switch (opt)
+ {
+ case 'p':
+ prompt = optarg;
+ break;
+ case 'u':
+ fd = atoi(optarg);
+ if (fd < 0)
+ {
+ fprintf (stderr, "%s: bad file descriptor `%s'\n", progname, optarg);
+ exit (2);
+ }
+ break;
+ case 'd':
+ deftext = optarg;
+ break;
+ case 'n':
+ nch = atoi(optarg);
+ if (nch < 0)
+ {
+ fprintf (stderr, "%s: bad value for -n: `%s'\n", progname, optarg);
+ exit (2);
+ }
+ break;
+ default:
+ usage ();
+ exit (2);
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (fd != 0)
+ {
+ if (fstat (fd, &sb) < 0)
+ {
+ fprintf (stderr, "%s: %d: bad file descriptor\n", progname, fd);
+ exit (1);
+ }
+ ifp = fdopen (fd, "r");
+ rl_instream = ifp;
+ }
+
+ if (deftext && *deftext)
+ rl_startup_hook = set_deftext;
+
+ if (nch > 0)
+ rl_num_chars_to_read = nch;
+
+ temp = readline (prompt);
+
+ /* Test for EOF. */
+ if (temp == 0)
+ exit (1);
+
+ printf ("%s\n", temp);
+ exit (0);
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/rlcat.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/rlcat.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..33aea4a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/rlcat.c
@@ -0,0 +1,180 @@
+/*
+ * rlcat - cat(1) using readline
+ *
+ * usage: rlcat
+ */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1987-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include "posixstat.h"
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+
+#ifdef HAVE_STDLIB_H
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+extern void exit();
+#endif
+
+#ifndef errno
+extern int errno;
+#endif
+
+#if defined (READLINE_LIBRARY)
+# include "readline.h"
+# include "history.h"
+#else
+# include <readline/readline.h>
+# include <readline/history.h>
+#endif
+
+extern int optind;
+extern char *optarg;
+
+static int stdcat();
+
+static char *progname;
+static int vflag;
+
+static void
+usage()
+{
+ fprintf (stderr, "%s: usage: %s [-vEVN] [filename]\n", progname, progname);
+}
+
+int
+main (argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char **argv;
+{
+ char *temp;
+ int opt, Vflag, Nflag;
+
+ progname = strrchr(argv[0], '/');
+ if (progname == 0)
+ progname = argv[0];
+ else
+ progname++;
+
+ vflag = Vflag = Nflag = 0;
+ while ((opt = getopt(argc, argv, "vEVN")) != EOF)
+ {
+ switch (opt)
+ {
+ case 'v':
+ vflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'V':
+ Vflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'E':
+ Vflag = 0;
+ break;
+ case 'N':
+ Nflag = 1;
+ break;
+ default:
+ usage ();
+ exit (2);
+ }
+ }
+
+ argc -= optind;
+ argv += optind;
+
+ if (isatty(0) == 0 || argc || Nflag)
+ return stdcat(argc, argv);
+
+ rl_variable_bind ("editing-mode", Vflag ? "vi" : "emacs");
+ while (temp = readline (""))
+ {
+ if (*temp)
+ add_history (temp);
+ printf ("%s\n", temp);
+ }
+
+ return (ferror (stdout));
+}
+
+static int
+fcopy(fp)
+ FILE *fp;
+{
+ int c;
+ char *x;
+
+ while ((c = getc(fp)) != EOF)
+ {
+ if (vflag && isascii ((unsigned char)c) && isprint((unsigned char)c) == 0)
+ {
+ x = rl_untranslate_keyseq (c);
+ if (fputs (x, stdout) != 0)
+ return 1;
+ }
+ else if (putchar (c) == EOF)
+ return 1;
+ }
+ return (ferror (stdout));
+}
+
+int
+stdcat (argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char **argv;
+{
+ int i, fd, r;
+ char *s;
+ FILE *fp;
+
+ if (argc == 0)
+ return (fcopy(stdin));
+
+ for (i = 0, r = 1; i < argc; i++)
+ {
+ if (*argv[i] == '-' && argv[i][1] == 0)
+ fp = stdin;
+ else
+ {
+ fp = fopen (argv[i], "r");
+ if (fp == 0)
+ {
+ fprintf (stderr, "%s: %s: cannot open: %s\n", progname, argv[i], strerror(errno));
+ continue;
+ }
+ }
+ r = fcopy (fp);
+ if (fp != stdin)
+ fclose(fp);
+ }
+ return r;
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/rltest.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/rltest.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..cb67bab
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/examples/rltest.c
@@ -0,0 +1,93 @@
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Testing Readline */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1987-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+#include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#ifdef HAVE_STDLIB_H
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+extern void exit();
+#endif
+
+#ifdef READLINE_LIBRARY
+# include "readline.h"
+# include "history.h"
+#else
+# include <readline/readline.h>
+# include <readline/history.h>
+#endif
+
+extern HIST_ENTRY **history_list ();
+
+main ()
+{
+ char *temp, *prompt;
+ int done;
+
+ temp = (char *)NULL;
+ prompt = "readline$ ";
+ done = 0;
+
+ while (!done)
+ {
+ temp = readline (prompt);
+
+ /* Test for EOF. */
+ if (!temp)
+ exit (1);
+
+ /* If there is anything on the line, print it and remember it. */
+ if (*temp)
+ {
+ fprintf (stderr, "%s\r\n", temp);
+ add_history (temp);
+ }
+
+ /* Check for `command' that we handle. */
+ if (strcmp (temp, "quit") == 0)
+ done = 1;
+
+ if (strcmp (temp, "list") == 0)
+ {
+ HIST_ENTRY **list;
+ register int i;
+
+ list = history_list ();
+ if (list)
+ {
+ for (i = 0; list[i]; i++)
+ fprintf (stderr, "%d: %s\r\n", i, list[i]->line);
+ }
+ }
+ free (temp);
+ }
+ exit (0);
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/funmap.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/funmap.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9c760cc
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/funmap.c
@@ -0,0 +1,255 @@
+/* funmap.c -- attach names to functions. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1987, 1989, 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#if !defined (BUFSIZ)
+#include <stdio.h>
+#endif /* BUFSIZ */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STDLIB_H)
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif /* HAVE_STDLIB_H */
+
+#include "rlconf.h"
+#include "readline.h"
+
+#include "xmalloc.h"
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+typedef int QSFUNC (const void *, const void *);
+#else
+typedef int QSFUNC ();
+#endif
+
+extern int _rl_qsort_string_compare PARAMS((char **, char **));
+
+FUNMAP **funmap;
+static int funmap_size;
+static int funmap_entry;
+
+/* After initializing the function map, this is the index of the first
+ program specific function. */
+int funmap_program_specific_entry_start;
+
+static FUNMAP default_funmap[] = {
+ { "abort", rl_abort },
+ { "accept-line", rl_newline },
+ { "arrow-key-prefix", rl_arrow_keys },
+ { "backward-byte", rl_backward_byte },
+ { "backward-char", rl_backward_char },
+ { "backward-delete-char", rl_rubout },
+ { "backward-kill-line", rl_backward_kill_line },
+ { "backward-kill-word", rl_backward_kill_word },
+ { "backward-word", rl_backward_word },
+ { "beginning-of-history", rl_beginning_of_history },
+ { "beginning-of-line", rl_beg_of_line },
+ { "call-last-kbd-macro", rl_call_last_kbd_macro },
+ { "capitalize-word", rl_capitalize_word },
+ { "character-search", rl_char_search },
+ { "character-search-backward", rl_backward_char_search },
+ { "clear-screen", rl_clear_screen },
+ { "complete", rl_complete },
+ { "copy-backward-word", rl_copy_backward_word },
+ { "copy-forward-word", rl_copy_forward_word },
+ { "copy-region-as-kill", rl_copy_region_to_kill },
+ { "delete-char", rl_delete },
+ { "delete-char-or-list", rl_delete_or_show_completions },
+ { "delete-horizontal-space", rl_delete_horizontal_space },
+ { "digit-argument", rl_digit_argument },
+ { "do-lowercase-version", rl_do_lowercase_version },
+ { "downcase-word", rl_downcase_word },
+ { "dump-functions", rl_dump_functions },
+ { "dump-macros", rl_dump_macros },
+ { "dump-variables", rl_dump_variables },
+ { "emacs-editing-mode", rl_emacs_editing_mode },
+ { "end-kbd-macro", rl_end_kbd_macro },
+ { "end-of-history", rl_end_of_history },
+ { "end-of-line", rl_end_of_line },
+ { "exchange-point-and-mark", rl_exchange_point_and_mark },
+ { "forward-backward-delete-char", rl_rubout_or_delete },
+ { "forward-byte", rl_forward_byte },
+ { "forward-char", rl_forward_char },
+ { "forward-search-history", rl_forward_search_history },
+ { "forward-word", rl_forward_word },
+ { "history-search-backward", rl_history_search_backward },
+ { "history-search-forward", rl_history_search_forward },
+ { "insert-comment", rl_insert_comment },
+ { "insert-completions", rl_insert_completions },
+ { "kill-whole-line", rl_kill_full_line },
+ { "kill-line", rl_kill_line },
+ { "kill-region", rl_kill_region },
+ { "kill-word", rl_kill_word },
+ { "menu-complete", rl_menu_complete },
+ { "next-history", rl_get_next_history },
+ { "non-incremental-forward-search-history", rl_noninc_forward_search },
+ { "non-incremental-reverse-search-history", rl_noninc_reverse_search },
+ { "non-incremental-forward-search-history-again", rl_noninc_forward_search_again },
+ { "non-incremental-reverse-search-history-again", rl_noninc_reverse_search_again },
+ { "overwrite-mode", rl_overwrite_mode },
+#ifdef __CYGWIN__
+ { "paste-from-clipboard", rl_paste_from_clipboard },
+#endif
+ { "possible-completions", rl_possible_completions },
+ { "previous-history", rl_get_previous_history },
+ { "quoted-insert", rl_quoted_insert },
+ { "re-read-init-file", rl_re_read_init_file },
+ { "redraw-current-line", rl_refresh_line},
+ { "reverse-search-history", rl_reverse_search_history },
+ { "revert-line", rl_revert_line },
+ { "self-insert", rl_insert },
+ { "set-mark", rl_set_mark },
+ { "start-kbd-macro", rl_start_kbd_macro },
+ { "tab-insert", rl_tab_insert },
+ { "tilde-expand", rl_tilde_expand },
+ { "transpose-chars", rl_transpose_chars },
+ { "transpose-words", rl_transpose_words },
+ { "tty-status", rl_tty_status },
+ { "undo", rl_undo_command },
+ { "universal-argument", rl_universal_argument },
+ { "unix-filename-rubout", rl_unix_filename_rubout },
+ { "unix-line-discard", rl_unix_line_discard },
+ { "unix-word-rubout", rl_unix_word_rubout },
+ { "upcase-word", rl_upcase_word },
+ { "yank", rl_yank },
+ { "yank-last-arg", rl_yank_last_arg },
+ { "yank-nth-arg", rl_yank_nth_arg },
+ { "yank-pop", rl_yank_pop },
+
+#if defined (VI_MODE)
+ { "vi-append-eol", rl_vi_append_eol },
+ { "vi-append-mode", rl_vi_append_mode },
+ { "vi-arg-digit", rl_vi_arg_digit },
+ { "vi-back-to-indent", rl_vi_back_to_indent },
+ { "vi-bWord", rl_vi_bWord },
+ { "vi-bword", rl_vi_bword },
+ { "vi-change-case", rl_vi_change_case },
+ { "vi-change-char", rl_vi_change_char },
+ { "vi-change-to", rl_vi_change_to },
+ { "vi-char-search", rl_vi_char_search },
+ { "vi-column", rl_vi_column },
+ { "vi-complete", rl_vi_complete },
+ { "vi-delete", rl_vi_delete },
+ { "vi-delete-to", rl_vi_delete_to },
+ { "vi-eWord", rl_vi_eWord },
+ { "vi-editing-mode", rl_vi_editing_mode },
+ { "vi-end-word", rl_vi_end_word },
+ { "vi-eof-maybe", rl_vi_eof_maybe },
+ { "vi-eword", rl_vi_eword },
+ { "vi-fWord", rl_vi_fWord },
+ { "vi-fetch-history", rl_vi_fetch_history },
+ { "vi-first-print", rl_vi_first_print },
+ { "vi-fword", rl_vi_fword },
+ { "vi-goto-mark", rl_vi_goto_mark },
+ { "vi-insert-beg", rl_vi_insert_beg },
+ { "vi-insertion-mode", rl_vi_insertion_mode },
+ { "vi-match", rl_vi_match },
+ { "vi-movement-mode", rl_vi_movement_mode },
+ { "vi-next-word", rl_vi_next_word },
+ { "vi-overstrike", rl_vi_overstrike },
+ { "vi-overstrike-delete", rl_vi_overstrike_delete },
+ { "vi-prev-word", rl_vi_prev_word },
+ { "vi-put", rl_vi_put },
+ { "vi-redo", rl_vi_redo },
+ { "vi-replace", rl_vi_replace },
+ { "vi-rubout", rl_vi_rubout },
+ { "vi-search", rl_vi_search },
+ { "vi-search-again", rl_vi_search_again },
+ { "vi-set-mark", rl_vi_set_mark },
+ { "vi-subst", rl_vi_subst },
+ { "vi-tilde-expand", rl_vi_tilde_expand },
+ { "vi-yank-arg", rl_vi_yank_arg },
+ { "vi-yank-to", rl_vi_yank_to },
+#endif /* VI_MODE */
+
+ {(char *)NULL, (rl_command_func_t *)NULL }
+};
+
+int
+rl_add_funmap_entry (name, function)
+ const char *name;
+ rl_command_func_t *function;
+{
+ if (funmap_entry + 2 >= funmap_size)
+ {
+ funmap_size += 64;
+ funmap = (FUNMAP **)xrealloc (funmap, funmap_size * sizeof (FUNMAP *));
+ }
+
+ funmap[funmap_entry] = (FUNMAP *)xmalloc (sizeof (FUNMAP));
+ funmap[funmap_entry]->name = name;
+ funmap[funmap_entry]->function = function;
+
+ funmap[++funmap_entry] = (FUNMAP *)NULL;
+ return funmap_entry;
+}
+
+static int funmap_initialized;
+
+/* Make the funmap contain all of the default entries. */
+void
+rl_initialize_funmap ()
+{
+ register int i;
+
+ if (funmap_initialized)
+ return;
+
+ for (i = 0; default_funmap[i].name; i++)
+ rl_add_funmap_entry (default_funmap[i].name, default_funmap[i].function);
+
+ funmap_initialized = 1;
+ funmap_program_specific_entry_start = i;
+}
+
+/* Produce a NULL terminated array of known function names. The array
+ is sorted. The array itself is allocated, but not the strings inside.
+ You should free () the array when you done, but not the pointrs. */
+const char **
+rl_funmap_names ()
+{
+ const char **result;
+ int result_size, result_index;
+
+ /* Make sure that the function map has been initialized. */
+ rl_initialize_funmap ();
+
+ for (result_index = result_size = 0, result = (const char **)NULL; funmap[result_index]; result_index++)
+ {
+ if (result_index + 2 > result_size)
+ {
+ result_size += 20;
+ result = (const char **)xrealloc (result, result_size * sizeof (char *));
+ }
+
+ result[result_index] = funmap[result_index]->name;
+ result[result_index + 1] = (char *)NULL;
+ }
+
+ qsort (result, result_index, sizeof (char *), (QSFUNC *)_rl_qsort_string_compare);
+ return (result);
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/histexpand.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/histexpand.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6847014
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/histexpand.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1593 @@
+/* histexpand.c -- history expansion. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1989-2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file contains the GNU History Library (the Library), a set of
+ routines for managing the text of previously typed lines.
+
+ The Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ The Library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
+ WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STDLIB_H)
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif /* HAVE_STDLIB_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# ifndef _MINIX
+# include <sys/types.h>
+# endif
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "rlmbutil.h"
+
+#include "history.h"
+#include "histlib.h"
+
+#include "rlshell.h"
+#include "xmalloc.h"
+
+#define HISTORY_WORD_DELIMITERS " \t\n;&()|<>"
+#define HISTORY_QUOTE_CHARACTERS "\"'`"
+
+#define slashify_in_quotes "\\`\"$"
+
+typedef int _hist_search_func_t PARAMS((const char *, int));
+
+extern int rl_byte_oriented; /* declared in mbutil.c */
+
+static char error_pointer;
+
+static char *subst_lhs;
+static char *subst_rhs;
+static int subst_lhs_len;
+static int subst_rhs_len;
+
+static char *get_history_word_specifier PARAMS((char *, char *, int *));
+static char *history_find_word PARAMS((char *, int));
+static int history_tokenize_word PARAMS((const char *, int));
+static char *history_substring PARAMS((const char *, int, int));
+
+static char *quote_breaks PARAMS((char *));
+
+/* Variables exported by this file. */
+/* The character that represents the start of a history expansion
+ request. This is usually `!'. */
+char history_expansion_char = '!';
+
+/* The character that invokes word substitution if found at the start of
+ a line. This is usually `^'. */
+char history_subst_char = '^';
+
+/* During tokenization, if this character is seen as the first character
+ of a word, then it, and all subsequent characters upto a newline are
+ ignored. For a Bourne shell, this should be '#'. Bash special cases
+ the interactive comment character to not be a comment delimiter. */
+char history_comment_char = '\0';
+
+/* The list of characters which inhibit the expansion of text if found
+ immediately following history_expansion_char. */
+char *history_no_expand_chars = " \t\n\r=";
+
+/* If set to a non-zero value, single quotes inhibit history expansion.
+ The default is 0. */
+int history_quotes_inhibit_expansion = 0;
+
+/* Used to split words by history_tokenize_internal. */
+char *history_word_delimiters = HISTORY_WORD_DELIMITERS;
+
+/* If set, this points to a function that is called to verify that a
+ particular history expansion should be performed. */
+rl_linebuf_func_t *history_inhibit_expansion_function;
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* History Expansion */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* Hairy history expansion on text, not tokens. This is of general
+ use, and thus belongs in this library. */
+
+/* The last string searched for by a !?string? search. */
+static char *search_string;
+
+/* The last string matched by a !?string? search. */
+static char *search_match;
+
+/* Return the event specified at TEXT + OFFSET modifying OFFSET to
+ point to after the event specifier. Just a pointer to the history
+ line is returned; NULL is returned in the event of a bad specifier.
+ You pass STRING with *INDEX equal to the history_expansion_char that
+ begins this specification.
+ DELIMITING_QUOTE is a character that is allowed to end the string
+ specification for what to search for in addition to the normal
+ characters `:', ` ', `\t', `\n', and sometimes `?'.
+ So you might call this function like:
+ line = get_history_event ("!echo:p", &index, 0); */
+char *
+get_history_event (string, caller_index, delimiting_quote)
+ const char *string;
+ int *caller_index;
+ int delimiting_quote;
+{
+ register int i;
+ register char c;
+ HIST_ENTRY *entry;
+ int which, sign, local_index, substring_okay;
+ _hist_search_func_t *search_func;
+ char *temp;
+
+ /* The event can be specified in a number of ways.
+
+ !! the previous command
+ !n command line N
+ !-n current command-line minus N
+ !str the most recent command starting with STR
+ !?str[?]
+ the most recent command containing STR
+
+ All values N are determined via HISTORY_BASE. */
+
+ i = *caller_index;
+
+ if (string[i] != history_expansion_char)
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+
+ /* Move on to the specification. */
+ i++;
+
+ sign = 1;
+ substring_okay = 0;
+
+#define RETURN_ENTRY(e, w) \
+ return ((e = history_get (w)) ? e->line : (char *)NULL)
+
+ /* Handle !! case. */
+ if (string[i] == history_expansion_char)
+ {
+ i++;
+ which = history_base + (history_length - 1);
+ *caller_index = i;
+ RETURN_ENTRY (entry, which);
+ }
+
+ /* Hack case of numeric line specification. */
+ if (string[i] == '-')
+ {
+ sign = -1;
+ i++;
+ }
+
+ if (_rl_digit_p (string[i]))
+ {
+ /* Get the extent of the digits and compute the value. */
+ for (which = 0; _rl_digit_p (string[i]); i++)
+ which = (which * 10) + _rl_digit_value (string[i]);
+
+ *caller_index = i;
+
+ if (sign < 0)
+ which = (history_length + history_base) - which;
+
+ RETURN_ENTRY (entry, which);
+ }
+
+ /* This must be something to search for. If the spec begins with
+ a '?', then the string may be anywhere on the line. Otherwise,
+ the string must be found at the start of a line. */
+ if (string[i] == '?')
+ {
+ substring_okay++;
+ i++;
+ }
+
+ /* Only a closing `?' or a newline delimit a substring search string. */
+ for (local_index = i; c = string[i]; i++)
+ {
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ {
+ int v;
+ mbstate_t ps;
+
+ memset (&ps, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+ /* These produce warnings because we're passing a const string to a
+ function that takes a non-const string. */
+ _rl_adjust_point ((char *)string, i, &ps);
+ if ((v = _rl_get_char_len ((char *)string + i, &ps)) > 1)
+ {
+ i += v - 1;
+ continue;
+ }
+ }
+
+#endif /* HANDLE_MULTIBYTE */
+ if ((!substring_okay && (whitespace (c) || c == ':' ||
+ (history_search_delimiter_chars && member (c, history_search_delimiter_chars)) ||
+ string[i] == delimiting_quote)) ||
+ string[i] == '\n' ||
+ (substring_okay && string[i] == '?'))
+ break;
+ }
+
+ which = i - local_index;
+ temp = (char *)xmalloc (1 + which);
+ if (which)
+ strncpy (temp, string + local_index, which);
+ temp[which] = '\0';
+
+ if (substring_okay && string[i] == '?')
+ i++;
+
+ *caller_index = i;
+
+#define FAIL_SEARCH() \
+ do { \
+ history_offset = history_length; free (temp) ; return (char *)NULL; \
+ } while (0)
+
+ /* If there is no search string, try to use the previous search string,
+ if one exists. If not, fail immediately. */
+ if (*temp == '\0' && substring_okay)
+ {
+ if (search_string)
+ {
+ free (temp);
+ temp = savestring (search_string);
+ }
+ else
+ FAIL_SEARCH ();
+ }
+
+ search_func = substring_okay ? history_search : history_search_prefix;
+ while (1)
+ {
+ local_index = (*search_func) (temp, -1);
+
+ if (local_index < 0)
+ FAIL_SEARCH ();
+
+ if (local_index == 0 || substring_okay)
+ {
+ entry = current_history ();
+ history_offset = history_length;
+
+ /* If this was a substring search, then remember the
+ string that we matched for word substitution. */
+ if (substring_okay)
+ {
+ FREE (search_string);
+ search_string = temp;
+
+ FREE (search_match);
+ search_match = history_find_word (entry->line, local_index);
+ }
+ else
+ free (temp);
+
+ return (entry->line);
+ }
+
+ if (history_offset)
+ history_offset--;
+ else
+ FAIL_SEARCH ();
+ }
+#undef FAIL_SEARCH
+#undef RETURN_ENTRY
+}
+
+/* Function for extracting single-quoted strings. Used for inhibiting
+ history expansion within single quotes. */
+
+/* Extract the contents of STRING as if it is enclosed in single quotes.
+ SINDEX, when passed in, is the offset of the character immediately
+ following the opening single quote; on exit, SINDEX is left pointing
+ to the closing single quote. */
+static void
+hist_string_extract_single_quoted (string, sindex)
+ char *string;
+ int *sindex;
+{
+ register int i;
+
+ for (i = *sindex; string[i] && string[i] != '\''; i++)
+ ;
+
+ *sindex = i;
+}
+
+static char *
+quote_breaks (s)
+ char *s;
+{
+ register char *p, *r;
+ char *ret;
+ int len = 3;
+
+ for (p = s; p && *p; p++, len++)
+ {
+ if (*p == '\'')
+ len += 3;
+ else if (whitespace (*p) || *p == '\n')
+ len += 2;
+ }
+
+ r = ret = (char *)xmalloc (len);
+ *r++ = '\'';
+ for (p = s; p && *p; )
+ {
+ if (*p == '\'')
+ {
+ *r++ = '\'';
+ *r++ = '\\';
+ *r++ = '\'';
+ *r++ = '\'';
+ p++;
+ }
+ else if (whitespace (*p) || *p == '\n')
+ {
+ *r++ = '\'';
+ *r++ = *p++;
+ *r++ = '\'';
+ }
+ else
+ *r++ = *p++;
+ }
+ *r++ = '\'';
+ *r = '\0';
+ return ret;
+}
+
+static char *
+hist_error(s, start, current, errtype)
+ char *s;
+ int start, current, errtype;
+{
+ char *temp;
+ const char *emsg;
+ int ll, elen;
+
+ ll = current - start;
+
+ switch (errtype)
+ {
+ case EVENT_NOT_FOUND:
+ emsg = "event not found";
+ elen = 15;
+ break;
+ case BAD_WORD_SPEC:
+ emsg = "bad word specifier";
+ elen = 18;
+ break;
+ case SUBST_FAILED:
+ emsg = "substitution failed";
+ elen = 19;
+ break;
+ case BAD_MODIFIER:
+ emsg = "unrecognized history modifier";
+ elen = 29;
+ break;
+ case NO_PREV_SUBST:
+ emsg = "no previous substitution";
+ elen = 24;
+ break;
+ default:
+ emsg = "unknown expansion error";
+ elen = 23;
+ break;
+ }
+
+ temp = (char *)xmalloc (ll + elen + 3);
+ strncpy (temp, s + start, ll);
+ temp[ll] = ':';
+ temp[ll + 1] = ' ';
+ strcpy (temp + ll + 2, emsg);
+ return (temp);
+}
+
+/* Get a history substitution string from STR starting at *IPTR
+ and return it. The length is returned in LENPTR.
+
+ A backslash can quote the delimiter. If the string is the
+ empty string, the previous pattern is used. If there is
+ no previous pattern for the lhs, the last history search
+ string is used.
+
+ If IS_RHS is 1, we ignore empty strings and set the pattern
+ to "" anyway. subst_lhs is not changed if the lhs is empty;
+ subst_rhs is allowed to be set to the empty string. */
+
+static char *
+get_subst_pattern (str, iptr, delimiter, is_rhs, lenptr)
+ char *str;
+ int *iptr, delimiter, is_rhs, *lenptr;
+{
+ register int si, i, j, k;
+ char *s;
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ mbstate_t ps;
+#endif
+
+ s = (char *)NULL;
+ i = *iptr;
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ memset (&ps, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+ _rl_adjust_point (str, i, &ps);
+#endif
+
+ for (si = i; str[si] && str[si] != delimiter; si++)
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ {
+ int v;
+ if ((v = _rl_get_char_len (str + si, &ps)) > 1)
+ si += v - 1;
+ else if (str[si] == '\\' && str[si + 1] == delimiter)
+ si++;
+ }
+ else
+#endif /* HANDLE_MULTIBYTE */
+ if (str[si] == '\\' && str[si + 1] == delimiter)
+ si++;
+
+ if (si > i || is_rhs)
+ {
+ s = (char *)xmalloc (si - i + 1);
+ for (j = 0, k = i; k < si; j++, k++)
+ {
+ /* Remove a backslash quoting the search string delimiter. */
+ if (str[k] == '\\' && str[k + 1] == delimiter)
+ k++;
+ s[j] = str[k];
+ }
+ s[j] = '\0';
+ if (lenptr)
+ *lenptr = j;
+ }
+
+ i = si;
+ if (str[i])
+ i++;
+ *iptr = i;
+
+ return s;
+}
+
+static void
+postproc_subst_rhs ()
+{
+ char *new;
+ int i, j, new_size;
+
+ new = (char *)xmalloc (new_size = subst_rhs_len + subst_lhs_len);
+ for (i = j = 0; i < subst_rhs_len; i++)
+ {
+ if (subst_rhs[i] == '&')
+ {
+ if (j + subst_lhs_len >= new_size)
+ new = (char *)xrealloc (new, (new_size = new_size * 2 + subst_lhs_len));
+ strcpy (new + j, subst_lhs);
+ j += subst_lhs_len;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* a single backslash protects the `&' from lhs interpolation */
+ if (subst_rhs[i] == '\\' && subst_rhs[i + 1] == '&')
+ i++;
+ if (j >= new_size)
+ new = (char *)xrealloc (new, new_size *= 2);
+ new[j++] = subst_rhs[i];
+ }
+ }
+ new[j] = '\0';
+ free (subst_rhs);
+ subst_rhs = new;
+ subst_rhs_len = j;
+}
+
+/* Expand the bulk of a history specifier starting at STRING[START].
+ Returns 0 if everything is OK, -1 if an error occurred, and 1
+ if the `p' modifier was supplied and the caller should just print
+ the returned string. Returns the new index into string in
+ *END_INDEX_PTR, and the expanded specifier in *RET_STRING. */
+static int
+history_expand_internal (string, start, end_index_ptr, ret_string, current_line)
+ char *string;
+ int start, *end_index_ptr;
+ char **ret_string;
+ char *current_line; /* for !# */
+{
+ int i, n, starting_index;
+ int substitute_globally, subst_bywords, want_quotes, print_only;
+ char *event, *temp, *result, *tstr, *t, c, *word_spec;
+ int result_len;
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ mbstate_t ps;
+
+ memset (&ps, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+#endif
+
+ result = (char *)xmalloc (result_len = 128);
+
+ i = start;
+
+ /* If it is followed by something that starts a word specifier,
+ then !! is implied as the event specifier. */
+
+ if (member (string[i + 1], ":$*%^"))
+ {
+ char fake_s[3];
+ int fake_i = 0;
+ i++;
+ fake_s[0] = fake_s[1] = history_expansion_char;
+ fake_s[2] = '\0';
+ event = get_history_event (fake_s, &fake_i, 0);
+ }
+ else if (string[i + 1] == '#')
+ {
+ i += 2;
+ event = current_line;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ int quoted_search_delimiter = 0;
+
+ /* If the character before this `!' is a double or single
+ quote, then this expansion takes place inside of the
+ quoted string. If we have to search for some text ("!foo"),
+ allow the delimiter to end the search string. */
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ {
+ int c, l;
+ l = _rl_find_prev_mbchar (string, i, MB_FIND_ANY);
+ c = string[l];
+ /* XXX - original patch had i - 1 ??? If i == 0 it would fail. */
+ if (i && (c == '\'' || c == '"'))
+ quoted_search_delimiter = c;
+ }
+ else
+#endif /* HANDLE_MULTIBYTE */
+ if (i && (string[i - 1] == '\'' || string[i - 1] == '"'))
+ quoted_search_delimiter = string[i - 1];
+
+ event = get_history_event (string, &i, quoted_search_delimiter);
+ }
+
+ if (event == 0)
+ {
+ *ret_string = hist_error (string, start, i, EVENT_NOT_FOUND);
+ free (result);
+ return (-1);
+ }
+
+ /* If a word specifier is found, then do what that requires. */
+ starting_index = i;
+ word_spec = get_history_word_specifier (string, event, &i);
+
+ /* There is no such thing as a `malformed word specifier'. However,
+ it is possible for a specifier that has no match. In that case,
+ we complain. */
+ if (word_spec == (char *)&error_pointer)
+ {
+ *ret_string = hist_error (string, starting_index, i, BAD_WORD_SPEC);
+ free (result);
+ return (-1);
+ }
+
+ /* If no word specifier, than the thing of interest was the event. */
+ temp = word_spec ? savestring (word_spec) : savestring (event);
+ FREE (word_spec);
+
+ /* Perhaps there are other modifiers involved. Do what they say. */
+ want_quotes = substitute_globally = subst_bywords = print_only = 0;
+ starting_index = i;
+
+ while (string[i] == ':')
+ {
+ c = string[i + 1];
+
+ if (c == 'g' || c == 'a')
+ {
+ substitute_globally = 1;
+ i++;
+ c = string[i + 1];
+ }
+ else if (c == 'G')
+ {
+ subst_bywords = 1;
+ i++;
+ c = string[i + 1];
+ }
+
+ switch (c)
+ {
+ default:
+ *ret_string = hist_error (string, i+1, i+2, BAD_MODIFIER);
+ free (result);
+ free (temp);
+ return -1;
+
+ case 'q':
+ want_quotes = 'q';
+ break;
+
+ case 'x':
+ want_quotes = 'x';
+ break;
+
+ /* :p means make this the last executed line. So we
+ return an error state after adding this line to the
+ history. */
+ case 'p':
+ print_only++;
+ break;
+
+ /* :t discards all but the last part of the pathname. */
+ case 't':
+ tstr = strrchr (temp, '/');
+ if (tstr)
+ {
+ tstr++;
+ t = savestring (tstr);
+ free (temp);
+ temp = t;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ /* :h discards the last part of a pathname. */
+ case 'h':
+ tstr = strrchr (temp, '/');
+ if (tstr)
+ *tstr = '\0';
+ break;
+
+ /* :r discards the suffix. */
+ case 'r':
+ tstr = strrchr (temp, '.');
+ if (tstr)
+ *tstr = '\0';
+ break;
+
+ /* :e discards everything but the suffix. */
+ case 'e':
+ tstr = strrchr (temp, '.');
+ if (tstr)
+ {
+ t = savestring (tstr);
+ free (temp);
+ temp = t;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ /* :s/this/that substitutes `that' for the first
+ occurrence of `this'. :gs/this/that substitutes `that'
+ for each occurrence of `this'. :& repeats the last
+ substitution. :g& repeats the last substitution
+ globally. */
+
+ case '&':
+ case 's':
+ {
+ char *new_event;
+ int delimiter, failed, si, l_temp, ws, we;
+
+ if (c == 's')
+ {
+ if (i + 2 < (int)strlen (string))
+ {
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ {
+ _rl_adjust_point (string, i + 2, &ps);
+ if (_rl_get_char_len (string + i + 2, &ps) > 1)
+ delimiter = 0;
+ else
+ delimiter = string[i + 2];
+ }
+ else
+#endif /* HANDLE_MULTIBYTE */
+ delimiter = string[i + 2];
+ }
+ else
+ break; /* no search delimiter */
+
+ i += 3;
+
+ t = get_subst_pattern (string, &i, delimiter, 0, &subst_lhs_len);
+ /* An empty substitution lhs with no previous substitution
+ uses the last search string as the lhs. */
+ if (t)
+ {
+ FREE (subst_lhs);
+ subst_lhs = t;
+ }
+ else if (!subst_lhs)
+ {
+ if (search_string && *search_string)
+ {
+ subst_lhs = savestring (search_string);
+ subst_lhs_len = strlen (subst_lhs);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ subst_lhs = (char *) NULL;
+ subst_lhs_len = 0;
+ }
+ }
+
+ FREE (subst_rhs);
+ subst_rhs = get_subst_pattern (string, &i, delimiter, 1, &subst_rhs_len);
+
+ /* If `&' appears in the rhs, it's supposed to be replaced
+ with the lhs. */
+ if (member ('&', subst_rhs))
+ postproc_subst_rhs ();
+ }
+ else
+ i += 2;
+
+ /* If there is no lhs, the substitution can't succeed. */
+ if (subst_lhs_len == 0)
+ {
+ *ret_string = hist_error (string, starting_index, i, NO_PREV_SUBST);
+ free (result);
+ free (temp);
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ l_temp = strlen (temp);
+ /* Ignore impossible cases. */
+ if (subst_lhs_len > l_temp)
+ {
+ *ret_string = hist_error (string, starting_index, i, SUBST_FAILED);
+ free (result);
+ free (temp);
+ return (-1);
+ }
+
+ /* Find the first occurrence of THIS in TEMP. */
+ /* Substitute SUBST_RHS for SUBST_LHS in TEMP. There are three
+ cases to consider:
+
+ 1. substitute_globally == subst_bywords == 0
+ 2. substitute_globally == 1 && subst_bywords == 0
+ 3. substitute_globally == 0 && subst_bywords == 1
+
+ In the first case, we substitute for the first occurrence only.
+ In the second case, we substitute for every occurrence.
+ In the third case, we tokenize into words and substitute the
+ first occurrence of each word. */
+
+ si = we = 0;
+ for (failed = 1; (si + subst_lhs_len) <= l_temp; si++)
+ {
+ /* First skip whitespace and find word boundaries if
+ we're past the end of the word boundary we found
+ the last time. */
+ if (subst_bywords && si > we)
+ {
+ for (; temp[si] && whitespace (temp[si]); si++)
+ ;
+ ws = si;
+ we = history_tokenize_word (temp, si);
+ }
+
+ if (STREQN (temp+si, subst_lhs, subst_lhs_len))
+ {
+ int len = subst_rhs_len - subst_lhs_len + l_temp;
+ new_event = (char *)xmalloc (1 + len);
+ strncpy (new_event, temp, si);
+ strncpy (new_event + si, subst_rhs, subst_rhs_len);
+ strncpy (new_event + si + subst_rhs_len,
+ temp + si + subst_lhs_len,
+ l_temp - (si + subst_lhs_len));
+ new_event[len] = '\0';
+ free (temp);
+ temp = new_event;
+
+ failed = 0;
+
+ if (substitute_globally)
+ {
+ /* Reported to fix a bug that causes it to skip every
+ other match when matching a single character. Was
+ si += subst_rhs_len previously. */
+ si += subst_rhs_len - 1;
+ l_temp = strlen (temp);
+ substitute_globally++;
+ continue;
+ }
+ else if (subst_bywords)
+ {
+ si = we;
+ l_temp = strlen (temp);
+ continue;
+ }
+ else
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (substitute_globally > 1)
+ {
+ substitute_globally = 0;
+ continue; /* don't want to increment i */
+ }
+
+ if (failed == 0)
+ continue; /* don't want to increment i */
+
+ *ret_string = hist_error (string, starting_index, i, SUBST_FAILED);
+ free (result);
+ free (temp);
+ return (-1);
+ }
+ }
+ i += 2;
+ }
+ /* Done with modfiers. */
+ /* Believe it or not, we have to back the pointer up by one. */
+ --i;
+
+ if (want_quotes)
+ {
+ char *x;
+
+ if (want_quotes == 'q')
+ x = sh_single_quote (temp);
+ else if (want_quotes == 'x')
+ x = quote_breaks (temp);
+ else
+ x = savestring (temp);
+
+ free (temp);
+ temp = x;
+ }
+
+ n = strlen (temp);
+ if (n >= result_len)
+ result = (char *)xrealloc (result, n + 2);
+ strcpy (result, temp);
+ free (temp);
+
+ *end_index_ptr = i;
+ *ret_string = result;
+ return (print_only);
+}
+
+/* Expand the string STRING, placing the result into OUTPUT, a pointer
+ to a string. Returns:
+
+ -1) If there was an error in expansion.
+ 0) If no expansions took place (or, if the only change in
+ the text was the de-slashifying of the history expansion
+ character)
+ 1) If expansions did take place
+ 2) If the `p' modifier was given and the caller should print the result
+
+ If an error ocurred in expansion, then OUTPUT contains a descriptive
+ error message. */
+
+#define ADD_STRING(s) \
+ do \
+ { \
+ int sl = strlen (s); \
+ j += sl; \
+ if (j >= result_len) \
+ { \
+ while (j >= result_len) \
+ result_len += 128; \
+ result = (char *)xrealloc (result, result_len); \
+ } \
+ strcpy (result + j - sl, s); \
+ } \
+ while (0)
+
+#define ADD_CHAR(c) \
+ do \
+ { \
+ if (j >= result_len - 1) \
+ result = (char *)xrealloc (result, result_len += 64); \
+ result[j++] = c; \
+ result[j] = '\0'; \
+ } \
+ while (0)
+
+int
+history_expand (hstring, output)
+ char *hstring;
+ char **output;
+{
+ register int j;
+ int i, r, l, passc, cc, modified, eindex, only_printing, dquote;
+ char *string;
+
+ /* The output string, and its length. */
+ int result_len;
+ char *result;
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ char mb[MB_LEN_MAX];
+ mbstate_t ps;
+#endif
+
+ /* Used when adding the string. */
+ char *temp;
+
+ if (output == 0)
+ return 0;
+
+ /* Setting the history expansion character to 0 inhibits all
+ history expansion. */
+ if (history_expansion_char == 0)
+ {
+ *output = savestring (hstring);
+ return (0);
+ }
+
+ /* Prepare the buffer for printing error messages. */
+ result = (char *)xmalloc (result_len = 256);
+ result[0] = '\0';
+
+ only_printing = modified = 0;
+ l = strlen (hstring);
+
+ /* Grovel the string. Only backslash and single quotes can quote the
+ history escape character. We also handle arg specifiers. */
+
+ /* Before we grovel forever, see if the history_expansion_char appears
+ anywhere within the text. */
+
+ /* The quick substitution character is a history expansion all right. That
+ is to say, "^this^that^" is equivalent to "!!:s^this^that^", and in fact,
+ that is the substitution that we do. */
+ if (hstring[0] == history_subst_char)
+ {
+ string = (char *)xmalloc (l + 5);
+
+ string[0] = string[1] = history_expansion_char;
+ string[2] = ':';
+ string[3] = 's';
+ strcpy (string + 4, hstring);
+ l += 4;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ memset (&ps, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+#endif
+
+ string = hstring;
+ /* If not quick substitution, still maybe have to do expansion. */
+
+ /* `!' followed by one of the characters in history_no_expand_chars
+ is NOT an expansion. */
+ for (i = dquote = 0; string[i]; i++)
+ {
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ {
+ int v;
+ v = _rl_get_char_len (string + i, &ps);
+ if (v > 1)
+ {
+ i += v - 1;
+ continue;
+ }
+ }
+#endif /* HANDLE_MULTIBYTE */
+
+ cc = string[i + 1];
+ /* The history_comment_char, if set, appearing at the beginning
+ of a word signifies that the rest of the line should not have
+ history expansion performed on it.
+ Skip the rest of the line and break out of the loop. */
+ if (history_comment_char && string[i] == history_comment_char &&
+ (i == 0 || member (string[i - 1], history_word_delimiters)))
+ {
+ while (string[i])
+ i++;
+ break;
+ }
+ else if (string[i] == history_expansion_char)
+ {
+ if (!cc || member (cc, history_no_expand_chars))
+ continue;
+ /* If the calling application has set
+ history_inhibit_expansion_function to a function that checks
+ for special cases that should not be history expanded,
+ call the function and skip the expansion if it returns a
+ non-zero value. */
+ else if (history_inhibit_expansion_function &&
+ (*history_inhibit_expansion_function) (string, i))
+ continue;
+ else
+ break;
+ }
+ /* Shell-like quoting: allow backslashes to quote double quotes
+ inside a double-quoted string. */
+ else if (dquote && string[i] == '\\' && cc == '"')
+ i++;
+ /* More shell-like quoting: if we're paying attention to single
+ quotes and letting them quote the history expansion character,
+ then we need to pay attention to double quotes, because single
+ quotes are not special inside double-quoted strings. */
+ else if (history_quotes_inhibit_expansion && string[i] == '"')
+ {
+ dquote = 1 - dquote;
+ }
+ else if (dquote == 0 && history_quotes_inhibit_expansion && string[i] == '\'')
+ {
+ /* If this is bash, single quotes inhibit history expansion. */
+ i++;
+ hist_string_extract_single_quoted (string, &i);
+ }
+ else if (history_quotes_inhibit_expansion && string[i] == '\\')
+ {
+ /* If this is bash, allow backslashes to quote single
+ quotes and the history expansion character. */
+ if (cc == '\'' || cc == history_expansion_char)
+ i++;
+ }
+
+ }
+
+ if (string[i] != history_expansion_char)
+ {
+ free (result);
+ *output = savestring (string);
+ return (0);
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Extract and perform the substitution. */
+ for (passc = dquote = i = j = 0; i < l; i++)
+ {
+ int tchar = string[i];
+
+ if (passc)
+ {
+ passc = 0;
+ ADD_CHAR (tchar);
+ continue;
+ }
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ {
+ int k, c;
+
+ c = tchar;
+ memset (mb, 0, sizeof (mb));
+ for (k = 0; k < MB_LEN_MAX; k++)
+ {
+ mb[k] = (char)c;
+ memset (&ps, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+ if (_rl_get_char_len (mb, &ps) == -2)
+ c = string[++i];
+ else
+ break;
+ }
+ if (strlen (mb) > 1)
+ {
+ ADD_STRING (mb);
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+#endif /* HANDLE_MULTIBYTE */
+
+ if (tchar == history_expansion_char)
+ tchar = -3;
+ else if (tchar == history_comment_char)
+ tchar = -2;
+
+ switch (tchar)
+ {
+ default:
+ ADD_CHAR (string[i]);
+ break;
+
+ case '\\':
+ passc++;
+ ADD_CHAR (tchar);
+ break;
+
+ case '"':
+ dquote = 1 - dquote;
+ ADD_CHAR (tchar);
+ break;
+
+ case '\'':
+ {
+ /* If history_quotes_inhibit_expansion is set, single quotes
+ inhibit history expansion. */
+ if (dquote == 0 && history_quotes_inhibit_expansion)
+ {
+ int quote, slen;
+
+ quote = i++;
+ hist_string_extract_single_quoted (string, &i);
+
+ slen = i - quote + 2;
+ temp = (char *)xmalloc (slen);
+ strncpy (temp, string + quote, slen);
+ temp[slen - 1] = '\0';
+ ADD_STRING (temp);
+ free (temp);
+ }
+ else
+ ADD_CHAR (string[i]);
+ break;
+ }
+
+ case -2: /* history_comment_char */
+ if (i == 0 || member (string[i - 1], history_word_delimiters))
+ {
+ temp = (char *)xmalloc (l - i + 1);
+ strcpy (temp, string + i);
+ ADD_STRING (temp);
+ free (temp);
+ i = l;
+ }
+ else
+ ADD_CHAR (string[i]);
+ break;
+
+ case -3: /* history_expansion_char */
+ cc = string[i + 1];
+
+ /* If the history_expansion_char is followed by one of the
+ characters in history_no_expand_chars, then it is not a
+ candidate for expansion of any kind. */
+ if (member (cc, history_no_expand_chars))
+ {
+ ADD_CHAR (string[i]);
+ break;
+ }
+
+#if defined (NO_BANG_HASH_MODIFIERS)
+ /* There is something that is listed as a `word specifier' in csh
+ documentation which means `the expanded text to this point'.
+ That is not a word specifier, it is an event specifier. If we
+ don't want to allow modifiers with `!#', just stick the current
+ output line in again. */
+ if (cc == '#')
+ {
+ if (result)
+ {
+ temp = (char *)xmalloc (1 + strlen (result));
+ strcpy (temp, result);
+ ADD_STRING (temp);
+ free (temp);
+ }
+ i++;
+ break;
+ }
+#endif
+
+ r = history_expand_internal (string, i, &eindex, &temp, result);
+ if (r < 0)
+ {
+ *output = temp;
+ free (result);
+ if (string != hstring)
+ free (string);
+ return -1;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if (temp)
+ {
+ modified++;
+ if (*temp)
+ ADD_STRING (temp);
+ free (temp);
+ }
+ only_printing = r == 1;
+ i = eindex;
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ *output = result;
+ if (string != hstring)
+ free (string);
+
+ if (only_printing)
+ {
+#if 0
+ add_history (result);
+#endif
+ return (2);
+ }
+
+ return (modified != 0);
+}
+
+/* Return a consed string which is the word specified in SPEC, and found
+ in FROM. NULL is returned if there is no spec. The address of
+ ERROR_POINTER is returned if the word specified cannot be found.
+ CALLER_INDEX is the offset in SPEC to start looking; it is updated
+ to point to just after the last character parsed. */
+static char *
+get_history_word_specifier (spec, from, caller_index)
+ char *spec, *from;
+ int *caller_index;
+{
+ register int i = *caller_index;
+ int first, last;
+ int expecting_word_spec = 0;
+ char *result;
+
+ /* The range of words to return doesn't exist yet. */
+ first = last = 0;
+ result = (char *)NULL;
+
+ /* If we found a colon, then this *must* be a word specification. If
+ it isn't, then it is an error. */
+ if (spec[i] == ':')
+ {
+ i++;
+ expecting_word_spec++;
+ }
+
+ /* Handle special cases first. */
+
+ /* `%' is the word last searched for. */
+ if (spec[i] == '%')
+ {
+ *caller_index = i + 1;
+ return (search_match ? savestring (search_match) : savestring (""));
+ }
+
+ /* `*' matches all of the arguments, but not the command. */
+ if (spec[i] == '*')
+ {
+ *caller_index = i + 1;
+ result = history_arg_extract (1, '$', from);
+ return (result ? result : savestring (""));
+ }
+
+ /* `$' is last arg. */
+ if (spec[i] == '$')
+ {
+ *caller_index = i + 1;
+ return (history_arg_extract ('$', '$', from));
+ }
+
+ /* Try to get FIRST and LAST figured out. */
+
+ if (spec[i] == '-')
+ first = 0;
+ else if (spec[i] == '^')
+ {
+ first = 1;
+ i++;
+ }
+ else if (_rl_digit_p (spec[i]) && expecting_word_spec)
+ {
+ for (first = 0; _rl_digit_p (spec[i]); i++)
+ first = (first * 10) + _rl_digit_value (spec[i]);
+ }
+ else
+ return ((char *)NULL); /* no valid `first' for word specifier */
+
+ if (spec[i] == '^' || spec[i] == '*')
+ {
+ last = (spec[i] == '^') ? 1 : '$'; /* x* abbreviates x-$ */
+ i++;
+ }
+ else if (spec[i] != '-')
+ last = first;
+ else
+ {
+ i++;
+
+ if (_rl_digit_p (spec[i]))
+ {
+ for (last = 0; _rl_digit_p (spec[i]); i++)
+ last = (last * 10) + _rl_digit_value (spec[i]);
+ }
+ else if (spec[i] == '$')
+ {
+ i++;
+ last = '$';
+ }
+#if 0
+ else if (!spec[i] || spec[i] == ':')
+ /* check against `:' because there could be a modifier separator */
+#else
+ else
+ /* csh seems to allow anything to terminate the word spec here,
+ leaving it as an abbreviation. */
+#endif
+ last = -1; /* x- abbreviates x-$ omitting word `$' */
+ }
+
+ *caller_index = i;
+
+ if (last >= first || last == '$' || last < 0)
+ result = history_arg_extract (first, last, from);
+
+ return (result ? result : (char *)&error_pointer);
+}
+
+/* Extract the args specified, starting at FIRST, and ending at LAST.
+ The args are taken from STRING. If either FIRST or LAST is < 0,
+ then make that arg count from the right (subtract from the number of
+ tokens, so that FIRST = -1 means the next to last token on the line).
+ If LAST is `$' the last arg from STRING is used. */
+char *
+history_arg_extract (first, last, string)
+ int first, last;
+ const char *string;
+{
+ register int i, len;
+ char *result;
+ int size, offset;
+ char **list;
+
+ /* XXX - think about making history_tokenize return a struct array,
+ each struct in array being a string and a length to avoid the
+ calls to strlen below. */
+ if ((list = history_tokenize (string)) == NULL)
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+
+ for (len = 0; list[len]; len++)
+ ;
+
+ if (last < 0)
+ last = len + last - 1;
+
+ if (first < 0)
+ first = len + first - 1;
+
+ if (last == '$')
+ last = len - 1;
+
+ if (first == '$')
+ first = len - 1;
+
+ last++;
+
+ if (first >= len || last > len || first < 0 || last < 0 || first > last)
+ result = ((char *)NULL);
+ else
+ {
+ for (size = 0, i = first; i < last; i++)
+ size += strlen (list[i]) + 1;
+ result = (char *)xmalloc (size + 1);
+ result[0] = '\0';
+
+ for (i = first, offset = 0; i < last; i++)
+ {
+ strcpy (result + offset, list[i]);
+ offset += strlen (list[i]);
+ if (i + 1 < last)
+ {
+ result[offset++] = ' ';
+ result[offset] = 0;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ for (i = 0; i < len; i++)
+ free (list[i]);
+ free (list);
+
+ return (result);
+}
+
+static int
+history_tokenize_word (string, ind)
+ const char *string;
+ int ind;
+{
+ register int i;
+ int delimiter;
+
+ i = ind;
+ delimiter = 0;
+
+ if (member (string[i], "()\n"))
+ {
+ i++;
+ return i;
+ }
+
+ if (member (string[i], "<>;&|$"))
+ {
+ int peek = string[i + 1];
+
+ if (peek == string[i] && peek != '$')
+ {
+ if (peek == '<' && string[i + 2] == '-')
+ i++;
+ i += 2;
+ return i;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if ((peek == '&' && (string[i] == '>' || string[i] == '<')) ||
+ (peek == '>' && string[i] == '&') ||
+ (peek == '(' && (string[i] == '>' || string[i] == '<')) || /* ) */
+ (peek == '(' && string[i] == '$')) /* ) */
+ {
+ i += 2;
+ return i;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (string[i] != '$')
+ {
+ i++;
+ return i;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Get word from string + i; */
+
+ if (member (string[i], HISTORY_QUOTE_CHARACTERS))
+ delimiter = string[i++];
+
+ for (; string[i]; i++)
+ {
+ if (string[i] == '\\' && string[i + 1] == '\n')
+ {
+ i++;
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ if (string[i] == '\\' && delimiter != '\'' &&
+ (delimiter != '"' || member (string[i], slashify_in_quotes)))
+ {
+ i++;
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ if (delimiter && string[i] == delimiter)
+ {
+ delimiter = 0;
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ if (!delimiter && (member (string[i], history_word_delimiters)))
+ break;
+
+ if (!delimiter && member (string[i], HISTORY_QUOTE_CHARACTERS))
+ delimiter = string[i];
+ }
+
+ return i;
+}
+
+static char *
+history_substring (string, start, end)
+ const char *string;
+ int start, end;
+{
+ register int len;
+ register char *result;
+
+ len = end - start;
+ result = (char *)xmalloc (len + 1);
+ strncpy (result, string + start, len);
+ result[len] = '\0';
+ return result;
+}
+
+/* Parse STRING into tokens and return an array of strings. If WIND is
+ not -1 and INDP is not null, we also want the word surrounding index
+ WIND. The position in the returned array of strings is returned in
+ *INDP. */
+static char **
+history_tokenize_internal (string, wind, indp)
+ const char *string;
+ int wind, *indp;
+{
+ char **result;
+ register int i, start, result_index, size;
+
+ /* If we're searching for a string that's not part of a word (e.g., " "),
+ make sure we set *INDP to a reasonable value. */
+ if (indp && wind != -1)
+ *indp = -1;
+
+ /* Get a token, and stuff it into RESULT. The tokens are split
+ exactly where the shell would split them. */
+ for (i = result_index = size = 0, result = (char **)NULL; string[i]; )
+ {
+ /* Skip leading whitespace. */
+ for (; string[i] && whitespace (string[i]); i++)
+ ;
+ if (string[i] == 0 || string[i] == history_comment_char)
+ return (result);
+
+ start = i;
+
+ i = history_tokenize_word (string, start);
+
+ /* If we have a non-whitespace delimiter character (which would not be
+ skipped by the loop above), use it and any adjacent delimiters to
+ make a separate field. Any adjacent white space will be skipped the
+ next time through the loop. */
+ if (i == start && history_word_delimiters)
+ {
+ i++;
+ while (string[i] && member (string[i], history_word_delimiters))
+ i++;
+ }
+
+ /* If we are looking for the word in which the character at a
+ particular index falls, remember it. */
+ if (indp && wind != -1 && wind >= start && wind < i)
+ *indp = result_index;
+
+ if (result_index + 2 >= size)
+ result = (char **)xrealloc (result, ((size += 10) * sizeof (char *)));
+
+ result[result_index++] = history_substring (string, start, i);
+ result[result_index] = (char *)NULL;
+ }
+
+ return (result);
+}
+
+/* Return an array of tokens, much as the shell might. The tokens are
+ parsed out of STRING. */
+char **
+history_tokenize (string)
+ const char *string;
+{
+ return (history_tokenize_internal (string, -1, (int *)NULL));
+}
+
+/* Find and return the word which contains the character at index IND
+ in the history line LINE. Used to save the word matched by the
+ last history !?string? search. */
+static char *
+history_find_word (line, ind)
+ char *line;
+ int ind;
+{
+ char **words, *s;
+ int i, wind;
+
+ words = history_tokenize_internal (line, ind, &wind);
+ if (wind == -1 || words == 0)
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+ s = words[wind];
+ for (i = 0; i < wind; i++)
+ free (words[i]);
+ for (i = wind + 1; words[i]; i++)
+ free (words[i]);
+ free (words);
+ return s;
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/histfile.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/histfile.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..717bbee
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/histfile.c
@@ -0,0 +1,542 @@
+/* histfile.c - functions to manipulate the history file. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1989-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file contains the GNU History Library (the Library), a set of
+ routines for managing the text of previously typed lines.
+
+ The Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ The Library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
+ WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+/* The goal is to make the implementation transparent, so that you
+ don't have to know what data types are used, just what functions
+ you can call. I think I have done that. */
+
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#if defined (__TANDEM)
+# include <floss.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#if ! defined (_MINIX) && defined (HAVE_SYS_FILE_H)
+# include <sys/file.h>
+#endif
+#include "posixstat.h"
+#include <fcntl.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STDLIB_H)
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif /* HAVE_STDLIB_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (__EMX__) || defined (__CYGWIN__)
+# undef HAVE_MMAP
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HISTORY_USE_MMAP
+# include <sys/mman.h>
+
+# ifdef MAP_FILE
+# define MAP_RFLAGS (MAP_FILE|MAP_PRIVATE)
+# define MAP_WFLAGS (MAP_FILE|MAP_SHARED)
+# else
+# define MAP_RFLAGS MAP_PRIVATE
+# define MAP_WFLAGS MAP_SHARED
+# endif
+
+# ifndef MAP_FAILED
+# define MAP_FAILED ((void *)-1)
+# endif
+
+#endif /* HISTORY_USE_MMAP */
+
+/* If we're compiling for __EMX__ (OS/2) or __CYGWIN__ (cygwin32 environment
+ on win 95/98/nt), we want to open files with O_BINARY mode so that there
+ is no \n -> \r\n conversion performed. On other systems, we don't want to
+ mess around with O_BINARY at all, so we ensure that it's defined to 0. */
+#if defined (__EMX__) || defined (__CYGWIN__)
+# ifndef O_BINARY
+# define O_BINARY 0
+# endif
+#else /* !__EMX__ && !__CYGWIN__ */
+# undef O_BINARY
+# define O_BINARY 0
+#endif /* !__EMX__ && !__CYGWIN__ */
+
+#include <errno.h>
+#if !defined (errno)
+extern int errno;
+#endif /* !errno */
+
+#include "history.h"
+#include "histlib.h"
+
+#include "rlshell.h"
+#include "xmalloc.h"
+
+/* If non-zero, we write timestamps to the history file in history_do_write() */
+int history_write_timestamps = 0;
+
+/* Does S look like the beginning of a history timestamp entry? Placeholder
+ for more extensive tests. */
+#define HIST_TIMESTAMP_START(s) (*(s) == history_comment_char)
+
+/* Return the string that should be used in the place of this
+ filename. This only matters when you don't specify the
+ filename to read_history (), or write_history (). */
+static char *
+history_filename (filename)
+ const char *filename;
+{
+ char *return_val;
+ const char *home;
+ int home_len;
+
+ return_val = filename ? savestring (filename) : (char *)NULL;
+
+ if (return_val)
+ return (return_val);
+
+ home = sh_get_env_value ("HOME");
+
+ if (home == 0)
+ {
+ home = ".";
+ home_len = 1;
+ }
+ else
+ home_len = strlen (home);
+
+ return_val = (char *)xmalloc (2 + home_len + 8); /* strlen(".history") == 8 */
+ strcpy (return_val, home);
+ return_val[home_len] = '/';
+#if defined (__MSDOS__)
+ strcpy (return_val + home_len + 1, "_history");
+#else
+ strcpy (return_val + home_len + 1, ".history");
+#endif
+
+ return (return_val);
+}
+
+/* Add the contents of FILENAME to the history list, a line at a time.
+ If FILENAME is NULL, then read from ~/.history. Returns 0 if
+ successful, or errno if not. */
+int
+read_history (filename)
+ const char *filename;
+{
+ return (read_history_range (filename, 0, -1));
+}
+
+/* Read a range of lines from FILENAME, adding them to the history list.
+ Start reading at the FROM'th line and end at the TO'th. If FROM
+ is zero, start at the beginning. If TO is less than FROM, read
+ until the end of the file. If FILENAME is NULL, then read from
+ ~/.history. Returns 0 if successful, or errno if not. */
+int
+read_history_range (filename, from, to)
+ const char *filename;
+ int from, to;
+{
+ register char *line_start, *line_end, *p;
+ char *input, *buffer, *bufend, *last_ts;
+ int file, current_line, chars_read;
+ struct stat finfo;
+ size_t file_size;
+#if defined (EFBIG)
+ int overflow_errno = EFBIG;
+#elif defined (EOVERFLOW)
+ int overflow_errno = EOVERFLOW;
+#else
+ int overflow_errno = EIO;
+#endif
+
+ buffer = last_ts = (char *)NULL;
+ input = history_filename (filename);
+ file = open (input, O_RDONLY|O_BINARY, 0666);
+
+ if ((file < 0) || (fstat (file, &finfo) == -1))
+ goto error_and_exit;
+
+ file_size = (size_t)finfo.st_size;
+
+ /* check for overflow on very large files */
+ if (file_size != finfo.st_size || file_size + 1 < file_size)
+ {
+ errno = overflow_errno;
+ goto error_and_exit;
+ }
+
+#ifdef HISTORY_USE_MMAP
+ /* We map read/write and private so we can change newlines to NULs without
+ affecting the underlying object. */
+ buffer = (char *)mmap (0, file_size, PROT_READ|PROT_WRITE, MAP_RFLAGS, file, 0);
+ if ((void *)buffer == MAP_FAILED)
+ {
+ errno = overflow_errno;
+ goto error_and_exit;
+ }
+ chars_read = file_size;
+#else
+ buffer = (char *)malloc (file_size + 1);
+ if (buffer == 0)
+ {
+ errno = overflow_errno;
+ goto error_and_exit;
+ }
+
+ chars_read = read (file, buffer, file_size);
+#endif
+ if (chars_read < 0)
+ {
+ error_and_exit:
+ if (errno != 0)
+ chars_read = errno;
+ else
+ chars_read = EIO;
+ if (file >= 0)
+ close (file);
+
+ FREE (input);
+#ifndef HISTORY_USE_MMAP
+ FREE (buffer);
+#endif
+
+ return (chars_read);
+ }
+
+ close (file);
+
+ /* Set TO to larger than end of file if negative. */
+ if (to < 0)
+ to = chars_read;
+
+ /* Start at beginning of file, work to end. */
+ bufend = buffer + chars_read;
+ current_line = 0;
+
+ /* Skip lines until we are at FROM. */
+ for (line_start = line_end = buffer; line_end < bufend && current_line < from; line_end++)
+ if (*line_end == '\n')
+ {
+ p = line_end + 1;
+ /* If we see something we think is a timestamp, continue with this
+ line. We should check more extensively here... */
+ if (HIST_TIMESTAMP_START(p) == 0)
+ current_line++;
+ line_start = p;
+ }
+
+ /* If there are lines left to gobble, then gobble them now. */
+ for (line_end = line_start; line_end < bufend; line_end++)
+ if (*line_end == '\n')
+ {
+ *line_end = '\0';
+
+ if (*line_start)
+ {
+ if (HIST_TIMESTAMP_START(line_start) == 0)
+ {
+ add_history (line_start);
+ if (last_ts)
+ {
+ add_history_time (last_ts);
+ last_ts = NULL;
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ last_ts = line_start;
+ current_line--;
+ }
+ }
+
+ current_line++;
+
+ if (current_line >= to)
+ break;
+
+ line_start = line_end + 1;
+ }
+
+ FREE (input);
+#ifndef HISTORY_USE_MMAP
+ FREE (buffer);
+#else
+ munmap (buffer, file_size);
+#endif
+
+ return (0);
+}
+
+/* Truncate the history file FNAME, leaving only LINES trailing lines.
+ If FNAME is NULL, then use ~/.history. Returns 0 on success, errno
+ on failure. */
+int
+history_truncate_file (fname, lines)
+ const char *fname;
+ int lines;
+{
+ char *buffer, *filename, *bp, *bp1; /* bp1 == bp+1 */
+ int file, chars_read, rv;
+ struct stat finfo;
+ size_t file_size;
+
+ buffer = (char *)NULL;
+ filename = history_filename (fname);
+ file = open (filename, O_RDONLY|O_BINARY, 0666);
+ rv = 0;
+
+ /* Don't try to truncate non-regular files. */
+ if (file == -1 || fstat (file, &finfo) == -1)
+ {
+ rv = errno;
+ if (file != -1)
+ close (file);
+ goto truncate_exit;
+ }
+
+ if (S_ISREG (finfo.st_mode) == 0)
+ {
+ close (file);
+#ifdef EFTYPE
+ rv = EFTYPE;
+#else
+ rv = EINVAL;
+#endif
+ goto truncate_exit;
+ }
+
+ file_size = (size_t)finfo.st_size;
+
+ /* check for overflow on very large files */
+ if (file_size != finfo.st_size || file_size + 1 < file_size)
+ {
+ close (file);
+#if defined (EFBIG)
+ rv = errno = EFBIG;
+#elif defined (EOVERFLOW)
+ rv = errno = EOVERFLOW;
+#else
+ rv = errno = EINVAL;
+#endif
+ goto truncate_exit;
+ }
+
+ buffer = (char *)malloc (file_size + 1);
+ if (buffer == 0)
+ {
+ close (file);
+ goto truncate_exit;
+ }
+
+ chars_read = read (file, buffer, file_size);
+ close (file);
+
+ if (chars_read <= 0)
+ {
+ rv = (chars_read < 0) ? errno : 0;
+ goto truncate_exit;
+ }
+
+ /* Count backwards from the end of buffer until we have passed
+ LINES lines. bp1 is set funny initially. But since bp[1] can't
+ be a comment character (since it's off the end) and *bp can't be
+ both a newline and the history comment character, it should be OK. */
+ for (bp1 = bp = buffer + chars_read - 1; lines && bp > buffer; bp--)
+ {
+ if (*bp == '\n' && HIST_TIMESTAMP_START(bp1) == 0)
+ lines--;
+ bp1 = bp;
+ }
+
+ /* If this is the first line, then the file contains exactly the
+ number of lines we want to truncate to, so we don't need to do
+ anything. It's the first line if we don't find a newline between
+ the current value of i and 0. Otherwise, write from the start of
+ this line until the end of the buffer. */
+ for ( ; bp > buffer; bp--)
+ {
+ if (*bp == '\n' && HIST_TIMESTAMP_START(bp1) == 0)
+ {
+ bp++;
+ break;
+ }
+ bp1 = bp;
+ }
+
+ /* Write only if there are more lines in the file than we want to
+ truncate to. */
+ if (bp > buffer && ((file = open (filename, O_WRONLY|O_TRUNC|O_BINARY, 0600)) != -1))
+ {
+ write (file, bp, chars_read - (bp - buffer));
+
+#if defined (__BEOS__)
+ /* BeOS ignores O_TRUNC. */
+ ftruncate (file, chars_read - (bp - buffer));
+#endif
+
+ close (file);
+ }
+
+ truncate_exit:
+
+ FREE (buffer);
+
+ free (filename);
+ return rv;
+}
+
+/* Workhorse function for writing history. Writes NELEMENT entries
+ from the history list to FILENAME. OVERWRITE is non-zero if you
+ wish to replace FILENAME with the entries. */
+static int
+history_do_write (filename, nelements, overwrite)
+ const char *filename;
+ int nelements, overwrite;
+{
+ register int i;
+ char *output;
+ int file, mode, rv;
+#ifdef HISTORY_USE_MMAP
+ size_t cursize;
+
+ mode = overwrite ? O_RDWR|O_CREAT|O_TRUNC|O_BINARY : O_RDWR|O_APPEND|O_BINARY;
+#else
+ mode = overwrite ? O_WRONLY|O_CREAT|O_TRUNC|O_BINARY : O_WRONLY|O_APPEND|O_BINARY;
+#endif
+ output = history_filename (filename);
+ rv = 0;
+
+ if ((file = open (output, mode, 0600)) == -1)
+ {
+ FREE (output);
+ return (errno);
+ }
+
+#ifdef HISTORY_USE_MMAP
+ cursize = overwrite ? 0 : lseek (file, 0, SEEK_END);
+#endif
+
+ if (nelements > history_length)
+ nelements = history_length;
+
+ /* Build a buffer of all the lines to write, and write them in one syscall.
+ Suggested by Peter Ho (peter@robosts.oxford.ac.uk). */
+ {
+ HIST_ENTRY **the_history; /* local */
+ register int j;
+ int buffer_size;
+ char *buffer;
+
+ the_history = history_list ();
+ /* Calculate the total number of bytes to write. */
+ for (buffer_size = 0, i = history_length - nelements; i < history_length; i++)
+#if 0
+ buffer_size += 2 + HISTENT_BYTES (the_history[i]);
+#else
+ {
+ if (history_write_timestamps && the_history[i]->timestamp && the_history[i]->timestamp[0])
+ buffer_size += strlen (the_history[i]->timestamp) + 1;
+ buffer_size += strlen (the_history[i]->line) + 1;
+ }
+#endif
+
+ /* Allocate the buffer, and fill it. */
+#ifdef HISTORY_USE_MMAP
+ if (ftruncate (file, buffer_size+cursize) == -1)
+ goto mmap_error;
+ buffer = (char *)mmap (0, buffer_size, PROT_READ|PROT_WRITE, MAP_WFLAGS, file, cursize);
+ if ((void *)buffer == MAP_FAILED)
+ {
+mmap_error:
+ rv = errno;
+ FREE (output);
+ close (file);
+ return rv;
+ }
+#else
+ buffer = (char *)malloc (buffer_size);
+ if (buffer == 0)
+ {
+ rv = errno;
+ FREE (output);
+ close (file);
+ return rv;
+ }
+#endif
+
+ for (j = 0, i = history_length - nelements; i < history_length; i++)
+ {
+ if (history_write_timestamps && the_history[i]->timestamp && the_history[i]->timestamp[0])
+ {
+ strcpy (buffer + j, the_history[i]->timestamp);
+ j += strlen (the_history[i]->timestamp);
+ buffer[j++] = '\n';
+ }
+ strcpy (buffer + j, the_history[i]->line);
+ j += strlen (the_history[i]->line);
+ buffer[j++] = '\n';
+ }
+
+#ifdef HISTORY_USE_MMAP
+ if (msync (buffer, buffer_size, 0) != 0 || munmap (buffer, buffer_size) != 0)
+ rv = errno;
+#else
+ if (write (file, buffer, buffer_size) < 0)
+ rv = errno;
+ free (buffer);
+#endif
+ }
+
+ close (file);
+
+ FREE (output);
+
+ return (rv);
+}
+
+/* Append NELEMENT entries to FILENAME. The entries appended are from
+ the end of the list minus NELEMENTs up to the end of the list. */
+int
+append_history (nelements, filename)
+ int nelements;
+ const char *filename;
+{
+ return (history_do_write (filename, nelements, HISTORY_APPEND));
+}
+
+/* Overwrite FILENAME with the current history. If FILENAME is NULL,
+ then write the history list to ~/.history. Values returned
+ are as in read_history ().*/
+int
+write_history (filename)
+ const char *filename;
+{
+ return (history_do_write (filename, history_length, HISTORY_OVERWRITE));
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/histlib.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/histlib.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c39af71
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/histlib.h
@@ -0,0 +1,82 @@
+/* histlib.h -- internal definitions for the history library. */
+/* Copyright (C) 1989, 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file contains the GNU History Library (the Library), a set of
+ routines for managing the text of previously typed lines.
+
+ The Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ The Library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
+ WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#if !defined (_HISTLIB_H_)
+#define _HISTLIB_H_
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STRING_H)
+# include <string.h>
+#else
+# include <strings.h>
+#endif /* !HAVE_STRING_H */
+
+#if !defined (STREQ)
+#define STREQ(a, b) (((a)[0] == (b)[0]) && (strcmp ((a), (b)) == 0))
+#define STREQN(a, b, n) (((n) == 0) ? (1) \
+ : ((a)[0] == (b)[0]) && (strncmp ((a), (b), (n)) == 0))
+#endif
+
+#ifndef savestring
+#define savestring(x) strcpy (xmalloc (1 + strlen (x)), (x))
+#endif
+
+#ifndef whitespace
+#define whitespace(c) (((c) == ' ') || ((c) == '\t'))
+#endif
+
+#ifndef _rl_digit_p
+#define _rl_digit_p(c) ((c) >= '0' && (c) <= '9')
+#endif
+
+#ifndef _rl_digit_value
+#define _rl_digit_value(c) ((c) - '0')
+#endif
+
+#ifndef member
+# ifndef strchr
+extern char *strchr ();
+# endif
+#define member(c, s) ((c) ? ((char *)strchr ((s), (c)) != (char *)NULL) : 0)
+#endif
+
+#ifndef FREE
+# define FREE(x) if (x) free (x)
+#endif
+
+/* Possible history errors passed to hist_error. */
+#define EVENT_NOT_FOUND 0
+#define BAD_WORD_SPEC 1
+#define SUBST_FAILED 2
+#define BAD_MODIFIER 3
+#define NO_PREV_SUBST 4
+
+/* Possible definitions for history starting point specification. */
+#define ANCHORED_SEARCH 1
+#define NON_ANCHORED_SEARCH 0
+
+/* Possible definitions for what style of writing the history file we want. */
+#define HISTORY_APPEND 0
+#define HISTORY_OVERWRITE 1
+
+/* Some variable definitions shared across history source files. */
+extern int history_offset;
+
+#endif /* !_HISTLIB_H_ */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/history.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/history.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..a538f91
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/history.c
@@ -0,0 +1,441 @@
+/* history.c -- standalone history library */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1989-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file contains the GNU History Library (the Library), a set of
+ routines for managing the text of previously typed lines.
+
+ The Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ The Library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
+ WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+/* The goal is to make the implementation transparent, so that you
+ don't have to know what data types are used, just what functions
+ you can call. I think I have done that. */
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STDLIB_H)
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif /* HAVE_STDLIB_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# ifdef _MINIX
+# include <sys/types.h>
+# endif
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "history.h"
+#include "histlib.h"
+
+#include "xmalloc.h"
+
+/* The number of slots to increase the_history by. */
+#define DEFAULT_HISTORY_GROW_SIZE 50
+
+static char *hist_inittime PARAMS((void));
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* History Functions */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* An array of HIST_ENTRY. This is where we store the history. */
+static HIST_ENTRY **the_history = (HIST_ENTRY **)NULL;
+
+/* Non-zero means that we have enforced a limit on the amount of
+ history that we save. */
+static int history_stifled;
+
+/* The current number of slots allocated to the input_history. */
+static int history_size;
+
+/* If HISTORY_STIFLED is non-zero, then this is the maximum number of
+ entries to remember. */
+int history_max_entries;
+int max_input_history; /* backwards compatibility */
+
+/* The current location of the interactive history pointer. Just makes
+ life easier for outside callers. */
+int history_offset;
+
+/* The number of strings currently stored in the history list. */
+int history_length;
+
+/* The logical `base' of the history array. It defaults to 1. */
+int history_base = 1;
+
+/* Return the current HISTORY_STATE of the history. */
+HISTORY_STATE *
+history_get_history_state ()
+{
+ HISTORY_STATE *state;
+
+ state = (HISTORY_STATE *)xmalloc (sizeof (HISTORY_STATE));
+ state->entries = the_history;
+ state->offset = history_offset;
+ state->length = history_length;
+ state->size = history_size;
+ state->flags = 0;
+ if (history_stifled)
+ state->flags |= HS_STIFLED;
+
+ return (state);
+}
+
+/* Set the state of the current history array to STATE. */
+void
+history_set_history_state (state)
+ HISTORY_STATE *state;
+{
+ the_history = state->entries;
+ history_offset = state->offset;
+ history_length = state->length;
+ history_size = state->size;
+ if (state->flags & HS_STIFLED)
+ history_stifled = 1;
+}
+
+/* Begin a session in which the history functions might be used. This
+ initializes interactive variables. */
+void
+using_history ()
+{
+ history_offset = history_length;
+}
+
+/* Return the number of bytes that the primary history entries are using.
+ This just adds up the lengths of the_history->lines and the associated
+ timestamps. */
+int
+history_total_bytes ()
+{
+ register int i, result;
+
+ for (i = result = 0; the_history && the_history[i]; i++)
+ result += HISTENT_BYTES (the_history[i]);
+
+ return (result);
+}
+
+/* Returns the magic number which says what history element we are
+ looking at now. In this implementation, it returns history_offset. */
+int
+where_history ()
+{
+ return (history_offset);
+}
+
+/* Make the current history item be the one at POS, an absolute index.
+ Returns zero if POS is out of range, else non-zero. */
+int
+history_set_pos (pos)
+ int pos;
+{
+ if (pos > history_length || pos < 0 || !the_history)
+ return (0);
+ history_offset = pos;
+ return (1);
+}
+
+/* Return the current history array. The caller has to be carefull, since this
+ is the actual array of data, and could be bashed or made corrupt easily.
+ The array is terminated with a NULL pointer. */
+HIST_ENTRY **
+history_list ()
+{
+ return (the_history);
+}
+
+/* Return the history entry at the current position, as determined by
+ history_offset. If there is no entry there, return a NULL pointer. */
+HIST_ENTRY *
+current_history ()
+{
+ return ((history_offset == history_length) || the_history == 0)
+ ? (HIST_ENTRY *)NULL
+ : the_history[history_offset];
+}
+
+/* Back up history_offset to the previous history entry, and return
+ a pointer to that entry. If there is no previous entry then return
+ a NULL pointer. */
+HIST_ENTRY *
+previous_history ()
+{
+ return history_offset ? the_history[--history_offset] : (HIST_ENTRY *)NULL;
+}
+
+/* Move history_offset forward to the next history entry, and return
+ a pointer to that entry. If there is no next entry then return a
+ NULL pointer. */
+HIST_ENTRY *
+next_history ()
+{
+ return (history_offset == history_length) ? (HIST_ENTRY *)NULL : the_history[++history_offset];
+}
+
+/* Return the history entry which is logically at OFFSET in the history array.
+ OFFSET is relative to history_base. */
+HIST_ENTRY *
+history_get (offset)
+ int offset;
+{
+ int local_index;
+
+ local_index = offset - history_base;
+ return (local_index >= history_length || local_index < 0 || the_history == 0)
+ ? (HIST_ENTRY *)NULL
+ : the_history[local_index];
+}
+
+time_t
+history_get_time (hist)
+ HIST_ENTRY *hist;
+{
+ char *ts;
+ time_t t;
+
+ if (hist == 0 || hist->timestamp == 0)
+ return 0;
+ ts = hist->timestamp;
+ if (ts[0] != history_comment_char)
+ return 0;
+ t = (time_t) atol (ts + 1); /* XXX - should use strtol() here */
+ return t;
+}
+
+static char *
+hist_inittime ()
+{
+ time_t t;
+ char ts[64], *ret;
+
+ t = (time_t) time ((time_t *)0);
+#if defined (HAVE_VSNPRINTF) /* assume snprintf if vsnprintf exists */
+ snprintf (ts, sizeof (ts) - 1, "X%lu", (unsigned long) t);
+#else
+ sprintf (ts, "X%lu", (unsigned long) t);
+#endif
+ ret = savestring (ts);
+ ret[0] = history_comment_char;
+
+ return ret;
+}
+
+/* Place STRING at the end of the history list. The data field
+ is set to NULL. */
+void
+add_history (string)
+ const char *string;
+{
+ HIST_ENTRY *temp;
+
+ if (history_stifled && (history_length == history_max_entries))
+ {
+ register int i;
+
+ /* If the history is stifled, and history_length is zero,
+ and it equals history_max_entries, we don't save items. */
+ if (history_length == 0)
+ return;
+
+ /* If there is something in the slot, then remove it. */
+ if (the_history[0])
+ (void) free_history_entry (the_history[0]);
+
+ /* Copy the rest of the entries, moving down one slot. */
+ for (i = 0; i < history_length; i++)
+ the_history[i] = the_history[i + 1];
+
+ history_base++;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if (history_size == 0)
+ {
+ history_size = DEFAULT_HISTORY_GROW_SIZE;
+ the_history = (HIST_ENTRY **)xmalloc (history_size * sizeof (HIST_ENTRY *));
+ history_length = 1;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if (history_length == (history_size - 1))
+ {
+ history_size += DEFAULT_HISTORY_GROW_SIZE;
+ the_history = (HIST_ENTRY **)
+ xrealloc (the_history, history_size * sizeof (HIST_ENTRY *));
+ }
+ history_length++;
+ }
+ }
+
+ temp = (HIST_ENTRY *)xmalloc (sizeof (HIST_ENTRY));
+ temp->line = savestring (string);
+ temp->data = (char *)NULL;
+
+ temp->timestamp = hist_inittime ();
+
+ the_history[history_length] = (HIST_ENTRY *)NULL;
+ the_history[history_length - 1] = temp;
+}
+
+/* Change the time stamp of the most recent history entry to STRING. */
+void
+add_history_time (string)
+ const char *string;
+{
+ HIST_ENTRY *hs;
+
+ hs = the_history[history_length - 1];
+ FREE (hs->timestamp);
+ hs->timestamp = savestring (string);
+}
+
+/* Free HIST and return the data so the calling application can free it
+ if necessary and desired. */
+histdata_t
+free_history_entry (hist)
+ HIST_ENTRY *hist;
+{
+ histdata_t x;
+
+ if (hist == 0)
+ return ((histdata_t) 0);
+ FREE (hist->line);
+ FREE (hist->timestamp);
+ x = hist->data;
+ free (hist);
+ return (x);
+}
+
+/* Make the history entry at WHICH have LINE and DATA. This returns
+ the old entry so you can dispose of the data. In the case of an
+ invalid WHICH, a NULL pointer is returned. */
+HIST_ENTRY *
+replace_history_entry (which, line, data)
+ int which;
+ const char *line;
+ histdata_t data;
+{
+ HIST_ENTRY *temp, *old_value;
+
+ if (which < 0 || which >= history_length)
+ return ((HIST_ENTRY *)NULL);
+
+ temp = (HIST_ENTRY *)xmalloc (sizeof (HIST_ENTRY));
+ old_value = the_history[which];
+
+ temp->line = savestring (line);
+ temp->data = data;
+ temp->timestamp = savestring (old_value->timestamp);
+ the_history[which] = temp;
+
+ return (old_value);
+}
+
+/* Remove history element WHICH from the history. The removed
+ element is returned to you so you can free the line, data,
+ and containing structure. */
+HIST_ENTRY *
+remove_history (which)
+ int which;
+{
+ HIST_ENTRY *return_value;
+ register int i;
+
+ if (which < 0 || which >= history_length || history_length == 0 || the_history == 0)
+ return ((HIST_ENTRY *)NULL);
+
+ return_value = the_history[which];
+
+ for (i = which; i < history_length; i++)
+ the_history[i] = the_history[i + 1];
+
+ history_length--;
+
+ return (return_value);
+}
+
+/* Stifle the history list, remembering only MAX number of lines. */
+void
+stifle_history (max)
+ int max;
+{
+ register int i, j;
+
+ if (max < 0)
+ max = 0;
+
+ if (history_length > max)
+ {
+ /* This loses because we cannot free the data. */
+ for (i = 0, j = history_length - max; i < j; i++)
+ free_history_entry (the_history[i]);
+
+ history_base = i;
+ for (j = 0, i = history_length - max; j < max; i++, j++)
+ the_history[j] = the_history[i];
+ the_history[j] = (HIST_ENTRY *)NULL;
+ history_length = j;
+ }
+
+ history_stifled = 1;
+ max_input_history = history_max_entries = max;
+}
+
+/* Stop stifling the history. This returns the previous maximum
+ number of history entries. The value is positive if the history
+ was stifled, negative if it wasn't. */
+int
+unstifle_history ()
+{
+ if (history_stifled)
+ {
+ history_stifled = 0;
+ return (history_max_entries);
+ }
+ else
+ return (-history_max_entries);
+}
+
+int
+history_is_stifled ()
+{
+ return (history_stifled);
+}
+
+void
+clear_history ()
+{
+ register int i;
+
+ /* This loses because we cannot free the data. */
+ for (i = 0; i < history_length; i++)
+ {
+ free_history_entry (the_history[i]);
+ the_history[i] = (HIST_ENTRY *)NULL;
+ }
+
+ history_offset = history_length = 0;
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/history.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/history.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..14ca2a9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/history.h
@@ -0,0 +1,266 @@
+/* history.h -- the names of functions that you can call in history. */
+/* Copyright (C) 1989-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file contains the GNU History Library (the Library), a set of
+ routines for managing the text of previously typed lines.
+
+ The Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ The Library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
+ WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#ifndef _HISTORY_H_
+#define _HISTORY_H_
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+extern "C" {
+#endif
+
+#include <time.h> /* XXX - for history timestamp code */
+
+#if defined READLINE_LIBRARY
+# include "rlstdc.h"
+# include "rltypedefs.h"
+#else
+# include <readline/rlstdc.h>
+# include <readline/rltypedefs.h>
+#endif
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+typedef void *histdata_t;
+#else
+typedef char *histdata_t;
+#endif
+
+/* The structure used to store a history entry. */
+typedef struct _hist_entry {
+ char *line;
+ char *timestamp; /* char * rather than time_t for read/write */
+ histdata_t data;
+} HIST_ENTRY;
+
+/* Size of the history-library-managed space in history entry HS. */
+#define HISTENT_BYTES(hs) (strlen ((hs)->line) + strlen ((hs)->timestamp))
+
+/* A structure used to pass the current state of the history stuff around. */
+typedef struct _hist_state {
+ HIST_ENTRY **entries; /* Pointer to the entries themselves. */
+ int offset; /* The location pointer within this array. */
+ int length; /* Number of elements within this array. */
+ int size; /* Number of slots allocated to this array. */
+ int flags;
+} HISTORY_STATE;
+
+/* Flag values for the `flags' member of HISTORY_STATE. */
+#define HS_STIFLED 0x01
+
+/* Initialization and state management. */
+
+/* Begin a session in which the history functions might be used. This
+ just initializes the interactive variables. */
+extern void using_history PARAMS((void));
+
+/* Return the current HISTORY_STATE of the history. */
+extern HISTORY_STATE *history_get_history_state PARAMS((void));
+
+/* Set the state of the current history array to STATE. */
+extern void history_set_history_state PARAMS((HISTORY_STATE *));
+
+/* Manage the history list. */
+
+/* Place STRING at the end of the history list.
+ The associated data field (if any) is set to NULL. */
+extern void add_history PARAMS((const char *));
+
+/* Change the timestamp associated with the most recent history entry to
+ STRING. */
+extern void add_history_time PARAMS((const char *));
+
+/* A reasonably useless function, only here for completeness. WHICH
+ is the magic number that tells us which element to delete. The
+ elements are numbered from 0. */
+extern HIST_ENTRY *remove_history PARAMS((int));
+
+/* Free the history entry H and return any application-specific data
+ associated with it. */
+extern histdata_t free_history_entry PARAMS((HIST_ENTRY *));
+
+/* Make the history entry at WHICH have LINE and DATA. This returns
+ the old entry so you can dispose of the data. In the case of an
+ invalid WHICH, a NULL pointer is returned. */
+extern HIST_ENTRY *replace_history_entry PARAMS((int, const char *, histdata_t));
+
+/* Clear the history list and start over. */
+extern void clear_history PARAMS((void));
+
+/* Stifle the history list, remembering only MAX number of entries. */
+extern void stifle_history PARAMS((int));
+
+/* Stop stifling the history. This returns the previous amount the
+ history was stifled by. The value is positive if the history was
+ stifled, negative if it wasn't. */
+extern int unstifle_history PARAMS((void));
+
+/* Return 1 if the history is stifled, 0 if it is not. */
+extern int history_is_stifled PARAMS((void));
+
+/* Information about the history list. */
+
+/* Return a NULL terminated array of HIST_ENTRY which is the current input
+ history. Element 0 of this list is the beginning of time. If there
+ is no history, return NULL. */
+extern HIST_ENTRY **history_list PARAMS((void));
+
+/* Returns the number which says what history element we are now
+ looking at. */
+extern int where_history PARAMS((void));
+
+/* Return the history entry at the current position, as determined by
+ history_offset. If there is no entry there, return a NULL pointer. */
+extern HIST_ENTRY *current_history PARAMS((void));
+
+/* Return the history entry which is logically at OFFSET in the history
+ array. OFFSET is relative to history_base. */
+extern HIST_ENTRY *history_get PARAMS((int));
+
+/* Return the timestamp associated with the HIST_ENTRY * passed as an
+ argument */
+extern time_t history_get_time PARAMS((HIST_ENTRY *));
+
+/* Return the number of bytes that the primary history entries are using.
+ This just adds up the lengths of the_history->lines. */
+extern int history_total_bytes PARAMS((void));
+
+/* Moving around the history list. */
+
+/* Set the position in the history list to POS. */
+extern int history_set_pos PARAMS((int));
+
+/* Back up history_offset to the previous history entry, and return
+ a pointer to that entry. If there is no previous entry, return
+ a NULL pointer. */
+extern HIST_ENTRY *previous_history PARAMS((void));
+
+/* Move history_offset forward to the next item in the input_history,
+ and return the a pointer to that entry. If there is no next entry,
+ return a NULL pointer. */
+extern HIST_ENTRY *next_history PARAMS((void));
+
+/* Searching the history list. */
+
+/* Search the history for STRING, starting at history_offset.
+ If DIRECTION < 0, then the search is through previous entries,
+ else through subsequent. If the string is found, then
+ current_history () is the history entry, and the value of this function
+ is the offset in the line of that history entry that the string was
+ found in. Otherwise, nothing is changed, and a -1 is returned. */
+extern int history_search PARAMS((const char *, int));
+
+/* Search the history for STRING, starting at history_offset.
+ The search is anchored: matching lines must begin with string.
+ DIRECTION is as in history_search(). */
+extern int history_search_prefix PARAMS((const char *, int));
+
+/* Search for STRING in the history list, starting at POS, an
+ absolute index into the list. DIR, if negative, says to search
+ backwards from POS, else forwards.
+ Returns the absolute index of the history element where STRING
+ was found, or -1 otherwise. */
+extern int history_search_pos PARAMS((const char *, int, int));
+
+/* Managing the history file. */
+
+/* Add the contents of FILENAME to the history list, a line at a time.
+ If FILENAME is NULL, then read from ~/.history. Returns 0 if
+ successful, or errno if not. */
+extern int read_history PARAMS((const char *));
+
+/* Read a range of lines from FILENAME, adding them to the history list.
+ Start reading at the FROM'th line and end at the TO'th. If FROM
+ is zero, start at the beginning. If TO is less than FROM, read
+ until the end of the file. If FILENAME is NULL, then read from
+ ~/.history. Returns 0 if successful, or errno if not. */
+extern int read_history_range PARAMS((const char *, int, int));
+
+/* Write the current history to FILENAME. If FILENAME is NULL,
+ then write the history list to ~/.history. Values returned
+ are as in read_history (). */
+extern int write_history PARAMS((const char *));
+
+/* Append NELEMENT entries to FILENAME. The entries appended are from
+ the end of the list minus NELEMENTs up to the end of the list. */
+extern int append_history PARAMS((int, const char *));
+
+/* Truncate the history file, leaving only the last NLINES lines. */
+extern int history_truncate_file PARAMS((const char *, int));
+
+/* History expansion. */
+
+/* Expand the string STRING, placing the result into OUTPUT, a pointer
+ to a string. Returns:
+
+ 0) If no expansions took place (or, if the only change in
+ the text was the de-slashifying of the history expansion
+ character)
+ 1) If expansions did take place
+ -1) If there was an error in expansion.
+ 2) If the returned line should just be printed.
+
+ If an error ocurred in expansion, then OUTPUT contains a descriptive
+ error message. */
+extern int history_expand PARAMS((char *, char **));
+
+/* Extract a string segment consisting of the FIRST through LAST
+ arguments present in STRING. Arguments are broken up as in
+ the shell. */
+extern char *history_arg_extract PARAMS((int, int, const char *));
+
+/* Return the text of the history event beginning at the current
+ offset into STRING. Pass STRING with *INDEX equal to the
+ history_expansion_char that begins this specification.
+ DELIMITING_QUOTE is a character that is allowed to end the string
+ specification for what to search for in addition to the normal
+ characters `:', ` ', `\t', `\n', and sometimes `?'. */
+extern char *get_history_event PARAMS((const char *, int *, int));
+
+/* Return an array of tokens, much as the shell might. The tokens are
+ parsed out of STRING. */
+extern char **history_tokenize PARAMS((const char *));
+
+/* Exported history variables. */
+extern int history_base;
+extern int history_length;
+extern int history_max_entries;
+extern char history_expansion_char;
+extern char history_subst_char;
+extern char *history_word_delimiters;
+extern char history_comment_char;
+extern char *history_no_expand_chars;
+extern char *history_search_delimiter_chars;
+extern int history_quotes_inhibit_expansion;
+
+extern int history_write_timestamps;
+
+/* Backwards compatibility */
+extern int max_input_history;
+
+/* If set, this function is called to decide whether or not a particular
+ history expansion should be treated as a special case for the calling
+ application and not expanded. */
+extern rl_linebuf_func_t *history_inhibit_expansion_function;
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+}
+#endif
+
+#endif /* !_HISTORY_H_ */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/histsearch.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/histsearch.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1cc5875
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/histsearch.c
@@ -0,0 +1,195 @@
+/* histsearch.c -- searching the history list. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1989, 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file contains the GNU History Library (the Library), a set of
+ routines for managing the text of previously typed lines.
+
+ The Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ The Library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
+ WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#if defined (HAVE_STDLIB_H)
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif /* HAVE_STDLIB_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# ifdef _MINIX
+# include <sys/types.h>
+# endif
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "history.h"
+#include "histlib.h"
+
+/* The list of alternate characters that can delimit a history search
+ string. */
+char *history_search_delimiter_chars = (char *)NULL;
+
+static int history_search_internal PARAMS((const char *, int, int));
+
+/* Search the history for STRING, starting at history_offset.
+ If DIRECTION < 0, then the search is through previous entries, else
+ through subsequent. If ANCHORED is non-zero, the string must
+ appear at the beginning of a history line, otherwise, the string
+ may appear anywhere in the line. If the string is found, then
+ current_history () is the history entry, and the value of this
+ function is the offset in the line of that history entry that the
+ string was found in. Otherwise, nothing is changed, and a -1 is
+ returned. */
+
+static int
+history_search_internal (string, direction, anchored)
+ const char *string;
+ int direction, anchored;
+{
+ register int i, reverse;
+ register char *line;
+ register int line_index;
+ int string_len;
+ HIST_ENTRY **the_history; /* local */
+
+ i = history_offset;
+ reverse = (direction < 0);
+
+ /* Take care of trivial cases first. */
+ if (string == 0 || *string == '\0')
+ return (-1);
+
+ if (!history_length || ((i >= history_length) && !reverse))
+ return (-1);
+
+ if (reverse && (i >= history_length))
+ i = history_length - 1;
+
+#define NEXT_LINE() do { if (reverse) i--; else i++; } while (0)
+
+ the_history = history_list ();
+ string_len = strlen (string);
+ while (1)
+ {
+ /* Search each line in the history list for STRING. */
+
+ /* At limit for direction? */
+ if ((reverse && i < 0) || (!reverse && i == history_length))
+ return (-1);
+
+ line = the_history[i]->line;
+ line_index = strlen (line);
+
+ /* If STRING is longer than line, no match. */
+ if (string_len > line_index)
+ {
+ NEXT_LINE ();
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /* Handle anchored searches first. */
+ if (anchored == ANCHORED_SEARCH)
+ {
+ if (STREQN (string, line, string_len))
+ {
+ history_offset = i;
+ return (0);
+ }
+
+ NEXT_LINE ();
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /* Do substring search. */
+ if (reverse)
+ {
+ line_index -= string_len;
+
+ while (line_index >= 0)
+ {
+ if (STREQN (string, line + line_index, string_len))
+ {
+ history_offset = i;
+ return (line_index);
+ }
+ line_index--;
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ register int limit;
+
+ limit = line_index - string_len + 1;
+ line_index = 0;
+
+ while (line_index < limit)
+ {
+ if (STREQN (string, line + line_index, string_len))
+ {
+ history_offset = i;
+ return (line_index);
+ }
+ line_index++;
+ }
+ }
+ NEXT_LINE ();
+ }
+}
+
+/* Do a non-anchored search for STRING through the history in DIRECTION. */
+int
+history_search (string, direction)
+ const char *string;
+ int direction;
+{
+ return (history_search_internal (string, direction, NON_ANCHORED_SEARCH));
+}
+
+/* Do an anchored search for string through the history in DIRECTION. */
+int
+history_search_prefix (string, direction)
+ const char *string;
+ int direction;
+{
+ return (history_search_internal (string, direction, ANCHORED_SEARCH));
+}
+
+/* Search for STRING in the history list. DIR is < 0 for searching
+ backwards. POS is an absolute index into the history list at
+ which point to begin searching. */
+int
+history_search_pos (string, dir, pos)
+ const char *string;
+ int dir, pos;
+{
+ int ret, old;
+
+ old = where_history ();
+ history_set_pos (pos);
+ if (history_search (string, dir) == -1)
+ {
+ history_set_pos (old);
+ return (-1);
+ }
+ ret = where_history ();
+ history_set_pos (old);
+ return ret;
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/input.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/input.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..0ec507e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/input.c
@@ -0,0 +1,570 @@
+/* input.c -- character input functions for readline. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1994-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#if defined (__TANDEM)
+# include <floss.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#if defined (HAVE_SYS_FILE_H)
+# include <sys/file.h>
+#endif /* HAVE_SYS_FILE_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif /* HAVE_UNISTD_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STDLIB_H)
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif /* HAVE_STDLIB_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_SELECT)
+# if !defined (HAVE_SYS_SELECT_H) || !defined (M_UNIX)
+# include <sys/time.h>
+# endif
+#endif /* HAVE_SELECT */
+#if defined (HAVE_SYS_SELECT_H)
+# include <sys/select.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (FIONREAD_IN_SYS_IOCTL)
+# include <sys/ioctl.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+
+#if !defined (errno)
+extern int errno;
+#endif /* !errno */
+
+/* System-specific feature definitions and include files. */
+#include "rldefs.h"
+#include "rlmbutil.h"
+
+/* Some standard library routines. */
+#include "readline.h"
+
+#include "rlprivate.h"
+#include "rlshell.h"
+#include "xmalloc.h"
+
+/* What kind of non-blocking I/O do we have? */
+#if !defined (O_NDELAY) && defined (O_NONBLOCK)
+# define O_NDELAY O_NONBLOCK /* Posix style */
+#endif
+
+/* Non-null means it is a pointer to a function to run while waiting for
+ character input. */
+rl_hook_func_t *rl_event_hook = (rl_hook_func_t *)NULL;
+
+rl_getc_func_t *rl_getc_function = rl_getc;
+
+static int _keyboard_input_timeout = 100000; /* 0.1 seconds; it's in usec */
+
+static int ibuffer_space PARAMS((void));
+static int rl_get_char PARAMS((int *));
+static int rl_gather_tyi PARAMS((void));
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Character Input Buffering */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+static int pop_index, push_index;
+static unsigned char ibuffer[512];
+static int ibuffer_len = sizeof (ibuffer) - 1;
+
+#define any_typein (push_index != pop_index)
+
+int
+_rl_any_typein ()
+{
+ return any_typein;
+}
+
+/* Return the amount of space available in the buffer for stuffing
+ characters. */
+static int
+ibuffer_space ()
+{
+ if (pop_index > push_index)
+ return (pop_index - push_index - 1);
+ else
+ return (ibuffer_len - (push_index - pop_index));
+}
+
+/* Get a key from the buffer of characters to be read.
+ Return the key in KEY.
+ Result is KEY if there was a key, or 0 if there wasn't. */
+static int
+rl_get_char (key)
+ int *key;
+{
+ if (push_index == pop_index)
+ return (0);
+
+ *key = ibuffer[pop_index++];
+
+ if (pop_index >= ibuffer_len)
+ pop_index = 0;
+
+ return (1);
+}
+
+/* Stuff KEY into the *front* of the input buffer.
+ Returns non-zero if successful, zero if there is
+ no space left in the buffer. */
+int
+_rl_unget_char (key)
+ int key;
+{
+ if (ibuffer_space ())
+ {
+ pop_index--;
+ if (pop_index < 0)
+ pop_index = ibuffer_len - 1;
+ ibuffer[pop_index] = key;
+ return (1);
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+
+int
+_rl_pushed_input_available ()
+{
+ return (push_index != pop_index);
+}
+
+/* If a character is available to be read, then read it and stuff it into
+ IBUFFER. Otherwise, just return. Returns number of characters read
+ (0 if none available) and -1 on error (EIO). */
+static int
+rl_gather_tyi ()
+{
+ int tty;
+ register int tem, result;
+ int chars_avail, k;
+ char input;
+#if defined(HAVE_SELECT)
+ fd_set readfds, exceptfds;
+ struct timeval timeout;
+#endif
+
+ tty = fileno (rl_instream);
+
+#if defined (HAVE_SELECT)
+ FD_ZERO (&readfds);
+ FD_ZERO (&exceptfds);
+ FD_SET (tty, &readfds);
+ FD_SET (tty, &exceptfds);
+ timeout.tv_sec = 0;
+ timeout.tv_usec = _keyboard_input_timeout;
+ result = select (tty + 1, &readfds, (fd_set *)NULL, &exceptfds, &timeout);
+ if (result <= 0)
+ return 0; /* Nothing to read. */
+#endif
+
+ result = -1;
+#if defined (FIONREAD)
+ errno = 0;
+ result = ioctl (tty, FIONREAD, &chars_avail);
+ if (result == -1 && errno == EIO)
+ return -1;
+#endif
+
+#if defined (O_NDELAY)
+ if (result == -1)
+ {
+ tem = fcntl (tty, F_GETFL, 0);
+
+ fcntl (tty, F_SETFL, (tem | O_NDELAY));
+ chars_avail = read (tty, &input, 1);
+
+ fcntl (tty, F_SETFL, tem);
+ if (chars_avail == -1 && errno == EAGAIN)
+ return 0;
+ if (chars_avail == 0) /* EOF */
+ {
+ rl_stuff_char (EOF);
+ return (0);
+ }
+ }
+#endif /* O_NDELAY */
+
+ /* If there's nothing available, don't waste time trying to read
+ something. */
+ if (chars_avail <= 0)
+ return 0;
+
+ tem = ibuffer_space ();
+
+ if (chars_avail > tem)
+ chars_avail = tem;
+
+ /* One cannot read all of the available input. I can only read a single
+ character at a time, or else programs which require input can be
+ thwarted. If the buffer is larger than one character, I lose.
+ Damn! */
+ if (tem < ibuffer_len)
+ chars_avail = 0;
+
+ if (result != -1)
+ {
+ while (chars_avail--)
+ {
+ k = (*rl_getc_function) (rl_instream);
+ rl_stuff_char (k);
+ if (k == NEWLINE || k == RETURN)
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if (chars_avail)
+ rl_stuff_char (input);
+ }
+
+ return 1;
+}
+
+int
+rl_set_keyboard_input_timeout (u)
+ int u;
+{
+ int o;
+
+ o = _keyboard_input_timeout;
+ if (u > 0)
+ _keyboard_input_timeout = u;
+ return (o);
+}
+
+/* Is there input available to be read on the readline input file
+ descriptor? Only works if the system has select(2) or FIONREAD.
+ Uses the value of _keyboard_input_timeout as the timeout; if another
+ readline function wants to specify a timeout and not leave it up to
+ the user, it should use _rl_input_queued(timeout_value_in_microseconds)
+ instead. */
+int
+_rl_input_available ()
+{
+#if defined(HAVE_SELECT)
+ fd_set readfds, exceptfds;
+ struct timeval timeout;
+#endif
+#if !defined (HAVE_SELECT) && defined(FIONREAD)
+ int chars_avail;
+#endif
+ int tty;
+
+ tty = fileno (rl_instream);
+
+#if defined (HAVE_SELECT)
+ FD_ZERO (&readfds);
+ FD_ZERO (&exceptfds);
+ FD_SET (tty, &readfds);
+ FD_SET (tty, &exceptfds);
+ timeout.tv_sec = 0;
+ timeout.tv_usec = _keyboard_input_timeout;
+ return (select (tty + 1, &readfds, (fd_set *)NULL, &exceptfds, &timeout) > 0);
+#else
+
+#if defined (FIONREAD)
+ if (ioctl (tty, FIONREAD, &chars_avail) == 0)
+ return (chars_avail);
+#endif
+
+#endif
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+int
+_rl_input_queued (t)
+ int t;
+{
+ int old_timeout, r;
+
+ old_timeout = rl_set_keyboard_input_timeout (t);
+ r = _rl_input_available ();
+ rl_set_keyboard_input_timeout (old_timeout);
+ return r;
+}
+
+void
+_rl_insert_typein (c)
+ int c;
+{
+ int key, t, i;
+ char *string;
+
+ i = key = 0;
+ string = (char *)xmalloc (ibuffer_len + 1);
+ string[i++] = (char) c;
+
+ while ((t = rl_get_char (&key)) &&
+ _rl_keymap[key].type == ISFUNC &&
+ _rl_keymap[key].function == rl_insert)
+ string[i++] = key;
+
+ if (t)
+ _rl_unget_char (key);
+
+ string[i] = '\0';
+ rl_insert_text (string);
+ free (string);
+}
+
+/* Add KEY to the buffer of characters to be read. Returns 1 if the
+ character was stuffed correctly; 0 otherwise. */
+int
+rl_stuff_char (key)
+ int key;
+{
+ if (ibuffer_space () == 0)
+ return 0;
+
+ if (key == EOF)
+ {
+ key = NEWLINE;
+ rl_pending_input = EOF;
+ RL_SETSTATE (RL_STATE_INPUTPENDING);
+ }
+ ibuffer[push_index++] = key;
+ if (push_index >= ibuffer_len)
+ push_index = 0;
+
+ return 1;
+}
+
+/* Make C be the next command to be executed. */
+int
+rl_execute_next (c)
+ int c;
+{
+ rl_pending_input = c;
+ RL_SETSTATE (RL_STATE_INPUTPENDING);
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Clear any pending input pushed with rl_execute_next() */
+int
+rl_clear_pending_input ()
+{
+ rl_pending_input = 0;
+ RL_UNSETSTATE (RL_STATE_INPUTPENDING);
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Character Input */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* Read a key, including pending input. */
+int
+rl_read_key ()
+{
+ int c;
+
+ rl_key_sequence_length++;
+
+ if (rl_pending_input)
+ {
+ c = rl_pending_input;
+ rl_clear_pending_input ();
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* If input is coming from a macro, then use that. */
+ if (c = _rl_next_macro_key ())
+ return (c);
+
+ /* If the user has an event function, then call it periodically. */
+ if (rl_event_hook)
+ {
+ while (rl_event_hook && rl_get_char (&c) == 0)
+ {
+ (*rl_event_hook) ();
+ if (rl_done) /* XXX - experimental */
+ return ('\n');
+ if (rl_gather_tyi () < 0) /* XXX - EIO */
+ {
+ rl_done = 1;
+ return ('\n');
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if (rl_get_char (&c) == 0)
+ c = (*rl_getc_function) (rl_instream);
+ }
+ }
+
+ return (c);
+}
+
+int
+rl_getc (stream)
+ FILE *stream;
+{
+ int result;
+ unsigned char c;
+
+ while (1)
+ {
+#if defined (__MINGW32__)
+ if (isatty (fileno (stream)))
+ return (getch ());
+#endif
+ result = read (fileno (stream), &c, sizeof (unsigned char));
+
+ if (result == sizeof (unsigned char))
+ return (c);
+
+ /* If zero characters are returned, then the file that we are
+ reading from is empty! Return EOF in that case. */
+ if (result == 0)
+ return (EOF);
+
+#if defined (__BEOS__)
+ if (errno == EINTR)
+ continue;
+#endif
+
+#if defined (EWOULDBLOCK)
+# define X_EWOULDBLOCK EWOULDBLOCK
+#else
+# define X_EWOULDBLOCK -99
+#endif
+
+#if defined (EAGAIN)
+# define X_EAGAIN EAGAIN
+#else
+# define X_EAGAIN -99
+#endif
+
+ if (errno == X_EWOULDBLOCK || errno == X_EAGAIN)
+ {
+ if (sh_unset_nodelay_mode (fileno (stream)) < 0)
+ return (EOF);
+ continue;
+ }
+
+#undef X_EWOULDBLOCK
+#undef X_EAGAIN
+
+ /* If the error that we received was SIGINT, then try again,
+ this is simply an interrupted system call to read ().
+ Otherwise, some error ocurred, also signifying EOF. */
+ if (errno != EINTR)
+ return (EOF);
+ }
+}
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+/* read multibyte char */
+int
+_rl_read_mbchar (mbchar, size)
+ char *mbchar;
+ int size;
+{
+ int mb_len = 0;
+ size_t mbchar_bytes_length;
+ wchar_t wc;
+ mbstate_t ps, ps_back;
+
+ memset(&ps, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+ memset(&ps_back, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+
+ while (mb_len < size)
+ {
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+ mbchar[mb_len++] = rl_read_key ();
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+
+ mbchar_bytes_length = mbrtowc (&wc, mbchar, mb_len, &ps);
+ if (mbchar_bytes_length == (size_t)(-1))
+ break; /* invalid byte sequence for the current locale */
+ else if (mbchar_bytes_length == (size_t)(-2))
+ {
+ /* shorted bytes */
+ ps = ps_back;
+ continue;
+ }
+ else if (mbchar_bytes_length == 0)
+ {
+ mbchar[0] = '\0'; /* null wide character */
+ mb_len = 1;
+ break;
+ }
+ else if (mbchar_bytes_length > (size_t)(0))
+ break;
+ }
+
+ return mb_len;
+}
+
+/* Read a multibyte-character string whose first character is FIRST into
+ the buffer MB of length MBLEN. Returns the last character read, which
+ may be FIRST. Used by the search functions, among others. Very similar
+ to _rl_read_mbchar. */
+int
+_rl_read_mbstring (first, mb, mblen)
+ int first;
+ char *mb;
+ int mblen;
+{
+ int i, c;
+ mbstate_t ps;
+
+ c = first;
+ memset (mb, 0, mblen);
+ for (i = 0; i < mblen; i++)
+ {
+ mb[i] = (char)c;
+ memset (&ps, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+ if (_rl_get_char_len (mb, &ps) == -2)
+ {
+ /* Read more for multibyte character */
+ RL_SETSTATE (RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+ c = rl_read_key ();
+ RL_UNSETSTATE (RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+ }
+ else
+ break;
+ }
+ return c;
+}
+#endif /* HANDLE_MULTIBYTE */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/isearch.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/isearch.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d7d8520
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/isearch.c
@@ -0,0 +1,666 @@
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* I-Search and Searching */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1987-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file contains the Readline Library (the Library), a set of
+ routines for providing Emacs style line input to programs that ask
+ for it.
+
+ The Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ The Library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
+ WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STDLIB_H)
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif
+
+#include "rldefs.h"
+#include "rlmbutil.h"
+
+#include "readline.h"
+#include "history.h"
+
+#include "rlprivate.h"
+#include "xmalloc.h"
+
+/* Variables exported to other files in the readline library. */
+char *_rl_isearch_terminators = (char *)NULL;
+
+_rl_search_cxt *_rl_iscxt = 0;
+
+/* Variables imported from other files in the readline library. */
+extern HIST_ENTRY *_rl_saved_line_for_history;
+
+static int rl_search_history PARAMS((int, int));
+
+static _rl_search_cxt *_rl_isearch_init PARAMS((int));
+static void _rl_isearch_fini PARAMS((_rl_search_cxt *));
+static int _rl_isearch_cleanup PARAMS((_rl_search_cxt *, int));
+
+/* Last line found by the current incremental search, so we don't `find'
+ identical lines many times in a row. */
+static char *prev_line_found;
+
+/* Last search string and its length. */
+static char *last_isearch_string;
+static int last_isearch_string_len;
+
+static char *default_isearch_terminators = "\033\012";
+
+_rl_search_cxt *
+_rl_scxt_alloc (type, flags)
+ int type, flags;
+{
+ _rl_search_cxt *cxt;
+
+ cxt = (_rl_search_cxt *)xmalloc (sizeof (_rl_search_cxt));
+
+ cxt->type = type;
+ cxt->sflags = flags;
+
+ cxt->search_string = 0;
+ cxt->search_string_size = cxt->search_string_index = 0;
+
+ cxt->lines = 0;
+ cxt->allocated_line = 0;
+ cxt->hlen = cxt->hindex = 0;
+
+ cxt->save_point = rl_point;
+ cxt->save_mark = rl_mark;
+ cxt->save_line = where_history ();
+ cxt->last_found_line = cxt->save_line;
+ cxt->prev_line_found = 0;
+
+ cxt->save_undo_list = 0;
+
+ cxt->history_pos = 0;
+ cxt->direction = 0;
+
+ cxt->lastc = 0;
+
+ cxt->sline = 0;
+ cxt->sline_len = cxt->sline_index = 0;
+
+ cxt->search_terminators = 0;
+
+ return cxt;
+}
+
+void
+_rl_scxt_dispose (cxt, flags)
+ _rl_search_cxt *cxt;
+ int flags;
+{
+ FREE (cxt->search_string);
+ FREE (cxt->allocated_line);
+ FREE (cxt->lines);
+
+ free (cxt);
+}
+
+/* Search backwards through the history looking for a string which is typed
+ interactively. Start with the current line. */
+int
+rl_reverse_search_history (sign, key)
+ int sign, key;
+{
+ return (rl_search_history (-sign, key));
+}
+
+/* Search forwards through the history looking for a string which is typed
+ interactively. Start with the current line. */
+int
+rl_forward_search_history (sign, key)
+ int sign, key;
+{
+ return (rl_search_history (sign, key));
+}
+
+/* Display the current state of the search in the echo-area.
+ SEARCH_STRING contains the string that is being searched for,
+ DIRECTION is zero for forward, or non-zero for reverse,
+ WHERE is the history list number of the current line. If it is
+ -1, then this line is the starting one. */
+static void
+rl_display_search (search_string, reverse_p, where)
+ char *search_string;
+ int reverse_p, where;
+{
+ char *message;
+ int msglen, searchlen;
+
+ searchlen = (search_string && *search_string) ? strlen (search_string) : 0;
+
+ message = (char *)xmalloc (searchlen + 33);
+ msglen = 0;
+
+#if defined (NOTDEF)
+ if (where != -1)
+ {
+ sprintf (message, "[%d]", where + history_base);
+ msglen = strlen (message);
+ }
+#endif /* NOTDEF */
+
+ message[msglen++] = '(';
+
+ if (reverse_p)
+ {
+ strcpy (message + msglen, "reverse-");
+ msglen += 8;
+ }
+
+ strcpy (message + msglen, "i-search)`");
+ msglen += 10;
+
+ if (search_string)
+ {
+ strcpy (message + msglen, search_string);
+ msglen += searchlen;
+ }
+
+ strcpy (message + msglen, "': ");
+
+ rl_message ("%s", message);
+ free (message);
+ (*rl_redisplay_function) ();
+}
+
+static _rl_search_cxt *
+_rl_isearch_init (direction)
+ int direction;
+{
+ _rl_search_cxt *cxt;
+ register int i;
+ HIST_ENTRY **hlist;
+
+ cxt = _rl_scxt_alloc (RL_SEARCH_ISEARCH, 0);
+ if (direction < 0)
+ cxt->sflags |= SF_REVERSE;
+
+ cxt->search_terminators = _rl_isearch_terminators ? _rl_isearch_terminators
+ : default_isearch_terminators;
+
+ /* Create an arrary of pointers to the lines that we want to search. */
+ hlist = history_list ();
+ rl_maybe_replace_line ();
+ i = 0;
+ if (hlist)
+ for (i = 0; hlist[i]; i++);
+
+ /* Allocate space for this many lines, +1 for the current input line,
+ and remember those lines. */
+ cxt->lines = (char **)xmalloc ((1 + (cxt->hlen = i)) * sizeof (char *));
+ for (i = 0; i < cxt->hlen; i++)
+ cxt->lines[i] = hlist[i]->line;
+
+ if (_rl_saved_line_for_history)
+ cxt->lines[i] = _rl_saved_line_for_history->line;
+ else
+ {
+ /* Keep track of this so we can free it. */
+ cxt->allocated_line = (char *)xmalloc (1 + strlen (rl_line_buffer));
+ strcpy (cxt->allocated_line, &rl_line_buffer[0]);
+ cxt->lines[i] = cxt->allocated_line;
+ }
+
+ cxt->hlen++;
+
+ /* The line where we start the search. */
+ cxt->history_pos = cxt->save_line;
+
+ rl_save_prompt ();
+
+ /* Initialize search parameters. */
+ cxt->search_string = (char *)xmalloc (cxt->search_string_size = 128);
+ cxt->search_string[cxt->search_string_index = 0] = '\0';
+
+ /* Normalize DIRECTION into 1 or -1. */
+ cxt->direction = (direction >= 0) ? 1 : -1;
+
+ cxt->sline = rl_line_buffer;
+ cxt->sline_len = strlen (cxt->sline);
+ cxt->sline_index = rl_point;
+
+ _rl_iscxt = cxt; /* save globally */
+
+ return cxt;
+}
+
+static void
+_rl_isearch_fini (cxt)
+ _rl_search_cxt *cxt;
+{
+ /* First put back the original state. */
+ strcpy (rl_line_buffer, cxt->lines[cxt->save_line]);
+
+ rl_restore_prompt ();
+
+ /* Save the search string for possible later use. */
+ FREE (last_isearch_string);
+ last_isearch_string = cxt->search_string;
+ last_isearch_string_len = cxt->search_string_index;
+ cxt->search_string = 0;
+
+ if (cxt->last_found_line < cxt->save_line)
+ rl_get_previous_history (cxt->save_line - cxt->last_found_line, 0);
+ else
+ rl_get_next_history (cxt->last_found_line - cxt->save_line, 0);
+
+ /* If the string was not found, put point at the end of the last matching
+ line. If last_found_line == orig_line, we didn't find any matching
+ history lines at all, so put point back in its original position. */
+ if (cxt->sline_index < 0)
+ {
+ if (cxt->last_found_line == cxt->save_line)
+ cxt->sline_index = cxt->save_point;
+ else
+ cxt->sline_index = strlen (rl_line_buffer);
+ rl_mark = cxt->save_mark;
+ }
+
+ rl_point = cxt->sline_index;
+ /* Don't worry about where to put the mark here; rl_get_previous_history
+ and rl_get_next_history take care of it. */
+
+ rl_clear_message ();
+}
+
+int
+_rl_search_getchar (cxt)
+ _rl_search_cxt *cxt;
+{
+ int c;
+
+ /* Read a key and decide how to proceed. */
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+ c = cxt->lastc = rl_read_key ();
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ c = cxt->lastc = _rl_read_mbstring (cxt->lastc, cxt->mb, MB_LEN_MAX);
+#endif
+
+ return c;
+}
+
+/* Process just-read character C according to isearch context CXT. Return
+ -1 if the caller should just free the context and return, 0 if we should
+ break out of the loop, and 1 if we should continue to read characters. */
+int
+_rl_isearch_dispatch (cxt, c)
+ _rl_search_cxt *cxt;
+ int c;
+{
+ int n, wstart, wlen, limit, cval;
+ rl_command_func_t *f;
+
+ f = (rl_command_func_t *)NULL;
+
+ /* Translate the keys we do something with to opcodes. */
+ if (c >= 0 && _rl_keymap[c].type == ISFUNC)
+ {
+ f = _rl_keymap[c].function;
+
+ if (f == rl_reverse_search_history)
+ cxt->lastc = (cxt->sflags & SF_REVERSE) ? -1 : -2;
+ else if (f == rl_forward_search_history)
+ cxt->lastc = (cxt->sflags & SF_REVERSE) ? -2 : -1;
+ else if (f == rl_rubout)
+ cxt->lastc = -3;
+ else if (c == CTRL ('G'))
+ cxt->lastc = -4;
+ else if (c == CTRL ('W')) /* XXX */
+ cxt->lastc = -5;
+ else if (c == CTRL ('Y')) /* XXX */
+ cxt->lastc = -6;
+ }
+
+ /* The characters in isearch_terminators (set from the user-settable
+ variable isearch-terminators) are used to terminate the search but
+ not subsequently execute the character as a command. The default
+ value is "\033\012" (ESC and C-J). */
+ if (strchr (cxt->search_terminators, cxt->lastc))
+ {
+ /* ESC still terminates the search, but if there is pending
+ input or if input arrives within 0.1 seconds (on systems
+ with select(2)) it is used as a prefix character
+ with rl_execute_next. WATCH OUT FOR THIS! This is intended
+ to allow the arrow keys to be used like ^F and ^B are used
+ to terminate the search and execute the movement command.
+ XXX - since _rl_input_available depends on the application-
+ settable keyboard timeout value, this could alternatively
+ use _rl_input_queued(100000) */
+ if (cxt->lastc == ESC && _rl_input_available ())
+ rl_execute_next (ESC);
+ return (0);
+ }
+
+#define ENDSRCH_CHAR(c) \
+ ((CTRL_CHAR (c) || META_CHAR (c) || (c) == RUBOUT) && ((c) != CTRL ('G')))
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ {
+ if (cxt->lastc >= 0 && (cxt->mb[0] && cxt->mb[1] == '\0') && ENDSRCH_CHAR (cxt->lastc))
+ {
+ /* This sets rl_pending_input to c; it will be picked up the next
+ time rl_read_key is called. */
+ rl_execute_next (cxt->lastc);
+ return (0);
+ }
+ }
+ else
+#endif
+ if (cxt->lastc >= 0 && ENDSRCH_CHAR (cxt->lastc))
+ {
+ /* This sets rl_pending_input to LASTC; it will be picked up the next
+ time rl_read_key is called. */
+ rl_execute_next (cxt->lastc);
+ return (0);
+ }
+
+ /* Now dispatch on the character. `Opcodes' affect the search string or
+ state. Other characters are added to the string. */
+ switch (cxt->lastc)
+ {
+ /* search again */
+ case -1:
+ if (cxt->search_string_index == 0)
+ {
+ if (last_isearch_string)
+ {
+ cxt->search_string_size = 64 + last_isearch_string_len;
+ cxt->search_string = (char *)xrealloc (cxt->search_string, cxt->search_string_size);
+ strcpy (cxt->search_string, last_isearch_string);
+ cxt->search_string_index = last_isearch_string_len;
+ rl_display_search (cxt->search_string, (cxt->sflags & SF_REVERSE), -1);
+ break;
+ }
+ return (1);
+ }
+ else if (cxt->sflags & SF_REVERSE)
+ cxt->sline_index--;
+ else if (cxt->sline_index != cxt->sline_len)
+ cxt->sline_index++;
+ else
+ rl_ding ();
+ break;
+
+ /* switch directions */
+ case -2:
+ cxt->direction = -cxt->direction;
+ if (cxt->direction < 0)
+ cxt->sflags |= SF_REVERSE;
+ else
+ cxt->sflags &= ~SF_REVERSE;
+ break;
+
+ /* delete character from search string. */
+ case -3: /* C-H, DEL */
+ /* This is tricky. To do this right, we need to keep a
+ stack of search positions for the current search, with
+ sentinels marking the beginning and end. But this will
+ do until we have a real isearch-undo. */
+ if (cxt->search_string_index == 0)
+ rl_ding ();
+ else
+ cxt->search_string[--cxt->search_string_index] = '\0';
+ break;
+
+ case -4: /* C-G, abort */
+ rl_replace_line (cxt->lines[cxt->save_line], 0);
+ rl_point = cxt->save_point;
+ rl_mark = cxt->save_mark;
+ rl_restore_prompt();
+ rl_clear_message ();
+
+ return -1;
+
+ case -5: /* C-W */
+ /* skip over portion of line we already matched and yank word */
+ wstart = rl_point + cxt->search_string_index;
+ if (wstart >= rl_end)
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /* if not in a word, move to one. */
+ cval = _rl_char_value (rl_line_buffer, wstart);
+ if (_rl_walphabetic (cval) == 0)
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ break;
+ }
+ n = MB_NEXTCHAR (rl_line_buffer, wstart, 1, MB_FIND_NONZERO);;
+ while (n < rl_end)
+ {
+ cval = _rl_char_value (rl_line_buffer, n);
+ if (_rl_walphabetic (cval) == 0)
+ break;
+ n = MB_NEXTCHAR (rl_line_buffer, n, 1, MB_FIND_NONZERO);;
+ }
+ wlen = n - wstart + 1;
+ if (cxt->search_string_index + wlen + 1 >= cxt->search_string_size)
+ {
+ cxt->search_string_size += wlen + 1;
+ cxt->search_string = (char *)xrealloc (cxt->search_string, cxt->search_string_size);
+ }
+ for (; wstart < n; wstart++)
+ cxt->search_string[cxt->search_string_index++] = rl_line_buffer[wstart];
+ cxt->search_string[cxt->search_string_index] = '\0';
+ break;
+
+ case -6: /* C-Y */
+ /* skip over portion of line we already matched and yank rest */
+ wstart = rl_point + cxt->search_string_index;
+ if (wstart >= rl_end)
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ break;
+ }
+ n = rl_end - wstart + 1;
+ if (cxt->search_string_index + n + 1 >= cxt->search_string_size)
+ {
+ cxt->search_string_size += n + 1;
+ cxt->search_string = (char *)xrealloc (cxt->search_string, cxt->search_string_size);
+ }
+ for (n = wstart; n < rl_end; n++)
+ cxt->search_string[cxt->search_string_index++] = rl_line_buffer[n];
+ cxt->search_string[cxt->search_string_index] = '\0';
+ break;
+
+ /* Add character to search string and continue search. */
+ default:
+ if (cxt->search_string_index + 2 >= cxt->search_string_size)
+ {
+ cxt->search_string_size += 128;
+ cxt->search_string = (char *)xrealloc (cxt->search_string, cxt->search_string_size);
+ }
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ {
+ int j, l;
+ for (j = 0, l = strlen (cxt->mb); j < l; )
+ cxt->search_string[cxt->search_string_index++] = cxt->mb[j++];
+ }
+ else
+#endif
+ cxt->search_string[cxt->search_string_index++] = c;
+ cxt->search_string[cxt->search_string_index] = '\0';
+ break;
+ }
+
+ for (cxt->sflags &= ~(SF_FOUND|SF_FAILED);; )
+ {
+ limit = cxt->sline_len - cxt->search_string_index + 1;
+
+ /* Search the current line. */
+ while ((cxt->sflags & SF_REVERSE) ? (cxt->sline_index >= 0) : (cxt->sline_index < limit))
+ {
+ if (STREQN (cxt->search_string, cxt->sline + cxt->sline_index, cxt->search_string_index))
+ {
+ cxt->sflags |= SF_FOUND;
+ break;
+ }
+ else
+ cxt->sline_index += cxt->direction;
+ }
+ if (cxt->sflags & SF_FOUND)
+ break;
+
+ /* Move to the next line, but skip new copies of the line
+ we just found and lines shorter than the string we're
+ searching for. */
+ do
+ {
+ /* Move to the next line. */
+ cxt->history_pos += cxt->direction;
+
+ /* At limit for direction? */
+ if ((cxt->sflags & SF_REVERSE) ? (cxt->history_pos < 0) : (cxt->history_pos == cxt->hlen))
+ {
+ cxt->sflags |= SF_FAILED;
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /* We will need these later. */
+ cxt->sline = cxt->lines[cxt->history_pos];
+ cxt->sline_len = strlen (cxt->sline);
+ }
+ while ((cxt->prev_line_found && STREQ (cxt->prev_line_found, cxt->lines[cxt->history_pos])) ||
+ (cxt->search_string_index > cxt->sline_len));
+
+ if (cxt->sflags & SF_FAILED)
+ break;
+
+ /* Now set up the line for searching... */
+ cxt->sline_index = (cxt->sflags & SF_REVERSE) ? cxt->sline_len - cxt->search_string_index : 0;
+ }
+
+ if (cxt->sflags & SF_FAILED)
+ {
+ /* We cannot find the search string. Ding the bell. */
+ rl_ding ();
+ cxt->history_pos = cxt->last_found_line;
+ return 1;
+ }
+
+ /* We have found the search string. Just display it. But don't
+ actually move there in the history list until the user accepts
+ the location. */
+ if (cxt->sflags & SF_FOUND)
+ {
+ cxt->prev_line_found = cxt->lines[cxt->history_pos];
+ rl_replace_line (cxt->lines[cxt->history_pos], 0);
+ rl_point = cxt->sline_index;
+ cxt->last_found_line = cxt->history_pos;
+ rl_display_search (cxt->search_string, (cxt->sflags & SF_REVERSE), (cxt->history_pos == cxt->save_line) ? -1 : cxt->history_pos);
+ }
+
+ return 1;
+}
+
+static int
+_rl_isearch_cleanup (cxt, r)
+ _rl_search_cxt *cxt;
+ int r;
+{
+ if (r >= 0)
+ _rl_isearch_fini (cxt);
+ _rl_scxt_dispose (cxt, 0);
+ _rl_iscxt = 0;
+
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_ISEARCH);
+
+ return (r != 0);
+}
+
+/* Search through the history looking for an interactively typed string.
+ This is analogous to i-search. We start the search in the current line.
+ DIRECTION is which direction to search; >= 0 means forward, < 0 means
+ backwards. */
+static int
+rl_search_history (direction, invoking_key)
+ int direction, invoking_key;
+{
+ _rl_search_cxt *cxt; /* local for now, but saved globally */
+ int c, r;
+
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_ISEARCH);
+ cxt = _rl_isearch_init (direction);
+
+ rl_display_search (cxt->search_string, (cxt->sflags & SF_REVERSE), -1);
+
+ /* If we are using the callback interface, all we do is set up here and
+ return. The key is that we leave RL_STATE_ISEARCH set. */
+ if (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_CALLBACK))
+ return (0);
+
+ r = -1;
+ for (;;)
+ {
+ c = _rl_search_getchar (cxt);
+ /* We might want to handle EOF here (c == 0) */
+ r = _rl_isearch_dispatch (cxt, cxt->lastc);
+ if (r <= 0)
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /* The searching is over. The user may have found the string that she
+ was looking for, or else she may have exited a failing search. If
+ LINE_INDEX is -1, then that shows that the string searched for was
+ not found. We use this to determine where to place rl_point. */
+ return (_rl_isearch_cleanup (cxt, r));
+}
+
+#if defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+/* Called from the callback functions when we are ready to read a key. The
+ callback functions know to call this because RL_ISSTATE(RL_STATE_ISEARCH).
+ If _rl_isearch_dispatch finishes searching, this function is responsible
+ for turning off RL_STATE_ISEARCH, which it does using _rl_isearch_cleanup. */
+int
+_rl_isearch_callback (cxt)
+ _rl_search_cxt *cxt;
+{
+ int c, r;
+
+ c = _rl_search_getchar (cxt);
+ /* We might want to handle EOF here */
+ r = _rl_isearch_dispatch (cxt, cxt->lastc);
+
+ return (r <= 0) ? _rl_isearch_cleanup (cxt, r) : 0;
+}
+#endif
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/keymaps.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/keymaps.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..70d0cc0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/keymaps.c
@@ -0,0 +1,149 @@
+/* keymaps.c -- Functions and keymaps for the GNU Readline library. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1988,1989 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Readline, a library for reading lines
+ of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ Readline is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the
+ Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any
+ later version.
+
+ Readline is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
+ WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with Readline; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
+ Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STDLIB_H)
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif /* HAVE_STDLIB_H */
+
+#include <stdio.h> /* for FILE * definition for readline.h */
+
+#include "readline.h"
+#include "rlconf.h"
+
+#include "emacs_keymap.c"
+
+#if defined (VI_MODE)
+#include "vi_keymap.c"
+#endif
+
+#include "xmalloc.h"
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Functions for manipulating Keymaps. */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+
+/* Return a new, empty keymap.
+ Free it with free() when you are done. */
+Keymap
+rl_make_bare_keymap ()
+{
+ register int i;
+ Keymap keymap = (Keymap)xmalloc (KEYMAP_SIZE * sizeof (KEYMAP_ENTRY));
+
+ for (i = 0; i < KEYMAP_SIZE; i++)
+ {
+ keymap[i].type = ISFUNC;
+ keymap[i].function = (rl_command_func_t *)NULL;
+ }
+
+#if 0
+ for (i = 'A'; i < ('Z' + 1); i++)
+ {
+ keymap[i].type = ISFUNC;
+ keymap[i].function = rl_do_lowercase_version;
+ }
+#endif
+
+ return (keymap);
+}
+
+/* Return a new keymap which is a copy of MAP. */
+Keymap
+rl_copy_keymap (map)
+ Keymap map;
+{
+ register int i;
+ Keymap temp;
+
+ temp = rl_make_bare_keymap ();
+ for (i = 0; i < KEYMAP_SIZE; i++)
+ {
+ temp[i].type = map[i].type;
+ temp[i].function = map[i].function;
+ }
+ return (temp);
+}
+
+/* Return a new keymap with the printing characters bound to rl_insert,
+ the uppercase Meta characters bound to run their lowercase equivalents,
+ and the Meta digits bound to produce numeric arguments. */
+Keymap
+rl_make_keymap ()
+{
+ register int i;
+ Keymap newmap;
+
+ newmap = rl_make_bare_keymap ();
+
+ /* All ASCII printing characters are self-inserting. */
+ for (i = ' '; i < 127; i++)
+ newmap[i].function = rl_insert;
+
+ newmap[TAB].function = rl_insert;
+ newmap[RUBOUT].function = rl_rubout; /* RUBOUT == 127 */
+ newmap[CTRL('H')].function = rl_rubout;
+
+#if KEYMAP_SIZE > 128
+ /* Printing characters in ISO Latin-1 and some 8-bit character sets. */
+ for (i = 128; i < 256; i++)
+ newmap[i].function = rl_insert;
+#endif /* KEYMAP_SIZE > 128 */
+
+ return (newmap);
+}
+
+/* Free the storage associated with MAP. */
+void
+rl_discard_keymap (map)
+ Keymap map;
+{
+ int i;
+
+ if (!map)
+ return;
+
+ for (i = 0; i < KEYMAP_SIZE; i++)
+ {
+ switch (map[i].type)
+ {
+ case ISFUNC:
+ break;
+
+ case ISKMAP:
+ rl_discard_keymap ((Keymap)map[i].function);
+ break;
+
+ case ISMACR:
+ free ((char *)map[i].function);
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/keymaps.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/keymaps.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..66fa2a5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/keymaps.h
@@ -0,0 +1,103 @@
+/* keymaps.h -- Manipulation of readline keymaps. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1987, 1989, 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#ifndef _KEYMAPS_H_
+#define _KEYMAPS_H_
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+extern "C" {
+#endif
+
+#if defined (READLINE_LIBRARY)
+# include "rlstdc.h"
+# include "chardefs.h"
+# include "rltypedefs.h"
+#else
+# include <readline/rlstdc.h>
+# include <readline/chardefs.h>
+# include <readline/rltypedefs.h>
+#endif
+
+/* A keymap contains one entry for each key in the ASCII set.
+ Each entry consists of a type and a pointer.
+ FUNCTION is the address of a function to run, or the
+ address of a keymap to indirect through.
+ TYPE says which kind of thing FUNCTION is. */
+typedef struct _keymap_entry {
+ char type;
+ rl_command_func_t *function;
+} KEYMAP_ENTRY;
+
+/* This must be large enough to hold bindings for all of the characters
+ in a desired character set (e.g, 128 for ASCII, 256 for ISO Latin-x,
+ and so on) plus one for subsequence matching. */
+#define KEYMAP_SIZE 257
+#define ANYOTHERKEY KEYMAP_SIZE-1
+
+/* I wanted to make the above structure contain a union of:
+ union { rl_command_func_t *function; struct _keymap_entry *keymap; } value;
+ but this made it impossible for me to create a static array.
+ Maybe I need C lessons. */
+
+typedef KEYMAP_ENTRY KEYMAP_ENTRY_ARRAY[KEYMAP_SIZE];
+typedef KEYMAP_ENTRY *Keymap;
+
+/* The values that TYPE can have in a keymap entry. */
+#define ISFUNC 0
+#define ISKMAP 1
+#define ISMACR 2
+
+extern KEYMAP_ENTRY_ARRAY emacs_standard_keymap, emacs_meta_keymap, emacs_ctlx_keymap;
+extern KEYMAP_ENTRY_ARRAY vi_insertion_keymap, vi_movement_keymap;
+
+/* Return a new, empty keymap.
+ Free it with free() when you are done. */
+extern Keymap rl_make_bare_keymap PARAMS((void));
+
+/* Return a new keymap which is a copy of MAP. */
+extern Keymap rl_copy_keymap PARAMS((Keymap));
+
+/* Return a new keymap with the printing characters bound to rl_insert,
+ the lowercase Meta characters bound to run their equivalents, and
+ the Meta digits bound to produce numeric arguments. */
+extern Keymap rl_make_keymap PARAMS((void));
+
+/* Free the storage associated with a keymap. */
+extern void rl_discard_keymap PARAMS((Keymap));
+
+/* These functions actually appear in bind.c */
+
+/* Return the keymap corresponding to a given name. Names look like
+ `emacs' or `emacs-meta' or `vi-insert'. */
+extern Keymap rl_get_keymap_by_name PARAMS((const char *));
+
+/* Return the current keymap. */
+extern Keymap rl_get_keymap PARAMS((void));
+
+/* Set the current keymap to MAP. */
+extern void rl_set_keymap PARAMS((Keymap));
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+}
+#endif
+
+#endif /* _KEYMAPS_H_ */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/kill.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/kill.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1d3254c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/kill.c
@@ -0,0 +1,693 @@
+/* kill.c -- kill ring management. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1994 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h> /* for _POSIX_VERSION */
+#endif /* HAVE_UNISTD_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STDLIB_H)
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif /* HAVE_STDLIB_H */
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+/* System-specific feature definitions and include files. */
+#include "rldefs.h"
+
+/* Some standard library routines. */
+#include "readline.h"
+#include "history.h"
+
+#include "rlprivate.h"
+#include "xmalloc.h"
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Killing Mechanism */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* What we assume for a max number of kills. */
+#define DEFAULT_MAX_KILLS 10
+
+/* The real variable to look at to find out when to flush kills. */
+static int rl_max_kills = DEFAULT_MAX_KILLS;
+
+/* Where to store killed text. */
+static char **rl_kill_ring = (char **)NULL;
+
+/* Where we are in the kill ring. */
+static int rl_kill_index;
+
+/* How many slots we have in the kill ring. */
+static int rl_kill_ring_length;
+
+static int _rl_copy_to_kill_ring PARAMS((char *, int));
+static int region_kill_internal PARAMS((int));
+static int _rl_copy_word_as_kill PARAMS((int, int));
+static int rl_yank_nth_arg_internal PARAMS((int, int, int));
+
+/* How to say that you only want to save a certain amount
+ of kill material. */
+int
+rl_set_retained_kills (num)
+ int num;
+{
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Add TEXT to the kill ring, allocating a new kill ring slot as necessary.
+ This uses TEXT directly, so the caller must not free it. If APPEND is
+ non-zero, and the last command was a kill, the text is appended to the
+ current kill ring slot, otherwise prepended. */
+static int
+_rl_copy_to_kill_ring (text, append)
+ char *text;
+ int append;
+{
+ char *old, *new;
+ int slot;
+
+ /* First, find the slot to work with. */
+ if (_rl_last_command_was_kill == 0)
+ {
+ /* Get a new slot. */
+ if (rl_kill_ring == 0)
+ {
+ /* If we don't have any defined, then make one. */
+ rl_kill_ring = (char **)
+ xmalloc (((rl_kill_ring_length = 1) + 1) * sizeof (char *));
+ rl_kill_ring[slot = 0] = (char *)NULL;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* We have to add a new slot on the end, unless we have
+ exceeded the max limit for remembering kills. */
+ slot = rl_kill_ring_length;
+ if (slot == rl_max_kills)
+ {
+ register int i;
+ free (rl_kill_ring[0]);
+ for (i = 0; i < slot; i++)
+ rl_kill_ring[i] = rl_kill_ring[i + 1];
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ slot = rl_kill_ring_length += 1;
+ rl_kill_ring = (char **)xrealloc (rl_kill_ring, slot * sizeof (char *));
+ }
+ rl_kill_ring[--slot] = (char *)NULL;
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ slot = rl_kill_ring_length - 1;
+
+ /* If the last command was a kill, prepend or append. */
+ if (_rl_last_command_was_kill && rl_editing_mode != vi_mode)
+ {
+ old = rl_kill_ring[slot];
+ new = (char *)xmalloc (1 + strlen (old) + strlen (text));
+
+ if (append)
+ {
+ strcpy (new, old);
+ strcat (new, text);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ strcpy (new, text);
+ strcat (new, old);
+ }
+ free (old);
+ free (text);
+ rl_kill_ring[slot] = new;
+ }
+ else
+ rl_kill_ring[slot] = text;
+
+ rl_kill_index = slot;
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* The way to kill something. This appends or prepends to the last
+ kill, if the last command was a kill command. if FROM is less
+ than TO, then the text is appended, otherwise prepended. If the
+ last command was not a kill command, then a new slot is made for
+ this kill. */
+int
+rl_kill_text (from, to)
+ int from, to;
+{
+ char *text;
+
+ /* Is there anything to kill? */
+ if (from == to)
+ {
+ _rl_last_command_was_kill++;
+ return 0;
+ }
+
+ text = rl_copy_text (from, to);
+
+ /* Delete the copied text from the line. */
+ rl_delete_text (from, to);
+
+ _rl_copy_to_kill_ring (text, from < to);
+
+ _rl_last_command_was_kill++;
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Now REMEMBER! In order to do prepending or appending correctly, kill
+ commands always make rl_point's original position be the FROM argument,
+ and rl_point's extent be the TO argument. */
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Killing Commands */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* Delete the word at point, saving the text in the kill ring. */
+int
+rl_kill_word (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ int orig_point;
+
+ if (count < 0)
+ return (rl_backward_kill_word (-count, key));
+ else
+ {
+ orig_point = rl_point;
+ rl_forward_word (count, key);
+
+ if (rl_point != orig_point)
+ rl_kill_text (orig_point, rl_point);
+
+ rl_point = orig_point;
+ if (rl_editing_mode == emacs_mode)
+ rl_mark = rl_point;
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Rubout the word before point, placing it on the kill ring. */
+int
+rl_backward_kill_word (count, ignore)
+ int count, ignore;
+{
+ int orig_point;
+
+ if (count < 0)
+ return (rl_kill_word (-count, ignore));
+ else
+ {
+ orig_point = rl_point;
+ rl_backward_word (count, ignore);
+
+ if (rl_point != orig_point)
+ rl_kill_text (orig_point, rl_point);
+
+ if (rl_editing_mode == emacs_mode)
+ rl_mark = rl_point;
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Kill from here to the end of the line. If DIRECTION is negative, kill
+ back to the line start instead. */
+int
+rl_kill_line (direction, ignore)
+ int direction, ignore;
+{
+ int orig_point;
+
+ if (direction < 0)
+ return (rl_backward_kill_line (1, ignore));
+ else
+ {
+ orig_point = rl_point;
+ rl_end_of_line (1, ignore);
+ if (orig_point != rl_point)
+ rl_kill_text (orig_point, rl_point);
+ rl_point = orig_point;
+ if (rl_editing_mode == emacs_mode)
+ rl_mark = rl_point;
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Kill backwards to the start of the line. If DIRECTION is negative, kill
+ forwards to the line end instead. */
+int
+rl_backward_kill_line (direction, ignore)
+ int direction, ignore;
+{
+ int orig_point;
+
+ if (direction < 0)
+ return (rl_kill_line (1, ignore));
+ else
+ {
+ if (!rl_point)
+ rl_ding ();
+ else
+ {
+ orig_point = rl_point;
+ rl_beg_of_line (1, ignore);
+ if (rl_point != orig_point)
+ rl_kill_text (orig_point, rl_point);
+ if (rl_editing_mode == emacs_mode)
+ rl_mark = rl_point;
+ }
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Kill the whole line, no matter where point is. */
+int
+rl_kill_full_line (count, ignore)
+ int count, ignore;
+{
+ rl_begin_undo_group ();
+ rl_point = 0;
+ rl_kill_text (rl_point, rl_end);
+ rl_mark = 0;
+ rl_end_undo_group ();
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* The next two functions mimic unix line editing behaviour, except they
+ save the deleted text on the kill ring. This is safer than not saving
+ it, and since we have a ring, nobody should get screwed. */
+
+/* This does what C-w does in Unix. We can't prevent people from
+ using behaviour that they expect. */
+int
+rl_unix_word_rubout (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ int orig_point;
+
+ if (rl_point == 0)
+ rl_ding ();
+ else
+ {
+ orig_point = rl_point;
+ if (count <= 0)
+ count = 1;
+
+ while (count--)
+ {
+ while (rl_point && whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point - 1]))
+ rl_point--;
+
+ while (rl_point && (whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point - 1]) == 0))
+ rl_point--;
+ }
+
+ rl_kill_text (orig_point, rl_point);
+ if (rl_editing_mode == emacs_mode)
+ rl_mark = rl_point;
+ }
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* This deletes one filename component in a Unix pathname. That is, it
+ deletes backward to directory separator (`/') or whitespace. */
+int
+rl_unix_filename_rubout (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ int orig_point, c;
+
+ if (rl_point == 0)
+ rl_ding ();
+ else
+ {
+ orig_point = rl_point;
+ if (count <= 0)
+ count = 1;
+
+ while (count--)
+ {
+ c = rl_line_buffer[rl_point - 1];
+ while (rl_point && (whitespace (c) || c == '/'))
+ {
+ rl_point--;
+ c = rl_line_buffer[rl_point - 1];
+ }
+
+ while (rl_point && (whitespace (c) == 0) && c != '/')
+ {
+ rl_point--;
+ c = rl_line_buffer[rl_point - 1];
+ }
+ }
+
+ rl_kill_text (orig_point, rl_point);
+ if (rl_editing_mode == emacs_mode)
+ rl_mark = rl_point;
+ }
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Here is C-u doing what Unix does. You don't *have* to use these
+ key-bindings. We have a choice of killing the entire line, or
+ killing from where we are to the start of the line. We choose the
+ latter, because if you are a Unix weenie, then you haven't backspaced
+ into the line at all, and if you aren't, then you know what you are
+ doing. */
+int
+rl_unix_line_discard (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ if (rl_point == 0)
+ rl_ding ();
+ else
+ {
+ rl_kill_text (rl_point, 0);
+ rl_point = 0;
+ if (rl_editing_mode == emacs_mode)
+ rl_mark = rl_point;
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Copy the text in the `region' to the kill ring. If DELETE is non-zero,
+ delete the text from the line as well. */
+static int
+region_kill_internal (delete)
+ int delete;
+{
+ char *text;
+
+ if (rl_mark != rl_point)
+ {
+ text = rl_copy_text (rl_point, rl_mark);
+ if (delete)
+ rl_delete_text (rl_point, rl_mark);
+ _rl_copy_to_kill_ring (text, rl_point < rl_mark);
+ }
+
+ _rl_last_command_was_kill++;
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Copy the text in the region to the kill ring. */
+int
+rl_copy_region_to_kill (count, ignore)
+ int count, ignore;
+{
+ return (region_kill_internal (0));
+}
+
+/* Kill the text between the point and mark. */
+int
+rl_kill_region (count, ignore)
+ int count, ignore;
+{
+ int r, npoint;
+
+ npoint = (rl_point < rl_mark) ? rl_point : rl_mark;
+ r = region_kill_internal (1);
+ _rl_fix_point (1);
+ rl_point = npoint;
+ return r;
+}
+
+/* Copy COUNT words to the kill ring. DIR says which direction we look
+ to find the words. */
+static int
+_rl_copy_word_as_kill (count, dir)
+ int count, dir;
+{
+ int om, op, r;
+
+ om = rl_mark;
+ op = rl_point;
+
+ if (dir > 0)
+ rl_forward_word (count, 0);
+ else
+ rl_backward_word (count, 0);
+
+ rl_mark = rl_point;
+
+ if (dir > 0)
+ rl_backward_word (count, 0);
+ else
+ rl_forward_word (count, 0);
+
+ r = region_kill_internal (0);
+
+ rl_mark = om;
+ rl_point = op;
+
+ return r;
+}
+
+int
+rl_copy_forward_word (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ if (count < 0)
+ return (rl_copy_backward_word (-count, key));
+
+ return (_rl_copy_word_as_kill (count, 1));
+}
+
+int
+rl_copy_backward_word (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ if (count < 0)
+ return (rl_copy_forward_word (-count, key));
+
+ return (_rl_copy_word_as_kill (count, -1));
+}
+
+/* Yank back the last killed text. This ignores arguments. */
+int
+rl_yank (count, ignore)
+ int count, ignore;
+{
+ if (rl_kill_ring == 0)
+ {
+ _rl_abort_internal ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ _rl_set_mark_at_pos (rl_point);
+ rl_insert_text (rl_kill_ring[rl_kill_index]);
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* If the last command was yank, or yank_pop, and the text just
+ before point is identical to the current kill item, then
+ delete that text from the line, rotate the index down, and
+ yank back some other text. */
+int
+rl_yank_pop (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ int l, n;
+
+ if (((rl_last_func != rl_yank_pop) && (rl_last_func != rl_yank)) ||
+ !rl_kill_ring)
+ {
+ _rl_abort_internal ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ l = strlen (rl_kill_ring[rl_kill_index]);
+ n = rl_point - l;
+ if (n >= 0 && STREQN (rl_line_buffer + n, rl_kill_ring[rl_kill_index], l))
+ {
+ rl_delete_text (n, rl_point);
+ rl_point = n;
+ rl_kill_index--;
+ if (rl_kill_index < 0)
+ rl_kill_index = rl_kill_ring_length - 1;
+ rl_yank (1, 0);
+ return 0;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ _rl_abort_internal ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+}
+
+/* Yank the COUNTh argument from the previous history line, skipping
+ HISTORY_SKIP lines before looking for the `previous line'. */
+static int
+rl_yank_nth_arg_internal (count, ignore, history_skip)
+ int count, ignore, history_skip;
+{
+ register HIST_ENTRY *entry;
+ char *arg;
+ int i, pos;
+
+ pos = where_history ();
+
+ if (history_skip)
+ {
+ for (i = 0; i < history_skip; i++)
+ entry = previous_history ();
+ }
+
+ entry = previous_history ();
+
+ history_set_pos (pos);
+
+ if (entry == 0)
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ arg = history_arg_extract (count, count, entry->line);
+ if (!arg || !*arg)
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ rl_begin_undo_group ();
+
+ _rl_set_mark_at_pos (rl_point);
+
+#if defined (VI_MODE)
+ /* Vi mode always inserts a space before yanking the argument, and it
+ inserts it right *after* rl_point. */
+ if (rl_editing_mode == vi_mode)
+ {
+ rl_vi_append_mode (1, ignore);
+ rl_insert_text (" ");
+ }
+#endif /* VI_MODE */
+
+ rl_insert_text (arg);
+ free (arg);
+
+ rl_end_undo_group ();
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Yank the COUNTth argument from the previous history line. */
+int
+rl_yank_nth_arg (count, ignore)
+ int count, ignore;
+{
+ return (rl_yank_nth_arg_internal (count, ignore, 0));
+}
+
+/* Yank the last argument from the previous history line. This `knows'
+ how rl_yank_nth_arg treats a count of `$'. With an argument, this
+ behaves the same as rl_yank_nth_arg. */
+int
+rl_yank_last_arg (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ static int history_skip = 0;
+ static int explicit_arg_p = 0;
+ static int count_passed = 1;
+ static int direction = 1;
+ static int undo_needed = 0;
+ int retval;
+
+ if (rl_last_func != rl_yank_last_arg)
+ {
+ history_skip = 0;
+ explicit_arg_p = rl_explicit_arg;
+ count_passed = count;
+ direction = 1;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if (undo_needed)
+ rl_do_undo ();
+ if (count < 1)
+ direction = -direction;
+ history_skip += direction;
+ if (history_skip < 0)
+ history_skip = 0;
+ }
+
+ if (explicit_arg_p)
+ retval = rl_yank_nth_arg_internal (count_passed, key, history_skip);
+ else
+ retval = rl_yank_nth_arg_internal ('$', key, history_skip);
+
+ undo_needed = retval == 0;
+ return retval;
+}
+
+/* A special paste command for users of Cygnus's cygwin32. */
+#if defined (__CYGWIN__)
+#include <windows.h>
+
+int
+rl_paste_from_clipboard (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ char *data, *ptr;
+ int len;
+
+ if (OpenClipboard (NULL) == 0)
+ return (0);
+
+ data = (char *)GetClipboardData (CF_TEXT);
+ if (data)
+ {
+ ptr = strchr (data, '\r');
+ if (ptr)
+ {
+ len = ptr - data;
+ ptr = (char *)xmalloc (len + 1);
+ ptr[len] = '\0';
+ strncpy (ptr, data, len);
+ }
+ else
+ ptr = data;
+ _rl_set_mark_at_pos (rl_point);
+ rl_insert_text (ptr);
+ if (ptr != data)
+ free (ptr);
+ CloseClipboard ();
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+#endif /* __CYGWIN__ */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/macro.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/macro.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..2975bf1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/macro.c
@@ -0,0 +1,271 @@
+/* macro.c -- keyboard macros for readline. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1994 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h> /* for _POSIX_VERSION */
+#endif /* HAVE_UNISTD_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STDLIB_H)
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif /* HAVE_STDLIB_H */
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+/* System-specific feature definitions and include files. */
+#include "rldefs.h"
+
+/* Some standard library routines. */
+#include "readline.h"
+#include "history.h"
+
+#include "rlprivate.h"
+#include "xmalloc.h"
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Hacking Keyboard Macros */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* The currently executing macro string. If this is non-zero,
+ then it is a malloc ()'ed string where input is coming from. */
+char *rl_executing_macro = (char *)NULL;
+
+/* The offset in the above string to the next character to be read. */
+static int executing_macro_index;
+
+/* The current macro string being built. Characters get stuffed
+ in here by add_macro_char (). */
+static char *current_macro = (char *)NULL;
+
+/* The size of the buffer allocated to current_macro. */
+static int current_macro_size;
+
+/* The index at which characters are being added to current_macro. */
+static int current_macro_index;
+
+/* A structure used to save nested macro strings.
+ It is a linked list of string/index for each saved macro. */
+struct saved_macro {
+ struct saved_macro *next;
+ char *string;
+ int sindex;
+};
+
+/* The list of saved macros. */
+static struct saved_macro *macro_list = (struct saved_macro *)NULL;
+
+/* Set up to read subsequent input from STRING.
+ STRING is free ()'ed when we are done with it. */
+void
+_rl_with_macro_input (string)
+ char *string;
+{
+ _rl_push_executing_macro ();
+ rl_executing_macro = string;
+ executing_macro_index = 0;
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_MACROINPUT);
+}
+
+/* Return the next character available from a macro, or 0 if
+ there are no macro characters. */
+int
+_rl_next_macro_key ()
+{
+ int c;
+
+ if (rl_executing_macro == 0)
+ return (0);
+
+ if (rl_executing_macro[executing_macro_index] == 0)
+ {
+ _rl_pop_executing_macro ();
+ return (_rl_next_macro_key ());
+ }
+
+#if defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+ c = rl_executing_macro[executing_macro_index++];
+ if (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_CALLBACK) && RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_READCMD) && rl_executing_macro[executing_macro_index] == 0)
+ _rl_pop_executing_macro ();
+ return c;
+#else
+ return (rl_executing_macro[executing_macro_index++]);
+#endif
+}
+
+/* Save the currently executing macro on a stack of saved macros. */
+void
+_rl_push_executing_macro ()
+{
+ struct saved_macro *saver;
+
+ saver = (struct saved_macro *)xmalloc (sizeof (struct saved_macro));
+ saver->next = macro_list;
+ saver->sindex = executing_macro_index;
+ saver->string = rl_executing_macro;
+
+ macro_list = saver;
+}
+
+/* Discard the current macro, replacing it with the one
+ on the top of the stack of saved macros. */
+void
+_rl_pop_executing_macro ()
+{
+ struct saved_macro *macro;
+
+ FREE (rl_executing_macro);
+ rl_executing_macro = (char *)NULL;
+ executing_macro_index = 0;
+
+ if (macro_list)
+ {
+ macro = macro_list;
+ rl_executing_macro = macro_list->string;
+ executing_macro_index = macro_list->sindex;
+ macro_list = macro_list->next;
+ free (macro);
+ }
+
+ if (rl_executing_macro == 0)
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_MACROINPUT);
+}
+
+/* Add a character to the macro being built. */
+void
+_rl_add_macro_char (c)
+ int c;
+{
+ if (current_macro_index + 1 >= current_macro_size)
+ {
+ if (current_macro == 0)
+ current_macro = (char *)xmalloc (current_macro_size = 25);
+ else
+ current_macro = (char *)xrealloc (current_macro, current_macro_size += 25);
+ }
+
+ current_macro[current_macro_index++] = c;
+ current_macro[current_macro_index] = '\0';
+}
+
+void
+_rl_kill_kbd_macro ()
+{
+ if (current_macro)
+ {
+ free (current_macro);
+ current_macro = (char *) NULL;
+ }
+ current_macro_size = current_macro_index = 0;
+
+ FREE (rl_executing_macro);
+ rl_executing_macro = (char *) NULL;
+ executing_macro_index = 0;
+
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_MACRODEF);
+}
+
+/* Begin defining a keyboard macro.
+ Keystrokes are recorded as they are executed.
+ End the definition with rl_end_kbd_macro ().
+ If a numeric argument was explicitly typed, then append this
+ definition to the end of the existing macro, and start by
+ re-executing the existing macro. */
+int
+rl_start_kbd_macro (ignore1, ignore2)
+ int ignore1, ignore2;
+{
+ if (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_MACRODEF))
+ {
+ _rl_abort_internal ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ if (rl_explicit_arg)
+ {
+ if (current_macro)
+ _rl_with_macro_input (savestring (current_macro));
+ }
+ else
+ current_macro_index = 0;
+
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_MACRODEF);
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Stop defining a keyboard macro.
+ A numeric argument says to execute the macro right now,
+ that many times, counting the definition as the first time. */
+int
+rl_end_kbd_macro (count, ignore)
+ int count, ignore;
+{
+ if (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_MACRODEF) == 0)
+ {
+ _rl_abort_internal ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ current_macro_index -= rl_key_sequence_length - 1;
+ current_macro[current_macro_index] = '\0';
+
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_MACRODEF);
+
+ return (rl_call_last_kbd_macro (--count, 0));
+}
+
+/* Execute the most recently defined keyboard macro.
+ COUNT says how many times to execute it. */
+int
+rl_call_last_kbd_macro (count, ignore)
+ int count, ignore;
+{
+ if (current_macro == 0)
+ _rl_abort_internal ();
+
+ if (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_MACRODEF))
+ {
+ rl_ding (); /* no recursive macros */
+ current_macro[--current_macro_index] = '\0'; /* erase this char */
+ return 0;
+ }
+
+ while (count--)
+ _rl_with_macro_input (savestring (current_macro));
+ return 0;
+}
+
+void
+rl_push_macro_input (macro)
+ char *macro;
+{
+ _rl_with_macro_input (macro);
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/mbutil.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/mbutil.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..17dde53
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/mbutil.c
@@ -0,0 +1,373 @@
+/* mbutil.c -- readline multibyte character utility functions */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 2001-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include "posixjmp.h"
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h> /* for _POSIX_VERSION */
+#endif /* HAVE_UNISTD_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STDLIB_H)
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif /* HAVE_STDLIB_H */
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <ctype.h>
+
+/* System-specific feature definitions and include files. */
+#include "rldefs.h"
+#include "rlmbutil.h"
+
+#if defined (TIOCSTAT_IN_SYS_IOCTL)
+# include <sys/ioctl.h>
+#endif /* TIOCSTAT_IN_SYS_IOCTL */
+
+/* Some standard library routines. */
+#include "readline.h"
+
+#include "rlprivate.h"
+#include "xmalloc.h"
+
+/* Declared here so it can be shared between the readline and history
+ libraries. */
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+int rl_byte_oriented = 0;
+#else
+int rl_byte_oriented = 1;
+#endif
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Multibyte Character Utility Functions */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+#if defined(HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+
+static int
+_rl_find_next_mbchar_internal (string, seed, count, find_non_zero)
+ char *string;
+ int seed, count, find_non_zero;
+{
+ size_t tmp;
+ mbstate_t ps;
+ int point;
+ wchar_t wc;
+
+ tmp = 0;
+
+ memset(&ps, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+ if (seed < 0)
+ seed = 0;
+ if (count <= 0)
+ return seed;
+
+ point = seed + _rl_adjust_point (string, seed, &ps);
+ /* if this is true, means that seed was not pointed character
+ started byte. So correct the point and consume count */
+ if (seed < point)
+ count--;
+
+ while (count > 0)
+ {
+ tmp = mbrtowc (&wc, string+point, strlen(string + point), &ps);
+ if (MB_INVALIDCH ((size_t)tmp))
+ {
+ /* invalid bytes. asume a byte represents a character */
+ point++;
+ count--;
+ /* reset states. */
+ memset(&ps, 0, sizeof(mbstate_t));
+ }
+ else if (MB_NULLWCH (tmp))
+ break; /* found wide '\0' */
+ else
+ {
+ /* valid bytes */
+ point += tmp;
+ if (find_non_zero)
+ {
+ if (wcwidth (wc) == 0)
+ continue;
+ else
+ count--;
+ }
+ else
+ count--;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (find_non_zero)
+ {
+ tmp = mbrtowc (&wc, string + point, strlen (string + point), &ps);
+ while (tmp > 0 && wcwidth (wc) == 0)
+ {
+ point += tmp;
+ tmp = mbrtowc (&wc, string + point, strlen (string + point), &ps);
+ if (MB_NULLWCH (tmp) || MB_INVALIDCH (tmp))
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ return point;
+}
+
+static int
+_rl_find_prev_mbchar_internal (string, seed, find_non_zero)
+ char *string;
+ int seed, find_non_zero;
+{
+ mbstate_t ps;
+ int prev, non_zero_prev, point, length;
+ size_t tmp;
+ wchar_t wc;
+
+ memset(&ps, 0, sizeof(mbstate_t));
+ length = strlen(string);
+
+ if (seed < 0)
+ return 0;
+ else if (length < seed)
+ return length;
+
+ prev = non_zero_prev = point = 0;
+ while (point < seed)
+ {
+ tmp = mbrtowc (&wc, string + point, length - point, &ps);
+ if (MB_INVALIDCH ((size_t)tmp))
+ {
+ /* in this case, bytes are invalid or shorted to compose
+ multibyte char, so assume that the first byte represents
+ a single character anyway. */
+ tmp = 1;
+ /* clear the state of the byte sequence, because
+ in this case effect of mbstate is undefined */
+ memset(&ps, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+
+ /* Since we're assuming that this byte represents a single
+ non-zero-width character, don't forget about it. */
+ prev = point;
+ }
+ else if (MB_NULLWCH (tmp))
+ break; /* Found '\0' char. Can this happen? */
+ else
+ {
+ if (find_non_zero)
+ {
+ if (wcwidth (wc) != 0)
+ prev = point;
+ }
+ else
+ prev = point;
+ }
+
+ point += tmp;
+ }
+
+ return prev;
+}
+
+/* return the number of bytes parsed from the multibyte sequence starting
+ at src, if a non-L'\0' wide character was recognized. It returns 0,
+ if a L'\0' wide character was recognized. It returns (size_t)(-1),
+ if an invalid multibyte sequence was encountered. It returns (size_t)(-2)
+ if it couldn't parse a complete multibyte character. */
+int
+_rl_get_char_len (src, ps)
+ char *src;
+ mbstate_t *ps;
+{
+ size_t tmp;
+
+ tmp = mbrlen((const char *)src, (size_t)strlen (src), ps);
+ if (tmp == (size_t)(-2))
+ {
+ /* shorted to compose multibyte char */
+ if (ps)
+ memset (ps, 0, sizeof(mbstate_t));
+ return -2;
+ }
+ else if (tmp == (size_t)(-1))
+ {
+ /* invalid to compose multibyte char */
+ /* initialize the conversion state */
+ if (ps)
+ memset (ps, 0, sizeof(mbstate_t));
+ return -1;
+ }
+ else if (tmp == (size_t)0)
+ return 0;
+ else
+ return (int)tmp;
+}
+
+/* compare the specified two characters. If the characters matched,
+ return 1. Otherwise return 0. */
+int
+_rl_compare_chars (buf1, pos1, ps1, buf2, pos2, ps2)
+ char *buf1;
+ int pos1;
+ mbstate_t *ps1;
+ char *buf2;
+ int pos2;
+ mbstate_t *ps2;
+{
+ int i, w1, w2;
+
+ if ((w1 = _rl_get_char_len (&buf1[pos1], ps1)) <= 0 ||
+ (w2 = _rl_get_char_len (&buf2[pos2], ps2)) <= 0 ||
+ (w1 != w2) ||
+ (buf1[pos1] != buf2[pos2]))
+ return 0;
+
+ for (i = 1; i < w1; i++)
+ if (buf1[pos1+i] != buf2[pos2+i])
+ return 0;
+
+ return 1;
+}
+
+/* adjust pointed byte and find mbstate of the point of string.
+ adjusted point will be point <= adjusted_point, and returns
+ differences of the byte(adjusted_point - point).
+ if point is invalied (point < 0 || more than string length),
+ it returns -1 */
+int
+_rl_adjust_point(string, point, ps)
+ char *string;
+ int point;
+ mbstate_t *ps;
+{
+ size_t tmp = 0;
+ int length;
+ int pos = 0;
+
+ length = strlen(string);
+ if (point < 0)
+ return -1;
+ if (length < point)
+ return -1;
+
+ while (pos < point)
+ {
+ tmp = mbrlen (string + pos, length - pos, ps);
+ if (MB_INVALIDCH ((size_t)tmp))
+ {
+ /* in this case, bytes are invalid or shorted to compose
+ multibyte char, so assume that the first byte represents
+ a single character anyway. */
+ pos++;
+ /* clear the state of the byte sequence, because
+ in this case effect of mbstate is undefined */
+ if (ps)
+ memset (ps, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+ }
+ else if (MB_NULLWCH (tmp))
+ pos++;
+ else
+ pos += tmp;
+ }
+
+ return (pos - point);
+}
+
+int
+_rl_is_mbchar_matched (string, seed, end, mbchar, length)
+ char *string;
+ int seed, end;
+ char *mbchar;
+ int length;
+{
+ int i;
+
+ if ((end - seed) < length)
+ return 0;
+
+ for (i = 0; i < length; i++)
+ if (string[seed + i] != mbchar[i])
+ return 0;
+ return 1;
+}
+
+wchar_t
+_rl_char_value (buf, ind)
+ char *buf;
+ int ind;
+{
+ size_t tmp;
+ wchar_t wc;
+ mbstate_t ps;
+ int l;
+
+ if (MB_LEN_MAX == 1 || rl_byte_oriented)
+ return ((wchar_t) buf[ind]);
+ l = strlen (buf);
+ if (ind >= l - 1)
+ return ((wchar_t) buf[ind]);
+ memset (&ps, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+ tmp = mbrtowc (&wc, buf + ind, l - ind, &ps);
+ if (MB_INVALIDCH (tmp) || MB_NULLWCH (tmp))
+ return ((wchar_t) buf[ind]);
+ return wc;
+}
+#endif /* HANDLE_MULTIBYTE */
+
+/* Find next `count' characters started byte point of the specified seed.
+ If flags is MB_FIND_NONZERO, we look for non-zero-width multibyte
+ characters. */
+#undef _rl_find_next_mbchar
+int
+_rl_find_next_mbchar (string, seed, count, flags)
+ char *string;
+ int seed, count, flags;
+{
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ return _rl_find_next_mbchar_internal (string, seed, count, flags);
+#else
+ return (seed + count);
+#endif
+}
+
+/* Find previous character started byte point of the specified seed.
+ Returned point will be point <= seed. If flags is MB_FIND_NONZERO,
+ we look for non-zero-width multibyte characters. */
+#undef _rl_find_prev_mbchar
+int
+_rl_find_prev_mbchar (string, seed, flags)
+ char *string;
+ int seed, flags;
+{
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ return _rl_find_prev_mbchar_internal (string, seed, flags);
+#else
+ return ((seed == 0) ? seed : seed - 1);
+#endif
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/misc.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/misc.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d455832
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/misc.c
@@ -0,0 +1,601 @@
+/* misc.c -- miscellaneous bindable readline functions. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1987-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif /* HAVE_UNISTD_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STDLIB_H)
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif /* HAVE_STDLIB_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_LOCALE_H)
+# include <locale.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+/* System-specific feature definitions and include files. */
+#include "rldefs.h"
+#include "rlmbutil.h"
+
+/* Some standard library routines. */
+#include "readline.h"
+#include "history.h"
+
+#include "rlprivate.h"
+#include "rlshell.h"
+#include "xmalloc.h"
+
+static int rl_digit_loop PARAMS((void));
+static void _rl_history_set_point PARAMS((void));
+
+/* Forward declarations used in this file */
+void _rl_free_history_entry PARAMS((HIST_ENTRY *));
+
+/* If non-zero, rl_get_previous_history and rl_get_next_history attempt
+ to preserve the value of rl_point from line to line. */
+int _rl_history_preserve_point = 0;
+
+_rl_arg_cxt _rl_argcxt;
+
+/* Saved target point for when _rl_history_preserve_point is set. Special
+ value of -1 means that point is at the end of the line. */
+int _rl_history_saved_point = -1;
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Numeric Arguments */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+int
+_rl_arg_overflow ()
+{
+ if (rl_numeric_arg > 1000000)
+ {
+ _rl_argcxt = 0;
+ rl_explicit_arg = rl_numeric_arg = 0;
+ rl_ding ();
+ rl_restore_prompt ();
+ rl_clear_message ();
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_NUMERICARG);
+ return 1;
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+void
+_rl_arg_init ()
+{
+ rl_save_prompt ();
+ _rl_argcxt = 0;
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_NUMERICARG);
+}
+
+int
+_rl_arg_getchar ()
+{
+ int c;
+
+ rl_message ("(arg: %d) ", rl_arg_sign * rl_numeric_arg);
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+ c = rl_read_key ();
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+
+ return c;
+}
+
+/* Process C as part of the current numeric argument. Return -1 if the
+ argument should be aborted, 0 if we should not read any more chars, and
+ 1 if we should continue to read chars. */
+int
+_rl_arg_dispatch (cxt, c)
+ _rl_arg_cxt cxt;
+ int c;
+{
+ int key, r;
+
+ key = c;
+
+ /* If we see a key bound to `universal-argument' after seeing digits,
+ it ends the argument but is otherwise ignored. */
+ if (_rl_keymap[c].type == ISFUNC && _rl_keymap[c].function == rl_universal_argument)
+ {
+ if ((cxt & NUM_SAWDIGITS) == 0)
+ {
+ rl_numeric_arg *= 4;
+ return 1;
+ }
+ else if (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_CALLBACK))
+ {
+ _rl_argcxt |= NUM_READONE;
+ return 0; /* XXX */
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+ key = rl_read_key ();
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+ rl_restore_prompt ();
+ rl_clear_message ();
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_NUMERICARG);
+ return (_rl_dispatch (key, _rl_keymap));
+ }
+ }
+
+ c = UNMETA (c);
+
+ if (_rl_digit_p (c))
+ {
+ r = _rl_digit_value (c);
+ rl_numeric_arg = rl_explicit_arg ? (rl_numeric_arg * 10) + r : r;
+ rl_explicit_arg = 1;
+ _rl_argcxt |= NUM_SAWDIGITS;
+ }
+ else if (c == '-' && rl_explicit_arg == 0)
+ {
+ rl_numeric_arg = 1;
+ _rl_argcxt |= NUM_SAWMINUS;
+ rl_arg_sign = -1;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Make M-- command equivalent to M--1 command. */
+ if ((_rl_argcxt & NUM_SAWMINUS) && rl_numeric_arg == 1 && rl_explicit_arg == 0)
+ rl_explicit_arg = 1;
+ rl_restore_prompt ();
+ rl_clear_message ();
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_NUMERICARG);
+
+ r = _rl_dispatch (key, _rl_keymap);
+ if (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_CALLBACK))
+ {
+ /* At worst, this will cause an extra redisplay. Otherwise,
+ we have to wait until the next character comes in. */
+ if (rl_done == 0)
+ (*rl_redisplay_function) ();
+ r = 0;
+ }
+ return r;
+ }
+
+ return 1;
+}
+
+/* Handle C-u style numeric args, as well as M--, and M-digits. */
+static int
+rl_digit_loop ()
+{
+ int c, r;
+
+ while (1)
+ {
+ if (_rl_arg_overflow ())
+ return 1;
+
+ c = _rl_arg_getchar ();
+
+ if (c < 0)
+ {
+ _rl_abort_internal ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ r = _rl_arg_dispatch (_rl_argcxt, c);
+ if (r <= 0 || (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_NUMERICARG) == 0))
+ break;
+ }
+}
+
+/* Create a default argument. */
+void
+_rl_reset_argument ()
+{
+ rl_numeric_arg = rl_arg_sign = 1;
+ rl_explicit_arg = 0;
+ _rl_argcxt = 0;
+}
+
+/* Start a numeric argument with initial value KEY */
+int
+rl_digit_argument (ignore, key)
+ int ignore, key;
+{
+ _rl_arg_init ();
+ if (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_CALLBACK))
+ {
+ _rl_arg_dispatch (_rl_argcxt, key);
+ rl_message ("(arg: %d) ", rl_arg_sign * rl_numeric_arg);
+ return 0;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ rl_execute_next (key);
+ return (rl_digit_loop ());
+ }
+}
+
+/* C-u, universal argument. Multiply the current argument by 4.
+ Read a key. If the key has nothing to do with arguments, then
+ dispatch on it. If the key is the abort character then abort. */
+int
+rl_universal_argument (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ _rl_arg_init ();
+ rl_numeric_arg *= 4;
+
+ return (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_CALLBACK) ? 0 : rl_digit_loop ());
+}
+
+int
+_rl_arg_callback (cxt)
+ _rl_arg_cxt cxt;
+{
+ int c, r;
+
+ c = _rl_arg_getchar ();
+
+ if (_rl_argcxt & NUM_READONE)
+ {
+ _rl_argcxt &= ~NUM_READONE;
+ rl_restore_prompt ();
+ rl_clear_message ();
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_NUMERICARG);
+ rl_execute_next (c);
+ return 0;
+ }
+
+ r = _rl_arg_dispatch (cxt, c);
+ return (r != 1);
+}
+
+/* What to do when you abort reading an argument. */
+int
+rl_discard_argument ()
+{
+ rl_ding ();
+ rl_clear_message ();
+ _rl_reset_argument ();
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* History Utilities */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* We already have a history library, and that is what we use to control
+ the history features of readline. This is our local interface to
+ the history mechanism. */
+
+/* While we are editing the history, this is the saved
+ version of the original line. */
+HIST_ENTRY *_rl_saved_line_for_history = (HIST_ENTRY *)NULL;
+
+/* Set the history pointer back to the last entry in the history. */
+void
+_rl_start_using_history ()
+{
+ using_history ();
+ if (_rl_saved_line_for_history)
+ _rl_free_history_entry (_rl_saved_line_for_history);
+
+ _rl_saved_line_for_history = (HIST_ENTRY *)NULL;
+}
+
+/* Free the contents (and containing structure) of a HIST_ENTRY. */
+void
+_rl_free_history_entry (entry)
+ HIST_ENTRY *entry;
+{
+ if (entry == 0)
+ return;
+
+ FREE (entry->line);
+ FREE (entry->timestamp);
+
+ free (entry);
+}
+
+/* Perhaps put back the current line if it has changed. */
+int
+rl_maybe_replace_line ()
+{
+ HIST_ENTRY *temp;
+
+ temp = current_history ();
+ /* If the current line has changed, save the changes. */
+ if (temp && ((UNDO_LIST *)(temp->data) != rl_undo_list))
+ {
+ temp = replace_history_entry (where_history (), rl_line_buffer, (histdata_t)rl_undo_list);
+ free (temp->line);
+ FREE (temp->timestamp);
+ free (temp);
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Restore the _rl_saved_line_for_history if there is one. */
+int
+rl_maybe_unsave_line ()
+{
+ if (_rl_saved_line_for_history)
+ {
+ /* Can't call with `1' because rl_undo_list might point to an undo
+ list from a history entry, as in rl_replace_from_history() below. */
+ rl_replace_line (_rl_saved_line_for_history->line, 0);
+ rl_undo_list = (UNDO_LIST *)_rl_saved_line_for_history->data;
+ _rl_free_history_entry (_rl_saved_line_for_history);
+ _rl_saved_line_for_history = (HIST_ENTRY *)NULL;
+ rl_point = rl_end; /* rl_replace_line sets rl_end */
+ }
+ else
+ rl_ding ();
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Save the current line in _rl_saved_line_for_history. */
+int
+rl_maybe_save_line ()
+{
+ if (_rl_saved_line_for_history == 0)
+ {
+ _rl_saved_line_for_history = (HIST_ENTRY *)xmalloc (sizeof (HIST_ENTRY));
+ _rl_saved_line_for_history->line = savestring (rl_line_buffer);
+ _rl_saved_line_for_history->timestamp = (char *)NULL;
+ _rl_saved_line_for_history->data = (char *)rl_undo_list;
+ }
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+int
+_rl_free_saved_history_line ()
+{
+ if (_rl_saved_line_for_history)
+ {
+ _rl_free_history_entry (_rl_saved_line_for_history);
+ _rl_saved_line_for_history = (HIST_ENTRY *)NULL;
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+static void
+_rl_history_set_point ()
+{
+ rl_point = (_rl_history_preserve_point && _rl_history_saved_point != -1)
+ ? _rl_history_saved_point
+ : rl_end;
+ if (rl_point > rl_end)
+ rl_point = rl_end;
+
+#if defined (VI_MODE)
+ if (rl_editing_mode == vi_mode && _rl_keymap != vi_insertion_keymap)
+ rl_point = 0;
+#endif /* VI_MODE */
+
+ if (rl_editing_mode == emacs_mode)
+ rl_mark = (rl_point == rl_end ? 0 : rl_end);
+}
+
+void
+rl_replace_from_history (entry, flags)
+ HIST_ENTRY *entry;
+ int flags; /* currently unused */
+{
+ /* Can't call with `1' because rl_undo_list might point to an undo list
+ from a history entry, just like we're setting up here. */
+ rl_replace_line (entry->line, 0);
+ rl_undo_list = (UNDO_LIST *)entry->data;
+ rl_point = rl_end;
+ rl_mark = 0;
+
+#if defined (VI_MODE)
+ if (rl_editing_mode == vi_mode)
+ {
+ rl_point = 0;
+ rl_mark = rl_end;
+ }
+#endif
+}
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* History Commands */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* Meta-< goes to the start of the history. */
+int
+rl_beginning_of_history (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ return (rl_get_previous_history (1 + where_history (), key));
+}
+
+/* Meta-> goes to the end of the history. (The current line). */
+int
+rl_end_of_history (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ rl_maybe_replace_line ();
+ using_history ();
+ rl_maybe_unsave_line ();
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Move down to the next history line. */
+int
+rl_get_next_history (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ HIST_ENTRY *temp;
+
+ if (count < 0)
+ return (rl_get_previous_history (-count, key));
+
+ if (count == 0)
+ return 0;
+
+ rl_maybe_replace_line ();
+
+ /* either not saved by rl_newline or at end of line, so set appropriately. */
+ if (_rl_history_saved_point == -1 && (rl_point || rl_end))
+ _rl_history_saved_point = (rl_point == rl_end) ? -1 : rl_point;
+
+ temp = (HIST_ENTRY *)NULL;
+ while (count)
+ {
+ temp = next_history ();
+ if (!temp)
+ break;
+ --count;
+ }
+
+ if (temp == 0)
+ rl_maybe_unsave_line ();
+ else
+ {
+ rl_replace_from_history (temp, 0);
+ _rl_history_set_point ();
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Get the previous item out of our interactive history, making it the current
+ line. If there is no previous history, just ding. */
+int
+rl_get_previous_history (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ HIST_ENTRY *old_temp, *temp;
+
+ if (count < 0)
+ return (rl_get_next_history (-count, key));
+
+ if (count == 0)
+ return 0;
+
+ /* either not saved by rl_newline or at end of line, so set appropriately. */
+ if (_rl_history_saved_point == -1 && (rl_point || rl_end))
+ _rl_history_saved_point = (rl_point == rl_end) ? -1 : rl_point;
+
+ /* If we don't have a line saved, then save this one. */
+ rl_maybe_save_line ();
+
+ /* If the current line has changed, save the changes. */
+ rl_maybe_replace_line ();
+
+ temp = old_temp = (HIST_ENTRY *)NULL;
+ while (count)
+ {
+ temp = previous_history ();
+ if (temp == 0)
+ break;
+
+ old_temp = temp;
+ --count;
+ }
+
+ /* If there was a large argument, and we moved back to the start of the
+ history, that is not an error. So use the last value found. */
+ if (!temp && old_temp)
+ temp = old_temp;
+
+ if (temp == 0)
+ rl_ding ();
+ else
+ {
+ rl_replace_from_history (temp, 0);
+ _rl_history_set_point ();
+ }
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Editing Modes */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* How to toggle back and forth between editing modes. */
+int
+rl_vi_editing_mode (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+#if defined (VI_MODE)
+ _rl_set_insert_mode (RL_IM_INSERT, 1); /* vi mode ignores insert mode */
+ rl_editing_mode = vi_mode;
+ rl_vi_insertion_mode (1, key);
+#endif /* VI_MODE */
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+int
+rl_emacs_editing_mode (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ rl_editing_mode = emacs_mode;
+ _rl_set_insert_mode (RL_IM_INSERT, 1); /* emacs mode default is insert mode */
+ _rl_keymap = emacs_standard_keymap;
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Function for the rest of the library to use to set insert/overwrite mode. */
+void
+_rl_set_insert_mode (im, force)
+ int im, force;
+{
+#ifdef CURSOR_MODE
+ _rl_set_cursor (im, force);
+#endif
+
+ rl_insert_mode = im;
+}
+
+/* Toggle overwrite mode. A positive explicit argument selects overwrite
+ mode. A negative or zero explicit argument selects insert mode. */
+int
+rl_overwrite_mode (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ if (rl_explicit_arg == 0)
+ _rl_set_insert_mode (rl_insert_mode ^ 1, 0);
+ else if (count > 0)
+ _rl_set_insert_mode (RL_IM_OVERWRITE, 0);
+ else
+ _rl_set_insert_mode (RL_IM_INSERT, 0);
+
+ return 0;
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/nls.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/nls.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..bcee875
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/nls.c
@@ -0,0 +1,252 @@
+/* nls.c -- skeletal internationalization code. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1996 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif /* HAVE_UNISTD_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STDLIB_H)
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif /* HAVE_STDLIB_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_LOCALE_H)
+# include <locale.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <ctype.h>
+
+#include "rldefs.h"
+#include "readline.h"
+#include "rlshell.h"
+#include "rlprivate.h"
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_SETLOCALE)
+/* A list of legal values for the LANG or LC_CTYPE environment variables.
+ If a locale name in this list is the value for the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE,
+ or LANG environment variable (using the first of those with a value),
+ readline eight-bit mode is enabled. */
+static char *legal_lang_values[] =
+{
+ "iso88591",
+ "iso88592",
+ "iso88593",
+ "iso88594",
+ "iso88595",
+ "iso88596",
+ "iso88597",
+ "iso88598",
+ "iso88599",
+ "iso885910",
+ "koi8r",
+ 0
+};
+
+static char *normalize_codeset PARAMS((char *));
+static char *find_codeset PARAMS((char *, size_t *));
+#endif /* !HAVE_SETLOCALE */
+
+static char *_rl_get_locale_var PARAMS((const char *));
+
+static char *
+_rl_get_locale_var (v)
+ const char *v;
+{
+ char *lspec;
+
+ lspec = sh_get_env_value ("LC_ALL");
+ if (lspec == 0 || *lspec == 0)
+ lspec = sh_get_env_value (v);
+ if (lspec == 0 || *lspec == 0)
+ lspec = sh_get_env_value ("LANG");
+
+ return lspec;
+}
+
+/* Check for LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG and use the first with a value
+ to decide the defaults for 8-bit character input and output. Returns
+ 1 if we set eight-bit mode. */
+int
+_rl_init_eightbit ()
+{
+/* If we have setlocale(3), just check the current LC_CTYPE category
+ value, and go into eight-bit mode if it's not C or POSIX. */
+#if defined (HAVE_SETLOCALE)
+ char *lspec, *t;
+
+ /* Set the LC_CTYPE locale category from environment variables. */
+ lspec = _rl_get_locale_var ("LC_CTYPE");
+ /* Since _rl_get_locale_var queries the right environment variables,
+ we query the current locale settings with setlocale(), and, if
+ that doesn't return anything, we set lspec to the empty string to
+ force the subsequent call to setlocale() to define the `native'
+ environment. */
+ if (lspec == 0 || *lspec == 0)
+ lspec = setlocale (LC_CTYPE, (char *)NULL);
+ if (lspec == 0)
+ lspec = "";
+ t = setlocale (LC_CTYPE, lspec);
+
+ if (t && *t && (t[0] != 'C' || t[1]) && (STREQ (t, "POSIX") == 0))
+ {
+ _rl_meta_flag = 1;
+ _rl_convert_meta_chars_to_ascii = 0;
+ _rl_output_meta_chars = 1;
+ return (1);
+ }
+ else
+ return (0);
+
+#else /* !HAVE_SETLOCALE */
+ char *lspec, *t;
+ int i;
+
+ /* We don't have setlocale. Finesse it. Check the environment for the
+ appropriate variables and set eight-bit mode if they have the right
+ values. */
+ lspec = _rl_get_locale_var ("LC_CTYPE");
+
+ if (lspec == 0 || (t = normalize_codeset (lspec)) == 0)
+ return (0);
+ for (i = 0; t && legal_lang_values[i]; i++)
+ if (STREQ (t, legal_lang_values[i]))
+ {
+ _rl_meta_flag = 1;
+ _rl_convert_meta_chars_to_ascii = 0;
+ _rl_output_meta_chars = 1;
+ break;
+ }
+ free (t);
+ return (legal_lang_values[i] ? 1 : 0);
+
+#endif /* !HAVE_SETLOCALE */
+}
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_SETLOCALE)
+static char *
+normalize_codeset (codeset)
+ char *codeset;
+{
+ size_t namelen, i;
+ int len, all_digits;
+ char *wp, *retval;
+
+ codeset = find_codeset (codeset, &namelen);
+
+ if (codeset == 0)
+ return (codeset);
+
+ all_digits = 1;
+ for (len = 0, i = 0; i < namelen; i++)
+ {
+ if (ISALNUM ((unsigned char)codeset[i]))
+ {
+ len++;
+ all_digits &= _rl_digit_p (codeset[i]);
+ }
+ }
+
+ retval = (char *)malloc ((all_digits ? 3 : 0) + len + 1);
+ if (retval == 0)
+ return ((char *)0);
+
+ wp = retval;
+ /* Add `iso' to beginning of an all-digit codeset */
+ if (all_digits)
+ {
+ *wp++ = 'i';
+ *wp++ = 's';
+ *wp++ = 'o';
+ }
+
+ for (i = 0; i < namelen; i++)
+ if (ISALPHA ((unsigned char)codeset[i]))
+ *wp++ = _rl_to_lower (codeset[i]);
+ else if (_rl_digit_p (codeset[i]))
+ *wp++ = codeset[i];
+ *wp = '\0';
+
+ return retval;
+}
+
+/* Isolate codeset portion of locale specification. */
+static char *
+find_codeset (name, lenp)
+ char *name;
+ size_t *lenp;
+{
+ char *cp, *language, *result;
+
+ cp = language = name;
+ result = (char *)0;
+
+ while (*cp && *cp != '_' && *cp != '@' && *cp != '+' && *cp != ',')
+ cp++;
+
+ /* This does not make sense: language has to be specified. As
+ an exception we allow the variable to contain only the codeset
+ name. Perhaps there are funny codeset names. */
+ if (language == cp)
+ {
+ *lenp = strlen (language);
+ result = language;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Next is the territory. */
+ if (*cp == '_')
+ do
+ ++cp;
+ while (*cp && *cp != '.' && *cp != '@' && *cp != '+' && *cp != ',' && *cp != '_');
+
+ /* Now, finally, is the codeset. */
+ result = cp;
+ if (*cp == '.')
+ do
+ ++cp;
+ while (*cp && *cp != '@');
+
+ if (cp - result > 2)
+ {
+ result++;
+ *lenp = cp - result;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ *lenp = strlen (language);
+ result = language;
+ }
+ }
+
+ return result;
+}
+#endif /* !HAVE_SETLOCALE */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/parens.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/parens.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..737f767
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/parens.c
@@ -0,0 +1,183 @@
+/* parens.c -- Implementation of matching parentheses feature. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1987, 1989, 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#if defined (__TANDEM)
+# include <floss.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "rlconf.h"
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (FD_SET) && !defined (HAVE_SELECT)
+# define HAVE_SELECT
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_SELECT)
+# include <sys/time.h>
+#endif /* HAVE_SELECT */
+#if defined (HAVE_SYS_SELECT_H)
+# include <sys/select.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STRING_H)
+# include <string.h>
+#else /* !HAVE_STRING_H */
+# include <strings.h>
+#endif /* !HAVE_STRING_H */
+
+#if !defined (strchr) && !defined (__STDC__)
+extern char *strchr (), *strrchr ();
+#endif /* !strchr && !__STDC__ */
+
+#include "readline.h"
+#include "rlprivate.h"
+
+static int find_matching_open PARAMS((char *, int, int));
+
+/* Non-zero means try to blink the matching open parenthesis when the
+ close parenthesis is inserted. */
+#if defined (HAVE_SELECT)
+int rl_blink_matching_paren = 1;
+#else /* !HAVE_SELECT */
+int rl_blink_matching_paren = 0;
+#endif /* !HAVE_SELECT */
+
+static int _paren_blink_usec = 500000;
+
+/* Change emacs_standard_keymap to have bindings for paren matching when
+ ON_OR_OFF is 1, change them back to self_insert when ON_OR_OFF == 0. */
+void
+_rl_enable_paren_matching (on_or_off)
+ int on_or_off;
+{
+ if (on_or_off)
+ { /* ([{ */
+ rl_bind_key_in_map (')', rl_insert_close, emacs_standard_keymap);
+ rl_bind_key_in_map (']', rl_insert_close, emacs_standard_keymap);
+ rl_bind_key_in_map ('}', rl_insert_close, emacs_standard_keymap);
+ }
+ else
+ { /* ([{ */
+ rl_bind_key_in_map (')', rl_insert, emacs_standard_keymap);
+ rl_bind_key_in_map (']', rl_insert, emacs_standard_keymap);
+ rl_bind_key_in_map ('}', rl_insert, emacs_standard_keymap);
+ }
+}
+
+int
+rl_set_paren_blink_timeout (u)
+ int u;
+{
+ int o;
+
+ o = _paren_blink_usec;
+ if (u > 0)
+ _paren_blink_usec = u;
+ return (o);
+}
+
+int
+rl_insert_close (count, invoking_key)
+ int count, invoking_key;
+{
+ if (rl_explicit_arg || !rl_blink_matching_paren)
+ _rl_insert_char (count, invoking_key);
+ else
+ {
+#if defined (HAVE_SELECT)
+ int orig_point, match_point, ready;
+ struct timeval timer;
+ fd_set readfds;
+
+ _rl_insert_char (1, invoking_key);
+ (*rl_redisplay_function) ();
+ match_point =
+ find_matching_open (rl_line_buffer, rl_point - 2, invoking_key);
+
+ /* Emacs might message or ring the bell here, but I don't. */
+ if (match_point < 0)
+ return -1;
+
+ FD_ZERO (&readfds);
+ FD_SET (fileno (rl_instream), &readfds);
+ timer.tv_sec = 0;
+ timer.tv_usec = _paren_blink_usec;
+
+ orig_point = rl_point;
+ rl_point = match_point;
+ (*rl_redisplay_function) ();
+ ready = select (1, &readfds, (fd_set *)NULL, (fd_set *)NULL, &timer);
+ rl_point = orig_point;
+#else /* !HAVE_SELECT */
+ _rl_insert_char (count, invoking_key);
+#endif /* !HAVE_SELECT */
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+static int
+find_matching_open (string, from, closer)
+ char *string;
+ int from, closer;
+{
+ register int i;
+ int opener, level, delimiter;
+
+ switch (closer)
+ {
+ case ']': opener = '['; break;
+ case '}': opener = '{'; break;
+ case ')': opener = '('; break;
+ default:
+ return (-1);
+ }
+
+ level = 1; /* The closer passed in counts as 1. */
+ delimiter = 0; /* Delimited state unknown. */
+
+ for (i = from; i > -1; i--)
+ {
+ if (delimiter && (string[i] == delimiter))
+ delimiter = 0;
+ else if (rl_basic_quote_characters && strchr (rl_basic_quote_characters, string[i]))
+ delimiter = string[i];
+ else if (!delimiter && (string[i] == closer))
+ level++;
+ else if (!delimiter && (string[i] == opener))
+ level--;
+
+ if (!level)
+ break;
+ }
+ return (i);
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/posixdir.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/posixdir.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..91f6d96
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/posixdir.h
@@ -0,0 +1,61 @@
+/* posixdir.h -- Posix directory reading includes and defines. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1987,1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT
+ ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY
+ or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public
+ License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
+ Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+/* This file should be included instead of <dirent.h> or <sys/dir.h>. */
+
+#if !defined (_POSIXDIR_H_)
+#define _POSIXDIR_H_
+
+#if defined (HAVE_DIRENT_H)
+# include <dirent.h>
+# if defined (HAVE_STRUCT_DIRENT_D_NAMLEN)
+# define D_NAMLEN(d) ((d)->d_namlen)
+# else
+# define D_NAMLEN(d) (strlen ((d)->d_name))
+# endif /* !HAVE_STRUCT_DIRENT_D_NAMLEN */
+#else
+# if defined (HAVE_SYS_NDIR_H)
+# include <sys/ndir.h>
+# endif
+# if defined (HAVE_SYS_DIR_H)
+# include <sys/dir.h>
+# endif
+# if defined (HAVE_NDIR_H)
+# include <ndir.h>
+# endif
+# if !defined (dirent)
+# define dirent direct
+# endif /* !dirent */
+# define D_NAMLEN(d) ((d)->d_namlen)
+#endif /* !HAVE_DIRENT_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STRUCT_DIRENT_D_INO) && !defined (HAVE_STRUCT_DIRENT_D_FILENO)
+# define d_fileno d_ino
+#endif
+
+#if defined (_POSIX_SOURCE) && (!defined (HAVE_STRUCT_DIRENT_D_INO) || defined (BROKEN_DIRENT_D_INO))
+/* Posix does not require that the d_ino field be present, and some
+ systems do not provide it. */
+# define REAL_DIR_ENTRY(dp) 1
+#else
+# define REAL_DIR_ENTRY(dp) (dp->d_ino != 0)
+#endif /* _POSIX_SOURCE */
+
+#endif /* !_POSIXDIR_H_ */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/posixjmp.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/posixjmp.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b52aa00
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/posixjmp.h
@@ -0,0 +1,40 @@
+/* posixjmp.h -- wrapper for setjmp.h with changes for POSIX systems. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1987,1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT
+ ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY
+ or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public
+ License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
+ Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#ifndef _POSIXJMP_H_
+#define _POSIXJMP_H_
+
+#include <setjmp.h>
+
+/* This *must* be included *after* config.h */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_POSIX_SIGSETJMP)
+# define procenv_t sigjmp_buf
+# if !defined (__OPENNT)
+# undef setjmp
+# define setjmp(x) sigsetjmp((x), 1)
+# undef longjmp
+# define longjmp(x, n) siglongjmp((x), (n))
+# endif /* !__OPENNT */
+#else
+# define procenv_t jmp_buf
+#endif
+
+#endif /* _POSIXJMP_H_ */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/posixstat.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/posixstat.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c93b528
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/posixstat.h
@@ -0,0 +1,142 @@
+/* posixstat.h -- Posix stat(2) definitions for systems that
+ don't have them. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1987,1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT
+ ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY
+ or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public
+ License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
+ Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+/* This file should be included instead of <sys/stat.h>.
+ It relies on the local sys/stat.h to work though. */
+#if !defined (_POSIXSTAT_H_)
+#define _POSIXSTAT_H_
+
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+
+#if defined (STAT_MACROS_BROKEN)
+# undef S_ISBLK
+# undef S_ISCHR
+# undef S_ISDIR
+# undef S_ISFIFO
+# undef S_ISREG
+# undef S_ISLNK
+#endif /* STAT_MACROS_BROKEN */
+
+/* These are guaranteed to work only on isc386 */
+#if !defined (S_IFDIR) && !defined (S_ISDIR)
+# define S_IFDIR 0040000
+#endif /* !S_IFDIR && !S_ISDIR */
+#if !defined (S_IFMT)
+# define S_IFMT 0170000
+#endif /* !S_IFMT */
+
+/* Posix 1003.1 5.6.1.1 <sys/stat.h> file types */
+
+/* Some Posix-wannabe systems define _S_IF* macros instead of S_IF*, but
+ do not provide the S_IS* macros that Posix requires. */
+
+#if defined (_S_IFMT) && !defined (S_IFMT)
+#define S_IFMT _S_IFMT
+#endif
+#if defined (_S_IFIFO) && !defined (S_IFIFO)
+#define S_IFIFO _S_IFIFO
+#endif
+#if defined (_S_IFCHR) && !defined (S_IFCHR)
+#define S_IFCHR _S_IFCHR
+#endif
+#if defined (_S_IFDIR) && !defined (S_IFDIR)
+#define S_IFDIR _S_IFDIR
+#endif
+#if defined (_S_IFBLK) && !defined (S_IFBLK)
+#define S_IFBLK _S_IFBLK
+#endif
+#if defined (_S_IFREG) && !defined (S_IFREG)
+#define S_IFREG _S_IFREG
+#endif
+#if defined (_S_IFLNK) && !defined (S_IFLNK)
+#define S_IFLNK _S_IFLNK
+#endif
+#if defined (_S_IFSOCK) && !defined (S_IFSOCK)
+#define S_IFSOCK _S_IFSOCK
+#endif
+
+/* Test for each symbol individually and define the ones necessary (some
+ systems claiming Posix compatibility define some but not all). */
+
+#if defined (S_IFBLK) && !defined (S_ISBLK)
+#define S_ISBLK(m) (((m)&S_IFMT) == S_IFBLK) /* block device */
+#endif
+
+#if defined (S_IFCHR) && !defined (S_ISCHR)
+#define S_ISCHR(m) (((m)&S_IFMT) == S_IFCHR) /* character device */
+#endif
+
+#if defined (S_IFDIR) && !defined (S_ISDIR)
+#define S_ISDIR(m) (((m)&S_IFMT) == S_IFDIR) /* directory */
+#endif
+
+#if defined (S_IFREG) && !defined (S_ISREG)
+#define S_ISREG(m) (((m)&S_IFMT) == S_IFREG) /* file */
+#endif
+
+#if defined (S_IFIFO) && !defined (S_ISFIFO)
+#define S_ISFIFO(m) (((m)&S_IFMT) == S_IFIFO) /* fifo - named pipe */
+#endif
+
+#if defined (S_IFLNK) && !defined (S_ISLNK)
+#define S_ISLNK(m) (((m)&S_IFMT) == S_IFLNK) /* symbolic link */
+#endif
+
+#if defined (S_IFSOCK) && !defined (S_ISSOCK)
+#define S_ISSOCK(m) (((m)&S_IFMT) == S_IFSOCK) /* socket */
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * POSIX 1003.1 5.6.1.2 <sys/stat.h> File Modes
+ */
+
+#if !defined (S_IRWXU)
+# if !defined (S_IREAD)
+# define S_IREAD 00400
+# define S_IWRITE 00200
+# define S_IEXEC 00100
+# endif /* S_IREAD */
+
+# if !defined (S_IRUSR)
+# define S_IRUSR S_IREAD /* read, owner */
+# define S_IWUSR S_IWRITE /* write, owner */
+# define S_IXUSR S_IEXEC /* execute, owner */
+
+# define S_IRGRP (S_IREAD >> 3) /* read, group */
+# define S_IWGRP (S_IWRITE >> 3) /* write, group */
+# define S_IXGRP (S_IEXEC >> 3) /* execute, group */
+
+# define S_IROTH (S_IREAD >> 6) /* read, other */
+# define S_IWOTH (S_IWRITE >> 6) /* write, other */
+# define S_IXOTH (S_IEXEC >> 6) /* execute, other */
+# endif /* !S_IRUSR */
+
+# define S_IRWXU (S_IRUSR | S_IWUSR | S_IXUSR)
+# define S_IRWXG (S_IRGRP | S_IWGRP | S_IXGRP)
+# define S_IRWXO (S_IROTH | S_IWOTH | S_IXOTH)
+#endif /* !S_IRWXU */
+
+/* These are non-standard, but are used in builtins.c$symbolic_umask() */
+#define S_IRUGO (S_IRUSR | S_IRGRP | S_IROTH)
+#define S_IWUGO (S_IWUSR | S_IWGRP | S_IWOTH)
+#define S_IXUGO (S_IXUSR | S_IXGRP | S_IXOTH)
+
+#endif /* _POSIXSTAT_H_ */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/readline.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/readline.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5e9767a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/readline.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1194 @@
+/* readline.c -- a general facility for reading lines of input
+ with emacs style editing and completion. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1987-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include "posixstat.h"
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#if defined (HAVE_SYS_FILE_H)
+# include <sys/file.h>
+#endif /* HAVE_SYS_FILE_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif /* HAVE_UNISTD_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STDLIB_H)
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif /* HAVE_STDLIB_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_LOCALE_H)
+# include <locale.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include "posixjmp.h"
+
+/* System-specific feature definitions and include files. */
+#include "rldefs.h"
+#include "rlmbutil.h"
+
+#if defined (__EMX__)
+# define INCL_DOSPROCESS
+# include <os2.h>
+#endif /* __EMX__ */
+
+/* Some standard library routines. */
+#include "readline.h"
+#include "history.h"
+
+#include "rlprivate.h"
+#include "rlshell.h"
+#include "xmalloc.h"
+
+#ifndef RL_LIBRARY_VERSION
+# define RL_LIBRARY_VERSION "5.1"
+#endif
+
+#ifndef RL_READLINE_VERSION
+# define RL_READLINE_VERSION 0x0501
+#endif
+
+extern void _rl_free_history_entry PARAMS((HIST_ENTRY *));
+
+/* Forward declarations used in this file. */
+static char *readline_internal PARAMS((void));
+static void readline_initialize_everything PARAMS((void));
+
+static void bind_arrow_keys_internal PARAMS((Keymap));
+static void bind_arrow_keys PARAMS((void));
+
+static void readline_default_bindings PARAMS((void));
+static void reset_default_bindings PARAMS((void));
+
+static int _rl_subseq_result PARAMS((int, Keymap, int, int));
+static int _rl_subseq_getchar PARAMS((int));
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Line editing input utility */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+const char *rl_library_version = RL_LIBRARY_VERSION;
+
+int rl_readline_version = RL_READLINE_VERSION;
+
+/* True if this is `real' readline as opposed to some stub substitute. */
+int rl_gnu_readline_p = 1;
+
+/* A pointer to the keymap that is currently in use.
+ By default, it is the standard emacs keymap. */
+Keymap _rl_keymap = emacs_standard_keymap;
+
+
+/* The current style of editing. */
+int rl_editing_mode = emacs_mode;
+
+/* The current insert mode: input (the default) or overwrite */
+int rl_insert_mode = RL_IM_DEFAULT;
+
+/* Non-zero if we called this function from _rl_dispatch(). It's present
+ so functions can find out whether they were called from a key binding
+ or directly from an application. */
+int rl_dispatching;
+
+/* Non-zero if the previous command was a kill command. */
+int _rl_last_command_was_kill = 0;
+
+/* The current value of the numeric argument specified by the user. */
+int rl_numeric_arg = 1;
+
+/* Non-zero if an argument was typed. */
+int rl_explicit_arg = 0;
+
+/* Temporary value used while generating the argument. */
+int rl_arg_sign = 1;
+
+/* Non-zero means we have been called at least once before. */
+static int rl_initialized;
+
+#if 0
+/* If non-zero, this program is running in an EMACS buffer. */
+static int running_in_emacs;
+#endif
+
+/* Flags word encapsulating the current readline state. */
+int rl_readline_state = RL_STATE_NONE;
+
+/* The current offset in the current input line. */
+int rl_point;
+
+/* Mark in the current input line. */
+int rl_mark;
+
+/* Length of the current input line. */
+int rl_end;
+
+/* Make this non-zero to return the current input_line. */
+int rl_done;
+
+/* The last function executed by readline. */
+rl_command_func_t *rl_last_func = (rl_command_func_t *)NULL;
+
+/* Top level environment for readline_internal (). */
+procenv_t readline_top_level;
+
+/* The streams we interact with. */
+FILE *_rl_in_stream, *_rl_out_stream;
+
+/* The names of the streams that we do input and output to. */
+FILE *rl_instream = (FILE *)NULL;
+FILE *rl_outstream = (FILE *)NULL;
+
+/* Non-zero means echo characters as they are read. Defaults to no echo;
+ set to 1 if there is a controlling terminal, we can get its attributes,
+ and the attributes include `echo'. Look at rltty.c:prepare_terminal_settings
+ for the code that sets it. */
+int readline_echoing_p = 0;
+
+/* Current prompt. */
+char *rl_prompt = (char *)NULL;
+int rl_visible_prompt_length = 0;
+
+/* Set to non-zero by calling application if it has already printed rl_prompt
+ and does not want readline to do it the first time. */
+int rl_already_prompted = 0;
+
+/* The number of characters read in order to type this complete command. */
+int rl_key_sequence_length = 0;
+
+/* If non-zero, then this is the address of a function to call just
+ before readline_internal_setup () prints the first prompt. */
+rl_hook_func_t *rl_startup_hook = (rl_hook_func_t *)NULL;
+
+/* If non-zero, this is the address of a function to call just before
+ readline_internal_setup () returns and readline_internal starts
+ reading input characters. */
+rl_hook_func_t *rl_pre_input_hook = (rl_hook_func_t *)NULL;
+
+/* What we use internally. You should always refer to RL_LINE_BUFFER. */
+static char *the_line;
+
+/* The character that can generate an EOF. Really read from
+ the terminal driver... just defaulted here. */
+int _rl_eof_char = CTRL ('D');
+
+/* Non-zero makes this the next keystroke to read. */
+int rl_pending_input = 0;
+
+/* Pointer to a useful terminal name. */
+const char *rl_terminal_name = (const char *)NULL;
+
+/* Non-zero means to always use horizontal scrolling in line display. */
+int _rl_horizontal_scroll_mode = 0;
+
+/* Non-zero means to display an asterisk at the starts of history lines
+ which have been modified. */
+int _rl_mark_modified_lines = 0;
+
+/* The style of `bell' notification preferred. This can be set to NO_BELL,
+ AUDIBLE_BELL, or VISIBLE_BELL. */
+int _rl_bell_preference = AUDIBLE_BELL;
+
+/* String inserted into the line by rl_insert_comment (). */
+char *_rl_comment_begin;
+
+/* Keymap holding the function currently being executed. */
+Keymap rl_executing_keymap;
+
+/* Keymap we're currently using to dispatch. */
+Keymap _rl_dispatching_keymap;
+
+/* Non-zero means to erase entire line, including prompt, on empty input lines. */
+int rl_erase_empty_line = 0;
+
+/* Non-zero means to read only this many characters rather than up to a
+ character bound to accept-line. */
+int rl_num_chars_to_read;
+
+/* Line buffer and maintenence. */
+char *rl_line_buffer = (char *)NULL;
+int rl_line_buffer_len = 0;
+
+/* Key sequence `contexts' */
+_rl_keyseq_cxt *_rl_kscxt = 0;
+
+/* Forward declarations used by the display, termcap, and history code. */
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* `Forward' declarations */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* Non-zero means do not parse any lines other than comments and
+ parser directives. */
+unsigned char _rl_parsing_conditionalized_out = 0;
+
+/* Non-zero means to convert characters with the meta bit set to
+ escape-prefixed characters so we can indirect through
+ emacs_meta_keymap or vi_escape_keymap. */
+int _rl_convert_meta_chars_to_ascii = 1;
+
+/* Non-zero means to output characters with the meta bit set directly
+ rather than as a meta-prefixed escape sequence. */
+int _rl_output_meta_chars = 0;
+
+/* Non-zero means to look at the termios special characters and bind
+ them to equivalent readline functions at startup. */
+int _rl_bind_stty_chars = 1;
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Top Level Functions */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* Non-zero means treat 0200 bit in terminal input as Meta bit. */
+int _rl_meta_flag = 0; /* Forward declaration */
+
+/* Set up the prompt and expand it. Called from readline() and
+ rl_callback_handler_install (). */
+int
+rl_set_prompt (prompt)
+ const char *prompt;
+{
+ FREE (rl_prompt);
+ rl_prompt = prompt ? savestring (prompt) : (char *)NULL;
+
+ rl_visible_prompt_length = rl_expand_prompt (rl_prompt);
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Read a line of input. Prompt with PROMPT. An empty PROMPT means
+ none. A return value of NULL means that EOF was encountered. */
+char *
+readline (prompt)
+ const char *prompt;
+{
+ char *value;
+
+ /* If we are at EOF return a NULL string. */
+ if (rl_pending_input == EOF)
+ {
+ rl_clear_pending_input ();
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+ }
+
+ rl_set_prompt (prompt);
+
+ rl_initialize ();
+ if (rl_prep_term_function)
+ (*rl_prep_term_function) (_rl_meta_flag);
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_SIGNALS)
+ rl_set_signals ();
+#endif
+
+ value = readline_internal ();
+ if (rl_deprep_term_function)
+ (*rl_deprep_term_function) ();
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_SIGNALS)
+ rl_clear_signals ();
+#endif
+
+ return (value);
+}
+
+#if defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+# define STATIC_CALLBACK
+#else
+# define STATIC_CALLBACK static
+#endif
+
+STATIC_CALLBACK void
+readline_internal_setup ()
+{
+ char *nprompt;
+
+ _rl_in_stream = rl_instream;
+ _rl_out_stream = rl_outstream;
+
+ if (rl_startup_hook)
+ (*rl_startup_hook) ();
+
+ /* If we're not echoing, we still want to at least print a prompt, because
+ rl_redisplay will not do it for us. If the calling application has a
+ custom redisplay function, though, let that function handle it. */
+ if (readline_echoing_p == 0 && rl_redisplay_function == rl_redisplay)
+ {
+ if (rl_prompt && rl_already_prompted == 0)
+ {
+ nprompt = _rl_strip_prompt (rl_prompt);
+ fprintf (_rl_out_stream, "%s", nprompt);
+ fflush (_rl_out_stream);
+ free (nprompt);
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if (rl_prompt && rl_already_prompted)
+ rl_on_new_line_with_prompt ();
+ else
+ rl_on_new_line ();
+ (*rl_redisplay_function) ();
+ }
+
+#if defined (VI_MODE)
+ if (rl_editing_mode == vi_mode)
+ rl_vi_insertion_mode (1, 'i');
+#endif /* VI_MODE */
+
+ if (rl_pre_input_hook)
+ (*rl_pre_input_hook) ();
+}
+
+STATIC_CALLBACK char *
+readline_internal_teardown (eof)
+ int eof;
+{
+ char *temp;
+ HIST_ENTRY *entry;
+
+ /* Restore the original of this history line, iff the line that we
+ are editing was originally in the history, AND the line has changed. */
+ entry = current_history ();
+
+ if (entry && rl_undo_list)
+ {
+ temp = savestring (the_line);
+ rl_revert_line (1, 0);
+ entry = replace_history_entry (where_history (), the_line, (histdata_t)NULL);
+ _rl_free_history_entry (entry);
+
+ strcpy (the_line, temp);
+ free (temp);
+ }
+
+ /* At any rate, it is highly likely that this line has an undo list. Get
+ rid of it now. */
+ if (rl_undo_list)
+ rl_free_undo_list ();
+
+ /* Restore normal cursor, if available. */
+ _rl_set_insert_mode (RL_IM_INSERT, 0);
+
+ return (eof ? (char *)NULL : savestring (the_line));
+}
+
+void
+_rl_internal_char_cleanup ()
+{
+#if defined (VI_MODE)
+ /* In vi mode, when you exit insert mode, the cursor moves back
+ over the previous character. We explicitly check for that here. */
+ if (rl_editing_mode == vi_mode && _rl_keymap == vi_movement_keymap)
+ rl_vi_check ();
+#endif /* VI_MODE */
+
+ if (rl_num_chars_to_read && rl_end >= rl_num_chars_to_read)
+ {
+ (*rl_redisplay_function) ();
+ _rl_want_redisplay = 0;
+ rl_newline (1, '\n');
+ }
+
+ if (rl_done == 0)
+ {
+ (*rl_redisplay_function) ();
+ _rl_want_redisplay = 0;
+ }
+
+ /* If the application writer has told us to erase the entire line if
+ the only character typed was something bound to rl_newline, do so. */
+ if (rl_erase_empty_line && rl_done && rl_last_func == rl_newline &&
+ rl_point == 0 && rl_end == 0)
+ _rl_erase_entire_line ();
+}
+
+STATIC_CALLBACK int
+#if defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+readline_internal_char ()
+#else
+readline_internal_charloop ()
+#endif
+{
+ static int lastc, eof_found;
+ int c, code, lk;
+
+ lastc = -1;
+ eof_found = 0;
+
+#if !defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+ while (rl_done == 0)
+ {
+#endif
+ lk = _rl_last_command_was_kill;
+
+ code = setjmp (readline_top_level);
+
+ if (code)
+ {
+ (*rl_redisplay_function) ();
+ _rl_want_redisplay = 0;
+ /* If we get here, we're not being called from something dispatched
+ from _rl_callback_read_char(), which sets up its own value of
+ readline_top_level (saving and restoring the old, of course), so
+ we can just return here. */
+ if (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_CALLBACK))
+ return (0);
+ }
+
+ if (rl_pending_input == 0)
+ {
+ /* Then initialize the argument and number of keys read. */
+ _rl_reset_argument ();
+ rl_key_sequence_length = 0;
+ }
+
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_READCMD);
+ c = rl_read_key ();
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_READCMD);
+
+ /* EOF typed to a non-blank line is a <NL>. */
+ if (c == EOF && rl_end)
+ c = NEWLINE;
+
+ /* The character _rl_eof_char typed to blank line, and not as the
+ previous character is interpreted as EOF. */
+ if (((c == _rl_eof_char && lastc != c) || c == EOF) && !rl_end)
+ {
+#if defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_DONE);
+ return (rl_done = 1);
+#else
+ eof_found = 1;
+ break;
+#endif
+ }
+
+ lastc = c;
+ _rl_dispatch ((unsigned char)c, _rl_keymap);
+
+ /* If there was no change in _rl_last_command_was_kill, then no kill
+ has taken place. Note that if input is pending we are reading
+ a prefix command, so nothing has changed yet. */
+ if (rl_pending_input == 0 && lk == _rl_last_command_was_kill)
+ _rl_last_command_was_kill = 0;
+
+ _rl_internal_char_cleanup ();
+
+#if defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+ return 0;
+#else
+ }
+
+ return (eof_found);
+#endif
+}
+
+#if defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+static int
+readline_internal_charloop ()
+{
+ int eof = 1;
+
+ while (rl_done == 0)
+ eof = readline_internal_char ();
+ return (eof);
+}
+#endif /* READLINE_CALLBACKS */
+
+/* Read a line of input from the global rl_instream, doing output on
+ the global rl_outstream.
+ If rl_prompt is non-null, then that is our prompt. */
+static char *
+readline_internal ()
+{
+ int eof;
+
+ readline_internal_setup ();
+ eof = readline_internal_charloop ();
+ return (readline_internal_teardown (eof));
+}
+
+void
+_rl_init_line_state ()
+{
+ rl_point = rl_end = rl_mark = 0;
+ the_line = rl_line_buffer;
+ the_line[0] = 0;
+}
+
+void
+_rl_set_the_line ()
+{
+ the_line = rl_line_buffer;
+}
+
+#if defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+_rl_keyseq_cxt *
+_rl_keyseq_cxt_alloc ()
+{
+ _rl_keyseq_cxt *cxt;
+
+ cxt = (_rl_keyseq_cxt *)xmalloc (sizeof (_rl_keyseq_cxt));
+
+ cxt->flags = cxt->subseq_arg = cxt->subseq_retval = 0;
+
+ cxt->okey = 0;
+ cxt->ocxt = _rl_kscxt;
+ cxt->childval = 42; /* sentinel value */
+
+ return cxt;
+}
+
+void
+_rl_keyseq_cxt_dispose (cxt)
+ _rl_keyseq_cxt *cxt;
+{
+ free (cxt);
+}
+
+void
+_rl_keyseq_chain_dispose ()
+{
+ _rl_keyseq_cxt *cxt;
+
+ while (_rl_kscxt)
+ {
+ cxt = _rl_kscxt;
+ _rl_kscxt = _rl_kscxt->ocxt;
+ _rl_keyseq_cxt_dispose (cxt);
+ }
+}
+#endif
+
+static int
+_rl_subseq_getchar (key)
+ int key;
+{
+ int k;
+
+ if (key == ESC)
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_METANEXT);
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+ k = rl_read_key ();
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+ if (key == ESC)
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_METANEXT);
+
+ return k;
+}
+
+#if defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+int
+_rl_dispatch_callback (cxt)
+ _rl_keyseq_cxt *cxt;
+{
+ int nkey, r;
+
+ /* For now */
+#if 1
+ /* The first time this context is used, we want to read input and dispatch
+ on it. When traversing the chain of contexts back `up', we want to use
+ the value from the next context down. We're simulating recursion using
+ a chain of contexts. */
+ if ((cxt->flags & KSEQ_DISPATCHED) == 0)
+ {
+ nkey = _rl_subseq_getchar (cxt->okey);
+ r = _rl_dispatch_subseq (nkey, cxt->dmap, cxt->subseq_arg);
+ cxt->flags |= KSEQ_DISPATCHED;
+ }
+ else
+ r = cxt->childval;
+#else
+ r = _rl_dispatch_subseq (nkey, cxt->dmap, cxt->subseq_arg);
+#endif
+
+ /* For now */
+ r = _rl_subseq_result (r, cxt->oldmap, cxt->okey, (cxt->flags & KSEQ_SUBSEQ));
+
+ if (r == 0) /* success! */
+ {
+ _rl_keyseq_chain_dispose ();
+ RL_UNSETSTATE (RL_STATE_MULTIKEY);
+ return r;
+ }
+
+ if (r != -3) /* magic value that says we added to the chain */
+ _rl_kscxt = cxt->ocxt;
+ if (_rl_kscxt)
+ _rl_kscxt->childval = r;
+ if (r != -3)
+ _rl_keyseq_cxt_dispose (cxt);
+
+ return r;
+}
+#endif /* READLINE_CALLBACKS */
+
+/* Do the command associated with KEY in MAP.
+ If the associated command is really a keymap, then read
+ another key, and dispatch into that map. */
+int
+_rl_dispatch (key, map)
+ register int key;
+ Keymap map;
+{
+ _rl_dispatching_keymap = map;
+ return _rl_dispatch_subseq (key, map, 0);
+}
+
+int
+_rl_dispatch_subseq (key, map, got_subseq)
+ register int key;
+ Keymap map;
+ int got_subseq;
+{
+ int r, newkey;
+ char *macro;
+ rl_command_func_t *func;
+#if defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+ _rl_keyseq_cxt *cxt;
+#endif
+
+ if (META_CHAR (key) && _rl_convert_meta_chars_to_ascii)
+ {
+ if (map[ESC].type == ISKMAP)
+ {
+ if (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_MACRODEF))
+ _rl_add_macro_char (ESC);
+ map = FUNCTION_TO_KEYMAP (map, ESC);
+ key = UNMETA (key);
+ rl_key_sequence_length += 2;
+ return (_rl_dispatch (key, map));
+ }
+ else
+ rl_ding ();
+ return 0;
+ }
+
+ if (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_MACRODEF))
+ _rl_add_macro_char (key);
+
+ r = 0;
+ switch (map[key].type)
+ {
+ case ISFUNC:
+ func = map[key].function;
+ if (func)
+ {
+ /* Special case rl_do_lowercase_version (). */
+ if (func == rl_do_lowercase_version)
+ return (_rl_dispatch (_rl_to_lower (key), map));
+
+ rl_executing_keymap = map;
+
+ rl_dispatching = 1;
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_DISPATCHING);
+ r = (*map[key].function)(rl_numeric_arg * rl_arg_sign, key);
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_DISPATCHING);
+ rl_dispatching = 0;
+
+ /* If we have input pending, then the last command was a prefix
+ command. Don't change the state of rl_last_func. Otherwise,
+ remember the last command executed in this variable. */
+ if (rl_pending_input == 0 && map[key].function != rl_digit_argument)
+ rl_last_func = map[key].function;
+ }
+ else if (map[ANYOTHERKEY].function)
+ {
+ /* OK, there's no function bound in this map, but there is a
+ shadow function that was overridden when the current keymap
+ was created. Return -2 to note that. */
+ _rl_unget_char (key);
+ return -2;
+ }
+ else if (got_subseq)
+ {
+ /* Return -1 to note that we're in a subsequence, but we don't
+ have a matching key, nor was one overridden. This means
+ we need to back up the recursion chain and find the last
+ subsequence that is bound to a function. */
+ _rl_unget_char (key);
+ return -1;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+#if defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+ RL_UNSETSTATE (RL_STATE_MULTIKEY);
+ _rl_keyseq_chain_dispose ();
+#endif
+ _rl_abort_internal ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case ISKMAP:
+ if (map[key].function != 0)
+ {
+#if defined (VI_MODE)
+ /* The only way this test will be true is if a subsequence has been
+ bound starting with ESC, generally the arrow keys. What we do is
+ check whether there's input in the queue, which there generally
+ will be if an arrow key has been pressed, and, if there's not,
+ just dispatch to (what we assume is) rl_vi_movement_mode right
+ away. This is essentially an input test with a zero timeout. */
+ if (rl_editing_mode == vi_mode && key == ESC && map == vi_insertion_keymap
+ && _rl_input_queued (0) == 0)
+ return (_rl_dispatch (ANYOTHERKEY, FUNCTION_TO_KEYMAP (map, key)));
+#endif
+
+ rl_key_sequence_length++;
+ _rl_dispatching_keymap = FUNCTION_TO_KEYMAP (map, key);
+
+ /* Allocate new context here. Use linked contexts (linked through
+ cxt->ocxt) to simulate recursion */
+#if defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+ if (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_CALLBACK))
+ {
+ /* Return 0 only the first time, to indicate success to
+ _rl_callback_read_char. The rest of the time, we're called
+ from _rl_dispatch_callback, so we return 3 to indicate
+ special handling is necessary. */
+ r = RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_MULTIKEY) ? -3 : 0;
+ cxt = _rl_keyseq_cxt_alloc ();
+
+ if (got_subseq)
+ cxt->flags |= KSEQ_SUBSEQ;
+ cxt->okey = key;
+ cxt->oldmap = map;
+ cxt->dmap = _rl_dispatching_keymap;
+ cxt->subseq_arg = got_subseq || cxt->dmap[ANYOTHERKEY].function;
+
+ RL_SETSTATE (RL_STATE_MULTIKEY);
+ _rl_kscxt = cxt;
+
+ return r; /* don't indicate immediate success */
+ }
+#endif
+
+ newkey = _rl_subseq_getchar (key);
+ if (newkey < 0)
+ {
+ _rl_abort_internal ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ r = _rl_dispatch_subseq (newkey, _rl_dispatching_keymap, got_subseq || map[ANYOTHERKEY].function);
+ return _rl_subseq_result (r, map, key, got_subseq);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ _rl_abort_internal ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case ISMACR:
+ if (map[key].function != 0)
+ {
+ macro = savestring ((char *)map[key].function);
+ _rl_with_macro_input (macro);
+ return 0;
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+#if defined (VI_MODE)
+ if (rl_editing_mode == vi_mode && _rl_keymap == vi_movement_keymap &&
+ key != ANYOTHERKEY &&
+ _rl_vi_textmod_command (key))
+ _rl_vi_set_last (key, rl_numeric_arg, rl_arg_sign);
+#endif
+
+ return (r);
+}
+
+static int
+_rl_subseq_result (r, map, key, got_subseq)
+ int r;
+ Keymap map;
+ int key, got_subseq;
+{
+ Keymap m;
+ int type, nt;
+ rl_command_func_t *func, *nf;
+
+ if (r == -2)
+ /* We didn't match anything, and the keymap we're indexed into
+ shadowed a function previously bound to that prefix. Call
+ the function. The recursive call to _rl_dispatch_subseq has
+ already taken care of pushing any necessary input back onto
+ the input queue with _rl_unget_char. */
+ {
+ m = _rl_dispatching_keymap;
+ type = m[ANYOTHERKEY].type;
+ func = m[ANYOTHERKEY].function;
+ if (type == ISFUNC && func == rl_do_lowercase_version)
+ r = _rl_dispatch (_rl_to_lower (key), map);
+ else if (type == ISFUNC && func == rl_insert)
+ {
+ /* If the function that was shadowed was self-insert, we
+ somehow need a keymap with map[key].func == self-insert.
+ Let's use this one. */
+ nt = m[key].type;
+ nf = m[key].function;
+
+ m[key].type = type;
+ m[key].function = func;
+ r = _rl_dispatch (key, m);
+ m[key].type = nt;
+ m[key].function = nf;
+ }
+ else
+ r = _rl_dispatch (ANYOTHERKEY, m);
+ }
+ else if (r && map[ANYOTHERKEY].function)
+ {
+ /* We didn't match (r is probably -1), so return something to
+ tell the caller that it should try ANYOTHERKEY for an
+ overridden function. */
+ _rl_unget_char (key);
+ _rl_dispatching_keymap = map;
+ return -2;
+ }
+ else if (r && got_subseq)
+ {
+ /* OK, back up the chain. */
+ _rl_unget_char (key);
+ _rl_dispatching_keymap = map;
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ return r;
+}
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Initializations */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* Initialize readline (and terminal if not already). */
+int
+rl_initialize ()
+{
+ /* If we have never been called before, initialize the
+ terminal and data structures. */
+ if (!rl_initialized)
+ {
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_INITIALIZING);
+ readline_initialize_everything ();
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_INITIALIZING);
+ rl_initialized++;
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_INITIALIZED);
+ }
+
+ /* Initalize the current line information. */
+ _rl_init_line_state ();
+
+ /* We aren't done yet. We haven't even gotten started yet! */
+ rl_done = 0;
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_DONE);
+
+ /* Tell the history routines what is going on. */
+ _rl_start_using_history ();
+
+ /* Make the display buffer match the state of the line. */
+ rl_reset_line_state ();
+
+ /* No such function typed yet. */
+ rl_last_func = (rl_command_func_t *)NULL;
+
+ /* Parsing of key-bindings begins in an enabled state. */
+ _rl_parsing_conditionalized_out = 0;
+
+#if defined (VI_MODE)
+ if (rl_editing_mode == vi_mode)
+ _rl_vi_initialize_line ();
+#endif
+
+ /* Each line starts in insert mode (the default). */
+ _rl_set_insert_mode (RL_IM_DEFAULT, 1);
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+#if 0
+#if defined (__EMX__)
+static void
+_emx_build_environ ()
+{
+ TIB *tibp;
+ PIB *pibp;
+ char *t, **tp;
+ int c;
+
+ DosGetInfoBlocks (&tibp, &pibp);
+ t = pibp->pib_pchenv;
+ for (c = 1; *t; c++)
+ t += strlen (t) + 1;
+ tp = environ = (char **)xmalloc ((c + 1) * sizeof (char *));
+ t = pibp->pib_pchenv;
+ while (*t)
+ {
+ *tp++ = t;
+ t += strlen (t) + 1;
+ }
+ *tp = 0;
+}
+#endif /* __EMX__ */
+#endif
+
+/* Initialize the entire state of the world. */
+static void
+readline_initialize_everything ()
+{
+#if 0
+#if defined (__EMX__)
+ if (environ == 0)
+ _emx_build_environ ();
+#endif
+#endif
+
+#if 0
+ /* Find out if we are running in Emacs -- UNUSED. */
+ running_in_emacs = sh_get_env_value ("EMACS") != (char *)0;
+#endif
+
+ /* Set up input and output if they are not already set up. */
+ if (!rl_instream)
+ rl_instream = stdin;
+
+ if (!rl_outstream)
+ rl_outstream = stdout;
+
+ /* Bind _rl_in_stream and _rl_out_stream immediately. These values
+ may change, but they may also be used before readline_internal ()
+ is called. */
+ _rl_in_stream = rl_instream;
+ _rl_out_stream = rl_outstream;
+
+ /* Allocate data structures. */
+ if (rl_line_buffer == 0)
+ rl_line_buffer = (char *)xmalloc (rl_line_buffer_len = DEFAULT_BUFFER_SIZE);
+
+ /* Initialize the terminal interface. */
+ if (rl_terminal_name == 0)
+ rl_terminal_name = sh_get_env_value ("TERM");
+ _rl_init_terminal_io (rl_terminal_name);
+
+ /* Bind tty characters to readline functions. */
+ readline_default_bindings ();
+
+ /* Initialize the function names. */
+ rl_initialize_funmap ();
+
+ /* Decide whether we should automatically go into eight-bit mode. */
+ _rl_init_eightbit ();
+
+ /* Read in the init file. */
+ rl_read_init_file ((char *)NULL);
+
+ /* XXX */
+ if (_rl_horizontal_scroll_mode && _rl_term_autowrap)
+ {
+ _rl_screenwidth--;
+ _rl_screenchars -= _rl_screenheight;
+ }
+
+ /* Override the effect of any `set keymap' assignments in the
+ inputrc file. */
+ rl_set_keymap_from_edit_mode ();
+
+ /* Try to bind a common arrow key prefix, if not already bound. */
+ bind_arrow_keys ();
+
+ /* Enable the meta key, if this terminal has one. */
+ if (_rl_enable_meta)
+ _rl_enable_meta_key ();
+
+ /* If the completion parser's default word break characters haven't
+ been set yet, then do so now. */
+ if (rl_completer_word_break_characters == (char *)NULL)
+ rl_completer_word_break_characters = (char *)rl_basic_word_break_characters;
+}
+
+/* If this system allows us to look at the values of the regular
+ input editing characters, then bind them to their readline
+ equivalents, iff the characters are not bound to keymaps. */
+static void
+readline_default_bindings ()
+{
+ if (_rl_bind_stty_chars)
+ rl_tty_set_default_bindings (_rl_keymap);
+}
+
+/* Reset the default bindings for the terminal special characters we're
+ interested in back to rl_insert and read the new ones. */
+static void
+reset_default_bindings ()
+{
+ if (_rl_bind_stty_chars)
+ {
+ rl_tty_unset_default_bindings (_rl_keymap);
+ rl_tty_set_default_bindings (_rl_keymap);
+ }
+}
+
+/* Bind some common arrow key sequences in MAP. */
+static void
+bind_arrow_keys_internal (map)
+ Keymap map;
+{
+ Keymap xkeymap;
+
+ xkeymap = _rl_keymap;
+ _rl_keymap = map;
+
+#if defined (__MSDOS__)
+ rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound ("\033[0A", rl_get_previous_history);
+ rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound ("\033[0B", rl_backward_char);
+ rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound ("\033[0C", rl_forward_char);
+ rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound ("\033[0D", rl_get_next_history);
+#endif
+
+ rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound ("\033[A", rl_get_previous_history);
+ rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound ("\033[B", rl_get_next_history);
+ rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound ("\033[C", rl_forward_char);
+ rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound ("\033[D", rl_backward_char);
+ rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound ("\033[H", rl_beg_of_line);
+ rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound ("\033[F", rl_end_of_line);
+
+ rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound ("\033OA", rl_get_previous_history);
+ rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound ("\033OB", rl_get_next_history);
+ rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound ("\033OC", rl_forward_char);
+ rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound ("\033OD", rl_backward_char);
+ rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound ("\033OH", rl_beg_of_line);
+ rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound ("\033OF", rl_end_of_line);
+
+#if defined (__MINGW32__)
+ rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound ("\340H", rl_get_previous_history);
+ rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound ("\340P", rl_get_next_history);
+ rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound ("\340M", rl_forward_char);
+ rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound ("\340K", rl_backward_char);
+#endif
+
+ _rl_keymap = xkeymap;
+}
+
+/* Try and bind the common arrow key prefixes after giving termcap and
+ the inputrc file a chance to bind them and create `real' keymaps
+ for the arrow key prefix. */
+static void
+bind_arrow_keys ()
+{
+ bind_arrow_keys_internal (emacs_standard_keymap);
+
+#if defined (VI_MODE)
+ bind_arrow_keys_internal (vi_movement_keymap);
+ bind_arrow_keys_internal (vi_insertion_keymap);
+#endif
+}
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Saving and Restoring Readline's state */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+int
+rl_save_state (sp)
+ struct readline_state *sp;
+{
+ if (sp == 0)
+ return -1;
+
+ sp->point = rl_point;
+ sp->end = rl_end;
+ sp->mark = rl_mark;
+ sp->buffer = rl_line_buffer;
+ sp->buflen = rl_line_buffer_len;
+ sp->ul = rl_undo_list;
+ sp->prompt = rl_prompt;
+
+ sp->rlstate = rl_readline_state;
+ sp->done = rl_done;
+ sp->kmap = _rl_keymap;
+
+ sp->lastfunc = rl_last_func;
+ sp->insmode = rl_insert_mode;
+ sp->edmode = rl_editing_mode;
+ sp->kseqlen = rl_key_sequence_length;
+ sp->inf = rl_instream;
+ sp->outf = rl_outstream;
+ sp->pendingin = rl_pending_input;
+ sp->macro = rl_executing_macro;
+
+ sp->catchsigs = rl_catch_signals;
+ sp->catchsigwinch = rl_catch_sigwinch;
+
+ return (0);
+}
+
+int
+rl_restore_state (sp)
+ struct readline_state *sp;
+{
+ if (sp == 0)
+ return -1;
+
+ rl_point = sp->point;
+ rl_end = sp->end;
+ rl_mark = sp->mark;
+ the_line = rl_line_buffer = sp->buffer;
+ rl_line_buffer_len = sp->buflen;
+ rl_undo_list = sp->ul;
+ rl_prompt = sp->prompt;
+
+ rl_readline_state = sp->rlstate;
+ rl_done = sp->done;
+ _rl_keymap = sp->kmap;
+
+ rl_last_func = sp->lastfunc;
+ rl_insert_mode = sp->insmode;
+ rl_editing_mode = sp->edmode;
+ rl_key_sequence_length = sp->kseqlen;
+ rl_instream = sp->inf;
+ rl_outstream = sp->outf;
+ rl_pending_input = sp->pendingin;
+ rl_executing_macro = sp->macro;
+
+ rl_catch_signals = sp->catchsigs;
+ rl_catch_sigwinch = sp->catchsigwinch;
+
+ return (0);
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/readline.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/readline.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..fade6d4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/readline.h
@@ -0,0 +1,849 @@
+/* Readline.h -- the names of functions callable from within readline. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1987-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#if !defined (_READLINE_H_)
+#define _READLINE_H_
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+extern "C" {
+#endif
+
+#if defined (READLINE_LIBRARY)
+# include "rlstdc.h"
+# include "rltypedefs.h"
+# include "keymaps.h"
+# include "tilde.h"
+#else
+# include <readline/rlstdc.h>
+# include <readline/rltypedefs.h>
+# include <readline/keymaps.h>
+# include <readline/tilde.h>
+#endif
+
+/* Hex-encoded Readline version number. */
+#define RL_READLINE_VERSION 0x0501 /* Readline 5.1 */
+#define RL_VERSION_MAJOR 5
+#define RL_VERSION_MINOR 1
+
+/* Readline data structures. */
+
+/* Maintaining the state of undo. We remember individual deletes and inserts
+ on a chain of things to do. */
+
+/* The actions that undo knows how to undo. Notice that UNDO_DELETE means
+ to insert some text, and UNDO_INSERT means to delete some text. I.e.,
+ the code tells undo what to undo, not how to undo it. */
+enum undo_code { UNDO_DELETE, UNDO_INSERT, UNDO_BEGIN, UNDO_END };
+
+/* What an element of THE_UNDO_LIST looks like. */
+typedef struct undo_list {
+ struct undo_list *next;
+ int start, end; /* Where the change took place. */
+ char *text; /* The text to insert, if undoing a delete. */
+ enum undo_code what; /* Delete, Insert, Begin, End. */
+} UNDO_LIST;
+
+/* The current undo list for RL_LINE_BUFFER. */
+extern UNDO_LIST *rl_undo_list;
+
+/* The data structure for mapping textual names to code addresses. */
+typedef struct _funmap {
+ const char *name;
+ rl_command_func_t *function;
+} FUNMAP;
+
+extern FUNMAP **funmap;
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Functions available to bind to key sequences */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* Bindable commands for numeric arguments. */
+extern int rl_digit_argument PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_universal_argument PARAMS((int, int));
+
+/* Bindable commands for moving the cursor. */
+extern int rl_forward_byte PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_forward_char PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_forward PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_backward_byte PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_backward_char PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_backward PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_beg_of_line PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_end_of_line PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_forward_word PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_backward_word PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_refresh_line PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_clear_screen PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_arrow_keys PARAMS((int, int));
+
+/* Bindable commands for inserting and deleting text. */
+extern int rl_insert PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_quoted_insert PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_tab_insert PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_newline PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_do_lowercase_version PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_rubout PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_delete PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_rubout_or_delete PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_delete_horizontal_space PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_delete_or_show_completions PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_insert_comment PARAMS((int, int));
+
+/* Bindable commands for changing case. */
+extern int rl_upcase_word PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_downcase_word PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_capitalize_word PARAMS((int, int));
+
+/* Bindable commands for transposing characters and words. */
+extern int rl_transpose_words PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_transpose_chars PARAMS((int, int));
+
+/* Bindable commands for searching within a line. */
+extern int rl_char_search PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_backward_char_search PARAMS((int, int));
+
+/* Bindable commands for readline's interface to the command history. */
+extern int rl_beginning_of_history PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_end_of_history PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_get_next_history PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_get_previous_history PARAMS((int, int));
+
+/* Bindable commands for managing the mark and region. */
+extern int rl_set_mark PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_exchange_point_and_mark PARAMS((int, int));
+
+/* Bindable commands to set the editing mode (emacs or vi). */
+extern int rl_vi_editing_mode PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_emacs_editing_mode PARAMS((int, int));
+
+/* Bindable commands to change the insert mode (insert or overwrite) */
+extern int rl_overwrite_mode PARAMS((int, int));
+
+/* Bindable commands for managing key bindings. */
+extern int rl_re_read_init_file PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_dump_functions PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_dump_macros PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_dump_variables PARAMS((int, int));
+
+/* Bindable commands for word completion. */
+extern int rl_complete PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_possible_completions PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_insert_completions PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_menu_complete PARAMS((int, int));
+
+/* Bindable commands for killing and yanking text, and managing the kill ring. */
+extern int rl_kill_word PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_backward_kill_word PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_kill_line PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_backward_kill_line PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_kill_full_line PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_unix_word_rubout PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_unix_filename_rubout PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_unix_line_discard PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_copy_region_to_kill PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_kill_region PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_copy_forward_word PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_copy_backward_word PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_yank PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_yank_pop PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_yank_nth_arg PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_yank_last_arg PARAMS((int, int));
+/* Not available unless __CYGWIN__ is defined. */
+#ifdef __CYGWIN__
+extern int rl_paste_from_clipboard PARAMS((int, int));
+#endif
+
+/* Bindable commands for incremental searching. */
+extern int rl_reverse_search_history PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_forward_search_history PARAMS((int, int));
+
+/* Bindable keyboard macro commands. */
+extern int rl_start_kbd_macro PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_end_kbd_macro PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_call_last_kbd_macro PARAMS((int, int));
+
+/* Bindable undo commands. */
+extern int rl_revert_line PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_undo_command PARAMS((int, int));
+
+/* Bindable tilde expansion commands. */
+extern int rl_tilde_expand PARAMS((int, int));
+
+/* Bindable terminal control commands. */
+extern int rl_restart_output PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_stop_output PARAMS((int, int));
+
+/* Miscellaneous bindable commands. */
+extern int rl_abort PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_tty_status PARAMS((int, int));
+
+/* Bindable commands for incremental and non-incremental history searching. */
+extern int rl_history_search_forward PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_history_search_backward PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_noninc_forward_search PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_noninc_reverse_search PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_noninc_forward_search_again PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_noninc_reverse_search_again PARAMS((int, int));
+
+/* Bindable command used when inserting a matching close character. */
+extern int rl_insert_close PARAMS((int, int));
+
+/* Not available unless READLINE_CALLBACKS is defined. */
+extern void rl_callback_handler_install PARAMS((const char *, rl_vcpfunc_t *));
+extern void rl_callback_read_char PARAMS((void));
+extern void rl_callback_handler_remove PARAMS((void));
+
+/* Things for vi mode. Not available unless readline is compiled -DVI_MODE. */
+/* VI-mode bindable commands. */
+extern int rl_vi_redo PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_undo PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_yank_arg PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_fetch_history PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_search_again PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_search PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_complete PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_tilde_expand PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_prev_word PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_next_word PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_end_word PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_insert_beg PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_append_mode PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_append_eol PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_eof_maybe PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_insertion_mode PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_movement_mode PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_arg_digit PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_change_case PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_put PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_column PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_delete_to PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_change_to PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_yank_to PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_rubout PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_delete PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_back_to_indent PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_first_print PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_char_search PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_match PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_change_char PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_subst PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_overstrike PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_overstrike_delete PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_replace PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_set_mark PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_goto_mark PARAMS((int, int));
+
+/* VI-mode utility functions. */
+extern int rl_vi_check PARAMS((void));
+extern int rl_vi_domove PARAMS((int, int *));
+extern int rl_vi_bracktype PARAMS((int));
+
+extern void rl_vi_start_inserting PARAMS((int, int, int));
+
+/* VI-mode pseudo-bindable commands, used as utility functions. */
+extern int rl_vi_fWord PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_bWord PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_eWord PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_fword PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_bword PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_vi_eword PARAMS((int, int));
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Well Published Functions */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* Readline functions. */
+/* Read a line of input. Prompt with PROMPT. A NULL PROMPT means none. */
+extern char *readline PARAMS((const char *));
+
+extern int rl_set_prompt PARAMS((const char *));
+extern int rl_expand_prompt PARAMS((char *));
+
+extern int rl_initialize PARAMS((void));
+
+/* Undocumented; unused by readline */
+extern int rl_discard_argument PARAMS((void));
+
+/* Utility functions to bind keys to readline commands. */
+extern int rl_add_defun PARAMS((const char *, rl_command_func_t *, int));
+extern int rl_bind_key PARAMS((int, rl_command_func_t *));
+extern int rl_bind_key_in_map PARAMS((int, rl_command_func_t *, Keymap));
+extern int rl_unbind_key PARAMS((int));
+extern int rl_unbind_key_in_map PARAMS((int, Keymap));
+extern int rl_bind_key_if_unbound PARAMS((int, rl_command_func_t *));
+extern int rl_bind_key_if_unbound_in_map PARAMS((int, rl_command_func_t *, Keymap));
+extern int rl_unbind_function_in_map PARAMS((rl_command_func_t *, Keymap));
+extern int rl_unbind_command_in_map PARAMS((const char *, Keymap));
+extern int rl_bind_keyseq PARAMS((const char *, rl_command_func_t *));
+extern int rl_bind_keyseq_in_map PARAMS((const char *, rl_command_func_t *, Keymap));
+extern int rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound PARAMS((const char *, rl_command_func_t *));
+extern int rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound_in_map PARAMS((const char *, rl_command_func_t *, Keymap));
+extern int rl_generic_bind PARAMS((int, const char *, char *, Keymap));
+
+extern char *rl_variable_value PARAMS((const char *));
+extern int rl_variable_bind PARAMS((const char *, const char *));
+
+/* Backwards compatibility, use rl_bind_keyseq_in_map instead. */
+extern int rl_set_key PARAMS((const char *, rl_command_func_t *, Keymap));
+
+/* Backwards compatibility, use rl_generic_bind instead. */
+extern int rl_macro_bind PARAMS((const char *, const char *, Keymap));
+
+/* Undocumented in the texinfo manual; not really useful to programs. */
+extern int rl_translate_keyseq PARAMS((const char *, char *, int *));
+extern char *rl_untranslate_keyseq PARAMS((int));
+
+extern rl_command_func_t *rl_named_function PARAMS((const char *));
+extern rl_command_func_t *rl_function_of_keyseq PARAMS((const char *, Keymap, int *));
+
+extern void rl_list_funmap_names PARAMS((void));
+extern char **rl_invoking_keyseqs_in_map PARAMS((rl_command_func_t *, Keymap));
+extern char **rl_invoking_keyseqs PARAMS((rl_command_func_t *));
+
+extern void rl_function_dumper PARAMS((int));
+extern void rl_macro_dumper PARAMS((int));
+extern void rl_variable_dumper PARAMS((int));
+
+extern int rl_read_init_file PARAMS((const char *));
+extern int rl_parse_and_bind PARAMS((char *));
+
+/* Functions for manipulating keymaps. */
+extern Keymap rl_make_bare_keymap PARAMS((void));
+extern Keymap rl_copy_keymap PARAMS((Keymap));
+extern Keymap rl_make_keymap PARAMS((void));
+extern void rl_discard_keymap PARAMS((Keymap));
+
+extern Keymap rl_get_keymap_by_name PARAMS((const char *));
+extern char *rl_get_keymap_name PARAMS((Keymap));
+extern void rl_set_keymap PARAMS((Keymap));
+extern Keymap rl_get_keymap PARAMS((void));
+/* Undocumented; used internally only. */
+extern void rl_set_keymap_from_edit_mode PARAMS((void));
+extern char *rl_get_keymap_name_from_edit_mode PARAMS((void));
+
+/* Functions for manipulating the funmap, which maps command names to functions. */
+extern int rl_add_funmap_entry PARAMS((const char *, rl_command_func_t *));
+extern const char **rl_funmap_names PARAMS((void));
+/* Undocumented, only used internally -- there is only one funmap, and this
+ function may be called only once. */
+extern void rl_initialize_funmap PARAMS((void));
+
+/* Utility functions for managing keyboard macros. */
+extern void rl_push_macro_input PARAMS((char *));
+
+/* Functions for undoing, from undo.c */
+extern void rl_add_undo PARAMS((enum undo_code, int, int, char *));
+extern void rl_free_undo_list PARAMS((void));
+extern int rl_do_undo PARAMS((void));
+extern int rl_begin_undo_group PARAMS((void));
+extern int rl_end_undo_group PARAMS((void));
+extern int rl_modifying PARAMS((int, int));
+
+/* Functions for redisplay. */
+extern void rl_redisplay PARAMS((void));
+extern int rl_on_new_line PARAMS((void));
+extern int rl_on_new_line_with_prompt PARAMS((void));
+extern int rl_forced_update_display PARAMS((void));
+extern int rl_clear_message PARAMS((void));
+extern int rl_reset_line_state PARAMS((void));
+extern int rl_crlf PARAMS((void));
+
+#if defined (USE_VARARGS) && defined (PREFER_STDARG)
+extern int rl_message (const char *, ...) __attribute__((__format__ (printf, 1, 2)));
+#else
+extern int rl_message ();
+#endif
+
+extern int rl_show_char PARAMS((int));
+
+/* Undocumented in texinfo manual. */
+extern int rl_character_len PARAMS((int, int));
+
+/* Save and restore internal prompt redisplay information. */
+extern void rl_save_prompt PARAMS((void));
+extern void rl_restore_prompt PARAMS((void));
+
+/* Modifying text. */
+extern void rl_replace_line PARAMS((const char *, int));
+extern int rl_insert_text PARAMS((const char *));
+extern int rl_delete_text PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int rl_kill_text PARAMS((int, int));
+extern char *rl_copy_text PARAMS((int, int));
+
+/* Terminal and tty mode management. */
+extern void rl_prep_terminal PARAMS((int));
+extern void rl_deprep_terminal PARAMS((void));
+extern void rl_tty_set_default_bindings PARAMS((Keymap));
+extern void rl_tty_unset_default_bindings PARAMS((Keymap));
+
+extern int rl_reset_terminal PARAMS((const char *));
+extern void rl_resize_terminal PARAMS((void));
+extern void rl_set_screen_size PARAMS((int, int));
+extern void rl_get_screen_size PARAMS((int *, int *));
+extern void rl_reset_screen_size PARAMS((void));
+
+extern char *rl_get_termcap PARAMS((const char *));
+
+/* Functions for character input. */
+extern int rl_stuff_char PARAMS((int));
+extern int rl_execute_next PARAMS((int));
+extern int rl_clear_pending_input PARAMS((void));
+extern int rl_read_key PARAMS((void));
+extern int rl_getc PARAMS((FILE *));
+extern int rl_set_keyboard_input_timeout PARAMS((int));
+
+/* `Public' utility functions . */
+extern void rl_extend_line_buffer PARAMS((int));
+extern int rl_ding PARAMS((void));
+extern int rl_alphabetic PARAMS((int));
+
+/* Readline signal handling, from signals.c */
+extern int rl_set_signals PARAMS((void));
+extern int rl_clear_signals PARAMS((void));
+extern void rl_cleanup_after_signal PARAMS((void));
+extern void rl_reset_after_signal PARAMS((void));
+extern void rl_free_line_state PARAMS((void));
+
+extern int rl_set_paren_blink_timeout PARAMS((int));
+
+/* Undocumented. */
+extern int rl_maybe_save_line PARAMS((void));
+extern int rl_maybe_unsave_line PARAMS((void));
+extern int rl_maybe_replace_line PARAMS((void));
+
+/* Completion functions. */
+extern int rl_complete_internal PARAMS((int));
+extern void rl_display_match_list PARAMS((char **, int, int));
+
+extern char **rl_completion_matches PARAMS((const char *, rl_compentry_func_t *));
+extern char *rl_username_completion_function PARAMS((const char *, int));
+extern char *rl_filename_completion_function PARAMS((const char *, int));
+
+extern int rl_completion_mode PARAMS((rl_command_func_t *));
+
+#if 0
+/* Backwards compatibility (compat.c). These will go away sometime. */
+extern void free_undo_list PARAMS((void));
+extern int maybe_save_line PARAMS((void));
+extern int maybe_unsave_line PARAMS((void));
+extern int maybe_replace_line PARAMS((void));
+
+extern int ding PARAMS((void));
+extern int alphabetic PARAMS((int));
+extern int crlf PARAMS((void));
+
+extern char **completion_matches PARAMS((char *, rl_compentry_func_t *));
+extern char *username_completion_function PARAMS((const char *, int));
+extern char *filename_completion_function PARAMS((const char *, int));
+#endif
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Well Published Variables */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* The version of this incarnation of the readline library. */
+extern const char *rl_library_version; /* e.g., "4.2" */
+extern int rl_readline_version; /* e.g., 0x0402 */
+
+/* True if this is real GNU readline. */
+extern int rl_gnu_readline_p;
+
+/* Flags word encapsulating the current readline state. */
+extern int rl_readline_state;
+
+/* Says which editing mode readline is currently using. 1 means emacs mode;
+ 0 means vi mode. */
+extern int rl_editing_mode;
+
+/* Insert or overwrite mode for emacs mode. 1 means insert mode; 0 means
+ overwrite mode. Reset to insert mode on each input line. */
+extern int rl_insert_mode;
+
+/* The name of the calling program. You should initialize this to
+ whatever was in argv[0]. It is used when parsing conditionals. */
+extern const char *rl_readline_name;
+
+/* The prompt readline uses. This is set from the argument to
+ readline (), and should not be assigned to directly. */
+extern char *rl_prompt;
+
+/* The line buffer that is in use. */
+extern char *rl_line_buffer;
+
+/* The location of point, and end. */
+extern int rl_point;
+extern int rl_end;
+
+/* The mark, or saved cursor position. */
+extern int rl_mark;
+
+/* Flag to indicate that readline has finished with the current input
+ line and should return it. */
+extern int rl_done;
+
+/* If set to a character value, that will be the next keystroke read. */
+extern int rl_pending_input;
+
+/* Non-zero if we called this function from _rl_dispatch(). It's present
+ so functions can find out whether they were called from a key binding
+ or directly from an application. */
+extern int rl_dispatching;
+
+/* Non-zero if the user typed a numeric argument before executing the
+ current function. */
+extern int rl_explicit_arg;
+
+/* The current value of the numeric argument specified by the user. */
+extern int rl_numeric_arg;
+
+/* The address of the last command function Readline executed. */
+extern rl_command_func_t *rl_last_func;
+
+/* The name of the terminal to use. */
+extern const char *rl_terminal_name;
+
+/* The input and output streams. */
+extern FILE *rl_instream;
+extern FILE *rl_outstream;
+
+/* If non-zero, Readline gives values of LINES and COLUMNS from the environment
+ greater precedence than values fetched from the kernel when computing the
+ screen dimensions. */
+extern int rl_prefer_env_winsize;
+
+/* If non-zero, then this is the address of a function to call just
+ before readline_internal () prints the first prompt. */
+extern rl_hook_func_t *rl_startup_hook;
+
+/* If non-zero, this is the address of a function to call just before
+ readline_internal_setup () returns and readline_internal starts
+ reading input characters. */
+extern rl_hook_func_t *rl_pre_input_hook;
+
+/* The address of a function to call periodically while Readline is
+ awaiting character input, or NULL, for no event handling. */
+extern rl_hook_func_t *rl_event_hook;
+
+/* The address of the function to call to fetch a character from the current
+ Readline input stream */
+extern rl_getc_func_t *rl_getc_function;
+
+extern rl_voidfunc_t *rl_redisplay_function;
+
+extern rl_vintfunc_t *rl_prep_term_function;
+extern rl_voidfunc_t *rl_deprep_term_function;
+
+/* Dispatch variables. */
+extern Keymap rl_executing_keymap;
+extern Keymap rl_binding_keymap;
+
+/* Display variables. */
+/* If non-zero, readline will erase the entire line, including any prompt,
+ if the only thing typed on an otherwise-blank line is something bound to
+ rl_newline. */
+extern int rl_erase_empty_line;
+
+/* If non-zero, the application has already printed the prompt (rl_prompt)
+ before calling readline, so readline should not output it the first time
+ redisplay is done. */
+extern int rl_already_prompted;
+
+/* A non-zero value means to read only this many characters rather than
+ up to a character bound to accept-line. */
+extern int rl_num_chars_to_read;
+
+/* The text of a currently-executing keyboard macro. */
+extern char *rl_executing_macro;
+
+/* Variables to control readline signal handling. */
+/* If non-zero, readline will install its own signal handlers for
+ SIGINT, SIGTERM, SIGQUIT, SIGALRM, SIGTSTP, SIGTTIN, and SIGTTOU. */
+extern int rl_catch_signals;
+
+/* If non-zero, readline will install a signal handler for SIGWINCH
+ that also attempts to call any calling application's SIGWINCH signal
+ handler. Note that the terminal is not cleaned up before the
+ application's signal handler is called; use rl_cleanup_after_signal()
+ to do that. */
+extern int rl_catch_sigwinch;
+
+/* Completion variables. */
+/* Pointer to the generator function for completion_matches ().
+ NULL means to use rl_filename_completion_function (), the default
+ filename completer. */
+extern rl_compentry_func_t *rl_completion_entry_function;
+
+/* If rl_ignore_some_completions_function is non-NULL it is the address
+ of a function to call after all of the possible matches have been
+ generated, but before the actual completion is done to the input line.
+ The function is called with one argument; a NULL terminated array
+ of (char *). If your function removes any of the elements, they
+ must be free()'ed. */
+extern rl_compignore_func_t *rl_ignore_some_completions_function;
+
+/* Pointer to alternative function to create matches.
+ Function is called with TEXT, START, and END.
+ START and END are indices in RL_LINE_BUFFER saying what the boundaries
+ of TEXT are.
+ If this function exists and returns NULL then call the value of
+ rl_completion_entry_function to try to match, otherwise use the
+ array of strings returned. */
+extern rl_completion_func_t *rl_attempted_completion_function;
+
+/* The basic list of characters that signal a break between words for the
+ completer routine. The initial contents of this variable is what
+ breaks words in the shell, i.e. "n\"\\'`@$>". */
+extern const char *rl_basic_word_break_characters;
+
+/* The list of characters that signal a break between words for
+ rl_complete_internal. The default list is the contents of
+ rl_basic_word_break_characters. */
+extern /*const*/ char *rl_completer_word_break_characters;
+
+/* Hook function to allow an application to set the completion word
+ break characters before readline breaks up the line. Allows
+ position-dependent word break characters. */
+extern rl_cpvfunc_t *rl_completion_word_break_hook;
+
+/* List of characters which can be used to quote a substring of the line.
+ Completion occurs on the entire substring, and within the substring
+ rl_completer_word_break_characters are treated as any other character,
+ unless they also appear within this list. */
+extern const char *rl_completer_quote_characters;
+
+/* List of quote characters which cause a word break. */
+extern const char *rl_basic_quote_characters;
+
+/* List of characters that need to be quoted in filenames by the completer. */
+extern const char *rl_filename_quote_characters;
+
+/* List of characters that are word break characters, but should be left
+ in TEXT when it is passed to the completion function. The shell uses
+ this to help determine what kind of completing to do. */
+extern const char *rl_special_prefixes;
+
+/* If non-zero, then this is the address of a function to call when
+ completing on a directory name. The function is called with
+ the address of a string (the current directory name) as an arg. It
+ changes what is displayed when the possible completions are printed
+ or inserted. */
+extern rl_icppfunc_t *rl_directory_completion_hook;
+
+/* If non-zero, this is the address of a function to call when completing
+ a directory name. This function takes the address of the directory name
+ to be modified as an argument. Unlike rl_directory_completion_hook, it
+ only modifies the directory name used in opendir(2), not what is displayed
+ when the possible completions are printed or inserted. It is called
+ before rl_directory_completion_hook. I'm not happy with how this works
+ yet, so it's undocumented. */
+extern rl_icppfunc_t *rl_directory_rewrite_hook;
+
+/* Backwards compatibility with previous versions of readline. */
+#define rl_symbolic_link_hook rl_directory_completion_hook
+
+/* If non-zero, then this is the address of a function to call when
+ completing a word would normally display the list of possible matches.
+ This function is called instead of actually doing the display.
+ It takes three arguments: (char **matches, int num_matches, int max_length)
+ where MATCHES is the array of strings that matched, NUM_MATCHES is the
+ number of strings in that array, and MAX_LENGTH is the length of the
+ longest string in that array. */
+extern rl_compdisp_func_t *rl_completion_display_matches_hook;
+
+/* Non-zero means that the results of the matches are to be treated
+ as filenames. This is ALWAYS zero on entry, and can only be changed
+ within a completion entry finder function. */
+extern int rl_filename_completion_desired;
+
+/* Non-zero means that the results of the matches are to be quoted using
+ double quotes (or an application-specific quoting mechanism) if the
+ filename contains any characters in rl_word_break_chars. This is
+ ALWAYS non-zero on entry, and can only be changed within a completion
+ entry finder function. */
+extern int rl_filename_quoting_desired;
+
+/* Set to a function to quote a filename in an application-specific fashion.
+ Called with the text to quote, the type of match found (single or multiple)
+ and a pointer to the quoting character to be used, which the function can
+ reset if desired. */
+extern rl_quote_func_t *rl_filename_quoting_function;
+
+/* Function to call to remove quoting characters from a filename. Called
+ before completion is attempted, so the embedded quotes do not interfere
+ with matching names in the file system. */
+extern rl_dequote_func_t *rl_filename_dequoting_function;
+
+/* Function to call to decide whether or not a word break character is
+ quoted. If a character is quoted, it does not break words for the
+ completer. */
+extern rl_linebuf_func_t *rl_char_is_quoted_p;
+
+/* Non-zero means to suppress normal filename completion after the
+ user-specified completion function has been called. */
+extern int rl_attempted_completion_over;
+
+/* Set to a character describing the type of completion being attempted by
+ rl_complete_internal; available for use by application completion
+ functions. */
+extern int rl_completion_type;
+
+/* Up to this many items will be displayed in response to a
+ possible-completions call. After that, we ask the user if she
+ is sure she wants to see them all. The default value is 100. */
+extern int rl_completion_query_items;
+
+/* Character appended to completed words when at the end of the line. The
+ default is a space. Nothing is added if this is '\0'. */
+extern int rl_completion_append_character;
+
+/* If set to non-zero by an application completion function,
+ rl_completion_append_character will not be appended. */
+extern int rl_completion_suppress_append;
+
+/* Set to any quote character readline thinks it finds before any application
+ completion function is called. */
+extern int rl_completion_quote_character;
+
+/* Set to a non-zero value if readline found quoting anywhere in the word to
+ be completed; set before any application completion function is called. */
+extern int rl_completion_found_quote;
+
+/* If non-zero, the completion functions don't append any closing quote.
+ This is set to 0 by rl_complete_internal and may be changed by an
+ application-specific completion function. */
+extern int rl_completion_suppress_quote;
+
+/* If non-zero, a slash will be appended to completed filenames that are
+ symbolic links to directory names, subject to the value of the
+ mark-directories variable (which is user-settable). This exists so
+ that application completion functions can override the user's preference
+ (set via the mark-symlinked-directories variable) if appropriate.
+ It's set to the value of _rl_complete_mark_symlink_dirs in
+ rl_complete_internal before any application-specific completion
+ function is called, so without that function doing anything, the user's
+ preferences are honored. */
+extern int rl_completion_mark_symlink_dirs;
+
+/* If non-zero, then disallow duplicates in the matches. */
+extern int rl_ignore_completion_duplicates;
+
+/* If this is non-zero, completion is (temporarily) inhibited, and the
+ completion character will be inserted as any other. */
+extern int rl_inhibit_completion;
+
+/* Definitions available for use by readline clients. */
+#define RL_PROMPT_START_IGNORE '\001'
+#define RL_PROMPT_END_IGNORE '\002'
+
+/* Possible values for do_replace argument to rl_filename_quoting_function,
+ called by rl_complete_internal. */
+#define NO_MATCH 0
+#define SINGLE_MATCH 1
+#define MULT_MATCH 2
+
+/* Possible state values for rl_readline_state */
+#define RL_STATE_NONE 0x000000 /* no state; before first call */
+
+#define RL_STATE_INITIALIZING 0x000001 /* initializing */
+#define RL_STATE_INITIALIZED 0x000002 /* initialization done */
+#define RL_STATE_TERMPREPPED 0x000004 /* terminal is prepped */
+#define RL_STATE_READCMD 0x000008 /* reading a command key */
+#define RL_STATE_METANEXT 0x000010 /* reading input after ESC */
+#define RL_STATE_DISPATCHING 0x000020 /* dispatching to a command */
+#define RL_STATE_MOREINPUT 0x000040 /* reading more input in a command function */
+#define RL_STATE_ISEARCH 0x000080 /* doing incremental search */
+#define RL_STATE_NSEARCH 0x000100 /* doing non-inc search */
+#define RL_STATE_SEARCH 0x000200 /* doing a history search */
+#define RL_STATE_NUMERICARG 0x000400 /* reading numeric argument */
+#define RL_STATE_MACROINPUT 0x000800 /* getting input from a macro */
+#define RL_STATE_MACRODEF 0x001000 /* defining keyboard macro */
+#define RL_STATE_OVERWRITE 0x002000 /* overwrite mode */
+#define RL_STATE_COMPLETING 0x004000 /* doing completion */
+#define RL_STATE_SIGHANDLER 0x008000 /* in readline sighandler */
+#define RL_STATE_UNDOING 0x010000 /* doing an undo */
+#define RL_STATE_INPUTPENDING 0x020000 /* rl_execute_next called */
+#define RL_STATE_TTYCSAVED 0x040000 /* tty special chars saved */
+#define RL_STATE_CALLBACK 0x080000 /* using the callback interface */
+#define RL_STATE_VIMOTION 0x100000 /* reading vi motion arg */
+#define RL_STATE_MULTIKEY 0x200000 /* reading multiple-key command */
+#define RL_STATE_VICMDONCE 0x400000 /* entered vi command mode at least once */
+
+#define RL_STATE_DONE 0x800000 /* done; accepted line */
+
+#define RL_SETSTATE(x) (rl_readline_state |= (x))
+#define RL_UNSETSTATE(x) (rl_readline_state &= ~(x))
+#define RL_ISSTATE(x) (rl_readline_state & (x))
+
+struct readline_state {
+ /* line state */
+ int point;
+ int end;
+ int mark;
+ char *buffer;
+ int buflen;
+ UNDO_LIST *ul;
+ char *prompt;
+
+ /* global state */
+ int rlstate;
+ int done;
+ Keymap kmap;
+
+ /* input state */
+ rl_command_func_t *lastfunc;
+ int insmode;
+ int edmode;
+ int kseqlen;
+ FILE *inf;
+ FILE *outf;
+ int pendingin;
+ char *macro;
+
+ /* signal state */
+ int catchsigs;
+ int catchsigwinch;
+
+ /* search state */
+
+ /* completion state */
+
+ /* options state */
+
+ /* reserved for future expansion, so the struct size doesn't change */
+ char reserved[64];
+};
+
+extern int rl_save_state PARAMS((struct readline_state *));
+extern int rl_restore_state PARAMS((struct readline_state *));
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+}
+#endif
+
+#endif /* _READLINE_H_ */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rlconf.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rlconf.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c651fd8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rlconf.h
@@ -0,0 +1,60 @@
+/* rlconf.h -- readline configuration definitions */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1994 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file contains the Readline Library (the Library), a set of
+ routines for providing Emacs style line input to programs that ask
+ for it.
+
+ The Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ The Library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
+ WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#if !defined (_RLCONF_H_)
+#define _RLCONF_H_
+
+/* Define this if you want the vi-mode editing available. */
+#define VI_MODE
+
+/* Define this to get an indication of file type when listing completions. */
+#define VISIBLE_STATS
+
+/* This definition is needed by readline.c, rltty.c, and signals.c. */
+/* If on, then readline handles signals in a way that doesn't screw. */
+#define HANDLE_SIGNALS
+
+/* Ugly but working hack for binding prefix meta. */
+#define PREFIX_META_HACK
+
+/* The final, last-ditch effort file name for an init file. */
+#define DEFAULT_INPUTRC "~/.inputrc"
+
+/* If defined, expand tabs to spaces. */
+#define DISPLAY_TABS
+
+/* If defined, use the terminal escape sequence to move the cursor forward
+ over a character when updating the line rather than rewriting it. */
+/* #define HACK_TERMCAP_MOTION */
+
+/* The string inserted by the `insert comment' command. */
+#define RL_COMMENT_BEGIN_DEFAULT "#"
+
+/* Define this if you want code that allows readline to be used in an
+ X `callback' style. */
+#define READLINE_CALLBACKS
+
+/* Define this if you want the cursor to indicate insert or overwrite mode. */
+/* #define CURSOR_MODE */
+
+#endif /* _RLCONF_H_ */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rldefs.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rldefs.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..0f6c874
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rldefs.h
@@ -0,0 +1,160 @@
+/* rldefs.h -- an attempt to isolate some of the system-specific defines
+ for readline. This should be included after any files that define
+ system-specific constants like _POSIX_VERSION or USG. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1987-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file contains the Readline Library (the Library), a set of
+ routines for providing Emacs style line input to programs that ask
+ for it.
+
+ The Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ The Library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
+ WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#if !defined (_RLDEFS_H_)
+#define _RLDEFS_H_
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include "config.h"
+#endif
+
+#include "rlstdc.h"
+
+#if defined (_POSIX_VERSION) && !defined (TERMIOS_MISSING)
+# define TERMIOS_TTY_DRIVER
+#else
+# if defined (HAVE_TERMIO_H)
+# define TERMIO_TTY_DRIVER
+# else
+# if !defined (__MINGW32__)
+# define NEW_TTY_DRIVER
+# else
+# define NO_TTY_DRIVER
+# endif
+# endif
+#endif
+
+/* Posix macro to check file in statbuf for directory-ness.
+ This requires that <sys/stat.h> be included before this test. */
+#if defined (S_IFDIR) && !defined (S_ISDIR)
+# define S_ISDIR(m) (((m)&S_IFMT) == S_IFDIR)
+#endif
+
+/* Decide which flavor of the header file describing the C library
+ string functions to include and include it. */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STRING_H)
+# include <string.h>
+#else /* !HAVE_STRING_H */
+# include <strings.h>
+#endif /* !HAVE_STRING_H */
+
+#if !defined (strchr) && !defined (__STDC__)
+extern char *strchr (), *strrchr ();
+#endif /* !strchr && !__STDC__ */
+
+#if defined (PREFER_STDARG)
+# include <stdarg.h>
+#else
+# if defined (PREFER_VARARGS)
+# include <varargs.h>
+# endif
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STRCASECMP)
+#define _rl_stricmp strcasecmp
+#define _rl_strnicmp strncasecmp
+#else
+extern int _rl_stricmp PARAMS((char *, char *));
+extern int _rl_strnicmp PARAMS((char *, char *, int));
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STRPBRK) && !defined (HAVE_MULTIBYTE)
+# define _rl_strpbrk(a,b) strpbrk((a),(b))
+#else
+extern char *_rl_strpbrk PARAMS((const char *, const char *));
+#endif
+
+#if !defined (emacs_mode)
+# define no_mode -1
+# define vi_mode 0
+# define emacs_mode 1
+#endif
+
+#if !defined (RL_IM_INSERT)
+# define RL_IM_INSERT 1
+# define RL_IM_OVERWRITE 0
+#
+# define RL_IM_DEFAULT RL_IM_INSERT
+#endif
+
+/* If you cast map[key].function to type (Keymap) on a Cray,
+ the compiler takes the value of map[key].function and
+ divides it by 4 to convert between pointer types (pointers
+ to functions and pointers to structs are different sizes).
+ This is not what is wanted. */
+#if defined (CRAY)
+# define FUNCTION_TO_KEYMAP(map, key) (Keymap)((int)map[key].function)
+# define KEYMAP_TO_FUNCTION(data) (rl_command_func_t *)((int)(data))
+#else
+# define FUNCTION_TO_KEYMAP(map, key) (Keymap)(map[key].function)
+# define KEYMAP_TO_FUNCTION(data) (rl_command_func_t *)(data)
+#endif
+
+#ifndef savestring
+#define savestring(x) strcpy ((char *)xmalloc (1 + strlen (x)), (x))
+#endif
+
+/* Possible values for _rl_bell_preference. */
+#define NO_BELL 0
+#define AUDIBLE_BELL 1
+#define VISIBLE_BELL 2
+
+/* Definitions used when searching the line for characters. */
+/* NOTE: it is necessary that opposite directions are inverses */
+#define FTO 1 /* forward to */
+#define BTO -1 /* backward to */
+#define FFIND 2 /* forward find */
+#define BFIND -2 /* backward find */
+
+/* Possible values for the found_quote flags word used by the completion
+ functions. It says what kind of (shell-like) quoting we found anywhere
+ in the line. */
+#define RL_QF_SINGLE_QUOTE 0x01
+#define RL_QF_DOUBLE_QUOTE 0x02
+#define RL_QF_BACKSLASH 0x04
+#define RL_QF_OTHER_QUOTE 0x08
+
+/* Default readline line buffer length. */
+#define DEFAULT_BUFFER_SIZE 256
+
+#if !defined (STREQ)
+#define STREQ(a, b) (((a)[0] == (b)[0]) && (strcmp ((a), (b)) == 0))
+#define STREQN(a, b, n) (((n) == 0) ? (1) \
+ : ((a)[0] == (b)[0]) && (strncmp ((a), (b), (n)) == 0))
+#endif
+
+#if !defined (FREE)
+# define FREE(x) if (x) free (x)
+#endif
+
+#if !defined (SWAP)
+# define SWAP(s, e) do { int t; t = s; s = e; e = t; } while (0)
+#endif
+
+/* CONFIGURATION SECTION */
+#include "rlconf.h"
+
+#endif /* !_RLDEFS_H_ */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rlmbutil.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rlmbutil.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..11adacb
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rlmbutil.h
@@ -0,0 +1,146 @@
+/* rlmbutil.h -- utility functions for multibyte characters. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#if !defined (_RL_MBUTIL_H_)
+#define _RL_MBUTIL_H_
+
+#include "rlstdc.h"
+
+/************************************************/
+/* check multibyte capability for I18N code */
+/************************************************/
+
+/* For platforms which support the ISO C amendement 1 functionality we
+ support user defined character classes. */
+ /* Solaris 2.5 has a bug: <wchar.h> must be included before <wctype.h>. */
+#if defined (HAVE_WCTYPE_H) && defined (HAVE_WCHAR_H)
+# include <wchar.h>
+# include <wctype.h>
+# if defined (HAVE_MBSRTOWCS) && defined (HAVE_MBRTOWC) && defined (HAVE_MBRLEN) && defined (HAVE_WCWIDTH)
+ /* system is supposed to support XPG5 */
+# define HANDLE_MULTIBYTE 1
+# endif
+#endif
+
+/* If we don't want multibyte chars even on a system that supports them, let
+ the configuring user turn multibyte support off. */
+#if defined (NO_MULTIBYTE_SUPPORT)
+# undef HANDLE_MULTIBYTE
+#endif
+
+/* Some systems, like BeOS, have multibyte encodings but lack mbstate_t. */
+#if HANDLE_MULTIBYTE && !defined (HAVE_MBSTATE_T)
+# define wcsrtombs(dest, src, len, ps) (wcsrtombs) (dest, src, len, 0)
+# define mbsrtowcs(dest, src, len, ps) (mbsrtowcs) (dest, src, len, 0)
+# define wcrtomb(s, wc, ps) (wcrtomb) (s, wc, 0)
+# define mbrtowc(pwc, s, n, ps) (mbrtowc) (pwc, s, n, 0)
+# define mbrlen(s, n, ps) (mbrlen) (s, n, 0)
+# define mbstate_t int
+#endif
+
+/* Make sure MB_LEN_MAX is at least 16 on systems that claim to be able to
+ handle multibyte chars (some systems define MB_LEN_MAX as 1) */
+#ifdef HANDLE_MULTIBYTE
+# include <limits.h>
+# if defined(MB_LEN_MAX) && (MB_LEN_MAX < 16)
+# undef MB_LEN_MAX
+# endif
+# if !defined (MB_LEN_MAX)
+# define MB_LEN_MAX 16
+# endif
+#endif
+
+/************************************************/
+/* end of multibyte capability checks for I18N */
+/************************************************/
+
+/*
+ * Flags for _rl_find_prev_mbchar and _rl_find_next_mbchar:
+ *
+ * MB_FIND_ANY find any multibyte character
+ * MB_FIND_NONZERO find a non-zero-width multibyte character
+ */
+
+#define MB_FIND_ANY 0x00
+#define MB_FIND_NONZERO 0x01
+
+extern int _rl_find_prev_mbchar PARAMS((char *, int, int));
+extern int _rl_find_next_mbchar PARAMS((char *, int, int, int));
+
+#ifdef HANDLE_MULTIBYTE
+
+extern int _rl_compare_chars PARAMS((char *, int, mbstate_t *, char *, int, mbstate_t *));
+extern int _rl_get_char_len PARAMS((char *, mbstate_t *));
+extern int _rl_adjust_point PARAMS((char *, int, mbstate_t *));
+
+extern int _rl_read_mbchar PARAMS((char *, int));
+extern int _rl_read_mbstring PARAMS((int, char *, int));
+
+extern int _rl_is_mbchar_matched PARAMS((char *, int, int, char *, int));
+
+extern wchar_t _rl_char_value PARAMS((char *, int));
+extern int _rl_walphabetic PARAMS((wchar_t));
+
+#define _rl_to_wupper(wc) (iswlower (wc) ? towupper (wc) : (wc))
+#define _rl_to_wlower(wc) (iswupper (wc) ? towlower (wc) : (wc))
+
+#define MB_NEXTCHAR(b,s,c,f) \
+ ((MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0) \
+ ? _rl_find_next_mbchar ((b), (s), (c), (f)) \
+ : ((s) + (c)))
+#define MB_PREVCHAR(b,s,f) \
+ ((MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0) \
+ ? _rl_find_prev_mbchar ((b), (s), (f)) \
+ : ((s) - 1))
+
+#define MB_INVALIDCH(x) ((x) == (size_t)-1 || (x) == (size_t)-2)
+#define MB_NULLWCH(x) ((x) == 0)
+
+#else /* !HANDLE_MULTIBYTE */
+
+#undef MB_LEN_MAX
+#undef MB_CUR_MAX
+
+#define MB_LEN_MAX 1
+#define MB_CUR_MAX 1
+
+#define _rl_find_prev_mbchar(b, i, f) (((i) == 0) ? (i) : ((i) - 1))
+#define _rl_find_next_mbchar(b, i1, i2, f) ((i1) + (i2))
+
+#define _rl_char_value(buf,ind) ((buf)[(ind)])
+
+#define _rl_walphabetic(c) (rl_alphabetic (c))
+
+#define _rl_to_wupper(c) (_rl_to_upper (c))
+#define _rl_to_wlower(c) (_rl_to_lower (c))
+
+#define MB_NEXTCHAR(b,s,c,f) ((s) + (c))
+#define MB_PREVCHAR(b,s,f) ((s) - 1)
+
+#define MB_INVALIDCH(x) (0)
+#define MB_NULLWCH(x) (0)
+
+#endif /* !HANDLE_MULTIBYTE */
+
+extern int rl_byte_oriented;
+
+#endif /* _RL_MBUTIL_H_ */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rlprivate.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rlprivate.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1c216ea
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rlprivate.h
@@ -0,0 +1,420 @@
+/* rlprivate.h -- functions and variables global to the readline library,
+ but not intended for use by applications. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1999-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#if !defined (_RL_PRIVATE_H_)
+#define _RL_PRIVATE_H_
+
+#include "rlconf.h" /* for VISIBLE_STATS */
+#include "rlstdc.h"
+#include "posixjmp.h" /* defines procenv_t */
+
+/*************************************************************************
+ * *
+ * Global structs undocumented in texinfo manual and not in readline.h *
+ * *
+ *************************************************************************/
+/* search types */
+#define RL_SEARCH_ISEARCH 0x01 /* incremental search */
+#define RL_SEARCH_NSEARCH 0x02 /* non-incremental search */
+#define RL_SEARCH_CSEARCH 0x04 /* intra-line char search */
+
+/* search flags */
+#define SF_REVERSE 0x01
+#define SF_FOUND 0x02
+#define SF_FAILED 0x04
+
+typedef struct __rl_search_context
+{
+ int type;
+ int sflags;
+
+ char *search_string;
+ int search_string_index;
+ int search_string_size;
+
+ char **lines;
+ char *allocated_line;
+ int hlen;
+ int hindex;
+
+ int save_point;
+ int save_mark;
+ int save_line;
+ int last_found_line;
+ char *prev_line_found;
+
+ UNDO_LIST *save_undo_list;
+
+ int history_pos;
+ int direction;
+
+ int lastc;
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ char mb[MB_LEN_MAX];
+#endif
+
+ char *sline;
+ int sline_len;
+ int sline_index;
+
+ char *search_terminators;
+} _rl_search_cxt;
+
+/* Callback data for reading numeric arguments */
+#define NUM_SAWMINUS 0x01
+#define NUM_SAWDIGITS 0x02
+#define NUM_READONE 0x04
+
+typedef int _rl_arg_cxt;
+
+/* A context for reading key sequences longer than a single character when
+ using the callback interface. */
+#define KSEQ_DISPATCHED 0x01
+#define KSEQ_SUBSEQ 0x02
+#define KSEQ_RECURSIVE 0x04
+
+typedef struct __rl_keyseq_context
+{
+ int flags;
+ int subseq_arg;
+ int subseq_retval; /* XXX */
+ Keymap dmap;
+
+ Keymap oldmap;
+ int okey;
+ struct __rl_keyseq_context *ocxt;
+ int childval;
+} _rl_keyseq_cxt;
+
+ /* fill in more as needed */
+/* `Generic' callback data and functions */
+typedef struct __rl_callback_generic_arg
+{
+ int count;
+ int i1, i2;
+ /* add here as needed */
+} _rl_callback_generic_arg;
+
+typedef int _rl_callback_func_t PARAMS((_rl_callback_generic_arg *));
+
+/*************************************************************************
+ * *
+ * Global functions undocumented in texinfo manual and not in readline.h *
+ * *
+ *************************************************************************/
+
+/*************************************************************************
+ * *
+ * Global variables undocumented in texinfo manual and not in readline.h *
+ * *
+ *************************************************************************/
+
+/* complete.c */
+extern int rl_complete_with_tilde_expansion;
+#if defined (VISIBLE_STATS)
+extern int rl_visible_stats;
+#endif /* VISIBLE_STATS */
+
+/* readline.c */
+extern int rl_line_buffer_len;
+extern int rl_arg_sign;
+extern int rl_visible_prompt_length;
+extern int readline_echoing_p;
+extern int rl_key_sequence_length;
+extern int rl_byte_oriented;
+
+extern _rl_keyseq_cxt *_rl_kscxt;
+
+/* display.c */
+extern int rl_display_fixed;
+
+/* parens.c */
+extern int rl_blink_matching_paren;
+
+/*************************************************************************
+ * *
+ * Global functions and variables unsed and undocumented *
+ * *
+ *************************************************************************/
+
+/* kill.c */
+extern int rl_set_retained_kills PARAMS((int));
+
+/* terminal.c */
+extern void _rl_set_screen_size PARAMS((int, int));
+
+/* undo.c */
+extern int _rl_fix_last_undo_of_type PARAMS((int, int, int));
+
+/* util.c */
+extern char *_rl_savestring PARAMS((const char *));
+
+/*************************************************************************
+ * *
+ * Functions and variables private to the readline library *
+ * *
+ *************************************************************************/
+
+/* NOTE: Functions and variables prefixed with `_rl_' are
+ pseudo-global: they are global so they can be shared
+ between files in the readline library, but are not intended
+ to be visible to readline callers. */
+
+/*************************************************************************
+ * Undocumented private functions *
+ *************************************************************************/
+
+#if defined(READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+
+/* readline.c */
+extern void readline_internal_setup PARAMS((void));
+extern char *readline_internal_teardown PARAMS((int));
+extern int readline_internal_char PARAMS((void));
+
+extern _rl_keyseq_cxt *_rl_keyseq_cxt_alloc PARAMS((void));
+extern void _rl_keyseq_cxt_dispose PARAMS((_rl_keyseq_cxt *));
+extern void _rl_keyseq_chain_dispose PARAMS((void));
+
+extern int _rl_dispatch_callback PARAMS((_rl_keyseq_cxt *));
+
+/* callback.c */
+extern _rl_callback_generic_arg *_rl_callback_data_alloc PARAMS((int));
+extern void _rl_callback_data_dispose PARAMS((_rl_callback_generic_arg *));
+
+#endif /* READLINE_CALLBACKS */
+
+/* bind.c */
+
+/* complete.c */
+extern char _rl_find_completion_word PARAMS((int *, int *));
+extern void _rl_free_match_list PARAMS((char **));
+
+/* display.c */
+extern char *_rl_strip_prompt PARAMS((char *));
+extern void _rl_move_cursor_relative PARAMS((int, const char *));
+extern void _rl_move_vert PARAMS((int));
+extern void _rl_save_prompt PARAMS((void));
+extern void _rl_restore_prompt PARAMS((void));
+extern char *_rl_make_prompt_for_search PARAMS((int));
+extern void _rl_erase_at_end_of_line PARAMS((int));
+extern void _rl_clear_to_eol PARAMS((int));
+extern void _rl_clear_screen PARAMS((void));
+extern void _rl_update_final PARAMS((void));
+extern void _rl_redisplay_after_sigwinch PARAMS((void));
+extern void _rl_clean_up_for_exit PARAMS((void));
+extern void _rl_erase_entire_line PARAMS((void));
+extern int _rl_current_display_line PARAMS((void));
+
+/* input.c */
+extern int _rl_any_typein PARAMS((void));
+extern int _rl_input_available PARAMS((void));
+extern int _rl_input_queued PARAMS((int));
+extern void _rl_insert_typein PARAMS((int));
+extern int _rl_unget_char PARAMS((int));
+extern int _rl_pushed_input_available PARAMS((void));
+
+/* isearch.c */
+extern _rl_search_cxt *_rl_scxt_alloc PARAMS((int, int));
+extern void _rl_scxt_dispose PARAMS((_rl_search_cxt *, int));
+
+extern int _rl_isearch_dispatch PARAMS((_rl_search_cxt *, int));
+extern int _rl_isearch_callback PARAMS((_rl_search_cxt *));
+
+extern int _rl_search_getchar PARAMS((_rl_search_cxt *));
+
+/* macro.c */
+extern void _rl_with_macro_input PARAMS((char *));
+extern int _rl_next_macro_key PARAMS((void));
+extern void _rl_push_executing_macro PARAMS((void));
+extern void _rl_pop_executing_macro PARAMS((void));
+extern void _rl_add_macro_char PARAMS((int));
+extern void _rl_kill_kbd_macro PARAMS((void));
+
+/* misc.c */
+extern int _rl_arg_overflow PARAMS((void));
+extern void _rl_arg_init PARAMS((void));
+extern int _rl_arg_getchar PARAMS((void));
+extern int _rl_arg_callback PARAMS((_rl_arg_cxt));
+extern void _rl_reset_argument PARAMS((void));
+
+extern void _rl_start_using_history PARAMS((void));
+extern int _rl_free_saved_history_line PARAMS((void));
+extern void _rl_set_insert_mode PARAMS((int, int));
+
+/* nls.c */
+extern int _rl_init_eightbit PARAMS((void));
+
+/* parens.c */
+extern void _rl_enable_paren_matching PARAMS((int));
+
+/* readline.c */
+extern void _rl_init_line_state PARAMS((void));
+extern void _rl_set_the_line PARAMS((void));
+extern int _rl_dispatch PARAMS((int, Keymap));
+extern int _rl_dispatch_subseq PARAMS((int, Keymap, int));
+extern void _rl_internal_char_cleanup PARAMS((void));
+
+/* rltty.c */
+extern int _rl_disable_tty_signals PARAMS((void));
+extern int _rl_restore_tty_signals PARAMS((void));
+
+/* search.c */
+extern int _rl_nsearch_callback PARAMS((_rl_search_cxt *));
+
+/* terminal.c */
+extern void _rl_get_screen_size PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int _rl_init_terminal_io PARAMS((const char *));
+#ifdef _MINIX
+extern void _rl_output_character_function PARAMS((int));
+#else
+extern int _rl_output_character_function PARAMS((int));
+#endif
+extern void _rl_output_some_chars PARAMS((const char *, int));
+extern int _rl_backspace PARAMS((int));
+extern void _rl_enable_meta_key PARAMS((void));
+extern void _rl_control_keypad PARAMS((int));
+extern void _rl_set_cursor PARAMS((int, int));
+
+/* text.c */
+extern void _rl_fix_point PARAMS((int));
+extern int _rl_replace_text PARAMS((const char *, int, int));
+extern int _rl_insert_char PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int _rl_overwrite_char PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int _rl_overwrite_rubout PARAMS((int, int));
+extern int _rl_rubout_char PARAMS((int, int));
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+extern int _rl_char_search_internal PARAMS((int, int, char *, int));
+#else
+extern int _rl_char_search_internal PARAMS((int, int, int));
+#endif
+extern int _rl_set_mark_at_pos PARAMS((int));
+
+/* util.c */
+extern int _rl_abort_internal PARAMS((void));
+extern char *_rl_strindex PARAMS((const char *, const char *));
+extern int _rl_qsort_string_compare PARAMS((char **, char **));
+extern int (_rl_uppercase_p) PARAMS((int));
+extern int (_rl_lowercase_p) PARAMS((int));
+extern int (_rl_pure_alphabetic) PARAMS((int));
+extern int (_rl_digit_p) PARAMS((int));
+extern int (_rl_to_lower) PARAMS((int));
+extern int (_rl_to_upper) PARAMS((int));
+extern int (_rl_digit_value) PARAMS((int));
+
+/* vi_mode.c */
+extern void _rl_vi_initialize_line PARAMS((void));
+extern void _rl_vi_reset_last PARAMS((void));
+extern void _rl_vi_set_last PARAMS((int, int, int));
+extern int _rl_vi_textmod_command PARAMS((int));
+extern void _rl_vi_done_inserting PARAMS((void));
+
+/*************************************************************************
+ * Undocumented private variables *
+ *************************************************************************/
+
+/* bind.c */
+extern const char *_rl_possible_control_prefixes[];
+extern const char *_rl_possible_meta_prefixes[];
+
+/* callback.c */
+extern _rl_callback_func_t *_rl_callback_func;
+extern _rl_callback_generic_arg *_rl_callback_data;
+
+/* complete.c */
+extern int _rl_complete_show_all;
+extern int _rl_complete_show_unmodified;
+extern int _rl_complete_mark_directories;
+extern int _rl_complete_mark_symlink_dirs;
+extern int _rl_print_completions_horizontally;
+extern int _rl_completion_case_fold;
+extern int _rl_match_hidden_files;
+extern int _rl_page_completions;
+
+/* display.c */
+extern int _rl_vis_botlin;
+extern int _rl_last_c_pos;
+extern int _rl_suppress_redisplay;
+extern int _rl_want_redisplay;
+extern char *rl_display_prompt;
+
+/* isearch.c */
+extern char *_rl_isearch_terminators;
+
+extern _rl_search_cxt *_rl_iscxt;
+
+/* macro.c */
+extern char *_rl_executing_macro;
+
+/* misc.c */
+extern int _rl_history_preserve_point;
+extern int _rl_history_saved_point;
+
+extern _rl_arg_cxt _rl_argcxt;
+
+/* readline.c */
+extern int _rl_horizontal_scroll_mode;
+extern int _rl_mark_modified_lines;
+extern int _rl_bell_preference;
+extern int _rl_meta_flag;
+extern int _rl_convert_meta_chars_to_ascii;
+extern int _rl_output_meta_chars;
+extern int _rl_bind_stty_chars;
+extern char *_rl_comment_begin;
+extern unsigned char _rl_parsing_conditionalized_out;
+extern Keymap _rl_keymap;
+extern FILE *_rl_in_stream;
+extern FILE *_rl_out_stream;
+extern int _rl_last_command_was_kill;
+extern int _rl_eof_char;
+extern procenv_t readline_top_level;
+
+/* search.c */
+extern _rl_search_cxt *_rl_nscxt;
+
+/* terminal.c */
+extern int _rl_enable_keypad;
+extern int _rl_enable_meta;
+extern char *_rl_term_clreol;
+extern char *_rl_term_clrpag;
+extern char *_rl_term_im;
+extern char *_rl_term_ic;
+extern char *_rl_term_ei;
+extern char *_rl_term_DC;
+extern char *_rl_term_up;
+extern char *_rl_term_dc;
+extern char *_rl_term_cr;
+extern char *_rl_term_IC;
+extern int _rl_screenheight;
+extern int _rl_screenwidth;
+extern int _rl_screenchars;
+extern int _rl_terminal_can_insert;
+extern int _rl_term_autowrap;
+
+/* undo.c */
+extern int _rl_doing_an_undo;
+extern int _rl_undo_group_level;
+
+/* vi_mode.c */
+extern int _rl_vi_last_command;
+
+#endif /* _RL_PRIVATE_H_ */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rlshell.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rlshell.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3c03fba
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rlshell.h
@@ -0,0 +1,34 @@
+/* rlshell.h -- utility functions normally provided by bash. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#if !defined (_RL_SHELL_H_)
+#define _RL_SHELL_H_
+
+#include "rlstdc.h"
+
+extern char *sh_single_quote PARAMS((char *));
+extern void sh_set_lines_and_columns PARAMS((int, int));
+extern char *sh_get_env_value PARAMS((const char *));
+extern char *sh_get_home_dir PARAMS((void));
+extern int sh_unset_nodelay_mode PARAMS((int));
+
+#endif /* _RL_SHELL_H_ */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rlstdc.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rlstdc.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..847fa9c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rlstdc.h
@@ -0,0 +1,45 @@
+/* stdc.h -- macros to make source compile on both ANSI C and K&R C
+ compilers. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1993 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT
+ ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY
+ or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public
+ License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
+ Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#if !defined (_RL_STDC_H_)
+#define _RL_STDC_H_
+
+/* Adapted from BSD /usr/include/sys/cdefs.h. */
+
+/* A function can be defined using prototypes and compile on both ANSI C
+ and traditional C compilers with something like this:
+ extern char *func PARAMS((char *, char *, int)); */
+
+#if !defined (PARAMS)
+# if defined (__STDC__) || defined (__GNUC__) || defined (__cplusplus)
+# define PARAMS(protos) protos
+# else
+# define PARAMS(protos) ()
+# endif
+#endif
+
+#ifndef __attribute__
+# if __GNUC__ < 2 || (__GNUC__ == 2 && __GNUC_MINOR__ < 8)
+# define __attribute__(x)
+# endif
+#endif
+
+#endif /* !_RL_STDC_H_ */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rltty.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rltty.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9a0326e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rltty.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1035 @@
+/* rltty.c -- functions to prepare and restore the terminal for readline's
+ use. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1992-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <signal.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif /* HAVE_UNISTD_H */
+
+#include "rldefs.h"
+
+#if defined (GWINSZ_IN_SYS_IOCTL)
+# include <sys/ioctl.h>
+#endif /* GWINSZ_IN_SYS_IOCTL */
+
+#include "rltty.h"
+#include "readline.h"
+#include "rlprivate.h"
+
+#if !defined (errno)
+extern int errno;
+#endif /* !errno */
+
+rl_vintfunc_t *rl_prep_term_function = rl_prep_terminal;
+rl_voidfunc_t *rl_deprep_term_function = rl_deprep_terminal;
+
+static void block_sigint PARAMS((void));
+static void release_sigint PARAMS((void));
+
+static void set_winsize PARAMS((int));
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Signal Management */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS)
+static sigset_t sigint_set, sigint_oset;
+#else /* !HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS */
+# if defined (HAVE_BSD_SIGNALS)
+static int sigint_oldmask;
+# endif /* HAVE_BSD_SIGNALS */
+#endif /* !HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS */
+
+static int sigint_blocked;
+
+/* Cause SIGINT to not be delivered until the corresponding call to
+ release_sigint(). */
+static void
+block_sigint ()
+{
+ if (sigint_blocked)
+ return;
+
+#if defined (HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS)
+ sigemptyset (&sigint_set);
+ sigemptyset (&sigint_oset);
+ sigaddset (&sigint_set, SIGINT);
+ sigprocmask (SIG_BLOCK, &sigint_set, &sigint_oset);
+#else /* !HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS */
+# if defined (HAVE_BSD_SIGNALS)
+ sigint_oldmask = sigblock (sigmask (SIGINT));
+# else /* !HAVE_BSD_SIGNALS */
+# if defined (HAVE_USG_SIGHOLD)
+ sighold (SIGINT);
+# endif /* HAVE_USG_SIGHOLD */
+# endif /* !HAVE_BSD_SIGNALS */
+#endif /* !HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS */
+
+ sigint_blocked = 1;
+}
+
+/* Allow SIGINT to be delivered. */
+static void
+release_sigint ()
+{
+ if (sigint_blocked == 0)
+ return;
+
+#if defined (HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS)
+ sigprocmask (SIG_SETMASK, &sigint_oset, (sigset_t *)NULL);
+#else
+# if defined (HAVE_BSD_SIGNALS)
+ sigsetmask (sigint_oldmask);
+# else /* !HAVE_BSD_SIGNALS */
+# if defined (HAVE_USG_SIGHOLD)
+ sigrelse (SIGINT);
+# endif /* HAVE_USG_SIGHOLD */
+# endif /* !HAVE_BSD_SIGNALS */
+#endif /* !HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS */
+
+ sigint_blocked = 0;
+}
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Saving and Restoring the TTY */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* Non-zero means that the terminal is in a prepped state. */
+static int terminal_prepped;
+
+static _RL_TTY_CHARS _rl_tty_chars, _rl_last_tty_chars;
+
+/* If non-zero, means that this process has called tcflow(fd, TCOOFF)
+ and output is suspended. */
+#if defined (__ksr1__)
+static int ksrflow;
+#endif
+
+/* Dummy call to force a backgrounded readline to stop before it tries
+ to get the tty settings. */
+static void
+set_winsize (tty)
+ int tty;
+{
+#if defined (TIOCGWINSZ)
+ struct winsize w;
+
+ if (ioctl (tty, TIOCGWINSZ, &w) == 0)
+ (void) ioctl (tty, TIOCSWINSZ, &w);
+#endif /* TIOCGWINSZ */
+}
+
+#if defined (NO_TTY_DRIVER)
+/* Nothing */
+#elif defined (NEW_TTY_DRIVER)
+
+/* Values for the `flags' field of a struct bsdtty. This tells which
+ elements of the struct bsdtty have been fetched from the system and
+ are valid. */
+#define SGTTY_SET 0x01
+#define LFLAG_SET 0x02
+#define TCHARS_SET 0x04
+#define LTCHARS_SET 0x08
+
+struct bsdtty {
+ struct sgttyb sgttyb; /* Basic BSD tty driver information. */
+ int lflag; /* Local mode flags, like LPASS8. */
+#if defined (TIOCGETC)
+ struct tchars tchars; /* Terminal special characters, including ^S and ^Q. */
+#endif
+#if defined (TIOCGLTC)
+ struct ltchars ltchars; /* 4.2 BSD editing characters */
+#endif
+ int flags; /* Bitmap saying which parts of the struct are valid. */
+};
+
+#define TIOTYPE struct bsdtty
+
+static TIOTYPE otio;
+
+static void save_tty_chars PARAMS((TIOTYPE *));
+static int _get_tty_settings PARAMS((int, TIOTYPE *));
+static int get_tty_settings PARAMS((int, TIOTYPE *));
+static int _set_tty_settings PARAMS((int, TIOTYPE *));
+static int set_tty_settings PARAMS((int, TIOTYPE *));
+
+static void prepare_terminal_settings PARAMS((int, TIOTYPE, TIOTYPE *));
+
+static void set_special_char PARAMS((Keymap, TIOTYPE *, int, rl_command_func_t));
+
+static void
+save_tty_chars (tiop)
+ TIOTYPE *tiop;
+{
+ _rl_last_tty_chars = _rl_tty_chars;
+
+ if (tiop->flags & SGTTY_SET)
+ {
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_erase = tiop->sgttyb.sg_erase;
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_kill = tiop->sgttyb.sg_kill;
+ }
+
+ if (tiop->flags & TCHARS_SET)
+ {
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_intr = tiop->tchars.t_intrc;
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_quit = tiop->tchars.t_quitc;
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_start = tiop->tchars.t_startc;
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_stop = tiop->tchars.t_stopc;
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_eof = tiop->tchars.t_eofc;
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_eol = '\n';
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_eol2 = tiop->tchars.t_brkc;
+ }
+
+ if (tiop->flags & LTCHARS_SET)
+ {
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_susp = tiop->ltchars.t_suspc;
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_dsusp = tiop->ltchars.t_dsuspc;
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_reprint = tiop->ltchars.t_rprntc;
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_flush = tiop->ltchars.t_flushc;
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_werase = tiop->ltchars.t_werasc;
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_lnext = tiop->ltchars.t_lnextc;
+ }
+
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_status = -1;
+}
+
+static int
+get_tty_settings (tty, tiop)
+ int tty;
+ TIOTYPE *tiop;
+{
+ set_winsize (tty);
+
+ tiop->flags = tiop->lflag = 0;
+
+ errno = 0;
+ if (ioctl (tty, TIOCGETP, &(tiop->sgttyb)) < 0)
+ return -1;
+ tiop->flags |= SGTTY_SET;
+
+#if defined (TIOCLGET)
+ if (ioctl (tty, TIOCLGET, &(tiop->lflag)) == 0)
+ tiop->flags |= LFLAG_SET;
+#endif
+
+#if defined (TIOCGETC)
+ if (ioctl (tty, TIOCGETC, &(tiop->tchars)) == 0)
+ tiop->flags |= TCHARS_SET;
+#endif
+
+#if defined (TIOCGLTC)
+ if (ioctl (tty, TIOCGLTC, &(tiop->ltchars)) == 0)
+ tiop->flags |= LTCHARS_SET;
+#endif
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+static int
+set_tty_settings (tty, tiop)
+ int tty;
+ TIOTYPE *tiop;
+{
+ if (tiop->flags & SGTTY_SET)
+ {
+ ioctl (tty, TIOCSETN, &(tiop->sgttyb));
+ tiop->flags &= ~SGTTY_SET;
+ }
+ readline_echoing_p = 1;
+
+#if defined (TIOCLSET)
+ if (tiop->flags & LFLAG_SET)
+ {
+ ioctl (tty, TIOCLSET, &(tiop->lflag));
+ tiop->flags &= ~LFLAG_SET;
+ }
+#endif
+
+#if defined (TIOCSETC)
+ if (tiop->flags & TCHARS_SET)
+ {
+ ioctl (tty, TIOCSETC, &(tiop->tchars));
+ tiop->flags &= ~TCHARS_SET;
+ }
+#endif
+
+#if defined (TIOCSLTC)
+ if (tiop->flags & LTCHARS_SET)
+ {
+ ioctl (tty, TIOCSLTC, &(tiop->ltchars));
+ tiop->flags &= ~LTCHARS_SET;
+ }
+#endif
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+static void
+prepare_terminal_settings (meta_flag, oldtio, tiop)
+ int meta_flag;
+ TIOTYPE oldtio, *tiop;
+{
+ readline_echoing_p = (oldtio.sgttyb.sg_flags & ECHO);
+
+ /* Copy the original settings to the structure we're going to use for
+ our settings. */
+ tiop->sgttyb = oldtio.sgttyb;
+ tiop->lflag = oldtio.lflag;
+#if defined (TIOCGETC)
+ tiop->tchars = oldtio.tchars;
+#endif
+#if defined (TIOCGLTC)
+ tiop->ltchars = oldtio.ltchars;
+#endif
+ tiop->flags = oldtio.flags;
+
+ /* First, the basic settings to put us into character-at-a-time, no-echo
+ input mode. */
+ tiop->sgttyb.sg_flags &= ~(ECHO | CRMOD);
+ tiop->sgttyb.sg_flags |= CBREAK;
+
+ /* If this terminal doesn't care how the 8th bit is used, then we can
+ use it for the meta-key. If only one of even or odd parity is
+ specified, then the terminal is using parity, and we cannot. */
+#if !defined (ANYP)
+# define ANYP (EVENP | ODDP)
+#endif
+ if (((oldtio.sgttyb.sg_flags & ANYP) == ANYP) ||
+ ((oldtio.sgttyb.sg_flags & ANYP) == 0))
+ {
+ tiop->sgttyb.sg_flags |= ANYP;
+
+ /* Hack on local mode flags if we can. */
+#if defined (TIOCLGET)
+# if defined (LPASS8)
+ tiop->lflag |= LPASS8;
+# endif /* LPASS8 */
+#endif /* TIOCLGET */
+ }
+
+#if defined (TIOCGETC)
+# if defined (USE_XON_XOFF)
+ /* Get rid of terminal output start and stop characters. */
+ tiop->tchars.t_stopc = -1; /* C-s */
+ tiop->tchars.t_startc = -1; /* C-q */
+
+ /* If there is an XON character, bind it to restart the output. */
+ if (oldtio.tchars.t_startc != -1)
+ rl_bind_key (oldtio.tchars.t_startc, rl_restart_output);
+# endif /* USE_XON_XOFF */
+
+ /* If there is an EOF char, bind _rl_eof_char to it. */
+ if (oldtio.tchars.t_eofc != -1)
+ _rl_eof_char = oldtio.tchars.t_eofc;
+
+# if defined (NO_KILL_INTR)
+ /* Get rid of terminal-generated SIGQUIT and SIGINT. */
+ tiop->tchars.t_quitc = -1; /* C-\ */
+ tiop->tchars.t_intrc = -1; /* C-c */
+# endif /* NO_KILL_INTR */
+#endif /* TIOCGETC */
+
+#if defined (TIOCGLTC)
+ /* Make the interrupt keys go away. Just enough to make people happy. */
+ tiop->ltchars.t_dsuspc = -1; /* C-y */
+ tiop->ltchars.t_lnextc = -1; /* C-v */
+#endif /* TIOCGLTC */
+}
+
+#else /* !defined (NEW_TTY_DRIVER) */
+
+#if !defined (VMIN)
+# define VMIN VEOF
+#endif
+
+#if !defined (VTIME)
+# define VTIME VEOL
+#endif
+
+#if defined (TERMIOS_TTY_DRIVER)
+# define TIOTYPE struct termios
+# define DRAIN_OUTPUT(fd) tcdrain (fd)
+# define GETATTR(tty, tiop) (tcgetattr (tty, tiop))
+# ifdef M_UNIX
+# define SETATTR(tty, tiop) (tcsetattr (tty, TCSANOW, tiop))
+# else
+# define SETATTR(tty, tiop) (tcsetattr (tty, TCSADRAIN, tiop))
+# endif /* !M_UNIX */
+#else
+# define TIOTYPE struct termio
+# define DRAIN_OUTPUT(fd)
+# define GETATTR(tty, tiop) (ioctl (tty, TCGETA, tiop))
+# define SETATTR(tty, tiop) (ioctl (tty, TCSETAW, tiop))
+#endif /* !TERMIOS_TTY_DRIVER */
+
+static TIOTYPE otio;
+
+static void save_tty_chars PARAMS((TIOTYPE *));
+static int _get_tty_settings PARAMS((int, TIOTYPE *));
+static int get_tty_settings PARAMS((int, TIOTYPE *));
+static int _set_tty_settings PARAMS((int, TIOTYPE *));
+static int set_tty_settings PARAMS((int, TIOTYPE *));
+
+static void prepare_terminal_settings PARAMS((int, TIOTYPE, TIOTYPE *));
+
+static void set_special_char PARAMS((Keymap, TIOTYPE *, int, rl_command_func_t));
+static void _rl_bind_tty_special_chars PARAMS((Keymap, TIOTYPE));
+
+#if defined (FLUSHO)
+# define OUTPUT_BEING_FLUSHED(tp) (tp->c_lflag & FLUSHO)
+#else
+# define OUTPUT_BEING_FLUSHED(tp) 0
+#endif
+
+static void
+save_tty_chars (tiop)
+ TIOTYPE *tiop;
+{
+ _rl_last_tty_chars = _rl_tty_chars;
+
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_eof = tiop->c_cc[VEOF];
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_eol = tiop->c_cc[VEOL];
+#ifdef VEOL2
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_eol2 = tiop->c_cc[VEOL2];
+#endif
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_erase = tiop->c_cc[VERASE];
+#ifdef VWERASE
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_werase = tiop->c_cc[VWERASE];
+#endif
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_kill = tiop->c_cc[VKILL];
+#ifdef VREPRINT
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_reprint = tiop->c_cc[VREPRINT];
+#endif
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_intr = tiop->c_cc[VINTR];
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_quit = tiop->c_cc[VQUIT];
+#ifdef VSUSP
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_susp = tiop->c_cc[VSUSP];
+#endif
+#ifdef VDSUSP
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_dsusp = tiop->c_cc[VDSUSP];
+#endif
+#ifdef VSTART
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_start = tiop->c_cc[VSTART];
+#endif
+#ifdef VSTOP
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_stop = tiop->c_cc[VSTOP];
+#endif
+#ifdef VLNEXT
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_lnext = tiop->c_cc[VLNEXT];
+#endif
+#ifdef VDISCARD
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_flush = tiop->c_cc[VDISCARD];
+#endif
+#ifdef VSTATUS
+ _rl_tty_chars.t_status = tiop->c_cc[VSTATUS];
+#endif
+}
+
+#if defined (_AIX) || defined (_AIX41)
+/* Currently this is only used on AIX */
+static void
+rltty_warning (msg)
+ char *msg;
+{
+ fprintf (stderr, "readline: warning: %s\n", msg);
+}
+#endif
+
+#if defined (_AIX)
+void
+setopost(tp)
+TIOTYPE *tp;
+{
+ if ((tp->c_oflag & OPOST) == 0)
+ {
+ rltty_warning ("turning on OPOST for terminal\r");
+ tp->c_oflag |= OPOST|ONLCR;
+ }
+}
+#endif
+
+static int
+_get_tty_settings (tty, tiop)
+ int tty;
+ TIOTYPE *tiop;
+{
+ int ioctl_ret;
+
+ while (1)
+ {
+ ioctl_ret = GETATTR (tty, tiop);
+ if (ioctl_ret < 0)
+ {
+ if (errno != EINTR)
+ return -1;
+ else
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (OUTPUT_BEING_FLUSHED (tiop))
+ {
+#if defined (FLUSHO) && defined (_AIX41)
+ rltty_warning ("turning off output flushing");
+ tiop->c_lflag &= ~FLUSHO;
+ break;
+#else
+ continue;
+#endif
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+static int
+get_tty_settings (tty, tiop)
+ int tty;
+ TIOTYPE *tiop;
+{
+ set_winsize (tty);
+
+ errno = 0;
+ if (_get_tty_settings (tty, tiop) < 0)
+ return -1;
+
+#if defined (_AIX)
+ setopost(tiop);
+#endif
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+static int
+_set_tty_settings (tty, tiop)
+ int tty;
+ TIOTYPE *tiop;
+{
+ while (SETATTR (tty, tiop) < 0)
+ {
+ if (errno != EINTR)
+ return -1;
+ errno = 0;
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+static int
+set_tty_settings (tty, tiop)
+ int tty;
+ TIOTYPE *tiop;
+{
+ if (_set_tty_settings (tty, tiop) < 0)
+ return -1;
+
+#if 0
+
+#if defined (TERMIOS_TTY_DRIVER)
+# if defined (__ksr1__)
+ if (ksrflow)
+ {
+ ksrflow = 0;
+ tcflow (tty, TCOON);
+ }
+# else /* !ksr1 */
+ tcflow (tty, TCOON); /* Simulate a ^Q. */
+# endif /* !ksr1 */
+#else
+ ioctl (tty, TCXONC, 1); /* Simulate a ^Q. */
+#endif /* !TERMIOS_TTY_DRIVER */
+
+#endif /* 0 */
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+static void
+prepare_terminal_settings (meta_flag, oldtio, tiop)
+ int meta_flag;
+ TIOTYPE oldtio, *tiop;
+{
+ readline_echoing_p = (oldtio.c_lflag & ECHO);
+
+ tiop->c_lflag &= ~(ICANON | ECHO);
+
+ if ((unsigned char) oldtio.c_cc[VEOF] != (unsigned char) _POSIX_VDISABLE)
+ _rl_eof_char = oldtio.c_cc[VEOF];
+
+#if defined (USE_XON_XOFF)
+#if defined (IXANY)
+ tiop->c_iflag &= ~(IXON | IXOFF | IXANY);
+#else
+ /* `strict' Posix systems do not define IXANY. */
+ tiop->c_iflag &= ~(IXON | IXOFF);
+#endif /* IXANY */
+#endif /* USE_XON_XOFF */
+
+ /* Only turn this off if we are using all 8 bits. */
+ if (((tiop->c_cflag & CSIZE) == CS8) || meta_flag)
+ tiop->c_iflag &= ~(ISTRIP | INPCK);
+
+ /* Make sure we differentiate between CR and NL on input. */
+ tiop->c_iflag &= ~(ICRNL | INLCR);
+
+#if !defined (HANDLE_SIGNALS)
+ tiop->c_lflag &= ~ISIG;
+#else
+ tiop->c_lflag |= ISIG;
+#endif
+
+ tiop->c_cc[VMIN] = 1;
+ tiop->c_cc[VTIME] = 0;
+
+#if defined (FLUSHO)
+ if (OUTPUT_BEING_FLUSHED (tiop))
+ {
+ tiop->c_lflag &= ~FLUSHO;
+ oldtio.c_lflag &= ~FLUSHO;
+ }
+#endif
+
+ /* Turn off characters that we need on Posix systems with job control,
+ just to be sure. This includes ^Y and ^V. This should not really
+ be necessary. */
+#if defined (TERMIOS_TTY_DRIVER) && defined (_POSIX_VDISABLE)
+
+#if defined (VLNEXT)
+ tiop->c_cc[VLNEXT] = _POSIX_VDISABLE;
+#endif
+
+#if defined (VDSUSP)
+ tiop->c_cc[VDSUSP] = _POSIX_VDISABLE;
+#endif
+
+#endif /* TERMIOS_TTY_DRIVER && _POSIX_VDISABLE */
+}
+#endif /* !NEW_TTY_DRIVER */
+
+/* Put the terminal in CBREAK mode so that we can detect key presses. */
+#if defined (NO_TTY_DRIVER)
+void
+rl_prep_terminal (meta_flag)
+ int meta_flag;
+{
+ readline_echoing_p = 1;
+}
+
+void
+rl_deprep_terminal ()
+{
+}
+
+#else /* ! NO_TTY_DRIVER */
+void
+rl_prep_terminal (meta_flag)
+ int meta_flag;
+{
+ int tty;
+ TIOTYPE tio;
+
+ if (terminal_prepped)
+ return;
+
+ /* Try to keep this function from being INTerrupted. */
+ block_sigint ();
+
+ tty = fileno (rl_instream);
+
+ if (get_tty_settings (tty, &tio) < 0)
+ {
+#if defined (ENOTSUP)
+ /* MacOS X, at least, lies about the value of errno if tcgetattr fails. */
+ if (errno == ENOTTY || errno == ENOTSUP)
+#else
+ if (errno == ENOTTY)
+#endif
+ readline_echoing_p = 1; /* XXX */
+ release_sigint ();
+ return;
+ }
+
+ otio = tio;
+
+ if (_rl_bind_stty_chars)
+ {
+#if defined (VI_MODE)
+ /* If editing in vi mode, make sure we restore the bindings in the
+ insertion keymap no matter what keymap we ended up in. */
+ if (rl_editing_mode == vi_mode)
+ rl_tty_unset_default_bindings (vi_insertion_keymap);
+ else
+#endif
+ rl_tty_unset_default_bindings (_rl_keymap);
+ }
+ save_tty_chars (&otio);
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_TTYCSAVED);
+ if (_rl_bind_stty_chars)
+ {
+#if defined (VI_MODE)
+ /* If editing in vi mode, make sure we set the bindings in the
+ insertion keymap no matter what keymap we ended up in. */
+ if (rl_editing_mode == vi_mode)
+ _rl_bind_tty_special_chars (vi_insertion_keymap, tio);
+ else
+#endif
+ _rl_bind_tty_special_chars (_rl_keymap, tio);
+ }
+
+ prepare_terminal_settings (meta_flag, otio, &tio);
+
+ if (set_tty_settings (tty, &tio) < 0)
+ {
+ release_sigint ();
+ return;
+ }
+
+ if (_rl_enable_keypad)
+ _rl_control_keypad (1);
+
+ fflush (rl_outstream);
+ terminal_prepped = 1;
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_TERMPREPPED);
+
+ release_sigint ();
+}
+
+/* Restore the terminal's normal settings and modes. */
+void
+rl_deprep_terminal ()
+{
+ int tty;
+
+ if (!terminal_prepped)
+ return;
+
+ /* Try to keep this function from being interrupted. */
+ block_sigint ();
+
+ tty = fileno (rl_instream);
+
+ if (_rl_enable_keypad)
+ _rl_control_keypad (0);
+
+ fflush (rl_outstream);
+
+ if (set_tty_settings (tty, &otio) < 0)
+ {
+ release_sigint ();
+ return;
+ }
+
+ terminal_prepped = 0;
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_TERMPREPPED);
+
+ release_sigint ();
+}
+#endif /* !NO_TTY_DRIVER */
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Bogus Flow Control */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+int
+rl_restart_output (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+#if defined (__MINGW32__)
+ return 0;
+#else /* !__MING32__ */
+
+ int fildes = fileno (rl_outstream);
+#if defined (TIOCSTART)
+#if defined (apollo)
+ ioctl (&fildes, TIOCSTART, 0);
+#else
+ ioctl (fildes, TIOCSTART, 0);
+#endif /* apollo */
+
+#else /* !TIOCSTART */
+# if defined (TERMIOS_TTY_DRIVER)
+# if defined (__ksr1__)
+ if (ksrflow)
+ {
+ ksrflow = 0;
+ tcflow (fildes, TCOON);
+ }
+# else /* !ksr1 */
+ tcflow (fildes, TCOON); /* Simulate a ^Q. */
+# endif /* !ksr1 */
+# else /* !TERMIOS_TTY_DRIVER */
+# if defined (TCXONC)
+ ioctl (fildes, TCXONC, TCOON);
+# endif /* TCXONC */
+# endif /* !TERMIOS_TTY_DRIVER */
+#endif /* !TIOCSTART */
+
+ return 0;
+#endif /* !__MINGW32__ */
+}
+
+int
+rl_stop_output (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+#if defined (__MINGW32__)
+ return 0;
+#else
+
+ int fildes = fileno (rl_instream);
+
+#if defined (TIOCSTOP)
+# if defined (apollo)
+ ioctl (&fildes, TIOCSTOP, 0);
+# else
+ ioctl (fildes, TIOCSTOP, 0);
+# endif /* apollo */
+#else /* !TIOCSTOP */
+# if defined (TERMIOS_TTY_DRIVER)
+# if defined (__ksr1__)
+ ksrflow = 1;
+# endif /* ksr1 */
+ tcflow (fildes, TCOOFF);
+# else
+# if defined (TCXONC)
+ ioctl (fildes, TCXONC, TCOON);
+# endif /* TCXONC */
+# endif /* !TERMIOS_TTY_DRIVER */
+#endif /* !TIOCSTOP */
+
+ return 0;
+#endif /* !__MINGW32__ */
+}
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Default Key Bindings */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+#if !defined (NO_TTY_DRIVER)
+#define SET_SPECIAL(sc, func) set_special_char(kmap, &ttybuff, sc, func)
+#endif
+
+#if defined (NO_TTY_DRIVER)
+
+#define SET_SPECIAL(sc, func)
+#define RESET_SPECIAL(c)
+
+#elif defined (NEW_TTY_DRIVER)
+static void
+set_special_char (kmap, tiop, sc, func)
+ Keymap kmap;
+ TIOTYPE *tiop;
+ int sc;
+ rl_command_func_t *func;
+{
+ if (sc != -1 && kmap[(unsigned char)sc].type == ISFUNC)
+ kmap[(unsigned char)sc].function = func;
+}
+
+#define RESET_SPECIAL(c) \
+ if (c != -1 && kmap[(unsigned char)c].type == ISFUNC)
+ kmap[(unsigned char)c].function = rl_insert;
+
+static void
+_rl_bind_tty_special_chars (kmap, ttybuff)
+ Keymap kmap;
+ TIOTYPE ttybuff;
+{
+ if (ttybuff.flags & SGTTY_SET)
+ {
+ SET_SPECIAL (ttybuff.sgttyb.sg_erase, rl_rubout);
+ SET_SPECIAL (ttybuff.sgttyb.sg_kill, rl_unix_line_discard);
+ }
+
+# if defined (TIOCGLTC)
+ if (ttybuff.flags & LTCHARS_SET)
+ {
+ SET_SPECIAL (ttybuff.ltchars.t_werasc, rl_unix_word_rubout);
+ SET_SPECIAL (ttybuff.ltchars.t_lnextc, rl_quoted_insert);
+ }
+# endif /* TIOCGLTC */
+}
+
+#else /* !NEW_TTY_DRIVER */
+static void
+set_special_char (kmap, tiop, sc, func)
+ Keymap kmap;
+ TIOTYPE *tiop;
+ int sc;
+ rl_command_func_t *func;
+{
+ unsigned char uc;
+
+ uc = tiop->c_cc[sc];
+ if (uc != (unsigned char)_POSIX_VDISABLE && kmap[uc].type == ISFUNC)
+ kmap[uc].function = func;
+}
+
+/* used later */
+#define RESET_SPECIAL(uc) \
+ if (uc != (unsigned char)_POSIX_VDISABLE && kmap[uc].type == ISFUNC) \
+ kmap[uc].function = rl_insert;
+
+static void
+_rl_bind_tty_special_chars (kmap, ttybuff)
+ Keymap kmap;
+ TIOTYPE ttybuff;
+{
+ SET_SPECIAL (VERASE, rl_rubout);
+ SET_SPECIAL (VKILL, rl_unix_line_discard);
+
+# if defined (VLNEXT) && defined (TERMIOS_TTY_DRIVER)
+ SET_SPECIAL (VLNEXT, rl_quoted_insert);
+# endif /* VLNEXT && TERMIOS_TTY_DRIVER */
+
+# if defined (VWERASE) && defined (TERMIOS_TTY_DRIVER)
+ SET_SPECIAL (VWERASE, rl_unix_word_rubout);
+# endif /* VWERASE && TERMIOS_TTY_DRIVER */
+}
+
+#endif /* !NEW_TTY_DRIVER */
+
+/* Set the system's default editing characters to their readline equivalents
+ in KMAP. Should be static, now that we have rl_tty_set_default_bindings. */
+void
+rltty_set_default_bindings (kmap)
+ Keymap kmap;
+{
+#if !defined (NO_TTY_DRIVER)
+ TIOTYPE ttybuff;
+ int tty;
+ static int called = 0;
+
+ tty = fileno (rl_instream);
+
+ if (get_tty_settings (tty, &ttybuff) == 0)
+ _rl_bind_tty_special_chars (kmap, ttybuff);
+#endif
+}
+
+/* New public way to set the system default editing chars to their readline
+ equivalents. */
+void
+rl_tty_set_default_bindings (kmap)
+ Keymap kmap;
+{
+ rltty_set_default_bindings (kmap);
+}
+
+/* Rebind all of the tty special chars that readline worries about back
+ to self-insert. Call this before saving the current terminal special
+ chars with save_tty_chars(). This only works on POSIX termios or termio
+ systems. */
+void
+rl_tty_unset_default_bindings (kmap)
+ Keymap kmap;
+{
+ /* Don't bother before we've saved the tty special chars at least once. */
+ if (RL_ISSTATE(RL_STATE_TTYCSAVED) == 0)
+ return;
+
+ RESET_SPECIAL (_rl_tty_chars.t_erase);
+ RESET_SPECIAL (_rl_tty_chars.t_kill);
+
+# if defined (VLNEXT) && defined (TERMIOS_TTY_DRIVER)
+ RESET_SPECIAL (_rl_tty_chars.t_lnext);
+# endif /* VLNEXT && TERMIOS_TTY_DRIVER */
+
+# if defined (VWERASE) && defined (TERMIOS_TTY_DRIVER)
+ RESET_SPECIAL (_rl_tty_chars.t_werase);
+# endif /* VWERASE && TERMIOS_TTY_DRIVER */
+}
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_SIGNALS)
+
+#if defined (NEW_TTY_DRIVER) || defined (NO_TTY_DRIVER)
+int
+_rl_disable_tty_signals ()
+{
+ return 0;
+}
+
+int
+_rl_restore_tty_signals ()
+{
+ return 0;
+}
+#else
+
+static TIOTYPE sigstty, nosigstty;
+static int tty_sigs_disabled = 0;
+
+int
+_rl_disable_tty_signals ()
+{
+ if (tty_sigs_disabled)
+ return 0;
+
+ if (_get_tty_settings (fileno (rl_instream), &sigstty) < 0)
+ return -1;
+
+ nosigstty = sigstty;
+
+ nosigstty.c_lflag &= ~ISIG;
+ nosigstty.c_iflag &= ~IXON;
+
+ if (_set_tty_settings (fileno (rl_instream), &nosigstty) < 0)
+ return (_set_tty_settings (fileno (rl_instream), &sigstty));
+
+ tty_sigs_disabled = 1;
+ return 0;
+}
+
+int
+_rl_restore_tty_signals ()
+{
+ int r;
+
+ if (tty_sigs_disabled == 0)
+ return 0;
+
+ r = _set_tty_settings (fileno (rl_instream), &sigstty);
+
+ if (r == 0)
+ tty_sigs_disabled = 0;
+
+ return r;
+}
+#endif /* !NEW_TTY_DRIVER */
+
+#endif /* HANDLE_SIGNALS */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rltty.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rltty.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..142e96b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rltty.h
@@ -0,0 +1,82 @@
+/* rltty.h - tty driver-related definitions used by some library files. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1995 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file contains the Readline Library (the Library), a set of
+ routines for providing Emacs style line input to programs that ask
+ for it.
+
+ The Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ The Library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
+ WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#if !defined (_RLTTY_H_)
+#define _RLTTY_H_
+
+/* Posix systems use termios and the Posix signal functions. */
+#if defined (TERMIOS_TTY_DRIVER)
+# include <termios.h>
+#endif /* TERMIOS_TTY_DRIVER */
+
+/* System V machines use termio. */
+#if defined (TERMIO_TTY_DRIVER)
+# include <termio.h>
+# if !defined (TCOON)
+# define TCOON 1
+# endif
+#endif /* TERMIO_TTY_DRIVER */
+
+/* Other (BSD) machines use sgtty. */
+#if defined (NEW_TTY_DRIVER)
+# include <sgtty.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "rlwinsize.h"
+
+/* Define _POSIX_VDISABLE if we are not using the `new' tty driver and
+ it is not already defined. It is used both to determine if a
+ special character is disabled and to disable certain special
+ characters. Posix systems should set to 0, USG systems to -1. */
+#if !defined (NEW_TTY_DRIVER) && !defined (_POSIX_VDISABLE)
+# if defined (_SVR4_VDISABLE)
+# define _POSIX_VDISABLE _SVR4_VDISABLE
+# else
+# if defined (_POSIX_VERSION)
+# define _POSIX_VDISABLE 0
+# else /* !_POSIX_VERSION */
+# define _POSIX_VDISABLE -1
+# endif /* !_POSIX_VERSION */
+# endif /* !_SVR4_DISABLE */
+#endif /* !NEW_TTY_DRIVER && !_POSIX_VDISABLE */
+
+typedef struct _rl_tty_chars {
+ unsigned char t_eof;
+ unsigned char t_eol;
+ unsigned char t_eol2;
+ unsigned char t_erase;
+ unsigned char t_werase;
+ unsigned char t_kill;
+ unsigned char t_reprint;
+ unsigned char t_intr;
+ unsigned char t_quit;
+ unsigned char t_susp;
+ unsigned char t_dsusp;
+ unsigned char t_start;
+ unsigned char t_stop;
+ unsigned char t_lnext;
+ unsigned char t_flush;
+ unsigned char t_status;
+} _RL_TTY_CHARS;
+
+#endif /* _RLTTY_H_ */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rltypedefs.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rltypedefs.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..862bdb8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rltypedefs.h
@@ -0,0 +1,94 @@
+/* rltypedefs.h -- Type declarations for readline functions. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 2000-2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#ifndef _RL_TYPEDEFS_H_
+#define _RL_TYPEDEFS_H_
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+extern "C" {
+#endif
+
+/* Old-style */
+
+#if !defined (_FUNCTION_DEF)
+# define _FUNCTION_DEF
+
+typedef int Function ();
+typedef void VFunction ();
+typedef char *CPFunction ();
+typedef char **CPPFunction ();
+
+#endif /* _FUNCTION_DEF */
+
+/* New style. */
+
+#if !defined (_RL_FUNCTION_TYPEDEF)
+# define _RL_FUNCTION_TYPEDEF
+
+/* Bindable functions */
+typedef int rl_command_func_t PARAMS((int, int));
+
+/* Typedefs for the completion system */
+typedef char *rl_compentry_func_t PARAMS((const char *, int));
+typedef char **rl_completion_func_t PARAMS((const char *, int, int));
+
+typedef char *rl_quote_func_t PARAMS((char *, int, char *));
+typedef char *rl_dequote_func_t PARAMS((char *, int));
+
+typedef int rl_compignore_func_t PARAMS((char **));
+
+typedef void rl_compdisp_func_t PARAMS((char **, int, int));
+
+/* Type for input and pre-read hook functions like rl_event_hook */
+typedef int rl_hook_func_t PARAMS((void));
+
+/* Input function type */
+typedef int rl_getc_func_t PARAMS((FILE *));
+
+/* Generic function that takes a character buffer (which could be the readline
+ line buffer) and an index into it (which could be rl_point) and returns
+ an int. */
+typedef int rl_linebuf_func_t PARAMS((char *, int));
+
+/* `Generic' function pointer typedefs */
+typedef int rl_intfunc_t PARAMS((int));
+#define rl_ivoidfunc_t rl_hook_func_t
+typedef int rl_icpfunc_t PARAMS((char *));
+typedef int rl_icppfunc_t PARAMS((char **));
+
+typedef void rl_voidfunc_t PARAMS((void));
+typedef void rl_vintfunc_t PARAMS((int));
+typedef void rl_vcpfunc_t PARAMS((char *));
+typedef void rl_vcppfunc_t PARAMS((char **));
+
+typedef char *rl_cpvfunc_t PARAMS((void));
+typedef char *rl_cpifunc_t PARAMS((int));
+typedef char *rl_cpcpfunc_t PARAMS((char *));
+typedef char *rl_cpcppfunc_t PARAMS((char **));
+
+#endif /* _RL_FUNCTION_TYPEDEF */
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+}
+#endif
+
+#endif /* _RL_TYPEDEFS_H_ */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rlwinsize.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rlwinsize.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..7838154
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/rlwinsize.h
@@ -0,0 +1,57 @@
+/* rlwinsize.h -- an attempt to isolate some of the system-specific defines
+ for `struct winsize' and TIOCGWINSZ. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file contains the Readline Library (the Library), a set of
+ routines for providing Emacs style line input to programs that ask
+ for it.
+
+ The Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ The Library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
+ WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#if !defined (_RLWINSIZE_H_)
+#define _RLWINSIZE_H_
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include "config.h"
+#endif
+
+/* Try to find the definitions of `struct winsize' and TIOGCWINSZ */
+
+#if defined (GWINSZ_IN_SYS_IOCTL) && !defined (TIOCGWINSZ)
+# include <sys/ioctl.h>
+#endif /* GWINSZ_IN_SYS_IOCTL && !TIOCGWINSZ */
+
+#if defined (STRUCT_WINSIZE_IN_TERMIOS) && !defined (STRUCT_WINSIZE_IN_SYS_IOCTL)
+# include <termios.h>
+#endif /* STRUCT_WINSIZE_IN_TERMIOS && !STRUCT_WINSIZE_IN_SYS_IOCTL */
+
+/* Not in either of the standard places, look around. */
+#if !defined (STRUCT_WINSIZE_IN_TERMIOS) && !defined (STRUCT_WINSIZE_IN_SYS_IOCTL)
+# if defined (HAVE_SYS_STREAM_H)
+# include <sys/stream.h>
+# endif /* HAVE_SYS_STREAM_H */
+# if defined (HAVE_SYS_PTEM_H) /* SVR4.2, at least, has it here */
+# include <sys/ptem.h>
+# define _IO_PTEM_H /* work around SVR4.2 1.1.4 bug */
+# endif /* HAVE_SYS_PTEM_H */
+# if defined (HAVE_SYS_PTE_H) /* ??? */
+# include <sys/pte.h>
+# endif /* HAVE_SYS_PTE_H */
+#endif /* !STRUCT_WINSIZE_IN_TERMIOS && !STRUCT_WINSIZE_IN_SYS_IOCTL */
+
+#endif /* _RL_WINSIZE_H */
+
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/savestring.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/savestring.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..820428d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/savestring.c
@@ -0,0 +1,37 @@
+/* savestring.c */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1998,2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#include <config.h>
+#ifdef HAVE_STRING_H
+# include <string.h>
+#endif
+#include "xmalloc.h"
+
+/* Backwards compatibility, now that savestring has been removed from
+ all `public' readline header files. */
+char *
+savestring (s)
+ const char *s;
+{
+ return ((char *)strcpy ((char *)xmalloc (1 + strlen (s)), (s)));
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/search.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/search.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..8013916
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/search.c
@@ -0,0 +1,572 @@
+/* search.c - code for non-incremental searching in emacs and vi modes. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1992-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the Readline Library (the Library), a set of
+ routines for providing Emacs style line input to programs that ask
+ for it.
+
+ The Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ The Library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
+ WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STDLIB_H)
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif
+
+#include "rldefs.h"
+#include "rlmbutil.h"
+
+#include "readline.h"
+#include "history.h"
+
+#include "rlprivate.h"
+#include "xmalloc.h"
+
+#ifdef abs
+# undef abs
+#endif
+#define abs(x) (((x) >= 0) ? (x) : -(x))
+
+_rl_search_cxt *_rl_nscxt = 0;
+
+extern HIST_ENTRY *_rl_saved_line_for_history;
+
+/* Functions imported from the rest of the library. */
+extern int _rl_free_history_entry PARAMS((HIST_ENTRY *));
+
+static char *noninc_search_string = (char *) NULL;
+static int noninc_history_pos;
+
+static char *prev_line_found = (char *) NULL;
+
+static int rl_history_search_len;
+static int rl_history_search_pos;
+static char *history_search_string;
+static int history_string_size;
+
+static UNDO_LIST *noninc_saved_undo_list;
+static void make_history_line_current PARAMS((HIST_ENTRY *));
+static int noninc_search_from_pos PARAMS((char *, int, int));
+static int noninc_dosearch PARAMS((char *, int));
+static int noninc_search PARAMS((int, int));
+static int rl_history_search_internal PARAMS((int, int));
+static void rl_history_search_reinit PARAMS((void));
+
+static _rl_search_cxt *_rl_nsearch_init PARAMS((int, int));
+static int _rl_nsearch_cleanup PARAMS((_rl_search_cxt *, int));
+static void _rl_nsearch_abort PARAMS((_rl_search_cxt *));
+static int _rl_nsearch_dispatch PARAMS((_rl_search_cxt *, int));
+
+/* Make the data from the history entry ENTRY be the contents of the
+ current line. This doesn't do anything with rl_point; the caller
+ must set it. */
+static void
+make_history_line_current (entry)
+ HIST_ENTRY *entry;
+{
+ _rl_replace_text (entry->line, 0, rl_end);
+ _rl_fix_point (1);
+#if defined (VI_MODE)
+ if (rl_editing_mode == vi_mode)
+ /* POSIX.2 says that the `U' command doesn't affect the copy of any
+ command lines to the edit line. We're going to implement that by
+ making the undo list start after the matching line is copied to the
+ current editing buffer. */
+ rl_free_undo_list ();
+#endif
+
+ if (_rl_saved_line_for_history)
+ _rl_free_history_entry (_rl_saved_line_for_history);
+ _rl_saved_line_for_history = (HIST_ENTRY *)NULL;
+}
+
+/* Search the history list for STRING starting at absolute history position
+ POS. If STRING begins with `^', the search must match STRING at the
+ beginning of a history line, otherwise a full substring match is performed
+ for STRING. DIR < 0 means to search backwards through the history list,
+ DIR >= 0 means to search forward. */
+static int
+noninc_search_from_pos (string, pos, dir)
+ char *string;
+ int pos, dir;
+{
+ int ret, old;
+
+ if (pos < 0)
+ return -1;
+
+ old = where_history ();
+ if (history_set_pos (pos) == 0)
+ return -1;
+
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_SEARCH);
+ if (*string == '^')
+ ret = history_search_prefix (string + 1, dir);
+ else
+ ret = history_search (string, dir);
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_SEARCH);
+
+ if (ret != -1)
+ ret = where_history ();
+
+ history_set_pos (old);
+ return (ret);
+}
+
+/* Search for a line in the history containing STRING. If DIR is < 0, the
+ search is backwards through previous entries, else through subsequent
+ entries. Returns 1 if the search was successful, 0 otherwise. */
+static int
+noninc_dosearch (string, dir)
+ char *string;
+ int dir;
+{
+ int oldpos, pos;
+ HIST_ENTRY *entry;
+
+ if (string == 0 || *string == '\0' || noninc_history_pos < 0)
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ return 0;
+ }
+
+ pos = noninc_search_from_pos (string, noninc_history_pos + dir, dir);
+ if (pos == -1)
+ {
+ /* Search failed, current history position unchanged. */
+ rl_maybe_unsave_line ();
+ rl_clear_message ();
+ rl_point = 0;
+ rl_ding ();
+ return 0;
+ }
+
+ noninc_history_pos = pos;
+
+ oldpos = where_history ();
+ history_set_pos (noninc_history_pos);
+ entry = current_history ();
+#if defined (VI_MODE)
+ if (rl_editing_mode != vi_mode)
+#endif
+ history_set_pos (oldpos);
+
+ make_history_line_current (entry);
+
+ rl_point = 0;
+ rl_mark = rl_end;
+
+ rl_clear_message ();
+ return 1;
+}
+
+static _rl_search_cxt *
+_rl_nsearch_init (dir, pchar)
+ int dir, pchar;
+{
+ _rl_search_cxt *cxt;
+ char *p;
+
+ cxt = _rl_scxt_alloc (RL_SEARCH_NSEARCH, 0);
+ if (dir < 0)
+ cxt->sflags |= SF_REVERSE; /* not strictly needed */
+
+ cxt->direction = dir;
+ cxt->history_pos = cxt->save_line;
+
+ rl_maybe_save_line ();
+
+ /* Clear the undo list, since reading the search string should create its
+ own undo list, and the whole list will end up being freed when we
+ finish reading the search string. */
+ rl_undo_list = 0;
+
+ /* Use the line buffer to read the search string. */
+ rl_line_buffer[0] = 0;
+ rl_end = rl_point = 0;
+
+ p = _rl_make_prompt_for_search (pchar ? pchar : ':');
+ rl_message (p, 0, 0);
+ free (p);
+
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_NSEARCH);
+
+ _rl_nscxt = cxt;
+
+ return cxt;
+}
+
+static int
+_rl_nsearch_cleanup (cxt, r)
+ _rl_search_cxt *cxt;
+ int r;
+{
+ _rl_scxt_dispose (cxt, 0);
+ _rl_nscxt = 0;
+
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_NSEARCH);
+
+ return (r != 1);
+}
+
+static void
+_rl_nsearch_abort (cxt)
+ _rl_search_cxt *cxt;
+{
+ rl_maybe_unsave_line ();
+ rl_clear_message ();
+ rl_point = cxt->save_point;
+ rl_mark = cxt->save_mark;
+ rl_restore_prompt ();
+
+ RL_UNSETSTATE (RL_STATE_NSEARCH);
+}
+
+/* Process just-read character C according to search context CXT. Return -1
+ if the caller should abort the search, 0 if we should break out of the
+ loop, and 1 if we should continue to read characters. */
+static int
+_rl_nsearch_dispatch (cxt, c)
+ _rl_search_cxt *cxt;
+ int c;
+{
+ switch (c)
+ {
+ case CTRL('W'):
+ rl_unix_word_rubout (1, c);
+ break;
+
+ case CTRL('U'):
+ rl_unix_line_discard (1, c);
+ break;
+
+ case RETURN:
+ case NEWLINE:
+ return 0;
+
+ case CTRL('H'):
+ case RUBOUT:
+ if (rl_point == 0)
+ {
+ _rl_nsearch_abort (cxt);
+ return -1;
+ }
+ _rl_rubout_char (1, c);
+ break;
+
+ case CTRL('C'):
+ case CTRL('G'):
+ rl_ding ();
+ _rl_nsearch_abort (cxt);
+ return -1;
+
+ default:
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ rl_insert_text (cxt->mb);
+ else
+#endif
+ _rl_insert_char (1, c);
+ break;
+ }
+
+ (*rl_redisplay_function) ();
+ return 1;
+}
+
+/* Perform one search according to CXT, using NONINC_SEARCH_STRING. Return
+ -1 if the search should be aborted, any other value means to clean up
+ using _rl_nsearch_cleanup (). Returns 1 if the search was successful,
+ 0 otherwise. */
+static int
+_rl_nsearch_dosearch (cxt)
+ _rl_search_cxt *cxt;
+{
+ rl_mark = cxt->save_mark;
+
+ /* If rl_point == 0, we want to re-use the previous search string and
+ start from the saved history position. If there's no previous search
+ string, punt. */
+ if (rl_point == 0)
+ {
+ if (noninc_search_string == 0)
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ rl_restore_prompt ();
+ RL_UNSETSTATE (RL_STATE_NSEARCH);
+ return -1;
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* We want to start the search from the current history position. */
+ noninc_history_pos = cxt->save_line;
+ FREE (noninc_search_string);
+ noninc_search_string = savestring (rl_line_buffer);
+
+ /* If we don't want the subsequent undo list generated by the search
+ matching a history line to include the contents of the search string,
+ we need to clear rl_line_buffer here. For now, we just clear the
+ undo list generated by reading the search string. (If the search
+ fails, the old undo list will be restored by rl_maybe_unsave_line.) */
+ rl_free_undo_list ();
+ }
+
+ rl_restore_prompt ();
+ return (noninc_dosearch (noninc_search_string, cxt->direction));
+}
+
+/* Search non-interactively through the history list. DIR < 0 means to
+ search backwards through the history of previous commands; otherwise
+ the search is for commands subsequent to the current position in the
+ history list. PCHAR is the character to use for prompting when reading
+ the search string; if not specified (0), it defaults to `:'. */
+static int
+noninc_search (dir, pchar)
+ int dir;
+ int pchar;
+{
+ _rl_search_cxt *cxt;
+ int c, r;
+
+ cxt = _rl_nsearch_init (dir, pchar);
+
+ if (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_CALLBACK))
+ return (0);
+
+ /* Read the search string. */
+ r = 0;
+ while (1)
+ {
+ c = _rl_search_getchar (cxt);
+
+ if (c == 0)
+ break;
+
+ r = _rl_nsearch_dispatch (cxt, c);
+ if (r < 0)
+ return 1;
+ else if (r == 0)
+ break;
+ }
+
+ r = _rl_nsearch_dosearch (cxt);
+ return ((r >= 0) ? _rl_nsearch_cleanup (cxt, r) : (r != 1));
+}
+
+/* Search forward through the history list for a string. If the vi-mode
+ code calls this, KEY will be `?'. */
+int
+rl_noninc_forward_search (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ return noninc_search (1, (key == '?') ? '?' : 0);
+}
+
+/* Reverse search the history list for a string. If the vi-mode code
+ calls this, KEY will be `/'. */
+int
+rl_noninc_reverse_search (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ return noninc_search (-1, (key == '/') ? '/' : 0);
+}
+
+/* Search forward through the history list for the last string searched
+ for. If there is no saved search string, abort. */
+int
+rl_noninc_forward_search_again (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ int r;
+
+ if (!noninc_search_string)
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ return (-1);
+ }
+ r = noninc_dosearch (noninc_search_string, 1);
+ return (r != 1);
+}
+
+/* Reverse search in the history list for the last string searched
+ for. If there is no saved search string, abort. */
+int
+rl_noninc_reverse_search_again (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ int r;
+
+ if (!noninc_search_string)
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ return (-1);
+ }
+ r = noninc_dosearch (noninc_search_string, -1);
+ return (r != 1);
+}
+
+#if defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+int
+_rl_nsearch_callback (cxt)
+ _rl_search_cxt *cxt;
+{
+ int c, r;
+
+ c = _rl_search_getchar (cxt);
+ r = _rl_nsearch_dispatch (cxt, c);
+ if (r != 0)
+ return 1;
+
+ r = _rl_nsearch_dosearch (cxt);
+ return ((r >= 0) ? _rl_nsearch_cleanup (cxt, r) : (r != 1));
+}
+#endif
+
+static int
+rl_history_search_internal (count, dir)
+ int count, dir;
+{
+ HIST_ENTRY *temp;
+ int ret, oldpos;
+
+ rl_maybe_save_line ();
+ temp = (HIST_ENTRY *)NULL;
+
+ /* Search COUNT times through the history for a line whose prefix
+ matches history_search_string. When this loop finishes, TEMP,
+ if non-null, is the history line to copy into the line buffer. */
+ while (count)
+ {
+ ret = noninc_search_from_pos (history_search_string, rl_history_search_pos + dir, dir);
+ if (ret == -1)
+ break;
+
+ /* Get the history entry we found. */
+ rl_history_search_pos = ret;
+ oldpos = where_history ();
+ history_set_pos (rl_history_search_pos);
+ temp = current_history ();
+ history_set_pos (oldpos);
+
+ /* Don't find multiple instances of the same line. */
+ if (prev_line_found && STREQ (prev_line_found, temp->line))
+ continue;
+ prev_line_found = temp->line;
+ count--;
+ }
+
+ /* If we didn't find anything at all, return. */
+ if (temp == 0)
+ {
+ rl_maybe_unsave_line ();
+ rl_ding ();
+ /* If you don't want the saved history line (last match) to show up
+ in the line buffer after the search fails, change the #if 0 to
+ #if 1 */
+#if 0
+ if (rl_point > rl_history_search_len)
+ {
+ rl_point = rl_end = rl_history_search_len;
+ rl_line_buffer[rl_end] = '\0';
+ rl_mark = 0;
+ }
+#else
+ rl_point = rl_history_search_len; /* rl_maybe_unsave_line changes it */
+ rl_mark = rl_end;
+#endif
+ return 1;
+ }
+
+ /* Copy the line we found into the current line buffer. */
+ make_history_line_current (temp);
+
+ rl_point = rl_history_search_len;
+ rl_mark = rl_end;
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+static void
+rl_history_search_reinit ()
+{
+ rl_history_search_pos = where_history ();
+ rl_history_search_len = rl_point;
+ prev_line_found = (char *)NULL;
+ if (rl_point)
+ {
+ if (rl_history_search_len >= history_string_size - 2)
+ {
+ history_string_size = rl_history_search_len + 2;
+ history_search_string = (char *)xrealloc (history_search_string, history_string_size);
+ }
+ history_search_string[0] = '^';
+ strncpy (history_search_string + 1, rl_line_buffer, rl_point);
+ history_search_string[rl_point + 1] = '\0';
+ }
+ _rl_free_saved_history_line ();
+}
+
+/* Search forward in the history for the string of characters
+ from the start of the line to rl_point. This is a non-incremental
+ search. */
+int
+rl_history_search_forward (count, ignore)
+ int count, ignore;
+{
+ if (count == 0)
+ return (0);
+
+ if (rl_last_func != rl_history_search_forward &&
+ rl_last_func != rl_history_search_backward)
+ rl_history_search_reinit ();
+
+ if (rl_history_search_len == 0)
+ return (rl_get_next_history (count, ignore));
+ return (rl_history_search_internal (abs (count), (count > 0) ? 1 : -1));
+}
+
+/* Search backward through the history for the string of characters
+ from the start of the line to rl_point. This is a non-incremental
+ search. */
+int
+rl_history_search_backward (count, ignore)
+ int count, ignore;
+{
+ if (count == 0)
+ return (0);
+
+ if (rl_last_func != rl_history_search_forward &&
+ rl_last_func != rl_history_search_backward)
+ rl_history_search_reinit ();
+
+ if (rl_history_search_len == 0)
+ return (rl_get_previous_history (count, ignore));
+ return (rl_history_search_internal (abs (count), (count > 0) ? -1 : 1));
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/shell.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/shell.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..346f811
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/shell.c
@@ -0,0 +1,208 @@
+/* shell.c -- readline utility functions that are normally provided by
+ bash when readline is linked as part of the shell. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif /* HAVE_UNISTD_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STDLIB_H)
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif /* HAVE_STDLIB_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STRING_H)
+# include <string.h>
+#else
+# include <strings.h>
+#endif /* !HAVE_STRING_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_LIMITS_H)
+# include <limits.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_FCNTL_H)
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#endif
+#if defined (HAVE_PWD_H)
+#include <pwd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+#include "rlstdc.h"
+#include "rlshell.h"
+#include "xmalloc.h"
+
+#if defined (HAVE_GETPWUID) && !defined (HAVE_GETPW_DECLS)
+extern struct passwd *getpwuid PARAMS((uid_t));
+#endif /* HAVE_GETPWUID && !HAVE_GETPW_DECLS */
+
+#ifndef NULL
+# define NULL 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef CHAR_BIT
+# define CHAR_BIT 8
+#endif
+
+/* Nonzero if the integer type T is signed. */
+#define TYPE_SIGNED(t) (! ((t) 0 < (t) -1))
+
+/* Bound on length of the string representing an integer value of type T.
+ Subtract one for the sign bit if T is signed;
+ 302 / 1000 is log10 (2) rounded up;
+ add one for integer division truncation;
+ add one more for a minus sign if t is signed. */
+#define INT_STRLEN_BOUND(t) \
+ ((sizeof (t) * CHAR_BIT - TYPE_SIGNED (t)) * 302 / 1000 \
+ + 1 + TYPE_SIGNED (t))
+
+/* All of these functions are resolved from bash if we are linking readline
+ as part of bash. */
+
+/* Does shell-like quoting using single quotes. */
+char *
+sh_single_quote (string)
+ char *string;
+{
+ register int c;
+ char *result, *r, *s;
+
+ result = (char *)xmalloc (3 + (4 * strlen (string)));
+ r = result;
+ *r++ = '\'';
+
+ for (s = string; s && (c = *s); s++)
+ {
+ *r++ = c;
+
+ if (c == '\'')
+ {
+ *r++ = '\\'; /* insert escaped single quote */
+ *r++ = '\'';
+ *r++ = '\''; /* start new quoted string */
+ }
+ }
+
+ *r++ = '\'';
+ *r = '\0';
+
+ return (result);
+}
+
+/* Set the environment variables LINES and COLUMNS to lines and cols,
+ respectively. */
+void
+sh_set_lines_and_columns (lines, cols)
+ int lines, cols;
+{
+ char *b;
+
+#if defined (HAVE_SETENV)
+ b = (char *)xmalloc (INT_STRLEN_BOUND (int) + 1);
+ sprintf (b, "%d", lines);
+ setenv ("LINES", b, 1);
+ free (b);
+
+ b = (char *)xmalloc (INT_STRLEN_BOUND (int) + 1);
+ sprintf (b, "%d", cols);
+ setenv ("COLUMNS", b, 1);
+ free (b);
+#else /* !HAVE_SETENV */
+# if defined (HAVE_PUTENV)
+ b = (char *)xmalloc (INT_STRLEN_BOUND (int) + sizeof ("LINES=") + 1);
+ sprintf (b, "LINES=%d", lines);
+ putenv (b);
+
+ b = (char *)xmalloc (INT_STRLEN_BOUND (int) + sizeof ("COLUMNS=") + 1);
+ sprintf (b, "COLUMNS=%d", cols);
+ putenv (b);
+# endif /* HAVE_PUTENV */
+#endif /* !HAVE_SETENV */
+}
+
+char *
+sh_get_env_value (varname)
+ const char *varname;
+{
+ return ((char *)getenv (varname));
+}
+
+char *
+sh_get_home_dir ()
+{
+ char *home_dir;
+ struct passwd *entry;
+
+ home_dir = (char *)NULL;
+#if defined (HAVE_GETPWUID)
+ entry = getpwuid (getuid ());
+ if (entry)
+ home_dir = entry->pw_dir;
+#endif
+ return (home_dir);
+}
+
+#if !defined (O_NDELAY)
+# if defined (FNDELAY)
+# define O_NDELAY FNDELAY
+# endif
+#endif
+
+int
+sh_unset_nodelay_mode (fd)
+ int fd;
+{
+#if defined (HAVE_FCNTL)
+ int flags, bflags;
+
+ if ((flags = fcntl (fd, F_GETFL, 0)) < 0)
+ return -1;
+
+ bflags = 0;
+
+#ifdef O_NONBLOCK
+ bflags |= O_NONBLOCK;
+#endif
+
+#ifdef O_NDELAY
+ bflags |= O_NDELAY;
+#endif
+
+ if (flags & bflags)
+ {
+ flags &= ~bflags;
+ return (fcntl (fd, F_SETFL, flags));
+ }
+#endif
+
+ return 0;
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/signals.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/signals.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f344ed8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/signals.c
@@ -0,0 +1,426 @@
+/* signals.c -- signal handling support for readline. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1987-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h> /* Just for NULL. Yuck. */
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <signal.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif /* HAVE_UNISTD_H */
+
+/* System-specific feature definitions and include files. */
+#include "rldefs.h"
+
+#if defined (GWINSZ_IN_SYS_IOCTL)
+# include <sys/ioctl.h>
+#endif /* GWINSZ_IN_SYS_IOCTL */
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_SIGNALS)
+/* Some standard library routines. */
+#include "readline.h"
+#include "history.h"
+
+#include "rlprivate.h"
+
+#if !defined (RETSIGTYPE)
+# if defined (VOID_SIGHANDLER)
+# define RETSIGTYPE void
+# else
+# define RETSIGTYPE int
+# endif /* !VOID_SIGHANDLER */
+#endif /* !RETSIGTYPE */
+
+#if defined (VOID_SIGHANDLER)
+# define SIGHANDLER_RETURN return
+#else
+# define SIGHANDLER_RETURN return (0)
+#endif
+
+/* This typedef is equivalent to the one for Function; it allows us
+ to say SigHandler *foo = signal (SIGKILL, SIG_IGN); */
+typedef RETSIGTYPE SigHandler ();
+
+#if defined (HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS)
+typedef struct sigaction sighandler_cxt;
+# define rl_sigaction(s, nh, oh) sigaction(s, nh, oh)
+#else
+typedef struct { SigHandler *sa_handler; int sa_mask, sa_flags; } sighandler_cxt;
+# define sigemptyset(m)
+#endif /* !HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS */
+
+#ifndef SA_RESTART
+# define SA_RESTART 0
+#endif
+
+static SigHandler *rl_set_sighandler PARAMS((int, SigHandler *, sighandler_cxt *));
+static void rl_maybe_set_sighandler PARAMS((int, SigHandler *, sighandler_cxt *));
+
+/* Exported variables for use by applications. */
+
+/* If non-zero, readline will install its own signal handlers for
+ SIGINT, SIGTERM, SIGQUIT, SIGALRM, SIGTSTP, SIGTTIN, and SIGTTOU. */
+int rl_catch_signals = 1;
+
+/* If non-zero, readline will install a signal handler for SIGWINCH. */
+#ifdef SIGWINCH
+int rl_catch_sigwinch = 1;
+#else
+int rl_catch_sigwinch = 0; /* for the readline state struct in readline.c */
+#endif
+
+static int signals_set_flag;
+static int sigwinch_set_flag;
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Signal Handling */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+static sighandler_cxt old_int, old_term, old_alrm, old_quit;
+#if defined (SIGTSTP)
+static sighandler_cxt old_tstp, old_ttou, old_ttin;
+#endif
+#if defined (SIGWINCH)
+static sighandler_cxt old_winch;
+#endif
+
+/* Readline signal handler functions. */
+
+static RETSIGTYPE
+rl_signal_handler (sig)
+ int sig;
+{
+#if defined (HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS)
+ sigset_t set;
+#else /* !HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS */
+# if defined (HAVE_BSD_SIGNALS)
+ long omask;
+# else /* !HAVE_BSD_SIGNALS */
+ sighandler_cxt dummy_cxt; /* needed for rl_set_sighandler call */
+# endif /* !HAVE_BSD_SIGNALS */
+#endif /* !HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS */
+
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_SIGHANDLER);
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_BSD_SIGNALS) && !defined (HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS)
+ /* Since the signal will not be blocked while we are in the signal
+ handler, ignore it until rl_clear_signals resets the catcher. */
+# if defined (SIGALRM)
+ if (sig == SIGINT || sig == SIGALRM)
+# else
+ if (sig == SIGINT)
+# endif
+ rl_set_sighandler (sig, SIG_IGN, &dummy_cxt);
+#endif /* !HAVE_BSD_SIGNALS && !HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS */
+
+ switch (sig)
+ {
+ case SIGINT:
+ rl_free_line_state ();
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+
+ case SIGTERM:
+#if defined (SIGTSTP)
+ case SIGTSTP:
+ case SIGTTOU:
+ case SIGTTIN:
+#endif /* SIGTSTP */
+#if defined (SIGALRM)
+ case SIGALRM:
+#endif
+#if defined (SIGQUIT)
+ case SIGQUIT:
+#endif
+ rl_cleanup_after_signal ();
+
+#if defined (HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS)
+ sigprocmask (SIG_BLOCK, (sigset_t *)NULL, &set);
+ sigdelset (&set, sig);
+#else /* !HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS */
+# if defined (HAVE_BSD_SIGNALS)
+ omask = sigblock (0);
+# endif /* HAVE_BSD_SIGNALS */
+#endif /* !HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS */
+
+#if defined (__EMX__)
+ signal (sig, SIG_ACK);
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_KILL)
+ kill (getpid (), sig);
+#else
+ raise (sig); /* assume we have raise */
+#endif
+
+ /* Let the signal that we just sent through. */
+#if defined (HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS)
+ sigprocmask (SIG_SETMASK, &set, (sigset_t *)NULL);
+#else /* !HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS */
+# if defined (HAVE_BSD_SIGNALS)
+ sigsetmask (omask & ~(sigmask (sig)));
+# endif /* HAVE_BSD_SIGNALS */
+#endif /* !HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS */
+
+ rl_reset_after_signal ();
+ }
+
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_SIGHANDLER);
+ SIGHANDLER_RETURN;
+}
+
+#if defined (SIGWINCH)
+static RETSIGTYPE
+rl_sigwinch_handler (sig)
+ int sig;
+{
+ SigHandler *oh;
+
+#if defined (MUST_REINSTALL_SIGHANDLERS)
+ sighandler_cxt dummy_winch;
+
+ /* We don't want to change old_winch -- it holds the state of SIGWINCH
+ disposition set by the calling application. We need this state
+ because we call the application's SIGWINCH handler after updating
+ our own idea of the screen size. */
+ rl_set_sighandler (SIGWINCH, rl_sigwinch_handler, &dummy_winch);
+#endif
+
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_SIGHANDLER);
+ rl_resize_terminal ();
+
+ /* If another sigwinch handler has been installed, call it. */
+ oh = (SigHandler *)old_winch.sa_handler;
+ if (oh && oh != (SigHandler *)SIG_IGN && oh != (SigHandler *)SIG_DFL)
+ (*oh) (sig);
+
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_SIGHANDLER);
+ SIGHANDLER_RETURN;
+}
+#endif /* SIGWINCH */
+
+/* Functions to manage signal handling. */
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS)
+static int
+rl_sigaction (sig, nh, oh)
+ int sig;
+ sighandler_cxt *nh, *oh;
+{
+ oh->sa_handler = signal (sig, nh->sa_handler);
+ return 0;
+}
+#endif /* !HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS */
+
+/* Set up a readline-specific signal handler, saving the old signal
+ information in OHANDLER. Return the old signal handler, like
+ signal(). */
+static SigHandler *
+rl_set_sighandler (sig, handler, ohandler)
+ int sig;
+ SigHandler *handler;
+ sighandler_cxt *ohandler;
+{
+ sighandler_cxt old_handler;
+#if defined (HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS)
+ struct sigaction act;
+
+ act.sa_handler = handler;
+ act.sa_flags = (sig == SIGWINCH) ? SA_RESTART : 0;
+ sigemptyset (&act.sa_mask);
+ sigemptyset (&ohandler->sa_mask);
+ sigaction (sig, &act, &old_handler);
+#else
+ old_handler.sa_handler = (SigHandler *)signal (sig, handler);
+#endif /* !HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS */
+
+ /* XXX -- assume we have memcpy */
+ /* If rl_set_signals is called twice in a row, don't set the old handler to
+ rl_signal_handler, because that would cause infinite recursion. */
+ if (handler != rl_signal_handler || old_handler.sa_handler != rl_signal_handler)
+ memcpy (ohandler, &old_handler, sizeof (sighandler_cxt));
+
+ return (ohandler->sa_handler);
+}
+
+static void
+rl_maybe_set_sighandler (sig, handler, ohandler)
+ int sig;
+ SigHandler *handler;
+ sighandler_cxt *ohandler;
+{
+ sighandler_cxt dummy;
+ SigHandler *oh;
+
+ sigemptyset (&dummy.sa_mask);
+ oh = rl_set_sighandler (sig, handler, ohandler);
+ if (oh == (SigHandler *)SIG_IGN)
+ rl_sigaction (sig, ohandler, &dummy);
+}
+
+int
+rl_set_signals ()
+{
+ sighandler_cxt dummy;
+ SigHandler *oh;
+
+ if (rl_catch_signals && signals_set_flag == 0)
+ {
+ rl_maybe_set_sighandler (SIGINT, rl_signal_handler, &old_int);
+ rl_maybe_set_sighandler (SIGTERM, rl_signal_handler, &old_term);
+#if defined (SIGQUIT)
+ rl_maybe_set_sighandler (SIGQUIT, rl_signal_handler, &old_quit);
+#endif
+
+#if defined (SIGALRM)
+ oh = rl_set_sighandler (SIGALRM, rl_signal_handler, &old_alrm);
+ if (oh == (SigHandler *)SIG_IGN)
+ rl_sigaction (SIGALRM, &old_alrm, &dummy);
+#if defined (HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS) && defined (SA_RESTART)
+ /* If the application using readline has already installed a signal
+ handler with SA_RESTART, SIGALRM will cause reads to be restarted
+ automatically, so readline should just get out of the way. Since
+ we tested for SIG_IGN above, we can just test for SIG_DFL here. */
+ if (oh != (SigHandler *)SIG_DFL && (old_alrm.sa_flags & SA_RESTART))
+ rl_sigaction (SIGALRM, &old_alrm, &dummy);
+#endif /* HAVE_POSIX_SIGNALS */
+#endif /* SIGALRM */
+
+#if defined (SIGTSTP)
+ rl_maybe_set_sighandler (SIGTSTP, rl_signal_handler, &old_tstp);
+#endif /* SIGTSTP */
+
+#if defined (SIGTTOU)
+ rl_maybe_set_sighandler (SIGTTOU, rl_signal_handler, &old_ttou);
+#endif /* SIGTTOU */
+
+#if defined (SIGTTIN)
+ rl_maybe_set_sighandler (SIGTTIN, rl_signal_handler, &old_ttin);
+#endif /* SIGTTIN */
+
+ signals_set_flag = 1;
+ }
+
+#if defined (SIGWINCH)
+ if (rl_catch_sigwinch && sigwinch_set_flag == 0)
+ {
+ rl_maybe_set_sighandler (SIGWINCH, rl_sigwinch_handler, &old_winch);
+ sigwinch_set_flag = 1;
+ }
+#endif /* SIGWINCH */
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+int
+rl_clear_signals ()
+{
+ sighandler_cxt dummy;
+
+ if (rl_catch_signals && signals_set_flag == 1)
+ {
+ sigemptyset (&dummy.sa_mask);
+
+ rl_sigaction (SIGINT, &old_int, &dummy);
+ rl_sigaction (SIGTERM, &old_term, &dummy);
+#if defined (SIGQUIT)
+ rl_sigaction (SIGQUIT, &old_quit, &dummy);
+#endif
+#if defined (SIGALRM)
+ rl_sigaction (SIGALRM, &old_alrm, &dummy);
+#endif
+
+#if defined (SIGTSTP)
+ rl_sigaction (SIGTSTP, &old_tstp, &dummy);
+#endif /* SIGTSTP */
+
+#if defined (SIGTTOU)
+ rl_sigaction (SIGTTOU, &old_ttou, &dummy);
+#endif /* SIGTTOU */
+
+#if defined (SIGTTIN)
+ rl_sigaction (SIGTTIN, &old_ttin, &dummy);
+#endif /* SIGTTIN */
+
+ signals_set_flag = 0;
+ }
+
+#if defined (SIGWINCH)
+ if (rl_catch_sigwinch && sigwinch_set_flag == 1)
+ {
+ sigemptyset (&dummy.sa_mask);
+ rl_sigaction (SIGWINCH, &old_winch, &dummy);
+ sigwinch_set_flag = 0;
+ }
+#endif
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Clean up the terminal and readline state after catching a signal, before
+ resending it to the calling application. */
+void
+rl_cleanup_after_signal ()
+{
+ _rl_clean_up_for_exit ();
+ if (rl_deprep_term_function)
+ (*rl_deprep_term_function) ();
+ rl_clear_signals ();
+ rl_clear_pending_input ();
+}
+
+/* Reset the terminal and readline state after a signal handler returns. */
+void
+rl_reset_after_signal ()
+{
+ if (rl_prep_term_function)
+ (*rl_prep_term_function) (_rl_meta_flag);
+ rl_set_signals ();
+}
+
+/* Free up the readline variable line state for the current line (undo list,
+ any partial history entry, any keyboard macros in progress, and any
+ numeric arguments in process) after catching a signal, before calling
+ rl_cleanup_after_signal(). */
+void
+rl_free_line_state ()
+{
+ register HIST_ENTRY *entry;
+
+ rl_free_undo_list ();
+
+ entry = current_history ();
+ if (entry)
+ entry->data = (char *)NULL;
+
+ _rl_kill_kbd_macro ();
+ rl_clear_message ();
+ _rl_reset_argument ();
+}
+
+#endif /* HANDLE_SIGNALS */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/tcap.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/tcap.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..58ab894
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/tcap.h
@@ -0,0 +1,60 @@
+/* tcap.h -- termcap library functions and variables. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1996 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file contains the Readline Library (the Library), a set of
+ routines for providing Emacs style line input to programs that ask
+ for it.
+
+ The Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ The Library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
+ WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#if !defined (_RLTCAP_H_)
+#define _RLTCAP_H_
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include "config.h"
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_TERMCAP_H)
+# if defined (__linux__) && !defined (SPEED_T_IN_SYS_TYPES)
+# include "rltty.h"
+# endif
+# include <termcap.h>
+#else
+
+/* On Solaris2, sys/types.h #includes sys/reg.h, which #defines PC.
+ Unfortunately, PC is a global variable used by the termcap library. */
+#ifdef PC
+# undef PC
+#endif
+
+extern char PC;
+extern char *UP, *BC;
+
+extern short ospeed;
+
+extern int tgetent ();
+extern int tgetflag ();
+extern int tgetnum ();
+extern char *tgetstr ();
+
+extern int tputs ();
+
+extern char *tgoto ();
+
+#endif /* HAVE_TERMCAP_H */
+
+#endif /* !_RLTCAP_H_ */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/terminal.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/terminal.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..cc61388
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/terminal.c
@@ -0,0 +1,698 @@
+/* terminal.c -- controlling the terminal with termcap. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1996-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include "posixstat.h"
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#if defined (HAVE_SYS_FILE_H)
+# include <sys/file.h>
+#endif /* HAVE_SYS_FILE_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif /* HAVE_UNISTD_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STDLIB_H)
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif /* HAVE_STDLIB_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_LOCALE_H)
+# include <locale.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+/* System-specific feature definitions and include files. */
+#include "rldefs.h"
+
+#if defined (GWINSZ_IN_SYS_IOCTL) && !defined (TIOCGWINSZ)
+# include <sys/ioctl.h>
+#endif /* GWINSZ_IN_SYS_IOCTL && !TIOCGWINSZ */
+
+#include "rltty.h"
+#include "tcap.h"
+
+/* Some standard library routines. */
+#include "readline.h"
+#include "history.h"
+
+#include "rlprivate.h"
+#include "rlshell.h"
+#include "xmalloc.h"
+
+#define CUSTOM_REDISPLAY_FUNC() (rl_redisplay_function != rl_redisplay)
+#define CUSTOM_INPUT_FUNC() (rl_getc_function != rl_getc)
+
+int rl_prefer_env_winsize;
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Terminal and Termcap */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+static char *term_buffer = (char *)NULL;
+static char *term_string_buffer = (char *)NULL;
+
+static int tcap_initialized;
+
+#if !defined (__linux__)
+# if defined (__EMX__) || defined (NEED_EXTERN_PC)
+extern
+# endif /* __EMX__ || NEED_EXTERN_PC */
+char PC, *BC, *UP;
+#endif /* __linux__ */
+
+/* Some strings to control terminal actions. These are output by tputs (). */
+char *_rl_term_clreol;
+char *_rl_term_clrpag;
+char *_rl_term_cr;
+char *_rl_term_backspace;
+char *_rl_term_goto;
+char *_rl_term_pc;
+
+/* Non-zero if we determine that the terminal can do character insertion. */
+int _rl_terminal_can_insert = 0;
+
+/* How to insert characters. */
+char *_rl_term_im;
+char *_rl_term_ei;
+char *_rl_term_ic;
+char *_rl_term_ip;
+char *_rl_term_IC;
+
+/* How to delete characters. */
+char *_rl_term_dc;
+char *_rl_term_DC;
+
+#if defined (HACK_TERMCAP_MOTION)
+char *_rl_term_forward_char;
+#endif /* HACK_TERMCAP_MOTION */
+
+/* How to go up a line. */
+char *_rl_term_up;
+
+/* A visible bell; char if the terminal can be made to flash the screen. */
+static char *_rl_visible_bell;
+
+/* Non-zero means the terminal can auto-wrap lines. */
+int _rl_term_autowrap;
+
+/* Non-zero means that this terminal has a meta key. */
+static int term_has_meta;
+
+/* The sequences to write to turn on and off the meta key, if this
+ terminal has one. */
+static char *_rl_term_mm;
+static char *_rl_term_mo;
+
+/* The key sequences output by the arrow keys, if this terminal has any. */
+static char *_rl_term_ku;
+static char *_rl_term_kd;
+static char *_rl_term_kr;
+static char *_rl_term_kl;
+
+/* How to initialize and reset the arrow keys, if this terminal has any. */
+static char *_rl_term_ks;
+static char *_rl_term_ke;
+
+/* The key sequences sent by the Home and End keys, if any. */
+static char *_rl_term_kh;
+static char *_rl_term_kH;
+static char *_rl_term_at7; /* @7 */
+
+/* Delete key */
+static char *_rl_term_kD;
+
+/* Insert key */
+static char *_rl_term_kI;
+
+/* Cursor control */
+static char *_rl_term_vs; /* very visible */
+static char *_rl_term_ve; /* normal */
+
+static void bind_termcap_arrow_keys PARAMS((Keymap));
+
+/* Variables that hold the screen dimensions, used by the display code. */
+int _rl_screenwidth, _rl_screenheight, _rl_screenchars;
+
+/* Non-zero means the user wants to enable the keypad. */
+int _rl_enable_keypad;
+
+/* Non-zero means the user wants to enable a meta key. */
+int _rl_enable_meta = 1;
+
+#if defined (__EMX__)
+static void
+_emx_get_screensize (swp, shp)
+ int *swp, *shp;
+{
+ int sz[2];
+
+ _scrsize (sz);
+
+ if (swp)
+ *swp = sz[0];
+ if (shp)
+ *shp = sz[1];
+}
+#endif
+
+/* Get readline's idea of the screen size. TTY is a file descriptor open
+ to the terminal. If IGNORE_ENV is true, we do not pay attention to the
+ values of $LINES and $COLUMNS. The tests for TERM_STRING_BUFFER being
+ non-null serve to check whether or not we have initialized termcap. */
+void
+_rl_get_screen_size (tty, ignore_env)
+ int tty, ignore_env;
+{
+ char *ss;
+#if defined (TIOCGWINSZ)
+ struct winsize window_size;
+#endif /* TIOCGWINSZ */
+ int wr, wc;
+
+ wr = wc = -1;
+#if defined (TIOCGWINSZ)
+ if (ioctl (tty, TIOCGWINSZ, &window_size) == 0)
+ {
+ wc = (int) window_size.ws_col;
+ wr = (int) window_size.ws_row;
+ }
+#endif /* TIOCGWINSZ */
+
+#if defined (__EMX__)
+ _emx_get_screensize (&_rl_screenwidth, &_rl_screenheight);
+#endif
+
+ if (ignore_env || rl_prefer_env_winsize == 0)
+ {
+ _rl_screenwidth = wc;
+ _rl_screenheight = wr;
+ }
+ else
+ _rl_screenwidth = _rl_screenheight = -1;
+
+ /* Environment variable COLUMNS overrides setting of "co" if IGNORE_ENV
+ is unset. If we prefer the environment, check it first before
+ assigning the value returned by the kernel. */
+ if (_rl_screenwidth <= 0)
+ {
+ if (ignore_env == 0 && (ss = sh_get_env_value ("COLUMNS")))
+ _rl_screenwidth = atoi (ss);
+
+ if (_rl_screenwidth <= 0)
+ _rl_screenwidth = wc;
+
+#if !defined (__DJGPP__)
+ if (_rl_screenwidth <= 0 && term_string_buffer)
+ _rl_screenwidth = tgetnum ("co");
+#endif
+ }
+
+ /* Environment variable LINES overrides setting of "li" if IGNORE_ENV
+ is unset. */
+ if (_rl_screenheight <= 0)
+ {
+ if (ignore_env == 0 && (ss = sh_get_env_value ("LINES")))
+ _rl_screenheight = atoi (ss);
+
+ if (_rl_screenheight <= 0)
+ _rl_screenheight = wr;
+
+#if !defined (__DJGPP__)
+ if (_rl_screenheight <= 0 && term_string_buffer)
+ _rl_screenheight = tgetnum ("li");
+#endif
+ }
+
+ /* If all else fails, default to 80x24 terminal. */
+ if (_rl_screenwidth <= 1)
+ _rl_screenwidth = 80;
+
+ if (_rl_screenheight <= 0)
+ _rl_screenheight = 24;
+
+ /* If we're being compiled as part of bash, set the environment
+ variables $LINES and $COLUMNS to new values. Otherwise, just
+ do a pair of putenv () or setenv () calls. */
+ sh_set_lines_and_columns (_rl_screenheight, _rl_screenwidth);
+
+ if (_rl_term_autowrap == 0)
+ _rl_screenwidth--;
+
+ _rl_screenchars = _rl_screenwidth * _rl_screenheight;
+}
+
+void
+_rl_set_screen_size (rows, cols)
+ int rows, cols;
+{
+ if (rows > 0)
+ _rl_screenheight = rows;
+ if (cols > 0)
+ {
+ _rl_screenwidth = cols;
+ if (_rl_term_autowrap == 0)
+ _rl_screenwidth--;
+ }
+
+ if (rows > 0 || cols > 0)
+ _rl_screenchars = _rl_screenwidth * _rl_screenheight;
+}
+
+void
+rl_set_screen_size (rows, cols)
+ int rows, cols;
+{
+ _rl_set_screen_size (rows, cols);
+}
+
+void
+rl_get_screen_size (rows, cols)
+ int *rows, *cols;
+{
+ if (rows)
+ *rows = _rl_screenheight;
+ if (cols)
+ *cols = _rl_screenwidth;
+}
+
+void
+rl_reset_screen_size ()
+{
+ _rl_get_screen_size (fileno (rl_instream), 0);
+}
+
+void
+rl_resize_terminal ()
+{
+ if (readline_echoing_p)
+ {
+ _rl_get_screen_size (fileno (rl_instream), 1);
+ if (CUSTOM_REDISPLAY_FUNC ())
+ rl_forced_update_display ();
+ else
+ _rl_redisplay_after_sigwinch ();
+ }
+}
+
+struct _tc_string {
+ const char *tc_var;
+ char **tc_value;
+};
+
+/* This should be kept sorted, just in case we decide to change the
+ search algorithm to something smarter. */
+static struct _tc_string tc_strings[] =
+{
+ { "@7", &_rl_term_at7 },
+ { "DC", &_rl_term_DC },
+ { "IC", &_rl_term_IC },
+ { "ce", &_rl_term_clreol },
+ { "cl", &_rl_term_clrpag },
+ { "cr", &_rl_term_cr },
+ { "dc", &_rl_term_dc },
+ { "ei", &_rl_term_ei },
+ { "ic", &_rl_term_ic },
+ { "im", &_rl_term_im },
+ { "kD", &_rl_term_kD }, /* delete */
+ { "kH", &_rl_term_kH }, /* home down ?? */
+ { "kI", &_rl_term_kI }, /* insert */
+ { "kd", &_rl_term_kd },
+ { "ke", &_rl_term_ke }, /* end keypad mode */
+ { "kh", &_rl_term_kh }, /* home */
+ { "kl", &_rl_term_kl },
+ { "kr", &_rl_term_kr },
+ { "ks", &_rl_term_ks }, /* start keypad mode */
+ { "ku", &_rl_term_ku },
+ { "le", &_rl_term_backspace },
+ { "mm", &_rl_term_mm },
+ { "mo", &_rl_term_mo },
+#if defined (HACK_TERMCAP_MOTION)
+ { "nd", &_rl_term_forward_char },
+#endif
+ { "pc", &_rl_term_pc },
+ { "up", &_rl_term_up },
+ { "vb", &_rl_visible_bell },
+ { "vs", &_rl_term_vs },
+ { "ve", &_rl_term_ve },
+};
+
+#define NUM_TC_STRINGS (sizeof (tc_strings) / sizeof (struct _tc_string))
+
+/* Read the desired terminal capability strings into BP. The capabilities
+ are described in the TC_STRINGS table. */
+static void
+get_term_capabilities (bp)
+ char **bp;
+{
+#if !defined (__DJGPP__) /* XXX - doesn't DJGPP have a termcap library? */
+ register int i;
+
+ for (i = 0; i < NUM_TC_STRINGS; i++)
+ *(tc_strings[i].tc_value) = tgetstr ((char *)tc_strings[i].tc_var, bp);
+#endif
+ tcap_initialized = 1;
+}
+
+int
+_rl_init_terminal_io (terminal_name)
+ const char *terminal_name;
+{
+ const char *term;
+ char *buffer;
+ int tty, tgetent_ret;
+
+ term = terminal_name ? terminal_name : sh_get_env_value ("TERM");
+ _rl_term_clrpag = _rl_term_cr = _rl_term_clreol = (char *)NULL;
+ tty = rl_instream ? fileno (rl_instream) : 0;
+
+ if (term == 0)
+ term = "dumb";
+
+ /* I've separated this out for later work on not calling tgetent at all
+ if the calling application has supplied a custom redisplay function,
+ (and possibly if the application has supplied a custom input function). */
+ if (CUSTOM_REDISPLAY_FUNC())
+ {
+ tgetent_ret = -1;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if (term_string_buffer == 0)
+ term_string_buffer = (char *)xmalloc(2032);
+
+ if (term_buffer == 0)
+ term_buffer = (char *)xmalloc(4080);
+
+ buffer = term_string_buffer;
+
+ tgetent_ret = tgetent (term_buffer, term);
+ }
+
+ if (tgetent_ret <= 0)
+ {
+ FREE (term_string_buffer);
+ FREE (term_buffer);
+ buffer = term_buffer = term_string_buffer = (char *)NULL;
+
+ _rl_term_autowrap = 0; /* used by _rl_get_screen_size */
+
+ /* Allow calling application to set default height and width, using
+ rl_set_screen_size */
+ if (_rl_screenwidth <= 0 || _rl_screenheight <= 0)
+ {
+#if defined (__EMX__)
+ _emx_get_screensize (&_rl_screenwidth, &_rl_screenheight);
+ _rl_screenwidth--;
+#else /* !__EMX__ */
+ _rl_get_screen_size (tty, 0);
+#endif /* !__EMX__ */
+ }
+
+ /* Defaults. */
+ if (_rl_screenwidth <= 0 || _rl_screenheight <= 0)
+ {
+ _rl_screenwidth = 79;
+ _rl_screenheight = 24;
+ }
+
+ /* Everything below here is used by the redisplay code (tputs). */
+ _rl_screenchars = _rl_screenwidth * _rl_screenheight;
+ _rl_term_cr = "\r";
+ _rl_term_im = _rl_term_ei = _rl_term_ic = _rl_term_IC = (char *)NULL;
+ _rl_term_up = _rl_term_dc = _rl_term_DC = _rl_visible_bell = (char *)NULL;
+ _rl_term_ku = _rl_term_kd = _rl_term_kl = _rl_term_kr = (char *)NULL;
+ _rl_term_kh = _rl_term_kH = _rl_term_kI = _rl_term_kD = (char *)NULL;
+ _rl_term_ks = _rl_term_ke = _rl_term_at7 = (char *)NULL;
+ _rl_term_mm = _rl_term_mo = (char *)NULL;
+ _rl_term_ve = _rl_term_vs = (char *)NULL;
+#if defined (HACK_TERMCAP_MOTION)
+ term_forward_char = (char *)NULL;
+#endif
+ _rl_terminal_can_insert = term_has_meta = 0;
+
+ /* Reasonable defaults for tgoto(). Readline currently only uses
+ tgoto if _rl_term_IC or _rl_term_DC is defined, but just in case we
+ change that later... */
+ PC = '\0';
+ BC = _rl_term_backspace = "\b";
+ UP = _rl_term_up;
+
+ return 0;
+ }
+
+ get_term_capabilities (&buffer);
+
+ /* Set up the variables that the termcap library expects the application
+ to provide. */
+ PC = _rl_term_pc ? *_rl_term_pc : 0;
+ BC = _rl_term_backspace;
+ UP = _rl_term_up;
+
+ if (!_rl_term_cr)
+ _rl_term_cr = "\r";
+
+ _rl_term_autowrap = tgetflag ("am") && tgetflag ("xn");
+
+ /* Allow calling application to set default height and width, using
+ rl_set_screen_size */
+ if (_rl_screenwidth <= 0 || _rl_screenheight <= 0)
+ _rl_get_screen_size (tty, 0);
+
+ /* "An application program can assume that the terminal can do
+ character insertion if *any one of* the capabilities `IC',
+ `im', `ic' or `ip' is provided." But we can't do anything if
+ only `ip' is provided, so... */
+ _rl_terminal_can_insert = (_rl_term_IC || _rl_term_im || _rl_term_ic);
+
+ /* Check to see if this terminal has a meta key and clear the capability
+ variables if there is none. */
+ term_has_meta = (tgetflag ("km") || tgetflag ("MT"));
+ if (!term_has_meta)
+ _rl_term_mm = _rl_term_mo = (char *)NULL;
+
+ /* Attempt to find and bind the arrow keys. Do not override already
+ bound keys in an overzealous attempt, however. */
+
+ bind_termcap_arrow_keys (emacs_standard_keymap);
+
+#if defined (VI_MODE)
+ bind_termcap_arrow_keys (vi_movement_keymap);
+ bind_termcap_arrow_keys (vi_insertion_keymap);
+#endif /* VI_MODE */
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Bind the arrow key sequences from the termcap description in MAP. */
+static void
+bind_termcap_arrow_keys (map)
+ Keymap map;
+{
+ Keymap xkeymap;
+
+ xkeymap = _rl_keymap;
+ _rl_keymap = map;
+
+ rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound (_rl_term_ku, rl_get_previous_history);
+ rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound (_rl_term_kd, rl_get_next_history);
+ rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound (_rl_term_kr, rl_forward_char);
+ rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound (_rl_term_kl, rl_backward_char);
+
+ rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound (_rl_term_kh, rl_beg_of_line); /* Home */
+ rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound (_rl_term_at7, rl_end_of_line); /* End */
+
+ rl_bind_keyseq_if_unbound (_rl_term_kD, rl_delete);
+
+ _rl_keymap = xkeymap;
+}
+
+char *
+rl_get_termcap (cap)
+ const char *cap;
+{
+ register int i;
+
+ if (tcap_initialized == 0)
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+ for (i = 0; i < NUM_TC_STRINGS; i++)
+ {
+ if (tc_strings[i].tc_var[0] == cap[0] && strcmp (tc_strings[i].tc_var, cap) == 0)
+ return *(tc_strings[i].tc_value);
+ }
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+}
+
+/* Re-initialize the terminal considering that the TERM/TERMCAP variable
+ has changed. */
+int
+rl_reset_terminal (terminal_name)
+ const char *terminal_name;
+{
+ _rl_screenwidth = _rl_screenheight = 0;
+ _rl_init_terminal_io (terminal_name);
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* A function for the use of tputs () */
+#ifdef _MINIX
+void
+_rl_output_character_function (c)
+ int c;
+{
+ putc (c, _rl_out_stream);
+}
+#else /* !_MINIX */
+int
+_rl_output_character_function (c)
+ int c;
+{
+ return putc (c, _rl_out_stream);
+}
+#endif /* !_MINIX */
+
+/* Write COUNT characters from STRING to the output stream. */
+void
+_rl_output_some_chars (string, count)
+ const char *string;
+ int count;
+{
+ fwrite (string, 1, count, _rl_out_stream);
+}
+
+/* Move the cursor back. */
+int
+_rl_backspace (count)
+ int count;
+{
+ register int i;
+
+ if (_rl_term_backspace)
+ for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
+ tputs (_rl_term_backspace, 1, _rl_output_character_function);
+ else
+ for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
+ putc ('\b', _rl_out_stream);
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Move to the start of the next line. */
+int
+rl_crlf ()
+{
+#if defined (NEW_TTY_DRIVER)
+ if (_rl_term_cr)
+ tputs (_rl_term_cr, 1, _rl_output_character_function);
+#endif /* NEW_TTY_DRIVER */
+ putc ('\n', _rl_out_stream);
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Ring the terminal bell. */
+int
+rl_ding ()
+{
+ if (readline_echoing_p)
+ {
+ switch (_rl_bell_preference)
+ {
+ case NO_BELL:
+ default:
+ break;
+ case VISIBLE_BELL:
+ if (_rl_visible_bell)
+ {
+ tputs (_rl_visible_bell, 1, _rl_output_character_function);
+ break;
+ }
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ case AUDIBLE_BELL:
+ fprintf (stderr, "\007");
+ fflush (stderr);
+ break;
+ }
+ return (0);
+ }
+ return (-1);
+}
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Controlling the Meta Key and Keypad */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+void
+_rl_enable_meta_key ()
+{
+#if !defined (__DJGPP__)
+ if (term_has_meta && _rl_term_mm)
+ tputs (_rl_term_mm, 1, _rl_output_character_function);
+#endif
+}
+
+void
+_rl_control_keypad (on)
+ int on;
+{
+#if !defined (__DJGPP__)
+ if (on && _rl_term_ks)
+ tputs (_rl_term_ks, 1, _rl_output_character_function);
+ else if (!on && _rl_term_ke)
+ tputs (_rl_term_ke, 1, _rl_output_character_function);
+#endif
+}
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Controlling the Cursor */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* Set the cursor appropriately depending on IM, which is one of the
+ insert modes (insert or overwrite). Insert mode gets the normal
+ cursor. Overwrite mode gets a very visible cursor. Only does
+ anything if we have both capabilities. */
+void
+_rl_set_cursor (im, force)
+ int im, force;
+{
+ if (_rl_term_ve && _rl_term_vs)
+ {
+ if (force || im != rl_insert_mode)
+ {
+ if (im == RL_IM_OVERWRITE)
+ tputs (_rl_term_vs, 1, _rl_output_character_function);
+ else
+ tputs (_rl_term_ve, 1, _rl_output_character_function);
+ }
+ }
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/text.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/text.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9053e96
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/text.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1639 @@
+/* text.c -- text handling commands for readline. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1987-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif /* HAVE_UNISTD_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STDLIB_H)
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif /* HAVE_STDLIB_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_LOCALE_H)
+# include <locale.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+/* System-specific feature definitions and include files. */
+#include "rldefs.h"
+#include "rlmbutil.h"
+
+#if defined (__EMX__)
+# define INCL_DOSPROCESS
+# include <os2.h>
+#endif /* __EMX__ */
+
+/* Some standard library routines. */
+#include "readline.h"
+#include "history.h"
+
+#include "rlprivate.h"
+#include "rlshell.h"
+#include "xmalloc.h"
+
+/* Forward declarations. */
+static int rl_change_case PARAMS((int, int));
+static int _rl_char_search PARAMS((int, int, int));
+
+#if defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+static int _rl_insert_next_callback PARAMS((_rl_callback_generic_arg *));
+static int _rl_char_search_callback PARAMS((_rl_callback_generic_arg *));
+#endif
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Insert and Delete */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* Insert a string of text into the line at point. This is the only
+ way that you should do insertion. _rl_insert_char () calls this
+ function. Returns the number of characters inserted. */
+int
+rl_insert_text (string)
+ const char *string;
+{
+ register int i, l;
+
+ l = (string && *string) ? strlen (string) : 0;
+ if (l == 0)
+ return 0;
+
+ if (rl_end + l >= rl_line_buffer_len)
+ rl_extend_line_buffer (rl_end + l);
+
+ for (i = rl_end; i >= rl_point; i--)
+ rl_line_buffer[i + l] = rl_line_buffer[i];
+ strncpy (rl_line_buffer + rl_point, string, l);
+
+ /* Remember how to undo this if we aren't undoing something. */
+ if (_rl_doing_an_undo == 0)
+ {
+ /* If possible and desirable, concatenate the undos. */
+ if ((l == 1) &&
+ rl_undo_list &&
+ (rl_undo_list->what == UNDO_INSERT) &&
+ (rl_undo_list->end == rl_point) &&
+ (rl_undo_list->end - rl_undo_list->start < 20))
+ rl_undo_list->end++;
+ else
+ rl_add_undo (UNDO_INSERT, rl_point, rl_point + l, (char *)NULL);
+ }
+ rl_point += l;
+ rl_end += l;
+ rl_line_buffer[rl_end] = '\0';
+ return l;
+}
+
+/* Delete the string between FROM and TO. FROM is inclusive, TO is not.
+ Returns the number of characters deleted. */
+int
+rl_delete_text (from, to)
+ int from, to;
+{
+ register char *text;
+ register int diff, i;
+
+ /* Fix it if the caller is confused. */
+ if (from > to)
+ SWAP (from, to);
+
+ /* fix boundaries */
+ if (to > rl_end)
+ {
+ to = rl_end;
+ if (from > to)
+ from = to;
+ }
+ if (from < 0)
+ from = 0;
+
+ text = rl_copy_text (from, to);
+
+ /* Some versions of strncpy() can't handle overlapping arguments. */
+ diff = to - from;
+ for (i = from; i < rl_end - diff; i++)
+ rl_line_buffer[i] = rl_line_buffer[i + diff];
+
+ /* Remember how to undo this delete. */
+ if (_rl_doing_an_undo == 0)
+ rl_add_undo (UNDO_DELETE, from, to, text);
+ else
+ free (text);
+
+ rl_end -= diff;
+ rl_line_buffer[rl_end] = '\0';
+ return (diff);
+}
+
+/* Fix up point so that it is within the line boundaries after killing
+ text. If FIX_MARK_TOO is non-zero, the mark is forced within line
+ boundaries also. */
+
+#define _RL_FIX_POINT(x) \
+ do { \
+ if (x > rl_end) \
+ x = rl_end; \
+ else if (x < 0) \
+ x = 0; \
+ } while (0)
+
+void
+_rl_fix_point (fix_mark_too)
+ int fix_mark_too;
+{
+ _RL_FIX_POINT (rl_point);
+ if (fix_mark_too)
+ _RL_FIX_POINT (rl_mark);
+}
+#undef _RL_FIX_POINT
+
+/* Replace the contents of the line buffer between START and END with
+ TEXT. The operation is undoable. To replace the entire line in an
+ undoable mode, use _rl_replace_text(text, 0, rl_end); */
+int
+_rl_replace_text (text, start, end)
+ const char *text;
+ int start, end;
+{
+ int n;
+
+ rl_begin_undo_group ();
+ rl_delete_text (start, end + 1);
+ rl_point = start;
+ n = rl_insert_text (text);
+ rl_end_undo_group ();
+
+ return n;
+}
+
+/* Replace the current line buffer contents with TEXT. If CLEAR_UNDO is
+ non-zero, we free the current undo list. */
+void
+rl_replace_line (text, clear_undo)
+ const char *text;
+ int clear_undo;
+{
+ int len;
+
+ len = strlen (text);
+ if (len >= rl_line_buffer_len)
+ rl_extend_line_buffer (len);
+ strcpy (rl_line_buffer, text);
+ rl_end = len;
+
+ if (clear_undo)
+ rl_free_undo_list ();
+
+ _rl_fix_point (1);
+}
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Readline character functions */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* This is not a gap editor, just a stupid line input routine. No hair
+ is involved in writing any of the functions, and none should be. */
+
+/* Note that:
+
+ rl_end is the place in the string that we would place '\0';
+ i.e., it is always safe to place '\0' there.
+
+ rl_point is the place in the string where the cursor is. Sometimes
+ this is the same as rl_end.
+
+ Any command that is called interactively receives two arguments.
+ The first is a count: the numeric arg pased to this command.
+ The second is the key which invoked this command.
+*/
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Movement Commands */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* Note that if you `optimize' the display for these functions, you cannot
+ use said functions in other functions which do not do optimizing display.
+ I.e., you will have to update the data base for rl_redisplay, and you
+ might as well let rl_redisplay do that job. */
+
+/* Move forward COUNT bytes. */
+int
+rl_forward_byte (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ if (count < 0)
+ return (rl_backward_byte (-count, key));
+
+ if (count > 0)
+ {
+ int end = rl_point + count;
+#if defined (VI_MODE)
+ int lend = rl_end > 0 ? rl_end - (rl_editing_mode == vi_mode) : rl_end;
+#else
+ int lend = rl_end;
+#endif
+
+ if (end > lend)
+ {
+ rl_point = lend;
+ rl_ding ();
+ }
+ else
+ rl_point = end;
+ }
+
+ if (rl_end < 0)
+ rl_end = 0;
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+/* Move forward COUNT characters. */
+int
+rl_forward_char (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ int point;
+
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX == 1 || rl_byte_oriented)
+ return (rl_forward_byte (count, key));
+
+ if (count < 0)
+ return (rl_backward_char (-count, key));
+
+ if (count > 0)
+ {
+ point = _rl_find_next_mbchar (rl_line_buffer, rl_point, count, MB_FIND_NONZERO);
+
+#if defined (VI_MODE)
+ if (rl_end <= point && rl_editing_mode == vi_mode)
+ point = _rl_find_prev_mbchar (rl_line_buffer, rl_end, MB_FIND_NONZERO);
+#endif
+
+ if (rl_point == point)
+ rl_ding ();
+
+ rl_point = point;
+
+ if (rl_end < 0)
+ rl_end = 0;
+ }
+
+ return 0;
+}
+#else /* !HANDLE_MULTIBYTE */
+int
+rl_forward_char (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ return (rl_forward_byte (count, key));
+}
+#endif /* !HANDLE_MULTIBYTE */
+
+/* Backwards compatibility. */
+int
+rl_forward (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ return (rl_forward_char (count, key));
+}
+
+/* Move backward COUNT bytes. */
+int
+rl_backward_byte (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ if (count < 0)
+ return (rl_forward_byte (-count, key));
+
+ if (count > 0)
+ {
+ if (rl_point < count)
+ {
+ rl_point = 0;
+ rl_ding ();
+ }
+ else
+ rl_point -= count;
+ }
+
+ if (rl_point < 0)
+ rl_point = 0;
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+/* Move backward COUNT characters. */
+int
+rl_backward_char (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ int point;
+
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX == 1 || rl_byte_oriented)
+ return (rl_backward_byte (count, key));
+
+ if (count < 0)
+ return (rl_forward_char (-count, key));
+
+ if (count > 0)
+ {
+ point = rl_point;
+
+ while (count > 0 && point > 0)
+ {
+ point = _rl_find_prev_mbchar (rl_line_buffer, point, MB_FIND_NONZERO);
+ count--;
+ }
+ if (count > 0)
+ {
+ rl_point = 0;
+ rl_ding ();
+ }
+ else
+ rl_point = point;
+ }
+
+ return 0;
+}
+#else
+int
+rl_backward_char (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ return (rl_backward_byte (count, key));
+}
+#endif
+
+/* Backwards compatibility. */
+int
+rl_backward (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ return (rl_backward_char (count, key));
+}
+
+/* Move to the beginning of the line. */
+int
+rl_beg_of_line (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ rl_point = 0;
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Move to the end of the line. */
+int
+rl_end_of_line (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ rl_point = rl_end;
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Move forward a word. We do what Emacs does. Handles multibyte chars. */
+int
+rl_forward_word (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ int c;
+
+ if (count < 0)
+ return (rl_backward_word (-count, key));
+
+ while (count)
+ {
+ if (rl_point == rl_end)
+ return 0;
+
+ /* If we are not in a word, move forward until we are in one.
+ Then, move forward until we hit a non-alphabetic character. */
+ c = _rl_char_value (rl_line_buffer, rl_point);
+
+ if (_rl_walphabetic (c) == 0)
+ {
+ rl_point = MB_NEXTCHAR (rl_line_buffer, rl_point, 1, MB_FIND_NONZERO);
+ while (rl_point < rl_end)
+ {
+ c = _rl_char_value (rl_line_buffer, rl_point);
+ if (_rl_walphabetic (c))
+ break;
+ rl_point = MB_NEXTCHAR (rl_line_buffer, rl_point, 1, MB_FIND_NONZERO);
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (rl_point == rl_end)
+ return 0;
+
+ rl_point = MB_NEXTCHAR (rl_line_buffer, rl_point, 1, MB_FIND_NONZERO);
+ while (rl_point < rl_end)
+ {
+ c = _rl_char_value (rl_line_buffer, rl_point);
+ if (_rl_walphabetic (c) == 0)
+ break;
+ rl_point = MB_NEXTCHAR (rl_line_buffer, rl_point, 1, MB_FIND_NONZERO);
+ }
+
+ --count;
+ }
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Move backward a word. We do what Emacs does. Handles multibyte chars. */
+int
+rl_backward_word (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ int c, p;
+
+ if (count < 0)
+ return (rl_forward_word (-count, key));
+
+ while (count)
+ {
+ if (rl_point == 0)
+ return 0;
+
+ /* Like rl_forward_word (), except that we look at the characters
+ just before point. */
+
+ p = MB_PREVCHAR (rl_line_buffer, rl_point, MB_FIND_NONZERO);
+ c = _rl_char_value (rl_line_buffer, p);
+
+ if (_rl_walphabetic (c) == 0)
+ {
+ rl_point = p;
+ while (rl_point > 0)
+ {
+ p = MB_PREVCHAR (rl_line_buffer, rl_point, MB_FIND_NONZERO);
+ c = _rl_char_value (rl_line_buffer, p);
+ if (_rl_walphabetic (c))
+ break;
+ rl_point = p;
+ }
+ }
+
+ while (rl_point)
+ {
+ p = MB_PREVCHAR (rl_line_buffer, rl_point, MB_FIND_NONZERO);
+ c = _rl_char_value (rl_line_buffer, p);
+ if (_rl_walphabetic (c) == 0)
+ break;
+ else
+ rl_point = p;
+ }
+
+ --count;
+ }
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Clear the current line. Numeric argument to C-l does this. */
+int
+rl_refresh_line (ignore1, ignore2)
+ int ignore1, ignore2;
+{
+ int curr_line;
+
+ curr_line = _rl_current_display_line ();
+
+ _rl_move_vert (curr_line);
+ _rl_move_cursor_relative (0, rl_line_buffer); /* XXX is this right */
+
+ _rl_clear_to_eol (0); /* arg of 0 means to not use spaces */
+
+ rl_forced_update_display ();
+ rl_display_fixed = 1;
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* C-l typed to a line without quoting clears the screen, and then reprints
+ the prompt and the current input line. Given a numeric arg, redraw only
+ the current line. */
+int
+rl_clear_screen (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ if (rl_explicit_arg)
+ {
+ rl_refresh_line (count, key);
+ return 0;
+ }
+
+ _rl_clear_screen (); /* calls termcap function to clear screen */
+ rl_forced_update_display ();
+ rl_display_fixed = 1;
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+int
+rl_arrow_keys (count, c)
+ int count, c;
+{
+ int ch;
+
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+ ch = rl_read_key ();
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+
+ switch (_rl_to_upper (ch))
+ {
+ case 'A':
+ rl_get_previous_history (count, ch);
+ break;
+
+ case 'B':
+ rl_get_next_history (count, ch);
+ break;
+
+ case 'C':
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ rl_forward_char (count, ch);
+ else
+ rl_forward_byte (count, ch);
+ break;
+
+ case 'D':
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ rl_backward_char (count, ch);
+ else
+ rl_backward_byte (count, ch);
+ break;
+
+ default:
+ rl_ding ();
+ }
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Text commands */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+#ifdef HANDLE_MULTIBYTE
+static char pending_bytes[MB_LEN_MAX];
+static int pending_bytes_length = 0;
+static mbstate_t ps = {0};
+#endif
+
+/* Insert the character C at the current location, moving point forward.
+ If C introduces a multibyte sequence, we read the whole sequence and
+ then insert the multibyte char into the line buffer. */
+int
+_rl_insert_char (count, c)
+ int count, c;
+{
+ register int i;
+ char *string;
+#ifdef HANDLE_MULTIBYTE
+ int string_size;
+ char incoming[MB_LEN_MAX + 1];
+ int incoming_length = 0;
+ mbstate_t ps_back;
+ static int stored_count = 0;
+#endif
+
+ if (count <= 0)
+ return 0;
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX == 1 || rl_byte_oriented)
+ {
+ incoming[0] = c;
+ incoming[1] = '\0';
+ incoming_length = 1;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ wchar_t wc;
+ size_t ret;
+
+ if (stored_count <= 0)
+ stored_count = count;
+ else
+ count = stored_count;
+
+ ps_back = ps;
+ pending_bytes[pending_bytes_length++] = c;
+ ret = mbrtowc (&wc, pending_bytes, pending_bytes_length, &ps);
+
+ if (ret == (size_t)-2)
+ {
+ /* Bytes too short to compose character, try to wait for next byte.
+ Restore the state of the byte sequence, because in this case the
+ effect of mbstate is undefined. */
+ ps = ps_back;
+ return 1;
+ }
+ else if (ret == (size_t)-1)
+ {
+ /* Invalid byte sequence for the current locale. Treat first byte
+ as a single character. */
+ incoming[0] = pending_bytes[0];
+ incoming[1] = '\0';
+ incoming_length = 1;
+ pending_bytes_length--;
+ memmove (pending_bytes, pending_bytes + 1, pending_bytes_length);
+ /* Clear the state of the byte sequence, because in this case the
+ effect of mbstate is undefined. */
+ memset (&ps, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+ }
+ else if (ret == (size_t)0)
+ {
+ incoming[0] = '\0';
+ incoming_length = 0;
+ pending_bytes_length--;
+ /* Clear the state of the byte sequence, because in this case the
+ effect of mbstate is undefined. */
+ memset (&ps, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* We successfully read a single multibyte character. */
+ memcpy (incoming, pending_bytes, pending_bytes_length);
+ incoming[pending_bytes_length] = '\0';
+ incoming_length = pending_bytes_length;
+ pending_bytes_length = 0;
+ }
+ }
+#endif /* HANDLE_MULTIBYTE */
+
+ /* If we can optimize, then do it. But don't let people crash
+ readline because of extra large arguments. */
+ if (count > 1 && count <= 1024)
+ {
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ string_size = count * incoming_length;
+ string = (char *)xmalloc (1 + string_size);
+
+ i = 0;
+ while (i < string_size)
+ {
+ strncpy (string + i, incoming, incoming_length);
+ i += incoming_length;
+ }
+ incoming_length = 0;
+ stored_count = 0;
+#else /* !HANDLE_MULTIBYTE */
+ string = (char *)xmalloc (1 + count);
+
+ for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
+ string[i] = c;
+#endif /* !HANDLE_MULTIBYTE */
+
+ string[i] = '\0';
+ rl_insert_text (string);
+ free (string);
+
+ return 0;
+ }
+
+ if (count > 1024)
+ {
+ int decreaser;
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ string_size = incoming_length * 1024;
+ string = (char *)xmalloc (1 + string_size);
+
+ i = 0;
+ while (i < string_size)
+ {
+ strncpy (string + i, incoming, incoming_length);
+ i += incoming_length;
+ }
+
+ while (count)
+ {
+ decreaser = (count > 1024) ? 1024 : count;
+ string[decreaser*incoming_length] = '\0';
+ rl_insert_text (string);
+ count -= decreaser;
+ }
+
+ free (string);
+ incoming_length = 0;
+ stored_count = 0;
+#else /* !HANDLE_MULTIBYTE */
+ char str[1024+1];
+
+ for (i = 0; i < 1024; i++)
+ str[i] = c;
+
+ while (count)
+ {
+ decreaser = (count > 1024 ? 1024 : count);
+ str[decreaser] = '\0';
+ rl_insert_text (str);
+ count -= decreaser;
+ }
+#endif /* !HANDLE_MULTIBYTE */
+
+ return 0;
+ }
+
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX == 1 || rl_byte_oriented)
+ {
+ /* We are inserting a single character.
+ If there is pending input, then make a string of all of the
+ pending characters that are bound to rl_insert, and insert
+ them all. */
+ if (_rl_any_typein ())
+ _rl_insert_typein (c);
+ else
+ {
+ /* Inserting a single character. */
+ char str[2];
+
+ str[1] = '\0';
+ str[0] = c;
+ rl_insert_text (str);
+ }
+ }
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ else
+ {
+ rl_insert_text (incoming);
+ stored_count = 0;
+ }
+#endif
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Overwrite the character at point (or next COUNT characters) with C.
+ If C introduces a multibyte character sequence, read the entire sequence
+ before starting the overwrite loop. */
+int
+_rl_overwrite_char (count, c)
+ int count, c;
+{
+ int i;
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ char mbkey[MB_LEN_MAX];
+ int k;
+
+ /* Read an entire multibyte character sequence to insert COUNT times. */
+ if (count > 0 && MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ k = _rl_read_mbstring (c, mbkey, MB_LEN_MAX);
+#endif
+
+ rl_begin_undo_group ();
+
+ for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
+ {
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ rl_insert_text (mbkey);
+ else
+#endif
+ _rl_insert_char (1, c);
+
+ if (rl_point < rl_end)
+ rl_delete (1, c);
+ }
+
+ rl_end_undo_group ();
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+int
+rl_insert (count, c)
+ int count, c;
+{
+ return (rl_insert_mode == RL_IM_INSERT ? _rl_insert_char (count, c)
+ : _rl_overwrite_char (count, c));
+}
+
+/* Insert the next typed character verbatim. */
+static int
+_rl_insert_next (count)
+ int count;
+{
+ int c;
+
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+ c = rl_read_key ();
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_SIGNALS)
+ if (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_CALLBACK) == 0)
+ _rl_restore_tty_signals ();
+#endif
+
+ return (_rl_insert_char (count, c));
+}
+
+#if defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+static int
+_rl_insert_next_callback (data)
+ _rl_callback_generic_arg *data;
+{
+ int count;
+
+ count = data->count;
+
+ /* Deregister function, let rl_callback_read_char deallocate data */
+ _rl_callback_func = 0;
+ _rl_want_redisplay = 1;
+
+ return _rl_insert_next (count);
+}
+#endif
+
+int
+rl_quoted_insert (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ /* Let's see...should the callback interface futz with signal handling? */
+#if defined (HANDLE_SIGNALS)
+ if (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_CALLBACK) == 0)
+ _rl_disable_tty_signals ();
+#endif
+
+#if defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+ if (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_CALLBACK))
+ {
+ _rl_callback_data = _rl_callback_data_alloc (count);
+ _rl_callback_func = _rl_insert_next_callback;
+ return (0);
+ }
+#endif
+
+ return _rl_insert_next (count);
+}
+
+/* Insert a tab character. */
+int
+rl_tab_insert (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ return (_rl_insert_char (count, '\t'));
+}
+
+/* What to do when a NEWLINE is pressed. We accept the whole line.
+ KEY is the key that invoked this command. I guess it could have
+ meaning in the future. */
+int
+rl_newline (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ rl_done = 1;
+
+ if (_rl_history_preserve_point)
+ _rl_history_saved_point = (rl_point == rl_end) ? -1 : rl_point;
+
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_DONE);
+
+#if defined (VI_MODE)
+ if (rl_editing_mode == vi_mode)
+ {
+ _rl_vi_done_inserting ();
+ if (_rl_vi_textmod_command (_rl_vi_last_command) == 0) /* XXX */
+ _rl_vi_reset_last ();
+ }
+#endif /* VI_MODE */
+
+ /* If we've been asked to erase empty lines, suppress the final update,
+ since _rl_update_final calls rl_crlf(). */
+ if (rl_erase_empty_line && rl_point == 0 && rl_end == 0)
+ return 0;
+
+ if (readline_echoing_p)
+ _rl_update_final ();
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* What to do for some uppercase characters, like meta characters,
+ and some characters appearing in emacs_ctlx_keymap. This function
+ is just a stub, you bind keys to it and the code in _rl_dispatch ()
+ is special cased. */
+int
+rl_do_lowercase_version (ignore1, ignore2)
+ int ignore1, ignore2;
+{
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* This is different from what vi does, so the code's not shared. Emacs
+ rubout in overwrite mode has one oddity: it replaces a control
+ character that's displayed as two characters (^X) with two spaces. */
+int
+_rl_overwrite_rubout (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ int opoint;
+ int i, l;
+
+ if (rl_point == 0)
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ return 1;
+ }
+
+ opoint = rl_point;
+
+ /* L == number of spaces to insert */
+ for (i = l = 0; i < count; i++)
+ {
+ rl_backward_char (1, key);
+ l += rl_character_len (rl_line_buffer[rl_point], rl_point); /* not exactly right */
+ }
+
+ rl_begin_undo_group ();
+
+ if (count > 1 || rl_explicit_arg)
+ rl_kill_text (opoint, rl_point);
+ else
+ rl_delete_text (opoint, rl_point);
+
+ /* Emacs puts point at the beginning of the sequence of spaces. */
+ if (rl_point < rl_end)
+ {
+ opoint = rl_point;
+ _rl_insert_char (l, ' ');
+ rl_point = opoint;
+ }
+
+ rl_end_undo_group ();
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Rubout the character behind point. */
+int
+rl_rubout (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ if (count < 0)
+ return (rl_delete (-count, key));
+
+ if (!rl_point)
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ if (rl_insert_mode == RL_IM_OVERWRITE)
+ return (_rl_overwrite_rubout (count, key));
+
+ return (_rl_rubout_char (count, key));
+}
+
+int
+_rl_rubout_char (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ int orig_point;
+ unsigned char c;
+
+ /* Duplicated code because this is called from other parts of the library. */
+ if (count < 0)
+ return (rl_delete (-count, key));
+
+ if (rl_point == 0)
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ orig_point = rl_point;
+ if (count > 1 || rl_explicit_arg)
+ {
+ rl_backward_char (count, key);
+ rl_kill_text (orig_point, rl_point);
+ }
+ else if (MB_CUR_MAX == 1 || rl_byte_oriented)
+ {
+ c = rl_line_buffer[--rl_point];
+ rl_delete_text (rl_point, orig_point);
+ /* The erase-at-end-of-line hack is of questionable merit now. */
+ if (rl_point == rl_end && ISPRINT (c) && _rl_last_c_pos)
+ {
+ int l;
+ l = rl_character_len (c, rl_point);
+ _rl_erase_at_end_of_line (l);
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ rl_point = _rl_find_prev_mbchar (rl_line_buffer, rl_point, MB_FIND_NONZERO);
+ rl_delete_text (rl_point, orig_point);
+ }
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Delete the character under the cursor. Given a numeric argument,
+ kill that many characters instead. */
+int
+rl_delete (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ int r;
+
+ if (count < 0)
+ return (_rl_rubout_char (-count, key));
+
+ if (rl_point == rl_end)
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ if (count > 1 || rl_explicit_arg)
+ {
+ int orig_point = rl_point;
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ rl_forward_char (count, key);
+ else
+ rl_forward_byte (count, key);
+
+ r = rl_kill_text (orig_point, rl_point);
+ rl_point = orig_point;
+ return r;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ int new_point;
+
+ new_point = MB_NEXTCHAR (rl_line_buffer, rl_point, 1, MB_FIND_NONZERO);
+ return (rl_delete_text (rl_point, new_point));
+ }
+}
+
+/* Delete the character under the cursor, unless the insertion
+ point is at the end of the line, in which case the character
+ behind the cursor is deleted. COUNT is obeyed and may be used
+ to delete forward or backward that many characters. */
+int
+rl_rubout_or_delete (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ if (rl_end != 0 && rl_point == rl_end)
+ return (_rl_rubout_char (count, key));
+ else
+ return (rl_delete (count, key));
+}
+
+/* Delete all spaces and tabs around point. */
+int
+rl_delete_horizontal_space (count, ignore)
+ int count, ignore;
+{
+ int start = rl_point;
+
+ while (rl_point && whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point - 1]))
+ rl_point--;
+
+ start = rl_point;
+
+ while (rl_point < rl_end && whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]))
+ rl_point++;
+
+ if (start != rl_point)
+ {
+ rl_delete_text (start, rl_point);
+ rl_point = start;
+ }
+
+ if (rl_point < 0)
+ rl_point = 0;
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Like the tcsh editing function delete-char-or-list. The eof character
+ is caught before this is invoked, so this really does the same thing as
+ delete-char-or-list-or-eof, as long as it's bound to the eof character. */
+int
+rl_delete_or_show_completions (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ if (rl_end != 0 && rl_point == rl_end)
+ return (rl_possible_completions (count, key));
+ else
+ return (rl_delete (count, key));
+}
+
+#ifndef RL_COMMENT_BEGIN_DEFAULT
+#define RL_COMMENT_BEGIN_DEFAULT "#"
+#endif
+
+/* Turn the current line into a comment in shell history.
+ A K*rn shell style function. */
+int
+rl_insert_comment (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ char *rl_comment_text;
+ int rl_comment_len;
+
+ rl_beg_of_line (1, key);
+ rl_comment_text = _rl_comment_begin ? _rl_comment_begin : RL_COMMENT_BEGIN_DEFAULT;
+
+ if (rl_explicit_arg == 0)
+ rl_insert_text (rl_comment_text);
+ else
+ {
+ rl_comment_len = strlen (rl_comment_text);
+ if (STREQN (rl_comment_text, rl_line_buffer, rl_comment_len))
+ rl_delete_text (rl_point, rl_point + rl_comment_len);
+ else
+ rl_insert_text (rl_comment_text);
+ }
+
+ (*rl_redisplay_function) ();
+ rl_newline (1, '\n');
+
+ return (0);
+}
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Changing Case */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* The three kinds of things that we know how to do. */
+#define UpCase 1
+#define DownCase 2
+#define CapCase 3
+
+/* Uppercase the word at point. */
+int
+rl_upcase_word (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ return (rl_change_case (count, UpCase));
+}
+
+/* Lowercase the word at point. */
+int
+rl_downcase_word (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ return (rl_change_case (count, DownCase));
+}
+
+/* Upcase the first letter, downcase the rest. */
+int
+rl_capitalize_word (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ return (rl_change_case (count, CapCase));
+}
+
+/* The meaty function.
+ Change the case of COUNT words, performing OP on them.
+ OP is one of UpCase, DownCase, or CapCase.
+ If a negative argument is given, leave point where it started,
+ otherwise, leave it where it moves to. */
+static int
+rl_change_case (count, op)
+ int count, op;
+{
+ int start, next, end;
+ int inword, c, nc, nop;
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ wchar_t wc, nwc;
+ char mb[MB_LEN_MAX+1];
+ int mblen, p;
+ mbstate_t ps;
+#endif
+
+ start = rl_point;
+ rl_forward_word (count, 0);
+ end = rl_point;
+
+ if (op != UpCase && op != DownCase && op != CapCase)
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ if (count < 0)
+ SWAP (start, end);
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ memset (&ps, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+#endif
+
+ /* We are going to modify some text, so let's prepare to undo it. */
+ rl_modifying (start, end);
+
+ inword = 0;
+ while (start < end)
+ {
+ c = _rl_char_value (rl_line_buffer, start);
+ /* This assumes that the upper and lower case versions are the same width. */
+ next = MB_NEXTCHAR (rl_line_buffer, start, 1, MB_FIND_NONZERO);
+
+ if (_rl_walphabetic (c) == 0)
+ {
+ inword = 0;
+ start = next;
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ if (op == CapCase)
+ {
+ nop = inword ? DownCase : UpCase;
+ inword = 1;
+ }
+ else
+ nop = op;
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX == 1 || rl_byte_oriented || isascii (c))
+ {
+ nc = (nop == UpCase) ? _rl_to_upper (c) : _rl_to_lower (c);
+ rl_line_buffer[start] = nc;
+ }
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ else
+ {
+ mbrtowc (&wc, rl_line_buffer + start, end - start, &ps);
+ nwc = (nop == UpCase) ? _rl_to_wupper (wc) : _rl_to_wlower (wc);
+ if (nwc != wc) /* just skip unchanged characters */
+ {
+ mblen = wcrtomb (mb, nwc, &ps);
+ if (mblen > 0)
+ mb[mblen] = '\0';
+ /* Assume the same width */
+ strncpy (rl_line_buffer + start, mb, mblen);
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+
+ start = next;
+ }
+
+ rl_point = end;
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Transposition */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* Transpose the words at point. If point is at the end of the line,
+ transpose the two words before point. */
+int
+rl_transpose_words (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ char *word1, *word2;
+ int w1_beg, w1_end, w2_beg, w2_end;
+ int orig_point = rl_point;
+
+ if (!count)
+ return 0;
+
+ /* Find the two words. */
+ rl_forward_word (count, key);
+ w2_end = rl_point;
+ rl_backward_word (1, key);
+ w2_beg = rl_point;
+ rl_backward_word (count, key);
+ w1_beg = rl_point;
+ rl_forward_word (1, key);
+ w1_end = rl_point;
+
+ /* Do some check to make sure that there really are two words. */
+ if ((w1_beg == w2_beg) || (w2_beg < w1_end))
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ rl_point = orig_point;
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ /* Get the text of the words. */
+ word1 = rl_copy_text (w1_beg, w1_end);
+ word2 = rl_copy_text (w2_beg, w2_end);
+
+ /* We are about to do many insertions and deletions. Remember them
+ as one operation. */
+ rl_begin_undo_group ();
+
+ /* Do the stuff at word2 first, so that we don't have to worry
+ about word1 moving. */
+ rl_point = w2_beg;
+ rl_delete_text (w2_beg, w2_end);
+ rl_insert_text (word1);
+
+ rl_point = w1_beg;
+ rl_delete_text (w1_beg, w1_end);
+ rl_insert_text (word2);
+
+ /* This is exactly correct since the text before this point has not
+ changed in length. */
+ rl_point = w2_end;
+
+ /* I think that does it. */
+ rl_end_undo_group ();
+ free (word1);
+ free (word2);
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Transpose the characters at point. If point is at the end of the line,
+ then transpose the characters before point. */
+int
+rl_transpose_chars (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ char *dummy;
+ int i;
+#else
+ char dummy[2];
+#endif
+ int char_length, prev_point;
+
+ if (count == 0)
+ return 0;
+
+ if (!rl_point || rl_end < 2)
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ rl_begin_undo_group ();
+
+ if (rl_point == rl_end)
+ {
+ rl_point = MB_PREVCHAR (rl_line_buffer, rl_point, MB_FIND_NONZERO);
+ count = 1;
+ }
+
+ prev_point = rl_point;
+ rl_point = MB_PREVCHAR (rl_line_buffer, rl_point, MB_FIND_NONZERO);
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ char_length = prev_point - rl_point;
+ dummy = (char *)xmalloc (char_length + 1);
+ for (i = 0; i < char_length; i++)
+ dummy[i] = rl_line_buffer[rl_point + i];
+ dummy[i] = '\0';
+#else
+ dummy[0] = rl_line_buffer[rl_point];
+ dummy[char_length = 1] = '\0';
+#endif
+
+ rl_delete_text (rl_point, rl_point + char_length);
+
+ rl_point = _rl_find_next_mbchar (rl_line_buffer, rl_point, count, MB_FIND_NONZERO);
+
+ _rl_fix_point (0);
+ rl_insert_text (dummy);
+ rl_end_undo_group ();
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ free (dummy);
+#endif
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Character Searching */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+int
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+_rl_char_search_internal (count, dir, smbchar, len)
+ int count, dir;
+ char *smbchar;
+ int len;
+#else
+_rl_char_search_internal (count, dir, schar)
+ int count, dir, schar;
+#endif
+{
+ int pos, inc;
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ int prepos;
+#endif
+
+ pos = rl_point;
+ inc = (dir < 0) ? -1 : 1;
+ while (count)
+ {
+ if ((dir < 0 && pos <= 0) || (dir > 0 && pos >= rl_end))
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ pos = (inc > 0) ? _rl_find_next_mbchar (rl_line_buffer, pos, 1, MB_FIND_ANY)
+ : _rl_find_prev_mbchar (rl_line_buffer, pos, MB_FIND_ANY);
+#else
+ pos += inc;
+#endif
+ do
+ {
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ if (_rl_is_mbchar_matched (rl_line_buffer, pos, rl_end, smbchar, len))
+#else
+ if (rl_line_buffer[pos] == schar)
+#endif
+ {
+ count--;
+ if (dir < 0)
+ rl_point = (dir == BTO) ? _rl_find_next_mbchar (rl_line_buffer, pos, 1, MB_FIND_ANY)
+ : pos;
+ else
+ rl_point = (dir == FTO) ? _rl_find_prev_mbchar (rl_line_buffer, pos, MB_FIND_ANY)
+ : pos;
+ break;
+ }
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ prepos = pos;
+#endif
+ }
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ while ((dir < 0) ? (pos = _rl_find_prev_mbchar (rl_line_buffer, pos, MB_FIND_ANY)) != prepos
+ : (pos = _rl_find_next_mbchar (rl_line_buffer, pos, 1, MB_FIND_ANY)) != prepos);
+#else
+ while ((dir < 0) ? pos-- : ++pos < rl_end);
+#endif
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+
+/* Search COUNT times for a character read from the current input stream.
+ FDIR is the direction to search if COUNT is non-negative; otherwise
+ the search goes in BDIR. So much is dependent on HANDLE_MULTIBYTE
+ that there are two separate versions of this function. */
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+static int
+_rl_char_search (count, fdir, bdir)
+ int count, fdir, bdir;
+{
+ char mbchar[MB_LEN_MAX];
+ int mb_len;
+
+ mb_len = _rl_read_mbchar (mbchar, MB_LEN_MAX);
+
+ if (count < 0)
+ return (_rl_char_search_internal (-count, bdir, mbchar, mb_len));
+ else
+ return (_rl_char_search_internal (count, fdir, mbchar, mb_len));
+}
+#else /* !HANDLE_MULTIBYTE */
+static int
+_rl_char_search (count, fdir, bdir)
+ int count, fdir, bdir;
+{
+ int c;
+
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+ c = rl_read_key ();
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+
+ if (count < 0)
+ return (_rl_char_search_internal (-count, bdir, c));
+ else
+ return (_rl_char_search_internal (count, fdir, c));
+}
+#endif /* !HANDLE_MULTIBYTE */
+
+#if defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+static int
+_rl_char_search_callback (data)
+ _rl_callback_generic_arg *data;
+{
+ _rl_callback_func = 0;
+ _rl_want_redisplay = 1;
+
+ return (_rl_char_search (data->count, data->i1, data->i2));
+}
+#endif
+
+int
+rl_char_search (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+#if defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+ if (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_CALLBACK))
+ {
+ _rl_callback_data = _rl_callback_data_alloc (count);
+ _rl_callback_data->i1 = FFIND;
+ _rl_callback_data->i2 = BFIND;
+ _rl_callback_func = _rl_char_search_callback;
+ return (0);
+ }
+#endif
+
+ return (_rl_char_search (count, FFIND, BFIND));
+}
+
+int
+rl_backward_char_search (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+#if defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+ if (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_CALLBACK))
+ {
+ _rl_callback_data = _rl_callback_data_alloc (count);
+ _rl_callback_data->i1 = BFIND;
+ _rl_callback_data->i2 = FFIND;
+ _rl_callback_func = _rl_char_search_callback;
+ return (0);
+ }
+#endif
+
+ return (_rl_char_search (count, BFIND, FFIND));
+}
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* The Mark and the Region. */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* Set the mark at POSITION. */
+int
+_rl_set_mark_at_pos (position)
+ int position;
+{
+ if (position > rl_end)
+ return -1;
+
+ rl_mark = position;
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* A bindable command to set the mark. */
+int
+rl_set_mark (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ return (_rl_set_mark_at_pos (rl_explicit_arg ? count : rl_point));
+}
+
+/* Exchange the position of mark and point. */
+int
+rl_exchange_point_and_mark (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ if (rl_mark > rl_end)
+ rl_mark = -1;
+
+ if (rl_mark == -1)
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+ else
+ SWAP (rl_point, rl_mark);
+
+ return 0;
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/tilde.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/tilde.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d757f7a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/tilde.c
@@ -0,0 +1,502 @@
+/* tilde.c -- Tilde expansion code (~/foo := $HOME/foo). */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1988,1989 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Readline, a library for reading lines
+ of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ Readline is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the
+ Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any
+ later version.
+
+ Readline is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
+ WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with Readline; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
+ Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# ifdef _MINIX
+# include <sys/types.h>
+# endif
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STRING_H)
+# include <string.h>
+#else /* !HAVE_STRING_H */
+# include <strings.h>
+#endif /* !HAVE_STRING_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STDLIB_H)
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif /* HAVE_STDLIB_H */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#if defined (HAVE_PWD_H)
+#include <pwd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "tilde.h"
+
+#if defined (TEST) || defined (STATIC_MALLOC)
+static void *xmalloc (), *xrealloc ();
+#else
+# include "xmalloc.h"
+#endif /* TEST || STATIC_MALLOC */
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_GETPW_DECLS)
+# if defined (HAVE_GETPWUID)
+extern struct passwd *getpwuid PARAMS((uid_t));
+# endif
+# if defined (HAVE_GETPWNAM)
+extern struct passwd *getpwnam PARAMS((const char *));
+# endif
+#endif /* !HAVE_GETPW_DECLS */
+
+#if !defined (savestring)
+#define savestring(x) strcpy ((char *)xmalloc (1 + strlen (x)), (x))
+#endif /* !savestring */
+
+#if !defined (NULL)
+# if defined (__STDC__)
+# define NULL ((void *) 0)
+# else
+# define NULL 0x0
+# endif /* !__STDC__ */
+#endif /* !NULL */
+
+/* If being compiled as part of bash, these will be satisfied from
+ variables.o. If being compiled as part of readline, they will
+ be satisfied from shell.o. */
+extern char *sh_get_home_dir PARAMS((void));
+extern char *sh_get_env_value PARAMS((const char *));
+
+/* The default value of tilde_additional_prefixes. This is set to
+ whitespace preceding a tilde so that simple programs which do not
+ perform any word separation get desired behaviour. */
+static const char *default_prefixes[] =
+ { " ~", "\t~", (const char *)NULL };
+
+/* The default value of tilde_additional_suffixes. This is set to
+ whitespace or newline so that simple programs which do not
+ perform any word separation get desired behaviour. */
+static const char *default_suffixes[] =
+ { " ", "\n", (const char *)NULL };
+
+/* If non-null, this contains the address of a function that the application
+ wants called before trying the standard tilde expansions. The function
+ is called with the text sans tilde, and returns a malloc()'ed string
+ which is the expansion, or a NULL pointer if the expansion fails. */
+tilde_hook_func_t *tilde_expansion_preexpansion_hook = (tilde_hook_func_t *)NULL;
+
+/* If non-null, this contains the address of a function to call if the
+ standard meaning for expanding a tilde fails. The function is called
+ with the text (sans tilde, as in "foo"), and returns a malloc()'ed string
+ which is the expansion, or a NULL pointer if there is no expansion. */
+tilde_hook_func_t *tilde_expansion_failure_hook = (tilde_hook_func_t *)NULL;
+
+/* When non-null, this is a NULL terminated array of strings which
+ are duplicates for a tilde prefix. Bash uses this to expand
+ `=~' and `:~'. */
+char **tilde_additional_prefixes = (char **)default_prefixes;
+
+/* When non-null, this is a NULL terminated array of strings which match
+ the end of a username, instead of just "/". Bash sets this to
+ `:' and `=~'. */
+char **tilde_additional_suffixes = (char **)default_suffixes;
+
+static int tilde_find_prefix PARAMS((const char *, int *));
+static int tilde_find_suffix PARAMS((const char *));
+static char *isolate_tilde_prefix PARAMS((const char *, int *));
+static char *glue_prefix_and_suffix PARAMS((char *, const char *, int));
+
+/* Find the start of a tilde expansion in STRING, and return the index of
+ the tilde which starts the expansion. Place the length of the text
+ which identified this tilde starter in LEN, excluding the tilde itself. */
+static int
+tilde_find_prefix (string, len)
+ const char *string;
+ int *len;
+{
+ register int i, j, string_len;
+ register char **prefixes;
+
+ prefixes = tilde_additional_prefixes;
+
+ string_len = strlen (string);
+ *len = 0;
+
+ if (*string == '\0' || *string == '~')
+ return (0);
+
+ if (prefixes)
+ {
+ for (i = 0; i < string_len; i++)
+ {
+ for (j = 0; prefixes[j]; j++)
+ {
+ if (strncmp (string + i, prefixes[j], strlen (prefixes[j])) == 0)
+ {
+ *len = strlen (prefixes[j]) - 1;
+ return (i + *len);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ return (string_len);
+}
+
+/* Find the end of a tilde expansion in STRING, and return the index of
+ the character which ends the tilde definition. */
+static int
+tilde_find_suffix (string)
+ const char *string;
+{
+ register int i, j, string_len;
+ register char **suffixes;
+
+ suffixes = tilde_additional_suffixes;
+ string_len = strlen (string);
+
+ for (i = 0; i < string_len; i++)
+ {
+#if defined (__MSDOS__)
+ if (string[i] == '/' || string[i] == '\\' /* || !string[i] */)
+#else
+ if (string[i] == '/' /* || !string[i] */)
+#endif
+ break;
+
+ for (j = 0; suffixes && suffixes[j]; j++)
+ {
+ if (strncmp (string + i, suffixes[j], strlen (suffixes[j])) == 0)
+ return (i);
+ }
+ }
+ return (i);
+}
+
+/* Return a new string which is the result of tilde expanding STRING. */
+char *
+tilde_expand (string)
+ const char *string;
+{
+ char *result;
+ int result_size, result_index;
+
+ result_index = result_size = 0;
+ if (result = strchr (string, '~'))
+ result = (char *)xmalloc (result_size = (strlen (string) + 16));
+ else
+ result = (char *)xmalloc (result_size = (strlen (string) + 1));
+
+ /* Scan through STRING expanding tildes as we come to them. */
+ while (1)
+ {
+ register int start, end;
+ char *tilde_word, *expansion;
+ int len;
+
+ /* Make START point to the tilde which starts the expansion. */
+ start = tilde_find_prefix (string, &len);
+
+ /* Copy the skipped text into the result. */
+ if ((result_index + start + 1) > result_size)
+ result = (char *)xrealloc (result, 1 + (result_size += (start + 20)));
+
+ strncpy (result + result_index, string, start);
+ result_index += start;
+
+ /* Advance STRING to the starting tilde. */
+ string += start;
+
+ /* Make END be the index of one after the last character of the
+ username. */
+ end = tilde_find_suffix (string);
+
+ /* If both START and END are zero, we are all done. */
+ if (!start && !end)
+ break;
+
+ /* Expand the entire tilde word, and copy it into RESULT. */
+ tilde_word = (char *)xmalloc (1 + end);
+ strncpy (tilde_word, string, end);
+ tilde_word[end] = '\0';
+ string += end;
+
+ expansion = tilde_expand_word (tilde_word);
+ free (tilde_word);
+
+ len = strlen (expansion);
+#ifdef __CYGWIN__
+ /* Fix for Cygwin to prevent ~user/xxx from expanding to //xxx when
+ $HOME for `user' is /. On cygwin, // denotes a network drive. */
+ if (len > 1 || *expansion != '/' || *string != '/')
+#endif
+ {
+ if ((result_index + len + 1) > result_size)
+ result = (char *)xrealloc (result, 1 + (result_size += (len + 20)));
+
+ strcpy (result + result_index, expansion);
+ result_index += len;
+ }
+ free (expansion);
+ }
+
+ result[result_index] = '\0';
+
+ return (result);
+}
+
+/* Take FNAME and return the tilde prefix we want expanded. If LENP is
+ non-null, the index of the end of the prefix into FNAME is returned in
+ the location it points to. */
+static char *
+isolate_tilde_prefix (fname, lenp)
+ const char *fname;
+ int *lenp;
+{
+ char *ret;
+ int i;
+
+ ret = (char *)xmalloc (strlen (fname));
+#if defined (__MSDOS__)
+ for (i = 1; fname[i] && fname[i] != '/' && fname[i] != '\\'; i++)
+#else
+ for (i = 1; fname[i] && fname[i] != '/'; i++)
+#endif
+ ret[i - 1] = fname[i];
+ ret[i - 1] = '\0';
+ if (lenp)
+ *lenp = i;
+ return ret;
+}
+
+#if 0
+/* Public function to scan a string (FNAME) beginning with a tilde and find
+ the portion of the string that should be passed to the tilde expansion
+ function. Right now, it just calls tilde_find_suffix and allocates new
+ memory, but it can be expanded to do different things later. */
+char *
+tilde_find_word (fname, flags, lenp)
+ const char *fname;
+ int flags, *lenp;
+{
+ int x;
+ char *r;
+
+ x = tilde_find_suffix (fname);
+ if (x == 0)
+ {
+ r = savestring (fname);
+ if (lenp)
+ *lenp = 0;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ r = (char *)xmalloc (1 + x);
+ strncpy (r, fname, x);
+ r[x] = '\0';
+ if (lenp)
+ *lenp = x;
+ }
+
+ return r;
+}
+#endif
+
+/* Return a string that is PREFIX concatenated with SUFFIX starting at
+ SUFFIND. */
+static char *
+glue_prefix_and_suffix (prefix, suffix, suffind)
+ char *prefix;
+ const char *suffix;
+ int suffind;
+{
+ char *ret;
+ int plen, slen;
+
+ plen = (prefix && *prefix) ? strlen (prefix) : 0;
+ slen = strlen (suffix + suffind);
+ ret = (char *)xmalloc (plen + slen + 1);
+ if (plen)
+ strcpy (ret, prefix);
+ strcpy (ret + plen, suffix + suffind);
+ return ret;
+}
+
+/* Do the work of tilde expansion on FILENAME. FILENAME starts with a
+ tilde. If there is no expansion, call tilde_expansion_failure_hook.
+ This always returns a newly-allocated string, never static storage. */
+char *
+tilde_expand_word (filename)
+ const char *filename;
+{
+ char *dirname, *expansion, *username;
+ int user_len;
+ struct passwd *user_entry;
+
+ if (filename == 0)
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+
+ if (*filename != '~')
+ return (savestring (filename));
+
+ /* A leading `~/' or a bare `~' is *always* translated to the value of
+ $HOME or the home directory of the current user, regardless of any
+ preexpansion hook. */
+ if (filename[1] == '\0' || filename[1] == '/')
+ {
+ /* Prefix $HOME to the rest of the string. */
+ expansion = sh_get_env_value ("HOME");
+
+ /* If there is no HOME variable, look up the directory in
+ the password database. */
+ if (expansion == 0)
+ expansion = sh_get_home_dir ();
+
+ return (glue_prefix_and_suffix (expansion, filename, 1));
+ }
+
+ username = isolate_tilde_prefix (filename, &user_len);
+
+ if (tilde_expansion_preexpansion_hook)
+ {
+ expansion = (*tilde_expansion_preexpansion_hook) (username);
+ if (expansion)
+ {
+ dirname = glue_prefix_and_suffix (expansion, filename, user_len);
+ free (username);
+ free (expansion);
+ return (dirname);
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* No preexpansion hook, or the preexpansion hook failed. Look in the
+ password database. */
+ dirname = (char *)NULL;
+#if defined (HAVE_GETPWNAM)
+ user_entry = getpwnam (username);
+#else
+ user_entry = 0;
+#endif
+ if (user_entry == 0)
+ {
+ /* If the calling program has a special syntax for expanding tildes,
+ and we couldn't find a standard expansion, then let them try. */
+ if (tilde_expansion_failure_hook)
+ {
+ expansion = (*tilde_expansion_failure_hook) (username);
+ if (expansion)
+ {
+ dirname = glue_prefix_and_suffix (expansion, filename, user_len);
+ free (expansion);
+ }
+ }
+ free (username);
+ /* If we don't have a failure hook, or if the failure hook did not
+ expand the tilde, return a copy of what we were passed. */
+ if (dirname == 0)
+ dirname = savestring (filename);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ free (username);
+ dirname = glue_prefix_and_suffix (user_entry->pw_dir, filename, user_len);
+ }
+#if defined (HAVE_GETPWENT)
+ endpwent ();
+#endif
+ return (dirname);
+}
+
+
+#if defined (TEST)
+#undef NULL
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+main (argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char **argv;
+{
+ char *result, line[512];
+ int done = 0;
+
+ while (!done)
+ {
+ printf ("~expand: ");
+ fflush (stdout);
+
+ if (!gets (line))
+ strcpy (line, "done");
+
+ if ((strcmp (line, "done") == 0) ||
+ (strcmp (line, "quit") == 0) ||
+ (strcmp (line, "exit") == 0))
+ {
+ done = 1;
+ break;
+ }
+
+ result = tilde_expand (line);
+ printf (" --> %s\n", result);
+ free (result);
+ }
+ exit (0);
+}
+
+static void memory_error_and_abort ();
+
+static void *
+xmalloc (bytes)
+ size_t bytes;
+{
+ void *temp = (char *)malloc (bytes);
+
+ if (!temp)
+ memory_error_and_abort ();
+ return (temp);
+}
+
+static void *
+xrealloc (pointer, bytes)
+ void *pointer;
+ int bytes;
+{
+ void *temp;
+
+ if (!pointer)
+ temp = malloc (bytes);
+ else
+ temp = realloc (pointer, bytes);
+
+ if (!temp)
+ memory_error_and_abort ();
+
+ return (temp);
+}
+
+static void
+memory_error_and_abort ()
+{
+ fprintf (stderr, "readline: out of virtual memory\n");
+ abort ();
+}
+
+/*
+ * Local variables:
+ * compile-command: "gcc -g -DTEST -o tilde tilde.c"
+ * end:
+ */
+#endif /* TEST */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/tilde.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/tilde.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c58ce20
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/tilde.h
@@ -0,0 +1,81 @@
+/* tilde.h: Externally available variables and function in libtilde.a. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file contains the Readline Library (the Library), a set of
+ routines for providing Emacs style line input to programs that ask
+ for it.
+
+ The Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ The Library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
+ WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#if !defined (_TILDE_H_)
+# define _TILDE_H_
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+extern "C" {
+#endif
+
+/* A function can be defined using prototypes and compile on both ANSI C
+ and traditional C compilers with something like this:
+ extern char *func PARAMS((char *, char *, int)); */
+
+#if !defined (PARAMS)
+# if defined (__STDC__) || defined (__GNUC__) || defined (__cplusplus)
+# define PARAMS(protos) protos
+# else
+# define PARAMS(protos) ()
+# endif
+#endif
+
+typedef char *tilde_hook_func_t PARAMS((char *));
+
+/* If non-null, this contains the address of a function that the application
+ wants called before trying the standard tilde expansions. The function
+ is called with the text sans tilde, and returns a malloc()'ed string
+ which is the expansion, or a NULL pointer if the expansion fails. */
+extern tilde_hook_func_t *tilde_expansion_preexpansion_hook;
+
+/* If non-null, this contains the address of a function to call if the
+ standard meaning for expanding a tilde fails. The function is called
+ with the text (sans tilde, as in "foo"), and returns a malloc()'ed string
+ which is the expansion, or a NULL pointer if there is no expansion. */
+extern tilde_hook_func_t *tilde_expansion_failure_hook;
+
+/* When non-null, this is a NULL terminated array of strings which
+ are duplicates for a tilde prefix. Bash uses this to expand
+ `=~' and `:~'. */
+extern char **tilde_additional_prefixes;
+
+/* When non-null, this is a NULL terminated array of strings which match
+ the end of a username, instead of just "/". Bash sets this to
+ `:' and `=~'. */
+extern char **tilde_additional_suffixes;
+
+/* Return a new string which is the result of tilde expanding STRING. */
+extern char *tilde_expand PARAMS((const char *));
+
+/* Do the work of tilde expansion on FILENAME. FILENAME starts with a
+ tilde. If there is no expansion, call tilde_expansion_failure_hook. */
+extern char *tilde_expand_word PARAMS((const char *));
+
+/* Find the portion of the string beginning with ~ that should be expanded. */
+extern char *tilde_find_word PARAMS((const char *, int, int *));
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+}
+#endif
+
+#endif /* _TILDE_H_ */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/undo.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/undo.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..fedfa12
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/undo.c
@@ -0,0 +1,268 @@
+/* readline.c -- a general facility for reading lines of input
+ with emacs style editing and completion. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1987, 1989, 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h> /* for _POSIX_VERSION */
+#endif /* HAVE_UNISTD_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STDLIB_H)
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif /* HAVE_STDLIB_H */
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+/* System-specific feature definitions and include files. */
+#include "rldefs.h"
+
+/* Some standard library routines. */
+#include "readline.h"
+#include "history.h"
+
+#include "rlprivate.h"
+#include "xmalloc.h"
+
+/* Non-zero tells rl_delete_text and rl_insert_text to not add to
+ the undo list. */
+int _rl_doing_an_undo = 0;
+
+/* How many unclosed undo groups we currently have. */
+int _rl_undo_group_level = 0;
+
+/* The current undo list for THE_LINE. */
+UNDO_LIST *rl_undo_list = (UNDO_LIST *)NULL;
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Undo, and Undoing */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* Remember how to undo something. Concatenate some undos if that
+ seems right. */
+void
+rl_add_undo (what, start, end, text)
+ enum undo_code what;
+ int start, end;
+ char *text;
+{
+ UNDO_LIST *temp = (UNDO_LIST *)xmalloc (sizeof (UNDO_LIST));
+ temp->what = what;
+ temp->start = start;
+ temp->end = end;
+ temp->text = text;
+ temp->next = rl_undo_list;
+ rl_undo_list = temp;
+}
+
+/* Free the existing undo list. */
+void
+rl_free_undo_list ()
+{
+ while (rl_undo_list)
+ {
+ UNDO_LIST *release = rl_undo_list;
+ rl_undo_list = rl_undo_list->next;
+
+ if (release->what == UNDO_DELETE)
+ free (release->text);
+
+ free (release);
+ }
+ rl_undo_list = (UNDO_LIST *)NULL;
+}
+
+/* Undo the next thing in the list. Return 0 if there
+ is nothing to undo, or non-zero if there was. */
+int
+rl_do_undo ()
+{
+ UNDO_LIST *release;
+ int waiting_for_begin, start, end;
+
+#define TRANS(i) ((i) == -1 ? rl_point : ((i) == -2 ? rl_end : (i)))
+
+ start = end = waiting_for_begin = 0;
+ do
+ {
+ if (!rl_undo_list)
+ return (0);
+
+ _rl_doing_an_undo = 1;
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_UNDOING);
+
+ /* To better support vi-mode, a start or end value of -1 means
+ rl_point, and a value of -2 means rl_end. */
+ if (rl_undo_list->what == UNDO_DELETE || rl_undo_list->what == UNDO_INSERT)
+ {
+ start = TRANS (rl_undo_list->start);
+ end = TRANS (rl_undo_list->end);
+ }
+
+ switch (rl_undo_list->what)
+ {
+ /* Undoing deletes means inserting some text. */
+ case UNDO_DELETE:
+ rl_point = start;
+ rl_insert_text (rl_undo_list->text);
+ free (rl_undo_list->text);
+ break;
+
+ /* Undoing inserts means deleting some text. */
+ case UNDO_INSERT:
+ rl_delete_text (start, end);
+ rl_point = start;
+ break;
+
+ /* Undoing an END means undoing everything 'til we get to a BEGIN. */
+ case UNDO_END:
+ waiting_for_begin++;
+ break;
+
+ /* Undoing a BEGIN means that we are done with this group. */
+ case UNDO_BEGIN:
+ if (waiting_for_begin)
+ waiting_for_begin--;
+ else
+ rl_ding ();
+ break;
+ }
+
+ _rl_doing_an_undo = 0;
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_UNDOING);
+
+ release = rl_undo_list;
+ rl_undo_list = rl_undo_list->next;
+ free (release);
+ }
+ while (waiting_for_begin);
+
+ return (1);
+}
+#undef TRANS
+
+int
+_rl_fix_last_undo_of_type (type, start, end)
+ int type, start, end;
+{
+ UNDO_LIST *rl;
+
+ for (rl = rl_undo_list; rl; rl = rl->next)
+ {
+ if (rl->what == type)
+ {
+ rl->start = start;
+ rl->end = end;
+ return 0;
+ }
+ }
+ return 1;
+}
+
+/* Begin a group. Subsequent undos are undone as an atomic operation. */
+int
+rl_begin_undo_group ()
+{
+ rl_add_undo (UNDO_BEGIN, 0, 0, 0);
+ _rl_undo_group_level++;
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* End an undo group started with rl_begin_undo_group (). */
+int
+rl_end_undo_group ()
+{
+ rl_add_undo (UNDO_END, 0, 0, 0);
+ _rl_undo_group_level--;
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Save an undo entry for the text from START to END. */
+int
+rl_modifying (start, end)
+ int start, end;
+{
+ if (start > end)
+ {
+ SWAP (start, end);
+ }
+
+ if (start != end)
+ {
+ char *temp = rl_copy_text (start, end);
+ rl_begin_undo_group ();
+ rl_add_undo (UNDO_DELETE, start, end, temp);
+ rl_add_undo (UNDO_INSERT, start, end, (char *)NULL);
+ rl_end_undo_group ();
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Revert the current line to its previous state. */
+int
+rl_revert_line (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ if (!rl_undo_list)
+ rl_ding ();
+ else
+ {
+ while (rl_undo_list)
+ rl_do_undo ();
+#if defined (VI_MODE)
+ if (rl_editing_mode == vi_mode)
+ rl_point = rl_mark = 0; /* rl_end should be set correctly */
+#endif
+ }
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Do some undoing of things that were done. */
+int
+rl_undo_command (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ if (count < 0)
+ return 0; /* Nothing to do. */
+
+ while (count)
+ {
+ if (rl_do_undo ())
+ count--;
+ else
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/util.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/util.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e44ef64
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/util.c
@@ -0,0 +1,355 @@
+/* util.c -- readline utility functions */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1987-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include "posixjmp.h"
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h> /* for _POSIX_VERSION */
+#endif /* HAVE_UNISTD_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STDLIB_H)
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif /* HAVE_STDLIB_H */
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <ctype.h>
+
+/* System-specific feature definitions and include files. */
+#include "rldefs.h"
+#include "rlmbutil.h"
+
+#if defined (TIOCSTAT_IN_SYS_IOCTL)
+# include <sys/ioctl.h>
+#endif /* TIOCSTAT_IN_SYS_IOCTL */
+
+/* Some standard library routines. */
+#include "readline.h"
+
+#include "rlprivate.h"
+#include "xmalloc.h"
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Utility Functions */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* Return 0 if C is not a member of the class of characters that belong
+ in words, or 1 if it is. */
+
+int _rl_allow_pathname_alphabetic_chars = 0;
+static const char *pathname_alphabetic_chars = "/-_=~.#$";
+
+int
+rl_alphabetic (c)
+ int c;
+{
+ if (ALPHABETIC (c))
+ return (1);
+
+ return (_rl_allow_pathname_alphabetic_chars &&
+ strchr (pathname_alphabetic_chars, c) != NULL);
+}
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+int
+_rl_walphabetic (wc)
+ wchar_t wc;
+{
+ int c;
+
+ if (iswalnum (wc))
+ return (1);
+
+ c = wc & 0177;
+ return (_rl_allow_pathname_alphabetic_chars &&
+ strchr (pathname_alphabetic_chars, c) != NULL);
+}
+#endif
+
+/* How to abort things. */
+int
+_rl_abort_internal ()
+{
+ rl_ding ();
+ rl_clear_message ();
+ _rl_reset_argument ();
+ rl_clear_pending_input ();
+
+ RL_UNSETSTATE (RL_STATE_MACRODEF);
+ while (rl_executing_macro)
+ _rl_pop_executing_macro ();
+
+ rl_last_func = (rl_command_func_t *)NULL;
+ longjmp (readline_top_level, 1);
+ return (0);
+}
+
+int
+rl_abort (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ return (_rl_abort_internal ());
+}
+
+int
+rl_tty_status (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+#if defined (TIOCSTAT)
+ ioctl (1, TIOCSTAT, (char *)0);
+ rl_refresh_line (count, key);
+#else
+ rl_ding ();
+#endif
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Return a copy of the string between FROM and TO.
+ FROM is inclusive, TO is not. */
+char *
+rl_copy_text (from, to)
+ int from, to;
+{
+ register int length;
+ char *copy;
+
+ /* Fix it if the caller is confused. */
+ if (from > to)
+ SWAP (from, to);
+
+ length = to - from;
+ copy = (char *)xmalloc (1 + length);
+ strncpy (copy, rl_line_buffer + from, length);
+ copy[length] = '\0';
+ return (copy);
+}
+
+/* Increase the size of RL_LINE_BUFFER until it has enough space to hold
+ LEN characters. */
+void
+rl_extend_line_buffer (len)
+ int len;
+{
+ while (len >= rl_line_buffer_len)
+ {
+ rl_line_buffer_len += DEFAULT_BUFFER_SIZE;
+ rl_line_buffer = (char *)xrealloc (rl_line_buffer, rl_line_buffer_len);
+ }
+
+ _rl_set_the_line ();
+}
+
+
+/* A function for simple tilde expansion. */
+int
+rl_tilde_expand (ignore, key)
+ int ignore, key;
+{
+ register int start, end;
+ char *homedir, *temp;
+ int len;
+
+ end = rl_point;
+ start = end - 1;
+
+ if (rl_point == rl_end && rl_line_buffer[rl_point] == '~')
+ {
+ homedir = tilde_expand ("~");
+ _rl_replace_text (homedir, start, end);
+ return (0);
+ }
+ else if (rl_line_buffer[start] != '~')
+ {
+ for (; !whitespace (rl_line_buffer[start]) && start >= 0; start--)
+ ;
+ start++;
+ }
+
+ end = start;
+ do
+ end++;
+ while (whitespace (rl_line_buffer[end]) == 0 && end < rl_end);
+
+ if (whitespace (rl_line_buffer[end]) || end >= rl_end)
+ end--;
+
+ /* If the first character of the current word is a tilde, perform
+ tilde expansion and insert the result. If not a tilde, do
+ nothing. */
+ if (rl_line_buffer[start] == '~')
+ {
+ len = end - start + 1;
+ temp = (char *)xmalloc (len + 1);
+ strncpy (temp, rl_line_buffer + start, len);
+ temp[len] = '\0';
+ homedir = tilde_expand (temp);
+ free (temp);
+
+ _rl_replace_text (homedir, start, end);
+ }
+
+ return (0);
+}
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* String Utility Functions */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* Determine if s2 occurs in s1. If so, return a pointer to the
+ match in s1. The compare is case insensitive. */
+char *
+_rl_strindex (s1, s2)
+ register const char *s1, *s2;
+{
+ register int i, l, len;
+
+ for (i = 0, l = strlen (s2), len = strlen (s1); (len - i) >= l; i++)
+ if (_rl_strnicmp (s1 + i, s2, l) == 0)
+ return ((char *) (s1 + i));
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+}
+
+#ifndef HAVE_STRPBRK
+/* Find the first occurrence in STRING1 of any character from STRING2.
+ Return a pointer to the character in STRING1. */
+char *
+_rl_strpbrk (string1, string2)
+ const char *string1, *string2;
+{
+ register const char *scan;
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ mbstate_t ps;
+ register int i, v;
+
+ memset (&ps, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+#endif
+
+ for (; *string1; string1++)
+ {
+ for (scan = string2; *scan; scan++)
+ {
+ if (*string1 == *scan)
+ return ((char *)string1);
+ }
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ {
+ v = _rl_get_char_len (string1, &ps);
+ if (v > 1)
+ string1 += v - 1; /* -1 to account for auto-increment in loop */
+ }
+#endif
+ }
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+}
+#endif
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_STRCASECMP)
+/* Compare at most COUNT characters from string1 to string2. Case
+ doesn't matter. */
+int
+_rl_strnicmp (string1, string2, count)
+ char *string1, *string2;
+ int count;
+{
+ register char ch1, ch2;
+
+ while (count)
+ {
+ ch1 = *string1++;
+ ch2 = *string2++;
+ if (_rl_to_upper(ch1) == _rl_to_upper(ch2))
+ count--;
+ else
+ break;
+ }
+ return (count);
+}
+
+/* strcmp (), but caseless. */
+int
+_rl_stricmp (string1, string2)
+ char *string1, *string2;
+{
+ register char ch1, ch2;
+
+ while (*string1 && *string2)
+ {
+ ch1 = *string1++;
+ ch2 = *string2++;
+ if (_rl_to_upper(ch1) != _rl_to_upper(ch2))
+ return (1);
+ }
+ return (*string1 - *string2);
+}
+#endif /* !HAVE_STRCASECMP */
+
+/* Stupid comparison routine for qsort () ing strings. */
+int
+_rl_qsort_string_compare (s1, s2)
+ char **s1, **s2;
+{
+#if defined (HAVE_STRCOLL)
+ return (strcoll (*s1, *s2));
+#else
+ int result;
+
+ result = **s1 - **s2;
+ if (result == 0)
+ result = strcmp (*s1, *s2);
+
+ return result;
+#endif
+}
+
+/* Function equivalents for the macros defined in chardefs.h. */
+#define FUNCTION_FOR_MACRO(f) int (f) (c) int c; { return f (c); }
+
+FUNCTION_FOR_MACRO (_rl_digit_p)
+FUNCTION_FOR_MACRO (_rl_digit_value)
+FUNCTION_FOR_MACRO (_rl_lowercase_p)
+FUNCTION_FOR_MACRO (_rl_pure_alphabetic)
+FUNCTION_FOR_MACRO (_rl_to_lower)
+FUNCTION_FOR_MACRO (_rl_to_upper)
+FUNCTION_FOR_MACRO (_rl_uppercase_p)
+
+/* Backwards compatibility, now that savestring has been removed from
+ all `public' readline header files. */
+#undef _rl_savestring
+char *
+_rl_savestring (s)
+ const char *s;
+{
+ return (strcpy ((char *)xmalloc (1 + (int)strlen (s)), (s)));
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/vi_keymap.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/vi_keymap.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..4b48c75
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/vi_keymap.c
@@ -0,0 +1,877 @@
+/* vi_keymap.c -- the keymap for vi_mode in readline (). */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1987, 1989, 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#if !defined (BUFSIZ)
+#include <stdio.h>
+#endif /* !BUFSIZ */
+
+#include "readline.h"
+
+#if 0
+extern KEYMAP_ENTRY_ARRAY vi_escape_keymap;
+#endif
+
+/* The keymap arrays for handling vi mode. */
+KEYMAP_ENTRY_ARRAY vi_movement_keymap = {
+ /* The regular control keys come first. */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-@ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-a */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-b */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-c */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_eof_maybe }, /* Control-d */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_emacs_editing_mode }, /* Control-e */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-f */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_abort }, /* Control-g */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_backward_char }, /* Control-h */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-i */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_newline }, /* Control-j */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_kill_line }, /* Control-k */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_clear_screen }, /* Control-l */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_newline }, /* Control-m */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_get_next_history }, /* Control-n */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-o */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_get_previous_history }, /* Control-p */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_quoted_insert }, /* Control-q */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_reverse_search_history }, /* Control-r */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_forward_search_history }, /* Control-s */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_transpose_chars }, /* Control-t */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_unix_line_discard }, /* Control-u */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_quoted_insert }, /* Control-v */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_unix_word_rubout }, /* Control-w */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-x */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_yank }, /* Control-y */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-z */
+
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-[ */ /* vi_escape_keymap */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-\ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-] */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-^ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_undo }, /* Control-_ */
+
+ /* The start of printing characters. */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_forward_char }, /* SPACE */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* ! */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* " */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert_comment }, /* # */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_end_of_line }, /* $ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_match }, /* % */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_tilde_expand }, /* & */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* ' */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* ( */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* ) */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_complete }, /* * */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_get_next_history}, /* + */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_char_search }, /* , */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_get_previous_history }, /* - */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_redo }, /* . */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_search }, /* / */
+
+ /* Regular digits. */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_beg_of_line }, /* 0 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_arg_digit }, /* 1 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_arg_digit }, /* 2 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_arg_digit }, /* 3 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_arg_digit }, /* 4 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_arg_digit }, /* 5 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_arg_digit }, /* 6 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_arg_digit }, /* 7 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_arg_digit }, /* 8 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_arg_digit }, /* 9 */
+
+ /* A little more punctuation. */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* : */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_char_search }, /* ; */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* < */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_complete }, /* = */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* > */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_search }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* @ */
+
+ /* Uppercase alphabet. */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_append_eol }, /* A */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_prev_word}, /* B */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_change_to }, /* C */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_delete_to }, /* D */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_end_word }, /* E */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_char_search }, /* F */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_fetch_history }, /* G */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* H */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_insert_beg }, /* I */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* J */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* K */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* L */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* M */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_search_again }, /* N */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* O */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_put }, /* P */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Q */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_replace }, /* R */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_subst }, /* S */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_char_search }, /* T */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_revert_line }, /* U */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* V */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_next_word }, /* W */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_rubout }, /* X */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_yank_to }, /* Y */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Z */
+
+ /* Some more punctuation. */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* [ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_complete }, /* \ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* ] */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_first_print }, /* ^ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_yank_arg }, /* _ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_goto_mark }, /* ` */
+
+ /* Lowercase alphabet. */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_append_mode }, /* a */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_prev_word }, /* b */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_change_to }, /* c */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_delete_to }, /* d */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_end_word }, /* e */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_char_search }, /* f */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* g */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_backward_char }, /* h */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_insertion_mode }, /* i */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_get_next_history }, /* j */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_get_previous_history }, /* k */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_forward_char }, /* l */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_set_mark }, /* m */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_search_again }, /* n */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* o */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_put }, /* p */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* q */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_change_char }, /* r */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_subst }, /* s */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_char_search }, /* t */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_undo }, /* u */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* v */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_next_word }, /* w */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_delete }, /* x */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_yank_to }, /* y */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* z */
+
+ /* Final punctuation. */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* { */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_column }, /* | */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* } */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_change_case }, /* ~ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* RUBOUT */
+
+#if KEYMAP_SIZE > 128
+ /* Undefined keys. */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }
+#endif /* KEYMAP_SIZE > 128 */
+};
+
+
+KEYMAP_ENTRY_ARRAY vi_insertion_keymap = {
+ /* The regular control keys come first. */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-@ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Control-a */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Control-b */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Control-c */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_eof_maybe }, /* Control-d */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Control-e */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Control-f */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Control-g */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_rubout }, /* Control-h */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_complete }, /* Control-i */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_newline }, /* Control-j */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Control-k */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Control-l */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_newline }, /* Control-m */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Control-n */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Control-o */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Control-p */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Control-q */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_reverse_search_history }, /* Control-r */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_forward_search_history }, /* Control-s */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_transpose_chars }, /* Control-t */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_unix_line_discard }, /* Control-u */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_quoted_insert }, /* Control-v */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_unix_word_rubout }, /* Control-w */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Control-x */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_yank }, /* Control-y */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Control-z */
+
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_movement_mode }, /* Control-[ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Control-\ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Control-] */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Control-^ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_undo }, /* Control-_ */
+
+ /* The start of printing characters. */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* SPACE */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ! */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* " */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* # */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* $ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* % */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* & */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ' */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ( */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ) */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* * */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* + */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* , */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* - */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* . */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* / */
+
+ /* Regular digits. */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* 0 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* 1 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* 2 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* 3 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* 4 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* 5 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* 6 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* 7 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* 8 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* 9 */
+
+ /* A little more punctuation. */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* : */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ; */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* < */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* = */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* > */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* @ */
+
+ /* Uppercase alphabet. */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* A */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* B */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* C */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* D */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* E */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* F */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* G */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* H */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* I */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* J */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* K */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* L */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* M */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* N */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* O */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* P */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Q */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* R */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* S */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* T */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* U */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* V */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* W */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* X */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Y */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Z */
+
+ /* Some more punctuation. */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* [ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* \ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ] */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ^ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* _ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ` */
+
+ /* Lowercase alphabet. */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* a */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* b */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* c */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* d */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* e */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* f */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* g */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* h */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* i */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* j */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* k */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* l */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* m */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* n */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* o */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* p */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* q */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* r */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* s */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* t */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* u */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* v */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* w */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* x */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* y */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* z */
+
+ /* Final punctuation. */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* { */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* | */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* } */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ~ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_rubout }, /* RUBOUT */
+
+#if KEYMAP_SIZE > 128
+ /* Pure 8-bit characters (128 - 159).
+ These might be used in some
+ character sets. */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* ? */
+
+ /* ISO Latin-1 characters (160 - 255) */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* No-break space */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Inverted exclamation mark */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Cent sign */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Pound sign */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Currency sign */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Yen sign */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Broken bar */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Section sign */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Diaeresis */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Copyright sign */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Feminine ordinal indicator */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Left pointing double angle quotation mark */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Not sign */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Soft hyphen */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Registered sign */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Macron */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Degree sign */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Plus-minus sign */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Superscript two */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Superscript three */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Acute accent */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Micro sign */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Pilcrow sign */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Middle dot */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Cedilla */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Superscript one */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Masculine ordinal indicator */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Right pointing double angle quotation mark */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Vulgar fraction one quarter */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Vulgar fraction one half */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Vulgar fraction three quarters */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Inverted questionk mark */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter a with grave */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter a with acute */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter a with circumflex */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter a with tilde */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter a with diaeresis */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter a with ring above */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter ae */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter c with cedilla */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter e with grave */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter e with acute */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter e with circumflex */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter e with diaeresis */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter i with grave */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter i with acute */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter i with circumflex */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter i with diaeresis */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter eth (Icelandic) */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter n with tilde */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter o with grave */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter o with acute */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter o with circumflex */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter o with tilde */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter o with diaeresis */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Multiplication sign */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter o with stroke */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter u with grave */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter u with acute */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter u with circumflex */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter u with diaeresis */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter Y with acute */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin capital letter thorn (Icelandic) */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter sharp s (German) */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter a with grave */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter a with acute */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter a with circumflex */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter a with tilde */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter a with diaeresis */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter a with ring above */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter ae */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter c with cedilla */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter e with grave */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter e with acute */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter e with circumflex */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter e with diaeresis */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter i with grave */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter i with acute */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter i with circumflex */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter i with diaeresis */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter eth (Icelandic) */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter n with tilde */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter o with grave */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter o with acute */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter o with circumflex */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter o with tilde */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter o with diaeresis */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Division sign */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter o with stroke */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter u with grave */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter u with acute */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter u with circumflex */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter u with diaeresis */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter y with acute */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert }, /* Latin small letter thorn (Icelandic) */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_insert } /* Latin small letter y with diaeresis */
+#endif /* KEYMAP_SIZE > 128 */
+};
+
+/* Unused for the time being. */
+#if 0
+KEYMAP_ENTRY_ARRAY vi_escape_keymap = {
+ /* The regular control keys come first. */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-@ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-a */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-b */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-c */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-d */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-e */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-f */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-g */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-h */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_tab_insert}, /* Control-i */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_emacs_editing_mode}, /* Control-j */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_kill_line }, /* Control-k */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-l */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_emacs_editing_mode}, /* Control-m */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-n */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-o */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-p */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-q */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-r */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-s */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-t */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-u */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-v */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-w */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-x */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-y */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-z */
+
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_movement_mode }, /* Control-[ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-\ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-] */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* Control-^ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_undo }, /* Control-_ */
+
+ /* The start of printing characters. */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* SPACE */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* ! */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* " */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* # */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* $ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* % */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* & */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* ' */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* ( */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* ) */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* * */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* + */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* , */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* - */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* . */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* / */
+
+ /* Regular digits. */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_arg_digit }, /* 0 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_arg_digit }, /* 1 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_arg_digit }, /* 2 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_arg_digit }, /* 3 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_arg_digit }, /* 4 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_arg_digit }, /* 5 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_arg_digit }, /* 6 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_arg_digit }, /* 7 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_arg_digit }, /* 8 */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_vi_arg_digit }, /* 9 */
+
+ /* A little more punctuation. */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* : */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* ; */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* < */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* = */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* > */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* ? */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* @ */
+
+ /* Uppercase alphabet. */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* A */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* B */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* C */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* D */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* E */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* F */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* G */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* H */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* I */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* J */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* K */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* L */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* M */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* N */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* O */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* P */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Q */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* R */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* S */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* T */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* U */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* V */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* W */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* X */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Y */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_do_lowercase_version }, /* Z */
+
+ /* Some more punctuation. */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_arrow_keys }, /* [ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* \ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* ] */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* ^ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* _ */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* ` */
+
+ /* Lowercase alphabet. */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* a */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* b */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* c */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* d */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* e */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* f */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* g */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* h */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* i */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* j */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* k */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* l */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* m */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* n */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_arrow_keys }, /* o */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* p */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* q */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* r */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* s */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* t */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* u */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* v */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* w */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* x */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* y */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* z */
+
+ /* Final punctuation. */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* { */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* | */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* } */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }, /* ~ */
+ { ISFUNC, rl_backward_kill_word }, /* RUBOUT */
+
+#if KEYMAP_SIZE > 128
+ /* Undefined keys. */
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 },
+ { ISFUNC, (rl_command_func_t *)0x0 }
+#endif /* KEYMAP_SIZE > 128 */
+};
+#endif
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/vi_mode.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/vi_mode.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ac5fd74
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/vi_mode.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1717 @@
+/* vi_mode.c -- A vi emulation mode for Bash.
+ Derived from code written by Jeff Sparkes (jsparkes@bnr.ca). */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1987-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* VI Emulation Mode */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+#include "rlconf.h"
+
+#if defined (VI_MODE)
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STDLIB_H)
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif /* HAVE_STDLIB_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+/* Some standard library routines. */
+#include "rldefs.h"
+#include "rlmbutil.h"
+
+#include "readline.h"
+#include "history.h"
+
+#include "rlprivate.h"
+#include "xmalloc.h"
+
+#ifndef member
+#define member(c, s) ((c) ? (char *)strchr ((s), (c)) != (char *)NULL : 0)
+#endif
+
+int _rl_vi_last_command = 'i'; /* default `.' puts you in insert mode */
+
+/* Non-zero means enter insertion mode. */
+static int _rl_vi_doing_insert;
+
+/* Command keys which do movement for xxx_to commands. */
+static const char *vi_motion = " hl^$0ftFT;,%wbeWBE|";
+
+/* Keymap used for vi replace characters. Created dynamically since
+ rarely used. */
+static Keymap vi_replace_map;
+
+/* The number of characters inserted in the last replace operation. */
+static int vi_replace_count;
+
+/* If non-zero, we have text inserted after a c[motion] command that put
+ us implicitly into insert mode. Some people want this text to be
+ attached to the command so that it is `redoable' with `.'. */
+static int vi_continued_command;
+static char *vi_insert_buffer;
+static int vi_insert_buffer_size;
+
+static int _rl_vi_last_repeat = 1;
+static int _rl_vi_last_arg_sign = 1;
+static int _rl_vi_last_motion;
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+static char _rl_vi_last_search_mbchar[MB_LEN_MAX];
+static int _rl_vi_last_search_mblen;
+#else
+static int _rl_vi_last_search_char;
+#endif
+static int _rl_vi_last_replacement;
+
+static int _rl_vi_last_key_before_insert;
+
+static int vi_redoing;
+
+/* Text modification commands. These are the `redoable' commands. */
+static const char *vi_textmod = "_*\\AaIiCcDdPpYyRrSsXx~";
+
+/* Arrays for the saved marks. */
+static int vi_mark_chars['z' - 'a' + 1];
+
+static void _rl_vi_stuff_insert PARAMS((int));
+static void _rl_vi_save_insert PARAMS((UNDO_LIST *));
+
+static int _rl_vi_arg_dispatch PARAMS((int));
+static int rl_digit_loop1 PARAMS((void));
+
+static int _rl_vi_set_mark PARAMS((void));
+static int _rl_vi_goto_mark PARAMS((void));
+
+static int _rl_vi_callback_getchar PARAMS((char *, int));
+
+#if defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+static int _rl_vi_callback_set_mark PARAMS((_rl_callback_generic_arg *));
+static int _rl_vi_callback_goto_mark PARAMS((_rl_callback_generic_arg *));
+static int _rl_vi_callback_change_char PARAMS((_rl_callback_generic_arg *));
+static int _rl_vi_callback_char_search PARAMS((_rl_callback_generic_arg *));
+#endif
+
+void
+_rl_vi_initialize_line ()
+{
+ register int i;
+
+ for (i = 0; i < sizeof (vi_mark_chars) / sizeof (int); i++)
+ vi_mark_chars[i] = -1;
+
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_VICMDONCE);
+}
+
+void
+_rl_vi_reset_last ()
+{
+ _rl_vi_last_command = 'i';
+ _rl_vi_last_repeat = 1;
+ _rl_vi_last_arg_sign = 1;
+ _rl_vi_last_motion = 0;
+}
+
+void
+_rl_vi_set_last (key, repeat, sign)
+ int key, repeat, sign;
+{
+ _rl_vi_last_command = key;
+ _rl_vi_last_repeat = repeat;
+ _rl_vi_last_arg_sign = sign;
+}
+
+/* A convenience function that calls _rl_vi_set_last to save the last command
+ information and enters insertion mode. */
+void
+rl_vi_start_inserting (key, repeat, sign)
+ int key, repeat, sign;
+{
+ _rl_vi_set_last (key, repeat, sign);
+ rl_vi_insertion_mode (1, key);
+}
+
+/* Is the command C a VI mode text modification command? */
+int
+_rl_vi_textmod_command (c)
+ int c;
+{
+ return (member (c, vi_textmod));
+}
+
+static void
+_rl_vi_stuff_insert (count)
+ int count;
+{
+ rl_begin_undo_group ();
+ while (count--)
+ rl_insert_text (vi_insert_buffer);
+ rl_end_undo_group ();
+}
+
+/* Bound to `.'. Called from command mode, so we know that we have to
+ redo a text modification command. The default for _rl_vi_last_command
+ puts you back into insert mode. */
+int
+rl_vi_redo (count, c)
+ int count, c;
+{
+ int r;
+
+ if (!rl_explicit_arg)
+ {
+ rl_numeric_arg = _rl_vi_last_repeat;
+ rl_arg_sign = _rl_vi_last_arg_sign;
+ }
+
+ r = 0;
+ vi_redoing = 1;
+ /* If we're redoing an insert with `i', stuff in the inserted text
+ and do not go into insertion mode. */
+ if (_rl_vi_last_command == 'i' && vi_insert_buffer && *vi_insert_buffer)
+ {
+ _rl_vi_stuff_insert (count);
+ /* And back up point over the last character inserted. */
+ if (rl_point > 0)
+ rl_point--;
+ }
+ else
+ r = _rl_dispatch (_rl_vi_last_command, _rl_keymap);
+ vi_redoing = 0;
+
+ return (r);
+}
+
+/* A placeholder for further expansion. */
+int
+rl_vi_undo (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ return (rl_undo_command (count, key));
+}
+
+/* Yank the nth arg from the previous line into this line at point. */
+int
+rl_vi_yank_arg (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ /* Readline thinks that the first word on a line is the 0th, while vi
+ thinks the first word on a line is the 1st. Compensate. */
+ if (rl_explicit_arg)
+ rl_yank_nth_arg (count - 1, 0);
+ else
+ rl_yank_nth_arg ('$', 0);
+
+ return (0);
+}
+
+/* With an argument, move back that many history lines, else move to the
+ beginning of history. */
+int
+rl_vi_fetch_history (count, c)
+ int count, c;
+{
+ int wanted;
+
+ /* Giving an argument of n means we want the nth command in the history
+ file. The command number is interpreted the same way that the bash
+ `history' command does it -- that is, giving an argument count of 450
+ to this command would get the command listed as number 450 in the
+ output of `history'. */
+ if (rl_explicit_arg)
+ {
+ wanted = history_base + where_history () - count;
+ if (wanted <= 0)
+ rl_beginning_of_history (0, 0);
+ else
+ rl_get_previous_history (wanted, c);
+ }
+ else
+ rl_beginning_of_history (count, 0);
+ return (0);
+}
+
+/* Search again for the last thing searched for. */
+int
+rl_vi_search_again (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ switch (key)
+ {
+ case 'n':
+ rl_noninc_reverse_search_again (count, key);
+ break;
+
+ case 'N':
+ rl_noninc_forward_search_again (count, key);
+ break;
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+
+/* Do a vi style search. */
+int
+rl_vi_search (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ switch (key)
+ {
+ case '?':
+ _rl_free_saved_history_line ();
+ rl_noninc_forward_search (count, key);
+ break;
+
+ case '/':
+ _rl_free_saved_history_line ();
+ rl_noninc_reverse_search (count, key);
+ break;
+
+ default:
+ rl_ding ();
+ break;
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+
+/* Completion, from vi's point of view. */
+int
+rl_vi_complete (ignore, key)
+ int ignore, key;
+{
+ if ((rl_point < rl_end) && (!whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point])))
+ {
+ if (!whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point + 1]))
+ rl_vi_end_word (1, 'E');
+ rl_point++;
+ }
+
+ if (key == '*')
+ rl_complete_internal ('*'); /* Expansion and replacement. */
+ else if (key == '=')
+ rl_complete_internal ('?'); /* List possible completions. */
+ else if (key == '\\')
+ rl_complete_internal (TAB); /* Standard Readline completion. */
+ else
+ rl_complete (0, key);
+
+ if (key == '*' || key == '\\')
+ rl_vi_start_inserting (key, 1, rl_arg_sign);
+
+ return (0);
+}
+
+/* Tilde expansion for vi mode. */
+int
+rl_vi_tilde_expand (ignore, key)
+ int ignore, key;
+{
+ rl_tilde_expand (0, key);
+ rl_vi_start_inserting (key, 1, rl_arg_sign);
+ return (0);
+}
+
+/* Previous word in vi mode. */
+int
+rl_vi_prev_word (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ if (count < 0)
+ return (rl_vi_next_word (-count, key));
+
+ if (rl_point == 0)
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ return (0);
+ }
+
+ if (_rl_uppercase_p (key))
+ rl_vi_bWord (count, key);
+ else
+ rl_vi_bword (count, key);
+
+ return (0);
+}
+
+/* Next word in vi mode. */
+int
+rl_vi_next_word (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ if (count < 0)
+ return (rl_vi_prev_word (-count, key));
+
+ if (rl_point >= (rl_end - 1))
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ return (0);
+ }
+
+ if (_rl_uppercase_p (key))
+ rl_vi_fWord (count, key);
+ else
+ rl_vi_fword (count, key);
+ return (0);
+}
+
+/* Move to the end of the ?next? word. */
+int
+rl_vi_end_word (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ if (count < 0)
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ if (_rl_uppercase_p (key))
+ rl_vi_eWord (count, key);
+ else
+ rl_vi_eword (count, key);
+ return (0);
+}
+
+/* Move forward a word the way that 'W' does. */
+int
+rl_vi_fWord (count, ignore)
+ int count, ignore;
+{
+ while (count-- && rl_point < (rl_end - 1))
+ {
+ /* Skip until whitespace. */
+ while (!whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]) && rl_point < rl_end)
+ rl_point++;
+
+ /* Now skip whitespace. */
+ while (whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]) && rl_point < rl_end)
+ rl_point++;
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+
+int
+rl_vi_bWord (count, ignore)
+ int count, ignore;
+{
+ while (count-- && rl_point > 0)
+ {
+ /* If we are at the start of a word, move back to whitespace so
+ we will go back to the start of the previous word. */
+ if (!whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]) &&
+ whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point - 1]))
+ rl_point--;
+
+ while (rl_point > 0 && whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]))
+ rl_point--;
+
+ if (rl_point > 0)
+ {
+ while (--rl_point >= 0 && !whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]));
+ rl_point++;
+ }
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+
+int
+rl_vi_eWord (count, ignore)
+ int count, ignore;
+{
+ while (count-- && rl_point < (rl_end - 1))
+ {
+ if (!whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]))
+ rl_point++;
+
+ /* Move to the next non-whitespace character (to the start of the
+ next word). */
+ while (rl_point < rl_end && whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]))
+ rl_point++;
+
+ if (rl_point && rl_point < rl_end)
+ {
+ /* Skip whitespace. */
+ while (rl_point < rl_end && whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]))
+ rl_point++;
+
+ /* Skip until whitespace. */
+ while (rl_point < rl_end && !whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]))
+ rl_point++;
+
+ /* Move back to the last character of the word. */
+ rl_point--;
+ }
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+
+int
+rl_vi_fword (count, ignore)
+ int count, ignore;
+{
+ while (count-- && rl_point < (rl_end - 1))
+ {
+ /* Move to white space (really non-identifer). */
+ if (_rl_isident (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]))
+ {
+ while (_rl_isident (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]) && rl_point < rl_end)
+ rl_point++;
+ }
+ else /* if (!whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point])) */
+ {
+ while (!_rl_isident (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]) &&
+ !whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]) && rl_point < rl_end)
+ rl_point++;
+ }
+
+ /* Move past whitespace. */
+ while (whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]) && rl_point < rl_end)
+ rl_point++;
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+
+int
+rl_vi_bword (count, ignore)
+ int count, ignore;
+{
+ while (count-- && rl_point > 0)
+ {
+ int last_is_ident;
+
+ /* If we are at the start of a word, move back to whitespace
+ so we will go back to the start of the previous word. */
+ if (!whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]) &&
+ whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point - 1]))
+ rl_point--;
+
+ /* If this character and the previous character are `opposite', move
+ back so we don't get messed up by the rl_point++ down there in
+ the while loop. Without this code, words like `l;' screw up the
+ function. */
+ last_is_ident = _rl_isident (rl_line_buffer[rl_point - 1]);
+ if ((_rl_isident (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]) && !last_is_ident) ||
+ (!_rl_isident (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]) && last_is_ident))
+ rl_point--;
+
+ while (rl_point > 0 && whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]))
+ rl_point--;
+
+ if (rl_point > 0)
+ {
+ if (_rl_isident (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]))
+ while (--rl_point >= 0 && _rl_isident (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]));
+ else
+ while (--rl_point >= 0 && !_rl_isident (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]) &&
+ !whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]));
+ rl_point++;
+ }
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+
+int
+rl_vi_eword (count, ignore)
+ int count, ignore;
+{
+ while (count-- && rl_point < rl_end - 1)
+ {
+ if (!whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]))
+ rl_point++;
+
+ while (rl_point < rl_end && whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]))
+ rl_point++;
+
+ if (rl_point < rl_end)
+ {
+ if (_rl_isident (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]))
+ while (++rl_point < rl_end && _rl_isident (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]));
+ else
+ while (++rl_point < rl_end && !_rl_isident (rl_line_buffer[rl_point])
+ && !whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]));
+ }
+ rl_point--;
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+
+int
+rl_vi_insert_beg (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ rl_beg_of_line (1, key);
+ rl_vi_insertion_mode (1, key);
+ return (0);
+}
+
+int
+rl_vi_append_mode (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ if (rl_point < rl_end)
+ {
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX == 1 || rl_byte_oriented)
+ rl_point++;
+ else
+ {
+ int point = rl_point;
+ rl_forward_char (1, key);
+ if (point == rl_point)
+ rl_point = rl_end;
+ }
+ }
+ rl_vi_insertion_mode (1, key);
+ return (0);
+}
+
+int
+rl_vi_append_eol (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ rl_end_of_line (1, key);
+ rl_vi_append_mode (1, key);
+ return (0);
+}
+
+/* What to do in the case of C-d. */
+int
+rl_vi_eof_maybe (count, c)
+ int count, c;
+{
+ return (rl_newline (1, '\n'));
+}
+
+/* Insertion mode stuff. */
+
+/* Switching from one mode to the other really just involves
+ switching keymaps. */
+int
+rl_vi_insertion_mode (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ _rl_keymap = vi_insertion_keymap;
+ _rl_vi_last_key_before_insert = key;
+ return (0);
+}
+
+static void
+_rl_vi_save_insert (up)
+ UNDO_LIST *up;
+{
+ int len, start, end;
+
+ if (up == 0)
+ {
+ if (vi_insert_buffer_size >= 1)
+ vi_insert_buffer[0] = '\0';
+ return;
+ }
+
+ start = up->start;
+ end = up->end;
+ len = end - start + 1;
+ if (len >= vi_insert_buffer_size)
+ {
+ vi_insert_buffer_size += (len + 32) - (len % 32);
+ vi_insert_buffer = (char *)xrealloc (vi_insert_buffer, vi_insert_buffer_size);
+ }
+ strncpy (vi_insert_buffer, rl_line_buffer + start, len - 1);
+ vi_insert_buffer[len-1] = '\0';
+}
+
+void
+_rl_vi_done_inserting ()
+{
+ if (_rl_vi_doing_insert)
+ {
+ /* The `C', `s', and `S' commands set this. */
+ rl_end_undo_group ();
+ /* Now, the text between rl_undo_list->next->start and
+ rl_undo_list->next->end is what was inserted while in insert
+ mode. It gets copied to VI_INSERT_BUFFER because it depends
+ on absolute indices into the line which may change (though they
+ probably will not). */
+ _rl_vi_doing_insert = 0;
+ _rl_vi_save_insert (rl_undo_list->next);
+ vi_continued_command = 1;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if ((_rl_vi_last_key_before_insert == 'i' || _rl_vi_last_key_before_insert == 'a') && rl_undo_list)
+ _rl_vi_save_insert (rl_undo_list);
+ /* XXX - Other keys probably need to be checked. */
+ else if (_rl_vi_last_key_before_insert == 'C')
+ rl_end_undo_group ();
+ while (_rl_undo_group_level > 0)
+ rl_end_undo_group ();
+ vi_continued_command = 0;
+ }
+}
+
+int
+rl_vi_movement_mode (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ if (rl_point > 0)
+ rl_backward_char (1, key);
+
+ _rl_keymap = vi_movement_keymap;
+ _rl_vi_done_inserting ();
+
+ /* This is how POSIX.2 says `U' should behave -- everything up until the
+ first time you go into command mode should not be undone. */
+ if (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_VICMDONCE) == 0)
+ rl_free_undo_list ();
+
+ RL_SETSTATE (RL_STATE_VICMDONCE);
+ return (0);
+}
+
+int
+rl_vi_arg_digit (count, c)
+ int count, c;
+{
+ if (c == '0' && rl_numeric_arg == 1 && !rl_explicit_arg)
+ return (rl_beg_of_line (1, c));
+ else
+ return (rl_digit_argument (count, c));
+}
+
+/* Change the case of the next COUNT characters. */
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+static int
+_rl_vi_change_mbchar_case (count)
+ int count;
+{
+ wchar_t wc;
+ char mb[MB_LEN_MAX+1];
+ int mblen, p;
+ mbstate_t ps;
+
+ memset (&ps, 0, sizeof (mbstate_t));
+ if (_rl_adjust_point (rl_line_buffer, rl_point, &ps) > 0)
+ count--;
+ while (count-- && rl_point < rl_end)
+ {
+ mbrtowc (&wc, rl_line_buffer + rl_point, rl_end - rl_point, &ps);
+ if (iswupper (wc))
+ wc = towlower (wc);
+ else if (iswlower (wc))
+ wc = towupper (wc);
+ else
+ {
+ /* Just skip over chars neither upper nor lower case */
+ rl_forward_char (1, 0);
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /* Vi is kind of strange here. */
+ if (wc)
+ {
+ p = rl_point;
+ mblen = wcrtomb (mb, wc, &ps);
+ if (mblen >= 0)
+ mb[mblen] = '\0';
+ rl_begin_undo_group ();
+ rl_vi_delete (1, 0);
+ if (rl_point < p) /* Did we retreat at EOL? */
+ rl_point++; /* XXX - should we advance more than 1 for mbchar? */
+ rl_insert_text (mb);
+ rl_end_undo_group ();
+ rl_vi_check ();
+ }
+ else
+ rl_forward_char (1, 0);
+ }
+
+ return 0;
+}
+#endif
+
+int
+rl_vi_change_case (count, ignore)
+ int count, ignore;
+{
+ int c, p;
+
+ /* Don't try this on an empty line. */
+ if (rl_point >= rl_end)
+ return (0);
+
+ c = 0;
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ return (_rl_vi_change_mbchar_case (count));
+#endif
+
+ while (count-- && rl_point < rl_end)
+ {
+ if (_rl_uppercase_p (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]))
+ c = _rl_to_lower (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]);
+ else if (_rl_lowercase_p (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]))
+ c = _rl_to_upper (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]);
+ else
+ {
+ /* Just skip over characters neither upper nor lower case. */
+ rl_forward_char (1, c);
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /* Vi is kind of strange here. */
+ if (c)
+ {
+ p = rl_point;
+ rl_begin_undo_group ();
+ rl_vi_delete (1, c);
+ if (rl_point < p) /* Did we retreat at EOL? */
+ rl_point++;
+ _rl_insert_char (1, c);
+ rl_end_undo_group ();
+ rl_vi_check ();
+ }
+ else
+ rl_forward_char (1, c);
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+
+int
+rl_vi_put (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ if (!_rl_uppercase_p (key) && (rl_point + 1 <= rl_end))
+ rl_point = _rl_find_next_mbchar (rl_line_buffer, rl_point, 1, MB_FIND_NONZERO);
+
+ while (count--)
+ rl_yank (1, key);
+
+ rl_backward_char (1, key);
+ return (0);
+}
+
+int
+rl_vi_check ()
+{
+ if (rl_point && rl_point == rl_end)
+ {
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ rl_point = _rl_find_prev_mbchar (rl_line_buffer, rl_point, MB_FIND_NONZERO);
+ else
+ rl_point--;
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+
+int
+rl_vi_column (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ if (count > rl_end)
+ rl_end_of_line (1, key);
+ else
+ rl_point = count - 1;
+ return (0);
+}
+
+int
+rl_vi_domove (key, nextkey)
+ int key, *nextkey;
+{
+ int c, save;
+ int old_end;
+
+ rl_mark = rl_point;
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+ c = rl_read_key ();
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+ *nextkey = c;
+
+ if (!member (c, vi_motion))
+ {
+ if (_rl_digit_p (c))
+ {
+ save = rl_numeric_arg;
+ rl_numeric_arg = _rl_digit_value (c);
+ rl_explicit_arg = 1;
+ RL_SETSTATE (RL_STATE_NUMERICARG|RL_STATE_VIMOTION);
+ rl_digit_loop1 ();
+ RL_UNSETSTATE (RL_STATE_VIMOTION);
+ rl_numeric_arg *= save;
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+ c = rl_read_key (); /* real command */
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+ *nextkey = c;
+ }
+ else if (key == c && (key == 'd' || key == 'y' || key == 'c'))
+ {
+ rl_mark = rl_end;
+ rl_beg_of_line (1, c);
+ _rl_vi_last_motion = c;
+ return (0);
+ }
+ else
+ return (-1);
+ }
+
+ _rl_vi_last_motion = c;
+
+ /* Append a blank character temporarily so that the motion routines
+ work right at the end of the line. */
+ old_end = rl_end;
+ rl_line_buffer[rl_end++] = ' ';
+ rl_line_buffer[rl_end] = '\0';
+
+ _rl_dispatch (c, _rl_keymap);
+
+ /* Remove the blank that we added. */
+ rl_end = old_end;
+ rl_line_buffer[rl_end] = '\0';
+ if (rl_point > rl_end)
+ rl_point = rl_end;
+
+ /* No change in position means the command failed. */
+ if (rl_mark == rl_point)
+ return (-1);
+
+ /* rl_vi_f[wW]ord () leaves the cursor on the first character of the next
+ word. If we are not at the end of the line, and we are on a
+ non-whitespace character, move back one (presumably to whitespace). */
+ if ((_rl_to_upper (c) == 'W') && rl_point < rl_end && rl_point > rl_mark &&
+ !whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]))
+ rl_point--;
+
+ /* If cw or cW, back up to the end of a word, so the behaviour of ce
+ or cE is the actual result. Brute-force, no subtlety. */
+ if (key == 'c' && rl_point >= rl_mark && (_rl_to_upper (c) == 'W'))
+ {
+ /* Don't move farther back than where we started. */
+ while (rl_point > rl_mark && whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]))
+ rl_point--;
+
+ /* Posix.2 says that if cw or cW moves the cursor towards the end of
+ the line, the character under the cursor should be deleted. */
+ if (rl_point == rl_mark)
+ rl_point++;
+ else
+ {
+ /* Move past the end of the word so that the kill doesn't
+ remove the last letter of the previous word. Only do this
+ if we are not at the end of the line. */
+ if (rl_point >= 0 && rl_point < (rl_end - 1) && !whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]))
+ rl_point++;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (rl_mark < rl_point)
+ SWAP (rl_point, rl_mark);
+
+ return (0);
+}
+
+/* Process C as part of the current numeric argument. Return -1 if the
+ argument should be aborted, 0 if we should not read any more chars, and
+ 1 if we should continue to read chars. */
+static int
+_rl_vi_arg_dispatch (c)
+ int c;
+{
+ int key;
+
+ key = c;
+ if (c >= 0 && _rl_keymap[c].type == ISFUNC && _rl_keymap[c].function == rl_universal_argument)
+ {
+ rl_numeric_arg *= 4;
+ return 1;
+ }
+
+ c = UNMETA (c);
+
+ if (_rl_digit_p (c))
+ {
+ if (rl_explicit_arg)
+ rl_numeric_arg = (rl_numeric_arg * 10) + _rl_digit_value (c);
+ else
+ rl_numeric_arg = _rl_digit_value (c);
+ rl_explicit_arg = 1;
+ return 1;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ rl_clear_message ();
+ rl_stuff_char (key);
+ return 0;
+ }
+}
+
+/* A simplified loop for vi. Don't dispatch key at end.
+ Don't recognize minus sign?
+ Should this do rl_save_prompt/rl_restore_prompt? */
+static int
+rl_digit_loop1 ()
+{
+ int c, r;
+
+ while (1)
+ {
+ if (_rl_arg_overflow ())
+ return 1;
+
+ c = _rl_arg_getchar ();
+
+ r = _rl_vi_arg_dispatch (c);
+ if (r <= 0)
+ break;
+ }
+
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_NUMERICARG);
+ return (0);
+}
+
+int
+rl_vi_delete_to (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ int c;
+
+ if (_rl_uppercase_p (key))
+ rl_stuff_char ('$');
+ else if (vi_redoing)
+ rl_stuff_char (_rl_vi_last_motion);
+
+ if (rl_vi_domove (key, &c))
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ /* These are the motion commands that do not require adjusting the
+ mark. */
+ if ((strchr (" l|h^0bB", c) == 0) && (rl_mark < rl_end))
+ rl_mark++;
+
+ rl_kill_text (rl_point, rl_mark);
+ return (0);
+}
+
+int
+rl_vi_change_to (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ int c, start_pos;
+
+ if (_rl_uppercase_p (key))
+ rl_stuff_char ('$');
+ else if (vi_redoing)
+ rl_stuff_char (_rl_vi_last_motion);
+
+ start_pos = rl_point;
+
+ if (rl_vi_domove (key, &c))
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ /* These are the motion commands that do not require adjusting the
+ mark. c[wW] are handled by special-case code in rl_vi_domove(),
+ and already leave the mark at the correct location. */
+ if ((strchr (" l|hwW^0bB", c) == 0) && (rl_mark < rl_end))
+ rl_mark++;
+
+ /* The cursor never moves with c[wW]. */
+ if ((_rl_to_upper (c) == 'W') && rl_point < start_pos)
+ rl_point = start_pos;
+
+ if (vi_redoing)
+ {
+ if (vi_insert_buffer && *vi_insert_buffer)
+ rl_begin_undo_group ();
+ rl_delete_text (rl_point, rl_mark);
+ if (vi_insert_buffer && *vi_insert_buffer)
+ {
+ rl_insert_text (vi_insert_buffer);
+ rl_end_undo_group ();
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ rl_begin_undo_group (); /* to make the `u' command work */
+ rl_kill_text (rl_point, rl_mark);
+ /* `C' does not save the text inserted for undoing or redoing. */
+ if (_rl_uppercase_p (key) == 0)
+ _rl_vi_doing_insert = 1;
+ rl_vi_start_inserting (key, rl_numeric_arg, rl_arg_sign);
+ }
+
+ return (0);
+}
+
+int
+rl_vi_yank_to (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ int c, save;
+
+ save = rl_point;
+ if (_rl_uppercase_p (key))
+ rl_stuff_char ('$');
+
+ if (rl_vi_domove (key, &c))
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ /* These are the motion commands that do not require adjusting the
+ mark. */
+ if ((strchr (" l|h^0%bB", c) == 0) && (rl_mark < rl_end))
+ rl_mark++;
+
+ rl_begin_undo_group ();
+ rl_kill_text (rl_point, rl_mark);
+ rl_end_undo_group ();
+ rl_do_undo ();
+ rl_point = save;
+
+ return (0);
+}
+
+int
+rl_vi_rubout (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ int p, opoint;
+
+ if (count < 0)
+ return (rl_vi_delete (-count, key));
+
+ if (rl_point == 0)
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ opoint = rl_point;
+ if (count > 1 && MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ rl_backward_char (count, key);
+ else if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ rl_point = _rl_find_prev_mbchar (rl_line_buffer, rl_point, MB_FIND_NONZERO);
+ else
+ rl_point -= count;
+
+ if (rl_point < 0)
+ rl_point = 0;
+
+ rl_kill_text (rl_point, opoint);
+
+ return (0);
+}
+
+int
+rl_vi_delete (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ int end;
+
+ if (count < 0)
+ return (rl_vi_rubout (-count, key));
+
+ if (rl_end == 0)
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ end = _rl_find_next_mbchar (rl_line_buffer, rl_point, count, MB_FIND_NONZERO);
+ else
+ end = rl_point + count;
+
+ if (end >= rl_end)
+ end = rl_end;
+
+ rl_kill_text (rl_point, end);
+
+ if (rl_point > 0 && rl_point == rl_end)
+ rl_backward_char (1, key);
+
+ return (0);
+}
+
+int
+rl_vi_back_to_indent (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ rl_beg_of_line (1, key);
+ while (rl_point < rl_end && whitespace (rl_line_buffer[rl_point]))
+ rl_point++;
+ return (0);
+}
+
+int
+rl_vi_first_print (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ return (rl_vi_back_to_indent (1, key));
+}
+
+static int _rl_cs_dir, _rl_cs_orig_dir;
+
+#if defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+static int
+_rl_vi_callback_char_search (data)
+ _rl_callback_generic_arg *data;
+{
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ _rl_vi_last_search_mblen = _rl_read_mbchar (_rl_vi_last_search_mbchar, MB_LEN_MAX);
+#else
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+ _rl_vi_last_search_char = rl_read_key ();
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+#endif
+
+ _rl_callback_func = 0;
+ _rl_want_redisplay = 1;
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ return (_rl_char_search_internal (data->count, _rl_cs_dir, _rl_vi_last_search_mbchar, _rl_vi_last_search_mblen));
+#else
+ return (_rl_char_search_internal (data->count, _rl_cs_dir, _rl_vi_last_search_char));
+#endif
+}
+#endif
+
+int
+rl_vi_char_search (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ static char *target;
+ static int tlen;
+#else
+ static char target;
+#endif
+
+ if (key == ';' || key == ',')
+ _rl_cs_dir = (key == ';') ? _rl_cs_orig_dir : -_rl_cs_orig_dir;
+ else
+ {
+ switch (key)
+ {
+ case 't':
+ _rl_cs_orig_dir = _rl_cs_dir = FTO;
+ break;
+
+ case 'T':
+ _rl_cs_orig_dir = _rl_cs_dir = BTO;
+ break;
+
+ case 'f':
+ _rl_cs_orig_dir = _rl_cs_dir = FFIND;
+ break;
+
+ case 'F':
+ _rl_cs_orig_dir = _rl_cs_dir = BFIND;
+ break;
+ }
+
+ if (vi_redoing)
+ {
+ /* set target and tlen below */
+ }
+#if defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+ else if (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_CALLBACK))
+ {
+ _rl_callback_data = _rl_callback_data_alloc (count);
+ _rl_callback_data->i1 = _rl_cs_dir;
+ _rl_callback_func = _rl_vi_callback_char_search;
+ return (0);
+ }
+#endif
+ else
+ {
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ _rl_vi_last_search_mblen = _rl_read_mbchar (_rl_vi_last_search_mbchar, MB_LEN_MAX);
+#else
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+ _rl_vi_last_search_char = rl_read_key ();
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+#endif
+ }
+ }
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ target = _rl_vi_last_search_mbchar;
+ tlen = _rl_vi_last_search_mblen;
+#else
+ target = _rl_vi_last_search_char;
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ return (_rl_char_search_internal (count, _rl_cs_dir, target, tlen));
+#else
+ return (_rl_char_search_internal (count, _rl_cs_dir, target));
+#endif
+}
+
+/* Match brackets */
+int
+rl_vi_match (ignore, key)
+ int ignore, key;
+{
+ int count = 1, brack, pos, tmp, pre;
+
+ pos = rl_point;
+ if ((brack = rl_vi_bracktype (rl_line_buffer[rl_point])) == 0)
+ {
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ {
+ while ((brack = rl_vi_bracktype (rl_line_buffer[rl_point])) == 0)
+ {
+ pre = rl_point;
+ rl_forward_char (1, key);
+ if (pre == rl_point)
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ while ((brack = rl_vi_bracktype (rl_line_buffer[rl_point])) == 0 &&
+ rl_point < rl_end - 1)
+ rl_forward_char (1, key);
+
+ if (brack <= 0)
+ {
+ rl_point = pos;
+ rl_ding ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+ }
+
+ pos = rl_point;
+
+ if (brack < 0)
+ {
+ while (count)
+ {
+ tmp = pos;
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX == 1 || rl_byte_oriented)
+ pos--;
+ else
+ {
+ pos = _rl_find_prev_mbchar (rl_line_buffer, pos, MB_FIND_ANY);
+ if (tmp == pos)
+ pos--;
+ }
+ if (pos >= 0)
+ {
+ int b = rl_vi_bracktype (rl_line_buffer[pos]);
+ if (b == -brack)
+ count--;
+ else if (b == brack)
+ count++;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ { /* brack > 0 */
+ while (count)
+ {
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX == 1 || rl_byte_oriented)
+ pos++;
+ else
+ pos = _rl_find_next_mbchar (rl_line_buffer, pos, 1, MB_FIND_ANY);
+
+ if (pos < rl_end)
+ {
+ int b = rl_vi_bracktype (rl_line_buffer[pos]);
+ if (b == -brack)
+ count--;
+ else if (b == brack)
+ count++;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ rl_point = pos;
+ return (0);
+}
+
+int
+rl_vi_bracktype (c)
+ int c;
+{
+ switch (c)
+ {
+ case '(': return 1;
+ case ')': return -1;
+ case '[': return 2;
+ case ']': return -2;
+ case '{': return 3;
+ case '}': return -3;
+ default: return 0;
+ }
+}
+
+static int
+_rl_vi_change_char (count, c, mb)
+ int count, c;
+ char *mb;
+{
+ int p;
+
+ if (c == '\033' || c == CTRL ('C'))
+ return -1;
+
+ rl_begin_undo_group ();
+ while (count-- && rl_point < rl_end)
+ {
+ p = rl_point;
+ rl_vi_delete (1, c);
+ if (rl_point < p) /* Did we retreat at EOL? */
+ rl_point++;
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ rl_insert_text (mb);
+ else
+#endif
+ _rl_insert_char (1, c);
+ }
+
+ /* The cursor shall be left on the last character changed. */
+ rl_backward_char (1, c);
+
+ rl_end_undo_group ();
+
+ return (0);
+}
+
+static int
+_rl_vi_callback_getchar (mb, mblen)
+ char *mb;
+ int mblen;
+{
+ int c;
+
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+ c = rl_read_key ();
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+
+#if defined (HANDLE_MULTIBYTE)
+ if (MB_CUR_MAX > 1 && rl_byte_oriented == 0)
+ c = _rl_read_mbstring (c, mb, mblen);
+#endif
+
+ return c;
+}
+
+#if defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+static int
+_rl_vi_callback_change_char (data)
+ _rl_callback_generic_arg *data;
+{
+ int c;
+ char mb[MB_LEN_MAX];
+
+ _rl_vi_last_replacement = c = _rl_vi_callback_getchar (mb, MB_LEN_MAX);
+
+ _rl_callback_func = 0;
+ _rl_want_redisplay = 1;
+
+ return (_rl_vi_change_char (data->count, c, mb));
+}
+#endif
+
+int
+rl_vi_change_char (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ int c;
+ char mb[MB_LEN_MAX];
+
+ if (vi_redoing)
+ {
+ c = _rl_vi_last_replacement;
+ mb[0] = c;
+ mb[1] = '\0';
+ }
+#if defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+ else if (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_CALLBACK))
+ {
+ _rl_callback_data = _rl_callback_data_alloc (count);
+ _rl_callback_func = _rl_vi_callback_change_char;
+ return (0);
+ }
+#endif
+ else
+ _rl_vi_last_replacement = c = _rl_vi_callback_getchar (mb, MB_LEN_MAX);
+
+ return (_rl_vi_change_char (count, c, mb));
+}
+
+int
+rl_vi_subst (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ /* If we are redoing, rl_vi_change_to will stuff the last motion char */
+ if (vi_redoing == 0)
+ rl_stuff_char ((key == 'S') ? 'c' : 'l'); /* `S' == `cc', `s' == `cl' */
+
+ return (rl_vi_change_to (count, 'c'));
+}
+
+int
+rl_vi_overstrike (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ if (_rl_vi_doing_insert == 0)
+ {
+ _rl_vi_doing_insert = 1;
+ rl_begin_undo_group ();
+ }
+
+ if (count > 0)
+ {
+ _rl_overwrite_char (count, key);
+ vi_replace_count += count;
+ }
+
+ return (0);
+}
+
+int
+rl_vi_overstrike_delete (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ int i, s;
+
+ for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
+ {
+ if (vi_replace_count == 0)
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ break;
+ }
+ s = rl_point;
+
+ if (rl_do_undo ())
+ vi_replace_count--;
+
+ if (rl_point == s)
+ rl_backward_char (1, key);
+ }
+
+ if (vi_replace_count == 0 && _rl_vi_doing_insert)
+ {
+ rl_end_undo_group ();
+ rl_do_undo ();
+ _rl_vi_doing_insert = 0;
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+
+int
+rl_vi_replace (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+ int i;
+
+ vi_replace_count = 0;
+
+ if (!vi_replace_map)
+ {
+ vi_replace_map = rl_make_bare_keymap ();
+
+ for (i = ' '; i < KEYMAP_SIZE; i++)
+ vi_replace_map[i].function = rl_vi_overstrike;
+
+ vi_replace_map[RUBOUT].function = rl_vi_overstrike_delete;
+ vi_replace_map[ESC].function = rl_vi_movement_mode;
+ vi_replace_map[RETURN].function = rl_newline;
+ vi_replace_map[NEWLINE].function = rl_newline;
+
+ /* If the normal vi insertion keymap has ^H bound to erase, do the
+ same here. Probably should remove the assignment to RUBOUT up
+ there, but I don't think it will make a difference in real life. */
+ if (vi_insertion_keymap[CTRL ('H')].type == ISFUNC &&
+ vi_insertion_keymap[CTRL ('H')].function == rl_rubout)
+ vi_replace_map[CTRL ('H')].function = rl_vi_overstrike_delete;
+
+ }
+ _rl_keymap = vi_replace_map;
+ return (0);
+}
+
+#if 0
+/* Try to complete the word we are standing on or the word that ends with
+ the previous character. A space matches everything. Word delimiters are
+ space and ;. */
+int
+rl_vi_possible_completions()
+{
+ int save_pos = rl_point;
+
+ if (rl_line_buffer[rl_point] != ' ' && rl_line_buffer[rl_point] != ';')
+ {
+ while (rl_point < rl_end && rl_line_buffer[rl_point] != ' ' &&
+ rl_line_buffer[rl_point] != ';')
+ rl_point++;
+ }
+ else if (rl_line_buffer[rl_point - 1] == ';')
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ return (0);
+ }
+
+ rl_possible_completions ();
+ rl_point = save_pos;
+
+ return (0);
+}
+#endif
+
+/* Functions to save and restore marks. */
+static int
+_rl_vi_set_mark ()
+{
+ int ch;
+
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+ ch = rl_read_key ();
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+
+ if (ch < 'a' || ch > 'z')
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+ ch -= 'a';
+ vi_mark_chars[ch] = rl_point;
+ return 0;
+}
+
+#if defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+static int
+_rl_vi_callback_set_mark (data)
+ _rl_callback_generic_arg *data;
+{
+ _rl_callback_func = 0;
+ _rl_want_redisplay = 1;
+
+ return (_rl_vi_set_mark ());
+}
+#endif
+
+int
+rl_vi_set_mark (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+#if defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+ if (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_CALLBACK))
+ {
+ _rl_callback_data = 0;
+ _rl_callback_func = _rl_vi_callback_set_mark;
+ return (0);
+ }
+#endif
+
+ return (_rl_vi_set_mark ());
+}
+
+static int
+_rl_vi_goto_mark ()
+{
+ int ch;
+
+ RL_SETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+ ch = rl_read_key ();
+ RL_UNSETSTATE(RL_STATE_MOREINPUT);
+
+ if (ch == '`')
+ {
+ rl_point = rl_mark;
+ return 0;
+ }
+ else if (ch < 'a' || ch > 'z')
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ ch -= 'a';
+ if (vi_mark_chars[ch] == -1)
+ {
+ rl_ding ();
+ return -1;
+ }
+ rl_point = vi_mark_chars[ch];
+ return 0;
+}
+
+#if defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+static int
+_rl_vi_callback_goto_mark (data)
+ _rl_callback_generic_arg *data;
+{
+ _rl_callback_func = 0;
+ _rl_want_redisplay = 1;
+
+ return (_rl_vi_goto_mark ());
+}
+#endif
+
+int
+rl_vi_goto_mark (count, key)
+ int count, key;
+{
+#if defined (READLINE_CALLBACKS)
+ if (RL_ISSTATE (RL_STATE_CALLBACK))
+ {
+ _rl_callback_data = 0;
+ _rl_callback_func = _rl_vi_callback_goto_mark;
+ return (0);
+ }
+#endif
+
+ return (_rl_vi_goto_mark ());
+}
+#endif /* VI_MODE */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/xmalloc.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/xmalloc.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..8985d34
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/xmalloc.c
@@ -0,0 +1,88 @@
+/* xmalloc.c -- safe versions of malloc and realloc */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Readline, a library for reading lines
+ of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ Readline is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the
+ Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any
+ later version.
+
+ Readline is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
+ WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with Readline; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
+ Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+#define READLINE_LIBRARY
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+#include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STDLIB_H)
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif /* HAVE_STDLIB_H */
+
+#include "xmalloc.h"
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Memory Allocation and Deallocation. */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+static void
+memory_error_and_abort (fname)
+ char *fname;
+{
+ fprintf (stderr, "%s: out of virtual memory\n", fname);
+ exit (2);
+}
+
+/* Return a pointer to free()able block of memory large enough
+ to hold BYTES number of bytes. If the memory cannot be allocated,
+ print an error message and abort. */
+PTR_T
+xmalloc (bytes)
+ size_t bytes;
+{
+ PTR_T temp;
+
+ temp = malloc (bytes);
+ if (temp == 0)
+ memory_error_and_abort ("xmalloc");
+ return (temp);
+}
+
+PTR_T
+xrealloc (pointer, bytes)
+ PTR_T pointer;
+ size_t bytes;
+{
+ PTR_T temp;
+
+ temp = pointer ? realloc (pointer, bytes) : malloc (bytes);
+
+ if (temp == 0)
+ memory_error_and_abort ("xrealloc");
+ return (temp);
+}
+
+/* Use this as the function to call when adding unwind protects so we
+ don't need to know what free() returns. */
+void
+xfree (string)
+ PTR_T string;
+{
+ if (string)
+ free (string);
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/xmalloc.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/xmalloc.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9cb08ba
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/readline/xmalloc.h
@@ -0,0 +1,46 @@
+/* xmalloc.h -- memory allocation that aborts on errors. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Readline Library, a library for
+ reading lines of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Readline Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#if !defined (_XMALLOC_H_)
+#define _XMALLOC_H_
+
+#if defined (READLINE_LIBRARY)
+# include "rlstdc.h"
+#else
+# include <readline/rlstdc.h>
+#endif
+
+#ifndef PTR_T
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+# define PTR_T void *
+#else
+# define PTR_T char *
+#endif
+
+#endif /* !PTR_T */
+
+extern PTR_T xmalloc PARAMS((size_t));
+extern PTR_T xrealloc PARAMS((void *, size_t));
+extern void xfree PARAMS((void *));
+
+#endif /* _XMALLOC_H_ */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/Makefile.in b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/Makefile.in
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..32e2b31
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/Makefile.in
@@ -0,0 +1,455 @@
+#
+# Makefile for the Bash library
+#
+#
+# Copyright (C) 1998-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+# any later version.
+
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+# GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA.
+
+PACKAGE = @PACKAGE_NAME@
+VERSION = @PACKAGE_VERSION@
+
+PACKAGE_BUGREPORT = @PACKAGE_BUGREPORT@
+PACKAGE_NAME = @PACKAGE_NAME@
+PACKAGE_STRING = @PACKAGE_STRING@
+PACKAGE_VERSION = @PACKAGE_VERSION@
+
+srcdir = @srcdir@
+VPATH = .:@srcdir@
+topdir = @top_srcdir@
+BUILD_DIR = @BUILD_DIR@
+
+LIBBUILD = ${BUILD_DIR}/lib
+
+BASHINCDIR = ${topdir}/include
+
+INTL_LIBSRC = ${topdir}/lib/intl
+INTL_BUILDDIR = ${LIBBUILD}/intl
+INTL_INC = @INTL_INC@
+LIBINTL_H = @LIBINTL_H@
+
+INSTALL = @INSTALL@
+INSTALL_PROGRAM = @INSTALL_PROGRAM@
+INSTALL_DATA = @INSTALL_DATA@
+
+CC = @CC@
+RANLIB = @RANLIB@
+AR = @AR@
+ARFLAGS = @ARFLAGS@
+RM = rm -f
+CP = cp
+MV = mv
+
+SHELL = @MAKE_SHELL@
+
+CFLAGS = @CFLAGS@
+LOCAL_CFLAGS = @LOCAL_CFLAGS@ ${DEBUG}
+CPPFLAGS = @CPPFLAGS@
+LDFLAGS = @LDFLAGS@ @LOCAL_LDFLAGS@
+
+PROFILE_FLAGS = @PROFILE_FLAGS@
+
+DEFS = @DEFS@
+LOCAL_DEFS = @LOCAL_DEFS@
+
+INCLUDES = -I. -I../.. -I$(topdir) -I$(topdir)/lib -I$(BASHINCDIR) -I$(srcdir) $(INTL_INC)
+
+CCFLAGS = ${PROFILE_FLAGS} ${INCLUDES} $(DEFS) $(LOCAL_DEFS) $(LOCAL_CFLAGS) \
+ $(CFLAGS) $(CPPFLAGS)
+
+GCC_LINT_FLAGS = -Wall -Wshadow -Wpointer-arith -Wcast-qual \
+ -Wcast-align -Wstrict-prototypes -Wconversion \
+ -Wmissing-prototypes -Wtraditional -Wredundant-decls -pedantic
+
+.c.o:
+ $(CC) -c $(CCFLAGS) $<
+
+# The name of the library target.
+LIBRARY_NAME = libsh.a
+
+# The C code source files for this library.
+CSOURCES = clktck.c clock.c getcwd.c getenv.c oslib.c setlinebuf.c \
+ strcasecmp.c strerror.c strtod.c strtol.c strtoul.c \
+ vprint.c itos.c rename.c zread.c zwrite.c shtty.c \
+ inet_aton.c netconn.c netopen.c strpbrk.c timeval.c makepath.c \
+ pathcanon.c pathphys.c tmpfile.c stringlist.c stringvec.c spell.c \
+ shquote.c strtrans.c strindex.c snprintf.c mailstat.c \
+ fmtulong.c fmtullong.c fmtumax.c shmatch.c strnlen.c \
+ strtoll.c strtoull.c strtoimax.c strtoumax.c memset.c strstr.c \
+ mktime.c strftime.c xstrchr.c zcatfd.c winsize.c
+
+# The header files for this library.
+HSOURCES =
+
+# The object files contained in $(LIBRARY_NAME)
+LIBOBJS = @LIBOBJS@
+OBJECTS = clktck.o clock.o getenv.o oslib.o setlinebuf.o strnlen.o \
+ itos.o zread.o zwrite.o shtty.o shmatch.o \
+ netconn.o netopen.o timeval.o makepath.o pathcanon.o \
+ pathphys.o tmpfile.o stringlist.o stringvec.o spell.o shquote.o \
+ strtrans.o strindex.o snprintf.o mailstat.o fmtulong.o \
+ fmtullong.o fmtumax.o xstrchr.o zcatfd.o winsize.o ${LIBOBJS}
+
+SUPPORT = Makefile
+
+all: $(LIBRARY_NAME)
+
+$(LIBRARY_NAME): $(OBJECTS)
+ $(RM) $@
+ $(AR) $(ARFLAGS) $@ $(OBJECTS)
+ -test -n "$(RANLIB)" && $(RANLIB) $@
+
+force:
+
+# The rule for 'includes' is written funny so that the if statement
+# always returns TRUE unless there really was an error installing the
+# include files.
+install:
+
+clean:
+ $(RM) $(OBJECTS) $(LIBRARY_NAME)
+
+realclean distclean maintainer-clean: clean
+ $(RM) Makefile
+
+mostlyclean: clean
+
+# Dependencies
+
+${BUILD_DIR}/version.h: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h ${BUILD_DIR}/Makefile Makefile
+ -( cd ${BUILD_DIR} && ${MAKE} ${MFLAGS} version.h )
+
+# rules for losing makes, like SunOS
+clktck.o: clktck.c
+clock.o: clock.c
+fmtullong.o: fmtullong.c
+fmtulong.o: fmtulong.c
+fmtumax.o: fmtumax.c
+getcwd.o: getcwd.c
+getenv.o: getenv.c
+inet_aton.o: inet_aton.c
+itos.o: itos.c
+mailstat.o: mailstat.c
+makepath.o: makepath.c
+memset.o: memset.c
+mktime.o: mktime.c
+netconn.o: netconn.c
+netopen.o: netopen.c
+oslib.o: oslib.c
+pathcanon.o: pathcanon.c
+pathphys.o: pathphys.c
+rename.o: rename.c
+setlinebuf.o: setlinebuf.c
+shquote.o: shquote.c
+shtty.o: shtty.c
+snprintf.o: snprintf.c
+spell.o: spell.c
+strcasecmp.o: strcasecmp.c
+strerror.o: strerror.c
+strftime.o: strftime.c
+strindex.o: strindex.c
+stringlist.o: stringlist.c
+stringvec.o: stringvec.c
+strnlen.o: strnlen.c
+strpbrk.o: strpbrk.c
+strtod.o: strtod.c
+strtoimax.o: strtoimax.c
+strtol.o: strtol.c
+strtoll.o: strtoll.c
+strtoul.o: strtoul.c
+strtoull.o: strtoull.c
+strtoumax.o: strtoumax.c
+strtrans.o: strtrans.c
+times.o: times.c
+timeval.o: timeval.c
+tmpfile.o: tmpfile.c
+vprint.o: vprint.c
+xstrchr.o: xstrchr.c
+zcatfd.o: zcatfd.c
+zread.o: zread.c
+zwrite.o: zwrite.c
+
+# dependencies for c files that include other c files
+fmtullong.o: fmtulong.c
+fmtumax.o: fmtulong.c
+strtoll.o: strtol.c
+strtoul.o: strtol.c
+strtoull.o: strtol.c
+
+# all files in the library depend on config.h
+clktck.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+clock.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+fmtullong.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+fmtulong.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+fmtumax.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+getcwd.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+getenv.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+inet_aton.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+itos.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+mailstat.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+makepath.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+memset.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+mktime.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+netconn.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+netopen.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+oslib.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+pathcanon.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+pathphys.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+rename.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+setlinebuf.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+shquote.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+shtty.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+snprintf.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+spell.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+strcasecmp.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+strerror.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+strftime.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+strindex.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+stringlist.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+stringvec.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+strnlen.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+strpbrk.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+strtod.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+strtoimax.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+strtol.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+strtoll.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+strtoul.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+strtoull.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+strtoumax.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+strtrans.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+times.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+timeval.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+tmpfile.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+vprint.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+xstrchr.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+zcatfd.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+zread.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+zwrite.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/config.h
+
+clktck.o: ${topdir}/bashtypes.h
+
+getcwd.o: ${topdir}/bashtypes.h ${topdir}/bashansi.h ${BASHINCDIR}/maxpath.h
+getcwd.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/posixstat.h ${BASHINCDIR}/posixdir.h
+getcwd.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/memalloc.h ${BASHINCDIR}/ansi_stdlib.h
+
+getenv.o: ${topdir}/bashansi.h ${BASHINCDIR}/ansi_stdlib.h
+getenv.o: ${topdir}/shell.h ${topdir}/syntax.h ${topdir}/bashjmp.h ${BASHINCDIR}/posixjmp.h
+getenv.o: ${topdir}/command.h ${BASHINCDIR}/stdc.h ${topdir}/error.h
+getenv.o: ${topdir}/general.h ${topdir}/bashtypes.h ${topdir}/variables.h ${topdir}/conftypes.h
+getenv.o: ${topdir}/array.h ${topdir}/hashlib.h ${topdir}/quit.h
+getenv.o: ${topdir}/unwind_prot.h ${topdir}/dispose_cmd.h
+getenv.o: ${topdir}/make_cmd.h ${topdir}/subst.h ${topdir}/sig.h
+getenv.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/pathnames.h ${topdir}/externs.h
+getenv.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/version.h
+
+inet_aton.o: ${topdir}/bashansi.h ${BASHINCDIR}/ansi_stdlib.h
+inet_aton.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/stdc.h
+
+itos.o: ${topdir}/bashansi.h ${BASHINCDIR}/ansi_stdlib.h
+itos.o: ${topdir}/shell.h ${topdir}/syntax.h ${topdir}/bashjmp.h ${BASHINCDIR}/posixjmp.h
+itos.o: ${topdir}/command.h ${BASHINCDIR}/stdc.h ${topdir}/error.h
+itos.o: ${topdir}/general.h ${topdir}/bashtypes.h ${topdir}/variables.h ${topdir}/conftypes.h
+itos.o: ${topdir}/array.h ${topdir}/hashlib.h ${topdir}/quit.h
+itos.o: ${topdir}/unwind_prot.h ${topdir}/dispose_cmd.h
+itos.o: ${topdir}/make_cmd.h ${topdir}/subst.h ${topdir}/sig.h
+itos.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/pathnames.h ${topdir}/externs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/version.h
+
+makepath.o: ${topdir}/bashansi.h ${BASHINCDIR}/ansi_stdlib.h
+makepath.o: ${topdir}/shell.h ${topdir}/syntax.h ${topdir}/bashjmp.h ${BASHINCDIR}/posixjmp.h
+makepath.o: ${topdir}/command.h ${BASHINCDIR}/stdc.h ${topdir}/error.h
+makepath.o: ${topdir}/general.h ${topdir}/bashtypes.h ${topdir}/variables.h ${topdir}/conftypes.h
+makepath.o: ${topdir}/array.h ${topdir}/hashlib.h ${topdir}/quit.h
+makepath.o: ${topdir}/unwind_prot.h ${topdir}/dispose_cmd.h
+makepath.o: ${topdir}/make_cmd.h ${topdir}/subst.h ${topdir}/sig.h
+makepath.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/pathnames.h ${topdir}/externs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/version.h
+
+netconn.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/posixstat.h ${BASHINCDIR}/filecntl.h
+netconn.o: ${topdir}/bashtypes.h
+
+netopen.o: ${topdir}/bashansi.h ${BASHINCDIR}/ansi_stdlib.h ${topdir}/xmalloc.h
+netopen.o: ${topdir}/shell.h ${topdir}/syntax.h ${topdir}/bashjmp.h ${BASHINCDIR}/posixjmp.h
+netopen.o: ${topdir}/command.h ${BASHINCDIR}/stdc.h ${topdir}/error.h
+netopen.o: ${topdir}/general.h ${topdir}/bashtypes.h ${topdir}/variables.h ${topdir}/conftypes.h
+netopen.o: ${topdir}/array.h ${topdir}/hashlib.h ${topdir}/quit.h
+netopen.o: ${topdir}/unwind_prot.h ${topdir}/dispose_cmd.h
+netopen.o: ${topdir}/make_cmd.h ${topdir}/subst.h ${topdir}/sig.h
+netopen.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/pathnames.h ${topdir}/externs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/version.h
+netopen.o: ${topdir}/bashintl.h ${LIBINTL_H} $(BASHINCDIR)/gettext.h
+
+oslib.o: ${topdir}/bashtypes.h ${topdir}/bashansi.h ${BASHINCDIR}/maxpath.h
+oslib.o: ${topdir}/shell.h ${topdir}/syntax.h ${topdir}/bashjmp.h ${BASHINCDIR}/posixjmp.h
+oslib.o: ${topdir}/command.h ${BASHINCDIR}/stdc.h ${topdir}/error.h
+oslib.o: ${topdir}/general.h ${topdir}/bashtypes.h ${topdir}/variables.h ${topdir}/conftypes.h
+oslib.o: ${topdir}/array.h ${topdir}/hashlib.h ${topdir}/quit.h
+oslib.o: ${topdir}/unwind_prot.h ${topdir}/dispose_cmd.h
+oslib.o: ${topdir}/make_cmd.h ${topdir}/subst.h ${topdir}/sig.h
+oslib.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/pathnames.h ${topdir}/externs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/version.h
+oslib.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/posixstat.h ${BASHINCDIR}/filecntl.h
+oslib.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/ansi_stdlib.h ${BASHINCDIR}/chartypes.h
+
+pathcanon.o: ${topdir}/bashtypes.h ${topdir}/bashansi.h ${BASHINCDIR}/maxpath.h
+pathcanon.o: ${topdir}/shell.h ${topdir}/syntax.h ${topdir}/bashjmp.h ${BASHINCDIR}/posixjmp.h
+pathcanon.o: ${topdir}/command.h ${BASHINCDIR}/stdc.h ${topdir}/error.h
+pathcanon.o: ${topdir}/general.h ${topdir}/bashtypes.h ${topdir}/variables.h ${topdir}/conftypes.h
+pathcanon.o: ${topdir}/array.h ${topdir}/hashlib.h ${topdir}/quit.h
+pathcanon.o: ${topdir}/unwind_prot.h ${topdir}/dispose_cmd.h
+pathcanon.o: ${topdir}/make_cmd.h ${topdir}/subst.h ${topdir}/sig.h
+pathcanon.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/pathnames.h ${topdir}/externs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/version.h
+pathcanon.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/posixstat.h ${BASHINCDIR}/filecntl.h
+pathcanon.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/ansi_stdlib.h ${BASHINCDIR}/chartypes.h
+
+pathphys.o: ${topdir}/bashtypes.h ${topdir}/bashansi.h ${BASHINCDIR}/maxpath.h
+pathphys.o: ${topdir}/shell.h ${topdir}/syntax.h ${topdir}/bashjmp.h ${BASHINCDIR}/posixjmp.h
+pathphys.o: ${topdir}/command.h ${BASHINCDIR}/stdc.h ${topdir}/error.h
+pathphys.o: ${topdir}/general.h ${topdir}/bashtypes.h ${topdir}/variables.h ${topdir}/conftypes.h
+pathphys.o: ${topdir}/array.h ${topdir}/hashlib.h ${topdir}/quit.h
+pathphys.o: ${topdir}/unwind_prot.h ${topdir}/dispose_cmd.h
+pathphys.o: ${topdir}/make_cmd.h ${topdir}/subst.h ${topdir}/sig.h
+pathphys.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/pathnames.h ${topdir}/externs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/version.h
+pathphys.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/posixstat.h ${BASHINCDIR}/filecntl.h
+pathphys.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/ansi_stdlib.h ${BASHINCDIR}/chartypes.h
+
+rename.o: ${topdir}/bashtypes.h ${BASHINCDIR}/stdc.h
+rename.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/posixstat.h
+
+setlinebuf.o: ${topdir}/xmalloc.h ${topdir}/bashansi.h
+setlinebuf.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/ansi_stdlib.h ${BASHINCDIR}/stdc.h
+
+shquote.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/stdc.h ${topdir}/bashansi.h
+shquote.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/ansi_stdlib.h ${topdir}/xmalloc.h
+
+shtty.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/shtty.h
+shtty.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/stdc.h
+
+snprintf.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/stdc.h ${topdir}/bashansi.h ${topdir}/xmalloc.h
+snprintf.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/ansi_stdlib.h ${BASHINCDIR}/chartypes.h
+snprintf.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/typemax.h
+
+spell.o: ${topdir}/bashtypes.h
+spell.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/posixstat.h ${BASHINCDIR}/posixdir.h
+spell.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/ansi_stdlib.h
+
+strcasecmp.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/stdc.h ${topdir}/bashansi.h
+strcasecmp.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/ansi_stdlib.h ${BASHINCDIR}/chartypes.h
+
+strerror.o: ${topdir}/bashtypes.h
+strerror.o: ${topdir}/shell.h ${topdir}/syntax.h ${topdir}/bashjmp.h ${BASHINCDIR}/posixjmp.h
+strerror.o: ${topdir}/command.h ${BASHINCDIR}/stdc.h ${topdir}/error.h
+strerror.o: ${topdir}/general.h ${topdir}/bashtypes.h ${topdir}/variables.h ${topdir}/conftypes.h
+strerror.o: ${topdir}/array.h ${topdir}/hashlib.h ${topdir}/quit.h
+strerror.o: ${topdir}/unwind_prot.h ${topdir}/dispose_cmd.h
+strerror.o: ${topdir}/make_cmd.h ${topdir}/subst.h ${topdir}/sig.h
+strerror.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/pathnames.h ${topdir}/externs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/version.h
+
+strindex.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/stdc.h ${topdir}/bashansi.h
+strindex.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/ansi_stdlib.h ${BASHINCDIR}/chartypes.h
+
+stringlist.o: ${topdir}/bashansi.h
+stringlist.o: ${topdir}/shell.h ${topdir}/syntax.h ${topdir}/bashjmp.h ${BASHINCDIR}/posixjmp.h
+stringlist.o: ${topdir}/command.h ${BASHINCDIR}/stdc.h ${topdir}/error.h
+stringlist.o: ${topdir}/general.h ${topdir}/bashtypes.h ${topdir}/variables.h ${topdir}/conftypes.h
+stringlist.o: ${topdir}/array.h ${topdir}/hashlib.h ${topdir}/quit.h
+stringlist.o: ${topdir}/unwind_prot.h ${topdir}/dispose_cmd.h
+stringlist.o: ${topdir}/make_cmd.h ${topdir}/subst.h ${topdir}/sig.h
+stringlist.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/pathnames.h ${topdir}/externs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/version.h
+
+stringvec.o: ${topdir}/bashansi.h ${BASHINCDIR}/chartypes.h
+stringvec.o: ${topdir}/shell.h ${topdir}/syntax.h ${topdir}/bashjmp.h ${BASHINCDIR}/posixjmp.h
+stringvec.o: ${topdir}/command.h ${BASHINCDIR}/stdc.h ${topdir}/error.h
+stringvec.o: ${topdir}/general.h ${topdir}/bashtypes.h ${topdir}/variables.h ${topdir}/conftypes.h
+stringvec.o: ${topdir}/array.h ${topdir}/hashlib.h ${topdir}/quit.h
+stringvec.o: ${topdir}/unwind_prot.h ${topdir}/dispose_cmd.h
+stringvec.o: ${topdir}/make_cmd.h ${topdir}/subst.h ${topdir}/sig.h
+stringvec.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/pathnames.h ${topdir}/externs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/version.h
+
+strnlen.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/stdc.h
+
+strpbrk.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/stdc.h
+
+strtod.o: ${topdir}/bashansi.h
+strtod.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/ansi_stdlib.h ${BASHINCDIR}/chartypes.h
+
+strtoimax.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/stdc.h
+
+strtol.o: ${topdir}/bashansi.h
+strtol.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/ansi_stdlib.h ${BASHINCDIR}/chartypes.h
+strtol.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/typemax.h
+
+strtoll.o: ${topdir}/bashansi.h
+strtoll.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/ansi_stdlib.h ${BASHINCDIR}/chartypes.h
+strtoll.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/typemax.h
+
+strtoul.o: ${topdir}/bashansi.h
+strtoul.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/ansi_stdlib.h ${BASHINCDIR}/chartypes.h
+strtoul.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/typemax.h
+
+strtoull.o: ${topdir}/bashansi.h
+strtoull.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/ansi_stdlib.h ${BASHINCDIR}/chartypes.h
+strtoull.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/typemax.h
+
+strtoumax.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/stdc.h
+
+strtrans.o: ${topdir}/bashansi.h
+strtrans.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/ansi_stdlib.h ${BASHINCDIR}/chartypes.h
+strtrans.o: ${topdir}/shell.h ${topdir}/syntax.h ${topdir}/bashjmp.h ${BASHINCDIR}/posixjmp.h
+strtrans.o: ${topdir}/command.h ${BASHINCDIR}/stdc.h ${topdir}/error.h
+strtrans.o: ${topdir}/general.h ${topdir}/bashtypes.h ${topdir}/variables.h ${topdir}/conftypes.h
+strtrans.o: ${topdir}/array.h ${topdir}/hashlib.h ${topdir}/quit.h
+strtrans.o: ${topdir}/unwind_prot.h ${topdir}/dispose_cmd.h
+strtrans.o: ${topdir}/make_cmd.h ${topdir}/subst.h ${topdir}/sig.h
+strtrans.o: ${BUILD_DIR}/pathnames.h ${topdir}/externs.h ${BUILD_DIR}/version.h
+
+times.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/systimes.h
+times.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/posixtime.h
+
+timeval.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/posixtime.h
+
+tmpfile.o: ${topdir}/bashtypes.h
+tmpfile.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/posixstat.h
+tmpfile.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/filecntl.h
+
+clock.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/posixtime.h
+
+mailstat.o: ${topdir}/bashansi.h
+mailstat.o: ${topdir}/bashtypes.h
+mailstat.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/ansi_stdlib.h
+mailstat.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/posixstat.h
+mailstat.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/posixdir.h
+mailstat.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/maxpath.h
+
+fmtulong.o: ${topdir}/bashansi.h
+fmtulong.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/ansi_stdlib.h
+fmtulong.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/chartypes.h
+fmtulong.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/stdc.h
+fmtulong.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/typemax.h
+fmtulong.o: ${topdir}/bashintl.h ${LIBINTL_H} ${BASHINCDIR}/gettext.h
+
+fmtullong.o: ${topdir}/bashansi.h
+fmtullong.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/ansi_stdlib.h
+fmtullong.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/chartypes.h
+fmtullong.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/stdc.h
+fmtullong.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/typemax.h
+fmtullong.o: ${topdir}/bashintl.h ${LIBINTL_H} ${BASHINCDIR}/gettext.h
+
+fmtumax.o: ${topdir}/bashansi.h
+fmtumax.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/ansi_stdlib.h
+fmtumax.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/chartypes.h
+fmtumax.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/stdc.h
+fmtumax.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/typemax.h
+fmtumax.o: ${topdir}/bashintl.h ${LIBINTL_H} ${BASHINCDIR}/gettext.h
+
+xstrchr.o: ${topdir}/bashansi.h
+xstrchr.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/ansi_stdlib.h
+xstrchr.o: ${BASHINCDIR}/shmbutil.h
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/clktck.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/clktck.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..546b49c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/clktck.c
@@ -0,0 +1,59 @@
+/* clktck.c - get the value of CLK_TCK. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#include <bashtypes.h>
+#include <sys/param.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_LIMITS_H)
+# include <limits.h>
+#endif
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_SYSCONF) || !defined (_SC_CLK_TCK)
+# if !defined (CLK_TCK)
+# if defined (HZ)
+# define CLK_TCK HZ
+# else
+# define CLK_TCK 60
+# endif
+# endif /* !CLK_TCK */
+#endif /* !HAVE_SYSCONF && !_SC_CLK_TCK */
+
+long
+get_clk_tck ()
+{
+ static long retval = 0;
+
+ if (retval != 0)
+ return (retval);
+
+#if defined (HAVE_SYSCONF) && defined (_SC_CLK_TCK)
+ retval = sysconf (_SC_CLK_TCK);
+#else /* !SYSCONF || !_SC_CLK_TCK */
+ retval = CLK_TCK;
+#endif /* !SYSCONF || !_SC_CLK_TCK */
+
+ return (retval);
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/clock.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/clock.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1186a19
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/clock.c
@@ -0,0 +1,81 @@
+/* clock.c - operations on struct tms and clock_t's */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_TIMES)
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <posixtime.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_SYS_TIMES_H)
+# include <sys/times.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdc.h>
+
+extern long get_clk_tck __P((void));
+
+void
+clock_t_to_secs (t, sp, sfp)
+ clock_t t;
+ time_t *sp;
+ int *sfp;
+{
+ static long clk_tck = -1;
+
+ if (clk_tck == -1)
+ clk_tck = get_clk_tck ();
+
+ *sfp = t % clk_tck;
+ *sfp = (*sfp * 1000) / clk_tck;
+
+ *sp = t / clk_tck;
+
+ /* Sanity check */
+ if (*sfp >= 1000)
+ {
+ *sp += 1;
+ *sfp -= 1000;
+ }
+}
+
+/* Print the time defined by a clock_t (returned by the `times' and `time'
+ system calls) in a standard way to stdio stream FP. This is scaled in
+ terms of the value of CLK_TCK, which is what is returned by the
+ `times' call. */
+void
+print_clock_t (fp, t)
+ FILE *fp;
+ clock_t t;
+{
+ time_t timestamp;
+ long minutes;
+ int seconds, seconds_fraction;
+
+ clock_t_to_secs (t, &timestamp, &seconds_fraction);
+
+ minutes = timestamp / 60;
+ seconds = timestamp % 60;
+
+ fprintf (fp, "%ldm%d.%03ds", minutes, seconds, seconds_fraction);
+}
+#endif /* HAVE_TIMES */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/fmtullong.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/fmtullong.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..df27944
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/fmtullong.c
@@ -0,0 +1,29 @@
+/* fmtullong.c - convert `long long int' to string */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 2001-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the
+Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any
+later version.
+
+This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#ifdef HAVE_LONG_LONG
+
+#define LONG long long
+#define UNSIGNED_LONG unsigned long long
+#define fmtulong fmtullong
+
+#include "fmtulong.c"
+
+#endif
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/fmtulong.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/fmtulong.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..43fdffd
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/fmtulong.c
@@ -0,0 +1,190 @@
+/* fmtulong.c -- Convert unsigned long int to string. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1998-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_LIMITS_H)
+# include <limits.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <bashansi.h>
+#ifdef HAVE_STDDEF_H
+# include <stddef.h>
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_STDINT_H
+# include <stdint.h>
+#endif
+#ifdef HAVE_INTTYPES_H
+# include <inttypes.h>
+#endif
+#include <chartypes.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+
+#include <bashintl.h>
+
+#include "stdc.h"
+
+#include <typemax.h>
+
+#ifndef errno
+extern int errno;
+#endif
+
+#define x_digs "0123456789abcdef"
+#define X_digs "0123456789ABCDEF"
+
+/* XXX -- assumes uppercase letters, lowercase letters, and digits are
+ contiguous */
+#define FMTCHAR(x) \
+ ((x) < 10) ? (x) + '0' \
+ : (((x) < 36) ? (x) - 10 + 'a' \
+ : (((x) < 62) ? (x) - 36 + 'A' \
+ : (((x) == 62) ? '@' : '_')))
+
+#ifndef FL_PREFIX
+# define FL_PREFIX 0x01 /* add 0x, 0X, or 0 prefix as appropriate */
+# define FL_ADDBASE 0x02 /* add base# prefix to converted value */
+# define FL_HEXUPPER 0x04 /* use uppercase when converting to hex */
+# define FL_UNSIGNED 0x08 /* don't add any sign */
+#endif
+
+#ifndef LONG
+# define LONG long
+# define UNSIGNED_LONG unsigned long
+#endif
+
+/* `unsigned long' (or unsigned long long) to string conversion for a given
+ base. The caller passes the output buffer and the size. This should
+ check for buffer underflow, but currently does not. */
+char *
+fmtulong (ui, base, buf, len, flags)
+ UNSIGNED_LONG ui;
+ int base;
+ char *buf;
+ size_t len;
+ int flags;
+{
+ char *p;
+ int sign;
+ LONG si;
+
+ if (base == 0)
+ base = 10;
+
+ if (base < 2 || base > 64)
+ {
+#if 1
+ strncpy (buf, _("invalid base"), len - 1);
+ buf[len] = '\0';
+ errno = EINVAL;
+ return (p = buf);
+#else
+ base = 10;
+#endif
+ }
+
+ sign = 0;
+ if ((flags & FL_UNSIGNED) == 0 && (LONG)ui < 0)
+ {
+ ui = -ui;
+ sign = '-';
+ }
+
+ p = buf + len - 2;
+ p[1] = '\0';
+
+ /* handle common cases explicitly */
+ switch (base)
+ {
+ case 10:
+ if (ui < 10)
+ {
+ *p-- = TOCHAR (ui);
+ break;
+ }
+ /* Favor signed arithmetic over unsigned arithmetic; it is faster on
+ many machines. */
+ if ((LONG)ui < 0)
+ {
+ *p-- = TOCHAR (ui % 10);
+ si = ui / 10;
+ }
+ else
+ si = ui;
+ do
+ *p-- = TOCHAR (si % 10);
+ while (si /= 10);
+ break;
+
+ case 8:
+ do
+ *p-- = TOCHAR (ui & 7);
+ while (ui >>= 3);
+ break;
+
+ case 16:
+ do
+ *p-- = (flags & FL_HEXUPPER) ? X_digs[ui & 15] : x_digs[ui & 15];
+ while (ui >>= 4);
+ break;
+
+ case 2:
+ do
+ *p-- = TOCHAR (ui & 1);
+ while (ui >>= 1);
+ break;
+
+ default:
+ do
+ *p-- = FMTCHAR (ui % base);
+ while (ui /= base);
+ break;
+ }
+
+ if ((flags & FL_PREFIX) && (base == 8 || base == 16))
+ {
+ if (base == 16)
+ {
+ *p-- = (flags & FL_HEXUPPER) ? 'X' : 'x';
+ *p-- = '0';
+ }
+ else if (p[1] != '0')
+ *p-- = '0';
+ }
+ else if ((flags & FL_ADDBASE) && base != 10)
+ {
+ *p-- = '#';
+ *p-- = TOCHAR (base % 10);
+ if (base > 10)
+ *p-- = TOCHAR (base / 10);
+ }
+
+ if (sign)
+ *p-- = '-';
+
+ return (p + 1);
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/fmtumax.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/fmtumax.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9bb4718
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/fmtumax.c
@@ -0,0 +1,25 @@
+/* fmtumax.c -- Convert uintmax_t to string. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the
+Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any
+later version.
+
+This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#define LONG intmax_t
+#define UNSIGNED_LONG uintmax_t
+#define fmtulong fmtumax
+
+#include "fmtulong.c"
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/getcwd.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/getcwd.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..cd724f6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/getcwd.c
@@ -0,0 +1,313 @@
+/* getcwd.c -- stolen from the GNU C library and modified to work with bash. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ This file is part of the GNU C Library.
+
+ The GNU C Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+ modify it under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as
+ published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the
+ License, or (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU C Library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with the GNU C Library; see the file COPYING.LIB. If
+ not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_GETCWD)
+
+#if !defined (__GNUC__) && !defined (HAVE_ALLOCA_H) && defined (_AIX)
+ #pragma alloca
+#endif /* _AIX && RISC6000 && !__GNUC__ */
+
+#include <bashtypes.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_LIMITS_H)
+# include <limits.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <posixdir.h>
+#include <posixstat.h>
+#include <maxpath.h>
+#include <memalloc.h>
+
+#include <bashansi.h>
+
+#include <xmalloc.h>
+
+#if !defined (errno)
+extern int errno;
+#endif /* !errno */
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_LSTAT)
+# define lstat stat
+#endif
+
+#if !defined (NULL)
+# define NULL 0
+#endif
+
+/* Get the pathname of the current working directory,
+ and put it in SIZE bytes of BUF. Returns NULL if the
+ directory couldn't be determined or SIZE was too small.
+ If successful, returns BUF. In GNU, if BUF is NULL,
+ an array is allocated with `malloc'; the array is SIZE
+ bytes long, unless SIZE <= 0, in which case it is as
+ big as necessary. */
+#if defined (__STDC__)
+char *
+getcwd (char *buf, size_t size)
+#else /* !__STDC__ */
+char *
+getcwd (buf, size)
+ char *buf;
+ size_t size;
+#endif /* !__STDC__ */
+{
+ static const char dots[]
+ = "../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../\
+../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../\
+../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../../..";
+ const char *dotp, *dotlist;
+ size_t dotsize;
+ dev_t rootdev, thisdev;
+ ino_t rootino, thisino;
+ char path[PATH_MAX + 1];
+ register char *pathp;
+ char *pathbuf;
+ size_t pathsize;
+ struct stat st;
+ int saved_errno;
+
+ if (buf != NULL && size == 0)
+ {
+ errno = EINVAL;
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+ }
+
+ pathsize = sizeof (path);
+ pathp = &path[pathsize];
+ *--pathp = '\0';
+ pathbuf = path;
+
+ if (stat (".", &st) < 0)
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+ thisdev = st.st_dev;
+ thisino = st.st_ino;
+
+ if (stat ("/", &st) < 0)
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+ rootdev = st.st_dev;
+ rootino = st.st_ino;
+
+ saved_errno = 0;
+
+ dotsize = sizeof (dots) - 1;
+ dotp = &dots[sizeof (dots)];
+ dotlist = dots;
+ while (!(thisdev == rootdev && thisino == rootino))
+ {
+ register DIR *dirstream;
+ register struct dirent *d;
+ dev_t dotdev;
+ ino_t dotino;
+ char mount_point;
+ int namlen;
+
+ /* Look at the parent directory. */
+ if (dotp == dotlist)
+ {
+ /* My, what a deep directory tree you have, Grandma. */
+ char *new;
+ if (dotlist == dots)
+ {
+ new = (char *)malloc (dotsize * 2 + 1);
+ if (new == NULL)
+ goto lose;
+ memcpy (new, dots, dotsize);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ new = (char *)realloc ((PTR_T) dotlist, dotsize * 2 + 1);
+ if (new == NULL)
+ goto lose;
+ }
+ memcpy (&new[dotsize], new, dotsize);
+ dotp = &new[dotsize];
+ dotsize *= 2;
+ new[dotsize] = '\0';
+ dotlist = new;
+ }
+
+ dotp -= 3;
+
+ /* Figure out if this directory is a mount point. */
+ if (stat (dotp, &st) < 0)
+ goto lose;
+ dotdev = st.st_dev;
+ dotino = st.st_ino;
+ mount_point = dotdev != thisdev;
+
+ /* Search for the last directory. */
+ dirstream = opendir (dotp);
+ if (dirstream == NULL)
+ goto lose;
+ while ((d = readdir (dirstream)) != NULL)
+ {
+ if (d->d_name[0] == '.' &&
+ (d->d_name[1] == '\0' ||
+ (d->d_name[1] == '.' && d->d_name[2] == '\0')))
+ continue;
+ if (mount_point || d->d_fileno == thisino)
+ {
+ char *name;
+
+ namlen = D_NAMLEN(d);
+ name = (char *)
+ alloca (dotlist + dotsize - dotp + 1 + namlen + 1);
+ memcpy (name, dotp, dotlist + dotsize - dotp);
+ name[dotlist + dotsize - dotp] = '/';
+ memcpy (&name[dotlist + dotsize - dotp + 1],
+ d->d_name, namlen + 1);
+ if (lstat (name, &st) < 0)
+ {
+#if 0
+ int save = errno;
+ (void) closedir (dirstream);
+ errno = save;
+ goto lose;
+#else
+ saved_errno = errno;
+#endif
+ }
+ if (st.st_dev == thisdev && st.st_ino == thisino)
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ if (d == NULL)
+ {
+#if 0
+ int save = errno;
+#else
+ int save = errno ? errno : saved_errno;
+#endif
+ (void) closedir (dirstream);
+ errno = save;
+ goto lose;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ size_t space;
+
+ while ((space = pathp - pathbuf) <= namlen)
+ {
+ char *new;
+
+ if (pathbuf == path)
+ {
+ new = (char *)malloc (pathsize * 2);
+ if (!new)
+ goto lose;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ new = (char *)realloc ((PTR_T) pathbuf, (pathsize * 2));
+ if (!new)
+ goto lose;
+ pathp = new + space;
+ }
+ (void) memcpy (new + pathsize + space, pathp, pathsize - space);
+ pathp = new + pathsize + space;
+ pathbuf = new;
+ pathsize *= 2;
+ }
+
+ pathp -= namlen;
+ (void) memcpy (pathp, d->d_name, namlen);
+ *--pathp = '/';
+ (void) closedir (dirstream);
+ }
+
+ thisdev = dotdev;
+ thisino = dotino;
+ }
+
+ if (pathp == &path[sizeof(path) - 1])
+ *--pathp = '/';
+
+ if (dotlist != dots)
+ free ((PTR_T) dotlist);
+
+ {
+ size_t len = pathbuf + pathsize - pathp;
+ if (buf == NULL)
+ {
+ if (len < (size_t) size)
+ len = size;
+ buf = (char *) malloc (len);
+ if (buf == NULL)
+ goto lose2;
+ }
+ else if ((size_t) size < len)
+ {
+ errno = ERANGE;
+ goto lose2;
+ }
+ (void) memcpy((PTR_T) buf, (PTR_T) pathp, len);
+ }
+
+ if (pathbuf != path)
+ free (pathbuf);
+
+ return (buf);
+
+ lose:
+ if ((dotlist != dots) && dotlist)
+ {
+ int e = errno;
+ free ((PTR_T) dotlist);
+ errno = e;
+ }
+
+ lose2:
+ if ((pathbuf != path) && pathbuf)
+ {
+ int e = errno;
+ free ((PTR_T) pathbuf);
+ errno = e;
+ }
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+}
+
+#if defined (TEST)
+# include <stdio.h>
+main (argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char **argv;
+{
+ char b[PATH_MAX];
+
+ if (getcwd(b, sizeof(b)))
+ {
+ printf ("%s\n", b);
+ exit (0);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ perror ("cwd: getcwd");
+ exit (1);
+ }
+}
+#endif /* TEST */
+#endif /* !HAVE_GETCWD */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/getenv.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/getenv.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c3fbf75
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/getenv.c
@@ -0,0 +1,233 @@
+/* getenv.c - get environment variable value from the shell's variable
+ list. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1997-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#if defined (CAN_REDEFINE_GETENV)
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <bashansi.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <shell.h>
+
+#ifndef errno
+extern int errno;
+#endif
+
+extern char **environ;
+
+/* We supply our own version of getenv () because we want library
+ routines to get the changed values of exported variables. */
+
+/* The NeXT C library has getenv () defined and used in the same file.
+ This screws our scheme. However, Bash will run on the NeXT using
+ the C library getenv (), since right now the only environment variable
+ that we care about is HOME, and that is already defined. */
+static char *last_tempenv_value = (char *)NULL;
+
+char *
+getenv (name)
+ const char *name;
+{
+ SHELL_VAR *var;
+
+ if (name == 0 || *name == '\0')
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+
+ var = find_tempenv_variable ((char *)name);
+ if (var)
+ {
+ FREE (last_tempenv_value);
+
+ last_tempenv_value = value_cell (var) ? savestring (value_cell (var)) : (char *)NULL;
+ return (last_tempenv_value);
+ }
+ else if (shell_variables)
+ {
+ var = find_variable ((char *)name);
+ if (var && exported_p (var))
+ return (value_cell (var));
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ register int i, len;
+
+ /* In some cases, s5r3 invokes getenv() before main(); BSD systems
+ using gprof also exhibit this behavior. This means that
+ shell_variables will be 0 when this is invoked. We look up the
+ variable in the real environment in that case. */
+
+ for (i = 0, len = strlen (name); environ[i]; i++)
+ {
+ if ((STREQN (environ[i], name, len)) && (environ[i][len] == '='))
+ return (environ[i] + len + 1);
+ }
+ }
+
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+}
+
+/* Some versions of Unix use _getenv instead. */
+char *
+_getenv (name)
+ const char *name;
+{
+ return (getenv (name));
+}
+
+/* SUSv3 says argument is a `char *'; BSD implementations disagree */
+int
+putenv (str)
+#ifndef HAVE_STD_PUTENV
+ const char *str;
+#else
+ char *str;
+#endif
+{
+ SHELL_VAR *var;
+ char *name, *value;
+ int offset;
+
+ if (str == 0 || *str == '\0')
+ {
+ errno = EINVAL;
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ offset = assignment (str, 0);
+ if (str[offset] != '=')
+ {
+ errno = EINVAL;
+ return -1;
+ }
+ name = savestring (str);
+ name[offset] = 0;
+
+ value = name + offset + 1;
+
+ /* XXX - should we worry about readonly here? */
+ var = bind_variable (name, value, 0);
+ if (var == 0)
+ {
+ errno = EINVAL;
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ VUNSETATTR (var, att_invisible);
+ VSETATTR (var, att_exported);
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+#if 0
+int
+_putenv (name)
+#ifndef HAVE_STD_PUTENV
+ const char *name;
+#else
+ char *name;
+#endif
+{
+ return putenv (name);
+}
+#endif
+
+int
+setenv (name, value, rewrite)
+ const char *name;
+ const char *value;
+ int rewrite;
+{
+ SHELL_VAR *var;
+ char *v;
+
+ if (name == 0 || *name == '\0' || strchr (name, '=') != 0)
+ {
+ errno = EINVAL;
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ var = 0;
+ v = (char *)value; /* some compilers need explicit cast */
+ /* XXX - should we worry about readonly here? */
+ if (rewrite == 0)
+ var = find_variable (name);
+
+ if (var == 0)
+ var = bind_variable (name, v, 0);
+
+ if (var == 0)
+ return -1;
+
+ VUNSETATTR (var, att_invisible);
+ VSETATTR (var, att_exported);
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+#if 0
+int
+_setenv (name, value, rewrite)
+ const char *name;
+ const char *value;
+ int rewrite;
+{
+ return setenv (name, value, rewrite);
+}
+#endif
+
+/* SUSv3 says unsetenv returns int; existing implementations (BSD) disagree. */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_STD_UNSETENV
+#define UNSETENV_RETURN(N) return(N)
+#define UNSETENV_RETTYPE int
+#else
+#define UNSETENV_RETURN(N) return
+#define UNSETENV_RETTYPE void
+#endif
+
+UNSETENV_RETTYPE
+unsetenv (name)
+ const char *name;
+{
+ if (name == 0 || *name == '\0' || strchr (name, '=') != 0)
+ {
+ errno = EINVAL;
+ UNSETENV_RETURN(-1);
+ }
+
+ /* XXX - should we just remove the export attribute here? */
+#if 1
+ unbind_variable (name);
+#else
+ SHELL_VAR *v;
+
+ v = find_variable (name);
+ if (v)
+ VUNSETATTR (v, att_exported);
+#endif
+
+ UNSETENV_RETURN(0);
+}
+#endif /* CAN_REDEFINE_GETENV */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/inet_aton.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/inet_aton.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..2835d62
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/inet_aton.c
@@ -0,0 +1,210 @@
+/* Snagged from GNU C library, version 2.0.3. */
+
+/*
+ * ++Copyright++ 1983, 1990, 1993
+ * -
+ * Copyright (c) 1983, 1990, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ * -
+ * Portions Copyright (c) 1993 by Digital Equipment Corporation.
+ *
+ * Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software for any
+ * purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above
+ * copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies, and that
+ * the name of Digital Equipment Corporation not be used in advertising or
+ * publicity pertaining to distribution of the document or software without
+ * specific, written prior permission.
+ *
+ * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND DIGITAL EQUIPMENT CORP. DISCLAIMS ALL
+ * WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES
+ * OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL DIGITAL EQUIPMENT
+ * CORPORATION BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR
+ * PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS
+ * ACTION, ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
+ * SOFTWARE.
+ * -
+ * --Copyright--
+ */
+
+#if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint)
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)inet_addr.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 6/17/93";
+static char rcsid[] = "$Id: inet_addr.c,v 1.5 1996/08/14 03:48:37 drepper Exp $";
+#endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_INET_ATON) && defined (HAVE_NETWORK) && defined (HAVE_NETINET_IN_H) && defined (HAVE_ARPA_INET_H)
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <netinet/in.h>
+#include <arpa/inet.h>
+
+#ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <bashansi.h>
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <stdc.h>
+
+#ifndef INADDR_NONE
+# define INADDR_NONE 0xffffffff
+#endif
+
+/* these are compatibility routines, not needed on recent BSD releases */
+
+#if 0
+/* Not used, not needed. */
+/*
+ * Ascii internet address interpretation routine.
+ * The value returned is in network order.
+ */
+u_long
+inet_addr(cp)
+ register const char *cp;
+{
+ struct in_addr val;
+
+ if (inet_aton(cp, &val))
+ return (val.s_addr);
+ return (INADDR_NONE);
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * Check whether "cp" is a valid ascii representation
+ * of an Internet address and convert to a binary address.
+ * Returns 1 if the address is valid, 0 if not.
+ * This replaces inet_addr, the return value from which
+ * cannot distinguish between failure and a local broadcast address.
+ */
+int
+inet_aton(cp, addr)
+ register const char *cp;
+ struct in_addr *addr;
+{
+ register u_bits32_t val;
+ register int base, n;
+ register unsigned char c;
+ u_int parts[4];
+ register u_int *pp = parts;
+
+ c = *cp;
+ for (;;) {
+ /*
+ * Collect number up to ``.''.
+ * Values are specified as for C:
+ * 0x=hex, 0=octal, isdigit=decimal.
+ */
+#if 0
+ if (!isdigit(c))
+#else
+ if (c != '0' && c != '1' && c != '2' && c != '3' && c != '4' &&
+ c != '5' && c != '6' && c != '7' && c != '8' && c != '9')
+#endif
+ return (0);
+ val = 0; base = 10;
+ if (c == '0') {
+ c = *++cp;
+ if (c == 'x' || c == 'X')
+ base = 16, c = *++cp;
+ else
+ base = 8;
+ }
+ for (;;) {
+ if (isascii(c) && isdigit(c)) {
+ val = (val * base) + (c - '0');
+ c = *++cp;
+ } else if (base == 16 && isascii(c) && isxdigit(c)) {
+ val = (val << 4) |
+ (c + 10 - (islower(c) ? 'a' : 'A'));
+ c = *++cp;
+ } else
+ break;
+ }
+ if (c == '.') {
+ /*
+ * Internet format:
+ * a.b.c.d
+ * a.b.c (with c treated as 16 bits)
+ * a.b (with b treated as 24 bits)
+ */
+ if (pp >= parts + 3)
+ return (0);
+ *pp++ = val;
+ c = *++cp;
+ } else
+ break;
+ }
+ /*
+ * Check for trailing characters.
+ */
+ if (c != '\0' && (!isascii(c) || !isspace(c)))
+ return (0);
+ /*
+ * Concoct the address according to
+ * the number of parts specified.
+ */
+ n = pp - parts + 1;
+ switch (n) {
+
+ case 0:
+ return (0); /* initial nondigit */
+
+ case 1: /* a -- 32 bits */
+ break;
+
+ case 2: /* a.b -- 8.24 bits */
+ if (val > 0xffffff)
+ return (0);
+ val |= parts[0] << 24;
+ break;
+
+ case 3: /* a.b.c -- 8.8.16 bits */
+ if (val > 0xffff)
+ return (0);
+ val |= (parts[0] << 24) | (parts[1] << 16);
+ break;
+
+ case 4: /* a.b.c.d -- 8.8.8.8 bits */
+ if (val > 0xff)
+ return (0);
+ val |= (parts[0] << 24) | (parts[1] << 16) | (parts[2] << 8);
+ break;
+ }
+ if (addr)
+ addr->s_addr = htonl(val);
+ return (1);
+}
+
+#endif /* !HAVE_INET_ATON */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/itos.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/itos.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e9a7942
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/itos.c
@@ -0,0 +1,72 @@
+/* itos.c -- Convert integer to string. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1998-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <bashansi.h>
+#include "shell.h"
+
+char *
+inttostr (i, buf, len)
+ intmax_t i;
+ char *buf;
+ size_t len;
+{
+ return (fmtumax (i, 10, buf, len, 0));
+}
+
+/* Integer to string conversion. This conses the string; the
+ caller should free it. */
+char *
+itos (i)
+ intmax_t i;
+{
+ char *p, lbuf[INT_STRLEN_BOUND(intmax_t) + 1];
+
+ p = fmtumax (i, 10, lbuf, sizeof(lbuf), 0);
+ return (savestring (p));
+}
+
+char *
+uinttostr (i, buf, len)
+ uintmax_t i;
+ char *buf;
+ size_t len;
+{
+ return (fmtumax (i, 10, buf, len, FL_UNSIGNED));
+}
+
+/* Integer to string conversion. This conses the string; the
+ caller should free it. */
+char *
+uitos (i)
+ uintmax_t i;
+{
+ char *p, lbuf[INT_STRLEN_BOUND(uintmax_t) + 1];
+
+ p = fmtumax (i, 10, lbuf, sizeof(lbuf), FL_UNSIGNED);
+ return (savestring (p));
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/mailstat.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/mailstat.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..03782e7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/mailstat.c
@@ -0,0 +1,159 @@
+/* mailstat.c -- stat a mailbox file, handling maildir-type mail directories */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+
+#include <bashtypes.h>
+#include <posixstat.h>
+#include <posixdir.h>
+#include <bashansi.h>
+
+#ifndef _MINIX
+# include <sys/param.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <maxpath.h>
+
+/*
+ * Stat a file. If it's a maildir, check all messages
+ * in the maildir and present the grand total as a file.
+ * The fields in the 'struct stat' are from the mail directory.
+ * The following fields are emulated:
+ *
+ * st_nlink always 1, unless st_blocks is not present, in which case it's
+ * the total number of messages
+ * st_size total number of bytes in all files
+ * st_blocks total number of messages, if present in struct stat
+ * st_atime access time of newest file in maildir
+ * st_mtime modify time of newest file in maildir
+ * st_mode S_IFDIR changed to S_IFREG
+ *
+ * This is good enough for most mail-checking applications.
+ */
+
+int
+mailstat(path, st)
+ const char *path;
+ struct stat *st;
+{
+ static struct stat st_new_last, st_ret_last;
+ struct stat st_ret, st_tmp;
+ DIR *dd;
+ struct dirent *fn;
+ char dir[PATH_MAX * 2], file[PATH_MAX * 2];
+ int i, l;
+ time_t atime, mtime;
+
+ atime = mtime = 0;
+
+ /* First see if it's a directory. */
+ if ((i = stat(path, st)) != 0 || S_ISDIR(st->st_mode) == 0)
+ return i;
+
+ if (strlen(path) > sizeof(dir) - 5)
+ {
+#ifdef ENAMETOOLONG
+ errno = ENAMETOOLONG;
+#else
+ errno = EINVAL;
+#endif
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ st_ret = *st;
+ st_ret.st_nlink = 1;
+ st_ret.st_size = 0;
+#ifdef HAVE_STRUCT_STAT_ST_BLOCKS
+ st_ret.st_blocks = 0;
+#else
+ st_ret.st_nlink = 0;
+#endif
+ st_ret.st_mode &= ~S_IFDIR;
+ st_ret.st_mode |= S_IFREG;
+
+ /* See if cur/ is present */
+ sprintf(dir, "%s/cur", path);
+ if (stat(dir, &st_tmp) || S_ISDIR(st_tmp.st_mode) == 0)
+ return 0;
+ st_ret.st_atime = st_tmp.st_atime;
+
+ /* See if tmp/ is present */
+ sprintf(dir, "%s/tmp", path);
+ if (stat(dir, &st_tmp) || S_ISDIR(st_tmp.st_mode) == 0)
+ return 0;
+ st_ret.st_mtime = st_tmp.st_mtime;
+
+ /* And new/ */
+ sprintf(dir, "%s/new", path);
+ if (stat(dir, &st_tmp) || S_ISDIR(st_tmp.st_mode) == 0)
+ return 0;
+ st_ret.st_mtime = st_tmp.st_mtime;
+
+ /* Optimization - if new/ didn't change, nothing else did. */
+ if (st_tmp.st_dev == st_new_last.st_dev &&
+ st_tmp.st_ino == st_new_last.st_ino &&
+ st_tmp.st_atime == st_new_last.st_atime &&
+ st_tmp.st_mtime == st_new_last.st_mtime)
+ {
+ *st = st_ret_last;
+ return 0;
+ }
+ st_new_last = st_tmp;
+
+ /* Loop over new/ and cur/ */
+ for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
+ {
+ sprintf(dir, "%s/%s", path, i ? "cur" : "new");
+ sprintf(file, "%s/", dir);
+ l = strlen(file);
+ if ((dd = opendir(dir)) == NULL)
+ return 0;
+ while ((fn = readdir(dd)) != NULL)
+ {
+ if (fn->d_name[0] == '.' || strlen(fn->d_name) + l >= sizeof(file))
+ continue;
+ strcpy(file + l, fn->d_name);
+ if (stat(file, &st_tmp) != 0)
+ continue;
+ st_ret.st_size += st_tmp.st_size;
+#ifdef HAVE_STRUCT_STAT_ST_BLOCKS
+ st_ret.st_blocks++;
+#else
+ st_ret.st_nlink++;
+#endif
+ if (st_tmp.st_atime != st_tmp.st_mtime && st_tmp.st_atime > atime)
+ atime = st_tmp.st_atime;
+ if (st_tmp.st_mtime > mtime)
+ mtime = st_tmp.st_mtime;
+ }
+ closedir(dd);
+ }
+
+/* if (atime) */ /* Set atime even if cur/ is empty */
+ st_ret.st_atime = atime;
+ if (mtime)
+ st_ret.st_mtime = mtime;
+
+ *st = st_ret_last = st_ret;
+ return 0;
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/makepath.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/makepath.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c496154
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/makepath.c
@@ -0,0 +1,118 @@
+/* makepath.c - glue PATH and DIR together into a full pathname. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1987, 1989, 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# ifdef _MINIX
+# include <sys/types.h>
+# endif
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <bashansi.h>
+#include "shell.h"
+
+#include <tilde/tilde.h>
+
+#ifndef NULL
+# define NULL 0
+#endif
+
+/* MAKE SURE THESE AGREE WITH ../../externs.h. */
+
+#ifndef MP_DOTILDE
+# define MP_DOTILDE 0x01
+# define MP_DOCWD 0x02
+# define MP_RMDOT 0x04
+#endif
+
+extern char *get_working_directory __P((char *));
+
+/* Take PATH, an element from, e.g., $CDPATH, and DIR, a directory name,
+ and paste them together into PATH/DIR. Tilde expansion is performed on
+ PATH if (flags & MP_DOTILDE) is non-zero. If PATH is NULL or the empty
+ string, it is converted to the current directory. A full pathname is
+ used if (flags & MP_DOCWD) is non-zero, otherwise `./' is used. If
+ (flags & MP_RMDOT) is non-zero, any `./' is removed from the beginning
+ of DIR. */
+
+#define MAKEDOT() \
+ do { \
+ xpath = (char *)xmalloc (2); \
+ xpath[0] = '.'; \
+ xpath[1] = '\0'; \
+ pathlen = 1; \
+ } while (0)
+
+char *
+sh_makepath (path, dir, flags)
+ const char *path, *dir;
+ int flags;
+{
+ int dirlen, pathlen;
+ char *ret, *xpath, *xdir, *r, *s;
+
+ if (path == 0 || *path == '\0')
+ {
+ if (flags & MP_DOCWD)
+ {
+ xpath = get_working_directory ("sh_makepath");
+ if (xpath == 0)
+ {
+ ret = get_string_value ("PWD");
+ if (ret)
+ xpath = savestring (ret);
+ }
+ if (xpath == 0)
+ MAKEDOT();
+ else
+ pathlen = strlen (xpath);
+ }
+ else
+ MAKEDOT();
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ xpath = ((flags & MP_DOTILDE) && *path == '~') ? bash_tilde_expand (path, 0) : (char *)path;
+ pathlen = strlen (xpath);
+ }
+
+ xdir = (char *)dir;
+ dirlen = strlen (xdir);
+ if ((flags & MP_RMDOT) && dir[0] == '.' && dir[1] == '/')
+ {
+ xdir += 2;
+ dirlen -= 2;
+ }
+
+ r = ret = (char *)xmalloc (2 + dirlen + pathlen);
+ s = xpath;
+ while (*s)
+ *r++ = *s++;
+ if (s[-1] != '/')
+ *r++ = '/';
+ s = xdir;
+ while (*r++ = *s++)
+ ;
+ if (xpath != path)
+ free (xpath);
+ return (ret);
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/memset.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/memset.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ddc36b6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/memset.c
@@ -0,0 +1,26 @@
+/* memset.c -- set an area of memory to a given value
+ Copyright (C) 1991-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
+
+char *
+memset (char *str, int c, unsigned int len)
+{
+ register char *st = str;
+
+ while (len-- > 0)
+ *st++ = c;
+ return str;
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/mktime.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/mktime.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..81aeb22
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/mktime.c
@@ -0,0 +1,425 @@
+/* Copyright (C) 1993-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ This file is part of the GNU C Library.
+ Contributed by Paul Eggert (eggert@twinsun.com).
+
+ The GNU C Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+ modify it under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as
+ published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the
+ License, or (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU C Library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Library General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+ License along with the GNU C Library; see the file COPYING.LIB. If not,
+ write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
+ Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
+
+/* Define this to have a standalone program to test this implementation of
+ mktime. */
+/* #define DEBUG 1 */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+#include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# define HAVE_LIMITS_H 1
+# define HAVE_LOCALTIME_R 1
+# define STDC_HEADERS 1
+#endif
+
+/* Assume that leap seconds are possible, unless told otherwise.
+ If the host has a `zic' command with a `-L leapsecondfilename' option,
+ then it supports leap seconds; otherwise it probably doesn't. */
+#ifndef LEAP_SECONDS_POSSIBLE
+#define LEAP_SECONDS_POSSIBLE 1
+#endif
+
+#ifndef VMS
+#include <sys/types.h> /* Some systems define `time_t' here. */
+#else
+#include <stddef.h>
+#endif
+#include <time.h>
+
+#if HAVE_LIMITS_H
+#include <limits.h>
+#endif
+
+#if DEBUG
+#include <stdio.h>
+#if STDC_HEADERS
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#endif
+/* Make it work even if the system's libc has its own mktime routine. */
+#define mktime my_mktime
+#endif /* DEBUG */
+
+#ifndef __P
+#if defined (__GNUC__) || (defined (__STDC__) && __STDC__)
+#define __P(args) args
+#else
+#define __P(args) ()
+#endif /* GCC. */
+#endif /* Not __P. */
+
+#ifndef CHAR_BIT
+#define CHAR_BIT 8
+#endif
+
+#ifndef INT_MIN
+#define INT_MIN (~0 << (sizeof (int) * CHAR_BIT - 1))
+#endif
+#ifndef INT_MAX
+#define INT_MAX (~0 - INT_MIN)
+#endif
+
+#ifndef TIME_T_MIN
+#define TIME_T_MIN (0 < (time_t) -1 ? (time_t) 0 \
+ : ~ (time_t) 0 << (sizeof (time_t) * CHAR_BIT - 1))
+#endif
+#ifndef TIME_T_MAX
+#define TIME_T_MAX (~ (time_t) 0 - TIME_T_MIN)
+#endif
+
+#define TM_YEAR_BASE 1900
+#define EPOCH_YEAR 1970
+
+#ifndef __isleap
+/* Nonzero if YEAR is a leap year (every 4 years,
+ except every 100th isn't, and every 400th is). */
+#define __isleap(year) \
+ ((year) % 4 == 0 && ((year) % 100 != 0 || (year) % 400 == 0))
+#endif
+
+/* How many days come before each month (0-12). */
+const unsigned short int __mon_yday[2][13] =
+ {
+ /* Normal years. */
+ { 0, 31, 59, 90, 120, 151, 181, 212, 243, 273, 304, 334, 365 },
+ /* Leap years. */
+ { 0, 31, 60, 91, 121, 152, 182, 213, 244, 274, 305, 335, 366 }
+ };
+
+static time_t ydhms_tm_diff __P ((int, int, int, int, int, const struct tm *));
+time_t __mktime_internal __P ((struct tm *,
+ struct tm *(*) (const time_t *, struct tm *),
+ time_t *));
+
+
+static struct tm *my_localtime_r __P ((const time_t *, struct tm *));
+static struct tm *
+my_localtime_r (t, tp)
+ const time_t *t;
+ struct tm *tp;
+{
+ struct tm *l = localtime (t);
+ if (! l)
+ return 0;
+ *tp = *l;
+ return tp;
+}
+
+
+/* Yield the difference between (YEAR-YDAY HOUR:MIN:SEC) and (*TP),
+ measured in seconds, ignoring leap seconds.
+ YEAR uses the same numbering as TM->tm_year.
+ All values are in range, except possibly YEAR.
+ If overflow occurs, yield the low order bits of the correct answer. */
+static time_t
+ydhms_tm_diff (year, yday, hour, min, sec, tp)
+ int year, yday, hour, min, sec;
+ const struct tm *tp;
+{
+ /* Compute intervening leap days correctly even if year is negative.
+ Take care to avoid int overflow. time_t overflow is OK, since
+ only the low order bits of the correct time_t answer are needed.
+ Don't convert to time_t until after all divisions are done, since
+ time_t might be unsigned. */
+ int a4 = (year >> 2) + (TM_YEAR_BASE >> 2) - ! (year & 3);
+ int b4 = (tp->tm_year >> 2) + (TM_YEAR_BASE >> 2) - ! (tp->tm_year & 3);
+ int a100 = a4 / 25 - (a4 % 25 < 0);
+ int b100 = b4 / 25 - (b4 % 25 < 0);
+ int a400 = a100 >> 2;
+ int b400 = b100 >> 2;
+ int intervening_leap_days = (a4 - b4) - (a100 - b100) + (a400 - b400);
+ time_t years = year - (time_t) tp->tm_year;
+ time_t days = (365 * years + intervening_leap_days
+ + (yday - tp->tm_yday));
+ return (60 * (60 * (24 * days + (hour - tp->tm_hour))
+ + (min - tp->tm_min))
+ + (sec - tp->tm_sec));
+}
+
+
+static time_t localtime_offset;
+
+/* Convert *TP to a time_t value. */
+time_t
+mktime (tp)
+ struct tm *tp;
+{
+#ifdef _LIBC
+ /* POSIX.1 8.1.1 requires that whenever mktime() is called, the
+ time zone names contained in the external variable `tzname' shall
+ be set as if the tzset() function had been called. */
+ __tzset ();
+#endif
+
+ return __mktime_internal (tp, my_localtime_r, &localtime_offset);
+}
+
+/* Convert *TP to a time_t value, inverting
+ the monotonic and mostly-unit-linear conversion function CONVERT.
+ Use *OFFSET to keep track of a guess at the offset of the result,
+ compared to what the result would be for UTC without leap seconds.
+ If *OFFSET's guess is correct, only one CONVERT call is needed. */
+time_t
+__mktime_internal (tp, convert, offset)
+ struct tm *tp;
+ struct tm *(*convert) __P ((const time_t *, struct tm *));
+ time_t *offset;
+{
+ time_t t, dt, t0;
+ struct tm tm;
+
+ /* The maximum number of probes (calls to CONVERT) should be enough
+ to handle any combinations of time zone rule changes, solar time,
+ and leap seconds. Posix.1 prohibits leap seconds, but some hosts
+ have them anyway. */
+ int remaining_probes = 4;
+
+ /* Time requested. Copy it in case CONVERT modifies *TP; this can
+ occur if TP is localtime's returned value and CONVERT is localtime. */
+ int sec = tp->tm_sec;
+ int min = tp->tm_min;
+ int hour = tp->tm_hour;
+ int mday = tp->tm_mday;
+ int mon = tp->tm_mon;
+ int year_requested = tp->tm_year;
+ int isdst = tp->tm_isdst;
+
+ /* Ensure that mon is in range, and set year accordingly. */
+ int mon_remainder = mon % 12;
+ int negative_mon_remainder = mon_remainder < 0;
+ int mon_years = mon / 12 - negative_mon_remainder;
+ int year = year_requested + mon_years;
+
+ /* The other values need not be in range:
+ the remaining code handles minor overflows correctly,
+ assuming int and time_t arithmetic wraps around.
+ Major overflows are caught at the end. */
+
+ /* Calculate day of year from year, month, and day of month.
+ The result need not be in range. */
+ int yday = ((__mon_yday[__isleap (year + TM_YEAR_BASE)]
+ [mon_remainder + 12 * negative_mon_remainder])
+ + mday - 1);
+
+#if LEAP_SECONDS_POSSIBLE
+ /* Handle out-of-range seconds specially,
+ since ydhms_tm_diff assumes every minute has 60 seconds. */
+ int sec_requested = sec;
+ if (sec < 0)
+ sec = 0;
+ if (59 < sec)
+ sec = 59;
+#endif
+
+ /* Invert CONVERT by probing. First assume the same offset as last time.
+ Then repeatedly use the error to improve the guess. */
+
+ tm.tm_year = EPOCH_YEAR - TM_YEAR_BASE;
+ tm.tm_yday = tm.tm_hour = tm.tm_min = tm.tm_sec = 0;
+ t0 = ydhms_tm_diff (year, yday, hour, min, sec, &tm);
+
+ for (t = t0 + *offset;
+ (dt = ydhms_tm_diff (year, yday, hour, min, sec, (*convert) (&t, &tm)));
+ t += dt)
+ if (--remaining_probes == 0)
+ return -1;
+
+ /* Check whether tm.tm_isdst has the requested value, if any. */
+ if (0 <= isdst && 0 <= tm.tm_isdst)
+ {
+ int dst_diff = (isdst != 0) - (tm.tm_isdst != 0);
+ if (dst_diff)
+ {
+ /* Move two hours in the direction indicated by the disagreement,
+ probe some more, and switch to a new time if found.
+ The largest known fallback due to daylight savings is two hours:
+ once, in Newfoundland, 1988-10-30 02:00 -> 00:00. */
+ time_t ot = t - 2 * 60 * 60 * dst_diff;
+ while (--remaining_probes != 0)
+ {
+ struct tm otm;
+ if (! (dt = ydhms_tm_diff (year, yday, hour, min, sec,
+ (*convert) (&ot, &otm))))
+ {
+ t = ot;
+ tm = otm;
+ break;
+ }
+ if ((ot += dt) == t)
+ break; /* Avoid a redundant probe. */
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ *offset = t - t0;
+
+#if LEAP_SECONDS_POSSIBLE
+ if (sec_requested != tm.tm_sec)
+ {
+ /* Adjust time to reflect the tm_sec requested, not the normalized value.
+ Also, repair any damage from a false match due to a leap second. */
+ t += sec_requested - sec + (sec == 0 && tm.tm_sec == 60);
+ (*convert) (&t, &tm);
+ }
+#endif
+
+ if (TIME_T_MAX / INT_MAX / 366 / 24 / 60 / 60 < 3)
+ {
+ /* time_t isn't large enough to rule out overflows in ydhms_tm_diff,
+ so check for major overflows. A gross check suffices,
+ since if t has overflowed, it is off by a multiple of
+ TIME_T_MAX - TIME_T_MIN + 1. So ignore any component of
+ the difference that is bounded by a small value. */
+
+ double dyear = (double) year_requested + mon_years - tm.tm_year;
+ double dday = 366 * dyear + mday;
+ double dsec = 60 * (60 * (24 * dday + hour) + min) + sec_requested;
+
+ if (TIME_T_MAX / 3 - TIME_T_MIN / 3 < (dsec < 0 ? - dsec : dsec))
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ *tp = tm;
+ return t;
+}
+
+#ifdef weak_alias
+weak_alias (mktime, timelocal)
+#endif
+
+#if DEBUG
+
+static int
+not_equal_tm (a, b)
+ struct tm *a;
+ struct tm *b;
+{
+ return ((a->tm_sec ^ b->tm_sec)
+ | (a->tm_min ^ b->tm_min)
+ | (a->tm_hour ^ b->tm_hour)
+ | (a->tm_mday ^ b->tm_mday)
+ | (a->tm_mon ^ b->tm_mon)
+ | (a->tm_year ^ b->tm_year)
+ | (a->tm_mday ^ b->tm_mday)
+ | (a->tm_yday ^ b->tm_yday)
+ | (a->tm_isdst ^ b->tm_isdst));
+}
+
+static void
+print_tm (tp)
+ struct tm *tp;
+{
+ printf ("%04d-%02d-%02d %02d:%02d:%02d yday %03d wday %d isdst %d",
+ tp->tm_year + TM_YEAR_BASE, tp->tm_mon + 1, tp->tm_mday,
+ tp->tm_hour, tp->tm_min, tp->tm_sec,
+ tp->tm_yday, tp->tm_wday, tp->tm_isdst);
+}
+
+static int
+check_result (tk, tmk, tl, tml)
+ time_t tk;
+ struct tm tmk;
+ time_t tl;
+ struct tm tml;
+{
+ if (tk != tl || not_equal_tm (&tmk, &tml))
+ {
+ printf ("mktime (");
+ print_tm (&tmk);
+ printf (")\nyields (");
+ print_tm (&tml);
+ printf (") == %ld, should be %ld\n", (long) tl, (long) tk);
+ return 1;
+ }
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+int
+main (argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char **argv;
+{
+ int status = 0;
+ struct tm tm, tmk, tml;
+ time_t tk, tl;
+ char trailer;
+
+ if ((argc == 3 || argc == 4)
+ && (sscanf (argv[1], "%d-%d-%d%c",
+ &tm.tm_year, &tm.tm_mon, &tm.tm_mday, &trailer)
+ == 3)
+ && (sscanf (argv[2], "%d:%d:%d%c",
+ &tm.tm_hour, &tm.tm_min, &tm.tm_sec, &trailer)
+ == 3))
+ {
+ tm.tm_year -= TM_YEAR_BASE;
+ tm.tm_mon--;
+ tm.tm_isdst = argc == 3 ? -1 : atoi (argv[3]);
+ tmk = tm;
+ tl = mktime (&tmk);
+ tml = *localtime (&tl);
+ printf ("mktime returns %ld == ", (long) tl);
+ print_tm (&tmk);
+ printf ("\n");
+ status = check_result (tl, tmk, tl, tml);
+ }
+ else if (argc == 4 || (argc == 5 && strcmp (argv[4], "-") == 0))
+ {
+ time_t from = atol (argv[1]);
+ time_t by = atol (argv[2]);
+ time_t to = atol (argv[3]);
+
+ if (argc == 4)
+ for (tl = from; tl <= to; tl += by)
+ {
+ tml = *localtime (&tl);
+ tmk = tml;
+ tk = mktime (&tmk);
+ status |= check_result (tk, tmk, tl, tml);
+ }
+ else
+ for (tl = from; tl <= to; tl += by)
+ {
+ /* Null benchmark. */
+ tml = *localtime (&tl);
+ tmk = tml;
+ tk = tl;
+ status |= check_result (tk, tmk, tl, tml);
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ printf ("Usage:\
+\t%s YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS [ISDST] # Test given time.\n\
+\t%s FROM BY TO # Test values FROM, FROM+BY, ..., TO.\n\
+\t%s FROM BY TO - # Do not test those values (for benchmark).\n",
+ argv[0], argv[0], argv[0]);
+
+ return status;
+}
+
+#endif /* DEBUG */
+
+/*
+Local Variables:
+compile-command: "gcc -DDEBUG=1 -Wall -O -g mktime.c -o mktime"
+End:
+*/
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/netconn.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/netconn.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ae7c249
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/netconn.c
@@ -0,0 +1,83 @@
+/* netconn.c -- is a particular file descriptor a network connection?. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 2002-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT
+ ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY
+ or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public
+ License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
+ Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA.
+*/
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#include <bashtypes.h>
+#if ! defined(_MINIX) && defined (HAVE_SYS_FILE_H)
+# include <sys/file.h>
+#endif
+#include <posixstat.h>
+#include <filecntl.h>
+
+#include <errno.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+/* The second and subsequent conditions must match those used to decide
+ whether or not to call getpeername() in isnetconn(). */
+#if defined (HAVE_SYS_SOCKET_H) && defined (HAVE_GETPEERNAME) && !defined (SVR4_2)
+# include <sys/socket.h>
+#endif
+
+/* Is FD a socket or network connection? */
+int
+isnetconn (fd)
+ int fd;
+{
+#if defined (HAVE_GETPEERNAME) && !defined (SVR4_2) && !defined (__BEOS__)
+ int rv;
+ socklen_t l;
+ struct sockaddr sa;
+
+ l = sizeof(sa);
+ rv = getpeername(fd, &sa, &l);
+ /* Posix.2 says getpeername can return these errors. */
+ return ((rv < 0 && (errno == ENOTSOCK || errno == ENOTCONN || errno == EINVAL)) ? 0 : 1);
+#else /* !HAVE_GETPEERNAME || SVR4_2 || __BEOS__ */
+# if defined (SVR4) || defined (SVR4_2)
+ /* Sockets on SVR4 and SVR4.2 are character special (streams) devices. */
+ struct stat sb;
+
+ if (isatty (fd))
+ return (0);
+ if (fstat (fd, &sb) < 0)
+ return (0);
+# if defined (S_ISFIFO)
+ if (S_ISFIFO (sb.st_mode))
+ return (0);
+# endif /* S_ISFIFO */
+ return (S_ISCHR (sb.st_mode));
+# else /* !SVR4 && !SVR4_2 */
+# if defined (S_ISSOCK) && !defined (__BEOS__)
+ struct stat sb;
+
+ if (fstat (fd, &sb) < 0)
+ return (0);
+ return (S_ISSOCK (sb.st_mode));
+# else /* !S_ISSOCK || __BEOS__ */
+ return (0);
+# endif /* !S_ISSOCK || __BEOS__ */
+# endif /* !SVR4 && !SVR4_2 */
+#endif /* !HAVE_GETPEERNAME || SVR4_2 || __BEOS__ */
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/netopen.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/netopen.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..aaf0c47
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/netopen.c
@@ -0,0 +1,340 @@
+/*
+ * netopen.c -- functions to make tcp/udp connections
+ *
+ * Chet Ramey
+ * chet@ins.CWRU.Edu
+ */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1987-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT
+ ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY
+ or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public
+ License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
+ Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_NETWORK)
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_SYS_SOCKET_H)
+# include <sys/socket.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_NETINET_IN_H)
+# include <netinet/in.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_NETDB_H)
+# include <netdb.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_ARPA_INET_H)
+# include <arpa/inet.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <bashansi.h>
+#include <bashintl.h>
+
+#include <errno.h>
+
+#include <shell.h>
+#include <xmalloc.h>
+
+#ifndef errno
+extern int errno;
+#endif
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_INET_ATON)
+extern int inet_aton __P((const char *, struct in_addr *));
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_GETADDRINFO
+/* Stuff the internet address corresponding to HOST into AP, in network
+ byte order. Return 1 on success, 0 on failure. */
+
+static int
+_getaddr (host, ap)
+ char *host;
+ struct in_addr *ap;
+{
+ struct hostent *h;
+ int r;
+
+ r = 0;
+ if (host[0] >= '0' && host[0] <= '9')
+ {
+ /* If the first character is a digit, guess that it's an
+ Internet address and return immediately if inet_aton succeeds. */
+ r = inet_aton (host, ap);
+ if (r)
+ return r;
+ }
+#if !defined (HAVE_GETHOSTBYNAME)
+ return 0;
+#else
+ h = gethostbyname (host);
+ if (h && h->h_addr)
+ {
+ bcopy(h->h_addr, (char *)ap, h->h_length);
+ return 1;
+ }
+#endif
+ return 0;
+
+}
+
+/* Return 1 if SERV is a valid port number and stuff the converted value into
+ PP in network byte order. */
+static int
+_getserv (serv, proto, pp)
+ char *serv;
+ int proto;
+ unsigned short *pp;
+{
+ intmax_t l;
+ unsigned short s;
+
+ if (legal_number (serv, &l))
+ {
+ s = (unsigned short)(l & 0xFFFF);
+ if (s != l)
+ return (0);
+ s = htons (s);
+ if (pp)
+ *pp = s;
+ return 1;
+ }
+ else
+#if defined (HAVE_GETSERVBYNAME)
+ {
+ struct servent *se;
+
+ se = getservbyname (serv, (proto == 't') ? "tcp" : "udp");
+ if (se == 0)
+ return 0;
+ if (pp)
+ *pp = se->s_port; /* ports returned in network byte order */
+ return 1;
+ }
+#else /* !HAVE_GETSERVBYNAME */
+ return 0;
+#endif /* !HAVE_GETSERVBYNAME */
+}
+
+/*
+ * Open a TCP or UDP connection to HOST on port SERV. Uses the
+ * traditional BSD mechanisms. Returns the connected socket or -1 on error.
+ */
+static int
+_netopen4(host, serv, typ)
+ char *host, *serv;
+ int typ;
+{
+ struct in_addr ina;
+ struct sockaddr_in sin;
+ unsigned short p;
+ int s, e;
+
+ if (_getaddr(host, &ina) == 0)
+ {
+ internal_error (_("%s: host unknown"), host);
+ errno = EINVAL;
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ if (_getserv(serv, typ, &p) == 0)
+ {
+ internal_error(_("%s: invalid service"), serv);
+ errno = EINVAL;
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ memset ((char *)&sin, 0, sizeof(sin));
+ sin.sin_family = AF_INET;
+ sin.sin_port = p;
+ sin.sin_addr = ina;
+
+ s = socket(AF_INET, (typ == 't') ? SOCK_STREAM : SOCK_DGRAM, 0);
+ if (s < 0)
+ {
+ sys_error ("socket");
+ return (-1);
+ }
+
+ if (connect (s, (struct sockaddr *)&sin, sizeof (sin)) < 0)
+ {
+ e = errno;
+ sys_error("connect");
+ close(s);
+ errno = e;
+ return (-1);
+ }
+
+ return(s);
+}
+#endif /* ! HAVE_GETADDRINFO */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_GETADDRINFO
+/*
+ * Open a TCP or UDP connection to HOST on port SERV. Uses getaddrinfo(3)
+ * which provides support for IPv6. Returns the connected socket or -1
+ * on error.
+ */
+static int
+_netopen6 (host, serv, typ)
+ char *host, *serv;
+ int typ;
+{
+ int s, e;
+ struct addrinfo hints, *res, *res0;
+ int gerr;
+
+ memset ((char *)&hints, 0, sizeof (hints));
+ /* XXX -- if problems with IPv6, set to PF_INET for IPv4 only */
+#ifdef DEBUG /* PF_INET is the one that works for me */
+ hints.ai_family = PF_INET;
+#else
+ hints.ai_family = PF_UNSPEC;
+#endif
+ hints.ai_socktype = (typ == 't') ? SOCK_STREAM : SOCK_DGRAM;
+
+ gerr = getaddrinfo (host, serv, &hints, &res0);
+ if (gerr)
+ {
+ if (gerr == EAI_SERVICE)
+ internal_error ("%s: %s", serv, gai_strerror (gerr));
+ else
+ internal_error ("%s: %s", host, gai_strerror (gerr));
+ errno = EINVAL;
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ for (res = res0; res; res = res->ai_next)
+ {
+ if ((s = socket (res->ai_family, res->ai_socktype, res->ai_protocol)) < 0)
+ {
+ if (res->ai_next)
+ continue;
+ sys_error ("socket");
+ freeaddrinfo (res0);
+ return -1;
+ }
+ if (connect (s, res->ai_addr, res->ai_addrlen) < 0)
+ {
+ if (res->ai_next)
+ {
+ close (s);
+ continue;
+ }
+ e = errno;
+ sys_error ("connect");
+ close (s);
+ freeaddrinfo (res0);
+ errno = e;
+ return -1;
+ }
+ freeaddrinfo (res0);
+ break;
+ }
+ return s;
+}
+#endif /* HAVE_GETADDRINFO */
+
+/*
+ * Open a TCP or UDP connection to HOST on port SERV. Uses getaddrinfo(3)
+ * if available, falling back to the traditional BSD mechanisms otherwise.
+ * Returns the connected socket or -1 on error.
+ */
+static int
+_netopen(host, serv, typ)
+ char *host, *serv;
+ int typ;
+{
+#ifdef HAVE_GETADDRINFO
+ return (_netopen6 (host, serv, typ));
+#else
+ return (_netopen4 (host, serv, typ));
+#endif
+}
+
+/*
+ * Open a TCP or UDP connection given a path like `/dev/tcp/host/port' to
+ * host `host' on port `port' and return the connected socket.
+ */
+int
+netopen (path)
+ char *path;
+{
+ char *np, *s, *t;
+ int fd;
+
+ np = (char *)xmalloc (strlen (path) + 1);
+ strcpy (np, path);
+
+ s = np + 9;
+ t = strchr (s, '/');
+ if (t == 0)
+ {
+ internal_error (_("%s: bad network path specification"), path);
+ return -1;
+ }
+ *t++ = '\0';
+ fd = _netopen (s, t, path[5]);
+ free (np);
+
+ return fd;
+}
+
+#if 0
+/*
+ * Open a TCP connection to host `host' on the port defined for service
+ * `serv' and return the connected socket.
+ */
+int
+tcpopen (host, serv)
+ char *host, *serv;
+{
+ return (_netopen (host, serv, 't'));
+}
+
+/*
+ * Open a UDP connection to host `host' on the port defined for service
+ * `serv' and return the connected socket.
+ */
+int
+udpopen (host, serv)
+ char *host, *serv;
+{
+ return _netopen (host, serv, 'u');
+}
+#endif
+
+#else /* !HAVE_NETWORK */
+
+int
+netopen (path)
+ char *path;
+{
+ internal_error (_("network operations not supported"));
+ return -1;
+}
+
+#endif /* !HAVE_NETWORK */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/oslib.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/oslib.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..90d7be9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/oslib.c
@@ -0,0 +1,296 @@
+/* oslib.c - functions present only in some unix versions. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1995 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#include <bashtypes.h>
+#ifndef _MINIX
+# include <sys/param.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_LIMITS_H)
+# include <limits.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <posixstat.h>
+#include <filecntl.h>
+#include <bashansi.h>
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <chartypes.h>
+
+#include <shell.h>
+
+#if !defined (errno)
+extern int errno;
+#endif /* !errno */
+
+/* Make the functions strchr and strrchr if they do not exist. */
+#if !defined (HAVE_STRCHR)
+char *
+strchr (string, c)
+ char *string;
+ int c;
+{
+ register char *s;
+
+ for (s = string; s && *s; s++)
+ if (*s == c)
+ return (s);
+
+ return ((char *) NULL);
+}
+
+char *
+strrchr (string, c)
+ char *string;
+ int c;
+{
+ register char *s, *t;
+
+ for (s = string, t = (char *)NULL; s && *s; s++)
+ if (*s == c)
+ t = s;
+ return (t);
+}
+#endif /* !HAVE_STRCHR */
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_DUP2) || defined (DUP2_BROKEN)
+/* Replacement for dup2 (), for those systems which either don't have it,
+ or supply one with broken behaviour. */
+int
+dup2 (fd1, fd2)
+ int fd1, fd2;
+{
+ int saved_errno, r;
+
+ /* If FD1 is not a valid file descriptor, then return immediately with
+ an error. */
+ if (fcntl (fd1, F_GETFL, 0) == -1)
+ return (-1);
+
+ if (fd2 < 0 || fd2 >= getdtablesize ())
+ {
+ errno = EBADF;
+ return (-1);
+ }
+
+ if (fd1 == fd2)
+ return (0);
+
+ saved_errno = errno;
+
+ (void) close (fd2);
+ r = fcntl (fd1, F_DUPFD, fd2);
+
+ if (r >= 0)
+ errno = saved_errno;
+ else
+ if (errno == EINVAL)
+ errno = EBADF;
+
+ /* Force the new file descriptor to remain open across exec () calls. */
+ SET_OPEN_ON_EXEC (fd2);
+ return (r);
+}
+#endif /* !HAVE_DUP2 */
+
+/*
+ * Return the total number of available file descriptors.
+ *
+ * On some systems, like 4.2BSD and its descendents, there is a system call
+ * that returns the size of the descriptor table: getdtablesize(). There are
+ * lots of ways to emulate this on non-BSD systems.
+ *
+ * On System V.3, this can be obtained via a call to ulimit:
+ * return (ulimit(4, 0L));
+ *
+ * On other System V systems, NOFILE is defined in /usr/include/sys/param.h
+ * (this is what we assume below), so we can simply use it:
+ * return (NOFILE);
+ *
+ * On POSIX systems, there are specific functions for retrieving various
+ * configuration parameters:
+ * return (sysconf(_SC_OPEN_MAX));
+ *
+ */
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_GETDTABLESIZE)
+int
+getdtablesize ()
+{
+# if defined (_POSIX_VERSION) && defined (HAVE_SYSCONF) && defined (_SC_OPEN_MAX)
+ return (sysconf(_SC_OPEN_MAX)); /* Posix systems use sysconf */
+# else /* ! (_POSIX_VERSION && HAVE_SYSCONF && _SC_OPEN_MAX) */
+# if defined (ULIMIT_MAXFDS)
+ return (ulimit (4, 0L)); /* System V.3 systems use ulimit(4, 0L) */
+# else /* !ULIMIT_MAXFDS */
+# if defined (NOFILE) /* Other systems use NOFILE */
+ return (NOFILE);
+# else /* !NOFILE */
+ return (20); /* XXX - traditional value is 20 */
+# endif /* !NOFILE */
+# endif /* !ULIMIT_MAXFDS */
+# endif /* ! (_POSIX_VERSION && _SC_OPEN_MAX) */
+}
+#endif /* !HAVE_GETDTABLESIZE */
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_BCOPY)
+# if defined (bcopy)
+# undef bcopy
+# endif
+void
+bcopy (s,d,n)
+ char *d, *s;
+ int n;
+{
+ FASTCOPY (s, d, n);
+}
+#endif /* !HAVE_BCOPY */
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_BZERO)
+# if defined (bzero)
+# undef bzero
+# endif
+void
+bzero (s, n)
+ char *s;
+ int n;
+{
+ register int i;
+ register char *r;
+
+ for (i = 0, r = s; i < n; i++)
+ *r++ = '\0';
+}
+#endif
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_GETHOSTNAME)
+# if defined (HAVE_UNAME)
+# include <sys/utsname.h>
+int
+gethostname (name, namelen)
+ char *name;
+ int namelen;
+{
+ int i;
+ struct utsname ut;
+
+ --namelen;
+
+ uname (&ut);
+ i = strlen (ut.nodename) + 1;
+ strncpy (name, ut.nodename, i < namelen ? i : namelen);
+ name[namelen] = '\0';
+ return (0);
+}
+# else /* !HAVE_UNAME */
+int
+gethostname (name, namelen)
+ int name, namelen;
+{
+ strncpy (name, "unknown", namelen);
+ name[namelen] = '\0';
+ return 0;
+}
+# endif /* !HAVE_UNAME */
+#endif /* !HAVE_GETHOSTNAME */
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_KILLPG)
+int
+killpg (pgrp, sig)
+ pid_t pgrp;
+ int sig;
+{
+ return (kill (-pgrp, sig));
+}
+#endif /* !HAVE_KILLPG */
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_MKFIFO) && defined (PROCESS_SUBSTITUTION)
+int
+mkfifo (path, mode)
+ char *path;
+ int mode;
+{
+#if defined (S_IFIFO)
+ return (mknod (path, (mode | S_IFIFO), 0));
+#else /* !S_IFIFO */
+ return (-1);
+#endif /* !S_IFIFO */
+}
+#endif /* !HAVE_MKFIFO && PROCESS_SUBSTITUTION */
+
+#define DEFAULT_MAXGROUPS 64
+
+int
+getmaxgroups ()
+{
+ static int maxgroups = -1;
+
+ if (maxgroups > 0)
+ return maxgroups;
+
+#if defined (HAVE_SYSCONF) && defined (_SC_NGROUPS_MAX)
+ maxgroups = sysconf (_SC_NGROUPS_MAX);
+#else
+# if defined (NGROUPS_MAX)
+ maxgroups = NGROUPS_MAX;
+# else /* !NGROUPS_MAX */
+# if defined (NGROUPS)
+ maxgroups = NGROUPS;
+# else /* !NGROUPS */
+ maxgroups = DEFAULT_MAXGROUPS;
+# endif /* !NGROUPS */
+# endif /* !NGROUPS_MAX */
+#endif /* !HAVE_SYSCONF || !SC_NGROUPS_MAX */
+
+ if (maxgroups <= 0)
+ maxgroups = DEFAULT_MAXGROUPS;
+
+ return maxgroups;
+}
+
+long
+getmaxchild ()
+{
+ static long maxchild = -1L;
+
+ if (maxchild > 0)
+ return maxchild;
+
+#if defined (HAVE_SYSCONF) && defined (_SC_CHILD_MAX)
+ maxchild = sysconf (_SC_CHILD_MAX);
+#else
+# if defined (CHILD_MAX)
+ maxchild = CHILD_MAX;
+# else
+# if defined (MAXUPRC)
+ maxchild = MAXUPRC;
+# endif /* MAXUPRC */
+# endif /* CHILD_MAX */
+#endif /* !HAVE_SYSCONF || !_SC_CHILD_MAX */
+
+ return (maxchild);
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/pathcanon.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/pathcanon.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3b427a8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/pathcanon.c
@@ -0,0 +1,234 @@
+/* pathcanon.c -- Canonicalize and manipulate pathnames. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#include <bashtypes.h>
+#ifndef _MINIX
+# include <sys/param.h>
+#endif
+#include <posixstat.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <filecntl.h>
+#include <bashansi.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <chartypes.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+
+#include "shell.h"
+
+#if !defined (errno)
+extern int errno;
+#endif
+
+#if defined (__CYGWIN__)
+#include <sys/cygwin.h>
+
+static int
+_is_cygdrive (path)
+ char *path;
+{
+ static char user[MAXPATHLEN];
+ static char system[MAXPATHLEN];
+ static int first_time = 1;
+
+ /* If the path is the first part of a network path, treat it as
+ existing. */
+ if (path[0] == '/' && path[1] == '/' && !strchr (path + 2, '/'))
+ return 1;
+ /* Otherwise check for /cygdrive prefix. */
+ if (first_time)
+ {
+ char user_flags[MAXPATHLEN];
+ char system_flags[MAXPATHLEN];
+ /* Get the cygdrive info */
+ cygwin_internal (CW_GET_CYGDRIVE_INFO, user, system, user_flags, system_flags);
+ first_time = 0;
+ }
+ return !strcasecmp (path, user) || !strcasecmp (path, system);
+}
+#endif /* __CYGWIN__ */
+
+/* Return 1 if PATH corresponds to a directory. A function for debugging. */
+static int
+_path_isdir (path)
+ char *path;
+{
+ int l;
+ struct stat sb;
+
+ /* This should leave errno set to the correct value. */
+ errno = 0;
+ l = stat (path, &sb) == 0 && S_ISDIR (sb.st_mode);
+#if defined (__CYGWIN__)
+ if (l == 0)
+ l = _is_cygdrive (path);
+#endif
+ return l;
+}
+
+/* Canonicalize PATH, and return a new path. The new path differs from PATH
+ in that:
+ Multple `/'s are collapsed to a single `/'.
+ Leading `./'s and trailing `/.'s are removed.
+ Trailing `/'s are removed.
+ Non-leading `../'s and trailing `..'s are handled by removing
+ portions of the path. */
+
+/* Look for ROOTEDPATH, PATHSEP, DIRSEP, and ISDIRSEP in ../../general.h */
+
+#define DOUBLE_SLASH(p) ((p[0] == '/') && (p[1] == '/') && p[2] != '/')
+
+char *
+sh_canonpath (path, flags)
+ char *path;
+ int flags;
+{
+ char stub_char;
+ char *result, *p, *q, *base, *dotdot;
+ int rooted, double_slash_path;
+
+ /* The result cannot be larger than the input PATH. */
+ result = (flags & PATH_NOALLOC) ? path : savestring (path);
+
+ /* POSIX.2 says to leave a leading `//' alone. On cygwin, we skip over any
+ leading `x:' (dos drive name). */
+ if (rooted = ROOTEDPATH(path))
+ {
+ stub_char = DIRSEP;
+#if defined (__CYGWIN__)
+ base = (ISALPHA((unsigned char)result[0]) && result[1] == ':') ? result + 3 : result + 1;
+#else
+ base = result + 1;
+#endif
+ double_slash_path = DOUBLE_SLASH (path);
+ base += double_slash_path;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ stub_char = '.';
+#if defined (__CYGWIN__)
+ base = (ISALPHA((unsigned char)result[0]) && result[1] == ':') ? result + 2 : result;
+#else
+ base = result;
+#endif
+ double_slash_path = 0;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * invariants:
+ * base points to the portion of the path we want to modify
+ * p points at beginning of path element we're considering.
+ * q points just past the last path element we wrote (no slash).
+ * dotdot points just past the point where .. cannot backtrack
+ * any further (no slash).
+ */
+ p = q = dotdot = base;
+
+ while (*p)
+ {
+ if (ISDIRSEP(p[0])) /* null element */
+ p++;
+ else if(p[0] == '.' && PATHSEP(p[1])) /* . and ./ */
+ p += 1; /* don't count the separator in case it is nul */
+ else if (p[0] == '.' && p[1] == '.' && PATHSEP(p[2])) /* .. and ../ */
+ {
+ p += 2; /* skip `..' */
+ if (q > dotdot) /* can backtrack */
+ {
+ if (flags & PATH_CHECKDOTDOT)
+ {
+ char c;
+
+ /* Make sure what we have so far corresponds to a valid
+ path before we chop some of it off. */
+ c = *q;
+ *q = '\0';
+ if (_path_isdir (result) == 0)
+ {
+ if ((flags & PATH_NOALLOC) == 0)
+ free (result);
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+ }
+ *q = c;
+ }
+
+ while (--q > dotdot && ISDIRSEP(*q) == 0)
+ ;
+ }
+ else if (rooted == 0)
+ {
+ /* /.. is / but ./../ is .. */
+ if (q != base)
+ *q++ = DIRSEP;
+ *q++ = '.';
+ *q++ = '.';
+ dotdot = q;
+ }
+ }
+ else /* real path element */
+ {
+ /* add separator if not at start of work portion of result */
+ if (q != base)
+ *q++ = DIRSEP;
+ while (*p && (ISDIRSEP(*p) == 0))
+ *q++ = *p++;
+ /* Check here for a valid directory with _path_isdir. */
+ if (flags & PATH_CHECKEXISTS)
+ {
+ char c;
+
+ /* Make sure what we have so far corresponds to a valid
+ path before we chop some of it off. */
+ c = *q;
+ *q = '\0';
+ if (_path_isdir (result) == 0)
+ {
+ if ((flags & PATH_NOALLOC) == 0)
+ free (result);
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+ }
+ *q = c;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Empty string is really ``.'' or `/', depending on what we started with. */
+ if (q == result)
+ *q++ = stub_char;
+ *q = '\0';
+
+ /* If the result starts with `//', but the original path does not, we
+ can turn the // into /. Because of how we set `base', this should never
+ be true, but it's a sanity check. */
+ if (DOUBLE_SLASH(result) && double_slash_path == 0)
+ {
+ if (result[2] == '\0') /* short-circuit for bare `//' */
+ result[1] = '\0';
+ else
+ strcpy (result, result + 1);
+ }
+
+ return (result);
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/pathphys.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/pathphys.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1f73944
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/pathphys.c
@@ -0,0 +1,296 @@
+/* pathphys.c -- Return pathname with all symlinks expanded. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#include <bashtypes.h>
+#ifndef _MINIX
+# include <sys/param.h>
+#endif
+#include <posixstat.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <filecntl.h>
+#include <bashansi.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <chartypes.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+
+#include "shell.h"
+
+#if !defined (MAXSYMLINKS)
+# define MAXSYMLINKS 32
+#endif
+
+#if !defined (errno)
+extern int errno;
+#endif /* !errno */
+
+extern char *get_working_directory __P((char *));
+
+static int
+_path_readlink (path, buf, bufsiz)
+ char *path;
+ char *buf;
+ int bufsiz;
+{
+#ifdef HAVE_READLINK
+ return readlink (path, buf, bufsiz);
+#else
+ errno = EINVAL;
+ return -1;
+#endif
+}
+
+/* Look for ROOTEDPATH, PATHSEP, DIRSEP, and ISDIRSEP in ../../general.h */
+
+#define DOUBLE_SLASH(p) ((p[0] == '/') && (p[1] == '/') && p[2] != '/')
+
+/*
+ * Return PATH with all symlinks expanded in newly-allocated memory.
+ * This always gets an absolute pathname.
+ */
+
+char *
+sh_physpath (path, flags)
+ char *path;
+ int flags;
+{
+ char tbuf[PATH_MAX+1], linkbuf[PATH_MAX+1];
+ char *result, *p, *q, *qsave, *qbase, *workpath;
+ int double_slash_path, linklen, nlink;
+
+ linklen = strlen (path);
+
+#if 0
+ /* First sanity check -- punt immediately if the name is too long. */
+ if (linklen >= PATH_MAX)
+ return (savestring (path));
+#endif
+
+ nlink = 0;
+ q = result = (char *)xmalloc (PATH_MAX + 1);
+
+ /* Even if we get something longer than PATH_MAX, we might be able to
+ shorten it, so we try. */
+ if (linklen >= PATH_MAX)
+ workpath = savestring (path);
+ else
+ {
+ workpath = (char *)xmalloc (PATH_MAX + 1);
+ strcpy (workpath, path);
+ }
+
+ /* This always gets an absolute pathname. */
+
+ /* POSIX.2 says to leave a leading `//' alone. On cygwin, we skip over any
+ leading `x:' (dos drive name). */
+#if defined (__CYGWIN__)
+ qbase = (ISALPHA((unsigned char)workpath[0]) && workpath[1] == ':') ? workpath + 3 : workpath + 1;
+#else
+ qbase = workpath + 1;
+#endif
+ double_slash_path = DOUBLE_SLASH (workpath);
+ qbase += double_slash_path;
+
+ for (p = workpath; p < qbase; )
+ *q++ = *p++;
+ qbase = q;
+
+ /*
+ * invariants:
+ * qbase points to the portion of the result path we want to modify
+ * p points at beginning of path element we're considering.
+ * q points just past the last path element we wrote (no slash).
+ *
+ * XXX -- need to fix error checking for too-long pathnames
+ */
+
+ while (*p)
+ {
+ if (ISDIRSEP(p[0])) /* null element */
+ p++;
+ else if(p[0] == '.' && PATHSEP(p[1])) /* . and ./ */
+ p += 1; /* don't count the separator in case it is nul */
+ else if (p[0] == '.' && p[1] == '.' && PATHSEP(p[2])) /* .. and ../ */
+ {
+ p += 2; /* skip `..' */
+ if (q > qbase)
+ {
+ while (--q > qbase && ISDIRSEP(*q) == 0)
+ ;
+ }
+ }
+ else /* real path element */
+ {
+ /* add separator if not at start of work portion of result */
+ qsave = q;
+ if (q != qbase)
+ *q++ = DIRSEP;
+ while (*p && (ISDIRSEP(*p) == 0))
+ {
+ if (q - result >= PATH_MAX)
+ {
+#ifdef ENAMETOOLONG
+ errno = ENAMETOOLONG;
+#else
+ errno = EINVAL;
+#endif
+ goto error;
+ }
+
+ *q++ = *p++;
+ }
+
+ *q = '\0';
+
+ linklen = _path_readlink (result, linkbuf, PATH_MAX);
+ if (linklen < 0) /* if errno == EINVAL, it's not a symlink */
+ {
+ if (errno != EINVAL)
+ goto error;
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /* It's a symlink, and the value is in LINKBUF. */
+ nlink++;
+ if (nlink > MAXSYMLINKS)
+ {
+#ifdef ELOOP
+ errno = ELOOP;
+#else
+ errno = EINVAL;
+#endif
+error:
+ free (result);
+ free (workpath);
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+ }
+
+ linkbuf[linklen] = '\0';
+
+ /* If the new path length would overrun PATH_MAX, punt now. */
+ if ((strlen (p) + linklen + 2) >= PATH_MAX)
+ {
+#ifdef ENAMETOOLONG
+ errno = ENAMETOOLONG;
+#else
+ errno = EINVAL;
+#endif
+ goto error;
+ }
+
+ /* Form the new pathname by copying the link value to a temporary
+ buffer and appending the rest of `workpath'. Reset p to point
+ to the start of the rest of the path. If the link value is an
+ absolute pathname, reset p, q, and qbase. If not, reset p
+ and q. */
+ strcpy (tbuf, linkbuf);
+ tbuf[linklen] = '/';
+ strcpy (tbuf + linklen, p);
+ strcpy (workpath, tbuf);
+
+ if (ABSPATH(linkbuf))
+ {
+ q = result;
+ /* Duplicating some code here... */
+#if defined (__CYGWIN__)
+ qbase = (ISALPHA((unsigned char)workpath[0]) && workpath[1] == ':') ? workpath + 3 : workpath + 1;
+#else
+ qbase = workpath + 1;
+#endif
+ double_slash_path = DOUBLE_SLASH (workpath);
+ qbase += double_slash_path;
+
+ for (p = workpath; p < qbase; )
+ *q++ = *p++;
+ qbase = q;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ p = workpath;
+ q = qsave;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ *q = '\0';
+ free (workpath);
+
+ /* If the result starts with `//', but the original path does not, we
+ can turn the // into /. Because of how we set `qbase', this should never
+ be true, but it's a sanity check. */
+ if (DOUBLE_SLASH(result) && double_slash_path == 0)
+ {
+ if (result[2] == '\0') /* short-circuit for bare `//' */
+ result[1] = '\0';
+ else
+ strcpy (result, result + 1);
+ }
+
+ return (result);
+}
+
+char *
+sh_realpath (pathname, resolved)
+ const char *pathname;
+ char *resolved;
+{
+ char *tdir, *wd;
+
+ if (pathname == 0 || *pathname == '\0')
+ {
+ errno = (pathname == 0) ? EINVAL : ENOENT;
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+ }
+
+ if (ABSPATH (pathname) == 0)
+ {
+ wd = get_working_directory ("sh_realpath");
+ if (wd == 0)
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+ tdir = sh_makepath ((char *)pathname, wd, 0);
+ free (wd);
+ }
+ else
+ tdir = savestring (pathname);
+
+ wd = sh_physpath (tdir, 0);
+ free (tdir);
+
+ if (resolved == 0)
+ return (wd);
+
+ if (wd)
+ {
+ strncpy (resolved, wd, PATH_MAX - 1);
+ resolved[PATH_MAX - 1] = '\0';
+ free (wd);
+ return resolved;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ resolved[0] = '\0';
+ return wd;
+ }
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/rename.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/rename.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d5c2778
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/rename.c
@@ -0,0 +1,76 @@
+/*
+ * rename - rename a file
+ */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT
+ ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY
+ or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public
+ License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
+ Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_RENAME)
+
+#include <bashtypes.h>
+#include <posixstat.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+#include <errno.h>
+
+#include <stdc.h>
+
+#ifndef errno
+extern int errno;
+#endif
+
+int
+rename (from, to)
+ const char *from, *to;
+{
+ struct stat fb, tb;
+
+ if (stat (from, &fb) < 0)
+ return -1;
+
+ if (stat (to, &tb) < 0)
+ {
+ if (errno != ENOENT)
+ return -1;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if (fb.st_dev == tb.st_dev && fb.st_ino == tb.st_ino)
+ return 0; /* same file */
+ if (unlink (to) < 0 && errno != ENOENT)
+ return -1;
+ }
+
+ if (link (from, to) < 0)
+ return (-1);
+
+ if (unlink (from) < 0 && errno != ENOENT)
+ {
+ int e = errno;
+ unlink (to);
+ errno = e;
+ return (-1);
+ }
+
+ return (0);
+}
+#endif /* !HAVE_RENAME */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/setlinebuf.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/setlinebuf.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3c5d056
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/setlinebuf.c
@@ -0,0 +1,63 @@
+/* setlinebuf.c - line-buffer a stdio stream. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+#include <xmalloc.h>
+
+#if defined (USING_BASH_MALLOC)
+# define LBUF_BUFSIZE 1008
+#else
+# define LBUF_BUFSIZE BUFSIZ
+#endif
+
+/* Cause STREAM to buffer lines as opposed to characters or blocks. */
+int
+sh_setlinebuf (stream)
+ FILE *stream;
+{
+ char *local_linebuf;
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_SETLINEBUF) && !defined (HAVE_SETVBUF)
+ return (0);
+#endif
+
+#if defined (USING_BASH_MALLOC)
+ local_linebuf = (char *)xmalloc (LBUF_BUFSIZE);
+#else
+ local_linebuf = (char *)NULL;
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_SETVBUF)
+
+# if defined (SETVBUF_REVERSED)
+ return (setvbuf (stream, _IOLBF, local_linebuf, LBUF_BUFSIZE));
+# else /* !SETVBUF_REVERSED */
+ return (setvbuf (stream, local_linebuf, _IOLBF, LBUF_BUFSIZE));
+# endif /* !SETVBUF_REVERSED */
+# else /* !HAVE_SETVBUF */
+
+ setlinebuf (stream);
+ return (0);
+
+#endif /* !HAVE_SETVBUF */
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/shmatch.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/shmatch.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..4508ed0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/shmatch.c
@@ -0,0 +1,121 @@
+/* Copyright (C) 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+/*
+ * shmatch.c -- shell interface to posix regular expression matching.
+ */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_POSIX_REGEXP)
+
+#ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "bashansi.h"
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <regex.h>
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "variables.h"
+#include "externs.h"
+
+extern int glob_ignore_case, match_ignore_case;
+
+int
+sh_regmatch (string, pattern, flags)
+ const char *string;
+ const char *pattern;
+ int flags;
+{
+ regex_t regex = { 0 };
+ regmatch_t *matches;
+ int rflags;
+#if defined (ARRAY_VARS)
+ SHELL_VAR *rematch;
+ ARRAY *amatch;
+ int subexp_ind;
+ char *subexp_str;
+ int subexp_len;
+#endif
+ int result;
+
+
+#if defined (ARRAY_VARS)
+ rematch = (SHELL_VAR *)NULL;
+#endif
+
+ rflags = REG_EXTENDED;
+ if (glob_ignore_case || match_ignore_case)
+ rflags |= REG_ICASE;
+#if !defined (ARRAY_VARS)
+ rflags |= REG_NOSUB;
+#endif
+
+ if (regcomp (&regex, pattern, rflags))
+ return 2; /* flag for printing a warning here. */
+
+#if defined (ARRAY_VARS)
+ matches = (regmatch_t *)malloc (sizeof (regmatch_t) * (regex.re_nsub + 1));
+#else
+ matches = NULL;
+#endif
+
+ if (regexec (&regex, string, regex.re_nsub + 1, matches, 0))
+ result = EXECUTION_FAILURE;
+ else
+ result = EXECUTION_SUCCESS; /* match */
+
+#if defined (ARRAY_VARS)
+ subexp_len = strlen (string) + 10;
+ subexp_str = malloc (subexp_len + 1);
+
+ /* Store the parenthesized subexpressions in the array BASH_REMATCH.
+ Element 0 is the portion that matched the entire regexp. Element 1
+ is the part that matched the first subexpression, and so on. */
+ unbind_variable ("BASH_REMATCH");
+ rematch = make_new_array_variable ("BASH_REMATCH");
+ amatch = array_cell (rematch);
+
+ if ((flags & SHMAT_SUBEXP) && result == EXECUTION_SUCCESS && subexp_str)
+ {
+ for (subexp_ind = 0; subexp_ind <= regex.re_nsub; subexp_ind++)
+ {
+ memset (subexp_str, 0, subexp_len);
+ strncpy (subexp_str, string + matches[subexp_ind].rm_so,
+ matches[subexp_ind].rm_eo - matches[subexp_ind].rm_so);
+ array_insert (amatch, subexp_ind, subexp_str);
+ }
+ }
+
+ VSETATTR (rematch, att_readonly);
+
+ free (subexp_str);
+ free (matches);
+#endif /* ARRAY_VARS */
+
+ regfree (&regex);
+
+ return result;
+}
+
+#endif /* HAVE_POSIX_REGEXP */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/shquote.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/shquote.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e992a66
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/shquote.c
@@ -0,0 +1,276 @@
+/* Copyright (C) 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# ifdef _MINIX
+# include <sys/types.h>
+# endif
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+#include "syntax.h"
+#include <xmalloc.h>
+
+/* **************************************************************** */
+/* */
+/* Functions for quoting strings to be re-read as input */
+/* */
+/* **************************************************************** */
+
+/* Return a new string which is the single-quoted version of STRING.
+ Used by alias and trap, among others. */
+char *
+sh_single_quote (string)
+ char *string;
+{
+ register int c;
+ char *result, *r, *s;
+
+ result = (char *)xmalloc (3 + (4 * strlen (string)));
+ r = result;
+ *r++ = '\'';
+
+ for (s = string; s && (c = *s); s++)
+ {
+ *r++ = c;
+
+ if (c == '\'')
+ {
+ *r++ = '\\'; /* insert escaped single quote */
+ *r++ = '\'';
+ *r++ = '\''; /* start new quoted string */
+ }
+ }
+
+ *r++ = '\'';
+ *r = '\0';
+
+ return (result);
+}
+
+/* Quote STRING using double quotes. Return a new string. */
+char *
+sh_double_quote (string)
+ char *string;
+{
+ register unsigned char c;
+ char *result, *r, *s;
+
+ result = (char *)xmalloc (3 + (2 * strlen (string)));
+ r = result;
+ *r++ = '"';
+
+ for (s = string; s && (c = *s); s++)
+ {
+ /* Backslash-newline disappears within double quotes, so don't add one. */
+ if ((sh_syntaxtab[c] & CBSDQUOTE) && c != '\n')
+ *r++ = '\\';
+ else if (c == CTLESC || c == CTLNUL)
+ *r++ = CTLESC; /* could be '\\'? */
+
+ *r++ = c;
+ }
+
+ *r++ = '"';
+ *r = '\0';
+
+ return (result);
+}
+
+/* Turn S into a simple double-quoted string. If FLAGS is non-zero, quote
+ double quote characters in S with backslashes. */
+char *
+sh_mkdoublequoted (s, slen, flags)
+ const char *s;
+ int slen, flags;
+{
+ char *r, *ret;
+ int rlen;
+
+ rlen = (flags == 0) ? slen + 3 : (2 * slen) + 1;
+ ret = r = (char *)xmalloc (rlen);
+
+ *r++ = '"';
+ while (*s)
+ {
+ if (flags && *s == '"')
+ *r++ = '\\';
+ *r++ = *s++;
+ }
+ *r++ = '"';
+ *r = '\0';
+
+ return ret;
+}
+
+/* Remove backslashes that are quoting characters that are special between
+ double quotes. Return a new string. XXX - should this handle CTLESC
+ and CTLNUL? */
+char *
+sh_un_double_quote (string)
+ char *string;
+{
+ register int c, pass_next;
+ char *result, *r, *s;
+
+ r = result = (char *)xmalloc (strlen (string) + 1);
+
+ for (pass_next = 0, s = string; s && (c = *s); s++)
+ {
+ if (pass_next)
+ {
+ *r++ = c;
+ pass_next = 0;
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (c == '\\' && (sh_syntaxtab[(unsigned char) s[1]] & CBSDQUOTE))
+ {
+ pass_next = 1;
+ continue;
+ }
+ *r++ = c;
+ }
+
+ *r = '\0';
+ return result;
+}
+
+/* Quote special characters in STRING using backslashes. Return a new
+ string. NOTE: if the string is to be further expanded, we need a
+ way to protect the CTLESC and CTLNUL characters. As I write this,
+ the current callers will never cause the string to be expanded without
+ going through the shell parser, which will protect the internal
+ quoting characters. */
+char *
+sh_backslash_quote (string)
+ char *string;
+{
+ int c;
+ char *result, *r, *s;
+
+ result = (char *)xmalloc (2 * strlen (string) + 1);
+
+ for (r = result, s = string; s && (c = *s); s++)
+ {
+ switch (c)
+ {
+ case ' ': case '\t': case '\n': /* IFS white space */
+ case '\'': case '"': case '\\': /* quoting chars */
+ case '|': case '&': case ';': /* shell metacharacters */
+ case '(': case ')': case '<': case '>':
+ case '!': case '{': case '}': /* reserved words */
+ case '*': case '[': case '?': case ']': /* globbing chars */
+ case '^':
+ case '$': case '`': /* expansion chars */
+ case ',': /* brace expansion */
+ *r++ = '\\';
+ *r++ = c;
+ break;
+#if 0
+ case '~': /* tilde expansion */
+ if (s == string || s[-1] == '=' || s[-1] == ':')
+ *r++ = '\\';
+ *r++ = c;
+ break;
+
+ case CTLESC: case CTLNUL: /* internal quoting characters */
+ *r++ = CTLESC; /* could be '\\'? */
+ *r++ = c;
+ break;
+#endif
+
+ case '#': /* comment char */
+ if (s == string)
+ *r++ = '\\';
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ default:
+ *r++ = c;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ *r = '\0';
+ return (result);
+}
+
+#if defined (PROMPT_STRING_DECODE)
+/* Quote characters that get special treatment when in double quotes in STRING
+ using backslashes. Return a new string. */
+char *
+sh_backslash_quote_for_double_quotes (string)
+ char *string;
+{
+ unsigned char c;
+ char *result, *r, *s;
+
+ result = (char *)xmalloc (2 * strlen (string) + 1);
+
+ for (r = result, s = string; s && (c = *s); s++)
+ {
+ if (sh_syntaxtab[c] & CBSDQUOTE)
+ *r++ = '\\';
+ /* I should probably add flags for these to sh_syntaxtab[] */
+ else if (c == CTLESC || c == CTLNUL)
+ *r++ = CTLESC; /* could be '\\'? */
+
+ *r++ = c;
+ }
+
+ *r = '\0';
+ return (result);
+}
+#endif /* PROMPT_STRING_DECODE */
+
+int
+sh_contains_shell_metas (string)
+ char *string;
+{
+ char *s;
+
+ for (s = string; s && *s; s++)
+ {
+ switch (*s)
+ {
+ case ' ': case '\t': case '\n': /* IFS white space */
+ case '\'': case '"': case '\\': /* quoting chars */
+ case '|': case '&': case ';': /* shell metacharacters */
+ case '(': case ')': case '<': case '>':
+ case '!': case '{': case '}': /* reserved words */
+ case '*': case '[': case '?': case ']': /* globbing chars */
+ case '^':
+ case '$': case '`': /* expansion chars */
+ return (1);
+ case '~': /* tilde expansion */
+ if (s == string || s[-1] == '=' || s[-1] == ':')
+ return (1);
+ break;
+ case '#':
+ if (s == string) /* comment char */
+ return (1);
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ default:
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ return (0);
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/shtty.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/shtty.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..15cc82f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/shtty.c
@@ -0,0 +1,284 @@
+/* Copyright (C) 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+/*
+ * shtty.c -- abstract interface to the terminal, focusing on capabilities.
+ */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <shtty.h>
+
+static TTYSTRUCT ttin, ttout;
+static int ttsaved = 0;
+
+int
+ttgetattr(fd, ttp)
+int fd;
+TTYSTRUCT *ttp;
+{
+#ifdef TERMIOS_TTY_DRIVER
+ return tcgetattr(fd, ttp);
+#else
+# ifdef TERMIO_TTY_DRIVER
+ return ioctl(fd, TCGETA, ttp);
+# else
+ return ioctl(fd, TIOCGETP, ttp);
+# endif
+#endif
+}
+
+int
+ttsetattr(fd, ttp)
+int fd;
+TTYSTRUCT *ttp;
+{
+#ifdef TERMIOS_TTY_DRIVER
+ return tcsetattr(fd, TCSADRAIN, ttp);
+#else
+# ifdef TERMIO_TTY_DRIVER
+ return ioctl(fd, TCSETAW, ttp);
+# else
+ return ioctl(fd, TIOCSETN, ttp);
+# endif
+#endif
+}
+
+void
+ttsave()
+{
+ if (ttsaved)
+ return;
+ ttgetattr (0, &ttin);
+ ttgetattr (1, &ttout);
+ ttsaved = 1;
+}
+
+void
+ttrestore()
+{
+ if (ttsaved == 0)
+ return;
+ ttsetattr (0, &ttin);
+ ttsetattr (1, &ttout);
+ ttsaved = 0;
+}
+
+/* Retrieve the attributes associated with tty fd FD. */
+TTYSTRUCT *
+ttattr (fd)
+ int fd;
+{
+ if (ttsaved == 0)
+ return ((TTYSTRUCT *)0);
+ if (fd == 0)
+ return &ttin;
+ else if (fd == 1)
+ return &ttout;
+ else
+ return ((TTYSTRUCT *)0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Change attributes in ttp so that when it is installed using
+ * ttsetattr, the terminal will be in one-char-at-a-time mode.
+ */
+int
+tt_setonechar(ttp)
+ TTYSTRUCT *ttp;
+{
+#if defined (TERMIOS_TTY_DRIVER) || defined (TERMIO_TTY_DRIVER)
+
+ /* XXX - might not want this -- it disables erase and kill processing. */
+ ttp->c_lflag &= ~ICANON;
+
+ ttp->c_lflag |= ISIG;
+# ifdef IEXTEN
+ ttp->c_lflag |= IEXTEN;
+# endif
+
+ ttp->c_iflag |= ICRNL; /* make sure we get CR->NL on input */
+ ttp->c_iflag &= ~INLCR; /* but no NL->CR */
+
+# ifdef OPOST
+ ttp->c_oflag |= OPOST;
+# endif
+# ifdef ONLCR
+ ttp->c_oflag |= ONLCR;
+# endif
+# ifdef OCRNL
+ ttp->c_oflag &= ~OCRNL;
+# endif
+# ifdef ONOCR
+ ttp->c_oflag &= ~ONOCR;
+# endif
+# ifdef ONLRET
+ ttp->c_oflag &= ~ONLRET;
+# endif
+
+ ttp->c_cc[VMIN] = 1;
+ ttp->c_cc[VTIME] = 0;
+
+#else
+
+ ttp->sg_flags |= CBREAK;
+
+#endif
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Set the terminal into one-character-at-a-time mode */
+int
+ttonechar ()
+{
+ TTYSTRUCT tt;
+
+ if (ttsaved == 0)
+ return -1;
+ tt = ttin;
+ if (tt_setonechar(&tt) < 0)
+ return -1;
+ return (ttsetattr (0, &tt));
+}
+
+/*
+ * Change attributes in ttp so that when it is installed using
+ * ttsetattr, the terminal will be in no-echo mode.
+ */
+int
+tt_setnoecho(ttp)
+ TTYSTRUCT *ttp;
+{
+#if defined (TERMIOS_TTY_DRIVER) || defined (TERMIO_TTY_DRIVER)
+ ttp->c_lflag &= ~(ECHO|ECHOK|ECHONL);
+#else
+ ttp->sg_flags &= ~ECHO;
+#endif
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Set the terminal into no-echo mode */
+int
+ttnoecho ()
+{
+ TTYSTRUCT tt;
+
+ if (ttsaved == 0)
+ return -1;
+ tt = ttin;
+ if (tt_setnoecho (&tt) < 0)
+ return -1;
+ return (ttsetattr (0, &tt));
+}
+
+/*
+ * Change attributes in ttp so that when it is installed using
+ * ttsetattr, the terminal will be in eight-bit mode (pass8).
+ */
+int
+tt_seteightbit (ttp)
+ TTYSTRUCT *ttp;
+{
+#if defined (TERMIOS_TTY_DRIVER) || defined (TERMIO_TTY_DRIVER)
+ ttp->c_iflag &= ~ISTRIP;
+ ttp->c_cflag |= CS8;
+ ttp->c_cflag &= ~PARENB;
+#else
+ ttp->sg_flags |= ANYP;
+#endif
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Set the terminal into eight-bit mode */
+int
+tteightbit ()
+{
+ TTYSTRUCT tt;
+
+ if (ttsaved == 0)
+ return -1;
+ tt = ttin;
+ if (tt_seteightbit (&tt) < 0)
+ return -1;
+ return (ttsetattr (0, &tt));
+}
+
+/*
+ * Change attributes in ttp so that when it is installed using
+ * ttsetattr, the terminal will be in non-canonical input mode.
+ */
+int
+tt_setnocanon (ttp)
+ TTYSTRUCT *ttp;
+{
+#if defined (TERMIOS_TTY_DRIVER) || defined (TERMIO_TTY_DRIVER)
+ ttp->c_lflag &= ~ICANON;
+#endif
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Set the terminal into non-canonical mode */
+int
+ttnocanon ()
+{
+ TTYSTRUCT tt;
+
+ if (ttsaved == 0)
+ return -1;
+ tt = ttin;
+ if (tt_setnocanon (&tt) < 0)
+ return -1;
+ return (ttsetattr (0, &tt));
+}
+
+/*
+ * Change attributes in ttp so that when it is installed using
+ * ttsetattr, the terminal will be in cbreak, no-echo mode.
+ */
+int
+tt_setcbreak(ttp)
+ TTYSTRUCT *ttp;
+{
+ if (tt_setonechar (ttp) < 0)
+ return -1;
+ return (tt_setnoecho (ttp));
+}
+
+/* Set the terminal into cbreak (no-echo, one-character-at-a-time) mode */
+int
+ttcbreak ()
+{
+ TTYSTRUCT tt;
+
+ if (ttsaved == 0)
+ return -1;
+ tt = ttin;
+ if (tt_setcbreak (&tt) < 0)
+ return -1;
+ return (ttsetattr (0, &tt));
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/snprintf.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/snprintf.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..114135f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/snprintf.c
@@ -0,0 +1,2107 @@
+/*
+ build a test version with
+ gcc -g -DDRIVER -I../.. -I../../include -o test-snprintf snprintf.c fmtu*long.o
+*/
+
+/*
+ Unix snprintf implementation.
+ derived from inetutils/libinetutils/snprintf.c Version 1.1
+
+ Copyright (C) 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General License
+ along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 675 Mass Ave, Cambridge, MA 02139, USA.
+
+ Revision History:
+
+ 1.1:
+ * added changes from Miles Bader
+ * corrected a bug with %f
+ * added support for %#g
+ * added more comments :-)
+ 1.0:
+ * supporting must ANSI syntaxic_sugars
+ 0.0:
+ * support %s %c %d
+
+ THANKS(for the patches and ideas):
+ Miles Bader
+ Cyrille Rustom
+ Jacek Slabocewiz
+ Mike Parker(mouse)
+
+*/
+
+/*
+ * Currently doesn't handle (and bash/readline doesn't use):
+ * * *M$ width, precision specifications
+ * * %N$ numbered argument conversions
+ * * inf, nan floating values imperfect (if isinf(), isnan() not in libc)
+ * * support for `F' is imperfect with ldfallback(), since underlying
+ * printf may not handle it -- should ideally have another autoconf test
+ */
+
+#define FLOATING_POINT
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined(DRIVER) && !defined(HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+#define HAVE_LONG_LONG
+#define HAVE_LONG_DOUBLE
+#ifdef __linux__
+#define HAVE_PRINTF_A_FORMAT
+#endif
+#define HAVE_ISINF_IN_LIBC
+#define PREFER_STDARG
+#define HAVE_STRINGIZE
+#define HAVE_LIMITS_H
+#define HAVE_STDDEF_H
+#define HAVE_LOCALE_H
+#define intmax_t long
+#endif
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_SNPRINTF) || !defined (HAVE_ASPRINTF)
+
+#include <bashtypes.h>
+
+#if defined(PREFER_STDARG)
+# include <stdarg.h>
+#else
+# include <varargs.h>
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_LIMITS_H
+# include <limits.h>
+#endif
+#include <bashansi.h>
+#ifdef HAVE_STDDEF_H
+# include <stddef.h>
+#endif
+#include <chartypes.h>
+
+#ifdef HAVE_STDINT_H
+# include <stdint.h>
+#endif
+
+#ifdef FLOATING_POINT
+# include <float.h> /* for manifest constants */
+# include <stdio.h> /* for sprintf */
+#endif
+
+#include <typemax.h>
+
+#ifdef HAVE_LOCALE_H
+# include <locale.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "stdc.h"
+#include <shmbutil.h>
+
+#ifndef DRIVER
+# include "shell.h"
+#else
+# define FL_PREFIX 0x01 /* add 0x, 0X, or 0 prefix as appropriate */
+# define FL_ADDBASE 0x02 /* add base# prefix to converted value */
+# define FL_HEXUPPER 0x04 /* use uppercase when converting to hex */
+# define FL_UNSIGNED 0x08 /* don't add any sign */
+extern char *fmtulong __P((unsigned long int, int, char *, size_t, int));
+extern char *fmtullong __P((unsigned long long int, int, char *, size_t, int));
+#endif
+
+#ifndef FREE
+# define FREE(x) if (x) free (x)
+#endif
+
+/* Bound on length of the string representing an integer value of type T.
+ Subtract one for the sign bit if T is signed;
+ 302 / 1000 is log10 (2) rounded up;
+ add one for integer division truncation;
+ add one more for a minus sign if t is signed. */
+#define INT_STRLEN_BOUND(t) \
+ ((sizeof (t) * CHAR_BIT - TYPE_SIGNED (t)) * 302 / 1000 \
+ + 1 + TYPE_SIGNED (t))
+
+/* conversion flags */
+#define PF_ALTFORM 0x00001 /* # */
+#define PF_HEXPREFIX 0x00002 /* 0[Xx] */
+#define PF_LADJUST 0x00004 /* - */
+#define PF_ZEROPAD 0x00008 /* 0 */
+#define PF_PLUS 0x00010 /* + */
+#define PF_SPACE 0x00020 /* ' ' */
+#define PF_THOUSANDS 0x00040 /* ' */
+
+#define PF_DOT 0x00080 /* `.precision' */
+#define PF_STAR_P 0x00100 /* `*' after precision */
+#define PF_STAR_W 0x00200 /* `*' before or without precision */
+
+/* length modifiers */
+#define PF_SIGNEDCHAR 0x00400 /* hh */
+#define PF_SHORTINT 0x00800 /* h */
+#define PF_LONGINT 0x01000 /* l */
+#define PF_LONGLONG 0x02000 /* ll */
+#define PF_LONGDBL 0x04000 /* L */
+#define PF_INTMAX_T 0x08000 /* j */
+#define PF_SIZE_T 0x10000 /* z */
+#define PF_PTRDIFF_T 0x20000 /* t */
+
+#define PF_ALLOCBUF 0x40000 /* for asprintf, vasprintf */
+
+#define PFM_SN 0x01 /* snprintf, vsnprintf */
+#define PFM_AS 0x02 /* asprintf, vasprintf */
+
+#define ASBUFSIZE 128
+
+#define x_digs "0123456789abcdef"
+#define X_digs "0123456789ABCDEF"
+
+static char intbuf[INT_STRLEN_BOUND(unsigned long) + 1];
+
+static int decpoint;
+static int thoussep;
+static char *grouping;
+
+/*
+ * For the FLOATING POINT FORMAT :
+ * the challenge was finding a way to
+ * manipulate the Real numbers without having
+ * to resort to mathematical function(it
+ * would require to link with -lm) and not
+ * going down to the bit pattern(not portable)
+ *
+ * so a number, a real is:
+
+ real = integral + fraction
+
+ integral = ... + a(2)*10^2 + a(1)*10^1 + a(0)*10^0
+ fraction = b(1)*10^-1 + b(2)*10^-2 + ...
+
+ where:
+ 0 <= a(i) => 9
+ 0 <= b(i) => 9
+
+ from then it was simple math
+ */
+
+/*
+ * size of the buffer for the integral part
+ * and the fraction part
+ */
+#define MAX_INT 99 + 1 /* 1 for the null */
+#define MAX_FRACT 307 + 1
+
+/*
+ * These functions use static buffers to store the results,
+ * and so are not reentrant
+ */
+#define itoa(n) fmtulong(n, 10, intbuf, sizeof(intbuf), 0);
+#define dtoa(n, p, f) numtoa(n, 10, p, f)
+
+#define SWAP_INT(a,b) {int t; t = (a); (a) = (b); (b) = t;}
+
+#define GETARG(type) (va_arg(args, type))
+
+/* Macros that do proper sign extension and handle length modifiers. Used
+ for the integer conversion specifiers. */
+#define GETSIGNED(p) \
+ (((p)->flags & PF_LONGINT) \
+ ? GETARG (long) \
+ : (((p)->flags & PF_SHORTINT) ? (long)(short)GETARG (int) \
+ : (long)GETARG (int)))
+
+#define GETUNSIGNED(p) \
+ (((p)->flags & PF_LONGINT) \
+ ? GETARG (unsigned long) \
+ : (((p)->flags & PF_SHORTINT) ? (unsigned long)(unsigned short)GETARG (int) \
+ : (unsigned long)GETARG (unsigned int)))
+
+
+#ifdef HAVE_LONG_DOUBLE
+#define GETLDOUBLE(p) GETARG (long double)
+#endif
+#define GETDOUBLE(p) GETARG (double)
+
+#define SET_SIZE_FLAGS(p, type) \
+ if (sizeof (type) > sizeof (int)) \
+ (p)->flags |= PF_LONGINT; \
+ if (sizeof (type) > sizeof (long)) \
+ (p)->flags |= PF_LONGLONG;
+
+/* this struct holds everything we need */
+struct DATA
+{
+ int length;
+ char *base; /* needed for [v]asprintf */
+ char *holder;
+ int counter;
+ const char *pf;
+
+/* FLAGS */
+ int flags;
+ int justify;
+ int width, precision;
+ char pad;
+};
+
+/* the floating point stuff */
+#ifdef FLOATING_POINT
+static double pow_10 __P((int));
+static int log_10 __P((double));
+static double integral __P((double, double *));
+static char *numtoa __P((double, int, int, char **));
+#endif
+
+static void init_data __P((struct DATA *, char *, size_t, const char *, int));
+static void init_conv_flag __P((struct DATA *));
+
+/* for the format */
+#ifdef FLOATING_POINT
+static void floating __P((struct DATA *, double));
+static void exponent __P((struct DATA *, double));
+#endif
+static void number __P((struct DATA *, unsigned long, int));
+#ifdef HAVE_LONG_LONG
+static void lnumber __P((struct DATA *, unsigned long long, int));
+#endif
+static void pointer __P((struct DATA *, unsigned long));
+static void strings __P((struct DATA *, char *));
+
+#ifdef FLOATING_POINT
+# define FALLBACK_FMTSIZE 32
+# define FALLBACK_BASE 4096
+# define LFALLBACK_BASE 5120
+# ifdef HAVE_LONG_DOUBLE
+static void ldfallback __P((struct DATA *, const char *, const char *, long double));
+# endif
+static void dfallback __P((struct DATA *, const char *, const char *, double));
+#endif
+
+static char *groupnum __P((char *));
+
+#ifdef DRIVER
+static void memory_error_and_abort ();
+static void *xmalloc __P((size_t));
+static void *xrealloc __P((void *, size_t));
+static void xfree __P((void *));
+#else
+# include <xmalloc.h>
+#endif
+
+/* those are defines specific to snprintf to hopefully
+ * make the code clearer :-)
+ */
+#define RIGHT 1
+#define LEFT 0
+#define NOT_FOUND -1
+#define FOUND 1
+#define MAX_FIELD 15
+
+/* round off to the precision */
+#define ROUND(d, p) \
+ (d < 0.) ? \
+ d - pow_10(-(p)->precision) * 0.5 : \
+ d + pow_10(-(p)->precision) * 0.5
+
+/* set default precision */
+#define DEF_PREC(p) \
+ if ((p)->precision == NOT_FOUND) \
+ (p)->precision = 6
+
+/* put a char. increment the number of chars written even if we've exceeded
+ the vsnprintf/snprintf buffer size (for the return value) */
+#define PUT_CHAR(c, p) \
+ do \
+ { \
+ if (((p)->flags & PF_ALLOCBUF) && ((p)->counter >= (p)->length - 1)) \
+ { \
+ (p)->length += ASBUFSIZE; \
+ (p)->base = (char *)xrealloc((p)->base, (p)->length); \
+ (p)->holder = (p)->base + (p)->counter; /* in case reallocated */ \
+ } \
+ if ((p)->counter < (p)->length) \
+ *(p)->holder++ = (c); \
+ (p)->counter++; \
+ } \
+ while (0)
+
+/* Output a string. P->WIDTH has already been adjusted for padding. */
+#define PUT_STRING(string, len, p) \
+ do \
+ { \
+ PAD_RIGHT (p); \
+ while ((len)-- > 0) \
+ { \
+ PUT_CHAR (*(string), (p)); \
+ (string)++; \
+ } \
+ PAD_LEFT (p); \
+ } \
+ while (0)
+
+#define PUT_PLUS(d, p, zero) \
+ if ((d) > zero && (p)->justify == RIGHT) \
+ PUT_CHAR('+', p)
+
+#define PUT_SPACE(d, p, zero) \
+ if (((p)->flags & PF_SPACE) && (d) > zero) \
+ PUT_CHAR(' ', p)
+
+/* pad right */
+#define PAD_RIGHT(p) \
+ if ((p)->width > 0 && (p)->justify != LEFT) \
+ for (; (p)->width > 0; (p)->width--) \
+ PUT_CHAR((p)->pad, p)
+
+/* pad left */
+#define PAD_LEFT(p) \
+ if ((p)->width > 0 && (p)->justify == LEFT) \
+ for (; (p)->width > 0; (p)->width--) \
+ PUT_CHAR((p)->pad, p)
+
+/* if width and prec. in the args */
+#define STAR_ARGS(p) \
+ do { \
+ if ((p)->flags & PF_STAR_W) \
+ { \
+ (p)->width = GETARG (int); \
+ if ((p)->width < 0) \
+ { \
+ (p)->flags |= PF_LADJUST; \
+ (p)->justify = LEFT; \
+ (p)->width = -(p)->width; \
+ } \
+ } \
+ if ((p)->flags & PF_STAR_P) \
+ { \
+ (p)->precision = GETARG (int); \
+ if ((p)->precision < 0) \
+ { \
+ (p)->flags &= ~PF_STAR_P; \
+ (p)->precision = NOT_FOUND; \
+ } \
+ } \
+ } while (0)
+
+#if defined (HAVE_LOCALE_H)
+# define GETLOCALEDATA(d, t, g) \
+ do \
+ { \
+ struct lconv *lv; \
+ if ((d) == 0) { \
+ (d) = '.'; (t) = -1; (g) = 0; /* defaults */ \
+ lv = localeconv(); \
+ if (lv) \
+ { \
+ if (lv->decimal_point && lv->decimal_point[0]) \
+ (d) = lv->decimal_point[0]; \
+ if (lv->thousands_sep && lv->thousands_sep[0]) \
+ (t) = lv->thousands_sep[0]; \
+ (g) = lv->grouping ? lv->grouping : ""; \
+ if (*(g) == '\0' || *(g) == CHAR_MAX || (t) == -1) (g) = 0; \
+ } \
+ } \
+ } \
+ while (0);
+#else
+# define GETLOCALEDATA(d, t, g) \
+ ( (d) = '.', (t) = ',', g = "\003" )
+#endif
+
+#ifdef FLOATING_POINT
+/*
+ * Find the nth power of 10
+ */
+static double
+pow_10(n)
+ int n;
+{
+ double P;
+
+ /* handle common cases with fast switch statement. */
+ switch (n)
+ {
+ case -3: return .001;
+ case -2: return .01;
+ case -1: return .1;
+ case 0: return 1.;
+ case 1: return 10.;
+ case 2: return 100.;
+ case 3: return 1000.;
+ }
+
+ if (n < 0)
+ {
+ P = .0001;
+ for (n += 4; n < 0; n++)
+ P /= 10.;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ P = 10000.;
+ for (n -= 4; n > 0; n--)
+ P *= 10.;
+ }
+
+ return P;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Find the integral part of the log in base 10
+ * Note: this not a real log10()
+ I just need and approximation(integerpart) of x in:
+ 10^x ~= r
+ * log_10(200) = 2;
+ * log_10(250) = 2;
+ */
+static int
+log_10(r)
+ double r;
+{
+ int i = 0;
+ double result = 1.;
+
+ if (r < 0.)
+ r = -r;
+
+ if (r < 1.)
+ {
+ while (result >= r)
+ {
+ result /= 10.;
+ i++;
+ }
+ return (-i);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ while (result <= r)
+ {
+ result *= 10.;
+ i++;
+ }
+ return (i - 1);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+ * This function return the fraction part of a double
+ * and set in ip the integral part.
+ * In many ways it resemble the modf() found on most Un*x
+ */
+static double
+integral(real, ip)
+ double real;
+ double *ip;
+{
+ int j;
+ double i, s, p;
+ double real_integral = 0.;
+
+ /* take care of the obvious */
+ /* equal to zero ? */
+ if (real == 0.)
+ {
+ *ip = 0.;
+ return (0.);
+ }
+
+ /* negative number ? */
+ if (real < 0.)
+ real = -real;
+
+ /* a fraction ? */
+ if ( real < 1.)
+ {
+ *ip = 0.;
+ return real;
+ }
+
+ /* the real work :-) */
+ for (j = log_10(real); j >= 0; j--)
+ {
+ p = pow_10(j);
+ s = (real - real_integral)/p;
+ i = 0.;
+ while (i + 1. <= s)
+ i++;
+ real_integral += i*p;
+ }
+ *ip = real_integral;
+ return (real - real_integral);
+}
+
+#define PRECISION 1.e-6
+/*
+ * return an ascii representation of the integral part of the number
+ * and set fract to be an ascii representation of the fraction part
+ * the container for the fraction and the integral part or staticly
+ * declare with fix size
+ */
+static char *
+numtoa(number, base, precision, fract)
+ double number;
+ int base, precision;
+ char **fract;
+{
+ register int i, j;
+ double ip, fp; /* integer and fraction part */
+ double fraction;
+ int digits = MAX_INT - 1;
+ static char integral_part[MAX_INT];
+ static char fraction_part[MAX_FRACT];
+ double sign;
+ int ch;
+
+ /* taking care of the obvious case: 0.0 */
+ if (number == 0.)
+ {
+ integral_part[0] = '0';
+ integral_part[1] = '\0';
+ fraction_part[0] = '0';
+ fraction_part[1] = '\0';
+ if (fract)
+ *fract = fraction_part;
+ return integral_part;
+ }
+
+ /* for negative numbers */
+ if ((sign = number) < 0.)
+ {
+ number = -number;
+ digits--; /* sign consume one digit */
+ }
+
+ fraction = integral(number, &ip);
+ number = ip;
+
+ /* do the integral part */
+ if (ip == 0.)
+ {
+ integral_part[0] = '0';
+ i = 1;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ for ( i = 0; i < digits && number != 0.; ++i)
+ {
+ number /= base;
+ fp = integral(number, &ip);
+ ch = (int)((fp + PRECISION)*base); /* force to round */
+ integral_part[i] = (ch <= 9) ? ch + '0' : ch + 'a' - 10;
+ if (! ISXDIGIT((unsigned char)integral_part[i]))
+ break; /* bail out overflow !! */
+ number = ip;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Oh No !! out of bound, ho well fill it up ! */
+ if (number != 0.)
+ for (i = 0; i < digits; ++i)
+ integral_part[i] = '9';
+
+ /* put the sign ? */
+ if (sign < 0.)
+ integral_part[i++] = '-';
+
+ integral_part[i] = '\0';
+
+ /* reverse every thing */
+ for ( i--, j = 0; j < i; j++, i--)
+ SWAP_INT(integral_part[i], integral_part[j]);
+
+ /* the fractional part */
+ for (i=0, fp=fraction; precision > 0 && i < MAX_FRACT ; i++, precision--)
+ {
+ fraction_part[i] = (int)((fp + PRECISION)*10. + '0');
+ if (! DIGIT(fraction_part[i])) /* underflow ? */
+ break;
+ fp = (fp*10.0) - (double)(long)((fp + PRECISION)*10.);
+ }
+ fraction_part[i] = '\0';
+
+ if (fract != (char **)0)
+ *fract = fraction_part;
+
+ return integral_part;
+}
+#endif
+
+/* for %d and friends, it puts in holder
+ * the representation with the right padding
+ */
+static void
+number(p, d, base)
+ struct DATA *p;
+ unsigned long d;
+ int base;
+{
+ char *tmp, *t;
+ long sd;
+ int flags;
+
+ sd = d; /* signed for ' ' padding in base 10 */
+ flags = (*p->pf == 'u' || *p->pf == 'U') ? FL_UNSIGNED : 0;
+ if (*p->pf == 'X')
+ flags |= FL_HEXUPPER;
+
+ tmp = fmtulong (d, base, intbuf, sizeof(intbuf), flags);
+ t = 0;
+ if ((p->flags & PF_THOUSANDS))
+ {
+ GETLOCALEDATA(decpoint, thoussep, grouping);
+ if (grouping && (t = groupnum (tmp)))
+ tmp = t;
+ }
+
+ p->width -= strlen(tmp);
+ PAD_RIGHT(p);
+
+ switch (base)
+ {
+ case 10:
+ PUT_PLUS(sd, p, 0);
+ PUT_SPACE(sd, p, 0);
+ break;
+ case 8:
+ if (p->flags & PF_ALTFORM)
+ PUT_CHAR('0', p);
+ break;
+ case 16:
+ if (p->flags & PF_ALTFORM)
+ {
+ PUT_CHAR('0', p);
+ PUT_CHAR(*p->pf, p);
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+
+ while (*tmp)
+ {
+ PUT_CHAR(*tmp, p);
+ tmp++;
+ }
+
+ PAD_LEFT(p);
+ FREE (t);
+}
+
+#ifdef HAVE_LONG_LONG
+/*
+ * identical to number() but works for `long long'
+ */
+static void
+lnumber(p, d, base)
+ struct DATA *p;
+ unsigned long long d;
+ int base;
+{
+ char *tmp, *t;
+ long long sd;
+ int flags;
+
+ sd = d; /* signed for ' ' padding in base 10 */
+ flags = (*p->pf == 'u' || *p->pf == 'U') ? FL_UNSIGNED : 0;
+ if (*p->pf == 'X')
+ flags |= FL_HEXUPPER;
+
+ tmp = fmtullong (d, base, intbuf, sizeof(intbuf), flags);
+ t = 0;
+ if ((p->flags & PF_THOUSANDS))
+ {
+ GETLOCALEDATA(decpoint, thoussep, grouping);
+ if (grouping && (t = groupnum (tmp)))
+ tmp = t;
+ }
+
+ p->width -= strlen(tmp);
+ PAD_RIGHT(p);
+
+ switch (base)
+ {
+ case 10:
+ PUT_PLUS(sd, p, 0);
+ PUT_SPACE(sd, p, 0);
+ break;
+ case 8:
+ if (p->flags & PF_ALTFORM)
+ PUT_CHAR('0', p);
+ break;
+ case 16:
+ if (p->flags & PF_ALTFORM)
+ {
+ PUT_CHAR('0', p);
+ PUT_CHAR(*p->pf, p);
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+
+ while (*tmp)
+ {
+ PUT_CHAR(*tmp, p);
+ tmp++;
+ }
+
+ PAD_LEFT(p);
+ FREE (t);
+}
+#endif
+
+static void
+pointer(p, d)
+ struct DATA *p;
+ unsigned long d;
+{
+ char *tmp;
+
+ tmp = fmtulong(d, 16, intbuf, sizeof(intbuf), 0);
+ p->width -= strlen(tmp);
+ PAD_RIGHT(p);
+
+ /* prefix '0x' for pointers */
+ PUT_CHAR('0', p);
+ PUT_CHAR('x', p);
+
+ while (*tmp)
+ {
+ PUT_CHAR(*tmp, p);
+ tmp++;
+ }
+ PAD_LEFT(p);
+}
+
+/* %s strings */
+static void
+strings(p, tmp)
+ struct DATA *p;
+ char *tmp;
+{
+ size_t len;
+
+ len = strlen(tmp);
+ if (p->precision != NOT_FOUND) /* the smallest number */
+ len = (len < p->precision ? len : p->precision);
+ p->width -= len;
+
+ PUT_STRING (tmp, len, p);
+}
+
+#if HANDLE_MULTIBYTE
+/* %ls wide-character strings */
+static void
+wstrings(p, tmp)
+ struct DATA *p;
+ wchar_t *tmp;
+{
+ size_t len;
+ mbstate_t mbs;
+ char *os;
+ const wchar_t *ws;
+
+ memset (&mbs, '\0', sizeof (mbstate_t));
+ ws = (const wchar_t *)tmp;
+
+ os = (char *)NULL;
+ if (p->precision != NOT_FOUND)
+ {
+ os = (char *)xmalloc (p->precision + 1);
+ len = wcsrtombs (os, &ws, p->precision, &mbs);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ len = wcsrtombs (NULL, &ws, 0, &mbs);
+ if (len != (size_t)-1)
+ {
+ memset (&mbs, '\0', sizeof (mbstate_t));
+ os = (char *)xmalloc (len + 1);
+ (void)wcsrtombs (os, &ws, len + 1, &mbs);
+ }
+ }
+ if (len == (size_t)-1)
+ {
+ /* invalid multibyte sequence; bail now. */
+ FREE (os);
+ return;
+ }
+
+ p->width -= len;
+ PUT_STRING (os, len, p);
+ free (os);
+}
+
+static void
+wchars (p, wc)
+ struct DATA *p;
+ wint_t wc;
+{
+ char *lbuf, *l;
+ mbstate_t mbs;
+ size_t len;
+
+ lbuf = (char *)malloc (MB_CUR_MAX+1);
+ if (lbuf == 0)
+ return;
+ memset (&mbs, '\0', sizeof (mbstate_t));
+ len = wcrtomb (lbuf, wc, &mbs);
+ if (len == (size_t)-1)
+ /* conversion failed; bail now. */
+ return;
+ p->width -= len;
+ l = lbuf;
+ PUT_STRING (l, len, p);
+ free (lbuf);
+}
+#endif /* HANDLE_MULTIBYTE */
+
+#ifdef FLOATING_POINT
+
+#ifndef HAVE_ISINF_IN_LIBC
+/* Half-assed versions, since we don't want to link with libm. */
+static int
+isinf(d)
+ double d;
+{
+#ifdef DBL_MAX
+ if (d < DBL_MIN)
+ return -1;
+ else if (d > DBL_MAX)
+ return 1;
+ else
+#endif
+ return 0;
+}
+
+static int
+isnan(d)
+ double d;
+{
+ return 0;
+}
+#endif
+
+/* Check for [+-]infinity and NaN. If MODE == 1, we check for Infinity, else
+ (mode == 2) we check for NaN. This does the necessary printing. Returns
+ 1 if Inf or Nan, 0 if not. */
+static int
+chkinfnan(p, d, mode)
+ struct DATA *p;
+ double d;
+ int mode; /* == 1 for inf, == 2 for nan */
+{
+ int i;
+ char *tmp;
+ char *big, *small;
+
+ i = (mode == 1) ? isinf(d) : isnan(d);
+ if (i == 0)
+ return 0;
+ big = (mode == 1) ? "INF" : "NAN";
+ small = (mode == 1) ? "inf" : "nan";
+
+ tmp = (*p->pf == 'F' || *p->pf == 'G' || *p->pf == 'E') ? big : small;
+
+ if (i < 0)
+ PUT_CHAR('-', p);
+
+ while (*tmp)
+ {
+ PUT_CHAR (*tmp, p);
+ tmp++;
+ }
+
+ return 1;
+}
+
+/* %f %F %g %G floating point representation */
+static void
+floating(p, d)
+ struct DATA *p;
+ double d;
+{
+ char *tmp, *tmp2, *t;
+ int i;
+
+ if (d != 0 && (chkinfnan(p, d, 1) || chkinfnan(p, d, 2)))
+ return; /* already printed nan or inf */
+
+ GETLOCALEDATA(decpoint, thoussep, grouping);
+ DEF_PREC(p);
+ d = ROUND(d, p);
+ tmp = dtoa(d, p->precision, &tmp2);
+ t = 0;
+ if ((p->flags & PF_THOUSANDS) && grouping && (t = groupnum (tmp)))
+ tmp = t;
+
+ /* calculate the padding. 1 for the dot */
+ p->width = p->width -
+ ((d > 0. && p->justify == RIGHT) ? 1:0) -
+ ((p->flags & PF_SPACE) ? 1:0) -
+ strlen(tmp) - p->precision - 1;
+ PAD_RIGHT(p);
+ PUT_PLUS(d, p, 0.);
+ PUT_SPACE(d, p, 0.);
+
+ while (*tmp)
+ {
+ PUT_CHAR(*tmp, p); /* the integral */
+ tmp++;
+ }
+ FREE (t);
+
+ if (p->precision != 0 || (p->flags & PF_ALTFORM))
+ PUT_CHAR(decpoint, p); /* put the '.' */
+
+ if ((*p->pf == 'g' || *p->pf == 'G') && (p->flags & PF_ALTFORM) == 0)
+ /* smash the trailing zeros unless altform */
+ for (i = strlen(tmp2) - 1; i >= 0 && tmp2[i] == '0'; i--)
+ tmp2[i] = '\0';
+
+ for (; *tmp2; tmp2++)
+ PUT_CHAR(*tmp2, p); /* the fraction */
+
+ PAD_LEFT(p);
+}
+
+/* %e %E %g %G exponent representation */
+static void
+exponent(p, d)
+ struct DATA *p;
+ double d;
+{
+ char *tmp, *tmp2;
+ int j, i;
+
+ if (chkinfnan(p, d, 1) || chkinfnan(p, d, 2))
+ return; /* already printed nan or inf */
+
+ GETLOCALEDATA(decpoint, thoussep, grouping);
+ DEF_PREC(p);
+ j = log_10(d);
+ d = d / pow_10(j); /* get the Mantissa */
+ d = ROUND(d, p);
+ tmp = dtoa(d, p->precision, &tmp2);
+
+ /* 1 for unit, 1 for the '.', 1 for 'e|E',
+ * 1 for '+|-', 2 for 'exp' */
+ /* calculate how much padding need */
+ p->width = p->width -
+ ((d > 0. && p->justify == RIGHT) ? 1:0) -
+ ((p->flags & PF_SPACE) ? 1:0) - p->precision - 6;
+
+ PAD_RIGHT(p);
+ PUT_PLUS(d, p, 0.);
+ PUT_SPACE(d, p, 0.);
+
+ while (*tmp)
+ {
+ PUT_CHAR(*tmp, p);
+ tmp++;
+ }
+
+ if (p->precision != 0 || (p->flags & PF_ALTFORM))
+ PUT_CHAR(decpoint, p); /* the '.' */
+
+ if ((*p->pf == 'g' || *p->pf == 'G') && (p->flags & PF_ALTFORM) == 0)
+ /* smash the trailing zeros unless altform */
+ for (i = strlen(tmp2) - 1; i >= 0 && tmp2[i] == '0'; i--)
+ tmp2[i] = '\0';
+
+ for (; *tmp2; tmp2++)
+ PUT_CHAR(*tmp2, p); /* the fraction */
+
+ /* the exponent put the 'e|E' */
+ if (*p->pf == 'g' || *p->pf == 'e')
+ PUT_CHAR('e', p);
+ else
+ PUT_CHAR('E', p);
+
+ /* the sign of the exp */
+ if (j >= 0)
+ PUT_CHAR('+', p);
+ else
+ {
+ PUT_CHAR('-', p);
+ j = -j;
+ }
+
+ tmp = itoa(j);
+ /* pad out to at least two spaces. pad with `0' if the exponent is a
+ single digit. */
+ if (j <= 9)
+ PUT_CHAR('0', p);
+
+ /* the exponent */
+ while (*tmp)
+ {
+ PUT_CHAR(*tmp, p);
+ tmp++;
+ }
+ PAD_LEFT(p);
+}
+#endif
+
+/* Return a new string with the digits in S grouped according to the locale's
+ grouping info and thousands separator. If no grouping should be performed,
+ this returns NULL; the caller needs to check for it. */
+static char *
+groupnum (s)
+ char *s;
+{
+ char *se, *ret, *re, *g;
+ int len, slen;
+
+ if (grouping == 0 || *grouping <= 0 || *grouping == CHAR_MAX)
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+
+ /* find min grouping to size returned string */
+ for (len = *grouping, g = grouping; *g; g++)
+ if (*g > 0 && *g < len)
+ len = *g;
+
+ slen = strlen (s);
+ len = slen / len + 1;
+ ret = (char *)xmalloc (slen + len + 1);
+ re = ret + slen + len;
+ *re = '\0';
+
+ g = grouping;
+ se = s + slen;
+ len = *g;
+
+ while (se > s)
+ {
+ *--re = *--se;
+
+ /* handle `-' inserted by numtoa() and the fmtu* family here. */
+ if (se > s && se[-1] == '-')
+ continue;
+
+ /* begin new group. */
+ if (--len == 0 && se > s)
+ {
+ *--re = thoussep;
+ len = *++g; /* was g++, but that uses first char twice (glibc bug, too) */
+ if (*g == '\0')
+ len = *--g; /* use previous grouping */
+ else if (*g == CHAR_MAX)
+ {
+ do
+ *--re = *--se;
+ while (se > s);
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (re > ret)
+#ifdef HAVE_MEMMOVE
+ memmove (ret, re, strlen (re) + 1);
+#else
+ strcpy (ret, re);
+#endif
+
+ return ret;
+}
+
+/* initialize the conversion specifiers */
+static void
+init_conv_flag (p)
+ struct DATA *p;
+{
+ p->flags &= PF_ALLOCBUF; /* preserve PF_ALLOCBUF flag */
+ p->precision = p->width = NOT_FOUND;
+ p->justify = NOT_FOUND;
+ p->pad = ' ';
+}
+
+static void
+init_data (p, string, length, format, mode)
+ struct DATA *p;
+ char *string;
+ size_t length;
+ const char *format;
+ int mode;
+{
+ p->length = length - 1; /* leave room for '\0' */
+ p->holder = p->base = string;
+ p->pf = format;
+ p->counter = 0;
+ p->flags = (mode == PFM_AS) ? PF_ALLOCBUF : 0;
+}
+
+static int
+#if defined (__STDC__)
+vsnprintf_internal(struct DATA *data, char *string, size_t length, const char *format, va_list args)
+#else
+vsnprintf_internal(data, string, length, format, args)
+ struct DATA *data;
+ char *string;
+ size_t length;
+ const char *format;
+ va_list args;
+#endif
+{
+ double d; /* temporary holder */
+#ifdef HAVE_LONG_DOUBLE
+ long double ld; /* for later */
+#endif
+ unsigned long ul;
+#ifdef HAVE_LONG_LONG
+ unsigned long long ull;
+#endif
+ int state, i, c, n;
+ char *s;
+#if HANDLE_MULTIBYTE
+ wchar_t *ws;
+ wint_t wc;
+#endif
+ const char *convstart;
+ int negprec;
+
+ /* Sanity check, the string length must be >= 0. C99 actually says that
+ LENGTH can be zero here, in the case of snprintf/vsnprintf (it's never
+ 0 in the case of asprintf/vasprintf), and the return value is the number
+ of characters that would have been written. */
+ if (length < 0)
+ return -1;
+
+ if (format == 0)
+ return 0;
+
+ /* Reset these for each call because the locale might have changed. */
+ decpoint = thoussep = 0;
+ grouping = 0;
+
+ negprec = 0;
+ for (; c = *(data->pf); data->pf++)
+ {
+ if (c != '%')
+ {
+ PUT_CHAR (c, data);
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ convstart = data->pf;
+ init_conv_flag (data); /* initialise format flags */
+
+ state = 1;
+ for (state = 1; state && *data->pf; )
+ {
+ c = *(++data->pf);
+ /* fmtend = data->pf */
+#if defined (FLOATING_POINT) && defined (HAVE_LONG_DOUBLE)
+ if (data->flags & PF_LONGDBL)
+ {
+ switch (c)
+ {
+ case 'f': case 'F':
+ case 'e': case 'E':
+ case 'g': case 'G':
+# ifdef HAVE_PRINTF_A_FORMAT
+ case 'a': case 'A':
+# endif
+ STAR_ARGS (data);
+ ld = GETLDOUBLE (data);
+ ldfallback (data, convstart, data->pf, ld);
+ goto conv_break;
+ }
+ }
+#endif /* FLOATING_POINT && HAVE_LONG_DOUBLE */
+
+ switch (c)
+ {
+ /* Parse format flags */
+ case '\0': /* a NULL here ? ? bail out */
+ *data->holder = '\0';
+ return data->counter;
+ break;
+ case '#':
+ data->flags |= PF_ALTFORM;
+ continue;
+ case '0':
+ data->flags |= PF_ZEROPAD;
+ data->pad = '0';
+ continue;
+ case '*':
+ if (data->flags & PF_DOT)
+ data->flags |= PF_STAR_P;
+ else
+ data->flags |= PF_STAR_W;
+ continue;
+ case '-':
+ if ((data->flags & PF_DOT) == 0)
+ {
+ data->flags |= PF_LADJUST;
+ data->justify = LEFT;
+ }
+ else
+ negprec = 1;
+ continue;
+ case ' ':
+ if ((data->flags & PF_PLUS) == 0)
+ data->flags |= PF_SPACE;
+ continue;
+ case '+':
+ if ((data->flags & PF_DOT) == 0)
+ {
+ data->flags |= PF_PLUS;
+ data->justify = RIGHT;
+ }
+ continue;
+ case '\'':
+ data->flags |= PF_THOUSANDS;
+ continue;
+
+ case '1': case '2': case '3':
+ case '4': case '5': case '6':
+ case '7': case '8': case '9':
+ n = 0;
+ do
+ {
+ n = n * 10 + TODIGIT(c);
+ c = *(++data->pf);
+ }
+ while (DIGIT(c));
+ data->pf--; /* went too far */
+ if (n < 0)
+ n = 0;
+ if (data->flags & PF_DOT)
+ data->precision = negprec ? NOT_FOUND : n;
+ else
+ data->width = n;
+ continue;
+
+ /* optional precision */
+ case '.':
+ data->flags |= PF_DOT;
+ data->precision = 0;
+ continue;
+
+ /* length modifiers */
+ case 'h':
+ data->flags |= (data->flags & PF_SHORTINT) ? PF_SIGNEDCHAR : PF_SHORTINT;
+ continue;
+ case 'l':
+ data->flags |= (data->flags & PF_LONGINT) ? PF_LONGLONG : PF_LONGINT;
+ continue;
+ case 'L':
+ data->flags |= PF_LONGDBL;
+ continue;
+ case 'q':
+ data->flags |= PF_LONGLONG;
+ continue;
+ case 'j':
+ data->flags |= PF_INTMAX_T;
+ SET_SIZE_FLAGS(data, intmax_t);
+ continue;
+ case 'z':
+ data->flags |= PF_SIZE_T;
+ SET_SIZE_FLAGS(data, size_t);
+ continue;
+ case 't':
+ data->flags |= PF_PTRDIFF_T;
+ SET_SIZE_FLAGS(data, ptrdiff_t);
+ continue;
+
+ /* Conversion specifiers */
+#ifdef FLOATING_POINT
+ case 'f': /* float, double */
+ case 'F':
+ STAR_ARGS(data);
+ d = GETDOUBLE(data);
+ floating(data, d);
+conv_break:
+ state = 0;
+ break;
+ case 'g':
+ case 'G':
+ STAR_ARGS(data);
+ DEF_PREC(data);
+ d = GETDOUBLE(data);
+ i = log_10(d);
+ /*
+ * for '%g|%G' ANSI: use f if exponent
+ * is in the range or [-4,p] exclusively
+ * else use %e|%E
+ */
+ if (-4 < i && i < data->precision)
+ {
+ /* reset precision */
+ data->precision -= i + 1;
+ floating(data, d);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* reduce precision by 1 because of leading digit before
+ decimal point in e format. */
+ data->precision--;
+ exponent(data, d);
+ }
+ state = 0;
+ break;
+ case 'e':
+ case 'E': /* Exponent double */
+ STAR_ARGS(data);
+ d = GETDOUBLE(data);
+ exponent(data, d);
+ state = 0;
+ break;
+# ifdef HAVE_PRINTF_A_FORMAT
+ case 'a':
+ case 'A':
+ STAR_ARGS(data);
+ d = GETDOUBLE(data);
+ dfallback(data, convstart, data->pf, d);
+ state = 0;
+ break;
+# endif /* HAVE_PRINTF_A_FORMAT */
+#endif /* FLOATING_POINT */
+ case 'U':
+ data->flags |= PF_LONGINT;
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ case 'u':
+ STAR_ARGS(data);
+#ifdef HAVE_LONG_LONG
+ if (data->flags & PF_LONGLONG)
+ {
+ ull = GETARG (unsigned long long);
+ lnumber(data, ull, 10);
+ }
+ else
+#endif
+ {
+ ul = GETUNSIGNED(data);
+ number(data, ul, 10);
+ }
+ state = 0;
+ break;
+ case 'D':
+ data->flags |= PF_LONGINT;
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ case 'd': /* decimal */
+ case 'i':
+ STAR_ARGS(data);
+#ifdef HAVE_LONG_LONG
+ if (data->flags & PF_LONGLONG)
+ {
+ ull = GETARG (long long);
+ lnumber(data, ull, 10);
+ }
+ else
+#endif
+ {
+ ul = GETSIGNED(data);
+ number(data, ul, 10);
+ }
+ state = 0;
+ break;
+ case 'o': /* octal */
+ STAR_ARGS(data);
+#ifdef HAVE_LONG_LONG
+ if (data->flags & PF_LONGLONG)
+ {
+ ull = GETARG (unsigned long long);
+ lnumber(data, ull, 8);
+ }
+ else
+#endif
+ {
+ ul = GETUNSIGNED(data);
+ number(data, ul, 8);
+ }
+ state = 0;
+ break;
+ case 'x':
+ case 'X': /* hexadecimal */
+ STAR_ARGS(data);
+#ifdef HAVE_LONG_LONG
+ if (data->flags & PF_LONGLONG)
+ {
+ ull = GETARG (unsigned long long);
+ lnumber(data, ull, 16);
+ }
+ else
+#endif
+ {
+ ul = GETUNSIGNED(data);
+ number(data, ul, 16);
+ }
+ state = 0;
+ break;
+ case 'p':
+ STAR_ARGS(data);
+ ul = (unsigned long)GETARG (void *);
+ pointer(data, ul);
+ state = 0;
+ break;
+#if HANDLE_MULTIBYTE
+ case 'C':
+ data->flags |= PF_LONGINT;
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+#endif
+ case 'c': /* character */
+ STAR_ARGS(data);
+#if HANDLE_MULTIBYTE
+ if (data->flags & PF_LONGINT)
+ {
+ wc = GETARG (wint_t);
+ wchars (data, wc);
+ }
+ else
+#endif
+ {
+ ul = GETARG (int);
+ PUT_CHAR(ul, data);
+ }
+ state = 0;
+ break;
+#if HANDLE_MULTIBYTE
+ case 'S':
+ data->flags |= PF_LONGINT;
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+#endif
+ case 's': /* string */
+ STAR_ARGS(data);
+#if HANDLE_MULTIBYTE
+ if (data->flags & PF_LONGINT)
+ {
+ ws = GETARG (wchar_t *);
+ wstrings (data, ws);
+ }
+ else
+#endif
+ {
+ s = GETARG (char *);
+ strings(data, s);
+ }
+ state = 0;
+ break;
+ case 'n':
+#ifdef HAVE_LONG_LONG
+ if (data->flags & PF_LONGLONG)
+ *(GETARG (long long *)) = data->counter;
+ else
+#endif
+ if (data->flags & PF_LONGINT)
+ *(GETARG (long *)) = data->counter;
+ else if (data->flags & PF_SHORTINT)
+ *(GETARG (short *)) = data->counter;
+ else
+ *(GETARG (int *)) = data->counter;
+ state = 0;
+ break;
+ case '%': /* nothing just % */
+ PUT_CHAR('%', data);
+ state = 0;
+ break;
+ default:
+ /* is this an error ? maybe bail out */
+ state = 0;
+ break;
+ } /* end switch */
+ } /* end of `%' for loop */
+ } /* end of format string for loop */
+
+ if (data->length >= 0)
+ *data->holder = '\0'; /* the end ye ! */
+
+ return data->counter;
+}
+
+#if defined (FLOATING_POINT) && defined (HAVE_LONG_DOUBLE)
+/*
+ * Printing floating point numbers accurately is an art. I'm not good
+ * at it. Fall back to sprintf for long double formats.
+ */
+static void
+ldfallback (data, fs, fe, ld)
+ struct DATA *data;
+ const char *fs, *fe;
+ long double ld;
+{
+ register char *x;
+ char fmtbuf[FALLBACK_FMTSIZE], *obuf;
+ int fl;
+
+ fl = LFALLBACK_BASE + (data->precision < 6 ? 6 : data->precision) + 2;
+ obuf = (char *)xmalloc (fl);
+ fl = fe - fs + 1;
+ strncpy (fmtbuf, fs, fl);
+ fmtbuf[fl] = '\0';
+
+ if ((data->flags & PF_STAR_W) && (data->flags & PF_STAR_P))
+ sprintf (obuf, fmtbuf, data->width, data->precision, ld);
+ else if (data->flags & PF_STAR_W)
+ sprintf (obuf, fmtbuf, data->width, ld);
+ else if (data->flags & PF_STAR_P)
+ sprintf (obuf, fmtbuf, data->precision, ld);
+ else
+ sprintf (obuf, fmtbuf, ld);
+
+ for (x = obuf; *x; x++)
+ PUT_CHAR (*x, data);
+ xfree (obuf);
+}
+#endif /* FLOATING_POINT && HAVE_LONG_DOUBLE */
+
+#ifdef FLOATING_POINT
+/* Used for %a, %A if the libc printf supports them. */
+static void
+dfallback (data, fs, fe, d)
+ struct DATA *data;
+ const char *fs, *fe;
+ double d;
+{
+ register char *x;
+ char fmtbuf[FALLBACK_FMTSIZE], obuf[FALLBACK_BASE];
+ int fl;
+
+ fl = fe - fs + 1;
+ strncpy (fmtbuf, fs, fl);
+ fmtbuf[fl] = '\0';
+
+ if ((data->flags & PF_STAR_W) && (data->flags & PF_STAR_P))
+ sprintf (obuf, fmtbuf, data->width, data->precision, d);
+ else if (data->flags & PF_STAR_W)
+ sprintf (obuf, fmtbuf, data->width, d);
+ else if (data->flags & PF_STAR_P)
+ sprintf (obuf, fmtbuf, data->precision, d);
+ else
+ sprintf (obuf, fmtbuf, d);
+
+ for (x = obuf; *x; x++)
+ PUT_CHAR (*x, data);
+}
+#endif /* FLOATING_POINT */
+
+#ifndef HAVE_SNPRINTF
+
+int
+#if defined (__STDC__)
+vsnprintf(char *string, size_t length, const char *format, va_list args)
+#else
+vsnprintf(string, length, format, args)
+ char *string;
+ size_t length;
+ const char *format;
+ va_list args;
+#endif
+{
+ struct DATA data;
+
+ if (string == 0 && length != 0)
+ return 0;
+ init_data (&data, string, length, format, PFM_SN);
+ return (vsnprintf_internal(&data, string, length, format, args));
+}
+
+int
+#if defined(PREFER_STDARG)
+snprintf(char *string, size_t length, const char * format, ...)
+#else
+snprintf(string, length, format, va_alist)
+ char *string;
+ size_t length;
+ const char *format;
+ va_dcl
+#endif
+{
+ struct DATA data;
+ int rval;
+ va_list args;
+
+ SH_VA_START(args, format);
+
+ if (string == 0 && length != 0)
+ return 0;
+ init_data (&data, string, length, format, PFM_SN);
+ rval = vsnprintf_internal (&data, string, length, format, args);
+
+ va_end(args);
+
+ return rval;
+}
+
+#endif /* HAVE_SNPRINTF */
+
+#ifndef HAVE_ASPRINTF
+
+int
+#if defined (__STDC__)
+vasprintf(char **stringp, const char *format, va_list args)
+#else
+vasprintf(stringp, format, args)
+ char **stringp;
+ const char *format;
+ va_list args;
+#endif
+{
+ struct DATA data;
+ char *string;
+ int r;
+
+ string = (char *)xmalloc(ASBUFSIZE);
+ init_data (&data, string, ASBUFSIZE, format, PFM_AS);
+ r = vsnprintf_internal(&data, string, ASBUFSIZE, format, args);
+ *stringp = data.base; /* not string in case reallocated */
+ return r;
+}
+
+int
+#if defined(PREFER_STDARG)
+asprintf(char **stringp, const char * format, ...)
+#else
+asprintf(stringp, format, va_alist)
+ char **stringp;
+ const char *format;
+ va_dcl
+#endif
+{
+ int rval;
+ va_list args;
+
+ SH_VA_START(args, format);
+
+ rval = vasprintf (stringp, format, args);
+
+ va_end(args);
+
+ return rval;
+}
+
+#endif
+
+#endif
+
+#ifdef DRIVER
+
+static void
+memory_error_and_abort ()
+{
+ write (2, "out of virtual memory\n", 22);
+ abort ();
+}
+
+static void *
+xmalloc(bytes)
+ size_t bytes;
+{
+ void *ret;
+
+ ret = malloc(bytes);
+ if (ret == 0)
+ memory_error_and_abort ();
+ return ret;
+}
+
+static void *
+xrealloc (pointer, bytes)
+ void *pointer;
+ size_t bytes;
+{
+ void *ret;
+
+ ret = pointer ? realloc(pointer, bytes) : malloc(bytes);
+ if (ret == 0)
+ memory_error_and_abort ();
+ return ret;
+}
+
+static void
+xfree(x)
+ void *x;
+{
+ if (x)
+ free (x);
+}
+
+/* set of small tests for snprintf() */
+main()
+{
+ char holder[100];
+ char *h;
+ int i, si, ai;
+
+#ifdef HAVE_LOCALE_H
+ setlocale(LC_ALL, "");
+#endif
+
+#if 1
+ si = snprintf((char *)NULL, 0, "abcde\n");
+ printf("snprintf returns %d with NULL first argument and size of 0\n", si);
+ si = snprintf(holder, 0, "abcde\n");
+ printf("snprintf returns %d with non-NULL first argument and size of 0\n", si);
+ si = snprintf((char *)NULL, 16, "abcde\n");
+ printf("snprintf returns %d with NULL first argument and non-zero size\n", si);
+
+/*
+ printf("Suite of test for snprintf:\n");
+ printf("a_format\n");
+ printf("printf() format\n");
+ printf("snprintf() format\n\n");
+*/
+/* Checking the field widths */
+
+ printf("/%%ld %%ld/, 336, 336\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%ld %ld/\n", 336, 336);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%ld %ld/\n", 336, 336);
+ printf("/%ld %ld/\n", 336, 336);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("/%%d/, 336\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%d/\n", 336);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%d/\n", 336);
+ printf("/%d/\n", 336);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("/%%2d/, 336\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%2d/\n", 336);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%2d/\n", 336);
+ printf("/%2d/\n", 336);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("/%%10d/, 336\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%10d/\n", 336);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%10d/\n", 336);
+ printf("/%10d/\n", 336);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("/%%-10d/, 336\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%-10d/\n", 336);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%-10d/\n", 336);
+ printf("/%-10d/\n", 336);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+
+/* floating points */
+
+ printf("/%%f/, 1234.56\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%f/\n", 1234.56);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%f/\n", 1234.56);
+ printf("/%f/\n", 1234.56);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("/%%e/, 1234.56\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%e/\n", 1234.56);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%e/\n", 1234.56);
+ printf("/%e/\n", 1234.56);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("/%%4.2f/, 1234.56\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%4.2f/\n", 1234.56);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%4.2f/\n", 1234.56);
+ printf("/%4.2f/\n", 1234.56);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("/%%3.1f/, 1234.56\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%3.1f/\n", 1234.56);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%3.1f/\n", 1234.56);
+ printf("/%3.1f/\n", 1234.56);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("/%%10.3f/, 1234.56\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%10.3f/\n", 1234.56);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%10.3f/\n", 1234.56);
+ printf("/%10.3f/\n", 1234.56);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("/%%10.3e/, 1234.56\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%10.3e/\n", 1234.56);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%10.3e/\n", 1234.56);
+ printf("/%10.3e/\n", 1234.56);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("/%%+4.2f/, 1234.56\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%+4.2f/\n", 1234.56);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%+4.2f/\n", 1234.56);
+ printf("/%+4.2f/\n", 1234.56);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("/%%010.2f/, 1234.56\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%010.2f/\n", 1234.56);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%010.2f/\n", 1234.56);
+ printf("/%010.2f/\n", 1234.56);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+#define BLURB "Outstanding acting !"
+/* strings precisions */
+
+ printf("/%%2s/, \"%s\"\n", BLURB);
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%2s/\n", BLURB);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%2s/\n", BLURB);
+ printf("/%2s/\n", BLURB);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("/%%22s/ %s\n", BLURB);
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%22s/\n", BLURB);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%22s/\n", BLURB);
+ printf("/%22s/\n", BLURB);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("/%%22.5s/ %s\n", BLURB);
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%22.5s/\n", BLURB);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%22.5s/\n", BLURB);
+ printf("/%22.5s/\n", BLURB);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("/%%-22.5s/ %s\n", BLURB);
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%-22.5s/\n", BLURB);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%-22.5s/\n", BLURB);
+ printf("/%-22.5s/\n", BLURB);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+/* see some flags */
+
+ printf("%%x %%X %%#x, 31, 31, 31\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "%x %X %#x\n", 31, 31, 31);
+ asprintf(&h, "%x %X %#x\n", 31, 31, 31);
+ printf("%x %X %#x\n", 31, 31, 31);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("**%%d**%% d**%% d**, 42, 42, -42\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "**%d**% d**% d**\n", 42, 42, -42);
+ asprintf(&h, "**%d**% d**% d**\n", 42, 42, -42);
+ printf("**%d**% d**% d**\n", 42, 42, -42);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+/* other flags */
+
+ printf("/%%g/, 31.4\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%g/\n", 31.4);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%g/\n", 31.4);
+ printf("/%g/\n", 31.4);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("/%%.6g/, 31.4\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%.6g/\n", 31.4);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%.6g/\n", 31.4);
+ printf("/%.6g/\n", 31.4);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("/%%.1G/, 31.4\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%.1G/\n", 31.4);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%.1G/\n", 31.4);
+ printf("/%.1G/\n", 31.4);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("/%%.1G/, 3100000000.4\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%.1G/\n", 3100000000.4);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%.1G/\n", 3100000000.4);
+ printf("/%.1G/\n", 3100000000.4);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("abc%%n\n");
+ printf("abc%n", &i); printf("%d\n", i);
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "abc%n", &i);
+ printf("%s", holder); printf("%d\n\n", i);
+ asprintf(&h, "abc%n", &i);
+ printf("%s", h); printf("%d\n\n", i);
+
+ printf("%%*.*s --> 10.10\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "%*.*s\n", 10, 10, BLURB);
+ asprintf(&h, "%*.*s\n", 10, 10, BLURB);
+ printf("%*.*s\n", 10, 10, BLURB);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("%%%%%%%%\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "%%%%\n");
+ asprintf(&h, "%%%%\n");
+ printf("%%%%\n");
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+#define BIG "Hello this is a too big string for the buffer"
+/* printf("A buffer to small of 10, trying to put this:\n");*/
+ printf("<%%>, %s\n", BIG);
+ i = snprintf(holder, 10, "%s\n", BIG);
+ i = asprintf(&h, "%s", BIG);
+ printf("<%s>\n", BIG);
+ printf("<%s>\n", holder);
+ printf("<%s>\n\n", h);
+
+ printf ("<%%p> vsnprintf\n");
+ i = snprintf(holder, 100, "%p", vsnprintf);
+ i = asprintf(&h, "%p", vsnprintf);
+ printf("<%p>\n", vsnprintf);
+ printf("<%s>\n", holder);
+ printf("<%s>\n\n", h);
+
+ printf ("<%%lu> LONG_MAX+1\n");
+ i = snprintf(holder, 100, "%lu", (unsigned long)(LONG_MAX)+1);
+ i = asprintf(&h, "%lu", (unsigned long)(LONG_MAX)+1);
+ printf("<%lu>\n", (unsigned long)(LONG_MAX)+1);
+ printf("<%s>\n", holder);
+ printf("<%s>\n\n", h);
+
+#ifdef HAVE_LONG_LONG
+ printf ("<%%llu> LLONG_MAX+1\n");
+ i = snprintf(holder, 100, "%llu", (unsigned long long)(LLONG_MAX)+1);
+ i = asprintf(&h, "%llu", (unsigned long long)(LLONG_MAX)+1);
+ printf("<%llu>\n", (unsigned long long)(LLONG_MAX)+1);
+ printf("<%s>\n", holder);
+ printf("<%s>\n\n", h);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_LONG_DOUBLE
+ printf ("<%%6.2LE> 42.42\n");
+ i = snprintf(holder, 100, "%6.2LE", (long double)42.42);
+ i = asprintf(&h, "%6.2LE", (long double)42.42);
+ printf ("<%6.2LE>\n", (long double)42.42);
+ printf ("<%s>\n", holder);
+ printf ("<%s>\n\n", h);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_PRINTF_A_FORMAT
+ printf ("<%%6.2A> 42.42\n");
+ i = snprintf(holder, 100, "%6.2A", 42.42);
+ i = asprintf(&h, "%6.2A", 42.42);
+ printf ("<%6.2A>\n", 42.42);
+ printf ("<%s>\n", holder);
+ printf ("<%s>\n\n", h);
+
+ printf ("<%%6.2LA> 42.42\n");
+ i = snprintf(holder, 100, "%6.2LA", (long double)42.42);
+ i = asprintf(&h, "%6.2LA", (long double)42.42);
+ printf ("<%6.2LA>\n", (long double)42.42);
+ printf ("<%s>\n", holder);
+ printf ("<%s>\n\n", h);
+#endif
+
+ printf ("<%%.10240f> DBL_MAX\n");
+ si = snprintf(holder, 100, "%.10240f", DBL_MAX);
+ ai = asprintf(&h, "%.10240f", DBL_MAX);
+ printf ("<%.10240f>\n", DBL_MAX);
+ printf ("<%d> <%s>\n", si, holder);
+ printf ("<%d> <%s>\n\n", ai, h);
+
+ printf ("<%%.10240Lf> LDBL_MAX\n");
+ si = snprintf(holder, 100, "%.10240Lf", (long double)LDBL_MAX);
+ ai = asprintf(&h, "%.10240Lf", (long double)LDBL_MAX);
+ printf ("<%.10240Lf>\n", (long double)LDBL_MAX);
+ printf ("<%d> <%s>\n", si, holder);
+ printf ("<%d> <%s>\n\n", ai, h);
+
+ /* huh? */
+ printf("/%%g/, 421.2345\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%g/\n", 421.2345);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%g/\n", 421.2345);
+ printf("/%g/\n", 421.2345);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("/%%g/, 4214.2345\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%g/\n", 4214.2345);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%g/\n", 4214.2345);
+ printf("/%g/\n", 4214.2345);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("/%%.5g/, 4214.2345\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%.5g/\n", 4214.2345);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%.5g/\n", 4214.2345);
+ printf("/%.5g/\n", 4214.2345);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("/%%.4g/, 4214.2345\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%.4g/\n", 4214.2345);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%.4g/\n", 4214.2345);
+ printf("/%.4g/\n", 4214.2345);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("/%%'ld %%'ld/, 12345, 1234567\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%'ld %'ld/\n", 12345, 1234567);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%'ld %'ld/\n", 12345, 1234567);
+ printf("/%'ld %'ld/\n", 12345, 1234567);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("/%%'ld %%'ld/, 336, 3336\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%'ld %'ld/\n", 336, 3336);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%'ld %'ld/\n", 336, 3336);
+ printf("/%'ld %'ld/\n", 336, 3336);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("/%%'ld %%'ld/, -42786, -142786\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%'ld %'ld/\n", -42786, -142786);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%'ld %'ld/\n", -42786, -142786);
+ printf("/%'ld %'ld/\n", -42786, -142786);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("/%%'f %%'f/, 421.2345, 421234.56789\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%'f %'f/\n", 421.2345, 421234.56789);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%'f %'f/\n", 421.2345, 421234.56789);
+ printf("/%'f %'f/\n", 421.2345, 421234.56789);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("/%%'f %%'f/, -421.2345, -421234.56789\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%'f %'f/\n", -421.2345, -421234.56789);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%'f %'f/\n", -421.2345, -421234.56789);
+ printf("/%'f %'f/\n", -421.2345, -421234.56789);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("/%%'g %%'g/, 421.2345, 421234.56789\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%'g %'g/\n", 421.2345, 421234.56789);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%'g %'g/\n", 421.2345, 421234.56789);
+ printf("/%'g %'g/\n", 421.2345, 421234.56789);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ printf("/%%'g %%'g/, -421.2345, -421234.56789\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%'g %'g/\n", -421.2345, -421234.56789);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%'g %'g/\n", -421.2345, -421234.56789);
+ printf("/%'g %'g/\n", -421.2345, -421234.56789);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+#endif
+
+ printf("/%%'g/, 4213455.8392\n");
+ snprintf(holder, sizeof holder, "/%'g/\n", 4213455.8392);
+ asprintf(&h, "/%'g/\n", 4213455.8392);
+ printf("/%'g/\n", 4213455.8392);
+ printf("%s", holder);
+ printf("%s\n", h);
+
+ exit (0);
+}
+#endif
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/spell.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/spell.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..cff20b2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/spell.c
@@ -0,0 +1,188 @@
+/* spell.c -- spelling correction for pathnames. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+version.
+
+Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+for more details.
+
+You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# ifdef _MINIX
+# include <sys/types.h>
+# endif
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <bashtypes.h>
+#include <posixdir.h>
+#include <posixstat.h>
+#ifndef _MINIX
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+#include <bashansi.h>
+#include <maxpath.h>
+#include <stdc.h>
+
+static int mindist __P((char *, char *, char *));
+static int spdist __P((char *, char *));
+
+/*
+ * `spname' and its helpers are inspired by the code in "The UNIX
+ * Programming Environment", Kernighan & Pike, Prentice-Hall 1984,
+ * pages 209 - 213.
+ */
+
+/*
+ * `spname' -- return a correctly spelled filename
+ *
+ * int spname(char * oldname, char * newname)
+ * Returns: -1 if no reasonable match found
+ * 0 if exact match found
+ * 1 if corrected
+ * Stores corrected name in `newname'.
+ */
+int
+spname(oldname, newname)
+ char *oldname;
+ char *newname;
+{
+ char *op, *np, *p;
+ char guess[PATH_MAX + 1], best[PATH_MAX + 1];
+
+ op = oldname;
+ np = newname;
+ for (;;)
+ {
+ while (*op == '/') /* Skip slashes */
+ *np++ = *op++;
+ *np = '\0';
+
+ if (*op == '\0') /* Exact or corrected */
+ {
+ /* `.' is rarely the right thing. */
+ if (oldname[1] == '\0' && newname[1] == '\0' &&
+ oldname[0] != '.' && newname[0] == '.')
+ return -1;
+ return strcmp(oldname, newname) != 0;
+ }
+
+ /* Copy next component into guess */
+ for (p = guess; *op != '/' && *op != '\0'; op++)
+ if (p < guess + PATH_MAX)
+ *p++ = *op;
+ *p = '\0';
+
+ if (mindist(newname, guess, best) >= 3)
+ return -1; /* Hopeless */
+
+ /*
+ * Add to end of newname
+ */
+ for (p = best; *np = *p++; np++)
+ ;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+ * Search directory for a guess
+ */
+static int
+mindist(dir, guess, best)
+ char *dir;
+ char *guess;
+ char *best;
+{
+ DIR *fd;
+ struct dirent *dp;
+ int dist, x;
+
+ dist = 3; /* Worst distance */
+ if (*dir == '\0')
+ dir = ".";
+
+ if ((fd = opendir(dir)) == NULL)
+ return dist;
+
+ while ((dp = readdir(fd)) != NULL)
+ {
+ /*
+ * Look for a better guess. If the new guess is as
+ * good as the current one, we take it. This way,
+ * any single character match will be a better match
+ * than ".".
+ */
+ x = spdist(dp->d_name, guess);
+ if (x <= dist && x != 3)
+ {
+ strcpy(best, dp->d_name);
+ dist = x;
+ if (dist == 0) /* Exact match */
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ (void)closedir(fd);
+
+ /* Don't return `.' */
+ if (best[0] == '.' && best[1] == '\0')
+ dist = 3;
+ return dist;
+}
+
+/*
+ * `spdist' -- return the "distance" between two names.
+ *
+ * int spname(char * oldname, char * newname)
+ * Returns: 0 if strings are identical
+ * 1 if two characters are transposed
+ * 2 if one character is wrong, added or deleted
+ * 3 otherwise
+ */
+static int
+spdist(cur, new)
+ char *cur, *new;
+{
+ while (*cur == *new)
+ {
+ if (*cur == '\0')
+ return 0; /* Exact match */
+ cur++;
+ new++;
+ }
+
+ if (*cur)
+ {
+ if (*new)
+ {
+ if (cur[1] && new[1] && cur[0] == new[1] && cur[1] == new[0] && strcmp (cur + 2, new + 2) == 0)
+ return 1; /* Transposition */
+
+ if (strcmp (cur + 1, new + 1) == 0)
+ return 2; /* One character mismatch */
+ }
+
+ if (strcmp(&cur[1], &new[0]) == 0)
+ return 2; /* Extra character */
+ }
+
+ if (*new && strcmp(cur, new + 1) == 0)
+ return 2; /* Missing character */
+
+ return 3;
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strcasecmp.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strcasecmp.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..33d925b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strcasecmp.c
@@ -0,0 +1,84 @@
+/* strcasecmp.c - functions for case-insensitive string comparison. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1995 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_STRCASECMP)
+
+#include <stdc.h>
+#include <bashansi.h>
+#include <chartypes.h>
+
+/* Compare at most COUNT characters from string1 to string2. Case
+ doesn't matter. */
+int
+strncasecmp (string1, string2, count)
+ const char *string1;
+ const char *string2;
+ int count;
+{
+ register const char *s1;
+ register const char *s2;
+ register int r;
+
+ if (count <= 0 || (string1 == string2))
+ return 0;
+
+ s1 = string1;
+ s2 = string2;
+ do
+ {
+ if ((r = TOLOWER ((unsigned char) *s1) - TOLOWER ((unsigned char) *s2)) != 0)
+ return r;
+ if (*s1++ == '\0')
+ break;
+ s2++;
+ }
+ while (--count != 0);
+
+ return (0);
+}
+
+/* strcmp (), but caseless. */
+int
+strcasecmp (string1, string2)
+ const char *string1;
+ const char *string2;
+{
+ register const char *s1;
+ register const char *s2;
+ register int r;
+
+ s1 = string1;
+ s2 = string2;
+
+ if (s1 == s2)
+ return (0);
+
+ while ((r = TOLOWER ((unsigned char)*s1) - TOLOWER ((unsigned char)*s2)) == 0)
+ {
+ if (*s1++ == '\0')
+ return 0;
+ s2++;
+ }
+
+ return (r);
+}
+#endif /* !HAVE_STRCASECMP */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strerror.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strerror.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..4990aa7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strerror.c
@@ -0,0 +1,74 @@
+/* strerror.c - string corresponding to a particular value of errno. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1995 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_STRERROR)
+
+#include <bashtypes.h>
+#ifndef _MINIX
+# include <sys/param.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+
+#include <shell.h>
+
+#if !defined (errno)
+extern int errno;
+#endif /* !errno */
+
+/* Return a string corresponding to the error number E. From
+ the ANSI C spec. */
+#if defined (strerror)
+# undef strerror
+#endif
+
+static char *errbase = "Unknown system error ";
+
+char *
+strerror (e)
+ int e;
+{
+ static char emsg[40];
+#if defined (HAVE_SYS_ERRLIST)
+ extern int sys_nerr;
+ extern char *sys_errlist[];
+
+ if (e > 0 && e < sys_nerr)
+ return (sys_errlist[e]);
+ else
+#endif /* HAVE_SYS_ERRLIST */
+ {
+ char *z;
+
+ z = itos (e);
+ strcpy (emsg, errbase);
+ strcat (emsg, z);
+ free (z);
+ return (&emsg[0]);
+ }
+}
+#endif /* HAVE_STRERROR */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strftime.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strftime.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..0783d28
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strftime.c
@@ -0,0 +1,874 @@
+/*
+ * Modified slightly by Chet Ramey for inclusion in Bash
+ */
+
+/*
+ * strftime.c
+ *
+ * Public-domain implementation of ISO C library routine.
+ *
+ * If you can't do prototypes, get GCC.
+ *
+ * The C99 standard now specifies just about all of the formats
+ * that were additional in the earlier versions of this file.
+ *
+ * For extensions from SunOS, add SUNOS_EXT.
+ * For extensions from HP/UX, add HPUX_EXT.
+ * For VMS dates, add VMS_EXT.
+ * For complete POSIX semantics, add POSIX_SEMANTICS.
+ *
+ * The code for %c, %x, and %X follows the C99 specification for
+ * the "C" locale.
+ *
+ * This version ignores LOCALE information.
+ * It also doesn't worry about multi-byte characters.
+ * So there.
+ *
+ * This file is also shipped with GAWK (GNU Awk), gawk specific bits of
+ * code are included if GAWK is defined.
+ *
+ * Arnold Robbins
+ * January, February, March, 1991
+ * Updated March, April 1992
+ * Updated April, 1993
+ * Updated February, 1994
+ * Updated May, 1994
+ * Updated January, 1995
+ * Updated September, 1995
+ * Updated January, 1996
+ * Updated July, 1997
+ * Updated October, 1999
+ * Updated September, 2000
+ *
+ * Fixes from ado@elsie.nci.nih.gov,
+ * February 1991, May 1992
+ * Fixes from Tor Lillqvist tml@tik.vtt.fi,
+ * May 1993
+ * Further fixes from ado@elsie.nci.nih.gov,
+ * February 1994
+ * %z code from chip@chinacat.unicom.com,
+ * Applied September 1995
+ * %V code fixed (again) and %G, %g added,
+ * January 1996
+ * %v code fixed, better configuration,
+ * July 1997
+ * Moved to C99 specification.
+ * September 2000
+ */
+#include <config.h>
+
+#ifndef GAWK
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <time.h>
+#endif
+#if defined(TM_IN_SYS_TIME)
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+/* defaults: season to taste */
+#define SUNOS_EXT 1 /* stuff in SunOS strftime routine */
+#define VMS_EXT 1 /* include %v for VMS date format */
+#define HPUX_EXT 1 /* non-conflicting stuff in HP-UX date */
+#ifndef GAWK
+#define POSIX_SEMANTICS 1 /* call tzset() if TZ changes */
+#endif
+
+#undef strchr /* avoid AIX weirdness */
+
+#if defined (SHELL)
+extern char *get_string_value (const char *);
+#endif
+
+extern void tzset(void);
+static int weeknumber(const struct tm *timeptr, int firstweekday);
+static int iso8601wknum(const struct tm *timeptr);
+
+#ifndef inline
+#ifdef __GNUC__
+#define inline __inline__
+#else
+#define inline /**/
+#endif
+#endif
+
+#define range(low, item, hi) max(low, min(item, hi))
+
+#if !defined(OS2) && !defined(MSDOS) && defined(HAVE_TZNAME)
+extern char *tzname[2];
+extern int daylight;
+#if defined(SOLARIS) || defined(mips) || defined (M_UNIX)
+extern long int timezone, altzone;
+#else
+# if defined (HPUX)
+extern long int timezone;
+# else
+extern int timezone, altzone;
+# endif /* !HPUX */
+#endif /* !SOLARIS && !mips && !M_UNIX */
+#endif
+
+#undef min /* just in case */
+
+/* min --- return minimum of two numbers */
+
+static inline int
+min(int a, int b)
+{
+ return (a < b ? a : b);
+}
+
+#undef max /* also, just in case */
+
+/* max --- return maximum of two numbers */
+
+static inline int
+max(int a, int b)
+{
+ return (a > b ? a : b);
+}
+
+/* strftime --- produce formatted time */
+
+size_t
+strftime(char *s, size_t maxsize, const char *format, const struct tm *timeptr)
+{
+ char *endp = s + maxsize;
+ char *start = s;
+ auto char tbuf[100];
+ long off;
+ int i, w, y;
+ static short first = 1;
+#ifdef POSIX_SEMANTICS
+ static char *savetz = NULL;
+ static int savetzlen = 0;
+ char *tz;
+#endif /* POSIX_SEMANTICS */
+#ifndef HAVE_TM_ZONE
+#ifndef HAVE_TM_NAME
+#ifndef HAVE_TZNAME
+ extern char *timezone();
+ struct timeval tv;
+ struct timezone zone;
+#endif /* HAVE_TZNAME */
+#endif /* HAVE_TM_NAME */
+#endif /* HAVE_TM_ZONE */
+
+ /* various tables, useful in North America */
+ static const char *days_a[] = {
+ "Sun", "Mon", "Tue", "Wed",
+ "Thu", "Fri", "Sat",
+ };
+ static const char *days_l[] = {
+ "Sunday", "Monday", "Tuesday", "Wednesday",
+ "Thursday", "Friday", "Saturday",
+ };
+ static const char *months_a[] = {
+ "Jan", "Feb", "Mar", "Apr", "May", "Jun",
+ "Jul", "Aug", "Sep", "Oct", "Nov", "Dec",
+ };
+ static const char *months_l[] = {
+ "January", "February", "March", "April",
+ "May", "June", "July", "August", "September",
+ "October", "November", "December",
+ };
+ static const char *ampm[] = { "AM", "PM", };
+
+ if (s == NULL || format == NULL || timeptr == NULL || maxsize == 0)
+ return 0;
+
+ /* quick check if we even need to bother */
+ if (strchr(format, '%') == NULL && strlen(format) + 1 >= maxsize)
+ return 0;
+
+#ifndef POSIX_SEMANTICS
+ if (first) {
+ tzset();
+ first = 0;
+ }
+#else /* POSIX_SEMANTICS */
+#if defined (SHELL)
+ tz = get_string_value ("TZ");
+#else
+ tz = getenv("TZ");
+#endif
+ if (first) {
+ if (tz != NULL) {
+ int tzlen = strlen(tz);
+
+ savetz = (char *) malloc(tzlen + 1);
+ if (savetz != NULL) {
+ savetzlen = tzlen + 1;
+ strcpy(savetz, tz);
+ }
+ }
+ tzset();
+ first = 0;
+ }
+ /* if we have a saved TZ, and it is different, recapture and reset */
+ if (tz && savetz && (tz[0] != savetz[0] || strcmp(tz, savetz) != 0)) {
+ i = strlen(tz) + 1;
+ if (i > savetzlen) {
+ savetz = (char *) realloc(savetz, i);
+ if (savetz) {
+ savetzlen = i;
+ strcpy(savetz, tz);
+ }
+ } else
+ strcpy(savetz, tz);
+ tzset();
+ }
+#endif /* POSIX_SEMANTICS */
+
+ for (; *format && s < endp - 1; format++) {
+ tbuf[0] = '\0';
+ if (*format != '%') {
+ *s++ = *format;
+ continue;
+ }
+ again:
+ switch (*++format) {
+ case '\0':
+ *s++ = '%';
+ goto out;
+
+ case '%':
+ *s++ = '%';
+ continue;
+
+ case 'a': /* abbreviated weekday name */
+ if (timeptr->tm_wday < 0 || timeptr->tm_wday > 6)
+ strcpy(tbuf, "?");
+ else
+ strcpy(tbuf, days_a[timeptr->tm_wday]);
+ break;
+
+ case 'A': /* full weekday name */
+ if (timeptr->tm_wday < 0 || timeptr->tm_wday > 6)
+ strcpy(tbuf, "?");
+ else
+ strcpy(tbuf, days_l[timeptr->tm_wday]);
+ break;
+
+ case 'b': /* abbreviated month name */
+ short_month:
+ if (timeptr->tm_mon < 0 || timeptr->tm_mon > 11)
+ strcpy(tbuf, "?");
+ else
+ strcpy(tbuf, months_a[timeptr->tm_mon]);
+ break;
+
+ case 'B': /* full month name */
+ if (timeptr->tm_mon < 0 || timeptr->tm_mon > 11)
+ strcpy(tbuf, "?");
+ else
+ strcpy(tbuf, months_l[timeptr->tm_mon]);
+ break;
+
+ case 'c': /* appropriate date and time representation */
+ /*
+ * This used to be:
+ *
+ * strftime(tbuf, sizeof tbuf, "%a %b %e %H:%M:%S %Y", timeptr);
+ *
+ * Now, per the ISO 1999 C standard, it this:
+ */
+ strftime(tbuf, sizeof tbuf, "%A %B %d %T %Y", timeptr);
+ break;
+
+ case 'C':
+ century:
+ sprintf(tbuf, "%02d", (timeptr->tm_year + 1900) / 100);
+ break;
+
+ case 'd': /* day of the month, 01 - 31 */
+ i = range(1, timeptr->tm_mday, 31);
+ sprintf(tbuf, "%02d", i);
+ break;
+
+ case 'D': /* date as %m/%d/%y */
+ strftime(tbuf, sizeof tbuf, "%m/%d/%y", timeptr);
+ break;
+
+ case 'e': /* day of month, blank padded */
+ sprintf(tbuf, "%2d", range(1, timeptr->tm_mday, 31));
+ break;
+
+ case 'E':
+ /* POSIX (now C99) locale extensions, ignored for now */
+ goto again;
+
+ case 'F': /* ISO 8601 date representation */
+ strftime(tbuf, sizeof tbuf, "%Y-%m-%d", timeptr);
+ break;
+
+ case 'g':
+ case 'G':
+ /*
+ * Year of ISO week.
+ *
+ * If it's December but the ISO week number is one,
+ * that week is in next year.
+ * If it's January but the ISO week number is 52 or
+ * 53, that week is in last year.
+ * Otherwise, it's this year.
+ */
+ w = iso8601wknum(timeptr);
+ if (timeptr->tm_mon == 11 && w == 1)
+ y = 1900 + timeptr->tm_year + 1;
+ else if (timeptr->tm_mon == 0 && w >= 52)
+ y = 1900 + timeptr->tm_year - 1;
+ else
+ y = 1900 + timeptr->tm_year;
+
+ if (*format == 'G')
+ sprintf(tbuf, "%d", y);
+ else
+ sprintf(tbuf, "%02d", y % 100);
+ break;
+
+ case 'h': /* abbreviated month name */
+ goto short_month;
+
+ case 'H': /* hour, 24-hour clock, 00 - 23 */
+ i = range(0, timeptr->tm_hour, 23);
+ sprintf(tbuf, "%02d", i);
+ break;
+
+ case 'I': /* hour, 12-hour clock, 01 - 12 */
+ i = range(0, timeptr->tm_hour, 23);
+ if (i == 0)
+ i = 12;
+ else if (i > 12)
+ i -= 12;
+ sprintf(tbuf, "%02d", i);
+ break;
+
+ case 'j': /* day of the year, 001 - 366 */
+ sprintf(tbuf, "%03d", timeptr->tm_yday + 1);
+ break;
+
+ case 'm': /* month, 01 - 12 */
+ i = range(0, timeptr->tm_mon, 11);
+ sprintf(tbuf, "%02d", i + 1);
+ break;
+
+ case 'M': /* minute, 00 - 59 */
+ i = range(0, timeptr->tm_min, 59);
+ sprintf(tbuf, "%02d", i);
+ break;
+
+ case 'n': /* same as \n */
+ tbuf[0] = '\n';
+ tbuf[1] = '\0';
+ break;
+
+ case 'O':
+ /* POSIX (now C99) locale extensions, ignored for now */
+ goto again;
+
+ case 'p': /* am or pm based on 12-hour clock */
+ i = range(0, timeptr->tm_hour, 23);
+ if (i < 12)
+ strcpy(tbuf, ampm[0]);
+ else
+ strcpy(tbuf, ampm[1]);
+ break;
+
+ case 'r': /* time as %I:%M:%S %p */
+ strftime(tbuf, sizeof tbuf, "%I:%M:%S %p", timeptr);
+ break;
+
+ case 'R': /* time as %H:%M */
+ strftime(tbuf, sizeof tbuf, "%H:%M", timeptr);
+ break;
+
+#if defined(HAVE_MKTIME) || defined(GAWK)
+ case 's': /* time as seconds since the Epoch */
+ {
+ struct tm non_const_timeptr;
+
+ non_const_timeptr = *timeptr;
+ sprintf(tbuf, "%ld", mktime(& non_const_timeptr));
+ break;
+ }
+#endif /* defined(HAVE_MKTIME) || defined(GAWK) */
+
+ case 'S': /* second, 00 - 60 */
+ i = range(0, timeptr->tm_sec, 60);
+ sprintf(tbuf, "%02d", i);
+ break;
+
+ case 't': /* same as \t */
+ tbuf[0] = '\t';
+ tbuf[1] = '\0';
+ break;
+
+ case 'T': /* time as %H:%M:%S */
+ the_time:
+ strftime(tbuf, sizeof tbuf, "%H:%M:%S", timeptr);
+ break;
+
+ case 'u':
+ /* ISO 8601: Weekday as a decimal number [1 (Monday) - 7] */
+ sprintf(tbuf, "%d", timeptr->tm_wday == 0 ? 7 :
+ timeptr->tm_wday);
+ break;
+
+ case 'U': /* week of year, Sunday is first day of week */
+ sprintf(tbuf, "%02d", weeknumber(timeptr, 0));
+ break;
+
+ case 'V': /* week of year according ISO 8601 */
+ sprintf(tbuf, "%02d", iso8601wknum(timeptr));
+ break;
+
+ case 'w': /* weekday, Sunday == 0, 0 - 6 */
+ i = range(0, timeptr->tm_wday, 6);
+ sprintf(tbuf, "%d", i);
+ break;
+
+ case 'W': /* week of year, Monday is first day of week */
+ sprintf(tbuf, "%02d", weeknumber(timeptr, 1));
+ break;
+
+ case 'x': /* appropriate date representation */
+ strftime(tbuf, sizeof tbuf, "%A %B %d %Y", timeptr);
+ break;
+
+ case 'X': /* appropriate time representation */
+ goto the_time;
+ break;
+
+ case 'y': /* year without a century, 00 - 99 */
+ year:
+ i = timeptr->tm_year % 100;
+ sprintf(tbuf, "%02d", i);
+ break;
+
+ case 'Y': /* year with century */
+ fullyear:
+ sprintf(tbuf, "%d", 1900 + timeptr->tm_year);
+ break;
+
+ /*
+ * From: Chip Rosenthal <chip@chinacat.unicom.com>
+ * Date: Sun, 19 Mar 1995 00:33:29 -0600 (CST)
+ *
+ * Warning: the %z [code] is implemented by inspecting the
+ * timezone name conditional compile settings, and
+ * inferring a method to get timezone offsets. I've tried
+ * this code on a couple of machines, but I don't doubt
+ * there is some system out there that won't like it.
+ * Maybe the easiest thing to do would be to bracket this
+ * with an #ifdef that can turn it off. The %z feature
+ * would be an admittedly obscure one that most folks can
+ * live without, but it would be a great help to those of
+ * us that muck around with various message processors.
+ */
+ case 'z': /* time zone offset east of GMT e.g. -0600 */
+#ifdef HAVE_TM_NAME
+ /*
+ * Systems with tm_name probably have tm_tzadj as
+ * secs west of GMT. Convert to mins east of GMT.
+ */
+ off = -timeptr->tm_tzadj / 60;
+#else /* !HAVE_TM_NAME */
+#ifdef HAVE_TM_ZONE
+ /*
+ * Systems with tm_zone probably have tm_gmtoff as
+ * secs east of GMT. Convert to mins east of GMT.
+ */
+ off = timeptr->tm_gmtoff / 60;
+#else /* !HAVE_TM_ZONE */
+#if HAVE_TZNAME
+ /*
+ * Systems with tzname[] probably have timezone as
+ * secs west of GMT. Convert to mins east of GMT.
+ */
+# ifdef HPUX
+ off = -timezone / 60;
+# else
+ off = -(daylight ? timezone : altzone) / 60;
+# endif /* !HPUX */
+#else /* !HAVE_TZNAME */
+ gettimeofday(& tv, & zone);
+ off = -zone.tz_minuteswest;
+#endif /* !HAVE_TZNAME */
+#endif /* !HAVE_TM_ZONE */
+#endif /* !HAVE_TM_NAME */
+ if (off < 0) {
+ tbuf[0] = '-';
+ off = -off;
+ } else {
+ tbuf[0] = '+';
+ }
+ sprintf(tbuf+1, "%02d%02d", off/60, off%60);
+ break;
+
+ case 'Z': /* time zone name or abbrevation */
+#ifdef HAVE_TZNAME
+ i = (daylight && timeptr->tm_isdst > 0); /* 0 or 1 */
+ strcpy(tbuf, tzname[i]);
+#else
+#ifdef HAVE_TM_ZONE
+ strcpy(tbuf, timeptr->tm_zone);
+#else
+#ifdef HAVE_TM_NAME
+ strcpy(tbuf, timeptr->tm_name);
+#else
+ gettimeofday(& tv, & zone);
+ strcpy(tbuf, timezone(zone.tz_minuteswest,
+ timeptr->tm_isdst > 0));
+#endif /* HAVE_TM_NAME */
+#endif /* HAVE_TM_ZONE */
+#endif /* HAVE_TZNAME */
+ break;
+
+#ifdef SUNOS_EXT
+ case 'k': /* hour, 24-hour clock, blank pad */
+ sprintf(tbuf, "%2d", range(0, timeptr->tm_hour, 23));
+ break;
+
+ case 'l': /* hour, 12-hour clock, 1 - 12, blank pad */
+ i = range(0, timeptr->tm_hour, 23);
+ if (i == 0)
+ i = 12;
+ else if (i > 12)
+ i -= 12;
+ sprintf(tbuf, "%2d", i);
+ break;
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HPUX_EXT
+ case 'N': /* Emperor/Era name */
+ /* this is essentially the same as the century */
+ goto century; /* %C */
+
+ case 'o': /* Emperor/Era year */
+ goto year; /* %y */
+#endif /* HPUX_EXT */
+
+
+#ifdef VMS_EXT
+ case 'v': /* date as dd-bbb-YYYY */
+ sprintf(tbuf, "%2d-%3.3s-%4d",
+ range(1, timeptr->tm_mday, 31),
+ months_a[range(0, timeptr->tm_mon, 11)],
+ timeptr->tm_year + 1900);
+ for (i = 3; i < 6; i++)
+ if (islower(tbuf[i]))
+ tbuf[i] = toupper(tbuf[i]);
+ break;
+#endif
+
+ default:
+ tbuf[0] = '%';
+ tbuf[1] = *format;
+ tbuf[2] = '\0';
+ break;
+ }
+ i = strlen(tbuf);
+ if (i) {
+ if (s + i < endp - 1) {
+ strcpy(s, tbuf);
+ s += i;
+ } else
+ return 0;
+ }
+ }
+out:
+ if (s < endp && *format == '\0') {
+ *s = '\0';
+ return (s - start);
+ } else
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* isleap --- is a year a leap year? */
+
+static int
+isleap(int year)
+{
+ return ((year % 4 == 0 && year % 100 != 0) || year % 400 == 0);
+}
+
+
+/* iso8601wknum --- compute week number according to ISO 8601 */
+
+static int
+iso8601wknum(const struct tm *timeptr)
+{
+ /*
+ * From 1003.2:
+ * If the week (Monday to Sunday) containing January 1
+ * has four or more days in the new year, then it is week 1;
+ * otherwise it is the highest numbered week of the previous
+ * year (52 or 53), and the next week is week 1.
+ *
+ * ADR: This means if Jan 1 was Monday through Thursday,
+ * it was week 1, otherwise week 52 or 53.
+ *
+ * XPG4 erroneously included POSIX.2 rationale text in the
+ * main body of the standard. Thus it requires week 53.
+ */
+
+ int weeknum, jan1day, diff;
+
+ /* get week number, Monday as first day of the week */
+ weeknum = weeknumber(timeptr, 1);
+
+ /*
+ * With thanks and tip of the hatlo to tml@tik.vtt.fi
+ *
+ * What day of the week does January 1 fall on?
+ * We know that
+ * (timeptr->tm_yday - jan1.tm_yday) MOD 7 ==
+ * (timeptr->tm_wday - jan1.tm_wday) MOD 7
+ * and that
+ * jan1.tm_yday == 0
+ * and that
+ * timeptr->tm_wday MOD 7 == timeptr->tm_wday
+ * from which it follows that. . .
+ */
+ jan1day = timeptr->tm_wday - (timeptr->tm_yday % 7);
+ if (jan1day < 0)
+ jan1day += 7;
+
+ /*
+ * If Jan 1 was a Monday through Thursday, it was in
+ * week 1. Otherwise it was last year's highest week, which is
+ * this year's week 0.
+ *
+ * What does that mean?
+ * If Jan 1 was Monday, the week number is exactly right, it can
+ * never be 0.
+ * If it was Tuesday through Thursday, the weeknumber is one
+ * less than it should be, so we add one.
+ * Otherwise, Friday, Saturday or Sunday, the week number is
+ * OK, but if it is 0, it needs to be 52 or 53.
+ */
+ switch (jan1day) {
+ case 1: /* Monday */
+ break;
+ case 2: /* Tuesday */
+ case 3: /* Wednesday */
+ case 4: /* Thursday */
+ weeknum++;
+ break;
+ case 5: /* Friday */
+ case 6: /* Saturday */
+ case 0: /* Sunday */
+ if (weeknum == 0) {
+#ifdef USE_BROKEN_XPG4
+ /* XPG4 (as of March 1994) says 53 unconditionally */
+ weeknum = 53;
+#else
+ /* get week number of last week of last year */
+ struct tm dec31ly; /* 12/31 last year */
+ dec31ly = *timeptr;
+ dec31ly.tm_year--;
+ dec31ly.tm_mon = 11;
+ dec31ly.tm_mday = 31;
+ dec31ly.tm_wday = (jan1day == 0) ? 6 : jan1day - 1;
+ dec31ly.tm_yday = 364 + isleap(dec31ly.tm_year + 1900);
+ weeknum = iso8601wknum(& dec31ly);
+#endif
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+
+ if (timeptr->tm_mon == 11) {
+ /*
+ * The last week of the year
+ * can be in week 1 of next year.
+ * Sigh.
+ *
+ * This can only happen if
+ * M T W
+ * 29 30 31
+ * 30 31
+ * 31
+ */
+ int wday, mday;
+
+ wday = timeptr->tm_wday;
+ mday = timeptr->tm_mday;
+ if ( (wday == 1 && (mday >= 29 && mday <= 31))
+ || (wday == 2 && (mday == 30 || mday == 31))
+ || (wday == 3 && mday == 31))
+ weeknum = 1;
+ }
+
+ return weeknum;
+}
+
+/* weeknumber --- figure how many weeks into the year */
+
+/* With thanks and tip of the hatlo to ado@elsie.nci.nih.gov */
+
+static int
+weeknumber(const struct tm *timeptr, int firstweekday)
+{
+ int wday = timeptr->tm_wday;
+ int ret;
+
+ if (firstweekday == 1) {
+ if (wday == 0) /* sunday */
+ wday = 6;
+ else
+ wday--;
+ }
+ ret = ((timeptr->tm_yday + 7 - wday) / 7);
+ if (ret < 0)
+ ret = 0;
+ return ret;
+}
+
+#if 0
+/* ADR --- I'm loathe to mess with ado's code ... */
+
+Date: Wed, 24 Apr 91 20:54:08 MDT
+From: Michal Jaegermann <audfax!emory!vm.ucs.UAlberta.CA!NTOMCZAK>
+To: arnold@audiofax.com
+
+Hi Arnold,
+in a process of fixing of strftime() in libraries on Atari ST I grabbed
+some pieces of code from your own strftime. When doing that it came
+to mind that your weeknumber() function compiles a little bit nicer
+in the following form:
+/*
+ * firstweekday is 0 if starting in Sunday, non-zero if in Monday
+ */
+{
+ return (timeptr->tm_yday - timeptr->tm_wday +
+ (firstweekday ? (timeptr->tm_wday ? 8 : 1) : 7)) / 7;
+}
+How nicer it depends on a compiler, of course, but always a tiny bit.
+
+ Cheers,
+ Michal
+ ntomczak@vm.ucs.ualberta.ca
+#endif
+
+#ifdef TEST_STRFTIME
+
+/*
+ * NAME:
+ * tst
+ *
+ * SYNOPSIS:
+ * tst
+ *
+ * DESCRIPTION:
+ * "tst" is a test driver for the function "strftime".
+ *
+ * OPTIONS:
+ * None.
+ *
+ * AUTHOR:
+ * Karl Vogel
+ * Control Data Systems, Inc.
+ * vogelke@c-17igp.wpafb.af.mil
+ *
+ * BUGS:
+ * None noticed yet.
+ *
+ * COMPILE:
+ * cc -o tst -DTEST_STRFTIME strftime.c
+ */
+
+/* ADR: I reformatted this to my liking, and deleted some unneeded code. */
+
+#ifndef NULL
+#include <stdio.h>
+#endif
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+#define MAXTIME 132
+
+/*
+ * Array of time formats.
+ */
+
+static char *array[] =
+{
+ "(%%A) full weekday name, var length (Sunday..Saturday) %A",
+ "(%%B) full month name, var length (January..December) %B",
+ "(%%C) Century %C",
+ "(%%D) date (%%m/%%d/%%y) %D",
+ "(%%E) Locale extensions (ignored) %E",
+ "(%%F) full month name, var length (January..December) %F",
+ "(%%H) hour (24-hour clock, 00..23) %H",
+ "(%%I) hour (12-hour clock, 01..12) %I",
+ "(%%M) minute (00..59) %M",
+ "(%%N) Emporer/Era Name %N",
+ "(%%O) Locale extensions (ignored) %O",
+ "(%%R) time, 24-hour (%%H:%%M) %R",
+ "(%%S) second (00..60) %S",
+ "(%%T) time, 24-hour (%%H:%%M:%%S) %T",
+ "(%%U) week of year, Sunday as first day of week (00..53) %U",
+ "(%%V) week of year according to ISO 8601 %V",
+ "(%%W) week of year, Monday as first day of week (00..53) %W",
+ "(%%X) appropriate locale time representation (%H:%M:%S) %X",
+ "(%%Y) year with century (1970...) %Y",
+ "(%%Z) timezone (EDT), or blank if timezone not determinable %Z",
+ "(%%a) locale's abbreviated weekday name (Sun..Sat) %a",
+ "(%%b) locale's abbreviated month name (Jan..Dec) %b",
+ "(%%c) full date (Sat Nov 4 12:02:33 1989)%n%t%t%t %c",
+ "(%%d) day of the month (01..31) %d",
+ "(%%e) day of the month, blank-padded ( 1..31) %e",
+ "(%%h) should be same as (%%b) %h",
+ "(%%j) day of the year (001..366) %j",
+ "(%%k) hour, 24-hour clock, blank pad ( 0..23) %k",
+ "(%%l) hour, 12-hour clock, blank pad ( 0..12) %l",
+ "(%%m) month (01..12) %m",
+ "(%%o) Emporer/Era Year %o",
+ "(%%p) locale's AM or PM based on 12-hour clock %p",
+ "(%%r) time, 12-hour (same as %%I:%%M:%%S %%p) %r",
+ "(%%u) ISO 8601: Weekday as decimal number [1 (Monday) - 7] %u",
+ "(%%v) VMS date (dd-bbb-YYYY) %v",
+ "(%%w) day of week (0..6, Sunday == 0) %w",
+ "(%%x) appropriate locale date representation %x",
+ "(%%y) last two digits of year (00..99) %y",
+ "(%%z) timezone offset east of GMT as HHMM (e.g. -0500) %z",
+ (char *) NULL
+};
+
+/* main routine. */
+
+int
+main(argc, argv)
+int argc;
+char **argv;
+{
+ long time();
+
+ char *next;
+ char string[MAXTIME];
+
+ int k;
+ int length;
+
+ struct tm *tm;
+
+ long clock;
+
+ /* Call the function. */
+
+ clock = time((long *) 0);
+ tm = localtime(&clock);
+
+ for (k = 0; next = array[k]; k++) {
+ length = strftime(string, MAXTIME, next, tm);
+ printf("%s\n", string);
+ }
+
+ exit(0);
+}
+#endif /* TEST_STRFTIME */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strindex.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strindex.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9172862
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strindex.c
@@ -0,0 +1,47 @@
+/* strindex.c - Find if one string appears as a substring of another string,
+ without regard to case. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 2000
+ Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#include <bashansi.h>
+#include <chartypes.h>
+
+#include <stdc.h>
+
+/* Determine if s2 occurs in s1. If so, return a pointer to the
+ match in s1. The compare is case insensitive. This is a
+ case-insensitive strstr(3). */
+char *
+strindex (s1, s2)
+ const char *s1;
+ const char *s2;
+{
+ register int i, l, len, c;
+
+ c = TOLOWER ((unsigned char)s2[0]);
+ len = strlen (s1);
+ l = strlen (s2);
+ for (i = 0; (len - i) >= l; i++)
+ if ((TOLOWER ((unsigned char)s1[i]) == c) && (strncasecmp (s1 + i, s2, l) == 0))
+ return ((char *)s1 + i);
+ return ((char *)0);
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/stringlist.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/stringlist.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..efc6fa5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/stringlist.c
@@ -0,0 +1,297 @@
+/* stringlist.c - functions to handle a generic `list of strings' structure */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 2000-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <bashansi.h>
+
+#include "shell.h"
+
+#ifdef STRDUP
+# undef STRDUP
+#endif
+#define STRDUP(x) ((x) ? savestring (x) : (char *)NULL)
+
+/* Allocate a new STRINGLIST, with room for N strings. */
+
+STRINGLIST *
+strlist_create (n)
+ int n;
+{
+ STRINGLIST *ret;
+ register int i;
+
+ ret = (STRINGLIST *)xmalloc (sizeof (STRINGLIST));
+ if (n)
+ {
+ ret->list = strvec_create (n+1);
+ ret->list_size = n;
+ for (i = 0; i < n; i++)
+ ret->list[i] = (char *)NULL;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ ret->list = (char **)NULL;
+ ret->list_size = 0;
+ }
+ ret->list_len = 0;
+ return ret;
+}
+
+STRINGLIST *
+strlist_resize (sl, n)
+ STRINGLIST *sl;
+ int n;
+{
+ register int i;
+
+ if (sl == 0)
+ return (sl = strlist_create (n));
+
+ if (n > sl->list_size)
+ {
+ sl->list = strvec_resize (sl->list, n + 1);
+ for (i = sl->list_size; i <= n; i++)
+ sl->list[i] = (char *)NULL;
+ sl->list_size = n;
+ }
+ return sl;
+}
+
+void
+strlist_flush (sl)
+ STRINGLIST *sl;
+{
+ if (sl == 0 || sl->list == 0)
+ return;
+ strvec_flush (sl->list);
+ sl->list_len = 0;
+}
+
+void
+strlist_dispose (sl)
+ STRINGLIST *sl;
+{
+ if (sl == 0)
+ return;
+ if (sl->list)
+ strvec_dispose (sl->list);
+ free (sl);
+}
+
+int
+strlist_remove (sl, s)
+ STRINGLIST *sl;
+ char *s;
+{
+ int r;
+
+ if (sl == 0 || sl->list == 0 || sl->list_len == 0)
+ return 0;
+
+ r = strvec_remove (sl->list, s);
+ if (r)
+ sl->list_len--;
+ return r;
+}
+
+STRINGLIST *
+strlist_copy (sl)
+ STRINGLIST *sl;
+{
+ STRINGLIST *new;
+ register int i;
+
+ if (sl == 0)
+ return ((STRINGLIST *)0);
+ new = strlist_create (sl->list_size);
+ /* I'd like to use strvec_copy, but that doesn't copy everything. */
+ if (sl->list)
+ {
+ for (i = 0; i < sl->list_size; i++)
+ new->list[i] = STRDUP (sl->list[i]);
+ }
+ new->list_size = sl->list_size;
+ new->list_len = sl->list_len;
+ /* just being careful */
+ if (new->list)
+ new->list[new->list_len] = (char *)NULL;
+ return new;
+}
+
+/* Return a new STRINGLIST with everything from M1 and M2. */
+
+STRINGLIST *
+strlist_merge (m1, m2)
+ STRINGLIST *m1, *m2;
+{
+ STRINGLIST *sl;
+ int i, n, l1, l2;
+
+ l1 = m1 ? m1->list_len : 0;
+ l2 = m2 ? m2->list_len : 0;
+
+ sl = strlist_create (l1 + l2 + 1);
+ for (i = n = 0; i < l1; i++, n++)
+ sl->list[n] = STRDUP (m1->list[i]);
+ for (i = 0; i < l2; i++, n++)
+ sl->list[n] = STRDUP (m2->list[i]);
+ sl->list_len = n;
+ sl->list[n] = (char *)NULL;
+ return (sl);
+}
+
+/* Make STRINGLIST M1 contain everything in M1 and M2. */
+STRINGLIST *
+strlist_append (m1, m2)
+ STRINGLIST *m1, *m2;
+{
+ register int i, n, len1, len2;
+
+ if (m1 == 0)
+ return (m2 ? strlist_copy (m2) : (STRINGLIST *)0);
+
+ len1 = m1->list_len;
+ len2 = m2 ? m2->list_len : 0;
+
+ if (len2)
+ {
+ m1 = strlist_resize (m1, len1 + len2 + 1);
+ for (i = 0, n = len1; i < len2; i++, n++)
+ m1->list[n] = STRDUP (m2->list[i]);
+ m1->list[n] = (char *)NULL;
+ m1->list_len = n;
+ }
+
+ return m1;
+}
+
+STRINGLIST *
+strlist_prefix_suffix (sl, prefix, suffix)
+ STRINGLIST *sl;
+ char *prefix, *suffix;
+{
+ int plen, slen, tlen, llen, i;
+ char *t;
+
+ if (sl == 0 || sl->list == 0 || sl->list_len == 0)
+ return sl;
+
+ plen = STRLEN (prefix);
+ slen = STRLEN (suffix);
+
+ if (plen == 0 && slen == 0)
+ return (sl);
+
+ for (i = 0; i < sl->list_len; i++)
+ {
+ llen = STRLEN (sl->list[i]);
+ tlen = plen + llen + slen + 1;
+ t = (char *)xmalloc (tlen + 1);
+ if (plen)
+ strcpy (t, prefix);
+ strcpy (t + plen, sl->list[i]);
+ if (slen)
+ strcpy (t + plen + llen, suffix);
+ free (sl->list[i]);
+ sl->list[i] = t;
+ }
+
+ return (sl);
+}
+
+void
+strlist_print (sl, prefix)
+ STRINGLIST *sl;
+ char *prefix;
+{
+ register int i;
+
+ if (sl == 0)
+ return;
+ for (i = 0; i < sl->list_len; i++)
+ printf ("%s%s\n", prefix ? prefix : "", sl->list[i]);
+}
+
+void
+strlist_walk (sl, func)
+ STRINGLIST *sl;
+ sh_strlist_map_func_t *func;
+{
+ register int i;
+
+ if (sl == 0)
+ return;
+ for (i = 0; i < sl->list_len; i++)
+ if ((*func)(sl->list[i]) < 0)
+ break;
+}
+
+void
+strlist_sort (sl)
+ STRINGLIST *sl;
+{
+ if (sl == 0 || sl->list_len == 0 || sl->list == 0)
+ return;
+ strvec_sort (sl->list);
+}
+
+STRINGLIST *
+strlist_from_word_list (list, alloc, starting_index, ip)
+ WORD_LIST *list;
+ int alloc, starting_index, *ip;
+{
+ STRINGLIST *ret;
+ int slen, len;
+
+ if (list == 0)
+ {
+ if (ip)
+ *ip = 0;
+ return ((STRINGLIST *)0);
+ }
+ slen = list_length (list);
+ ret = (STRINGLIST *)xmalloc (sizeof (STRINGLIST));
+ ret->list = strvec_from_word_list (list, alloc, starting_index, &len);
+ ret->list_size = slen + starting_index;
+ ret->list_len = len;
+ if (ip)
+ *ip = len;
+ return ret;
+}
+
+WORD_LIST *
+strlist_to_word_list (sl, alloc, starting_index)
+ STRINGLIST *sl;
+ int alloc, starting_index;
+{
+ WORD_LIST *list;
+
+ if (sl == 0 || sl->list == 0)
+ return ((WORD_LIST *)NULL);
+
+ list = strvec_to_word_list (sl->list, alloc, starting_index);
+ return list;
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/stringvec.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/stringvec.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..222fcd6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/stringvec.c
@@ -0,0 +1,232 @@
+/* stringvec.c - functions for managing arrays of strings. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 2000-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#include <bashtypes.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <bashansi.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <chartypes.h>
+
+#include "shell.h"
+
+/* Allocate an array of strings with room for N members. */
+char **
+strvec_create (n)
+ int n;
+{
+ return ((char **)xmalloc ((n) * sizeof (char *)));
+}
+
+char **
+strvec_resize (array, nsize)
+ char **array;
+ int nsize;
+{
+ return ((char **)xrealloc (array, nsize * sizeof (char *)));
+}
+
+/* Return the length of ARRAY, a NULL terminated array of char *. */
+int
+strvec_len (array)
+ char **array;
+{
+ register int i;
+
+ for (i = 0; array[i]; i++);
+ return (i);
+}
+
+/* Free the contents of ARRAY, a NULL terminated array of char *. */
+void
+strvec_flush (array)
+ char **array;
+{
+ register int i;
+
+ if (array == 0)
+ return;
+
+ for (i = 0; array[i]; i++)
+ free (array[i]);
+}
+
+void
+strvec_dispose (array)
+ char **array;
+{
+ if (array == 0)
+ return;
+
+ strvec_flush (array);
+ free (array);
+}
+
+int
+strvec_remove (array, name)
+ char **array, *name;
+{
+ register int i, j;
+ char *x;
+
+ if (array == 0)
+ return 0;
+
+ for (i = 0; array[i]; i++)
+ if (STREQ (name, array[i]))
+ {
+ x = array[i];
+ for (j = i; array[j]; j++)
+ array[j] = array[j + 1];
+ free (x);
+ return 1;
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+#ifdef INCLUDE_UNUSED
+/* Find NAME in ARRAY. Return the index of NAME, or -1 if not present.
+ ARRAY should be NULL terminated. */
+int
+strvec_search (array, name)
+ char **array, *name;
+{
+ int i;
+
+ for (i = 0; array[i]; i++)
+ if (STREQ (name, array[i]))
+ return (i);
+
+ return (-1);
+}
+#endif
+
+/* Allocate and return a new copy of ARRAY and its contents. */
+char **
+strvec_copy (array)
+ char **array;
+{
+ register int i;
+ int len;
+ char **ret;
+
+ len = strvec_len (array);
+
+ ret = (char **)xmalloc ((len + 1) * sizeof (char *));
+ for (i = 0; array[i]; i++)
+ ret[i] = savestring (array[i]);
+ ret[i] = (char *)NULL;
+
+ return (ret);
+}
+
+/* Comparison routine for use with qsort() on arrays of strings. Uses
+ strcoll(3) if available, otherwise it uses strcmp(3). */
+int
+strvec_strcmp (s1, s2)
+ register char **s1, **s2;
+{
+#if defined (HAVE_STRCOLL)
+ return (strcoll (*s1, *s2));
+#else /* !HAVE_STRCOLL */
+ int result;
+
+ if ((result = **s1 - **s2) == 0)
+ result = strcmp (*s1, *s2);
+
+ return (result);
+#endif /* !HAVE_STRCOLL */
+}
+
+/* Sort ARRAY, a null terminated array of pointers to strings. */
+void
+strvec_sort (array)
+ char **array;
+{
+ qsort (array, strvec_len (array), sizeof (char *), (QSFUNC *)strvec_strcmp);
+}
+
+/* Cons up a new array of words. The words are taken from LIST,
+ which is a WORD_LIST *. If ALLOC is true, everything is malloc'ed,
+ so you should free everything in this array when you are done.
+ The array is NULL terminated. If IP is non-null, it gets the
+ number of words in the returned array. STARTING_INDEX says where
+ to start filling in the returned array; it can be used to reserve
+ space at the beginning of the array. */
+
+char **
+strvec_from_word_list (list, alloc, starting_index, ip)
+ WORD_LIST *list;
+ int alloc, starting_index, *ip;
+{
+ int count;
+ char **array;
+
+ count = list_length (list);
+ array = (char **)xmalloc ((1 + count + starting_index) * sizeof (char *));
+
+ for (count = 0; count < starting_index; count++)
+ array[count] = (char *)NULL;
+ for (count = starting_index; list; count++, list = list->next)
+ array[count] = alloc ? savestring (list->word->word) : list->word->word;
+ array[count] = (char *)NULL;
+
+ if (ip)
+ *ip = count;
+ return (array);
+}
+
+/* Convert an array of strings into the form used internally by the shell.
+ ALLOC means to allocate new storage for each WORD_DESC in the returned
+ list rather than copy the values in ARRAY. STARTING_INDEX says where
+ in ARRAY to begin. */
+
+WORD_LIST *
+strvec_to_word_list (array, alloc, starting_index)
+ char **array;
+ int alloc, starting_index;
+{
+ WORD_LIST *list;
+ WORD_DESC *w;
+ int i, count;
+
+ if (array == 0 || array[0] == 0)
+ return (WORD_LIST *)NULL;
+
+ for (count = 0; array[count]; count++)
+ ;
+
+ for (i = starting_index, list = (WORD_LIST *)NULL; i < count; i++)
+ {
+ w = make_bare_word (alloc ? array[i] : "");
+ if (alloc == 0)
+ {
+ free (w->word);
+ w->word = array[i];
+ }
+ list = make_word_list (w, list);
+ }
+ return (REVERSE_LIST (list, WORD_LIST *));
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strnlen.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strnlen.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..da8feec
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strnlen.c
@@ -0,0 +1,45 @@
+/* Copyright (C) 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the
+ Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any
+ later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_STRNLEN)
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdc.h>
+
+/* Find the length of S, but scan at most MAXLEN characters. If no '\0'
+ terminator is found within the first MAXLEN characters, return MAXLEN. */
+size_t
+strnlen (s, maxlen)
+ register const char *s;
+ size_t maxlen;
+{
+ register const char *e;
+ size_t n;
+
+ for (e = s, n = 0; *e && n < maxlen; e++, n++)
+ ;
+ return n;
+}
+#endif
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strpbrk.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strpbrk.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3c493a8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strpbrk.c
@@ -0,0 +1,44 @@
+/* Copyright (C) 1991, 1994 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ NOTE: The canonical source of this file is maintained with the GNU C Library.
+ Bugs can be reported to bug-glibc@prep.ai.mit.edu.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the
+ Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any
+ later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_STRPBRK)
+
+#include <stdc.h>
+
+/* Find the first ocurrence in S of any character in ACCEPT. */
+char *
+strpbrk (s, accept)
+ register const char *s;
+ register const char *accept;
+{
+ while (*s != '\0')
+ {
+ const char *a = accept;
+ while (*a != '\0')
+ if (*a++ == *s)
+ return (char *) s;
+ ++s;
+ }
+
+ return 0;
+}
+#endif
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strstr.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strstr.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c41e903
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strstr.c
@@ -0,0 +1,122 @@
+/* Copyright (C) 1994, 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+This file is part of the GNU C Library.
+
+This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+any later version.
+
+This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
+
+/*
+ * My personal strstr() implementation that beats most other algorithms.
+ * Until someone tells me otherwise, I assume that this is the
+ * fastest implementation of strstr() in C.
+ * I deliberately chose not to comment it. You should have at least
+ * as much fun trying to understand it, as I had to write it :-).
+ *
+ * Stephen R. van den Berg, berg@pool.informatik.rwth-aachen.de */
+
+#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_STRING_H
+# include <string.h>
+#endif
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+typedef unsigned chartype;
+
+#undef strstr
+
+char *
+strstr (const char *phaystack, const char *pneedle)
+{
+ register const unsigned char *haystack, *needle;
+ register chartype b, c;
+
+ haystack = (const unsigned char *) phaystack;
+ needle = (const unsigned char *) pneedle;
+
+ b = *needle;
+ if (b != '\0')
+ {
+ haystack--; /* possible ANSI violation */
+ do
+ {
+ c = *++haystack;
+ if (c == '\0')
+ goto ret0;
+ }
+ while (c != b);
+
+ c = *++needle;
+ if (c == '\0')
+ goto foundneedle;
+ ++needle;
+ goto jin;
+
+ for (;;)
+ {
+ register chartype a;
+ register const unsigned char *rhaystack, *rneedle;
+
+ do
+ {
+ a = *++haystack;
+ if (a == '\0')
+ goto ret0;
+ if (a == b)
+ break;
+ a = *++haystack;
+ if (a == '\0')
+ goto ret0;
+shloop:; }
+ while (a != b);
+
+jin: a = *++haystack;
+ if (a == '\0')
+ goto ret0;
+
+ if (a != c)
+ goto shloop;
+
+ rhaystack = haystack-- + 1;
+ rneedle = needle;
+ a = *rneedle;
+
+ if (*rhaystack == a)
+ do
+ {
+ if (a == '\0')
+ goto foundneedle;
+ ++rhaystack;
+ a = *++needle;
+ if (*rhaystack != a)
+ break;
+ if (a == '\0')
+ goto foundneedle;
+ ++rhaystack;
+ a = *++needle;
+ }
+ while (*rhaystack == a);
+
+ needle = rneedle; /* took the register-poor approach */
+
+ if (a == '\0')
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+foundneedle:
+ return (char*) haystack;
+ret0:
+ return 0;
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtod.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtod.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..cc3bec9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtod.c
@@ -0,0 +1,197 @@
+/* Copyright (C) 1991, 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
+
+#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_STRTOD
+
+#include <errno.h>
+#ifndef errno
+extern int errno;
+#endif
+
+#include <chartypes.h>
+#include <math.h>
+
+#if HAVE_FLOAT_H
+# include <float.h>
+#else
+# define DBL_MAX 1.7976931348623159e+308
+# define DBL_MIN 2.2250738585072010e-308
+#endif
+
+#include <bashansi.h>
+
+#ifndef NULL
+# define NULL 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HUGE_VAL
+# define HUGE_VAL HUGE
+#endif
+
+/* Convert NPTR to a double. If ENDPTR is not NULL, a pointer to the
+ character after the last one used in the number is put in *ENDPTR. */
+double
+strtod (nptr, endptr)
+ const char *nptr;
+ char **endptr;
+{
+ register const char *s;
+ short sign;
+
+ /* The number so far. */
+ double num;
+
+ int got_dot; /* Found a decimal point. */
+ int got_digit; /* Seen any digits. */
+
+ /* The exponent of the number. */
+ long int exponent;
+
+ if (nptr == NULL)
+ {
+ errno = EINVAL;
+ goto noconv;
+ }
+
+ s = nptr;
+
+ /* Eat whitespace. */
+ while (ISSPACE ((unsigned char)*s))
+ ++s;
+
+ /* Get the sign. */
+ sign = *s == '-' ? -1 : 1;
+ if (*s == '-' || *s == '+')
+ ++s;
+
+ num = 0.0;
+ got_dot = 0;
+ got_digit = 0;
+ exponent = 0;
+ for (;; ++s)
+ {
+ if (DIGIT (*s))
+ {
+ got_digit = 1;
+
+ /* Make sure that multiplication by 10 will not overflow. */
+ if (num > DBL_MAX * 0.1)
+ /* The value of the digit doesn't matter, since we have already
+ gotten as many digits as can be represented in a `double'.
+ This doesn't necessarily mean the result will overflow.
+ The exponent may reduce it to within range.
+
+ We just need to record that there was another
+ digit so that we can multiply by 10 later. */
+ ++exponent;
+ else
+ num = (num * 10.0) + (*s - '0');
+
+ /* Keep track of the number of digits after the decimal point.
+ If we just divided by 10 here, we would lose precision. */
+ if (got_dot)
+ --exponent;
+ }
+ else if (!got_dot && *s == '.')
+ /* Record that we have found the decimal point. */
+ got_dot = 1;
+ else
+ /* Any other character terminates the number. */
+ break;
+ }
+
+ if (!got_digit)
+ goto noconv;
+
+ if (TOLOWER ((unsigned char)*s) == 'e')
+ {
+ /* Get the exponent specified after the `e' or `E'. */
+ int save = errno;
+ char *end;
+ long int exp;
+
+ errno = 0;
+ ++s;
+ exp = strtol (s, &end, 10);
+ if (errno == ERANGE)
+ {
+ /* The exponent overflowed a `long int'. It is probably a safe
+ assumption that an exponent that cannot be represented by
+ a `long int' exceeds the limits of a `double'. */
+ if (endptr != NULL)
+ *endptr = end;
+ if (exp < 0)
+ goto underflow;
+ else
+ goto overflow;
+ }
+ else if (end == s)
+ /* There was no exponent. Reset END to point to
+ the 'e' or 'E', so *ENDPTR will be set there. */
+ end = (char *) s - 1;
+ errno = save;
+ s = end;
+ exponent += exp;
+ }
+
+ if (endptr != NULL)
+ *endptr = (char *) s;
+
+ if (num == 0.0)
+ return 0.0;
+
+ /* Multiply NUM by 10 to the EXPONENT power,
+ checking for overflow and underflow. */
+
+ if (exponent < 0)
+ {
+ if (num < DBL_MIN * pow (10.0, (double) -exponent))
+ goto underflow;
+ }
+ else if (exponent > 0)
+ {
+ if (num > DBL_MAX * pow (10.0, (double) -exponent))
+ goto overflow;
+ }
+
+ num *= pow (10.0, (double) exponent);
+
+ return num * sign;
+
+overflow:
+ /* Return an overflow error. */
+ errno = ERANGE;
+ return HUGE_VAL * sign;
+
+underflow:
+ /* Return an underflow error. */
+ if (endptr != NULL)
+ *endptr = (char *) nptr;
+ errno = ERANGE;
+ return 0.0;
+
+noconv:
+ /* There was no number. */
+ if (endptr != NULL)
+ *endptr = (char *) nptr;
+ return 0.0;
+}
+
+#endif /* !HAVE_STRTOD */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtoimax.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtoimax.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e20c4cc
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtoimax.c
@@ -0,0 +1,106 @@
+/* Convert string representation of a number into an intmax_t value.
+ Copyright 1999-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
+
+/* Written by Paul Eggert. Modified by Chet Ramey for Bash. */
+
+#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#if HAVE_INTTYPES_H
+# include <inttypes.h>
+#endif
+
+#if HAVE_STDLIB_H
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdc.h>
+
+/* Verify a requirement at compile-time (unlike assert, which is runtime). */
+#define verify(name, assertion) struct name { char a[(assertion) ? 1 : -1]; }
+
+#ifndef HAVE_DECL_STRTOL
+"this configure-time declaration test was not run"
+#endif
+#if !HAVE_DECL_STRTOL
+extern long strtol __P((const char *, char **, int));
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_DECL_STRTOLL
+"this configure-time declaration test was not run"
+#endif
+#if !HAVE_DECL_STRTOLL && HAVE_LONG_LONG
+extern long long strtoll __P((const char *, char **, int));
+#endif
+
+#ifdef strtoimax
+#undef strtoimax
+#endif
+
+intmax_t
+strtoimax (ptr, endptr, base)
+ const char *ptr;
+ char **endptr;
+ int base;
+{
+#if HAVE_LONG_LONG
+ verify(size_is_that_of_long_or_long_long,
+ (sizeof (intmax_t) == sizeof (long) ||
+ sizeof (intmax_t) == sizeof (long long)));
+
+ if (sizeof (intmax_t) != sizeof (long))
+ return (strtoll (ptr, endptr, base));
+#else
+ verify (size_is_that_of_long, sizeof (intmax_t) == sizeof (long));
+#endif
+
+ return (strtol (ptr, endptr, base));
+}
+
+#ifdef TESTING
+# include <stdio.h>
+int
+main ()
+{
+ char *p, *endptr;
+ intmax_t x;
+#if HAVE_LONG_LONG
+ long long y;
+#endif
+ long z;
+
+ printf ("sizeof intmax_t: %d\n", sizeof (intmax_t));
+
+#if HAVE_LONG_LONG
+ printf ("sizeof long long: %d\n", sizeof (long long));
+#endif
+ printf ("sizeof long: %d\n", sizeof (long));
+
+ x = strtoimax("42", &endptr, 10);
+#if HAVE_LONG_LONG
+ y = strtoll("42", &endptr, 10);
+#else
+ y = -1;
+#endif
+ z = strtol("42", &endptr, 10);
+
+ printf ("%lld %lld %ld\n", x, y, z);
+
+ exit (0);
+}
+#endif
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtol.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtol.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..2adbb89
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtol.c
@@ -0,0 +1,258 @@
+/* Convert string representation of a number into an integer value.
+ Copyright (C) 1991,92,94,95,96,97,98,99,2000,2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ This file is part of the GNU C Library.
+
+ The GNU C Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+ modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
+ License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
+ version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU C Library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ Lesser General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
+ License along with the GNU C Library; if not, write to the Free
+ Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
+ 02111-1307 USA. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_STRTOL)
+
+#include <chartypes.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+
+#ifndef errno
+extern int errno;
+#endif
+
+#ifndef __set_errno
+# define __set_errno(Val) errno = (Val)
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_LIMITS_H
+# include <limits.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <typemax.h>
+
+#include <stdc.h>
+#include <bashansi.h>
+
+#ifndef NULL
+# define NULL 0
+#endif
+
+/* Nonzero if we are defining `strtoul' or `strtoull', operating on
+ unsigned integers. */
+#ifndef UNSIGNED
+# define UNSIGNED 0
+# define INT LONG int
+#else
+# define INT unsigned LONG int
+#endif
+
+#if UNSIGNED
+# ifdef QUAD
+# define strtol strtoull
+# else
+# define strtol strtoul
+# endif
+#else
+# ifdef QUAD
+# define strtol strtoll
+# endif
+#endif
+
+/* If QUAD is defined, we are defining `strtoll' or `strtoull',
+ operating on `long long ints. */
+
+#ifdef QUAD
+# define LONG long long
+# define STRTOL_LONG_MIN LLONG_MIN
+# define STRTOL_LONG_MAX LLONG_MAX
+# define STRTOL_ULONG_MAX ULLONG_MAX
+#else /* !QUAD */
+# define LONG long
+# define STRTOL_LONG_MIN LONG_MIN
+# define STRTOL_LONG_MAX LONG_MAX
+# define STRTOL_ULONG_MAX ULONG_MAX
+#endif
+
+/* Convert NPTR to an `unsigned long int' or `long int' in base BASE.
+ If BASE is 0 the base is determined by the presence of a leading
+ zero, indicating octal or a leading "0x" or "0X", indicating hexadecimal.
+ If BASE is < 2 or > 36, it is no longer reset to 10; EINVAL is returned.
+ If ENDPTR is not NULL, a pointer to the character after the last
+ one converted is stored in *ENDPTR. */
+
+INT
+strtol (nptr, endptr, base)
+ const char *nptr;
+ char **endptr;
+ int base;
+{
+ int negative;
+ register unsigned LONG int cutoff;
+ register unsigned int cutlim;
+ register unsigned LONG int i;
+ register const char *s;
+ register unsigned char c;
+ const char *save, *end;
+ int overflow;
+
+ if (base < 0 || base == 1 || base > 36)
+ {
+ __set_errno (EINVAL);
+ return 0;
+ }
+
+ save = s = nptr;
+
+ /* Skip white space. */
+ while (ISSPACE ((unsigned char)*s))
+ ++s;
+ if (*s == '\0')
+ goto noconv;
+
+ /* Check for a sign. */
+ if (*s == '-' || *s == '+')
+ {
+ negative = (*s == '-');
+ ++s;
+ }
+ else
+ negative = 0;
+
+ /* Recognize number prefix and if BASE is zero, figure it out ourselves. */
+ if (*s == '0')
+ {
+ if ((base == 0 || base == 16) && TOUPPER ((unsigned char) s[1]) == 'X')
+ {
+ s += 2;
+ base = 16;
+ }
+ else if (base == 0)
+ base = 8;
+ }
+ else if (base == 0)
+ base = 10;
+
+ /* Save the pointer so we can check later if anything happened. */
+ save = s;
+
+ end = NULL;
+
+ cutoff = STRTOL_ULONG_MAX / (unsigned LONG int) base;
+ cutlim = STRTOL_ULONG_MAX % (unsigned LONG int) base;
+
+ overflow = 0;
+ i = 0;
+ c = *s;
+ if (sizeof (long int) != sizeof (LONG int))
+ {
+ unsigned long int j = 0;
+ unsigned long int jmax = ULONG_MAX / base;
+
+ for (;c != '\0'; c = *++s)
+ {
+ if (s == end)
+ break;
+ if (DIGIT (c))
+ c -= '0';
+ else if (ISALPHA (c))
+ c = TOUPPER (c) - 'A' + 10;
+ else
+ break;
+
+ if ((int) c >= base)
+ break;
+ /* Note that we never can have an overflow. */
+ else if (j >= jmax)
+ {
+ /* We have an overflow. Now use the long representation. */
+ i = (unsigned LONG int) j;
+ goto use_long;
+ }
+ else
+ j = j * (unsigned long int) base + c;
+ }
+
+ i = (unsigned LONG int) j;
+ }
+ else
+ for (;c != '\0'; c = *++s)
+ {
+ if (s == end)
+ break;
+ if (DIGIT (c))
+ c -= '0';
+ else if (ISALPHA (c))
+ c = TOUPPER (c) - 'A' + 10;
+ else
+ break;
+ if ((int) c >= base)
+ break;
+ /* Check for overflow. */
+ if (i > cutoff || (i == cutoff && c > cutlim))
+ overflow = 1;
+ else
+ {
+ use_long:
+ i *= (unsigned LONG int) base;
+ i += c;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Check if anything actually happened. */
+ if (s == save)
+ goto noconv;
+
+ /* Store in ENDPTR the address of one character
+ past the last character we converted. */
+ if (endptr != NULL)
+ *endptr = (char *) s;
+
+#if !UNSIGNED
+ /* Check for a value that is within the range of
+ `unsigned LONG int', but outside the range of `LONG int'. */
+ if (overflow == 0
+ && i > (negative
+ ? -((unsigned LONG int) (STRTOL_LONG_MIN + 1)) + 1
+ : (unsigned LONG int) STRTOL_LONG_MAX))
+ overflow = 1;
+#endif
+
+ if (overflow)
+ {
+ __set_errno (ERANGE);
+#if UNSIGNED
+ return STRTOL_ULONG_MAX;
+#else
+ return negative ? STRTOL_LONG_MIN : STRTOL_LONG_MAX;
+#endif
+ }
+
+ /* Return the result of the appropriate sign. */
+ return negative ? -i : i;
+
+noconv:
+ /* We must handle a special case here: the base is 0 or 16 and the
+ first two characters are '0' and 'x', but the rest are no
+ hexadecimal digits. This is no error case. We return 0 and
+ ENDPTR points to the `x`. */
+ if (endptr != NULL)
+ {
+ if (save - nptr >= 2 && TOUPPER ((unsigned char) save[-1]) == 'X' && save[-2] == '0')
+ *endptr = (char *) &save[-1];
+ else
+ /* There was no number to convert. */
+ *endptr = (char *) nptr;
+ }
+
+ return 0L;
+}
+
+#endif /* !HAVE_STRTOL */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtoll.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtoll.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..2000497
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtoll.c
@@ -0,0 +1,26 @@
+/* Copyright (C) 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the
+Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any
+later version.
+
+This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_LONG_LONG) && !defined (HAVE_STRTOLL)
+
+#define QUAD 1
+#undef HAVE_STRTOL
+
+#include "strtol.c"
+
+#endif /* HAVE_LONG_LONG && !HAVE_STRTOLL */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtoul.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtoul.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..4a75d76
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtoul.c
@@ -0,0 +1,26 @@
+/* Copyright (C) 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the
+Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any
+later version.
+
+This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#ifndef HAVE_STRTOUL
+
+#define UNSIGNED 1
+#undef HAVE_STRTOL
+
+#include <strtol.c>
+
+#endif /* !HAVE_STRTOUL */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtoull.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtoull.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..09a2fac
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtoull.c
@@ -0,0 +1,27 @@
+/* Copyright (C) 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the
+Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any
+later version.
+
+This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_LONG_LONG) && !defined (HAVE_STRTOULL)
+
+#define QUAD 1
+#define UNSIGNED 1
+#undef HAVE_STRTOL
+
+#include "strtol.c"
+
+#endif /* HAVE_LONG_LONG && !HAVE_STRTOULL */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtoumax.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtoumax.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e723d49
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtoumax.c
@@ -0,0 +1,106 @@
+/* Convert string representation of a number into an uintmax_t value.
+ Copyright 1999-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
+
+/* Written by Paul Eggert. Modified by Chet Ramey for Bash. */
+
+#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#if HAVE_INTTYPES_H
+# include <inttypes.h>
+#endif
+
+#if HAVE_STDLIB_H
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdc.h>
+
+/* Verify a requirement at compile-time (unlike assert, which is runtime). */
+#define verify(name, assertion) struct name { char a[(assertion) ? 1 : -1]; }
+
+#ifndef HAVE_DECL_STRTOUL
+"this configure-time declaration test was not run"
+#endif
+#if !HAVE_DECL_STRTOUL
+extern unsigned long strtoul __P((const char *, char **, int));
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_DECL_STRTOULL
+"this configure-time declaration test was not run"
+#endif
+#if !HAVE_DECL_STRTOULL && HAVE_UNSIGNED_LONG_LONG
+extern unsigned long long strtoull __P((const char *, char **, int));
+#endif
+
+#ifdef strtoumax
+#undef strtoumax
+#endif
+
+uintmax_t
+strtoumax (ptr, endptr, base)
+ const char *ptr;
+ char **endptr;
+ int base;
+{
+#if HAVE_UNSIGNED_LONG_LONG
+ verify (size_is_that_of_unsigned_long_or_unsigned_long_long,
+ (sizeof (uintmax_t) == sizeof (unsigned long) ||
+ sizeof (uintmax_t) == sizeof (unsigned long long)));
+
+ if (sizeof (uintmax_t) != sizeof (unsigned long))
+ return (strtoull (ptr, endptr, base));
+#else
+ verify (size_is_that_of_unsigned_long, sizeof (uintmax_t) == sizeof (unsigned long));
+#endif
+
+ return (strtoul (ptr, endptr, base));
+}
+
+#ifdef TESTING
+# include <stdio.h>
+int
+main ()
+{
+ char *p, *endptr;
+ uintmax_t x;
+#if HAVE_UNSIGNED_LONG_LONG
+ unsigned long long y;
+#endif
+ unsigned long z;
+
+ printf ("sizeof uintmax_t: %d\n", sizeof (uintmax_t));
+
+#if HAVE_UNSIGNED_LONG_LONG
+ printf ("sizeof unsigned long long: %d\n", sizeof (unsigned long long));
+#endif
+ printf ("sizeof unsigned long: %d\n", sizeof (unsigned long));
+
+ x = strtoumax("42", &endptr, 10);
+#if HAVE_LONG_LONG
+ y = strtoull("42", &endptr, 10);
+#else
+ y = 0;
+#endif
+ z = strtoul("42", &endptr, 10);
+
+ printf ("%llu %llu %lu\n", x, y, z);
+
+ exit (0);
+}
+#endif
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtrans.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtrans.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..acf9d69
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/strtrans.c
@@ -0,0 +1,274 @@
+/* strtrans.c - Translate and untranslate strings with ANSI-C escape
+ sequences. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 2000
+ Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <bashansi.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <chartypes.h>
+
+#include "shell.h"
+
+#ifdef ESC
+#undef ESC
+#endif
+#define ESC '\033' /* ASCII */
+
+/* Convert STRING by expanding the escape sequences specified by the
+ ANSI C standard. If SAWC is non-null, recognize `\c' and use that
+ as a string terminator. If we see \c, set *SAWC to 1 before
+ returning. LEN is the length of STRING. If (FLAGS&1) is non-zero,
+ that we're translating a string for `echo -e', and therefore should not
+ treat a single quote as a character that may be escaped with a backslash.
+ If (FLAGS&2) is non-zero, we're expanding for the parser and want to
+ quote CTLESC and CTLNUL with CTLESC. If (flags&4) is non-zero, we want
+ to remove the backslash before any unrecognized escape sequence. */
+char *
+ansicstr (string, len, flags, sawc, rlen)
+ char *string;
+ int len, flags, *sawc, *rlen;
+{
+ int c, temp;
+ char *ret, *r, *s;
+
+ if (string == 0 || *string == '\0')
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+
+ ret = (char *)xmalloc (2*len + 1); /* 2*len for possible CTLESC */
+ for (r = ret, s = string; s && *s; )
+ {
+ c = *s++;
+ if (c != '\\' || *s == '\0')
+ *r++ = c;
+ else
+ {
+ switch (c = *s++)
+ {
+#if defined (__STDC__)
+ case 'a': c = '\a'; break;
+ case 'v': c = '\v'; break;
+#else
+ case 'a': c = '\007'; break;
+ case 'v': c = (int) 0x0B; break;
+#endif
+ case 'b': c = '\b'; break;
+ case 'e': case 'E': /* ESC -- non-ANSI */
+ c = ESC; break;
+ case 'f': c = '\f'; break;
+ case 'n': c = '\n'; break;
+ case 'r': c = '\r'; break;
+ case 't': c = '\t'; break;
+ case '0': case '1': case '2': case '3':
+ case '4': case '5': case '6': case '7':
+ /* If (FLAGS & 1), we're translating a string for echo -e (or
+ the equivalent xpg_echo option), so we obey the SUSv3/
+ POSIX-2001 requirement and accept 0-3 octal digits after
+ a leading `0'. */
+ temp = 2 + ((flags & 1) && (c == '0'));
+ for (c -= '0'; ISOCTAL (*s) && temp--; s++)
+ c = (c * 8) + OCTVALUE (*s);
+ c &= 0xFF;
+ break;
+ case 'x': /* Hex digit -- non-ANSI */
+ if ((flags & 2) && *s == '{')
+ {
+ flags |= 16; /* internal flag value */
+ s++;
+ }
+ /* Consume at least two hex characters */
+ for (temp = 2, c = 0; ISXDIGIT ((unsigned char)*s) && temp--; s++)
+ c = (c * 16) + HEXVALUE (*s);
+ /* DGK says that after a `\x{' ksh93 consumes ISXDIGIT chars
+ until a non-xdigit or `}', so potentially more than two
+ chars are consumed. */
+ if (flags & 16)
+ {
+ for ( ; ISXDIGIT ((unsigned char)*s); s++)
+ c = (c * 16) + HEXVALUE (*s);
+ flags &= ~16;
+ if (*s == '}')
+ s++;
+ }
+ /* \x followed by non-hex digits is passed through unchanged */
+ else if (temp == 2)
+ {
+ *r++ = '\\';
+ c = 'x';
+ }
+ c &= 0xFF;
+ break;
+ case '\\':
+ break;
+ case '\'': case '"': case '?':
+ if (flags & 1)
+ *r++ = '\\';
+ break;
+ case 'c':
+ if (sawc)
+ {
+ *sawc = 1;
+ *r = '\0';
+ if (rlen)
+ *rlen = r - ret;
+ return ret;
+ }
+ else if ((flags & 1) == 0 && (c = *s))
+ {
+ s++;
+ c = TOCTRL(c);
+ break;
+ }
+ /*FALLTHROUGH*/
+ default:
+ if ((flags & 4) == 0)
+ *r++ = '\\';
+ break;
+ }
+ if ((flags & 2) && (c == CTLESC || c == CTLNUL))
+ *r++ = CTLESC;
+ *r++ = c;
+ }
+ }
+ *r = '\0';
+ if (rlen)
+ *rlen = r - ret;
+ return ret;
+}
+
+/* Take a string STR, possibly containing non-printing characters, and turn it
+ into a $'...' ANSI-C style quoted string. Returns a new string. */
+char *
+ansic_quote (str, flags, rlen)
+ char *str;
+ int flags, *rlen;
+{
+ char *r, *ret, *s;
+ int l, rsize, t;
+ unsigned char c;
+
+ if (str == 0 || *str == 0)
+ return ((char *)0);
+
+ l = strlen (str);
+ rsize = 4 * l + 4;
+ r = ret = (char *)xmalloc (rsize);
+
+ *r++ = '$';
+ *r++ = '\'';
+
+ for (s = str, l = 0; *s; s++)
+ {
+ c = *s;
+ l = 1; /* 1 == add backslash; 0 == no backslash */
+ switch (c)
+ {
+ case ESC: c = 'E'; break;
+#ifdef __STDC__
+ case '\a': c = 'a'; break;
+ case '\v': c = 'v'; break;
+#else
+ case '\007': c = 'a'; break;
+ case 0x0b: c = 'v'; break;
+#endif
+
+ case '\b': c = 'b'; break;
+ case '\f': c = 'f'; break;
+ case '\n': c = 'n'; break;
+ case '\r': c = 'r'; break;
+ case '\t': c = 't'; break;
+ case '\\':
+ case '\'':
+ break;
+ default:
+ if (ISPRINT (c) == 0)
+ {
+ *r++ = '\\';
+ *r++ = TOCHAR ((c >> 6) & 07);
+ *r++ = TOCHAR ((c >> 3) & 07);
+ *r++ = TOCHAR (c & 07);
+ continue;
+ }
+ l = 0;
+ break;
+ }
+ if (l)
+ *r++ = '\\';
+ *r++ = c;
+ }
+
+ *r++ = '\'';
+ *r = '\0';
+ if (rlen)
+ *rlen = r - ret;
+ return ret;
+}
+
+/* return 1 if we need to quote with $'...' because of non-printing chars. */
+int
+ansic_shouldquote (string)
+ const char *string;
+{
+ const char *s;
+ unsigned char c;
+
+ if (string == 0)
+ return 0;
+
+ for (s = string; c = *s; s++)
+ if (ISPRINT (c) == 0)
+ return 1;
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* $'...' ANSI-C expand the portion of STRING between START and END and
+ return the result. The result cannot be longer than the input string. */
+char *
+ansiexpand (string, start, end, lenp)
+ char *string;
+ int start, end, *lenp;
+{
+ char *temp, *t;
+ int len, tlen;
+
+ temp = (char *)xmalloc (end - start + 1);
+ for (tlen = 0, len = start; len < end; )
+ temp[tlen++] = string[len++];
+ temp[tlen] = '\0';
+
+ if (*temp)
+ {
+ t = ansicstr (temp, tlen, 2, (int *)NULL, lenp);
+ free (temp);
+ return (t);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if (lenp)
+ *lenp = 0;
+ return (temp);
+ }
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/times.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/times.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..7136cf2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/times.c
@@ -0,0 +1,77 @@
+/* times.c - times(3) library function */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_TIMES)
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <posixtime.h>
+#include <systimes.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_SYS_RESOURCE_H) && defined (HAVE_GETRUSAGE)
+# include <sys/resource.h>
+#endif /* HAVE_SYS_RESOURCE_H && HAVE_GETRUSAGE */
+
+extern long get_clk_tck __P((void));
+
+#define CONVTCK(r) (r.tv_sec * clk_tck + r.tv_usec / (1000000 / clk_tck))
+
+clock_t
+times(tms)
+ struct tms *tms;
+{
+ clock_t rv;
+ static long clk_tck = -1;
+
+#if defined (HAVE_GETRUSAGE)
+ struct timeval tv;
+ struct rusage ru;
+
+ if (clk_tck == -1)
+ clk_tck = get_clk_tck();
+
+ if (getrusage(RUSAGE_SELF, &ru) < 0)
+ return ((clock_t)-1);
+ tms->tms_utime = CONVTCK(ru.ru_utime);
+ tms->tms_stime = CONVTCK(ru.ru_stime);
+
+ if (getrusage(RUSAGE_CHILDREN, &ru) < 0)
+ return ((clock_t)-1);
+ tms->tms_cutime = CONVTCK(ru.ru_utime);
+ tms->tms_cstime = CONVTCK(ru.ru_stime);
+
+ if (gettimeofday(&tv, (struct timezone *) 0) < 0)
+ return ((clock_t)-1);
+ rv = (clock_t)(CONVTCK(tv));
+#else /* !HAVE_GETRUSAGE */
+ if (clk_tck == -1)
+ clk_tck = get_clk_tck();
+
+ /* We can't do anything. */
+ tms->tms_utime = tms->tms_stime = (clock_t)0;
+ tms->tms_cutime = tms->tms_cstime = (clock_t)0;
+
+ rv = (clock_t)time((time_t *)0) * clk_tck;
+# endif /* HAVE_GETRUSAGE */
+
+ return rv;
+}
+#endif /* !HAVE_TIMES */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/timeval.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/timeval.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f7f624e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/timeval.c
@@ -0,0 +1,145 @@
+/* timeval.c - functions to perform operations on struct timevals */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL)
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <posixtime.h>
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+struct timeval *
+difftimeval (d, t1, t2)
+ struct timeval *d, *t1, *t2;
+{
+ d->tv_sec = t2->tv_sec - t1->tv_sec;
+ d->tv_usec = t2->tv_usec - t1->tv_usec;
+ if (d->tv_usec < 0)
+ {
+ d->tv_usec += 1000000;
+ d->tv_sec -= 1;
+ if (d->tv_sec < 0) /* ??? -- BSD/OS does this */
+ {
+ d->tv_sec = 0;
+ d->tv_usec = 0;
+ }
+ }
+ return d;
+}
+
+struct timeval *
+addtimeval (d, t1, t2)
+ struct timeval *d, *t1, *t2;
+{
+ d->tv_sec = t1->tv_sec + t2->tv_sec;
+ d->tv_usec = t1->tv_usec + t2->tv_usec;
+ if (d->tv_usec >= 1000000)
+ {
+ d->tv_usec -= 1000000;
+ d->tv_sec += 1;
+ }
+ return d;
+}
+
+/* Do "cpu = ((user + sys) * 10000) / real;" with timevals.
+ Barely-tested code from Deven T. Corzine <deven@ties.org>. */
+int
+timeval_to_cpu (rt, ut, st)
+ struct timeval *rt, *ut, *st; /* real, user, sys */
+{
+ struct timeval t1, t2;
+ register int i;
+
+ addtimeval (&t1, ut, st);
+ t2.tv_sec = rt->tv_sec;
+ t2.tv_usec = rt->tv_usec;
+
+ for (i = 0; i < 6; i++)
+ {
+ if ((t1.tv_sec > 99999999) || (t2.tv_sec > 99999999))
+ break;
+ t1.tv_sec *= 10;
+ t1.tv_sec += t1.tv_usec / 100000;
+ t1.tv_usec *= 10;
+ t1.tv_usec %= 1000000;
+ t2.tv_sec *= 10;
+ t2.tv_sec += t2.tv_usec / 100000;
+ t2.tv_usec *= 10;
+ t2.tv_usec %= 1000000;
+ }
+ for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
+ {
+ if (t1.tv_sec < 100000000)
+ t1.tv_sec *= 10;
+ else
+ t2.tv_sec /= 10;
+ }
+
+ return ((t2.tv_sec == 0) ? 0 : t1.tv_sec / t2.tv_sec);
+}
+
+/* Convert a pointer to a struct timeval to seconds and thousandths of a
+ second, returning the values in *SP and *SFP, respectively. This does
+ rounding on the fractional part, not just truncation to three places. */
+void
+timeval_to_secs (tvp, sp, sfp)
+ struct timeval *tvp;
+ time_t *sp;
+ int *sfp;
+{
+ int rest;
+
+ *sp = tvp->tv_sec;
+
+ *sfp = tvp->tv_usec % 1000000; /* pretty much a no-op */
+ rest = *sfp % 1000;
+ *sfp = (*sfp * 1000) / 1000000;
+ if (rest >= 500)
+ *sfp += 1;
+
+ /* Sanity check */
+ if (*sfp >= 1000)
+ {
+ *sp += 1;
+ *sfp -= 1000;
+ }
+}
+
+/* Print the contents of a struct timeval * in a standard way to stdio
+ stream FP. */
+void
+print_timeval (fp, tvp)
+ FILE *fp;
+ struct timeval *tvp;
+{
+ time_t timestamp;
+ long minutes;
+ int seconds, seconds_fraction;
+
+ timeval_to_secs (tvp, &timestamp, &seconds_fraction);
+
+ minutes = timestamp / 60;
+ seconds = timestamp % 60;
+
+ fprintf (fp, "%ldm%d.%03ds", minutes, seconds, seconds_fraction);
+}
+#endif /* HAVE_TIMEVAL */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/tmpfile.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/tmpfile.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..fb7b732
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/tmpfile.c
@@ -0,0 +1,216 @@
+/*
+ * tmpfile.c - functions to create and safely open temp files for the shell.
+ */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT
+ ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY
+ or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public
+ License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
+ Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#include <bashtypes.h>
+#include <posixstat.h>
+#include <posixtime.h>
+#include <filecntl.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+
+#include <shell.h>
+
+#ifndef errno
+extern int errno;
+#endif
+
+#define BASEOPENFLAGS (O_CREAT | O_TRUNC | O_EXCL)
+
+#define DEFAULT_TMPDIR "." /* bogus default, should be changed */
+#define DEFAULT_NAMEROOT "shtmp"
+
+extern pid_t dollar_dollar_pid;
+
+static char *sys_tmpdir = (char *)NULL;
+static int ntmpfiles;
+static int tmpnamelen = -1;
+static unsigned long filenum = 1L;
+
+static char *
+get_sys_tmpdir ()
+{
+ struct stat sb;
+
+ if (sys_tmpdir)
+ return sys_tmpdir;
+
+#ifdef P_tmpdir
+ sys_tmpdir = P_tmpdir;
+ if (file_iswdir (sys_tmpdir))
+ return sys_tmpdir;
+#endif
+
+ sys_tmpdir = "/tmp";
+ if (file_iswdir (sys_tmpdir))
+ return sys_tmpdir;
+
+ sys_tmpdir = "/var/tmp";
+ if (file_iswdir (sys_tmpdir))
+ return sys_tmpdir;
+
+ sys_tmpdir = "/usr/tmp";
+ if (file_iswdir (sys_tmpdir))
+ return sys_tmpdir;
+
+ sys_tmpdir = DEFAULT_TMPDIR;
+
+ return sys_tmpdir;
+}
+
+static char *
+get_tmpdir (flags)
+ int flags;
+{
+ char *tdir;
+
+ tdir = (flags & MT_USETMPDIR) ? get_string_value ("TMPDIR") : (char *)NULL;
+ if (tdir == 0)
+ tdir = get_sys_tmpdir ();
+
+#if defined (HAVE_PATHCONF) && defined (_PC_NAME_MAX)
+ if (tmpnamelen == -1)
+ tmpnamelen = pathconf (tdir, _PC_NAME_MAX);
+#else
+ tmpnamelen = 0;
+#endif
+
+ return tdir;
+}
+
+char *
+sh_mktmpname (nameroot, flags)
+ char *nameroot;
+ int flags;
+{
+ char *filename, *tdir, *lroot;
+ struct stat sb;
+ int r, tdlen;
+
+ filename = (char *)xmalloc (PATH_MAX + 1);
+ tdir = get_tmpdir (flags);
+ tdlen = strlen (tdir);
+
+ lroot = nameroot ? nameroot : DEFAULT_NAMEROOT;
+
+#ifdef USE_MKTEMP
+ sprintf (filename, "%s/%s.XXXXXX", tdir, lroot);
+ if (mktemp (filename) == 0)
+ {
+ free (filename);
+ filename = NULL;
+ }
+#else /* !USE_MKTEMP */
+ while (1)
+ {
+ filenum = (filenum << 1) ^
+ (unsigned long) time ((time_t *)0) ^
+ (unsigned long) dollar_dollar_pid ^
+ (unsigned long) ((flags & MT_USERANDOM) ? get_random_number () : ntmpfiles++);
+ sprintf (filename, "%s/%s-%lu", tdir, lroot, filenum);
+ if (tmpnamelen > 0 && tmpnamelen < 32)
+ filename[tdlen + 1 + tmpnamelen] = '\0';
+# ifdef HAVE_LSTAT
+ r = lstat (filename, &sb);
+# else
+ r = stat (filename, &sb);
+# endif
+ if (r < 0 && errno == ENOENT)
+ break;
+ }
+#endif /* !USE_MKTEMP */
+
+ return filename;
+}
+
+int
+sh_mktmpfd (nameroot, flags, namep)
+ char *nameroot;
+ int flags;
+ char **namep;
+{
+ char *filename, *tdir, *lroot;
+ int fd, tdlen;
+
+ filename = (char *)xmalloc (PATH_MAX + 1);
+ tdir = get_tmpdir (flags);
+ tdlen = strlen (tdir);
+
+ lroot = nameroot ? nameroot : DEFAULT_NAMEROOT;
+
+#ifdef USE_MKSTEMP
+ sprintf (filename, "%s/%s.XXXXXX", tdir, lroot);
+ fd = mkstemp (filename);
+ if (fd < 0 || namep == 0)
+ {
+ free (filename);
+ filename = NULL;
+ }
+ if (namep)
+ *namep = filename;
+ return fd;
+#else /* !USE_MKSTEMP */
+ do
+ {
+ filenum = (filenum << 1) ^
+ (unsigned long) time ((time_t *)0) ^
+ (unsigned long) dollar_dollar_pid ^
+ (unsigned long) ((flags & MT_USERANDOM) ? get_random_number () : ntmpfiles++);
+ sprintf (filename, "%s/%s-%lu", tdir, lroot, filenum);
+ if (tmpnamelen > 0 && tmpnamelen < 32)
+ filename[tdlen + 1 + tmpnamelen] = '\0';
+ fd = open (filename, BASEOPENFLAGS | ((flags & MT_READWRITE) ? O_RDWR : O_WRONLY), 0600);
+ }
+ while (fd < 0 && errno == EEXIST);
+
+ if (namep)
+ *namep = filename;
+ else
+ free (filename);
+
+ return fd;
+#endif /* !USE_MKSTEMP */
+}
+
+FILE *
+sh_mktmpfp (nameroot, flags, namep)
+ char *nameroot;
+ int flags;
+ char **namep;
+{
+ int fd;
+ FILE *fp;
+
+ fd = sh_mktmpfd (nameroot, flags, namep);
+ if (fd < 0)
+ return ((FILE *)NULL);
+ fp = fdopen (fd, (flags & MT_READWRITE) ? "w+" : "w");
+ if (fp == 0)
+ close (fd);
+ return fp;
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/vprint.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/vprint.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..929bdbc
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/vprint.c
@@ -0,0 +1,85 @@
+/* vprint.c -- v[fs]printf() for 4.[23] BSD systems. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1987,1989 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+version.
+
+Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+for more details.
+
+You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#if defined (USE_VFPRINTF_EMULATION)
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+#if !defined (NULL)
+# if defined (__STDC__)
+# define NULL ((void *)0)
+# else
+# define NULL 0x0
+# endif /* __STDC__ */
+#endif /* !NULL */
+
+/*
+ * Beware! Don't trust the value returned by either of these functions; it
+ * seems that pre-4.3-tahoe implementations of _doprnt () return the first
+ * argument, i.e. a char *.
+ */
+#include <varargs.h>
+
+int
+vfprintf (iop, fmt, ap)
+ FILE *iop;
+ char *fmt;
+ va_list ap;
+{
+ int len;
+ char localbuf[BUFSIZ];
+
+ if (iop->_flag & _IONBF)
+ {
+ iop->_flag &= ~_IONBF;
+ iop->_ptr = iop->_base = localbuf;
+ len = _doprnt (fmt, ap, iop);
+ (void) fflush (iop);
+ iop->_flag |= _IONBF;
+ iop->_base = NULL;
+ iop->_bufsiz = 0;
+ iop->_cnt = 0;
+ }
+ else
+ len = _doprnt (fmt, ap, iop);
+ return (ferror (iop) ? EOF : len);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Ditto for vsprintf
+ */
+int
+vsprintf (str, fmt, ap)
+ char *str, *fmt;
+ va_list ap;
+{
+ FILE f;
+ int len;
+
+ f._flag = _IOWRT|_IOSTRG;
+ f._ptr = str;
+ f._cnt = 32767;
+ len = _doprnt (fmt, ap, &f);
+ *f._ptr = 0;
+ return (len);
+}
+#endif /* USE_VFPRINTF_EMULATION */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/winsize.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/winsize.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..8b39c99
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/winsize.c
@@ -0,0 +1,82 @@
+/* Handle window size changes and information. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#include "config.h"
+
+#include <stdc.h>
+
+#include "bashtypes.h"
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <sys/ioctl.h>
+
+#if !defined (STRUCT_WINSIZE_IN_SYS_IOCTL)
+/* For struct winsize on SCO */
+/* sys/ptem.h has winsize but needs mblk_t from sys/stream.h */
+# if defined (HAVE_SYS_PTEM_H) && defined (TIOCGWINSZ) && defined (SIGWINCH)
+# if defined (HAVE_SYS_STREAM_H)
+# include <sys/stream.h>
+# endif
+# include <sys/ptem.h>
+# endif /* HAVE_SYS_PTEM_H && TIOCGWINSZ && SIGWINCH */
+#endif /* !STRUCT_WINSIZE_IN_SYS_IOCTL */
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+/* Return the fd from which we are actually getting input. */
+#define input_tty() (shell_tty != -1) ? shell_tty : fileno (stderr)
+
+#if !defined (errno)
+extern int errno;
+#endif /* !errno */
+
+extern int shell_tty;
+
+#if defined (READLINE)
+extern void rl_set_screen_size __P((int, int));
+#endif
+
+void
+get_new_window_size (from_sig, rp, cp)
+ int from_sig;
+ int *rp, *cp;
+{
+#if defined (TIOCGWINSZ)
+ struct winsize win;
+ int tty;
+
+ tty = input_tty ();
+ if (tty >= 0 && (ioctl (tty, TIOCGWINSZ, &win) == 0) &&
+ win.ws_row > 0 && win.ws_col > 0)
+ {
+ sh_set_lines_and_columns (win.ws_row, win.ws_col);
+#if defined (READLINE)
+ rl_set_screen_size (win.ws_row, win.ws_col);
+ if (rp)
+ *rp = win.ws_row;
+ if (cp)
+ *cp = win.ws_col;
+#endif
+ }
+#endif
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/xstrchr.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/xstrchr.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3272837
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/xstrchr.c
@@ -0,0 +1,78 @@
+/* xstrchr.c - strchr(3) that handles multibyte characters. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#ifdef HAVE_STDLIB_H
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "bashansi.h"
+#include "shmbutil.h"
+
+#undef xstrchr
+
+/* In some locales, the non-first byte of some multibyte characters have
+ the same value as some ascii character. Faced with these strings, a
+ legacy strchr() might return the wrong value. */
+
+char *
+#if defined (PROTOTYPES)
+xstrchr (const char *s, int c)
+#else
+xstrchr (s, c)
+ const char *s;
+ int c;
+#endif
+{
+#if HANDLE_MULTIBYTE
+ char *pos;
+ mbstate_t state;
+ size_t strlength, mblength;
+
+ /* The locale encodings with said weird property are BIG5, BIG5-HKSCS,
+ GBK, GB18030, SHIFT_JIS, and JOHAB. They exhibit the problem only
+ when c >= 0x30. We can therefore use the faster bytewise search if
+ c <= 0x30. */
+ if ((unsigned char)c >= '0' && MB_CUR_MAX > 1)
+ {
+ pos = (char *)s;
+ memset (&state, '\0', sizeof(mbstate_t));
+ strlength = strlen (s);
+
+ while (strlength > 0)
+ {
+ mblength = mbrlen (pos, strlength, &state);
+ if (mblength == (size_t)-2 || mblength == (size_t)-1 || mblength == (size_t)0)
+ mblength = 1;
+
+ if (c == (unsigned char)*pos)
+ return pos;
+
+ strlength -= mblength;
+ pos += mblength;
+ }
+
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+ }
+ else
+#endif
+ return (strchr (s, c));
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/zcatfd.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/zcatfd.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..24020eb
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/zcatfd.c
@@ -0,0 +1,68 @@
+/* Copyright (C) 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <errno.h>
+
+#include <stdc.h>
+
+#if !defined (errno)
+extern int errno;
+#endif
+
+extern ssize_t zread __P((int, char *, size_t));
+extern int zwrite __P((int, char *, ssize_t));
+
+/* Dump contents of file descriptor FD to OFD. FN is the filename for
+ error messages (not used right now). */
+int
+zcatfd (fd, ofd, fn)
+ int fd, ofd;
+ char *fn;
+{
+ ssize_t nr;
+ int rval;
+ char lbuf[128];
+
+ rval = 0;
+ while (1)
+ {
+ nr = zread (fd, lbuf, sizeof (lbuf));
+ if (nr == 0)
+ break;
+ else if (nr < 0)
+ {
+ rval = -1;
+ break;
+ }
+ else if (zwrite (ofd, lbuf, nr) < 0)
+ {
+ rval = -1;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ return rval;
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/zread.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/zread.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..460234b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/zread.c
@@ -0,0 +1,136 @@
+/* Copyright (C) 1999-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <errno.h>
+
+#if !defined (errno)
+extern int errno;
+#endif
+
+#ifndef SEEK_CUR
+# define SEEK_CUR 1
+#endif
+
+/* Read LEN bytes from FD into BUF. Retry the read on EINTR. Any other
+ error causes the loop to break. */
+ssize_t
+zread (fd, buf, len)
+ int fd;
+ char *buf;
+ size_t len;
+{
+ ssize_t r;
+
+ while ((r = read (fd, buf, len)) < 0 && errno == EINTR)
+ ;
+ return r;
+}
+
+/* Read LEN bytes from FD into BUF. Retry the read on EINTR, up to three
+ interrupts. Any other error causes the loop to break. */
+
+#ifdef NUM_INTR
+# undef NUM_INTR
+#endif
+#define NUM_INTR 3
+
+ssize_t
+zreadintr (fd, buf, len)
+ int fd;
+ char *buf;
+ size_t len;
+{
+ ssize_t r;
+ int nintr;
+
+ for (nintr = 0; ; )
+ {
+ r = read (fd, buf, len);
+ if (r >= 0)
+ return r;
+ if (r == -1 && errno == EINTR)
+ {
+ if (++nintr > NUM_INTR)
+ return -1;
+ continue;
+ }
+ return r;
+ }
+}
+
+/* Read one character from FD and return it in CP. Return values are as
+ in read(2). This does some local buffering to avoid many one-character
+ calls to read(2), like those the `read' builtin performs. */
+
+static char lbuf[128];
+static size_t lind, lused;
+
+ssize_t
+zreadc (fd, cp)
+ int fd;
+ char *cp;
+{
+ ssize_t nr;
+
+ if (lind == lused || lused == 0)
+ {
+ nr = zread (fd, lbuf, sizeof (lbuf));
+ lind = 0;
+ if (nr <= 0)
+ {
+ lused = 0;
+ return nr;
+ }
+ lused = nr;
+ }
+ if (cp)
+ *cp = lbuf[lind++];
+ return 1;
+}
+
+void
+zreset ()
+{
+ lind = lused = 0;
+}
+
+/* Sync the seek pointer for FD so that the kernel's idea of the last char
+ read is the last char returned by zreadc. */
+void
+zsyncfd (fd)
+ int fd;
+{
+ off_t off;
+ int r;
+
+ off = lused - lind;
+ r = 0;
+ if (off > 0)
+ r = lseek (fd, -off, SEEK_CUR);
+
+ if (r >= 0)
+ lused = lind = 0;
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/zwrite.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/zwrite.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..cf1f9e6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/sh/zwrite.c
@@ -0,0 +1,62 @@
+/* Copyright (C) 1999-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Bash, the Bourne Again SHell.
+
+ Bash is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
+ Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
+ version.
+
+ Bash is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
+ WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
+ for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with Bash; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <errno.h>
+
+#if !defined (errno)
+extern int errno;
+#endif
+
+/* Write NB bytes from BUF to file descriptor FD, retrying the write if
+ it is interrupted. We retry three times if we get a zero-length
+ write. Any other signal causes this function to return prematurely. */
+int
+zwrite (fd, buf, nb)
+ int fd;
+ char *buf;
+ size_t nb;
+{
+ int n, i, nt;
+
+ for (n = nb, nt = 0;;)
+ {
+ i = write (fd, buf, n);
+ if (i > 0)
+ {
+ n -= i;
+ if (n <= 0)
+ return nb;
+ buf += i;
+ }
+ else if (i == 0)
+ {
+ if (++nt > 3)
+ return (nb - n);
+ }
+ else if (errno != EINTR)
+ return -1;
+ }
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/Makefile.in b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/Makefile.in
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..bf5639f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/Makefile.in
@@ -0,0 +1,91 @@
+## -*- text -*- ####################################################
+# #
+# Makefile for termcap replacement libbrary. #
+# #
+####################################################################
+
+# Copyright (C) 1996-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+# any later version.
+
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+# GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA.
+
+srcdir = @srcdir@
+VPATH = .:@srcdir@
+topdir = @top_srcdir@
+BUILD_DIR = @BUILD_DIR@
+
+libdir = @libdir@
+
+INSTALL = @INSTALL@
+INSTALL_PROGRAM = @INSTALL_PROGRAM@
+INSTALL_DATA = @INSTALL_DATA@
+
+CC = @CC@
+RANLIB = @RANLIB@
+AR = @AR@
+ARFLAGS = @ARFLAGS@
+RM = rm -f
+CP = cp
+MV = mv
+
+SHELL = @MAKE_SHELL@
+
+CFLAGS = @CFLAGS@
+CPPFLAGS = @CPPFLAGS@
+LDFLAGS = @LDFLAGS@
+
+DEFS = @DEFS@
+
+INCLUDES = -I. -I../.. -I$(topdir) -I$(topdir)/lib -I$(srcdir)
+
+CCFLAGS = $(CFLAGS) $(DEFS) $(CPPFLAGS) ${INCLUDES}
+
+# Here is a rule for making .o files from .c files that doesn't force
+# the type of the machine (like -sun3) into the flags.
+.c.o:
+ $(CC) -c $(CCFLAGS) $<
+
+SOURCES = termcap.c tparam.c
+OBJECTS = termcap.o tparam.o
+
+DOCUMENTATION = termcap.texinfo
+
+THINGS_TO_TAR = $(SOURCES) $(DOCUMENTATION)
+
+##########################################################################
+
+all: libtermcap.a
+
+libtermcap.a: $(OBJECTS)
+ $(RM) -f $@
+ $(AR) $(ARFLAGS) $@ $(OBJECTS)
+ -test -n "$(RANLIB)" && $(RANLIB) $@
+
+install:
+
+clean:
+ $(RM) *.o *.a *.log *.cp *.tp *.vr *.fn *.aux *.pg *.toc
+
+mostlyclean: clean
+
+distclean maintainer-clean: clean
+ $(RM) Makefile
+
+$(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/libtermcap.a: libtermcap.a
+ ${INSTALL_DATA} -c -m 644 libtermcap.a $@
+ -test -n "$(RANLIB)" && $(RANLIB) -t $@
+
+termcap.o: $(BUILD_DIR)/config.h
+tparam.o: $(BUILD_DIR)/config.h
+version.o: $(BUILD_DIR)/config.h
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/COPYING b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/COPYING
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..2b940a4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/COPYING
@@ -0,0 +1,347 @@
+ GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
+ Version 2, June 1991
+
+ Copyright (C) 1989, 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA
+ Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
+ of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
+
+The Free Software Foundation has exempted Bash from the requirement of
+Paragraph 2c of the General Public License. This is to say, there is
+no requirement for Bash to print a notice when it is started
+interactively in the usual way. We made this exception because users
+and standards expect shells not to print such messages. This
+exception applies to any program that serves as a shell and that is
+based primarily on Bash as opposed to other GNU software.
+
+ Preamble
+
+ The licenses for most software are designed to take away your
+freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the GNU General Public
+License is intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change free
+software--to make sure the software is free for all its users. This
+General Public License applies to most of the Free Software
+Foundation's software and to any other program whose authors commit to
+using it. (Some other Free Software Foundation software is covered by
+the GNU Library General Public License instead.) You can apply it to
+your programs, too.
+
+ When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not
+price. Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you
+have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for
+this service if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it
+if you want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it
+in new free programs; and that you know you can do these things.
+
+ To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid
+anyone to deny you these rights or to ask you to surrender the rights.
+These restrictions translate to certain responsibilities for you if you
+distribute copies of the software, or if you modify it.
+
+ For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether
+gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all the rights that
+you have. You must make sure that they, too, receive or can get the
+source code. And you must show them these terms so they know their
+rights.
+
+ We protect your rights with two steps: (1) copyright the software, and
+(2) offer you this license which gives you legal permission to copy,
+distribute and/or modify the software.
+
+ Also, for each author's protection and ours, we want to make certain
+that everyone understands that there is no warranty for this free
+software. If the software is modified by someone else and passed on, we
+want its recipients to know that what they have is not the original, so
+that any problems introduced by others will not reflect on the original
+authors' reputations.
+
+ Finally, any free program is threatened constantly by software
+patents. We wish to avoid the danger that redistributors of a free
+program will individually obtain patent licenses, in effect making the
+program proprietary. To prevent this, we have made it clear that any
+patent must be licensed for everyone's free use or not licensed at all.
+
+ The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and
+modification follow.
+
+ GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
+ TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION
+
+ 0. This License applies to any program or other work which contains
+a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it may be distributed
+under the terms of this General Public License. The "Program", below,
+refers to any such program or work, and a "work based on the Program"
+means either the Program or any derivative work under copyright law:
+that is to say, a work containing the Program or a portion of it,
+either verbatim or with modifications and/or translated into another
+language. (Hereinafter, translation is included without limitation in
+the term "modification".) Each licensee is addressed as "you".
+
+Activities other than copying, distribution and modification are not
+covered by this License; they are outside its scope. The act of
+running the Program is not restricted, and the output from the Program
+is covered only if its contents constitute a work based on the
+Program (independent of having been made by running the Program).
+Whether that is true depends on what the Program does.
+
+ 1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the Program's
+source code as you receive it, in any medium, provided that you
+conspicuously and appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate
+copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact all the
+notices that refer to this License and to the absence of any warranty;
+and give any other recipients of the Program a copy of this License
+along with the Program.
+
+You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy, and
+you may at your option offer warranty protection in exchange for a fee.
+
+ 2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Program or any portion
+of it, thus forming a work based on the Program, and copy and
+distribute such modifications or work under the terms of Section 1
+above, provided that you also meet all of these conditions:
+
+ a) You must cause the modified files to carry prominent notices
+ stating that you changed the files and the date of any change.
+
+ b) You must cause any work that you distribute or publish, that in
+ whole or in part contains or is derived from the Program or any
+ part thereof, to be licensed as a whole at no charge to all third
+ parties under the terms of this License.
+
+ c) If the modified program normally reads commands interactively
+ when run, you must cause it, when started running for such
+ interactive use in the most ordinary way, to print or display an
+ announcement including an appropriate copyright notice and a
+ notice that there is no warranty (or else, saying that you provide
+ a warranty) and that users may redistribute the program under
+ these conditions, and telling the user how to view a copy of this
+ License. (Exception: if the Program itself is interactive but
+ does not normally print such an announcement, your work based on
+ the Program is not required to print an announcement.)
+
+These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. If
+identifiable sections of that work are not derived from the Program,
+and can be reasonably considered independent and separate works in
+themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not apply to those
+sections when you distribute them as separate works. But when you
+distribute the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based
+on the Program, the distribution of the whole must be on the terms of
+this License, whose permissions for other licensees extend to the
+entire whole, and thus to each and every part regardless of who wrote it.
+
+Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest
+your rights to work written entirely by you; rather, the intent is to
+exercise the right to control the distribution of derivative or
+collective works based on the Program.
+
+In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on the Program
+with the Program (or with a work based on the Program) on a volume of
+a storage or distribution medium does not bring the other work under
+the scope of this License.
+
+ 3. You may copy and distribute the Program (or a work based on it,
+under Section 2) in object code or executable form under the terms of
+Sections 1 and 2 above provided that you also do one of the following:
+
+ a) Accompany it with the complete corresponding machine-readable
+ source code, which must be distributed under the terms of Sections
+ 1 and 2 above on a medium customarily used for software interchange; or,
+
+ b) Accompany it with a written offer, valid for at least three
+ years, to give any third party, for a charge no more than your
+ cost of physically performing source distribution, a complete
+ machine-readable copy of the corresponding source code, to be
+ distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a medium
+ customarily used for software interchange; or,
+
+ c) Accompany it with the information you received as to the offer
+ to distribute corresponding source code. (This alternative is
+ allowed only for noncommercial distribution and only if you
+ received the program in object code or executable form with such
+ an offer, in accord with Subsection b above.)
+
+The source code for a work means the preferred form of the work for
+making modifications to it. For an executable work, complete source
+code means all the source code for all modules it contains, plus any
+associated interface definition files, plus the scripts used to
+control compilation and installation of the executable. However, as a
+special exception, the source code distributed need not include
+anything that is normally distributed (in either source or binary
+form) with the major components (compiler, kernel, and so on) of the
+operating system on which the executable runs, unless that component
+itself accompanies the executable.
+
+If distribution of executable or object code is made by offering
+access to copy from a designated place, then offering equivalent
+access to copy the source code from the same place counts as
+distribution of the source code, even though third parties are not
+compelled to copy the source along with the object code.
+
+ 4. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Program
+except as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt
+otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense or distribute the Program is
+void, and will automatically terminate your rights under this License.
+However, parties who have received copies, or rights, from you under
+this License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such
+parties remain in full compliance.
+
+ 5. You are not required to accept this License, since you have not
+signed it. However, nothing else grants you permission to modify or
+distribute the Program or its derivative works. These actions are
+prohibited by law if you do not accept this License. Therefore, by
+modifying or distributing the Program (or any work based on the
+Program), you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so, and
+all its terms and conditions for copying, distributing or modifying
+the Program or works based on it.
+
+ 6. Each time you redistribute the Program (or any work based on the
+Program), the recipient automatically receives a license from the
+original licensor to copy, distribute or modify the Program subject to
+these terms and conditions. You may not impose any further
+restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the rights granted herein.
+You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties to
+this License.
+
+ 7. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent
+infringement or for any other reason (not limited to patent issues),
+conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or
+otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not
+excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot
+distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this
+License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you
+may not distribute the Program at all. For example, if a patent
+license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of the Program by
+all those who receive copies directly or indirectly through you, then
+the only way you could satisfy both it and this License would be to
+refrain entirely from distribution of the Program.
+
+If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under
+any particular circumstance, the balance of the section is intended to
+apply and the section as a whole is intended to apply in other
+circumstances.
+
+It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any
+patents or other property right claims or to contest validity of any
+such claims; this section has the sole purpose of protecting the
+integrity of the free software distribution system, which is
+implemented by public license practices. Many people have made
+generous contributions to the wide range of software distributed
+through that system in reliance on consistent application of that
+system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he or she is willing
+to distribute software through any other system and a licensee cannot
+impose that choice.
+
+This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to
+be a consequence of the rest of this License.
+
+ 8. If the distribution and/or use of the Program is restricted in
+certain countries either by patents or by copyrighted interfaces, the
+original copyright holder who places the Program under this License
+may add an explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding
+those countries, so that distribution is permitted only in or among
+countries not thus excluded. In such case, this License incorporates
+the limitation as if written in the body of this License.
+
+ 9. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions
+of the General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will
+be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to
+address new problems or concerns.
+
+Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Program
+specifies a version number of this License which applies to it and "any
+later version", you have the option of following the terms and conditions
+either of that version or of any later version published by the Free
+Software Foundation. If the Program does not specify a version number of
+this License, you may choose any version ever published by the Free Software
+Foundation.
+
+ 10. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Program into other free
+programs whose distribution conditions are different, write to the author
+to ask for permission. For software which is copyrighted by the Free
+Software Foundation, write to the Free Software Foundation; we sometimes
+make exceptions for this. Our decision will be guided by the two goals
+of preserving the free status of all derivatives of our free software and
+of promoting the sharing and reuse of software generally.
+
+ NO WARRANTY
+
+ 11. BECAUSE THE PROGRAM IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY
+FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN
+OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES
+PROVIDE THE PROGRAM "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED
+OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
+MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS
+TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE
+PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING,
+REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
+
+ 12. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING
+WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY AND/OR
+REDISTRIBUTE THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES,
+INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING
+OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED
+TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY
+YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER
+PROGRAMS), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE
+POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
+
+ END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
+
+ Appendix: How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs
+
+ If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the greatest
+possible use to the public, the best way to achieve this is to make it
+free software which everyone can redistribute and change under these terms.
+
+ To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is safest
+to attach them to the start of each source file to most effectively
+convey the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least
+the "copyright" line and a pointer to where the full notice is found.
+
+ <one line to give the program's name and a brief idea of what it does.>
+ Copyright (C) 19yy <name of author>
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA
+
+Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail.
+
+If the program is interactive, make it output a short notice like this
+when it starts in an interactive mode:
+
+ Gnomovision version 69, Copyright (C) 19yy name of author
+ Gnomovision comes with ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY; for details type `show w'.
+ This is free software, and you are welcome to redistribute it
+ under certain conditions; type `show c' for details.
+
+The hypothetical commands `show w' and `show c' should show the appropriate
+parts of the General Public License. Of course, the commands you use may
+be called something other than `show w' and `show c'; they could even be
+mouse-clicks or menu items--whatever suits your program.
+
+You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or your
+school, if any, to sign a "copyright disclaimer" for the program, if
+necessary. Here is a sample; alter the names:
+
+ Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest in the program
+ `Gnomovision' (which makes passes at compilers) written by James Hacker.
+
+ <signature of Ty Coon>, 1 April 1989
+ Ty Coon, President of Vice
+
+This General Public License does not permit incorporating your program into
+proprietary programs. If your program is a subroutine library, you may
+consider it more useful to permit linking proprietary applications with the
+library. If this is what you want to do, use the GNU Library General
+Public License instead of this License.
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/ChangeLog b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/ChangeLog
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e8c4751
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/ChangeLog
@@ -0,0 +1,137 @@
+Wed Aug 16 20:45:44 1995 David J. MacKenzie <djm@geech.gnu.ai.mit.edu>
+
+ * version.c: Version 1.3.
+
+ * termcap.c (tgetent): Use the user-supplied buffer even if we
+ don't find a matching terminal, so the program can set the buffer
+ if they want (`less' does this). From Bob Pegram
+ <pegram@emba.uvm.edu>.
+
+Wed Jul 26 11:44:51 1995 David J. MacKenzie <djm@geech.gnu.ai.mit.edu>
+
+ * termcap.c: TERMCAP_NAME -> TERMCAP_FILE.
+
+ * configure.in: Add --enable-install-termcap and --with-termcap
+ options.
+
+ * Makefile.in: Add hooks for new configure options.
+
+ * Makefile.in (DISTFILES): Add termcap.src.
+ (DEFS): Remove -DNO_ARG_ARRAY.
+ (install-data, uninstall-data): New targets.
+
+ * tparam.c (tparam): Remove arg array version and the #ifdef.
+
+ * termcap.c: Move #define of bcopy to after #include <string.h>.
+
+ * termcap.h: Prototype the arg to the tputs outfun arg.
+
+ * Makefile.in: realclean -> maintainer-clean. Use @prefix@ and
+ @exec_prefix@.
+
+ * Makefile.in (DISTFILES): Add install-sh.
+
+Fri Apr 7 14:57:45 1995 Richard Stallman <rms@mole.gnu.ai.mit.edu>
+
+ * termcap.c (tgetent): Don't try to return the allocated address.
+ Always return 1 if successful.
+
+Tue Feb 14 02:34:43 1995 Richard Stallman <rms@pogo.gnu.ai.mit.edu>
+
+ * termcap.c (speeds): Make it ints. Add some higher speeds.
+ (tputs) [emacs]: If speed is high, convert to smaller units.
+ (tputs): Really use SPEED to calculate PADCOUNT.
+
+Sat Dec 17 07:20:24 1994 Richard Stallman <rms@mole.gnu.ai.mit.edu>
+
+ * termcap.c (tgetst1): Let ^? stand for DEL character.
+
+Thu Jun 30 04:35:50 1994 Roland McGrath (roland@churchy.gnu.ai.mit.edu)
+
+ * configure.in: Use AC_HAVE_HEADERS instead of AC_UNISTD_H.
+ Add AC_PROG_RANLIB.
+ * Makefile.in (AR, RANLIB): New variables.
+ (install, libtermcap.a): Use them instead of hard-wired commands.
+
+Sat Jun 4 12:21:41 1994 Roland McGrath (roland@geech.gnu.ai.mit.edu)
+
+ * termcap.c [HAVE_CONFIG_H]: Include <sys/file.h>, and include
+ <fcntl.h> #ifdef USG5, so we get O_* defns.
+
+Wed May 25 19:05:30 1994 Roland McGrath (roland@churchy.gnu.ai.mit.edu)
+
+ * termcap.c (O_RDONLY): Define to 0 if not already defined.
+ (tgetent): Use O_RDONLY instead of explicit 0 in call to open.
+
+Wed Jan 5 22:20:15 1993 Morten Welinder (terra@diku.dk)
+
+ * termcap.c (tgetent) [INTERNAL_TERMINAL]: Fake internal terminal
+ without reading any files.
+ (valid_file_name, tgetent) [MSDOS]: Drive letter support.
+ (tgetent) [MSDOS]: Use text mode for database.
+
+Fri Dec 17 00:22:43 1993 Mike Long (mike.long@analog.com)
+
+ * termcap.c (tgetent): Replaced literal filenames for termcap
+ database with preprocessor symbol TERMCAP_NAME.
+ (TERMCAP_NAME): Define if not defined.
+
+Fri Sep 10 00:35:07 1993 Roland McGrath (roland@churchy.gnu.ai.mit.edu)
+
+ * Makefile.in (.c.o): Put -I. before -I$(srcdir).
+ * termcap.c: Include <config.h> instead of "config.h".
+ * tparam.c: Likewise.
+
+Thu Jul 29 20:53:30 1993 David J. MacKenzie (djm@wookumz.gnu.ai.mit.edu)
+
+ * Makefile.in (config.status): Run config.status --recheck, not
+ configure, to get the right args passed.
+
+Thu Apr 15 12:45:10 1993 David J. MacKenzie (djm@kropotkin.gnu.ai.mit.edu)
+
+ * Version 1.2.
+
+ * tparam.c [!emacs] (xmalloc, xrealloc, memory_out): New functions.
+ (tparam1): Use them.
+
+ * termcap.c, tparam.c: Use NULL or '\0' where appropriate
+ instead of 0. Rename some vars.
+ * termcap.c (tgetent): If EOF is reached on termcap file,
+ free allocated resources before returning.
+
+ * termcap.c (tgetent): Use /etc/termcap if TERMCAP is an entry
+ for a term type other than TERM.
+ From pjr@jet.UK (Paul J Rippin).
+
+Sat Apr 10 23:55:12 1993 Richard Stallman (rms@mole.gnu.ai.mit.edu)
+
+ * tparam.c (tparam1): Don't set the 0200 bit on a non-0 character code.
+ From junio@twinsun.COM (Junio Hamano).
+
+Tue Dec 8 22:02:15 1992 David J. MacKenzie (djm@kropotkin.gnu.ai.mit.edu)
+
+ * termcap.c, tparam.c: Use HAVE_STRING_H instead of USG.
+
+Thu Dec 3 13:47:56 1992 David J. MacKenzie (djm@nutrimat.gnu.ai.mit.edu)
+
+ * termcap.c, tparam.c [HAVE_CONFIG_H]: Include config.h.
+
+Fri Oct 23 12:35:29 1992 David J. MacKenzie (djm@goldman.gnu.ai.mit.edu)
+
+ * termcap.h [__STDC__]: Add consts. From Franc,ois Pinard.
+
+Tue Oct 13 15:52:21 1992 David J. MacKenzie (djm@goldman.gnu.ai.mit.edu)
+
+ * Version 1.1.
+
+Tue Sep 29 21:04:39 1992 David J. MacKenzie (djm@geech.gnu.ai.mit.edu)
+
+ * termcap.[ch], tparam.c: Fix some lint.
+
+ * version.c: New file.
+
+Local Variables:
+mode: indented-text
+left-margin: 8
+version-control: never
+End:
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/INSTALL b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/INSTALL
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..95d84c8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/INSTALL
@@ -0,0 +1,176 @@
+Basic Installation
+==================
+
+ These are generic installation instructions.
+
+ The `configure' shell script attempts to guess correct values for
+various system-dependent variables used during compilation. It uses
+those values to create a `Makefile' in each directory of the package.
+It may also create one or more `.h' files containing system-dependent
+definitions. Finally, it creates a shell script `config.status' that
+you can run in the future to recreate the current configuration, a file
+`config.cache' that saves the results of its tests to speed up
+reconfiguring, and a file `config.log' containing compiler output
+(useful mainly for debugging `configure').
+
+ If you need to do unusual things to compile the package, please try
+to figure out how `configure' could check whether to do them, and mail
+diffs or instructions to the address given in the `README' so they can
+be considered for the next release. If at some point `config.cache'
+contains results you don't want to keep, you may remove or edit it.
+
+ The file `configure.in' is used to create `configure' by a program
+called `autoconf'. You only need `configure.in' if you want to change
+it or regenerate `configure' using a newer version of `autoconf'.
+
+The simplest way to compile this package is:
+
+ 1. `cd' to the directory containing the package's source code and type
+ `./configure' to configure the package for your system. If you're
+ using `csh' on an old version of System V, you might need to type
+ `sh ./configure' instead to prevent `csh' from trying to execute
+ `configure' itself.
+
+ Running `configure' takes awhile. While running, it prints some
+ messages telling which features it is checking for.
+
+ 2. Type `make' to compile the package.
+
+ 3. Optionally, type `make check' to run any self-tests that come with
+ the package.
+
+ 4. Type `make install' to install the programs and any data files and
+ documentation.
+
+ 5. You can remove the program binaries and object files from the
+ source code directory by typing `make clean'. To also remove the
+ files that `configure' created (so you can compile the package for
+ a different kind of computer), type `make distclean'. There is
+ also a `make maintainer-clean' target, but that is intended mainly
+ for the package's developers. If you use it, you may have to get
+ all sorts of other programs in order to regenerate files that came
+ with the distribution.
+
+Compilers and Options
+=====================
+
+ Some systems require unusual options for compilation or linking that
+the `configure' script does not know about. You can give `configure'
+initial values for variables by setting them in the environment. Using
+a Bourne-compatible shell, you can do that on the command line like
+this:
+ CC=c89 CFLAGS=-O2 LIBS=-lposix ./configure
+
+Or on systems that have the `env' program, you can do it like this:
+ env CPPFLAGS=-I/usr/local/include LDFLAGS=-s ./configure
+
+Compiling For Multiple Architectures
+====================================
+
+ You can compile the package for more than one kind of computer at the
+same time, by placing the object files for each architecture in their
+own directory. To do this, you must use a version of `make' that
+supports the `VPATH' variable, such as GNU `make'. `cd' to the
+directory where you want the object files and executables to go and run
+the `configure' script. `configure' automatically checks for the
+source code in the directory that `configure' is in and in `..'.
+
+ If you have to use a `make' that does not supports the `VPATH'
+variable, you have to compile the package for one architecture at a time
+in the source code directory. After you have installed the package for
+one architecture, use `make distclean' before reconfiguring for another
+architecture.
+
+Installation Names
+==================
+
+ By default, `make install' will install the package's files in
+`/usr/local/bin', `/usr/local/man', etc. You can specify an
+installation prefix other than `/usr/local' by giving `configure' the
+option `--prefix=PATH'.
+
+ You can specify separate installation prefixes for
+architecture-specific files and architecture-independent files. If you
+give `configure' the option `--exec-prefix=PATH', the package will use
+PATH as the prefix for installing programs and libraries.
+Documentation and other data files will still use the regular prefix.
+
+ If the package supports it, you can cause programs to be installed
+with an extra prefix or suffix on their names by giving `configure' the
+option `--program-prefix=PREFIX' or `--program-suffix=SUFFIX'.
+
+Optional Features
+=================
+
+ Some packages pay attention to `--enable-FEATURE' options to
+`configure', where FEATURE indicates an optional part of the package.
+They may also pay attention to `--with-PACKAGE' options, where PACKAGE
+is something like `gnu-as' or `x' (for the X Window System). The
+`README' should mention any `--enable-' and `--with-' options that the
+package recognizes.
+
+ For packages that use the X Window System, `configure' can usually
+find the X include and library files automatically, but if it doesn't,
+you can use the `configure' options `--x-includes=DIR' and
+`--x-libraries=DIR' to specify their locations.
+
+Specifying the System Type
+==========================
+
+ There may be some features `configure' can not figure out
+automatically, but needs to determine by the type of host the package
+will run on. Usually `configure' can figure that out, but if it prints
+a message saying it can not guess the host type, give it the
+`--host=TYPE' option. TYPE can either be a short name for the system
+type, such as `sun4', or a canonical name with three fields:
+ CPU-COMPANY-SYSTEM
+
+See the file `config.sub' for the possible values of each field. If
+`config.sub' isn't included in this package, then this package doesn't
+need to know the host type.
+
+ If you are building compiler tools for cross-compiling, you can also
+use the `--target=TYPE' option to select the type of system they will
+produce code for and the `--build=TYPE' option to select the type of
+system on which you are compiling the package.
+
+Sharing Defaults
+================
+
+ If you want to set default values for `configure' scripts to share,
+you can create a site shell script called `config.site' that gives
+default values for variables like `CC', `cache_file', and `prefix'.
+`configure' looks for `PREFIX/share/config.site' if it exists, then
+`PREFIX/etc/config.site' if it exists. Or, you can set the
+`CONFIG_SITE' environment variable to the location of the site script.
+A warning: not all `configure' scripts look for a site script.
+
+Operation Controls
+==================
+
+ `configure' recognizes the following options to control how it
+operates.
+
+`--cache-file=FILE'
+ Use and save the results of the tests in FILE instead of
+ `./config.cache'. Set FILE to `/dev/null' to disable caching, for
+ debugging `configure'.
+
+`--help'
+ Print a summary of the options to `configure', and exit.
+
+`--quiet'
+`--silent'
+`-q'
+ Do not print messages saying which checks are being made.
+
+`--srcdir=DIR'
+ Look for the package's source code in directory DIR. Usually
+ `configure' can determine that directory automatically.
+
+`--version'
+ Print the version of Autoconf used to generate the `configure'
+ script, and exit.
+
+`configure' also accepts some other, not widely useful, options.
+
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/Makefile.in b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/Makefile.in
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e6f06ae
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/Makefile.in
@@ -0,0 +1,138 @@
+# Makefile for GNU termcap library.
+# Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1994 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+# any later version.
+
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+# GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA.
+
+#### Start of system configuration section. ####
+
+srcdir = @srcdir@
+VPATH = @srcdir@
+
+CC = @CC@
+AR = ar
+RANLIB = @RANLIB@
+
+INSTALL = @INSTALL@
+INSTALL_DATA = @INSTALL_DATA@
+
+MAKEINFO = makeinfo
+
+DEFS = @DEFS@ -DTERMCAP_FILE=\"$(termcapfile)\"
+
+CFLAGS = -g
+
+prefix = @prefix@
+exec_prefix = @exec_prefix@
+
+# Directory in which to install libtermcap.a.
+libdir = $(exec_prefix)/lib
+
+# Directory in which to install termcap.h.
+includedir = $(prefix)/include
+
+# Directory in which to optionally also install termcap.h,
+# so compilers besides gcc can find it by default.
+# If it is empty or not defined, termcap.h will only be installed in
+# includedir.
+oldincludedir = /usr/include
+
+# Directory in which to install the documentation info files.
+infodir = $(prefix)/info
+
+# File to which `install-data' should install the data file
+# if --enable-install-termcap was given.
+termcapfile = @termcapfile@
+
+#### End of system configuration section. ####
+
+SHELL = /bin/sh
+
+SRCS = termcap.c tparam.c version.c
+OBJS = termcap.o tparam.o version.o
+HDRS = termcap.h
+DISTFILES = $(SRCS) $(HDRS) ChangeLog COPYING README INSTALL NEWS \
+termcap.src termcap.texi termcap.info* \
+texinfo.tex Makefile.in configure configure.in mkinstalldirs install-sh
+
+all: libtermcap.a info
+
+.c.o:
+ $(CC) -c $(CPPFLAGS) $(DEFS) -I. -I$(srcdir) $(CFLAGS) $<
+
+install: all installdirs @installdata@
+ $(INSTALL_DATA) libtermcap.a $(libdir)/libtermcap.a
+ -$(RANLIB) $(libdir)/libtermcap.a
+ cd $(srcdir); $(INSTALL_DATA) termcap.h $(includedir)/termcap.h
+ -cd $(srcdir); test -z "$(oldincludedir)" || \
+ $(INSTALL_DATA) termcap.h $(oldincludedir)/termcap.h
+ cd $(srcdir); for f in termcap.info*; \
+ do $(INSTALL_DATA) $$f $(infodir)/$$f; done
+
+uninstall: @uninstalldata@
+ rm -f $(libdir)/libtermcap.a $(includedir)/termcap.h
+ test -z "$(oldincludedir)" || rm -f $(oldincludedir)/termcap.h
+ rm -f $(infodir)/termcap.info*
+
+# These are separate targets to avoid trashing the user's existing
+# termcap file unexpectedly.
+install-data:
+ $(INSTALL_DATA) ${srcdir}/termcap.src ${termcapfile}
+
+uninstall-data:
+ rm -f ${termcapfile}
+
+installdirs:
+ $(SHELL) ${srcdir}/mkinstalldirs $(bindir) $(libdir) \
+ $(includedir) $(infodir)
+
+Makefile: Makefile.in config.status
+ $(SHELL) config.status
+config.status: configure
+ $(SHELL) config.status --recheck
+configure: configure.in
+ cd $(srcdir) && autoconf
+
+libtermcap.a: $(OBJS)
+ $(AR) rc $@ $(OBJS)
+ -$(RANLIB) $@
+
+info: termcap.info
+
+termcap.info: termcap.texi
+ $(MAKEINFO) $(srcdir)/termcap.texi --output=$@
+
+TAGS: $(SRCS)
+ etags $(SRCS)
+
+clean:
+ rm -f *.a *.o core
+
+mostlyclean: clean
+
+distclean: clean
+ rm -f Makefile config.status config.cache config.log
+
+maintainer-clean: distclean
+ @echo "This command is intended for maintainers to use;"
+ @echo "rebuilding the deleted files requires makeinfo."
+ rm -f TAGS *.info*
+
+dist: $(DISTFILES)
+ echo termcap-`sed -e '/version_string/!d' -e 's/[^0-9]*\([0-9a-z.]*\).*/\1/' -e q version.c` > .fname
+ rm -rf `cat .fname`
+ mkdir `cat .fname`
+ ln $(DISTFILES) `cat .fname`
+ tar chzf `cat .fname`.tar.gz `cat .fname`
+ rm -rf `cat .fname` .fname
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/NEWS b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/NEWS
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e5d58b9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/NEWS
@@ -0,0 +1,20 @@
+Major changes in release 1.3:
+
+Termcap data file is now included in distribution and may optionally
+ be installed, or used in a non-default location.
+Support for a fake internal terminal (no external files).
+Higher tty speeds supported.
+Portability tweaks.
+
+Major changes in release 1.2:
+
+For `%.', only set the high bit on NUL.
+Fix a file descriptor and memory leak.
+Add const in termcap.h prototypes.
+Configuration improvements.
+
+Major changes in release 1.1:
+
+Fix portability problems.
+Improve configuration and installation.
+Fix compiler warnings.
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/README b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/README
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ba1a19c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/README
@@ -0,0 +1,34 @@
+This is the GNU termcap library -- a library of C functions that
+enable programs to send control strings to terminals in a way
+independent of the terminal type. The GNU termcap library does not
+place an arbitrary limit on the size of termcap entries, unlike most
+other termcap libraries.
+
+Most of this package is also distributed with GNU Emacs, but it is
+available in this separate distribution to make it easier to install
+as -ltermcap. However, use of termcap is discouraged. Termcap is
+being phased out in favor of the terminfo-based ncurses library, which
+contains an emulation of the termcap library routines in addition to
+an excellent curses implementation. ncurses is available from the
+usual GNU archive sites.
+
+See the file INSTALL for compilation and installation instructions.
+Additionally:
+
+This package contains termcap.src, the latest official termcap data
+file. By default, it is not installed. The current version contains
+some entries that are more than 1023 bytes long, which is the largest
+value that is safe to use with the many historical applications that
+only allocate a 1024 byte termcap buffer (telnet, for example). If
+you make sure that all of your programs allocate buffers of at least
+2500 bytes, or let the termcap library do it by passing a NULL
+pointer, then it is safe to install the new termcap file, as described
+below.
+
+You can give configure two special options:
+ --enable-install-termcap install the termcap data file
+ --with-termcap=FILE use data file FILE instead of /etc/termcap
+
+Please report any bugs in this library to bug-gnu-emacs@prep.ai.mit.edu.
+You can check which version of the library you have by using the RCS
+`ident' command on libtermcap.a.
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/configure b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/configure
new file mode 100755
index 0000000..8a885fa
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/configure
@@ -0,0 +1,998 @@
+#! /bin/sh
+
+# Guess values for system-dependent variables and create Makefiles.
+# Generated automatically using autoconf version 2.4
+# Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1994 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+#
+# This configure script is free software; the Free Software Foundation
+# gives unlimited permission to copy, distribute and modify it.
+
+# Defaults:
+ac_help=
+ac_default_prefix=/usr/local
+# Any additions from configure.in:
+ac_help="$ac_help
+ --enable-install-termcap install the termcap data file"
+ac_help="$ac_help
+ --with-termcap=FILE use data file FILE instead of /etc/termcap"
+
+# Initialize some variables set by options.
+# The variables have the same names as the options, with
+# dashes changed to underlines.
+build=NONE
+cache_file=./config.cache
+exec_prefix=NONE
+host=NONE
+no_create=
+nonopt=NONE
+no_recursion=
+prefix=NONE
+program_prefix=NONE
+program_suffix=NONE
+program_transform_name=s,x,x,
+silent=
+site=
+srcdir=
+target=NONE
+verbose=
+x_includes=NONE
+x_libraries=NONE
+
+# Initialize some other variables.
+subdirs=
+
+ac_prev=
+for ac_option
+do
+
+ # If the previous option needs an argument, assign it.
+ if test -n "$ac_prev"; then
+ eval "$ac_prev=\$ac_option"
+ ac_prev=
+ continue
+ fi
+
+ case "$ac_option" in
+ -*=*) ac_optarg=`echo "$ac_option" | sed 's/[-_a-zA-Z0-9]*=//'` ;;
+ *) ac_optarg= ;;
+ esac
+
+ # Accept the important Cygnus configure options, so we can diagnose typos.
+
+ case "$ac_option" in
+
+ -build | --build | --buil | --bui | --bu | --b)
+ ac_prev=build ;;
+ -build=* | --build=* | --buil=* | --bui=* | --bu=* | --b=*)
+ build="$ac_optarg" ;;
+
+ -cache-file | --cache-file | --cache-fil | --cache-fi \
+ | --cache-f | --cache- | --cache | --cach | --cac | --ca | --c)
+ ac_prev=cache_file ;;
+ -cache-file=* | --cache-file=* | --cache-fil=* | --cache-fi=* \
+ | --cache-f=* | --cache-=* | --cache=* | --cach=* | --cac=* | --ca=* | --c=*)
+ cache_file="$ac_optarg" ;;
+
+ -disable-* | --disable-*)
+ ac_feature=`echo $ac_option|sed -e 's/-*disable-//'`
+ # Reject names that are not valid shell variable names.
+ if test -n "`echo $ac_feature| sed 's/[-a-zA-Z0-9_]//g'`"; then
+ { echo "configure: error: $ac_feature: invalid feature name" 1>&2; exit 1; }
+ fi
+ ac_feature=`echo $ac_feature| sed 's/-/_/g'`
+ eval "enable_${ac_feature}=no" ;;
+
+ -enable-* | --enable-*)
+ ac_feature=`echo $ac_option|sed -e 's/-*enable-//' -e 's/=.*//'`
+ # Reject names that are not valid shell variable names.
+ if test -n "`echo $ac_feature| sed 's/[-_a-zA-Z0-9]//g'`"; then
+ { echo "configure: error: $ac_feature: invalid feature name" 1>&2; exit 1; }
+ fi
+ ac_feature=`echo $ac_feature| sed 's/-/_/g'`
+ case "$ac_option" in
+ *=*) ;;
+ *) ac_optarg=yes ;;
+ esac
+ eval "enable_${ac_feature}='$ac_optarg'" ;;
+
+ -exec-prefix | --exec_prefix | --exec-prefix | --exec-prefi \
+ | --exec-pref | --exec-pre | --exec-pr | --exec-p | --exec- \
+ | --exec | --exe | --ex)
+ ac_prev=exec_prefix ;;
+ -exec-prefix=* | --exec_prefix=* | --exec-prefix=* | --exec-prefi=* \
+ | --exec-pref=* | --exec-pre=* | --exec-pr=* | --exec-p=* | --exec-=* \
+ | --exec=* | --exe=* | --ex=*)
+ exec_prefix="$ac_optarg" ;;
+
+ -gas | --gas | --ga | --g)
+ # Obsolete; use --with-gas.
+ with_gas=yes ;;
+
+ -help | --help | --hel | --he)
+ # Omit some internal or obsolete options to make the list less imposing.
+ # This message is too long to be a string in the A/UX 3.1 sh.
+ cat << EOF
+Usage: configure [options] [host]
+Options: [defaults in brackets after descriptions]
+Configuration:
+ --cache-file=FILE cache test results in FILE
+ --help print this message
+ --no-create do not create output files
+ --quiet, --silent do not print \`checking...' messages
+ --version print the version of autoconf that created configure
+Directory and file names:
+ --prefix=PREFIX install architecture-independent files in PREFIX
+ [$ac_default_prefix]
+ --exec-prefix=PREFIX install architecture-dependent files in PREFIX
+ [same as prefix]
+ --srcdir=DIR find the sources in DIR [configure dir or ..]
+ --program-prefix=PREFIX prepend PREFIX to installed program names
+ --program-suffix=SUFFIX append SUFFIX to installed program names
+ --program-transform-name=PROGRAM run sed PROGRAM on installed program names
+Host type:
+ --build=BUILD configure for building on BUILD [BUILD=HOST]
+ --host=HOST configure for HOST [guessed]
+ --target=TARGET configure for TARGET [TARGET=HOST]
+Features and packages:
+ --disable-FEATURE do not include FEATURE (same as --enable-FEATURE=no)
+ --enable-FEATURE[=ARG] include FEATURE [ARG=yes]
+ --with-PACKAGE[=ARG] use PACKAGE [ARG=yes]
+ --without-PACKAGE do not use PACKAGE (same as --with-PACKAGE=no)
+ --x-includes=DIR X include files are in DIR
+ --x-libraries=DIR X library files are in DIR
+--enable and --with options recognized:$ac_help
+EOF
+ exit 0 ;;
+
+ -host | --host | --hos | --ho)
+ ac_prev=host ;;
+ -host=* | --host=* | --hos=* | --ho=*)
+ host="$ac_optarg" ;;
+
+ -nfp | --nfp | --nf)
+ # Obsolete; use --without-fp.
+ with_fp=no ;;
+
+ -no-create | --no-create | --no-creat | --no-crea | --no-cre \
+ | --no-cr | --no-c)
+ no_create=yes ;;
+
+ -no-recursion | --no-recursion | --no-recursio | --no-recursi \
+ | --no-recurs | --no-recur | --no-recu | --no-rec | --no-re | --no-r)
+ no_recursion=yes ;;
+
+ -prefix | --prefix | --prefi | --pref | --pre | --pr | --p)
+ ac_prev=prefix ;;
+ -prefix=* | --prefix=* | --prefi=* | --pref=* | --pre=* | --pr=* | --p=*)
+ prefix="$ac_optarg" ;;
+
+ -program-prefix | --program-prefix | --program-prefi | --program-pref \
+ | --program-pre | --program-pr | --program-p)
+ ac_prev=program_prefix ;;
+ -program-prefix=* | --program-prefix=* | --program-prefi=* \
+ | --program-pref=* | --program-pre=* | --program-pr=* | --program-p=*)
+ program_prefix="$ac_optarg" ;;
+
+ -program-suffix | --program-suffix | --program-suffi | --program-suff \
+ | --program-suf | --program-su | --program-s)
+ ac_prev=program_suffix ;;
+ -program-suffix=* | --program-suffix=* | --program-suffi=* \
+ | --program-suff=* | --program-suf=* | --program-su=* | --program-s=*)
+ program_suffix="$ac_optarg" ;;
+
+ -program-transform-name | --program-transform-name \
+ | --program-transform-nam | --program-transform-na \
+ | --program-transform-n | --program-transform- \
+ | --program-transform | --program-transfor \
+ | --program-transfo | --program-transf \
+ | --program-trans | --program-tran \
+ | --progr-tra | --program-tr | --program-t)
+ ac_prev=program_transform_name ;;
+ -program-transform-name=* | --program-transform-name=* \
+ | --program-transform-nam=* | --program-transform-na=* \
+ | --program-transform-n=* | --program-transform-=* \
+ | --program-transform=* | --program-transfor=* \
+ | --program-transfo=* | --program-transf=* \
+ | --program-trans=* | --program-tran=* \
+ | --progr-tra=* | --program-tr=* | --program-t=*)
+ program_transform_name="$ac_optarg" ;;
+
+ -q | -quiet | --quiet | --quie | --qui | --qu | --q \
+ | -silent | --silent | --silen | --sile | --sil)
+ silent=yes ;;
+
+ -site | --site | --sit)
+ ac_prev=site ;;
+ -site=* | --site=* | --sit=*)
+ site="$ac_optarg" ;;
+
+ -srcdir | --srcdir | --srcdi | --srcd | --src | --sr)
+ ac_prev=srcdir ;;
+ -srcdir=* | --srcdir=* | --srcdi=* | --srcd=* | --src=* | --sr=*)
+ srcdir="$ac_optarg" ;;
+
+ -target | --target | --targe | --targ | --tar | --ta | --t)
+ ac_prev=target ;;
+ -target=* | --target=* | --targe=* | --targ=* | --tar=* | --ta=* | --t=*)
+ target="$ac_optarg" ;;
+
+ -v | -verbose | --verbose | --verbos | --verbo | --verb)
+ verbose=yes ;;
+
+ -version | --version | --versio | --versi | --vers)
+ echo "configure generated by autoconf version 2.4"
+ exit 0 ;;
+
+ -with-* | --with-*)
+ ac_package=`echo $ac_option|sed -e 's/-*with-//' -e 's/=.*//'`
+ # Reject names that are not valid shell variable names.
+ if test -n "`echo $ac_package| sed 's/[-_a-zA-Z0-9]//g'`"; then
+ { echo "configure: error: $ac_package: invalid package name" 1>&2; exit 1; }
+ fi
+ ac_package=`echo $ac_package| sed 's/-/_/g'`
+ case "$ac_option" in
+ *=*) ;;
+ *) ac_optarg=yes ;;
+ esac
+ eval "with_${ac_package}='$ac_optarg'" ;;
+
+ -without-* | --without-*)
+ ac_package=`echo $ac_option|sed -e 's/-*without-//'`
+ # Reject names that are not valid shell variable names.
+ if test -n "`echo $ac_package| sed 's/[-a-zA-Z0-9_]//g'`"; then
+ { echo "configure: error: $ac_package: invalid package name" 1>&2; exit 1; }
+ fi
+ ac_package=`echo $ac_package| sed 's/-/_/g'`
+ eval "with_${ac_package}=no" ;;
+
+ --x)
+ # Obsolete; use --with-x.
+ with_x=yes ;;
+
+ -x-includes | --x-includes | --x-include | --x-includ | --x-inclu \
+ | --x-incl | --x-inc | --x-in | --x-i)
+ ac_prev=x_includes ;;
+ -x-includes=* | --x-includes=* | --x-include=* | --x-includ=* | --x-inclu=* \
+ | --x-incl=* | --x-inc=* | --x-in=* | --x-i=*)
+ x_includes="$ac_optarg" ;;
+
+ -x-libraries | --x-libraries | --x-librarie | --x-librari \
+ | --x-librar | --x-libra | --x-libr | --x-lib | --x-li | --x-l)
+ ac_prev=x_libraries ;;
+ -x-libraries=* | --x-libraries=* | --x-librarie=* | --x-librari=* \
+ | --x-librar=* | --x-libra=* | --x-libr=* | --x-lib=* | --x-li=* | --x-l=*)
+ x_libraries="$ac_optarg" ;;
+
+ -*) { echo "configure: error: $ac_option: invalid option; use --help to show usage" 1>&2; exit 1; }
+ ;;
+
+ *)
+ if test -n "`echo $ac_option| sed 's/[-a-z0-9.]//g'`"; then
+ echo "configure: warning: $ac_option: invalid host type" 1>&2
+ fi
+ if test "x$nonopt" != xNONE; then
+ { echo "configure: error: can only configure for one host and one target at a time" 1>&2; exit 1; }
+ fi
+ nonopt="$ac_option"
+ ;;
+
+ esac
+done
+
+if test -n "$ac_prev"; then
+ { echo "configure: error: missing argument to --`echo $ac_prev | sed 's/_/-/g'`" 1>&2; exit 1; }
+fi
+
+trap 'rm -fr conftest* confdefs* core core.* *.core $ac_clean_files; exit 1' 1 2 15
+
+# File descriptor usage:
+# 0 standard input
+# 1 file creation
+# 2 errors and warnings
+# 3 some systems may open it to /dev/tty
+# 4 used on the Kubota Titan
+# 6 checking for... messages and results
+# 5 compiler messages saved in config.log
+if test "$silent" = yes; then
+ exec 6>/dev/null
+else
+ exec 6>&1
+fi
+exec 5>./config.log
+
+echo "\
+This file contains any messages produced by compilers while
+running configure, to aid debugging if configure makes a mistake.
+" 1>&5
+
+# Strip out --no-create and --no-recursion so they do not pile up.
+# Also quote any args containing shell metacharacters.
+ac_configure_args=
+for ac_arg
+do
+ case "$ac_arg" in
+ -no-create | --no-create | --no-creat | --no-crea | --no-cre \
+ | --no-cr | --no-c) ;;
+ -no-recursion | --no-recursion | --no-recursio | --no-recursi \
+ | --no-recurs | --no-recur | --no-recu | --no-rec | --no-re | --no-r) ;;
+ *" "*|*" "*|*[\[\]\~\#\$\^\&\*\(\)\{\}\\\|\;\<\>\?]*)
+ ac_configure_args="$ac_configure_args '$ac_arg'" ;;
+ *) ac_configure_args="$ac_configure_args $ac_arg" ;;
+ esac
+done
+
+# NLS nuisances.
+# Only set LANG and LC_ALL to C if already set.
+# These must not be set unconditionally because not all systems understand
+# e.g. LANG=C (notably SCO).
+if test "${LC_ALL+set}" = set; then LC_ALL=C; export LC_ALL; fi
+if test "${LANG+set}" = set; then LANG=C; export LANG; fi
+
+# confdefs.h avoids OS command line length limits that DEFS can exceed.
+rm -rf conftest* confdefs.h
+# AIX cpp loses on an empty file, so make sure it contains at least a newline.
+echo > confdefs.h
+
+# A filename unique to this package, relative to the directory that
+# configure is in, which we can look for to find out if srcdir is correct.
+ac_unique_file=termcap.h
+
+# Find the source files, if location was not specified.
+if test -z "$srcdir"; then
+ ac_srcdir_defaulted=yes
+ # Try the directory containing this script, then its parent.
+ ac_prog=$0
+ ac_confdir=`echo $ac_prog|sed 's%/[^/][^/]*$%%'`
+ test "x$ac_confdir" = "x$ac_prog" && ac_confdir=.
+ srcdir=$ac_confdir
+ if test ! -r $srcdir/$ac_unique_file; then
+ srcdir=..
+ fi
+else
+ ac_srcdir_defaulted=no
+fi
+if test ! -r $srcdir/$ac_unique_file; then
+ if test "$ac_srcdir_defaulted" = yes; then
+ { echo "configure: error: can not find sources in $ac_confdir or .." 1>&2; exit 1; }
+ else
+ { echo "configure: error: can not find sources in $srcdir" 1>&2; exit 1; }
+ fi
+fi
+srcdir=`echo "${srcdir}" | sed 's%\([^/]\)/*$%\1%'`
+
+# Prefer explicitly selected file to automatically selected ones.
+if test -z "$CONFIG_SITE"; then
+ if test "x$prefix" != xNONE; then
+ CONFIG_SITE="$prefix/share/config.site $prefix/etc/config.site"
+ else
+ CONFIG_SITE="$ac_default_prefix/share/config.site $ac_default_prefix/etc/config.site"
+ fi
+fi
+for ac_site_file in $CONFIG_SITE; do
+ if test -r "$ac_site_file"; then
+ echo "loading site script $ac_site_file"
+ . "$ac_site_file"
+ fi
+done
+
+if test -r "$cache_file"; then
+ echo "loading cache $cache_file"
+ . $cache_file
+else
+ echo "creating cache $cache_file"
+ > $cache_file
+fi
+
+ac_ext=c
+# CFLAGS is not in ac_cpp because -g, -O, etc. are not valid cpp options.
+ac_cpp='$CPP $CPPFLAGS'
+ac_compile='${CC-cc} -c $CFLAGS $CPPFLAGS conftest.$ac_ext 1>&5 2>&5'
+ac_link='${CC-cc} -o conftest $CFLAGS $CPPFLAGS $LDFLAGS conftest.$ac_ext $LIBS 1>&5 2>&5'
+
+if (echo "testing\c"; echo 1,2,3) | grep c >/dev/null; then
+ # Stardent Vistra SVR4 grep lacks -e, says ghazi@caip.rutgers.edu.
+ if (echo -n testing; echo 1,2,3) | sed s/-n/xn/ | grep xn >/dev/null; then
+ ac_n= ac_c='
+' ac_t=' '
+ else
+ ac_n=-n ac_c= ac_t=
+ fi
+else
+ ac_n= ac_c='\c' ac_t=
+fi
+
+
+
+# Check whether --enable-install-termcap or --disable-install-termcap was given.
+enableval="$enable_install_termcap"
+if test -n "$enableval"; then
+ if test $enableval = yes; then
+ installdata=install-data uninstalldata=uninstall-data
+ fi
+fi
+
+
+# Check whether --with-termcap or --without-termcap was given.
+withval="$with_termcap"
+if test -n "$withval"; then
+ termcapfile=$withval
+else
+ termcapfile=/etc/termcap
+fi
+
+
+# Extract the first word of "gcc", so it can be a program name with args.
+set dummy gcc; ac_word=$2
+echo $ac_n "checking for $ac_word""... $ac_c" 1>&6
+if eval "test \"`echo '$''{'ac_cv_prog_CC'+set}'`\" = set"; then
+ echo $ac_n "(cached) $ac_c" 1>&6
+else
+ if test -n "$CC"; then
+ ac_cv_prog_CC="$CC" # Let the user override the test.
+else
+ IFS="${IFS= }"; ac_save_ifs="$IFS"; IFS="${IFS}:"
+ for ac_dir in $PATH; do
+ test -z "$ac_dir" && ac_dir=.
+ if test -f $ac_dir/$ac_word; then
+ ac_cv_prog_CC="gcc"
+ break
+ fi
+ done
+ IFS="$ac_save_ifs"
+ test -z "$ac_cv_prog_CC" && ac_cv_prog_CC="cc"
+fi
+fi
+CC="$ac_cv_prog_CC"
+if test -n "$CC"; then
+ echo "$ac_t""$CC" 1>&6
+else
+ echo "$ac_t""no" 1>&6
+fi
+
+
+echo $ac_n "checking whether we are using GNU C""... $ac_c" 1>&6
+if eval "test \"`echo '$''{'ac_cv_prog_gcc'+set}'`\" = set"; then
+ echo $ac_n "(cached) $ac_c" 1>&6
+else
+ cat > conftest.c <<EOF
+#ifdef __GNUC__
+ yes;
+#endif
+EOF
+if ${CC-cc} -E conftest.c 2>&5 | egrep yes >/dev/null 2>&1; then
+ ac_cv_prog_gcc=yes
+else
+ ac_cv_prog_gcc=no
+fi
+fi
+echo "$ac_t""$ac_cv_prog_gcc" 1>&6
+if test $ac_cv_prog_gcc = yes; then
+ GCC=yes
+ if test "${CFLAGS+set}" != set; then
+ echo $ac_n "checking whether ${CC-cc} accepts -g""... $ac_c" 1>&6
+if eval "test \"`echo '$''{'ac_cv_prog_gcc_g'+set}'`\" = set"; then
+ echo $ac_n "(cached) $ac_c" 1>&6
+else
+ echo 'void f(){}' > conftest.c
+if test -z "`${CC-cc} -g -c conftest.c 2>&1`"; then
+ ac_cv_prog_gcc_g=yes
+else
+ ac_cv_prog_gcc_g=no
+fi
+rm -f conftest*
+
+fi
+ echo "$ac_t""$ac_cv_prog_gcc_g" 1>&6
+ if test $ac_cv_prog_gcc_g = yes; then
+ CFLAGS="-g -O"
+ else
+ CFLAGS="-O"
+ fi
+ fi
+else
+ GCC=
+ test "${CFLAGS+set}" = set || CFLAGS="-g"
+fi
+
+# Extract the first word of "ranlib", so it can be a program name with args.
+set dummy ranlib; ac_word=$2
+echo $ac_n "checking for $ac_word""... $ac_c" 1>&6
+if eval "test \"`echo '$''{'ac_cv_prog_RANLIB'+set}'`\" = set"; then
+ echo $ac_n "(cached) $ac_c" 1>&6
+else
+ if test -n "$RANLIB"; then
+ ac_cv_prog_RANLIB="$RANLIB" # Let the user override the test.
+else
+ IFS="${IFS= }"; ac_save_ifs="$IFS"; IFS="${IFS}:"
+ for ac_dir in $PATH; do
+ test -z "$ac_dir" && ac_dir=.
+ if test -f $ac_dir/$ac_word; then
+ ac_cv_prog_RANLIB="ranlib"
+ break
+ fi
+ done
+ IFS="$ac_save_ifs"
+ test -z "$ac_cv_prog_RANLIB" && ac_cv_prog_RANLIB=":"
+fi
+fi
+RANLIB="$ac_cv_prog_RANLIB"
+if test -n "$RANLIB"; then
+ echo "$ac_t""$RANLIB" 1>&6
+else
+ echo "$ac_t""no" 1>&6
+fi
+
+ac_aux_dir=
+for ac_dir in $srcdir $srcdir/.. $srcdir/../..; do
+ if test -f $ac_dir/install-sh; then
+ ac_aux_dir=$ac_dir
+ ac_install_sh="$ac_aux_dir/install-sh -c"
+ break
+ elif test -f $ac_dir/install.sh; then
+ ac_aux_dir=$ac_dir
+ ac_install_sh="$ac_aux_dir/install.sh -c"
+ break
+ fi
+done
+if test -z "$ac_aux_dir"; then
+ { echo "configure: error: can not find install-sh or install.sh in $srcdir $srcdir/.. $srcdir/../.." 1>&2; exit 1; }
+fi
+ac_config_guess=$ac_aux_dir/config.guess
+ac_config_sub=$ac_aux_dir/config.sub
+ac_configure=$ac_aux_dir/configure # This should be Cygnus configure.
+
+# Find a good install program. We prefer a C program (faster),
+# so one script is as good as another. But avoid the broken or
+# incompatible versions:
+# SysV /etc/install, /usr/sbin/install
+# SunOS /usr/etc/install
+# IRIX /sbin/install
+# AIX /bin/install
+# AFS /usr/afsws/bin/install, which mishandles nonexistent args
+# SVR4 /usr/ucb/install, which tries to use the nonexistent group "staff"
+# ./install, which can be erroneously created by make from ./install.sh.
+echo $ac_n "checking for a BSD compatible install""... $ac_c" 1>&6
+if test -z "$INSTALL"; then
+if eval "test \"`echo '$''{'ac_cv_path_install'+set}'`\" = set"; then
+ echo $ac_n "(cached) $ac_c" 1>&6
+else
+ IFS="${IFS= }"; ac_save_ifs="$IFS"; IFS="${IFS}:"
+ for ac_dir in $PATH; do
+ # Account for people who put trailing slashes in PATH elements.
+ case "$ac_dir/" in
+ /|./|.//|/etc/*|/usr/sbin/*|/usr/etc/*|/sbin/*|/usr/afsws/bin/*|/usr/ucb/*) ;;
+ *)
+ # OSF1 and SCO ODT 3.0 have their own names for install.
+ for ac_prog in ginstall installbsd scoinst install; do
+ if test -f $ac_dir/$ac_prog; then
+ if test $ac_prog = install &&
+ grep dspmsg $ac_dir/$ac_prog >/dev/null 2>&1; then
+ # AIX install. It has an incompatible calling convention.
+ # OSF/1 installbsd also uses dspmsg, but is usable.
+ :
+ else
+ ac_cv_path_install="$ac_dir/$ac_prog -c"
+ break 2
+ fi
+ fi
+ done
+ ;;
+ esac
+ done
+ IFS="$ac_save_ifs"
+ # As a last resort, use the slow shell script.
+ test -z "$ac_cv_path_install" && ac_cv_path_install="$ac_install_sh"
+fi
+ INSTALL="$ac_cv_path_install"
+fi
+echo "$ac_t""$INSTALL" 1>&6
+
+# Use test -z because SunOS4 sh mishandles braces in ${var-val}.
+# It thinks the first close brace ends the variable substitution.
+test -z "$INSTALL_PROGRAM" && INSTALL_PROGRAM='${INSTALL}'
+
+test -z "$INSTALL_DATA" && INSTALL_DATA='${INSTALL} -m 644'
+
+echo $ac_n "checking how to run the C preprocessor""... $ac_c" 1>&6
+# On Suns, sometimes $CPP names a directory.
+if test -n "$CPP" && test -d "$CPP"; then
+ CPP=
+fi
+if test -z "$CPP"; then
+if eval "test \"`echo '$''{'ac_cv_prog_CPP'+set}'`\" = set"; then
+ echo $ac_n "(cached) $ac_c" 1>&6
+else
+ # This must be in double quotes, not single quotes, because CPP may get
+ # substituted into the Makefile and "${CC-cc}" will confuse make.
+ CPP="${CC-cc} -E"
+ # On the NeXT, cc -E runs the code through the compiler's parser,
+ # not just through cpp.
+ cat > conftest.$ac_ext <<EOF
+#line 612 "configure"
+#include "confdefs.h"
+#include <assert.h>
+Syntax Error
+EOF
+eval "$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out"
+ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out`
+if test -z "$ac_err"; then
+ :
+else
+ echo "$ac_err" >&5
+ rm -rf conftest*
+ CPP="${CC-cc} -E -traditional-cpp"
+ cat > conftest.$ac_ext <<EOF
+#line 626 "configure"
+#include "confdefs.h"
+#include <assert.h>
+Syntax Error
+EOF
+eval "$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out"
+ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out`
+if test -z "$ac_err"; then
+ :
+else
+ echo "$ac_err" >&5
+ rm -rf conftest*
+ CPP=/lib/cpp
+fi
+rm -f conftest*
+fi
+rm -f conftest*
+ ac_cv_prog_CPP="$CPP"
+fi
+ CPP="$ac_cv_prog_CPP"
+else
+ ac_cv_prog_CPP="$CPP"
+fi
+echo "$ac_t""$CPP" 1>&6
+
+for ac_hdr in string.h unistd.h
+do
+ac_safe=`echo "$ac_hdr" | tr './\055' '___'`
+echo $ac_n "checking for $ac_hdr""... $ac_c" 1>&6
+if eval "test \"`echo '$''{'ac_cv_header_$ac_safe'+set}'`\" = set"; then
+ echo $ac_n "(cached) $ac_c" 1>&6
+else
+ cat > conftest.$ac_ext <<EOF
+#line 659 "configure"
+#include "confdefs.h"
+#include <$ac_hdr>
+EOF
+eval "$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out"
+ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out`
+if test -z "$ac_err"; then
+ rm -rf conftest*
+ eval "ac_cv_header_$ac_safe=yes"
+else
+ echo "$ac_err" >&5
+ rm -rf conftest*
+ eval "ac_cv_header_$ac_safe=no"
+fi
+rm -f conftest*
+fi
+if eval "test \"`echo '$ac_cv_header_'$ac_safe`\" = yes"; then
+ echo "$ac_t""yes" 1>&6
+ ac_tr_hdr=HAVE_`echo $ac_hdr | tr '[a-z]./\055' '[A-Z]___'`
+ cat >> confdefs.h <<EOF
+#define $ac_tr_hdr 1
+EOF
+
+else
+ echo "$ac_t""no" 1>&6
+fi
+done
+
+# If we cannot run a trivial program, we must be cross compiling.
+echo $ac_n "checking whether cross-compiling""... $ac_c" 1>&6
+if eval "test \"`echo '$''{'ac_cv_c_cross'+set}'`\" = set"; then
+ echo $ac_n "(cached) $ac_c" 1>&6
+else
+ if test "$cross_compiling" = yes; then
+ ac_cv_c_cross=yes
+else
+cat > conftest.$ac_ext <<EOF
+#line 696 "configure"
+#include "confdefs.h"
+main(){return(0);}
+EOF
+eval $ac_link
+if test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit) 2>/dev/null; then
+ ac_cv_c_cross=no
+else
+ ac_cv_c_cross=yes
+fi
+fi
+rm -fr conftest*
+fi
+cross_compiling=$ac_cv_c_cross
+echo "$ac_t""$ac_cv_c_cross" 1>&6
+
+echo $ac_n "checking for ANSI C header files""... $ac_c" 1>&6
+if eval "test \"`echo '$''{'ac_cv_header_stdc'+set}'`\" = set"; then
+ echo $ac_n "(cached) $ac_c" 1>&6
+else
+ cat > conftest.$ac_ext <<EOF
+#line 717 "configure"
+#include "confdefs.h"
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <stdarg.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <float.h>
+EOF
+eval "$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext >/dev/null 2>conftest.out"
+ac_err=`grep -v '^ *+' conftest.out`
+if test -z "$ac_err"; then
+ rm -rf conftest*
+ ac_cv_header_stdc=yes
+else
+ echo "$ac_err" >&5
+ rm -rf conftest*
+ ac_cv_header_stdc=no
+fi
+rm -f conftest*
+
+if test $ac_cv_header_stdc = yes; then
+ # SunOS 4.x string.h does not declare mem*, contrary to ANSI.
+cat > conftest.$ac_ext <<EOF
+#line 739 "configure"
+#include "confdefs.h"
+#include <string.h>
+EOF
+if (eval "$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext") 2>&5 |
+ egrep "memchr" >/dev/null 2>&1; then
+ :
+else
+ rm -rf conftest*
+ ac_cv_header_stdc=no
+fi
+rm -f conftest*
+
+fi
+
+if test $ac_cv_header_stdc = yes; then
+ # ISC 2.0.2 stdlib.h does not declare free, contrary to ANSI.
+cat > conftest.$ac_ext <<EOF
+#line 757 "configure"
+#include "confdefs.h"
+#include <stdlib.h>
+EOF
+if (eval "$ac_cpp conftest.$ac_ext") 2>&5 |
+ egrep "free" >/dev/null 2>&1; then
+ :
+else
+ rm -rf conftest*
+ ac_cv_header_stdc=no
+fi
+rm -f conftest*
+
+fi
+
+if test $ac_cv_header_stdc = yes; then
+ # /bin/cc in Irix-4.0.5 gets non-ANSI ctype macros unless using -ansi.
+if test "$cross_compiling" = yes; then
+ ac_cv_header_stdc=no
+else
+cat > conftest.$ac_ext <<EOF
+#line 778 "configure"
+#include "confdefs.h"
+#include <ctype.h>
+#define ISLOWER(c) ('a' <= (c) && (c) <= 'z')
+#define TOUPPER(c) (ISLOWER(c) ? 'A' + ((c) - 'a') : (c))
+#define XOR(e, f) (((e) && !(f)) || (!(e) && (f)))
+int main () { int i; for (i = 0; i < 256; i++)
+if (XOR (islower (i), ISLOWER (i)) || toupper (i) != TOUPPER (i)) exit(2);
+exit (0); }
+
+EOF
+eval $ac_link
+if test -s conftest && (./conftest; exit) 2>/dev/null; then
+ :
+else
+ ac_cv_header_stdc=no
+fi
+fi
+rm -fr conftest*
+fi
+fi
+echo "$ac_t""$ac_cv_header_stdc" 1>&6
+if test $ac_cv_header_stdc = yes; then
+ cat >> confdefs.h <<\EOF
+#define STDC_HEADERS 1
+EOF
+
+fi
+
+
+trap '' 1 2 15
+cat > confcache <<\EOF
+# This file is a shell script that caches the results of configure
+# tests run on this system so they can be shared between configure
+# scripts and configure runs. It is not useful on other systems.
+# If it contains results you don't want to keep, you may remove or edit it.
+#
+# By default, configure uses ./config.cache as the cache file,
+# creating it if it does not exist already. You can give configure
+# the --cache-file=FILE option to use a different cache file; that is
+# what configure does when it calls configure scripts in
+# subdirectories, so they share the cache.
+# Giving --cache-file=/dev/null disables caching, for debugging configure.
+# config.status only pays attention to the cache file if you give it the
+# --recheck option to rerun configure.
+#
+EOF
+# Ultrix sh set writes to stderr and can't be redirected directly,
+# and sets the high bit in the cache file unless we assign to the vars.
+(set) 2>&1 |
+ sed -n "s/^\([a-zA-Z0-9_]*_cv_[a-zA-Z0-9_]*\)=\(.*\)/\1=\${\1='\2'}/p" \
+ >> confcache
+if cmp -s $cache_file confcache; then
+ :
+else
+ if test -w $cache_file; then
+ echo "updating cache $cache_file"
+ cat confcache > $cache_file
+ else
+ echo "not updating unwritable cache $cache_file"
+ fi
+fi
+rm -f confcache
+
+trap 'rm -fr conftest* confdefs* core core.* *.core $ac_clean_files; exit 1' 1 2 15
+
+test "x$prefix" = xNONE && prefix=$ac_default_prefix
+# Let make expand exec_prefix.
+test "x$exec_prefix" = xNONE && exec_prefix='${prefix}'
+
+# Any assignment to VPATH causes Sun make to only execute
+# the first set of double-colon rules, so remove it if not needed.
+# If there is a colon in the path, we need to keep it.
+if test "x$srcdir" = x.; then
+ ac_vpsub='/^[ ]*VPATH[ ]*=[^:]*$/d'
+fi
+
+trap 'rm -f $CONFIG_STATUS conftest*; exit 1' 1 2 15
+
+# Transform confdefs.h into DEFS.
+# Protect against shell expansion while executing Makefile rules.
+# Protect against Makefile macro expansion.
+cat > conftest.defs <<\EOF
+s%#define \([A-Za-z_][A-Za-z0-9_]*\) \(.*\)%-D\1=\2%g
+s%[ `~#$^&*(){}\\|;'"<>?]%\\&%g
+s%\[%\\&%g
+s%\]%\\&%g
+s%\$%$$%g
+EOF
+DEFS=`sed -f conftest.defs confdefs.h | tr '\012' ' '`
+rm -f conftest.defs
+
+
+# Without the "./", some shells look in PATH for config.status.
+: ${CONFIG_STATUS=./config.status}
+
+echo creating $CONFIG_STATUS
+rm -f $CONFIG_STATUS
+cat > $CONFIG_STATUS <<EOF
+#! /bin/sh
+# Generated automatically by configure.
+# Run this file to recreate the current configuration.
+# This directory was configured as follows,
+# on host `(hostname || uname -n) 2>/dev/null | sed 1q`:
+#
+# $0 $ac_configure_args
+#
+# Compiler output produced by configure, useful for debugging
+# configure, is in ./config.log if it exists.
+
+ac_cs_usage="Usage: $CONFIG_STATUS [--recheck] [--version] [--help]"
+for ac_option
+do
+ case "\$ac_option" in
+ -recheck | --recheck | --rechec | --reche | --rech | --rec | --re | --r)
+ echo "running \${CONFIG_SHELL-/bin/sh} $0 $ac_configure_args --no-create --no-recursion"
+ exec \${CONFIG_SHELL-/bin/sh} $0 $ac_configure_args --no-create --no-recursion ;;
+ -version | --version | --versio | --versi | --vers | --ver | --ve | --v)
+ echo "$CONFIG_STATUS generated by autoconf version 2.4"
+ exit 0 ;;
+ -help | --help | --hel | --he | --h)
+ echo "\$ac_cs_usage"; exit 0 ;;
+ *) echo "\$ac_cs_usage"; exit 1 ;;
+ esac
+done
+
+ac_given_srcdir=$srcdir
+ac_given_INSTALL="$INSTALL"
+
+trap 'rm -fr `echo "Makefile" | sed "s/:[^ ]*//g"` conftest*; exit 1' 1 2 15
+
+# Protect against being on the right side of a sed subst in config.status.
+sed 's/%@/@@/; s/@%/@@/; s/%g$/@g/; /@g$/s/[\\\\&%]/\\\\&/g;
+ s/@@/%@/; s/@@/@%/; s/@g$/%g/' > conftest.subs <<\CEOF
+$ac_vpsub
+$extrasub
+s%@CFLAGS@%$CFLAGS%g
+s%@CPPFLAGS@%$CPPFLAGS%g
+s%@CXXFLAGS@%$CXXFLAGS%g
+s%@DEFS@%$DEFS%g
+s%@LDFLAGS@%$LDFLAGS%g
+s%@LIBS@%$LIBS%g
+s%@exec_prefix@%$exec_prefix%g
+s%@prefix@%$prefix%g
+s%@program_transform_name@%$program_transform_name%g
+s%@installdata@%$installdata%g
+s%@uninstalldata@%$uninstalldata%g
+s%@termcapfile@%$termcapfile%g
+s%@CC@%$CC%g
+s%@RANLIB@%$RANLIB%g
+s%@INSTALL_PROGRAM@%$INSTALL_PROGRAM%g
+s%@INSTALL_DATA@%$INSTALL_DATA%g
+s%@CPP@%$CPP%g
+
+CEOF
+EOF
+cat >> $CONFIG_STATUS <<EOF
+
+CONFIG_FILES=\${CONFIG_FILES-"Makefile"}
+EOF
+cat >> $CONFIG_STATUS <<\EOF
+for ac_file in .. $CONFIG_FILES; do if test "x$ac_file" != x..; then
+ # Support "outfile[:infile]", defaulting infile="outfile.in".
+ case "$ac_file" in
+ *:*) ac_file_in=`echo "$ac_file"|sed 's%.*:%%'`
+ ac_file=`echo "$ac_file"|sed 's%:.*%%'` ;;
+ *) ac_file_in="${ac_file}.in" ;;
+ esac
+
+ # Adjust relative srcdir, etc. for subdirectories.
+
+ # Remove last slash and all that follows it. Not all systems have dirname.
+ ac_dir=`echo $ac_file|sed 's%/[^/][^/]*$%%'`
+ if test "$ac_dir" != "$ac_file" && test "$ac_dir" != .; then
+ # The file is in a subdirectory.
+ test ! -d "$ac_dir" && mkdir "$ac_dir"
+ ac_dir_suffix="/`echo $ac_dir|sed 's%^\./%%'`"
+ # A "../" for each directory in $ac_dir_suffix.
+ ac_dots=`echo $ac_dir_suffix|sed 's%/[^/]*%../%g'`
+ else
+ ac_dir_suffix= ac_dots=
+ fi
+
+ case "$ac_given_srcdir" in
+ .) srcdir=.
+ if test -z "$ac_dots"; then top_srcdir=.
+ else top_srcdir=`echo $ac_dots|sed 's%/$%%'`; fi ;;
+ /*) srcdir="$ac_given_srcdir$ac_dir_suffix"; top_srcdir="$ac_given_srcdir" ;;
+ *) # Relative path.
+ srcdir="$ac_dots$ac_given_srcdir$ac_dir_suffix"
+ top_srcdir="$ac_dots$ac_given_srcdir" ;;
+ esac
+
+ case "$ac_given_INSTALL" in
+ [/$]*) INSTALL="$ac_given_INSTALL" ;;
+ *) INSTALL="$ac_dots$ac_given_INSTALL" ;;
+ esac
+ echo creating "$ac_file"
+ rm -f "$ac_file"
+ configure_input="Generated automatically from `echo $ac_file_in|sed 's%.*/%%'` by configure."
+ case "$ac_file" in
+ *Makefile*) ac_comsub="1i\\
+# $configure_input" ;;
+ *) ac_comsub= ;;
+ esac
+ sed -e "$ac_comsub
+s%@configure_input@%$configure_input%g
+s%@srcdir@%$srcdir%g
+s%@top_srcdir@%$top_srcdir%g
+s%@INSTALL@%$INSTALL%g
+" -f conftest.subs $ac_given_srcdir/$ac_file_in > $ac_file
+fi; done
+rm -f conftest.subs
+
+
+
+exit 0
+EOF
+chmod +x $CONFIG_STATUS
+rm -fr confdefs* $ac_clean_files
+test "$no_create" = yes || ${CONFIG_SHELL-/bin/sh} $CONFIG_STATUS || exit 1
+
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/configure.in b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/configure.in
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f3f944f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/configure.in
@@ -0,0 +1,23 @@
+dnl Process this file with autoconf to produce a configure script.
+AC_INIT(termcap.h)
+
+AC_ARG_ENABLE(install-termcap,
+[ --enable-install-termcap install the termcap data file],
+[if test $enableval = yes; then
+ installdata=install-data uninstalldata=uninstall-data
+ fi])
+AC_SUBST(installdata)dnl
+AC_SUBST(uninstalldata)dnl
+
+AC_ARG_WITH(termcap,
+[ --with-termcap=FILE use data file FILE instead of /etc/termcap],
+termcapfile=$withval, termcapfile=/etc/termcap)
+AC_SUBST(termcapfile)dnl
+
+AC_PROG_CC
+AC_PROG_RANLIB
+AC_PROG_INSTALL
+AC_HAVE_HEADERS(string.h unistd.h)
+AC_STDC_HEADERS
+
+AC_OUTPUT(Makefile)
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/termcap.info b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/termcap.info
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f663195
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/termcap.info
@@ -0,0 +1,80 @@
+This is Info file ./termcap.info, produced by Makeinfo-1.55 from the
+input file ./termcap.texi.
+
+ This file documents the termcap library of the GNU system.
+
+ Copyright (C) 1988 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of this
+manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice are
+preserved on all copies.
+
+ Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of
+this manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided that
+the entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
+permission notice identical to this one.
+
+ Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this
+manual into another language, under the above conditions for modified
+versions, except that this permission notice may be stated in a
+translation approved by the Foundation.
+
+
+Indirect:
+termcap.info-1: 874
+termcap.info-2: 47411
+termcap.info-3: 90390
+termcap.info-4: 138827
+
+Tag Table:
+(Indirect)
+Node: Top874
+Node: Introduction4105
+Node: Library5832
+Node: Preparation6851
+Node: Find8034
+Node: Interrogate11492
+Node: Initialize16800
+Node: Padding18440
+Node: Why Pad19146
+Node: Not Enough20768
+Node: Describe Padding23336
+Node: Output Padding24826
+Node: Parameters28441
+Node: Encode Parameters30101
+Node: Using Parameters36185
+Node: tparam36780
+Node: tgoto38806
+Node: Data Base41361
+Node: Format42257
+Node: Capability Format44346
+Node: Naming47411
+Node: Inheriting51980
+Node: Changing54224
+Node: Capabilities55388
+Node: Basic58127
+Node: Screen Size62180
+Node: Cursor Motion63920
+Node: Wrapping74062
+Node: Scrolling77091
+Node: Windows82980
+Node: Clearing83714
+Node: Insdel Line85478
+Node: Insdel Char90390
+Node: Standout100375
+Node: Underlining109433
+Node: Cursor Visibility111852
+Node: Bell112600
+Node: Keypad113149
+Node: Meta Key117864
+Node: Initialization118818
+Node: Pad Specs121369
+Node: Status Line123422
+Node: Half-Line125306
+Node: Printer126108
+Node: Summary127787
+Node: Var Index138114
+Node: Cap Index138827
+Node: Index145991
+
+End Tag Table
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/termcap.info-1 b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/termcap.info-1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..a5b5da0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/termcap.info-1
@@ -0,0 +1,1114 @@
+This is Info file ./termcap.info, produced by Makeinfo-1.55 from the
+input file ./termcap.texi.
+
+ This file documents the termcap library of the GNU system.
+
+ Copyright (C) 1988 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of this
+manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice are
+preserved on all copies.
+
+ Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of
+this manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided that
+the entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
+permission notice identical to this one.
+
+ Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this
+manual into another language, under the above conditions for modified
+versions, except that this permission notice may be stated in a
+translation approved by the Foundation.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Top, Next: Introduction, Prev: (dir), Up: (dir)
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Introduction:: What is termcap? Why this manual?
+* Library:: The termcap library functions.
+* Data Base:: What terminal descriptions in `/etc/termcap' look like.
+* Capabilities:: Definitions of the individual terminal capabilities:
+ how to write them in descriptions, and how to use
+ their values to do display updating.
+* Summary:: Brief table of capability names and their meanings.
+* Var Index:: Index of C functions and variables.
+* Cap Index:: Index of termcap capabilities.
+* Index:: Concept index.
+
+ -- The Detailed Node Listing --
+
+The Termcap Library
+
+* Preparation:: Preparing to use the termcap library.
+* Find:: Finding the description of the terminal being used.
+* Interrogate:: Interrogating the description for particular capabilities.
+* Initialize:: Initialization for output using termcap.
+* Padding:: Outputting padding.
+* Parameters:: Encoding parameters such as cursor positions.
+
+Padding
+
+* Why Pad:: Explanation of padding.
+* Not Enough:: When there is not enough padding.
+* Describe Padding:: The data base says how much padding a terminal needs.
+* Output Padding:: Using `tputs' to output the needed padding.
+
+Filling In Parameters
+
+* Encode Parameters:: The language for encoding parameters.
+* Using Parameters:: Outputting a string command with parameters.
+
+Sending Display Commands with Parameters
+
+* tparam:: The general case, for GNU termcap only.
+* tgoto:: The special case of cursor motion.
+
+The Format of the Data Base
+
+* Format:: Overall format of a terminal description.
+* Capability Format:: Format of capabilities within a description.
+* Naming:: Naming conventions for terminal types.
+* Inheriting:: Inheriting part of a description from
+a related terminal type.
+* Changing:: When changes in the data base take effect.
+
+Definitions of the Terminal Capabilities
+
+* Basic:: Basic characteristics.
+* Screen Size:: Screen size, and what happens when it changes.
+* Cursor Motion:: Various ways to move the cursor.
+* Wrapping:: What happens if you write a character in the last column.
+* Scrolling:: Pushing text up and down on the screen.
+* Windows:: Limiting the part of the window that output affects.
+* Clearing:: Erasing one or many lines.
+* Insdel Line:: Making new blank lines in mid-screen; deleting lines.
+* Insdel Char:: Inserting and deleting characters within a line.
+* Standout:: Highlighting some of the text.
+* Underlining:: Underlining some of the text.
+* Cursor Visibility:: Making the cursor more or less easy to spot.
+* Bell:: Attracts user's attention; not localized on the screen.
+* Keypad:: Recognizing when function keys or arrows are typed.
+* Meta Key:: META acts like an extra shift key.
+* Initialization:: Commands used to initialize or reset the terminal.
+* Pad Specs:: Info for the kernel on how much padding is needed.
+* Status Line:: A status line displays "background" information.
+* Half-Line:: Moving by half-lines, for superscripts and subscripts.
+* Printer:: Controlling auxiliary printers of display terminals.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Introduction, Next: Library, Prev: Top, Up: Top
+
+Introduction
+************
+
+ "Termcap" is a library and data base that enables programs to use
+display terminals in a terminal-independent manner. It originated in
+Berkeley Unix.
+
+ The termcap data base describes the capabilities of hundreds of
+different display terminals in great detail. Some examples of the
+information recorded for a terminal could include how many columns wide
+it is, what string to send to move the cursor to an arbitrary position
+(including how to encode the row and column numbers), how to scroll the
+screen up one or several lines, and how much padding is needed for such
+a scrolling operation.
+
+ The termcap library is provided for easy access this data base in
+programs that want to do terminal-independent character-based display
+output.
+
+ This manual describes the GNU version of the termcap library, which
+has some extensions over the Unix version. All the extensions are
+identified as such, so this manual also tells you how to use the Unix
+termcap.
+
+ The GNU version of the termcap library is available free as source
+code, for use in free programs, and runs on Unix and VMS systems (at
+least). You can find it in the GNU Emacs distribution in the files
+`termcap.c' and `tparam.c'.
+
+ This manual was written for the GNU project, whose goal is to
+develop a complete free operating system upward-compatible with Unix
+for user programs. The project is approximately two thirds complete.
+For more information on the GNU project, including the GNU Emacs editor
+and the mostly-portable optimizing C compiler, send one dollar to
+
+ Free Software Foundation
+ 675 Mass Ave
+ Cambridge, MA 02139
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Library, Next: Data Base, Prev: Introduction, Up: Top
+
+The Termcap Library
+*******************
+
+ The termcap library is the application programmer's interface to the
+termcap data base. It contains functions for the following purposes:
+
+ * Finding the description of the user's terminal type (`tgetent').
+
+ * Interrogating the description for information on various topics
+ (`tgetnum', `tgetflag', `tgetstr').
+
+ * Computing and performing padding (`tputs').
+
+ * Encoding numeric parameters such as cursor positions into the
+ terminal-specific form required for display commands (`tparam',
+ `tgoto').
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Preparation:: Preparing to use the termcap library.
+* Find:: Finding the description of the terminal being used.
+* Interrogate:: Interrogating the description for particular capabilities.
+* Initialize:: Initialization for output using termcap.
+* Padding:: Outputting padding.
+* Parameters:: Encoding parameters such as cursor positions.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Preparation, Next: Find, Up: Library
+
+Preparing to Use the Termcap Library
+====================================
+
+ To use the termcap library in a program, you need two kinds of
+preparation:
+
+ * The compiler needs declarations of the functions and variables in
+ the library.
+
+ On GNU systems, it suffices to include the header file `termcap.h'
+ in each source file that uses these functions and variables.
+
+ On Unix systems, there is often no such header file. Then you must
+ explictly declare the variables as external. You can do likewise
+ for the functions, or let them be implicitly declared and cast
+ their values from type `int' to the appropriate type.
+
+ We illustrate the declarations of the individual termcap library
+ functions with ANSI C prototypes because they show how to pass the
+ arguments. If you are not using the GNU C compiler, you probably
+ cannot use function prototypes, so omit the argument types and
+ names from your declarations.
+
+ * The linker needs to search the library. Usually either
+ `-ltermcap' or `-ltermlib' as an argument when linking will do
+ this.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Find, Next: Interrogate, Prev: Preparation, Up: Library
+
+Finding a Terminal Description: `tgetent'
+=========================================
+
+ An application program that is going to use termcap must first look
+up the description of the terminal type in use. This is done by calling
+`tgetent', whose declaration in ANSI Standard C looks like:
+
+ int tgetent (char *BUFFER, char *TERMTYPE);
+
+This function finds the description and remembers it internally so that
+you can interrogate it about specific terminal capabilities (*note
+Interrogate::.).
+
+ The argument TERMTYPE is a string which is the name for the type of
+terminal to look up. Usually you would obtain this from the environment
+variable `TERM' using `getenv ("TERM")'.
+
+ If you are using the GNU version of termcap, you can alternatively
+ask `tgetent' to allocate enough space. Pass a null pointer for
+BUFFER, and `tgetent' itself allocates the storage using `malloc'.
+There is no way to get the address that was allocated, and you
+shouldn't try to free the storage.
+
+ With the Unix version of termcap, you must allocate space for the
+description yourself and pass the address of the space as the argument
+BUFFER. There is no way you can tell how much space is needed, so the
+convention is to allocate a buffer 2048 characters long and assume that
+is enough. (Formerly the convention was to allocate 1024 characters and
+assume that was enough. But one day, for one kind of terminal, that was
+not enough.)
+
+ No matter how the space to store the description has been obtained,
+termcap records its address internally for use when you later
+interrogate the description with `tgetnum', `tgetstr' or `tgetflag'. If
+the buffer was allocated by termcap, it will be freed by termcap too if
+you call `tgetent' again. If the buffer was provided by you, you must
+make sure that its contents remain unchanged for as long as you still
+plan to interrogate the description.
+
+ The return value of `tgetent' is -1 if there is some difficulty
+accessing the data base of terminal types, 0 if the data base is
+accessible but the specified type is not defined in it, and some other
+value otherwise.
+
+ Here is how you might use the function `tgetent':
+
+ #ifdef unix
+ static char term_buffer[2048];
+ #else
+ #define term_buffer 0
+ #endif
+
+ init_terminal_data ()
+ {
+ char *termtype = getenv ("TERM");
+ int success;
+
+ if (termtype == 0)
+ fatal ("Specify a terminal type with `setenv TERM <yourtype>'.\n");
+
+ success = tgetent (term_buffer, termtype);
+ if (success < 0)
+ fatal ("Could not access the termcap data base.\n");
+ if (success == 0)
+ fatal ("Terminal type `%s' is not defined.\n", termtype);
+ }
+
+Here we assume the function `fatal' prints an error message and exits.
+
+ If the environment variable `TERMCAP' is defined, its value is used
+to override the terminal type data base. The function `tgetent' checks
+the value of `TERMCAP' automatically. If the value starts with `/'
+then it is taken as a file name to use as the data base file, instead
+of `/etc/termcap' which is the standard data base. If the value does
+not start with `/' then it is itself used as the terminal description,
+provided that the terminal type TERMTYPE is among the types it claims
+to apply to. *Note Data Base::, for information on the format of a
+terminal description.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Interrogate, Next: Initialize, Prev: Find, Up: Library
+
+Interrogating the Terminal Description
+======================================
+
+ Each piece of information recorded in a terminal description is
+called a "capability". Each defined terminal capability has a
+two-letter code name and a specific meaning. For example, the number
+of columns is named `co'. *Note Capabilities::, for definitions of all
+the standard capability names.
+
+ Once you have found the proper terminal description with `tgetent'
+(*note Find::.), your application program must "interrogate" it for
+various terminal capabilities. You must specify the two-letter code of
+the capability whose value you seek.
+
+ Capability values can be numeric, boolean (capability is either
+present or absent) or strings. Any particular capability always has
+the same value type; for example, `co' always has a numeric value,
+while `am' (automatic wrap at margin) is always a flag, and `cm'
+(cursor motion command) always has a string value. The documentation
+of each capability says which type of value it has.
+
+ There are three functions to use to get the value of a capability,
+depending on the type of value the capability has. Here are their
+declarations in ANSI C:
+
+ int tgetnum (char *NAME);
+ int tgetflag (char *NAME);
+ char *tgetstr (char *NAME, char **AREA);
+
+`tgetnum'
+ Use `tgetnum' to get a capability value that is numeric. The
+ argument NAME is the two-letter code name of the capability. If
+ the capability is present, `tgetnum' returns the numeric value
+ (which is nonnegative). If the capability is not mentioned in the
+ terminal description, `tgetnum' returns -1.
+
+`tgetflag'
+ Use `tgetflag' to get a boolean value. If the capability NAME is
+ present in the terminal description, `tgetflag' returns 1;
+ otherwise, it returns 0.
+
+`tgetstr'
+ Use `tgetstr' to get a string value. It returns a pointer to a
+ string which is the capability value, or a null pointer if the
+ capability is not present in the terminal description.
+
+ There are two ways `tgetstr' can find space to store the string
+ value:
+
+ * You can ask `tgetstr' to allocate the space. Pass a null
+ pointer for the argument AREA, and `tgetstr' will use
+ `malloc' to allocate storage big enough for the value.
+ Termcap will never free this storage or refer to it again; you
+ should free it when you are finished with it.
+
+ This method is more robust, since there is no need to guess
+ how much space is needed. But it is supported only by the GNU
+ termcap library.
+
+ * You can provide the space. Provide for the argument AREA the
+ address of a pointer variable of type `char *'. Before
+ calling `tgetstr', initialize the variable to point at
+ available space. Then `tgetstr' will store the string value
+ in that space and will increment the pointer variable to
+ point after the space that has been used. You can use the
+ same pointer variable for many calls to `tgetstr'.
+
+ There is no way to determine how much space is needed for a
+ single string, and no way for you to prevent or handle
+ overflow of the area you have provided. However, you can be
+ sure that the total size of all the string values you will
+ obtain from the terminal description is no greater than the
+ size of the description (unless you get the same capability
+ twice). You can determine that size with `strlen' on the
+ buffer you provided to `tgetent'. See below for an example.
+
+ Providing the space yourself is the only method supported by
+ the Unix version of termcap.
+
+ Note that you do not have to specify a terminal type or terminal
+description for the interrogation functions. They automatically use the
+description found by the most recent call to `tgetent'.
+
+ Here is an example of interrogating a terminal description for
+various capabilities, with conditionals to select between the Unix and
+GNU methods of providing buffer space.
+
+ char *tgetstr ();
+
+ char *cl_string, *cm_string;
+ int height;
+ int width;
+ int auto_wrap;
+
+ char PC; /* For tputs. */
+ char *BC; /* For tgoto. */
+ char *UP;
+
+ interrogate_terminal ()
+ {
+ #ifdef UNIX
+ /* Here we assume that an explicit term_buffer
+ was provided to tgetent. */
+ char *buffer
+ = (char *) malloc (strlen (term_buffer));
+ #define BUFFADDR &buffer
+ #else
+ #define BUFFADDR 0
+ #endif
+
+ char *temp;
+
+ /* Extract information we will use. */
+ cl_string = tgetstr ("cl", BUFFADDR);
+ cm_string = tgetstr ("cm", BUFFADDR);
+ auto_wrap = tgetflag ("am");
+ height = tgetnum ("li");
+ width = tgetnum ("co");
+
+ /* Extract information that termcap functions use. */
+ temp = tgetstr ("pc", BUFFADDR);
+ PC = temp ? *temp : 0;
+ BC = tgetstr ("le", BUFFADDR);
+ UP = tgetstr ("up", BUFFADDR);
+ }
+
+*Note Padding::, for information on the variable `PC'. *Note Using
+Parameters::, for information on `UP' and `BC'.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Initialize, Next: Padding, Prev: Interrogate, Up: Library
+
+Initialization for Use of Termcap
+=================================
+
+ Before starting to output commands to a terminal using termcap, an
+application program should do two things:
+
+ * Initialize various global variables which termcap library output
+ functions refer to. These include `PC' and `ospeed' for padding
+ (*note Output Padding::.) and `UP' and `BC' for cursor motion
+ (*note tgoto::.).
+
+ * Tell the kernel to turn off alteration and padding of
+ horizontal-tab characters sent to the terminal.
+
+ To turn off output processing in Berkeley Unix you would use `ioctl'
+with code `TIOCLSET' to set the bit named `LLITOUT', and clear the bits
+`ANYDELAY' using `TIOCSETN'. In POSIX or System V, you must clear the
+bit named `OPOST'. Refer to the system documentation for details.
+
+ If you do not set the terminal flags properly, some older terminals
+will not work. This is because their commands may contain the
+characters that normally signify newline, carriage return and
+horizontal tab--characters which the kernel thinks it ought to modify
+before output.
+
+ When you change the kernel's terminal flags, you must arrange to
+restore them to their normal state when your program exits. This
+implies that the program must catch fatal signals such as `SIGQUIT' and
+`SIGINT' and restore the old terminal flags before actually terminating.
+
+ Modern terminals' commands do not use these special characters, so
+if you do not care about problems with old terminals, you can leave the
+kernel's terminal flags unaltered.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Padding, Next: Parameters, Prev: Initialize, Up: Library
+
+Padding
+=======
+
+ "Padding" means outputting null characters following a terminal
+display command that takes a long time to execute. The terminal
+description says which commands require padding and how much; the
+function `tputs', described below, outputs a terminal command while
+extracting from it the padding information, and then outputs the
+padding that is necessary.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Why Pad:: Explanation of padding.
+* Not Enough:: When there is not enough padding.
+* Describe Padding:: The data base says how much padding a terminal needs.
+* Output Padding:: Using `tputs' to output the needed padding.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Why Pad, Next: Not Enough, Up: Padding
+
+Why Pad, and How
+----------------
+
+ Most types of terminal have commands that take longer to execute
+than they do to send over a high-speed line. For example, clearing the
+screen may take 20msec once the entire command is received. During
+that time, on a 9600 bps line, the terminal could receive about 20
+additional output characters while still busy clearing the screen.
+Every terminal has a certain amount of buffering capacity to remember
+output characters that cannot be processed yet, but too many slow
+commands in a row can cause the buffer to fill up. Then any additional
+output that cannot be processed immediately will be lost.
+
+ To avoid this problem, we normally follow each display command with
+enough useless charaters (usually null characters) to fill up the time
+that the display command needs to execute. This does the job if the
+terminal throws away null characters without using up space in the
+buffer (which most terminals do). If enough padding is used, no output
+can ever be lost. The right amount of padding avoids loss of output
+without slowing down operation, since the time used to transmit padding
+is time that nothing else could be done.
+
+ The number of padding characters needed for an operation depends on
+the line speed. In fact, it is proportional to the line speed. A 9600
+baud line transmits about one character per msec, so the clear screen
+command in the example above would need about 20 characters of padding.
+At 1200 baud, however, only about 3 characters of padding are needed
+to fill up 20msec.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Not Enough, Next: Describe Padding, Prev: Why Pad, Up: Padding
+
+When There Is Not Enough Padding
+--------------------------------
+
+ There are several common manifestations of insufficient padding.
+
+ * Emacs displays `I-search: ^Q-' at the bottom of the screen.
+
+ This means that the terminal thought its buffer was getting full of
+ display commands, so it tried to tell the computer to stop sending
+ any.
+
+ * The screen is garbled intermittently, or the details of garbling
+ vary when you repeat the action. (A garbled screen could be due
+ to a command which is simply incorrect, or to user option in the
+ terminal which doesn't match the assumptions of the terminal
+ description, but this usually leads to reproducible failure.)
+
+ This means that the buffer did get full, and some commands were
+ lost. Many changeable factors can change which ones are lost.
+
+ * Screen is garbled at high output speeds but not at low speeds.
+ Padding problems nearly always go away at low speeds, usually even
+ at 1200 baud.
+
+ This means that a high enough speed permits commands to arrive
+ faster than they can be executed.
+
+ Although any obscure command on an obscure terminal might lack
+padding, in practice problems arise most often from the clearing
+commands `cl' and `cd' (*note Clearing::.), the scrolling commands `sf'
+and `sr' (*note Scrolling::.), and the line insert/delete commands `al'
+and `dl' (*note Insdel Line::.).
+
+ Occasionally the terminal description fails to define `sf' and some
+programs will use `do' instead, so you may get a problem with `do'. If
+so, first define `sf' just like `do', then add some padding to `sf'.
+
+ The best strategy is to add a lot of padding at first, perhaps 200
+msec. This is much more than enough; in fact, it should cause a
+visible slowdown. (If you don't see a slowdown, the change has not
+taken effect; *note Changing::..) If this makes the problem go away,
+you have found the right place to add padding; now reduce the amount
+until the problem comes back, then increase it again. If the problem
+remains, either it is in some other capability or it is not a matter of
+padding at all.
+
+ Keep in mind that on many terminals the correct padding for
+insert/delete line or for scrolling is cursor-position dependent. If
+you get problems from scrolling a large region of the screen but not
+from scrolling a small part (just a few lines moving), it may mean that
+fixed padding should be replaced with position-dependent padding.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Describe Padding, Next: Output Padding, Prev: Not Enough, Up: Padding
+
+Specifying Padding in a Terminal Description
+--------------------------------------------
+
+ In the terminal description, the amount of padding required by each
+display command is recorded as a sequence of digits at the front of the
+command. These digits specify the padding time in milliseconds (msec).
+They can be followed optionally by a decimal point and one more digit,
+which is a number of tenths of msec.
+
+ Sometimes the padding needed by a command depends on the cursor
+position. For example, the time taken by an "insert line" command is
+usually proportional to the number of lines that need to be moved down
+or cleared. An asterisk (`*') following the padding time says that the
+time should be multiplied by the number of screen lines affected by the
+command.
+
+ :al=1.3*\E[L:
+
+is used to describe the "insert line" command for a certain terminal.
+The padding required is 1.3 msec per line affected. The command itself
+is `ESC [ L'.
+
+ The padding time specified in this way tells `tputs' how many pad
+characters to output. *Note Output Padding::.
+
+ Two special capability values affect padding for all commands.
+These are the `pc' and `pb'. The variable `pc' specifies the character
+to pad with, and `pb' the speed below which no padding is needed. The
+defaults for these variables, a null character and 0, are correct for
+most terminals. *Note Pad Specs::.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Output Padding, Prev: Describe Padding, Up: Padding
+
+Performing Padding with `tputs'
+-------------------------------
+
+ Use the termcap function `tputs' to output a string containing an
+optional padding spec of the form described above (*note Describe
+Padding::.). The function `tputs' strips off and decodes the padding
+spec, outputs the rest of the string, and then outputs the appropriate
+padding. Here is its declaration in ANSI C:
+
+ char PC;
+ short ospeed;
+
+ int tputs (char *STRING, int NLINES, int (*OUTFUN) ());
+
+ Here STRING is the string (including padding spec) to be output;
+NLINES is the number of lines affected by the operation, which is used
+to multiply the amount of padding if the padding spec ends with a `*'.
+Finally, OUTFUN is a function (such as `fputchar') that is called to
+output each character. When actually called, OUTFUN should expect one
+argument, a character.
+
+ The operation of `tputs' is controlled by two global variables,
+`ospeed' and `PC'. The value of `ospeed' is supposed to be the
+terminal output speed, encoded as in the `ioctl' system call which gets
+the speed information. This is needed to compute the number of padding
+characters. The value of `PC' is the character used for padding.
+
+ You are responsible for storing suitable values into these variables
+before using `tputs'. The value stored into the `PC' variable should be
+taken from the `pc' capability in the terminal description (*note Pad
+Specs::.). Store zero in `PC' if there is no `pc' capability.
+
+ The argument NLINES requires some thought. Normally, it should be
+the number of lines whose contents will be cleared or moved by the
+command. For cursor motion commands, or commands that do editing
+within one line, use the value 1. For most commands that affect
+multiple lines, such as `al' (insert a line) and `cd' (clear from the
+cursor to the end of the screen), NLINES should be the screen height
+minus the current vertical position (origin 0). For multiple insert
+and scroll commands such as `AL' (insert multiple lines), that same
+value for NLINES is correct; the number of lines being inserted is not
+correct.
+
+ If a "scroll window" feature is used to reduce the number of lines
+affected by a command, the value of NLINES should take this into
+account. This is because the delay time required depends on how much
+work the terminal has to do, and the scroll window feature reduces the
+work. *Note Scrolling::.
+
+ Commands such as `ic' and `dc' (insert or delete characters) are
+problematical because the padding needed by these commands is
+proportional to the number of characters affected, which is the number
+of columns from the cursor to the end of the line. It would be nice to
+have a way to specify such a dependence, and there is no need for
+dependence on vertical position in these commands, so it is an obvious
+idea to say that for these commands NLINES should really be the number
+of columns affected. However, the definition of termcap clearly says
+that NLINES is always the number of lines affected, even in this case,
+where it is always 1. It is not easy to change this rule now, because
+too many programs and terminal descriptions have been written to follow
+it.
+
+ Because NLINES is always 1 for the `ic' and `dc' strings, there is
+no reason for them to use `*', but some of them do. These should be
+corrected by deleting the `*'. If, some day, such entries have
+disappeared, it may be possible to change to a more useful convention
+for the NLINES argument for these operations without breaking any
+programs.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Parameters, Prev: Padding, Up: Library
+
+Filling In Parameters
+=====================
+
+ Some terminal control strings require numeric "parameters". For
+example, when you move the cursor, you need to say what horizontal and
+vertical positions to move it to. The value of the terminal's `cm'
+capability, which says how to move the cursor, cannot simply be a
+string of characters; it must say how to express the cursor position
+numbers and where to put them within the command.
+
+ The specifications of termcap include conventions as to which
+string-valued capabilities require parameters, how many parameters, and
+what the parameters mean; for example, it defines the `cm' string to
+take two parameters, the vertical and horizontal positions, with 0,0
+being the upper left corner. These conventions are described where the
+individual commands are documented.
+
+ Termcap also defines a language used within the capability
+definition for specifying how and where to encode the parameters for
+output. This language uses character sequences starting with `%'.
+(This is the same idea as `printf', but the details are different.)
+The language for parameter encoding is described in this section.
+
+ A program that is doing display output calls the functions `tparam'
+or `tgoto' to encode parameters according to the specifications. These
+functions produce a string containing the actual commands to be output
+(as well a padding spec which must be processed with `tputs'; *note
+Padding::.).
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Encode Parameters:: The language for encoding parameters.
+* Using Parameters:: Outputting a string command with parameters.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Encode Parameters, Next: Using Parameters, Up: Parameters
+
+Describing the Encoding
+-----------------------
+
+ A terminal command string that requires parameters contains special
+character sequences starting with `%' to say how to encode the
+parameters. These sequences control the actions of `tparam' and
+`tgoto'.
+
+ The parameters values passed to `tparam' or `tgoto' are considered
+to form a vector. A pointer into this vector determines the next
+parameter to be processed. Some of the `%'-sequences encode one
+parameter and advance the pointer to the next parameter. Other
+`%'-sequences alter the pointer or alter the parameter values without
+generating output.
+
+ For example, the `cm' string for a standard ANSI terminal is written
+as `\E[%i%d;%dH'. (`\E' stands for ESC.) `cm' by convention always
+requires two parameters, the vertical and horizontal goal positions, so
+this string specifies the encoding of two parameters. Here `%i'
+increments the two values supplied, and each `%d' encodes one of the
+values in decimal. If the cursor position values 20,58 are encoded
+with this string, the result is `\E[21;59H'.
+
+ First, here are the `%'-sequences that generate output. Except for
+`%%', each of them encodes one parameter and advances the pointer to
+the following parameter.
+
+`%%'
+ Output a single `%'. This is the only way to represent a literal
+ `%' in a terminal command with parameters. `%%' does not use up a
+ parameter.
+
+`%d'
+ As in `printf', output the next parameter in decimal.
+
+`%2'
+ Like `%02d' in `printf': output the next parameter in decimal, and
+ always use at least two digits.
+
+`%3'
+ Like `%03d' in `printf': output the next parameter in decimal, and
+ always use at least three digits. Note that `%4' and so on are
+ *not* defined.
+
+`%.'
+ Output the next parameter as a single character whose ASCII code is
+ the parameter value. Like `%c' in `printf'.
+
+`%+CHAR'
+ Add the next parameter to the character CHAR, and output the
+ resulting character. For example, `%+ ' represents 0 as a space,
+ 1 as `!', etc.
+
+ The following `%'-sequences specify alteration of the parameters
+(their values, or their order) rather than encoding a parameter for
+output. They generate no output; they are used only for their side
+effects on the parameters. Also, they do not advance the "next
+parameter" pointer except as explicitly stated. Only `%i', `%r' and
+`%>' are defined in standard Unix termcap. The others are GNU
+extensions.
+
+`%i'
+ Increment the next two parameters. This is used for terminals that
+ expect cursor positions in origin 1. For example, `%i%d,%d' would
+ output two parameters with `1' for 0, `2' for 1, etc.
+
+`%r'
+ Interchange the next two parameters. This is used for terminals
+ whose cursor positioning command expects the horizontal position
+ first.
+
+`%s'
+ Skip the next parameter. Do not output anything.
+
+`%b'
+ Back up one parameter. The last parameter used will become once
+ again the next parameter to be output, and the next output command
+ will use it. Using `%b' more than once, you can back up any
+ number of parameters, and you can refer to each parameter any
+ number of times.
+
+`%>C1C2'
+ Conditionally increment the next parameter. Here C1 and C2 are
+ characters which stand for their ASCII codes as numbers. If the
+ next parameter is greater than the ASCII code of C1, the ASCII
+ code of C2 is added to it.
+
+`%a OP TYPE POS'
+ Perform arithmetic on the next parameter, do not use it up, and do
+ not output anything. Here OP specifies the arithmetic operation,
+ while TYPE and POS together specify the other operand.
+
+ Spaces are used above to separate the operands for clarity; the
+ spaces don't appear in the data base, where this sequence is
+ exactly five characters long.
+
+ The character OP says what kind of arithmetic operation to
+ perform. It can be any of these characters:
+
+ `='
+ assign a value to the next parameter, ignoring its old value.
+ The new value comes from the other operand.
+
+ `+'
+ add the other operand to the next parameter.
+
+ `-'
+ subtract the other operand from the next parameter.
+
+ `*'
+ multiply the next parameter by the other operand.
+
+ `/'
+ divide the next parameter by the other operand.
+
+ The "other operand" may be another parameter's value or a constant;
+ the character TYPE says which. It can be:
+
+ `p'
+ Use another parameter. The character POS says which
+ parameter to use. Subtract 64 from its ASCII code to get the
+ position of the desired parameter relative to this one. Thus,
+ the character `A' as POS means the parameter after the next
+ one; the character `?' means the parameter before the next
+ one.
+
+ `c'
+ Use a constant value. The character POS specifies the value
+ of the constant. The 0200 bit is cleared out, so that 0200
+ can be used to represent zero.
+
+ The following `%'-sequences are special purpose hacks to compensate
+for the weird designs of obscure terminals. They modify the next
+parameter or the next two parameters but do not generate output and do
+not use up any parameters. `%m' is a GNU extension; the others are
+defined in standard Unix termcap.
+
+`%n'
+ Exclusive-or the next parameter with 0140, and likewise the
+ parameter after next.
+
+`%m'
+ Complement all the bits of the next parameter and the parameter
+ after next.
+
+`%B'
+ Encode the next parameter in BCD. It alters the value of the
+ parameter by adding six times the quotient of the parameter by ten.
+ Here is a C statement that shows how the new value is computed:
+
+ PARM = (PARM / 10) * 16 + PARM % 10;
+
+`%D'
+ Transform the next parameter as needed by Delta Data terminals.
+ This involves subtracting twice the remainder of the parameter by
+ 16.
+
+ PARM -= 2 * (PARM % 16);
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Using Parameters, Prev: Encode Parameters, Up: Parameters
+
+Sending Display Commands with Parameters
+----------------------------------------
+
+ The termcap library functions `tparam' and `tgoto' serve as the
+analog of `printf' for terminal string parameters. The newer function
+`tparam' is a GNU extension, more general but missing from Unix
+termcap. The original parameter-encoding function is `tgoto', which is
+preferable for cursor motion.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* tparam:: The general case, for GNU termcap only.
+* tgoto:: The special case of cursor motion.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: tparam, Next: tgoto, Up: Using Parameters
+
+`tparam'
+........
+
+ The function `tparam' can encode display commands with any number of
+parameters and allows you to specify the buffer space. It is the
+preferred function for encoding parameters for all but the `cm'
+capability. Its ANSI C declaration is as follows:
+
+ char *tparam (char *CTLSTRING, char *BUFFER, int SIZE, int PARM1,...)
+
+ The arguments are a control string CTLSTRING (the value of a terminal
+capability, presumably), an output buffer BUFFER and SIZE, and any
+number of integer parameters to be encoded. The effect of `tparam' is
+to copy the control string into the buffer, encoding parameters
+according to the `%' sequences in the control string.
+
+ You describe the output buffer by its address, BUFFER, and its size
+in bytes, SIZE. If the buffer is not big enough for the data to be
+stored in it, `tparam' calls `malloc' to get a larger buffer. In
+either case, `tparam' returns the address of the buffer it ultimately
+uses. If the value equals BUFFER, your original buffer was used.
+Otherwise, a new buffer was allocated, and you must free it after you
+are done with printing the results. If you pass zero for SIZE and
+BUFFER, `tparam' always allocates the space with `malloc'.
+
+ All capabilities that require parameters also have the ability to
+specify padding, so you should use `tputs' to output the string
+produced by `tparam'. *Note Padding::. Here is an example.
+
+ {
+ char *buf;
+ char buffer[40];
+
+ buf = tparam (command, buffer, 40, parm);
+ tputs (buf, 1, fputchar);
+ if (buf != buffer)
+ free (buf);
+ }
+
+ If a parameter whose value is zero is encoded with `%.'-style
+encoding, the result is a null character, which will confuse `tputs'.
+This would be a serious problem, but luckily `%.' encoding is used only
+by a few old models of terminal, and only for the `cm' capability. To
+solve the problem, use `tgoto' rather than `tparam' to encode the `cm'
+capability.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: tgoto, Prev: tparam, Up: Using Parameters
+
+`tgoto'
+.......
+
+ The special case of cursor motion is handled by `tgoto'. There are
+two reasons why you might choose to use `tgoto':
+
+ * For Unix compatibility, because Unix termcap does not have
+ `tparam'.
+
+ * For the `cm' capability, since `tgoto' has a special feature to
+ avoid problems with null characters, tabs and newlines on certain
+ old terminal types that use `%.' encoding for that capability.
+
+ Here is how `tgoto' might be declared in ANSI C:
+
+ char *tgoto (char *CSTRING, int HPOS, int VPOS)
+
+ There are three arguments, the terminal description's `cm' string and
+the two cursor position numbers; `tgoto' computes the parametrized
+string in an internal static buffer and returns the address of that
+buffer. The next time you use `tgoto' the same buffer will be reused.
+
+ Parameters encoded with `%.' encoding can generate null characters,
+tabs or newlines. These might cause trouble: the null character because
+`tputs' would think that was the end of the string, the tab because the
+kernel or other software might expand it into spaces, and the newline
+becaue the kernel might add a carriage-return, or padding characters
+normally used for a newline. To prevent such problems, `tgoto' is
+careful to avoid these characters. Here is how this works: if the
+target cursor position value is such as to cause a problem (that is to
+say, zero, nine or ten), `tgoto' increments it by one, then compensates
+by appending a string to move the cursor back or up one position.
+
+ The compensation strings to use for moving back or up are found in
+global variables named `BC' and `UP'. These are actual external C
+variables with upper case names; they are declared `char *'. It is up
+to you to store suitable values in them, normally obtained from the
+`le' and `up' terminal capabilities in the terminal description with
+`tgetstr'. Alternatively, if these two variables are both zero, the
+feature of avoiding nulls, tabs and newlines is turned off.
+
+ It is safe to use `tgoto' for commands other than `cm' only if you
+have stored zero in `BC' and `UP'.
+
+ Note that `tgoto' reverses the order of its operands: the horizontal
+position comes before the vertical position in the arguments to
+`tgoto', even though the vertical position comes before the horizontal
+in the parameters of the `cm' string. If you use `tgoto' with a
+command such as `AL' that takes one parameter, you must pass the
+parameter to `tgoto' as the "vertical position".
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Data Base, Next: Capabilities, Prev: Library, Up: Top
+
+The Format of the Data Base
+***************************
+
+ The termcap data base of terminal descriptions is stored in the file
+`/etc/termcap'. It contains terminal descriptions, blank lines, and
+comments.
+
+ A terminal description starts with one or more names for the
+terminal type. The information in the description is a series of
+"capability names" and values. The capability names have standard
+meanings (*note Capabilities::.) and their values describe the terminal.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Format:: Overall format of a terminal description.
+* Capability Format:: Format of capabilities within a description.
+* Naming:: Naming conventions for terminal types.
+* Inheriting:: Inheriting part of a description from
+a related terminal type.
+* Changing:: When changes in the data base take effect.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Format, Next: Capability Format, Up: Data Base
+
+Terminal Description Format
+===========================
+
+ Aside from comments (lines starting with `#', which are ignored),
+each nonblank line in the termcap data base is a terminal description.
+A terminal description is nominally a single line, but it can be split
+into multiple lines by inserting the two characters `\ newline'. This
+sequence is ignored wherever it appears in a description.
+
+ The preferred way to split the description is between capabilities:
+insert the four characters `: \ newline tab' immediately before any
+colon. This allows each sub-line to start with some indentation. This
+works because, after the `\ newline' are ignored, the result is `: tab
+:'; the first colon ends the preceding capability and the second colon
+starts the next capability. If you split with `\ newline' alone, you
+may not add any indentation after them.
+
+ Here is a real example of a terminal description:
+
+ dw|vt52|DEC vt52:\
+ :cr=^M:do=^J:nl=^J:bl=^G:\
+ :le=^H:bs:cd=\EJ:ce=\EK:cl=\EH\EJ:\
+ :cm=\EY%+ %+ :co#80:li#24:\
+ :nd=\EC:ta=^I:pt:sr=\EI:up=\EA:\
+ :ku=\EA:kd=\EB:kr=\EC:kl=\ED:kb=^H:
+
+ Each terminal description begins with several names for the terminal
+type. The names are separated by `|' characters, and a colon ends the
+last name. The first name should be two characters long; it exists
+only for the sake of very old Unix systems and is never used in modern
+systems. The last name should be a fully verbose name such as "DEC
+vt52" or "Ann Arbor Ambassador with 48 lines". The other names should
+include whatever the user ought to be able to specify to get this
+terminal type, such as `vt52' or `aaa-48'. *Note Naming::, for
+information on how to choose terminal type names.
+
+ After the terminal type names come the terminal capabilities,
+separated by colons and with a colon after the last one. Each
+capability has a two-letter name, such as `cm' for "cursor motion
+string" or `li' for "number of display lines".
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Capability Format, Next: Naming, Prev: Format, Up: Data Base
+
+Writing the Capabilities
+========================
+
+ There are three kinds of capabilities: flags, numbers, and strings.
+Each kind has its own way of being written in the description. Each
+defined capability has by convention a particular kind of value; for
+example, `li' always has a numeric value and `cm' always a string value.
+
+ A flag capability is thought of as having a boolean value: the value
+is true if the capability is present, false if not. When the
+capability is present, just write its name between two colons.
+
+ A numeric capability has a value which is a nonnegative number.
+Write the capability name, a `#', and the number, between two colons.
+For example, `...:li#48:...' is how you specify the `li' capability for
+48 lines.
+
+ A string-valued capability has a value which is a sequence of
+characters. Usually these are the characters used to perform some
+display operation. Write the capability name, a `=', and the
+characters of the value, between two colons. For example,
+`...:cm=\E[%i%d;%dH:...' is how the cursor motion command for a
+standard ANSI terminal would be specified.
+
+ Special characters in the string value can be expressed using
+`\'-escape sequences as in C; in addition, `\E' stands for ESC. `^' is
+also a kind of escape character; `^' followed by CHAR stands for the
+control-equivalent of CHAR. Thus, `^a' stands for the character
+control-a, just like `\001'. `\' and `^' themselves can be represented
+as `\\' and `\^'.
+
+ To include a colon in the string, you must write `\072'. You might
+ask, "Why can't `\:' be used to represent a colon?" The reason is that
+the interrogation functions do not count slashes while looking for a
+capability. Even if `:ce=ab\:cd:' were interpreted as giving the `ce'
+capability the value `ab:cd', it would also appear to define `cd' as a
+flag.
+
+ The string value will often contain digits at the front to specify
+padding (*note Padding::.) and/or `%'-sequences within to specify how
+to encode parameters (*note Parameters::.). Although these things are
+not to be output literally to the terminal, they are considered part of
+the value of the capability. They are special only when the string
+value is processed by `tputs', `tparam' or `tgoto'. By contrast, `\'
+and `^' are considered part of the syntax for specifying the characters
+in the string.
+
+ Let's look at the VT52 example again:
+
+ dw|vt52|DEC vt52:\
+ :cr=^M:do=^J:nl=^J:bl=^G:\
+ :le=^H:bs:cd=\EJ:ce=\EK:cl=\EH\EJ:\
+ :cm=\EY%+ %+ :co#80:li#24:\
+ :nd=\EC:ta=^I:pt:sr=\EI:up=\EA:\
+ :ku=\EA:kd=\EB:kr=\EC:kl=\ED:kb=^H:
+
+ Here we see the numeric-valued capabilities `co' and `li', the flags
+`bs' and `pt', and many string-valued capabilities. Most of the
+strings start with ESC represented as `\E'. The rest contain control
+characters represented using `^'. The meanings of the individual
+capabilities are defined elsewhere (*note Capabilities::.).
+
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/termcap.info-2 b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/termcap.info-2
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6098d62
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/termcap.info-2
@@ -0,0 +1,974 @@
+This is Info file ./termcap.info, produced by Makeinfo-1.55 from the
+input file ./termcap.texi.
+
+ This file documents the termcap library of the GNU system.
+
+ Copyright (C) 1988 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of this
+manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice are
+preserved on all copies.
+
+ Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of
+this manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided that
+the entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
+permission notice identical to this one.
+
+ Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this
+manual into another language, under the above conditions for modified
+versions, except that this permission notice may be stated in a
+translation approved by the Foundation.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Naming, Next: Inheriting, Prev: Capability Format, Up: Data Base
+
+Terminal Type Name Conventions
+==============================
+
+ There are conventions for choosing names of terminal types. For one
+thing, all letters should be in lower case. The terminal type for a
+terminal in its most usual or most fundamental mode of operation should
+not have a hyphen in it.
+
+ If the same terminal has other modes of operation which require
+different terminal descriptions, these variant descriptions are given
+names made by adding suffixes with hyphens. Such alternate descriptions
+are used for two reasons:
+
+ * When the terminal has a switch that changes its behavior. Since
+ the computer cannot tell how the switch is set, the user must tell
+ the computer by choosing the appropriate terminal type name.
+
+ For example, the VT-100 has a setup flag that controls whether the
+ cursor wraps at the right margin. If this flag is set to "wrap",
+ you must use the terminal type `vt100-am'. Otherwise you must use
+ `vt100-nam'. Plain `vt100' is defined as a synonym for either
+ `vt100-am' or `vt100-nam' depending on the preferences of the
+ local site.
+
+ The standard suffix `-am' stands for "automatic margins".
+
+ * To give the user a choice in how to use the terminal. This is done
+ when the terminal has a switch that the computer normally controls.
+
+ For example, the Ann Arbor Ambassador can be configured with many
+ screen sizes ranging from 20 to 60 lines. Fewer lines make bigger
+ characters but more lines let you see more of what you are editing.
+ As a result, users have different preferences. Therefore, termcap
+ provides terminal types for many screen sizes. If you choose type
+ `aaa-30', the terminal will be configured to use 30 lines; if you
+ choose `aaa-48', 48 lines will be used, and so on.
+
+ Here is a list of standard suffixes and their conventional meanings:
+
+`-w'
+ Short for "wide". This is a mode that gives the terminal more
+ columns than usual. This is normally a user option.
+
+`-am'
+ "Automatic margins". This is an alternate description for use when
+ the terminal's margin-wrap switch is on; it contains the `am'
+ flag. The implication is that normally the switch is off and the
+ usual description for the terminal says that the switch is off.
+
+`-nam'
+ "No automatic margins". The opposite of `-am', this names an
+ alternative description which lacks the `am' flag. This implies
+ that the terminal is normally operated with the margin-wrap switch
+ turned on, and the normal description of the terminal says so.
+
+`-na'
+ "No arrows". This terminal description initializes the terminal to
+ keep its arrow keys in local mode. This is a user option.
+
+`-rv'
+ "Reverse video". This terminal description causes text output for
+ normal video to appear as reverse, and text output for reverse
+ video to come out as normal. Often this description differs from
+ the usual one by interchanging the two strings which turn reverse
+ video on and off.
+
+ This is a user option; you can choose either the "reverse video"
+ variant terminal type or the normal terminal type, and termcap will
+ obey.
+
+`-s'
+ "Status". Says to enable use of a status line which ordinary
+ output does not touch (*note Status Line::.).
+
+ Some terminals have a special line that is used only as a status
+ line. For these terminals, there is no need for an `-s' variant;
+ the status line commands should be defined by default. On other
+ terminals, enabling a status line means removing one screen line
+ from ordinary use and reducing the effective screen height. For
+ these terminals, the user can choose the `-s' variant type to
+ request use of a status line.
+
+`-NLINES'
+ Says to operate with NLINES lines on the screen, for terminals
+ such as the Ambassador which provide this as an option. Normally
+ this is a user option; by choosing the terminal type, you control
+ how many lines termcap will use.
+
+`-NPAGESp'
+ Says that the terminal has NPAGES pages worth of screen memory,
+ for terminals where this is a hardware option.
+
+`-unk'
+ Says that description is not for direct use, but only for
+ reference in `tc' capabilities. Such a description is a kind of
+ subroutine, because it describes the common characteristics of
+ several variant descriptions that would use other suffixes in
+ place of `-unk'.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Inheriting, Next: Changing, Prev: Naming, Up: Data Base
+
+Inheriting from Related Descriptions
+====================================
+
+ When two terminal descriptions are similar, their identical parts do
+not need to be given twice. Instead, one of the two can be defined in
+terms of the other, using the `tc' capability. We say that one
+description "refers to" the other, or "inherits from" the other.
+
+ The `tc' capability must be the last one in the terminal description,
+and its value is a string which is the name of another terminal type
+which is referred to. For example,
+
+ N9|aaa|ambassador|aaa-30|ann arbor ambassador/30 lines:\
+ :ti=\E[2J\E[30;0;0;30p:\
+ :te=\E[60;0;0;30p\E[30;1H\E[J:\
+ :li#30:tc=aaa-unk:
+
+defines the terminal type `aaa-30' (also known as plain `aaa') in terms
+of `aaa-unk', which defines everything about the Ambassador that is
+independent of screen height. The types `aaa-36', `aaa-48' and so on
+for other screen heights are likewise defined to inherit from `aaa-unk'.
+
+ The capabilities overridden by `aaa-30' include `li', which says how
+many lines there are, and `ti' and `te', which configure the terminal
+to use that many lines.
+
+ The effective terminal description for type `aaa' consists of the
+text shown above followed by the text of the description of `aaa-unk'.
+The `tc' capability is handled automatically by `tgetent', which finds
+the description thus referenced and combines the two descriptions
+(*note Find::.). Therefore, only the implementor of the terminal
+descriptions needs to think about using `tc'. Users and application
+programmers do not need to be concerned with it.
+
+ Since the reference terminal description is used last, capabilities
+specified in the referring description override any specifications of
+the same capabilities in the reference description.
+
+ The referring description can cancel out a capability without
+specifying any new value for it by means of a special trick. Write the
+capability in the referring description, with the character `@' after
+the capability name, as follows:
+
+ NZ|aaa-30-nam|ann arbor ambassador/30 lines/no automatic-margins:\
+ :am@:tc=aaa-30:
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Changing, Prev: Inheriting, Up: Data Base
+
+When Changes in the Data Base Take Effect
+=========================================
+
+ Each application program must read the terminal description from the
+data base, so a change in the data base is effective for all jobs
+started after the change is made.
+
+ The change will usually have no effect on a job that have been in
+existence since before the change. The program probably read the
+terminal description once, when it was started, and is continuing to
+use what it read then. If the program does not have a feature for
+reexamining the data base, then you will need to run it again (probably
+killing the old job).
+
+ If the description in use is coming from the `TERMCAP' environment
+variable, then the data base file is effectively overridden, and
+changes in it will have no effect until you change the `TERMCAP'
+variable as well. For example, some users' `.login' files
+automatically copy the terminal description into `TERMCAP' to speed
+startup of applications. If you have done this, you will need to
+change the `TERMCAP' variable to make the changed data base take effect.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Capabilities, Next: Summary, Prev: Data Base, Up: Top
+
+Definitions of the Terminal Capabilities
+****************************************
+
+ This section is divided into many subsections, each for one aspect of
+use of display terminals. For writing a display program, you usually
+need only check the subsections for the operations you want to use.
+For writing a terminal description, you must read each subsection and
+fill in the capabilities described there.
+
+ String capabilities that are display commands may require numeric
+parameters (*note Parameters::.). Most such capabilities do not use
+parameters. When a capability requires parameters, this is explicitly
+stated at the beginning of its definition. In simple cases, the first
+or second sentence of the definition mentions all the parameters, in
+the order they should be given, using a name in upper case for each
+one. For example, the `rp' capability is a command that requires two
+parameters; its definition begins as follows:
+
+ String of commands to output a graphic character C, repeated N
+ times.
+
+ In complex cases or when there are many parameters, they are
+described explicitly.
+
+ When a capability is described as obsolete, this means that programs
+should not be written to look for it, but terminal descriptions should
+still be written to provide it.
+
+ When a capability is described as very obsolete, this means that it
+should be omitted from terminal descriptions as well.
+
+* Menu:
+
+* Basic:: Basic characteristics.
+* Screen Size:: Screen size, and what happens when it changes.
+* Cursor Motion:: Various ways to move the cursor.
+* Wrapping:: What happens if you write a character in the last column.
+* Scrolling:: Pushing text up and down on the screen.
+* Windows:: Limiting the part of the window that output affects.
+* Clearing:: Erasing one or many lines.
+* Insdel Line:: Making new blank lines in mid-screen; deleting lines.
+* Insdel Char:: Inserting and deleting characters within a line.
+* Standout:: Highlighting some of the text.
+* Underlining:: Underlining some of the text.
+* Cursor Visibility:: Making the cursor more or less easy to spot.
+* Bell:: Attracts user's attention; not localized on the screen.
+* Keypad:: Recognizing when function keys or arrows are typed.
+* Meta Key:: META acts like an extra shift key.
+* Initialization:: Commands used to initialize or reset the terminal.
+* Pad Specs:: Info for the kernel on how much padding is needed.
+* Status Line:: A status line displays "background" information.
+* Half-Line:: Moving by half-lines, for superscripts and subscripts.
+* Printer:: Controlling auxiliary printers of display terminals.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Basic, Next: Screen Size, Up: Capabilities
+
+Basic Characteristics
+=====================
+
+ This section documents the capabilities that describe the basic and
+nature of the terminal, and also those that are relevant to the output
+of graphic characters.
+
+`os'
+ Flag whose presence means that the terminal can overstrike. This
+ means that outputting a graphic character does not erase whatever
+ was present in the same character position before. The terminals
+ that can overstrike include printing terminals, storage tubes (all
+ obsolete nowadays), and many bit-map displays.
+
+`eo'
+ Flag whose presence means that outputting a space erases a
+ character position even if the terminal supports overstriking. If
+ this flag is not present and overstriking is supported, output of
+ a space has no effect except to move the cursor.
+
+ (On terminals that do not support overstriking, you can always
+ assume that outputting a space at a position erases whatever
+ character was previously displayed there.)
+
+`gn'
+ Flag whose presence means that this terminal type is a generic type
+ which does not really describe any particular terminal. Generic
+ types are intended for use as the default type assigned when the
+ user connects to the system, with the intention that the user
+ should specify what type he really has. One example of a generic
+ type is the type `network'.
+
+ Since the generic type cannot say how to do anything interesting
+ with the terminal, termcap-using programs will always find that the
+ terminal is too weak to be supported if the user has failed to
+ specify a real terminal type in place of the generic one. The
+ `gn' flag directs these programs to use a different error message:
+ "You have not specified your real terminal type", rather than
+ "Your terminal is not powerful enough to be used".
+
+`hc'
+ Flag whose presence means this is a hardcopy terminal.
+
+`rp'
+ String of commands to output a graphic character C, repeated N
+ times. The first parameter value is the ASCII code for the desired
+ character, and the second parameter is the number of times to
+ repeat the character. Often this command requires padding
+ proportional to the number of times the character is repeated.
+ This effect can be had by using parameter arithmetic with
+ `%'-sequences to compute the amount of padding, then generating
+ the result as a number at the front of the string so that `tputs'
+ will treat it as padding.
+
+`hz'
+ Flag whose presence means that the ASCII character `~' cannot be
+ output on this terminal because it is used for display commands.
+
+ Programs handle this flag by checking all text to be output and
+ replacing each `~' with some other character(s). If this is not
+ done, the screen will be thoroughly garbled.
+
+ The old Hazeltine terminals that required such treatment are
+ probably very rare today, so you might as well not bother to
+ support this flag.
+
+`CC'
+ String whose presence means the terminal has a settable command
+ character. The value of the string is the default command
+ character (which is usually ESC).
+
+ All the strings of commands in the terminal description should be
+ written to use the default command character. If you are writing
+ an application program that changes the command character, use the
+ `CC' capability to figure out how to translate all the display
+ commands to work with the new command character.
+
+ Most programs have no reason to look at the `CC' capability.
+
+`xb'
+ Flag whose presence identifies Superbee terminals which are unable
+ to transmit the characters ESC and `Control-C'. Programs which
+ support this flag are supposed to check the input for the code
+ sequences sent by the F1 and F2 keys, and pretend that ESC or
+ `Control-C' (respectively) had been read. But this flag is
+ obsolete, and not worth supporting.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Screen Size, Next: Cursor Motion, Prev: Basic, Up: Capabilities
+
+Screen Size
+===========
+
+ A terminal description has two capabilities, `co' and `li', that
+describe the screen size in columns and lines. But there is more to
+the question of screen size than this.
+
+ On some operating systems the "screen" is really a window and the
+effective width can vary. On some of these systems, `tgetnum' uses the
+actual width of the window to decide what value to return for the `co'
+capability, overriding what is actually written in the terminal
+description. On other systems, it is up to the application program to
+check the actual window width using a system call. For example, on BSD
+4.3 systems, the system call `ioctl' with code `TIOCGWINSZ' will tell
+you the current screen size.
+
+ On all window systems, termcap is powerless to advise the application
+program if the user resizes the window. Application programs must deal
+with this possibility in a system-dependent fashion. On some systems
+the C shell handles part of the problem by detecting changes in window
+size and setting the `TERMCAP' environment variable appropriately.
+This takes care of application programs that are started subsequently.
+It does not help application programs already running.
+
+ On some systems, including BSD 4.3, all programs using a terminal get
+a signal named `SIGWINCH' whenever the screen size changes. Programs
+that use termcap should handle this signal by using `ioctl TIOCGWINSZ'
+to learn the new screen size.
+
+`co'
+ Numeric value, the width of the screen in character positions.
+ Even hardcopy terminals normally have a `co' capability.
+
+`li'
+ Numeric value, the height of the screen in lines.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Cursor Motion, Next: Wrapping, Prev: Screen Size, Up: Capabilities
+
+Cursor Motion
+=============
+
+ Termcap assumes that the terminal has a "cursor", a spot on the
+screen where a visible mark is displayed, and that most display
+commands take effect at the position of the cursor. It follows that
+moving the cursor to a specified location is very important.
+
+ There are many terminal capabilities for different cursor motion
+operations. A terminal description should define as many as possible,
+but most programs do not need to use most of them. One capability,
+`cm', moves the cursor to an arbitrary place on the screen; this by
+itself is sufficient for any application as long as there is no need to
+support hardcopy terminals or certain old, weak displays that have only
+relative motion commands. Use of other cursor motion capabilities is an
+optimization, enabling the program to output fewer characters in some
+common cases.
+
+ If you plan to use the relative cursor motion commands in an
+application program, you must know what the starting cursor position
+is. To do this, you must keep track of the cursor position and update
+the records each time anything is output to the terminal, including
+graphic characters. In addition, it is necessary to know whether the
+terminal wraps after writing in the rightmost column. *Note Wrapping::.
+
+ One other motion capability needs special mention: `nw' moves the
+cursor to the beginning of the following line, perhaps clearing all the
+starting line after the cursor, or perhaps not clearing at all. This
+capability is a least common denominator that is probably supported
+even by terminals that cannot do most other things such as `cm' or `do'.
+Even hardcopy terminals can support `nw'.
+
+`cm'
+ String of commands to position the cursor at line L, column C.
+ Both parameters are origin-zero, and are defined relative to the
+ screen, not relative to display memory.
+
+ All display terminals except a few very obsolete ones support `cm',
+ so it is acceptable for an application program to refuse to
+ operate on terminals lacking `cm'.
+
+`ho'
+ String of commands to move the cursor to the upper left corner of
+ the screen (this position is called the "home position"). In
+ terminals where the upper left corner of the screen is not the
+ same as the beginning of display memory, this command must go to
+ the upper left corner of the screen, not the beginning of display
+ memory.
+
+ Every display terminal supports this capability, and many
+ application programs refuse to operate if the `ho' capability is
+ missing.
+
+`ll'
+ String of commands to move the cursor to the lower left corner of
+ the screen. On some terminals, moving up from home position does
+ this, but programs should never assume that will work. Just
+ output the `ll' string (if it is provided); if moving to home
+ position and then moving up is the best way to get there, the `ll'
+ command will do that.
+
+`cr'
+ String of commands to move the cursor to the beginning of the line
+ it is on. If this capability is not specified, many programs
+ assume they can use the ASCII carriage return character for this.
+
+`le'
+ String of commands to move the cursor left one column. Unless the
+ `bw' flag capability is specified, the effect is undefined if the
+ cursor is at the left margin; do not use this command there. If
+ `bw' is present, this command may be used at the left margin, and
+ it wraps the cursor to the last column of the preceding line.
+
+`nd'
+ String of commands to move the cursor right one column. The
+ effect is undefined if the cursor is at the right margin; do not
+ use this command there, not even if `am' is present.
+
+`up'
+ String of commands to move the cursor vertically up one line. The
+ effect of sending this string when on the top line is undefined;
+ programs should never use it that way.
+
+`do'
+ String of commands to move the cursor vertically down one line.
+ The effect of sending this string when on the bottom line is
+ undefined; programs should never use it that way.
+
+ Some programs do use `do' to scroll up one line if used at the
+ bottom line, if `sf' is not defined but `sr' is. This is only to
+ compensate for certain old, incorrect terminal descriptions. (In
+ principle this might actually lead to incorrect behavior on other
+ terminals, but that seems to happen rarely if ever.) But the
+ proper solution is that the terminal description should define
+ `sf' as well as `do' if the command is suitable for scrolling.
+
+ The original idea was that this string would not contain a newline
+ character and therefore could be used without disabling the
+ kernel's usual habit of converting of newline into a
+ carriage-return newline sequence. But many terminal descriptions
+ do use newline in the `do' string, so this is not possible; a
+ program which sends the `do' string must disable output conversion
+ in the kernel (*note Initialize::.).
+
+`bw'
+ Flag whose presence says that `le' may be used in column zero to
+ move to the last column of the preceding line. If this flag is
+ not present, `le' should not be used in column zero.
+
+`nw'
+ String of commands to move the cursor to start of next line,
+ possibly clearing rest of line (following the cursor) before
+ moving.
+
+`DO', `UP', `LE', `RI'
+ Strings of commands to move the cursor N lines down vertically, up
+ vertically, or N columns left or right. Do not attempt to move
+ past any edge of the screen with these commands; the effect of
+ trying that is undefined. Only a few terminal descriptions provide
+ these commands, and most programs do not use them.
+
+`CM'
+ String of commands to position the cursor at line L, column C,
+ relative to display memory. Both parameters are origin-zero.
+ This capability is present only in terminals where there is a
+ difference between screen-relative and memory-relative addressing,
+ and not even in all such terminals.
+
+`ch'
+ String of commands to position the cursor at column C in the same
+ line it is on. This is a special case of `cm' in which the
+ vertical position is not changed. The `ch' capability is provided
+ only when it is faster to output than `cm' would be in this
+ special case. Programs should not assume most display terminals
+ have `ch'.
+
+`cv'
+ String of commands to position the cursor at line L in the same
+ column. This is a special case of `cm' in which the horizontal
+ position is not changed. The `cv' capability is provided only
+ when it is faster to output than `cm' would be in this special
+ case. Programs should not assume most display terminals have `cv'.
+
+`sc'
+ String of commands to make the terminal save the current cursor
+ position. Only the last saved position can be used. If this
+ capability is present, `rc' should be provided also. Most
+ terminals have neither.
+
+`rc'
+ String of commands to make the terminal restore the last saved
+ cursor position. If this capability is present, `sc' should be
+ provided also. Most terminals have neither.
+
+`ff'
+ String of commands to advance to the next page, for a hardcopy
+ terminal.
+
+`ta'
+ String of commands to move the cursor right to the next hardware
+ tab stop column. Missing if the terminal does not have any kind of
+ hardware tabs. Do not send this command if the kernel's terminal
+ modes say that the kernel is expanding tabs into spaces.
+
+`bt'
+ String of commands to move the cursor left to the previous hardware
+ tab stop column. Missing if the terminal has no such ability; many
+ terminals do not. Do not send this command if the kernel's
+ terminal modes say that the kernel is expanding tabs into spaces.
+
+ The following obsolete capabilities should be included in terminal
+descriptions when appropriate, but should not be looked at by new
+programs.
+
+`nc'
+ Flag whose presence means the terminal does not support the ASCII
+ carriage return character as `cr'. This flag is needed because
+ old programs assume, when the `cr' capability is missing, that
+ ASCII carriage return can be used for the purpose. We use `nc' to
+ tell the old programs that carriage return may not be used.
+
+ New programs should not assume any default for `cr', so they need
+ not look at `nc'. However, descriptions should contain `nc'
+ whenever they do not contain `cr'.
+
+`xt'
+ Flag whose presence means that the ASCII tab character may not be
+ used for cursor motion. This flag exists because old programs
+ assume, when the `ta' capability is missing, that ASCII tab can be
+ used for the purpose. We use `xt' to tell the old programs not to
+ use tab.
+
+ New programs should not assume any default for `ta', so they need
+ not look at `xt' in connection with cursor motion. Note that `xt'
+ also has implications for standout mode (*note Standout::.). It
+ is obsolete in regard to cursor motion but not in regard to
+ standout.
+
+ In fact, `xt' means that the terminal is a Teleray 1061.
+
+`bc'
+ Very obsolete alternative name for the `le' capability.
+
+`bs'
+ Flag whose presence means that the ASCII character backspace may be
+ used to move the cursor left. Obsolete; look at `le' instead.
+
+`nl'
+ Obsolete capability which is a string that can either be used to
+ move the cursor down or to scroll. The same string must scroll
+ when used on the bottom line and move the cursor when used on any
+ other line. New programs should use `do' or `sf', and ignore `nl'.
+
+ If there is no `nl' capability, some old programs assume they can
+ use the newline character for this purpose. These programs follow
+ a bad practice, but because they exist, it is still desirable to
+ define the `nl' capability in a terminal description if the best
+ way to move down is *not* a newline.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Wrapping, Next: Scrolling, Prev: Cursor Motion, Up: Capabilities
+
+Wrapping
+========
+
+ "Wrapping" means moving the cursor from the right margin to the left
+margin of the following line. Some terminals wrap automatically when a
+graphic character is output in the last column, while others do not.
+Most application programs that use termcap need to know whether the
+terminal wraps. There are two special flag capabilities to describe
+what the terminal does when a graphic character is output in the last
+column.
+
+`am'
+ Flag whose presence means that writing a character in the last
+ column causes the cursor to wrap to the beginning of the next line.
+
+ If `am' is not present, writing in the last column leaves the
+ cursor at the place where the character was written.
+
+ Writing in the last column of the last line should be avoided on
+ terminals with `am', as it may or may not cause scrolling to occur
+ (*note Scrolling::.). Scrolling is surely not what you would
+ intend.
+
+ If your program needs to check the `am' flag, then it also needs
+ to check the `xn' flag which indicates that wrapping happens in a
+ strange way. Many common terminals have the `xn' flag.
+
+`xn'
+ Flag whose presence means that the cursor wraps in a strange way.
+ At least two distinct kinds of strange behavior are known; the
+ termcap data base does not contain anything to distinguish the two.
+
+ On Concept-100 terminals, output in the last column wraps the
+ cursor almost like an ordinary `am' terminal. But if the next
+ thing output is a newline, it is ignored.
+
+ DEC VT-100 terminals (when the wrap switch is on) do a different
+ strange thing: the cursor wraps only if the next thing output is
+ another graphic character. In fact, the wrap occurs when the
+ following graphic character is received by the terminal, before the
+ character is placed on the screen.
+
+ On both of these terminals, after writing in the last column a
+ following graphic character will be displayed in the first column
+ of the following line. But the effect of relative cursor motion
+ characters such as newline or backspace at such a time depends on
+ the terminal. The effect of erase or scrolling commands also
+ depends on the terminal. You can't assume anything about what
+ they will do on a terminal that has `xn'. So, to be safe, you
+ should never do these things at such a time on such a terminal.
+
+ To be sure of reliable results on a terminal which has the `xn'
+ flag, output a `cm' absolute positioning command after writing in
+ the last column. Another safe thing to do is to output
+ carriage-return newline, which will leave the cursor at the
+ beginning of the following line.
+
+`LP'
+ Flag whose presence means that it is safe to write in the last
+ column of the last line without worrying about undesired
+ scrolling. `LP' indicates the DEC flavor of `xn' strangeness.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Scrolling, Next: Windows, Prev: Wrapping, Up: Capabilities
+
+Scrolling
+=========
+
+ "Scrolling" means moving the contents of the screen up or down one or
+more lines. Moving the contents up is "forward scrolling"; moving them
+down is "reverse scrolling".
+
+ Scrolling happens after each line of output during ordinary output
+on most display terminals. But in an application program that uses
+termcap for random-access output, scrolling happens only when
+explicitly requested with the commands in this section.
+
+ Some terminals have a "scroll region" feature. This lets you limit
+the effect of scrolling to a specified range of lines. Lines outside
+the range are unaffected when scrolling happens. The scroll region
+feature is available if either `cs' or `cS' is present.
+
+`sf'
+ String of commands to scroll the screen one line up, assuming it is
+ output with the cursor at the beginning of the bottom line.
+
+`sr'
+ String of commands to scroll the screen one line down, assuming it
+ is output with the cursor at the beginning of the top line.
+
+`do'
+ A few programs will try to use `do' to do the work of `sf'. This
+ is not really correct--it is an attempt to compensate for the
+ absence of a `sf' command in some old terminal descriptions.
+
+ Since these terminal descriptions do define `sr', perhaps at one
+ time the definition of `do' was different and it could be used for
+ scrolling as well. But it isn't desirable to combine these two
+ functions in one capability, since scrolling often requires more
+ padding than simply moving the cursor down. Defining `sf' and
+ `do' separately allows you to specify the padding properly. Also,
+ all sources agree that `do' should not be relied on to do
+ scrolling.
+
+ So the best approach is to add `sf' capabilities to the
+ descriptions of these terminals, copying the definition of `do' if
+ that does scroll.
+
+`SF'
+ String of commands to scroll the screen N lines up, assuming it is
+ output with the cursor at the beginning of the bottom line.
+
+`SR'
+ String of commands to scroll the screen N lines down, assuming it
+ is output with the cursor at the beginning of the top line.
+
+`cs'
+ String of commands to set the scroll region. This command takes
+ two parameters, START and END, which are the line numbers
+ (origin-zero) of the first line to include in the scroll region
+ and of the last line to include in it. When a scroll region is
+ set, scrolling is limited to the specified range of lines; lines
+ outside the range are not affected by scroll commands.
+
+ Do not try to move the cursor outside the scroll region. The
+ region remains set until explicitly removed. To remove the scroll
+ region, use another `cs' command specifying the full height of the
+ screen.
+
+ The cursor position is undefined after the `cs' command is set, so
+ position the cursor with `cm' immediately afterward.
+
+`cS'
+ String of commands to set the scroll region using parameters in
+ different form. The effect is the same as if `cs' were used.
+ Four parameters are required:
+
+ 1. Total number of lines on the screen.
+
+ 2. Number of lines above desired scroll region.
+
+ 3. Number of lines below (outside of) desired scroll region.
+
+ 4. Total number of lines on the screen, the same as the first
+ parameter.
+
+ This capability is a GNU extension that was invented to allow the
+ Ann Arbor Ambassador's scroll-region command to be described; it
+ could also be done by putting non-Unix `%'-sequences into a `cs'
+ string, but that would have confused Unix programs that used the
+ `cs' capability with the Unix termcap. Currently only GNU Emacs
+ uses the `cS' capability.
+
+`ns'
+ Flag which means that the terminal does not normally scroll for
+ ordinary sequential output. For modern terminals, this means that
+ outputting a newline in ordinary sequential output with the cursor
+ on the bottom line wraps to the top line. For some obsolete
+ terminals, other things may happen.
+
+ The terminal may be able to scroll even if it does not normally do
+ so. If the `sf' capability is provided, it can be used for
+ scrolling regardless of `ns'.
+
+`da'
+ Flag whose presence means that lines scrolled up off the top of the
+ screen may come back if scrolling down is done subsequently.
+
+ The `da' and `db' flags do not, strictly speaking, affect how to
+ scroll. But programs that scroll usually need to clear the lines
+ scrolled onto the screen, if these flags are present.
+
+`db'
+ Flag whose presence means that lines scrolled down off the bottom
+ of the screen may come back if scrolling up is done subsequently.
+
+`lm'
+ Numeric value, the number of lines of display memory that the
+ terminal has. A value of zero means that the terminal has more
+ display memory than can fit on the screen, but no fixed number of
+ lines. (The number of lines may depend on the amount of text in
+ each line.)
+
+ Any terminal description that defines `SF' should also define `sf';
+likewise for `SR' and `sr'. However, many terminals can only scroll by
+one line at a time, so it is common to find `sf' and not `SF', or `sr'
+without `SR'.
+
+ Therefore, all programs that use the scrolling facilities should be
+prepared to work with `sf' in the case that `SF' is absent, and
+likewise with `sr'. On the other hand, an application program that
+uses only `sf' and not `SF' is acceptable, though slow on some
+terminals.
+
+ When outputting a scroll command with `tputs', the NLINES argument
+should be the total number of lines in the portion of the screen being
+scrolled. Very often these commands require padding proportional to
+this number of lines. *Note Padding::.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Windows, Next: Clearing, Prev: Scrolling, Up: Capabilities
+
+Windows
+=======
+
+ A "window", in termcap, is a rectangular portion of the screen to
+which all display operations are restricted. Wrapping, clearing,
+scrolling, insertion and deletion all operate as if the specified
+window were all the screen there was.
+
+`wi'
+ String of commands to set the terminal output screen window. This
+ string requires four parameters, all origin-zero:
+ 1. The first line to include in the window.
+
+ 2. The last line to include in the window.
+
+ 3. The first column to include in the window.
+
+ 4. The last column to include in the window.
+
+ Most terminals do not support windows.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Clearing, Next: Insdel Line, Prev: Windows, Up: Capabilities
+
+Clearing Parts of the Screen
+============================
+
+ There are several terminal capabilities for clearing parts of the
+screen to blank. All display terminals support the `cl' string, and
+most display terminals support all of these capabilities.
+
+`cl'
+ String of commands to clear the entire screen and position the
+ cursor at the upper left corner.
+
+`cd'
+ String of commands to clear the line the cursor is on, and all the
+ lines below it, down to the bottom of the screen. This command
+ string should be used only with the cursor in column zero; their
+ effect is undefined if the cursor is elsewhere.
+
+`ce'
+ String of commands to clear from the cursor to the end of the
+ current line.
+
+`ec'
+ String of commands to clear N characters, starting with the
+ character that the cursor is on. This command string is expected
+ to leave the cursor position unchanged. The parameter N should
+ never be large enough to reach past the right margin; the effect
+ of such a large parameter would be undefined.
+
+ Clear to end of line (`ce') is extremely important in programs that
+maintain an updating display. Nearly all display terminals support this
+operation, so it is acceptable for a an application program to refuse to
+work if `ce' is not present. However, if you do not want this
+limitation, you can accomplish clearing to end of line by outputting
+spaces until you reach the right margin. In order to do this, you must
+know the current horizontal position. Also, this technique assumes
+that writing a space will erase. But this happens to be true on all
+the display terminals that fail to support `ce'.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Insdel Line, Next: Insdel Char, Prev: Clearing, Up: Capabilities
+
+Insert/Delete Line
+==================
+
+ "Inserting a line" means creating a blank line in the middle of the
+screen, and pushing the existing lines of text apart. In fact, the
+lines above the insertion point do not change, while the lines below
+move down, and one is normally lost at the bottom of the screen.
+
+ "Deleting a line" means causing the line to disappear from the
+screen, closing up the gap by moving the lines below it upward. A new
+line appears at the bottom of the screen. Usually this line is blank,
+but on terminals with the `db' flag it may be a line previously moved
+off the screen bottom by scrolling or line insertion.
+
+ Insertion and deletion of lines is useful in programs that maintain
+an updating display some parts of which may get longer or shorter.
+They are also useful in editors for scrolling parts of the screen, and
+for redisplaying after lines of text are killed or inserted.
+
+ Many terminals provide commands to insert or delete a single line at
+the cursor position. Some provide the ability to insert or delete
+several lines with one command, using the number of lines to insert or
+delete as a parameter. Always move the cursor to column zero before
+using any of these commands.
+
+`al'
+ String of commands to insert a blank line before the line the
+ cursor is on. The existing line, and all lines below it, are
+ moved down. The last line in the screen (or in the scroll region,
+ if one is set) disappears and in most circumstances is discarded.
+ It may not be discarded if the `db' is present (*note
+ Scrolling::.).
+
+ The cursor must be at the left margin before this command is used.
+ This command does not move the cursor.
+
+`dl'
+ String of commands to delete the line the cursor is on. The
+ following lines move up, and a blank line appears at the bottom of
+ the screen (or bottom of the scroll region). If the terminal has
+ the `db' flag, a nonblank line previously pushed off the screen
+ bottom may reappear at the bottom.
+
+ The cursor must be at the left margin before this command is used.
+ This command does not move the cursor.
+
+`AL'
+ String of commands to insert N blank lines before the line that
+ the cursor is on. It is like `al' repeated N times, except that
+ it is as fast as one `al'.
+
+`DL'
+ String of commands to delete N lines starting with the line that
+ the cursor is on. It is like `dl' repeated N times, except that
+ it is as fast as one `dl'.
+
+ Any terminal description that defines `AL' should also define `al';
+likewise for `DL' and `dl'. However, many terminals can only insert or
+delete one line at a time, so it is common to find `al' and not `AL',
+or `dl' without `DL'.
+
+ Therefore, all programs that use the insert and delete facilities
+should be prepared to work with `al' in the case that `AL' is absent,
+and likewise with `dl'. On the other hand, it is acceptable to write
+an application that uses only `al' and `dl' and does not look for `AL'
+or `DL' at all.
+
+ If a terminal does not support line insertion and deletion directly,
+but does support a scroll region, the effect of insertion and deletion
+can be obtained with scrolling. However, it is up to the individual
+user program to check for this possibility and use the scrolling
+commands to get the desired result. It is fairly important to implement
+this alternate strategy, since it is the only way to get the effect of
+line insertion and deletion on the popular VT100 terminal.
+
+ Insertion and deletion of lines is affected by the scroll region on
+terminals that have a settable scroll region. This is useful when it is
+desirable to move any few consecutive lines up or down by a few lines.
+*Note Scrolling::.
+
+ The line pushed off the bottom of the screen is not lost if the
+terminal has the `db' flag capability; instead, it is pushed into
+display memory that does not appear on the screen. This is the same
+thing that happens when scrolling pushes a line off the bottom of the
+screen. Either reverse scrolling or deletion of a line can bring the
+apparently lost line back onto the bottom of the screen. If the
+terminal has the scroll region feature as well as `db', the pushed-out
+line really is lost if a scroll region is in effect.
+
+ When outputting an insert or delete command with `tputs', the NLINES
+argument should be the total number of lines from the cursor to the
+bottom of the screen (or scroll region). Very often these commands
+require padding proportional to this number of lines. *Note Padding::.
+
+ For `AL' and `DL' the NLINES argument should *not* depend on the
+number of lines inserted or deleted; only the total number of lines
+affected. This is because it is just as fast to insert two or N lines
+with `AL' as to insert one line with `al'.
+
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/termcap.info-3 b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/termcap.info-3
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d5b309f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/termcap.info-3
@@ -0,0 +1,1480 @@
+This is Info file ./termcap.info, produced by Makeinfo-1.55 from the
+input file ./termcap.texi.
+
+ This file documents the termcap library of the GNU system.
+
+ Copyright (C) 1988 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of this
+manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice are
+preserved on all copies.
+
+ Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of
+this manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided that
+the entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
+permission notice identical to this one.
+
+ Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this
+manual into another language, under the above conditions for modified
+versions, except that this permission notice may be stated in a
+translation approved by the Foundation.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Insdel Char, Next: Standout, Prev: Insdel Line, Up: Capabilities
+
+Insert/Delete Character
+=======================
+
+ "Inserting a character" means creating a blank space in the middle
+of a line, and pushing the rest of the line rightward. The character
+in the rightmost column is lost.
+
+ "Deleting a character" means causing the character to disappear from
+the screen, closing up the gap by moving the rest of the line leftward.
+A blank space appears in the rightmost column.
+
+ Insertion and deletion of characters is useful in programs that
+maintain an updating display some parts of which may get longer or
+shorter. It is also useful in editors for redisplaying the results of
+editing within a line.
+
+ Many terminals provide commands to insert or delete a single
+character at the cursor position. Some provide the ability to insert
+or delete several characters with one command, using the number of
+characters to insert or delete as a parameter.
+
+ Many terminals provide an insert mode in which outputting a graphic
+character has the added effect of inserting a position for that
+character. A special command string is used to enter insert mode and
+another is used to exit it. The reason for designing a terminal with
+an insert mode rather than an insert command is that inserting
+character positions is usually followed by writing characters into
+them. With insert mode, this is as fast as simply writing the
+characters, except for the fixed overhead of entering and leaving
+insert mode. However, when the line speed is great enough, padding may
+be required for the graphic characters output in insert mode.
+
+ Some terminals require you to enter insert mode and then output a
+special command for each position to be inserted. Or they may require
+special commands to be output before or after each graphic character to
+be inserted.
+
+ Deletion of characters is usually accomplished by a straightforward
+command to delete one or several positions; but on some terminals, it
+is necessary to enter a special delete mode before using the delete
+command, and leave delete mode afterward. Sometimes delete mode and
+insert mode are the same mode.
+
+ Some terminals make a distinction between character positions in
+which a space character has been output and positions which have been
+cleared. On these terminals, the effect of insert or delete character
+runs to the first cleared position rather than to the end of the line.
+In fact, the effect may run to more than one line if there is no
+cleared position to stop the shift on the first line. These terminals
+are identified by the `in' flag capability.
+
+ On terminals with the `in' flag, the technique of skipping over
+characters that you know were cleared, and then outputting text later
+on in the same line, causes later insert and delete character
+operations on that line to do nonstandard things. A program that has
+any chance of doing this must check for the `in' flag and must be
+careful to write explicit space characters into the intermediate
+columns when `in' is present.
+
+ A plethora of terminal capabilities are needed to describe all of
+this complexity. Here is a list of them all. Following the list, we
+present an algorithm for programs to use to take proper account of all
+of these capabilities.
+
+`im'
+ String of commands to enter insert mode.
+
+ If the terminal has no special insert mode, but it can insert
+ characters with a special command, `im' should be defined with a
+ null value, because the `vi' editor assumes that insertion of a
+ character is impossible if `im' is not provided.
+
+ New programs should not act like `vi'. They should pay attention
+ to `im' only if it is defined.
+
+`ei'
+ String of commands to leave insert mode. This capability must be
+ present if `im' is.
+
+ On a few old terminals the same string is used to enter and exit
+ insert mode. This string turns insert mode on if it was off, and
+ off it it was on. You can tell these terminals because the `ei'
+ string equals the `im' string. If you want to support these
+ terminals, you must always remember accurately whether insert mode
+ is in effect. However, these terminals are obsolete, and it is
+ reasonable to refuse to support them. On all modern terminals, you
+ can safely output `ei' at any time to ensure that insert mode is
+ turned off.
+
+`ic'
+ String of commands to insert one character position at the cursor.
+ The cursor does not move.
+
+ If outputting a graphic character while in insert mode is
+ sufficient to insert the character, then the `ic' capability
+ should be defined with a null value.
+
+ If your terminal offers a choice of ways to insert--either use
+ insert mode or use a special command--then define `im' and do not
+ define `ic', since this gives the most efficient operation when
+ several characters are to be inserted. *Do not* define both
+ strings, for that means that *both* must be used each time
+ insertion is done.
+
+`ip'
+ String of commands to output following an inserted graphic
+ character in insert mode. Often it is used just for a padding
+ spec, when padding is needed after an inserted character (*note
+ Padding::.).
+
+`IC'
+ String of commands to insert N character positions at and after
+ the cursor. It has the same effect as repeating the `ic' string
+ and a space, N times.
+
+ If `IC' is provided, application programs may use it without first
+ entering insert mode.
+
+`mi'
+ Flag whose presence means it is safe to move the cursor while in
+ insert mode and assume the terminal remains in insert mode.
+
+`in'
+ Flag whose presence means that the terminal distinguishes between
+ character positions in which space characters have been output and
+ positions which have been cleared.
+
+ An application program can assume that the terminal can do character
+insertion if *any one of* the capabilities `IC', `im', `ic' or `ip' is
+provided.
+
+ To insert N blank character positions, move the cursor to the place
+to insert them and follow this algorithm:
+
+ 1. If an `IC' string is provided, output it with parameter N and you
+ are finished. Otherwise (or if you don't want to bother to look
+ for an `IC' string) follow the remaining steps.
+
+ 2. Output the `im' string, if there is one, unless the terminal is
+ already in insert mode.
+
+ 3. Repeat steps 4 through 6, N times.
+
+ 4. Output the `ic' string if any.
+
+ 5. Output a space.
+
+ 6. Output the `ip' string if any.
+
+ 7. Output the `ei' string, eventually, to exit insert mode. There is
+ no need to do this right away. If the `mi' flag is present, you
+ can move the cursor and the cursor will remain in insert mode;
+ then you can do more insertion elsewhere without reentering insert
+ mode.
+
+ To insert N graphic characters, position the cursor and follow this
+algorithm:
+
+ 1. If an `IC' string is provided, output it with parameter N, then
+ output the graphic characters, and you are finished. Otherwise
+ (or if you don't want to bother to look for an `IC' string) follow
+ the remaining steps.
+
+ 2. Output the `im' string, if there is one, unless the terminal is
+ already in insert mode.
+
+ 3. For each character to be output, repeat steps 4 through 6.
+
+ 4. Output the `ic' string if any.
+
+ 5. Output the next graphic character.
+
+ 6. Output the `ip' string if any.
+
+ 7. Output the `ei' string, eventually, to exit insert mode. There is
+ no need to do this right away. If the `mi' flag is present, you
+ can move the cursor and the cursor will remain in insert mode;
+ then you can do more insertion elsewhere without reentering insert
+ mode.
+
+ Note that this is not the same as the original Unix termcap
+specifications in one respect: it assumes that the `IC' string can be
+used without entering insert mode. This is true as far as I know, and
+it allows you be able to avoid entering and leaving insert mode, and
+also to be able to avoid the inserted-character padding after the
+characters that go into the inserted positions.
+
+ Deletion of characters is less complicated; deleting one column is
+done by outputting the `dc' string. However, there may be a delete
+mode that must be entered with `dm' in order to make `dc' work.
+
+`dc'
+ String of commands to delete one character position at the cursor.
+ If `dc' is not present, the terminal cannot delete characters.
+
+`DC'
+ String of commands to delete N characters starting at the cursor.
+ It has the same effect as repeating the `dc' string N times. Any
+ terminal description that has `DC' also has `dc'.
+
+`dm'
+ String of commands to enter delete mode. If not present, there is
+ no delete mode, and `dc' can be used at any time (assuming there is
+ a `dc').
+
+`ed'
+ String of commands to exit delete mode. This must be present if
+ `dm' is.
+
+ To delete N character positions, position the cursor and follow these
+steps:
+
+ 1. If the `DC' string is present, output it with parameter N and you
+ are finished. Otherwise, follow the remaining steps.
+
+ 2. Output the `dm' string, unless you know the terminal is already in
+ delete mode.
+
+ 3. Output the `dc' string N times.
+
+ 4. Output the `ed' string eventually. If the flag capability `mi' is
+ present, you can move the cursor and do more deletion without
+ leaving and reentering delete mode.
+
+ As with the `IC' string, we have departed from the original termcap
+specifications by assuming that `DC' works without entering delete mode
+even though `dc' would not.
+
+ If the `dm' and `im' capabilities are both present and have the same
+value, it means that the terminal has one mode for both insertion and
+deletion. It is useful for a program to know this, because then it can
+do insertions after deletions, or vice versa, without leaving
+insert/delete mode and reentering it.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Standout, Next: Underlining, Prev: Insdel Char, Up: Capabilities
+
+Standout and Appearance Modes
+=============================
+
+ "Appearance modes" are modifications to the ways characters are
+displayed. Typical appearance modes include reverse video, dim, bright,
+blinking, underlined, invisible, and alternate character set. Each
+kind of terminal supports various among these, or perhaps none.
+
+ For each type of terminal, one appearance mode or combination of
+them that looks good for highlighted text is chosen as the "standout
+mode". The capabilities `so' and `se' say how to enter and leave
+standout mode. Programs that use appearance modes only to highlight
+some text generally use the standout mode so that they can work on as
+many terminals as possible. Use of specific appearance modes other
+than "underlined" and "alternate character set" is rare.
+
+ Terminals that implement appearance modes fall into two general
+classes as to how they do it.
+
+ In some terminals, the presence or absence of any appearance mode is
+recorded separately for each character position. In these terminals,
+each graphic character written is given the appearance modes current at
+the time it is written, and keeps those modes until it is erased or
+overwritten. There are special commands to turn the appearance modes
+on or off for characters to be written in the future.
+
+ In other terminals, the change of appearance modes is represented by
+a marker that belongs to a certain screen position but affects all
+following screen positions until the next marker. These markers are
+traditionally called "magic cookies".
+
+ The same capabilities (`so', `se', `mb' and so on) for turning
+appearance modes on and off are used for both magic-cookie terminals
+and per-character terminals. On magic cookie terminals, these give the
+commands to write the magic cookies. On per-character terminals, they
+change the current modes that affect future output and erasure. Some
+simple applications can use these commands without knowing whether or
+not they work by means of cookies.
+
+ However, a program that maintains and updates a display needs to know
+whether the terminal uses magic cookies, and exactly what their effect
+is. This information comes from the `sg' capability.
+
+ The `sg' capability is a numeric capability whose presence indicates
+that the terminal uses magic cookies for appearance modes. Its value is
+the number of character positions that a magic cookie occupies. Usually
+the cookie occupies one or more character positions on the screen, and
+these character positions are displayed as blank, but in some terminals
+the cookie has zero width.
+
+ The `sg' capability describes both the magic cookie to turn standout
+on and the cookie to turn it off. This makes the assumption that both
+kinds of cookie have the same width on the screen. If that is not true,
+the narrower cookie must be "widened" with spaces until it has the same
+width as the other.
+
+ On some magic cookie terminals, each line always starts with normal
+display; in other words, the scope of a magic cookie never extends over
+more than one line. But on other terminals, one magic cookie affects
+all the lines below it unless explicitly canceled. Termcap does not
+define any way to distinguish these two ways magic cookies can work.
+To be safe, it is best to put a cookie at the beginning of each line.
+
+ On some per-character terminals, standout mode or other appearance
+modes may be canceled by moving the cursor. On others, moving the
+cursor has no effect on the state of the appearance modes. The latter
+class of terminals are given the flag capability `ms' ("can move in
+standout"). All programs that might have occasion to move the cursor
+while appearance modes are turned on must check for this flag; if it is
+not present, they should reset appearance modes to normal before doing
+cursor motion.
+
+ A program that has turned on only standout mode should use `se' to
+reset the standout mode to normal. A program that has turned on only
+alternate character set mode should use `ae' to return it to normal.
+If it is possible that any other appearance modes are turned on, use the
+`me' capability to return them to normal.
+
+ Note that the commands to turn on one appearance mode, including `so'
+and `mb' ... `mr', if used while some other appearance modes are turned
+on, may combine the two modes on some terminals but may turn off the
+mode previously enabled on other terminals. This is because some
+terminals do not have a command to set or clear one appearance mode
+without changing the others. Programs should not attempt to use
+appearance modes in combination except with `sa', and when switching
+from one single mode to another should always turn off the previously
+enabled mode and then turn on the new desired mode.
+
+ On some old terminals, the `so' and `se' commands may be the same
+command, which has the effect of turning standout on if it is off, or
+off it is on. It is therefore risky for a program to output extra `se'
+commands for good measure. Fortunately, all these terminals are
+obsolete.
+
+ Programs that update displays in which standout-text may be replaced
+with non-standout text must check for the `xs' flag. In a per-character
+terminal, this flag says that the only way to remove standout once
+written is to clear that portion of the line with the `ce' string or
+something even more powerful (*note Clearing::.); just writing new
+characters at those screen positions will not change the modes in
+effect there. In a magic cookie terminal, `xs' says that the only way
+to remove a cookie is to clear a portion of the line that includes the
+cookie; writing a different cookie at the same position does not work.
+
+ Such programs must also check for the `xt' flag, which means that the
+terminal is a Teleray 1061. On this terminal it is impossible to
+position the cursor at the front of a magic cookie, so the only two
+ways to remove a cookie are (1) to delete the line it is on or (2) to
+position the cursor at least one character before it (possibly on a
+previous line) and output the `se' string, which on these terminals
+finds and removes the next `so' magic cookie on the screen. (It may
+also be possible to remove a cookie which is not at the beginning of a
+line by clearing that line.) The `xt' capability also has implications
+for the use of tab characters, but in that regard it is obsolete (*Note
+Cursor Motion::).
+
+`so'
+ String of commands to enter standout mode.
+
+`se'
+ String of commands to leave standout mode.
+
+`sg'
+ Numeric capability, the width on the screen of the magic cookie.
+ This capability is absent in terminals that record appearance modes
+ character by character.
+
+`ms'
+ Flag whose presence means that it is safe to move the cursor while
+ the appearance modes are not in the normal state. If this flag is
+ absent, programs should always reset the appearance modes to
+ normal before moving the cursor.
+
+`xs'
+ Flag whose presence means that the only way to reset appearance
+ modes already on the screen is to clear to end of line. On a
+ per-character terminal, you must clear the area where the modes
+ are set. On a magic cookie terminal, you must clear an area
+ containing the cookie. See the discussion above.
+
+`xt'
+ Flag whose presence means that the cursor cannot be positioned
+ right in front of a magic cookie, and that `se' is a command to
+ delete the next magic cookie following the cursor. See discussion
+ above.
+
+`mb'
+ String of commands to enter blinking mode.
+
+`md'
+ String of commands to enter double-bright mode.
+
+`mh'
+ String of commands to enter half-bright mode.
+
+`mk'
+ String of commands to enter invisible mode.
+
+`mp'
+ String of commands to enter protected mode.
+
+`mr'
+ String of commands to enter reverse-video mode.
+
+`me'
+ String of commands to turn off all appearance modes, including
+ standout mode and underline mode. On some terminals it also turns
+ off alternate character set mode; on others, it may not. This
+ capability must be present if any of `mb' ... `mr' is present.
+
+`as'
+ String of commands to turn on alternate character set mode. This
+ mode assigns some or all graphic characters an alternate picture
+ on the screen. There is no standard as to what the alternate
+ pictures look like.
+
+`ae'
+ String of commands to turn off alternate character set mode.
+
+`sa'
+ String of commands to turn on an arbitrary combination of
+ appearance modes. It accepts 9 parameters, each of which controls
+ a particular kind of appearance mode. A parameter should be 1 to
+ turn its appearance mode on, or zero to turn that mode off. Most
+ terminals do not support the `sa' capability, even among those
+ that do have various appearance modes.
+
+ The nine parameters are, in order, STANDOUT, UNDERLINE, REVERSE,
+ BLINK, HALF-BRIGHT, DOUBLE-BRIGHT, BLANK, PROTECT, ALT CHAR SET.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Underlining, Next: Cursor Visibility, Prev: Standout, Up: Capabilities
+
+Underlining
+===========
+
+ Underlining on most terminals is a kind of appearance mode, much like
+standout mode. Therefore, it may be implemented using magic cookies or
+as a flag in the terminal whose current state affects each character
+that is output. *Note Standout::, for a full explanation.
+
+ The `ug' capability is a numeric capability whose presence indicates
+that the terminal uses magic cookies for underlining. Its value is the
+number of character positions that a magic cookie for underlining
+occupies; it is used for underlining just as `sg' is used for standout.
+Aside from the simplest applications, it is impossible to use
+underlining correctly without paying attention to the value of `ug'.
+
+`us'
+ String of commands to turn on underline mode or to output a magic
+ cookie to start underlining.
+
+`ue'
+ String of commands to turn off underline mode or to output a magic
+ cookie to stop underlining.
+
+`ug'
+ Width of magic cookie that represents a change of underline mode;
+ or missing, if the terminal does not use a magic cookie for this.
+
+`ms'
+ Flag whose presence means that it is safe to move the cursor while
+ the appearance modes are not in the normal state. Underlining is
+ an appearance mode. If this flag is absent, programs should
+ always turn off underlining before moving the cursor.
+
+ There are two other, older ways of doing underlining: there can be a
+command to underline a single character, or the output of `_', the
+ASCII underscore character, as an overstrike could cause a character to
+be underlined. New programs need not bother to handle these
+capabilities unless the author cares strongly about the obscure
+terminals which support them. However, terminal descriptions should
+provide these capabilities when appropriate.
+
+`uc'
+ String of commands to underline the character under the cursor, and
+ move the cursor right.
+
+`ul'
+ Flag whose presence means that the terminal can underline by
+ overstriking an underscore character (`_'); some terminals can do
+ this even though they do not support overstriking in general. An
+ implication of this flag is that when outputting new text to
+ overwrite old text, underscore characters must be treated
+ specially lest they underline the old text instead.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Cursor Visibility, Next: Bell, Prev: Underlining, Up: Capabilities
+
+Cursor Visibility
+=================
+
+ Some terminals have the ability to make the cursor invisible, or to
+enhance it. Enhancing the cursor is often done by programs that plan
+to use the cursor to indicate to the user a position of interest that
+may be anywhere on the screen--for example, the Emacs editor enhances
+the cursor on entry. Such programs should always restore the cursor to
+normal on exit.
+
+`vs'
+ String of commands to enhance the cursor.
+
+`vi'
+ String of commands to make the cursor invisible.
+
+`ve'
+ String of commands to return the cursor to normal.
+
+ If you define either `vs' or `vi', you must also define `ve'.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Bell, Next: Keypad, Prev: Cursor Visibility, Up: Capabilities
+
+Bell
+====
+
+ Here we describe commands to make the terminal ask for the user to
+pay attention to it.
+
+`bl'
+ String of commands to cause the terminal to make an audible sound.
+ If this capability is absent, the terminal has no way to make a
+ suitable sound.
+
+`vb'
+ String of commands to cause the screen to flash to attract
+ attention ("visible bell"). If this capability is absent, the
+ terminal has no way to do such a thing.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Keypad, Next: Meta Key, Prev: Bell, Up: Capabilities
+
+Keypad and Function Keys
+========================
+
+ Many terminals have arrow and function keys that transmit specific
+character sequences to the computer. Since the precise sequences used
+depend on the terminal, termcap defines capabilities used to say what
+the sequences are. Unlike most termcap string-valued capabilities,
+these are not strings of commands to be sent to the terminal, rather
+strings that are received from the terminal.
+
+ Programs that expect to use keypad keys should check, initially, for
+a `ks' capability and send it, to make the keypad actually transmit.
+Such programs should also send the `ke' string when exiting.
+
+`ks'
+ String of commands to make the keypad keys transmit. If this
+ capability is not provided, but the others in this section are,
+ programs may assume that the keypad keys always transmit.
+
+`ke'
+ String of commands to make the keypad keys work locally. This
+ capability is provided only if `ks' is.
+
+`kl'
+ String of input characters sent by typing the left-arrow key. If
+ this capability is missing, you cannot expect the terminal to have
+ a left-arrow key that transmits anything to the computer.
+
+`kr'
+ String of input characters sent by typing the right-arrow key.
+
+`ku'
+ String of input characters sent by typing the up-arrow key.
+
+`kd'
+ String of input characters sent by typing the down-arrow key.
+
+`kh'
+ String of input characters sent by typing the "home-position" key.
+
+`K1' ... `K5'
+ Strings of input characters sent by the five other keys in a 3-by-3
+ array that includes the arrow keys, if the keyboard has such a
+ 3-by-3 array. Note that one of these keys may be the
+ "home-position" key, in which case one of these capabilities will
+ have the same value as the `kh' key.
+
+`k0'
+ String of input characters sent by function key 10 (or 0, if the
+ terminal has one labeled 0).
+
+`k1' ... `k9'
+ Strings of input characters sent by function keys 1 through 9,
+ provided for those function keys that exist.
+
+`kn'
+ Number: the number of numbered function keys, if there are more
+ than 10.
+
+`l0' ... `l9'
+ Strings which are the labels appearing on the keyboard on the keys
+ described by the capabilities `k0' ... `l9'. These capabilities
+ should be left undefined if the labels are `f0' or `f10' and `f1'
+ ... `f9'.
+
+`kH'
+ String of input characters sent by the "home down" key, if there is
+ one.
+
+`kb'
+ String of input characters sent by the "backspace" key, if there is
+ one.
+
+`ka'
+ String of input characters sent by the "clear all tabs" key, if
+ there is one.
+
+`kt'
+ String of input characters sent by the "clear tab stop this column"
+ key, if there is one.
+
+`kC'
+ String of input characters sent by the "clear screen" key, if
+ there is one.
+
+`kD'
+ String of input characters sent by the "delete character" key, if
+ there is one.
+
+`kL'
+ String of input characters sent by the "delete line" key, if there
+ is one.
+
+`kM'
+ String of input characters sent by the "exit insert mode" key, if
+ there is one.
+
+`kE'
+ String of input characters sent by the "clear to end of line" key,
+ if there is one.
+
+`kS'
+ String of input characters sent by the "clear to end of screen"
+ key, if there is one.
+
+`kI'
+ String of input characters sent by the "insert character" or "enter
+ insert mode" key, if there is one.
+
+`kA'
+ String of input characters sent by the "insert line" key, if there
+ is one.
+
+`kN'
+ String of input characters sent by the "next page" key, if there is
+ one.
+
+`kP'
+ String of input characters sent by the "previous page" key, if
+ there is one.
+
+`kF'
+ String of input characters sent by the "scroll forward" key, if
+ there is one.
+
+`kR'
+ String of input characters sent by the "scroll reverse" key, if
+ there is one.
+
+`kT'
+ String of input characters sent by the "set tab stop in this
+ column" key, if there is one.
+
+`ko'
+ String listing the other function keys the terminal has. This is a
+ very obsolete way of describing the same information found in the
+ `kH' ... `kT' keys. The string contains a list of two-character
+ termcap capability names, separated by commas. The meaning is
+ that for each capability name listed, the terminal has a key which
+ sends the string which is the value of that capability. For
+ example, the value `:ko=cl,ll,sf,sr:' says that the terminal has
+ four function keys which mean "clear screen", "home down", "scroll
+ forward" and "scroll reverse".
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Meta Key, Next: Initialization, Prev: Keypad, Up: Capabilities
+
+Meta Key
+========
+
+ A Meta key is a key on the keyboard that modifies each character you
+type by controlling the 0200 bit. This bit is on if and only if the
+Meta key is held down when the character is typed. Characters typed
+using the Meta key are called Meta characters. Emacs uses Meta
+characters as editing commands.
+
+`km'
+ Flag whose presence means that the terminal has a Meta key.
+
+`mm'
+ String of commands to enable the functioning of the Meta key.
+
+`mo'
+ String of commands to disable the functioning of the Meta key.
+
+ If the terminal has `km' but does not have `mm' and `mo', it means
+that the Meta key always functions. If it has `mm' and `mo', it means
+that the Meta key can be turned on or off. Send the `mm' string to
+turn it on, and the `mo' string to turn it off. I do not know why one
+would ever not want it to be on.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Initialization, Next: Pad Specs, Prev: Meta Key, Up: Capabilities
+
+Initialization
+==============
+
+`ti'
+ String of commands to put the terminal into whatever special modes
+ are needed or appropriate for programs that move the cursor
+ nonsequentially around the screen. Programs that use termcap to do
+ full-screen display should output this string when they start up.
+
+`te'
+ String of commands to undo what is done by the `ti' string.
+ Programs that output the `ti' string on entry should output this
+ string when they exit.
+
+`is'
+ String of commands to initialize the terminal for each login
+ session.
+
+`if'
+ String which is the name of a file containing the string of
+ commands to initialize the terminal for each session of use.
+ Normally `is' and `if' are not both used.
+
+`i1'
+`i3'
+ Two more strings of commands to initialize the terminal for each
+ login session. The `i1' string (if defined) is output before `is'
+ or `if', and the `i3' string (if defined) is output after.
+
+ The reason for having three separate initialization strings is to
+ make it easier to define a group of related terminal types with
+ slightly different initializations. Define two or three of the
+ strings in the basic type; then the other types can override one
+ or two of the strings.
+
+`rs'
+ String of commands to reset the terminal from any strange mode it
+ may be in. Normally this includes the `is' string (or other
+ commands with the same effects) and more. What would go in the
+ `rs' string but not in the `is' string are annoying or slow
+ commands to bring the terminal back from strange modes that nobody
+ would normally use.
+
+`it'
+ Numeric value, the initial spacing between hardware tab stop
+ columns when the terminal is powered up. Programs to initialize
+ the terminal can use this to decide whether there is a need to set
+ the tab stops. If the initial width is 8, well and good; if it is
+ not 8, then the tab stops should be set; if they cannot be set,
+ the kernel is told to convert tabs to spaces, and other programs
+ will observe this and do likewise.
+
+`ct'
+ String of commands to clear all tab stops.
+
+`st'
+ String of commands to set tab stop at current cursor column on all
+ lines.
+
+`NF'
+ Flag whose presence means that the terminal does not support
+ XON/XOFF flow control. Programs should not send XON (`C-q') or
+ XOFF (`C-s') characters to the terminal.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Pad Specs, Next: Status Line, Prev: Initialization, Up: Capabilities
+
+Padding Capabilities
+====================
+
+ There are two terminal capabilities that exist just to explain the
+proper way to obey the padding specifications in all the command string
+capabilities. One, `pc', must be obeyed by all termcap-using programs.
+
+`pb'
+ Numeric value, the lowest baud rate at which padding is actually
+ needed. Programs may check this and refrain from doing any
+ padding at lower speeds.
+
+`pc'
+ String of commands for padding. The first character of this
+ string is to be used as the pad character, instead of using null
+ characters for padding. If `pc' is not provided, use null
+ characters. Every program that uses termcap must look up this
+ capability and use it to set the variable `PC' that is used by
+ `tputs'. *Note Padding::.
+
+ Some termcap capabilities exist just to specify the amount of
+padding that the kernel should give to cursor motion commands used in
+ordinary sequential output.
+
+`dC'
+ Numeric value, the number of msec of padding needed for the
+ carriage-return character.
+
+`dN'
+ Numeric value, the number of msec of padding needed for the newline
+ (linefeed) character.
+
+`dB'
+ Numeric value, the number of msec of padding needed for the
+ backspace character.
+
+`dF'
+ Numeric value, the number of msec of padding needed for the
+ formfeed character.
+
+`dT'
+ Numeric value, the number of msec of padding needed for the tab
+ character.
+
+ In some systems, the kernel uses the above capabilities; in other
+systems, the kernel uses the paddings specified in the string
+capabilities `cr', `sf', `le', `ff' and `ta'. Descriptions of
+terminals which require such padding should contain the `dC' ... `dT'
+capabilities and also specify the appropriate padding in the
+corresponding string capabilities. Since no modern terminals require
+padding for ordinary sequential output, you probably won't need to do
+either of these things.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Status Line, Next: Half-Line, Prev: Pad Specs, Up: Capabilities
+
+Status Line
+===========
+
+ A "status line" is a line on the terminal that is not used for
+ordinary display output but instead used for a special message. The
+intended use is for a continuously updated description of what the
+user's program is doing, and that is where the name "status line" comes
+from, but in fact it could be used for anything. The distinguishing
+characteristic of a status line is that ordinary output to the terminal
+does not affect it; it changes only if the special status line commands
+of this section are used.
+
+`hs'
+ Flag whose presence means that the terminal has a status line. If
+ a terminal description specifies that there is a status line, it
+ must provide the `ts' and `fs' capabilities.
+
+`ts'
+ String of commands to move the terminal cursor into the status
+ line. Usually these commands must specifically record the old
+ cursor position for the sake of the `fs' string.
+
+`fs'
+ String of commands to move the cursor back from the status line to
+ its previous position (outside the status line).
+
+`es'
+ Flag whose presence means that other display commands work while
+ writing the status line. In other words, one can clear parts of
+ it, insert or delete characters, move the cursor within it using
+ `ch' if there is a `ch' capability, enter and leave standout mode,
+ and so on.
+
+`ds'
+ String of commands to disable the display of the status line. This
+ may be absent, if there is no way to disable the status line
+ display.
+
+`ws'
+ Numeric value, the width of the status line. If this capability is
+ absent in a terminal that has a status line, it means the status
+ line is the same width as the other lines.
+
+ Note that the value of `ws' is sometimes as small as 8.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Half-Line, Next: Printer, Prev: Status Line, Up: Capabilities
+
+Half-Line Motion
+================
+
+ Some terminals have commands for moving the cursor vertically by
+half-lines, useful for outputting subscripts and superscripts. Mostly
+it is hardcopy terminals that have such features.
+
+`hu'
+ String of commands to move the cursor up half a line. If the
+ terminal is a display, it is your responsibility to avoid moving
+ up past the top line; however, most likely the terminal that
+ supports this is a hardcopy terminal and there is nothing to be
+ concerned about.
+
+`hd'
+ String of commands to move the cursor down half a line. If the
+ terminal is a display, it is your responsibility to avoid moving
+ down past the bottom line, etc.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Printer, Prev: Half-Line, Up: Capabilities
+
+Controlling Printers Attached to Terminals
+==========================================
+
+ Some terminals have attached hardcopy printer ports. They may be
+able to copy the screen contents to the printer; they may also be able
+to redirect output to the printer. Termcap does not have anything to
+tell the program whether the redirected output appears also on the
+screen; it does on some terminals but not all.
+
+`ps'
+ String of commands to cause the contents of the screen to be
+ printed. If it is absent, the screen contents cannot be printed.
+
+`po'
+ String of commands to redirect further output to the printer.
+
+`pf'
+ String of commands to terminate redirection of output to the
+ printer. This capability must be present in the description if
+ `po' is.
+
+`pO'
+ String of commands to redirect output to the printer for next N
+ characters of output, regardless of what they are. Redirection
+ will end automatically after N characters of further output. Until
+ then, nothing that is output can end redirection, not even the
+ `pf' string if there is one. The number N should not be more than
+ 255.
+
+ One use of this capability is to send non-text byte sequences
+ (such as bit-maps) to the printer.
+
+ Most terminals with printers do not support all of `ps', `po' and
+`pO'; any one or two of them may be supported. To make a program that
+can send output to all kinds of printers, it is necessary to check for
+all three of these capabilities, choose the most convenient of the ones
+that are provided, and use it in its own appropriate fashion.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Summary, Next: Var Index, Prev: Capabilities, Up: Top
+
+Summary of Capability Names
+***************************
+
+ Here are all the terminal capability names in alphabetical order
+with a brief description of each. For cross references to their
+definitions, see the index of capability names (*note Cap Index::.).
+
+`ae'
+ String to turn off alternate character set mode.
+
+`al'
+ String to insert a blank line before the cursor.
+
+`AL'
+ String to insert N blank lines before the cursor.
+
+`am'
+ Flag: output to last column wraps cursor to next line.
+
+`as'
+ String to turn on alternate character set mode.like.
+
+`bc'
+ Very obsolete alternative name for the `le' capability.
+
+`bl'
+ String to sound the bell.
+
+`bs'
+ Obsolete flag: ASCII backspace may be used for leftward motion.
+
+`bt'
+ String to move the cursor left to the previous hardware tab stop
+ column.
+
+`bw'
+ Flag: `le' at left margin wraps to end of previous line.
+
+`CC'
+ String to change terminal's command character.
+
+`cd'
+ String to clear the line the cursor is on, and following lines.
+
+`ce'
+ String to clear from the cursor to the end of the line.
+
+`ch'
+ String to position the cursor at column C in the same line.
+
+`cl'
+ String to clear the entire screen and put cursor at upper left
+ corner.
+
+`cm'
+ String to position the cursor at line L, column C.
+
+`CM'
+ String to position the cursor at line L, column C, relative to
+ display memory.
+
+`co'
+ Number: width of the screen.
+
+`cr'
+ String to move cursor sideways to left margin.
+
+`cs'
+ String to set the scroll region.
+
+`cS'
+ Alternate form of string to set the scroll region.
+
+`ct'
+ String to clear all tab stops.
+
+`cv'
+ String to position the cursor at line L in the same column.
+
+`da'
+ Flag: data scrolled off top of screen may be scrolled back.
+
+`db'
+ Flag: data scrolled off bottom of screen may be scrolled back.
+
+`dB'
+ Obsolete number: msec of padding needed for the backspace
+ character.
+
+`dc'
+ String to delete one character position at the cursor.
+
+`dC'
+ Obsolete number: msec of padding needed for the carriage-return
+ character.
+
+`DC'
+ String to delete N characters starting at the cursor.
+
+`dF'
+ Obsolete number: msec of padding needed for the formfeed character.
+
+`dl'
+ String to delete the line the cursor is on.
+
+`DL'
+ String to delete N lines starting with the cursor's line.
+
+`dm'
+ String to enter delete mode.
+
+`dN'
+ Obsolete number: msec of padding needed for the newline character.
+
+`do'
+ String to move the cursor vertically down one line.
+
+`DO'
+ String to move cursor vertically down N lines.
+
+`ds'
+ String to disable the display of the status line.
+
+`dT'
+ Obsolete number: msec of padding needed for the tab character.
+
+`ec'
+ String of commands to clear N characters at cursor.
+
+`ed'
+ String to exit delete mode.
+
+`ei'
+ String to leave insert mode.
+
+`eo'
+ Flag: output of a space can erase an overstrike.
+
+`es'
+ Flag: other display commands work while writing the status line.
+
+`ff'
+ String to advance to the next page, for a hardcopy terminal.
+
+`fs'
+ String to move the cursor back from the status line to its
+ previous position (outside the status line).
+
+`gn'
+ Flag: this terminal type is generic, not real.
+
+`hc'
+ Flag: hardcopy terminal.
+
+`hd'
+ String to move the cursor down half a line.
+
+`ho'
+ String to position cursor at upper left corner.
+
+`hs'
+ Flag: the terminal has a status line.
+
+`hu'
+ String to move the cursor up half a line.
+
+`hz'
+ Flag: terminal cannot accept `~' as output.
+
+`i1'
+ String to initialize the terminal for each login session.
+
+`i3'
+ String to initialize the terminal for each login session.
+
+`ic'
+ String to insert one character position at the cursor.
+
+`IC'
+ String to insert N character positions at the cursor.
+
+`if'
+ String naming a file of commands to initialize the terminal.
+
+`im'
+ String to enter insert mode.
+
+`in'
+ Flag: outputting a space is different from moving over empty
+ positions.
+
+`ip'
+ String to output following an inserted character in insert mode.
+
+`is'
+ String to initialize the terminal for each login session.
+
+`it'
+ Number: initial spacing between hardware tab stop columns.
+
+`k0'
+ String of input sent by function key 0 or 10.
+
+`k1 ... k9'
+ Strings of input sent by function keys 1 through 9.
+
+`K1 ... K5'
+ Strings sent by the five other keys in 3-by-3 array with arrows.
+
+`ka'
+ String of input sent by the "clear all tabs" key.
+
+`kA'
+ String of input sent by the "insert line" key.
+
+`kb'
+ String of input sent by the "backspace" key.
+
+`kC'
+ String of input sent by the "clear screen" key.
+
+`kd'
+ String of input sent by typing the down-arrow key.
+
+`kD'
+ String of input sent by the "delete character" key.
+
+`ke'
+ String to make the function keys work locally.
+
+`kE'
+ String of input sent by the "clear to end of line" key.
+
+`kF'
+ String of input sent by the "scroll forward" key.
+
+`kh'
+ String of input sent by typing the "home-position" key.
+
+`kH'
+ String of input sent by the "home down" key.
+
+`kI'
+ String of input sent by the "insert character" or "enter insert
+ mode" key.
+
+`kl'
+ String of input sent by typing the left-arrow key.
+
+`kL'
+ String of input sent by the "delete line" key.
+
+`km'
+ Flag: the terminal has a Meta key.
+
+`kM'
+ String of input sent by the "exit insert mode" key.
+
+`kn'
+ Numeric value, the number of numbered function keys.
+
+`kN'
+ String of input sent by the "next page" key.
+
+`ko'
+ Very obsolete string listing the terminal's named function keys.
+
+`kP'
+ String of input sent by the "previous page" key.
+
+`kr'
+ String of input sent by typing the right-arrow key.
+
+`kR'
+ String of input sent by the "scroll reverse" key.
+
+`ks'
+ String to make the function keys transmit.
+
+`kS'
+ String of input sent by the "clear to end of screen" key.
+
+`kt'
+ String of input sent by the "clear tab stop this column" key.
+
+`kT'
+ String of input sent by the "set tab stop in this column" key.
+
+`ku'
+ String of input sent by typing the up-arrow key.
+
+`l0'
+ String on keyboard labelling function key 0 or 10.
+
+`l1 ... l9'
+ Strings on keyboard labelling function keys 1 through 9.
+
+`le'
+ String to move the cursor left one column.
+
+`LE'
+ String to move cursor left N columns.
+
+`li'
+ Number: height of the screen.
+
+`ll'
+ String to position cursor at lower left corner.
+
+`lm'
+ Number: lines of display memory.
+
+`LP'
+ Flag: writing to last column of last line will not scroll.
+
+`mb'
+ String to enter blinking mode.
+
+`md'
+ String to enter double-bright mode.
+
+`me'
+ String to turn off all appearance modes
+
+`mh'
+ String to enter half-bright mode.
+
+`mi'
+ Flag: cursor motion in insert mode is safe.
+
+`mk'
+ String to enter invisible mode.
+
+`mm'
+ String to enable the functioning of the Meta key.
+
+`mo'
+ String to disable the functioning of the Meta key.
+
+`mp'
+ String to enter protected mode.
+
+`mr'
+ String to enter reverse-video mode.
+
+`ms'
+ Flag: cursor motion in standout mode is safe.
+
+`nc'
+ Obsolete flag: do not use ASCII carriage-return on this terminal.
+
+`nd'
+ String to move the cursor right one column.
+
+`NF'
+ Flag: do not use XON/XOFF flow control.
+
+`nl'
+ Obsolete alternative name for the `do' and `sf' capabilities.
+
+`ns'
+ Flag: the terminal does not normally scroll for sequential output.
+
+`nw'
+ String to move to start of next line, possibly clearing rest of
+ old line.
+
+`os'
+ Flag: terminal can overstrike.
+
+`pb'
+ Number: the lowest baud rate at which padding is actually needed.
+
+`pc'
+ String containing character for padding.
+
+`pf'
+ String to terminate redirection of output to the printer.
+
+`po'
+ String to redirect further output to the printer.
+
+`pO'
+ String to redirect N characters ofoutput to the printer.
+
+`ps'
+ String to print the screen on the attached printer.
+
+`rc'
+ String to move to last saved cursor position.
+
+`RI'
+ String to move cursor right N columns.
+
+`rp'
+ String to output character C repeated N times.
+
+`rs'
+ String to reset the terminal from any strange modes.
+
+`sa'
+ String to turn on an arbitrary combination of appearance modes.
+
+`sc'
+ String to save the current cursor position.
+
+`se'
+ String to leave standout mode.
+
+`sf'
+ String to scroll the screen one line up.
+
+`SF'
+ String to scroll the screen N lines up.
+
+`sg'
+ Number: width of magic standout cookie. Absent if magic cookies
+ are not used.
+
+`so'
+ String to enter standout mode.
+
+`sr'
+ String to scroll the screen one line down.
+
+`SR'
+ String to scroll the screen N line down.
+
+`st'
+ String to set tab stop at current cursor column on all lines.
+ programs.
+
+`ta'
+ String to move the cursor right to the next hardware tab stop
+ column.
+
+`te'
+ String to return terminal to settings for sequential output.
+
+`ti'
+ String to initialize terminal for random cursor motion.
+
+`ts'
+ String to move the terminal cursor into the status line.
+
+`uc'
+ String to underline one character and move cursor right.
+
+`ue'
+ String to turn off underline mode
+
+`ug'
+ Number: width of underlining magic cookie. Absent if underlining
+ doesn't use magic cookies.
+
+`ul'
+ Flag: underline by overstriking with an underscore.
+
+`up'
+ String to move the cursor vertically up one line.
+
+`UP'
+ String to move cursor vertically up N lines.
+
+`us'
+ String to turn on underline mode
+
+`vb'
+ String to make the screen flash.
+
+`ve'
+ String to return the cursor to normal.
+
+`vi'
+ String to make the cursor invisible.
+
+`vs'
+ String to enhance the cursor.
+
+`wi'
+ String to set the terminal output screen window.
+
+`ws'
+ Number: the width of the status line.
+
+`xb'
+ Flag: superbee terminal.
+
+`xn'
+ Flag: cursor wraps in a strange way.
+
+`xs'
+ Flag: clearing a line is the only way to clear the appearance
+ modes of positions in that line (or, only way to remove magic
+ cookies on that line).
+
+`xt'
+ Flag: Teleray 1061; several strange characteristics.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Var Index, Next: Cap Index, Prev: Summary, Up: Top
+
+Variable and Function Index
+***************************
+
+* Menu:
+
+* BC: tgoto.
+* ospeed: Output Padding.
+* PC: Output Padding.
+* tgetent: Find.
+* tgetflag: Interrogate.
+* tgetnum: Interrogate.
+* tgetstr: Interrogate.
+* tgoto: tgoto.
+* tparam: tparam.
+* tputs: Output Padding.
+* UP: tgoto.
+
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/termcap.info-4 b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/termcap.info-4
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..4b8bf79
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/termcap.info-4
@@ -0,0 +1,220 @@
+This is Info file ./termcap.info, produced by Makeinfo-1.55 from the
+input file ./termcap.texi.
+
+ This file documents the termcap library of the GNU system.
+
+ Copyright (C) 1988 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of this
+manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice are
+preserved on all copies.
+
+ Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of
+this manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided that
+the entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
+permission notice identical to this one.
+
+ Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this
+manual into another language, under the above conditions for modified
+versions, except that this permission notice may be stated in a
+translation approved by the Foundation.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Cap Index, Next: Index, Prev: Var Index, Up: Top
+
+Capability Index
+****************
+
+* Menu:
+
+* ae: Standout.
+* al: Insdel Line.
+* AL: Insdel Line.
+* am: Wrapping.
+* as: Standout.
+* bc: Cursor Motion.
+* bl: Bell.
+* bs: Cursor Motion.
+* bt: Cursor Motion.
+* bw: Cursor Motion.
+* CC: Basic.
+* cd: Clearing.
+* ce: Clearing.
+* ch: Cursor Motion.
+* cl: Clearing.
+* cm: Cursor Motion.
+* CM: Cursor Motion.
+* co: Screen Size.
+* cr: Cursor Motion.
+* cS: Scrolling.
+* cs: Scrolling.
+* ct: Initialization.
+* cv: Cursor Motion.
+* da: Scrolling.
+* dB: Pad Specs.
+* db: Scrolling.
+* dC: Pad Specs.
+* DC: Insdel Char.
+* dc: Insdel Char.
+* dF: Pad Specs.
+* dl: Insdel Line.
+* DL: Insdel Line.
+* dm: Insdel Char.
+* dN: Pad Specs.
+* do: Cursor Motion.
+* DO: Cursor Motion.
+* ds: Status Line.
+* dT: Pad Specs.
+* ec: Clearing.
+* ed: Insdel Char.
+* ei: Insdel Char.
+* eo: Basic.
+* es: Status Line.
+* ff: Cursor Motion.
+* fs: Status Line.
+* gn: Basic.
+* hc: Basic.
+* hd: Half-Line.
+* ho: Cursor Motion.
+* hs: Status Line.
+* hu: Half-Line.
+* hz: Basic.
+* i1: Initialization.
+* i3: Initialization.
+* IC: Insdel Char.
+* ic: Insdel Char.
+* if: Initialization.
+* im: Insdel Char.
+* in: Insdel Char.
+* ip: Insdel Char.
+* is: Initialization.
+* it: Initialization.
+* K1...K5: Keypad.
+* k1...k9: Keypad.
+* kA...kT: Keypad.
+* ka...ku: Keypad.
+* km: Meta Key.
+* l0...l9: Keypad.
+* le: Cursor Motion.
+* LE: Cursor Motion.
+* li: Screen Size.
+* ll: Cursor Motion.
+* lm: Scrolling.
+* LP: Wrapping.
+* mb: Standout.
+* md: Standout.
+* me: Standout.
+* mh: Standout.
+* mi: Insdel Char.
+* mk: Standout.
+* mm: Meta Key.
+* mo: Meta Key.
+* mp: Standout.
+* mr: Standout.
+* ms: Standout.
+* ms: Underlining.
+* nc: Cursor Motion.
+* nd: Cursor Motion.
+* NF: Initialization.
+* nl: Cursor Motion.
+* ns: Scrolling.
+* nw: Cursor Motion.
+* os: Basic.
+* pb: Pad Specs.
+* pc: Pad Specs.
+* pf: Printer.
+* pO: Printer.
+* po: Printer.
+* ps: Printer.
+* rc: Cursor Motion.
+* RI: Cursor Motion.
+* rp: Basic.
+* rs: Initialization.
+* sa: Standout.
+* sc: Cursor Motion.
+* se: Standout.
+* SF: Scrolling.
+* sf: Scrolling.
+* sg: Standout.
+* so: Standout.
+* SR: Scrolling.
+* sr: Scrolling.
+* st: Initialization.
+* ta: Cursor Motion.
+* te: Initialization.
+* ti: Initialization.
+* ts: Status Line.
+* uc: Underlining.
+* ue: Underlining.
+* ug: Underlining.
+* ul: Underlining.
+* up: Cursor Motion.
+* UP: Cursor Motion.
+* us: Underlining.
+* vb: Bell.
+* ve: Cursor Visibility.
+* vi: Cursor Visibility.
+* vs: Cursor Visibility.
+* wi: Windows.
+* ws: Status Line.
+* xb: Basic.
+* xn: Wrapping.
+* xs: Standout.
+* xt: Cursor Motion.
+* xt: Standout.
+
+
+File: termcap.info, Node: Index, Prev: Cap Index, Up: Top
+
+Concept Index
+*************
+
+* Menu:
+
+* %: Encode Parameters.
+* appearance modes: Standout.
+* bell: Bell.
+* clearing the screen: Clearing.
+* command character: Basic.
+* cursor motion: Cursor Motion.
+* delete character: Insdel Char.
+* delete line: Insdel Line.
+* delete mode: Insdel Char.
+* description format: Format.
+* erasing: Clearing.
+* generic terminal type: Basic.
+* home position: Cursor Motion.
+* inheritance: Inheriting.
+* initialization: Initialization.
+* insert character: Insdel Char.
+* insert line: Insdel Line.
+* insert mode: Insdel Char.
+* line speed: Output Padding.
+* magic cookie: Standout.
+* meta key: Meta Key.
+* names of terminal types: Naming.
+* overstrike: Basic.
+* padding: Pad Specs.
+* padding: Padding.
+* parameters: Parameters.
+* printer: Printer.
+* repeat output: Basic.
+* reset: Initialization.
+* screen size: Screen Size.
+* screen size: Naming.
+* screen size: Screen Size.
+* scrolling: Scrolling.
+* standout: Standout.
+* status line: Status Line.
+* Superbee: Basic.
+* tab stops: Initialization.
+* termcap: Introduction.
+* terminal flags (kernel): Initialize.
+* underlining: Underlining.
+* visibility: Cursor Visibility.
+* visible bell: Bell.
+* window: Windows.
+* wrapping: Wrapping.
+* wrapping: Naming.
+
+
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/termcap.texi b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/termcap.texi
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..eab49e8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/termcap.texi
@@ -0,0 +1,3617 @@
+\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
+@setfilename termcap.info
+@settitle The Termcap Library
+@smallbook
+
+@ifinfo
+This file documents the termcap library of the GNU system.
+
+Copyright (C) 1988 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
+this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
+are preserved on all copies.
+
+@ignore
+Permission is granted to process this file through TeX and print the
+results, provided the printed document carries copying permission
+notice identical to this one except for the removal of this paragraph
+(this paragraph not being relevant to the printed manual).
+
+@end ignore
+Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
+manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided that the entire
+resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a permission
+notice identical to this one.
+
+Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
+into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions,
+except that this permission notice may be stated in a translation approved
+by the Foundation.
+@end ifinfo
+
+@setchapternewpage odd
+
+@c @shorttitlepage The Termcap Manual
+
+@titlepage
+@ignore
+@sp 6
+@center @titlefont{Termcap}
+@sp 1
+@center The Termcap Library and Data Base
+@sp 4
+@center Second Edition
+@sp 1
+@center December 1992
+@sp 5
+@center Richard M. Stallman
+@sp 1
+@center Free Software Foundation
+@end ignore
+
+@c Real title page
+@title The Termcap Manual
+@subtitle The Termcap Library and Data Base
+@subtitle Second Edition
+@subtitle December 1992
+@author Richard M. Stallman
+@page
+@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
+Copyright @copyright{} 1988 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+Published by the Free Software Foundation
+(59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA).
+Printed copies are available for $10 each.
+
+Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
+this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
+are preserved on all copies.
+
+Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
+manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided that the entire
+resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a permission
+notice identical to this one.
+
+Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
+into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions,
+except that this permission notice may be stated in a translation approved
+by the Foundation.
+@sp 2
+Cover art by Etienne Suvasa.
+@end titlepage
+@page
+
+@synindex vr fn
+
+@node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
+
+@menu
+* Introduction:: What is termcap? Why this manual?
+* Library:: The termcap library functions.
+* Data Base:: What terminal descriptions in @file{/etc/termcap} look like.
+* Capabilities:: Definitions of the individual terminal capabilities:
+ how to write them in descriptions, and how to use
+ their values to do display updating.
+* Summary:: Brief table of capability names and their meanings.
+* Var Index:: Index of C functions and variables.
+* Cap Index:: Index of termcap capabilities.
+* Index:: Concept index.
+
+ --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
+
+The Termcap Library
+
+* Preparation:: Preparing to use the termcap library.
+* Find:: Finding the description of the terminal being used.
+* Interrogate:: Interrogating the description for particular capabilities.
+* Initialize:: Initialization for output using termcap.
+* Padding:: Outputting padding.
+* Parameters:: Encoding parameters such as cursor positions.
+
+Padding
+
+* Why Pad:: Explanation of padding.
+* Not Enough:: When there is not enough padding.
+* Describe Padding:: The data base says how much padding a terminal needs.
+* Output Padding:: Using @code{tputs} to output the needed padding.
+
+Filling In Parameters
+
+* Encode Parameters:: The language for encoding parameters.
+* Using Parameters:: Outputting a string command with parameters.
+
+Sending Display Commands with Parameters
+
+* tparam:: The general case, for GNU termcap only.
+* tgoto:: The special case of cursor motion.
+
+The Format of the Data Base
+
+* Format:: Overall format of a terminal description.
+* Capability Format:: Format of capabilities within a description.
+* Naming:: Naming conventions for terminal types.
+* Inheriting:: Inheriting part of a description from
+a related terminal type.
+* Changing:: When changes in the data base take effect.
+
+Definitions of the Terminal Capabilities
+
+* Basic:: Basic characteristics.
+* Screen Size:: Screen size, and what happens when it changes.
+* Cursor Motion:: Various ways to move the cursor.
+* Wrapping:: What happens if you write a character in the last column.
+* Scrolling:: Pushing text up and down on the screen.
+* Windows:: Limiting the part of the window that output affects.
+* Clearing:: Erasing one or many lines.
+* Insdel Line:: Making new blank lines in mid-screen; deleting lines.
+* Insdel Char:: Inserting and deleting characters within a line.
+* Standout:: Highlighting some of the text.
+* Underlining:: Underlining some of the text.
+* Cursor Visibility:: Making the cursor more or less easy to spot.
+* Bell:: Attracts user's attention; not localized on the screen.
+* Keypad:: Recognizing when function keys or arrows are typed.
+* Meta Key:: @key{META} acts like an extra shift key.
+* Initialization:: Commands used to initialize or reset the terminal.
+* Pad Specs:: Info for the kernel on how much padding is needed.
+* Status Line:: A status line displays ``background'' information.
+* Half-Line:: Moving by half-lines, for superscripts and subscripts.
+* Printer:: Controlling auxiliary printers of display terminals.
+@end menu
+
+@node Introduction, Library, Top, Top
+@unnumbered Introduction
+
+@cindex termcap
+@dfn{Termcap} is a library and data base that enables programs to use
+display terminals in a terminal-independent manner. It originated in
+Berkeley Unix.
+
+The termcap data base describes the capabilities of hundreds of different
+display terminals in great detail. Some examples of the information
+recorded for a terminal could include how many columns wide it is, what
+string to send to move the cursor to an arbitrary position (including how
+to encode the row and column numbers), how to scroll the screen up one or
+several lines, and how much padding is needed for such a scrolling
+operation.
+
+The termcap library is provided for easy access this data base in programs
+that want to do terminal-independent character-based display output.
+
+This manual describes the GNU version of the termcap library, which has
+some extensions over the Unix version. All the extensions are identified
+as such, so this manual also tells you how to use the Unix termcap.
+
+The GNU version of the termcap library is available free as source code,
+for use in free programs, and runs on Unix and VMS systems (at least). You
+can find it in the GNU Emacs distribution in the files @file{termcap.c} and
+@file{tparam.c}.
+
+This manual was written for the GNU project, whose goal is to develop a
+complete free operating system upward-compatible with Unix for user
+programs. The project is approximately two thirds complete. For more
+information on the GNU project, including the GNU Emacs editor and the
+mostly-portable optimizing C compiler, send one dollar to
+
+@display
+Free Software Foundation
+675 Mass Ave
+Cambridge, MA 02139
+@end display
+
+@node Library, Data Base, Introduction, Top
+@chapter The Termcap Library
+
+The termcap library is the application programmer's interface to the
+termcap data base. It contains functions for the following purposes:
+
+@itemize @bullet
+@item
+Finding the description of the user's terminal type (@code{tgetent}).
+
+@item
+Interrogating the description for information on various topics
+(@code{tgetnum}, @code{tgetflag}, @code{tgetstr}).
+
+@item
+Computing and performing padding (@code{tputs}).
+
+@item
+Encoding numeric parameters such as cursor positions into the
+terminal-specific form required for display commands (@code{tparam},
+@code{tgoto}).
+@end itemize
+
+@menu
+* Preparation:: Preparing to use the termcap library.
+* Find:: Finding the description of the terminal being used.
+* Interrogate:: Interrogating the description for particular capabilities.
+* Initialize:: Initialization for output using termcap.
+* Padding:: Outputting padding.
+* Parameters:: Encoding parameters such as cursor positions.
+@end menu
+
+@node Preparation, Find, , Library
+@section Preparing to Use the Termcap Library
+
+To use the termcap library in a program, you need two kinds of preparation:
+
+@itemize @bullet
+@item
+The compiler needs declarations of the functions and variables in the
+library.
+
+On GNU systems, it suffices to include the header file
+@file{termcap.h} in each source file that uses these functions and
+variables.@refill
+
+On Unix systems, there is often no such header file. Then you must
+explictly declare the variables as external. You can do likewise for
+the functions, or let them be implicitly declared and cast their
+values from type @code{int} to the appropriate type.
+
+We illustrate the declarations of the individual termcap library
+functions with ANSI C prototypes because they show how to pass the
+arguments. If you are not using the GNU C compiler, you probably
+cannot use function prototypes, so omit the argument types and names
+from your declarations.
+
+@item
+The linker needs to search the library. Usually either
+@samp{-ltermcap} or @samp{-ltermlib} as an argument when linking will
+do this.@refill
+@end itemize
+
+@node Find, Interrogate, Preparation, Library
+@section Finding a Terminal Description: @code{tgetent}
+
+@findex tgetent
+An application program that is going to use termcap must first look up the
+description of the terminal type in use. This is done by calling
+@code{tgetent}, whose declaration in ANSI Standard C looks like:
+
+@example
+int tgetent (char *@var{buffer}, char *@var{termtype});
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This function finds the description and remembers it internally so that
+you can interrogate it about specific terminal capabilities
+(@pxref{Interrogate}).
+
+The argument @var{termtype} is a string which is the name for the type of
+terminal to look up. Usually you would obtain this from the environment
+variable @code{TERM} using @code{getenv ("TERM")}.
+
+If you are using the GNU version of termcap, you can alternatively ask
+@code{tgetent} to allocate enough space. Pass a null pointer for
+@var{buffer}, and @code{tgetent} itself allocates the storage using
+@code{malloc}. There is no way to get the address that was allocated,
+and you shouldn't try to free the storage.@refill
+
+With the Unix version of termcap, you must allocate space for the
+description yourself and pass the address of the space as the argument
+@var{buffer}. There is no way you can tell how much space is needed, so
+the convention is to allocate a buffer 2048 characters long and assume that
+is enough. (Formerly the convention was to allocate 1024 characters and
+assume that was enough. But one day, for one kind of terminal, that was
+not enough.)
+
+No matter how the space to store the description has been obtained,
+termcap records its address internally for use when you later interrogate
+the description with @code{tgetnum}, @code{tgetstr} or @code{tgetflag}. If
+the buffer was allocated by termcap, it will be freed by termcap too if you
+call @code{tgetent} again. If the buffer was provided by you, you must
+make sure that its contents remain unchanged for as long as you still plan
+to interrogate the description.@refill
+
+The return value of @code{tgetent} is @minus{}1 if there is some difficulty
+accessing the data base of terminal types, 0 if the data base is accessible
+but the specified type is not defined in it, and some other value
+otherwise.
+
+Here is how you might use the function @code{tgetent}:
+
+@smallexample
+#ifdef unix
+static char term_buffer[2048];
+#else
+#define term_buffer 0
+#endif
+
+init_terminal_data ()
+@{
+ char *termtype = getenv ("TERM");
+ int success;
+
+ if (termtype == 0)
+ fatal ("Specify a terminal type with `setenv TERM <yourtype>'.\n");
+
+ success = tgetent (term_buffer, termtype);
+ if (success < 0)
+ fatal ("Could not access the termcap data base.\n");
+ if (success == 0)
+ fatal ("Terminal type `%s' is not defined.\n", termtype);
+@}
+@end smallexample
+
+@noindent
+Here we assume the function @code{fatal} prints an error message and exits.
+
+If the environment variable @code{TERMCAP} is defined, its value is used to
+override the terminal type data base. The function @code{tgetent} checks
+the value of @code{TERMCAP} automatically. If the value starts with
+@samp{/} then it is taken as a file name to use as the data base file,
+instead of @file{/etc/termcap} which is the standard data base. If the
+value does not start with @samp{/} then it is itself used as the terminal
+description, provided that the terminal type @var{termtype} is among the
+types it claims to apply to. @xref{Data Base}, for information on the
+format of a terminal description.@refill
+
+@node Interrogate, Initialize, Find, Library
+@section Interrogating the Terminal Description
+
+Each piece of information recorded in a terminal description is called a
+@dfn{capability}. Each defined terminal capability has a two-letter code
+name and a specific meaning. For example, the number of columns is named
+@samp{co}. @xref{Capabilities}, for definitions of all the standard
+capability names.
+
+Once you have found the proper terminal description with @code{tgetent}
+(@pxref{Find}), your application program must @dfn{interrogate} it for
+various terminal capabilities. You must specify the two-letter code of
+the capability whose value you seek.
+
+Capability values can be numeric, boolean (capability is either present or
+absent) or strings. Any particular capability always has the same value
+type; for example, @samp{co} always has a numeric value, while @samp{am}
+(automatic wrap at margin) is always a flag, and @samp{cm} (cursor motion
+command) always has a string value. The documentation of each capability
+says which type of value it has.@refill
+
+There are three functions to use to get the value of a capability,
+depending on the type of value the capability has. Here are their
+declarations in ANSI C:
+
+@findex tgetnum
+@findex tgetflag
+@findex tgetstr
+@example
+int tgetnum (char *@var{name});
+int tgetflag (char *@var{name});
+char *tgetstr (char *@var{name}, char **@var{area});
+@end example
+
+@table @code
+@item tgetnum
+Use @code{tgetnum} to get a capability value that is numeric. The
+argument @var{name} is the two-letter code name of the capability. If
+the capability is present, @code{tgetnum} returns the numeric value
+(which is nonnegative). If the capability is not mentioned in the
+terminal description, @code{tgetnum} returns @minus{}1.
+
+@item tgetflag
+Use @code{tgetflag} to get a boolean value. If the capability
+@var{name} is present in the terminal description, @code{tgetflag}
+returns 1; otherwise, it returns 0.
+
+@item tgetstr
+Use @code{tgetstr} to get a string value. It returns a pointer to a
+string which is the capability value, or a null pointer if the
+capability is not present in the terminal description.
+
+There are two ways @code{tgetstr} can find space to store the string value:
+
+@itemize @bullet
+@item
+You can ask @code{tgetstr} to allocate the space. Pass a null
+pointer for the argument @var{area}, and @code{tgetstr} will use
+@code{malloc} to allocate storage big enough for the value.
+Termcap will never free this storage or refer to it again; you
+should free it when you are finished with it.
+
+This method is more robust, since there is no need to guess how
+much space is needed. But it is supported only by the GNU
+termcap library.
+
+@item
+You can provide the space. Provide for the argument @var{area} the
+address of a pointer variable of type @code{char *}. Before calling
+@code{tgetstr}, initialize the variable to point at available space.
+Then @code{tgetstr} will store the string value in that space and will
+increment the pointer variable to point after the space that has been
+used. You can use the same pointer variable for many calls to
+@code{tgetstr}.
+
+There is no way to determine how much space is needed for a single
+string, and no way for you to prevent or handle overflow of the area
+you have provided. However, you can be sure that the total size of
+all the string values you will obtain from the terminal description is
+no greater than the size of the description (unless you get the same
+capability twice). You can determine that size with @code{strlen} on
+the buffer you provided to @code{tgetent}. See below for an example.
+
+Providing the space yourself is the only method supported by the Unix
+version of termcap.
+@end itemize
+@end table
+
+Note that you do not have to specify a terminal type or terminal
+description for the interrogation functions. They automatically use the
+description found by the most recent call to @code{tgetent}.
+
+Here is an example of interrogating a terminal description for various
+capabilities, with conditionals to select between the Unix and GNU methods
+of providing buffer space.
+
+@example
+char *tgetstr ();
+
+char *cl_string, *cm_string;
+int height;
+int width;
+int auto_wrap;
+
+char PC; /* For tputs. */
+char *BC; /* For tgoto. */
+char *UP;
+
+interrogate_terminal ()
+@{
+#ifdef UNIX
+ /* Here we assume that an explicit term_buffer
+ was provided to tgetent. */
+ char *buffer
+ = (char *) malloc (strlen (term_buffer));
+#define BUFFADDR &buffer
+#else
+#define BUFFADDR 0
+#endif
+
+ char *temp;
+
+ /* Extract information we will use. */
+ cl_string = tgetstr ("cl", BUFFADDR);
+ cm_string = tgetstr ("cm", BUFFADDR);
+ auto_wrap = tgetflag ("am");
+ height = tgetnum ("li");
+ width = tgetnum ("co");
+
+ /* Extract information that termcap functions use. */
+ temp = tgetstr ("pc", BUFFADDR);
+ PC = temp ? *temp : 0;
+ BC = tgetstr ("le", BUFFADDR);
+ UP = tgetstr ("up", BUFFADDR);
+@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+@xref{Padding}, for information on the variable @code{PC}. @xref{Using
+Parameters}, for information on @code{UP} and @code{BC}.
+
+@node Initialize, Padding, Interrogate, Library
+@section Initialization for Use of Termcap
+@cindex terminal flags (kernel)
+
+Before starting to output commands to a terminal using termcap,
+an application program should do two things:
+
+@itemize @bullet
+@item
+Initialize various global variables which termcap library output
+functions refer to. These include @code{PC} and @code{ospeed} for
+padding (@pxref{Output Padding}) and @code{UP} and @code{BC} for
+cursor motion (@pxref{tgoto}).@refill
+
+@item
+Tell the kernel to turn off alteration and padding of horizontal-tab
+characters sent to the terminal.
+@end itemize
+
+To turn off output processing in Berkeley Unix you would use @code{ioctl}
+with code @code{TIOCLSET} to set the bit named @code{LLITOUT}, and clear
+the bits @code{ANYDELAY} using @code{TIOCSETN}. In POSIX or System V, you
+must clear the bit named @code{OPOST}. Refer to the system documentation
+for details.@refill
+
+If you do not set the terminal flags properly, some older terminals will
+not work. This is because their commands may contain the characters that
+normally signify newline, carriage return and horizontal tab---characters
+which the kernel thinks it ought to modify before output.
+
+When you change the kernel's terminal flags, you must arrange to restore
+them to their normal state when your program exits. This implies that the
+program must catch fatal signals such as @code{SIGQUIT} and @code{SIGINT}
+and restore the old terminal flags before actually terminating.
+
+Modern terminals' commands do not use these special characters, so if you
+do not care about problems with old terminals, you can leave the kernel's
+terminal flags unaltered.
+
+@node Padding, Parameters, Initialize, Library
+@section Padding
+@cindex padding
+
+@dfn{Padding} means outputting null characters following a terminal display
+command that takes a long time to execute. The terminal description says
+which commands require padding and how much; the function @code{tputs},
+described below, outputs a terminal command while extracting from it the
+padding information, and then outputs the padding that is necessary.
+
+@menu
+* Why Pad:: Explanation of padding.
+* Not Enough:: When there is not enough padding.
+* Describe Padding:: The data base says how much padding a terminal needs.
+* Output Padding:: Using @code{tputs} to output the needed padding.
+@end menu
+
+@node Why Pad, Not Enough, , Padding
+@subsection Why Pad, and How
+
+Most types of terminal have commands that take longer to execute than they
+do to send over a high-speed line. For example, clearing the screen may
+take 20msec once the entire command is received. During that time, on a
+9600 bps line, the terminal could receive about 20 additional output
+characters while still busy clearing the screen. Every terminal has a
+certain amount of buffering capacity to remember output characters that
+cannot be processed yet, but too many slow commands in a row can cause the
+buffer to fill up. Then any additional output that cannot be processed
+immediately will be lost.
+
+To avoid this problem, we normally follow each display command with enough
+useless charaters (usually null characters) to fill up the time that the
+display command needs to execute. This does the job if the terminal throws
+away null characters without using up space in the buffer (which most
+terminals do). If enough padding is used, no output can ever be lost. The
+right amount of padding avoids loss of output without slowing down
+operation, since the time used to transmit padding is time that nothing
+else could be done.
+
+The number of padding characters needed for an operation depends on the
+line speed. In fact, it is proportional to the line speed. A 9600 baud
+line transmits about one character per msec, so the clear screen command in
+the example above would need about 20 characters of padding. At 1200 baud,
+however, only about 3 characters of padding are needed to fill up 20msec.
+
+@node Not Enough, Describe Padding, Why Pad, Padding
+@subsection When There Is Not Enough Padding
+
+There are several common manifestations of insufficient padding.
+
+@itemize @bullet
+@item
+Emacs displays @samp{I-search: ^Q-} at the bottom of the screen.
+
+This means that the terminal thought its buffer was getting full of
+display commands, so it tried to tell the computer to stop sending
+any.
+
+@item
+The screen is garbled intermittently, or the details of garbling vary
+when you repeat the action. (A garbled screen could be due to a
+command which is simply incorrect, or to user option in the terminal
+which doesn't match the assumptions of the terminal description, but
+this usually leads to reproducible failure.)
+
+This means that the buffer did get full, and some commands were lost.
+Many changeable factors can change which ones are lost.
+
+@item
+Screen is garbled at high output speeds but not at low speeds.
+Padding problems nearly always go away at low speeds, usually even at
+1200 baud.
+
+This means that a high enough speed permits commands to arrive faster
+than they can be executed.
+@end itemize
+
+Although any obscure command on an obscure terminal might lack padding,
+in practice problems arise most often from the clearing commands
+@samp{cl} and @samp{cd} (@pxref{Clearing}), the scrolling commands
+@samp{sf} and @samp{sr} (@pxref{Scrolling}), and the line insert/delete
+commands @samp{al} and @samp{dl} (@pxref{Insdel Line}).
+
+Occasionally the terminal description fails to define @samp{sf} and some
+programs will use @samp{do} instead, so you may get a problem with
+@samp{do}. If so, first define @samp{sf} just like @samp{do}, then
+add some padding to @samp{sf}.
+
+The best strategy is to add a lot of padding at first, perhaps 200 msec.
+This is much more than enough; in fact, it should cause a visible slowdown.
+(If you don't see a slowdown, the change has not taken effect;
+@pxref{Changing}.) If this makes the problem go away, you have found the
+right place to add padding; now reduce the amount until the problem comes
+back, then increase it again. If the problem remains, either it is in some
+other capability or it is not a matter of padding at all.
+
+Keep in mind that on many terminals the correct padding for insert/delete
+line or for scrolling is cursor-position dependent. If you get problems
+from scrolling a large region of the screen but not from scrolling a small
+part (just a few lines moving), it may mean that fixed padding should be
+replaced with position-dependent padding.
+
+@node Describe Padding, Output Padding, Not Enough, Padding
+@subsection Specifying Padding in a Terminal Description
+
+In the terminal description, the amount of padding required by each display
+command is recorded as a sequence of digits at the front of the command.
+These digits specify the padding time in milliseconds (msec). They can be
+followed optionally by a decimal point and one more digit, which is a
+number of tenths of msec.
+
+Sometimes the padding needed by a command depends on the cursor position.
+For example, the time taken by an ``insert line'' command is usually
+proportional to the number of lines that need to be moved down or cleared.
+An asterisk (@samp{*}) following the padding time says that the time
+should be multiplied by the number of screen lines affected by the command.
+
+@example
+:al=1.3*\E[L:
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+is used to describe the ``insert line'' command for a certain terminal.
+The padding required is 1.3 msec per line affected. The command itself is
+@samp{@key{ESC} [ L}.
+
+The padding time specified in this way tells @code{tputs} how many pad
+characters to output. @xref{Output Padding}.
+
+Two special capability values affect padding for all commands. These are
+the @samp{pc} and @samp{pb}. The variable @samp{pc} specifies the
+character to pad with, and @samp{pb} the speed below which no padding is
+needed. The defaults for these variables, a null character and 0,
+are correct for most terminals. @xref{Pad Specs}.
+
+@node Output Padding, , Describe Padding, Padding
+@subsection Performing Padding with @code{tputs}
+@cindex line speed
+
+@findex tputs
+Use the termcap function @code{tputs} to output a string containing an
+optional padding spec of the form described above (@pxref{Describe
+Padding}). The function @code{tputs} strips off and decodes the padding
+spec, outputs the rest of the string, and then outputs the appropriate
+padding. Here is its declaration in ANSI C:
+
+@example
+char PC;
+short ospeed;
+
+int tputs (char *@var{string}, int @var{nlines}, int (*@var{outfun}) ());
+@end example
+
+Here @var{string} is the string (including padding spec) to be output;
+@var{nlines} is the number of lines affected by the operation, which is
+used to multiply the amount of padding if the padding spec ends with a
+@samp{*}. Finally, @var{outfun} is a function (such as @code{fputchar})
+that is called to output each character. When actually called,
+@var{outfun} should expect one argument, a character.
+
+@vindex ospeed
+@vindex PC
+The operation of @code{tputs} is controlled by two global variables,
+@code{ospeed} and @code{PC}. The value of @code{ospeed} is supposed to be
+the terminal output speed, encoded as in the @code{ioctl} system call which
+gets the speed information. This is needed to compute the number of
+padding characters. The value of @code{PC} is the character used for
+padding.
+
+You are responsible for storing suitable values into these variables before
+using @code{tputs}. The value stored into the @code{PC} variable should be
+taken from the @samp{pc} capability in the terminal description (@pxref{Pad
+Specs}). Store zero in @code{PC} if there is no @samp{pc}
+capability.@refill
+
+The argument @var{nlines} requires some thought. Normally, it should be
+the number of lines whose contents will be cleared or moved by the command.
+For cursor motion commands, or commands that do editing within one line,
+use the value 1. For most commands that affect multiple lines, such as
+@samp{al} (insert a line) and @samp{cd} (clear from the cursor to the end
+of the screen), @var{nlines} should be the screen height minus the current
+vertical position (origin 0). For multiple insert and scroll commands such
+as @samp{AL} (insert multiple lines), that same value for @var{nlines} is
+correct; the number of lines being inserted is @i{not} correct.@refill
+
+If a ``scroll window'' feature is used to reduce the number of lines
+affected by a command, the value of @var{nlines} should take this into
+account. This is because the delay time required depends on how much work
+the terminal has to do, and the scroll window feature reduces the work.
+@xref{Scrolling}.
+
+Commands such as @samp{ic} and @samp{dc} (insert or delete characters) are
+problematical because the padding needed by these commands is proportional
+to the number of characters affected, which is the number of columns from
+the cursor to the end of the line. It would be nice to have a way to
+specify such a dependence, and there is no need for dependence on vertical
+position in these commands, so it is an obvious idea to say that for these
+commands @var{nlines} should really be the number of columns affected.
+However, the definition of termcap clearly says that @var{nlines} is always
+the number of lines affected, even in this case, where it is always 1. It
+is not easy to change this rule now, because too many programs and terminal
+descriptions have been written to follow it.
+
+Because @var{nlines} is always 1 for the @samp{ic} and @samp{dc} strings,
+there is no reason for them to use @samp{*}, but some of them do. These
+should be corrected by deleting the @samp{*}. If, some day, such entries
+have disappeared, it may be possible to change to a more useful convention
+for the @var{nlines} argument for these operations without breaking any
+programs.
+
+@node Parameters, , Padding, Library
+@section Filling In Parameters
+@cindex parameters
+
+Some terminal control strings require numeric @dfn{parameters}. For
+example, when you move the cursor, you need to say what horizontal and
+vertical positions to move it to. The value of the terminal's @samp{cm}
+capability, which says how to move the cursor, cannot simply be a string of
+characters; it must say how to express the cursor position numbers and
+where to put them within the command.
+
+The specifications of termcap include conventions as to which string-valued
+capabilities require parameters, how many parameters, and what the
+parameters mean; for example, it defines the @samp{cm} string to take
+two parameters, the vertical and horizontal positions, with 0,0 being the
+upper left corner. These conventions are described where the individual
+commands are documented.
+
+Termcap also defines a language used within the capability definition for
+specifying how and where to encode the parameters for output. This language
+uses character sequences starting with @samp{%}. (This is the same idea as
+@code{printf}, but the details are different.) The language for parameter
+encoding is described in this section.
+
+A program that is doing display output calls the functions @code{tparam} or
+@code{tgoto} to encode parameters according to the specifications. These
+functions produce a string containing the actual commands to be output (as
+well a padding spec which must be processed with @code{tputs};
+@pxref{Padding}).
+
+@menu
+* Encode Parameters:: The language for encoding parameters.
+* Using Parameters:: Outputting a string command with parameters.
+@end menu
+
+@node Encode Parameters, Using Parameters, , Parameters
+@subsection Describing the Encoding
+@cindex %
+
+A terminal command string that requires parameters contains special
+character sequences starting with @samp{%} to say how to encode the
+parameters. These sequences control the actions of @code{tparam} and
+@code{tgoto}.
+
+The parameters values passed to @code{tparam} or @code{tgoto} are
+considered to form a vector. A pointer into this vector determines
+the next parameter to be processed. Some of the @samp{%}-sequences
+encode one parameter and advance the pointer to the next parameter.
+Other @samp{%}-sequences alter the pointer or alter the parameter
+values without generating output.
+
+For example, the @samp{cm} string for a standard ANSI terminal is written
+as @samp{\E[%i%d;%dH}. (@samp{\E} stands for @key{ESC}.) @samp{cm} by
+convention always requires two parameters, the vertical and horizontal goal
+positions, so this string specifies the encoding of two parameters. Here
+@samp{%i} increments the two values supplied, and each @samp{%d} encodes
+one of the values in decimal. If the cursor position values 20,58 are
+encoded with this string, the result is @samp{\E[21;59H}.
+
+First, here are the @samp{%}-sequences that generate output. Except for
+@samp{%%}, each of them encodes one parameter and advances the pointer
+to the following parameter.
+
+@table @samp
+@item %%
+Output a single @samp{%}. This is the only way to represent a literal
+@samp{%} in a terminal command with parameters. @samp{%%} does not
+use up a parameter.
+
+@item %d
+As in @code{printf}, output the next parameter in decimal.
+
+@item %2
+Like @samp{%02d} in @code{printf}: output the next parameter in
+decimal, and always use at least two digits.
+
+@item %3
+Like @samp{%03d} in @code{printf}: output the next parameter in
+decimal, and always use at least three digits. Note that @samp{%4}
+and so on are @emph{not} defined.
+
+@item %.
+Output the next parameter as a single character whose ASCII code is
+the parameter value. Like @samp{%c} in @code{printf}.
+
+@item %+@var{char}
+Add the next parameter to the character @var{char}, and output the
+resulting character. For example, @samp{%+ } represents 0 as a space,
+1 as @samp{!}, etc.
+@end table
+
+The following @samp{%}-sequences specify alteration of the parameters
+(their values, or their order) rather than encoding a parameter for output.
+They generate no output; they are used only for their side effects
+on the parameters. Also, they do not advance the ``next parameter'' pointer
+except as explicitly stated. Only @samp{%i}, @samp{%r} and @samp{%>} are
+defined in standard Unix termcap. The others are GNU extensions.@refill
+
+@table @samp
+@item %i
+Increment the next two parameters. This is used for terminals that
+expect cursor positions in origin 1. For example, @samp{%i%d,%d} would
+output two parameters with @samp{1} for 0, @samp{2} for 1, etc.
+
+@item %r
+Interchange the next two parameters. This is used for terminals whose
+cursor positioning command expects the horizontal position first.
+
+@item %s
+Skip the next parameter. Do not output anything.
+
+@item %b
+Back up one parameter. The last parameter used will become once again
+the next parameter to be output, and the next output command will use
+it. Using @samp{%b} more than once, you can back up any number of
+parameters, and you can refer to each parameter any number of times.
+
+@item %>@var{c1}@var{c2}
+Conditionally increment the next parameter. Here @var{c1} and
+@var{c2} are characters which stand for their ASCII codes as numbers.
+If the next parameter is greater than the ASCII code of @var{c1}, the
+ASCII code of @var{c2} is added to it.@refill
+
+@item %a @var{op} @var{type} @var{pos}
+Perform arithmetic on the next parameter, do not use it up, and do not
+output anything. Here @var{op} specifies the arithmetic operation,
+while @var{type} and @var{pos} together specify the other operand.
+
+Spaces are used above to separate the operands for clarity; the spaces
+don't appear in the data base, where this sequence is exactly five
+characters long.
+
+The character @var{op} says what kind of arithmetic operation to
+perform. It can be any of these characters:
+
+@table @samp
+@item =
+assign a value to the next parameter, ignoring its old value.
+The new value comes from the other operand.
+
+@item +
+add the other operand to the next parameter.
+
+@item -
+subtract the other operand from the next parameter.
+
+@item *
+multiply the next parameter by the other operand.
+
+@item /
+divide the next parameter by the other operand.
+@end table
+
+The ``other operand'' may be another parameter's value or a constant;
+the character @var{type} says which. It can be:
+
+@table @samp
+@item p
+Use another parameter. The character @var{pos} says which
+parameter to use. Subtract 64 from its ASCII code to get the
+position of the desired parameter relative to this one. Thus,
+the character @samp{A} as @var{pos} means the parameter after the
+next one; the character @samp{?} means the parameter before the
+next one.
+
+@item c
+Use a constant value. The character @var{pos} specifies the
+value of the constant. The 0200 bit is cleared out, so that 0200
+can be used to represent zero.
+@end table
+@end table
+
+The following @samp{%}-sequences are special purpose hacks to compensate
+for the weird designs of obscure terminals. They modify the next parameter
+or the next two parameters but do not generate output and do not use up any
+parameters. @samp{%m} is a GNU extension; the others are defined in
+standard Unix termcap.
+
+@table @samp
+@item %n
+Exclusive-or the next parameter with 0140, and likewise the parameter
+after next.
+
+@item %m
+Complement all the bits of the next parameter and the parameter after next.
+
+@item %B
+Encode the next parameter in BCD. It alters the value of the
+parameter by adding six times the quotient of the parameter by ten.
+Here is a C statement that shows how the new value is computed:
+
+@example
+@var{parm} = (@var{parm} / 10) * 16 + @var{parm} % 10;
+@end example
+
+@item %D
+Transform the next parameter as needed by Delta Data terminals.
+This involves subtracting twice the remainder of the parameter by 16.
+
+@example
+@var{parm} -= 2 * (@var{parm} % 16);
+@end example
+@end table
+
+@node Using Parameters, , Encode Parameters, Parameters
+@subsection Sending Display Commands with Parameters
+
+The termcap library functions @code{tparam} and @code{tgoto} serve as the
+analog of @code{printf} for terminal string parameters. The newer function
+@code{tparam} is a GNU extension, more general but missing from Unix
+termcap. The original parameter-encoding function is @code{tgoto}, which
+is preferable for cursor motion.
+
+@menu
+* tparam:: The general case, for GNU termcap only.
+* tgoto:: The special case of cursor motion.
+@end menu
+
+@node tparam, tgoto, , Using Parameters
+@subsubsection @code{tparam}
+
+@findex tparam
+The function @code{tparam} can encode display commands with any number of
+parameters and allows you to specify the buffer space. It is the preferred
+function for encoding parameters for all but the @samp{cm} capability. Its
+ANSI C declaration is as follows:
+
+@smallexample
+char *tparam (char *@var{ctlstring}, char *@var{buffer}, int @var{size}, int @var{parm1},...)
+@end smallexample
+
+The arguments are a control string @var{ctlstring} (the value of a terminal
+capability, presumably), an output buffer @var{buffer} and @var{size}, and
+any number of integer parameters to be encoded. The effect of
+@code{tparam} is to copy the control string into the buffer, encoding
+parameters according to the @samp{%} sequences in the control string.
+
+You describe the output buffer by its address, @var{buffer}, and its size
+in bytes, @var{size}. If the buffer is not big enough for the data to be
+stored in it, @code{tparam} calls @code{malloc} to get a larger buffer. In
+either case, @code{tparam} returns the address of the buffer it ultimately
+uses. If the value equals @var{buffer}, your original buffer was used.
+Otherwise, a new buffer was allocated, and you must free it after you are
+done with printing the results. If you pass zero for @var{size} and
+@var{buffer}, @code{tparam} always allocates the space with @code{malloc}.
+
+All capabilities that require parameters also have the ability to specify
+padding, so you should use @code{tputs} to output the string produced by
+@code{tparam}. @xref{Padding}. Here is an example.
+
+@example
+@{
+char *buf;
+char buffer[40];
+
+buf = tparam (command, buffer, 40, parm);
+tputs (buf, 1, fputchar);
+if (buf != buffer)
+free (buf);
+@}
+@end example
+
+If a parameter whose value is zero is encoded with @samp{%.}-style
+encoding, the result is a null character, which will confuse @code{tputs}.
+This would be a serious problem, but luckily @samp{%.} encoding is used
+only by a few old models of terminal, and only for the @samp{cm}
+capability. To solve the problem, use @code{tgoto} rather than
+@code{tparam} to encode the @samp{cm} capability.@refill
+
+@node tgoto, , tparam, Using Parameters
+@subsubsection @code{tgoto}
+
+@findex tgoto
+The special case of cursor motion is handled by @code{tgoto}. There
+are two reasons why you might choose to use @code{tgoto}:
+
+@itemize @bullet
+@item
+For Unix compatibility, because Unix termcap does not have @code{tparam}.
+
+@item
+For the @samp{cm} capability, since @code{tgoto} has a special feature
+to avoid problems with null characters, tabs and newlines on certain old
+terminal types that use @samp{%.} encoding for that capability.
+@end itemize
+
+Here is how @code{tgoto} might be declared in ANSI C:
+
+@example
+char *tgoto (char *@var{cstring}, int @var{hpos}, int @var{vpos})
+@end example
+
+There are three arguments, the terminal description's @samp{cm} string and
+the two cursor position numbers; @code{tgoto} computes the parametrized
+string in an internal static buffer and returns the address of that buffer.
+The next time you use @code{tgoto} the same buffer will be reused.
+
+@vindex UP
+@vindex BC
+Parameters encoded with @samp{%.} encoding can generate null characters,
+tabs or newlines. These might cause trouble: the null character because
+@code{tputs} would think that was the end of the string, the tab because
+the kernel or other software might expand it into spaces, and the newline
+becaue the kernel might add a carriage-return, or padding characters
+normally used for a newline. To prevent such problems, @code{tgoto} is
+careful to avoid these characters. Here is how this works: if the target
+cursor position value is such as to cause a problem (that is to say, zero,
+nine or ten), @code{tgoto} increments it by one, then compensates by
+appending a string to move the cursor back or up one position.
+
+The compensation strings to use for moving back or up are found in global
+variables named @code{BC} and @code{UP}. These are actual external C
+variables with upper case names; they are declared @code{char *}. It is up
+to you to store suitable values in them, normally obtained from the
+@samp{le} and @samp{up} terminal capabilities in the terminal description
+with @code{tgetstr}. Alternatively, if these two variables are both zero,
+the feature of avoiding nulls, tabs and newlines is turned off.
+
+It is safe to use @code{tgoto} for commands other than @samp{cm} only if
+you have stored zero in @code{BC} and @code{UP}.
+
+Note that @code{tgoto} reverses the order of its operands: the horizontal
+position comes before the vertical position in the arguments to
+@code{tgoto}, even though the vertical position comes before the horizontal
+in the parameters of the @samp{cm} string. If you use @code{tgoto} with a
+command such as @samp{AL} that takes one parameter, you must pass the
+parameter to @code{tgoto} as the ``vertical position''.@refill
+
+@node Data Base, Capabilities, Library, Top
+@chapter The Format of the Data Base
+
+The termcap data base of terminal descriptions is stored in the file
+@file{/etc/termcap}. It contains terminal descriptions, blank lines, and
+comments.
+
+A terminal description starts with one or more names for the terminal type.
+The information in the description is a series of @dfn{capability names}
+and values. The capability names have standard meanings
+(@pxref{Capabilities}) and their values describe the terminal.
+
+@menu
+* Format:: Overall format of a terminal description.
+* Capability Format:: Format of capabilities within a description.
+* Naming:: Naming conventions for terminal types.
+* Inheriting:: Inheriting part of a description from
+a related terminal type.
+* Changing:: When changes in the data base take effect.
+@end menu
+
+@node Format, Capability Format, , Data Base
+@section Terminal Description Format
+@cindex description format
+
+Aside from comments (lines starting with @samp{#}, which are ignored), each
+nonblank line in the termcap data base is a terminal description.
+A terminal description is nominally a single line, but it can be split
+into multiple lines by inserting the two characters @samp{\ newline}.
+This sequence is ignored wherever it appears in a description.
+
+The preferred way to split the description is between capabilities: insert
+the four characters @samp{: \ newline tab} immediately before any colon.
+This allows each sub-line to start with some indentation. This works
+because, after the @samp{\ newline} are ignored, the result is @samp{: tab
+:}; the first colon ends the preceding capability and the second colon
+starts the next capability. If you split with @samp{\ newline} alone, you
+may not add any indentation after them.
+
+Here is a real example of a terminal description:
+
+@example
+dw|vt52|DEC vt52:\
+ :cr=^M:do=^J:nl=^J:bl=^G:\
+ :le=^H:bs:cd=\EJ:ce=\EK:cl=\EH\EJ:\
+ :cm=\EY%+ %+ :co#80:li#24:\
+ :nd=\EC:ta=^I:pt:sr=\EI:up=\EA:\
+ :ku=\EA:kd=\EB:kr=\EC:kl=\ED:kb=^H:
+@end example
+
+Each terminal description begins with several names for the terminal type.
+The names are separated by @samp{|} characters, and a colon ends the last
+name. The first name should be two characters long; it exists only for the
+sake of very old Unix systems and is never used in modern systems. The
+last name should be a fully verbose name such as ``DEC vt52'' or ``Ann
+Arbor Ambassador with 48 lines''. The other names should include whatever
+the user ought to be able to specify to get this terminal type, such as
+@samp{vt52} or @samp{aaa-48}. @xref{Naming}, for information on how to
+choose terminal type names.
+
+After the terminal type names come the terminal capabilities, separated by
+colons and with a colon after the last one. Each capability has a
+two-letter name, such as @samp{cm} for ``cursor motion string'' or @samp{li}
+for ``number of display lines''.
+
+@node Capability Format, Naming, Format, Data Base
+@section Writing the Capabilities
+
+There are three kinds of capabilities: flags, numbers, and strings. Each
+kind has its own way of being written in the description. Each defined
+capability has by convention a particular kind of value; for example,
+@samp{li} always has a numeric value and @samp{cm} always a string value.
+
+A flag capability is thought of as having a boolean value: the value is
+true if the capability is present, false if not. When the capability is
+present, just write its name between two colons.
+
+A numeric capability has a value which is a nonnegative number. Write the
+capability name, a @samp{#}, and the number, between two colons. For
+example, @samp{@dots{}:li#48:@dots{}} is how you specify the @samp{li}
+capability for 48 lines.@refill
+
+A string-valued capability has a value which is a sequence of characters.
+Usually these are the characters used to perform some display operation.
+Write the capability name, a @samp{=}, and the characters of the value,
+between two colons. For example, @samp{@dots{}:cm=\E[%i%d;%dH:@dots{}} is
+how the cursor motion command for a standard ANSI terminal would be
+specified.@refill
+
+Special characters in the string value can be expressed using
+@samp{\}-escape sequences as in C; in addition, @samp{\E} stands for
+@key{ESC}. @samp{^} is also a kind of escape character; @samp{^} followed
+by @var{char} stands for the control-equivalent of @var{char}. Thus,
+@samp{^a} stands for the character control-a, just like @samp{\001}.
+@samp{\} and @samp{^} themselves can be represented as @samp{\\} and
+@samp{\^}.@refill
+
+To include a colon in the string, you must write @samp{\072}. You might
+ask, ``Why can't @samp{\:} be used to represent a colon?'' The reason is
+that the interrogation functions do not count slashes while looking for a
+capability. Even if @samp{:ce=ab\:cd:} were interpreted as giving the
+@samp{ce} capability the value @samp{ab:cd}, it would also appear to define
+@samp{cd} as a flag.
+
+The string value will often contain digits at the front to specify padding
+(@pxref{Padding}) and/or @samp{%}-sequences within to specify how to encode
+parameters (@pxref{Parameters}). Although these things are not to be
+output literally to the terminal, they are considered part of the value of
+the capability. They are special only when the string value is processed
+by @code{tputs}, @code{tparam} or @code{tgoto}. By contrast, @samp{\} and
+@samp{^} are considered part of the syntax for specifying the characters
+in the string.
+
+Let's look at the VT52 example again:
+
+@example
+dw|vt52|DEC vt52:\
+ :cr=^M:do=^J:nl=^J:bl=^G:\
+ :le=^H:bs:cd=\EJ:ce=\EK:cl=\EH\EJ:\
+ :cm=\EY%+ %+ :co#80:li#24:\
+ :nd=\EC:ta=^I:pt:sr=\EI:up=\EA:\
+ :ku=\EA:kd=\EB:kr=\EC:kl=\ED:kb=^H:
+@end example
+
+Here we see the numeric-valued capabilities @samp{co} and @samp{li}, the
+flags @samp{bs} and @samp{pt}, and many string-valued capabilities. Most
+of the strings start with @key{ESC} represented as @samp{\E}. The rest
+contain control characters represented using @samp{^}. The meanings of the
+individual capabilities are defined elsewhere (@pxref{Capabilities}).
+
+@node Naming, Inheriting, Capability Format, Data Base
+@section Terminal Type Name Conventions
+@cindex names of terminal types
+
+There are conventions for choosing names of terminal types. For one thing,
+all letters should be in lower case. The terminal type for a terminal in
+its most usual or most fundamental mode of operation should not have a
+hyphen in it.
+
+If the same terminal has other modes of operation which require
+different terminal descriptions, these variant descriptions are given
+names made by adding suffixes with hyphens. Such alternate descriptions
+are used for two reasons:
+
+@itemize @bullet
+@item
+When the terminal has a switch that changes its behavior. Since the
+computer cannot tell how the switch is set, the user must tell the
+computer by choosing the appropriate terminal type name.
+
+@cindex wrapping
+For example, the VT-100 has a setup flag that controls whether the
+cursor wraps at the right margin. If this flag is set to ``wrap'',
+you must use the terminal type @samp{vt100-am}. Otherwise you must
+use @samp{vt100-nam}. Plain @samp{vt100} is defined as a synonym for
+either @samp{vt100-am} or @samp{vt100-nam} depending on the
+preferences of the local site.@refill
+
+The standard suffix @samp{-am} stands for ``automatic margins''.
+
+@item
+To give the user a choice in how to use the terminal. This is done
+when the terminal has a switch that the computer normally controls.
+
+@cindex screen size
+For example, the Ann Arbor Ambassador can be configured with many
+screen sizes ranging from 20 to 60 lines. Fewer lines make bigger
+characters but more lines let you see more of what you are editing.
+As a result, users have different preferences. Therefore, termcap
+provides terminal types for many screen sizes. If you choose type
+@samp{aaa-30}, the terminal will be configured to use 30 lines; if you
+choose @samp{aaa-48}, 48 lines will be used, and so on.
+@end itemize
+
+Here is a list of standard suffixes and their conventional meanings:
+
+@table @samp
+@item -w
+Short for ``wide''. This is a mode that gives the terminal more
+columns than usual. This is normally a user option.
+
+@item -am
+``Automatic margins''. This is an alternate description for use when
+the terminal's margin-wrap switch is on; it contains the @samp{am}
+flag. The implication is that normally the switch is off and the
+usual description for the terminal says that the switch is off.
+
+@item -nam
+``No automatic margins''. The opposite of @samp{-am}, this names an
+alternative description which lacks the @samp{am} flag. This implies
+that the terminal is normally operated with the margin-wrap switch
+turned on, and the normal description of the terminal says so.
+
+@item -na
+``No arrows''. This terminal description initializes the terminal to
+keep its arrow keys in local mode. This is a user option.
+
+@item -rv
+``Reverse video''. This terminal description causes text output for
+normal video to appear as reverse, and text output for reverse video
+to come out as normal. Often this description differs from the usual
+one by interchanging the two strings which turn reverse video on and
+off.@refill
+
+This is a user option; you can choose either the ``reverse video''
+variant terminal type or the normal terminal type, and termcap will
+obey.
+
+@item -s
+``Status''. Says to enable use of a status line which ordinary output
+does not touch (@pxref{Status Line}).
+
+Some terminals have a special line that is used only as a status line.
+For these terminals, there is no need for an @samp{-s} variant; the
+status line commands should be defined by default. On other
+terminals, enabling a status line means removing one screen line from
+ordinary use and reducing the effective screen height. For these
+terminals, the user can choose the @samp{-s} variant type to request
+use of a status line.
+
+@item -@var{nlines}
+Says to operate with @var{nlines} lines on the screen, for terminals
+such as the Ambassador which provide this as an option. Normally this
+is a user option; by choosing the terminal type, you control how many
+lines termcap will use.
+
+@item -@var{npages}p
+Says that the terminal has @var{npages} pages worth of screen memory,
+for terminals where this is a hardware option.
+
+@item -unk
+Says that description is not for direct use, but only for reference in
+@samp{tc} capabilities. Such a description is a kind of subroutine,
+because it describes the common characteristics of several variant
+descriptions that would use other suffixes in place of @samp{-unk}.
+@end table
+
+@node Inheriting, Changing, Naming, Data Base
+@section Inheriting from Related Descriptions
+
+@cindex inheritance
+When two terminal descriptions are similar, their identical parts do not
+need to be given twice. Instead, one of the two can be defined in terms of
+the other, using the @samp{tc} capability. We say that one description
+@dfn{refers to} the other, or @dfn{inherits from} the other.
+
+The @samp{tc} capability must be the last one in the terminal description,
+and its value is a string which is the name of another terminal type which
+is referred to. For example,
+
+@example
+N9|aaa|ambassador|aaa-30|ann arbor ambassador/30 lines:\
+ :ti=\E[2J\E[30;0;0;30p:\
+ :te=\E[60;0;0;30p\E[30;1H\E[J:\
+ :li#30:tc=aaa-unk:
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+defines the terminal type @samp{aaa-30} (also known as plain @samp{aaa}) in
+terms of @samp{aaa-unk}, which defines everything about the Ambassador that
+is independent of screen height. The types @samp{aaa-36}, @samp{aaa-48}
+and so on for other screen heights are likewise defined to inherit from
+@samp{aaa-unk}.
+
+The capabilities overridden by @samp{aaa-30} include @samp{li}, which says
+how many lines there are, and @samp{ti} and @samp{te}, which configure the
+terminal to use that many lines.
+
+The effective terminal description for type @samp{aaa} consists of the text
+shown above followed by the text of the description of @samp{aaa-unk}. The
+@samp{tc} capability is handled automatically by @code{tgetent}, which
+finds the description thus referenced and combines the two descriptions
+(@pxref{Find}). Therefore, only the implementor of the terminal
+descriptions needs to think about using @samp{tc}. Users and application
+programmers do not need to be concerned with it.
+
+Since the reference terminal description is used last, capabilities
+specified in the referring description override any specifications of the
+same capabilities in the reference description.
+
+The referring description can cancel out a capability without specifying
+any new value for it by means of a special trick. Write the capability in
+the referring description, with the character @samp{@@} after the capability
+name, as follows:
+
+@smallexample
+NZ|aaa-30-nam|ann arbor ambassador/30 lines/no automatic-margins:\
+ :am@@:tc=aaa-30:
+@end smallexample
+
+@node Changing, , Inheriting, Data Base
+@section When Changes in the Data Base Take Effect
+
+Each application program must read the terminal description from the
+data base, so a change in the data base is effective for all jobs started
+after the change is made.
+
+The change will usually have no effect on a job that have been in existence
+since before the change. The program probably read the terminal description
+once, when it was started, and is continuing to use what it read then.
+If the program does not have a feature for reexamining the data base, then
+you will need to run it again (probably killing the old job).
+
+If the description in use is coming from the @code{TERMCAP} environment
+variable, then the data base file is effectively overridden, and changes in
+it will have no effect until you change the @code{TERMCAP} variable as
+well. For example, some users' @file{.login} files automatically copy the
+terminal description into @code{TERMCAP} to speed startup of applications.
+If you have done this, you will need to change the @code{TERMCAP} variable
+to make the changed data base take effect.
+
+@node Capabilities, Summary, Data Base, Top
+@chapter Definitions of the Terminal Capabilities
+
+This section is divided into many subsections, each for one aspect of
+use of display terminals. For writing a display program, you usually need
+only check the subsections for the operations you want to use. For writing
+a terminal description, you must read each subsection and fill in the
+capabilities described there.
+
+String capabilities that are display commands may require numeric
+parameters (@pxref{Parameters}). Most such capabilities do not use
+parameters. When a capability requires parameters, this is explicitly
+stated at the beginning of its definition. In simple cases, the first or
+second sentence of the definition mentions all the parameters, in the order
+they should be given, using a name
+@iftex
+in italics
+@end iftex
+@ifinfo
+in upper case
+@end ifinfo
+for each one. For example, the @samp{rp} capability is a command that
+requires two parameters; its definition begins as follows:
+
+@quotation
+String of commands to output a graphic character @var{c}, repeated @var{n}
+times.
+@end quotation
+
+In complex cases or when there are many parameters, they are described
+explicitly.
+
+When a capability is described as obsolete, this means that programs should
+not be written to look for it, but terminal descriptions should still be
+written to provide it.
+
+When a capability is described as very obsolete, this means that it should
+be omitted from terminal descriptions as well.
+
+@menu
+* Basic:: Basic characteristics.
+* Screen Size:: Screen size, and what happens when it changes.
+* Cursor Motion:: Various ways to move the cursor.
+* Wrapping:: What happens if you write a character in the last column.
+* Scrolling:: Pushing text up and down on the screen.
+* Windows:: Limiting the part of the window that output affects.
+* Clearing:: Erasing one or many lines.
+* Insdel Line:: Making new blank lines in mid-screen; deleting lines.
+* Insdel Char:: Inserting and deleting characters within a line.
+* Standout:: Highlighting some of the text.
+* Underlining:: Underlining some of the text.
+* Cursor Visibility:: Making the cursor more or less easy to spot.
+* Bell:: Attracts user's attention; not localized on the screen.
+* Keypad:: Recognizing when function keys or arrows are typed.
+* Meta Key:: @key{META} acts like an extra shift key.
+* Initialization:: Commands used to initialize or reset the terminal.
+* Pad Specs:: Info for the kernel on how much padding is needed.
+* Status Line:: A status line displays ``background'' information.
+* Half-Line:: Moving by half-lines, for superscripts and subscripts.
+* Printer:: Controlling auxiliary printers of display terminals.
+@end menu
+
+@node Basic, Screen Size, , Capabilities
+@section Basic Characteristics
+
+This section documents the capabilities that describe the basic and
+nature of the terminal, and also those that are relevant to the output
+of graphic characters.
+
+@table @samp
+@item os
+@kindex os
+@cindex overstrike
+Flag whose presence means that the terminal can overstrike. This
+means that outputting a graphic character does not erase whatever was
+present in the same character position before. The terminals that can
+overstrike include printing terminals, storage tubes (all obsolete
+nowadays), and many bit-map displays.
+
+@item eo
+@kindex eo
+Flag whose presence means that outputting a space erases a character
+position even if the terminal supports overstriking. If this flag is
+not present and overstriking is supported, output of a space has no
+effect except to move the cursor.
+
+(On terminals that do not support overstriking, you can always assume
+that outputting a space at a position erases whatever character was
+previously displayed there.)
+
+@item gn
+@kindex gn
+@cindex generic terminal type
+Flag whose presence means that this terminal type is a generic type
+which does not really describe any particular terminal. Generic types
+are intended for use as the default type assigned when the user
+connects to the system, with the intention that the user should
+specify what type he really has. One example of a generic type
+is the type @samp{network}.
+
+Since the generic type cannot say how to do anything interesting with
+the terminal, termcap-using programs will always find that the
+terminal is too weak to be supported if the user has failed to specify
+a real terminal type in place of the generic one. The @samp{gn} flag
+directs these programs to use a different error message: ``You have
+not specified your real terminal type'', rather than ``Your terminal
+is not powerful enough to be used''.
+
+@item hc
+@kindex hc
+Flag whose presence means this is a hardcopy terminal.
+
+@item rp
+@kindex rp
+@cindex repeat output
+String of commands to output a graphic character @var{c}, repeated @var{n}
+times. The first parameter value is the ASCII code for the desired
+character, and the second parameter is the number of times to repeat the
+character. Often this command requires padding proportional to the
+number of times the character is repeated. This effect can be had by
+using parameter arithmetic with @samp{%}-sequences to compute the
+amount of padding, then generating the result as a number at the front
+of the string so that @code{tputs} will treat it as padding.
+
+@item hz
+@kindex hz
+Flag whose presence means that the ASCII character @samp{~} cannot be
+output on this terminal because it is used for display commands.
+
+Programs handle this flag by checking all text to be output and
+replacing each @samp{~} with some other character(s). If this is not
+done, the screen will be thoroughly garbled.
+
+The old Hazeltine terminals that required such treatment are probably
+very rare today, so you might as well not bother to support this flag.
+
+@item CC
+@kindex CC
+@cindex command character
+String whose presence means the terminal has a settable command
+character. The value of the string is the default command character
+(which is usually @key{ESC}).
+
+All the strings of commands in the terminal description should be
+written to use the default command character. If you are writing an
+application program that changes the command character, use the
+@samp{CC} capability to figure out how to translate all the display
+commands to work with the new command character.
+
+Most programs have no reason to look at the @samp{CC} capability.
+
+@item xb
+@kindex xb
+@cindex Superbee
+Flag whose presence identifies Superbee terminals which are unable to
+transmit the characters @key{ESC} and @kbd{Control-C}. Programs which
+support this flag are supposed to check the input for the code sequences
+sent by the @key{F1} and @key{F2} keys, and pretend that @key{ESC}
+or @kbd{Control-C} (respectively) had been read. But this flag is
+obsolete, and not worth supporting.
+@end table
+
+@node Screen Size, Cursor Motion, Basic, Capabilities
+@section Screen Size
+@cindex screen size
+
+A terminal description has two capabilities, @samp{co} and @samp{li},
+that describe the screen size in columns and lines. But there is more
+to the question of screen size than this.
+
+On some operating systems the ``screen'' is really a window and the
+effective width can vary. On some of these systems, @code{tgetnum}
+uses the actual width of the window to decide what value to return for
+the @samp{co} capability, overriding what is actually written in the
+terminal description. On other systems, it is up to the application
+program to check the actual window width using a system call. For
+example, on BSD 4.3 systems, the system call @code{ioctl} with code
+@code{TIOCGWINSZ} will tell you the current screen size.
+
+On all window systems, termcap is powerless to advise the application
+program if the user resizes the window. Application programs must
+deal with this possibility in a system-dependent fashion. On some
+systems the C shell handles part of the problem by detecting changes
+in window size and setting the @code{TERMCAP} environment variable
+appropriately. This takes care of application programs that are
+started subsequently. It does not help application programs already
+running.
+
+On some systems, including BSD 4.3, all programs using a terminal get
+a signal named @code{SIGWINCH} whenever the screen size changes.
+Programs that use termcap should handle this signal by using
+@code{ioctl TIOCGWINSZ} to learn the new screen size.
+
+@table @samp
+@item co
+@kindex co
+@cindex screen size
+Numeric value, the width of the screen in character positions. Even
+hardcopy terminals normally have a @samp{co} capability.
+
+@item li
+@kindex li
+Numeric value, the height of the screen in lines.
+@end table
+
+@node Cursor Motion, Wrapping, Screen Size, Capabilities
+@section Cursor Motion
+@cindex cursor motion
+
+Termcap assumes that the terminal has a @dfn{cursor}, a spot on the screen
+where a visible mark is displayed, and that most display commands take
+effect at the position of the cursor. It follows that moving the cursor
+to a specified location is very important.
+
+There are many terminal capabilities for different cursor motion
+operations. A terminal description should define as many as possible, but
+most programs do not need to use most of them. One capability, @samp{cm},
+moves the cursor to an arbitrary place on the screen; this by itself is
+sufficient for any application as long as there is no need to support
+hardcopy terminals or certain old, weak displays that have only relative
+motion commands. Use of other cursor motion capabilities is an
+optimization, enabling the program to output fewer characters in some
+common cases.
+
+If you plan to use the relative cursor motion commands in an application
+program, you must know what the starting cursor position is. To do this,
+you must keep track of the cursor position and update the records each
+time anything is output to the terminal, including graphic characters.
+In addition, it is necessary to know whether the terminal wraps after
+writing in the rightmost column. @xref{Wrapping}.
+
+One other motion capability needs special mention: @samp{nw} moves the
+cursor to the beginning of the following line, perhaps clearing all the
+starting line after the cursor, or perhaps not clearing at all. This
+capability is a least common denominator that is probably supported even by
+terminals that cannot do most other things such as @samp{cm} or @samp{do}.
+Even hardcopy terminals can support @samp{nw}.
+
+@table @asis
+@item @samp{cm}
+@kindex cm
+String of commands to position the cursor at line @var{l}, column @var{c}.
+Both parameters are origin-zero, and are defined relative to the
+screen, not relative to display memory.
+
+All display terminals except a few very obsolete ones support @samp{cm},
+so it is acceptable for an application program to refuse to operate on
+terminals lacking @samp{cm}.
+
+@item @samp{ho}
+@kindex ho
+@cindex home position
+String of commands to move the cursor to the upper left corner of the
+screen (this position is called the @dfn{home position}). In
+terminals where the upper left corner of the screen is not the same as
+the beginning of display memory, this command must go to the upper
+left corner of the screen, not the beginning of display memory.
+
+Every display terminal supports this capability, and many application
+programs refuse to operate if the @samp{ho} capability is missing.
+
+@item @samp{ll}
+@kindex ll
+String of commands to move the cursor to the lower left corner of the
+screen. On some terminals, moving up from home position does this,
+but programs should never assume that will work. Just output the
+@samp{ll} string (if it is provided); if moving to home position and
+then moving up is the best way to get there, the @samp{ll} command
+will do that.
+
+@item @samp{cr}
+@kindex cr
+String of commands to move the cursor to the beginning of the line it
+is on. If this capability is not specified, many programs assume
+they can use the ASCII carriage return character for this.
+
+@item @samp{le}
+@kindex le
+String of commands to move the cursor left one column. Unless the
+@samp{bw} flag capability is specified, the effect is undefined if the
+cursor is at the left margin; do not use this command there. If
+@samp{bw} is present, this command may be used at the left margin, and
+it wraps the cursor to the last column of the preceding line.
+
+@item @samp{nd}
+@kindex nd
+String of commands to move the cursor right one column. The effect is
+undefined if the cursor is at the right margin; do not use this
+command there, not even if @samp{am} is present.
+
+@item @samp{up}
+@kindex up
+String of commands to move the cursor vertically up one line. The
+effect of sending this string when on the top line is undefined;
+programs should never use it that way.
+
+@item @samp{do}
+@kindex do
+String of commands to move the cursor vertically down one line. The
+effect of sending this string when on the bottom line is undefined;
+programs should never use it that way.
+
+Some programs do use @samp{do} to scroll up one line if used at the
+bottom line, if @samp{sf} is not defined but @samp{sr} is. This is
+only to compensate for certain old, incorrect terminal descriptions.
+(In principle this might actually lead to incorrect behavior on other
+terminals, but that seems to happen rarely if ever.) But the proper
+solution is that the terminal description should define @samp{sf} as
+well as @samp{do} if the command is suitable for scrolling.
+
+The original idea was that this string would not contain a newline
+character and therefore could be used without disabling the kernel's
+usual habit of converting of newline into a carriage-return newline
+sequence. But many terminal descriptions do use newline in the
+@samp{do} string, so this is not possible; a program which sends the
+@samp{do} string must disable output conversion in the kernel
+(@pxref{Initialize}).
+
+@item @samp{bw}
+@kindex bw
+Flag whose presence says that @samp{le} may be used in column zero
+to move to the last column of the preceding line. If this flag
+is not present, @samp{le} should not be used in column zero.
+
+@item @samp{nw}
+@kindex nw
+String of commands to move the cursor to start of next line, possibly
+clearing rest of line (following the cursor) before moving.
+
+@item @samp{DO}, @samp{UP}, @samp{LE}, @samp{RI}
+@kindex DO
+@kindex LE
+@kindex RI
+@kindex UP
+Strings of commands to move the cursor @var{n} lines down vertically,
+up vertically, or @var{n} columns left or right. Do not attempt to
+move past any edge of the screen with these commands; the effect of
+trying that is undefined. Only a few terminal descriptions provide
+these commands, and most programs do not use them.
+
+@item @samp{CM}
+@kindex CM
+String of commands to position the cursor at line @var{l}, column
+@var{c}, relative to display memory. Both parameters are origin-zero.
+This capability is present only in terminals where there is a
+difference between screen-relative and memory-relative addressing, and
+not even in all such terminals.
+
+@item @samp{ch}
+@kindex ch
+String of commands to position the cursor at column @var{c} in the
+same line it is on. This is a special case of @samp{cm} in which the
+vertical position is not changed. The @samp{ch} capability is
+provided only when it is faster to output than @samp{cm} would be in
+this special case. Programs should not assume most display terminals
+have @samp{ch}.
+
+@item @samp{cv}
+@kindex cv
+String of commands to position the cursor at line @var{l} in the same
+column. This is a special case of @samp{cm} in which the horizontal
+position is not changed. The @samp{cv} capability is provided only
+when it is faster to output than @samp{cm} would be in this special
+case. Programs should not assume most display terminals have
+@samp{cv}.
+
+@item @samp{sc}
+@kindex sc
+String of commands to make the terminal save the current cursor
+position. Only the last saved position can be used. If this
+capability is present, @samp{rc} should be provided also. Most
+terminals have neither.
+
+@item @samp{rc}
+@kindex rc
+String of commands to make the terminal restore the last saved cursor
+position. If this capability is present, @samp{sc} should be provided
+also. Most terminals have neither.
+
+@item @samp{ff}
+@kindex ff
+String of commands to advance to the next page, for a hardcopy
+terminal.
+
+@item @samp{ta}
+@kindex ta
+String of commands to move the cursor right to the next hardware tab
+stop column. Missing if the terminal does not have any kind of
+hardware tabs. Do not send this command if the kernel's terminal
+modes say that the kernel is expanding tabs into spaces.
+
+@item @samp{bt}
+@kindex bt
+String of commands to move the cursor left to the previous hardware
+tab stop column. Missing if the terminal has no such ability; many
+terminals do not. Do not send this command if the kernel's terminal
+modes say that the kernel is expanding tabs into spaces.
+@end table
+
+The following obsolete capabilities should be included in terminal
+descriptions when appropriate, but should not be looked at by new programs.
+
+@table @samp
+@item nc
+@kindex nc
+Flag whose presence means the terminal does not support the ASCII
+carriage return character as @samp{cr}. This flag is needed because
+old programs assume, when the @samp{cr} capability is missing, that
+ASCII carriage return can be used for the purpose. We use @samp{nc}
+to tell the old programs that carriage return may not be used.
+
+New programs should not assume any default for @samp{cr}, so they need
+not look at @samp{nc}. However, descriptions should contain @samp{nc}
+whenever they do not contain @samp{cr}.
+
+@item xt
+@kindex xt
+Flag whose presence means that the ASCII tab character may not be used
+for cursor motion. This flag exists because old programs assume, when
+the @samp{ta} capability is missing, that ASCII tab can be used for
+the purpose. We use @samp{xt} to tell the old programs not to use tab.
+
+New programs should not assume any default for @samp{ta}, so they need
+not look at @samp{xt} in connection with cursor motion. Note that
+@samp{xt} also has implications for standout mode (@pxref{Standout}).
+It is obsolete in regard to cursor motion but not in regard to
+standout.
+
+In fact, @samp{xt} means that the terminal is a Teleray 1061.
+
+@item bc
+@kindex bc
+Very obsolete alternative name for the @samp{le} capability.
+
+@item bs
+@kindex bs
+Flag whose presence means that the ASCII character backspace may be
+used to move the cursor left. Obsolete; look at @samp{le} instead.
+
+@item nl
+@kindex nl
+Obsolete capability which is a string that can either be used to move
+the cursor down or to scroll. The same string must scroll when used
+on the bottom line and move the cursor when used on any other line.
+New programs should use @samp{do} or @samp{sf}, and ignore @samp{nl}.
+
+If there is no @samp{nl} capability, some old programs assume they can
+use the newline character for this purpose. These programs follow a
+bad practice, but because they exist, it is still desirable to define
+the @samp{nl} capability in a terminal description if the best way to
+move down is @emph{not} a newline.
+@end table
+
+@node Wrapping, Scrolling, Cursor Motion, Capabilities
+@section Wrapping
+@cindex wrapping
+
+@dfn{Wrapping} means moving the cursor from the right margin to the left
+margin of the following line. Some terminals wrap automatically when a
+graphic character is output in the last column, while others do not. Most
+application programs that use termcap need to know whether the terminal
+wraps. There are two special flag capabilities to describe what the
+terminal does when a graphic character is output in the last column.
+
+@table @samp
+@item am
+@kindex am
+Flag whose presence means that writing a character in the last column
+causes the cursor to wrap to the beginning of the next line.
+
+If @samp{am} is not present, writing in the last column leaves the
+cursor at the place where the character was written.
+
+Writing in the last column of the last line should be avoided on
+terminals with @samp{am}, as it may or may not cause scrolling to
+occur (@pxref{Scrolling}). Scrolling is surely not what you would
+intend.
+
+If your program needs to check the @samp{am} flag, then it also needs
+to check the @samp{xn} flag which indicates that wrapping happens in a
+strange way. Many common terminals have the @samp{xn} flag.
+
+@item xn
+@kindex xn
+Flag whose presence means that the cursor wraps in a strange way. At
+least two distinct kinds of strange behavior are known; the termcap
+data base does not contain anything to distinguish the two.
+
+On Concept-100 terminals, output in the last column wraps the cursor
+almost like an ordinary @samp{am} terminal. But if the next thing
+output is a newline, it is ignored.
+
+DEC VT-100 terminals (when the wrap switch is on) do a different
+strange thing: the cursor wraps only if the next thing output is
+another graphic character. In fact, the wrap occurs when the
+following graphic character is received by the terminal, before the
+character is placed on the screen.
+
+On both of these terminals, after writing in the last column a
+following graphic character will be displayed in the first column of
+the following line. But the effect of relative cursor motion
+characters such as newline or backspace at such a time depends on the
+terminal. The effect of erase or scrolling commands also depends on
+the terminal. You can't assume anything about what they will do on a
+terminal that has @samp{xn}. So, to be safe, you should never do
+these things at such a time on such a terminal.
+
+To be sure of reliable results on a terminal which has the @samp{xn}
+flag, output a @samp{cm} absolute positioning command after writing in
+the last column. Another safe thing to do is to output carriage-return
+newline, which will leave the cursor at the beginning of the following
+line.
+
+@item LP
+@kindex LP
+Flag whose presence means that it is safe to write in the last column of
+the last line without worrying about undesired scrolling. @samp{LP}
+indicates the DEC flavor of @samp{xn} strangeness.
+@end table
+
+@node Scrolling, Windows, Wrapping, Capabilities
+@section Scrolling
+@cindex scrolling
+
+@dfn{Scrolling} means moving the contents of the screen up or down one or
+more lines. Moving the contents up is @dfn{forward scrolling}; moving them
+down is @dfn{reverse scrolling}.
+
+Scrolling happens after each line of output during ordinary output on most
+display terminals. But in an application program that uses termcap for
+random-access output, scrolling happens only when explicitly requested with
+the commands in this section.
+
+Some terminals have a @dfn{scroll region} feature. This lets you limit
+the effect of scrolling to a specified range of lines. Lines outside the
+range are unaffected when scrolling happens. The scroll region feature
+is available if either @samp{cs} or @samp{cS} is present.
+
+@table @samp
+@item sf
+@kindex sf
+String of commands to scroll the screen one line up, assuming it is
+output with the cursor at the beginning of the bottom line.
+
+@item sr
+@kindex sr
+String of commands to scroll the screen one line down, assuming it is
+output with the cursor at the beginning of the top line.
+
+@item do
+A few programs will try to use @samp{do} to do the work of @samp{sf}.
+This is not really correct---it is an attempt to compensate for the
+absence of a @samp{sf} command in some old terminal descriptions.
+
+Since these terminal descriptions do define @samp{sr}, perhaps at one
+time the definition of @samp{do} was different and it could be used
+for scrolling as well. But it isn't desirable to combine these two
+functions in one capability, since scrolling often requires more
+padding than simply moving the cursor down. Defining @samp{sf} and
+@samp{do} separately allows you to specify the padding properly.
+Also, all sources agree that @samp{do} should not be relied on to do
+scrolling.
+
+So the best approach is to add @samp{sf} capabilities to the
+descriptions of these terminals, copying the definition of @samp{do}
+if that does scroll.
+
+@item SF
+@kindex SF
+String of commands to scroll the screen @var{n} lines up, assuming it
+is output with the cursor at the beginning of the bottom line.
+
+@item SR
+@kindex SR
+String of commands to scroll the screen @var{n} lines down, assuming it
+is output with the cursor at the beginning of the top line.
+
+@item cs
+@kindex cs
+String of commands to set the scroll region. This command takes two
+parameters, @var{start} and @var{end}, which are the line numbers
+(origin-zero) of the first line to include in the scroll region and of
+the last line to include in it. When a scroll region is set,
+scrolling is limited to the specified range of lines; lines outside
+the range are not affected by scroll commands.
+
+Do not try to move the cursor outside the scroll region. The region
+remains set until explicitly removed. To remove the scroll region,
+use another @samp{cs} command specifying the full height of the
+screen.
+
+The cursor position is undefined after the @samp{cs} command is set,
+so position the cursor with @samp{cm} immediately afterward.
+
+@item cS
+@kindex cS
+String of commands to set the scroll region using parameters in
+different form. The effect is the same as if @samp{cs} were used.
+Four parameters are required:
+
+@enumerate
+@item
+Total number of lines on the screen.
+@item
+Number of lines above desired scroll region.
+@item
+Number of lines below (outside of) desired scroll region.
+@item
+Total number of lines on the screen, the same as the first parameter.
+@end enumerate
+
+This capability is a GNU extension that was invented to allow the Ann
+Arbor Ambassador's scroll-region command to be described; it could
+also be done by putting non-Unix @samp{%}-sequences into a @samp{cs}
+string, but that would have confused Unix programs that used the
+@samp{cs} capability with the Unix termcap. Currently only GNU Emacs
+uses the @samp{cS} capability.
+
+@item ns
+@kindex ns
+Flag which means that the terminal does not normally scroll for
+ordinary sequential output. For modern terminals, this means that
+outputting a newline in ordinary sequential output with the cursor on
+the bottom line wraps to the top line. For some obsolete terminals,
+other things may happen.
+
+The terminal may be able to scroll even if it does not normally do so.
+If the @samp{sf} capability is provided, it can be used for scrolling
+regardless of @samp{ns}.
+
+@item da
+@kindex da
+Flag whose presence means that lines scrolled up off the top of the
+screen may come back if scrolling down is done subsequently.
+
+The @samp{da} and @samp{db} flags do not, strictly speaking, affect
+how to scroll. But programs that scroll usually need to clear the
+lines scrolled onto the screen, if these flags are present.
+
+@item db
+@kindex db
+Flag whose presence means that lines scrolled down off the bottom of
+the screen may come back if scrolling up is done subsequently.
+
+@item lm
+@kindex lm
+Numeric value, the number of lines of display memory that the terminal
+has. A value of zero means that the terminal has more display memory
+than can fit on the screen, but no fixed number of lines. (The number
+of lines may depend on the amount of text in each line.)
+@end table
+
+Any terminal description that defines @samp{SF} should also define @samp{sf};
+likewise for @samp{SR} and @samp{sr}. However, many terminals can only
+scroll by one line at a time, so it is common to find @samp{sf} and not
+@samp{SF}, or @samp{sr} without @samp{SR}.@refill
+
+Therefore, all programs that use the scrolling facilities should be
+prepared to work with @samp{sf} in the case that @samp{SF} is absent, and
+likewise with @samp{sr}. On the other hand, an application program that
+uses only @samp{sf} and not @samp{SF} is acceptable, though slow on some
+terminals.@refill
+
+When outputting a scroll command with @code{tputs}, the @var{nlines}
+argument should be the total number of lines in the portion of the screen
+being scrolled. Very often these commands require padding proportional to
+this number of lines. @xref{Padding}.
+
+@node Windows, Clearing, Scrolling, Capabilities
+@section Windows
+@cindex window
+
+A @dfn{window}, in termcap, is a rectangular portion of the screen to which
+all display operations are restricted. Wrapping, clearing, scrolling,
+insertion and deletion all operate as if the specified window were all the
+screen there was.
+
+@table @samp
+@item wi
+@kindex wi
+String of commands to set the terminal output screen window.
+This string requires four parameters, all origin-zero:
+@enumerate
+@item
+The first line to include in the window.
+@item
+The last line to include in the window.
+@item
+The first column to include in the window.
+@item
+The last column to include in the window.
+@end enumerate
+@end table
+
+Most terminals do not support windows.
+
+@node Clearing, Insdel Line, Windows, Capabilities
+@section Clearing Parts of the Screen
+@cindex erasing
+@cindex clearing the screen
+
+There are several terminal capabilities for clearing parts of the screen
+to blank. All display terminals support the @samp{cl} string, and most
+display terminals support all of these capabilities.
+
+@table @samp
+@item cl
+@kindex cl
+String of commands to clear the entire screen and position the cursor
+at the upper left corner.
+
+@item cd
+@kindex cd
+String of commands to clear the line the cursor is on, and all the
+lines below it, down to the bottom of the screen. This command string
+should be used only with the cursor in column zero; their effect is
+undefined if the cursor is elsewhere.
+
+@item ce
+@kindex ce
+String of commands to clear from the cursor to the end of the current
+line.
+
+@item ec
+@kindex ec
+String of commands to clear @var{n} characters, starting with the
+character that the cursor is on. This command string is expected to
+leave the cursor position unchanged. The parameter @var{n} should never
+be large enough to reach past the right margin; the effect of such a
+large parameter would be undefined.
+@end table
+
+Clear to end of line (@samp{ce}) is extremely important in programs that
+maintain an updating display. Nearly all display terminals support this
+operation, so it is acceptable for a an application program to refuse to
+work if @samp{ce} is not present. However, if you do not want this
+limitation, you can accomplish clearing to end of line by outputting spaces
+until you reach the right margin. In order to do this, you must know the
+current horizontal position. Also, this technique assumes that writing a
+space will erase. But this happens to be true on all the display terminals
+that fail to support @samp{ce}.
+
+@node Insdel Line, Insdel Char, Clearing, Capabilities
+@section Insert/Delete Line
+
+@cindex insert line
+@cindex delete line
+@dfn{Inserting a line} means creating a blank line in the middle
+of the screen, and pushing the existing lines of text apart. In fact,
+the lines above the insertion point do not change, while the lines below
+move down, and one is normally lost at the bottom of the screen.
+
+@dfn{Deleting a line} means causing the line to disappear from the screen,
+closing up the gap by moving the lines below it upward. A new line
+appears at the bottom of the screen. Usually this line is blank, but
+on terminals with the @samp{db} flag it may be a line previously moved
+off the screen bottom by scrolling or line insertion.
+
+Insertion and deletion of lines is useful in programs that maintain an
+updating display some parts of which may get longer or shorter. They are
+also useful in editors for scrolling parts of the screen, and for
+redisplaying after lines of text are killed or inserted.
+
+Many terminals provide commands to insert or delete a single line at the
+cursor position. Some provide the ability to insert or delete several
+lines with one command, using the number of lines to insert or delete as a
+parameter. Always move the cursor to column zero before using any of
+these commands.
+
+@table @samp
+@item al
+@kindex al
+String of commands to insert a blank line before the line the cursor
+is on. The existing line, and all lines below it, are moved down.
+The last line in the screen (or in the scroll region, if one is set)
+disappears and in most circumstances is discarded. It may not be
+discarded if the @samp{db} is present (@pxref{Scrolling}).
+
+The cursor must be at the left margin before this command is used.
+This command does not move the cursor.
+
+@item dl
+@kindex dl
+String of commands to delete the line the cursor is on. The following
+lines move up, and a blank line appears at the bottom of the screen
+(or bottom of the scroll region). If the terminal has the @samp{db}
+flag, a nonblank line previously pushed off the screen bottom may
+reappear at the bottom.
+
+The cursor must be at the left margin before this command is used.
+This command does not move the cursor.
+
+@item AL
+@kindex AL
+String of commands to insert @var{n} blank lines before the line that
+the cursor is on. It is like @samp{al} repeated @var{n} times, except
+that it is as fast as one @samp{al}.
+
+@item DL
+@kindex DL
+String of commands to delete @var{n} lines starting with the line that
+the cursor is on. It is like @samp{dl} repeated @var{n} times, except
+that it is as fast as one @samp{dl}.
+@end table
+
+Any terminal description that defines @samp{AL} should also define
+@samp{al}; likewise for @samp{DL} and @samp{dl}. However, many terminals
+can only insert or delete one line at a time, so it is common to find
+@samp{al} and not @samp{AL}, or @samp{dl} without @samp{DL}.@refill
+
+Therefore, all programs that use the insert and delete facilities should be
+prepared to work with @samp{al} in the case that @samp{AL} is absent, and
+likewise with @samp{dl}. On the other hand, it is acceptable to write
+an application that uses only @samp{al} and @samp{dl} and does not look
+for @samp{AL} or @samp{DL} at all.@refill
+
+If a terminal does not support line insertion and deletion directly,
+but does support a scroll region, the effect of insertion and deletion
+can be obtained with scrolling. However, it is up to the individual
+user program to check for this possibility and use the scrolling
+commands to get the desired result. It is fairly important to implement
+this alternate strategy, since it is the only way to get the effect of
+line insertion and deletion on the popular VT100 terminal.
+
+Insertion and deletion of lines is affected by the scroll region on
+terminals that have a settable scroll region. This is useful when it is
+desirable to move any few consecutive lines up or down by a few lines.
+@xref{Scrolling}.
+
+The line pushed off the bottom of the screen is not lost if the terminal
+has the @samp{db} flag capability; instead, it is pushed into display
+memory that does not appear on the screen. This is the same thing that
+happens when scrolling pushes a line off the bottom of the screen.
+Either reverse scrolling or deletion of a line can bring the apparently
+lost line back onto the bottom of the screen. If the terminal has the
+scroll region feature as well as @samp{db}, the pushed-out line really
+is lost if a scroll region is in effect.
+
+When outputting an insert or delete command with @code{tputs}, the
+@var{nlines} argument should be the total number of lines from the cursor
+to the bottom of the screen (or scroll region). Very often these commands
+require padding proportional to this number of lines. @xref{Padding}.
+
+For @samp{AL} and @samp{DL} the @var{nlines} argument should @emph{not}
+depend on the number of lines inserted or deleted; only the total number of
+lines affected. This is because it is just as fast to insert two or
+@var{n} lines with @samp{AL} as to insert one line with @samp{al}.
+
+@node Insdel Char, Standout, Insdel Line, Capabilities
+@section Insert/Delete Character
+@cindex insert character
+@cindex delete character
+
+@dfn{Inserting a character} means creating a blank space in the middle of a
+line, and pushing the rest of the line rightward. The character in the
+rightmost column is lost.
+
+@dfn{Deleting a character} means causing the character to disappear from
+the screen, closing up the gap by moving the rest of the line leftward. A
+blank space appears in the rightmost column.
+
+Insertion and deletion of characters is useful in programs that maintain an
+updating display some parts of which may get longer or shorter. It is also
+useful in editors for redisplaying the results of editing within a line.
+
+Many terminals provide commands to insert or delete a single character at
+the cursor position. Some provide the ability to insert or delete several
+characters with one command, using the number of characters to insert or
+delete as a parameter.
+
+@cindex insert mode
+Many terminals provide an insert mode in which outputting a graphic
+character has the added effect of inserting a position for that character.
+A special command string is used to enter insert mode and another is used
+to exit it. The reason for designing a terminal with an insert mode rather
+than an insert command is that inserting character positions is usually
+followed by writing characters into them. With insert mode, this is as
+fast as simply writing the characters, except for the fixed overhead of
+entering and leaving insert mode. However, when the line speed is great
+enough, padding may be required for the graphic characters output in insert
+mode.
+
+Some terminals require you to enter insert mode and then output a special
+command for each position to be inserted. Or they may require special
+commands to be output before or after each graphic character to be
+inserted.
+
+@cindex delete mode
+Deletion of characters is usually accomplished by a straightforward command
+to delete one or several positions; but on some terminals, it is necessary
+to enter a special delete mode before using the delete command, and leave
+delete mode afterward. Sometimes delete mode and insert mode are the same
+mode.
+
+Some terminals make a distinction between character positions in which a
+space character has been output and positions which have been cleared. On
+these terminals, the effect of insert or delete character runs to the first
+cleared position rather than to the end of the line. In fact, the effect
+may run to more than one line if there is no cleared position to stop the
+shift on the first line. These terminals are identified by the @samp{in}
+flag capability.
+
+On terminals with the @samp{in} flag, the technique of skipping over
+characters that you know were cleared, and then outputting text later on in
+the same line, causes later insert and delete character operations on that
+line to do nonstandard things. A program that has any chance of doing this
+must check for the @samp{in} flag and must be careful to write explicit
+space characters into the intermediate columns when @samp{in} is present.
+
+A plethora of terminal capabilities are needed to describe all of this
+complexity. Here is a list of them all. Following the list, we present
+an algorithm for programs to use to take proper account of all of these
+capabilities.
+
+@table @samp
+@item im
+@kindex im
+String of commands to enter insert mode.
+
+If the terminal has no special insert mode, but it can insert
+characters with a special command, @samp{im} should be defined with a
+null value, because the @samp{vi} editor assumes that insertion of a
+character is impossible if @samp{im} is not provided.
+
+New programs should not act like @samp{vi}. They should pay attention
+to @samp{im} only if it is defined.
+
+@item ei
+@kindex ei
+String of commands to leave insert mode. This capability must be
+present if @samp{im} is.
+
+On a few old terminals the same string is used to enter and exit
+insert mode. This string turns insert mode on if it was off, and off
+it it was on. You can tell these terminals because the @samp{ei}
+string equals the @samp{im} string. If you want to support these
+terminals, you must always remember accurately whether insert mode is
+in effect. However, these terminals are obsolete, and it is
+reasonable to refuse to support them. On all modern terminals, you
+can safely output @samp{ei} at any time to ensure that insert mode is
+turned off.
+
+@item ic
+@kindex ic
+String of commands to insert one character position at the cursor.
+The cursor does not move.
+
+If outputting a graphic character while in insert mode is sufficient
+to insert the character, then the @samp{ic} capability should be
+defined with a null value.
+
+If your terminal offers a choice of ways to insert---either use insert
+mode or use a special command---then define @samp{im} and do not define
+@samp{ic}, since this gives the most efficient operation when several
+characters are to be inserted. @emph{Do not} define both strings, for
+that means that @emph{both} must be used each time insertion is done.
+
+@item ip
+@kindex ip
+String of commands to output following an inserted graphic character
+in insert mode. Often it is used just for a padding spec, when padding
+is needed after an inserted character (@pxref{Padding}).
+
+@item IC
+@kindex IC
+String of commands to insert @var{n} character positions at and after
+the cursor. It has the same effect as repeating the @samp{ic} string
+and a space, @var{n} times.
+
+If @samp{IC} is provided, application programs may use it without first
+entering insert mode.
+
+@item mi
+@kindex mi
+Flag whose presence means it is safe to move the cursor while in insert
+mode and assume the terminal remains in insert mode.
+
+@item in
+@kindex in
+Flag whose presence means that the terminal distinguishes between
+character positions in which space characters have been output and
+positions which have been cleared.
+@end table
+
+An application program can assume that the terminal can do character
+insertion if @emph{any one of} the capabilities @samp{IC}, @samp{im},
+@samp{ic} or @samp{ip} is provided.
+
+To insert @var{n} blank character positions, move the cursor to the place
+to insert them and follow this algorithm:
+
+@enumerate
+@item
+If an @samp{IC} string is provided, output it with parameter @var{n}
+and you are finished. Otherwise (or if you don't want to bother to
+look for an @samp{IC} string) follow the remaining steps.
+
+@item
+Output the @samp{im} string, if there is one, unless the terminal is
+already in insert mode.
+
+@item
+Repeat steps 4 through 6, @var{n} times.
+
+@item
+Output the @samp{ic} string if any.
+
+@item
+Output a space.
+
+@item
+Output the @samp{ip} string if any.
+
+@item
+Output the @samp{ei} string, eventually, to exit insert mode. There
+is no need to do this right away. If the @samp{mi} flag is present,
+you can move the cursor and the cursor will remain in insert mode;
+then you can do more insertion elsewhere without reentering insert
+mode.
+@end enumerate
+
+To insert @var{n} graphic characters, position the cursor and follow this
+algorithm:
+
+@enumerate
+@item
+If an @samp{IC} string is provided, output it with parameter @var{n},
+then output the graphic characters, and you are finished. Otherwise
+(or if you don't want to bother to look for an @samp{IC} string)
+follow the remaining steps.
+
+@item
+Output the @samp{im} string, if there is one, unless the terminal is
+already in insert mode.
+
+@item
+For each character to be output, repeat steps 4 through 6.
+
+@item
+Output the @samp{ic} string if any.
+
+@item
+Output the next graphic character.
+
+@item
+Output the @samp{ip} string if any.
+
+@item
+Output the @samp{ei} string, eventually, to exit insert mode. There
+is no need to do this right away. If the @samp{mi} flag is present,
+you can move the cursor and the cursor will remain in insert mode;
+then you can do more insertion elsewhere without reentering insert
+mode.
+@end enumerate
+
+Note that this is not the same as the original Unix termcap specifications
+in one respect: it assumes that the @samp{IC} string can be used without
+entering insert mode. This is true as far as I know, and it allows you be
+able to avoid entering and leaving insert mode, and also to be able to
+avoid the inserted-character padding after the characters that go into the
+inserted positions.
+
+Deletion of characters is less complicated; deleting one column is done by
+outputting the @samp{dc} string. However, there may be a delete mode that
+must be entered with @samp{dm} in order to make @samp{dc} work.
+
+@table @samp
+@item dc
+@kindex dc
+String of commands to delete one character position at the cursor. If
+@samp{dc} is not present, the terminal cannot delete characters.
+
+@item DC
+@kindex DC
+String of commands to delete @var{n} characters starting at the cursor.
+It has the same effect as repeating the @samp{dc} string @var{n} times.
+Any terminal description that has @samp{DC} also has @samp{dc}.
+
+@item dm
+@kindex dm
+String of commands to enter delete mode. If not present, there is no
+delete mode, and @samp{dc} can be used at any time (assuming there is
+a @samp{dc}).
+
+@item ed
+@kindex ed
+String of commands to exit delete mode. This must be present if
+@samp{dm} is.
+@end table
+
+To delete @var{n} character positions, position the cursor and follow these
+steps:
+
+@enumerate
+@item
+If the @samp{DC} string is present, output it with parameter @var{n}
+and you are finished. Otherwise, follow the remaining steps.
+
+@item
+Output the @samp{dm} string, unless you know the terminal is already
+in delete mode.
+
+@item
+Output the @samp{dc} string @var{n} times.
+
+@item
+Output the @samp{ed} string eventually. If the flag capability
+@samp{mi} is present, you can move the cursor and do more deletion
+without leaving and reentering delete mode.
+@end enumerate
+
+As with the @samp{IC} string, we have departed from the original termcap
+specifications by assuming that @samp{DC} works without entering delete
+mode even though @samp{dc} would not.
+
+If the @samp{dm} and @samp{im} capabilities are both present and have the
+same value, it means that the terminal has one mode for both insertion and
+deletion. It is useful for a program to know this, because then it can do
+insertions after deletions, or vice versa, without leaving insert/delete
+mode and reentering it.
+
+@node Standout, Underlining, Insdel Char, Capabilities
+@section Standout and Appearance Modes
+@cindex appearance modes
+@cindex standout
+@cindex magic cookie
+
+@dfn{Appearance modes} are modifications to the ways characters are
+displayed. Typical appearance modes include reverse video, dim, bright,
+blinking, underlined, invisible, and alternate character set. Each kind of
+terminal supports various among these, or perhaps none.
+
+For each type of terminal, one appearance mode or combination of them that
+looks good for highlighted text is chosen as the @dfn{standout mode}. The
+capabilities @samp{so} and @samp{se} say how to enter and leave standout
+mode. Programs that use appearance modes only to highlight some text
+generally use the standout mode so that they can work on as many terminals
+as possible. Use of specific appearance modes other than ``underlined''
+and ``alternate character set'' is rare.
+
+Terminals that implement appearance modes fall into two general classes as
+to how they do it.
+
+In some terminals, the presence or absence of any appearance mode is
+recorded separately for each character position. In these terminals, each
+graphic character written is given the appearance modes current at the time
+it is written, and keeps those modes until it is erased or overwritten.
+There are special commands to turn the appearance modes on or off for
+characters to be written in the future.
+
+In other terminals, the change of appearance modes is represented by a
+marker that belongs to a certain screen position but affects all following
+screen positions until the next marker. These markers are traditionally
+called @dfn{magic cookies}.
+
+The same capabilities (@samp{so}, @samp{se}, @samp{mb} and so on) for
+turning appearance modes on and off are used for both magic-cookie
+terminals and per-character terminals. On magic cookie terminals, these
+give the commands to write the magic cookies. On per-character terminals,
+they change the current modes that affect future output and erasure. Some
+simple applications can use these commands without knowing whether or not
+they work by means of cookies.
+
+However, a program that maintains and updates a display needs to know
+whether the terminal uses magic cookies, and exactly what their effect is.
+This information comes from the @samp{sg} capability.
+
+The @samp{sg} capability is a numeric capability whose presence indicates
+that the terminal uses magic cookies for appearance modes. Its value is
+the number of character positions that a magic cookie occupies. Usually
+the cookie occupies one or more character positions on the screen, and these
+character positions are displayed as blank, but in some terminals the
+cookie has zero width.
+
+The @samp{sg} capability describes both the magic cookie to turn standout
+on and the cookie to turn it off. This makes the assumption that both
+kinds of cookie have the same width on the screen. If that is not true,
+the narrower cookie must be ``widened'' with spaces until it has the same
+width as the other.
+
+On some magic cookie terminals, each line always starts with normal
+display; in other words, the scope of a magic cookie never extends over
+more than one line. But on other terminals, one magic cookie affects all
+the lines below it unless explicitly canceled. Termcap does not define any
+way to distinguish these two ways magic cookies can work. To be safe, it
+is best to put a cookie at the beginning of each line.
+
+On some per-character terminals, standout mode or other appearance modes
+may be canceled by moving the cursor. On others, moving the cursor has no
+effect on the state of the appearance modes. The latter class of terminals
+are given the flag capability @samp{ms} (``can move in standout''). All
+programs that might have occasion to move the cursor while appearance modes
+are turned on must check for this flag; if it is not present, they should
+reset appearance modes to normal before doing cursor motion.
+
+A program that has turned on only standout mode should use @samp{se} to
+reset the standout mode to normal. A program that has turned on only
+alternate character set mode should use @samp{ae} to return it to normal.
+If it is possible that any other appearance modes are turned on, use the
+@samp{me} capability to return them to normal.
+
+Note that the commands to turn on one appearance mode, including @samp{so}
+and @samp{mb} @dots{} @samp{mr}, if used while some other appearance modes
+are turned on, may combine the two modes on some terminals but may turn off
+the mode previously enabled on other terminals. This is because some
+terminals do not have a command to set or clear one appearance mode without
+changing the others. Programs should not attempt to use appearance modes
+in combination except with @samp{sa}, and when switching from one single
+mode to another should always turn off the previously enabled mode and then
+turn on the new desired mode.
+
+On some old terminals, the @samp{so} and @samp{se} commands may be the same
+command, which has the effect of turning standout on if it is off, or off
+it is on. It is therefore risky for a program to output extra @samp{se}
+commands for good measure. Fortunately, all these terminals are obsolete.
+
+Programs that update displays in which standout-text may be replaced with
+non-standout text must check for the @samp{xs} flag. In a per-character
+terminal, this flag says that the only way to remove standout once written is
+to clear that portion of the line with the @samp{ce} string or something
+even more powerful (@pxref{Clearing}); just writing new characters at those
+screen positions will not change the modes in effect there. In a magic
+cookie terminal, @samp{xs} says that the only way to remove a cookie is to
+clear a portion of the line that includes the cookie; writing a different
+cookie at the same position does not work.
+
+Such programs must also check for the @samp{xt} flag, which means that the
+terminal is a Teleray 1061. On this terminal it is impossible to position
+the cursor at the front of a magic cookie, so the only two ways to remove a
+cookie are (1) to delete the line it is on or (2) to position the cursor at
+least one character before it (possibly on a previous line) and output the
+@samp{se} string, which on these terminals finds and removes the next
+@samp{so} magic cookie on the screen. (It may also be possible to remove a
+cookie which is not at the beginning of a line by clearing that line.) The
+@samp{xt} capability also has implications for the use of tab characters,
+but in that regard it is obsolete (@xref{Cursor Motion}).
+
+@table @samp
+@item so
+@kindex so
+String of commands to enter standout mode.
+
+@item se
+@kindex se
+String of commands to leave standout mode.
+
+@item sg
+@kindex sg
+Numeric capability, the width on the screen of the magic cookie. This
+capability is absent in terminals that record appearance modes
+character by character.
+
+@item ms
+@kindex ms
+Flag whose presence means that it is safe to move the cursor while the
+appearance modes are not in the normal state. If this flag is absent,
+programs should always reset the appearance modes to normal before
+moving the cursor.
+
+@item xs
+@kindex xs
+Flag whose presence means that the only way to reset appearance modes
+already on the screen is to clear to end of line. On a per-character
+terminal, you must clear the area where the modes are set. On a magic
+cookie terminal, you must clear an area containing the cookie.
+See the discussion above.
+
+@item xt
+@kindex xt
+Flag whose presence means that the cursor cannot be positioned right
+in front of a magic cookie, and that @samp{se} is a command to delete
+the next magic cookie following the cursor. See discussion above.
+
+@item mb
+@kindex mb
+String of commands to enter blinking mode.
+
+@item md
+@kindex md
+String of commands to enter double-bright mode.
+
+@item mh
+@kindex mh
+String of commands to enter half-bright mode.
+
+@item mk
+@kindex mk
+String of commands to enter invisible mode.
+
+@item mp
+@kindex mp
+String of commands to enter protected mode.
+
+@item mr
+@kindex mr
+String of commands to enter reverse-video mode.
+
+@item me
+@kindex me
+String of commands to turn off all appearance modes, including
+standout mode and underline mode. On some terminals it also turns off
+alternate character set mode; on others, it may not. This capability
+must be present if any of @samp{mb} @dots{} @samp{mr} is present.
+
+@item as
+@kindex as
+String of commands to turn on alternate character set mode. This mode
+assigns some or all graphic characters an alternate picture on the
+screen. There is no standard as to what the alternate pictures look
+like.
+
+@item ae
+@kindex ae
+String of commands to turn off alternate character set mode.
+
+@item sa
+@kindex sa
+String of commands to turn on an arbitrary combination of appearance
+modes. It accepts 9 parameters, each of which controls a particular
+kind of appearance mode. A parameter should be 1 to turn its appearance
+mode on, or zero to turn that mode off. Most terminals do not support
+the @samp{sa} capability, even among those that do have various
+appearance modes.
+
+The nine parameters are, in order, @var{standout}, @var{underline},
+@var{reverse}, @var{blink}, @var{half-bright}, @var{double-bright},
+@var{blank}, @var{protect}, @var{alt char set}.
+@end table
+
+@node Underlining, Cursor Visibility, Standout, Capabilities
+@section Underlining
+@cindex underlining
+
+Underlining on most terminals is a kind of appearance mode, much like
+standout mode. Therefore, it may be implemented using magic cookies or as
+a flag in the terminal whose current state affects each character that is
+output. @xref{Standout}, for a full explanation.
+
+The @samp{ug} capability is a numeric capability whose presence indicates
+that the terminal uses magic cookies for underlining. Its value is the
+number of character positions that a magic cookie for underlining occupies;
+it is used for underlining just as @samp{sg} is used for standout. Aside
+from the simplest applications, it is impossible to use underlining
+correctly without paying attention to the value of @samp{ug}.
+
+@table @samp
+@item us
+@kindex us
+String of commands to turn on underline mode or to output a magic cookie
+to start underlining.
+
+@item ue
+@kindex ue
+String of commands to turn off underline mode or to output a magic
+cookie to stop underlining.
+
+@item ug
+@kindex ug
+Width of magic cookie that represents a change of underline mode;
+or missing, if the terminal does not use a magic cookie for this.
+
+@item ms
+@kindex ms
+Flag whose presence means that it is safe to move the cursor while the
+appearance modes are not in the normal state. Underlining is an
+appearance mode. If this flag is absent, programs should always turn
+off underlining before moving the cursor.
+@end table
+
+There are two other, older ways of doing underlining: there can be a
+command to underline a single character, or the output of @samp{_}, the
+ASCII underscore character, as an overstrike could cause a character to be
+underlined. New programs need not bother to handle these capabilities
+unless the author cares strongly about the obscure terminals which support
+them. However, terminal descriptions should provide these capabilities
+when appropriate.
+
+@table @samp
+@item uc
+@kindex uc
+String of commands to underline the character under the cursor, and
+move the cursor right.
+
+@item ul
+@kindex ul
+Flag whose presence means that the terminal can underline by
+overstriking an underscore character (@samp{_}); some terminals can do
+this even though they do not support overstriking in general. An
+implication of this flag is that when outputting new text to overwrite
+old text, underscore characters must be treated specially lest they
+underline the old text instead.
+@end table
+
+@node Cursor Visibility, Bell, Underlining, Capabilities
+@section Cursor Visibility
+@cindex visibility
+
+Some terminals have the ability to make the cursor invisible, or to enhance
+it. Enhancing the cursor is often done by programs that plan to use the
+cursor to indicate to the user a position of interest that may be anywhere
+on the screen---for example, the Emacs editor enhances the cursor on entry.
+Such programs should always restore the cursor to normal on exit.
+
+@table @samp
+@item vs
+@kindex vs
+String of commands to enhance the cursor.
+
+@item vi
+@kindex vi
+String of commands to make the cursor invisible.
+
+@item ve
+@kindex ve
+String of commands to return the cursor to normal.
+@end table
+
+If you define either @samp{vs} or @samp{vi}, you must also define @samp{ve}.
+
+@node Bell, Keypad, Cursor Visibility, Capabilities
+@section Bell
+@cindex bell
+@cindex visible bell
+
+Here we describe commands to make the terminal ask for the user to pay
+attention to it.
+
+@table @samp
+@item bl
+@kindex bl
+String of commands to cause the terminal to make an audible sound. If
+this capability is absent, the terminal has no way to make a suitable
+sound.
+
+@item vb
+@kindex vb
+String of commands to cause the screen to flash to attract attention
+(``visible bell''). If this capability is absent, the terminal has no
+way to do such a thing.
+@end table
+
+@node Keypad, Meta Key, Bell, Capabilities
+@section Keypad and Function Keys
+
+Many terminals have arrow and function keys that transmit specific
+character sequences to the computer. Since the precise sequences used
+depend on the terminal, termcap defines capabilities used to say what the
+sequences are. Unlike most termcap string-valued capabilities, these are
+not strings of commands to be sent to the terminal, rather strings that
+are received from the terminal.
+
+Programs that expect to use keypad keys should check, initially, for a
+@samp{ks} capability and send it, to make the keypad actually transmit.
+Such programs should also send the @samp{ke} string when exiting.
+
+@table @asis
+@item @samp{ks}
+@kindex ka@dots{}ku
+String of commands to make the keypad keys transmit. If this
+capability is not provided, but the others in this section are,
+programs may assume that the keypad keys always transmit.
+
+@item @samp{ke}
+String of commands to make the keypad keys work locally. This
+capability is provided only if @samp{ks} is.
+
+@item @samp{kl}
+String of input characters sent by typing the left-arrow key. If this
+capability is missing, you cannot expect the terminal to have a
+left-arrow key that transmits anything to the computer.
+
+@item @samp{kr}
+String of input characters sent by typing the right-arrow key.
+
+@item @samp{ku}
+String of input characters sent by typing the up-arrow key.
+
+@item @samp{kd}
+String of input characters sent by typing the down-arrow key.
+
+@item @samp{kh}
+String of input characters sent by typing the ``home-position'' key.
+
+@item @samp{K1} @dots{} @samp{K5}
+@kindex K1@dots{}K5
+Strings of input characters sent by the five other keys in a 3-by-3
+array that includes the arrow keys, if the keyboard has such a 3-by-3
+array. Note that one of these keys may be the ``home-position'' key,
+in which case one of these capabilities will have the same value as
+the @samp{kh} key.
+
+@item @samp{k0}
+String of input characters sent by function key 10 (or 0, if the terminal
+has one labeled 0).
+
+@item @samp{k1} @dots{} @samp{k9}
+@kindex k1@dots{}k9
+Strings of input characters sent by function keys 1 through 9,
+provided for those function keys that exist.
+
+@item @samp{kn}
+Number: the number of numbered function keys, if there are more than
+10.
+
+@item @samp{l0} @dots{} @samp{l9}
+@kindex l0@dots{}l9
+Strings which are the labels appearing on the keyboard on the keys
+described by the capabilities @samp{k0} @dots{} @samp{l9}. These
+capabilities should be left undefined if the labels are @samp{f0} or
+@samp{f10} and @samp{f1} @dots{} @samp{f9}.@refill
+
+@item @samp{kH}
+@kindex kA@dots{}kT
+String of input characters sent by the ``home down'' key, if there is
+one.
+
+@item @samp{kb}
+String of input characters sent by the ``backspace'' key, if there is
+one.
+
+@item @samp{ka}
+String of input characters sent by the ``clear all tabs'' key, if there
+is one.
+
+@item @samp{kt}
+String of input characters sent by the ``clear tab stop this column''
+key, if there is one.
+
+@item @samp{kC}
+String of input characters sent by the ``clear screen'' key, if there is
+one.
+
+@item @samp{kD}
+String of input characters sent by the ``delete character'' key, if
+there is one.
+
+@item @samp{kL}
+String of input characters sent by the ``delete line'' key, if there is
+one.
+
+@item @samp{kM}
+String of input characters sent by the ``exit insert mode'' key, if
+there is one.
+
+@item @samp{kE}
+String of input characters sent by the ``clear to end of line'' key, if
+there is one.
+
+@item @samp{kS}
+String of input characters sent by the ``clear to end of screen'' key,
+if there is one.
+
+@item @samp{kI}
+String of input characters sent by the ``insert character'' or ``enter
+insert mode'' key, if there is one.
+
+@item @samp{kA}
+String of input characters sent by the ``insert line'' key, if there is
+one.
+
+@item @samp{kN}
+String of input characters sent by the ``next page'' key, if there is
+one.
+
+@item @samp{kP}
+String of input characters sent by the ``previous page'' key, if there is
+one.
+
+@item @samp{kF}
+String of input characters sent by the ``scroll forward'' key, if there
+is one.
+
+@item @samp{kR}
+String of input characters sent by the ``scroll reverse'' key, if there
+is one.
+
+@item @samp{kT}
+String of input characters sent by the ``set tab stop in this column''
+key, if there is one.
+
+@item @samp{ko}
+String listing the other function keys the terminal has. This is a
+very obsolete way of describing the same information found in the
+@samp{kH} @dots{} @samp{kT} keys. The string contains a list of
+two-character termcap capability names, separated by commas. The
+meaning is that for each capability name listed, the terminal has a
+key which sends the string which is the value of that capability. For
+example, the value @samp{:ko=cl,ll,sf,sr:} says that the terminal has
+four function keys which mean ``clear screen'', ``home down'',
+``scroll forward'' and ``scroll reverse''.@refill
+@end table
+
+@node Meta Key, Initialization, Keypad, Capabilities
+@section Meta Key
+
+@cindex meta key
+A Meta key is a key on the keyboard that modifies each character you type
+by controlling the 0200 bit. This bit is on if and only if the Meta key is
+held down when the character is typed. Characters typed using the Meta key
+are called Meta characters. Emacs uses Meta characters as editing
+commands.
+
+@table @samp
+@item km
+@kindex km
+Flag whose presence means that the terminal has a Meta key.
+
+@item mm
+@kindex mm
+String of commands to enable the functioning of the Meta key.
+
+@item mo
+@kindex mo
+String of commands to disable the functioning of the Meta key.
+@end table
+
+If the terminal has @samp{km} but does not have @samp{mm} and @samp{mo}, it
+means that the Meta key always functions. If it has @samp{mm} and
+@samp{mo}, it means that the Meta key can be turned on or off. Send the
+@samp{mm} string to turn it on, and the @samp{mo} string to turn it off.
+I do not know why one would ever not want it to be on.
+
+@node Initialization, Pad Specs, Meta Key, Capabilities
+@section Initialization
+@cindex reset
+@cindex initialization
+@cindex tab stops
+
+@table @samp
+@item ti
+@kindex ti
+String of commands to put the terminal into whatever special modes are
+needed or appropriate for programs that move the cursor
+nonsequentially around the screen. Programs that use termcap to do
+full-screen display should output this string when they start up.
+
+@item te
+@kindex te
+String of commands to undo what is done by the @samp{ti} string.
+Programs that output the @samp{ti} string on entry should output this
+string when they exit.
+
+@item is
+@kindex is
+String of commands to initialize the terminal for each login session.
+
+@item if
+@kindex if
+String which is the name of a file containing the string of commands
+to initialize the terminal for each session of use. Normally @samp{is}
+and @samp{if} are not both used.
+
+@item i1
+@itemx i3
+@kindex i1
+@kindex i3
+Two more strings of commands to initialize the terminal for each login
+session. The @samp{i1} string (if defined) is output before @samp{is}
+or @samp{if}, and the @samp{i3} string (if defined) is output after.
+
+The reason for having three separate initialization strings is to make
+it easier to define a group of related terminal types with slightly
+different initializations. Define two or three of the strings in the
+basic type; then the other types can override one or two of the
+strings.
+
+@item rs
+@kindex rs
+String of commands to reset the terminal from any strange mode it may
+be in. Normally this includes the @samp{is} string (or other commands
+with the same effects) and more. What would go in the @samp{rs}
+string but not in the @samp{is} string are annoying or slow commands
+to bring the terminal back from strange modes that nobody would
+normally use.
+
+@item it
+@kindex it
+Numeric value, the initial spacing between hardware tab stop columns
+when the terminal is powered up. Programs to initialize the terminal
+can use this to decide whether there is a need to set the tab stops.
+If the initial width is 8, well and good; if it is not 8, then the
+tab stops should be set; if they cannot be set, the kernel is told
+to convert tabs to spaces, and other programs will observe this and do
+likewise.
+
+@item ct
+@kindex ct
+String of commands to clear all tab stops.
+
+@item st
+@kindex st
+String of commands to set tab stop at current cursor column on all
+lines.
+
+@item NF
+@kindex NF
+Flag whose presence means that the terminal does not support XON/XOFF
+flow control. Programs should not send XON (@kbd{C-q}) or XOFF
+(@kbd{C-s}) characters to the terminal.
+@end table
+
+@node Pad Specs, Status Line, Initialization, Capabilities
+@section Padding Capabilities
+@cindex padding
+
+There are two terminal capabilities that exist just to explain the proper
+way to obey the padding specifications in all the command string
+capabilities. One, @samp{pc}, must be obeyed by all termcap-using
+programs.
+
+@table @samp
+@item pb
+@kindex pb
+Numeric value, the lowest baud rate at which padding is actually
+needed. Programs may check this and refrain from doing any padding at
+lower speeds.
+
+@item pc
+@kindex pc
+String of commands for padding. The first character of this string is
+to be used as the pad character, instead of using null characters for
+padding. If @samp{pc} is not provided, use null characters. Every
+program that uses termcap must look up this capability and use it to
+set the variable @code{PC} that is used by @code{tputs}.
+@xref{Padding}.
+@end table
+
+Some termcap capabilities exist just to specify the amount of padding that
+the kernel should give to cursor motion commands used in ordinary
+sequential output.
+
+@table @samp
+@item dC
+@kindex dC
+Numeric value, the number of msec of padding needed for the
+carriage-return character.
+
+@item dN
+@kindex dN
+Numeric value, the number of msec of padding needed for the newline
+(linefeed) character.
+
+@item dB
+@kindex dB
+Numeric value, the number of msec of padding needed for the backspace
+character.
+
+@item dF
+@kindex dF
+Numeric value, the number of msec of padding needed for the formfeed
+character.
+
+@item dT
+@kindex dT
+Numeric value, the number of msec of padding needed for the tab
+character.
+@end table
+
+In some systems, the kernel uses the above capabilities; in other systems,
+the kernel uses the paddings specified in the string capabilities
+@samp{cr}, @samp{sf}, @samp{le}, @samp{ff} and @samp{ta}. Descriptions of
+terminals which require such padding should contain the @samp{dC} @dots{}
+@samp{dT} capabilities and also specify the appropriate padding in the
+corresponding string capabilities. Since no modern terminals require
+padding for ordinary sequential output, you probably won't need to do
+either of these things.
+
+@node Status Line, Half-Line, Pad Specs, Capabilities
+@section Status Line
+
+@cindex status line
+A @dfn{status line} is a line on the terminal that is not used for ordinary
+display output but instead used for a special message. The intended use is
+for a continuously updated description of what the user's program is doing,
+and that is where the name ``status line'' comes from, but in fact it could
+be used for anything. The distinguishing characteristic of a status line
+is that ordinary output to the terminal does not affect it; it changes only
+if the special status line commands of this section are used.
+
+@table @samp
+@item hs
+@kindex hs
+Flag whose presence means that the terminal has a status line. If a
+terminal description specifies that there is a status line, it must
+provide the @samp{ts} and @samp{fs} capabilities.
+
+@item ts
+@kindex ts
+String of commands to move the terminal cursor into the status line.
+Usually these commands must specifically record the old cursor
+position for the sake of the @samp{fs} string.
+
+@item fs
+@kindex fs
+String of commands to move the cursor back from the status line to its
+previous position (outside the status line).
+
+@item es
+@kindex es
+Flag whose presence means that other display commands work while
+writing the status line. In other words, one can clear parts of it,
+insert or delete characters, move the cursor within it using @samp{ch}
+if there is a @samp{ch} capability, enter and leave standout mode, and
+so on.
+
+@item ds
+@kindex ds
+String of commands to disable the display of the status line. This
+may be absent, if there is no way to disable the status line display.
+
+@item ws
+@kindex ws
+Numeric value, the width of the status line. If this capability is
+absent in a terminal that has a status line, it means the status line
+is the same width as the other lines.
+
+Note that the value of @samp{ws} is sometimes as small as 8.
+@end table
+
+@node Half-Line, Printer, Status Line, Capabilities
+@section Half-Line Motion
+
+Some terminals have commands for moving the cursor vertically by half-lines,
+useful for outputting subscripts and superscripts. Mostly it is hardcopy
+terminals that have such features.
+
+@table @samp
+@item hu
+@kindex hu
+String of commands to move the cursor up half a line. If the terminal
+is a display, it is your responsibility to avoid moving up past the
+top line; however, most likely the terminal that supports this is a
+hardcopy terminal and there is nothing to be concerned about.
+
+@item hd
+@kindex hd
+String of commands to move the cursor down half a line. If the
+terminal is a display, it is your responsibility to avoid moving down
+past the bottom line, etc.
+@end table
+
+@node Printer, , Half-Line, Capabilities
+@section Controlling Printers Attached to Terminals
+@cindex printer
+
+Some terminals have attached hardcopy printer ports. They may be able to
+copy the screen contents to the printer; they may also be able to redirect
+output to the printer. Termcap does not have anything to tell the program
+whether the redirected output appears also on the screen; it does on some
+terminals but not all.
+
+@table @samp
+@item ps
+@kindex ps
+String of commands to cause the contents of the screen to be printed.
+If it is absent, the screen contents cannot be printed.
+
+@item po
+@kindex po
+String of commands to redirect further output to the printer.
+
+@item pf
+@kindex pf
+String of commands to terminate redirection of output to the printer.
+This capability must be present in the description if @samp{po} is.
+
+@item pO
+@kindex pO
+String of commands to redirect output to the printer for next @var{n}
+characters of output, regardless of what they are. Redirection will
+end automatically after @var{n} characters of further output. Until
+then, nothing that is output can end redirection, not even the
+@samp{pf} string if there is one. The number @var{n} should not be
+more than 255.
+
+One use of this capability is to send non-text byte sequences (such as
+bit-maps) to the printer.
+@end table
+
+Most terminals with printers do not support all of @samp{ps}, @samp{po} and
+@samp{pO}; any one or two of them may be supported. To make a program that
+can send output to all kinds of printers, it is necessary to check for all
+three of these capabilities, choose the most convenient of the ones that
+are provided, and use it in its own appropriate fashion.
+
+@node Summary, Var Index, Capabilities, Top
+@chapter Summary of Capability Names
+
+Here are all the terminal capability names in alphabetical order
+with a brief description of each. For cross references to their definitions,
+see the index of capability names (@pxref{Cap Index}).
+
+@table @samp
+@item ae
+String to turn off alternate character set mode.
+@item al
+String to insert a blank line before the cursor.
+@item AL
+String to insert @var{n} blank lines before the cursor.
+@item am
+Flag: output to last column wraps cursor to next line.
+@item as
+String to turn on alternate character set mode.like.
+@item bc
+Very obsolete alternative name for the @samp{le} capability.
+@item bl
+String to sound the bell.
+@item bs
+Obsolete flag: ASCII backspace may be used for leftward motion.
+@item bt
+String to move the cursor left to the previous hardware tab stop column.
+@item bw
+Flag: @samp{le} at left margin wraps to end of previous line.
+@item CC
+String to change terminal's command character.
+@item cd
+String to clear the line the cursor is on, and following lines.
+@item ce
+String to clear from the cursor to the end of the line.
+@item ch
+String to position the cursor at column @var{c} in the same line.
+@item cl
+String to clear the entire screen and put cursor at upper left corner.
+@item cm
+String to position the cursor at line @var{l}, column @var{c}.
+@item CM
+String to position the cursor at line @var{l}, column
+@var{c}, relative to display memory.
+@item co
+Number: width of the screen.
+@item cr
+String to move cursor sideways to left margin.
+@item cs
+String to set the scroll region.
+@item cS
+Alternate form of string to set the scroll region.
+@item ct
+String to clear all tab stops.
+@item cv
+String to position the cursor at line @var{l} in the same column.
+@item da
+Flag: data scrolled off top of screen may be scrolled back.
+@item db
+Flag: data scrolled off bottom of screen may be scrolled back.
+@item dB
+Obsolete number: msec of padding needed for the backspace character.
+@item dc
+String to delete one character position at the cursor.
+@item dC
+Obsolete number: msec of padding needed for the carriage-return character.
+@item DC
+String to delete @var{n} characters starting at the cursor.
+@item dF
+Obsolete number: msec of padding needed for the formfeed character.
+@item dl
+String to delete the line the cursor is on.
+@item DL
+String to delete @var{n} lines starting with the cursor's line.
+@item dm
+String to enter delete mode.
+@item dN
+Obsolete number: msec of padding needed for the newline character.
+@item do
+String to move the cursor vertically down one line.
+@item DO
+String to move cursor vertically down @var{n} lines.
+@item ds
+String to disable the display of the status line.
+@item dT
+Obsolete number: msec of padding needed for the tab character.
+@item ec
+String of commands to clear @var{n} characters at cursor.
+@item ed
+String to exit delete mode.
+@item ei
+String to leave insert mode.
+@item eo
+Flag: output of a space can erase an overstrike.
+@item es
+Flag: other display commands work while writing the status line.
+@item ff
+String to advance to the next page, for a hardcopy terminal.
+@item fs
+String to move the cursor back from the status line to its
+previous position (outside the status line).
+@item gn
+Flag: this terminal type is generic, not real.
+@item hc
+Flag: hardcopy terminal.
+@item hd
+String to move the cursor down half a line.
+@item ho
+String to position cursor at upper left corner.
+@item hs
+Flag: the terminal has a status line.
+@item hu
+String to move the cursor up half a line.
+@item hz
+Flag: terminal cannot accept @samp{~} as output.
+@item i1
+String to initialize the terminal for each login session.
+@item i3
+String to initialize the terminal for each login session.
+@item ic
+String to insert one character position at the cursor.
+@item IC
+String to insert @var{n} character positions at the cursor.
+@item if
+String naming a file of commands to initialize the terminal.
+@item im
+String to enter insert mode.
+@item in
+Flag: outputting a space is different from moving over empty positions.
+@item ip
+String to output following an inserted character in insert mode.
+@item is
+String to initialize the terminal for each login session.
+@item it
+Number: initial spacing between hardware tab stop columns.
+@item k0
+String of input sent by function key 0 or 10.
+@item k1 @dots{} k9
+Strings of input sent by function keys 1 through 9.
+@item K1 @dots{} K5
+Strings sent by the five other keys in 3-by-3 array with arrows.
+@item ka
+String of input sent by the ``clear all tabs'' key.
+@item kA
+String of input sent by the ``insert line'' key.
+@item kb
+String of input sent by the ``backspace'' key.
+@item kC
+String of input sent by the ``clear screen'' key.
+@item kd
+String of input sent by typing the down-arrow key.
+@item kD
+String of input sent by the ``delete character'' key.
+@item ke
+String to make the function keys work locally.
+@item kE
+String of input sent by the ``clear to end of line'' key.
+@item kF
+String of input sent by the ``scroll forward'' key.
+@item kh
+String of input sent by typing the ``home-position'' key.
+@item kH
+String of input sent by the ``home down'' key.
+@item kI
+String of input sent by the ``insert character'' or ``enter
+insert mode'' key.
+@item kl
+String of input sent by typing the left-arrow key.
+@item kL
+String of input sent by the ``delete line'' key.
+@item km
+Flag: the terminal has a Meta key.
+@item kM
+String of input sent by the ``exit insert mode'' key.
+@item kn
+Numeric value, the number of numbered function keys.
+@item kN
+String of input sent by the ``next page'' key.
+@item ko
+Very obsolete string listing the terminal's named function keys.
+@item kP
+String of input sent by the ``previous page'' key.
+@item kr
+String of input sent by typing the right-arrow key.
+@item kR
+String of input sent by the ``scroll reverse'' key.
+@item ks
+String to make the function keys transmit.
+@item kS
+String of input sent by the ``clear to end of screen'' key.
+@item kt
+String of input sent by the ``clear tab stop this column'' key.
+@item kT
+String of input sent by the ``set tab stop in this column'' key.
+@item ku
+String of input sent by typing the up-arrow key.
+@item l0
+String on keyboard labelling function key 0 or 10.
+@item l1 @dots{} l9
+Strings on keyboard labelling function keys 1 through 9.
+@item le
+String to move the cursor left one column.
+@item LE
+String to move cursor left @var{n} columns.
+@item li
+Number: height of the screen.
+@item ll
+String to position cursor at lower left corner.
+@item lm
+Number: lines of display memory.
+@item LP
+Flag: writing to last column of last line will not scroll.
+@item mb
+String to enter blinking mode.
+@item md
+String to enter double-bright mode.
+@item me
+String to turn off all appearance modes
+@item mh
+String to enter half-bright mode.
+@item mi
+Flag: cursor motion in insert mode is safe.
+@item mk
+String to enter invisible mode.
+@item mm
+String to enable the functioning of the Meta key.
+@item mo
+String to disable the functioning of the Meta key.
+@item mp
+String to enter protected mode.
+@item mr
+String to enter reverse-video mode.
+@item ms
+Flag: cursor motion in standout mode is safe.
+@item nc
+Obsolete flag: do not use ASCII carriage-return on this terminal.
+@item nd
+String to move the cursor right one column.
+@item NF
+Flag: do not use XON/XOFF flow control.
+@item nl
+Obsolete alternative name for the @samp{do} and @samp{sf} capabilities.
+@item ns
+Flag: the terminal does not normally scroll for sequential output.
+@item nw
+String to move to start of next line, possibly clearing rest of old line.
+@item os
+Flag: terminal can overstrike.
+@item pb
+Number: the lowest baud rate at which padding is actually needed.
+@item pc
+String containing character for padding.
+@item pf
+String to terminate redirection of output to the printer.
+@item po
+String to redirect further output to the printer.
+@item pO
+String to redirect @var{n} characters ofoutput to the printer.
+@item ps
+String to print the screen on the attached printer.
+@item rc
+String to move to last saved cursor position.
+@item RI
+String to move cursor right @var{n} columns.
+@item rp
+String to output character @var{c} repeated @var{n} times.
+@item rs
+String to reset the terminal from any strange modes.
+@item sa
+String to turn on an arbitrary combination of appearance modes.
+@item sc
+String to save the current cursor position.
+@item se
+String to leave standout mode.
+@item sf
+String to scroll the screen one line up.
+@item SF
+String to scroll the screen @var{n} lines up.
+@item sg
+Number: width of magic standout cookie. Absent if magic cookies are
+not used.
+@item so
+String to enter standout mode.
+@item sr
+String to scroll the screen one line down.
+@item SR
+String to scroll the screen @var{n} line down.
+@item st
+String to set tab stop at current cursor column on all lines.
+programs.
+@item ta
+String to move the cursor right to the next hardware tab stop column.
+@item te
+String to return terminal to settings for sequential output.
+@item ti
+String to initialize terminal for random cursor motion.
+@item ts
+String to move the terminal cursor into the status line.
+@item uc
+String to underline one character and move cursor right.
+@item ue
+String to turn off underline mode
+@item ug
+Number: width of underlining magic cookie. Absent if underlining
+doesn't use magic cookies.
+@item ul
+Flag: underline by overstriking with an underscore.
+@item up
+String to move the cursor vertically up one line.
+@item UP
+String to move cursor vertically up @var{n} lines.
+@item us
+String to turn on underline mode
+@item vb
+String to make the screen flash.
+@item ve
+String to return the cursor to normal.
+@item vi
+String to make the cursor invisible.
+@item vs
+String to enhance the cursor.
+@item wi
+String to set the terminal output screen window.
+@item ws
+Number: the width of the status line.
+@item xb
+Flag: superbee terminal.
+@item xn
+Flag: cursor wraps in a strange way.
+@item xs
+Flag: clearing a line is the only way to clear the appearance modes of
+positions in that line (or, only way to remove magic cookies on that
+line).
+@item xt
+Flag: Teleray 1061; several strange characteristics.
+@end table
+
+@node Var Index, Cap Index, Summary, Top
+@unnumbered Variable and Function Index
+
+@printindex fn
+
+@node Cap Index, Index, Var Index, Top
+@unnumbered Capability Index
+
+@printindex ky
+
+@node Index, , Cap Index, Top
+@unnumbered Concept Index
+
+@printindex cp
+
+@contents
+@bye
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/texinfo.tex b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/texinfo.tex
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f62e9f5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/grot/texinfo.tex
@@ -0,0 +1,4422 @@
+%% TeX macros to handle texinfo files
+
+% Copyright (C) 1985, 86, 88, 90, 91, 92, 93, 1994 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+%This texinfo.tex file is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+%modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
+%published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at
+%your option) any later version.
+
+%This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be
+%useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+%of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+%General Public License for more details.
+
+%You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+%along with this texinfo.tex file; see the file COPYING. If not, write
+%to the Free Software Foundation, 675 Mass Ave, Cambridge, MA 02139,
+%USA.
+
+
+%In other words, you are welcome to use, share and improve this program.
+%You are forbidden to forbid anyone else to use, share and improve
+%what you give them. Help stamp out software-hoarding!
+
+
+% Send bug reports to bug-texinfo@prep.ai.mit.edu.
+% Please include a *precise* test case in each bug report.
+
+
+% Make it possible to create a .fmt file just by loading this file:
+% if the underlying format is not loaded, start by loading it now.
+% Added by gildea November 1993.
+\expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname\endcsname\relax\input plain\fi
+
+% This automatically updates the version number based on RCS.
+\def\deftexinfoversion$#1: #2 ${\def\texinfoversion{#2}}
+\deftexinfoversion$Revision: 2.146 $
+\message{Loading texinfo package [Version \texinfoversion]:}
+
+% If in a .fmt file, print the version number
+% and turn on active characters that we couldn't do earlier because
+% they might have appeared in the input file name.
+\everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}\message{}
+ \catcode`+=\active \catcode`\_=\active}
+
+% Save some parts of plain tex whose names we will redefine.
+
+\let\ptextilde=\~
+\let\ptexlbrace=\{
+\let\ptexrbrace=\}
+\let\ptexdots=\dots
+\let\ptexdot=\.
+\let\ptexstar=\*
+\let\ptexend=\end
+\let\ptexbullet=\bullet
+\let\ptexb=\b
+\let\ptexc=\c
+\let\ptexi=\i
+\let\ptext=\t
+\let\ptexl=\l
+\let\ptexL=\L
+
+% Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space
+% equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space
+% at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and
+% since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the
+% penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph.
+{\catcode`@ = 11
+ \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\@M\ }
+}
+\let\~ = \tie % And make it available as @~.
+
+\message{Basics,}
+\chardef\other=12
+
+% If this character appears in an error message or help string, it
+% starts a new line in the output.
+\newlinechar = `^^J
+
+% Set up fixed words for English.
+\ifx\putwordChapter\undefined{\gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter}}\fi%
+\def\putwordInfo{Info}%
+\ifx\putwordSee\undefined{\gdef\putwordSee{See}}\fi%
+\ifx\putwordsee\undefined{\gdef\putwordsee{see}}\fi%
+\ifx\putwordfile\undefined{\gdef\putwordfile{file}}\fi%
+\ifx\putwordpage\undefined{\gdef\putwordpage{page}}\fi%
+\ifx\putwordsection\undefined{\gdef\putwordsection{section}}\fi%
+\ifx\putwordSection\undefined{\gdef\putwordSection{Section}}\fi%
+\ifx\putwordTableofContents\undefined{\gdef\putwordTableofContents{Table of Contents}}\fi%
+\ifx\putwordShortContents\undefined{\gdef\putwordShortContents{Short Contents}}\fi%
+\ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined{\gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}}\fi%
+
+% Ignore a token.
+%
+\def\gobble#1{}
+
+\hyphenation{ap-pen-dix}
+\hyphenation{mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers}
+\hyphenation{eshell}
+
+% Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages.
+\newdimen \bindingoffset \bindingoffset=0pt
+\newdimen \normaloffset \normaloffset=\hoffset
+\newdimen\pagewidth \newdimen\pageheight
+\pagewidth=\hsize \pageheight=\vsize
+
+% Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file
+% and nothing on the terminal. We don't just call \tracingall here,
+% since that produces some useless output on the terminal.
+%
+\def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs = 1 \loggingall \endgroup}%
+\def\loggingall{\tracingcommands2 \tracingstats2
+ \tracingpages1 \tracingoutput1 \tracinglostchars1
+ \tracingmacros2 \tracingparagraphs1 \tracingrestores1
+ \showboxbreadth\maxdimen\showboxdepth\maxdimen
+}%
+
+%---------------------Begin change-----------------------
+%
+%%%% For @cropmarks command.
+% Dimensions to add cropmarks at corners Added by P. A. MacKay, 12 Nov. 1986
+%
+\newdimen\cornerlong \newdimen\cornerthick
+\newdimen \topandbottommargin
+\newdimen \outerhsize \newdimen \outervsize
+\cornerlong=1pc\cornerthick=.3pt % These set size of cropmarks
+\outerhsize=7in
+%\outervsize=9.5in
+% Alternative @smallbook page size is 9.25in
+\outervsize=9.25in
+\topandbottommargin=.75in
+%
+%---------------------End change-----------------------
+
+% \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument. Note that \pagecontents
+% does insertions itself, but you have to call it yourself.
+\chardef\PAGE=255 \output={\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}
+\def\onepageout#1{\hoffset=\normaloffset
+\ifodd\pageno \advance\hoffset by \bindingoffset
+\else \advance\hoffset by -\bindingoffset\fi
+{\escapechar=`\\\relax % makes sure backslash is used in output files.
+\shipout\vbox{{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makeheadline} \pagebody{#1}%
+{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makefootline}}}%
+\advancepageno \ifnum\outputpenalty>-20000 \else\dosupereject\fi}
+
+%%%% For @cropmarks command %%%%
+
+% Here is a modification of the main output routine for Near East Publications
+% This provides right-angle cropmarks at all four corners.
+% The contents of the page are centerlined into the cropmarks,
+% and any desired binding offset is added as an \hskip on either
+% site of the centerlined box. (P. A. MacKay, 12 November, 1986)
+%
+\def\croppageout#1{\hoffset=0pt % make sure this doesn't mess things up
+{\escapechar=`\\\relax % makes sure backslash is used in output files.
+ \shipout
+ \vbox to \outervsize{\hsize=\outerhsize
+ \vbox{\line{\ewtop\hfill\ewtop}}
+ \nointerlineskip
+ \line{\vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nstop}
+ \hfill
+ \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nstop}}
+ \vskip \topandbottommargin
+ \centerline{\ifodd\pageno\hskip\bindingoffset\fi
+ \vbox{
+ {\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makeheadline}
+ \pagebody{#1}
+ {\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makefootline}}
+ \ifodd\pageno\else\hskip\bindingoffset\fi}
+ \vskip \topandbottommargin plus1fill minus1fill
+ \boxmaxdepth\cornerthick
+ \line{\vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nsbot}
+ \hfill
+ \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nsbot}}
+ \nointerlineskip
+ \vbox{\line{\ewbot\hfill\ewbot}}
+ }}
+ \advancepageno
+ \ifnum\outputpenalty>-20000 \else\dosupereject\fi}
+%
+% Do @cropmarks to get crop marks
+\def\cropmarks{\let\onepageout=\croppageout }
+
+\newinsert\margin \dimen\margin=\maxdimen
+
+\def\pagebody#1{\vbox to\pageheight{\boxmaxdepth=\maxdepth #1}}
+{\catcode`\@ =11
+\gdef\pagecontents#1{\ifvoid\topins\else\unvbox\topins\fi
+% marginal hacks, juha@viisa.uucp (Juha Takala)
+\ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present
+ \rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to\z@{\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi
+\dimen@=\dp#1 \unvbox#1
+\ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi
+\ifr@ggedbottom \kern-\dimen@ \vfil \fi}
+}
+
+%
+% Here are the rules for the cropmarks. Note that they are
+% offset so that the space between them is truly \outerhsize or \outervsize
+% (P. A. MacKay, 12 November, 1986)
+%
+\def\ewtop{\vrule height\cornerthick depth0pt width\cornerlong}
+\def\nstop{\vbox
+ {\hrule height\cornerthick depth\cornerlong width\cornerthick}}
+\def\ewbot{\vrule height0pt depth\cornerthick width\cornerlong}
+\def\nsbot{\vbox
+ {\hrule height\cornerlong depth\cornerthick width\cornerthick}}
+
+% Parse an argument, then pass it to #1. The argument is the rest of
+% the input line (except we remove a trailing comment). #1 should be a
+% macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument.
+%
+\def\parsearg#1{%
+ \let\next = #1%
+ \begingroup
+ \obeylines
+ \futurelet\temp\parseargx
+}
+
+% If the next token is an obeyed space (from an @example environment or
+% the like), remove it and recurse. Otherwise, we're done.
+\def\parseargx{%
+ % \obeyedspace is defined far below, after the definition of \sepspaces.
+ \ifx\obeyedspace\temp
+ \expandafter\parseargdiscardspace
+ \else
+ \expandafter\parseargline
+ \fi
+}
+
+% Remove a single space (as the delimiter token to the macro call).
+{\obeyspaces %
+ \gdef\parseargdiscardspace {\futurelet\temp\parseargx}}
+
+{\obeylines %
+ \gdef\parseargline#1^^M{%
+ \endgroup % End of the group started in \parsearg.
+ %
+ % First remove any @c comment, then any @comment.
+ % Result of each macro is put in \toks0.
+ \argremovec #1\c\relax %
+ \expandafter\argremovecomment \the\toks0 \comment\relax %
+ %
+ % Call the caller's macro, saved as \next in \parsearg.
+ \expandafter\next\expandafter{\the\toks0}%
+ }%
+}
+
+% Since all \c{,omment} does is throw away the argument, we can let TeX
+% do that for us. The \relax here is matched by the \relax in the call
+% in \parseargline; it could be more or less anything, its purpose is
+% just to delimit the argument to the \c.
+\def\argremovec#1\c#2\relax{\toks0 = {#1}}
+\def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\relax{\toks0 = {#1}}
+
+% \argremovec{,omment} might leave us with trailing spaces, though; e.g.,
+% @end itemize @c foo
+% will have two active spaces as part of the argument with the
+% `itemize'. Here we remove all active spaces from #1, and assign the
+% result to \toks0.
+%
+% This loses if there are any *other* active characters besides spaces
+% in the argument -- _ ^ +, for example -- since they get expanded.
+% Fortunately, Texinfo does not define any such commands. (If it ever
+% does, the catcode of the characters in questionwill have to be changed
+% here.) But this means we cannot call \removeactivespaces as part of
+% \argremovec{,omment}, since @c uses \parsearg, and thus the argument
+% that \parsearg gets might well have any character at all in it.
+%
+\def\removeactivespaces#1{%
+ \begingroup
+ \ignoreactivespaces
+ \edef\temp{#1}%
+ \global\toks0 = \expandafter{\temp}%
+ \endgroup
+}
+
+% Change the active space to expand to nothing.
+%
+\begingroup
+ \obeyspaces
+ \gdef\ignoreactivespaces{\obeyspaces\let =\empty}
+\endgroup
+
+
+\def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next##1{}\else \let\next=\relax \fi \next}
+
+%% These are used to keep @begin/@end levels from running away
+%% Call \inENV within environments (after a \begingroup)
+\newif\ifENV \ENVfalse \def\inENV{\ifENV\relax\else\ENVtrue\fi}
+\def\ENVcheck{%
+\ifENV\errmessage{Still within an environment. Type Return to continue.}
+\endgroup\fi} % This is not perfect, but it should reduce lossage
+
+% @begin foo is the same as @foo, for now.
+\newhelp\EMsimple{Type <Return> to continue.}
+
+\outer\def\begin{\parsearg\beginxxx}
+
+\def\beginxxx #1{%
+\expandafter\ifx\csname #1\endcsname\relax
+{\errhelp=\EMsimple \errmessage{Undefined command @begin #1}}\else
+\csname #1\endcsname\fi}
+
+% @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo.
+%
+\def\end{\parsearg\endxxx}
+\def\endxxx #1{%
+ \removeactivespaces{#1}%
+ \edef\endthing{\the\toks0}%
+ %
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname E\endthing\endcsname\relax
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname \endthing\endcsname\relax
+ % There's no \foo, i.e., no ``environment'' foo.
+ \errhelp = \EMsimple
+ \errmessage{Undefined command `@end \endthing'}%
+ \else
+ \unmatchedenderror\endthing
+ \fi
+ \else
+ % Everything's ok; the right environment has been started.
+ \csname E\endthing\endcsname
+ \fi
+}
+
+% There is an environment #1, but it hasn't been started. Give an error.
+%
+\def\unmatchedenderror#1{%
+ \errhelp = \EMsimple
+ \errmessage{This `@end #1' doesn't have a matching `@#1'}%
+}
+
+% Define the control sequence \E#1 to give an unmatched @end error.
+%
+\def\defineunmatchedend#1{%
+ \expandafter\def\csname E#1\endcsname{\unmatchedenderror{#1}}%
+}
+
+
+% Single-spacing is done by various environments (specifically, in
+% \nonfillstart and \quotations).
+\newskip\singlespaceskip \singlespaceskip = 12.5pt
+\def\singlespace{%
+ % Why was this kern here? It messes up equalizing space above and below
+ % environments. --karl, 6may93
+ %{\advance \baselineskip by -\singlespaceskip
+ %\kern \baselineskip}%
+ \setleading \singlespaceskip
+}
+
+%% Simple single-character @ commands
+
+% @@ prints an @
+% Kludge this until the fonts are right (grr).
+\def\@{{\tt \char '100}}
+
+% This is turned off because it was never documented
+% and you can use @w{...} around a quote to suppress ligatures.
+%% Define @` and @' to be the same as ` and '
+%% but suppressing ligatures.
+%\def\`{{`}}
+%\def\'{{'}}
+
+% Used to generate quoted braces.
+
+\def\mylbrace {{\tt \char '173}}
+\def\myrbrace {{\tt \char '175}}
+\let\{=\mylbrace
+\let\}=\myrbrace
+
+% @: forces normal size whitespace following.
+\def\:{\spacefactor=1000 }
+
+% @* forces a line break.
+\def\*{\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces}
+
+% @. is an end-of-sentence period.
+\def\.{.\spacefactor=3000 }
+
+% @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis.
+\gdef\enddots{$\mathinner{\ldotp\ldotp\ldotp\ldotp}$\spacefactor=3000}
+
+% @! is an end-of-sentence bang.
+\gdef\!{!\spacefactor=3000 }
+
+% @? is an end-of-sentence query.
+\gdef\?{?\spacefactor=3000 }
+
+% @w prevents a word break. Without the \leavevmode, @w at the
+% beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would
+% produce a whole line of output instead of starting the paragraph.
+\def\w#1{\leavevmode\hbox{#1}}
+
+% @group ... @end group forces ... to be all on one page, by enclosing
+% it in a TeX vbox. We use \vtop instead of \vbox to construct the box
+% to keep its height that of a normal line. According to the rules for
+% \topskip (p.114 of the TeXbook), the glue inserted is
+% max (\topskip - \ht (first item), 0). If that height is large,
+% therefore, no glue is inserted, and the space between the headline and
+% the text is small, which looks bad.
+%
+\def\group{\begingroup
+ \ifnum\catcode13=\active \else
+ \errhelp = \groupinvalidhelp
+ \errmessage{@group invalid in context where filling is enabled}%
+ \fi
+ %
+ % The \vtop we start below produces a box with normal height and large
+ % depth; thus, TeX puts \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the
+ % next line of text is done) \lineskip glue after it. (See p.82 of
+ % the TeXbook.) Thus, space below is not quite equal to space
+ % above. But it's pretty close.
+ \def\Egroup{%
+ \egroup % End the \vtop.
+ \endgroup % End the \group.
+ }%
+ %
+ \vtop\bgroup
+ % We have to put a strut on the last line in case the @group is in
+ % the midst of an example, rather than completely enclosing it.
+ % Otherwise, the interline space between the last line of the group
+ % and the first line afterwards is too small. But we can't put the
+ % strut in \Egroup, since there it would be on a line by itself.
+ % Hence this just inserts a strut at the beginning of each line.
+ \everypar = {\strut}%
+ %
+ % Since we have a strut on every line, we don't need any of TeX's
+ % normal interline spacing.
+ \offinterlineskip
+ %
+ % OK, but now we have to do something about blank
+ % lines in the input in @example-like environments, which normally
+ % just turn into \lisppar, which will insert no space now that we've
+ % turned off the interline space. Simplest is to make them be an
+ % empty paragraph.
+ \ifx\par\lisppar
+ \edef\par{\leavevmode \par}%
+ %
+ % Reset ^^M's definition to new definition of \par.
+ \obeylines
+ \fi
+ %
+ % Do @comment since we are called inside an environment such as
+ % @example, where each end-of-line in the input causes an
+ % end-of-line in the output. We don't want the end-of-line after
+ % the `@group' to put extra space in the output. Since @group
+ % should appear on a line by itself (according to the Texinfo
+ % manual), we don't worry about eating any user text.
+ \comment
+}
+%
+% TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help
+% message, so this ends up printing `@group can only ...'.
+%
+\newhelp\groupinvalidhelp{%
+group can only be used in environments such as @example,^^J%
+where each line of input produces a line of output.}
+
+% @need space-in-mils
+% forces a page break if there is not space-in-mils remaining.
+
+\newdimen\mil \mil=0.001in
+
+\def\need{\parsearg\needx}
+
+% Old definition--didn't work.
+%\def\needx #1{\par %
+%% This method tries to make TeX break the page naturally
+%% if the depth of the box does not fit.
+%{\baselineskip=0pt%
+%\vtop to #1\mil{\vfil}\kern -#1\mil\penalty 10000
+%\prevdepth=-1000pt
+%}}
+
+\def\needx#1{%
+ % Go into vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a
+ % paragraph.
+ \par
+ %
+ % Don't add any leading before our big empty box, but allow a page
+ % break, since the best break might be right here.
+ \allowbreak
+ \nointerlineskip
+ \vtop to #1\mil{\vfil}%
+ %
+ % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the
+ % main vertical list is 10000 or more. But in order to see if the
+ % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider
+ % page breaks. On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the
+ % page after the empty box. So we use a penalty of 9999.
+ %
+ % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the
+ % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in
+ % sight. (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which
+ % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing
+ % good page breaking, for example.) However, I could not construct an
+ % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real
+ % document, then we can reconsider our strategy.
+ \penalty9999
+ %
+ % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not.
+ \kern -#1\mil
+ %
+ % Do not allow a page break right after this kern.
+ \nobreak
+}
+
+% @br forces paragraph break
+
+\let\br = \par
+
+% @dots{} output some dots
+
+\def\dots{$\ldots$}
+
+% @page forces the start of a new page
+
+\def\page{\par\vfill\supereject}
+
+% @exdent text....
+% outputs text on separate line in roman font, starting at standard page margin
+
+% This records the amount of indent in the innermost environment.
+% That's how much \exdent should take out.
+\newskip\exdentamount
+
+% This defn is used inside fill environments such as @defun.
+\def\exdent{\parsearg\exdentyyy}
+\def\exdentyyy #1{{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break}}
+
+% This defn is used inside nofill environments such as @example.
+\def\nofillexdent{\parsearg\nofillexdentyyy}
+\def\nofillexdentyyy #1{{\advance \leftskip by -\exdentamount
+\leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}}
+
+%\hbox{{\rm#1}}\hfil\break}}
+
+% @include file insert text of that file as input.
+
+\def\include{\parsearg\includezzz}
+%Use \input\thisfile to avoid blank after \input, which may be an active
+%char (in which case the blank would become the \input argument).
+%The grouping keeps the value of \thisfile correct even when @include
+%is nested.
+\def\includezzz #1{\begingroup
+\def\thisfile{#1}\input\thisfile
+\endgroup}
+
+\def\thisfile{}
+
+% @center line outputs that line, centered
+
+\def\center{\parsearg\centerzzz}
+\def\centerzzz #1{{\advance\hsize by -\leftskip
+\advance\hsize by -\rightskip
+\centerline{#1}}}
+
+% @sp n outputs n lines of vertical space
+
+\def\sp{\parsearg\spxxx}
+\def\spxxx #1{\par \vskip #1\baselineskip}
+
+% @comment ...line which is ignored...
+% @c is the same as @comment
+% @ignore ... @end ignore is another way to write a comment
+
+\def\comment{\catcode 64=\other \catcode 123=\other \catcode 125=\other%
+\parsearg \commentxxx}
+
+\def\commentxxx #1{\catcode 64=0 \catcode 123=1 \catcode 125=2 }
+
+\let\c=\comment
+
+% Prevent errors for section commands.
+% Used in @ignore and in failing conditionals.
+\def\ignoresections{%
+\let\chapter=\relax
+\let\unnumbered=\relax
+\let\top=\relax
+\let\unnumberedsec=\relax
+\let\unnumberedsection=\relax
+\let\unnumberedsubsec=\relax
+\let\unnumberedsubsection=\relax
+\let\unnumberedsubsubsec=\relax
+\let\unnumberedsubsubsection=\relax
+\let\section=\relax
+\let\subsec=\relax
+\let\subsubsec=\relax
+\let\subsection=\relax
+\let\subsubsection=\relax
+\let\appendix=\relax
+\let\appendixsec=\relax
+\let\appendixsection=\relax
+\let\appendixsubsec=\relax
+\let\appendixsubsection=\relax
+\let\appendixsubsubsec=\relax
+\let\appendixsubsubsection=\relax
+\let\contents=\relax
+\let\smallbook=\relax
+\let\titlepage=\relax
+}
+
+% Used in nested conditionals, where we have to parse the Texinfo source
+% and so want to turn off most commands, in case they are used
+% incorrectly.
+%
+\def\ignoremorecommands{%
+ \let\defcv = \relax
+ \let\deffn = \relax
+ \let\deffnx = \relax
+ \let\defindex = \relax
+ \let\defivar = \relax
+ \let\defmac = \relax
+ \let\defmethod = \relax
+ \let\defop = \relax
+ \let\defopt = \relax
+ \let\defspec = \relax
+ \let\deftp = \relax
+ \let\deftypefn = \relax
+ \let\deftypefun = \relax
+ \let\deftypevar = \relax
+ \let\deftypevr = \relax
+ \let\defun = \relax
+ \let\defvar = \relax
+ \let\defvr = \relax
+ \let\ref = \relax
+ \let\xref = \relax
+ \let\printindex = \relax
+ \let\pxref = \relax
+ \let\settitle = \relax
+ \let\include = \relax
+ \let\lowersections = \relax
+ \let\down = \relax
+ \let\raisesections = \relax
+ \let\up = \relax
+ \let\set = \relax
+ \let\clear = \relax
+ \let\item = \relax
+ \let\message = \relax
+}
+
+% Ignore @ignore ... @end ignore.
+%
+\def\ignore{\doignore{ignore}}
+
+% Also ignore @ifinfo, @ifhtml, @html, @menu, and @direntry text.
+%
+\def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}}
+\def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}}
+\def\html{\doignore{html}}
+\def\menu{\doignore{menu}}
+\def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}}
+
+% Ignore text until a line `@end #1'.
+%
+\def\doignore#1{\begingroup
+ % Don't complain about control sequences we have declared \outer.
+ \ignoresections
+ %
+ % Define a command to swallow text until we reach `@end #1'.
+ \long\def\doignoretext##1\end #1{\enddoignore}%
+ %
+ % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants.
+ \catcode32 = 10
+ %
+ % And now expand that command.
+ \doignoretext
+}
+
+% What we do to finish off ignored text.
+%
+\def\enddoignore{\endgroup\ignorespaces}%
+
+\newif\ifwarnedobs\warnedobsfalse
+\def\obstexwarn{%
+ \ifwarnedobs\relax\else
+ % We need to warn folks that they may have trouble with TeX 3.0.
+ % This uses \immediate\write16 rather than \message to get newlines.
+ \immediate\write16{}
+ \immediate\write16{***WARNING*** for users of Unix TeX 3.0!}
+ \immediate\write16{This manual trips a bug in TeX version 3.0 (tex hangs).}
+ \immediate\write16{If you are running another version of TeX, relax.}
+ \immediate\write16{If you are running Unix TeX 3.0, kill this TeX process.}
+ \immediate\write16{ Then upgrade your TeX installation if you can.}
+ \immediate\write16{If you are stuck with version 3.0, run the}
+ \immediate\write16{ script ``tex3patch'' from the Texinfo distribution}
+ \immediate\write16{ to use a workaround.}
+ \immediate\write16{}
+ \warnedobstrue
+ \fi
+}
+
+% **In TeX 3.0, setting text in \nullfont hangs tex. For a
+% workaround (which requires the file ``dummy.tfm'' to be installed),
+% uncomment the following line:
+%%%%%\font\nullfont=dummy\let\obstexwarn=\relax
+
+% Ignore text, except that we keep track of conditional commands for
+% purposes of nesting, up to an `@end #1' command.
+%
+\def\nestedignore#1{%
+ \obstexwarn
+ % We must actually expand the ignored text to look for the @end
+ % command, so that nested ignore constructs work. Thus, we put the
+ % text into a \vbox and then do nothing with the result. To minimize
+ % the change of memory overflow, we follow the approach outlined on
+ % page 401 of the TeXbook: make the current font be a dummy font.
+ %
+ \setbox0 = \vbox\bgroup
+ % Don't complain about control sequences we have declared \outer.
+ \ignoresections
+ %
+ % Define `@end #1' to end the box, which will in turn undefine the
+ % @end command again.
+ \expandafter\def\csname E#1\endcsname{\egroup\ignorespaces}%
+ %
+ % We are going to be parsing Texinfo commands. Most cause no
+ % trouble when they are used incorrectly, but some commands do
+ % complicated argument parsing or otherwise get confused, so we
+ % undefine them.
+ %
+ % We can't do anything about stray @-signs, unfortunately;
+ % they'll produce `undefined control sequence' errors.
+ \ignoremorecommands
+ %
+ % Set the current font to be \nullfont, a TeX primitive, and define
+ % all the font commands to also use \nullfont. We don't use
+ % dummy.tfm, as suggested in the TeXbook, because not all sites
+ % might have that installed. Therefore, math mode will still
+ % produce output, but that should be an extremely small amount of
+ % stuff compared to the main input.
+ %
+ \nullfont
+ \let\tenrm = \nullfont \let\tenit = \nullfont \let\tensl = \nullfont
+ \let\tenbf = \nullfont \let\tentt = \nullfont \let\smallcaps = \nullfont
+ \let\tensf = \nullfont
+ % Similarly for index fonts (mostly for their use in
+ % smallexample)
+ \let\indrm = \nullfont \let\indit = \nullfont \let\indsl = \nullfont
+ \let\indbf = \nullfont \let\indtt = \nullfont \let\indsc = \nullfont
+ \let\indsf = \nullfont
+ %
+ % Don't complain when characters are missing from the fonts.
+ \tracinglostchars = 0
+ %
+ % Don't bother to do space factor calculations.
+ \frenchspacing
+ %
+ % Don't report underfull hboxes.
+ \hbadness = 10000
+ %
+ % Do minimal line-breaking.
+ \pretolerance = 10000
+ %
+ % Do not execute instructions in @tex
+ \def\tex{\doignore{tex}}
+}
+
+% @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value.
+% @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE.
+%
+% Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be
+% empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our
+% own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we
+% didn't need it.
+%
+\def\set{\parsearg\setxxx}
+\def\setxxx#1{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy}
+\def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{%
+ \def\temp{#2}%
+ \ifx\temp\empty \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname = \empty
+ \else \setzzz{#1}#2\endsetzzz % Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted.
+ \fi
+}
+% Can't use \xdef to pre-expand #2 and save some time, since \temp or
+% \next or other control sequences that we've defined might get us into
+% an infinite loop. Consider `@set foo @cite{bar}'.
+\def\setzzz#1#2 \endsetzzz{\expandafter\gdef\csname SET#1\endcsname{#2}}
+
+% @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR.
+%
+\def\clear{\parsearg\clearxxx}
+\def\clearxxx#1{\global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax}
+
+% @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo.
+%
+\def\value#1{\expandafter
+ \ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
+ {\{No value for ``#1''\}}
+ \else \csname SET#1\endcsname \fi}
+
+% @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined
+% with @set.
+%
+\def\ifset{\parsearg\ifsetxxx}
+\def\ifsetxxx #1{%
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
+ \expandafter\ifsetfail
+ \else
+ \expandafter\ifsetsucceed
+ \fi
+}
+\def\ifsetsucceed{\conditionalsucceed{ifset}}
+\def\ifsetfail{\nestedignore{ifset}}
+\defineunmatchedend{ifset}
+
+% @ifclear VAR ... @end ifclear reads the `...' iff VAR has never been
+% defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear.
+%
+\def\ifclear{\parsearg\ifclearxxx}
+\def\ifclearxxx #1{%
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
+ \expandafter\ifclearsucceed
+ \else
+ \expandafter\ifclearfail
+ \fi
+}
+\def\ifclearsucceed{\conditionalsucceed{ifclear}}
+\def\ifclearfail{\nestedignore{ifclear}}
+\defineunmatchedend{ifclear}
+
+% @iftex always succeeds; we read the text following, through @end
+% iftex). But `@end iftex' should be valid only after an @iftex.
+%
+\def\iftex{\conditionalsucceed{iftex}}
+\defineunmatchedend{iftex}
+
+% We can't just want to start a group at @iftex (for example) and end it
+% at @end iftex, since then @set commands inside the conditional have no
+% effect (they'd get reverted at the end of the group). So we must
+% define \Eiftex to redefine itself to be its previous value. (We can't
+% just define it to fail again with an ``unmatched end'' error, since
+% the @ifset might be nested.)
+%
+\def\conditionalsucceed#1{%
+ \edef\temp{%
+ % Remember the current value of \E#1.
+ \let\nece{prevE#1} = \nece{E#1}%
+ %
+ % At the `@end #1', redefine \E#1 to be its previous value.
+ \def\nece{E#1}{\let\nece{E#1} = \nece{prevE#1}}%
+ }%
+ \temp
+}
+
+% We need to expand lots of \csname's, but we don't want to expand the
+% control sequences after we've constructed them.
+%
+\def\nece#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname}
+
+% @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example.
+%
+\def\asis#1{#1}
+
+% @math means output in math mode.
+% We don't use $'s directly in the definition of \math because control
+% sequences like \math are expanded when the toc file is written. Then,
+% we read the toc file back, the $'s will be normal characters (as they
+% should be, according to the definition of Texinfo). So we must use a
+% control sequence to switch into and out of math mode.
+%
+% This isn't quite enough for @math to work properly in indices, but it
+% seems unlikely it will ever be needed there.
+%
+\let\implicitmath = $
+\def\math#1{\implicitmath #1\implicitmath}
+
+% @bullet and @minus need the same treatment as @math, just above.
+\def\bullet{\implicitmath\ptexbullet\implicitmath}
+\def\minus{\implicitmath-\implicitmath}
+
+\def\node{\ENVcheck\parsearg\nodezzz}
+\def\nodezzz#1{\nodexxx [#1,]}
+\def\nodexxx[#1,#2]{\gdef\lastnode{#1}}
+\let\nwnode=\node
+\let\lastnode=\relax
+
+\def\donoderef{\ifx\lastnode\relax\else
+\expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\setref{\lastnode}\fi
+\global\let\lastnode=\relax}
+
+\def\unnumbnoderef{\ifx\lastnode\relax\else
+\expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\unnumbsetref{\lastnode}\fi
+\global\let\lastnode=\relax}
+
+\def\appendixnoderef{\ifx\lastnode\relax\else
+\expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\appendixsetref{\lastnode}\fi
+\global\let\lastnode=\relax}
+
+\let\refill=\relax
+
+% @setfilename is done at the beginning of every texinfo file.
+% So open here the files we need to have open while reading the input.
+% This makes it possible to make a .fmt file for texinfo.
+\def\setfilename{%
+ \readauxfile
+ \opencontents
+ \openindices
+ \fixbackslash % Turn off hack to swallow `\input texinfo'.
+ \global\let\setfilename=\comment % Ignore extra @setfilename cmds.
+ \comment % Ignore the actual filename.
+}
+
+\outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=1\ptexend}
+
+\def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**}
+\def\inforefzzz #1,#2,#3,#4**{\putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}},
+ node \samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}}
+
+\message{fonts,}
+
+% Font-change commands.
+
+% Texinfo supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not.
+% So we set up a \sf analogous to plain's \rm, etc.
+\newfam\sffam
+\def\sf{\fam=\sffam \tensf}
+\let\li = \sf % Sometimes we call it \li, not \sf.
+
+%% Try out Computer Modern fonts at \magstephalf
+\let\mainmagstep=\magstephalf
+
+% Set the font macro #1 to the font named #2, adding on the
+% specified font prefix (normally `cm').
+\def\setfont#1#2{\font#1=\fontprefix#2}
+
+% Use cm as the default font prefix.
+% To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix
+% before you read in texinfo.tex.
+\ifx\fontprefix\undefined
+\def\fontprefix{cm}
+\fi
+
+\ifx\bigger\relax
+\let\mainmagstep=\magstep1
+\setfont\textrm{r12}
+\setfont\texttt{tt12}
+\else
+\setfont\textrm{r10 scaled \mainmagstep}
+\setfont\texttt{tt10 scaled \mainmagstep}
+\fi
+% Instead of cmb10, you many want to use cmbx10.
+% cmbx10 is a prettier font on its own, but cmb10
+% looks better when embedded in a line with cmr10.
+\setfont\textbf{b10 scaled \mainmagstep}
+\setfont\textit{ti10 scaled \mainmagstep}
+\setfont\textsl{sl10 scaled \mainmagstep}
+\setfont\textsf{ss10 scaled \mainmagstep}
+\setfont\textsc{csc10 scaled \mainmagstep}
+\font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
+\font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
+
+% A few fonts for @defun, etc.
+\setfont\defbf{bx10 scaled \magstep1} %was 1314
+\setfont\deftt{tt10 scaled \magstep1}
+\def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \bf}
+
+% Fonts for indices and small examples.
+% We actually use the slanted font rather than the italic,
+% because texinfo normally uses the slanted fonts for that.
+% Do not make many font distinctions in general in the index, since they
+% aren't very useful.
+\setfont\ninett{tt9}
+\setfont\indrm{r9}
+\setfont\indit{sl9}
+\let\indsl=\indit
+\let\indtt=\ninett
+\let\indsf=\indrm
+\let\indbf=\indrm
+\setfont\indsc{csc10 at 9pt}
+\font\indi=cmmi9
+\font\indsy=cmsy9
+
+% Fonts for headings
+\setfont\chaprm{bx12 scaled \magstep2}
+\setfont\chapit{ti12 scaled \magstep2}
+\setfont\chapsl{sl12 scaled \magstep2}
+\setfont\chaptt{tt12 scaled \magstep2}
+\setfont\chapsf{ss12 scaled \magstep2}
+\let\chapbf=\chaprm
+\setfont\chapsc{csc10 scaled\magstep3}
+\font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep2
+\font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep3
+
+\setfont\secrm{bx12 scaled \magstep1}
+\setfont\secit{ti12 scaled \magstep1}
+\setfont\secsl{sl12 scaled \magstep1}
+\setfont\sectt{tt12 scaled \magstep1}
+\setfont\secsf{ss12 scaled \magstep1}
+\setfont\secbf{bx12 scaled \magstep1}
+\setfont\secsc{csc10 scaled\magstep2}
+\font\seci=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
+\font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
+
+% \setfont\ssecrm{bx10 scaled \magstep1} % This size an font looked bad.
+% \setfont\ssecit{cmti10 scaled \magstep1} % The letters were too crowded.
+% \setfont\ssecsl{sl10 scaled \magstep1}
+% \setfont\ssectt{tt10 scaled \magstep1}
+% \setfont\ssecsf{ss10 scaled \magstep1}
+
+%\setfont\ssecrm{b10 scaled 1315} % Note the use of cmb rather than cmbx.
+%\setfont\ssecit{ti10 scaled 1315} % Also, the size is a little larger than
+%\setfont\ssecsl{sl10 scaled 1315} % being scaled magstep1.
+%\setfont\ssectt{tt10 scaled 1315}
+%\setfont\ssecsf{ss10 scaled 1315}
+
+%\let\ssecbf=\ssecrm
+
+\setfont\ssecrm{bx12 scaled \magstephalf}
+\setfont\ssecit{ti12 scaled \magstephalf}
+\setfont\ssecsl{sl12 scaled \magstephalf}
+\setfont\ssectt{tt12 scaled \magstephalf}
+\setfont\ssecsf{ss12 scaled \magstephalf}
+\setfont\ssecbf{bx12 scaled \magstephalf}
+\setfont\ssecsc{csc10 scaled \magstep1}
+\font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled \magstephalf
+\font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep1
+% The smallcaps and symbol fonts should actually be scaled \magstep1.5,
+% but that is not a standard magnification.
+
+% Fonts for title page:
+\setfont\titlerm{bx12 scaled \magstep3}
+\let\authorrm = \secrm
+
+% In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters,
+% we have to define the \textfont of the standard families. Since
+% texinfo doesn't allow for producing subscripts and superscripts, we
+% don't bother to reset \scriptfont and \scriptscriptfont (which would
+% also require loading a lot more fonts).
+%
+\def\resetmathfonts{%
+ \textfont0 = \tenrm \textfont1 = \teni \textfont2 = \tensy
+ \textfont\itfam = \tenit \textfont\slfam = \tensl \textfont\bffam = \tenbf
+ \textfont\ttfam = \tentt \textfont\sffam = \tensf
+}
+
+
+% The font-changing commands redefine the meanings of \tenSTYLE, instead
+% of just \STYLE. We do this so that font changes will continue to work
+% in math mode, where it is the current \fam that is relevant in most
+% cases, not the current. Plain TeX does, for example,
+% \def\bf{\fam=\bffam \tenbf} By redefining \tenbf, we obviate the need
+% to redefine \bf itself.
+\def\textfonts{%
+ \let\tenrm=\textrm \let\tenit=\textit \let\tensl=\textsl
+ \let\tenbf=\textbf \let\tentt=\texttt \let\smallcaps=\textsc
+ \let\tensf=\textsf \let\teni=\texti \let\tensy=\textsy
+ \resetmathfonts}
+\def\chapfonts{%
+ \let\tenrm=\chaprm \let\tenit=\chapit \let\tensl=\chapsl
+ \let\tenbf=\chapbf \let\tentt=\chaptt \let\smallcaps=\chapsc
+ \let\tensf=\chapsf \let\teni=\chapi \let\tensy=\chapsy
+ \resetmathfonts}
+\def\secfonts{%
+ \let\tenrm=\secrm \let\tenit=\secit \let\tensl=\secsl
+ \let\tenbf=\secbf \let\tentt=\sectt \let\smallcaps=\secsc
+ \let\tensf=\secsf \let\teni=\seci \let\tensy=\secsy
+ \resetmathfonts}
+\def\subsecfonts{%
+ \let\tenrm=\ssecrm \let\tenit=\ssecit \let\tensl=\ssecsl
+ \let\tenbf=\ssecbf \let\tentt=\ssectt \let\smallcaps=\ssecsc
+ \let\tensf=\ssecsf \let\teni=\sseci \let\tensy=\ssecsy
+ \resetmathfonts}
+\def\indexfonts{%
+ \let\tenrm=\indrm \let\tenit=\indit \let\tensl=\indsl
+ \let\tenbf=\indbf \let\tentt=\indtt \let\smallcaps=\indsc
+ \let\tensf=\indsf \let\teni=\indi \let\tensy=\indsy
+ \resetmathfonts}
+
+% Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes.
+%
+\textfonts
+
+% Count depth in font-changes, for error checks
+\newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=0
+
+% Fonts for short table of contents.
+\setfont\shortcontrm{r12}
+\setfont\shortcontbf{bx12}
+\setfont\shortcontsl{sl12}
+
+%% Add scribe-like font environments, plus @l for inline lisp (usually sans
+%% serif) and @ii for TeX italic
+
+% \smartitalic{ARG} outputs arg in italics, followed by an italic correction
+% unless the following character is such as not to need one.
+\def\smartitalicx{\ifx\next,\else\ifx\next-\else\ifx\next.\else\/\fi\fi\fi}
+\def\smartitalic#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
+
+\let\i=\smartitalic
+\let\var=\smartitalic
+\let\dfn=\smartitalic
+\let\emph=\smartitalic
+\let\cite=\smartitalic
+
+\def\b#1{{\bf #1}}
+\let\strong=\b
+
+% We can't just use \exhyphenpenalty, because that only has effect at
+% the end of a paragraph. Restore normal hyphenation at the end of the
+% group within which \nohyphenation is presumably called.
+%
+\def\nohyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = -1 \aftergroup\restorehyphenation}
+\def\restorehyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = `- }
+
+\def\t#1{%
+ {\tt \rawbackslash \frenchspacing #1}%
+ \null
+}
+\let\ttfont=\t
+\def\samp #1{`\tclose{#1}'\null}
+\def\key #1{{\tt \nohyphenation \uppercase{#1}}\null}
+\def\ctrl #1{{\tt \rawbackslash \hat}#1}
+
+\let\file=\samp
+
+% @code is a modification of @t,
+% which makes spaces the same size as normal in the surrounding text.
+\def\tclose#1{%
+ {%
+ % Change normal interword space to be same as for the current font.
+ \spaceskip = \fontdimen2\font
+ %
+ % Switch to typewriter.
+ \tt
+ %
+ % But `\ ' produces the large typewriter interword space.
+ \def\ {{\spaceskip = 0pt{} }}%
+ %
+ % Turn off hyphenation.
+ \nohyphenation
+ %
+ \rawbackslash
+ \frenchspacing
+ #1%
+ }%
+ \null
+}
+
+% We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in \code.
+% Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overful hboxes
+% in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc.
+
+% Unfortunately, TeX uses one parameter (\hyphenchar) to control
+% both hyphenation at - and hyphenation within words.
+% We must therefore turn them both off (\tclose does that)
+% and arrange explicitly to hyphenate an a dash.
+% -- rms.
+{
+\catcode`\-=\active
+\catcode`\_=\active
+\global\def\code{\begingroup \catcode`\-=\active \let-\codedash \catcode`\_=\active \let_\codeunder \codex}
+% The following is used by \doprintindex to insure that long function names
+% wrap around. It is necessary for - and _ to be active before the index is
+% read from the file, as \entry parses the arguments long before \code is
+% ever called. -- mycroft
+\global\def\indexbreaks{\catcode`\-=\active \let-\realdash \catcode`\_=\active \let_\realunder}
+}
+
+\def\realdash{-}
+\def\realunder{_}
+\def\codedash{-\discretionary{}{}{}}
+\def\codeunder{\normalunderscore\discretionary{}{}{}}
+\def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup}
+
+%\let\exp=\tclose %Was temporary
+
+% @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command,
+% then @kbd has no effect.
+
+\def\xkey{\key}
+\def\kbdfoo#1#2#3\par{\def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??}%
+\ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}%
+\else\tclose{\look}\fi
+\else\tclose{\look}\fi}
+
+% Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'. The only reason for the
+% argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of
+% @dmn{}pt.
+%
+\def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1}
+
+\def\kbd#1{\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdfoo\look??\par}
+
+\def\l#1{{\li #1}\null} %
+
+\def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font
+% Use of \lowercase was suggested.
+\def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font
+\def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font
+
+\message{page headings,}
+
+\newskip\titlepagetopglue \titlepagetopglue = 1.5in
+\newskip\titlepagebottomglue \titlepagebottomglue = 2pc
+
+% First the title page. Must do @settitle before @titlepage.
+\def\titlefont#1{{\titlerm #1}}
+
+\newif\ifseenauthor
+\newif\iffinishedtitlepage
+
+\def\shorttitlepage{\parsearg\shorttitlepagezzz}
+\def\shorttitlepagezzz #1{\begingroup\hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}%
+ \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page}
+
+\def\titlepage{\begingroup \parindent=0pt \textfonts
+ \let\subtitlerm=\tenrm
+% I deinstalled the following change because \cmr12 is undefined.
+% This change was not in the ChangeLog anyway. --rms.
+% \let\subtitlerm=\cmr12
+ \def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines}%
+ %
+ \def\authorfont{\authorrm \normalbaselineskip = 16pt \normalbaselines}%
+ %
+ % Leave some space at the very top of the page.
+ \vglue\titlepagetopglue
+ %
+ % Now you can print the title using @title.
+ \def\title{\parsearg\titlezzz}%
+ \def\titlezzz##1{\leftline{\titlefont{##1}}
+ % print a rule at the page bottom also.
+ \finishedtitlepagefalse
+ \vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt}%
+ % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title.
+ \finishedtitlepagetrue
+ %
+ % Now you can put text using @subtitle.
+ \def\subtitle{\parsearg\subtitlezzz}%
+ \def\subtitlezzz##1{{\subtitlefont \rightline{##1}}}%
+ %
+ % @author should come last, but may come many times.
+ \def\author{\parsearg\authorzzz}%
+ \def\authorzzz##1{\ifseenauthor\else\vskip 0pt plus 1filll\seenauthortrue\fi
+ {\authorfont \leftline{##1}}}%
+ %
+ % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space
+ % at the top of the second. We don't want the ragged left on the second.
+ \let\oldpage = \page
+ \def\page{%
+ \iffinishedtitlepage\else
+ \finishtitlepage
+ \fi
+ \oldpage
+ \let\page = \oldpage
+ \hbox{}}%
+% \def\page{\oldpage \hbox{}}
+}
+
+\def\Etitlepage{%
+ \iffinishedtitlepage\else
+ \finishtitlepage
+ \fi
+ % It is important to do the page break before ending the group,
+ % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group.
+ % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page
+ % after the title page, which we certainly don't want.
+ \oldpage
+ \endgroup
+ \HEADINGSon
+}
+
+\def\finishtitlepage{%
+ \vskip4pt \hrule height 2pt width \hsize
+ \vskip\titlepagebottomglue
+ \finishedtitlepagetrue
+}
+
+%%% Set up page headings and footings.
+
+\let\thispage=\folio
+
+\newtoks \evenheadline % Token sequence for heading line of even pages
+\newtoks \oddheadline % Token sequence for heading line of odd pages
+\newtoks \evenfootline % Token sequence for footing line of even pages
+\newtoks \oddfootline % Token sequence for footing line of odd pages
+
+% Now make Tex use those variables
+\headline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline
+ \else \the\evenheadline \fi}}
+\footline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline
+ \else \the\evenfootline \fi}\HEADINGShook}
+\let\HEADINGShook=\relax
+
+% Commands to set those variables.
+% For example, this is what @headings on does
+% @evenheading @thistitle|@thispage|@thischapter
+% @oddheading @thischapter|@thispage|@thistitle
+% @evenfooting @thisfile||
+% @oddfooting ||@thisfile
+
+\def\evenheading{\parsearg\evenheadingxxx}
+\def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx}
+\def\everyheading{\parsearg\everyheadingxxx}
+
+\def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx}
+\def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx}
+\def\everyfooting{\parsearg\everyfootingxxx}
+
+{\catcode`\@=0 %
+
+\gdef\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1@|@|@|@|\finish}
+\gdef\evenheadingyyy #1@|#2@|#3@|#4\finish{%
+\global\evenheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
+
+\gdef\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1@|@|@|@|\finish}
+\gdef\oddheadingyyy #1@|#2@|#3@|#4\finish{%
+\global\oddheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
+
+\gdef\everyheadingxxx #1{\everyheadingyyy #1@|@|@|@|\finish}
+\gdef\everyheadingyyy #1@|#2@|#3@|#4\finish{%
+\global\evenheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}
+\global\oddheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
+
+\gdef\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1@|@|@|@|\finish}
+\gdef\evenfootingyyy #1@|#2@|#3@|#4\finish{%
+\global\evenfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
+
+\gdef\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1@|@|@|@|\finish}
+\gdef\oddfootingyyy #1@|#2@|#3@|#4\finish{%
+\global\oddfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
+
+\gdef\everyfootingxxx #1{\everyfootingyyy #1@|@|@|@|\finish}
+\gdef\everyfootingyyy #1@|#2@|#3@|#4\finish{%
+\global\evenfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}
+\global\oddfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
+%
+}% unbind the catcode of @.
+
+% @headings double turns headings on for double-sided printing.
+% @headings single turns headings on for single-sided printing.
+% @headings off turns them off.
+% @headings on same as @headings double, retained for compatibility.
+% @headings after turns on double-sided headings after this page.
+% @headings doubleafter turns on double-sided headings after this page.
+% @headings singleafter turns on single-sided headings after this page.
+% By default, they are off.
+
+\def\headings #1 {\csname HEADINGS#1\endcsname}
+
+\def\HEADINGSoff{
+\global\evenheadline={\hfil} \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
+\global\oddheadline={\hfil} \global\oddfootline={\hfil}}
+\HEADINGSoff
+% When we turn headings on, set the page number to 1.
+% For double-sided printing, put current file name in lower left corner,
+% chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document
+% title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top
+% edge of all pages.
+\def\HEADINGSdouble{
+%\pagealignmacro
+\global\pageno=1
+\global\evenfootline={\hfil}
+\global\oddfootline={\hfil}
+\global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
+\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
+}
+% For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page,
+% page number on top right.
+\def\HEADINGSsingle{
+%\pagealignmacro
+\global\pageno=1
+\global\evenfootline={\hfil}
+\global\oddfootline={\hfil}
+\global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
+\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
+}
+\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}
+
+\def\HEADINGSafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSdoublex}
+\let\HEADINGSdoubleafter=\HEADINGSafter
+\def\HEADINGSdoublex{%
+\global\evenfootline={\hfil}
+\global\oddfootline={\hfil}
+\global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
+\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
+}
+
+\def\HEADINGSsingleafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSsinglex}
+\def\HEADINGSsinglex{%
+\global\evenfootline={\hfil}
+\global\oddfootline={\hfil}
+\global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
+\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
+}
+
+% Subroutines used in generating headings
+% Produces Day Month Year style of output.
+\def\today{\number\day\space
+\ifcase\month\or
+January\or February\or March\or April\or May\or June\or
+July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi
+\space\number\year}
+
+% Use this if you want the Month Day, Year style of output.
+%\def\today{\ifcase\month\or
+%January\or February\or March\or April\or May\or June\or
+%July\or August\or September\or October\or November\or December\fi
+%\space\number\day, \number\year}
+
+% @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings
+% It generates no output of its own
+
+\def\thistitle{No Title}
+\def\settitle{\parsearg\settitlezzz}
+\def\settitlezzz #1{\gdef\thistitle{#1}}
+
+\message{tables,}
+
+% @tabs -- simple alignment
+
+% These don't work. For one thing, \+ is defined as outer.
+% So these macros cannot even be defined.
+
+%\def\tabs{\parsearg\tabszzz}
+%\def\tabszzz #1{\settabs\+#1\cr}
+%\def\tabline{\parsearg\tablinezzz}
+%\def\tablinezzz #1{\+#1\cr}
+%\def\&{&}
+
+% Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x), @kitem(x), @xitem(x).
+
+% default indentation of table text
+\newdimen\tableindent \tableindent=.8in
+% default indentation of @itemize and @enumerate text
+\newdimen\itemindent \itemindent=.3in
+% margin between end of table item and start of table text.
+\newdimen\itemmargin \itemmargin=.1in
+
+% used internally for \itemindent minus \itemmargin
+\newdimen\itemmax
+
+% Note @table, @vtable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with
+% these defs.
+% They also define \itemindex
+% to index the item name in whatever manner is desired (perhaps none).
+
+\newif\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip
+
+\def\itemxpar{\par\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip\vskip-\parskip\nobreak\fi}
+
+\def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz}
+\def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz}
+
+\def\internalBxitem "#1"{\def\xitemsubtopix{#1} \smallbreak \parsearg\xitemzzz}
+\def\internalBxitemx "#1"{\def\xitemsubtopix{#1} \itemxpar \parsearg\xitemzzz}
+
+\def\internalBkitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\kitemzzz}
+\def\internalBkitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\kitemzzz}
+
+\def\kitemzzz #1{\dosubind {kw}{\code{#1}}{for {\bf \lastfunction}}%
+ \itemzzz {#1}}
+
+\def\xitemzzz #1{\dosubind {kw}{\code{#1}}{for {\bf \xitemsubtopic}}%
+ \itemzzz {#1}}
+
+\def\itemzzz #1{\begingroup %
+ \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
+ \advance\hsize by -\tableindent
+ \setbox0=\hbox{\itemfont{#1}}%
+ \itemindex{#1}%
+ \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx.
+ %
+ % Be sure we are not still in the middle of a paragraph.
+ %{\parskip = 0in
+ %\par
+ %}%
+ %
+ % If the item text does not fit in the space we have, put it on a line
+ % by itself, and do not allow a page break either before or after that
+ % line. We do not start a paragraph here because then if the next
+ % command is, e.g., @kindex, the whatsit would get put into the
+ % horizontal list on a line by itself, resulting in extra blank space.
+ \ifdim \wd0>\itemmax
+ %
+ % Make this a paragraph so we get the \parskip glue and wrapping,
+ % but leave it ragged-right.
+ \begingroup
+ \advance\leftskip by-\tableindent
+ \advance\hsize by\tableindent
+ \advance\rightskip by0pt plus1fil
+ \leavevmode\unhbox0\par
+ \endgroup
+ %
+ % We're going to be starting a paragraph, but we don't want the
+ % \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started.
+ \nobreak \vskip-\parskip
+ %
+ % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up. Unfortunately
+ % we can't prevent a possible page break at the following
+ % \baselineskip glue.
+ \nobreak
+ \endgroup
+ \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse
+ \else
+ % The item text fits into the space. Start a paragraph, so that the
+ % following text (if any) will end up on the same line. Since that
+ % text will be indented by \tableindent, we make the item text be in
+ % a zero-width box.
+ \noindent
+ \rlap{\hskip -\tableindent\box0}\ignorespaces%
+ \endgroup%
+ \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue%
+ \fi
+}
+
+\def\item{\errmessage{@item while not in a table}}
+\def\itemx{\errmessage{@itemx while not in a table}}
+\def\kitem{\errmessage{@kitem while not in a table}}
+\def\kitemx{\errmessage{@kitemx while not in a table}}
+\def\xitem{\errmessage{@xitem while not in a table}}
+\def\xitemx{\errmessage{@xitemx while not in a table}}
+
+%% Contains a kludge to get @end[description] to work
+\def\description{\tablez{\dontindex}{1}{}{}{}{}}
+
+\def\table{\begingroup\inENV\obeylines\obeyspaces\tablex}
+{\obeylines\obeyspaces%
+\gdef\tablex #1^^M{%
+\tabley\dontindex#1 \endtabley}}
+
+\def\ftable{\begingroup\inENV\obeylines\obeyspaces\ftablex}
+{\obeylines\obeyspaces%
+\gdef\ftablex #1^^M{%
+\tabley\fnitemindex#1 \endtabley
+\def\Eftable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak\endgroup}%
+\let\Etable=\relax}}
+
+\def\vtable{\begingroup\inENV\obeylines\obeyspaces\vtablex}
+{\obeylines\obeyspaces%
+\gdef\vtablex #1^^M{%
+\tabley\vritemindex#1 \endtabley
+\def\Evtable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak\endgroup}%
+\let\Etable=\relax}}
+
+\def\dontindex #1{}
+\def\fnitemindex #1{\doind {fn}{\code{#1}}}%
+\def\vritemindex #1{\doind {vr}{\code{#1}}}%
+
+{\obeyspaces %
+\gdef\tabley#1#2 #3 #4 #5 #6 #7\endtabley{\endgroup%
+\tablez{#1}{#2}{#3}{#4}{#5}{#6}}}
+
+\def\tablez #1#2#3#4#5#6{%
+\aboveenvbreak %
+\begingroup %
+\def\Edescription{\Etable}% Neccessary kludge.
+\let\itemindex=#1%
+\ifnum 0#3>0 \advance \leftskip by #3\mil \fi %
+\ifnum 0#4>0 \tableindent=#4\mil \fi %
+\ifnum 0#5>0 \advance \rightskip by #5\mil \fi %
+\def\itemfont{#2}%
+\itemmax=\tableindent %
+\advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin %
+\advance \leftskip by \tableindent %
+\exdentamount=\tableindent
+\parindent = 0pt
+\parskip = \smallskipamount
+\ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi%
+\def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak\endgroup}%
+\let\item = \internalBitem %
+\let\itemx = \internalBitemx %
+\let\kitem = \internalBkitem %
+\let\kitemx = \internalBkitemx %
+\let\xitem = \internalBxitem %
+\let\xitemx = \internalBxitemx %
+}
+
+% This is the counter used by @enumerate, which is really @itemize
+
+\newcount \itemno
+
+\def\itemize{\parsearg\itemizezzz}
+
+\def\itemizezzz #1{%
+ \begingroup % ended by the @end itemsize
+ \itemizey {#1}{\Eitemize}
+}
+
+\def\itemizey #1#2{%
+\aboveenvbreak %
+\itemmax=\itemindent %
+\advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin %
+\advance \leftskip by \itemindent %
+\exdentamount=\itemindent
+\parindent = 0pt %
+\parskip = \smallskipamount %
+\ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi%
+\def#2{\endgraf\afterenvbreak\endgroup}%
+\def\itemcontents{#1}%
+\let\item=\itemizeitem}
+
+% Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value.
+% These are `.?!:;,'
+\def\frenchspacing{\sfcode46=1000 \sfcode63=1000 \sfcode33=1000
+ \sfcode58=1000 \sfcode59=1000 \sfcode44=1000 }
+
+% \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in
+% TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder.
+%
+\def\splitoff#1#2\endmark{\def\first{#1}\def\rest{#2}}%
+
+% Allow an optional argument of an uppercase letter, lowercase letter,
+% or number, to specify the first label in the enumerated list. No
+% argument is the same as `1'.
+%
+\def\enumerate{\parsearg\enumeratezzz}
+\def\enumeratezzz #1{\enumeratey #1 \endenumeratey}
+\def\enumeratey #1 #2\endenumeratey{%
+ \begingroup % ended by the @end enumerate
+ %
+ % If we were given no argument, pretend we were given `1'.
+ \def\thearg{#1}%
+ \ifx\thearg\empty \def\thearg{1}\fi
+ %
+ % Detect if the argument is a single token. If so, it might be a
+ % letter. Otherwise, the only valid thing it can be is a number.
+ % (We will always have one token, because of the test we just made.
+ % This is a good thing, since \splitoff doesn't work given nothing at
+ % all -- the first parameter is undelimited.)
+ \expandafter\splitoff\thearg\endmark
+ \ifx\rest\empty
+ % Only one token in the argument. It could still be anything.
+ % A ``lowercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is nonzero.
+ % An ``uppercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is both nonzero, and
+ % not equal to itself.
+ % Otherwise, we assume it's a number.
+ %
+ % We need the \relax at the end of the \ifnum lines to stop TeX from
+ % continuing to look for a <number>.
+ %
+ \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=0\relax
+ \numericenumerate % a number (we hope)
+ \else
+ % It's a letter.
+ \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=\expandafter`\thearg\relax
+ \lowercaseenumerate % lowercase letter
+ \else
+ \uppercaseenumerate % uppercase letter
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ \else
+ % Multiple tokens in the argument. We hope it's a number.
+ \numericenumerate
+ \fi
+}
+
+% An @enumerate whose labels are integers. The starting integer is
+% given in \thearg.
+%
+\def\numericenumerate{%
+ \itemno = \thearg
+ \startenumeration{\the\itemno}%
+}
+
+% The starting (lowercase) letter is in \thearg.
+\def\lowercaseenumerate{%
+ \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
+ \startenumeration{%
+ % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
+ \ifnum\itemno=0
+ \errmessage{No more lowercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
+ alphabet}%
+ \fi
+ \char\lccode\itemno
+ }%
+}
+
+% The starting (uppercase) letter is in \thearg.
+\def\uppercaseenumerate{%
+ \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
+ \startenumeration{%
+ % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
+ \ifnum\itemno=0
+ \errmessage{No more uppercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
+ alphabet}
+ \fi
+ \char\uccode\itemno
+ }%
+}
+
+% Call itemizey, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the
+% common last two arguments. Also subtract one from the initial value in
+% \itemno, since @item increments \itemno.
+%
+\def\startenumeration#1{%
+ \advance\itemno by -1
+ \itemizey{#1.}\Eenumerate\flushcr
+}
+
+% @alphaenumerate and @capsenumerate are abbreviations for giving an arg
+% to @enumerate.
+%
+\def\alphaenumerate{\enumerate{a}}
+\def\capsenumerate{\enumerate{A}}
+\def\Ealphaenumerate{\Eenumerate}
+\def\Ecapsenumerate{\Eenumerate}
+
+% Definition of @item while inside @itemize.
+
+\def\itemizeitem{%
+\advance\itemno by 1
+{\let\par=\endgraf \smallbreak}%
+\ifhmode \errmessage{\in hmode at itemizeitem}\fi
+{\parskip=0in \hskip 0pt
+\hbox to 0pt{\hss \itemcontents\hskip \itemmargin}%
+\vadjust{\penalty 1200}}%
+\flushcr}
+
+% @multitable macros
+% Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94
+%
+% @multitable ... @endmultitable will make as many columns as desired.
+% Contents of each column will wrap at width given in preamble. Width
+% can be specified either with sample text given in a template line,
+% or in percent of \hsize, the current width of text on page.
+
+% Table can continue over pages but will only break between lines.
+
+% To make preamble:
+%
+% Either define widths of columns in terms of percent of \hsize:
+% @multitable @percentofhsize .2 .3 .5
+% @item ...
+%
+% Numbers following @percentofhsize are the percent of the total
+% current hsize to be used for each column. You may use as many
+% columns as desired.
+
+% Or use a template:
+% @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
+% @item ...
+% using the widest term desired in each column.
+
+
+% Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column
+% starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's
+% with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed,
+% ie, @tab@tab@tab will produce two empty columns.
+
+% @item, @tab, @multicolumn or @endmulticolumn do not need to be on their
+% own lines, but it will not hurt if they are.
+
+% Sample multitable:
+
+% @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
+% @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff @tab third col
+% @item
+% first col stuff
+% @tab
+% second col stuff
+% @tab
+% third col
+% @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff
+% @tab Many paragraphs of text may be used in any column.
+%
+% They will wrap at the width determined by the template.
+% @item@tab@tab This will be in third column.
+% @endmultitable
+
+% Default dimensions may be reset by user.
+% @intableparskip will set vertical space between paragraphs in table.
+% @intableparindent will set paragraph indent in table.
+% @spacebetweencols will set horizontal space to be left between columns.
+% @spacebetweenlines will set vertical space to be left between lines.
+
+%%%%
+% Dimensions
+
+\newdimen\intableparskip
+\newdimen\intableparindent
+\newdimen\spacebetweencols
+\newdimen\spacebetweenlines
+\intableparskip=0pt
+\intableparindent=6pt
+\spacebetweencols=12pt
+\spacebetweenlines=12pt
+
+%%%%
+% Macros used to set up halign preamble:
+\let\endsetuptable\relax
+\def\xendsetuptable{\endsetuptable}
+\let\percentofhsize\relax
+\def\xpercentofhsize{\percentofhsize}
+\newif\ifsetpercent
+
+\newcount\colcount
+\def\setuptable#1{\def\firstarg{#1}%
+\ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable\let\go\relax%
+\else
+ \ifx\firstarg\xpercentofhsize\global\setpercenttrue%
+ \else
+ \ifsetpercent
+ \if#1.\else%
+ \global\advance\colcount by1 %
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{.#1\hsize}%
+ \fi
+ \else
+ \global\advance\colcount by1
+ \setbox0=\hbox{#1}%
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}%
+ \fi%
+ \fi%
+ \let\go\setuptable%
+\fi\go}
+%%%%
+% multitable syntax
+\def\tab{&}
+
+%%%%
+% @multitable ... @endmultitable definitions:
+
+\def\multitable#1\item{\bgroup
+\let\item\cr
+\tolerance=9500
+\hbadness=9500
+\parskip=\intableparskip
+\parindent=\intableparindent
+\overfullrule=0pt
+\global\colcount=0\relax%
+\def\Emultitable{\global\setpercentfalse\global\everycr{}\cr\egroup\egroup}%
+ % To parse everything between @multitable and @item :
+\def\one{#1}\expandafter\setuptable\one\endsetuptable
+ % Need to reset this to 0 after \setuptable.
+\global\colcount=0\relax%
+ %
+ % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will
+ % be used as many times as user calls for columns.
+ % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and
+ % continue for many paragraphs if desired.
+\halign\bgroup&\global\advance\colcount by 1\relax%
+\vtop{\hsize=\expandafter\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname
+ % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other
+ % we will add a \leftskip of \spacebetweencols to all columns after
+ % the first one.
+ % If a template has been used, we will add \spacebetweencols
+ % to the width of each template entry.
+ % If user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize
+ % we will use that dimension as the width of the column, and
+ % the \leftskip will keep entries from bumping into each other.
+ % Table will start at left margin and final column will justify at
+ % right margin.
+\ifnum\colcount=1
+\else
+ \ifsetpercent
+ \else
+ % If user has <not> set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize
+ % we will advance \hsize by \spacebetweencols
+ \advance\hsize by \spacebetweencols
+ \fi
+ % In either case we will make \leftskip=\spacebetweencols:
+\leftskip=\spacebetweencols
+\fi
+\noindent##}\cr%
+ % \everycr will reset column counter, \colcount, at the end of
+ % each line. Every column entry will cause \colcount to advance by one.
+ % The table preamble
+ % looks at the current \colcount to find the correct column width.
+\global\everycr{\noalign{\nointerlineskip\vskip\spacebetweenlines
+\filbreak%% keeps underfull box messages off when table breaks over pages.
+\global\colcount=0\relax}}}
+
+\message{indexing,}
+% Index generation facilities
+
+% Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite
+% except not \outer, so it can be used within \newindex.
+{\catcode`\@=11
+\gdef\newwrite{\alloc@7\write\chardef\sixt@@n}}
+
+% \newindex {foo} defines an index named foo.
+% It automatically defines \fooindex such that
+% \fooindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index foo.
+% It also defines \fooindfile to be the number of the output channel for
+% the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is foo.
+% The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long
+% for the sake of vms.
+
+\def\newindex #1{
+\expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname% Define number for output file
+\openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 % Open the file
+\expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define \xxxindex
+\noexpand\doindex {#1}}
+}
+
+% @defindex foo == \newindex{foo}
+
+\def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex}
+
+% Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code.
+
+\def\newcodeindex #1{
+\expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname% Define number for output file
+\openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 % Open the file
+\expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define \xxxindex
+\noexpand\docodeindex {#1}}
+}
+
+\def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex}
+
+% @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar.
+% Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index.
+\def\synindex #1 #2 {%
+\expandafter\let\expandafter\synindexfoo\expandafter=\csname#2indfile\endcsname
+\expandafter\let\csname#1indfile\endcsname=\synindexfoo
+\expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define \xxxindex
+\noexpand\doindex {#2}}%
+}
+
+% @syncodeindex foo bar similar, but put all entries made for index foo
+% inside @code.
+\def\syncodeindex #1 #2 {%
+\expandafter\let\expandafter\synindexfoo\expandafter=\csname#2indfile\endcsname
+\expandafter\let\csname#1indfile\endcsname=\synindexfoo
+\expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define \xxxindex
+\noexpand\docodeindex {#2}}%
+}
+
+% Define \doindex, the driver for all \fooindex macros.
+% Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro,
+% and it is "foo", the name of the index.
+
+% \doindex just uses \parsearg; it calls \doind for the actual work.
+% This is because \doind is more useful to call from other macros.
+
+% There is also \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic}
+% which makes an entry in a two-level index such as the operation index.
+
+\def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singleindexer}
+\def\singleindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}}
+
+% like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument.
+\def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singlecodeindexer}
+\def\singlecodeindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}}
+
+\def\indexdummies{%
+% Take care of the plain tex accent commands.
+\def\"{\realbackslash "}%
+\def\`{\realbackslash `}%
+\def\'{\realbackslash '}%
+\def\^{\realbackslash ^}%
+\def\~{\realbackslash ~}%
+\def\={\realbackslash =}%
+\def\b{\realbackslash b}%
+\def\c{\realbackslash c}%
+\def\d{\realbackslash d}%
+\def\u{\realbackslash u}%
+\def\v{\realbackslash v}%
+\def\H{\realbackslash H}%
+% Take care of the plain tex special European modified letters.
+\def\oe{\realbackslash oe}%
+\def\ae{\realbackslash ae}%
+\def\aa{\realbackslash aa}%
+\def\OE{\realbackslash OE}%
+\def\AE{\realbackslash AE}%
+\def\AA{\realbackslash AA}%
+\def\o{\realbackslash o}%
+\def\O{\realbackslash O}%
+\def\l{\realbackslash l}%
+\def\L{\realbackslash L}%
+\def\ss{\realbackslash ss}%
+% Take care of texinfo commands likely to appear in an index entry.
+\def\_{{\realbackslash _}}%
+\def\w{\realbackslash w }%
+\def\bf{\realbackslash bf }%
+\def\rm{\realbackslash rm }%
+\def\sl{\realbackslash sl }%
+\def\sf{\realbackslash sf}%
+\def\tt{\realbackslash tt}%
+\def\gtr{\realbackslash gtr}%
+\def\less{\realbackslash less}%
+\def\hat{\realbackslash hat}%
+\def\char{\realbackslash char}%
+\def\TeX{\realbackslash TeX}%
+\def\dots{\realbackslash dots }%
+\def\copyright{\realbackslash copyright }%
+\def\tclose##1{\realbackslash tclose {##1}}%
+\def\code##1{\realbackslash code {##1}}%
+\def\samp##1{\realbackslash samp {##1}}%
+\def\t##1{\realbackslash r {##1}}%
+\def\r##1{\realbackslash r {##1}}%
+\def\i##1{\realbackslash i {##1}}%
+\def\b##1{\realbackslash b {##1}}%
+\def\cite##1{\realbackslash cite {##1}}%
+\def\key##1{\realbackslash key {##1}}%
+\def\file##1{\realbackslash file {##1}}%
+\def\var##1{\realbackslash var {##1}}%
+\def\kbd##1{\realbackslash kbd {##1}}%
+\def\dfn##1{\realbackslash dfn {##1}}%
+\def\emph##1{\realbackslash emph {##1}}%
+}
+
+% \indexnofonts no-ops all font-change commands.
+% This is used when outputting the strings to sort the index by.
+\def\indexdummyfont#1{#1}
+\def\indexdummytex{TeX}
+\def\indexdummydots{...}
+
+\def\indexnofonts{%
+% Just ignore accents.
+\let\"=\indexdummyfont
+\let\`=\indexdummyfont
+\let\'=\indexdummyfont
+\let\^=\indexdummyfont
+\let\~=\indexdummyfont
+\let\==\indexdummyfont
+\let\b=\indexdummyfont
+\let\c=\indexdummyfont
+\let\d=\indexdummyfont
+\let\u=\indexdummyfont
+\let\v=\indexdummyfont
+\let\H=\indexdummyfont
+% Take care of the plain tex special European modified letters.
+\def\oe{oe}%
+\def\ae{ae}%
+\def\aa{aa}%
+\def\OE{OE}%
+\def\AE{AE}%
+\def\AA{AA}%
+\def\o{o}%
+\def\O{O}%
+\def\l{l}%
+\def\L{L}%
+\def\ss{ss}%
+\let\w=\indexdummyfont
+\let\t=\indexdummyfont
+\let\r=\indexdummyfont
+\let\i=\indexdummyfont
+\let\b=\indexdummyfont
+\let\emph=\indexdummyfont
+\let\strong=\indexdummyfont
+\let\cite=\indexdummyfont
+\let\sc=\indexdummyfont
+%Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command
+% and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |...
+%\let\tt=\indexdummyfont
+\let\tclose=\indexdummyfont
+\let\code=\indexdummyfont
+\let\file=\indexdummyfont
+\let\samp=\indexdummyfont
+\let\kbd=\indexdummyfont
+\let\key=\indexdummyfont
+\let\var=\indexdummyfont
+\let\TeX=\indexdummytex
+\let\dots=\indexdummydots
+}
+
+% To define \realbackslash, we must make \ not be an escape.
+% We must first make another character (@) an escape
+% so we do not become unable to do a definition.
+
+{\catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\other
+@gdef@realbackslash{\}}
+
+\let\indexbackslash=0 %overridden during \printindex.
+
+\let\SETmarginindex=\relax %initialize!
+% workhorse for all \fooindexes
+% #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there
+\def\doind #1#2{%
+% Put the index entry in the margin if desired.
+\ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else%
+\insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt #2}}%
+\fi%
+{\count10=\lastpenalty %
+{\indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage
+\escapechar=`\\%
+{\let\folio=0% Expand all macros now EXCEPT \folio
+\def\rawbackslashxx{\indexbackslash}% \indexbackslash isn't defined now
+% so it will be output as is; and it will print as backslash in the indx.
+%
+% Now process the index-string once, with all font commands turned off,
+% to get the string to sort the index by.
+{\indexnofonts
+\xdef\temp1{#2}%
+}%
+% Now produce the complete index entry. We process the index-string again,
+% this time with font commands expanded, to get what to print in the index.
+\edef\temp{%
+\write \csname#1indfile\endcsname{%
+\realbackslash entry {\temp1}{\folio}{#2}}}%
+\temp }%
+}\penalty\count10}}
+
+\def\dosubind #1#2#3{%
+{\count10=\lastpenalty %
+{\indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage
+\escapechar=`\\%
+{\let\folio=0%
+\def\rawbackslashxx{\indexbackslash}%
+%
+% Now process the index-string once, with all font commands turned off,
+% to get the string to sort the index by.
+{\indexnofonts
+\xdef\temp1{#2 #3}%
+}%
+% Now produce the complete index entry. We process the index-string again,
+% this time with font commands expanded, to get what to print in the index.
+\edef\temp{%
+\write \csname#1indfile\endcsname{%
+\realbackslash entry {\temp1}{\folio}{#2}{#3}}}%
+\temp }%
+}\penalty\count10}}
+
+% The index entry written in the file actually looks like
+% \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}
+% or
+% \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}{subtopic}
+% The texindex program reads in these files and writes files
+% containing these kinds of lines:
+% \initial {c}
+% before the first topic whose initial is c
+% \entry {topic}{pagelist}
+% for a topic that is used without subtopics
+% \primary {topic}
+% for the beginning of a topic that is used with subtopics
+% \secondary {subtopic}{pagelist}
+% for each subtopic.
+
+% Define the user-accessible indexing commands
+% @findex, @vindex, @kindex, @cindex.
+
+\def\findex {\fnindex}
+\def\kindex {\kyindex}
+\def\cindex {\cpindex}
+\def\vindex {\vrindex}
+\def\tindex {\tpindex}
+\def\pindex {\pgindex}
+
+\def\cindexsub {\begingroup\obeylines\cindexsub}
+{\obeylines %
+\gdef\cindexsub "#1" #2^^M{\endgroup %
+\dosubind{cp}{#2}{#1}}}
+
+% Define the macros used in formatting output of the sorted index material.
+
+% This is what you call to cause a particular index to get printed.
+% Write
+% @unnumbered Function Index
+% @printindex fn
+
+\def\printindex{\parsearg\doprintindex}
+
+\def\doprintindex#1{%
+ \tex
+ \dobreak \chapheadingskip {10000}
+ \catcode`\%=\other\catcode`\&=\other\catcode`\#=\other
+ \catcode`\$=\other
+ \catcode`\~=\other
+ \indexbreaks
+ %
+ % The following don't help, since the chars were translated
+ % when the raw index was written, and their fonts were discarded
+ % due to \indexnofonts.
+ %\catcode`\"=\active
+ %\catcode`\^=\active
+ %\catcode`\_=\active
+ %\catcode`\|=\active
+ %\catcode`\<=\active
+ %\catcode`\>=\active
+ % %
+ \def\indexbackslash{\rawbackslashxx}
+ \indexfonts\rm \tolerance=9500 \advance\baselineskip -1pt
+ \begindoublecolumns
+ %
+ % See if the index file exists and is nonempty.
+ \openin 1 \jobname.#1s
+ \ifeof 1
+ % \enddoublecolumns gets confused if there is no text in the index,
+ % and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the
+ % index. The easiest way to prevent this problem is to make sure
+ % there is some text.
+ (Index is nonexistent)
+ \else
+ %
+ % If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof
+ % false. We have to make TeX try to read something from the file, so
+ % it can discover if there is anything in it.
+ \read 1 to \temp
+ \ifeof 1
+ (Index is empty)
+ \else
+ \input \jobname.#1s
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ \closein 1
+ \enddoublecolumns
+ \Etex
+}
+
+% These macros are used by the sorted index file itself.
+% Change them to control the appearance of the index.
+
+% Same as \bigskipamount except no shrink.
+% \balancecolumns gets confused if there is any shrink.
+\newskip\initialskipamount \initialskipamount 12pt plus4pt
+
+\def\initial #1{%
+{\let\tentt=\sectt \let\tt=\sectt \let\sf=\sectt
+\ifdim\lastskip<\initialskipamount
+\removelastskip \penalty-200 \vskip \initialskipamount\fi
+\line{\secbf#1\hfill}\kern 2pt\penalty10000}}
+
+% This typesets a paragraph consisting of #1, dot leaders, and then #2
+% flush to the right margin. It is used for index and table of contents
+% entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip.
+%
+\def\entry #1#2{\begingroup
+ %
+ % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't
+ % affect previous text.
+ \par
+ %
+ % Do not fill out the last line with white space.
+ \parfillskip = 0in
+ %
+ % No extra space above this paragraph.
+ \parskip = 0in
+ %
+ % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines.
+ \finalhyphendemerits = 0
+ %
+ % \hangindent is only relevant when the entry text and page number
+ % don't both fit on one line. In that case, bob suggests starting the
+ % dots pretty far over on the line. Unfortunately, a large
+ % indentation looks wrong when the entry text itself is broken across
+ % lines. So we use a small indentation and put up with long leaders.
+ %
+ % \hangafter is reset to 1 (which is the value we want) at the start
+ % of each paragraph, so we need not do anything with that.
+ \hangindent=2em
+ %
+ % When the entry text needs to be broken, just fill out the first line
+ % with blank space.
+ \rightskip = 0pt plus1fil
+ %
+ % Start a ``paragraph'' for the index entry so the line breaking
+ % parameters we've set above will have an effect.
+ \noindent
+ %
+ % Insert the text of the index entry. TeX will do line-breaking on it.
+ #1%
+ % The following is kluged to not output a line of dots in the index if
+ % there are no page numbers. The next person who breaks this will be
+ % cursed by a Unix daemon.
+ \def\tempa{{\rm }}%
+ \def\tempb{#2}%
+ \edef\tempc{\tempa}%
+ \edef\tempd{\tempb}%
+ \ifx\tempc\tempd\ \else%
+ %
+ % If we must, put the page number on a line of its own, and fill out
+ % this line with blank space. (The \hfil is overwhelmed with the
+ % fill leaders glue in \indexdotfill if the page number does fit.)
+ \hfil\penalty50
+ \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number.
+ %
+ % The `\ ' here is removed by the implicit \unskip that TeX does as
+ % part of (the primitive) \par. Without it, a spurious underfull
+ % \hbox ensues.
+ \ #2% The page number ends the paragraph.
+ \fi%
+ \par
+\endgroup}
+
+% Like \dotfill except takes at least 1 em.
+\def\indexdotfill{\cleaders
+ \hbox{$\mathsurround=0pt \mkern1.5mu ${\it .}$ \mkern1.5mu$}\hskip 1em plus 1fill}
+
+\def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}}
+
+\newskip\secondaryindent \secondaryindent=0.5cm
+
+\def\secondary #1#2{
+{\parfillskip=0in \parskip=0in
+\hangindent =1in \hangafter=1
+\noindent\hskip\secondaryindent\hbox{#1}\indexdotfill #2\par
+}}
+
+%% Define two-column mode, which is used in indexes.
+%% Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416.
+\catcode `\@=11
+
+\newbox\partialpage
+
+\newdimen\doublecolumnhsize
+
+\def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup
+ % Grab any single-column material above us.
+ \output = {\global\setbox\partialpage
+ =\vbox{\unvbox255\kern -\topskip \kern \baselineskip}}%
+ \eject
+ %
+ % Now switch to the double-column output routine.
+ \output={\doublecolumnout}%
+ %
+ % Change the page size parameters. We could do this once outside this
+ % routine, in each of @smallbook, @afourpaper, and the default 8.5x11
+ % format, but then we repeat the same computation. Repeating a couple
+ % of assignments once per index is clearly meaningless for the
+ % execution time, so we may as well do it once.
+ %
+ % First we halve the line length, less a little for the gutter between
+ % the columns. We compute the gutter based on the line length, so it
+ % changes automatically with the paper format. The magic constant
+ % below is chosen so that the gutter has the same value (well, +- <
+ % 1pt) as it did when we hard-coded it.
+ %
+ % We put the result in a separate register, \doublecolumhsize, so we
+ % can restore it in \pagesofar, after \hsize itself has (potentially)
+ % been clobbered.
+ %
+ \doublecolumnhsize = \hsize
+ \advance\doublecolumnhsize by -.04154\hsize
+ \divide\doublecolumnhsize by 2
+ \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
+ %
+ % Double the \vsize as well. (We don't need a separate register here,
+ % since nobody clobbers \vsize.)
+ \vsize = 2\vsize
+ \doublecolumnpagegoal
+}
+
+\def\enddoublecolumns{\eject \endgroup \pagegoal=\vsize \unvbox\partialpage}
+
+\def\doublecolumnsplit{\splittopskip=\topskip \splitmaxdepth=\maxdepth
+ \global\dimen@=\pageheight \global\advance\dimen@ by-\ht\partialpage
+ \global\setbox1=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ \global\setbox0=\vbox{\unvbox1}
+ \global\setbox3=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ \global\setbox2=\vbox{\unvbox3}
+ \ifdim\ht0>\dimen@ \setbox255=\vbox{\unvbox0\unvbox2} \global\setbox255=\copy5 \fi
+ \ifdim\ht2>\dimen@ \setbox255=\vbox{\unvbox0\unvbox2} \global\setbox255=\copy5 \fi
+}
+\def\doublecolumnpagegoal{%
+ \dimen@=\vsize \advance\dimen@ by-2\ht\partialpage \global\pagegoal=\dimen@
+}
+\def\pagesofar{\unvbox\partialpage %
+ \hsize=\doublecolumnhsize % have to restore this since output routine
+ \wd0=\hsize \wd2=\hsize \hbox to\pagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}}
+\def\doublecolumnout{%
+ \setbox5=\copy255
+ {\vbadness=10000 \doublecolumnsplit}
+ \ifvbox255
+ \setbox0=\vtop to\dimen@{\unvbox0}
+ \setbox2=\vtop to\dimen@{\unvbox2}
+ \onepageout\pagesofar \unvbox255 \penalty\outputpenalty
+ \else
+ \setbox0=\vbox{\unvbox5}
+ \ifvbox0
+ \dimen@=\ht0 \advance\dimen@ by\topskip \advance\dimen@ by-\baselineskip
+ \divide\dimen@ by2 \splittopskip=\topskip \splitmaxdepth=\maxdepth
+ {\vbadness=10000
+ \loop \global\setbox5=\copy0
+ \setbox1=\vsplit5 to\dimen@
+ \setbox3=\vsplit5 to\dimen@
+ \ifvbox5 \global\advance\dimen@ by1pt \repeat
+ \setbox0=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox1}
+ \setbox2=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox3}
+ \global\setbox\partialpage=\vbox{\pagesofar}
+ \doublecolumnpagegoal
+ }
+ \fi
+ \fi
+}
+
+\catcode `\@=\other
+\message{sectioning,}
+% Define chapters, sections, etc.
+
+\newcount \chapno
+\newcount \secno \secno=0
+\newcount \subsecno \subsecno=0
+\newcount \subsubsecno \subsubsecno=0
+
+% This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ...
+\newcount \appendixno \appendixno = `\@
+\def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno}
+
+\newwrite \contentsfile
+% This is called from \setfilename.
+\def\opencontents{\openout \contentsfile = \jobname.toc}
+
+% Each @chapter defines this as the name of the chapter.
+% page headings and footings can use it. @section does likewise
+
+\def\thischapter{} \def\thissection{}
+\def\seccheck#1{\if \pageno<0 %
+\errmessage{@#1 not allowed after generating table of contents}\fi
+%
+}
+
+\def\chapternofonts{%
+\let\rawbackslash=\relax%
+\let\frenchspacing=\relax%
+\def\result{\realbackslash result}
+\def\equiv{\realbackslash equiv}
+\def\expansion{\realbackslash expansion}
+\def\print{\realbackslash print}
+\def\TeX{\realbackslash TeX}
+\def\dots{\realbackslash dots}
+\def\copyright{\realbackslash copyright}
+\def\tt{\realbackslash tt}
+\def\bf{\realbackslash bf }
+\def\w{\realbackslash w}
+\def\less{\realbackslash less}
+\def\gtr{\realbackslash gtr}
+\def\hat{\realbackslash hat}
+\def\char{\realbackslash char}
+\def\tclose##1{\realbackslash tclose {##1}}
+\def\code##1{\realbackslash code {##1}}
+\def\samp##1{\realbackslash samp {##1}}
+\def\r##1{\realbackslash r {##1}}
+\def\b##1{\realbackslash b {##1}}
+\def\key##1{\realbackslash key {##1}}
+\def\file##1{\realbackslash file {##1}}
+\def\kbd##1{\realbackslash kbd {##1}}
+% These are redefined because @smartitalic wouldn't work inside xdef.
+\def\i##1{\realbackslash i {##1}}
+\def\cite##1{\realbackslash cite {##1}}
+\def\var##1{\realbackslash var {##1}}
+\def\emph##1{\realbackslash emph {##1}}
+\def\dfn##1{\realbackslash dfn {##1}}
+}
+
+\newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level
+\newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raise/lowersections modify this count
+
+% @raisesections: treat @section as chapter, @subsection as section, etc.
+\def\raisesections{\global\advance\secbase by -1}
+\let\up=\raisesections % original BFox name
+
+% @lowersections: treat @chapter as section, @section as subsection, etc.
+\def\lowersections{\global\advance\secbase by 1}
+\let\down=\lowersections % original BFox name
+
+% Choose a numbered-heading macro
+% #1 is heading level if unmodified by @raisesections or @lowersections
+% #2 is text for heading
+\def\numhead#1#2{\absseclevel=\secbase\advance\absseclevel by #1
+\ifcase\absseclevel
+ \chapterzzz{#2}
+\or
+ \seczzz{#2}
+\or
+ \numberedsubseczzz{#2}
+\or
+ \numberedsubsubseczzz{#2}
+\else
+ \ifnum \absseclevel<0
+ \chapterzzz{#2}
+ \else
+ \numberedsubsubseczzz{#2}
+ \fi
+\fi
+}
+
+% like \numhead, but chooses appendix heading levels
+\def\apphead#1#2{\absseclevel=\secbase\advance\absseclevel by #1
+\ifcase\absseclevel
+ \appendixzzz{#2}
+\or
+ \appendixsectionzzz{#2}
+\or
+ \appendixsubseczzz{#2}
+\or
+ \appendixsubsubseczzz{#2}
+\else
+ \ifnum \absseclevel<0
+ \appendixzzz{#2}
+ \else
+ \appendixsubsubseczzz{#2}
+ \fi
+\fi
+}
+
+% like \numhead, but chooses numberless heading levels
+\def\unnmhead#1#2{\absseclevel=\secbase\advance\absseclevel by #1
+\ifcase\absseclevel
+ \unnumberedzzz{#2}
+\or
+ \unnumberedseczzz{#2}
+\or
+ \unnumberedsubseczzz{#2}
+\or
+ \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#2}
+\else
+ \ifnum \absseclevel<0
+ \unnumberedzzz{#2}
+ \else
+ \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#2}
+ \fi
+\fi
+}
+
+
+\def\thischaptername{No Chapter Title}
+\outer\def\chapter{\parsearg\chapteryyy}
+\def\chapteryyy #1{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz
+\def\chapterzzz #1{\seccheck{chapter}%
+\secno=0 \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0
+\global\advance \chapno by 1 \message{\putwordChapter \the\chapno}%
+\chapmacro {#1}{\the\chapno}%
+\gdef\thissection{#1}%
+\gdef\thischaptername{#1}%
+% We don't substitute the actual chapter name into \thischapter
+% because we don't want its macros evaluated now.
+\xdef\thischapter{\putwordChapter{} \the\chapno: \noexpand\thischaptername}%
+{\chapternofonts%
+\edef\temp{{\realbackslash chapentry {#1}{\the\chapno}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
+\escapechar=`\\%
+\write \contentsfile \temp %
+\donoderef %
+\global\let\section = \numberedsec
+\global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
+\global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
+}}
+
+\outer\def\appendix{\parsearg\appendixyyy}
+\def\appendixyyy #1{\apphead0{#1}} % normally apphead0 calls appendixzzz
+\def\appendixzzz #1{\seccheck{appendix}%
+\secno=0 \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0
+\global\advance \appendixno by 1 \message{Appendix \appendixletter}%
+\chapmacro {#1}{\putwordAppendix{} \appendixletter}%
+\gdef\thissection{#1}%
+\gdef\thischaptername{#1}%
+\xdef\thischapter{\putwordAppendix{} \appendixletter: \noexpand\thischaptername}%
+{\chapternofonts%
+\edef\temp{{\realbackslash chapentry
+ {#1}{\putwordAppendix{} \appendixletter}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
+\escapechar=`\\%
+\write \contentsfile \temp %
+\appendixnoderef %
+\global\let\section = \appendixsec
+\global\let\subsection = \appendixsubsec
+\global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec
+}}
+
+\outer\def\top{\parsearg\unnumberedyyy}
+\outer\def\unnumbered{\parsearg\unnumberedyyy}
+\def\unnumberedyyy #1{\unnmhead0{#1}} % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz
+\def\unnumberedzzz #1{\seccheck{unnumbered}%
+\secno=0 \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0
+%
+% This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the
+% argument to \message. Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX
+% expanded them. For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX
+% expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant
+% to be executed, not expanded).
+%
+% Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear
+% as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use
+% \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once,
+% simply yielding the contents of the <toks register>.
+\toks0 = {#1}\message{(\the\toks0)}%
+%
+\unnumbchapmacro {#1}%
+\gdef\thischapter{#1}\gdef\thissection{#1}%
+{\chapternofonts%
+\edef\temp{{\realbackslash unnumbchapentry {#1}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
+\escapechar=`\\%
+\write \contentsfile \temp %
+\unnumbnoderef %
+\global\let\section = \unnumberedsec
+\global\let\subsection = \unnumberedsubsec
+\global\let\subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec
+}}
+
+\outer\def\numberedsec{\parsearg\secyyy}
+\def\secyyy #1{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz
+\def\seczzz #1{\seccheck{section}%
+\subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 \global\advance \secno by 1 %
+\gdef\thissection{#1}\secheading {#1}{\the\chapno}{\the\secno}%
+{\chapternofonts%
+\edef\temp{{\realbackslash secentry %
+{#1}{\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
+\escapechar=`\\%
+\write \contentsfile \temp %
+\donoderef %
+\penalty 10000 %
+}}
+
+\outer\def\appenixsection{\parsearg\appendixsecyyy}
+\outer\def\appendixsec{\parsearg\appendixsecyyy}
+\def\appendixsecyyy #1{\apphead1{#1}} % normally calls appendixsectionzzz
+\def\appendixsectionzzz #1{\seccheck{appendixsection}%
+\subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 \global\advance \secno by 1 %
+\gdef\thissection{#1}\secheading {#1}{\appendixletter}{\the\secno}%
+{\chapternofonts%
+\edef\temp{{\realbackslash secentry %
+{#1}{\appendixletter}{\the\secno}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
+\escapechar=`\\%
+\write \contentsfile \temp %
+\appendixnoderef %
+\penalty 10000 %
+}}
+
+\outer\def\unnumberedsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsecyyy}
+\def\unnumberedsecyyy #1{\unnmhead1{#1}} % normally calls unnumberedseczzz
+\def\unnumberedseczzz #1{\seccheck{unnumberedsec}%
+\plainsecheading {#1}\gdef\thissection{#1}%
+{\chapternofonts%
+\edef\temp{{\realbackslash unnumbsecentry{#1}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
+\escapechar=`\\%
+\write \contentsfile \temp %
+\unnumbnoderef %
+\penalty 10000 %
+}}
+
+\outer\def\numberedsubsec{\parsearg\numberedsubsecyyy}
+\def\numberedsubsecyyy #1{\numhead2{#1}} % normally calls numberedsubseczzz
+\def\numberedsubseczzz #1{\seccheck{subsection}%
+\gdef\thissection{#1}\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance \subsecno by 1 %
+\subsecheading {#1}{\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}%
+{\chapternofonts%
+\edef\temp{{\realbackslash subsecentry %
+{#1}{\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
+\escapechar=`\\%
+\write \contentsfile \temp %
+\donoderef %
+\penalty 10000 %
+}}
+
+\outer\def\appendixsubsec{\parsearg\appendixsubsecyyy}
+\def\appendixsubsecyyy #1{\apphead2{#1}} % normally calls appendixsubseczzz
+\def\appendixsubseczzz #1{\seccheck{appendixsubsec}%
+\gdef\thissection{#1}\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance \subsecno by 1 %
+\subsecheading {#1}{\appendixletter}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}%
+{\chapternofonts%
+\edef\temp{{\realbackslash subsecentry %
+{#1}{\appendixletter}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
+\escapechar=`\\%
+\write \contentsfile \temp %
+\appendixnoderef %
+\penalty 10000 %
+}}
+
+\outer\def\unnumberedsubsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsubsecyyy}
+\def\unnumberedsubsecyyy #1{\unnmhead2{#1}} %normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz
+\def\unnumberedsubseczzz #1{\seccheck{unnumberedsubsec}%
+\plainsecheading {#1}\gdef\thissection{#1}%
+{\chapternofonts%
+\edef\temp{{\realbackslash unnumbsubsecentry{#1}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
+\escapechar=`\\%
+\write \contentsfile \temp %
+\unnumbnoderef %
+\penalty 10000 %
+}}
+
+\outer\def\numberedsubsubsec{\parsearg\numberedsubsubsecyyy}
+\def\numberedsubsubsecyyy #1{\numhead3{#1}} % normally numberedsubsubseczzz
+\def\numberedsubsubseczzz #1{\seccheck{subsubsection}%
+\gdef\thissection{#1}\global\advance \subsubsecno by 1 %
+\subsubsecheading {#1}
+ {\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\the\subsubsecno}%
+{\chapternofonts%
+\edef\temp{{\realbackslash subsubsecentry %
+ {#1}
+ {\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\the\subsubsecno}
+ {\noexpand\folio}}}%
+\escapechar=`\\%
+\write \contentsfile \temp %
+\donoderef %
+\penalty 10000 %
+}}
+
+\outer\def\appendixsubsubsec{\parsearg\appendixsubsubsecyyy}
+\def\appendixsubsubsecyyy #1{\apphead3{#1}} % normally appendixsubsubseczzz
+\def\appendixsubsubseczzz #1{\seccheck{appendixsubsubsec}%
+\gdef\thissection{#1}\global\advance \subsubsecno by 1 %
+\subsubsecheading {#1}
+ {\appendixletter}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\the\subsubsecno}%
+{\chapternofonts%
+\edef\temp{{\realbackslash subsubsecentry{#1}%
+ {\appendixletter}
+ {\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\the\subsubsecno}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
+\escapechar=`\\%
+\write \contentsfile \temp %
+\appendixnoderef %
+\penalty 10000 %
+}}
+
+\outer\def\unnumberedsubsubsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsubsubsecyyy}
+\def\unnumberedsubsubsecyyy #1{\unnmhead3{#1}} %normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz
+\def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz #1{\seccheck{unnumberedsubsubsec}%
+\plainsecheading {#1}\gdef\thissection{#1}%
+{\chapternofonts%
+\edef\temp{{\realbackslash unnumbsubsubsecentry{#1}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
+\escapechar=`\\%
+\write \contentsfile \temp %
+\unnumbnoderef %
+\penalty 10000 %
+}}
+
+% These are variants which are not "outer", so they can appear in @ifinfo.
+% Actually, they should now be obsolete; ordinary section commands should work.
+\def\infotop{\parsearg\unnumberedzzz}
+\def\infounnumbered{\parsearg\unnumberedzzz}
+\def\infounnumberedsec{\parsearg\unnumberedseczzz}
+\def\infounnumberedsubsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsubseczzz}
+\def\infounnumberedsubsubsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsubsubseczzz}
+
+\def\infoappendix{\parsearg\appendixzzz}
+\def\infoappendixsec{\parsearg\appendixseczzz}
+\def\infoappendixsubsec{\parsearg\appendixsubseczzz}
+\def\infoappendixsubsubsec{\parsearg\appendixsubsubseczzz}
+
+\def\infochapter{\parsearg\chapterzzz}
+\def\infosection{\parsearg\sectionzzz}
+\def\infosubsection{\parsearg\subsectionzzz}
+\def\infosubsubsection{\parsearg\subsubsectionzzz}
+
+% These macros control what the section commands do, according
+% to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered).
+% Define them by default for a numbered chapter.
+\global\let\section = \numberedsec
+\global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
+\global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
+
+% Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading
+
+% NOTE on use of \vbox for chapter headings, section headings, and
+% such:
+% 1) We use \vbox rather than the earlier \line to permit
+% overlong headings to fold.
+% 2) \hyphenpenalty is set to 10000 because hyphenation in a
+% heading is obnoxious; this forbids it.
+% 3) Likewise, headings look best if no \parindent is used, and
+% if justification is not attempted. Hence \raggedright.
+
+
+\def\majorheading{\parsearg\majorheadingzzz}
+\def\majorheadingzzz #1{%
+{\advance\chapheadingskip by 10pt \chapbreak }%
+{\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
+ \parindent=0pt\raggedright
+ \rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\penalty 200}
+
+\def\chapheading{\parsearg\chapheadingzzz}
+\def\chapheadingzzz #1{\chapbreak %
+{\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
+ \parindent=0pt\raggedright
+ \rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\penalty 200}
+
+\def\heading{\parsearg\secheadingi}
+
+\def\subheading{\parsearg\subsecheadingi}
+
+\def\subsubheading{\parsearg\subsubsecheadingi}
+
+% These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only
+% (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it),
+% given all the information in convenient, parsed form.
+
+%%% Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative)
+\def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi}
+
+\def\setchapterstyle #1 {\csname CHAPF#1\endcsname}
+
+%%% Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it
+% Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed)
+
+\newskip \chapheadingskip \chapheadingskip = 30pt plus 8pt minus 4pt
+
+\def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-4000}}
+\def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject}
+\def\chapoddpage{\chappager \ifodd\pageno \else \hbox to 0pt{} \chappager\fi}
+
+\def\setchapternewpage #1 {\csname CHAPPAG#1\endcsname}
+
+\def\CHAPPAGoff{
+\global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapbreak
+\global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager}
+
+\def\CHAPPAGon{
+\global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chappager
+\global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager
+\global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsingle}}
+
+\def\CHAPPAGodd{
+\global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapoddpage
+\global\let\pagealignmacro=\chapoddpage
+\global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}}
+
+\CHAPPAGon
+
+\def\CHAPFplain{
+\global\let\chapmacro=\chfplain
+\global\let\unnumbchapmacro=\unnchfplain}
+
+\def\chfplain #1#2{%
+ \pchapsepmacro
+ {%
+ \chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
+ \parindent=0pt\raggedright
+ \rm #2\enspace #1}%
+ }%
+ \bigskip
+ \penalty5000
+}
+
+\def\unnchfplain #1{%
+\pchapsepmacro %
+{\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
+ \parindent=0pt\raggedright
+ \rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\penalty 10000 %
+}
+\CHAPFplain % The default
+
+\def\unnchfopen #1{%
+\chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
+ \parindent=0pt\raggedright
+ \rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\penalty 10000 %
+}
+
+\def\chfopen #1#2{\chapoddpage {\chapfonts
+\vbox to 3in{\vfil \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #2} \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #1} \vfil}}%
+\par\penalty 5000 %
+}
+
+\def\CHAPFopen{
+\global\let\chapmacro=\chfopen
+\global\let\unnumbchapmacro=\unnchfopen}
+
+% Parameter controlling skip before section headings.
+
+\newskip \subsecheadingskip \subsecheadingskip = 17pt plus 8pt minus 4pt
+\def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip {-500}}
+
+\newskip \secheadingskip \secheadingskip = 21pt plus 8pt minus 4pt
+\def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip {-1000}}
+
+% @paragraphindent is defined for the Info formatting commands only.
+\let\paragraphindent=\comment
+
+% Section fonts are the base font at magstep2, which produces
+% a size a bit more than 14 points in the default situation.
+
+\def\secheading #1#2#3{\secheadingi {#2.#3\enspace #1}}
+\def\plainsecheading #1{\secheadingi {#1}}
+\def\secheadingi #1{{\advance \secheadingskip by \parskip %
+\secheadingbreak}%
+{\secfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
+ \parindent=0pt\raggedright
+ \rm #1\hfill}}%
+\ifdim \parskip<10pt \kern 10pt\kern -\parskip\fi \penalty 10000 }
+
+
+% Subsection fonts are the base font at magstep1,
+% which produces a size of 12 points.
+
+\def\subsecheading #1#2#3#4{\subsecheadingi {#2.#3.#4\enspace #1}}
+\def\subsecheadingi #1{{\advance \subsecheadingskip by \parskip %
+\subsecheadingbreak}%
+{\subsecfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
+ \parindent=0pt\raggedright
+ \rm #1\hfill}}%
+\ifdim \parskip<10pt \kern 10pt\kern -\parskip\fi \penalty 10000 }
+
+\def\subsubsecfonts{\subsecfonts} % Maybe this should change:
+ % Perhaps make sssec fonts scaled
+ % magstep half
+\def\subsubsecheading #1#2#3#4#5{\subsubsecheadingi {#2.#3.#4.#5\enspace #1}}
+\def\subsubsecheadingi #1{{\advance \subsecheadingskip by \parskip %
+\subsecheadingbreak}%
+{\subsubsecfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
+ \parindent=0pt\raggedright
+ \rm #1\hfill}}%
+\ifdim \parskip<10pt \kern 10pt\kern -\parskip\fi \penalty 10000}
+
+
+\message{toc printing,}
+
+% Finish up the main text and prepare to read what we've written
+% to \contentsfile.
+
+\newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=1in
+\def\startcontents#1{%
+ \pagealignmacro
+ \immediate\closeout \contentsfile
+ \ifnum \pageno>0
+ \pageno = -1 % Request roman numbered pages.
+ \fi
+ % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline.
+ % It is abundantly clear what they are.
+ \unnumbchapmacro{#1}\def\thischapter{}%
+ \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly.
+ \catcode`\\=0 \catcode`\{=1 \catcode`\}=2 \catcode`\@=11
+ \catcode`\^=7 % to see ^^e4 as \"a etc. juha@piuha.ydi.vtt.fi
+ \raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom.
+ \advance\hsize by -\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length.
+}
+
+
+% Normal (long) toc.
+\outer\def\contents{%
+ \startcontents{\putwordTableofContents}%
+ \input \jobname.toc
+ \endgroup
+ \vfill \eject
+}
+
+% And just the chapters.
+\outer\def\summarycontents{%
+ \startcontents{\putwordShortContents}%
+ %
+ \let\chapentry = \shortchapentry
+ \let\unnumbchapentry = \shortunnumberedentry
+ % We want a true roman here for the page numbers.
+ \secfonts
+ \let\rm=\shortcontrm \let\bf=\shortcontbf \let\sl=\shortcontsl
+ \rm
+ \advance\baselineskip by 1pt % Open it up a little.
+ \def\secentry ##1##2##3##4{}
+ \def\unnumbsecentry ##1##2{}
+ \def\subsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5{}
+ \def\unnumbsubsecentry ##1##2{}
+ \def\subsubsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5##6{}
+ \def\unnumbsubsubsecentry ##1##2{}
+ \input \jobname.toc
+ \endgroup
+ \vfill \eject
+}
+\let\shortcontents = \summarycontents
+
+% These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents.
+% The first argument is the chapter or section name.
+% The last argument is the page number.
+% The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ...
+
+% Chapter-level things, for both the long and short contents.
+\def\chapentry#1#2#3{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#3}}
+
+% See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings
+\def\shortchapentry#1#2#3{%
+ \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno{#3}}%
+}
+
+% Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents.
+% The arg is, e.g. `Appendix A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter.
+% We could simplify the code here by writing out an \appendixentry
+% command in the toc file for appendices, instead of using \chapentry
+% for both, but it doesn't seem worth it.
+\setbox0 = \hbox{\shortcontrm \putwordAppendix }
+\newdimen\shortappendixwidth \shortappendixwidth = \wd0
+
+\def\shortchaplabel#1{%
+ % We typeset #1 in a box of constant width, regardless of the text of
+ % #1, so the chapter titles will come out aligned.
+ \setbox0 = \hbox{#1}%
+ \dimen0 = \ifdim\wd0 > \shortappendixwidth \shortappendixwidth \else 0pt \fi
+ %
+ % This space should be plenty, since a single number is .5em, and the
+ % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts.
+ % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after
+ % the label; that gets put in in \shortchapentry above.)
+ \advance\dimen0 by 1.1em
+ \hbox to \dimen0{#1\hfil}%
+}
+
+\def\unnumbchapentry#1#2{\dochapentry{#1}{#2}}
+\def\shortunnumberedentry#1#2{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno{#2}}}
+
+% Sections.
+\def\secentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2.#3\labelspace#1}{#4}}
+\def\unnumbsecentry#1#2{\dosecentry{#1}{#2}}
+
+% Subsections.
+\def\subsecentry#1#2#3#4#5{\dosubsecentry{#2.#3.#4\labelspace#1}{#5}}
+\def\unnumbsubsecentry#1#2{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#2}}
+
+% And subsubsections.
+\def\subsubsecentry#1#2#3#4#5#6{%
+ \dosubsubsecentry{#2.#3.#4.#5\labelspace#1}{#6}}
+\def\unnumbsubsubsecentry#1#2{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#2}}
+
+
+% This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels.
+\newdimen\tocindent \tocindent = 3pc
+
+% Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the
+% page number.
+%
+% If the toc has to be broken over pages, we would want to be at chapters
+% if at all possible; hence the \penalty.
+\def\dochapentry#1#2{%
+ \penalty-300 \vskip\baselineskip
+ \begingroup
+ \chapentryfonts
+ \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno{#2}}%
+ \endgroup
+ \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip
+}
+
+\def\dosecentry#1#2{\begingroup
+ \secentryfonts \leftskip=\tocindent
+ \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno{#2}}%
+\endgroup}
+
+\def\dosubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
+ \subsecentryfonts \leftskip=2\tocindent
+ \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno{#2}}%
+\endgroup}
+
+\def\dosubsubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
+ \subsubsecentryfonts \leftskip=3\tocindent
+ \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno{#2}}%
+\endgroup}
+
+% Final typesetting of a toc entry; we use the same \entry macro as for
+% the index entries, but we want to suppress hyphenation here. (We
+% can't do that in the \entry macro, since index entries might consist
+% of hyphenated-identifiers-that-do-not-fit-on-a-line-and-nothing-else.)
+%
+% \turnoffactive is for the sake of @" used for umlauts.
+\def\tocentry#1#2{\begingroup
+ \hyphenpenalty = 10000
+ \entry{\turnoffactive #1}{\turnoffactive #2}%
+\endgroup}
+
+% Space between chapter (or whatever) number and the title.
+\def\labelspace{\hskip1em \relax}
+
+\def\dopageno#1{{\rm #1}}
+\def\doshortpageno#1{{\rm #1}}
+
+\def\chapentryfonts{\secfonts \rm}
+\def\secentryfonts{\textfonts}
+\let\subsecentryfonts = \textfonts
+\let\subsubsecentryfonts = \textfonts
+
+
+\message{environments,}
+
+% Since these characters are used in examples, it should be an even number of
+% \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em.
+% Furthermore, these definitions must come after we define our fonts.
+\newbox\dblarrowbox \newbox\longdblarrowbox
+\newbox\pushcharbox \newbox\bullbox
+\newbox\equivbox \newbox\errorbox
+
+\let\ptexequiv = \equiv
+
+%{\tentt
+%\global\setbox\dblarrowbox = \hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}
+%\global\setbox\longdblarrowbox = \hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}
+%\global\setbox\pushcharbox = \hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil}
+%\global\setbox\equivbox = \hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}
+% Adapted from the manmac format (p.420 of TeXbook)
+%\global\setbox\bullbox = \hbox to 1em{\kern.15em\vrule height .75ex width .85ex
+% depth .1ex\hfil}
+%}
+
+\def\point{$\star$}
+
+\def\result{\leavevmode\raise.15ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}}
+\def\expansion{\leavevmode\raise.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}}
+\def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil}}
+
+\def\equiv{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}}
+
+% Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit.
+{\tentt \global\dimen0 = 3em}% Width of the box.
+\dimen2 = .55pt % Thickness of rules
+% The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.)
+\setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \tensf error\kern-1.5pt}
+
+\global\setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil
+ \hsize = \dimen0 \advance\hsize by -5.8pt % Space to left+right.
+ \advance\hsize by -2\dimen2 % Rules.
+ \vbox{
+ \hrule height\dimen2
+ \hbox{\vrule width\dimen2 \kern3pt % Space to left of text.
+ \vtop{\kern2.4pt \box0 \kern2.4pt}% Space above/below.
+ \kern3pt\vrule width\dimen2}% Space to right.
+ \hrule height\dimen2}
+ \hfil}
+
+% The @error{} command.
+\def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex\copy\errorbox}
+
+% @tex ... @end tex escapes into raw Tex temporarily.
+% One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works.
+% But \@ or @@ will get a plain tex @ character.
+
+\def\tex{\begingroup
+\catcode `\\=0 \catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2
+\catcode `\$=3 \catcode `\&=4 \catcode `\#=6
+\catcode `\^=7 \catcode `\_=8 \catcode `\~=13 \let~=\tie
+\catcode `\%=14
+\catcode 43=12
+\catcode`\"=12
+\catcode`\==12
+\catcode`\|=12
+\catcode`\<=12
+\catcode`\>=12
+\escapechar=`\\
+%
+\let\~=\ptextilde
+\let\{=\ptexlbrace
+\let\}=\ptexrbrace
+\let\.=\ptexdot
+\let\*=\ptexstar
+\let\dots=\ptexdots
+\def\@{@}%
+\let\bullet=\ptexbullet
+\let\b=\ptexb \let\c=\ptexc \let\i=\ptexi \let\t=\ptext \let\l=\ptexl
+\let\L=\ptexL
+%
+\let\Etex=\endgroup}
+
+% Define @lisp ... @endlisp.
+% @lisp does a \begingroup so it can rebind things,
+% including the definition of @endlisp (which normally is erroneous).
+
+% Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp.
+\newskip\lispnarrowing \lispnarrowing=0.4in
+
+% This is the definition that ^^M gets inside @lisp, @example, and other
+% such environments. \null is better than a space, since it doesn't
+% have any width.
+\def\lisppar{\null\endgraf}
+
+% Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword
+% space in the output. Don't allow a line break at this space, as this
+% is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input
+% should produce a line of output anyway.
+%
+{\obeyspaces %
+\gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\tie}}
+
+% Define \obeyedspace to be our active space, whatever it is. This is
+% for use in \parsearg.
+{\sepspaces%
+\global\let\obeyedspace= }
+
+% This space is always present above and below environments.
+\newskip\envskipamount \envskipamount = 0pt
+
+% Make spacing and below environment symmetrical. We use \parskip here
+% to help in doing that, since in @example-like environments \parskip
+% is reset to zero; thus the \afterenvbreak inserts no space -- but the
+% start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip
+%
+\def\aboveenvbreak{{\advance\envskipamount by \parskip
+\endgraf \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount
+\removelastskip \penalty-50 \vskip\envskipamount \fi}}
+
+\let\afterenvbreak = \aboveenvbreak
+
+% \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins.
+\let\nonarrowing=\relax
+
+%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
+% \cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around argument
+\font\circle=lcircle10
+\newdimen\circthick
+\newdimen\cartouter\newdimen\cartinner
+\newskip\normbskip\newskip\normpskip\newskip\normlskip
+\circthick=\fontdimen8\circle
+%
+\def\ctl{{\circle\char'013\hskip -6pt}}% 6pt from pl file: 1/2charwidth
+\def\ctr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'010}}
+\def\cbl{{\circle\char'012\hskip -6pt}}
+\def\cbr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'011}}
+\def\carttop{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
+ \ctl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\ctr
+ \hskip\rskip}}
+\def\cartbot{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
+ \cbl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\cbr
+ \hskip\rskip}}
+%
+\newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip
+
+\long\def\cartouche{%
+\begingroup
+ \lskip=\leftskip \rskip=\rightskip
+ \leftskip=0pt\rightskip=0pt %we want these *outside*.
+ \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip
+ \advance\cartinner by-\rskip
+ \cartouter=\hsize
+ \advance\cartouter by 18pt % allow for 3pt kerns on either
+% side, and for 6pt waste from
+% each corner char
+ \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip
+ % Flag to tell @lisp, etc., not to narrow margin.
+ \let\nonarrowing=\comment
+ \vbox\bgroup
+ \baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt
+ \carttop
+ \hbox\bgroup
+ \hskip\lskip
+ \vrule\kern3pt
+ \vbox\bgroup
+ \hsize=\cartinner
+ \kern3pt
+ \begingroup
+ \baselineskip=\normbskip
+ \lineskip=\normlskip
+ \parskip=\normpskip
+ \vskip -\parskip
+\def\Ecartouche{%
+ \endgroup
+ \kern3pt
+ \egroup
+ \kern3pt\vrule
+ \hskip\rskip
+ \egroup
+ \cartbot
+ \egroup
+\endgroup
+}}
+
+
+% This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants,
+% inside a group.
+\def\nonfillstart{%
+ \aboveenvbreak
+ \inENV % This group ends at the end of the body
+ \hfuzz = 12pt % Don't be fussy
+ \sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens.
+ \singlespace
+ \let\par = \lisppar % don't ignore blank lines
+ \obeylines % each line of input is a line of output
+ \parskip = 0pt
+ \parindent = 0pt
+ \emergencystretch = 0pt % don't try to avoid overfull boxes
+ % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing
+ % at next level down.
+ \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
+ \advance \leftskip by \lispnarrowing
+ \exdentamount=\lispnarrowing
+ \let\exdent=\nofillexdent
+ \let\nonarrowing=\relax
+ \fi
+}
+
+% To ending an @example-like environment, we first end the paragraph
+% (via \afterenvbreak's vertical glue), and then the group. That way we
+% keep the zero \parskip that the environments set -- \parskip glue
+% will be inserted at the beginning of the next paragraph in the
+% document, after the environment.
+%
+\def\nonfillfinish{\afterenvbreak\endgroup}%
+
+% This macro is
+\def\lisp{\begingroup
+ \nonfillstart
+ \let\Elisp = \nonfillfinish
+ \tt
+ \rawbackslash % have \ input char produce \ char from current font
+ \gobble
+}
+
+% Define the \E... control sequence only if we are inside the
+% environment, so the error checking in \end will work.
+%
+% We must call \lisp last in the definition, since it reads the
+% return following the @example (or whatever) command.
+%
+\def\example{\begingroup \def\Eexample{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\lisp}
+\def\smallexample{\begingroup \def\Esmallexample{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\lisp}
+\def\smalllisp{\begingroup \def\Esmalllisp{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\lisp}
+
+% @smallexample and @smalllisp. This is not used unless the @smallbook
+% command is given. Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox.
+%
+\def\smalllispx{\begingroup
+ \nonfillstart
+ \let\Esmalllisp = \nonfillfinish
+ \let\Esmallexample = \nonfillfinish
+ %
+ % Smaller interline space and fonts for small examples.
+ \setleading{10pt}%
+ \indexfonts \tt
+ \rawbackslash % make \ output the \ character from the current font (tt)
+ \gobble
+}
+
+% This is @display; same as @lisp except use roman font.
+%
+\def\display{\begingroup
+ \nonfillstart
+ \let\Edisplay = \nonfillfinish
+ \gobble
+}
+
+% This is @format; same as @display except don't narrow margins.
+%
+\def\format{\begingroup
+ \let\nonarrowing = t
+ \nonfillstart
+ \let\Eformat = \nonfillfinish
+ \gobble
+}
+
+% @flushleft (same as @format) and @flushright.
+%
+\def\flushleft{\begingroup
+ \let\nonarrowing = t
+ \nonfillstart
+ \let\Eflushleft = \nonfillfinish
+ \gobble
+}
+\def\flushright{\begingroup
+ \let\nonarrowing = t
+ \nonfillstart
+ \let\Eflushright = \nonfillfinish
+ \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill
+ \gobble}
+
+% @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart)
+% and narrows the margins.
+%
+\def\quotation{%
+ \begingroup\inENV %This group ends at the end of the @quotation body
+ {\parskip=0pt \aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip
+ \singlespace
+ \parindent=0pt
+ % We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're
+ % doing normal filling. So to avoid extra space below the environment...
+ \def\Equotation{\parskip = 0pt \nonfillfinish}%
+ %
+ % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down.
+ \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
+ \advance\leftskip by \lispnarrowing
+ \advance\rightskip by \lispnarrowing
+ \exdentamount = \lispnarrowing
+ \let\nonarrowing = \relax
+ \fi
+}
+
+\message{defuns,}
+% Define formatter for defuns
+% First, allow user to change definition object font (\df) internally
+\def\setdeffont #1 {\csname DEF#1\endcsname}
+
+\newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=.4in
+\newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=50pt
+\newskip\deftypemargin \deftypemargin=12pt
+\newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=18pt
+
+\newcount\parencount
+% define \functionparens, which makes ( and ) and & do special things.
+% \functionparens affects the group it is contained in.
+\def\activeparens{%
+\catcode`\(=\active \catcode`\)=\active \catcode`\&=\active
+\catcode`\[=\active \catcode`\]=\active}
+
+% Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars.
+\let\lparen = ( \let\rparen = )
+
+{\activeparens % Now, smart parens don't turn on until &foo (see \amprm)
+
+% Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc. For example,
+% if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet,
+% so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence.
+\global\let(=\lparen \global\let)=\rparen
+\global\let[=\lbrack \global\let]=\rbrack
+
+\gdef\functionparens{\boldbrax\let&=\amprm\parencount=0 }
+\gdef\boldbrax{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb}
+% This is used to turn on special parens
+% but make & act ordinary (given that it's active).
+\gdef\boldbraxnoamp{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb\let&=\ampnr}
+
+% Definitions of (, ) and & used in args for functions.
+% This is the definition of ( outside of all parentheses.
+\gdef\oprm#1 {{\rm\char`\(}#1 \bf \let(=\opnested %
+\global\advance\parencount by 1 }
+%
+% This is the definition of ( when already inside a level of parens.
+\gdef\opnested{\char`\(\global\advance\parencount by 1 }
+%
+\gdef\clrm{% Print a paren in roman if it is taking us back to depth of 0.
+% also in that case restore the outer-level definition of (.
+\ifnum \parencount=1 {\rm \char `\)}\sl \let(=\oprm \else \char `\) \fi
+\global\advance \parencount by -1 }
+% If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards
+\gdef\amprm#1 {{\rm\&#1}\let(=\oprm \let)=\clrm\ }
+%
+\gdef\normalparens{\boldbrax\let&=\ampnr}
+} % End of definition inside \activeparens
+%% These parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than the
+%% contained text. This is especially needed for [ and ]
+\def\opnr{{\sf\char`\(}} \def\clnr{{\sf\char`\)}} \def\ampnr{\&}
+\def\lbrb{{\bf\char`\[}} \def\rbrb{{\bf\char`\]}}
+
+% First, defname, which formats the header line itself.
+% #1 should be the function name.
+% #2 should be the type of definition, such as "Function".
+
+\def\defname #1#2{%
+% Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were
+% outside the @def...
+\dimen2=\leftskip
+\advance\dimen2 by -\defbodyindent
+\dimen3=\rightskip
+\advance\dimen3 by -\defbodyindent
+\noindent %
+\setbox0=\hbox{\hskip \deflastargmargin{\rm #2}\hskip \deftypemargin}%
+\dimen0=\hsize \advance \dimen0 by -\wd0 % compute size for first line
+\dimen1=\hsize \advance \dimen1 by -\defargsindent %size for continuations
+\parshape 2 0in \dimen0 \defargsindent \dimen1 %
+% Now output arg 2 ("Function" or some such)
+% ending at \deftypemargin from the right margin,
+% but stuck inside a box of width 0 so it does not interfere with linebreaking
+{% Adjust \hsize to exclude the ambient margins,
+% so that \rightline will obey them.
+\advance \hsize by -\dimen2 \advance \hsize by -\dimen3
+\rlap{\rightline{{\rm #2}\hskip \deftypemargin}}}%
+% Make all lines underfull and no complaints:
+\tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000
+\advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent
+\exdentamount=\defbodyindent
+{\df #1}\enskip % Generate function name
+}
+
+% Actually process the body of a definition
+% #1 should be the terminating control sequence, such as \Edefun.
+% #2 should be the "another name" control sequence, such as \defunx.
+% #3 should be the control sequence that actually processes the header,
+% such as \defunheader.
+
+\def\defparsebody #1#2#3{\begingroup\inENV% Environment for definitionbody
+\medbreak %
+% Define the end token that this defining construct specifies
+% so that it will exit this group.
+\def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}%
+\def#2{\begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit#3}%
+\parindent=0in
+\advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent \advance \rightskip by \defbodyindent
+\exdentamount=\defbodyindent
+\begingroup %
+\catcode 61=\active % 61 is `='
+\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit#3}
+
+\def\defmethparsebody #1#2#3#4 {\begingroup\inENV %
+\medbreak %
+% Define the end token that this defining construct specifies
+% so that it will exit this group.
+\def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}%
+\def#2##1 {\begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{##1}}}%
+\parindent=0in
+\advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent \advance \rightskip by \defbodyindent
+\exdentamount=\defbodyindent
+\begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{#4}}}
+
+\def\defopparsebody #1#2#3#4#5 {\begingroup\inENV %
+\medbreak %
+% Define the end token that this defining construct specifies
+% so that it will exit this group.
+\def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}%
+\def#2##1 ##2 {\def#4{##1}%
+\begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{##2}}}%
+\parindent=0in
+\advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent \advance \rightskip by \defbodyindent
+\exdentamount=\defbodyindent
+\begingroup\obeylines\activeparens\spacesplit{#3{#5}}}
+
+% These parsing functions are similar to the preceding ones
+% except that they do not make parens into active characters.
+% These are used for "variables" since they have no arguments.
+
+\def\defvarparsebody #1#2#3{\begingroup\inENV% Environment for definitionbody
+\medbreak %
+% Define the end token that this defining construct specifies
+% so that it will exit this group.
+\def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}%
+\def#2{\begingroup\obeylines\spacesplit#3}%
+\parindent=0in
+\advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent \advance \rightskip by \defbodyindent
+\exdentamount=\defbodyindent
+\begingroup %
+\catcode 61=\active %
+\obeylines\spacesplit#3}
+
+% This is used for \def{tp,vr}parsebody. It could probably be used for
+% some of the others, too, with some judicious conditionals.
+%
+\def\parsebodycommon#1#2#3{%
+ \begingroup\inENV %
+ \medbreak %
+ % Define the end token that this defining construct specifies
+ % so that it will exit this group.
+ \def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}%
+ \def#2##1 {\begingroup\obeylines\spacesplit{#3{##1}}}%
+ \parindent=0in
+ \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent \advance \rightskip by \defbodyindent
+ \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
+ \begingroup\obeylines
+}
+
+\def\defvrparsebody#1#2#3#4 {%
+ \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}%
+ \spacesplit{#3{#4}}%
+}
+
+% This loses on `@deftp {Data Type} {struct termios}' -- it thinks the
+% type is just `struct', because we lose the braces in `{struct
+% termios}' when \spacesplit reads its undelimited argument. Sigh.
+% \let\deftpparsebody=\defvrparsebody
+%
+% So, to get around this, we put \empty in with the type name. That
+% way, TeX won't find exactly `{...}' as an undelimited argument, and
+% won't strip off the braces.
+%
+\def\deftpparsebody #1#2#3#4 {%
+ \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}%
+ \spacesplit{\parsetpheaderline{#3{#4}}}\empty
+}
+
+% Fine, but then we have to eventually remove the \empty *and* the
+% braces (if any). That's what this does, putting the result in \tptemp.
+%
+\def\removeemptybraces\empty#1\relax{\def\tptemp{#1}}%
+
+% After \spacesplit has done its work, this is called -- #1 is the final
+% thing to call, #2 the type name (which starts with \empty), and #3
+% (which might be empty) the arguments.
+%
+\def\parsetpheaderline#1#2#3{%
+ \removeemptybraces#2\relax
+ #1{\tptemp}{#3}%
+}%
+
+\def\defopvarparsebody #1#2#3#4#5 {\begingroup\inENV %
+\medbreak %
+% Define the end token that this defining construct specifies
+% so that it will exit this group.
+\def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}%
+\def#2##1 ##2 {\def#4{##1}%
+\begingroup\obeylines\spacesplit{#3{##2}}}%
+\parindent=0in
+\advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent \advance \rightskip by \defbodyindent
+\exdentamount=\defbodyindent
+\begingroup\obeylines\spacesplit{#3{#5}}}
+
+% Split up #2 at the first space token.
+% call #1 with two arguments:
+% the first is all of #2 before the space token,
+% the second is all of #2 after that space token.
+% If #2 contains no space token, all of it is passed as the first arg
+% and the second is passed as empty.
+
+{\obeylines
+\gdef\spacesplit#1#2^^M{\endgroup\spacesplitfoo{#1}#2 \relax\spacesplitfoo}%
+\long\gdef\spacesplitfoo#1#2 #3#4\spacesplitfoo{%
+\ifx\relax #3%
+#1{#2}{}\else #1{#2}{#3#4}\fi}}
+
+% So much for the things common to all kinds of definitions.
+
+% Define @defun.
+
+% First, define the processing that is wanted for arguments of \defun
+% Use this to expand the args and terminate the paragraph they make up
+
+\def\defunargs #1{\functionparens \sl
+% Expand, preventing hyphenation at `-' chars.
+% Note that groups don't affect changes in \hyphenchar.
+\hyphenchar\tensl=0
+#1%
+\hyphenchar\tensl=45
+\ifnum\parencount=0 \else \errmessage{unbalanced parens in @def arguments}\fi%
+\interlinepenalty=10000
+\advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil
+\endgraf\penalty 10000\vskip -\parskip\penalty 10000%
+}
+
+\def\deftypefunargs #1{%
+% Expand, preventing hyphenation at `-' chars.
+% Note that groups don't affect changes in \hyphenchar.
+% Use \boldbraxnoamp, not \functionparens, so that & is not special.
+\boldbraxnoamp
+\tclose{#1}% avoid \code because of side effects on active chars
+\interlinepenalty=10000
+\advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil
+\endgraf\penalty 10000\vskip -\parskip\penalty 10000%
+}
+
+% Do complete processing of one @defun or @defunx line already parsed.
+
+% @deffn Command forward-char nchars
+
+\def\deffn{\defmethparsebody\Edeffn\deffnx\deffnheader}
+
+\def\deffnheader #1#2#3{\doind {fn}{\code{#2}}%
+\begingroup\defname {#2}{#1}\defunargs{#3}\endgroup %
+\catcode 61=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody
+}
+
+% @defun == @deffn Function
+
+\def\defun{\defparsebody\Edefun\defunx\defunheader}
+
+\def\defunheader #1#2{\doind {fn}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in function index
+\begingroup\defname {#1}{Function}%
+\defunargs {#2}\endgroup %
+\catcode 61=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody
+}
+
+% @deftypefun int foobar (int @var{foo}, float @var{bar})
+
+\def\deftypefun{\defparsebody\Edeftypefun\deftypefunx\deftypefunheader}
+
+% #1 is the data type. #2 is the name and args.
+\def\deftypefunheader #1#2{\deftypefunheaderx{#1}#2 \relax}
+% #1 is the data type, #2 the name, #3 the args.
+\def\deftypefunheaderx #1#2 #3\relax{%
+\doind {fn}{\code{#2}}% Make entry in function index
+\begingroup\defname {\defheaderxcond#1\relax$$$#2}{Function}%
+\deftypefunargs {#3}\endgroup %
+\catcode 61=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody
+}
+
+% @deftypefn {Library Function} int foobar (int @var{foo}, float @var{bar})
+
+\def\deftypefn{\defmethparsebody\Edeftypefn\deftypefnx\deftypefnheader}
+
+% \defheaderxcond#1\relax$$$
+% puts #1 in @code, followed by a space, but does nothing if #1 is null.
+\def\defheaderxcond#1#2$$${\ifx#1\relax\else\code{#1#2} \fi}
+
+% #1 is the classification. #2 is the data type. #3 is the name and args.
+\def\deftypefnheader #1#2#3{\deftypefnheaderx{#1}{#2}#3 \relax}
+% #1 is the classification, #2 the data type, #3 the name, #4 the args.
+\def\deftypefnheaderx #1#2#3 #4\relax{%
+\doind {fn}{\code{#3}}% Make entry in function index
+\begingroup
+\normalparens % notably, turn off `&' magic, which prevents
+% at least some C++ text from working
+\defname {\defheaderxcond#2\relax$$$#3}{#1}%
+\deftypefunargs {#4}\endgroup %
+\catcode 61=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody
+}
+
+% @defmac == @deffn Macro
+
+\def\defmac{\defparsebody\Edefmac\defmacx\defmacheader}
+
+\def\defmacheader #1#2{\doind {fn}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in function index
+\begingroup\defname {#1}{Macro}%
+\defunargs {#2}\endgroup %
+\catcode 61=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody
+}
+
+% @defspec == @deffn Special Form
+
+\def\defspec{\defparsebody\Edefspec\defspecx\defspecheader}
+
+\def\defspecheader #1#2{\doind {fn}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in function index
+\begingroup\defname {#1}{Special Form}%
+\defunargs {#2}\endgroup %
+\catcode 61=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody
+}
+
+% This definition is run if you use @defunx
+% anywhere other than immediately after a @defun or @defunx.
+
+\def\deffnx #1 {\errmessage{@deffnx in invalid context}}
+\def\defunx #1 {\errmessage{@defunx in invalid context}}
+\def\defmacx #1 {\errmessage{@defmacx in invalid context}}
+\def\defspecx #1 {\errmessage{@defspecx in invalid context}}
+\def\deftypefnx #1 {\errmessage{@deftypefnx in invalid context}}
+\def\deftypeunx #1 {\errmessage{@deftypeunx in invalid context}}
+
+% @defmethod, and so on
+
+% @defop {Funny Method} foo-class frobnicate argument
+
+\def\defop #1 {\def\defoptype{#1}%
+\defopparsebody\Edefop\defopx\defopheader\defoptype}
+
+\def\defopheader #1#2#3{%
+\dosubind {fn}{\code{#2}}{on #1}% Make entry in function index
+\begingroup\defname {#2}{\defoptype{} on #1}%
+\defunargs {#3}\endgroup %
+}
+
+% @defmethod == @defop Method
+
+\def\defmethod{\defmethparsebody\Edefmethod\defmethodx\defmethodheader}
+
+\def\defmethodheader #1#2#3{%
+\dosubind {fn}{\code{#2}}{on #1}% entry in function index
+\begingroup\defname {#2}{Method on #1}%
+\defunargs {#3}\endgroup %
+}
+
+% @defcv {Class Option} foo-class foo-flag
+
+\def\defcv #1 {\def\defcvtype{#1}%
+\defopvarparsebody\Edefcv\defcvx\defcvarheader\defcvtype}
+
+\def\defcvarheader #1#2#3{%
+\dosubind {vr}{\code{#2}}{of #1}% Make entry in var index
+\begingroup\defname {#2}{\defcvtype{} of #1}%
+\defvarargs {#3}\endgroup %
+}
+
+% @defivar == @defcv {Instance Variable}
+
+\def\defivar{\defvrparsebody\Edefivar\defivarx\defivarheader}
+
+\def\defivarheader #1#2#3{%
+\dosubind {vr}{\code{#2}}{of #1}% Make entry in var index
+\begingroup\defname {#2}{Instance Variable of #1}%
+\defvarargs {#3}\endgroup %
+}
+
+% These definitions are run if you use @defmethodx, etc.,
+% anywhere other than immediately after a @defmethod, etc.
+
+\def\defopx #1 {\errmessage{@defopx in invalid context}}
+\def\defmethodx #1 {\errmessage{@defmethodx in invalid context}}
+\def\defcvx #1 {\errmessage{@defcvx in invalid context}}
+\def\defivarx #1 {\errmessage{@defivarx in invalid context}}
+
+% Now @defvar
+
+% First, define the processing that is wanted for arguments of @defvar.
+% This is actually simple: just print them in roman.
+% This must expand the args and terminate the paragraph they make up
+\def\defvarargs #1{\normalparens #1%
+\interlinepenalty=10000
+\endgraf\penalty 10000\vskip -\parskip\penalty 10000}
+
+% @defvr Counter foo-count
+
+\def\defvr{\defvrparsebody\Edefvr\defvrx\defvrheader}
+
+\def\defvrheader #1#2#3{\doind {vr}{\code{#2}}%
+\begingroup\defname {#2}{#1}\defvarargs{#3}\endgroup}
+
+% @defvar == @defvr Variable
+
+\def\defvar{\defvarparsebody\Edefvar\defvarx\defvarheader}
+
+\def\defvarheader #1#2{\doind {vr}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in var index
+\begingroup\defname {#1}{Variable}%
+\defvarargs {#2}\endgroup %
+}
+
+% @defopt == @defvr {User Option}
+
+\def\defopt{\defvarparsebody\Edefopt\defoptx\defoptheader}
+
+\def\defoptheader #1#2{\doind {vr}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in var index
+\begingroup\defname {#1}{User Option}%
+\defvarargs {#2}\endgroup %
+}
+
+% @deftypevar int foobar
+
+\def\deftypevar{\defvarparsebody\Edeftypevar\deftypevarx\deftypevarheader}
+
+% #1 is the data type. #2 is the name.
+\def\deftypevarheader #1#2{%
+\doind {vr}{\code{#2}}% Make entry in variables index
+\begingroup\defname {\defheaderxcond#1\relax$$$#2}{Variable}%
+\interlinepenalty=10000
+\endgraf\penalty 10000\vskip -\parskip\penalty 10000
+\endgroup}
+
+% @deftypevr {Global Flag} int enable
+
+\def\deftypevr{\defvrparsebody\Edeftypevr\deftypevrx\deftypevrheader}
+
+\def\deftypevrheader #1#2#3{\doind {vr}{\code{#3}}%
+\begingroup\defname {\defheaderxcond#2\relax$$$#3}{#1}
+\interlinepenalty=10000
+\endgraf\penalty 10000\vskip -\parskip\penalty 10000
+\endgroup}
+
+% This definition is run if you use @defvarx
+% anywhere other than immediately after a @defvar or @defvarx.
+
+\def\defvrx #1 {\errmessage{@defvrx in invalid context}}
+\def\defvarx #1 {\errmessage{@defvarx in invalid context}}
+\def\defoptx #1 {\errmessage{@defoptx in invalid context}}
+\def\deftypevarx #1 {\errmessage{@deftypevarx in invalid context}}
+\def\deftypevrx #1 {\errmessage{@deftypevrx in invalid context}}
+
+% Now define @deftp
+% Args are printed in bold, a slight difference from @defvar.
+
+\def\deftpargs #1{\bf \defvarargs{#1}}
+
+% @deftp Class window height width ...
+
+\def\deftp{\deftpparsebody\Edeftp\deftpx\deftpheader}
+
+\def\deftpheader #1#2#3{\doind {tp}{\code{#2}}%
+\begingroup\defname {#2}{#1}\deftpargs{#3}\endgroup}
+
+% This definition is run if you use @deftpx, etc
+% anywhere other than immediately after a @deftp, etc.
+
+\def\deftpx #1 {\errmessage{@deftpx in invalid context}}
+
+\message{cross reference,}
+% Define cross-reference macros
+\newwrite \auxfile
+
+\newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known.
+\newif\ifwarnedxrefs % True if we warned once that they aren't known.
+
+% \setref{foo} defines a cross-reference point named foo.
+
+\def\setref#1{%
+\dosetq{#1-title}{Ytitle}%
+\dosetq{#1-pg}{Ypagenumber}%
+\dosetq{#1-snt}{Ysectionnumberandtype}}
+
+\def\unnumbsetref#1{%
+\dosetq{#1-title}{Ytitle}%
+\dosetq{#1-pg}{Ypagenumber}%
+\dosetq{#1-snt}{Ynothing}}
+
+\def\appendixsetref#1{%
+\dosetq{#1-title}{Ytitle}%
+\dosetq{#1-pg}{Ypagenumber}%
+\dosetq{#1-snt}{Yappendixletterandtype}}
+
+% \xref, \pxref, and \ref generate cross-references to specified points.
+% For \xrefX, #1 is the node name, #2 the name of the Info
+% cross-reference, #3 the printed node name, #4 the name of the Info
+% file, #5 the name of the printed manual. All but the node name can be
+% omitted.
+%
+\def\pxref#1{\putwordsee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
+\def\xref#1{\putwordSee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
+\def\ref#1{\xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
+\def\xrefX[#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6]{\begingroup
+ \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}%
+ \def\printednodename{\ignorespaces #3}%
+ \setbox1=\hbox{\printedmanual}%
+ \setbox0=\hbox{\printednodename}%
+ \ifdim \wd0 = 0pt
+ % No printed node name was explicitly given.
+ \ifx\SETxref-automatic-section-title\relax %
+ % Use the actual chapter/section title appear inside
+ % the square brackets. Use the real section title if we have it.
+ \ifdim \wd1>0pt%
+ % It is in another manual, so we don't have it.
+ \def\printednodename{\ignorespaces #1}%
+ \else
+ \ifhavexrefs
+ % We know the real title if we have the xref values.
+ \def\printednodename{\refx{#1-title}}%
+ \else
+ % Otherwise just copy the Info node name.
+ \def\printednodename{\ignorespaces #1}%
+ \fi%
+ \fi
+ \def\printednodename{#1-title}%
+ \else
+ % Use the node name inside the square brackets.
+ \def\printednodename{\ignorespaces #1}%
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ %
+ % If we use \unhbox0 and \unhbox1 to print the node names, TeX does not
+ % insert empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will
+ % not find a line break at a hyphen in a node names. Since some manuals
+ % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens, this
+ % is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name again, so it
+ % is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time.
+ \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
+ \putwordsection{} ``\printednodename'' in \cite{\printedmanual}%
+ \else
+ % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the
+ % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand
+ % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of
+ % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the
+ % printing, back off for the \refx-pg.
+ {\turnoffactive \refx{#1-snt}{}}%
+ \space [\printednodename],\space
+ \turnoffactive \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}%
+ \fi
+\endgroup}
+
+% \dosetq is the interface for calls from other macros
+
+% Use \turnoffactive so that punctuation chars such as underscore
+% work in node names.
+\def\dosetq #1#2{{\let\folio=0 \turnoffactive \auxhat%
+\edef\next{\write\auxfile{\internalsetq {#1}{#2}}}%
+\next}}
+
+% \internalsetq {foo}{page} expands into
+% CHARACTERS 'xrdef {foo}{...expansion of \Ypage...}
+% When the aux file is read, ' is the escape character
+
+\def\internalsetq #1#2{'xrdef {#1}{\csname #2\endcsname}}
+
+% Things to be expanded by \internalsetq
+
+\def\Ypagenumber{\folio}
+
+\def\Ytitle{\thissection}
+
+\def\Ynothing{}
+
+\def\Ysectionnumberandtype{%
+\ifnum\secno=0 \putwordChapter\xreftie\the\chapno %
+\else \ifnum \subsecno=0 \putwordSection\xreftie\the\chapno.\the\secno %
+\else \ifnum \subsubsecno=0 %
+\putwordSection\xreftie\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno %
+\else %
+\putwordSection\xreftie\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno %
+\fi \fi \fi }
+
+\def\Yappendixletterandtype{%
+\ifnum\secno=0 \putwordAppendix\xreftie'char\the\appendixno{}%
+\else \ifnum \subsecno=0 \putwordSection\xreftie'char\the\appendixno.\the\secno %
+\else \ifnum \subsubsecno=0 %
+\putwordSection\xreftie'char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno %
+\else %
+\putwordSection\xreftie'char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno %
+\fi \fi \fi }
+
+\gdef\xreftie{'tie}
+
+% Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error
+% messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything.
+%
+\ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined
+ \let\linenumber = \empty % Non-3.0.
+\else
+ \def\linenumber{\the\inputlineno:\space}
+\fi
+
+% Define \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} to reference a cross-reference string named NAME.
+% If its value is nonempty, SUFFIX is output afterward.
+
+\def\refx#1#2{%
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname X#1\endcsname\relax
+ % If not defined, say something at least.
+ $\langle$un\-de\-fined$\rangle$%
+ \ifhavexrefs
+ \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `#1'.}%
+ \else
+ \ifwarnedxrefs\else
+ \global\warnedxrefstrue
+ \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.}%
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ \else
+ % It's defined, so just use it.
+ \csname X#1\endcsname
+ \fi
+ #2% Output the suffix in any case.
+}
+
+% Read the last existing aux file, if any. No error if none exists.
+
+% This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file.
+\def\xrdef #1#2{
+{\catcode`\'=\other\expandafter \gdef \csname X#1\endcsname {#2}}}
+
+\def\readauxfile{%
+\begingroup
+\catcode `\^^@=\other
+\catcode `\=\other
+\catcode `\=\other
+\catcode `\^^C=\other
+\catcode `\^^D=\other
+\catcode `\^^E=\other
+\catcode `\^^F=\other
+\catcode `\^^G=\other
+\catcode `\^^H=\other
+\catcode `\ =\other
+\catcode `\^^L=\other
+\catcode `\=\other
+\catcode `\=\other
+\catcode `\=\other
+\catcode `\=\other
+\catcode `\=\other
+\catcode `\=\other
+\catcode `\=\other
+\catcode `\=\other
+\catcode `\=\other
+\catcode `\=\other
+\catcode `\=\other
+\catcode `\=\other
+\catcode 26=\other
+\catcode `\^^[=\other
+\catcode `\^^\=\other
+\catcode `\^^]=\other
+\catcode `\^^^=\other
+\catcode `\^^_=\other
+\catcode `\@=\other
+\catcode `\^=\other
+\catcode `\~=\other
+\catcode `\[=\other
+\catcode `\]=\other
+\catcode`\"=\other
+\catcode`\_=\other
+\catcode`\|=\other
+\catcode`\<=\other
+\catcode`\>=\other
+\catcode `\$=\other
+\catcode `\#=\other
+\catcode `\&=\other
+% `\+ does not work, so use 43.
+\catcode 43=\other
+% Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters
+{%
+ \count 1=128
+ \def\loop{%
+ \catcode\count 1=\other
+ \advance\count 1 by 1
+ \ifnum \count 1<256 \loop \fi
+ }%
+}%
+% the aux file uses ' as the escape.
+% Turn off \ as an escape so we do not lose on
+% entries which were dumped with control sequences in their names.
+% For example, 'xrdef {$\leq $-fun}{page ...} made by @defun ^^
+% Reference to such entries still does not work the way one would wish,
+% but at least they do not bomb out when the aux file is read in.
+\catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2
+\catcode `\%=\other
+\catcode `\'=0
+\catcode`\^=7 % to make ^^e4 etc usable in xref tags
+\catcode `\\=\other
+\openin 1 \jobname.aux
+\ifeof 1 \else \closein 1 \input \jobname.aux \global\havexrefstrue
+\global\warnedobstrue
+\fi
+% Open the new aux file. Tex will close it automatically at exit.
+\openout \auxfile=\jobname.aux
+\endgroup}
+
+
+% Footnotes.
+
+\newcount \footnoteno
+
+% The trailing space in the following definition for supereject is
+% vital for proper filling; pages come out unaligned when you do a
+% pagealignmacro call if that space before the closing brace is
+% removed.
+\def\supereject{\par\penalty -20000\footnoteno =0 }
+
+% @footnotestyle is meaningful for info output only..
+\let\footnotestyle=\comment
+
+\let\ptexfootnote=\footnote
+
+{\catcode `\@=11
+%
+% Auto-number footnotes. Otherwise like plain.
+\gdef\footnote{%
+ \global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne
+ \edef\thisfootno{$^{\the\footnoteno}$}%
+ %
+ % In case the footnote comes at the end of a sentence, preserve the
+ % extra spacing after we do the footnote number.
+ \let\@sf\empty
+ \ifhmode\edef\@sf{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\/\fi
+ %
+ % Remove inadvertent blank space before typesetting the footnote number.
+ \unskip
+ \thisfootno\@sf
+ \footnotezzz
+}%
+
+% Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the
+% footnote text as a parameter. Our footnotes don't need to be so general.
+%
+\long\gdef\footnotezzz#1{\insert\footins{%
+ % We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the
+ % footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment.
+ % So reset some parameters.
+ \interlinepenalty\interfootnotelinepenalty
+ \splittopskip\ht\strutbox % top baseline for broken footnotes
+ \splitmaxdepth\dp\strutbox
+ \floatingpenalty\@MM
+ \leftskip\z@skip
+ \rightskip\z@skip
+ \spaceskip\z@skip
+ \xspaceskip\z@skip
+ \parindent\defaultparindent
+ %
+ % Hang the footnote text off the number.
+ \hang
+ \textindent{\thisfootno}%
+ %
+ % Don't crash into the line above the footnote text. Since this
+ % expands into a box, it must come within the paragraph, lest it
+ % provide a place where TeX can split the footnote.
+ \footstrut
+ #1\strut}%
+}
+
+}%end \catcode `\@=11
+
+% Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size
+% correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers
+% used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined.
+%
+\def\lineskipfactor{.08333}
+\def\strutheightpercent{.70833}
+\def\strutdepthpercent {.29167}
+%
+\def\setleading#1{%
+ \normalbaselineskip = #1\relax
+ \normallineskip = \lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip
+ \normalbaselines
+ \setbox\strutbox =\hbox{%
+ \vrule width0pt height\strutheightpercent\baselineskip
+ depth \strutdepthpercent \baselineskip
+ }%
+}
+
+% @| inserts a changebar to the left of the current line. It should
+% surround any changed text. This approach does *not* work if the
+% change spans more than two lines of output. To handle that, we would
+% have adopt a much more difficult approach (putting marks into the main
+% vertical list for the beginning and end of each change).
+%
+\def\|{%
+ % \vadjust can only be used in horizontal mode.
+ \leavevmode
+ %
+ % Append this vertical mode material after the current line in the output.
+ \vadjust{%
+ % We want to insert a rule with the height and depth of the current
+ % leading; that is exactly what \strutbox is supposed to record.
+ \vskip-\baselineskip
+ %
+ % \vadjust-items are inserted at the left edge of the type. So
+ % the \llap here moves out into the left-hand margin.
+ \llap{%
+ %
+ % For a thicker or thinner bar, change the `1pt'.
+ \vrule height\baselineskip width1pt
+ %
+ % This is the space between the bar and the text.
+ \hskip 12pt
+ }%
+ }%
+}
+
+% For a final copy, take out the rectangles
+% that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided
+% that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin).
+%
+\def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt}
+
+
+% End of control word definitions.
+
+\message{and turning on texinfo input format.}
+
+\def\openindices{%
+ \newindex{cp}%
+ \newcodeindex{fn}%
+ \newcodeindex{vr}%
+ \newcodeindex{tp}%
+ \newcodeindex{ky}%
+ \newcodeindex{pg}%
+}
+
+% Set some numeric style parameters, for 8.5 x 11 format.
+
+%\hsize = 6.5in
+\newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent = 15pt
+\parindent = \defaultparindent
+\parskip 18pt plus 1pt
+\setleading{15pt}
+\advance\topskip by 1.2cm
+
+% Prevent underfull vbox error messages.
+\vbadness=10000
+
+% Following George Bush, just get rid of widows and orphans.
+\widowpenalty=10000
+\clubpenalty=10000
+
+% Use TeX 3.0's \emergencystretch to help line breaking, but if we're
+% using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. We want the amount of
+% stretch added to depend on the line length, hence the dependence on
+% \hsize. This makes it come to about 9pt for the 8.5x11 format.
+%
+\ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined
+ % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway.
+ \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}%
+\else
+ \emergencystretch = \hsize
+ \divide\emergencystretch by 45
+\fi
+
+% Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.5 format (or else 7x9.25)
+\def\smallbook{
+
+% These values for secheadingskip and subsecheadingskip are
+% experiments. RJC 7 Aug 1992
+\global\secheadingskip = 17pt plus 6pt minus 3pt
+\global\subsecheadingskip = 14pt plus 6pt minus 3pt
+
+\global\lispnarrowing = 0.3in
+\setleading{12pt}
+\advance\topskip by -1cm
+\global\parskip 3pt plus 1pt
+\global\hsize = 5in
+\global\vsize=7.5in
+\global\tolerance=700
+\global\hfuzz=1pt
+\global\contentsrightmargin=0pt
+\global\deftypemargin=0pt
+\global\defbodyindent=.5cm
+
+\global\pagewidth=\hsize
+\global\pageheight=\vsize
+
+\global\let\smalllisp=\smalllispx
+\global\let\smallexample=\smalllispx
+\global\def\Esmallexample{\Esmalllisp}
+}
+
+% Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper.
+\def\afourpaper{
+\global\tolerance=700
+\global\hfuzz=1pt
+\setleading{12pt}
+\global\parskip 15pt plus 1pt
+
+\global\vsize= 53\baselineskip
+\advance\vsize by \topskip
+%\global\hsize= 5.85in % A4 wide 10pt
+\global\hsize= 6.5in
+\global\outerhsize=\hsize
+\global\advance\outerhsize by 0.5in
+\global\outervsize=\vsize
+\global\advance\outervsize by 0.6in
+
+\global\pagewidth=\hsize
+\global\pageheight=\vsize
+}
+
+% Allow control of the text dimensions. Parameters in order: textheight;
+% textwidth; \voffset; \hoffset (!); binding offset. All require a dimension;
+% header is additional; added length extends the bottom of the page.
+
+\def\changepagesizes#1#2#3#4#5{
+ \global\vsize= #1
+ \advance\vsize by \topskip
+ \global\voffset= #3
+ \global\hsize= #2
+ \global\outerhsize=\hsize
+ \global\advance\outerhsize by 0.5in
+ \global\outervsize=\vsize
+ \global\advance\outervsize by 0.6in
+ \global\pagewidth=\hsize
+ \global\pageheight=\vsize
+ \global\normaloffset= #4
+ \global\bindingoffset= #5}
+
+% This layout is compatible with Latex on A4 paper.
+
+\def\afourlatex{\changepagesizes{22cm}{15cm}{7mm}{4.6mm}{5mm}}
+
+% Use @afourwide to print on European A4 paper in wide format.
+\def\afourwide{\afourpaper
+\changepagesizes{9.5in}{6.5in}{\hoffset}{\normaloffset}{\bindingoffset}}
+
+% Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text.
+\catcode`\"=\other
+\catcode`\~=\other
+\catcode`\^=\other
+\catcode`\_=\other
+\catcode`\|=\other
+\catcode`\<=\other
+\catcode`\>=\other
+\catcode`\+=\other
+\def\normaldoublequote{"}
+\def\normaltilde{~}
+\def\normalcaret{^}
+\def\normalunderscore{_}
+\def\normalverticalbar{|}
+\def\normalless{<}
+\def\normalgreater{>}
+\def\normalplus{+}
+
+% This macro is used to make a character print one way in ttfont
+% where it can probably just be output, and another way in other fonts,
+% where something hairier probably needs to be done.
+%
+% #1 is what to print if we are indeed using \tt; #2 is what to print
+% otherwise. Since all the Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero
+% interword stretch (and shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all
+% typewriter fonts to have this, we can check that font parameter.
+%
+\def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\the\font=0pt #1\else #2\fi}
+
+% Turn off all special characters except @
+% (and those which the user can use as if they were ordinary).
+% Most of these we simply print from the \tt font, but for some, we can
+% use math or other variants that look better in normal text.
+
+\catcode`\"=\active
+\def\activedoublequote{{\tt \char '042}}
+\let"=\activedoublequote
+\catcode`\~=\active
+\def~{{\tt \char '176}}
+\chardef\hat=`\^
+\catcode`\^=\active
+\def\auxhat{\def^{'hat}}
+\def^{{\tt \hat}}
+
+\catcode`\_=\active
+\def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_}
+% Subroutine for the previous macro.
+\def\_{\lvvmode \kern.06em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}}
+
+% \lvvmode is equivalent in function to \leavevmode.
+% Using \leavevmode runs into trouble when written out to
+% an index file due to the expansion of \leavevmode into ``\unhbox
+% \voidb@x'' ---which looks to TeX like ``\unhbox \voidb\x'' due to our
+% magic tricks with @.
+\def\lvvmode{\vbox to 0pt{}}
+
+\catcode`\|=\active
+\def|{{\tt \char '174}}
+\chardef \less=`\<
+\catcode`\<=\active
+\def<{{\tt \less}}
+\chardef \gtr=`\>
+\catcode`\>=\active
+\def>{{\tt \gtr}}
+\catcode`\+=\active
+\def+{{\tt \char 43}}
+%\catcode 27=\active
+%\def^^[{$\diamondsuit$}
+
+% Set up an active definition for =, but don't enable it most of the time.
+{\catcode`\==\active
+\global\def={{\tt \char 61}}}
+
+\catcode`+=\active
+\catcode`\_=\active
+
+% If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file
+% name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line.
+% So turn them off again, and have \everyjob (or @setfilename) turn them on.
+% \otherifyactive is called near the end of this file.
+\def\otherifyactive{\catcode`+=\other \catcode`\_=\other}
+
+\catcode`\@=0
+
+% \rawbackslashxx output one backslash character in current font
+\global\chardef\rawbackslashxx=`\\
+%{\catcode`\\=\other
+%@gdef@rawbackslashxx{\}}
+
+% \rawbackslash redefines \ as input to do \rawbackslashxx.
+{\catcode`\\=\active
+@gdef@rawbackslash{@let\=@rawbackslashxx }}
+
+% \normalbackslash outputs one backslash in fixed width font.
+\def\normalbackslash{{\tt\rawbackslashxx}}
+
+% Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages.
+\escapechar=`\@
+
+% \catcode 17=0 % Define control-q
+\catcode`\\=\active
+
+% Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters
+% even after parsing them.
+@def@turnoffactive{@let"=@normaldoublequote
+@let\=@realbackslash
+@let~=@normaltilde
+@let^=@normalcaret
+@let_=@normalunderscore
+@let|=@normalverticalbar
+@let<=@normalless
+@let>=@normalgreater
+@let+=@normalplus}
+
+@def@normalturnoffactive{@let"=@normaldoublequote
+@let\=@normalbackslash
+@let~=@normaltilde
+@let^=@normalcaret
+@let_=@normalunderscore
+@let|=@normalverticalbar
+@let<=@normalless
+@let>=@normalgreater
+@let+=@normalplus}
+
+% Make _ and + \other characters, temporarily.
+% This is canceled by @fixbackslash.
+@otherifyactive
+
+% If a .fmt file is being used, we don't want the `\input texinfo' to show up.
+% That is what \eatinput is for; after that, the `\' should revert to printing
+% a backslash.
+%
+@gdef@eatinput input texinfo{@fixbackslash}
+@global@let\ = @eatinput
+
+% On the other hand, perhaps the file did not have a `\input texinfo'. Then
+% the first `\{ in the file would cause an error. This macro tries to fix
+% that, assuming it is called before the first `\' could plausibly occur.
+% Also back turn on active characters that might appear in the input
+% file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format.
+%
+@gdef@fixbackslash{@ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @normalbackslash @fi
+ @catcode`+=@active @catcode`@_=@active}
+
+%% These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special. The @rm below
+%% makes sure that the current font starts out as the newly loaded cmr10
+@catcode`@$=@other @catcode`@%=@other @catcode`@&=@other @catcode`@#=@other
+
+@textfonts
+@rm
+
+@c Local variables:
+@c page-delimiter: "^\\\\message"
+@c End:
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/ltcap.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/ltcap.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..507481f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/ltcap.h
@@ -0,0 +1,29 @@
+/* Local declarations for termcap library.
+ Copyright (C) 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#ifndef _LTCAP_H_
+#define _LTCAP_H_ 1
+
+#if !defined (__APPLE__)
+# define __private_extern__
+#endif
+
+#ifndef MAX_TGETENT_BUFSIZ
+# define MAX_TGETENT_BUFSIZ 2048
+#endif
+
+#endif /* _LTCAP_H_ */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/termcap.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/termcap.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..780b15c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/termcap.c
@@ -0,0 +1,800 @@
+/* Work-alike for termcap, plus extra features.
+ Copyright (C) 1985, 86, 93, 94, 95 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+any later version.
+
+This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+along with this program; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the
+Free Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+/* Emacs config.h may rename various library functions such as malloc. */
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+
+#include <config.h>
+
+/* Get the O_* definitions for open et al. */
+#if !defined (_MINIX) && defined (HAVE_SYS_FILE_H)
+# include <sys/file.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <fcntl.h>
+
+#ifdef HAVE_STDLIB_H
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+extern char *getenv ();
+extern char *malloc ();
+extern char *realloc ();
+#endif
+
+#else /* not HAVE_CONFIG_H */
+
+#ifdef STDC_HEADERS
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#else
+char *getenv ();
+char *malloc ();
+char *realloc ();
+#endif
+
+/* Do this after the include, in case string.h prototypes bcopy. */
+#if (defined(HAVE_STRING_H) || defined(STDC_HEADERS)) && !defined(bcopy)
+#define bcopy(s, d, n) memcpy ((d), (s), (n))
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
+#include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+#ifdef _POSIX_VERSION
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#endif
+
+#endif /* not HAVE_CONFIG_H */
+
+#ifndef NULL
+#define NULL (char *) 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef O_RDONLY
+#define O_RDONLY 0
+#endif
+
+/* BUFSIZE is the initial size allocated for the buffer
+ for reading the termcap file.
+ It is not a limit.
+ Make it large normally for speed.
+ Make it variable when debugging, so can exercise
+ increasing the space dynamically. */
+
+#ifndef BUFSIZE
+#ifdef DEBUG
+#define BUFSIZE bufsize
+
+int bufsize = 128;
+#else
+#define BUFSIZE 2048
+#endif
+#endif
+
+#include "ltcap.h"
+
+#ifndef TERMCAP_FILE
+#define TERMCAP_FILE "/etc/termcap"
+#endif
+
+#ifndef emacs
+static void
+memory_out ()
+{
+ write (2, "virtual memory exhausted\n", 25);
+ exit (1);
+}
+
+static char *
+xmalloc (size)
+ unsigned size;
+{
+ register char *tem = malloc (size);
+
+ if (!tem)
+ memory_out ();
+ return tem;
+}
+
+static char *
+xrealloc (ptr, size)
+ char *ptr;
+ unsigned size;
+{
+ register char *tem = realloc (ptr, size);
+
+ if (!tem)
+ memory_out ();
+ return tem;
+}
+#endif /* not emacs */
+
+/* Looking up capabilities in the entry already found. */
+
+/* The pointer to the data made by tgetent is left here
+ for tgetnum, tgetflag and tgetstr to find. */
+static char *term_entry;
+
+static char *tgetst1 ();
+
+/* Search entry BP for capability CAP.
+ Return a pointer to the capability (in BP) if found,
+ 0 if not found. */
+
+static char *
+find_capability (bp, cap)
+ register char *bp, *cap;
+{
+ for (; *bp; bp++)
+ if (bp[0] == ':'
+ && bp[1] == cap[0]
+ && bp[2] == cap[1])
+ return &bp[4];
+ return NULL;
+}
+
+__private_extern__
+int
+tgetnum (cap)
+ char *cap;
+{
+ register char *ptr = find_capability (term_entry, cap);
+ if (!ptr || ptr[-1] != '#')
+ return -1;
+ return atoi (ptr);
+}
+
+__private_extern__
+int
+tgetflag (cap)
+ char *cap;
+{
+ register char *ptr = find_capability (term_entry, cap);
+ return ptr && ptr[-1] == ':';
+}
+
+/* Look up a string-valued capability CAP.
+ If AREA is non-null, it points to a pointer to a block in which
+ to store the string. That pointer is advanced over the space used.
+ If AREA is null, space is allocated with `malloc'. */
+
+__private_extern__
+char *
+tgetstr (cap, area)
+ char *cap;
+ char **area;
+{
+ register char *ptr = find_capability (term_entry, cap);
+ if (!ptr || (ptr[-1] != '=' && ptr[-1] != '~'))
+ return NULL;
+ return tgetst1 (ptr, area);
+}
+
+/* Table, indexed by a character in range 0100 to 0140 with 0100 subtracted,
+ gives meaning of character following \, or a space if no special meaning.
+ Eight characters per line within the string. */
+
+static char esctab[]
+ = " \007\010 \033\014 \
+ \012 \
+ \015 \011 \013 \
+ ";
+
+/* PTR points to a string value inside a termcap entry.
+ Copy that value, processing \ and ^ abbreviations,
+ into the block that *AREA points to,
+ or to newly allocated storage if AREA is NULL.
+ Return the address to which we copied the value,
+ or NULL if PTR is NULL. */
+
+static char *
+tgetst1 (ptr, area)
+ char *ptr;
+ char **area;
+{
+ register char *p, *r;
+ register int c;
+ register int size;
+ char *ret;
+ register int c1;
+
+ if (!ptr)
+ return NULL;
+
+ /* `ret' gets address of where to store the string. */
+ if (!area)
+ {
+ /* Compute size of block needed (may overestimate). */
+ p = ptr;
+ while ((c = *p++) && c != ':' && c != '\n')
+ ;
+ ret = (char *) xmalloc (p - ptr + 1);
+ }
+ else
+ ret = *area;
+
+ /* Copy the string value, stopping at null or colon.
+ Also process ^ and \ abbreviations. */
+ p = ptr;
+ r = ret;
+ while ((c = *p++) && c != ':' && c != '\n')
+ {
+ if (c == '^')
+ {
+ c = *p++;
+ if (c == '?')
+ c = 0177;
+ else
+ c &= 037;
+ }
+ else if (c == '\\')
+ {
+ c = *p++;
+ if (c >= '0' && c <= '7')
+ {
+ c -= '0';
+ size = 0;
+
+ while (++size < 3 && (c1 = *p) >= '0' && c1 <= '7')
+ {
+ c *= 8;
+ c += c1 - '0';
+ p++;
+ }
+ }
+ else if (c >= 0100 && c < 0200)
+ {
+ c1 = esctab[(c & ~040) - 0100];
+ if (c1 != ' ')
+ c = c1;
+ }
+ }
+ *r++ = c;
+ }
+ *r = '\0';
+ /* Update *AREA. */
+ if (area)
+ *area = r + 1;
+ return ret;
+}
+
+/* Outputting a string with padding. */
+
+short ospeed;
+/* If OSPEED is 0, we use this as the actual baud rate. */
+int tputs_baud_rate;
+__private_extern__ char PC = '\0';
+
+/* Actual baud rate if positive;
+ - baud rate / 100 if negative. */
+
+static int speeds[] =
+ {
+#ifdef VMS
+ 0, 50, 75, 110, 134, 150, -3, -6, -12, -18,
+ -20, -24, -36, -48, -72, -96, -192
+#else /* not VMS */
+ 0, 50, 75, 110, 135, 150, -2, -3, -6, -12,
+ -18, -24, -48, -96, -192, -288, -384, -576, -1152
+#endif /* not VMS */
+ };
+
+__private_extern__
+void
+tputs (str, nlines, outfun)
+ register char *str;
+ int nlines;
+ register int (*outfun) ();
+{
+ register int padcount = 0;
+ register int speed;
+
+#ifdef emacs
+ extern baud_rate;
+ speed = baud_rate;
+ /* For quite high speeds, convert to the smaller
+ units to avoid overflow. */
+ if (speed > 10000)
+ speed = - speed / 100;
+#else
+ if (ospeed == 0)
+ speed = tputs_baud_rate;
+ else if (ospeed > 0 && ospeed < (sizeof speeds / sizeof speeds[0]))
+ speed = speeds[ospeed];
+ else
+ speed = 0;
+#endif
+
+ if (!str)
+ return;
+
+ while (*str >= '0' && *str <= '9')
+ {
+ padcount += *str++ - '0';
+ padcount *= 10;
+ }
+ if (*str == '.')
+ {
+ str++;
+ padcount += *str++ - '0';
+ }
+ if (*str == '*')
+ {
+ str++;
+ padcount *= nlines;
+ }
+ while (*str)
+ (*outfun) (*str++);
+
+ /* PADCOUNT is now in units of tenths of msec.
+ SPEED is measured in characters per 10 seconds
+ or in characters per .1 seconds (if negative).
+ We use the smaller units for larger speeds to avoid overflow. */
+ padcount *= speed;
+ padcount += 500;
+ padcount /= 1000;
+ if (speed < 0)
+ padcount = -padcount;
+ else
+ {
+ padcount += 50;
+ padcount /= 100;
+ }
+
+ while (padcount-- > 0)
+ (*outfun) (PC);
+}
+
+/* Finding the termcap entry in the termcap data base. */
+
+struct buffer
+ {
+ char *beg;
+ int size;
+ char *ptr;
+ int ateof;
+ int full;
+ };
+
+/* Forward declarations of static functions. */
+
+static int scan_file ();
+static char *gobble_line ();
+static int compare_contin ();
+static int name_match ();
+
+#ifdef VMS
+
+#include <rmsdef.h>
+#include <fab.h>
+#include <nam.h>
+
+static int
+valid_filename_p (fn)
+ char *fn;
+{
+ struct FAB fab = cc$rms_fab;
+ struct NAM nam = cc$rms_nam;
+ char esa[NAM$C_MAXRSS];
+
+ fab.fab$l_fna = fn;
+ fab.fab$b_fns = strlen(fn);
+ fab.fab$l_nam = &nam;
+ fab.fab$l_fop = FAB$M_NAM;
+
+ nam.nam$l_esa = esa;
+ nam.nam$b_ess = sizeof esa;
+
+ return SYS$PARSE(&fab, 0, 0) == RMS$_NORMAL;
+}
+
+#else /* !VMS */
+
+#ifdef MSDOS /* MW, May 1993 */
+static int
+valid_filename_p (fn)
+ char *fn;
+{
+ return *fn == '\\' || *fn == '/' ||
+ (*fn >= 'A' && *fn <= 'z' && fn[1] == ':');
+}
+#else
+#define valid_filename_p(fn) (*(fn) == '/')
+#endif
+
+#endif /* !VMS */
+
+/* Find the termcap entry data for terminal type NAME
+ and store it in the block that BP points to.
+ Record its address for future use.
+
+ If BP is null, space is dynamically allocated.
+
+ Return -1 if there is some difficulty accessing the data base
+ of terminal types,
+ 0 if the data base is accessible but the type NAME is not defined
+ in it, and some other value otherwise. */
+
+__private_extern__
+int
+tgetent (bp, name)
+ char *bp, *name;
+{
+ register char *termcap_name;
+ register int fd;
+ struct buffer buf;
+ register char *bp1;
+ char *bp2;
+ char *term;
+ int malloc_size = 0;
+ register int c;
+ char *tcenv; /* TERMCAP value, if it contains :tc=. */
+ char *indirect = NULL; /* Terminal type in :tc= in TERMCAP value. */
+ int filep;
+
+#ifdef INTERNAL_TERMINAL
+ /* For the internal terminal we don't want to read any termcap file,
+ so fake it. */
+ if (!strcmp (name, "internal"))
+ {
+ term = INTERNAL_TERMINAL;
+ if (!bp)
+ {
+ malloc_size = 1 + strlen (term);
+ bp = (char *) xmalloc (malloc_size);
+ }
+ strcpy (bp, term);
+ goto ret;
+ }
+#endif /* INTERNAL_TERMINAL */
+
+ /* For compatibility with programs like `less' that want to
+ put data in the termcap buffer themselves as a fallback. */
+ if (bp)
+ term_entry = bp;
+
+ termcap_name = getenv ("TERMCAP");
+ if (termcap_name && *termcap_name == '\0')
+ termcap_name = NULL;
+#if 0
+#if defined (MSDOS) && !defined (TEST)
+ if (termcap_name && (*termcap_name == '\\'
+ || *termcap_name == '/'
+ || termcap_name[1] == ':'))
+ dostounix_filename(termcap_name);
+#endif
+#endif
+
+ filep = termcap_name && valid_filename_p (termcap_name);
+
+ /* If termcap_name is non-null and starts with / (in the un*x case, that is),
+ it is a file name to use instead of /etc/termcap.
+ If it is non-null and does not start with /,
+ it is the entry itself, but only if
+ the name the caller requested matches the TERM variable. */
+
+ if (termcap_name && !filep && !strcmp (name, getenv ("TERM")))
+ {
+ indirect = tgetst1 (find_capability (termcap_name, "tc"), (char **) 0);
+ if (!indirect)
+ {
+ if (!bp)
+ bp = termcap_name;
+ else
+ strcpy (bp, termcap_name);
+ goto ret;
+ }
+ else
+ { /* It has tc=. Need to read /etc/termcap. */
+ tcenv = termcap_name;
+ termcap_name = NULL;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (!termcap_name || !filep)
+ termcap_name = TERMCAP_FILE;
+
+ /* Here we know we must search a file and termcap_name has its name. */
+
+#ifdef MSDOS
+ fd = open (termcap_name, O_RDONLY|O_TEXT, 0);
+#else
+ fd = open (termcap_name, O_RDONLY, 0);
+#endif
+ if (fd < 0)
+ return -1;
+
+ buf.size = BUFSIZE;
+ /* Add 1 to size to ensure room for terminating null. */
+ buf.beg = (char *) xmalloc (buf.size + 1);
+ term = indirect ? indirect : name;
+
+ if (!bp)
+ {
+ malloc_size = indirect ? strlen (tcenv) + 1 : buf.size;
+ bp = (char *) xmalloc (malloc_size);
+ }
+ bp1 = bp;
+
+ if (indirect)
+ /* Copy the data from the environment variable. */
+ {
+ strcpy (bp, tcenv);
+ bp1 += strlen (tcenv);
+ }
+
+ while (term)
+ {
+ /* Scan the file, reading it via buf, till find start of main entry. */
+ if (scan_file (term, fd, &buf) == 0)
+ {
+ close (fd);
+ free (buf.beg);
+ if (malloc_size)
+ free (bp);
+ return 0;
+ }
+
+ /* Free old `term' if appropriate. */
+ if (term != name)
+ free (term);
+
+ /* If BP is malloc'd by us, make sure it is big enough. */
+ if (malloc_size)
+ {
+ malloc_size = bp1 - bp + buf.size;
+ termcap_name = (char *) xrealloc (bp, malloc_size);
+ bp1 += termcap_name - bp;
+ bp = termcap_name;
+ }
+
+ bp2 = bp1;
+
+ /* Copy the line of the entry from buf into bp. */
+ termcap_name = buf.ptr;
+ while ((*bp1++ = c = *termcap_name++) && c != '\n')
+ /* Drop out any \ newline sequence. */
+ if (c == '\\' && *termcap_name == '\n')
+ {
+ bp1--;
+ termcap_name++;
+ }
+ *bp1 = '\0';
+
+ /* Does this entry refer to another terminal type's entry?
+ If something is found, copy it into heap and null-terminate it. */
+ term = tgetst1 (find_capability (bp2, "tc"), (char **) 0);
+ }
+
+ close (fd);
+ free (buf.beg);
+
+ if (malloc_size)
+ bp = (char *) xrealloc (bp, bp1 - bp + 1);
+
+ ret:
+ term_entry = bp;
+ return 1;
+}
+
+/* Given file open on FD and buffer BUFP,
+ scan the file from the beginning until a line is found
+ that starts the entry for terminal type STR.
+ Return 1 if successful, with that line in BUFP,
+ or 0 if no entry is found in the file. */
+
+static int
+scan_file (str, fd, bufp)
+ char *str;
+ int fd;
+ register struct buffer *bufp;
+{
+ register char *end;
+
+ bufp->ptr = bufp->beg;
+ bufp->full = 0;
+ bufp->ateof = 0;
+ *bufp->ptr = '\0';
+
+ lseek (fd, 0L, 0);
+
+ while (!bufp->ateof)
+ {
+ /* Read a line into the buffer. */
+ end = NULL;
+ do
+ {
+ /* if it is continued, append another line to it,
+ until a non-continued line ends. */
+ end = gobble_line (fd, bufp, end);
+ }
+ while (!bufp->ateof && end[-2] == '\\');
+
+ if (*bufp->ptr != '#'
+ && name_match (bufp->ptr, str))
+ return 1;
+
+ /* Discard the line just processed. */
+ bufp->ptr = end;
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Return nonzero if NAME is one of the names specified
+ by termcap entry LINE. */
+
+static int
+name_match (line, name)
+ char *line, *name;
+{
+ register char *tem;
+
+ if (!compare_contin (line, name))
+ return 1;
+ /* This line starts an entry. Is it the right one? */
+ for (tem = line; *tem && *tem != '\n' && *tem != ':'; tem++)
+ if (*tem == '|' && !compare_contin (tem + 1, name))
+ return 1;
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+static int
+compare_contin (str1, str2)
+ register char *str1, *str2;
+{
+ register int c1, c2;
+ while (1)
+ {
+ c1 = *str1++;
+ c2 = *str2++;
+ while (c1 == '\\' && *str1 == '\n')
+ {
+ str1++;
+ while ((c1 = *str1++) == ' ' || c1 == '\t');
+ }
+ if (c2 == '\0')
+ {
+ /* End of type being looked up. */
+ if (c1 == '|' || c1 == ':')
+ /* If end of name in data base, we win. */
+ return 0;
+ else
+ return 1;
+ }
+ else if (c1 != c2)
+ return 1;
+ }
+}
+
+/* Make sure that the buffer <- BUFP contains a full line
+ of the file open on FD, starting at the place BUFP->ptr
+ points to. Can read more of the file, discard stuff before
+ BUFP->ptr, or make the buffer bigger.
+
+ Return the pointer to after the newline ending the line,
+ or to the end of the file, if there is no newline to end it.
+
+ Can also merge on continuation lines. If APPEND_END is
+ non-null, it points past the newline of a line that is
+ continued; we add another line onto it and regard the whole
+ thing as one line. The caller decides when a line is continued. */
+
+static char *
+gobble_line (fd, bufp, append_end)
+ int fd;
+ register struct buffer *bufp;
+ char *append_end;
+{
+ register char *end;
+ register int nread;
+ register char *buf = bufp->beg;
+ register char *tem;
+
+ if (!append_end)
+ append_end = bufp->ptr;
+
+ while (1)
+ {
+ end = append_end;
+ while (*end && *end != '\n') end++;
+ if (*end)
+ break;
+ if (bufp->ateof)
+ return buf + bufp->full;
+ if (bufp->ptr == buf)
+ {
+ if (bufp->full == bufp->size)
+ {
+ bufp->size *= 2;
+ /* Add 1 to size to ensure room for terminating null. */
+ tem = (char *) xrealloc (buf, bufp->size + 1);
+ bufp->ptr = (bufp->ptr - buf) + tem;
+ append_end = (append_end - buf) + tem;
+ bufp->beg = buf = tem;
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ append_end -= bufp->ptr - buf;
+ bcopy (bufp->ptr, buf, bufp->full -= bufp->ptr - buf);
+ bufp->ptr = buf;
+ }
+ if (!(nread = read (fd, buf + bufp->full, bufp->size - bufp->full)))
+ bufp->ateof = 1;
+ bufp->full += nread;
+ buf[bufp->full] = '\0';
+ }
+ return end + 1;
+}
+
+#ifdef TEST
+
+#ifdef NULL
+#undef NULL
+#endif
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+main (argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char **argv;
+{
+ char *term;
+ char *buf;
+
+ term = argv[1];
+ printf ("TERM: %s\n", term);
+
+ buf = (char *) tgetent (0, term);
+ if ((int) buf <= 0)
+ {
+ printf ("No entry.\n");
+ return 0;
+ }
+
+ printf ("Entry: %s\n", buf);
+
+ tprint ("cm");
+ tprint ("AL");
+
+ printf ("co: %d\n", tgetnum ("co"));
+ printf ("am: %d\n", tgetflag ("am"));
+}
+
+tprint (cap)
+ char *cap;
+{
+ char *x = tgetstr (cap, 0);
+ register char *y;
+
+ printf ("%s: ", cap);
+ if (x)
+ {
+ for (y = x; *y; y++)
+ if (*y <= ' ' || *y == 0177)
+ printf ("\\%0o", *y);
+ else
+ putchar (*y);
+ free (x);
+ }
+ else
+ printf ("none");
+ putchar ('\n');
+}
+
+#endif /* TEST */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/termcap.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/termcap.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..40c2e29
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/termcap.h
@@ -0,0 +1,62 @@
+/* Declarations for termcap library.
+ Copyright (C) 1991, 1992, 1995 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+ Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#ifndef _TERMCAP_H
+#define _TERMCAP_H 1
+
+#if __STDC__
+
+extern int tgetent (char *buffer, const char *termtype);
+
+extern int tgetnum (const char *name);
+extern int tgetflag (const char *name);
+extern char *tgetstr (const char *name, char **area);
+
+extern char PC;
+extern short ospeed;
+extern void tputs (const char *string, int nlines, int (*outfun) (int));
+
+extern char *tparam (const char *ctlstring, char *buffer, int size, ...);
+
+extern char *UP;
+extern char *BC;
+
+extern char *tgoto (const char *cstring, int hpos, int vpos);
+
+#else /* not __STDC__ */
+
+extern int tgetent ();
+
+extern int tgetnum ();
+extern int tgetflag ();
+extern char *tgetstr ();
+
+extern char PC;
+extern short ospeed;
+
+extern void tputs ();
+
+extern char *tparam ();
+
+extern char *UP;
+extern char *BC;
+
+extern char *tgoto ();
+
+#endif /* not __STDC__ */
+
+#endif /* not _TERMCAP_H */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/tparam.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/tparam.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1c83f04
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/tparam.c
@@ -0,0 +1,334 @@
+/* Merge parameters into a termcap entry string.
+ Copyright (C) 1985, 87, 93, 95 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+any later version.
+
+This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+along with this program; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the
+Free Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+/* Emacs config.h may rename various library functions such as malloc. */
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+#include <config.h>
+
+#ifdef HAVE_STDLIB_H
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+extern char *getenv ();
+extern char *malloc ();
+extern char *realloc ();
+#endif
+
+#else /* not HAVE_CONFIG_H */
+
+#if defined(HAVE_STRING_H) || defined(STDC_HEADERS)
+#define bcopy(s, d, n) memcpy ((d), (s), (n))
+#endif
+
+#ifdef STDC_HEADERS
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#else
+char *malloc ();
+char *realloc ();
+#endif
+
+#endif /* not HAVE_CONFIG_H */
+
+#include "ltcap.h"
+
+#ifndef NULL
+#define NULL (char *) 0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef emacs
+static void
+memory_out ()
+{
+ write (2, "virtual memory exhausted\n", 25);
+ exit (1);
+}
+
+static char *
+xmalloc (size)
+ unsigned size;
+{
+ register char *tem = malloc (size);
+
+ if (!tem)
+ memory_out ();
+ return tem;
+}
+
+static char *
+xrealloc (ptr, size)
+ char *ptr;
+ unsigned size;
+{
+ register char *tem = realloc (ptr, size);
+
+ if (!tem)
+ memory_out ();
+ return tem;
+}
+#endif /* not emacs */
+
+/* Assuming STRING is the value of a termcap string entry
+ containing `%' constructs to expand parameters,
+ merge in parameter values and store result in block OUTSTRING points to.
+ LEN is the length of OUTSTRING. If more space is needed,
+ a block is allocated with `malloc'.
+
+ The value returned is the address of the resulting string.
+ This may be OUTSTRING or may be the address of a block got with `malloc'.
+ In the latter case, the caller must free the block.
+
+ The fourth and following args to tparam serve as the parameter values. */
+
+static char *tparam1 ();
+
+/* VARARGS 2 */
+char *
+tparam (string, outstring, len, arg0, arg1, arg2, arg3)
+ char *string;
+ char *outstring;
+ int len;
+ int arg0, arg1, arg2, arg3;
+{
+ int arg[4];
+
+ arg[0] = arg0;
+ arg[1] = arg1;
+ arg[2] = arg2;
+ arg[3] = arg3;
+ return tparam1 (string, outstring, len, NULL, NULL, arg);
+}
+
+__private_extern__ char *BC;
+__private_extern__ char *UP;
+
+static char tgoto_buf[50];
+
+__private_extern__
+char *
+tgoto (cm, hpos, vpos)
+ char *cm;
+ int hpos, vpos;
+{
+ int args[2];
+ if (!cm)
+ return NULL;
+ args[0] = vpos;
+ args[1] = hpos;
+ return tparam1 (cm, tgoto_buf, 50, UP, BC, args);
+}
+
+static char *
+tparam1 (string, outstring, len, up, left, argp)
+ char *string;
+ char *outstring;
+ int len;
+ char *up, *left;
+ register int *argp;
+{
+ register int c;
+ register char *p = string;
+ register char *op = outstring;
+ char *outend;
+ int outlen = 0;
+
+ register int tem;
+ int *old_argp = argp;
+ int doleft = 0;
+ int doup = 0;
+
+ outend = outstring + len;
+
+ while (1)
+ {
+ /* If the buffer might be too short, make it bigger. */
+ if (op + 5 >= outend)
+ {
+ register char *new;
+ if (outlen == 0)
+ {
+ outlen = len + 40;
+ new = (char *) xmalloc (outlen);
+ outend += 40;
+ bcopy (outstring, new, op - outstring);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ outend += outlen;
+ outlen *= 2;
+ new = (char *) xrealloc (outstring, outlen);
+ }
+ op += new - outstring;
+ outend += new - outstring;
+ outstring = new;
+ }
+ c = *p++;
+ if (!c)
+ break;
+ if (c == '%')
+ {
+ c = *p++;
+ tem = *argp;
+ switch (c)
+ {
+ case 'd': /* %d means output in decimal. */
+ if (tem < 10)
+ goto onedigit;
+ if (tem < 100)
+ goto twodigit;
+ case '3': /* %3 means output in decimal, 3 digits. */
+ if (tem > 999)
+ {
+ *op++ = tem / 1000 + '0';
+ tem %= 1000;
+ }
+ *op++ = tem / 100 + '0';
+ case '2': /* %2 means output in decimal, 2 digits. */
+ twodigit:
+ tem %= 100;
+ *op++ = tem / 10 + '0';
+ onedigit:
+ *op++ = tem % 10 + '0';
+ argp++;
+ break;
+
+ case 'C':
+ /* For c-100: print quotient of value by 96, if nonzero,
+ then do like %+. */
+ if (tem >= 96)
+ {
+ *op++ = tem / 96;
+ tem %= 96;
+ }
+ case '+': /* %+x means add character code of char x. */
+ tem += *p++;
+ case '.': /* %. means output as character. */
+ if (left)
+ {
+ /* If want to forbid output of 0 and \n and \t,
+ and this is one of them, increment it. */
+ while (tem == 0 || tem == '\n' || tem == '\t')
+ {
+ tem++;
+ if (argp == old_argp)
+ doup++, outend -= strlen (up);
+ else
+ doleft++, outend -= strlen (left);
+ }
+ }
+ *op++ = tem ? tem : 0200;
+ case 'f': /* %f means discard next arg. */
+ argp++;
+ break;
+
+ case 'b': /* %b means back up one arg (and re-use it). */
+ argp--;
+ break;
+
+ case 'r': /* %r means interchange following two args. */
+ argp[0] = argp[1];
+ argp[1] = tem;
+ old_argp++;
+ break;
+
+ case '>': /* %>xy means if arg is > char code of x, */
+ if (argp[0] > *p++) /* then add char code of y to the arg, */
+ argp[0] += *p; /* and in any case don't output. */
+ p++; /* Leave the arg to be output later. */
+ break;
+
+ case 'a': /* %a means arithmetic. */
+ /* Next character says what operation.
+ Add or subtract either a constant or some other arg. */
+ /* First following character is + to add or - to subtract
+ or = to assign. */
+ /* Next following char is 'p' and an arg spec
+ (0100 plus position of that arg relative to this one)
+ or 'c' and a constant stored in a character. */
+ tem = p[2] & 0177;
+ if (p[1] == 'p')
+ tem = argp[tem - 0100];
+ if (p[0] == '-')
+ argp[0] -= tem;
+ else if (p[0] == '+')
+ argp[0] += tem;
+ else if (p[0] == '*')
+ argp[0] *= tem;
+ else if (p[0] == '/')
+ argp[0] /= tem;
+ else
+ argp[0] = tem;
+
+ p += 3;
+ break;
+
+ case 'i': /* %i means add one to arg, */
+ argp[0] ++; /* and leave it to be output later. */
+ argp[1] ++; /* Increment the following arg, too! */
+ break;
+
+ case '%': /* %% means output %; no arg. */
+ goto ordinary;
+
+ case 'n': /* %n means xor each of next two args with 140. */
+ argp[0] ^= 0140;
+ argp[1] ^= 0140;
+ break;
+
+ case 'm': /* %m means xor each of next two args with 177. */
+ argp[0] ^= 0177;
+ argp[1] ^= 0177;
+ break;
+
+ case 'B': /* %B means express arg as BCD char code. */
+ argp[0] += 6 * (tem / 10);
+ break;
+
+ case 'D': /* %D means weird Delta Data transformation. */
+ argp[0] -= 2 * (tem % 16);
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ /* Ordinary character in the argument string. */
+ ordinary:
+ *op++ = c;
+ }
+ *op = 0;
+ while (doup-- > 0)
+ strcat (op, up);
+ while (doleft-- > 0)
+ strcat (op, left);
+ return outstring;
+}
+
+#ifdef DEBUG
+
+main (argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char **argv;
+{
+ char buf[50];
+ int args[3];
+ args[0] = atoi (argv[2]);
+ args[1] = atoi (argv[3]);
+ args[2] = atoi (argv[4]);
+ tparam1 (argv[1], buf, "LEFT", "UP", args);
+ printf ("%s\n", buf);
+ return 0;
+}
+
+#endif /* DEBUG */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/version.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/version.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ad2ab91
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/termcap/version.c
@@ -0,0 +1,18 @@
+/* Copyright (C) 1985-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
+ WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General
+ Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+ with this program; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
+ Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+/* Make the library identifiable with the RCS ident command. */
+static char *termcap_version_string = "\n$Version: GNU termcap 1.3 $\n";
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/tilde/Makefile.in b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/tilde/Makefile.in
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..a9d3741
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/tilde/Makefile.in
@@ -0,0 +1,127 @@
+## -*- text -*- ####################################################
+# #
+# Makefile for the GNU Tilde Library. #
+# #
+####################################################################
+
+# Copyright (C) 1996-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+# any later version.
+
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+# GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA.
+
+srcdir = @srcdir@
+VPATH = .:@srcdir@
+topdir = @top_srcdir@
+BUILD_DIR = @BUILD_DIR@
+
+INSTALL = @INSTALL@
+INSTALL_PROGRAM = @INSTALL_PROGRAM@
+INSTALL_DATA = @INSTALL_DATA@
+
+CC = @CC@
+RANLIB = @RANLIB@
+AR = @AR@
+ARFLAGS = @ARFLAGS@
+RM = rm
+CP = cp
+MV = mv
+
+SHELL = @MAKE_SHELL@
+
+PROFILE_FLAGS = @PROFILE_FLAGS@
+
+CFLAGS = @CFLAGS@
+LOCAL_CFLAGS = @LOCAL_CFLAGS@
+CPPFLAGS = @CPPFLAGS@
+LDFLAGS = @LDFLAGS@ @LOCAL_LDFLAGS@
+
+DEFS = @DEFS@
+LOCAL_DEFS = @LOCAL_DEFS@
+
+BASHINCDIR = ${topdir}/include
+
+INCLUDES = -I. -I../.. -I$(topdir) -I${BASHINCDIR} -I$(topdir)/lib
+
+CCFLAGS = $(PROFILE_FLAGS) $(DEFS) $(LOCAL_DEFS) $(CPPFLAGS) \
+ ${INCLUDES} $(LOCAL_CFLAGS) $(CFLAGS)
+
+.c.o:
+ $(CC) -c $(CCFLAGS) $<
+
+# The name of the library target.
+LIBRARY_NAME = libtilde.a
+
+# The C code source files for this library.
+CSOURCES = $(srcdir)/tilde.c
+
+# The header files for this library.
+HSOURCES = $(srcdir)/tilde.h
+
+OBJECTS = tilde.o
+
+# The texinfo files which document this library.
+DOCSOURCE = doc/tilde.texi
+DOCOBJECT = doc/tilde.dvi
+DOCSUPPORT = doc/Makefile
+DOCUMENTATION = $(DOCSOURCE) $(DOCOBJECT) $(DOCSUPPORT)
+
+SUPPORT = Makefile ChangeLog $(DOCSUPPORT)
+
+SOURCES = $(CSOURCES) $(HSOURCES) $(DOCSOURCE)
+
+THINGS_TO_TAR = $(SOURCES) $(SUPPORT)
+
+######################################################################
+
+all: $(LIBRARY_NAME)
+
+$(LIBRARY_NAME): $(OBJECTS)
+ $(RM) -f $@
+ $(AR) $(ARFLAGS) $@ $(OBJECTS)
+ -test -n "$(RANLIB)" && $(RANLIB) $@
+
+documentation: force
+ -(cd doc; $(MAKE) $(MFLAGS))
+
+force:
+
+# The rule for 'includes' is written funny so that the if statement
+# always returns TRUE unless there really was an error installing the
+# include files.
+install:
+ $(INSTALL_DATA) -c -m 644 $(LIBRARY_NAME) $(libdir)/$(LIBRARY_NAME)
+ -test -n "$(RANLIB)" && $(RANLIB) -t $(libdir)/$(LIBRARY_NAME)
+
+clean:
+ $(RM) -f $(OBJECTS) $(LIBRARY_NAME)
+ -( cd doc && $(MAKE) $(MFLAGS) $@ )
+
+realclean distclean maintainer-clean: clean
+ -( cd doc && $(MAKE) $(MFLAGS) $@ )
+ $(RM) -f Makefile
+
+mostlyclean: clean
+ -( cd doc && $(MAKE) $(MFLAGS) $@ )
+
+######################################################################
+# #
+# Dependencies for the object files which make up this library. #
+# #
+######################################################################
+
+tilde.o: tilde.h $(BASHINCDIR)/ansi_stdlib.h
+tilde.o: $(BUILD_DIR)/config.h
+
+# Rules for deficient makes, like SunOS and Solaris
+tilde.o: tilde.c
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/tilde/README b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/tilde/README
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..a8772f3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/tilde/README
@@ -0,0 +1,5 @@
+If you're building this separately from bash or the readline library, add
+$(srcdir)/shell.c to the CSOURCES variable and shell.o to the OBJECTS
+variable in Makefile.in. (Not that this is very useful without readline
+or bash.)
+
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/tilde/shell.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/tilde/shell.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..a45af2d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/tilde/shell.c
@@ -0,0 +1,70 @@
+/* shell.c -- tilde utility functions that are normally provided by
+ bash when readline is linked as part of the shell. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1998 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of the GNU Tilde Library.
+
+ The GNU Tilde Library is free software; you can redistribute it
+ and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
+ as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ The GNU Tilde Library is distributed in the hope that it will be
+ useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+ of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# ifdef _MINIX
+# include <sys/types.h>
+# endif
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif /* HAVE_UNISTD_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STDLIB_H)
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif /* HAVE_STDLIB_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STRING_H)
+# include <string.h>
+#else
+# include <strings.h>
+#endif /* !HAVE_STRING_H */
+
+#include <pwd.h>
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_GETPW_DECLS)
+extern struct passwd *getpwuid ();
+#endif /* !HAVE_GETPW_DECLS */
+
+char *
+get_env_value (varname)
+ char *varname;
+{
+ return ((char *)getenv (varname));
+}
+
+char *
+get_home_dir ()
+{
+ char *home_dir;
+ struct passwd *entry;
+
+ home_dir = (char *)NULL;
+ entry = getpwuid (getuid ());
+ if (entry)
+ home_dir = entry->pw_dir;
+ return (home_dir);
+}
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/tilde/tilde.c b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/tilde/tilde.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d757f7a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/tilde/tilde.c
@@ -0,0 +1,502 @@
+/* tilde.c -- Tilde expansion code (~/foo := $HOME/foo). */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1988,1989 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file is part of GNU Readline, a library for reading lines
+ of text with interactive input and history editing.
+
+ Readline is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
+ under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the
+ Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any
+ later version.
+
+ Readline is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
+ WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+ along with Readline; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
+ Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_CONFIG_H)
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_UNISTD_H)
+# ifdef _MINIX
+# include <sys/types.h>
+# endif
+# include <unistd.h>
+#endif
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STRING_H)
+# include <string.h>
+#else /* !HAVE_STRING_H */
+# include <strings.h>
+#endif /* !HAVE_STRING_H */
+
+#if defined (HAVE_STDLIB_H)
+# include <stdlib.h>
+#else
+# include "ansi_stdlib.h"
+#endif /* HAVE_STDLIB_H */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#if defined (HAVE_PWD_H)
+#include <pwd.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "tilde.h"
+
+#if defined (TEST) || defined (STATIC_MALLOC)
+static void *xmalloc (), *xrealloc ();
+#else
+# include "xmalloc.h"
+#endif /* TEST || STATIC_MALLOC */
+
+#if !defined (HAVE_GETPW_DECLS)
+# if defined (HAVE_GETPWUID)
+extern struct passwd *getpwuid PARAMS((uid_t));
+# endif
+# if defined (HAVE_GETPWNAM)
+extern struct passwd *getpwnam PARAMS((const char *));
+# endif
+#endif /* !HAVE_GETPW_DECLS */
+
+#if !defined (savestring)
+#define savestring(x) strcpy ((char *)xmalloc (1 + strlen (x)), (x))
+#endif /* !savestring */
+
+#if !defined (NULL)
+# if defined (__STDC__)
+# define NULL ((void *) 0)
+# else
+# define NULL 0x0
+# endif /* !__STDC__ */
+#endif /* !NULL */
+
+/* If being compiled as part of bash, these will be satisfied from
+ variables.o. If being compiled as part of readline, they will
+ be satisfied from shell.o. */
+extern char *sh_get_home_dir PARAMS((void));
+extern char *sh_get_env_value PARAMS((const char *));
+
+/* The default value of tilde_additional_prefixes. This is set to
+ whitespace preceding a tilde so that simple programs which do not
+ perform any word separation get desired behaviour. */
+static const char *default_prefixes[] =
+ { " ~", "\t~", (const char *)NULL };
+
+/* The default value of tilde_additional_suffixes. This is set to
+ whitespace or newline so that simple programs which do not
+ perform any word separation get desired behaviour. */
+static const char *default_suffixes[] =
+ { " ", "\n", (const char *)NULL };
+
+/* If non-null, this contains the address of a function that the application
+ wants called before trying the standard tilde expansions. The function
+ is called with the text sans tilde, and returns a malloc()'ed string
+ which is the expansion, or a NULL pointer if the expansion fails. */
+tilde_hook_func_t *tilde_expansion_preexpansion_hook = (tilde_hook_func_t *)NULL;
+
+/* If non-null, this contains the address of a function to call if the
+ standard meaning for expanding a tilde fails. The function is called
+ with the text (sans tilde, as in "foo"), and returns a malloc()'ed string
+ which is the expansion, or a NULL pointer if there is no expansion. */
+tilde_hook_func_t *tilde_expansion_failure_hook = (tilde_hook_func_t *)NULL;
+
+/* When non-null, this is a NULL terminated array of strings which
+ are duplicates for a tilde prefix. Bash uses this to expand
+ `=~' and `:~'. */
+char **tilde_additional_prefixes = (char **)default_prefixes;
+
+/* When non-null, this is a NULL terminated array of strings which match
+ the end of a username, instead of just "/". Bash sets this to
+ `:' and `=~'. */
+char **tilde_additional_suffixes = (char **)default_suffixes;
+
+static int tilde_find_prefix PARAMS((const char *, int *));
+static int tilde_find_suffix PARAMS((const char *));
+static char *isolate_tilde_prefix PARAMS((const char *, int *));
+static char *glue_prefix_and_suffix PARAMS((char *, const char *, int));
+
+/* Find the start of a tilde expansion in STRING, and return the index of
+ the tilde which starts the expansion. Place the length of the text
+ which identified this tilde starter in LEN, excluding the tilde itself. */
+static int
+tilde_find_prefix (string, len)
+ const char *string;
+ int *len;
+{
+ register int i, j, string_len;
+ register char **prefixes;
+
+ prefixes = tilde_additional_prefixes;
+
+ string_len = strlen (string);
+ *len = 0;
+
+ if (*string == '\0' || *string == '~')
+ return (0);
+
+ if (prefixes)
+ {
+ for (i = 0; i < string_len; i++)
+ {
+ for (j = 0; prefixes[j]; j++)
+ {
+ if (strncmp (string + i, prefixes[j], strlen (prefixes[j])) == 0)
+ {
+ *len = strlen (prefixes[j]) - 1;
+ return (i + *len);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ return (string_len);
+}
+
+/* Find the end of a tilde expansion in STRING, and return the index of
+ the character which ends the tilde definition. */
+static int
+tilde_find_suffix (string)
+ const char *string;
+{
+ register int i, j, string_len;
+ register char **suffixes;
+
+ suffixes = tilde_additional_suffixes;
+ string_len = strlen (string);
+
+ for (i = 0; i < string_len; i++)
+ {
+#if defined (__MSDOS__)
+ if (string[i] == '/' || string[i] == '\\' /* || !string[i] */)
+#else
+ if (string[i] == '/' /* || !string[i] */)
+#endif
+ break;
+
+ for (j = 0; suffixes && suffixes[j]; j++)
+ {
+ if (strncmp (string + i, suffixes[j], strlen (suffixes[j])) == 0)
+ return (i);
+ }
+ }
+ return (i);
+}
+
+/* Return a new string which is the result of tilde expanding STRING. */
+char *
+tilde_expand (string)
+ const char *string;
+{
+ char *result;
+ int result_size, result_index;
+
+ result_index = result_size = 0;
+ if (result = strchr (string, '~'))
+ result = (char *)xmalloc (result_size = (strlen (string) + 16));
+ else
+ result = (char *)xmalloc (result_size = (strlen (string) + 1));
+
+ /* Scan through STRING expanding tildes as we come to them. */
+ while (1)
+ {
+ register int start, end;
+ char *tilde_word, *expansion;
+ int len;
+
+ /* Make START point to the tilde which starts the expansion. */
+ start = tilde_find_prefix (string, &len);
+
+ /* Copy the skipped text into the result. */
+ if ((result_index + start + 1) > result_size)
+ result = (char *)xrealloc (result, 1 + (result_size += (start + 20)));
+
+ strncpy (result + result_index, string, start);
+ result_index += start;
+
+ /* Advance STRING to the starting tilde. */
+ string += start;
+
+ /* Make END be the index of one after the last character of the
+ username. */
+ end = tilde_find_suffix (string);
+
+ /* If both START and END are zero, we are all done. */
+ if (!start && !end)
+ break;
+
+ /* Expand the entire tilde word, and copy it into RESULT. */
+ tilde_word = (char *)xmalloc (1 + end);
+ strncpy (tilde_word, string, end);
+ tilde_word[end] = '\0';
+ string += end;
+
+ expansion = tilde_expand_word (tilde_word);
+ free (tilde_word);
+
+ len = strlen (expansion);
+#ifdef __CYGWIN__
+ /* Fix for Cygwin to prevent ~user/xxx from expanding to //xxx when
+ $HOME for `user' is /. On cygwin, // denotes a network drive. */
+ if (len > 1 || *expansion != '/' || *string != '/')
+#endif
+ {
+ if ((result_index + len + 1) > result_size)
+ result = (char *)xrealloc (result, 1 + (result_size += (len + 20)));
+
+ strcpy (result + result_index, expansion);
+ result_index += len;
+ }
+ free (expansion);
+ }
+
+ result[result_index] = '\0';
+
+ return (result);
+}
+
+/* Take FNAME and return the tilde prefix we want expanded. If LENP is
+ non-null, the index of the end of the prefix into FNAME is returned in
+ the location it points to. */
+static char *
+isolate_tilde_prefix (fname, lenp)
+ const char *fname;
+ int *lenp;
+{
+ char *ret;
+ int i;
+
+ ret = (char *)xmalloc (strlen (fname));
+#if defined (__MSDOS__)
+ for (i = 1; fname[i] && fname[i] != '/' && fname[i] != '\\'; i++)
+#else
+ for (i = 1; fname[i] && fname[i] != '/'; i++)
+#endif
+ ret[i - 1] = fname[i];
+ ret[i - 1] = '\0';
+ if (lenp)
+ *lenp = i;
+ return ret;
+}
+
+#if 0
+/* Public function to scan a string (FNAME) beginning with a tilde and find
+ the portion of the string that should be passed to the tilde expansion
+ function. Right now, it just calls tilde_find_suffix and allocates new
+ memory, but it can be expanded to do different things later. */
+char *
+tilde_find_word (fname, flags, lenp)
+ const char *fname;
+ int flags, *lenp;
+{
+ int x;
+ char *r;
+
+ x = tilde_find_suffix (fname);
+ if (x == 0)
+ {
+ r = savestring (fname);
+ if (lenp)
+ *lenp = 0;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ r = (char *)xmalloc (1 + x);
+ strncpy (r, fname, x);
+ r[x] = '\0';
+ if (lenp)
+ *lenp = x;
+ }
+
+ return r;
+}
+#endif
+
+/* Return a string that is PREFIX concatenated with SUFFIX starting at
+ SUFFIND. */
+static char *
+glue_prefix_and_suffix (prefix, suffix, suffind)
+ char *prefix;
+ const char *suffix;
+ int suffind;
+{
+ char *ret;
+ int plen, slen;
+
+ plen = (prefix && *prefix) ? strlen (prefix) : 0;
+ slen = strlen (suffix + suffind);
+ ret = (char *)xmalloc (plen + slen + 1);
+ if (plen)
+ strcpy (ret, prefix);
+ strcpy (ret + plen, suffix + suffind);
+ return ret;
+}
+
+/* Do the work of tilde expansion on FILENAME. FILENAME starts with a
+ tilde. If there is no expansion, call tilde_expansion_failure_hook.
+ This always returns a newly-allocated string, never static storage. */
+char *
+tilde_expand_word (filename)
+ const char *filename;
+{
+ char *dirname, *expansion, *username;
+ int user_len;
+ struct passwd *user_entry;
+
+ if (filename == 0)
+ return ((char *)NULL);
+
+ if (*filename != '~')
+ return (savestring (filename));
+
+ /* A leading `~/' or a bare `~' is *always* translated to the value of
+ $HOME or the home directory of the current user, regardless of any
+ preexpansion hook. */
+ if (filename[1] == '\0' || filename[1] == '/')
+ {
+ /* Prefix $HOME to the rest of the string. */
+ expansion = sh_get_env_value ("HOME");
+
+ /* If there is no HOME variable, look up the directory in
+ the password database. */
+ if (expansion == 0)
+ expansion = sh_get_home_dir ();
+
+ return (glue_prefix_and_suffix (expansion, filename, 1));
+ }
+
+ username = isolate_tilde_prefix (filename, &user_len);
+
+ if (tilde_expansion_preexpansion_hook)
+ {
+ expansion = (*tilde_expansion_preexpansion_hook) (username);
+ if (expansion)
+ {
+ dirname = glue_prefix_and_suffix (expansion, filename, user_len);
+ free (username);
+ free (expansion);
+ return (dirname);
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* No preexpansion hook, or the preexpansion hook failed. Look in the
+ password database. */
+ dirname = (char *)NULL;
+#if defined (HAVE_GETPWNAM)
+ user_entry = getpwnam (username);
+#else
+ user_entry = 0;
+#endif
+ if (user_entry == 0)
+ {
+ /* If the calling program has a special syntax for expanding tildes,
+ and we couldn't find a standard expansion, then let them try. */
+ if (tilde_expansion_failure_hook)
+ {
+ expansion = (*tilde_expansion_failure_hook) (username);
+ if (expansion)
+ {
+ dirname = glue_prefix_and_suffix (expansion, filename, user_len);
+ free (expansion);
+ }
+ }
+ free (username);
+ /* If we don't have a failure hook, or if the failure hook did not
+ expand the tilde, return a copy of what we were passed. */
+ if (dirname == 0)
+ dirname = savestring (filename);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ free (username);
+ dirname = glue_prefix_and_suffix (user_entry->pw_dir, filename, user_len);
+ }
+#if defined (HAVE_GETPWENT)
+ endpwent ();
+#endif
+ return (dirname);
+}
+
+
+#if defined (TEST)
+#undef NULL
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+main (argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char **argv;
+{
+ char *result, line[512];
+ int done = 0;
+
+ while (!done)
+ {
+ printf ("~expand: ");
+ fflush (stdout);
+
+ if (!gets (line))
+ strcpy (line, "done");
+
+ if ((strcmp (line, "done") == 0) ||
+ (strcmp (line, "quit") == 0) ||
+ (strcmp (line, "exit") == 0))
+ {
+ done = 1;
+ break;
+ }
+
+ result = tilde_expand (line);
+ printf (" --> %s\n", result);
+ free (result);
+ }
+ exit (0);
+}
+
+static void memory_error_and_abort ();
+
+static void *
+xmalloc (bytes)
+ size_t bytes;
+{
+ void *temp = (char *)malloc (bytes);
+
+ if (!temp)
+ memory_error_and_abort ();
+ return (temp);
+}
+
+static void *
+xrealloc (pointer, bytes)
+ void *pointer;
+ int bytes;
+{
+ void *temp;
+
+ if (!pointer)
+ temp = malloc (bytes);
+ else
+ temp = realloc (pointer, bytes);
+
+ if (!temp)
+ memory_error_and_abort ();
+
+ return (temp);
+}
+
+static void
+memory_error_and_abort ()
+{
+ fprintf (stderr, "readline: out of virtual memory\n");
+ abort ();
+}
+
+/*
+ * Local variables:
+ * compile-command: "gcc -g -DTEST -o tilde tilde.c"
+ * end:
+ */
+#endif /* TEST */
diff --git a/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/tilde/tilde.h b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/tilde/tilde.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c58ce20
--- /dev/null
+++ b/scratch/bash-3.1-postpatch/lib/tilde/tilde.h
@@ -0,0 +1,81 @@
+/* tilde.h: Externally available variables and function in libtilde.a. */
+
+/* Copyright (C) 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+ This file contains the Readline Library (the Library), a set of
+ routines for providing Emacs style line input to programs that ask
+ for it.
+
+ The Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ any later version.
+
+ The Library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
+ WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+ General Public License for more details.
+
+ The GNU General Public License is often shipped with GNU software, and
+ is generally kept in a file called COPYING or LICENSE. If you do not
+ have a copy of the license, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111 USA. */
+
+#if !defined (_TILDE_H_)
+# define _TILDE_H_
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+extern "C" {
+#endif
+
+/* A function can be defined using prototypes and compile on both ANSI C
+ and traditional C compilers with something like this:
+ extern char *func PARAMS((char *, char *, int)); */
+
+#if !defined (PARAMS)
+# if defined (__STDC__) || defined (__GNUC__) || defined (__cplusplus)
+# define PARAMS(protos) protos
+# else
+# define PARAMS(protos) ()
+# endif
+#endif
+
+typedef char *tilde_hook_func_t PARAMS((char *));
+
+/* If non-null, this contains the address of a function that the application
+ wants called before trying the standard tilde expansions. The function
+ is called with the text sans tilde, and returns a malloc()'ed string
+ which is the expansion, or a NULL pointer if the expansion fails. */
+extern tilde_hook_func_t *tilde_expansion_preexpansion_hook;
+
+/* If non-null, this contains the address of a function to call if the
+ standard meaning for expanding a tilde fails. The function is called
+ with the text (sans tilde, as in "foo"), and returns a malloc()'ed string
+ which is the expansion, or a NULL pointer if there is no expansion. */
+extern tilde_hook_func_t *tilde_expansion_failure_hook;
+
+/* When non-null, this is a NULL terminated array of strings which
+ are duplicates for a tilde prefix. Bash uses this to expand
+ `=~' and `:~'. */
+extern char **tilde_additional_prefixes;
+
+/* When non-null, this is a NULL terminated array of strings which match
+ the end of a username, instead of just "/". Bash sets this to
+ `:' and `=~'. */
+extern char **tilde_additional_suffixes;
+
+/* Return a new string which is the result of tilde expanding STRING. */
+extern char *tilde_expand PARAMS((const char *));
+
+/* Do the work of tilde expansion on FILENAME. FILENAME starts with a
+ tilde. If there is no expansion, call tilde_expansion_failure_hook. */
+extern char *tilde_expand_word PARAMS((const char *));
+
+/* Find the portion of the string beginning with ~ that should be expanded. */
+extern char *tilde_find_word PARAMS((const char *, int, int *));
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+}
+#endif
+
+#endif /* _TILDE_H_ */